summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes3
-rw-r--r--15560-8.txt21077
-rw-r--r--15560-8.zipbin0 -> 369989 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h.zipbin0 -> 3840050 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/15560-h.htm24127
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/110.jpgbin0 -> 69466 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/110s.jpgbin0 -> 18933 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/12.jpgbin0 -> 97953 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/124.jpgbin0 -> 54497 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/124s.jpgbin0 -> 14837 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/12s.jpgbin0 -> 21718 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/140.jpgbin0 -> 77664 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/140s.jpgbin0 -> 23528 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/152.jpgbin0 -> 36954 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/152s.jpgbin0 -> 11480 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/162.jpgbin0 -> 74777 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/162s.jpgbin0 -> 24280 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/172.jpgbin0 -> 73739 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/172s.jpgbin0 -> 21199 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/196.jpgbin0 -> 70858 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/196s.jpgbin0 -> 21465 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/220.jpgbin0 -> 83728 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/220s.jpgbin0 -> 24517 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/234.jpgbin0 -> 72408 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/234s.jpgbin0 -> 21496 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/246.jpgbin0 -> 74595 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/246s.jpgbin0 -> 22662 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/260.jpgbin0 -> 82268 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/260s.jpgbin0 -> 25341 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/262.jpgbin0 -> 93175 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/262s.jpgbin0 -> 22849 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/266.jpgbin0 -> 89144 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/266s.jpgbin0 -> 29071 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/290.jpgbin0 -> 74667 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/290s.jpgbin0 -> 24319 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/296.jpgbin0 -> 71117 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/296s.jpgbin0 -> 21546 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/30.jpgbin0 -> 87680 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/30s.jpgbin0 -> 28785 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/374.jpgbin0 -> 136146 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/374s.jpgbin0 -> 33508 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/38.jpgbin0 -> 83334 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/38s.jpgbin0 -> 21684 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/390.jpgbin0 -> 113064 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/390s.jpgbin0 -> 27320 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/418.jpgbin0 -> 108791 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/418s.jpgbin0 -> 27097 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/436.jpgbin0 -> 112754 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/436s.jpgbin0 -> 33271 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/440.jpgbin0 -> 82692 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/440s.jpgbin0 -> 27019 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/448.jpgbin0 -> 108174 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/448s.jpgbin0 -> 25736 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/48.jpgbin0 -> 82638 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/48s.jpgbin0 -> 26390 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/54.jpgbin0 -> 70317 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/54s.jpgbin0 -> 22233 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/6.jpgbin0 -> 87558 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/62.jpgbin0 -> 62954 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/62s.jpgbin0 -> 17908 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/6s.jpgbin0 -> 28334 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/80.jpgbin0 -> 68925 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/80s.jpgbin0 -> 22161 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/96.jpgbin0 -> 63022 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/96s.jpgbin0 -> 19715 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/cover-1.jpgbin0 -> 63816 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/cover-1s.jpgbin0 -> 19096 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/cover-2.jpgbin0 -> 65557 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/cover-2s.jpgbin0 -> 19726 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/frontis.jpgbin0 -> 75805 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560-h/images/frontiss.jpgbin0 -> 22244 bytes
-rw-r--r--15560.txt21077
-rw-r--r--15560.zipbin0 -> 369981 bytes
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
75 files changed, 66297 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6833f05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+* text=auto
+*.txt text
+*.md text
diff --git a/15560-8.txt b/15560-8.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b5bd935
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-8.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,21077 @@
+The Project Gutenberg eBook, Young Folks Treasury, Volume 3 (of 12), by
+Various, Edited by Hamilton Wright Mabie
+
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+
+
+
+Title: Young Folks Treasury, Volume 3 (of 12)
+ Classic Tales And Old-Fashioned Stories
+
+
+Author: Various
+
+Editor: Hamilton Wright Mabie
+
+Release Date: April 6, 2005 [eBook #15560]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
+
+
+***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK YOUNG FOLKS TREASURY, VOLUME 3 (OF
+12)***
+
+
+E-text prepared by Juliet Sutherland, Sandra Brown, and the Project
+Gutenberg Online Distributed Proofreading Team
+
+
+
+Note: Project Gutenberg also has an HTML version of this
+ file which includes the original illustrations.
+ See 15560-h.htm or 15560-h.zip:
+ (https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/1/5/5/6/15560/15560-h/15560-h.htm)
+ or
+ (https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/1/5/5/6/15560/15560-h.zip)
+
+
+
+
+
+YOUNG FOLKS' TREASURY
+
+In 12 Volumes
+
+HAMILTON WRIGHT MABIE, Editor
+
+EDWARD EVERETT HALE, Associate Editor
+
+VOLUME III: CLASSIC TALES AND OLD-FASHIONED STORIES
+
+HAMILTON WRIGHT MABIE, Editor
+
+DANIEL EDWIN WHEELER, Assistant Editor
+
+New York
+The University Society Inc.
+Publishers
+
+1909
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+PARTIAL LIST OF EDITORS AND CONTRIBUTORS
+
+
+HAMILTON WRIGHT MABIE
+Editor
+
+EDWARD EVERETT HALE
+Associate Editor
+
+DANIEL EDWIN WHEELER
+Managing Editor
+
+
+Partial List of Contributors, Assistant Editors and Advisers:
+
+
+NICHOLAS MURRAY BUTLER, President Columbia University.
+
+WILLIAM R. HARPER, Late President Chicago University.
+
+Hon. THEODORE ROOSEVELT, Ex-President of the United States.
+
+Hon. GROVER CLEVELAND, Late President of the United States.
+
+JAMES CARDINAL GIBBONS, American Roman Catholic prelate.
+
+LAWRENCE J. BURPEE, Librarian Ottawa Public Library; author of
+"Canadian Life in Town and Country," etc.
+
+BLISS CARMAN, poet, essayist, and editor.
+
+THOMAS B. FLINT, Clerk House of Commons, Canada; editor "Parliamentary
+Practice and Procedure."
+
+AGNES C. LAUT, author "Lords of the North," "Hudson's Bay Company,"
+etc.
+
+BECKLES WILLSON, author of "The Romance of Canada," "Life and Letters
+of James Wolfe," etc.
+
+EDWARD W. BOK, editor "Ladies' Home Journal."
+
+HENRY VAN DYKE, author, poet, and Professor of English Literature,
+Princeton University.
+
+LYMAN ABBOTT, author, editor of "The Outlook."
+
+JACOB A. RIIS, author and journalist.
+
+EDWARD EVERETT HALE, JR., Professor at Union College.
+
+CHARLES G.D. ROBERTS, writer of animal stories.
+
+JANET H. KELMAN, author "Stories from the Crusades," "A Book of
+Butterflies," etc.
+
+VAUTIER GOLDING, author "Life of Henry M. Stanley," etc.
+
+LENA DALKEITH, author "A Book of Beasts," "Stories from French
+History," etc.
+
+H.E. MARSHALL, author "A Child's History of England." "History of
+English Literature," etc.
+
+JOEL CHANDLER HARRIS, creator of "Uncle Remus."
+
+GEORGE CARY EGGLESTON, novelist and journalist.
+
+WILLIAM BLAIKIE, author of "How to Get Strong and How to Stay So."
+
+JOSEPH JACOBS, folklore writer and editor of the "Jewish
+Encyclopedia."
+
+Mrs. VIRGINIA TERHUNE ("Marlon Harland"), author of "Common Sense in
+the Household," etc.
+
+A.D. INNES, author "England Under the Tudors," "England's Industrial
+Development," etc.
+
+EDMUND F. SELLAR, author "Life of Nelson," etc.
+
+MARY MACGREGOR, author "King Arthur's Knights," etc.
+
+JEANIE LANG, author "Life of General Gordon," etc.
+
+Rev. THEODORE WOOD, F.E.S., writer on natural history.
+
+MARGARET E. SANGSTER, author of "The Art of Home-Making," etc.
+
+HERBERT T. WADE, editor and writer on physics.
+
+JOHN H. CLIFFORD, editor and writer.
+
+ERNEST INGERSOLL, naturalist and author.
+
+IDA PRENTICE WHITCOMB, author of "Young People's Story of Music,"
+"Heroes of History," etc.
+
+MARK HAMBOURG, pianist and composer.
+
+Mme. BLANCHE MARCHESI, opera singer and teacher.
+
+ELBRIDGE S. BROOKS, author "Historic Boys," etc.
+
+PAULINE C. BOUVÉ, author "Stories of American Heroes for Boys and
+Girls," etc.
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+
+Introduction
+
+
+CLASSIC TALES
+
+
+Don Quixote
+
+By Miguel Cervantes. Adapted by John Lang
+
+ I. HOW DON QUIXOTE WAS KNIGHTED
+
+ II. HOW DON QUIXOTE RESCUED ANDRES; AND HOW HE RETURNED HOME
+
+ III. HOW DON QUIXOTE AND SANCHO PANZA STARTED ON THEIR SEARCH FOR
+ ADVENTURES; AND HOW DON QUIXOTE FOUGHT WITH THE WINDMILLS
+
+ IV. HOW DON QUIXOTE WON A HELMET; HOW HE FOUGHT WITH TWO ARMIES; AND
+ HOW SANCHO'S ASS WAS STOLEN
+
+ V. HOW DON QUIXOTE SAW DULCINEA
+
+ VI. HOW DON QUIXOTE FOUGHT WITH A LION; AND HOW HE DEFEATED THE MOORS
+
+ VII. THE BATTLE WITH THE BULLS; THE FIGHT WITH THE KNIGHT OF THE WHITE
+ MOON; AND HOW DON QUIXOTE DIED
+
+
+Gulliver's Travels: Voyage to Lilliput
+
+By Jonathan Swift. Adapted by John Lang
+
+ I. GULLIVER'S BIRTH AND EARLY VOYAGES
+
+ II. GULLIVER IS WRECKED ON THE COAST OF LILLIPUT
+
+ III. GULLIVER IS TAKEN AS A PRISONER TO THE CAPITAL OF LILLIPUT
+
+ IV. GULLIVER IS FREED, AND CAPTURES THE BLEFUSCAN FLEET
+
+ V. GULLIVER'S ESCAPE FROM LILLIPUT AND RETURN TO ENGLAND
+
+
+The Arabian Nights
+
+Adapted by Amy Steedman
+
+ I. ALADDIN AND THE WONDERFUL LAMP
+
+ II. THE ENCHANTED HORSE
+
+ III. SINDBAD THE SAILOR
+
+
+The Iliad of Homer
+
+Adapted by Jeanie Lang
+
+ I. THE STORY Of WHAT LED TO THE SIEGE OF TROY
+
+ II. THE COUNCIL
+
+ III. THE FIGHT BETWEEN PARIS AND MENELAUS
+
+ IV. HECTOR AND ANDROMACHE
+
+ V. HOW PATROCLUS FOUGHT AND DIED
+
+ VI. THE ROUSING OF ACHILLES
+
+
+The Odyssey of Homer
+
+Adapted by Jeanie Lang
+
+ I. WHAT HAPPENED IN ITHACA WHILE ODYSSEUS WAS AWAY
+
+ II. HOW ODYSSEUS CAME HOME
+
+
+Robinson Crusoe
+
+By Daniel Defoe. Adapted by John Lang
+
+ I. HOW ROBINSON FIRST WENT TO SEA; AND HOW HE WAS SHIPWRECKED
+
+ II. ROBINSON WORKS HARD AT MAKING HIMSELF A HOME
+
+ III. THE EARTHQUAKE AND HURRICANE; AND HOW ROBINSON BUILT A BOAT
+
+ IV. ROBINSON BUILDS A SECOND BOAT, IN WHICH HE IS SWEPT OUT TO SEA
+
+ V. ROBINSON SEES A FOOTPRINT ON THE SAND, FINDS A CAVE, AND RESCUES
+ FRIDAY
+
+ VI. ROBINSON TRAINS FRIDAY AND THEY BUILD A LARGE BOAT; THEY RESCUE
+ TWO PRISONERS FROM THE CANNIBALS
+
+ VII. ARRIVAL OF AN ENGLISH SHIP: ROBINSON SAILS FOR HOME
+
+
+Canterbury Tales
+
+By Geoffrey Chaucer. Adapted by Janet Harvey Kelman
+
+ I. DORIGEN
+
+ II. EMELIA
+
+ III. GRISELDA
+
+
+The Pilgrim's Progress
+
+By John Bunyan. Adapted by Mary Macgregor
+
+
+Tales from Shakespeare
+
+By Charles and Mary Lamb
+
+ I. THE TEMPEST
+
+ II. A MIDSUMMER NIGHT'S DREAM
+
+
+OLD-FASHIONED STORIES
+
+
+Simple Susan
+
+By Maria Edgeworth. Adapted by Louey Chisholm
+
+ I. QUEEN OF THE MAY
+
+ II. BAD NEWS
+
+ III. SUSAN'S GUINEA-FOWL
+
+ IV. SUSAN VISITS THE ABBEY
+
+ V. SUSAN'S PET LAMB
+
+ VI. THE BLIND HARPER
+
+ VII. GOOD NEWS
+
+ VIII. BARBARA VISITS THE ABBEY
+
+ IX. A SURPRISE FOR SUSAN
+
+ X. BARBARA'S ACCIDENT
+
+ XI. THE PRIZE-GIVING
+
+ XII. ATTORNEY CASE IN TROUBLE
+
+ XIII. SUSAN'S BIRTHDAY
+
+
+Limby Lumpy
+
+
+The Sore Tongue
+
+By Jane Taylor
+
+
+Eyes and No Eyes, or The Art of Seeing
+
+By John Aikin and Mrs. Barbauld
+
+
+Prince Life
+
+By G.P.R. James
+
+
+The Fruits of Disobedience, or The Kidnapped Child
+
+
+Dicky Random, or Good Nature Is Nothing Without Good Conduct
+
+
+Embellishment
+
+By Jacob Abbott
+
+
+The Oyster Patties
+
+
+Two Little Boys
+
+By Thomas Day
+
+ I. THE GOOD-NATURED LITTLE BOY
+
+ II. THE ILL-NATURED LITTLE BOY
+
+
+The Purple Jar
+
+By Maria Edgeworth
+
+
+The Three Cakes
+
+By Armand Berquin
+
+
+Amendment
+
+
+Trial
+
+By John Aikin and Mrs. Barbauld
+
+
+A Plot of Gunpowder: An Old Lady Seized for a Guy
+
+Ascribed to William Martin ("Peter Parley")
+
+
+Uncle David's Nonsensical Story About Giants and Fairies
+
+By Katherine Sinclair
+
+
+The Inquisitive Girl
+
+
+Busy Idleness
+
+By Jane Taylor
+
+
+The Renowned History of Little Goody Two-Shoes
+
+Ascribed to Oliver Goldsmith
+
+INTRODUCTION
+
+ I. HOW AND ABOUT LITTLE MARGERY AND HER BROTHER
+
+ II. HOW AND ABOUT MR. SMITH
+
+ III. HOW LITTLE MARGERY OBTAINED THE NAME OF GOODY TWO-SHOES, AND
+ WHAT HAPPENED IN THE PARISH
+
+ IV. HOW LITTLE MARGERY LEARNED TO READ, AND BY DEGREES TAUGHT OTHERS
+
+ V. HOW LITTLE TWO-SHOES BECAME A TROTTING TUTORESS, AND HOW SHE
+ TAUGHT HER YOUNG PUPILS
+
+ VI. HOW THE WHOLE PARISH WAS FRIGHTENED
+
+ VII. CONTAINING AN ACCOUNT OF ALL THE SPIRITS OR THINGS SHE SAW IN THE
+ CHURCH
+
+ VIII. OF SOMETHING WHICH HAPPENED TO LITTLE MARGERY TWO-SHOES IN A
+ BARN, MORE DREADFUL THAN THE GHOST IN THE CHURCH; AND HOW SHE
+ RETURNED GOOD FOR EVIL TO HER ENEMY, SIR TIMOTHY
+
+ IX. HOW LITTLE MARGERY WAS MADE PRINCIPAL OF A COUNTRY COLLEGE
+
+
+(Part Two.) The Renowned History of Mrs. Margery Two-Shoes
+
+ I. OF HER SCHOOL, HER USHERS, OR ASSISTANTS, AND HER MANNER OF
+ TEACHING
+
+ II. A SCENE OF DISTRESS IN A SCHOOL
+
+ III. OF THE AMAZING SAGACITY AND INSTINCT OF A LITTLE DOG
+
+ IV. WHAT HAPPENED AT FARMER GROVE'S, AND HOW SHE GRATIFIED HIM FOR
+ THE USE OF HIS ROOM
+
+ V. THE CASE OF MRS. MARGERY
+
+ VI. THE TRUE USE OF RICHES
+
+
+
+
+ILLUSTRATIONS
+
+
+VOLUME III
+
+
+THE HORSE FLEW THROUGH THE AIR
+
+"PAY AT ONCE, YOU SCOUNDREL"
+
+HORSE AND MAN WERE SENT ROLLING ON THE GROUND
+
+THE BULLS HAD RUN RIGHT OVER HIM AND ROZINANTE
+
+HE FOUND THAT HIS ARMS AND LEGS WERE TIGHTLY FASTENED TO THE GROUND
+
+GULLIVER IN LILLIPUT
+
+ON THIS OCCASION, GULLIVER ATE MORE THAN USUAL
+
+ALADDIN AND THE MAGICIAN
+
+HINDBAD WAS CARRYING A VERY HEAVY LOAD
+
+FROM FAR AND WIDE DID THE GREEK HOSTS GATHER
+
+ANDROMACHE IN CAPTIVITY
+
+TELEMACHUS KNELT WHERE THE GRAY WATER BROKE ON THE SAND
+
+THE ESCAPE FROM THE SHIPWRECK
+
+HE SAW THE MARK OF A NAKED FOOT ON THE SAND
+
+ROBINSON RAN TO THE WHITE PRISONER AND CUT HIS BONDS
+
+ALAS! OF ALL THE SHIPS I SEE, IS THERE NEVER ONE THAT WILL BRING MY
+LORD HOME?
+
+THE CURTAIN AT THE DOORWAY WAS DRAWN ASIDE
+
+THEN DID CHRISTIAN DRAW HIS SWORD
+
+MIRANDA WATCHING THE STORM
+
+THE FAIRIES SING TITANIA TO SLEEP
+
+BENDING DOWN A BRANCH OF THE LABURNUM-TREE
+
+"IT WON'T DO," SAID BARBARA, TURNING HER BACK
+
+"AND HERE'S HER CROWN!" CRIED ROSE
+
+SHE SPOKE OF WHAT SHE DID NOT UNDERSTAND
+
+HE WAS WANTED TO HOLD THE JUG OF MILK
+
+HE TOOK THE CURRANT TART, AND ... THREW IT AT HIS NURSE
+
+ROSAMOND RAN UP TO IT WITH AN EXCLAMATION OF JOY
+
+WIDOW DOROTHY CAREFUL MADE A CURTSEY
+
+THE GOAT DASHED IN AMONG THEM AND THE CHAIR WAS UPSET
+
+EACH OF MY VISITORS IS QUITE AN EXCLUSIVE
+
+IF LOUISA RECEIVED A NOTE, SHE CAREFULLY LOCKED IT UP
+
+
+(Many of the illustrations in this volume are reproduced by special
+permission of E.P. Dutton & Company, owners of American rights.)
+
+
+
+
+INTRODUCTION
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+CLASSIC TALES
+
+
+After our boys and girls have read the first half of this volume,
+containing selected and simplified stories from some of the greatest
+books of all time, their authors will cease to be merely names. Homer,
+Shakespeare, Chaucer, Cervantes and Bunyan will be found here as
+familiar and easy in style as "Cinderella" or "The Three Bears." True
+enough, the first word in "Classic Tales" may look somewhat alarming
+to the eyes of youthful seekers after romance and adventure, but we
+challenge them to turn to any one of these selections from immortal
+masterpieces and not become spellbound and, moreover, impatient for
+more. And, believing now that they have grown very much interested in
+these famous books, of course we also believe they want to learn
+something about them.
+
+Following the order of our stories we must begin with "Don Quixote."
+Its author wrote it under great difficulties and distress; but one
+would never think so, as it is full of laughable doings. When you read
+our selections you must not think that Don Quixote was merely a silly
+old man, for indeed he was a very noble gentleman and tried with all
+his might to do what he believed to be his duty, and in no act of his
+life was there ever a stain of dishonor or of meanness. As for his
+queer fancies, you will find in your own experience that many things
+are not as they seem.
+
+Next comes one of Gulliver's voyages. Under all this account of a tiny
+race of people there is fun poked at government and its ministers.
+But we do not concern ourselves with such matters--all we think about
+is the wonderful deeds of Gulliver in the land of the Lilliputians. Do
+not think such people are impossible, for did not Stanley, the
+explorer, find in Africa a race of dwarfs so little that he called
+them pygmies? And perhaps when some of our young readers grow up,
+they, too, may discover small folks in the world.
+
+In regard to the "Arabian Nights," from which we give you three choice
+stories, you ought to know the way they came to be told. Once upon a
+time, a Sultan of Arabia thought that all women were of not much use,
+so every day he married a new wife, and before twenty-four hours were
+over he ordered that she have her head cut off. One brave woman
+thought of a clever plan by which she could end this cruelty. She went
+to the palace and offered to marry the Sultan, and that night she
+began to tell him such fascinating stories that when morning came he
+still wished to hear more. He commanded that she should not be
+beheaded until all her stories were told. Then for a thousand and one
+nights, night after night, she gave him fresh stories, and by the end
+of that time the Sultan had fallen very much in love with her.
+Naturally, they lived happily forever after. Perhaps these three
+stories which we have selected will compel you to seek out all the
+rest, and if you do, we are quite sure you will not wonder that the
+brave lady won the heart of the wicked Sultan and made him good.
+
+From the "Iliad" and the "Odyssey" of Homer, we have given you some
+soul-stirring happenings. Several thousand years ago these stories
+were sung by a blind minstrel named Homer. Some day you may read
+Homer's sublime poetry in the original Greek, and the selections which
+we give you will help you to remember the stories when you are
+struggling with that difficult language.
+
+Parts of the old favorite "Robinson Crusoe" follow the Grecian tales,
+and we trust its simple language will make the little ones love it
+more than ever. You will remember that Defoe wrote this nearly two
+hundred years ago. Everybody liked long stories in those days, but we
+have all heard children of to-day ask when a somewhat lengthy book
+would end, no matter how interesting, and many grown-ups are guilty
+of reading the close of a story before they have gone very far in it.
+So with that in mind we have put down in brief form most of Robinson
+Crusoe's important adventures during his twenty-eight years on the
+desert island.
+
+Here we also give three splendid stories from Chaucer's "Canterbury
+Tales," which were supposedly told to one another by a party of
+pilgrims on their way to Canterbury. According to our gentle author,
+who was one of them, they stopped over night at a house in England
+called the Tabard Inn, and here they passed the hours repeating fine
+stories. Afterward Chaucer wrote these down in a book in quaint old
+English. One might look at these words all day long and not know in
+the least what what some of them meant, though they do hold such
+beautiful tales.
+
+Now about "Pilgrim's Progress." More than two hundred years ago a
+tinker named John Bunyan was in jail, but one night this poor man left
+his prison and wandered into the land of dreams. There he saw
+wonderful sights and heard marvelous things, and as there was no one
+to listen to his dream, John Bunyan wrote it down, and had it made
+into a book. And this he called "The Pilgrim's Progress." It was about
+the journey and adventures of a pilgrim and his companions. In our
+version we have given most of the dream, but when the boys and girls
+grow older they will want to read it all in Bunyan's own language, and
+we hope this account will lead them to do so.
+
+Shakespeare is a magic name to grown-ups, but to children it does not
+mean much. All they know is, that sometimes this name is spelled on
+the back of one fat volume, sometimes on three, sometimes on a dozen
+or more, but of the inside they know almost nothing, and when they
+hear persons say that Shakespeare is the greatest writer that ever
+lived, they wonder about it. If they take down a volume containing one
+of his plays, they think it very dull, but here in simple language we
+present the stories of two of the most fairy-like and beautiful plays,
+as retold for children by Charles and Mary Lamb.
+
+DANIEL EDWIN WHEELER.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+OLD-FASHIONED STORIES
+
+
+There is much truth in the saying that "old things are best, old books
+are best, old friends are best." We like to connect in thought our
+best-loved books and our best-loved friends. A good friend must have
+some of the wisdom of a good book, though good books often talk to us
+with wisdom and also with humor and courtesy greater than any living
+friend may show. "Sometimes we think books are the best friends; they
+never interrupt or contradict or criticise us."
+
+Every year in our own country about ten thousand books are published.
+Most of them die in early life. Three hundred years from now every one
+of this year's ten thousand books will be dead and forgotten, except
+possibly thirty or forty. The very best books do not die young. The
+books written about three hundred years ago that are read to-day--like
+Shakespeare's plays--are as a rule the books that deserve to live
+forever. And, "Gentle Reader," if you are wise you will see _why_ the
+old books are best: they are the wheat, and the winds of time have
+blown only the chaff away.
+
+Is it not strange that in the olden times so few poems or books or
+stories were written for children? The "Iliad," the stories of King
+Arthur, the "Canterbury Tales," and "Gulliver's Travels" and "Robinson
+Crusoe," were written for men and women.
+
+But happily this is the children's age, and now nearly half of all the
+books written are written for children. You must remember, however,
+that all boys and girls are children--in the eyes of the law--till
+they are twenty-one years old.
+
+We know a little boy who read last week a very modern story. The book
+was bound in red cloth. It had a gilt top and very modern pictures
+drawn by a great artist and printed in three or four colors. How
+different from the books of one hundred years ago, with their black
+covers and queer pictures!
+
+This story read by the little New York boy last week has been read by
+many little boys in Iowa, and by many little girls in Georgia. It
+tells about an orphan boy who was "bound out" to a farmer who treated
+him cruelly. He ran away to the Rocky Mountain region, where he had
+many adventures with robbers and Indians and blizzards. He was strong
+and heroic; he could shoot straight and ride the swiftest horses, and
+nothing ever hurt him very much.
+
+This, as I have said, is a modern story. It does not tell the reader
+to be truthful and good. It just tells him a story of thrilling
+adventures and daring escapes from danger. But the old-fashioned story
+is different; and now we are getting close to our subject.
+
+I will tell you all about the old-fashioned stories in a moment; but I
+must remind you that these old stories were written about a hundred
+years ago. They were usually written to teach a moral lesson. Dear old
+John Aikin, or his sister Anna Letitia Barbauld, or Maria Edgeworth,
+or Jane Taylor would say some morning--at any rate, so it seems to
+me--"I will write a story to-day to teach boys and girls to be
+industrious." And so "Busy Idleness" was written. Or one of these old
+authors would decide to write a story the main object of which was to
+teach little girls not to be too curious, and so "The Inquisitive
+Girl" was written. Both of these stories, and many others equally
+good, are found in this volume.
+
+I could really tell you many interesting things about these
+old-fashioned stories but I will do something better--urge you to read
+them yourself. They are quaint, delightful, and entertaining stories,
+besides teaching a moral. You boys and girls should read every one of
+them, and then read them again, out loud, to your mothers or to
+anybody else who will listen.
+
+Among all the old-fashioned stories in this volume I find only one
+that seems to me "really funny," and that is "Uncle David's
+Nonsensical Story about the Giants and Fairies." Think of a giant so
+tall that "he was obliged to climb up a ladder to comb his own hair."
+But this bit of humor is not so good as a very modern nonsense-story
+entitled "The Giant's Shoes," which I read the other day, and from
+which the Managing Editor permits me to quote this little passage:
+
+"The Giant slept for three weeks at a time, and two days after he
+woke his breakfast was brought to him, consisting of bright brown
+horses sprinkled on his bread and butter. Besides his boots, the Giant
+had a pair of shoes, and in one of them his wife lived when she was at
+home; on other occasions she lived in the other shoe. She was a
+sensible, practical kind of woman, with two wooden legs and a
+clothes-horse, but in other respects not rich. The wooden legs were
+kept pointed at both ends, in order that if the Giant were
+dissatisfied with his breakfast, he might pick up any stray people
+that were within reach, using his wife as a fork; this annoyed the
+inhabitants of the district, so that they built their church in a
+southwesterly direction from the castle, behind the Giant's back, that
+he might not be able to pick them up as they went in. But those who
+stayed outside to play pitch-and-toss were exposed to great danger and
+sufferings."
+
+G.J.B.
+
+
+
+
+CLASSIC TALES
+
+
+
+
+DON QUIXOTE
+
+By MIGUEL CERVANTES
+
+ADAPTED BY JOHN LANG
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+HOW DON QUIXOTE WAS KNIGHTED
+
+
+Some three or four hundred years ago, there lived in sunny Spain an
+old gentleman named Quixada, who owned a house and a small property
+near a village in La Mancha.
+
+With him lived his niece, a housekeeper, and a man who looked after
+Quixada's farm and his one old white horse, which, though its master
+imagined it to be an animal of great strength and beauty, was really
+as lean as Quixada himself and as broken down as any old cab horse.
+
+Quixada had nothing in the world to do in the shape of work, and so,
+his whole time was taken up in reading old books about knights and
+giants, and ladies shut up in enchanted castles by wicked ogres. In
+time, so fond did he become of such tales that he passed his days, and
+even the best part of his nights, in reading them. His mind was so
+wholly taken up in this way that at last he came to believe that he
+himself lived in a land of giants and of ogres, and that it was his
+duty to ride forth on his noble steed, to the rescue of unhappy
+Princesses.
+
+In the lumber-room of Quixada's house there had lain, ever since he
+was born, a rusty old suit of armor, which had belonged to his
+great-grandfather. This was now got out, and Quixada spent many days
+in polishing and putting it in order.
+
+Unfortunately, there was no more than half of the helmet to be found,
+and a knight cannot ride forth without a helmet.
+
+So Quixada made the other half of strong pasteboard; and to prove that
+it was strong enough, when finished, he drew his sword and gave the
+helmet a great slash. Alas! a whole week's work was ruined by that one
+stroke; the pasteboard flew into pieces. This troubled Quixada sadly,
+but he set to work at once and made another helmet of pasteboard,
+lining it with thin sheets of iron, and it looked so well that, this
+time, he put it to no test with his sword.
+
+Now that his armor was complete, it occurred to him that he must give
+his horse a name--every knight's horse should have a good name--and
+after four days thought he decided that "Rozinante" would best suit
+the animal.
+
+Then, for himself, after eight days of puzzling, he resolved that he
+should be called Don Quixote de la Mancha.
+
+There was but one thing more. Every knight of olden time had a lady,
+whom he called the Mistress of his Heart, whose glove he wore in his
+helmet; and if anybody dared to deny that this lady was the most
+beautiful woman in the whole world, then the knight made him prove his
+words by fighting.
+
+So it was necessary that Don Quixote should select some lady as the
+Mistress of his Heart.
+
+Near La Mancha there lived a stout country lass, for whom some years
+before Don Quixote had had a kind of liking. Who, therefore, could
+better take the place of Mistress of his Heart? To whom could he
+better send the defeated knights and ogres whom he was going out to
+fight? It was true that her name. Aldonza Lorenzo, did not sound like
+that of a Princess or lady of high birth; so he determined in future
+to call her Dulcinea del Toboso. No Princess could have a sweeter
+name!
+
+All being now ready, one morning Don Quixote got up before daylight,
+and without saying a word to anybody, put on his armor, took his
+sword, and spear, and shield, saddled "Rozinante," and started on his
+search for adventures.
+
+But before he had gone very far, a dreadful thought struck him. He had
+not been knighted! Moreover, he had read in his books that until a
+knight had done some great deed, he must wear white armor, and be
+without any device or coat of arms on his shield. What was to be done?
+He was so staggered by this thought that he almost felt that he must
+turn back. But then he remembered that he had read how adventurers
+were sometimes knighted by persons whom they happened to meet on the
+road. And as to his armor, why, he thought he might scour and polish
+that till nothing could be whiter. So he rode on, letting "Rozinante"
+take which road he pleased, that being, he supposed, as good a way as
+any of looking for adventures.
+
+All day he rode, to his sorrow without finding anything worth calling
+an adventure.
+
+At last as evening began to fall, and when he and his horse were both
+very weary, they came in sight of an inn. Don Quixote no sooner saw
+the inn than he fancied it to be a great castle, and he halted at some
+distance from it, expecting that, as in days of old, a dwarf would
+certainly appear on the battlements, and, by sounding a trumpet, give
+notice of the arrival of a knight. But no dwarf appeared, and as
+"Rozinante" showed great haste to reach the stable, Don Quixote began
+to move towards the inn.
+
+At this moment it happened that a swineherd in a field near at hand
+sounded his horn to bring his herd of pigs home to be fed. Don
+Quixote, imagining that this must be the dwarf at last giving notice
+of his coming, rode quickly up to the inn door, beside which it
+chanced that there stood two very impudent young women, whom the
+Knight imagined to be two beautiful ladies taking the air at the
+castle gate.
+
+Astonished at the sight of so strange a figure, and a little
+frightened, the girls turned to run away. But Don Quixote stopped
+them.
+
+"I beseech ye, ladies, do not fly," he said. "I will harm no one,
+least of all maidens of rank so high as yours."
+
+And much more he said, whereat the young women laughed so loud and so
+long that Don Quixote became very angry, and there is no saying what
+he might not have done had not the innkeeper at that moment come out.
+This innkeeper was very fat and good-natured, and anxious not to
+offend anybody, but even he could hardly help laughing when he saw Don
+Quixote. However, he very civilly asked the Knight to dismount and
+offered him everything that the inn could provide.
+
+Don Quixote being by this time both tired and hungry, with some
+difficulty got off his horse and handed it to the innkeeper (to whom
+he spoke as governor of the castle), asking him to take the greatest
+care of "Rozinante," for in the whole world there was no better steed.
+
+When the landlord returned from the stable, he found Don Quixote in a
+room, where, with the help of the two young women, he was trying to
+get rid of his armor. His back and breastplates had been taken off,
+but by no means could his helmet be removed without cutting the green
+ribbons with which he had tied it on, and this the Knight would not
+allow.
+
+There was nothing for it, therefore, but to keep his helmet on all
+night, and to eat and drink in it, which was more than he could do
+without help. However, one of the young women fed him, and the
+innkeeper having made a kind of funnel, through it poured the wine
+into his mouth, and Don Quixote ate his supper in great peace of mind.
+
+There was but one thing that still vexed him. He had not yet been
+knighted.
+
+On this subject he thought long and deeply, and at last he asked the
+innkeeper to come with him to the stable. Having shut the door, Don
+Quixote threw himself at the landlord's feet, saying, "I will never
+rise from this place, most valorous Knight, until you grant me a
+boon."
+
+The innkeeper was amazed, but as he could not by any means make Don
+Quixote rise, he promised to do whatever was asked.
+
+"Then, noble sir," said Don Quixote, "the boon which I crave is that
+to-morrow you will be pleased to grant me the honor of knighthood."
+
+The landlord, when he heard such talk, thought that the wisest thing
+he could do was to humor his guest, and he readily promised. Thereupon
+Don Quixote very happily rose to his feet, and after some further talk
+he said to the innkeeper that this night he would "watch his armor" in
+the chapel of the castle, it being the duty of any one on whom the
+honor of knighthood was to be conferred, to stand on his feet in the
+chapel, praying, until the morning. The innkeeper, thinking that
+great sport might come of this, encouraged Don Quixote, but as his own
+chapel had lately--so he said--been pulled down in order that a better
+might be built, he advised Don Quixote to watch that night in the
+courtyard. This was "lawful in a case where a chapel was not at hand.
+And in the morning," he said, "I will knight you."
+
+"Have you any money?" then asked the innkeeper.
+
+"Not a penny," said Don Quixote, "for I never yet read of any knight
+who carried money with him."
+
+"You are greatly mistaken," answered the innkeeper. "Most knights had
+squires, who carried their money and clean shirts and other things.
+But when a knight had no squire, he always carried his money and his
+shirts, and salve for his wounds, in a little bag behind his saddle. I
+must therefore advise you never in future to go anywhere without
+money."
+
+Don Quixote promised to remember this. Then taking his armor, he went
+into the inn yard and laid it in a horse-trough.
+
+Backwards and forwards, spear in hand, he marched in the moonlight,
+very solemnly keeping his eyes on his armor, while the innkeeper's
+other guests, laughing, looked on from a distance.
+
+Now it happened that a carrier who lodged at the inn came into the
+yard to water his mules, and this he could not do while the armor lay
+in the horse-trough. As Don Quixote saw the man come up, "Take heed,
+rash Knight," he cried. "Defile not by a touch the armor of the most
+brave knight-errant that ever wore a sword."
+
+But the mule-driver took no notice of Don Quixote. He picked up the
+armor and threw it away.
+
+Don Quixote no sooner saw this than, raising his eyes to heaven, and
+calling on his Lady Dulcinea del Toboso, he lifted up his spear with
+both hands and gave the mule-driver such a whack over the head that
+the man fell down senseless. Then, picking up his armor and putting it
+back in the horse-trough, he went on with his march, taking no further
+notice of the poor mule-driver.
+
+Soon up came another carrier who also wanted to water his mules.
+
+Not a word did Don Quixote say this time, but he lifted up his spear
+and smote so heavily that he broke the man's head in three or four
+places. The poor wretch made such an outcry that all the people in the
+inn came running, and the friends of the two carriers began to pelt
+Don Quixote with stones. But drawing his sword, and holding his shield
+in front of him, he defied them all, crying, "Come on, base knaves!
+Draw nearer if you dare!"
+
+The landlord now came hurrying up and stopped the stone-throwing;
+then, having calmed Don Quixote, he said that there was no need for
+him to watch his armor any longer; to finish the ceremony it would now
+be enough if he were touched on the neck and shoulders with a sword.
+Don Quixote was quite satisfied, and prayed the innkeeper to get the
+business over as quickly as possible, "for," said he, "if I were but
+knighted, and should see myself attacked, I believe that I should not
+leave a man alive in this castle."
+
+The innkeeper, a good deal alarmed at this, and anxious to get rid of
+him, hurried off and got the book in which he kept his accounts, which
+he pretended was a kind of book of prayer. Having also brought the two
+young women, and a boy to hold a candle, he ordered Don Quixote to
+kneel. Then muttering from his book, as if he were reading, he
+finished by giving Don Quixote a good blow on the neck, and a slap on
+the back, with the flat of a sword. After this, one of the young women
+belted the sword round the newly made knight's waist, while the other
+buckled on his spurs, and having at once saddled "Rozinante." Don
+Quixote was ready to set out.
+
+The innkeeper was only too glad to see him go, even without paying for
+his supper.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+HOW DON QUIXOTE RESCUED ANDRES; AND HOW HE RETURNED HOME
+
+
+As he rode along in the early morning light, Don Quixote began to
+think that it would be well that he should return home for a little,
+there to lay in a stock of money and of clean shirts, and he turned
+his willing horse's head in the direction of his village.
+
+But ere he had gone far on his way, coming from a thicket he fancied
+that he heard cries of distress.
+
+"Certainly these are the moans of some poor creature in want of help,"
+thought Don Quixote. "I thank Heaven for so soon giving me the chance
+to perform my duty as a knight."
+
+And he rode quickly towards the sounds. No sooner had he reached the
+wood than he saw a horse tied to a tree, and bound to another was a
+lad of fifteen, all naked above the waist. By his side stood a
+countryman beating him with a strap, and with every blow calling out,
+"I'll teach you to keep your eyes open, you young scamp. I'll teach
+you to keep your mouth shut."
+
+The boy howled with pain. Quickly Don Quixote rode up to the man.
+
+"Sir Knight," said he angrily, "I would have thee to know that it is
+an unworthy act to strike one who cannot defend himself. Mount thy
+steed, therefore, take thy spear, and I will teach thee that thou art
+a coward."
+
+The countryman gave himself up for lost, and he gasped out very humbly
+that the boy was his servant, through whose carelessness many of the
+sheep that he should have watched had been lost, and that therefore he
+was giving him a sound beating. "And," said he, "because I beat him
+for his carelessness, he says I do it to cheat him out of his wages."
+
+"What!" shouted Don Quixote, "do you dare to lie to me? By the sun
+above us, I have a mind to run you through with my spear. Pay the boy
+this instant, and let him go free. What does he owe you, boy?"
+
+The boy said that the man owed him nine months' wages.
+
+"Pay at once, you scoundrel, unless you want to be killed," roared Don
+Quixote.
+
+The poor man, trembling with fear, said that there was a mistake; he
+did not owe nearly so much, and besides, he had no money with him. But
+if Andres would go home with him he would pay every penny.
+
+"Go home with him!" cried the boy. "I know a trick worth two of that.
+No sooner will he have me home than he'll take the skin off me. No,
+no, not I!"
+
+"He will not dare to touch you," said the Knight. "I command him, and
+that is enough. If he swears by his order of knighthood to do this
+thing, I will let him go, and he will pay you your wages."
+
+"Of course I will," said the man. "Come along with me. Andres, and I
+swear I'll give you all I owe."
+
+"Remember, then, what you have promised, for I am Don Quixote de la
+Mancha, the righter of wrongs, and it is at your peril to disobey me."
+
+So saying, Don Quixote clapped spurs to his horse, and galloped off
+through the trees.
+
+The countryman watched till the Knight was out of sight. Then,
+turning, he said "Come, my lad, and I'll pay thee what I owe, and
+more."
+
+"Ay," answered the boy, "see that you do, for if you do not, that
+brave man will come back and make you."
+
+"I dare swear that," said the man. "And just to show how much I love
+you, I am going to increase the debt, so that I may pay you more. Come
+here!"
+
+And with that he caught the boy by the arm, tied him again to the
+tree, and belted him till his arm was tired.
+
+"Now go," he said, "and tell your righter of wrongs. I wish I had
+flayed you alive, you young whelp."
+
+And so ended Don Quixote's first attempt to right wrongs.
+
+As the Knight cantered along, very well pleased with himself, about
+two miles from where he had freed the boy he saw riding towards him
+six men, each shading himself under a large umbrella. With them were
+four mounted servants, and three on foot.
+
+No sooner did Don Quixote see this party than it struck him that here
+was the chance for which, above all others, he had been longing.
+
+Posting himself in the middle of the road, he waited till the men were
+at no great distance. Then, "Halt!" shouted he. "Let all know that no
+man shall pass further till he owns that in the whole world there is
+no damsel more beautiful than the peerless Dulcinea del Toboso."
+
+"But," said the men (who were merchants of Toledo, on their way to buy
+silks), "we do not know the lady. We have never seen her. How then can
+we say that she is beautiful?"
+
+"What!" roared Don Quixote in a terrible rage, "not know the beauteous
+Lady Dulcinea del Toboso! That only makes matters worse. Do you dare
+to argue?"
+
+And with that he couched his spear, drove his spurs into "Rozinante,"
+and rode furiously at the nearest merchant.
+
+What he would have done it is not possible to say. But as he galloped,
+it chanced that "Rozinante" stumbled and fell heavily, rolling Don
+Quixote over and over. There the Knight lay helpless, the weight of
+his armor preventing him from rising to his feet. But as he lay, he
+continued to cry out at the top of his voice, "Stop, you rascals! Do
+not fly. It is my horse's fault that I lie here, you cowards!"
+
+One of the grooms, hearing his master called a rascal and a coward,
+thereupon ran up and snatched away Don Quixote's spear, which he broke
+in pieces. Then with each piece he belabored the poor Knight till the
+broken lance flew into splinters. The merchants then rode away,
+leaving Don Quixote lying where he fell, still shouting threats, but
+quite unable to rise.
+
+There he was found by a man who knew him well, and who with great
+difficulty mounted him on his donkey and took him home. When at last
+they reached Don Quixote's house, the poor Knight was put to bed,
+where he lay for many days, raving, and very ill.
+
+During this time the Curate of the village and the Barber came and
+burned nearly all the books which Don Quixote had so loved.
+
+"For," said they, "it is by reading these books that the poor
+gentleman has lost his mind, and if he reads them again he will never
+get better."
+
+So a bonfire was made of the books, and the door of Don Quixote's
+study was bricked up.
+
+When the Knight was again able to go about, he made at once for his
+study and his beloved books. Up and down the house he searched without
+saying a word, and often he would stand where the door of the study
+used to be, feeling with his hands and gazing about. At last he asked
+his housekeeper to show him the study.
+
+"Study!" cried the woman, "what study? There is no study in this house
+now, nor any books."
+
+"No," said his niece. "When you were away, a famous enchanter came
+along, mounted on a dragon, and he went into your study. What he did
+there we know not. But after a time he flew out of the roof, leaving
+the house full of smoke, and ever since then we have not been able to
+find either books or study."
+
+"Ha!" said Don Quixote. "That must have been Freston. He is a famous
+enchanter, and my bitter enemy. But when I am again well I shall get
+the better of him."
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+HOW DON QUIXOTE AND SANCHO PANZA STARTED ON THEIR SEARCH FOR
+ADVENTURES; AND HOW DON QUIXOTE FOUGHT WITH THE WINDMILLS
+
+
+For some weeks the poor Knight stayed very quietly at home. But he had
+not forgotten the things for which he had come back to his village.
+
+There was a farm laborer who lived near by, a fat, good-natured,
+simple man. To him Don Quixote talked long and often, and made many
+promises; among others that if he would but come with him as squire,
+he should be made governor of any island which the Knight might happen
+to conquer during his search after adventures.
+
+This seemed so grand a thing to the man (whose name was Sancho Panza),
+that he willingly promised to come.
+
+Having got together some money, and having made other preparations,
+Don Quixote and Sancho Panza one dark night stole out of the village
+without a word to any one, and began their adventures.
+
+Don Quixote rode "Rozinante;" Sancho Panza was mounted on an ass. That
+his squire should ride an ass at first troubled the Knight not a
+little, for in none of his books could he remember to have read of
+any squire being so mounted. However, he gave Sancho leave to bring
+the ass, thinking that in no great time a better mount would surely be
+found for him.
+
+As they rode along in the cool of the morning, Sancho Panza spoke to
+his master about their journey, and asked him to be sure not to forget
+his promise about the governorship of the island.
+
+"It may even happen," answered Don Quixote, "that I may by some
+strange chance conquer a kingdom. And then presently, I may be able to
+crown thee King."
+
+"Why," said Sancho, "if by some such miracle as your worship speaks
+of, I am made a King, then would my wife be Queen?"
+
+"Certainly," answered Don Quixote, "who can doubt it?"
+
+"I doubt it," replied Sancho, "for I think if it should rain kingdoms
+upon the face of the earth, not one of them would sit well on my
+wife's head. For I must tell you, sir, she's not worth two brass jacks
+to make a Queen of. No, no! countess will be quite good enough; that's
+as much as she could well manage."
+
+"Nay," said Don Quixote, "leave the matter in the hands of Providence,
+and be not tempted by anything less than the title of Viceroy."
+
+Thus talking, they came over the brow of a hill, and looking down on
+the plain below, Don Quixote saw there thirty or forty windmills.
+
+"Ha!" cried he. "Fortune directs our affairs better than we ourselves
+could do. Look yonder, friend Sancho, there are at at least thirty
+outrageous giants whom I must now fight."
+
+"Giants!" gasped Sancho Panza, "what giants?"
+
+"Those whom you see over there with their long arms," answered Don
+Quixote. "Some of that horrible race, I have heard, have arms near two
+leagues in length."
+
+"But, sir," said Sancho, "these are no giants. They are only
+windmills, and the things you think are arms are but their sails,
+whereby the wind drives them."
+
+"That is but a sign," answered Don Quixote, "whereby one may see how
+little you know of adventures. I tell you they are giants: and I shall
+fight against them all. If you are afraid, go aside and say your
+prayers."
+
+So saying, and without paying any heed to the bawlings of Sancho
+Panza, he put spurs to his horse and galloped furiously at the
+windmills, shouting aloud, "Stand, cowards! stand your ground, and fly
+not from a single Knight."
+
+Just at this moment the wind happened to rise, causing the arms of the
+windmills to move.
+
+"Base scoundrels!" roared the Knight, "though you wave as many arms as
+the giant Briareus, you shall pay for your pride."
+
+And with couched lance, and covering himself with his shield, he
+rushed "Rozinante" at top speed on the nearest windmill. Round whirled
+the sails, and as Don Quixote's lance pierced one of them, horse and
+man were sent rolling on the ground. There Sancho Panza came to help
+his sorely bruised master.
+
+"Mercy o' me!" cried Sancho, "did not I tell you they were windmills?"
+
+"Peace, friend Sancho," answered Don Quixote. "It is the fortune of
+war. I know very well it is that accursed wizard Freston, the enemy
+who took from me my study and my books, who has changed these giants
+into windmills to take from me the honor of the victory. But in the
+end I shall yet surely get the better of him."
+
+"Amen! say I" quoth Sancho: and heaving the poor Knight on to his
+legs, once more he got him seated on "Rozinante."
+
+As they now rode along, it was a great sorrow to Don Quixote that his
+spear had been broken to pieces in this battle with the windmill.
+
+"I have read," said he to Sancho, "that a certain Spanish knight,
+having broken his sword in a fight, pulled up by the roots a huge
+oak-tree, or at least tore down a great branch, and with it did such
+wonderful deeds that he was ever after called 'The Bruiser.' I tell
+you this because I intend to tear up the next oak-tree we meet, and
+you may think yourself fortunate that you will see the deeds I shall
+perform with it."
+
+"Heaven grant you may!" said Sancho. "But, an' it please you, sit a
+little more upright in your saddle; you are all to one side. But that,
+mayhap, comes from your hurts?"
+
+"It does so," answered Don Quixote, "and if I do not complain of the
+pain, it is because a knight-errant must never complain of his wounds,
+though they be killing him."
+
+"I have no more to say," replied Sancho. "Yet Heaven knows I should be
+glad to hear your honor complain a bit, now and then, when something
+ails you. For my part, I always cry out when I'm hurt, and I am glad
+the rule about not complaining doesn't extend to squires."
+
+That night they spent under the trees, from one of which Don Quixote
+tore down a branch, to which he fixed the point of his spear, and in
+some sort that served him for a lance. Don Quixote neither ate nor
+slept all the night, but passed his time, as he had learned from his
+books that a knight should do, in thoughts of the Lady Dulcinea. As
+for Sancho Panza, he had brought with him a big bottle of wine, and
+some food in his wallet, and he stuffed himself as full as he could
+hold, and slept like a top.
+
+As they rode along next day, they came to the Pass of Lapice.
+
+"Here, Sancho," said Don Quixote, "is the spot where adventures should
+begin. Now may we hope to thrust our hands, as it were, up to the very
+elbows in adventures. But remember this! However sore pressed and in
+danger I may be when fighting with another knight, you must not offer
+to draw your sword to help me. It is against the laws of chivalry for
+a squire to attack a knight."
+
+"Never fear me, master," said Sancho. "I'll be sure to obey you; I
+have ever loved peace. But if a knight offers to set upon me first,
+there is no rule forbidding me to hit him back, is there?"
+
+"None," answered Don Quixote, "only do not help me."
+
+"I will not," said Sancho. "Never trust me if I don't keep that
+commandment as well as I do the Sabbath."
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+HOW DON QUIXOTE WON A HELMET; HOW HE FOUGHT WITH TWO ARMIES; AND HOW
+SANCHO'S ASS WAS STOLEN
+
+
+Many were the adventures that now befell Don Quixote and Sancho Panza.
+In the very first, wherein he fought with a man from Biscay, whom he
+left lying in a pool of blood, Don Quixote lost part of his helmet,
+and had the half of one of his ears sliced off by the Biscayan's
+sword. The accident to the helmet was a great grief to him, and he
+swore an oath that until he had taken from some other knight as good a
+helmet as that which was now made useless to him, he would never again
+eat his food on a table-cloth.
+
+One day as they rode along a highway between two villages Don Quixote
+halted and looked eagerly at something.
+
+"Sancho," said he, "dost thou not see yonder knight that comes riding
+this way on a dapple-gray steed, with a helmet of gold on his head?"
+
+"Not a thing can I see," answered Sancho, "but a fellow on just such
+another ass as mine, with something that glitters on top of his head."
+
+"Can you not see," asked Don Quixote, "that it is a helmet? Do you
+stand back, and let me deal with him. Soon now shall I possess myself
+of the helmet that I need."
+
+Now, in those far-away days, when doctors were few, if anybody needed
+to be bled for a fever or any other illness (for it was then thought
+that "letting blood" was the cure for most illnesses), it was the
+custom for the barber to bleed the sick person. For the purpose of
+catching the blood that ran from a vein when it had been cut, a brass
+dish was carried, a dish with part of it cut away from one side, so
+that it might the more easily be held close to the patient's arm or
+body. A small dish like this you may sometimes still see hanging as a
+sign at the end of a pole outside barbers' shops. Barbers in those
+days of old were called barber-surgeons, for the reason that they bled
+people, as well as shaved them or cut their hair.
+
+And the truth of the matter was this, that the man whom Don Quixote
+now believed to be a knight, wearing a golden helmet, was a barber
+riding on his ass to bleed a sick man. And because it was raining, he
+had put his brass dish on his head, in order to keep his new hat from
+being spoiled.
+
+Don Quixote did not wait to speak to the man, but, couching his lance,
+galloped at him as hard as "Rozinante" could go, shouting as he rode,
+"Defend thyself, base wretch!"
+
+The barber no sooner saw this terrible figure charging down on him,
+than, to save himself from being run through, he flung himself on to
+the ground, and then jumping to his feet, ran for his life, leaving
+his ass and the brass basin behind him. Then Don Quixote ordered
+Sancho to pick up the helmet.
+
+"O' my word," said Sancho, as he gave it to his master, "it is a fine
+basin."
+
+Don Quixote at once put it on his head, saying, "It is a famous
+helmet, but the head for which it was made must have been of great
+size. The worst of it is that at least one-half of it is gone. What is
+the fool grinning at now?" he cried, as Sancho laughed.
+
+"Why, master," answered Sancho, "it is a barber's basin."
+
+"It has indeed some likeness to a basin," said Don Quixote, "but I
+tell you it is an enchanted helmet of pure gold, and for the sake of a
+little wretched money some one has melted down the half of it. When we
+come to a town where there is an armorer, I will have it altered to
+fit my head. Meantime I shall wear it as it is."
+
+As they rode along one day talking of many things, Don Quixote beheld
+a cloud of dust rising right before them.
+
+"Seest thou that cloud of dust, Sancho?" he asked. "It is raised by a
+great army marching this way."
+
+"Why, master," said Sancho, "there must be two armies there, for
+yonder is just such another cloud of dust."
+
+The knight looked, and was overjoyed, believing that two armies were
+about to meet and fight in the plain.
+
+"What are we to do, master?" asked Sancho.
+
+"Do!" said Don Quixote, "why, what can we do but help the weaker side?
+Look yonder, Sancho, that knight whom thou seest in the gilded armory
+with a lion crouching at the feet of a lady painted on his shield,
+that is the valiant Laurcalco. That other, the giant on his right,
+Brandabarbaran." And he ran over a long list of names of knights whom
+he believed that he saw.
+
+Sancho listened, as dumb as a fish; but at last he gasped. "Why,
+master, you might as well tell me that it snows. Never a knight, nor a
+giant, nor a man can I see."
+
+"How!" answered Don Quixote, "canst thou not hear their horses neigh,
+and their drums beating?"
+
+"Drums!" said Sancho. "Not I! I hear only the bleating of sheep."
+
+"Since you are afraid," said the Knight, "stand aside, and I will go
+by myself to fight."
+
+With that, he galloped down on to the plain, shouting, leaving Sancho
+bawling to him, "Hold, sir! Stop! For Heaven's sake come back. As sure
+as I'm a sinner, they are only harmless sheep. Come back, I say."
+
+But Don Quixote, paying not the least heed, galloped on furiously and
+charged into the middle of the sheep, spearing them right and left,
+trampling the living and the dead under "Rozinante's" feet. The
+shepherds, finding that he took no notice of their shouts, now hurled
+stones at him from their slings, and one big stone presently hit the
+Knight fair in his ribs and doubled him up in the saddle.
+
+Gasping for breath, with all speed Don Quixote got from his wallet a
+bottle filled with a mixture he had made, a mixture which he firmly
+believed to be a certain cure for all wounds. Of this he took a long
+gulp, but just at that moment another big stone hit him such a rap on
+the mouth that the bottle was smashed into a thousand pieces, and half
+of his teeth were knocked out.
+
+Down dropped the Knight on the ground, and the shepherds thinking that
+he was killed, ran away, taking with them seven dead sheep which he
+had slain.
+
+Sancho Panza found his master in a very bad way, with nearly all the
+teeth gone from one side of his mouth, and with a terrible pain under
+his ribs.
+
+"Ah! master," he said, "I told you they were sheep. Why would not you
+listen to me?"
+
+"Sheep! Sancho. No, no! There is nothing so easy for a wizard like
+Freston as to change things from one shape to the other. I will wager
+if you now mount your ass and ride over the hill after them, you will
+find no sheep there, but the knights and squires come back to their
+own shape, and the armies marching as when we first saw them."
+
+Now, after this and many other adventures (about which, perhaps, you
+may some day read for yourself), Don Quixote and Sancho Panza rode
+away into the mountains, for the Knight was sorely in need of a quiet
+place in which to rest.
+
+So weary were he and his squire, that one night, when they had ridden
+into a wood, and it chanced that the horse and the ass stood still,
+both Don Quixote and Sancho Panza fell sound asleep without even
+getting out of their saddles. There sat the Knight, leaning on his
+lance; and Sancho, doubled over the pommel, snored as loud as if he
+had been in a four-post feather bed.
+
+It happened that a wandering thief saw them as he passed.
+
+"Now," thought he, "I want something to ride upon, for I'm tired of
+walking in these abominable mountains. Here's a chance of a good ass.
+But how am I to get it, without waking its master?"
+
+Very quietly he cut four long sticks. One after the other he placed
+these under each side of Sancho's saddle; then loosening the girths,
+he gradually raised the sticks till the saddle was clear of the
+animal's back.
+
+Gently, in the moonlight, he led the tired ass away, and Sancho,
+undisturbed, snored on.
+
+When it was broad daylight, the squire awoke, and without opening his
+eyes, stretched himself. Down fell the sticks; down with a terrible
+bump fell Sancho.
+
+"Body o' me!" he yelled, "where is my ass?" And with many tears he
+searched high and low, but no ass was then to be found, nor for many
+months afterwards. And how at last Sancho got back the ass you must
+read for yourself in the History of Don Quixote. For yourself, too,
+you must read of Don Quixote's adventures in the mountains; how he
+there did penance; and of many other things, till at last the Curate
+and the Barber of La Mancha took him home in a cart which the Knight
+believed to be an enchanted chariot.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+HOW DON QUIXOTE SAW DULCINEA
+
+
+Now a third time did Don Quixote set off on his search for adventures,
+and as he and Sancho Panza rode again away from their village, it
+seemed to Don Quixote that certainly it was his duty as a
+knight-errant to visit the Mistress of his Heart, the beautiful
+Dulcinea.
+
+It was midnight when they reached Toboso, and the whole town was
+still, everybody in bed and asleep.
+
+"Lead me to her palace, Sancho," said Don Quixote.
+
+"Palace?" cried Sancho, "What palace do you mean? Body o' me! When
+last I saw her, she lived in a little cottage in a blind alley. And
+even if it were a palace, we can't go and thunder at the door at this
+time o' night."
+
+"When we find it, I will tell thee what to do. But, here! What is
+this?" said the Knight, riding up to a huge building, and knocking at
+the door. "This indeed, without doubt, must be her palace."
+
+But it was only the great Church of Toboso. Hunt as he would, he found
+no Dulcinea's palace, and as morning began to break, Sancho persuaded
+him to come and rest in a grove of trees two miles outside the town.
+From there Sancho was again sent to look for Dulcinea, bearing many
+messages from his sorrowful master.
+
+"Cheer up, sir," said Sancho. "I'll be back in a trice. Don't be cast
+down. Faint heart never won fair lady."
+
+And Sancho rode away, leaving the Knight sitting on his horse, very
+full of melancholy. But he had not ridden far, when, turning round and
+finding that his master was no longer in sight, the squire dismounted,
+and lying down under a shady tree, began to think the matter over.
+
+"Friend Sancho," said he to himself, "what's this you are doing?"
+
+"Why, hunting for a Princess, who, my master says, is the Sun of
+Beauty, and all sorts of other fine things, and who lives in a King's
+palace, or great castle, somewhere or other."
+
+"And how are you going to find her?"
+
+"Why, it's like looking for a needle in a bundle of hay, to look for
+Dulcinea all over Toboso. My master's mad, there's no doubt of that;
+and perhaps I'm not very much better, for they say birds of a feather
+flock together. But if he's so mad as to mistake windmills for giants,
+and flocks of sheep for armies, why, it shouldn't be so very hard to
+make him believe that the first country lass I meet is the Lady
+Dulcinea. If he won't believe, I'll swear it, and stand to it, so that
+he'll think some of those wicked wizards of his have played another
+trick on him, and have changed her into some other shape just to spite
+him."
+
+Having thus settled his plans, Sancho lay there till the evening, so
+that his master might think that all the day had been spent in going
+to and from Toboso, and in looking for Dulcinea.
+
+As luck would have it, just as he mounted his ass to ride back to Don
+Quixote, he spied coming that way three country lasses mounted on
+asses. As soon as Sancho saw the girls, he made haste to get to his
+master.
+
+"What news, Sancho?" asked the Knight. "Has your fortune been good?"
+
+"Ay, marry has it, sir," answered Sancho, "you have no more to do but
+to clap spurs to 'Rozinante' and get into the open fields, and you'll
+meet my Lady Dulcinea del Toboso with two of her damsels coming to see
+you."
+
+"Blessed Heaven!" cried the Knight. "What do you say, my dear Sancho?
+Is it possible?"
+
+"Possible!" said Sancho. "Why should I play a trick on you? Come, sir,
+and you will see her presently, all dressed up and decked with jewels.
+Her damsels and she are all covered with diamonds, and rubies, and
+cloth of gold. And what is more, they are riding three flea-bitten
+gambling hags, the like of which won't be seen again."
+
+"Ambling nags, thou meanest, Sancho," said Don Quixote.
+
+"Well, well, master, gambling hags or ambling nags, it's all one and
+the same thing. Any way, I'm sure I never set eyes on more beautiful
+ladies than those that sit upon them."
+
+"Let us be moving then, Sancho. And as a reward for your good news, I
+promise you the very best things I get in our next adventure. And if
+that is not enough, then I will give you the three colts that I have
+at home in La Mancha."
+
+"Thank you for the colts," said Sancho. "As for the other things, I'm
+not sure that they will be worth so very much."
+
+They were now out of the wood, and could see the three country lasses
+at a little distance.
+
+Don Quixote looked long towards Toboso, but seeing no one anywhere but
+these girls, he was much troubled in his mind, and asked Sancho if he
+were sure that the Princess had left the city.
+
+"Left the city!" cried Sancho. "Why where are your eyes, sir? In the
+name of wonder, do you not see her and her maidens coming towards us
+now, as bright as the sun at midday?"
+
+"I see nothing, Sancho, but three country wenches riding on asses."
+
+"Now Heaven help me," cried Sancho, "is it possible that you can
+mistake three what do you call 'ems--ambling nags as white as snow,
+for three asses! Pull my beard out by the roots if it is not so."
+
+"Believe me, Sancho, they are asses."
+
+"Come, sir," answered Sancho, "do but clear your eyes, and go and
+speak to the Mistress of your Heart, for she is near you now."
+
+So saying, Sancho hurried up to one of the girls, and, jumping off his
+ass, fell on his knees before her, gabbling a lot of nonsense.
+
+Don Quixote followed, and also knelt down, gazing with doubting and
+sorrowful eyes on the creature that Sancho had told him was the
+beautiful Dulcinea. He was lost in wonder, for she was a flat-nosed,
+blubber-cheeked, bouncing country girl, and Don Quixote could not
+utter a word.
+
+"Come! get out of the way," screamed the girl, "and let us go about
+our business. We're in a hurry."
+
+"Rise, Sancho," said Don Quixote when he heard the girl's voice. "I am
+now convinced that misfortune has not yet finished with me. O most
+beautiful lady! a spiteful enchanter puts mists before my eyes, and
+hides from me your loveliness."
+
+"My grandmother take him!" cried the girl. "Listen to his gibberish!
+Get out of the way, and let us alone." And kicking her donkey in the
+ribs, she galloped away with her friends. Don Quixote followed them
+long with his eyes.
+
+"O the spite of those wicked enchanters!" he sighed, "to turn my
+beautiful Dulcinea into so vile a shape as that: to take from her the
+sweet and delicate scent of fragrant flowers, and give to her what she
+has. For, to tell the truth, Sancho, she gave me such a whiff of raw
+onions that it was like to upset me altogether."
+
+"O the vile and evil-minded enchanters!" cried Sancho. "Oh that I
+might see the lot of you threaded on one string, and hung up in the
+smoke like so many herrings." And Sancho turned away to hide his
+laughter.
+
+Don Quixote rode on, very sad, and letting "Rozinante" go where he
+pleased.
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+HOW DON QUIXOTE FOUGHT WITH A LION; AND HOW HE DEFEATED THE MOORS
+
+
+As Don Quixote and Sancho Panza went along, they were overtaken by a
+gentleman in a fine green coat, who rode a very good mare. This
+gentleman stared very hard at Don Quixote, and the two began to speak
+together about knight-errantry, and were so interested in what they
+were saying, that Sancho took the opportunity of riding over to ask
+for a little milk from some shepherds, who were milking their ewes
+near at hand.
+
+While he was thus away from his master, a wagon, on top of which
+fluttered little yellow and red flags, came along the road towards
+them. Don Quixote at once imagined this to be some new adventure, and
+he called to Sancho for his helmet. At the moment, Sancho was
+bargaining with the shepherds for some curds. Hearing his master call,
+he had not time to wait till the shepherds could give him a bowl in
+which to carry them, and not wishing to lose his bargain (for he had
+paid the shepherds), he poured the curds into the Knight's helmet, and
+galloped off to see what his master wanted.
+
+"Give me my helmet," said Don Quixote, "for if I know anything of my
+business, here is an adventure for which I must be ready."
+
+The gentleman in green, hearing what Don Quixote said, looked
+everywhere, but he could see nothing except the wagon coming towards
+them, and as that had on it the King of Spain's colors, he thought
+that no doubt it was one of his Majesty's treasure-vans. He said as
+much to Don Quixote, but the Knight answered: "Sir, I cannot tell
+when, or where, or in what shape, my enemies will attack me. It is
+always wise to be ready. Fore-warned is fore-armed. Give me my helmet,
+Sancho!"
+
+Snatching it out of Sancho's unwilling hands, he clapped it on his
+head without looking into it.
+
+"What is this, Sancho?" he cried, as the whey ran down his face. "What
+is the matter with me? Is my brain melting, or am I breaking out in a
+cold sweat? If I am, it is not from fear. This must be a dreadful
+adventure that is coming. Quick. Sancho! give me something to wipe
+away the torrent of sweat, for I am almost blinded."
+
+Without a word, Sancho handed to his master a cloth. Don Quixote dried
+himself, and then took off his helmet to see what it was that felt so
+cold on his head.
+
+"What is this white stuff?" said he, putting some of the curds to his
+nose. "Sancho, you vile traitor, you have been putting curds in my
+helmet!"
+
+"Curds!--I?" cried Sancho. "Nay, the devil must have put them there.
+Would I dare to make such a mess in your helmet, sir? It must have
+been one of those vile enchanters. Where could I get curds? I would
+sooner put them in my stomach than in your helmet."
+
+"Well, that's true, I dare say," said Don Quixote. "There's something
+in that."
+
+Then again he put on the helmet, and made ready for the adventure.
+
+"Now come what may, I dare meet it," he cried.
+
+The wagon had now come near to them. On top was seated a man, and the
+driver rode one of the mules that drew it. Don Quixote rode up.
+
+"Whither go ye, my friends?" said he. "What wagon is this, and what
+have you in it? What is the meaning of the flags?"
+
+"The wagon is mine," said the driver, "and I have in it a lion that is
+being sent to the King, and the flags are flying to let the people
+know that it is the King's property."
+
+"A lion!" cried Don Quixote, "Is it a large one?"
+
+"The biggest I ever saw," said the man on top of the wagon. "I am the
+keeper, and I have had charge of many lions, but I never saw one so
+large as this. Pray get out of the way, sir, for we must hurry on to
+our stopping-place. It is already past his feeding-time; he is
+beginning to get hungry, and they are always savage when they are
+hungry."
+
+"What!" cried Don Quixote, "lion whelps against me! I'll let those
+gentlemen know who send lions this way, that I am not to be scared by
+any of their lions. So, Mr. Keeper, just jump down and open his cage,
+and let him out. In spite of all the enchanters in the world that have
+sent him to try me, I'll let the animal see who Don Quixote de la
+Mancha is."
+
+Up ran Sancho to the gentleman in green.
+
+"O good, dear sir," he cried, "don't let my master get at the lion, or
+we shall all be torn to pieces."
+
+"Why," said the gentleman, "is your master so mad that you fear he'll
+set upon such a dangerous brute."
+
+"Oh no, sir, he's not mad; he's only rash, very, very rash," cried
+Sancho.
+
+"Well," said the gentleman, "I'll see to it," and up he went to Don
+Quixote, who was trying to get the keeper to open the cage.
+
+"Sir," said he, "knight-errants ought not to engage in adventures from
+which there is no hope of coming off in safety. That is more like
+madness than courage. Besides, this is the King's wagon; it will
+never do to stop that. And after all, the lion has not been sent
+against you; it is a present to the King."
+
+"Pray, sir," cried Don Quixote, "will you attend to your own business?
+This is mine, and I know best whether this lion has been sent against
+me or not. Now you, sir," he cried to the keeper, "either open that
+cage at once, or I'll pin you to your wagon with my spear."
+
+"For mercy's sake, sir," cried the driver, "do but let me take my
+mules out of harm's way before the lion gets out. My cart and my mules
+are all I have in the world, and I shall be ruined if harm comes to
+them."
+
+"Take them out quickly, then," said Don Quixote, "and take them where
+you please."
+
+On this the driver made all the haste he could to unharness his mules,
+while the keeper called aloud, "Take notice, everybody, that it is
+against my will that I am forced to let loose the lion, and that this
+gentleman here is to blame for all the damage that will be done. Get
+out of the way, everybody: look out for yourselves."
+
+Once more the gentleman in green tried to persuade Don Quixote not to
+be so foolish, but the Knight only said, "I know very well what I am
+doing. If you are afraid, and do not care to see the fight, just put
+spurs to your mare and take yourself where you think you will be
+safe."
+
+Sancho now hurried up, and with tears in his eyes begged his master
+not to put himself in so great danger, but Don Quixote only said,
+"Take yourself away, Sancho, and leave me alone. If I am killed, go,
+as I have so often told you, to the beautiful Dulcinea, and tell
+her--you know what to tell her."
+
+The gentleman in green, finding that words were thrown away on Don
+Quixote, now quickly followed the driver, who had hastily taken his
+mules as far away as he could beyond the brow of the hill. Sancho
+hurried after them at the top speed of his ass, kicking him in the
+ribs all the while to make him go even faster, and loudly bewailing
+his master's coming death. The keeper made one more attempt to turn
+Don Quixote from his folly, but again finding it useless, very
+unwillingly opened the cage door.
+
+Meantime the Knight had been thinking whether it would be best to
+fight the lion on foot or on horseback, and he had made up his mind to
+fight on foot, for the reason that "Rozinante" would probably be too
+much afraid to face the lion. So he got off his horse, drew his sword,
+and holding his shield in front of him, marched slowly up to the cage.
+The keeper, having thrown the door wide open, now quickly got himself
+out of harm's way.
+
+The lion, seeing the cage open, and Don Quixote standing in front,
+turned round and stretched out his great paws. Then he opened his
+enormous mouth, and, letting out a tongue as long as a man's arm,
+licked the dust off his face. Now rising to his feet, he thrust his
+head out of the door and glared around with eyes like burning coals.
+
+It was a sight to make any man afraid; but Don Quixote calmly waited
+for the animal to jump out and come within reach of his sword.
+
+The lion looked at him for a moment with its great yellow eyes--then,
+slowly turning, it strolled to the back of the cage, gave a long,
+weary yawn, and lay quietly down.
+
+"Force him to come out," cried Don Quixote to the keeper, "beat him."
+
+"Not I," said the man. "I dare not for my life. He would tear me to
+pieces. And let me advise you, sir, to be content with your day's
+work. I beseech you, go no further. You have shown how brave you are.
+No man can be expected to do more than challenge his enemy and wait
+ready for him. If he does not come, the fault and the disgrace are
+his."
+
+"'Tis true," said the Knight. "Shut the door, my friend, and give me
+the best certificate you can of what you have seen me do; how you
+opened the door, and how I waited for the lion to come out, and how he
+turned tail and lay down. I am obliged to do no more."
+
+So saying, Don Quixote put on the end of his spear the cloth with
+which he had wiped the curds from his face, and began to wave to the
+others to come back.
+
+"I'll be hanged," cried Sancho when he saw this signal, "if my master
+has not killed the lion." And they all hurried up to the wagon where
+the keeper gave them a long account of what had happened, adding,
+that when he got to court he would tell the King of Don Quixote's
+bravery.
+
+"If his Majesty should happen to ask who did this thing, tell him,"
+said Don Quixote, "that it was the Knight of the Lions, for that is
+the name by which I shall now call myself."
+
+Sancho and his master now rode with the gentleman in green to his
+house, where they stopped some days, to the great contentment of
+Sancho. And of the wedding at which they were present, of the feast
+where Sancho so greatly enjoyed himself, as well as of other matters,
+you must read for yourself.
+
+When the Knight and his squire again began their travels, it chanced
+that they stopped one night at an inn. To this inn, while Don Quixote
+was outside, waiting for supper, there came a man, all dressed in
+chamois leather, and wearing over his left eye, and part of his face,
+a green patch.
+
+"Have you any lodgings, landlord?" he cried in a loud voice; "for here
+comes the fortune-telling ape, and the great puppet-show of
+Melisendra's Deliverance."
+
+"Why, bless me!" cried the innkeeper, "if here isn't Master Peter. Now
+we shall have a merry night of it. You are welcome, with all my heart.
+Where is the ape, Peter?"
+
+"Coming presently," said Master Peter. "I only came on before to see
+if lodgings were to be had."
+
+"Lodgings!" cried the landlord. "Why, I'd turn out the Duke of Alva
+himself rather than you should want room. Bring on the monkey and the
+show, for I have guests in the inn to-night who will pay well to see
+the performance."
+
+"That's good news," said Peter, going off to hurry up his cart.
+
+"Who is this Peter?" asked Don Quixote.
+
+"Why, sir," answered the landlord, "he has been going about the
+country this long time with his play of Melisendra and Don Gayferos,
+one of the very best shows that ever was seen. Then he has the
+cleverest ape in the world. You have only to ask it a question and it
+will jump on its master's shoulder and whisper the answer in his ear,
+and then Master Peter will tell you what it says. It's true, he isn't
+always right, but he so often hits the nail on the head that we
+sometimes think Satan is in him."
+
+Don Quixote no sooner saw the ape, than he marched up to it, and asked
+a question.
+
+"Ah!" said Master Peter, "the animal can't tell what is going to
+happen; only what has already happened."
+
+"I wouldn't give a brass centesimo," cried Sancho, "to know what is
+past. Who can tell that better than myself? Tell me what my wife
+Teresa is doing at home just now."
+
+Master Peter tapped his shoulder: the ape at once sprang on to it, and
+putting its head at his ear, began to chatter--as apes do--for a
+minute. Then it skipped down again, and immediately Master Peter ran
+to Don Quixote and fell on his knees before him.
+
+"O glorious restorer of knight-errantry!" he cried, "who can say
+enough in praise of the great Don Quixote de la Mancha, the righter of
+wrongs, the comfort of the afflicted and unhappy?"
+
+Don Quixote was amazed at these words, for he was certain that he was
+unknown to any one at the inn. He did not guess that Master Peter was
+a clever rogue, who, before giving a performance, always made it his
+business to find out about those who were likely to be looking on.
+
+As for Sancho, he quaked with fear.
+
+"And thou, honest Sancho," went on Master Peter, "the best squire to
+the best knight in the world, be not unhappy about your wife. She is
+well, and at this moment is dressing flax. By the same token, she has
+at her left hand, to cheer her, a broken-mouthed jug of wine."
+
+"That's like enough," said Sancho.
+
+"Well," cried Don Quixote, "if I had not seen it with my own eyes,
+nothing should have made me believe that apes have the gift of second
+sight. I am in very truth the Don Quixote de la Mancha that this
+wonderful animal has told you about."
+
+But he was not quite pleased at the idea of the ape having such
+powers, and taking Sancho aside he spoke to him seriously on the
+subject.
+
+While they spoke, the showman came to tell them that the puppet-show
+was now ready to begin, and Don Quixote and Sancho went into the room
+where it stood, with candles burning all round it. Master Peter got
+inside in order to move the puppets, and a boy standing in front
+explained what was going on.
+
+The story that was acted by the puppets was that of a certain Don
+Gayferos, who rescued his wife Melisendra from captivity by the Moors
+in the city of Saragossa. Melisendra was imprisoned in the castle, and
+the story goes that Don Gayferos, when riding past, in his search,
+spied her on the balcony. Melisendra, with the help of a rope, lets
+herself down to her husband, mounts behind him, and the two gallop
+away from the city. But Melisendra's flight has been noticed, and the
+city bells ring an alarm. The Moors rush out like angry wasps, start
+in pursuit, and the capture and death of Don Gayferos and Melisendra
+seem certain.
+
+Don Quixote listened and looked with growing excitement and anger, but
+when he saw the Moors gallop in pursuit and about to close on Don
+Gayferos and Melisendra, he could keep quiet no longer. Starting up,
+"It shall never be said," cried he, "that in my presence I suffered
+such a wrong to be done to so famous a knight as Don Gayferos. Stop
+your unjust pursuit, ye base rascals! Stop! or prepare to meet me in
+battle."
+
+Then, drawing his sword, with one spring he fell with fury on the
+Moors, hacking some in pieces, beheading others, and sending the rest
+flying into every corner. And had not Master Peter ducked and squatted
+down on the ground behind part of the show, Don Quixote would
+certainly have chopped off his head also.
+
+"Hold! hold, sir!" cried Master Peter, "for mercy's sake, hold! These
+are not real Moors. You will ruin me if you destroy my show."
+
+But Don Quixote paid not the slightest heed. He went on slashing and
+hacking till the whole show was a wreck. Everybody ran to get out of
+harm's way, and the ape scampered, chattering, on to the roof of the
+house. Sancho himself quaked with fear, for he had never before seen
+his master in such a fury.
+
+All the puppet Moors being now cut to pieces, Don Quixote became
+calmer, saying aloud, "How miserable had been the fate of poor Don
+Gayferos and Melisendra his wife if I had not been in time to save
+them from those infidel Moors! Long live knight-errantry!"
+
+"Ay, ay," moaned Master Peter in a doleful voice, "it may live long
+enough. As for me, I may as well die, for I am a ruined man and a
+beggar now."
+
+Sancho Panza took pity on the showman.
+
+"Come, come! Master Peter," said he, "don't cry. Don't be cast down.
+My master will pay you when he comes to know that he has done you an
+injury."
+
+"Truly," said Peter, "if his honor will pay for my puppets.'ll ask no
+more."
+
+"How!" cried Don Quixote. "I do not see that I have injured you, good
+Master Peter."
+
+"Not injured me!" cried Master Peter. "Do but look at those figures
+lying there, all hacked to bits."
+
+"Well," said Don Quixote, "now I know for certain a truth I have
+suspected before, that those accursed enchanters do nothing but put
+before my eyes things as they are, and then presently after change
+them as they please. Really and truly gentlemen, I vow and protest
+that all that was acted here seemed to me to be real. I could not
+contain my fury, and I acted as I thought was my duty. But if Master
+Peter will tell me the value of the figures, I will pay for them all."
+
+"Heaven bless your worship!" whined Master Peter. But had Don Quixote
+known that this same Master Peter was the very man who stole Sancho
+Panza's ass, perhaps he might have paid him in another way.
+
+
+
+
+VII
+
+THE BATTLE WITH THE BULLS; THE FIGHT WITH THE KNIGHT OF THE WHITE
+MOON; AND HOW DON QUIXOTE DIED
+
+
+Soon after this, Don Quixote and Sancho Panza rode forth in search of
+other adventures.
+
+They had ridden no great way when they happened upon some young people
+who had gaily dressed themselves as shepherds and shepherdesses, and
+were having a picnic in the woods. These people invited Don Quixote
+and Sancho to join their feast.
+
+When they had eaten and drunk, the Knight rose, and said that there
+was no sin worse than that of ingratitude, and that to show how
+grateful he was for the kindness that had been shown to him and to
+Sancho, he had only one means in his power.
+
+"Therefore," said he, "I will maintain for two whole days, in the
+middle of this high road leading to Saragossa, that these ladies here,
+disguised as shepherdesses, are the most beautiful damsels in the
+world, except only the peerless Dulcinea del Toboso, the mistress of
+my heart."
+
+So, mounting "Rozinante" he rode into the middle of the highway and
+there took his stand, ready to challenge all comers. He had sat there
+no long time when there appeared on the road coming towards him a
+number of riders, some with spears in their hands, all riding very
+fast and close together. In front of them thundered a drove of wild
+bulls, bellowing and tossing their horns. At once all the shepherds
+and the shepherdesses ran behind trees, but Don Quixote sat bravely
+where he was.
+
+When the horsemen came near, "Get out of the way!" bawled one of them.
+"Stand clear, or these bulls will have you in pieces in no time."
+
+"Halt, scoundrels!" roared the Knight. "What are bulls to Don Quixote
+de la Mancha, if they were the fiercest that ever lived? Stop,
+hangdogs!"
+
+But the herdsmen had no time to answer, nor Don Quixote to get out of
+the way had he wanted to do so, for before any one knew what was
+happening, the bulls had run right over him and "Rozinante," leaving
+them and Sancho and "Dapple," his ass, stunned and bruised, rolling in
+the dust.
+
+As soon as Don Quixote came to his senses he got up in great haste,
+stumbling here and falling there, and began to run after the herd.
+
+"Stop, you scoundrels!" he bawled. "Stop! It is a single knight that
+defies you."
+
+But no one took the least notice of him, and he sat sadly down on the
+road, waiting till Sancho brought "Rozinante" to him. Then master and
+man went on their way, Don Quixote sore ashamed of his defeat, hurt as
+much in mind as in body.
+
+That evening they dismounted at the door of an inn, and put up
+"Rozinante" and "Dapple" in the stable. Sancho asked the landlord what
+he could give them for supper.
+
+"Why," said the man, "you may have anything you choose to call for.
+The inn can provide fowls of the air, birds of the earth, and fishes
+of the sea."
+
+"There's no need for all that," said Sancho. "If you roast a couple of
+chickens it will be enough, for my master eats but little, and for
+myself, I have no great appetite."
+
+"Chickens?" said the host. "I am sorry I have no chickens just now.
+The hawks have killed them all."
+
+"Well, then, roast us a pullet, if it be tender."
+
+"A pullet? Well, now, that is unlucky. I sent away fifty to the market
+only yesterday. But, putting pullets aside, ask for anything you
+like."
+
+"Why, then," said Sancho, pondering, "let us have some veal, or a bit
+of kid."
+
+"Sorry sir, we are just out of veal and kid also. Next week we shall
+have enough and to spare."
+
+"That helps us nicely," said Sancho. "But at any rate, let us have
+some eggs and bacon."
+
+"Eggs!" cried the landlord. "Now didn't I tell him I had no hens or
+pullets, and how then can I have eggs? No, no! Ask for anything you
+please in the way of dainties, but don't ask for hens."
+
+"Body o' me!" said Sancho, "let us have something. Tell me what you
+have, and have done."
+
+"Well, what I really and truly have is a pair of cow-heels that look
+like calves'-feet, or a pair of calves'-feet that look like cow-heels.
+You can have that and some bacon."
+
+"They are mine," cried Sancho. "I don't care whether they are feet or
+heels."
+
+And as Don Quixote had supper with some other guests who carried with
+them their own cook and their own larder, Sancho and the landlord
+supped well on the cow-heels.
+
+Some days after this, the Knight and his squire reached Barcelona.
+Neither of them had ever before been near the sea, and the galleys
+that they saw in the distance being rowed about in the bay sorely
+puzzled Sancho, who thought that the oars were their legs, and that
+they must be some strange kind of beast.
+
+Now, one morning, when Don Quixote rode out, fully armed as usual, to
+take the air on the seashore, he saw a knight riding towards him,
+armed like himself, and having a bright moon painted on his shield. As
+soon as this knight came within hearing he halted, and in a loud voice
+called out:
+
+"Illustrious Don Quixote de la Mancha, I am the Knight of the White
+Moon, of whose doings you may have heard. I am come to fight with you
+and to make you own that the Lady of my Heart, whoever she may be, is
+more beautiful by far than the Lady Dulcinea del Toboso. Which truth,
+if you will confess, I will not slay you. And if we fight, and I
+should conquer you, then I ask no more than that you shall go to your
+own home, and for the space of one year give up carrying arms or
+searching for adventures. But if you should conquer me, then my head
+shall be at your disposal, my horse and arms shall be your spoils, and
+the fame of my deeds shall be yours. Consider what I say, and let your
+answer be quick."
+
+Don Quixote was amazed at hearing these words.
+
+"Knight of the White Moon," said he very solemnly, "the fame of whose
+doings has not yet come to my ears, I dare swear that thou hast never
+seen the beautiful Dulcinea, for hadst thou ever viewed her, thou
+wouldst have been careful not to make this challenge. The sight of her
+would have made thee know that there never has been, nor can be,
+beauty to match hers. And therefore, without giving thee the lie, I
+only tell thee thou art mistaken. I accept your challenge, on your
+conditions, and at once, except that I am content with the fame of my
+own deeds, and want not yours. Choose then whichever side of the field
+you please, and let us set to."
+
+The two knights then turned their horses to take ground for their
+charge, but at this moment up rode, with some friends, the Governor of
+the city of Barcelona, who knew Don Quixote, and who fancied that
+perhaps this was some new trick being played on him. The Governor,
+seeing both knights ready to turn for their charge, asked the Knight
+of the White Moon what was the cause of the combat, and having heard
+his answer, could not believe that the affair was not a joke, and so
+stood aside.
+
+Instantly the two knights charged at top speed. But the horse of the
+Knight of the White Moon was by far the bigger and heavier and faster,
+and he came with such a shock into poor old "Rozinante" that Don
+Quixote and his horse were hurled to the ground with terrible force,
+and lay stunned and helpless. In a moment the Knight of the White Moon
+was off his horse and holding his spear at Don Quixote's throat.
+
+"Yield, Sir Knight!" he cried, "or you are a dead man."
+
+Don Quixote, sorely hurt, but with steadfast look, gasped in a faint
+voice:
+
+"I do not yield. Dulcinea del Toboso is the most beautiful woman in
+the whole world. Press on with your spear, Sir Knight, and kill me."
+
+"Nay," said the Knight of the White Moon. "That will I not do. I am
+content if the great Don Quixote return to his home for a year, as we
+agreed before we fought."
+
+And Don Quixote answered very faintly that as nothing was asked of him
+to the hurt of Dulcinea, he would carry out all the rest faithfully
+and truly. The Knight of the White Moon then galloped away toward the
+city, where one of the Governor's friends followed him, in order to
+find out who he was. The victorious knight was Samson Carrasco, who,
+some months before, had fought with and had been beaten by Don
+Quixote. And he explained to the Governor's friend that all he wanted
+in fighting was, not to harm Don Quixote, but to make him promise to
+go home, and stop there for a year, by which time he hoped that his
+madness about knight-errantry might be cured.
+
+They raised Don Quixote and took off his helmet. His face was very
+pale, and he was covered with a cold sweat. "Rozinante" was in as bad
+plight as his master, and lay where he had fallen. Sancho, in great
+grief, could speak no word, and knew not what to do; to him it was all
+as a bad dream.
+
+Don Quixote was carried on a stretcher to the town, where for a week
+he lay in bed without ever raising his head, stricken to the soul by
+the disgrace of his defeat.
+
+Sancho tried to comfort him.
+
+"Pluck up your heart and be of good cheer, sir," he cried, "and thank
+Heaven you have broken no bones. They that give must take. Let us go
+home and give up looking for adventures."
+
+"After all, Sancho," said Don Quixote, "it is only for a year. After
+that I can begin again, and perhaps then I may be able to make thee an
+Earl."
+
+"Heaven grant it" said Sancho.
+
+So when the Knight was once more able to move they set out for home,
+Don Quixote riding "Rozinante" Sancho walking, for "Dapple" carried
+the armor.
+
+But all the way Don Quixote did not recover from his melancholy, and
+when at last they reached his village:
+
+"Help me to bed," he said, "for I think that I am not very well."
+
+He was put to bed, and carefully nursed. But a fever had taken hold of
+him, and for many days Sancho Panza never left his master's bedside.
+On the sixth day, the doctor told him he was in great danger. Don
+Quixote listened very calmly, and then asked that he might be left by
+himself for a little--he had a mind to sleep. His niece and Sancho
+left the room weeping bitterly, and Don Quixote fell into a deep
+sleep.
+
+When he awoke, with a firm voice he cried:
+
+"Blessed be God! My mind is is now clear, and the clouds have rolled
+away which those detestable books of knight-errantry cast over me. Now
+can I see their nonsense and deceit. I am at the point of death, and I
+would meet it so that I may not leave behind me the character of a
+madman. Send for the lawyer, that I may make my will."
+
+Excepting only a small sum of money which he gave to Sancho Panza, he
+left all to his niece.
+
+Thereafter he fell back in bed, and lay unconscious and without
+movement till the third day, when death very gently took him.
+
+So died Don Quixote de la Mancha, a good man and a brave gentleman to
+the end.
+
+
+
+
+GULLIVER'S TRAVELS
+
+_VOYAGE TO LILLIPUT_
+
+By JONATHAN SWIFT
+
+ADAPTED BY JOHN LANG
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+GULLIVER'S BIRTH AND EARLY VOYAGES
+
+
+Two hundred years ago, a great deal of the world as we now know it was
+still undiscovered; there were yet very many islands, small and great,
+on which the eyes of white men had never looked, seas in which nothing
+bigger than an Indian canoe had ever sailed.
+
+A voyage in those days was not often a pleasant thing, for ships then
+were very bluff-bowed and slow-sailing, and, for a long voyage, very
+ill-provided with food. There were no tinned meats two hundred years
+ago, no luxuries for use even in the cabin. Sailors lived chiefly on
+salt junk, as hard as leather, on biscuit that was generally as much
+weevil as biscuit, and the water that they drank was evil-smelling and
+bad when it had been long in the ship's casks.
+
+So, when a man said good-by to his friends and sailed away into the
+unknown, generally very many years passed before he came back--if ever
+he came back at all. For the dangers of the seas were then far greater
+than they now are, and if a ship was not wrecked some dark night on an
+unknown island or uncharted reef, there was always the probability of
+meeting a pirate vessel and of having to fight for life and liberty.
+Steam has nowadays nearly done away with pirates, except on the China
+coast and in a few other out-of-the-way places. But things were
+different long ago, before steamers were invented; and sailors then,
+when they came home, had many very surprising things to tell their
+friends, many astonishing adventures to speak of, among the strange
+peoples that they said they had met in far-off lands. One man, who saw
+more wonderful things than any one else, was named Lemuel Gulliver,
+and I will try to tell you a little about one of his voyages.
+
+Gulliver was born in Nottinghamshire, and when he was only fourteen
+years old he was sent to Emanuel College, Cambridge. There he remained
+till he was seventeen, but his father had not money enough to keep him
+any longer at the University. So, as was then the custom for those who
+meant to become doctors, he was bound apprentice to a surgeon in
+London, under whom he studied for four years. But all the time, as
+often as his father sent him money, he spent some of it in learning
+navigation (which means the art of finding your way across the sea,
+far from land). He had always had a great longing to travel, and he
+thought that a knowledge of navigation would be of use to him if he
+should happen to go a voyage.
+
+After leaving London, he went to Germany, and there studied medicine
+for some years, with the view of being appointed surgeon of a ship.
+And by the help of his late master in London, such a post he did get
+on board the "Swallow" on which vessel he made several voyages. But
+tiring of this, he settled in London, and, having married, began
+practise as a doctor.
+
+He did not, however, make much money at that, and so for six years he
+again went to sea as a surgeon, sailing both to the East and to the
+West Indies.
+
+Again tiring of the sea, he once more settled on shore, this time at
+Wapping, because in that place there are always many sailors, and he
+hoped to make money by doctoring them.
+
+But this turned out badly, and on May 4, 1699, he sailed from Bristol
+for the South Seas as surgeon of a ship named the "Antelope."
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+GULLIVER IS WRECKED ON THE COAST OF LILLIPUT
+
+
+At first, everything went well, but after leaving the South Seas, when
+steering for the East Indies, the ship was driven by a great storm far
+to the south. The gale lasted so long that twelve of the crew died
+from the effects of the hard work and the bad food, and all the others
+were worn out and weak. On a sailing ship, when the weather is very
+heavy, all hands have to be constantly on deck, and there is little
+rest for the men. Perhaps a sail, one of the few that can still be
+carried in such a gale, may be blown to ribbons by the furious wind,
+and a new one has to be bent on.
+
+The night, perhaps, is dark, the tattered canvas is thrashing with a
+noise like thunder, the ship burying her decks under angry black seas
+every few minutes. The men's hands are numb with the cold and the wet,
+and the hard, dangerous work aloft. There is no chance of going below
+when their job is done, to "turn in" between warm, dry blankets in a
+snug berth. Possibly even those who belong to the "watch below" may
+have to remain on deck. Or, if they have the good fortune to be
+allowed to go below, they may no sooner have dropped off asleep
+(rolled round in blankets which perhaps have been wet ever since the
+gale began) than there is a thump, thump overhead, and one of the
+watch on deck bellows down the forecastle-hatch, "All hands shorten
+sail." And out they must tumble again, once more to battle with the
+hungry, roaring seas and the raging wind. So, when there has been a
+long spell of bad weather, it is no wonder that the men are worn out.
+And when, as was the case with Gulliver's ship, the food also is bad,
+it is easy to understand why so many of the crew had died.
+
+It was on the 5th of November, the beginning of summer in latitudes
+south of the equator. The storm had not yet cleared off, and the
+weather was very thick, the wind coming in furious squalls that drove
+the ship along at great speed, when suddenly from the lookout man came
+a wild cry--"Breakers ahead!"
+
+But so close had the vessel come to the rocks before they were seen
+through the thick driving spray, that immediately, with, a heavy
+plunge, she crashed into the reef, and split her bows.
+
+Gulliver and six of the crew lowered a boat and got clear of the wreck
+and of the breakers. But the men were so weak from overwork that they
+could not handle the boat in such a sea, and very soon, during a
+fierce squall, she sank. What became of the men Gulliver never knew,
+for he saw none of them again. Probably they were drowned at once,
+for they were too weak to keep long afloat in a sea breaking so
+heavily.
+
+And indeed, Gulliver himself was like to have been lost. He swam till
+no strength or feeling was left in his arms and legs, swam bravely,
+his breath coming in great sobs, his eyes blinded with the salt seas
+that broke over his head. Still he struggled on, utterly spent, until
+at last, in a part where the wind seemed to have less force, and the
+seas swept over him less furiously, on letting down his legs he found
+that he was within his depth. But the shore shelved so gradually that
+for nearly a mile he had to wade wearily through shallow water, till,
+fainting almost with fatigue, he reached dry land.
+
+By this time darkness was coming on, and there were no signs of houses
+or of people. He staggered forward but a little distance, and then, on
+the short, soft turf, sank down exhausted and slept.
+
+When he woke, the sun was shining, and he tried to rise; but not by
+any means could he stir hand or foot. Gulliver had fallen asleep lying
+on his back, and now he found that his arms and legs were tightly
+fastened to the ground. Across his body were numbers of thin but
+strong cords, and even his hair, which was very long, was pegged down
+so securely that he could not turn his head.
+
+All round about him there was a confused sound of voices, but he could
+see nothing except the sky, and the sun shone so hot and fierce into
+his eyes that he could scarcely keep them open.
+
+Soon he felt something come gently up his left leg, and forward on to
+his breast almost to his chin. Looking down as much as possible, he
+saw standing there a very little man, not more than six inches high,
+armed with a bow and arrows.
+
+Then many more small men began to swarm over him. Gulliver let out
+such a roar of wonder and fright that they all turned and ran, many of
+them getting bad falls in their hurry to get out of danger. But very
+quickly the little people came back again.
+
+This time, with a great struggle Gulliver managed to break the cords
+that fastened his left arm, and at the same time, by a violent wrench
+that hurt him dreadfully, he slightly loosened the strings that
+fastened his hair, so that he was able to turn his head a little to
+one side. But the little men were too quick for him, and got out of
+reach before he could catch any of them.
+
+Then he heard a great shouting, followed by a shrill little voice that
+called sharply, "_Tolgo phonac_," and immediately, arrows like needles
+were shot into his hand, and another volley struck him in the face.
+Poor Gulliver covered his face with his hand, and lay groaning with
+pain.
+
+Again he struggled to get loose. But the harder he fought for freedom,
+the more the little men shot arrows into him, and some of them even
+tried to run their spears into his sides.
+
+When he found that the more he struggled the more he was hurt,
+Gulliver lay still, thinking to himself that at night at least, now
+that his left hand was free, he could easily get rid of the rest of
+his bonds. As soon as the little people saw that he struggled no more,
+they ceased shooting at him; but he knew from the increasing sound of
+voices that more and more of the little soldiers were coming round
+him.
+
+Soon, a few yards from him, on the right, he heard a continued sound
+of hammering, and on turning his head to that side as far as the
+strings would let him, he saw that a small wooden stage was being
+built. On to this, when it was finished, there climbed by ladders four
+men, and one of them (who seemed to be a very important person, for a
+little page boy attended to hold up his train) immediately gave an
+order. At once about fifty of the soldiers ran forward and cut the
+strings that tied Gulliver's hair on the left side, so that he could
+turn his head easily to the right.
+
+Then the person began to make a long speech, not one word of which
+could Gulliver understand, but it seemed to him that sometimes the
+little man threatened, and sometimes made offers of kindness.
+
+As well as he could, Gulliver made signs that he submitted. Then,
+feeling by this time faint with hunger, he pointed with his fingers
+many times to his mouth, to show that he wanted something to eat.
+
+They understood him very well. Several ladders were put against
+Gulliver's sides, and about a hundred little people climbed up and
+carried to his mouth all kinds of bread and meat. There were things
+shaped like legs, and shoulders, and saddles of mutton. Very good they
+were, Gulliver thought, but very small, no bigger than a lark's wing;
+and the loaves of bread were about the size of bullets, so that he
+could take several at a mouthful. The people wondered greatly at the
+amount that he ate.
+
+When he signed that he was thirsty, they slung up on to his body two
+of their biggest casks of wine, and having rolled them forward to his
+hand they knocked out the heads of the casks. Gulliver drank them both
+off at a draught, and asked for more, for they held only about a small
+tumblerful each. But there was no more to be had.
+
+As the small people walked to and fro over his body, Gulliver was
+sorely tempted to seize forty or fifty of them and dash them on the
+ground, and then to make a further struggle for liberty. But the pain
+he had already suffered from their arrows made him think better of it,
+and he wisely lay quiet.
+
+Soon another small man, who from his brilliant uniform seemed to be an
+officer of very high rank, marched with some others on to Gulliver's
+chest and held up to his eyes a paper which Gulliver understood to be
+an order from the King of the country. The officer made a long speech,
+often pointing towards something a long way off, and (as Gulliver
+afterwards learned) told him that he was to be taken as a prisoner to
+the city, the capital of the country.
+
+Gulliver asked, by signs, that his bonds might be loosed. The officer
+shook his head and refused, but he allowed some of his soldiers to
+slack the cords on one side, whereby Gulliver was able to feel more
+comfortable. After this, the little people drew out the arrows that
+still stuck in his hands and face, and rubbed the wounds with some
+pleasant-smelling ointment, which so soothed his pain that very soon
+he fell sound asleep. And this was no great wonder, for, as he
+afterwards understood, the King's physicians had mixed a very strong
+sleeping draught with the wine that had been given him.
+
+Gulliver awoke with a violent fit of sneezing, and with the feeling of
+small feet running away from off his chest.
+
+Where was he? Bound still, without doubt, but no longer did he find
+himself lying on the ground. It puzzled him greatly that now he lay on
+a sort of platform. How had he got there?
+
+Soon he began to realize what had happened; and later, when he
+understood the language, he learned all that had been done to him
+while he slept. Before he dropped asleep, he had heard a rumbling as
+of wheels, and the shouts of many drivers. This, it seemed, was caused
+by the arrival of a huge kind of trolley, a few inches high, but
+nearly seven feet long, drawn by fifteen hundred of the King's largest
+horses.
+
+On this it was meant that he should be taken to the city. By the use
+of strong poles fixed in the ground, to which were attached many
+pulleys, and the strongest ropes to be found in the country, nine
+hundred men managed to hoist him as he slept. They then put him on the
+trolley, where they again tied him fast.
+
+It was when they were far on their way to the city that Gulliver
+awoke. The trolley had stopped for a little to breathe the horses, and
+one of the officers of the King's Guard who had not before seen
+Gulliver, climbed with some friends up his body. While looking at his
+face, the officer could not resist the temptation of putting the point
+of his sword up Gulliver's nose, which tickled him so that he woke,
+sneezing violently.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+GULLIVER IS TAKEN AS A PRISONER TO THE CAPITAL OF LILLIPUT
+
+
+The city was not reached till the following day, and Gulliver had to
+spend the night lying where he was, guarded on each side by five
+hundred men with torches and bows and arrows, ready to shoot him if he
+should attempt to move.
+
+In the morning, the King and all his court, and thousands of the
+people, came out to gaze on the wonderful sight. The trolley, with
+Gulliver on it, stopped outside the walls, alongside a very large
+building which had once been used as a temple, but the use of which
+had been given up owing to a murder having been committed in it.
+
+The door of this temple was quite four feet high and about two feet
+wide, and on each side, about six inches from the ground, was a small
+window. Inside the building the King's blacksmiths fastened many
+chains, which they then brought through one of these little windows
+and padlocked round Gulliver's left ankle. Then his bonds were cut,
+and he was allowed to get up. He found that he could easily creep
+through the door, and that there was room inside to lie down.
+
+His chains were nearly six feet long, so that he could get a little
+exercise by walking backwards and forwards outside. Always when he
+walked, thousands of people thronged around to look at him; even the
+King himself used to come and gaze by the hour from a high tower which
+stood opposite.
+
+One day, just as Gulliver had crept out from his house and had got on
+his feet, it chanced that the King, who was a very fine-looking man,
+taller than any of his people, came riding along on his great white
+charger. When the horse saw Gulliver move it was terrified, and
+plunged and reared so madly that the people feared that a terrible
+accident was going to happen, and several of the King's guards ran in
+to seize the horse by the head. But the King was a good horseman, and
+managed the animal so well that very soon it got over its fright, and
+he was able to dismount.
+
+Then he gave orders that food should be brought for Gulliver, twenty
+little carts full, and ten of wine; and he and his courtiers, all
+covered with gold and silver, stood around and watched him eating.
+After the King had gone away the people of the city crowded round, and
+some of them began to behave very badly, one man even going so far as
+to shoot an arrow at Gulliver which was not far from putting out one
+of his eyes. But the officer in command of the soldiers who were on
+guard ordered his men to bind and push six of the worst behaved of the
+crowd within reach of Gulliver, who at once seized five of them and
+put them in his coat pocket. The sixth he held up to his mouth and
+made as if he meant to eat him, whereupon the wretched little creature
+shrieked aloud with terror, and when Gulliver took out his knife, all
+the people, even the soldiers, were dreadfully alarmed. But Gulliver
+only cut the man's bonds, and let him run away, which he did in a
+great hurry. And when he took the others out of his pocket, one by
+one, and treated them in the same way, the crowd began to laugh. After
+that the people always behaved very well to Gulliver, and he became a
+great favorite. From all over the kingdom crowds flocked to see the
+Great Man Mountain.
+
+In the meantime, as Gulliver learned later, there were frequent
+meetings of the King's council to discuss the question of what was to
+be done with him. Some of the councilors feared lest he might break
+loose and cause great damage in the city. Some were of opinion that to
+keep and feed so huge a creature would cause a famine in the land, or,
+at the least, that the expense would be greater than the public funds
+could bear; they advised, therefore, that he should be killed--shot in
+the hands and face with poisoned arrows. Others, however, argued that
+if this were done it would be a very difficult thing to get rid of so
+large a dead body, which might cause a pestilence to break out if it
+lay long unburied so near the city.
+
+Finally, the King and his council gave orders that each morning the
+surrounding villages should send into the city for Gulliver's daily
+use six oxen, forty sheep, and a sufficient quantity of bread and
+wine.
+
+It was also commanded that six hundred persons should act as his
+servants; that three hundred tailors were to make for him a suit of
+clothes; and that six professors from the University were to teach him
+the language of the country.
+
+When Gulliver could speak the language, he learned a great deal about
+the land in which he now found himself. It was called Lilliput, and
+the people, Lilliputians. These Lilliputians believed that their
+kingdom and the neighboring country of Blefuscu were the whole world.
+Blefuscu lay far over the sea, to these little people dim and blue on
+the horizon, though to Gulliver the distance did not seem to be more
+than a mile. The Lilliputians knew of no land beyond Blefuscu. And as
+for Gulliver himself, they believed that he had fallen from the moon,
+or from one of the stars; it was impossible, they said, that so big a
+race of men could live on the earth. It was quite certain that there
+could not be food enough for them. They did not believe Gulliver's
+story. He must have fallen from the moon!
+
+Almost the first thing that Gulliver did when he knew the language
+fairly well, was to send a petition to the King, praying that his
+chains might be taken off and that he might be free to walk about. But
+this he was told could not then be granted. He must first, the King's
+council said, "swear a peace" with the kingdom of Lilliput, and
+afterwards, if by continued good behavior he gained their confidence,
+he might be freed.
+
+Meantime, by the King's orders, two high officers of state were sent
+to search him, Gulliver lifted up these officers in his hand and put
+them into each of his pockets, one after the other, and they made for
+the King a careful list of everything found there.
+
+Gulliver afterward saw this inventory. His snuff-box they had
+described as a "huge silver chest, full of a sort of dust." Into that
+dust one of them stepped, and the snuff, flying up in his face, caused
+him nearly to sneeze his head off. His pistols they called "hollow
+pillars of iron, fastened to strong pieces of timber," and the use of
+his bullets, and of his powder (which he had been lucky enough to
+bring ashore dry, owing to his pouch being water-tight), they could
+not understand, while of his watch they could make nothing. They
+called it "a wonderful kind of engine, which makes an incessant noise
+like a water-wheel." But some fancied that it was perhaps a kind of
+animal. Certainly it was alive.
+
+All these things, together with his sword, which he carried slung to a
+belt round his waist, Gulliver had to give up, first, as well as he
+could, explaining the use of them. The Lilliputians could not
+understand the pistols, and to show his meaning, Gulliver was obliged
+to fire one of them. At once hundreds of little people fell down as if
+they had been struck dead by the noise. Even the King, though he stood
+his ground, was sorely frightened. Most of Gulliver's property was
+returned to him; but the pistols and powder and bullets, and his
+sword, were taken away and put, for safety, under strict guard.
+
+As the King and his courtiers gained more faith in Gulliver, and
+became less afraid of his breaking loose and doing some mischief,
+they began to treat him in a more friendly way than they had hitherto
+done, and showed him more of the manners and customs of the country.
+Some of these were very curious.
+
+One of the sports of which they were most fond was rope-dancing, and
+there was no more certain means of being promoted to high office and
+power in the state than to possess great cleverness in that art.
+Indeed, it was said that the Lord High Treasurer had gained and kept
+his post chiefly through his great skill in turning somersaults on the
+tight rope. The Chief Secretary for private affairs ran him very
+close, and there was hardly a Minister of State who did not owe his
+position to such successes. Few of them, indeed, had escaped without
+severe accidents at one time or another, while trying some specially
+difficult feat, and many had been lamed for life. But however many and
+bad the falls, there were always plenty of other persons to attempt
+the same or some more difficult jump.
+
+Taught by his narrow escape from a serious accident when his horse
+first saw Gulliver, the King now gave orders that the horses of his
+army, as well as those from the Royal stables, should be exercised
+daily close to the Man Mountain. Soon they became so used to the sight
+of him that they would come right up to his foot without starting or
+shying. Often the riders would jump their chargers over Gulliver's
+hand as he held it on the ground; and once the King's huntsman, better
+mounted than most of the others, actually jumped over his foot, shoe
+and all--a wonderful leap.
+
+Gulliver saw that it was wise to amuse the King in this and other
+ways, because the more his Majesty was pleased with him the sooner was
+it likely that his liberty would be granted. So he asked one day that
+some strong sticks, about two feet in height, should be brought to
+him. Several of these he fixed firmly in the ground, and across them,
+near the top, he lashed four other sticks, enclosing a square space of
+about two and a half feet. Then to the uprights, about five inches
+lower than the crossed sticks, he tied his pocket-handkerchief, and
+stretched it tight as a drum.
+
+When the work was finished, he asked the King to let a troop exercise
+on this stage. His Majesty was delighted with the idea, and for
+several days nothing pleased him more than to see Gulliver lift up the
+men and horses, and to watch them go through their drill on this
+platform. Sometimes he would even be lifted up himself and give the
+words of command; and once he persuaded the Queen, who was rather
+timid, to let herself be held up in her chair within full view of the
+scene. But a fiery horse one day, pawing with his hoof, wore a hole in
+the handkerchief, and came down heavily on its side, and after this
+Gulliver could no longer trust the strength of his stage.
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+GULLIVER IS FREED, AND CAPTURES THE BLEFUSCAN FLEET
+
+
+By this time Gulliver's clothes were almost in rags. The three hundred
+tailors had not yet been able to finish his new suit, and he had no
+hat at all, for that had been lost as he came ashore from the wreck.
+So he was greatly pleased one day when an express message came to the
+King from the coast, saying that some men had found on the shore a
+great, black, strangely-shaped mass, as high as a man; it was not
+alive, they were certain. It had never moved, though for a time they
+had watched, before going closer. After making certain that it was not
+likely to injure them, by mounting on each other's shoulders they had
+got on the top, which they found was flat and smooth, and, by the
+sound when stamped upon, they judged that it was hollow. It was
+thought that the object might possibly be something belonging to the
+Man Mountain, and they proposed by the help of five horses to bring it
+to the city.
+
+Gulliver was sure that it must be his hat, and so it turned out. Nor
+was it very greatly damaged, either by the sea or by being drawn by
+the horses over the ground all the way from the coast, except that two
+holes had been bored in the brim, to which a long cord had been fixed
+by hooks. Gulliver was much pleased to have it once more.
+
+Two days after this the King took into his head a curious fancy. He
+ordered a review of troops to be held, and he directed that Gulliver
+should stand with his legs very wide apart, while under him both horse
+and foot were commanded to march. Over three thousand infantry and one
+thousand cavalry passed through the great arch made by his legs,
+colors flying and bands playing. The King and Queen themselves sat in
+their State Coach at the saluting point, near to his left leg, and all
+the while Gulliver dared not move a hair's-breadth, lest he should
+injure some of the soldiers.
+
+Shortly after this, Gulliver was set free. There had been a meeting of
+the King's Council on the subject, and the Lord High Admiral was the
+only member in favor of still keeping him chained. This great officer
+to the end was Gulliver's bitter enemy, and though on this occasion he
+was out-voted, yet he was allowed to draw up the conditions which
+Gulliver was to sign before his chains were struck off.
+
+The conditions were:
+
+First, that he was not to quit the country without leave granted under
+the King's Great Seal.
+
+Second, that he was not to come into the city without orders; at which
+times the people were to have two hours' notice to keep indoors.
+
+Third, that he should keep to the high roads, and not walk or lie down
+in a meadow.
+
+Fourth, that he was to take the utmost care not to trample on anybody,
+or on any horses or carriages, and that he was not to lift any persons
+in his hand against their will.
+
+Fifth, that if at any time an express had to be sent in great haste,
+he was to carry the messenger and his horse in his pocket a six-days'
+journey, and to bring them safely back.
+
+Sixth, that he should be the King's ally against the Blefuscans, and
+that he should try to destroy their fleet, which was said to be
+preparing to invade Lilliput.
+
+Seventh, that he should help the workmen to move certain great stones
+which were needed to repair some of the public buildings.
+
+Eighth, that he should in "two moons' time" make an exact survey of
+the kingdom, by counting how many of his own paces it took him to go
+all round the coast.
+
+Lastly, on his swearing to the above conditions, it was promised that
+he should have a daily allowance of meat and drink equal to the amount
+consumed by seventeen hundred and twenty-four of the Lilliputians, for
+they estimated that Gulliver's size was about equal to that number of
+their own people.
+
+Though one or two of the conditions did not please him, especially
+that about helping the workmen (which he thought was making him too
+much a servant), yet Gulliver signed the document at once, and swore
+to observe its conditions.
+
+After having done so, and having had his chains removed, the first
+thing he asked was to be allowed to see the city (which was called
+Mildendo). He found that it was surrounded by a great wall about two
+and a half feet high, broad enough for one of their coaches and four
+to be driven along, and at every ten feet there were strong flanking
+towers.
+
+Gulliver took off his coat, lest the tails might do damage to the
+roofs or chimneys of the houses, and he then stepped over the wall and
+very carefully walked down the finest of the streets, one quite five
+feet wide. Wherever he went, the tops of the houses and the attic
+windows were packed with wondering spectators, and he reckoned that
+the town must hold quite half a million of people.
+
+In the center of the city, where the two chief streets met, stood the
+King's Palace, a very fine building surrounded by a wall. But he was
+not able to see the whole palace that day, because the part in which
+were the royal apartments was shut off by another wall nearly five
+feet in height, which he could not get over without a risk of doing
+damage.
+
+Some days later he climbed over by the help of two stools which he
+made from some of the largest trees in the Royal Park, trees nearly
+seven feet high, which he was allowed to cut down for the purpose. By
+putting one of the stools at each side of the wall Gulliver was able
+to step across. Then, lying down on his side, and putting his face
+close to the open windows, he looked in and saw the Queen and all the
+young Princes. The Queen smiled, and held her hand out of one of the
+windows, that he might kiss it. She was very pleasant and friendly.
+
+One day, about a fortnight after this, there came to call on him,
+Reldresal, the King's Chief Secretary, a very great man, one who had
+always been Gulliver's very good friend. This person had a long and
+serious talk with Gulliver about the state of the country.
+
+He said that though to the outward eye things in Lilliput seemed very
+settled and prosperous, yet in reality there were troubles, both
+internal and external, that threatened the safety of the kingdom.
+
+There had been in Lilliput for a very long time two parties at bitter
+enmity with each other, so bitter that they would neither eat, drink,
+nor talk together, and what one party did, the other would always try
+to undo. Each professed to believe that nothing good could come from
+the other. Any measure proposed by the party in power was by the other
+always looked upon as foolish or evil. And any new law passed by the
+Government party was said by the Opposition to be either a wicked
+attack on the liberties of the people, or something undertaken solely
+for the purpose of keeping that party in, and the Opposition out, of
+power. To such a pitch had things now come, said the Chief Secretary,
+entirely owing to the folly of the Opposition, that the business of
+the kingdom was almost at a standstill.
+
+Meantime the country was in danger of an invasion by the Blefuscans,
+who were now fitting out a great fleet, which was almost ready to sail
+to attack Lilliput. The war with Blefuscu had been raging for some
+years, and the losses by both nations of ships and of men had been
+very heavy.
+
+This war had broken out in the following way. It had always been the
+custom in Lilliput, as far back as history went, for people when
+breaking an egg at breakfast to do so at the big end. But it had
+happened, said the Chief Secretary, that the present King's
+grandfather, when a boy, had once when breaking his egg in the usual
+way, severely cut his finger. Whereupon his father at once gave strict
+commands that in future all his subjects should break their eggs at
+the small end.
+
+This greatly angered the people, who thought that the King had no
+right to give such an order, and they refused to obey. As a
+consequence no less than six rebellions had taken place: thousands of
+the Lilliputians had had their heads cut off, or had been cast into
+prison, and thousands had fled for refuge to Blefuscu, rather than
+obey the hated order.
+
+These "Big endians," as they were called, had been very well received
+at the Court of Blefuscu, and finally the Emperor of that country had
+taken upon himself to interfere in the affairs of Lilliput, thus
+bringing on war.
+
+The Chief Secretary ended the talk by saying that the King, having
+great faith in Gulliver's strength, and depending on the oath which he
+had sworn before being released, expected him now to help in defeating
+the Blefuscan fleet.
+
+Gulliver was very ready to do what he could, and he at once thought of
+a plan whereby he might destroy the whole fleet at one blow. He told
+all his ideas on the subject to the King, who gave orders that
+everything he might need should be supplied without delay. Then
+Gulliver went to the oldest seamen in the navy, and learned from them
+the depth of water between Lilliput and Blefuscu. It was, they said,
+nowhere deeper than seventy _glumgluffs_ (which is equal to about six
+feet) at high water, and there was no great extent so deep.
+
+After this he walked to the coast opposite Blefuscu, and lying down
+there behind a hillock, so that he might not be seen should any of the
+enemy's ships happen to be cruising near, he looked long through a
+small pocket-telescope across the channel. With the naked eye he could
+easily see the cliffs of Blefuscu, and soon with his telescope he made
+out where the fleet lay--fifty great men-of-war, and many transports,
+waiting for a fair wind.
+
+Coming back to the city, he gave orders for a great length of the
+strongest cable, and a quantity of bars of iron. The cable was little
+thicker than ordinary pack-thread, and the bars of iron much about the
+length and size of knitting-needles. Gulliver twisted three of the
+iron bars together and bent them to a hook at one end. He trebled the
+cable for greater strength, and thus made fifty shorter cables, to
+which he fastened the hooks.
+
+Then, carrying these in his hand, he walked back to the coast and
+waded into the sea, a little before high water. When he came to
+mid-channel, he had to swim, but for no great distance.
+
+As soon as they noticed Gulliver coming wading through the water
+towards their ships, the Blefuscan sailors all jumped overboard and
+swam ashore in a terrible fright. Never before had any of them seen or
+dreamt of so monstrous a giant, nor had they heard of his being in
+Lilliput.
+
+Gulliver then quietly took his cables and fixed one securely in the
+bows of each of the ships of war, and finally he tied the cables
+together at his end. But while he was doing this the Blefuscan
+soldiers on the shore plucked up courage and began to shoot arrows at
+him, many of which stuck in his hands and face. He was very much
+afraid lest some of these might put out his eyes; but he remembered,
+luckily, that in his inner pocket were his spectacles, which he put
+on, and then finished his work without risk to his eyes.
+
+On pulling at the cables, however, not a ship could he move. He had
+forgotten that their anchors were all down. So he was forced to go in
+closer and with his knife to cut the vessels free. While doing this he
+was of course exposed to a furious fire from the enemy, and hundreds
+of arrows struck him, some almost knocking off his spectacles. But
+again he hauled, and this time drew the whole fifty vessels after him.
+
+The Blefuscans had thought that it was his intention merely to cast
+the vessels adrift, so that they might run aground, but when they saw
+their great fleet being steadily drawn out to sea, their grief was
+terrible. For a great distance Gulliver could hear their cries of
+despair.
+
+When he had got well away from the land, he stopped in order to pick
+the arrows from his face and hands, and to put on some of the ointment
+that had been rubbed on his wounds when first the Lilliputians fired
+into him. By this time the tide had fallen a little, and he was able
+to wade all the way across the channel.
+
+The King and his courtiers stood waiting on the shore. They could see
+the vessels steadily drawing nearer, but they could not for some time
+see Gulliver, because only his head was above water. At first some
+imagined that he had been drowned, and that the fleet was now on its
+way to attack Lilliput.
+
+There was great joy when Gulliver was seen hauling the vessels; and
+when he landed, the King was so pleased that on the spot he created
+him a _Nardac_, the highest honor that it was in his power to bestow.
+
+His great success over the Blefuscans, however, turned out to be but
+the beginning of trouble for Gulliver. The King was so puffed up by
+the victory that he formed plans for capturing in the same way the
+whole of the enemy's ships of every kind. And it was now his wish to
+crush Blefuscu utterly, and to make it nothing but a province
+depending on Lilliput. Thus, he thought, he himself would then be
+monarch of the whole world.
+
+In this scheme Gulliver refused to take any part, and he very plainly
+said that he would give no help in making slaves of the Blefuscans.
+This refusal angered the King very much, and more than once he
+artfully brought the matter up at a State Council. Now, several of the
+councilors, though they pretended to be Gulliver's friends so long as
+he was in favor with the King, were really his secret enemies, and
+nothing pleased these persons better than to see that the King was no
+longer pleased with him. So they did all in their power to nurse and
+increase the King's anger, and to make him believe that Gulliver was a
+traitor.
+
+About this time there came to Lilliput ambassadors from Blefuscu,
+suing for peace. When a treaty had been made and signed (very greatly
+to the advantage of Lilliput), the Blefuscan ambassadors asked to see
+the Great Man Mountain, of whom they had heard so much, and they paid
+Gulliver a formal call. After asking him to give them some proofs of
+his strength, they invited him to visit their Emperor, which Gulliver
+promised to do.
+
+Accordingly, the next time that he met the King, he asked, as he was
+bound to do by the paper he had signed, for permission to leave the
+country for a time, in order to visit Blefuscu. The King did not
+refuse, but his manner was so cold that Gulliver could not help
+noticing it. Afterwards he learned from a friend that his enemies in
+the council had told the King lying tales of his meetings with the
+Blefuscan ambassadors, which had had the effect of still further
+rousing his anger.
+
+It happened too, most unfortunately, at this time, that Gulliver had
+offended the Queen by a well-meant, but badly-managed, effort to do
+her a service, and thus he lost also her friendship. But though he was
+now out of favor at court, he was still an object of great interest to
+every one.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+GULLIVER'S ESCAPE FROM LILLIPUT AND RETURN TO ENGLAND
+
+
+Gulliver had three hundred cooks to dress his food and these men, with
+their families, lived in small huts which had been built for them near
+his house.
+
+He had made for himself a chair and a table. On to this table it was
+his custom to lift twenty waiters, and these men then drew up by ropes
+and pulleys all his food, and his wine in casks, which one hundred
+other servants had in readiness on the ground. Gulliver would often
+eat his meal with many hundreds of people looking on.
+
+One day the King, who had not seen him eat since this table had been
+built, sent a message that he and the Queen desired to be present that
+day while Gulliver dined. They arrived just before his dinner hour,
+and he at once lifted the King and Queen and the Princes, with their
+attendants and guards, on to the table.
+
+Their Majesties sat in their chairs of state all the time, watching
+with deep interest the roasts of beef and mutton, and whole flocks of
+geese and turkeys and fowls disappear into Gulliver's mouth. A roast
+of beef of which he had to make more than two mouthfuls was seldom
+seen, and he ate them bones and all. A goose or a turkey was but one
+bite.
+
+Certainly, on this occasion, Gulliver ate more than usual, thinking by
+so doing to amuse and please the court.
+
+But in this he erred, for it was turned against him. Flimnap, the Lord
+High Treasurer, who had always been one of his enemies, pointed out to
+the King the great daily expense of such meals, and told how this huge
+man had already cost the country over a million and a half of _sprugs_
+(the largest Lilliputian gold coin). Things, indeed, were beginning to
+go very ill with Gulliver.
+
+Now it happened about this time that one of the King's courtiers, to
+whom Gulliver had been very kind, came to him by night very privately
+in a closed chair, and asked to have a talk, without any one else
+being present.
+
+Gulliver gave to a servant whom he could trust orders that no one else
+was to be admitted, and having put the courtier and his chair upon the
+table, so that he might better hear all that was said, he sat down to
+listen.
+
+Gulliver was told that there had lately been several secret meetings
+of the King's Privy Council, on his account. The Lord High Admiral
+(who now hated him because of his success against the Blefuscan
+fleet), Flimnap, the High Treasurer, and others of his enemies, had
+drawn up against him charges of treason and other crimes. The courtier
+had brought with him a copy of these charges, and Gulliver now read
+them.
+
+It was made a point against him that, when ordered to do so by the
+King, he had refused to seize all the other Blefuscan ships. It was
+also said that he would not join in utterly crushing the empire of
+Blefuscu, nor give aid when it was proposed to put to death not only
+all the Big endians who had fled for refuge to that country, but all
+the Blefuscans themselves who were friends of the Big-endians. For
+this he was said to be a traitor.
+
+He was also accused of being over-friendly with the Blefuscan
+ambassadors; and it was made a grave charge against him that though
+his Majesty had not given him written leave to visit Blefuscu, he yet
+was getting ready to go to that country, in order to give help to the
+Emperor against Lilliput.
+
+There had been many debates on these charges, said the courtier, and
+the Lord High Admiral had made violent speeches, strongly advising
+that the Great Man Mountain should be put to death. In this he was
+joined by Flimnap, and by others, so that actually the greater part of
+the council was in favor of instant death by the most painful means
+that could be used.
+
+The less unfriendly members of the council, however, while saying that
+they had no doubt of Gulliver's guilt, were yet of the opinion that,
+as his services to the kingdom of Lilliput had been great, the
+punishment of death was too severe. They thought it would be enough if
+his eyes were put out. This, they said, would not prevent him from
+being still made useful.
+
+Then began a most excited argument, the Admiral and those who sided
+with him insisting that Gulliver should be killed at once.
+
+At last the Secretary rose and said that he had a middle course to
+suggest. This was, that Gulliver's eyes should be put out, and that
+thereafter his food should be gradually so reduced in quantity that in
+the course of two or three months he would die of starvation. By which
+time, said the Secretary, his body would be wasted to an extent that
+would make it easy for five or six hundred men, in a few days, to cut
+off the flesh and take it away in cart-loads to be buried at a
+distance. Thus there would be no danger of a pestilence breaking out
+from the dead body lying near the city. The skeleton, he said, could
+then be put in the National Museum.
+
+It was finally decided that this sentence should be carried out, and
+twenty of the King's surgeons were ordered to be present in three
+days' time to see the operation of putting out Gulliver's eyes
+properly done. Sharp-pointed arrows were to be shot into the balls of
+his eyes.
+
+The courtier now left the house, as privately as he had come, and
+Gulliver was left to decide what he should do.
+
+At first he thought of attacking the city, and destroying it. But by
+doing this he must have destroyed, with the city, a great many
+thousands of innocent people, which he could not make up his mind to
+do.
+
+At last he wrote a letter to the Chief Secretary, saying that as the
+King had himself told him that he might visit Blefuscu, he had decided
+to do so that morning.
+
+Without waiting for an answer, he set out for the coast, where he
+seized a large man-of-war which was at anchor there, tied a cable to
+her bow, and then putting his clothes and his blanket on board, he
+drew the ship after him to Blefuscu. There he was well received by the
+Emperor. But as there happened to be no house big enough for him, he
+was forced, during his stay, to sleep each night on the ground,
+wrapped in his blanket.
+
+Three days after his arrival, when walking along the seashore, he
+noticed something in the water which looked not unlike a boat
+floating bottom up. Gulliver waded and swam out, and found that he was
+right. It was a boat. By the help of some of the Blefsucan ships, with
+much difficulty he got it ashore. When the tide had fallen, two
+thousand of the Emperor's dockyard men helped him to turn it over, and
+Gulliver found that but little damage had been done.
+
+He now set to work to make oars and mast and sail for the boat, and to
+fit it out and provision it for a voyage.
+
+While this work was going on, there came from Lilliput a message
+demanding that Gulliver should be bound hand and foot and returned to
+that country as a prisoner, there to be punished as a traitor. To this
+message the Emperor replied that it was not possible to bind him; that
+moreover the Great Man Mountain had found a vessel of size great
+enough to carry him over the sea, and that it was his purpose to leave
+the Empire of Blefuscu in the course of a few weeks.
+
+Gulliver did not delay his work, and in less than a month he was ready
+to sail.
+
+He put on board the boat the carcasses of one hundred oxen and three
+hundred sheep, with a quantity of bread and wine, and as much meat
+ready cooked as four hundred cooks could prepare.
+
+He also took with him a herd of six live black cows and two bulls, and
+a flock of sheep, meaning to take them with him to England, if ever he
+should get there. As food for these animals he took a quantity of hay
+and corn.
+
+Gulliver would have liked to take with him some of the people, but
+this the Emperor would not permit.
+
+Everything being ready, he sailed from Blefuscu on 24th September
+1701, and the same night anchored on the lee side of an island which
+seemed to be uninhabited. Leaving this island on the following
+morning, he sailed to the eastward for two days. On the evening of the
+second day he sighted a ship, on reaching which, to his great joy, he
+found that she was an English vessel on her way home from Japan.
+
+Putting his cattle and sheep in his coat-pockets, he went on board
+with all his cargo of provisions. The captain received him very
+kindly, and asked him from whence he had come, and how he happened to
+be at sea in an open boat.
+
+Gulliver told his tale in as few words as possible. The captain stared
+with wonder, and would not believe his story. But Gulliver then took
+from his pockets the black cattle and the sheep, which of course
+clearly showed that he had been speaking truth. He also showed gold
+coins which the Emperor of Blefuscu had given him, some of which he
+presented to the captain.
+
+The vessel did not arrive at the port of London till April, 1702, but
+there was no loss of the live stock, excepting that the rats on board
+carried off and ate one of the sheep. All the others were got safely
+ashore, and were put to graze on a bowling-green at Greenwich, where
+they throve very well.
+
+
+
+
+THE ARABIAN NIGHTS
+
+ADAPTED BY AMY STEEDMAN
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+ALADDIN AND THE WONDERFUL LAMP
+
+
+Far away on the other side of the world, in one of the great wealthy
+cities of China, there once lived a poor tailor called Mustapha. He
+had a wife whom he loved dearly and an only son whose name was
+Aladdin.
+
+But, sad to say, although the tailor was good and industrious, his son
+was so idle and bad that his father and mother did not know what to do
+with him. All day long he played in the streets with other idle boys,
+and when he grew big enough to learn a trade he said he did not mean
+to work at all. His poor father was very much troubled, and ordered
+Aladdin to come to the workshop to learn to be a tailor, but Aladdin
+only laughed, and ran away so swiftly that neither his father nor
+mother could catch him.
+
+"Alas!" said Mustapha sadly, "I can do nothing with this idle boy."
+
+And he grew so sad about it, that at last he fell ill and died.
+
+Then the poor widow was obliged to sell the little workshop, and try
+to make enough money for herself and Aladdin by spinning.
+
+Now it happened that one day when Aladdin was playing as usual with
+the idle street boys, a tall, dark, old man stood watching him, and
+when the game was finished he made a sign to Aladdin to come to him.
+
+"What is thy name, my boy?" asked this old man, who, though he
+appeared so kind, was really an African Magician.
+
+"My name is Aladdin," answered the boy, wondering who this stranger
+could be.
+
+"And what is thy father's name?" asked the Magician.
+
+"My father was Mustapha the tailor, but he has been dead a long time
+now," answered Aladdin.
+
+"Alas!" cried the wicked old Magician, pretending to weep, "he was my
+brother, and thou must be my nephew. I am thy long-lost uncle!" and he
+threw his arms round Aladdin's neck and embraced him.
+
+"Tell thy dear mother that I will come and see her this very day," he
+cried, "and give her this small present." And he placed in Aladdin's
+hands five gold pieces.
+
+Aladdin ran home in great haste to tell his mother the story of the
+long-lost uncle.
+
+"It must be a mistake," she said, "thou hast no uncle."
+
+But when she saw the gold she began to think that this stranger must
+be a relation, and so she prepared a grand supper to welcome him when
+he came.
+
+They had not long to wait before the African Magician appeared,
+bringing with him all sorts of fruits and delicious sweets for desert.
+
+"Tell me about my poor brother," he said, as he embraced Aladdin and
+his mother. "Show me exactly where he used to sit."
+
+Then the widow pointed to a seat on the sofa, and the Magician knelt
+down and began to kiss the place and weep over it.
+
+The poor widow was quite touched, and began to believe that this
+really must be her husband's brother, especially when he began to show
+the kindest interest in Aladdin.
+
+"What is thy trade?" he asked the boy.
+
+"Alas!" said the widow, "he will do nothing but play in the streets."
+
+Aladdin hung his head with shame as his uncle gravely shook his head.
+
+"He must begin work at once," he said. "How would it please thee to
+have a shop of thy own? I could buy one for thee, and stock it with
+silks and rich stuffs."
+
+Aladdin danced with joy at the very idea, and next day set out with
+his supposed uncle, who bought him a splendid suit of clothes, and
+took him all over the city to show him the sights.
+
+The day after, the Magician again took Aladdin out with him, but this
+time they went outside the city, through beautiful gardens, into the
+open country. They walked so far that Aladdin began to grow weary, but
+the Magician gave him a cake and some delicious fruit and told him
+such wonderful tales that he scarcely noticed how far they had gone.
+At last they came to a deep valley between two mountains, and there
+the Magician paused.
+
+"Stop!" he cried, "this is the very place I am in search of. Gather
+some sticks that we may make a fire."
+
+Aladdin quickly did as he was bid, and had soon gathered together a
+great heap of dry sticks. The Magician then set fire to them, and the
+heap blazed up merrily. With great care the old man now sprinkled some
+curious-looking powder on the flames, and muttered strange words. In
+an instant the earth beneath their feet trembled, and they heard a
+rumbling like distant thunder. Then the ground opened in front of
+them, and showed a great square slab of stone with a ring in it.
+
+By this time Aladdin was so frightened that he turned to run home as
+fast as he could, but the Magician caught him, and gave him such a
+blow that he fell to the earth.
+
+"Why dost thou strike me, uncle?" sobbed Aladdin.
+
+"Do as I bid thee," said the Magician, "and then thou shalt be well
+treated. Dost thou see that stone? Beneath it is a treasure which I
+will share with thee. Only obey me, and it will soon be ours."
+
+As soon as Aladdin heard of a treasure, he jumped up and forgot all
+his fears. He seized the ring as the Magician directed, and easily
+pulled up the stone.
+
+"Now," said the old man, "look in and thou wilt see stone steps
+leading downwards. Thou shalt descend those steps until thou comest to
+three great halls. Pass through them, but take care to wrap thy coat
+well round thee that thou mayest touch nothing, for if thou dost, thou
+wilt die instantly. When thou hast passed through the halls thou wilt
+come into a garden of fruit-trees. Go through it until thou seest a
+niche with a lighted lamp in it. Put the light out, pour forth the
+oil, and bring the lamp to me."
+
+So saying the Magician placed a magic ring upon Aladdin's finger to
+guard him, and bade the boy begin his search.
+
+Aladdin did exactly as he was told and found everything just as the
+Magician had said. He went through the halls and the garden until he
+came to the lamp, and when he had poured out the oil and placed the
+lamp carefully inside his coat he began to look about him.
+
+He had never seen such a lovely garden before, even in his dreams. The
+fruits that hung upon the trees were of every color of the rainbow.
+Some were clear and shining like crystal, some sparkled with a crimson
+light and others were green, blue, violet, and orange, while the
+leaves that shaded them were silver and gold. Aladdin did not guess
+that these fruits were precious stones, diamonds, rubies, emeralds,
+and sapphires, but they looked so pretty that he filled all his
+pockets with them as he passed back through the garden.
+
+The Magician was eagerly peering down the stone steps when Aladdin
+began to climb up.
+
+"Give me the lamp," he cried, stretching his hand for it.
+
+"Wait until I get out," answered Aladdin, "and then I will give it
+thee."
+
+"Hand it up to me at once," screamed the old man angrily.
+
+"Not till I am safely out," repeated Aladdin.
+
+Then the Magician stamped with rage, and rushing to the fire threw on
+it some more of the curious powder, uttered the same strange words as
+before, and instantly the stone slipped back into its place, the earth
+closed over it, and Aladdin was left in darkness.
+
+This showed indeed that the wicked old man was not Aladdin's uncle. By
+his magic arts in Africa he had found out all about the lamp, which
+was a wonderful treasure, as you will see. But he knew that he could
+not get it himself, that another hand must fetch it to him. This was
+the reason why he had fixed upon Aladdin to help him, and had meant,
+as soon as the lamp was safely in his hand, to kill the boy.
+
+As his plan had failed he went back to Africa, and was not seen again
+for a long, long time.
+
+But there was poor Aladdin shut up underground, with no way of
+getting out! He tried to find his way back to the great halls and the
+beautiful garden of shining fruits, but the walls had closed up, and
+there was no escape that way either. For two days the poor boy sat
+crying and moaning in his despair, and just as he had made up his mind
+that he must die, he clasped his hands together, and in doing so
+rubbed the ring which the Magician had put upon his finger.
+
+In an instant a huge figure rose out of the earth and stood before
+him.
+
+"What is thy will, my master?" it said. "I am the Slave of the Ring,
+and must obey him who wears the ring."
+
+"Whoever or whatever you are," cried Aladdin, "take me out of this
+dreadful place."
+
+Scarcely had he said these words when the earth opened, and the next
+moment Aladdin found himself lying at his mother's door. He was so
+weak for want of food, and his joy at seeing his mother was so great,
+that he fainted away, but when he came to himself he promised to tell
+her all that had happened.
+
+"But first give me something to eat," he cried, "for I am dying of
+hunger."
+
+"Alas!" said his mother, "I have nothing in the house except a little
+cotton, which I will go out and sell."
+
+"Stop a moment," cried Aladdin, "rather let us sell this old lamp
+which I have brought back with me."
+
+Now the lamp looked so old and dirty that Aladdin's mother began to
+rub it, wishing to brighten it a little that it might fetch a higher
+price.
+
+But no sooner had she given it the first rub than a huge dark figure
+slowly rose from the floor like a wreath of smoke until it reached the
+ceiling, towering above them.
+
+"What is thy will?" it asked. "I am the Slave of the Lamp, and must do
+the bidding of him who holds the Lamp."
+
+The moment the figure began to rise from the ground Aladdin's mother
+was so terrified that she fainted away, but Aladdin managed to snatch
+the lamp from her, although he could scarcely hold it in his own
+shaking hand.
+
+"Fetch me something to eat," he said in a trembling voice, for the
+terrible Genie was glaring down upon him.
+
+The Slave of the Lamp disappeared in a cloud of smoke, but in an
+instant he was back again, bringing with him a most delicious
+breakfast, served upon plates and dishes of pure gold.
+
+By this time Aladdin's mother had recovered, but she was almost too
+frightened to eat, and begged Aladdin to sell the lamp at once, for
+she was sure it had something to do with evil spirits. But Aladdin
+only laughed at her fears, and said he meant to make use of the magic
+lamp and wonderful ring, now that he knew their worth.
+
+As soon as they again wanted money they sold the golden plates and
+dishes, and when these were all gone Aladdin ordered the Genie to
+bring more, and so they lived in comfort for several years.
+
+Now Aladdin had heard a great deal about the beauty of the Sultan's
+daughter, and he began to long so greatly to see her that he could not
+rest. He thought of a great many plans, but they all seemed
+impossible, for the Princess never went out without a veil, which
+covered her entirely. At last, however, he managed to enter the palace
+and hide himself behind a door, peeping through a chink when the
+Princess passed to go to her bath.
+
+The moment Aladdin's eyes rested upon the beautiful Princess he loved
+her with all his heart, for she was as fair as the dawn of a summer
+morning.
+
+"Mother," he cried when he reached home, "I have seen the Princess,
+and I have made up my mind to marry her. Thou shalt go at once to the
+Sultan, and beg him to give me his daughter."
+
+Aladdin's mother stared at her son, and then began to laugh at such a
+wild idea. She was almost afraid that Aladdin must be mad, but he gave
+her no peace until she did as he wished.
+
+So the next day she very unwillingly set out for the palace, carrying
+the magic fruit wrapped up in a napkin, to present to the Sultan.
+There were many other people offering their petitions that day, and
+the poor woman was so frightened that she dared not go forward, and so
+no one paid any attention to her as she stood there patiently holding
+her bundle. For a whole week she had gone every day to the palace,
+before the Sultan noticed her.
+
+"Who is that poor woman who comes every day carrying a white bundle?"
+he asked.
+
+Then the Grand Vizier ordered that she should be brought forward, and
+she came bowing herself to the ground.
+
+She was almost too terrified to speak, but when the Sultan spoke so
+kindly to her she took courage, and told him of Aladdin's love for the
+Princess, and of his bold request, "He sends you this gift," she
+continued, and opening the bundle she presented the magic fruit.
+
+A cry of wonder went up from all those who stood around, for never had
+they beheld such exquisite jewels before. They shone and sparkled with
+a thousand lights and colors, and dazzled the eyes that gazed upon
+them.
+
+The Sultan was astounded, and spoke to the Grand Vizier apart.
+
+"Surely it is fit that I should give my daughter to one who can
+present such a wondrous gift?" he said....
+
+Now when three months were ended, Aladdin's mother again presented
+herself before the Sultan, and reminded him of his promise, that the
+Princess should wed her son.
+
+"I ever abide by my royal word," said the Sultan; "but he who marries
+my daughter must first send me forty golden basins filled to the brim
+with precious stones. These basins must be carried by forty black
+slaves, each led by a white slave dressed as befits the servants of
+the Sultan."
+
+Aladdin's mother returned home in great distress when she heard this,
+and told Aladdin what the Sultan had said.
+
+"Alas, my son!" she cried, "thy hopes are ended."
+
+"Not so, mother," answered Aladdin. "The Sultan shall not have long to
+wait for his answer."
+
+Then he rubbed the magic lamp, and when the Genie appeared, he bade
+him provide the forty golden basins filled with jewels, and all the
+slaves which the Sultan had demanded.
+
+Now when this splendid procession passed through the streets on its
+way to the palace, all the people came out to see the sight, and stood
+amazed when they saw the golden basins filled with sparkling gems
+carried on the heads of the great black slaves. And when the palace
+was reached, and the slaves presented the jewels to the Sultan, he
+was so surprised and delighted that he was more than willing that
+Aladdin should marry the Princess at once.
+
+"Go, fetch thy son," he said to Aladdin's mother, who was waiting
+near. "Tell him that this day he shall wed my daughter."
+
+But when Aladdin heard the news he refused to hasten at once to the
+palace, as his mother advised. First he called the Genie, and told him
+to bring a scented bath, and a robe worked in gold, such as a King
+might wear. After this he called for forty slaves to attend him, and
+six to walk before his mother, and a horse more beautiful than the
+Sultan's, and lastly, for ten thousand pieces of gold put up in ten
+purses.
+
+When all these things were ready, and Aladdin was dressed in his royal
+robe, he set out for the palace. As he rode along on his beautiful
+horse, attended by his forty slaves, he scattered the golden pieces
+out of the ten purses among the crowd, and all the people shouted with
+joy and delight. No one knew that this was the idle boy who used to
+play about the streets but they thought he was some great foreign
+Prince.
+
+Thus Aladdin arrived at the palace in great state, and when the Sultan
+had embraced him, he ordered that the wedding feast should be prepared
+at once, and that the marriage should take place that day.
+
+"Not so, your Majesty," said Aladdin; "I will not marry the Princess
+until I have built a palace fit for the daughter of the Sultan."
+
+Then he returned home, and once more called up the Slave of the Lamp.
+
+"Build me the fairest palace ever beheld by mortal eye," ordered
+Aladdin. "Let it be built of marble and jasper and precious stones. In
+the midst I would have a great hall, whose walls shall be of gold and
+silver, lighted by four-and-twenty windows. These windows shall all be
+set with diamonds, rubies, and other precious stones, and one only
+shall be left unfinished. There must also be stables with horses, and
+slaves to serve in the palace. Begone, and do thy work quickly."
+
+And lo! in the morning when Aladdin looked out, there stood the most
+wonderful palace that ever was built. Its marble walls were flushed a
+delicate pink in the morning light, and the jewels flashed from every
+window.
+
+Then Aladdin and his mother set off for the Sultan's palace, and the
+wedding took place that day. The Princess loved Aladdin as soon as she
+saw him, and great were the rejoicings throughout the city.
+
+The next day Aladdin invited the Sultan to visit the new palace, and
+when he entered the great hall, whose walls were of gold and silver
+and whose windows were set with jewels, he was filled with admiration
+and astonishment.
+
+"It is the wonder of the world," he cried. "Never before have mortal
+eyes beheld such a beautiful palace. One thing alone surprises me. Why
+is there one window left unfinished?"
+
+"Your Majesty," answered Aladdin, "this has been done with a purpose,
+for I wished that thine own royal hand should have the honor of
+putting the finishing touch to my palace."
+
+The Sultan was so pleased when he heard this, that he sent at once for
+all the court jewelers and ordered them to finish the window like the
+rest.
+
+The court jewelers worked for many days, and then sent to tell the
+Sultan that they had used up all the jewels they possessed, and still
+the window was not half finished. The Sultan commanded that his own
+jewels should be given to complete the work; even when these were used
+the window was not finished.
+
+Then Aladdin ordered the jewelers to stop their work, and to take back
+all the Sultan's jewels as well as their own. And that night he called
+up the Slave of the Lamp once more, and bade him finish the window.
+This was done before the morning, and great was the surprise of the
+Sultan and all his workmen.
+
+Now Aladdin did not grow proud of his great riches but was gentle and
+courteous to all, and kind to the poor, so that the people all loved
+him dearly. He fought and won many battles for the Sultan, and was the
+greatest favorite in the land.
+
+But far away in Africa there was trouble brewing for Aladdin. The
+wicked old Magician who had pretended to be Aladdin's uncle found out
+by his magic powers that the boy had not perished when he left him
+underground, but had somehow managed to escape and become rich and
+powerful.
+
+"He must have discovered the secret of the lamp," shrieked the
+Magician, tearing his hair with rage. "I will not rest day or night
+until I shall have found some way of taking it from him."
+
+So he journeyed from Africa to China, and when he came to the city
+where Aladdin lived and saw the wonderful palace, he nearly choked
+with fury to see all its splendor and richness. Then he disguised
+himself as a merchant, and bought a number of copper lamps, and with
+these went from street to street, crying, "New lamps for old."
+
+As soon as the people heard his cry, they crowded round him, laughing
+and jeering, for they thought he must be mad to make such an offer.
+
+Now it happened that Aladdin was out hunting, and the Princess sat
+alone in the hall of the jeweled windows. When, therefore, she heard
+the noise that was going on in the street outside, she called to her
+slaves to ask what it meant.
+
+Presently one of the slaves came back, laughing so much that she could
+hardly speak.
+
+"It is a curious old man who offers to give new lamps for old," she
+cried. "Did any one ever hear before of such a strange way of
+trading?"
+
+The Princess laughed too, and pointed to an old lamp which hung in a
+niche close by.
+
+"There is an old enough lamp," she said. "Take it and see if the old
+man will really give a new one for it."
+
+The slave took it down and ran out to the street once more, and when
+the Magician saw that it was indeed what he wanted, he seized the
+Magic Lamp with both his hands.
+
+"Choose any lamp you like," he said, showing her those of bright new
+copper. He did not care now what happened. She might have all the new
+lamps if she wanted them.
+
+Then he went a little way outside the city, and when he was quite
+alone he took out the Magic Lamp and rubbed it gently. Immediately the
+Genie stood before him and asked what was his will.
+
+"I order thee to carry off the palace of Aladdin, with the Princess
+inside, and set it down in a lonely spot in Africa."
+
+And in an instant the palace, with every one in it, had disappeared,
+and when the Sultan happened to look out of his window, lo! there was
+no longer a palace to be seen.
+
+"This must be enchantment," he cried.
+
+Then he ordered his men to set out and bring Aladdin to him in chains.
+
+The officers met Aladdin as he was returning from the hunt, and they
+immediately seized him, loaded him with chains, and carried him off to
+the Sultan. But as he was borne along, the people gathered around him,
+for they loved him dearly, and vowed that no harm should befall him.
+
+The Sultan was beside himself with rage when he saw Aladdin, and gave
+orders that his head should be cut off at once. But the people had
+begun to crowd into the palace, and they were so fierce and
+threatening that he dared not do as he wished. He was obliged to order
+the chains to be taken off, and Aladdin to be set free.
+
+As soon as Aladdin was allowed to speak he asked why all this was done
+to him.
+
+"Wretch!" exclaimed the Sultan, "come hither, and I will show thee."
+
+Then he led Aladdin to the window and showed him the empty space where
+his palace had once stood.
+
+"Think not that I care for thy vanished palace," he said. "But where
+is the Princess, my daughter?"
+
+So astonished was Aladdin that for some time he could only stand
+speechless, staring at the place where his palace ought to have been.
+
+At last he turned to the Sultan.
+
+"Your Majesty," he said, "grant me grace for one month, and if by that
+time I have not brought back thy daughter to thee, then put me to
+death as I deserve."
+
+So Aladdin was set free, and for three days he went about like a
+madman, asking every one he met where his palace was. But no one could
+tell him, and all laughed at his misery. Then he went to the river to
+drown himself; but as he knelt on the bank and clasped his hands to
+say his prayers before throwing himself in, he once more rubbed the
+Magic Ring. Instantly the Genie of the Ring stood before him.
+
+"What is thy will, O master?" it asked.
+
+"Bring back my Princess and my palace," cried Aladdin, "and save my
+life."
+
+"That I cannot do," said the Slave of the Ring. "Only the Slave of the
+Lamp has power to bring back thy palace."
+
+"Then take me to the place where my palace now stands," said Aladdin,
+"and put me down beneath the window of the Princess."
+
+And almost before Aladdin had done speaking he found himself in
+Africa, beneath the windows of his own palace.
+
+He was so weary that he lay down and fell fast asleep; but before
+long, when day dawned, he was awakened by the song of the birds, and
+as he looked around his courage returned. He was now sure that all his
+misfortunes must have been caused by the loss of the Magic Lamp, and
+he determined to find out as soon as possible who had stolen it.
+
+That same morning the Princess awoke feeling happier than she had felt
+since she had been carried off. The sun was shining so brightly, and
+the birds were singing so gaily, that she went to the window to greet
+the opening day. And who should she see standing beneath her window
+but Aladdin!
+
+With a cry of joy she threw open the casement and the sound made
+Aladdin look up. It was not long before he made his way through a
+secret door and held her in his arms.
+
+"Tell me, Princess," said Aladdin, when they had joyfully embraced
+each other many times, "what has become of the old lamp which hung in
+a niche of the great hall?"
+
+"Alas! my husband," answered the Princess, "I fear my carelessness has
+been the cause of all our misfortunes."
+
+Then she told him how the wicked old Magician had pretended to be a
+merchant, and had offered new lamps for old, and how he had thus
+managed to secure the Magic Lamp.
+
+"He has it still," she added, "for I know that he carries it always,
+hidden in his robe."
+
+"Princess," said Aladdin, "I must recover this lamp, and thou shalt
+help me. To-night when the Magician dines with thee, dress thyself in
+thy costliest robes, and be kind and gracious to him. Then bid him
+fetch some of the wines of Africa, and when he is gone, I will tell
+thee what thou shalt do."
+
+So that night the Princess put on her most beautiful robes, and looked
+so lovely and was so kind when the Magician came in, that he could
+scarcely believe his eyes. For she had been sad and angry ever since
+he had carried her off.
+
+"I believe now that Aladdin must be dead," she said, "and I have made
+up my mind to mourn no longer. Let us begin our feast. But see! I grow
+weary of these wines of China, fetch me instead the wine of thy own
+country."
+
+Now Aladdin had meanwhile prepared a powder which he directed the
+Princess to place in her own wine-cup. So when the Magician returned
+with the African wine, she filled her cup and offered it to him in
+token of friendship. The Magician drank it up eagerly, and scarcely
+had he finished when he dropped down dead.
+
+Then Aladdin came out of the next chamber where he had hidden himself,
+and searched in the Magician's robe until he found the Magic Lamp. He
+rubbed it joyfully, and when the Genie appeared, ordered that the
+palace should be carried back to China, and set down in its own place.
+
+The following morning, when the Sultan rose early, for he was too sad
+to take much rest, he went to the window to gaze on the place where
+Aladdin's palace had once stood. He rubbed his eyes, and stared wildly
+about.
+
+"This must be a dream," he cried, for there stood the palace in all
+its beauty, looking fairer than ever in the morning light.
+
+Not a moment did the Sultan lose, but he rode over to the palace at
+once, and when he had embraced Aladdin and his daughter, they told him
+the whole story of the African Magician. Then Aladdin showed him the
+dead body of the wicked old man, and there was peace between them once
+more.
+
+But there was still trouble in store for Aladdin. The African Magician
+had a younger brother who also dealt in magic, and who was if possible
+even more wicked than his elder brother.
+
+Full of revenge, this younger brother started for China, determined
+to punish Aladdin and steal the Magic Lamp for himself. As soon as he
+arrived he went in secret to the cell of a holy woman called Fatima,
+and obliged her to give him her robe and veil as a disguise. Then to
+keep the secret safe he killed the poor woman.
+
+Dressed in the robe and veil, the wicked Magician walked through the
+streets near Aladdin's palace, and all the people as he passed by
+knelt and kissed his robe, for they thought he was indeed the holy
+woman.
+
+As soon as the Princess heard that Fatima was passing by in the
+street, she sent and commanded her to be brought into the hall, and
+she treated the supposed holy woman with great respect and kindness,
+for she had often longed to see her.
+
+"Is not this a fine hall?" she asked, as they sat together in the hall
+of the jeweled windows.
+
+"It is indeed most beautiful," answered the Magician, who kept his
+veil carefully down, "but to my mind there is one thing wanting. If
+only thou couldst have a roc's egg hung in the dome it would be
+perfect."
+
+As soon as the Princess heard these words she became discontented and
+miserable, and when Aladdin came in, she looked so sad that he at once
+asked what was the matter.
+
+"I can never be happy until I have a roc's egg hanging from the dome
+of the great hall," she answered.
+
+"In that case thou shalt soon be happy," said Aladdin gaily, and
+taking down the lamp, he summoned the Genie.
+
+But when the Slave of the Lamp heard the order his face grew terrible
+with rage, and his eyes gleamed like burning coals.
+
+"Vile wretch!" he shrieked, "have I not given thee all thy wishes, and
+now dost thou ask me to kill my master, and hang him as an ornament in
+thy palace? Thou deservest truly to die; but I know that the request
+cometh not from thine own heart, but was the suggestion of that wicked
+Magician who pretends to be a holy woman."
+
+With these words the Genie vanished, and. Aladdin went at once to the
+room where the Princess was awaiting him.
+
+"I have a headache," he said. "Call the holy woman, that she may place
+her hand upon my forehead and ease the pain."
+
+But the moment that the false Fatima appeared Aladdin sprang up and
+plunged his dagger into that evil heart.
+
+"What hast thou done?" cried the Princess. "Alas! thou hast slain the
+holy woman."
+
+"This is no holy woman," answered Aladdin, "but an evil Magician whose
+purpose was to destroy us both."
+
+So Aladdin was saved from the wicked design of the two Magicians, and
+there was no one left to disturb his peace. He and the Princess lived
+together in great happiness for many years, and when the Sultan died
+they succeeded to the throne, and ruled both wisely and well. And so
+there was great peace throughout the land.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+THE ENCHANTED HORSE
+
+
+It was New Year's day in Persia, the most splendid feast-day of all
+the year, and the King had been entertained, hour after hour, by the
+wonderful shows prepared for him by his people. Evening was drawing on
+and the court was just about to retire, when an Indian appeared,
+leading a horse which he wished to show to the King. It was not a real
+horse, but it was so wonderfully made that it looked exactly as if it
+were alive.
+
+"Your Majesty," cried the Indian, as he bowed himself to the ground,
+"I beg thou wilt look upon this wonder. Nothing thou hast seen to-day
+can equal this horse of mine. I have only to mount upon its back and
+wish myself in any part of the world, and it carries me there in a few
+minutes." Now the King of Persia was very fond of curious and clever
+things, so he looked at the horse with great interest.
+
+"It seems only a common horse," he said, "but thou shalt show us what
+it can do."
+
+Then he pointed to a distant mountain, and bade the Indian to fetch a
+branch from the palm-trees which grew near its foot.
+
+The Indian vaulted into the saddle, turned a little peg in the horse's
+neck, and in a moment was flying so swiftly through the air that he
+soon disappeared from sight. In less than a quarter of an hour he
+reappeared, and laid the palm-branch at the King's feet.
+
+"Thou art right," cried the King; "thy enchanted horse is the most
+wonderful thing I have yet seen. What is its price? I must have it for
+my own."
+
+The Indian shook his head.
+
+"Your Majesty," he said, "this horse can never be sold for money, but
+can only be exchanged for something of equal value. It shall be thine
+only if thou wilt give me instead the Princess, your daughter, for my
+wife."
+
+At these words the King's son sprang to his feet.
+
+"Sire," he cried, "thou wilt never dream of granting such a request."
+
+"My son," answered the King, "at whatever cost I must have this
+wonderful horse. But before I agree to the exchange, I would wish thee
+to try the horse, and tell me what thou thinkest of it."
+
+The Indian, who stood listening to what they said, was quite willing
+that the Prince should try the Enchanted Horse, and began to give him
+directions how to guide it. But as soon as the Prince was in the
+saddle and saw the peg which made the horse start, he never waited to
+hear more. He turned the screw at once, and went flying off through
+the air.
+
+"Alas!" cried the Indian, "he has gone off without learning how to
+come back. Never will he be able to stop the horse unless he finds the
+second peg."
+
+The King was terribly frightened when he heard the Indian's words,
+for, by this time, the Prince had disappeared from sight.
+
+"Wretch," he cried, "thou shalt be cast into prison, and unless my son
+returns in safety, thou shalt be put to death."
+
+Meanwhile the Prince had gone gaily sailing up into the air until he
+reached the clouds, and could no longer see the earth below. This was
+very pleasant, and he felt that he had never had such a delicious ride
+in his life before. But presently he began to think it was time to
+descend. He screwed the peg round and round, backwards and forwards,
+but it seemed to make no difference. Instead of coming down he sailed
+higher and higher, until he thought he was going to knock his head
+against the blue sky.
+
+What was to be done? The Prince began to grow a little nervous, and he
+felt over the horse's neck to see if there was another peg to be found
+anywhere. To his joy, just behind the ear. He touched a small screw,
+and when he turned it, he felt he was going slower and slower, and
+gently turning round. Then he shouted with joy as the Enchanted Horse
+flew downwards through the starry night, and he saw, stretched out
+before him, a beautiful city gleaming white through the purple mantle
+of the night.
+
+Everything was strange to him, and he did not know in what direction
+to guide the horse, so he let it go where it would, and presently it
+stopped on the roof of a great marble palace. There was a gallery
+running round the roof, and at the end of the gallery there was a door
+leading down some white marble steps.
+
+The Prince began at once to descend the steps, and found himself in a
+great hall where a row of black slaves were sleeping soundly, guarding
+the entrance to a room beyond.
+
+Very softly the Prince crept past the guards, and lifting the curtain
+from the door, looked in.
+
+And there he saw a splendid room lighted by a thousand lights and
+filled with sleeping slaves, and in the middle, upon a sofa, was the
+most beautiful Princess his eyes had ever gazed upon.
+
+She was so lovely that the Prince held his breath with admiration as
+he looked at her. Then he went softly to her side, and, kneeling by
+the sofa, gently touched her hand. The Princess sighed and opened her
+eyes, but before she could cry out, he begged her in a whisper to be
+silent and fear nothing.
+
+"I am a Prince," he said, "the son of the King of Persia. I am in
+danger of my life here, and crave thy protection."
+
+Now this Princess was no other than the daughter of the King of
+Bengal, who happened to be staying alone in her summer palace outside
+the city.
+
+"I will protect thee," said the Princess kindly, giving him her hand.
+Then she awoke her slaves and bade them give the stranger food and
+prepare a sleeping-room for him.
+
+"I long to hear thy adventures and how thou camest here," she said to
+the Prince, "but first thou must rest and refresh thyself."
+
+Never before had the Princess seen any one so gallant and handsome as
+this strange young Prince. She dressed herself in her loveliest robes,
+and twined her hair with her most precious jewels, that she might
+appear as beautiful as possible in his eyes. And when the Prince saw
+her again, he thought her the most charming Princess in all the world,
+and he loved her with all his heart. But when he had told her all his
+adventures she sighed to think that he must now leave her and return
+to his father's court.
+
+"Do not grieve," he said, "I will return in state as befits a Prince,
+and demand thy hand in marriage from the King thy father."
+
+"Stay but a few days ere thou goest," replied the Princess. "I cannot
+part with thee so soon."
+
+The Prince was only too willing to wait a while, and the Princess
+entertained him so well with feasts and hunting-parties that day after
+day slipped by, and still he lingered.
+
+At last, however, the thought of his home and his father's grief made
+him decide to return at once.
+
+"My Princess," he said, "since it is so hard to part, wilt thou not
+ride with me upon the Enchanted Horse? When we are once more in Persia
+our marriage shall take place, and then we will return to the King thy
+father."
+
+So together they mounted the Enchanted Horse and the Prince placed his
+arm around the Princess and turned the magic peg. Up and up they flew
+over land and sea, and then the Prince turned the other screw, and
+they landed just outside his father's city. He guided the horse to a
+palace outside the gates, and there he left the Princess, for he
+wished to go alone to prepare his father.
+
+Now when the Prince reached the court he found every one dressed in
+brown, and all the bells of the city were tolling mournfully.
+
+"Why is every one so sad?" he asked of one of the guards.
+
+"The Prince, the Prince!" cried the man. "The Prince has come back."
+
+And soon the joyful news spread over the town, and the bells stopped
+tolling and rang a joyful peal.
+
+"My beloved son!" cried the King, as he embraced him. "We thought thou
+wert lost for ever, and we have mourned for thee day and night."
+
+Without waiting to hear more, the Prince began to tell the King all
+his adventures, and how the Princess of Bengal awaited him in the
+palace outside the gates.
+
+"Let her be brought here instantly," cried the King, "and the marriage
+shall take place to-day."
+
+Then he ordered that the Indian should be set free at once and allowed
+to depart with the Enchanted Horse.
+
+Great was the surprise of the Indian when, instead of having his head
+cut off as he had expected, he was allowed to go free with his
+wonderful horse. He asked what adventures had befallen the Prince, and
+when he heard of the Princess who was waiting in the palace outside
+the gates, a wicked plan came into his head.
+
+He took the Enchanted Horse, and went straight to the palace before
+the King's messengers could reach it.
+
+"Tell the Princess," he said to the slaves, "that the Prince of Persia
+has sent me to bring her to his father's palace upon the Enchanted
+Horse."
+
+The Princess was very glad when she heard this message, and she
+quickly made herself ready to go with the messenger.
+
+But alas! as soon as the Indian turned the peg and the horse flew
+through the air, she found she was being carried off, far away from
+Persia and her beloved Prince.
+
+All her prayers and entreaties were in vain. The Indian only mocked at
+her, and told her he meant to marry her himself.
+
+Meanwhile the Prince and his attendants had arrived at the palace
+outside the gates, only to find that the Indian had been there before
+them and had carried off the Princess.
+
+The Prince was nearly beside himself with grief, but he still hoped
+to find his bride. He disguised himself as a dervish and set off to
+seek for her, vowing that he would find her, or perish in the attempt.
+
+By this time the Enchanted Horse had traveled many hundreds of miles.
+Then, as the Indian was hungry, it was made to descend into a wood
+close to a town of Cashmere.
+
+Here the Indian went in search of food, and when he returned with some
+fruit he shared it with the Princess, who was faint and weary.
+
+As soon as the Princess had eaten a little she felt stronger and
+braver, and as she heard horses galloping past, she called out loudly
+for help.
+
+The men on horseback came riding at once to her aid, and she quickly
+told them who she was, and how the Indian had carried her off against
+her will. Then the leader of the horsemen, who was the Sultan of
+Cashmere, ordered his men to cut off the Indian's head. But he placed
+the Princess upon his horse and led her to his palace.
+
+Now the Princess thought that her troubles were all at an end, but she
+was much mistaken. The Sultan had no sooner seen her than he made up
+his mind to marry her, and he ordered the wedding preparations to be
+begun without loss of time.
+
+In vain the Princess begged to be sent back to Persia. The Sultan only
+smiled and fixed the wedding-day. Then when she saw that nothing would
+turn him from his purpose, she thought of a plan to save herself. She
+began talking all the nonsense she could think of and behaving as if
+she were mad, and so well did she pretend, that the wedding was put
+off, and all the doctors were called in to see if they could cure her.
+
+But whenever a doctor came near the Princess she became so wild and
+violent that he dared not even feel her pulse, so none of them
+discovered that she was only pretending.
+
+The Sultan was in great distress, and sent far and near for the
+cleverest doctors. But none of them seemed to be able to cure the
+Princess of her madness.
+
+All this time the Prince of Persia was wandering about in search of
+his Princess, and when he came to one of the great cities of India, he
+heard every one talking about the sad illness of the Princess of
+Bengal who was to have married the Sultan. He at once disguised
+himself as a doctor and went to the palace, saying he had come to cure
+the Princess.
+
+The Sultan received the new doctor with joy, and led him at once to
+the room where the Princess sat alone, weeping and wringing her hands.
+
+"Your Majesty," said the disguised Prince, "no one else must enter the
+room with me, or the cure will fail."
+
+So the Sultan left him, and the Prince went close to the Princess, and
+gently touched her hand.
+
+"My beloved Princess," he said, "dost thou not know me?"
+
+As soon as the Princess heard that dear voice she threw herself into
+the Prince's arms, and her joy was so great that she could not speak.
+
+"We must at once plan our escape," said the Prince. "Canst thou tell
+me what has become of the Enchanted Horse?"
+
+"Naught can I tell thee of it, dear Prince," answered the Princess,
+"but since the Sultan knows its value, no doubt he has kept it in some
+safe place."
+
+"Then first we must persuade the Sultan that thou art almost cured,"
+said the Prince. "Put on thy costliest robes and dine with him
+to-night, and I will do the rest."
+
+The Sultan was charmed to find the Princess so much better, and his
+joy knew no bounds when the new doctor told him that he hoped by the
+next day to complete the cure.
+
+"I find that the Princess has somehow been infected by the magic of
+the Enchanted Horse," he said. "If thou wilt have the horse brought
+out into the great square, and place the Princess upon its back, I
+will prepare some magic perfumes which will dispel the enchantment.
+Let all the people be gathered together to see the sight, and let the
+Princess be arrayed in her richest dress and decked with all her
+jewels."
+
+So next morning the Enchanted Horse was brought out into the crowded
+square, and the Princess was mounted upon its back. Then the disguised
+Prince placed four braziers of burning coals round the horse and threw
+into them a perfume of a most delicious scent. The smoke of the
+perfume rose in thick clouds, almost hiding the Princess, and at that
+moment the Prince leaped into the saddle behind her, turned the peg,
+and sailed away into the blue sky.
+
+But as he swept past the Sultan, he cried aloud, "Sultan of Cashmere,
+next time thou dost wish to wed a Princess, ask her first if she be
+willing to wed thee."
+
+So this was the manner in which the Prince of Persia carried off the
+Princess of Bengal for the second time. The Enchanted Horse never
+stopped until it had carried them safely back to Persia, and there
+they were married amid great rejoicings.
+
+But what became of the Enchanted Horse? Ah! that is a question which
+no one can answer.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+SINDBAD THE SAILOR
+
+
+In the city of Bagdad, far away in Persia, there lived a poor man
+called Hindbad. He was a porter, and one hot afternoon, as he was
+carrying a very heavy load, he stopped to rest in a quiet street near
+a beautiful house which he had never seen before. The pavement outside
+was sprinkled with rose-water, which felt very cool and pleasant to
+his hot, weary feet, and from the open windows came the most delicious
+scents which perfumed all the air.
+
+Hindbad wondered who lived in this beautiful house, and presently he
+went up to one of the splendidly dressed servants, who was standing at
+the door, and asked to whom it belonged. The servant stared in
+amazement.
+
+"Dost thou indeed live in Bagdad and knowest not my master's name?" he
+said. "He is the great Sindbad the Sailor, the man who has sailed all
+round the world, and who has had the most wonderful adventures under
+the sun."
+
+Now Hindbad had often heard of this wonderful man and of his great
+riches, and as he looked at the beautiful palace and saw the
+splendidly dressed servants it made him feel sad and envious. As he
+turned away sighing, to take up his load again, he looked up into the
+blue sky, and said aloud:
+
+"What a difference there is between this man's lot and mine. He has
+all that he wants, and nothing to do but to spend money and enjoy a
+pleasant life, while I have to work hard to get dry bread enough to
+keep myself and my children alive. What has he done that he should be
+so lucky, and what have I done that I should be so miserable?"
+
+Just then one of the servants touched him on the shoulder, and said to
+him: "My noble master wishes to see thee, and has bidden me fetch thee
+to him."
+
+The poor porter was frightened at first, for he thought some one might
+have overheard what he had been saying, but the servant took his arm
+and led him into the great dining-hall. There were many guests seated
+round the table, on which was spread a most delicious feast, and at
+the head of the table sat a grave, stately old man with a long white
+beard. This was Sindbad the Sailor. He smiled kindly on poor
+frightened Hindbad, and made a sign that he should come and sit at his
+right hand. Then all the most delicious things on the table were
+offered by the servants to Hindbad, and his glass was filled with the
+choicest wine, so that he began to feel it must all be a dream.
+
+But when the feast was over Sindbad turned to him and asked him what
+it was he had been saying outside the window just before he came in.
+
+Then Hindbad was very much ashamed, and hung his head as he answered:
+"My lord, I was tired and ill-tempered, and I said foolish words,
+which I trust thou wilt now pardon."
+
+"Oh," replied Sindbad, "I am not so unjust as to blame thee. I am
+indeed only sorry for thee. But thou wert wrong in thinking that I
+have always led an easy life, and that these riches came to me without
+trouble or suffering. I have won them by years of toil and danger."
+
+Then turning to his other guests he said, "Yes, my friends, the tale
+of my adventures is enough to warn every one of you never to go in
+search of wealth. I have never told you the story of my voyages, but
+if you will listen I will begin this very night."
+
+So the servants were ordered to carry home the porter's load, that he
+might stay in Sindbad's palace that evening and listen to the story.
+
+"My father left me a great deal of money when I was a young man, but I
+spent it so quickly and foolishly that I began to see it would soon
+all be gone. This made me stop and think, for I did not like the idea
+of being poor. So I counted up all the money that remained, and made
+up my mind that I would trade with it. I joined a company of
+merchants, and we set sail in a good ship, meaning to go from place to
+place, and sell or exchange our goods at whatever towns we stopped.
+And so began my first voyage.
+
+"For the first few days I could think of nothing but the heaving of
+the waves; but by and by I began to feel better, and never again was I
+at all unhappy upon the sea. One afternoon, when the wind had suddenly
+dropped and we were lying becalmed, we found ourselves near a little
+low green island, which looked like a meadow, and only just showed
+above the sea. The captain of the ship gave us permission to land, and
+presently we were all enjoying ourselves on the green meadow. We
+walked about for some time and then sat down to rest, and some of us
+set to work to light a fire, that we might make our evening meal.
+
+"But scarcely had the fire begun to burn, when we heard loud shouts
+from the ship warning us to come back at once, for what we had taken
+to be an island was indeed the back of a sleeping whale. My companions
+all rushed to the boats, but before I could follow them the great
+monster dived down and disappeared, leaving me struggling in the
+water.
+
+"I clung to a piece of wood which we had brought from the ship to make
+the fire, and I could only hope that I would soon be picked up by my
+companions. But alas! there was so much confusion on board that no one
+missed me, and as a wind sprang up the captain set sail, and I was
+left alone at the mercy of the waves.
+
+"All night long I floated, and when morning came I was so tired and
+weak that I thought I must die. But just then a great wave lifted me
+up and threw me against the steep side of an island, and to my joy I
+managed to climb the cliff and rest on the green grass above.
+
+"Soon I began to feel better, and as I was very hungry I went to look
+for something to eat. I found some plants which tasted good, and a
+spring of clear water, and having made a good meal, I walked about the
+island to see what I would find next.
+
+"Before long I came to a great meadow where a horse was tied, and as I
+stood looking at it, I heard men's voices which sounded as if they
+came from under the earth. Then from an underground cave a man
+appeared, who asked me who I was and where I came from. He took me
+into the cave where his companions were, and they told me they were
+the grooms belonging to the King of the island, whose horses they
+brought to feed in the meadow. They gave me a good meal, and told me
+it was very lucky that I had come just then, for next day, they meant
+to return to their master, and would show me the way, which I could
+never have found for myself.
+
+"So we set off together early next morning, and when we reached the
+city I was very kindly received by the King. He listened to the story
+of my adventures, and then bade his servants see that I wanted for
+nothing.
+
+"As I was a merchant I took great interest in the shipping, and often
+went down to the quay to see the boats unload. One day when I was
+looking over a cargo which had just been landed, what was my
+astonishment to see a number of bales with my own name marked on them.
+I went at once to the captain and asked him who was the owner of these
+bales of goods.
+
+"'Ah!' replied the captain, 'they belonged to a merchant of Bagdad
+called Sindbad. But he, alas! perished in a dreadful way soon after we
+sailed, for with a number of people belonging to my ship he landed on
+what looked like a green island, but which was really the back of a
+great sleeping whale. As soon as the monster felt the warmth of the
+fire which they had lighted on his back, he woke up and dived below
+the sea. Many of my men were drowned, and among them poor Sindbad. Now
+I mean to sell his goods that I may give the money to his relations
+when I find them.'
+
+"'Captain,' said I, 'these bales are mine, for I am that Sindbad who
+thou sayest was drowned.'
+
+"'What wickedness there is in the world,' cried the captain. 'How
+canst thou pretend to be Sindbad when I saw him drowned before my
+eyes?'
+
+"But presently, when I had told him all that had happened to me, and
+when the other merchants from the ship knew me to be the true Sindbad,
+he was overjoyed, and ordered that the bales should be at once given
+to me.
+
+"Now I was able to give the King a handsome present, and after I had
+traded with my goods for sandal-wood, nutmegs, ginger, pepper and
+cloves, I set sail once more with the kind old captain. On the way
+home I was able to sell all my spices at a good price, so that when I
+landed I found I had a hundred thousand sequins.
+
+"My family were delighted to see me again, and I soon bought some land
+and built a splendid house, in which I meant to live happily and
+forget all the troubles through which I had passed."
+
+Here Sindbad ended the story of his first voyage. He ordered the music
+to strike up and the feast to go on, and when it was over he gave the
+poor porter Hindbad a hundred gold pieces and told him to come back at
+the same time next evening if he wished to hear the tale of the second
+voyage.
+
+Hindbad went joyfully home, and you can imagine how happy the poor
+family were that night.
+
+Next evening he set out once more for Sindbad's house, dressed in his
+best clothes. There he enjoyed a splendid supper as before, and when
+it was over Sindbad said:
+
+"I was very happy for some time at home, but before long I began to
+grow weary of leading an idle life. I longed to be upon the sea again,
+to feel the good ship bounding over the waves, and to hear the wind
+whistling through the rigging.
+
+"So I set to work at once and bought all kinds of goods that I might
+sell again in foreign lands, and then, having found a suitable ship, I
+set sail with other merchants, and so began my second voyage.
+
+"We stopped at many places, and sold our goods at a great profit, and
+all went well until one day when we landed on a new island. It was a
+most beautiful place, fair as the garden of Eden, where exquisite
+flowers made a perfect rainbow of color and delicious fruits hung in
+ripe clusters above.
+
+"Here, under the shadow of the tree, I sat down to rest and to feast
+my eyes upon all the loveliness around. I ate the food I had brought
+with me, drank my wine, and then closed my eyes. The soft music of the
+stream which flowed close by was like a song in my ears, and, before I
+knew what I was doing, I fell asleep.
+
+"I cannot tell how long I slept, but when at last I opened my eyes, I
+could not see my companions anywhere, and when I looked towards the
+sea, to my horror I found the ship was gone. It was sailing away, a
+white speck in the distance, and here was I, left alone upon this
+desert island. I cried aloud and wrung my hands with grief, and wished
+with all my heart that I had stayed safely at home. But what was the
+use of wishing that now?
+
+"So I climbed into a high tree, and looked around to see if I could by
+any means find a way of escape from the island. First I looked towards
+the sea, but there was no hope for me there, and then I turned and
+looked inland. The first thing that caught my eye was a huge white
+dome, that seemed to rise from the center of the island, unlike
+anything I had ever seen before.
+
+"I climbed down the tree, and made my way towards the white dome as
+quickly as I could, but when I reached it, it puzzled me more than
+ever. It was like a great smooth ball, much too slippery to climb, and
+into it there was no door or entrance of any sort. I walked round and
+round it, wondering what it could be, when suddenly a dark shadow fell
+upon everything and it grew black as night.
+
+"I gazed upwards in great fear, and knew that the shadow was cast by a
+great bird with outspread wings hovering over the place where I stood
+and shutting out heaven's light. As I looked, it suddenly came
+swooping down, and sat upon the white dome.
+
+"Then it flashed into my mind that this must be the bird which I had
+heard sailors talk of, called a roc, and the smooth white ball must be
+its egg.
+
+"Quick as thought, I unbound my turban, and twisted it into a rope.
+Then I wound it round and round my waist, and tied the two ends
+tightly round the roc's leg, which was close to where I stood.
+
+"'It will fly away soon, and carry me away with it off this desert
+island,' I said to myself joyfully.
+
+"And sure enough, before very long I felt myself lifted off the
+ground, and carried up and up until it seemed as if we had reached the
+clouds. Then the huge bird began to sink down again, and when it
+reached the ground I quickly untied my turban, and set myself free.
+
+"I was so small, compared to the roc, that it had never even noticed
+me, but darted off towards a great black object lying near, which it
+seized with its beak and carried off. Imagine my horror when I looked
+again and saw other dark objects, and discovered that they were great
+black snakes.
+
+"Here was I, in a deep valley, with mountains rising sheer up on every
+side, and nothing to be seen among the rocks but those terrible black
+snakes.
+
+"'Oh!' I cried, 'why did I ever try to leave the desert island? I have
+indeed only come into worse misfortune.'
+
+"As I looked around, I noticed that the ground was strewn with
+sparkling stones, which seemed to quiver with light, and when I looked
+nearer, I found they were diamonds of extraordinary size, although
+lying about like common pebbles. At first I was delighted, but they
+soon ceased to please me, for I feared each moment I might be seized
+by one of the terrible snakes.
+
+"These snakes were so large that they could easily have swallowed an
+elephant, and although they lay quiet during the day, and hid
+themselves for fear of the roc, at night they came out in search of
+food. I managed to find a cave among the rocks before nightfall, and
+there I sat in fear and trembling until morning, when I once more went
+out into the valley.
+
+"As I sat thinking what I should do next, I saw a great piece of raw
+meat come bounding down into the valley, from rock to rock. Then
+another piece followed, and another, until several large pieces lay at
+my feet.
+
+"Then I remembered a tale which travelers had told me about the famous
+Diamond Valley. They said that every year, when the young eagles were
+hatched, merchants went to the heights above, and rolled down great
+pieces of raw meat into the valley. The diamonds on which the meat
+fell would often stick into the soft flesh, and then when the eagles
+came, and carried off the meat to feed their young ones, the merchants
+would beat them off their nests, and take the diamonds out of the
+meat.
+
+"I had never believed this wonderful tale, but now indeed I knew it to
+be true, and felt sure that I was in the famous Diamond Valley.
+
+"I had quite given up all hope of escape, for there was no possible
+way of climbing out of the valley, but as I watched the eagles carry
+off the lumps of raw meat, I thought of a plan, and hope revived.
+
+"First of all I searched around, and filled all my pockets with the
+biggest diamonds I could find. Then I chose out the largest piece of
+meat and fastened myself securely to it, with the rope made out of my
+turban. I knew that the eagles would soon come for more food, so I lay
+flat on the ground, with the meat uppermost, and holding on tightly, I
+waited for what would happen next. I had not long to wait before a
+gigantic eagle came swooping down. It seized the meat and carried it
+and me swiftly up, until it reached its nest high among the mountain
+rocks. And no sooner had it dropped me into the nest, than a man
+climbed out from behind the rock, and with loud cries frightened the
+eagle away. Then this man, who was the merchant to whom the nest
+belonged, came eagerly to look for his piece of meat. When he saw me,
+he started back in surprise and anger.
+
+"'What doest thou here?' he asked roughly. 'How dost thou dare to try
+and steal my diamonds?'
+
+"'Have patience,' I answered calmly, 'I am no thief, and when thou
+hast heard my story thou wilt pity and not blame me. As for diamonds,
+I have some here which will more than make up to thee for thy
+disappointment.'
+
+"Then I told him and the other merchants all my adventures, and they
+cast up their eyes to heaven in surprise at my courage, and the
+wonderful manner in which I had managed to escape so many dangers.
+Pulling out a handful of diamonds, I then passed the precious stones
+round among them, and they all declared them to be the finest they had
+ever seen.
+
+"'Thou shalt choose one, to make up for thy disappointment,' I said to
+the merchant who had found me.
+
+"'I will choose this small one,' he replied, picking out one of the
+least of the glistening heap.
+
+"I urged him to take a larger one, but he only shook his head.
+
+"'This one will bring me all the wealth I can desire,' he said, 'and I
+need no longer risk my life seeking for more.'
+
+"Then we all set off for the nearest port, where we found a ship ready
+to carry us home. We had many adventures on the way, but at last we
+reached our journey's end, and when I had sold my diamonds, I had so
+much money that I gave a great deal to the poor, and lived in even
+greater splendor than before."
+
+Here Sindbad paused, and ordered that another hundred gold pieces
+should be given to Hindbad, and that he should depart. But next
+evening when the guests had all assembled and Hindbad had also
+returned, Sindbad began once more to tell them a story of his
+adventures.
+
+"This time," began Sindbad, "I stayed at home for the space of a whole
+year, and then I prepared to set out on another voyage. My friends and
+relations did all in their power to prevent my going, but I could not
+be persuaded, and before long I set sail in a ship which was about to
+make a very long voyage.
+
+"Nothing went well with us from the beginning. We were driven out of
+our course by storms and tempests, and the captain and pilot knew not
+where we were. When at last they found out in which direction we had
+drifted, things seemed in a worse state than ever. We were alarmed to
+see the captain suddenly pull off his turban, tear the hair from his
+beard, and beat his head as if he were mad.
+
+"'What is the matter?' we asked, gathering round him.
+
+"'Alas!' he cried, 'we are lost. The ship is now caught in a dangerous
+current from which nothing can save her and us. In a very few moments
+we shall all be dashed to pieces.'
+
+"No sooner had he spoken than the ship was carried along at a
+tremendous speed straight on to a rocky shore which lay at the foot of
+a steep mountain.
+
+"But although the ship was dashed to pieces, we all managed to escape,
+and were thrown with our goods and some provisions high on to the
+rocky strip of shore. Here we found the scattered remains of many
+wrecks, and quantities of bones bleached white in the sun.
+
+"'We may prepare ourselves for death,' said the captain mournfully.
+'No man has ever escaped from this shore, for it is impossible to
+climb the mountain behind us, and no ship dare approach to save us.'
+
+"But nevertheless he divided the provisions among us, that we might
+live as long as possible.
+
+"One thing that surprised me greatly was a river of fresh water which
+flowed out of the mountain, and, instead of running into the sea,
+disappeared into a rocky cavern on the other side of the shore. As I
+gazed into the mouth of this cavern I saw that it was lined with
+sparkling gems, and that the bed of the river was studded with rubies
+and diamonds and all manner of precious stones. Great quantities of
+these were also scattered around, and treasures from the wrecked ships
+lay in every corner of the shore.
+
+"One by one my companions died as they came to the end of their food,
+and one by one I buried them, until at last I was left quite alone. I
+was able to live on very little, and so my food had lasted longer.
+
+"'Woe is me!' I cried, 'who shall bury me when I die? Why, oh! why was
+I not content to remain safe and happy at home?'
+
+"As I bemoaned my evil fate I wandered to the banks of the river, and
+as I watched it disappear into the rocky cave a happy thought came to
+me. Surely if this stream entered the mountain it must have an opening
+somewhere, and if I could only follow its course I might yet escape.
+
+"Eagerly I began to make a strong raft of the wood and planks which
+were scattered all over the shore. Then I collected as many diamonds
+and rubies and as much wrecked treasure as my raft would hold, and
+took my last little store of food. I launched the raft with great
+care, and soon found myself floating swiftly along until I disappeared
+into the dark passage of the cavern.
+
+"On and on I went through the thick darkness, the passage seeming to
+grow smaller and narrower until I was obliged to lie flat on the raft
+for fear of striking my head. My food was now all gone, and I gave
+myself up for lost, and then mercifully I fell into a deep sleep which
+must have lasted many hours. I was awakened by the sound of strange
+voices, and jumping up, what was my joy to find I was once more in
+heaven's sunshine.
+
+"The river was flowing gently through a green, pleasant land, and the
+sounds I had heard were the voices of a company of negroes who were
+gently guiding my raft to the bank.
+
+"I could not understand the language these negroes spoke, until at
+last one of their number began to speak to me in Arabic.
+
+"Peace be to thee!' he said. 'Who art thou, and whence hast thou come?
+We are the people of this country, and were working in our fields when
+we found thee asleep upon the raft. Tell us, then, how thou hast come
+to this place.'
+
+"I pray thee, by Allah." I cried, 'give me food, and then I will tell
+thee all.'
+
+"Then the men gave me food, and I ate until my strength returned and
+my soul was refreshed, and I could tell them of all my adventures.
+
+"'We must take him to the King,' they cried with one voice.
+
+"Then they told me that the King of Serendib was the richest and
+greatest king on earth, and I went with them willingly, taking with me
+my bales and treasures.
+
+"Never had I seen such splendor and richness as at the court of the
+King of Serendib, and great was his kindness towards me. He listened
+to the tale of my adventures with interest, and when I begged to be
+allowed to return home, he ordered that a ship should be made ready at
+once. Then he wrote a letter with his own hand to the Caliph, our
+sovereign lord, and loaded me with costly gifts.
+
+"Thus, when I arrived at Bagdad, I went at once to the court of the
+Caliph, and presented the letter and the gift which the King had sent.
+
+"This gift was a cup made out of a single ruby lined inside with
+precious stones, also a skin of the serpent that swallows elephants,
+which had spots upon its back like pieces of gold, and which could
+cure all illnesses.
+
+"The Caliph was delighted with the letter and the gift.
+
+"'Tell me, O Sindbad,' he said, 'is this King as great and rich as it
+is reported of him?'
+
+"'O my Lord,' I said, 'no words can give you an idea of his riches.
+His throne is set upon a huge elephant and a thousand horsemen ride
+around him, clad in cloth of gold. His mace is of gold studded with
+emeralds, and indeed his splendor is as great as that of King
+Solomon.'
+
+"The Caliph listened attentively to my words, and then, giving me a
+present, he allowed me to depart. I returned home swiftly to my family
+and friends, and when I had sold my treasures and given much to the
+poor, I lived in such peace and happiness that my evil adventures soon
+seemed like a far-off dream."
+
+So Sindbad finished the story, and bade his guests return the next
+evening as usual. And next day, when all the guests were once more
+seated at the table and had finished their feasting, Sindbad began the
+story of his last voyage.
+
+"I had now made up my mind that nothing would tempt me to leave my
+home again, and that I would seek for no more adventures.
+
+"One day, however, as I was feasting with my friends, one of my
+servants came to tell me that a messenger from the Caliph awaited my
+pleasure.
+
+"'What is thy errand?' I asked when the messenger was presented to me.
+
+"'The Caliph desires thy presence at once,' answered the messenger.
+
+"Thus was I obliged to set out immediately for the palace.
+
+"'Sindbad,' said the Caliph, when I had bowed myself to the ground
+before him, 'I have need of thy services. I desire to send a letter
+and a gift to the King of Serendib, and thou shalt be the bearer of
+them.'
+
+"Then indeed did my face fall, and I became pale as death.
+
+"'Commander of the Faithful,' I cried, 'do with me as thou wilt, but I
+have made a vow never to leave my home again.'
+
+"Then I told him all my adventures, which caused him much
+astonishment. Nevertheless, he urged me to do as he wished, and seeing
+that there was no escape, I consented.
+
+"I set sail at the Caliph's command, and after a good voyage I at last
+reached the island of Serendib, where I received a hearty welcome. I
+told the officers of the court what my errand was, and they led me to
+the palace, where I bowed myself to the ground before the great King.
+
+"'Sindbad,' he said kindly, 'thou art welcome. I have often thought of
+thee, and wished to see thy face again.'
+
+"So I presented the Caliph's letter, and the rich present he had sent,
+which pleased the King well. When a few days had passed, I begged to
+be allowed to depart, and after receiving many gifts I once more set
+sail for home.
+
+"But alas! the return journey began badly. We had not sailed many
+days, when we were pursued by pirates, who captured the ship, and took
+prisoners all those who were not killed. I, among others, was carried
+ashore and sold by a pirate to a rich merchant.
+
+"'What is thy trade?' asked the merchant when he had bought me.
+
+"'I am a merchant,' I answered, 'and know no trade.'
+
+"'Canst thou shoot with a bow and arrow?' asked my master.
+
+"This I said I could do, and putting one in my hand he led me out to a
+great forest and bade me climb into a high tree.
+
+"'Watch there,' he said, 'until thou shalt see a herd of elephants
+pass by. Then try to shoot one, and if thou art fortunate, come at
+once and tell me.'
+
+"All night I watched, and saw nothing, but in the morning a great
+number of elephants came thundering by, and I shot several arrows
+among them. One big elephant fell to the ground, and lay there while
+the rest passed on; so, as soon as it was safe, I climbed down and
+carried the news to my master. Together we buried the huge animal and
+marked the place, so that we might return to fetch the tusks.
+
+"I continued this work for some time, and killed many elephants, until
+one night I saw to my horror that the elephants, instead of passing
+on, had surrounded the tree in which I sat, and were stamping and
+trumpeting, until the very earth shook. Then one of them seized the
+tree with his trunk, and tore it up by the roots, laying it flat on
+the ground.
+
+"I was almost senseless with terror, but the next moment I felt myself
+gently lifted up by an elephant's trunk, and placed on his back. I
+clung on with all my might, as the elephant carried me through the
+forest, until at last we came to the slope of a hill, which was
+covered with bleached bones and tusks.
+
+"Here the elephant gently laid me down, and left me alone. I gazed
+around on this great treasure of ivory, and I could not help wondering
+at the wisdom of these animals. They had evidently brought me here to
+show me that I could get ivory without killing any more of their
+number. For this, I felt sure, was the elephants' burying-place.
+
+"I did not stay long on the hill, but gathering a few tusks together I
+sped back to the town, that I might tell my tale to the merchant. 'My
+poor Sindbad,' he cried, when he saw me, I thought thou wert dead, for
+I found the uprooted tree, and never expected to look upon thy face
+again.'
+
+"Great was his delight when I told him of the Hill of Ivory, and when
+we had gone there together, and he saw for himself the wonders I had
+described, he was filled with astonishment.
+
+"'Sindbad,' he cried, 'thou too shalt have a share of this great
+wealth. And first of all I shall give thee thy, freedom. Until now,
+year by year have all my slaves been killed by the elephants, but now
+we need no longer run any risks, for here is ivory enough to enrich
+the whole island.'
+
+"So I was set free, and loaded with honors, and when the trade winds
+brought the ships that traded in ivory, I bade good-by to the island,
+and set sail for home, carrying with me a great cargo of ivory and
+other treasures.
+
+"As soon as I landed I went to the Caliph, who was overjoyed to see
+me.
+
+"'Great has been my anxiety, O Sindbad,' he said, 'for I feared some
+evil had befallen thee.'
+
+"When, therefore, I had told him of my adventures, he was the more
+astonished, and ordered that all my story should be written in letters
+of gold, and placed among his treasures.
+
+"Then I returned to my own house, and ever since have remained at home
+in peace and safety."
+
+Thus Sindbad finished the story of his voyages, and turning to
+Hindbad, he said: "And now, friend Hindbad, what dost thou think of
+the way I have earned my riches? Is it not just that I should live in
+enjoyment and ease?"
+
+"O my lord," cried Hindbad, bowing before Sindbad, and kissing his
+hand, "great have been thy labors and perils, and truly dost thou
+deserve thy riches. My troubles are as nothing compared to thine. Long
+mayest thou live and prosper!"
+
+Sindbad was well pleased with this answer, and he ordered that Hindbad
+should dine every day at his table, and receive his golden pieces, so
+that all his life he might have reason to remember the adventures of
+Sindbad the Sailor.
+
+
+
+
+THE ILIAD OF HOMER
+
+ADAPTED BY JEANIE LANG
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+THE STORY OF WHAT LED TO THE SIEGE OF TROY
+
+
+In the deep forest that clothes Mount Ida, not far from the strong
+city of Troy, Paris, son of King Priam, watched his father's flocks by
+night.
+
+Suddenly through the dim woods he saw a light, as if the golden sun
+and silver moon shone both together.
+
+And, lo! in the radiance of this light there stood before him the
+three fairest of the godesses--queenly Hera, wise Athene, and lovely
+Aphrodite.
+
+Like music stealing through the trees came the soft voice of Hera:
+
+"Of all mortal men thou art the most beautiful, Paris, and to thee do
+we come for judgment. Tell us which of us is the fairest of all, and
+to that one whom thou so deemest, give this golden apple."
+
+So spake Hera, and placed in the hand of Paris an apple of purest
+gold.
+
+Again she spake: "If to me, Hera, queen of goddesses, and wife of
+mighty Zeus, king of all the gods, thou dost grant the prize of
+loveliness, Power immeasurable shall be thine. King shalt thou be of
+the lands where the gray dawn rises, and king even to where the red
+sun goes down. A hundred peoples shall call thee lord."
+
+She was silent, and the voice of Athene, fair and pure as a silver
+moonbeam, broke the stillness of the starless night.
+
+"To me award the prize," she said, "and wise as the gods shalt thou
+be. With me as thy friend and guide, all things will be possible to
+thee."
+
+Last of all, standing in a rosy light, as of the dawning sunlight in
+the spring, spoke Aphrodite.
+
+"What are Power and Wisdom, fair Paris?" she pled. "Wisdom and Power
+bring no joy at last. I will give thee Love, and for thy wife thou
+shalt have the fairest woman in all the world."
+
+And Paris, the melody of her voice still in his ears, as he gazed
+spellbound on her face of wondrous beauty, handed to Aphrodite the
+golden prize.
+
+So was it that the wrath of the gods came upon Paris, son of Priam.
+For Hera and Athene, filled with rage, vowed to be revenged upon Paris
+and all his race, and made all the gods pledge themselves to aid them
+in their vengeance.
+
+Across far seas sailed Paris, with Aphrodite as his guide, to Sparta,
+where Menelaus was king.
+
+A brave king was Menelaus, and happily he lived in his kingdom with
+Helen, his queen, fairest of all women. One child they had, a little
+maid, Hermione.
+
+When to Sparta there came Paris, with eyes blue as the sea, and hair
+that gleamed like gold on his purple robe, gallant and brave, and more
+beautiful than any mortal man, glad was the welcome that he had from
+Menelaus.
+
+And when Paris gazed on Helen's face, he knew that in all the world
+there was no woman half so fair as the wife of Menelaus.
+
+Then did Aphrodite cast her magic upon Helen.
+
+No longer did she love her husband, nor did she remember little
+Hermione, her own dear child.
+
+When Paris spoke to her words of love, and begged her to flee with
+him, and to be his wife, she knew only that she loved Paris more than
+all else. Gladly she went with him, and in his red-prowed ship
+together they sailed across the green waves to Troyland, where Mount
+Ida showed her snowy crown high above the forests.
+
+An angry man was Menelaus when he found that Paris had stolen from him
+the fair wife who was to him as his own heart.
+
+To his elder brother Agamemnon, overlord of all the Greeks, he went
+and told his grievous tale.
+
+And from far and wide did the Greek hosts gather, until a hundred
+thousand men and eleven hundred fourscore and six ships were ready to
+cross the seas to Troyland.
+
+Many were the heroes who sailed away from Greece to punish Paris and
+his kin, and to bring back fair Helen to her own land.
+
+Few there were who came home, for ten long years of woe and of
+spilling of blood came to the men of Greece and of Troy from the fatal
+beauty of Helen the queen.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+THE COUNCIL
+
+
+That night both gods and men slept long; only Zeus, king of the gods,
+lay wakeful, pondering in his heart how best he might do honor to
+Achilles. "I shall send a Dream to beguile Agamemnon," at length he
+resolved.
+
+Then did he call to a Dream, for by Dreams the gods sent their
+messages to mortal men.
+
+"Go now, thou evil Dream," said Zeus, "go to where Agamemnon sleeps in
+his tent near to his fleet ships, and tell him every word as I shall
+tell it thee. Bid him call to arms with speed his warriors, for now he
+shall take the strong city of Troy."
+
+To the tent of Agamemnon sped the Dream. Taking the form of the old
+warrior who had striven to make peace between Agamemnon and Achilles,
+the Dream stooped over the sleeping warrior, and thus to him it spoke:
+
+"Sleepest thou, Agamemnon? Ill fits it for the overlord of so mighty a
+host to sleep all through the night. From Zeus I come, and to thee he
+sends this message: 'Call to arms with speed thy warriors, Agamemnon,
+for now shalt thou take the strong city of Troy.'"
+
+Off then sped the Dream, winging its way like a strip of gray mist
+aloft to Mount Olympus.
+
+Then Agamemnon awoke from sleep, and the voice of the Dream still rang
+in his ears.
+
+Speedily he arose from his bed, donned his fair tunic, cast around him
+his great cloak, and bound his sandals on his feet. Then over his
+shoulder he cast his silver-studded sword, and with the scepter of his
+house, token of his overlordship, in his hand, he went down to where
+the Greek ships lay, and called a council together.
+
+To his lords he told what had befallen him as they slept.
+
+"Call to arms!" had been the message from Zeus. "Call to arms! for
+victory shall be thine."
+
+Then said the old warrior in whose likeness the Dream had come:
+
+"My friends, had any other told us this dream we might deem it false;
+but to our overlord the Dream hath come. Let us then call our men to
+arms."
+
+So did all the lords follow his counsel, and quickly did the Greeks
+obey their summons. Like bees that pour from out their nests in some
+hollow rock, and fly to where the spring flowers grow most sweet, even
+so did the warriors pour forth from their ships and their huts by the
+sea. Loudly they shouted as they came, till all the earth echoed. Nine
+heralds sought to quiet them, but it was long before they would cease
+their noise, and sit silent to listen to the voice of Agamemnon their
+lord.
+
+Then did Agamemnon prove his people. "Ill hath Zeus dealt with us, my
+friends," he said. "To us he promised ere we sailed hither that
+victory should be ours. But nine years have passed away, and our
+ships' timbers have rotted, and the rigging is worn. In our halls our
+wives and children still sit awaiting us, yet are we no nearer victory
+than we were on the day that we came hither. Come then, let us flee
+with our ships to our dear native land, for never shall Troy be ours."
+
+So spake Agamemnon, and stirred the hearts of all that had not heard
+his secret council.
+
+As the high sea-waves are swayed by the winds that rush upon them from
+the east and from the south, even so the Greek host was swayed. And
+even as the west wind sweeps over a cornfield and all the ears bow
+down before the blast, so were the warriors stirred.
+
+Shouting, they hastened down to their ships. And the dust rose up in
+clouds from under their hurrying feet.
+
+Quickly did they prepare their ships, and gladly did they make them
+ready to sail homeward across the bright salt sea.
+
+Then would the Greeks have returned, even though fate willed it not.
+But Hera spoke to Athene.
+
+"Shall we indeed allow the Greeks thus to flee homeward?" she cried.
+"Shame it will be to us if Helen is left, in Troy, and Paris goes
+unpunished. Haste, then, and with thy gentle words hold back the men
+from setting forth in their ships for their own homeland."
+
+Down from the peaks of Olympus darted the bright-eyed Athene, clown to
+where the dark ships were being dragged to the launching ways.
+
+By his ship stood Odysseus of the many devices, and heavy of heart was
+he.
+
+As one who speaks aloud the thoughts of another, so then to Odysseus
+spake the fair goddess who was ever his guide.
+
+"Will ye indeed fling yourselves upon your ships and flee homeward to
+your own land?" she said. "Will brave Odysseus leave Helen, for whose
+sake so many Greeks have died, to be the boast of the men of Troy?
+Hasten, then, and suffer not the Greeks to drag their ships down to
+the sea."
+
+At the sound of the voice of Athene, Odysseus cast away his mantle and
+ran to meet Agamemnon. From him he received the scepter of
+overlordship, and bearing it he went among the ships.
+
+Whenever he saw a chief, he would say to him with gentle words:
+
+"Good sir, it fits thee ill to be a coward. Stay, now, for thou
+knowest not what is the will of Agamemnon. He is only making trial of
+thee. Hold back then thy people, and anger him not."
+
+But when Odysseus met a common man hasting to the ships, with his
+scepter he smote him, saying:
+
+"Sit still, sir, and listen to the words of thy betters. No warrior
+art thou, but a weakling. One king only hath Zeus given to us. Hearken
+then to the will of Agamemnon!"
+
+Thus did Odysseus rule the people, driving them back from the ships to
+where sat Agamemnon.
+
+And the noise they made in returning was as the noise of mighty waves
+of the sea, when they crash upon the beach and drive their roaring
+echoes far abroad.
+
+Silence came upon them as they sat themselves down before Agamemnon
+and their lords. Upon all but one did silence fall. Thersites,
+bandy-legged, round-shouldered, lame of one foot, with ugly head
+covered with scanty stubble, most ill-favored of all men in the host,
+would not hold his peace.
+
+Shrilly he poured his upbraidings upon Agamemnon.
+
+"What lackest thou now?" he cried. "Surely thy huts are full of the
+spoils we have brought to thee each time we have taken a town. What
+more dost thou want? Soft fools, women, not men, are ye Greeks, else
+would ye return home now with the ships, and leave this fellow here in
+Troyland gorging himself on the spoils for which he himself hath never
+fought. To brave Achilles hath he done dishonor, a far better man than
+he!"
+
+Straight to the side of Thersites came the goodly Odysseus.
+
+"Hold thy peace," he sternly said. "Plainly I tell thee that if ever
+again I find thee raving as thou hast raved now, I myself will strip
+off thy mantle and tunic, with shameful blows beat thee out of the
+assembly, and send thee back weeping to the ships."
+
+So spake Odysseus, and with his scepter smote Thersites on his back
+and shoulders. And Thersites bowed down, and big tears fell from his
+eyes, and a bloody weal from the golden scepter stood up from his
+back. Amazed he sat down, and in pain and amazement he wiped away a
+tear. The others, though they were sorry, laughed at his bewilderment.
+
+"Many are the good deeds of Odysseus," said they, "but never did he do
+a better deed than when he stopped the tongue of this prating railer."
+
+Then spake Odysseus, scepter in hand.
+
+"Surely it is the wish of the Greeks to make thee the most despised of
+all kings, great Agamemnon," he said, "for like young children or
+mourning women do they wail that they must go home. Nine years have
+we stayed in this land, and small wonder is it that we long for our
+homes again. Yet shameful would it be to wait so long and to return
+with empty hands. Be of good heart, my friends, and wait a little, for
+surely Troy shall be ours. Do ye forget, on the day that we set sail
+for Troyland, the mighty portent that we saw? As we offered sacrifices
+to the gods beneath a fair plane-tree whence flowed clear water, a
+snake, blood-red on the back and dreadful to look upon, glided from
+beneath the altar and darted to the tree. On the tree's topmost bough
+was a sparrow's nest, and in it eight tender nestlings, over which the
+mother bird spread her wings. Pitifully did the little ones cheep as
+the snake swallowed them all, and pitifully cried the mother as she
+fluttered over her nestlings. But of her, too, did the snake lay hold,
+coiling himself round her and crushing her life out. Then did the god
+who sent this sign show us that a sign from the gods in truth it was,
+for he turned the snake into stone. And Chalcas, our soothsayer, told
+us then the meaning of the sign. 'Nine years,' said he--for nine birds
+did the snake slay--'shall ye fight in Troyland, but in the tenth year
+the city shall fall before you.' So then, let us abide here, until we
+have taken the great city!"
+
+When Odysseus had ceased to speak, the Greeks shouted aloud, until the
+ships echoed the praises of the goodly Odysseus.
+
+Then said Agamemnon:
+
+"Go now, all of you, and eat, that ye may be ready for battle. Let
+each man sharpen well his spear and see to his shield, and see to it
+that the horses are well fed and the chariots prepared. And whomsoever
+I see minded to stay far away from the fight, beside the ships here by
+the sea, for him shall there be no hope hereafter, but he shall be
+food for dogs and for birds of prey."
+
+And when Agamemnon had spoken, the shouts of the Greeks were as the
+thunder of mighty breakers on a reef when the winds blow high.
+
+Quickly then they scattered, and kindled fires, and made their evening
+meal, and offered sacrifices to the gods, praying for escape from
+death in the coming battle.
+
+To Zeus did Agamemnon offer his sacrifice and to the mighty god he
+prayed:
+
+"Great Zeus, god of the storm-cloud, let not the sun set nor the
+darkness fall until I have laid low the palaces of Troy and burned
+down its walls with fire."
+
+So he prayed, but as yet Zeus heeded not his prayer. Then did the
+Greeks gather themselves together to battle, and among them went the
+bright-eyed Athene, urging on each one, and rousing in each man's
+heart the joy of strength and of battle.
+
+As the red and golden blaze of a fire that devours a mighty forest is
+seen from afar, so was seen from afar the dazzling gleam of their
+bronze armor as they marched.
+
+Like wild geese and cranes and swans that in long-drawn strings fly
+tirelessly onward, so poured they forth, while the earth echoed
+terribly under the tread of men and horses.
+
+As flies that swarm in the spring when the herdsmen's milk-pails are
+full, so did the Greeks throng to battle, unnumbered as the leaves and
+the flowers upon which they trod in the flowery plain by the banks of
+the river Scamander.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+THE FIGHT BETWEEN PARIS AND MENELAUS
+
+
+To meet the great Greek host came the men of Troy. With loud shouting
+and clamor they came, noisy as the flocks of cranes that fly to
+far-off seas before the coming of winter and sudden rain.
+
+But in silence marched the Greeks, shoulder to shoulder, their hearts
+full of courage.
+
+Like the mist that rolls from the crest of the mountains until no man
+can see in front of him further than the cast of a stone, so did the
+dust rise in clouds under the tread of the warriors' feet as they
+marched across the plain.
+
+Front to front did the two armies stand at last, and from the Trojan
+ranks strode forth Paris the godlike, he who robbed Menelaus of her
+who was to him most dear.
+
+From the shoulders of Paris swung a panther's skin. He bore a curved
+bow and sword, and, brandishing two bronze-headed spears, he
+challenged all the chieftains of the Greek host to fight him, man to
+man, in mortal fight.
+
+As a hungry lion rejoices to see a great-horned stag coming to be his
+prey, even so did Menelaus rejoice when he saw Paris, the
+golden-haired and blue-eyed, stride proudly forth.
+
+Straightway, in his armor, did Menelaus leap from his chariot to the
+ground.
+
+But when Paris saw him to whom he had done so sore a wrong, his heart
+was smitten.
+
+As a man who, in a mountain glen, suddenly sees a deadly snake and
+shrinks away from it with shaking limbs, even so did Paris shrink back
+among his comrades.
+
+Scornfully did Hector his brother behold him.
+
+"Fair in face thou art!" said Hector, "but shamed I am by thee! I ween
+these long-haired Greeks make sport of us because we have for champion
+one whose face and form are beautiful, but in whose heart is neither
+strength nor courage. Art thou a coward? and yet thou daredst to sail
+across the sea and steal from her husband the fair woman who hath
+brought us so much harm. Thou shalt see what sort of warrior is he
+whose lovely wife thou hast taken. Thy harp and thy golden locks and
+fair face, and all the graces given to thee by Aphrodite, shall count
+for little when thou liest in the dust! Cowards must we Trojans be,
+else thou hadst been stoned to death ere this, for all the evil thou
+hast wrought."
+
+Then answered Paris:
+
+"No word hast thou said that I do not deserve, brave Hector. Yet scorn
+not the gifts of golden Aphrodite, for by his own desire can no man
+win the love and beauty that the goddess gives. But let me now do
+battle with Menelaus. Make the Trojans and the men of Greece sit down,
+while Menelaus and I fight for Helen. Let him who is conqueror have
+her and all that is hers for his own, and let the others take an oath
+of friendship so that the Greeks may depart in peace to their own
+land, and in peace the Trojans dwell in Troy."
+
+Greatly did Hector rejoice at his brother's word. His spear grasped
+by the middle, he went through the Trojan ranks and bid the warriors
+hold back.
+
+But as he went, the Greeks shot arrows at brave Hector and cast
+stones.
+
+"Hold! hold! ye Greeks," called Agamemnon. "Hector of the glancing
+helm hath somewhat to say to us."
+
+In silence, then, the two armies stood, while Hector told them the
+words of Paris his brother.
+
+When they had heard him, Menelaus spoke:
+
+"Many ills have ye endured," he said, "for my sake and because of the
+sins of Paris. Yet now, I think, the end of this long war hath come.
+Let us fight, then, and death and fate shall decide which of us shall
+die. Let us offer sacrifice now to Zeus, and call hither Priam, King
+of Troy. I fear for the faith of his sons, Paris and Hector, but Priam
+is an old man and will not break faith."
+
+Then were the Greeks and the Trojans glad. They came down from their
+chariots, and took off their arms, and laid them on the ground, while
+heralds went to tell Priam and to fetch lambs and a ram for the
+sacrifice.
+
+While they went, Hera sent to Troy Iris, her messenger, in the guise
+of the fairest daughter of Priam.
+
+To the hall where Helen sat came lovely Iris. And there she found
+Helen, fairest of women, her white arms swiftly moving back and
+forward as she wove a great purple web of double wool, and wrought
+thereon pictures of many battles of the Greeks and the men of Troy.
+
+"Come hither, dear lady," said Iris, "and see a wondrous thing. For
+they that so fiercely fought with each other, now sit in silence. The
+battle is stayed; they lean upon their shields, and their tall spears
+are thrust in the earth by their sides. But for thee are Menelaus and
+Paris now going to fight, and thou shalt be the wife of the
+conqueror."
+
+So spake lovely Iris, and into the sleeping heart of Helen there came
+remembrance, and a hungry longing for her old home, and for Menelaus,
+and her father and mother, and for little Hermione, her child.
+
+The tears rolled down her cheeks, but quickly she hid her face with a
+veil of fair linen, and hastened out, with her two handmaidens, to the
+place where the two armies lay.
+
+At the Scćan gates sat Priam and other old warriors.
+
+As Helen, in her fair white robes, drew near, the old men marveled at
+her loveliness.
+
+"Small wonder is it," said they, "that Trojans and Greeks should
+suffer hardships and lay down their lives for one so beautiful. Yet
+well would it be for her to sail away upon the Greek ships rather than
+stay here to bring trouble upon us now, and upon our children
+hereafter."
+
+Then Priam called to Helen:
+
+"Come hither, dear child, and sit beside me, that thou may'st see the
+man who once was thy husband, and thy kinsmen, and thy friends. No
+blame do I give to thee for all our woes, but only to the gods who
+have chosen thee to be the cause of all this bloodshed."
+
+Then did Priam ask her the names of the mighty heroes who stood by
+their spears in the Grecian ranks, and Helen, making answer to him,
+said:
+
+"Dear father of Paris, my lord, would that I had died ere I left my
+own land and my little child, and all those that I loved, and followed
+thy son hither. Agamemnon, a goodly king and a mighty spearsman, is
+the Greek warrior whose name thou dost ask. Brother of him who was my
+husband is he. Ah! shameless me, who did leave mine own."
+
+Of Odysseus also, and of many another warrior of great stature and
+brave looks, did Priam make inquiry. And Helen told him all she knew,
+while tears of longing stood in her eyes.
+
+"My two brethren, Castor, tamer of horses, and Polydeuces, the skilful
+boxer, I do not see," she said; "mayhap they have not crossed the
+sea." For she knew not that her two brothers lay dead in her own
+beautiful land.
+
+Then was the sacrifice to Zeus offered, and the vows made between
+Agamemnon and Priam, King of Troy.
+
+When the sacrifice and vows were accomplished, Priam in haste mounted
+his chariot and drove away.
+
+"Verily will I return to windy Ilios," said the old man, "for I cannot
+bear to watch the fight between Menelaus and my own dear son. But
+only Zeus and the gods know which one of them is to fall."
+
+Then Hector and Odysseus marked out a space for the fight, and into a
+bronze helmet Hector placed two pebbles and shook them in the helmet,
+looking behind him. And the pebble of Paris leapt out the first, so
+that to him fell the lot to cast first his spear of bronze.
+
+Then did Paris arm himself. Greaves of beauteous fashioning he placed
+upon his legs, and fastened them with silver ankle-clasps. Over his
+shoulders he put his silver-studded sword of bronze and his great
+shield. On his head he placed a helmet with nodding crest of
+horsehair, and in his hand he grasped his strong spear. In like manner
+did Menelaus arm himself.
+
+One moment did they stand face to face, wrath and hatred in their
+hearts, their spears gripped firm in their hands.
+
+Then did Paris hurl his spear and smite the shield of Menelaus. But
+the shield was strong and the spear could not pierce it.
+
+His hand lifted up for the cast, Menelaus looked upwards and called to
+Zeus.
+
+"Grant me revenge, great Zeus!" he cried. "On him that hath done me
+grievous wrong, grant me vengeance, so that all men hereafter may
+shudder to wrong one who hath treated him as his honored guest."
+
+Then hurled he his mighty spear. Through the bright shield it went,
+and through the shining breastplate, tearing the tunic of Paris on his
+thigh. But Paris swerved aside, and so escaped death.
+
+Then Menelaus drew his silver-studded sword and drove it crashing down
+upon the helmet of Paris. But in four pieces was the sword shattered,
+and fell from the hand of Menelaus.
+
+"Surely art thou the most cruel of all the gods, Zeus!" angrily he
+cried. "My spear is cast in vain, and my sword shattered, and my
+vengeance is still to come!"
+
+So saying, he leapt upon Paris. By the crest on his helmet he seized
+him, and, swinging him round, he dragged him towards the Greek host.
+The embroidered strap beneath the helmet of Paris strangled him, and
+so he would have shamefully died, had not Aphrodite marked his plight.
+Swiftly did she burst the leather strap, and the helmet was left
+empty in the grasp of Menelaus.
+
+Casting the empty helmet, with a swing, to his comrades, Menelaus
+sprang back, ready, with another spear, to slay his enemy.
+
+But Aphrodite snatched Paris up, and in thick mist she hid him, and
+bore him away to his own home. Like a wild beast Menelaus strode
+through the host, searching for him. But no Trojan would have hidden
+him, for with a bitter hatred did the men of Troy hate Paris, most
+beautiful of mortal men.
+
+Then said Agamemnon:
+
+"Hearken to me, ye Trojans. Now hath Menelaus gained the victory. Give
+us back Helen, and all that is hers, and pay me the recompense that ye
+owe me for all the evil days that are gone."
+
+So spake he, and glad were the shouts of the Greeks as they heard the
+words of their king.
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+HECTOR AND ANDROMACHE
+
+
+From where the battle still raged went Hector, son of Priam. At the
+oak-tree by the gates of Troy there came running to meet him wives and
+daughters of those who fought. For eagerly did they long for tidings
+of many a warrior who now lay dead on the field.
+
+When he reached the beautiful, many-pillared palace of his father, his
+mother came to meet him.
+
+His hand she took in hers, and gently spoke she to him.
+
+"Art thou wearied that thou hast left the battle, Hector, my son?" she
+said. "Let me bring thee wine that thou may'st be refreshed and yet
+gain strength."
+
+"Bring me no wine, dear mother," said Hector, "lest it take from me
+the strength and courage that I have. Rather go thou to the temple of
+Athene and offer her sacrifices, beseeching that she will have mercy
+on Troy and on the wives of the Trojans and their little children. So
+may she hold back Diomedes the destroyer. I go to Paris--would that he
+were dead!"
+
+And the mother of Hector straightway, with other old women, the
+mothers of heroes, offered sacrifices and prayers to Athene. But
+Athene paid no heed.
+
+To the palace of Paris, his mighty bronze spear in his hand, then
+strode Hector.
+
+Paris, the golden-haired, sat in a room with Helen, idly handling his
+shining shield and breastplate and curved bow.
+
+In bitter scorn spoke Hector to his brother.
+
+"Our people die in battle for thy sake!" he cried, "while here thou
+sittest idle. Up then, ere the enemies that thou hast made for us burn
+our city to the ground!"
+
+And Paris answered:
+
+"Justly dost thou chide me, Hector. Even now hath Helen urged me to
+play the man and go back to battle. Only let me put on my armor, and
+soon will I overtake thee."
+
+Never a word did Hector answer him.
+
+But to Hector did Helen then speak:
+
+"Brother Hector," she said, "unworthy am I to be sister of thine.
+Would that I had died on the day I was born, or would that the gods
+who have brought me this evil had given me for a husband one who was
+shamed by reproach and who feared dishonor. Rest thee here, my
+brother, who hast suffered so much for the sake of wretched me and for
+the sin of Paris. Well I know that for us cometh punishment of which
+men will sing in the far-off years that are yet to come."
+
+"Of thy love, ask me not to stay, Helen," answered Hector. "For to
+help the men of Troy is my whole heart set, and they are now in want
+of me. But rouse this fellow, and make him hasten after me. I go now
+to see my dear wife and my babe, for I know not whether I shall return
+to them again."
+
+In his own house Hector found not his fair wife Andromache, nor their
+little babe.
+
+"Whither went thy mistress?" he asked in eagerness of the
+serving-women.
+
+"Truly, my lord," answered one, "tidings came to us that the Trojans
+were sorely pressed and that with the Greeks was the victory. So then
+did Andromache, like one frenzied, hasten with her child and his nurse
+to the walls that she might see somewhat of what befell. There, on the
+tower, she stands now, weeping and wailing."
+
+Back through the streets by which he had come then hastened Hector.
+And as he drew near the gates, Andromache, who had spied him from
+afar, ran to meet him.
+
+As, hand clasped in hand, Andromache and Hector stood, Hector looked
+silently at the beautiful babe in his nurse's arms, and smiled.
+
+Astyanax, "The City King," those of Troy called the child, because it
+was Hector his father who saved the city.
+
+Then said Andromache:
+
+"Dear lord, thy courage will bring thee death. Hast thou no pity for
+this babe nor for thy wife, who so soon shall be thy widow? Better
+would it be for me to die if to thee death should come. For if I lose
+thee, then sorrow must for evermore be mine. No father nor mother have
+I, and on one day were my seven brothers slain. Father and mother and
+brother art thou to me, Hector, and my dear loved husband as well.
+Have pity now, and stay with thy wife and thy little child."
+
+"All these things know I well, my wife," answered Hector, "but black
+shame would be mine were I to shrink like a coward from battle. Ever
+it hath been mine to be where the fight was fiercest, and to win glory
+for my father's name, and for my own. But soon will that glory be
+gone, for my heart doth tell me that Troy must fall. Yet for the
+sorrows of the Trojans, and of my own father and mother and brethren,
+and of the many heroes that must perish, grieve I less bitterly than
+for the anguish that must come upon thee on that day when thou no
+longer hast a husband to fight for thee and a Greek leads thee away a
+prisoner. May the earth be heaped up high above me ere I hear thy
+crying, Andromache!"
+
+So spake Hector, and stretched out his arms to take his boy.
+
+But from his father's bronze helmet with its fiercely nodding plume of
+horsehair the babe shrank back in terror and hid his face in his
+nurse's breast. Then did the little City King's father and his sweet
+mother laugh aloud, and on the ground Hector laid his helmet, and
+taking his little son in his arms he kissed him and gently dandled
+him. And as he did so, thus Hector prayed to Zeus and all the gods:
+
+"O Zeus and all ye gods, grant that my son may be a brave warrior and
+a great king in Troyland. Let men say of him when he returns from
+battle, 'Far greater is he than his father,' and may he gladden his
+mother's heart."
+
+Then did Hector lay his babe in Andromache's arms, and she held him to
+her bosom, smiling through her tears.
+
+Full of love and pity and tenderness was the heart of Hector, and
+gently he caressed her and said:
+
+"Dear one, I pray thee be not of over-sorrowful heart. No man shall
+slay me ere the time appointed for my death hath come. Go home and
+busy thyself with loom and distaff and see to the work of thy maidens.
+But war is for us men, and of all those who dwell in Troyland, most of
+all for me."
+
+So spake Hector, and on his head again he placed his crested helmet.
+And his wife went home, many times looking back to watch him she loved
+going forth to battle, with her eyes half blinded by her tears.
+
+Not far behind Hector followed Paris, his armor glittering like the
+sun, and with a laugh on the face that was more full of beauty than
+that of any other man on earth. Like a noble charger that has broken
+its bonds and gallops exultingly across the plain, so did Paris stride
+onward.
+
+"I fear I have delayed thee," he said to his brother when he overtook
+him.
+
+"No man can speak lightly of thy courage," answered Hector, "only thou
+hast brought shame on thyself by holding back from battle. But now let
+us go forward, and may the gods give the Greeks into our hands."
+
+So went Hector and Paris together into battle, and many a Greek fell
+before them on that day.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+HOW PATROCLUS FOUGHT AND DIED
+
+
+While round the dark ships of Greece the fierce fight raged, Achilles,
+from afar, listened unmoved to the din of battle, and watched with
+stony eyes the men of Greece as they fell and died on the reddened
+ground.
+
+To him came Patroclus.
+
+"Why dost thou weep, Patroclus?" asked Achilles. "Like a fond little
+maid art thou that runs by her mother's side, plucking at her gown,
+hindering her as she walks, and with tearful eyes looking up at her
+until the mother lifts her in her arms. Like her, Patroclus, dost thou
+softly weep."
+
+Then Patroclus, heavily groaning, made answer:
+
+"Among the ships lie the bravest and best of the men of Greece, sore
+wounded or dead. Pitiless art thou, Achilles, pitiless and
+unforgiving. Yet if thou dost still hold back from the battle, give
+me, I pray thee, thine armor, and send me forth in thy stead.
+Perchance the Trojans may take me for the mighty Achilles, and even
+now the victory be ours."
+
+Then said Achilles, and heavy was his heart within him:
+
+"These Greeks took from me my well-won prize, Patroclus. Yet let the
+past be past; no man may keep his anger for ever. I have said that
+until the men of Troy come to burn my own ships I will hold me back
+from the battle. But take you my armor; lead my men in the fight, and
+drive from the ships the men of Troy. But to others leave it to chase
+them across the plain."
+
+Even as Achilles spoke, the strength of mighty Ajax had come to an
+end, and with furious rush did the Trojans board the ships. In their
+hands they bore blazing torches, and up to the sky rushed the fiercely
+roaring flames.
+
+Then cried Achilles, smiting his thighs:
+
+"Haste thee, Patroclus! They burn the ships! Arm thyself speedily, and
+I will call my men!"
+
+Corslet and shield and helmet did Patroclus swiftly don, and girded on
+the silver-studded sword and took two strong lances in his hand.
+
+In the chariot of Achilles he mounted, and Automedon, best and bravest
+of charioteers, took the reins.
+
+Swift as the wild west wind were Bayard and Piebald, the two horses of
+Achilles, and in the side harness was Pedasus, a horse only less swift
+than they.
+
+Gladly did the men of Achilles meet his call to arms, for fierce as
+wolves were they.
+
+"Many times hast thou blamed me," cried Achilles, "because in my
+wrath I kept ye back from battle. Here for ye now is a mighty fight,
+such as ye love."
+
+To battle they went, and while Patroclus led them forth, Achilles in
+his tent offered up an offering to Zeus.
+
+Like wasps that pour forth from their nests by the wayside to sting
+the boys who have stoned them, so now did the Greeks swarm from their
+ships.
+
+Before the sword of Patroclus fell a mighty warrior, and when the men
+of Troy saw the shining armor of Achilles in his own chariot their
+hearts sank within them.
+
+Out of the ships were they driven, the fire was quenched, and back to
+the trench rolled the tide of battle. In the trench writhed many a
+horse and many a man in dying agonies. But clear across it leaped the
+horses of Achilles, and close to the walls of Troy did Patroclus drive
+brave Hector before him.
+
+His chariot then he turned, and headed off the fleeing Trojans,
+driving them down to the ships. Before the furious rush of his swift
+steeds, other horses were borne off their feet, other chariots cast in
+ruins on the ground, and men crushed to death under his wheels. Chief
+after chief did Patroclus slay. A mighty destroyer was he that day.
+
+One only of the chiefs of Troy kept his courage before the destroyer
+who wore the shining arms of Achilles.
+
+"Shame on ye!" cried Sarpedon to his men, "whither do ye flee? I
+myself will fight this man who deals death and destruction to the
+Trojan host."
+
+From their chariots leaped Sarpedon and Patroclus.
+
+With the first cast of his spear Patroelus missed Sarpedon, but slew
+his charioteer. Then did Sarpedon cast, and his spear whizzed past
+Patroclus, and smote the good horse Pedasus. With a dreadful scream
+Pedasus fell, kicking and struggling, in the dust. This way and that
+did the other two horses plunge and rear, until the yoke creaked and
+the reins became entangled. But the charioteer leaped down, with his
+sword slashed clear the traces from Pedasus, and the horses righted
+themselves.
+
+Once again did Sarpedon cast his spear, and the point flew over the
+left shoulder of Patroclus. But Patroclus missed not. Through the
+heart of Sarpedon sped the fiercely hurled spear, and like a slim tree
+before the axe of the wood-cutter he fell, his dying hands clutching
+at the bloody dust.
+
+Furious was the combat then over the body of Sarpedon. One brave
+warrior after another did Patroclus lay dead.
+
+And more terrible still was the fight because in the ranks of the men
+of Troy there fought now, in all-devouring wrath, the god Apollo.
+
+Nine men, good warriors all, did Patroclus slay; then, waxing bolder,
+he tried to climb the very walls of Troy.
+
+Three times did Apollo thrust him back, and when, a fourth time, he
+attacked, the god cried aloud to him in anger, warning him not to dare
+so much.
+
+Against Patroclus did Hector then drive his war-horses, but Patroclus,
+leaping from his chariot, hurled at Hector a jagged stone. In the eyes
+it smote the charioteer of Hector, and the slain man dropped to the
+ground.
+
+"How nimble a man is this!" jeered Patroclus. "How lightly he diveth!
+Were this the sea, how good an oyster-seeker would this fellow be!"
+
+Then from his chariot leaped Hector and met Patroclus, and the noise
+of the battle was as the noise of a mighty gale in the forest when
+great trees fall crashing to the ground.
+
+When the sun went down, victory was with the Greeks. Three mighty
+charges did Patroclus make, and each time he slew nine men. But when,
+a fourth time, he charged, Apollo met him. In thick mist he met him,
+and Patroclus knew not that he fought with a god. With a fierce
+down-stroke from behind, Apollo smote his broad shoulders, and from
+off his head the helmet of Achilles fell with a clang, rattling under
+the hoofs of the horses. Before the smiting of the god, Patroclus
+stood stricken, stupid and amazed. Shattered in his hands was the
+spear of Achilles, and his mighty shield clanged on the ground.
+
+Ere he could know who was the smiter, a Trojan ally drove a spear
+between his shoulders, and Patroclus, sore wounded, fell back.
+
+Marking his dismay, Hector pressed forward, and clean through his
+body drove his bronze spear. With a crash Patroclus fell.
+
+"Thou that didst boast that thou wouldst sack my town, here shall
+vultures devour thee!" cried Hector.
+
+And in a faint voice Patroclus made answer:
+
+"Not to thee do I owe my doom, great Hector. Twenty such as thou would
+I have fought and conquered, but the gods have slain me. Yet verily I
+tell thee that thou thyself hast not long to live. Even now doth Death
+stand beside thee!"
+
+As he spoke, the shadow of Death fell upon Patroclus. No more in his
+ears roared the din of battle; still and silent for ever he lay.
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+THE ROUSING OF ACHILLES
+
+
+Fierce had been the fight before Patroclus died. More fiercely yet it
+raged when he lay dead.
+
+From his body did Hector take the arms of Achilles, and the dead
+Patroclus would the Trojans fain have dragged to their city, there to
+bring shame to him and to all the Greek host.
+
+But for him fought the Greeks, until the earth was wet with blood and
+the very skies echoed the clang of battle.
+
+To Achilles came Antilochos, a messenger fleet of foot.
+
+"Fallen is Patroclus!" he cried, "and around his naked body do they
+fight, for his armor is held by Hector."
+
+Then did Achilles moan aloud. On the ground he lay, and in his hair he
+poured black ashes. And the sound of his terrible lament was heard by
+his mother, Thetis, the goddess, as she sat in her palace down under
+the depths of the green sea.
+
+Up from under the waves swiftly came she to Achilles, and tenderly did
+she listen while he poured forth to her the tale of the death of his
+dear comrade.
+
+Then said Thetis:
+
+"Not long, methinks, shall Hector glory in the armor that was thine,
+for Death presseth hard upon him. Go not forth to battle, my son,
+until I return, bearing with me new and fair armor for thee."
+
+But when Thetis had departed, to Achilles in his sorrow came Iris,
+fair messenger of the gods.
+
+"Unto windy Ilios will the Trojans drag the body of Patroclus unless
+thou comest now. Thou needst not fight, Achilles, only show thyself to
+the men of Troy, for sore is the need of Patroclus thy friend."
+
+Then, all unarmed, did Achilles go forth, and stood beside the trench.
+With a mighty voice he shouted, and at the sound of his voice terror
+fell upon the Trojans. Backward in flight they went, and from among
+the dead did the Greeks draw the body of Patroclus, and hot were the
+tears that Achilles shed for the friend whom he had sent forth to
+battle.
+
+All that night, in the house of the Immortals, resounded the clang of
+hammer on anvil as Hephaistus, the lame god, fashioned new arms for
+Achilles.
+
+Bronze and silver and gold he threw in his fire, and golden
+handmaidens helped their master to wield the great bellows, and to
+send on the crucibles blasts that made the ruddy flames dance.
+
+No fairer shield was ever borne by man than that which Hephaistus made
+for Achilles. For him also he wrought a corslet brighter than a flame
+of fire, and a helmet with a golden crest.
+
+And in the morning light did Thetis dart down from snowy Olympus,
+bearing in her arms the splendid gift of a god.
+
+Glad was Achilles as he put on the armor, and terrible was his war-cry
+as he roused the Greek warriors. No man, however sore his wounds, held
+back when the voice of Achilles called him to the fight once again.
+Wounded was Agamemnon, overlord of the Greeks, but forth also came he.
+And there, while the sun rose on many a warrior who would fight no
+more, did Achilles and Agamemnon speak as friends once again, their
+long strife ended.
+
+Hungry for war, with Achilles as their leader, did the Greeks then
+meet the Trojans on the plain. And as a fierce fire rages through the
+forest, its flames driven by the wind, so did Achilles in his wrath
+drive through the host of Troy.
+
+Down to the Scamander he drove the fleeing Trojans, and the water
+reddened with blood, as he smote and spared not.
+
+Merciless was Achilles; pitilessly did he exult as one brave man after
+another was sent by him to dye red the swift flood of the Scamander.
+
+At length, at his lack of mercy, did even the river grow wrathful.
+
+"Choked is my stream with dead men!" it cried, "and still thou
+slayest!"
+
+But when Achilles heeded not, in fierce flood the river up-rose
+against him, sweeping the slain before it, and in furious spate
+seeking to destroy Achilles. But as its waves smote against his
+shield, Achilles grasped a tall elm, and uprooting it, cast it into
+the river to dam the torrent. For the moment only was the angry river
+stayed. In fear did Achilles flee across the plain, but with a mighty
+roar it pursued him, and caught him.
+
+To the gods then cried Achilles, and to his aid came Athene, and close
+to the walls of Troy again did Achilles chase the Trojan men.
+
+From the city walls old Priam saw the dreadful things Achilles
+wrought.
+
+And when, his armor blazing like the brightest stars of the sky, he
+drew near, and Hector would have gone to meet him, in grief did Priam
+cry to his dearly loved son:
+
+"Hector, beloved son, I pray thee go not alone to meet this man;
+mightier far than thou is he."
+
+But all eager for the fight was Hector. Of all the men of Troy he
+alone still stood unafraid. Then did the mother of Hector beseech him
+to hold back from what must surely mean death. Yet Hector held not
+back, but on his shining shield leaned against a tower, awaiting the
+coming of the great destroyer.
+
+And at last they met, face to face, spear to spear. As a shooting-star
+in the darkness so flashed the spear of Achilles as he hurled it home
+to pierce the neck of Hector. Gods and men had deserted Hector, and
+alone before the walls of Troy he fell and died.
+
+Thus ended the fight.
+
+For twelve days did the Greek host rejoice, and all through the days
+Hector's body lay unburied. For at the heels of swift horses had the
+Greeks dragged him to the ships, while from the battlements his mother
+and his wife Andromache watched, wailing in agony, with hearts that
+broke.
+
+Then at length went old Priam to the camp of the Greeks. And before
+Achilles he fell, beseeching him to have mercy and to give him back
+the body of his son.
+
+So was the heart of Achilles moved, and the body of Hector ransomed;
+and with wailing of women did the people of Troy welcome home their
+hero.
+
+Over him lamented his old mother, for of all her sons was he to her
+most dear, and over him wept, with burning tears, his wife Andromache.
+
+And to his bier came Helen, and with breaking heart did she sob forth
+her sorrow:
+
+"Dearest of my brothers," she said, "from thee have I heard neither
+reproach nor evil word. With kind words and gentle heart hast thou
+ever stood by me. Lost, lost is my one true friend. No more in
+Troyland is any left to pity me."
+
+On lofty funeral pyre then laid they the dead Hector, and when the
+flames had consumed his body his comrades placed his white bones in a
+golden urn, and over it with great stones did they raise a mighty
+mound that all might see where he rested.
+
+Yet still was the warfare between Greeks and Trojans not ended.
+
+To Achilles death came in a shaft from the bow of Paris. By a poisoned
+arrow driven at venture and at dark midnight from the bow of an
+outcast leper was fair Paris slain. While winter snow lay white on
+Ida, in Helen's arms did his life ebb away.
+
+Then came there a day when the Greeks burned their camp and sailed
+homeward across the gray water.
+
+Behind them they left a mighty horse of wood, and the men of Troy came
+and drew it into the city as trophy and sign of victory over those who
+had made it. But inside the horse were hidden many of the bravest
+warriors of Greece, and at night, when the Trojans feasted, the Greeks
+came out of their hiding-place and threw open the gates.
+
+And up from the sea came the Greek host, and in fire and in blood fell
+the city of Troy.
+
+Yet did not Helen perish. Back to his own kingdom by the sea Menelaus
+took her, to reign, in peace, a queen, she who had brought grief and
+death to so many, and to the city of Troy unutterable woe.
+
+
+
+
+THE ODYSSEY OF HOMER
+
+ADAPTED BY JEANIE LANG
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+WHAT HAPPENED IN ITHACA WHILE ODYSSEUS WAS AWAY
+
+
+While Odysseus was fighting far away in Troyland, his baby son grew to
+be a big boy. And when years passed and Odysseus did not return, the
+boy, Telemachus, grew to be a man.
+
+Telemachus loved his beautiful mother, Penelope, but his heart always
+longed for the hero father whom he could only dimly remember. As time
+went on, he longed more and more, for evil things came to pass in the
+kingdom of Odysseus.
+
+The chiefs and lords of Ithaca admired Penelope for her beauty. They
+also coveted her money and her lands, and when Odysseus did not
+return, each one of these greedy and wicked men wished to marry her
+and make his own all that had belonged to brave Odysseus.
+
+"Odysseus is surely dead," they said, "and Telemachus is only a lad
+and cannot harm us."
+
+So they came to the palace where Penelope and Telemachus lived, and
+there they stayed, year in, year out, feasting and drinking and
+wasting the goods of Odysseus. Their roughness and greed troubled
+Penelope, but still more did they each one daily torment her by rudely
+asking: "Wilt thou marry me?"
+
+At last she fell on a plan to stop them from talking to her of
+marriage.
+
+In the palace hall she set up a great web, beautiful and fine of woof.
+
+Then she said, "When I have finished weaving this robe I shall give
+you my answer."
+
+Each day she worked at it, but each night, when the wooers slept, she
+undid all that she had done during the day. So it seemed to the wooers
+as if the robe would never be finished.
+
+Penelope's heart was heavy, and heavy, too, was the heart of
+Telemachus. For three weary years, while Odysseus was imprisoned on
+the island of Calypso, the mother and son pined together.
+
+One day Telemachus sat at the door of the palace sadly watching the
+wooers as they drank and reveled. He was thinking of the brave father
+that he feared was dead, when there walked up to the door of the
+courtyard a stranger dressed like a warrior from another land.
+
+The stranger was the goddess Athene. At the same time that she gained
+leave from the gods to set Odysseus free, they had agreed that she
+should go to Ithaca and help Telemachus. But she came dressed as a
+warrior, and not as a beautiful, gray-eyed, golden-haired goddess with
+golden sandals on her feet.
+
+Telemachus rose up and shook her kindly by the hand, and led her into
+the hall. He took from her the heavy bronze spear that she carried,
+and made her sit down on one of the finest of the chairs, in a place
+where the noise of the rough wooers should not disturb her.
+
+"Welcome, stranger," he said. "When thou hast had food, then shalt
+thou tell us in what way we can help thee."
+
+He then made servants bring a silver basin and golden ewer that she
+might wash her hands, and he fetched her food and wine of the best.
+
+Soon the wooers entered, and noisily ate they and drank, and roughly
+jested.
+
+Telemachus watched them and listened with an angry heart. Then, in a
+low voice, he said to Athene:
+
+"These men greedily eat and drink, and waste my father's goods. They
+think the bones of Odysseus bleach out in the rain in a far land, or
+are tossed about by the sea. But did my father still live, and were he
+to come home, the cowards would flee before him. Tell me, stranger,
+hast thou come from a far-off country? Hast thou ever seen my father?"
+
+Athene answered: "Odysseus still lives. He is a prisoner on a
+sea-girt island, but it will not be long ere he escapes and comes
+home. Thou art like Odysseus, my son. Thou hast a head like his, and
+the same beautiful eyes."
+
+When Athene spoke to him so kindly and so hopefully, Telemachus told
+her all that was in his heart. And when the wickedness and greed of
+the wooers was made known to her, Athene grew very angry.
+
+"Thou art in sore need of Odysseus," she said. "If Odysseus were to
+come to the door now with lance in hand, soon would he scatter those
+shameless ones before him."
+
+Then she told Telemachus what he must do.
+
+"To-morrow," said she, "call thy lords to a council meeting, and tell
+the wooers to return to their homes."
+
+For himself, she told him to fit out a ship with twenty oars-men, that
+he might sail to a land where he should get tidings of his father.
+
+"Thou art tall and handsome, my friend," she said. "Be brave, that
+even in days to come men may praise thy name."
+
+"Thou speakest as a father to a son. I will never forget what thou
+hast said," said Telemachus.
+
+He begged Athene to stay longer, and wished to give her a costly gift.
+But she would not stay, nor accept any present. To Telemachus she had
+given a gift, though he did not know it. For into his heart she had
+put strength and courage, so that when she flew away like a beautiful
+bird across the sea she left behind her, not a frightened, unhappy
+boy, but a strong, brave man.
+
+The wooers took no notice of the comings and goings of the strange
+warrior, so busy were they with their noisy feast. As they feasted a
+minstrel played to them on his lyre, and sang a song of the return of
+the warriors from Troyland when the fighting was over.
+
+From her room above, Penelope heard the song, and came down. For a
+little, standing by the door, she listened. Then she could bear it no
+longer, and, weeping, she said to the minstrel:
+
+"Sing some other song, and do not sing a song of return from Troyland
+to me, whose husband never returned."
+
+Then Telemachus, in a new and manly way that made her wonder, spoke to
+his mother:
+
+"Blame not the minstrel, dear mother," he said. "It is not his fault
+that he sings sad songs, but the fault of the gods who allow sad
+things to be. Thou art not the only one who hast lost a loved one in
+Troyland. Go back to thy room, and let me order what shall be, for I
+am now the head of the house."
+
+In the same fearless, manly way he spoke to the wooers:
+
+"Ye may feast to-night," he said; "only let there be no brawling.
+To-morrow meet with me. For once and for all it must be decided if ye
+are to go on wasting my goods, or if I am to be master of my own house
+and king in mine own land."
+
+The wooers bit their lips with rage, and some of them answered him
+rudely; but Telemachus paid no heed, and when at last they returned to
+their houses, he went upstairs to his own room. The old woman who had
+nursed him when he was a child carried torches before him to show him
+the way. When he sat down on his bed and took off his doublet, she
+folded and smoothed it and hung it up. Then she shut the door with its
+silver handle, and left Telemachus, wrapped in a soft fleece of wool,
+thinking far into the night of all that Athene had said to him.
+
+When day dawned he dressed and buckled on his sword, and told heralds
+to call the lords to a council meeting. When all were assembled he
+went into the hall. In his hand he carried a bronze spear, and two of
+his hounds followed him, and when he went up to his father's seat and
+sat down there, the oldest men gave place to him. For Athene had shed
+on him such a wondrous grace that he looked like a young god.
+
+"Never since brave Odysseus sailed away to Troyland have we had a
+council meeting," said one old lord. "I think the man who hath called
+this meeting is a true man--good luck go with him! May the gods give
+him his heart's desire."
+
+So good a beginning did this seem that Telemachus was glad, and,
+burning to say all that had been in his heart for so long, he rose to
+his feet and spoke.
+
+Of the loss of his father he spoke sadly, and then, with burning
+words, of the cowardly wooers, of their feastings and revelings and
+wasting of his goods, and of their insolence to Penelope and himself.
+
+When he had thus spoken in rage and grief, he burst into tears.
+
+For a little there was silence, then one of the wooers said angrily:
+
+"Penelope is to blame, and no other. For three years she has deceived
+us. 'I will give you my answer when I have finished weaving this
+robe,' she said, and so we waited and waited. But now that three years
+have gone and a fourth has begun, it is told us by one of her maids
+that each night she has undone all she has woven during the day. She
+can deceive us no longer. She must now finish the robe, and tell us
+whom she will marry. For we will not leave this place until she has
+chosen a husband."
+
+Then, once again, with pleading words, Telemachus tried to move the
+hearts of the wooers.
+
+"If ye will not go," at last he said, "I will ask the gods to reward
+you for your wickedness."
+
+As he spoke, two eagles flew, fleet as the wind, from the mountain
+crest. Side by side they flew until they were above the place of the
+council meeting. Then they wheeled about, darted with fury at each
+other, and tore with their savage talons at each other's heads and
+necks. Flapping their great wings, they then went swiftly away and
+were lost in the far distance.
+
+Said a wise old man: "It is an omen. Odysseus will return, and woe
+will come upon the wooers. Let us make an end of these evil doings and
+keep harm away from us."
+
+"Go home, old man," angrily mocked the wooers. "Prophesy to thine own
+children. Odysseus is dead. Would that thou hadst died with him. Then
+thou couldst not have babbled nonsense, and tried to hound on
+Telemachus in the hope that he may give thee a gift."
+
+To Telemachus they said again:
+
+"We will go on wasting thy goods until Penelope weds one of us."
+
+Only one other beside the old man was brave enough to speak for
+Telemachus. Fearlessly and nobly did his friend Mentor blame the
+wooers for their shamelessness. But they jeered at him, and laughed
+aloud when Telemachus told them he was going to take a ship and go to
+look for his father.
+
+"He will never come back," said one, "and even were Odysseus himself
+to return, we should slay him when he came."
+
+Then the council meeting broke up, and the wooers went again to revel
+in the palace of Odysseus.
+
+Down to the seashore went Telemachus and knelt where the gray water
+broke in little white wavelets on the sand.
+
+"Hear me," he cried, "thou who didst speak with me yesterday. I know
+now that thou art a god. Tell me, I pray thee? how shall I find a ship
+to sail across the misty sea and find my father? For there is none to
+help me."
+
+Swiftly, in answer to his cry, came Athene.
+
+"Be brave. Be thy father's son," she said. "Go back to thy house and
+get ready corn and wine for the voyage. I will choose the best of all
+the ships in Ithaca for thee, and have her launched, and manned by a
+crew, all of them willing men."
+
+Then Telemachus returned to the palace. In the courtyard the wooers
+were slaying goats and singeing swine and making ready a great feast.
+
+"Here comes Telemachus, who is planning to destroy us," they mocked.
+"Telemachus, who speaks so proudly--- angry Telemachus."
+
+Said one youth:
+
+"Who knows but what if he goes on a voyage he will be like Odysseus,
+and never return. Then will we have all his riches to divide among
+ourselves, and his house will belong to the man who weds Penelope."
+
+Telemachus shook off the jeering crowd, and went down to the vaulted
+chamber where his father's treasures were kept. Gold and bronze lay
+there in piles, and there were great boxes of splendid clothes, and
+casks of wine. The heavy folding doors of the treasure chamber were
+shut day and night, and the old nurse was the keeper of the treasures.
+
+Telemachus bade her get ready corn and wine for the voyage.
+
+"When my mother has gone to rest I will take them away," he said, "for
+this night I go to seek my father across the sea."
+
+At this the old nurse began to cry.
+
+"Do not go, dear child," she wailed. "Thou art our only one, and we
+love thee so well. Odysseus is dead, and what canst thou do, sailing
+far away across the deep sea? As soon as thou art gone, those wicked
+men will begin to plot evil against thee. Do not go. Do not go. There
+is no need for thee to risk thy life on the sea and go wandering far
+from home."
+
+"Take heart, nurse," said Telemachus. "The goddess Athene has told me
+to go, so all will be well. But promise me not to tell my dear mother
+that I am gone until she misses me. For I do not wish to mar her fair
+face with tears."
+
+The nurse promised, and began to make ready all that Telemachus
+wished.
+
+Meantime Athene, in the likeness of Telemachus, found a swift-sailing
+ship, and men to sail it. When darkness fell, she sent sleep on the
+wooers and led Telemachus down to the shore where his men sat by their
+oars.
+
+To the palace, where every one slept and all was still and quiet,
+Telemachus brought his men. None but the old nurse knew he was going
+away, but they found the food and wine that she had got ready and
+carried it down to the ship. Then Athene went on board, and Telemachus
+sat beside her. A fresh west wind filled the sails and went singing
+over the waves. The dark water surged up at the bow as the ship cut
+through it. And all night long and till the dawn, the ship sailed
+happily on her way.
+
+At sunrise they came to land, and Athene and Telemachus went on shore.
+The rulers of the country welcomed them and treated them well, but
+could tell nothing of Odysseus after the siege of Troy was over.
+Athene gave Telemachus into their care, then, turning herself into a
+sea-eagle, she flew swiftly away, leaving them amazed because they
+knew she must be one of the gods.
+
+While Telemachus sought for news of his father in this kingdom, and
+the kingdoms near it, the wooers began to miss him at their feasts.
+They fancied he was away hunting, until, one day, as they played games
+in front of the palace, the man whose ship Athene had borrowed came to
+them.
+
+"When will Telemachus return with my ship?" he asked.
+
+"I need it that I may cross over to where I keep my horses. I wish to
+catch one and break him in."
+
+When the wooers heard from him that Telemachus had sailed away with
+twenty brave youths, in the swiftest ship in Ithaca, they were filled
+with rage.
+
+At once they got a ship and sailed to where they might meet Telemachus
+in a strait between Ithaca and another rocky island.
+
+"We will slay him there," said they. "We will give him a woful end to
+his voyage in search of his father."
+
+When Penelope heard this, and knew that her son was perhaps sailing to
+his doom, her heart well-nigh broke. She wept bitterly, and reproached
+her maidens with not having told her that Telemachus had gone.
+
+"Slay me if thou wilt," said the old nurse, "but I alone knew it.
+Telemachus made me promise not to tell thee, that thy fair face might
+not be marred by weeping. Do not fear, the goddess Athene will take
+care of him."
+
+Thus she comforted her mistress, and although she lay long awake that
+night, Penelope fell asleep at last. In her dreams Athene came to her
+and told her that Telemachus would come safely home, and so Penelope's
+sad heart was cheered.
+
+While she slept the wooers sailed away in a swift, black ship, with
+spears in their hands and murder in their hearts. On a little rocky
+isle they landed until the ship of Telemachus should pass, and there
+they waited, that they might slay him when he came.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+HOW ODYSSEUS CAME HOME
+
+
+While yet Telemachus sought news of his father, Odysseus was well-nigh
+home. On that misty morning when he found himself in Ithaca, and did
+not know it, because the gray fog made everything seem strange and
+unfriendly, Odysseus was very sad as he sat beside the moaning sea.
+
+Then came Athene, and drove the mist before her, and Odysseus saw
+again the land that he loved, and knew that his wanderings were past.
+She told him the tale of the wooers, and of the unhappiness of
+Penelope and Telemachus, and the heart of Odysseus grew hot within
+him.
+
+"Stand by me!" he said to the goddess. "If thou of thy grace wilt help
+me, I myself will fight three hundred men."
+
+"Truly I will stand by thee," said Athene, "and many of the greedy
+wooers shall stain the earth with their blood."
+
+She then told Odysseus how the wooers were to be destroyed, and
+Odysseus gladly agreed to her plans. First she made him hide far in
+the darkness of the cave, under the olive-tree, all the gold and
+bronze ornaments and beautiful clothes that had been given to him in
+the land of Nausicaa.
+
+Then she touched him with her golden wand. In a moment his yellow hair
+fell off his head; his bright eyes were dim; his skin was withered and
+wrinkled, and he had a stooping back and tottering legs like a feeble
+old man. His clothes of purple and silver she changed into torn and
+filthy old rags, and over his shoulders she threw the old skin of a
+stag with the hair worn off.
+
+"Go now," said Athene, "to where thy faithful swineherd sits on the
+hill, watching his swine as they grub among the acorns and drink of
+the clear spring. He has always been true to thee and to thy wife and
+son. Stay with him and hear all that he has to tell, and I will go and
+fetch home Telemachus."
+
+"When thou didst know all, why didst thou not tell Telemachus?" asked
+Odysseus. "Is he, too, to go wandering over stormy seas, far from his
+own land?"
+
+"Telemachus will be a braver man for what he has gone through," said
+Athene. "No harm shall come to him, although the wooers in their black
+ship wait to slay him."
+
+Then Athene flew across the sea, and Odysseus climbed up a rough track
+through the woods to where the swineherd had built himself a hut. The
+hut was made of stones and thorn-branches, and beside it were sties
+for the swine made in the same way. The wooers had eaten many swine at
+their daily feasts, but thousands remained. These the swineherd
+tended, with three men and four fierce dogs to help him.
+
+At an open space on the hill, from whence he could look down at the
+woods and the sea, Odysseus found the swineherd sitting at the door of
+his hut making himself a pair of sandals out of brown ox-hide.
+
+When the swineherd's dogs saw a dirty, bent old man toiling up the
+hill, they rushed at him, barking furiously. Up they leapt on him and
+would have torn him to pieces if their master had not cast away his
+ox-hide, dashed after them, scolded them and beaten them, and then
+driven them off with showers of stones.
+
+"If my dogs had killed thee I should have been for ever ashamed," he
+said to Odysseus, "and without that I have enough sorrow. For while my
+noble master may be wandering in a strange land and lacking food, I
+have to feed his fat swine for others to eat."
+
+So speaking, he led Odysseus to his hut. He laid some brushwood on the
+floor, spread over it the soft, shaggy skin of a wild goat, and bade
+Odysseus be seated. Then he went out to the sties, killed two sucking
+pigs, and roasted them daintily. When they were ready he cut off the
+choicest bits and gave them to Odysseus, with a bowl of honey-sweet
+wine.
+
+While Odysseus ate and drank, the swineherd talked to him of the greed
+and wastefulness of the wooers, and in silence Odysseus listened,
+planning in his heart how he might punish them.
+
+"Tell me thy master's name," he said at length. "I have traveled in
+many lands. Perchance I may have seen him, and may give thee news of
+him."
+
+But the swineherd answered:
+
+"Each vagrant who comes straying to the land of Ithaca goes to my
+mistress with lying tales of how he has seen or heard of my master.
+She receives them all kindly, and asks many questions, while tears run
+down her cheeks. You, too, old man, would quickly make up a story if
+any one would give thee some new clothes. My master is surely dead,
+and wherever I may go I shall never again find a lord so gentle."
+
+Then said Odysseus:
+
+"My friend, I swear to thee that Odysseus shall return. In this year,
+as the old moon wanes and the new is born, he shall return to his
+home."
+
+When the other herds returned that evening they found Odysseus and
+their master still deep in talk. At night the swineherd made a feast
+of the best that he had, and still they talked, almost until dawn. The
+night was black and stormy, and a drenching rain blotted out the moon,
+but the swineherd, leaving Odysseus lying in the bed he had made for
+him, with his own thick mantle spread over him, went outside and lay
+under a rock that sheltered him from the storm, keeping guard on the
+white-tusked boars that slept around him. And Odysseus knew that he
+had still at least one servant who was faithful and true.
+
+While Odysseus dwelt with the swineherd, Athene sought Telemachus and
+bade him hasten home. Speedily Telemachus went back to his ship and
+his men. The hawsers were loosed, the white sail hauled up, and Athene
+sent a fresh breeze that made the ship cut through the water like a
+white-winged bird. It was night when they passed the island where the
+wooers awaited their coming, and in the darkness none saw them go by.
+
+By daybreak they reached Ithaca, and Telemachus, as Athene had bidden
+him, sent on the men to the harbor with the ship, but made them put
+him ashore on the woody coast near the swineherd's dwelling.
+
+With his bronze-shod spear in his hand, Telemachus strode up the rocky
+path. Odysseus and the swineherd had kindled a fire, and were
+preparing the morning meal, when Odysseus heard the noise of
+footsteps. He looked out and saw a tall lad with yellow hair and
+bright eyes, and a fearless, noble face. "Surely here is a friend," he
+said to the swineherd. "Thy dogs are not barking, but jump up and fawn
+on him."
+
+The swineherd looked, and when he saw his young master he wept for
+joy.
+
+"I thought I should never see thee more, sweet light of my eyes," he
+said. "Come into my hut, that I may gladden my heart with the sight of
+thee."
+
+He then spread before him the best he had, and the three men ate
+together. Although Odysseus seemed only a poor, ragged, old beggar,
+Telemachus treated him with such gentleness and such courtesy that
+Odysseus was proud and glad of his noble son. Soon Telemachus sent the
+swineherd to tell Penelope of his safe return, and while he was gone
+Athene entered the hut. She made herself invisible to Telemachus, but
+beckoned to Odysseus to go outside.
+
+"The time is come for thee to tell thy son who thou art," she said,
+and touched him with her golden wand.
+
+At once Odysseus was again a strong man, dressed in fine robes, and
+radiant and beautiful as the sun.
+
+When he went back into the hut Telemachus thought he was a god.
+
+"No god am I," said Odysseus; "I am thy father, Telemachus."
+
+And Odysseus took his son in his arms and kissed him, and the tears
+that he had kept back until now ran down his cheeks. Telemachus flung
+his arms round his father's neck, and he, too, wept like a little
+child, so glad was he that Odysseus had come home.
+
+All day they spoke of the wooers and plotted how to slay them.
+
+When the swineherd returned, and Athene had once more changed Odysseus
+into an old beggar-man, he told Telemachus that the wooers had
+returned, and were so furious with Telemachus for escaping from them,
+that they were going to kill him next day.
+
+At this Telemachus smiled to his father, but neither said a word.
+
+Next morning Telemachus took his spear and said to the swineherd:
+
+"I go to the palace to see my mother. As for this old beggar-man, lead
+him to the city, that he may beg there."
+
+And Odysseus, still pretending to be a beggar, said:
+
+"It is better to beg in the town than in the fields. My garments are
+very poor and thin, and this frosty air chills me; but as soon as I am
+warmed at the fire and the sun grows hot, I will gladly set out."
+
+Down the hill to the city strode Telemachus. When he came to the
+palace, his old nurse, whom he found busy in the hall, wept for joy.
+And when Penelope heard his voice, she came from her room and cast her
+arms round him and kissed his face and his eyes, and said, while tears
+ran down her cheeks:
+
+"Thou art come, sweet light of my eyes. I thought I should never see
+thee more."
+
+Then Telemachus, looking like a young god, with his spear in his hand
+and his two hounds following at his heels, went to the hall where the
+wooers sat. To his friend Mentor he told his adventures, but he looked
+on the wooers with silence and scorn.
+
+Soon Odysseus and the swineherd followed him to the city. A beggar's
+bag, all tattered, was slung round the shoulders of Odysseus. In his
+hand he carried a staff. Men who saw him, tattered and feeble, mocked
+at him and his guide. But Odysseus kept down the anger in his heart,
+and they went on to the palace. Near the doorway, lying in the dirt,
+thin and old and rough of coat, lay Argos, the dog that long ago had
+been the best and fleetest that had hunted the hares and deer with
+Odysseus.
+
+When he heard his master's voice he wagged his tail and tried to crawl
+near him. But he was too feeble to move. He could only look up with
+loving, wistful eyes that were almost blind, and thump his tail
+gladly. So glad was he that his faithful heart broke for joy, and
+before Odysseus could pat his head or speak a kind word to him, old
+Argos rolled over dead.
+
+There were tears in the eyes of Odysseus as he walked past the body of
+his friend. He sat down on the threshold leaning on his staff, and
+when Telemachus sent him bread and meat from his table he ate
+hungrily. When the meal was over he went round the hall begging from
+the wooers. Some gave him scraps of broken meats, others called him
+hard names and bade him begone, and one of them seized a footstool and
+struck him with it.
+
+But Odysseus still kept down the anger in his heart, and went back to
+his seat on the threshold with his beggar's bag full of the scraps
+that had been given to him.
+
+As he sat there, a common beggar, well known for his greed and
+impudence, came to the palace.
+
+"Get thee hence, old man," said he to Odysseus, "else I shall knock
+all thy teeth from thy head."
+
+More, too, he said, rudely and roughly, and at last he struck
+Odysseus.
+
+Then Odysseus could bear no more, and smote him such a blow on his
+neck that the bones were broken, and he fell on the ground with blood
+gushing from his mouth. Odysseus dragged him outside by the heels, and
+propped him, with his staff in his hands, against the courtyard wall.
+
+"Sit there," he said, "and scare off dogs and swine."
+
+The wooers laughed and enjoyed the sport, and gave gifts of food to
+the sturdy old beggar, as they took Odysseus to be. All evening they
+feasted and drank, but when night fell they went to their own homes.
+
+When they were gone Odysseus and Telemachus carried all the helmets
+and swords and sharp-pointed spears that stood in the hall, away to
+the armory and hid them there.
+
+Then Telemachus went to his room to rest, but Odysseus sat in the hall
+where the servants were clearing away the remains of the feast. While
+he sat there, Penelope came with her maids and rested on a chair In
+front of the glowing wood fire on which the servants had piled fresh
+logs.
+
+She talked kindly and gently to the old beggar-man, and bade the old
+nurse bring water to wash his weary feet.
+
+Now, once long ago, a wild boar that he hunted had torn the leg of
+Odysseus with his tusk, and as the old nurse washed his feet she saw
+the scar. In a moment she knew her master, and cried out. The brazen
+bath fell with a clang on the floor, and the water was spilt.
+
+"Thou art Odysseus," she said; "I did not know thee, my dear child,
+until I found the scar."
+
+Penelope must have heard her glad cry, had not Athene at that moment
+made her deep in thoughts of other things. Quickly Odysseus bade the
+old nurse be silent, and the old woman obeyed him.
+
+Before Penelope went to rest she said sadly to Odysseus: "I feel that
+the end is drawing near. Soon I shall be parted from the house of
+Odysseus. My husband, who was always the best and bravest, used to set
+up the twelve axes ye see standing here, and between each axe he shot
+an arrow. I have told the wooers that I shall marry whichever one of
+them can do the like. Then I shall leave this house, which must be for
+ever most dear to me."
+
+Then answered the old beggar-man: "Odysseus will be here when they
+shoot. It will be Odysseus who shoots between the axes."
+
+Penelope, longing for his words to be true, went up to her room and
+lay crying on her bed until her pillows were wet. Then Athene sent
+sleep upon her eyelids and made her forget all her sorrows.
+
+Odysseus, too, would have tossed all night wide awake, with a heart
+full of anger and revenge, had not Athene gently laid her hands on his
+eyes and made him fall asleep.
+
+Next day the wooers came to the palace, and with rough jest and rude
+word they greeted Odysseus.
+
+"Who harms this man must fight with me," said Telemachus, and at that
+the wooers shouted with laughter.
+
+But a stranger who sat among them cried out in a voice of fear:
+
+"I see your hands and knees shrouded in blackness! I see your cheeks
+wet with tears! The walls and the pillars drip blood; the porch is
+full of shadows, and pale ghosts are hastening out of the gray mist
+that fills the palace."
+
+At this the wooers laughed the more, for they thought the man was mad.
+But, as in a dream, he had seen truly what was to come to pass.
+
+Weeping, Penelope then brought forth from the armory the great bow
+with which Odysseus had shot in years that were past. Her heart was
+full of love for Odysseus, and she could not bear to wed another.
+
+Telemachus then threw aside his red cloak and ranged out the bronze
+axes.
+
+One by one the wooers tried to move the great bow and make it drive a
+swift arrow before it. One by one they failed.
+
+And when it seemed as if no man there was strong enough to move it,
+Odysseus took it in his hands, and between each axe he shot an arrow.
+When the last arrow was shot he tore off his rags, and in a voice that
+rang through the palace he cried to Telemachus: "Now is it time to
+prepare supper for the wooers! Now, at last, is this terrible trial
+ended. I go to shoot at another mark!"
+
+With that he shot an arrow at the wooer who had ever been the most
+insolent and the most cruel. It smote him in the throat, his blood
+dripped red on the ground, and he fell dead.
+
+The others gave a great cry of rage, but Odysseus looked at them with
+burning eyes, and with a voice that made them tremble he cried:
+
+"Ye dogs! ye said I should never return, and, like the traitors ye
+are, ye have wasted my goods and insulted my queen. But now death has
+come for you, and none shall escape."
+
+In vain did the cowards, their faces pale with fear, beg for mercy.
+Mercy there was none that day. It was useless for those who drew their
+swords and rushed on Odysseus to try to slay him, for ere their swords
+could touch him, his bow had driven sharp arrows into their hearts.
+
+One of the servants of the palace treacherously climbed into the
+armory and brought spears and shields and helmets for the wooers. But
+even that did not daunt Odysseus and his son. Telemachus, with his
+spear, slew man after man. When his arrows were done Odysseus also
+snatched a spear, and they fought side by side. Beside them fought the
+swineherd and one other man, and they all fought the more fearlessly
+because, all the time, Athene put fresh courage in their hearts.
+
+There were four men to very many others when that fight began. When it
+was ended the floor ran with blood, and Odysseus, like a lion at bay,
+stood with the dead bodies of the wooers piled in heaps around him and
+his face and hands stained with blood.
+
+When all lay dead, the old nurse gave a great cry of joy.
+
+"Rejoice in thy heart, old nurse," said Odysseus. "It is an unholy
+thing to rejoice openly over slain men."
+
+The nurse hastened to Penelope's room.
+
+"Penelope, dear child!" she cried, "Odysseus is come home, and all the
+wooers lie dead."
+
+At first Penelope would not believe her. Too good did it seem to be
+true. Even when she came down and saw Odysseus leaning against a tall
+pillar in the light of the fire, she would not believe what her own
+eyes saw.
+
+"Surely, mother, thy heart is as hard as stone," said Telemachus.
+"Dost thou not know my father?"
+
+But Penelope saw only a ragged beggar-man, soiled with the blood of
+the men he had slain, old and ugly and poor.
+
+Then Athene shed her grace upon Odysseus, and once more he was tall
+and strong and gallant to look upon, with golden hair curling like
+hyacinth flowers around his head. And Penelope ran to him and threw
+out her arms, and they held each other close and wept together like
+those who have suffered shipwreck, and have been tossed for long by
+angry seas, and yet have won safely home at last.
+
+And when the sun went down that night on the little rocky island of
+Ithaca in the far seas, the heart of Odysseus was glad, for he knew
+that his wanderings were ended.
+
+
+
+
+ROBINSON CRUSOE
+
+By DANIEL DEFOE
+
+ADAPTED BY JOHN LANG
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+HOW ROBINSON FIRST WENT TO SEA; AND HOW HE WAS SHIPWRECKED
+
+
+Long, long ago, before even your grandfather's father was born, there
+lived in the town of York a boy whose name was Robinson Crusoe. Though
+he never even saw the sea till he was quite a big boy, he had always
+wanted to be a sailor, and to go away in a ship to visit strange,
+foreign, far-off lands; and he thought that if he could only do that,
+he would be quite happy.
+
+But his father wanted him to be a lawyer, and he often talked to
+Robinson, and told him of the terrible things that might happen to him
+if he went away, and how people who stopped at home were always the
+happiest. He told him, too, how Robinson's brother had gone away, and
+had been killed in the wars.
+
+So Robinson promised at last that he would give up wanting to be a
+sailor. But in a few days the longing came back as bad as ever, and he
+asked his mother to try to coax his father to let him go just one
+voyage. But his mother was very angry, and his father said, "If he
+goes abroad he will be the most miserable wretch that ever was born. I
+can give no consent to it."
+
+Robinson stopped at home for another year, till he was nineteen years
+old, all the time thinking and thinking of the sea. But one day when
+he had gone on a visit to Hull, a big town by the sea, to say good-by
+to one of his friends who was going to London, he could not resist the
+chance. Without even sending a message to his father and mother, he
+went on board his friend's ship, and sailed away.
+
+But as soon as the wind began to blow and the waves to rise, poor
+Robinson was very frightened and seasick, and he said to himself that
+if ever he got on shore he would go straight home and never again
+leave it.
+
+He was very solemn till the wind stopped blowing. His friend and the
+sailors laughed at him, and called him a fool, and he very soon
+forgot, when the weather was fine and the sun shining, all he had
+thought about going back to his father and mother.
+
+But in a few days, when the ship had sailed as far as Yarmouth Roads
+on her way to London, they had to anchor, and wait for a fair wind. In
+those days there were no steamers, and vessels had only their sails to
+help them along; so if it was calm, or the wind blew the wrong way,
+they had just to wait where they were till a fair wind blew.
+
+While they lay at Yarmouth the weather became very bad, and there was
+a great storm. The sea was so heavy and Robinson's ship was in such
+danger, that at last they had to cut away the masts in order to ease
+her and to stop her from rolling so terribly. The Captain fired guns
+to show that his ship wanted help. So a boat from another ship was
+lowered, and came with much difficulty and took off Robinson and all
+the crew, just before their vessel sank; and they got ashore at last,
+very wet and miserable, having lost all their clothes except what they
+had on.
+
+But Robinson had some money in his pocket, and he went on to London by
+land, thinking that if he returned home now, people would laugh at
+him.
+
+In London he made friends with a ship's captain, who had not long
+before come home from a voyage to the Guinea Coast, as that part of
+Africa was then called; and the Captain was so pleased with the money
+he had made there, that he easily persuaded Robinson to go with him on
+his next voyage.
+
+So Robinson took with him toys, and beads, and other things, to sell
+to the natives in Africa, and he got there, in exchange for these
+things, so much gold-dust that he thought he was soon going in that
+way to make his fortune.
+
+And therefore he went on a second voyage.
+
+But this time he was not so lucky, for before they reached the African
+coast, one morning, very early, they sighted another ship, which they
+were sure was a pirate. So fast did this other vessel sail, that
+before night she had come up to Robinson's ship, which did not carry
+nearly so many men nor so many guns as the pirate, and which therefore
+did not want to fight; and the pirates soon took prisoner Robinson and
+all the crew of his ship who were not killed, and made slaves of them.
+
+The pirate captain took Robinson as his own slave, and made him dig in
+his garden and work in his house. Sometimes, too, he made him look
+after his ship when she was in port, but he never took him away on a
+voyage.
+
+For two years Robinson lived like this, very unhappy, and always
+thinking how he might escape.
+
+At last, when the Captain happened one time to be at home longer than
+usual, he began to go out fishing in a boat two or three times a week,
+taking Robinson, who was a very good fisher, and a black boy named
+Xury, with him.
+
+One day he gave Robinson orders to put food and water, and some guns,
+and powder and shot, on a big boat that the pirates had taken out of
+an English ship, and to be ready to go with him and some of his
+friends on a fishing trip.
+
+But at the last moment the Captain's friends could not come, and so
+Robinson was told to go out in the boat with one of the Captain's
+servants who was not a slave, and with Xury, to catch fish for supper.
+
+Then Robinson thought that his chance to escape had come.
+
+He spoke to the servant, who was not very clever, and persuaded him to
+put more food and water on the boat, for, said Robinson, "we must not
+take what was meant for our master." And then he got the servant to
+bring some more powder and shot, because, Robinson said, they might as
+well kill some birds to eat.
+
+When they had gone out about a mile, they hauled down the sail and
+began to fish. But Robinson pretended that he could not catch anything
+there, and he said that they ought to go further out. When they had
+gone so far that nobody on shore could see what they were doing,
+Robinson again pretended to fish. But this time he watched his chance,
+and when the servant was not looking, came behind him and threw him
+overboard, knowing that the man could swim so well that he could
+easily reach the land.
+
+Then Robinson sailed away with Xury down the coast to the south. He
+did not know to what country he was steering, but cared only to get
+away from the pirates, and to be free once more.
+
+Long days and nights they sailed, sometimes running in close to the
+land, but they were afraid to go ashore very often, because of the
+wild beasts and the natives. Many times they saw great lions come
+roaring down on to the beach, and once Robinson shot one that he saw
+lying asleep, and took its skin to make a bed for himself on the boat.
+
+At last, after some weeks, when they had got south as far as the great
+cape that is called Cape Verde, they saw a Portuguese vessel, which
+took them on board. It was not easy for Robinson to tell who he was,
+because he could not talk Portuguese, but everybody was very kind to
+him, and they bought his boat and his guns and everything that he had.
+They even bought poor Xury, who, of course, was a black slave, and
+could be sold just like a horse or a dog.
+
+So, when they got to Brazil, where the vessel was bound, Robinson had
+enough money to buy a plantation; and he grew sugar and tobacco there
+for four years, and was very happy and contented for a time, and made
+money.
+
+But he could never be contented for very long. So when some of his
+neighbors asked him if he would go in a ship to the Guinea Coast to
+get slaves for them, he went, only making a bargain that he was to be
+paid for his trouble, and to get some of the slaves to work on his
+plantation when he came back.
+
+Twelve days after the ship sailed, a terrible storm blew, and they
+were driven far from where they wanted to go. Great, angry, foaming
+seas broke over the deck, sweeping everything off that could be moved,
+and a man and a boy were carried overboard and drowned. No one on the
+ship expected to be saved.
+
+This storm was followed by another, even worse. The wind howled and
+roared through the rigging, and the weather was thick with rain and
+flying spray.
+
+Then early one morning land was dimly seen through the driving rain,
+but almost at once the vessel struck on a sand-bank. In an instant the
+sails were blown to bits, and flapped with such uproar that no one
+could hear the Captain's orders. Waves poured over the decks, and the
+vessel bumped on the sand so terribly that the masts broke off near
+the deck, and fell over the side into the sea.
+
+With great difficulty the only boat left on the ship was put in the
+water, and everybody got into her. They rowed for the shore, hoping to
+get perhaps into some bay, or to the mouth of a river, where the sea
+would be quiet.
+
+But before they could reach the land, a huge gray wave, big like the
+side of a house, came foaming and thundering up behind them, and
+before any one could even cry out, it upset the boat, and they were
+all left struggling in the water.
+
+Robinson was a very good swimmer, but no man could swim in such a sea,
+and it was only good fortune that brought him at last safely to land.
+Big wave after big wave washed him further and further up the beach,
+rolling him over and over, once leaving him helpless, and more than
+half drowned, beside a rock.
+
+But before the next wave could come up, perhaps to drag him back with
+it into the sea, he was able to jump up and run for his life.
+
+And so he got safely out of the reach of the water, and lay down upon
+the grass. But of all on board the ship, Robinson was the only one who
+was not drowned.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+ROBINSON WORKS HARD AT MAKING HIMSELF A HOME
+
+
+When he had rested a little, Robinson got up and began to walk about
+very sadly, for darkness was coming on; he was wet, and cold, and
+hungry, and he did not know where to sleep, because he was afraid of
+wild beasts coming out of the woods and killing him during the night.
+
+But he found that he still had his knife in his pocket, so he cut a
+big stick to protect himself with. Then he climbed into a tree which
+had very thick leaves, and there he fixed himself among the branches
+as well as he could, and fell sound asleep.
+
+In the morning when he awoke, the storm was past, and the sea quieter.
+To his surprise, he saw that the ship had been carried in the night,
+by the great seas, much nearer to the shore than she had been when the
+boat left her, and was now lying not far from the rock where Robinson
+had first been washed up.
+
+By midday the sea was quite calm, and the tide had gone so far out
+that he could walk very near to the ship. So he took off his clothes
+and swam the rest of the way to her. But it was not easy to get on
+board, because the ship was resting on the sand, and lay so high out
+of the water that Robinson could not reach anything by which he could
+pull himself up.
+
+At last, after swimming twice round the vessel, he saw a rope hanging
+over, near the bow, and by its help he climbed on board.
+
+Everything in the stern of the ship was dry, and in pretty good order,
+and the water had not hurt the provisions much. So he took some
+biscuits, and ate them as he looked about, and drank some rum, and
+then he felt better, and stronger, and more fit to begin work.
+
+First of all, he took a few large spars of wood, and a spare topmast
+or two, that were on the deck. These he pushed overboard, tying each
+with a rope to keep it from drifting away. Then he went over the side
+of the ship, and tied all the spars together so as to make a raft, and
+on top he put pieces of plank across. But it was long before he could
+make the raft fit to carry the things he wanted to take on shore.
+
+At last, after much hard work, he got on to it three of the seamen's
+chests, which he had broken open, and emptied, and he filled these
+with bread, and rice, and cheese, and whatever he could find to eat,
+and with all sorts of things that he thought he might need. He found,
+too, the carpenter's tool-chest, and put it on the raft; and nothing
+on the whole ship was of more use to him than that.
+
+Then he set about looking for clothes, for while he had been on the
+ship, the tide had risen and had washed away his coat and waistcoat
+and shirt, which he had left lying on the sand.
+
+Guns and pistols also, and powder and shot, he took, and two rusty old
+cutlasses.
+
+Now the trouble was to reach land, for the raft had no mast nor sail
+nor rudder, and was too heavy and clumsy to be pulled by Robinson with
+the broken oars that he had found. But the tide was rising, and slowly
+she drifted nearer and nearer, and at last was carried up the mouth of
+a little river which Robinson had not seen when he was on shore.
+
+There was a strong tide running up, which once carried the raft
+against a point of land, where she stuck for a time, and very nearly
+upset all the things into deep water. But as the tide rose higher,
+Robinson was able to push her into a little bay where the water was
+shallow and the ground beneath flat, and when the tide went out there
+she was left high and dry, and he got everything safely ashore.
+
+The next thing that Robinson did was to climb a hill, that he might
+see what sort of country he was in, and find out if there were any
+other people in it. But when he got to the top, he saw to his sorrow
+that he was on an island, with no other land in sight except some
+rocks, and two smaller islands far over the sea. There were no signs
+of any people, and he saw nothing living except great numbers of
+birds, one of which he shot. But it was not fit to eat, being some
+kind of hawk.
+
+After this, with the chests and boards that he had brought on shore,
+he made a kind of hut to sleep in that night, and he lay there on the
+sand very comfortably.
+
+Day by day now for some time Robinson swam out to the ship, and made
+fresh rafts, loading them with many stores, powder and shot, and lead
+for bullets, seven muskets, a great barrel of bread, three casks of
+rum, a quantity of flour, some grain, a box of sugar, sails and ropes
+and twine, bags of nails, and many hatchets. With one of the sails he
+made himself a good tent, in which he put everything that could be
+spoiled by rain or sun. Around it he piled all the casks and other
+heavy things, so that no wild beast could very easily get at him.
+
+In about a fortnight the weather changed; it blew very hard one
+night, and in the morning the ship had broken up, and was no more to
+be seen. But that did not so much matter, for Robinson had got out of
+her nearly everything that he could use.
+
+Now Robinson thought it time to find some better place for his tent.
+The land where it then stood was low and near the sea, and the only
+water he could get to drink tasted rather salt. Looking about, he
+found a little plain, about a hundred yards across, on the side of a
+hill, and at the end of the plain was a great rock partly hollowed
+out, but not so as quite to make a cave. Here he pitched his tent,
+close to the hollow place in the rock. Round in front of the tent he
+drove two rows of strong stakes, about eighteen inches apart,
+sharpened at top; and he made this fence so strong that when it was
+finished he was sure that nothing could get at him, for he left no
+door, but climbed in and out by a ladder, which he always hauled up
+after him.
+
+Before closing up the end, Robinson hauled inside this fence all his
+stores, his food and his guns, his powder and shot, and he rigged
+inside a double tent, so better to keep off the hot sun and the rain.
+
+Then he began to dig into the rock, which was not very hard, and soon
+behind his tent he had a cave in which he thought it wise to stow his
+gunpowder, about one hundred and forty pounds in all, packed in small
+parcels; for, he thought, if a big thunderstorm were to come, a flash
+of lightning might explode it all, and blow him to bits, if he kept
+the whole of it in his tent.
+
+Robinson was now very comfortable, and as he had saved from the wreck
+two cats and a dog, he did not feel quite so lonely. He had got, also,
+ink and pens and paper, so that he could keep a diary; and he set up a
+large wooden cross, on which he cut with his knife the date of his
+landing on the island--September 30, 1659; and every day he cut a
+notch on the post, with a longer one each Sunday, so that he might
+always know how the months and years passed.
+
+As for food, he found that there were many goats on the island, and
+numbers of pigeons, and he had no difficulty in shooting as many as he
+needed.
+
+But now he saw that his tent and cave were too small for all the
+things he had stowed in them, so he began to make the cave bigger,
+bringing out all the rock and soil that he cut down, and making with
+it a kind of terrace round the inside of his stockade. And as he was
+sure that there were no wild beasts on the island to harm him, he went
+on tunneling to the right hand till he broke through the rock outside
+his fence.
+
+Then he began to hang things up against the side of the cave, and he
+even made shelves, and a door for the outside entrance. This was a
+very difficult job, and took him a long time; for, to make a board, he
+was forced to cut down a whole tree, and chop away with his axe till
+one side was flat, and then cut at the other side till the board was
+thin enough, when he smoothed it with his adze. But in this way, out
+of each tree he would only get one plank. He made for himself also a
+table and a chair, and finally got his castle, as he called it, in
+very good order.
+
+With all his care, however, there was one thing that he forgot, and
+that was, when he had made the cave so much bigger, to prop it, so as
+to keep the roof from falling in. And so one day he got a terrible
+fright, and was nearly killed, by a huge bit of the soft rock which
+fell and buried many of his things. It took weeks of hard work
+afterwards to clear away the fallen rubbish, and to cut beams strong
+enough to prop the roof.
+
+Every day, all this time, he used to climb up the hill and look around
+over the lonely waters, hoping, always hoping, that some morning he
+might see the sails of a ship that would take him home. But none ever
+came, and sometimes the tears ran down his cheeks because of the
+sorrow he felt at being so utterly alone. At times even, he thought in
+his misery that if he only had any kind of a boat, it would be better
+to sail away, and chance reaching other land, rather than to stop
+where he was. By and by, however, he grew less unhappy, for he had
+plenty of work to do.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+THE EARTHQUAKE AND HURRICANE; AND HOW ROBINSON BUILT A BOAT
+
+
+Now about this time, when Robinson had been some months on the island,
+heavy and constant rain began to fall, and sometimes weeks would pass
+without a single dry day. He found that instead of there being spring,
+summer, autumn, and winter, as in England, the seasons in his island
+were divided into the wet and the dry. There was no cold weather, no
+winter. It chanced that just before this first rain began, Robinson
+had emptied out some refuse from bags which had once held rice, and
+other grain, and he had forgotten all about having emptied them. So he
+was very much astonished to find, some time afterwards, both barley
+and rice growing near his tent, in the shade of the rock. The ears,
+when ripe, he kept to sow again, and from this very small beginning,
+in the course of a few seasons, he had a great quantity of grain, both
+for food and for sowing. But this meant every year much hard work, for
+he had no plow nor harrow, and all the ground had to be dug with a
+clumsy spade, made from a very hard, heavy wood that grew on the
+island.
+
+At first Robinson could not grind the grain that he grew, nor make
+bread from it. If he could have found a large stone, slightly hollow
+on top, he might, by pounding the grain on it with another round
+stone, have made very good meal. But all the stones he could find were
+too soft, and in the end he had to make a sort of mill of hard wood,
+in which he burnt a hollow place, and on that he pounded the grain
+into meal with a heavy stick.
+
+Baking he did by building a big fire, then raking away the ashes, and
+putting the dough on the hot place, covered with a kind of basin made
+of clay, over which he heaped the red ashes. In this way very good
+bread can be made.
+
+Before the rainy season was over, and just after he had finished the
+fence round his tent, one day when Robinson was at work in the cave,
+all of a sudden the earth began to fall from the roof, and the strong
+props he had put in cracked in a way which frightened him terribly. At
+the same time there was a curious moaning, rumbling noise, that he
+could not understand. He rushed out, and so afraid was he that the
+roof was falling in, and that he should be buried, that he got over
+the fence and began to run.
+
+But he was even more frightened when he found that all the ground was
+shaking. Then he knew that this was an earthquake.
+
+Three times there came violent shocks; a huge rock about half a mile
+away fell with a great noise like thunder, and the sea was churned up
+as if by a whirlwind. Robinson was sick with the movement of the
+ground, and trembling with the dread of being swallowed by the earth
+as it cracked and gaped; and after the noise and shaking were over, he
+was too frightened to go back to his tent, but sat where he was, all
+the time expecting another shock.
+
+Suddenly a furious wind began to blow, tearing up trees by the roots,
+and lashing the water till nothing could be seen but foam and flying
+spray. The air was full of branches and leaves torn off by the
+hurricane, and birds in hundreds were swept helpless out to sea. In
+about three hours, as suddenly as it had begun, the wind fell, and
+there was a dead calm, followed by rain such as Robinson had never
+before seen, which soaked him to the skin, and forced him to return to
+the cave, where he sat in great fear.
+
+For long after this he was very uneasy, and made up his mind to shift
+his quarters as soon as he could find a better place for his tent. But
+the earthquake had one good result, for what remained of the wreck was
+again thrown up by the sea, and Robinson got more things out of it
+which were useful to him, and for days he worked hard at that. One
+day, too, when he was on his way to the remains of the ship, he came
+on a large turtle, which he killed, and this gave him plenty of good
+food, for besides the flesh, there were, inside the animal, many eggs,
+which she had come to the shore to lay in the sand, as is the habit of
+turtles, and which Robinson thought were even better than hen's eggs.
+
+Now a few days after he had got so wet in the heavy rain, though the
+weather was hot, Robinson felt very cold and shivery, and had pains
+all over his body, and at night he dreamed terrible dreams. The
+following day, and many days, he lay very ill with fever and ague, and
+hardly knew what he was doing. So weak was he, that he believed he was
+dying, and there was no one to give him water to quench his thirst,
+nor to help him in any way. His only medicine was rum, in which he had
+soaked tobacco. It was very nasty, and made him sick, but it also
+made him sleep for more than a whole day and a night, and he woke much
+better, and able to walk about a little, though for a fortnight he was
+too weak to work. From this illness he learned not to go out more than
+he could help during the rainy season.
+
+When he was again quite strong, Robinson started to explore the island
+better than he had yet done, and he found many things growing, of
+which he made great use afterwards, tobacco, sugar-cane, and all
+manner of fruits, among them grapes, which he used to dry to raisins
+in the sun in great quantities.
+
+Near the spot where the most fruit grew, he built a hut, and round it,
+for safety, he put a double fence made of stakes cut from some of the
+trees near at hand. During the next rainy season these stakes took
+root, and grew so fast that soon nothing of the hut could be seen from
+outside the hedge, and it made so good a hiding-place, that Robinson
+cut more stakes of the same kind, and planted them outside the fence
+around his first dwelling; and in a year or two that also was quite
+hidden from view. The twigs of this tree, too, were good for making
+baskets, of which he had been in great need.
+
+When he had finished all this work, he started again to go over the
+rest of the island, and on his way across, from a hill, the day being
+very clear, he saw high land a great way off over the water, but
+whether it was another island, or the coast of America, he could not
+be sure.
+
+When he reached the other side of his island Robinson found the beach
+covered with turtles in astonishing numbers, and he thought how much
+better off he would have been if he had been cast ashore here, for not
+only would the turtles have supplied him with plenty of food, but
+there were far more birds than on the part of the island where he had
+been living, and far more goats.
+
+During the journey back to his castle he caught a young parrot, which,
+after a long time, he taught to speak and to call him by his name. It
+was so long since he had heard any voice, that it was a comfort to
+listen even to a parrot talking.
+
+Now, the sight which Robinson had had of the far distant land raised
+in him again the great longing to get away from this island where he
+had been so long alone, and he wished greatly for a boat. He went over
+to the remains of the boat in which he and the others had tried to
+come ashore when their ship struck on the sand-bank, and which had
+been flung far up on the beach by the sea, and he worked for weeks
+trying to repair her and to get her into the water. But it was all of
+no use; he could not move her.
+
+Then, he thought, "I'll cut down a tree, and make a new boat." This he
+fancied would be easy, for he had heard how the Indians make canoes by
+felling a tree and burning out the inside. "If they can do it, then
+surely I can do it even better," he thought. So he looked about, and
+chose a huge tree which stood about a hundred yards from the water,
+and with great labor in about three weeks he had cut it down.
+
+Four months Robinson worked at this boat, thinking all the time of
+what he would do when he reached the far distant land, and much
+pleased with himself for the beautiful boat he was making. Day after
+day he trimmed and shaped it, and very proud he was when it was
+finished and lay there on the ground, big enough to carry twenty men.
+
+Then he started to get her into the water. But that was quite another
+thing. By no means in his power could he move her an inch, try as he
+might. She was far too big. Then he began to dig a canal from the sea
+to the boat; but before he had got much of that work done, he saw
+clearly that there was so much earth to dig away, that, without some
+one to help him, it must take years and years before he could get the
+water to the boat. So he gave it up, and left her to lie and rot in
+the sun and the rain--a great grief to him.
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+ROBINSON BUILDS A SECOND BOAT, IN WHICH HE IS SWEPT OUT TO SEA
+
+
+By the time that Robinson had been four years on the island, all his
+clothes had become very ragged, and he had hardly anything that could
+be called a hat. Clothes he must have, for he could not go naked
+without getting his skin blistered by the hot sun, and he was afraid
+of getting a sunstroke if he went about without a hat.
+
+Now he had kept all the skins of the goats, and other animals, such as
+hares and foxes, that he had shot; and from these, after many
+failures, at last he made a hat and coat of goatskin, and a pair of
+short trousers, all with the hair outside, so as to shoot off the wet
+when it rained. The hat was very tall, and came to a sharp peak on
+top, and it had a flap which hung down the back of his neck. Robinson
+also, with much trouble, made of the skins an umbrella which he could
+open and shut; and if his clothes and his umbrella, and especially his
+hat, were not very good to look at, they were useful, and he could now
+go about in any weather.
+
+During the next five years nothing out of the common happened, and
+Robinson's time was mostly taken up with the getting of food, the
+yearly sowing and reaping of his crops, and the curing of his raisins.
+But towards the end of that time he made another attempt to build a
+boat, and this time he made one much smaller than the first, and
+though it took him nearly two years to finish, in the end he got her
+into the sea. She was not big enough for him to try to sail in to the
+far-off land that he had seen, and he used her only for cruising about
+the shores of his own island, and for fishing. In her he fixed a
+little mast, on which he rigged a small sail, made from a bit of one
+of the old ship's sails, and, using a paddle to steer with, he found
+that she sailed very well. Over the stern he fixed his big umbrella,
+to shade him from the sun, like an awning.
+
+Eager to go all round the island, one day Robinson put a lot of food
+on board, and, taking his gun, started on a voyage. All went well till
+he came to the east end of the island, where he found that a ledge of
+rocks, and beyond that a sand-bank, stretched out to sea for eight or
+nine miles. Robinson did not like the idea of venturing so far in a
+boat so small, and he therefore ran the boat ashore, and climbed a
+hill, to get a good view of the rocks and shoals before going near
+them. From the hill, he saw that a strong current was sweeping past
+the sand-bank, which showed just clear of the water, and on which the
+sea was breaking; but he thought there was an eddy which would swing
+him safely round the point, without bringing him near the breakers.
+However, that day and the next, there was a good deal of wind blowing
+in the direction contrary to the current, which, of course, raised a
+sea too big for a small boat, so Robinson stopped on shore where he
+was.
+
+On the third day it was calm, and he set off. But no sooner had he
+come abreast of the sand-bank than he found himself in very deep
+water, with a current running like a mill-race, which carried the boat
+further and further away from the land, in spite of all that he could
+do with his paddle. There was no wind, and the sail was useless.
+
+Now he gave himself up for lost, for the harder he worked, only the
+further away seemed the boat to be swept. The island was soon so far
+off that Robinson could hardly see it, and he was quite exhausted with
+the hard struggle to paddle the boat against the current. He was in
+despair, and giving up paddling, left the boat to drift where she
+would. Just then a faint puff of wind touched his cheek, and Robinson
+hurriedly hoisted his sail. Soon a good breeze blew, which carried him
+past a dangerous reef of rocks. Here the current seemed to divide, the
+part in which he now was began to swing round towards the island, and
+he plucked up heart again, and with his paddle did all he could to
+help the sail. Robinson felt like a man who is set free after he has
+been told that he must die; he could almost have wept for joy. Miles
+and miles he sailed, steadily getting nearer to the land, and late in
+the evening at last he got ashore, but on the other side of the point
+that he had tried to round in the morning. He drew up his boat on the
+shore of a little cove that he found, and when he had made her fast,
+so that the tide could not carry her away, there among the trees he
+lay down, and slept sound, quite worn out.
+
+In the morning he again got on board, and coasted along close inshore,
+till he came to a bay with a little river running into it, which made
+a very good harbor for the boat. Here he left her, and went on foot.
+
+Soon he found that he was not far from a spot that he had once before
+visited, and by afternoon he arrived at the hut which he called his
+country-house. Robinson got over the fence by the ladder, as usual,
+pulling it up after him, and then he lay down to rest in the shade,
+for he was still very weary from the hard work of the day before. Soon
+he fell asleep. But what was his surprise in a little time to be
+awakened by a voice calling, "Robin! Robin Crusoe! where are you?"
+
+At first he thought he was dreaming. But still the voice went on
+calling:
+
+"Where are you, Robin?"
+
+Up he jumped, trembling with fright and wonder, for it was so long
+since he had heard any voice but his own that he fancied it must be
+something more than human that he now listened to. But no sooner had
+he risen than he saw, sitting on the tree near to him, his parrot,
+which must have flown all the way from Robinson's other house, where
+it had been left. It was talking away at a great rate, very excited at
+again seeing its master, and Robinson hardly knew whether to be more
+relieved or disappointed that it was only the bird that had called
+him.
+
+For about a year after this Robinson kept to his own side of the
+island, and employed his time chiefly in working on his land, and in
+making dishes and pots of clay. These he had now learned to burn
+properly. Pipes, too, he made, and they were a great comfort to him,
+for he managed to cure very good tobacco from the wild plants that
+grew around. And as he feared lest his powder might begin to run
+short, he thought much over ways whereby he could trap goats for food,
+instead of shooting them. After many trials, the best plan, he
+decided, was to dig holes, which he covered with thin branches and
+leaves, on which he sprinkled earth, so that when anything heavy
+passed over, it must fall into the pit. By this means he caught many,
+and the kids he kept and tamed, so that in no great time he had quite
+a large herd of goats. These he kept in various small fields, round
+which from time to time he had put fences.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+ROBINSON SEES A FOOTPRINT ON THE SAND, FINDS A CAVE, AND RESCUES
+FRIDAY
+
+
+All this time Robinson had never gone near his canoe, but now the
+longing came on him to go over to where he had left her, though he
+felt that he should be afraid again to put to sea in her. This time,
+however, when he got to the hill from which he had watched the set of
+the current the day that he had been carried out to sea, he noticed
+that there was no current to be seen, from which he concluded that it
+must depend on the ebb and flow of the tide. Still, he was afraid to
+venture far in the canoe, though he stopped some time at his
+country-house, and went out sailing very often.
+
+One day when Robinson was walking along the sand towards his boat,
+suddenly, close to the water, he stopped as if he had been shot, and,
+with thumping heart, stood staring in wonder and fear at something
+that he saw. The mark of a naked foot on the sand! It could not be his
+own, he knew, for the shape was quite different. Whose could it be?
+
+He listened, he looked about, but nothing could he hear or see. To the
+top of a rising ground he ran, and looked all around. There was
+nothing to be seen. And though he searched everywhere on the beach for
+more footmarks, he found none.
+
+Whose footprint could it be? That of some man, perhaps, he thought,
+who might come stealing on him out from the trees, or murder him while
+he slept.
+
+Back to his house he hurried, all the way in a state of terror,
+starting every now and again and facing round, thinking he was being
+followed, and fancying often that a stump or a bush was a man, waiting
+to spring on him. That night he slept not at all, and so shaken was
+his nerve that every cry of a night-bird, even every sound made by an
+insect or a frog, caused him to start with fear, so that the
+perspiration ran down his brow.
+
+As day followed day, however, and nothing happened, Robinson began to
+be less uneasy in his mind, and went about his usual work again. But
+he strengthened the fence round his castle, and cut in it seven small
+loopholes, in which, fixed on frames, he placed loaded muskets, all
+ready to fire if he should be attacked. And some distance from the
+outside of the fence he planted a thick belt of small stakes, so that
+in a few years' time a perfect thicket of trees and bushes hid all
+trace of his dwelling.
+
+Years passed quietly, and nothing further happened to disturb
+Robinson, or to make him think more of the footprint that had
+frightened him so much. But he kept more than formerly to the interior
+of the island, and lost no chance of looking for good places to hide
+in, if he should ever need them. And he always carried a cutlass now,
+as well as his gun and a couple of pistols.
+
+One day it chanced, however, that he had gone further to the west of
+the island than he had ever done before, and, looking over the sea, he
+fancied that he saw, at a great distance, something like a boat or a
+long canoe, but it was so far off that he he could not be sure what it
+was. This made him determine that always in future he would bring with
+him to his lookout-place the telescope which he had saved from the
+wreck.
+
+The sight of this supposed boat brought back his uneasiness to some
+extent, but he went on down to the beach, and there he saw a sight
+which filled him with horror. All about the shore were scattered men's
+skulls and bones, and bits of burnt flesh, and in one place were the
+remains of a big fire. Robinson stood aghast, feeling deadly sick. It
+was easy for him to know the meaning of the terrible sight. It meant
+that cannibals had been there, killing and eating their prisoners; for
+when the natives of some parts of the world go to war, and catch any
+of their enemies, it is their habit to build a fire, then to kill the
+prisoners and feast on their roasted bodies, eating till they can eat
+no more. Sometimes, if the man they are going to eat is too thin, they
+keep him, and feed him up, till they think he is fat enough.
+
+Now Robinson knew all this, though he had never yet met any cannibals.
+And when he looked around he saw many bones lying about. They were so
+old that it seemed certain to him that all those years he had been
+living on an island which was a regular place for the natives to come
+to for such feasts. Then he saw what a mercy it was that he had been
+wrecked on the other side of the island, to which, he supposed, the
+cannibals never came, because the beach was not so good for them to
+land on.
+
+Full of horror, Robinson hurried back to his house, and for almost two
+years he never again came near that part of the island where the bones
+lay, nor ever visited his boat. But all the time he kept thinking how
+he might some day kill those cannibals while they were at their feast,
+and perhaps save some of the poor men whom they had not yet killed.
+
+Now one day when Robinson was down in the bottom of the valley,
+cutting thick branches to burn for charcoal, he cleared away some
+undergrowth at the foot of a great rock, in which, near the ground,
+there was a sort of hole, or opening. Into this hole Robinson
+squeezed, not very easily, and found himself in a cave of good size,
+high enough, at least, to stand up in. It was quite dark, of course,
+to him coming in from the sunlight, and he turned his back to the
+entrance to feel his way further in, when suddenly, from the back of
+the cave he saw two great fiery eyes glaring at him. His very hair
+bristled with fright, for he could only think that it must be the
+Devil at least that he saw; and through the mouth of the cave he fled
+with a yell.
+
+But when he got into the bright sunshine he began to feel ashamed of
+his panic, and to reason with himself that what he had seen must be
+only his own fancy. So, taking up a big burning branch from his fire,
+in he went again.
+
+Before Robinson had taken three steps he stopped, in almost as great a
+fright as at first. Close to him he heard a great sigh, as if of some
+one in pain, then a sound like a muttering, as of words that he could
+not understand; again another deep sigh. Cold sweat broke out all over
+him, and he stepped back trembling, yet determined this time not to
+run away.
+
+Holding his torch well over his head, he looked around, and there on
+the floor of the cave lay a huge old he goat, gasping for breath,
+dying, seemingly of mere old age.
+
+He stirred him with his toe to see if he could get him out of the
+cave, but the poor beast could not rise, and Robinson left him to die
+where he was.
+
+Now that he had got over his fright, Robinson looked carefully about
+him. The cave was small, not more than twelve feet across at its
+widest, but he noticed at the far end another opening. This was so low
+down, however, that he had to creep on his hands and knees to get in,
+and without a better light than the burning torch, he could not see
+how far it went. So he made up his mind to come again.
+
+Robinson had long before this made a good supply of very fair candles
+from the tallow of the goats he had killed, and next day he returned
+to the cave with six of these, and his tinder-box to light them with.
+In those days there were no matches, and men used to strike a light
+with a flint and steel, and tinder, which was a stuff that caught fire
+very easily from a spark.
+
+Entering the cave, Robinson found, on lighting a candle, that the goat
+was now dead. Moving it aside, to be buried later, he went down on his
+hands and knees, and crawled about ten yards through the small
+passage, till at last he found himself in a great chamber, the roof of
+which was quite twenty feet high. On every side the walls reflected
+the light of his candle, and glittered like gold, or almost like
+diamonds, he thought. The floor was perfectly dry and level, even on
+the walls there was no damp, and Robinson was delighted with his
+discovery. Its only drawback was the low entrance; but, as he decided
+to use the cave chiefly as a place to retreat to if he should ever be
+attacked, that was in reality an advantage, because one man, if he had
+firearms could easily defend it against hundreds.
+
+At once Robinson set about storing in it all his powder, except three
+or four pounds, all his lead for making bullets, and his spare guns
+and muskets. When moving the powder, he thought he might as well open
+a barrel which had drifted ashore out of the wreck 'after the
+earthquake, and though water had got into it, there was not a great
+deal of damage done, for the powder had crusted on the outside only,
+and in the inside there was about sixty pounds weight, quite dry and
+good. This, with what remained of the first lot, gave him a very large
+supply, enough to last all his life.
+
+For more than two-and-twenty years Robinson had now been in the
+island, and he had grown quite used to it, and to his manner of
+living. If he could only have been sure that no savages would come
+near him, he felt almost that he would be content to spend all the
+rest of his days there, to die at last, as the goat he found in the
+cave had died, of old age.
+
+At times, when his spirits were more than usually low, when the burden
+of the lonely years pressed most heavily upon him, Robinson used to
+think that surely if the savages could come to his land, he could go
+to theirs. How far did they come? Where was their country? What kind
+of boats had they? And so eager to go was he sometimes, that he forgot
+to think of what he would do when he got there, or what would become
+of him if he fell into the hands of the savages. His mind was utterly
+taken up with the one thought of getting to the mainland, and even his
+dreams were of little else.
+
+One night, when he had put himself almost into a fever with the
+trouble of his mind, he had lain long awake, tossing and moaning, but
+at last he had fallen asleep. And he dreamed, not as he had usually
+done of late, that he was sailing to the mainland, but that as he was
+leaving his castle in the morning he saw on the shore two canoes and
+eleven savages landing, and that they had with them another man, whom
+they were just about to kill and eat, when suddenly the prisoner
+jumped up and ran for his life. And in his dream Robinson fancied that
+the man came running to hide in the thicket round the castle, and that
+thereupon he went out to help him. Then in the dream, the savage
+kneeled down, as if begging for mercy, and Robinson took him over the
+ladder into the castle, saying to himself, "Now that I've got this
+fellow, I can certainly go to the mainland, for he will show me what
+course to steer, and where to go when we land." And he woke, with the
+joyful feeling that now at last all was well. But when he was wide
+awake, and knew that it was only a dream after all, poor Robinson was
+more cast down than ever, and more unhappy than he had been during all
+the years he had lived on the island.
+
+The dream had, however, this result; that he saw his only plan to get
+away was, if possible, to rescue some day one of the prisoners whom
+the cannibals were about to kill, and in time get the man to help him
+to navigate his canoe across the sea.
+
+With this idea, he set himself to watch, more closely than ever he had
+done before, for the savages to land, and during more than a year and
+a half he went nearly every day to his lookout-place, and swept the
+sea with his telescope, in the hope of seeing canoes coming. But none
+came, and Robinson was getting terribly tired of the constant watch.
+Still he did not give up, for he knew that sooner or later the savages
+would land again.
+
+Yet many months passed, and still they did not come, till one morning,
+very early, almost to his surprise, he saw no fewer than five canoes
+hauled up on the shore on his own side of the island. The savages who
+had come in them were nowhere to be seen. Now, he knew that always
+from four to six men came in each canoe, which meant that at least
+twenty, and perhaps as many as thirty men had landed.
+
+This was a greater number than he cared to face, so he kept inside his
+castle, in great doubt what to do, but ready to fight, in case they
+should attack him.
+
+When he had waited a long time and still could hear nothing of the
+savages, he climbed up his ladder and got to the top of the rock,
+taking great care not to show himself against the skyline. Looking
+through his glass, he saw that there were at least thirty savages,
+dancing wildly round a fire.
+
+As he looked, some of the men left the others, and going over to the
+canoes dragged from' them two prisoners. One of these almost at once
+fell forward on his face, knocked down from behind, as it seemed to
+Robinson, with a wooden club, and two or three of the cannibals at
+once cut him open to be ready for cooking, while for a moment or two
+they left the other prisoner standing by himself.
+
+Seeing a chance of escape, the man made a dash for his life, running
+with tremendous speed along the sands straight for that part of the
+beach near Robinson's castle.
+
+Now this alarmed Robinson very much, for it seemed to him that the
+whole of the savages started after the prisoner. He could not help
+thinking it likely that, as in his dream, this man would take shelter
+in the thicket round the castle, in which case Robinson was likely
+soon to have more fighting than he would relish, for the whole body of
+the cannibals would be on him at once.
+
+As he watched the poor man racing for life, however, he was relieved
+to see that he ran much faster than his pursuers, of whom only three
+continued to run after him. If he could hold out for another mile or
+two there was little doubt that he would escape. Between the castle
+and the runners was the creek up which Robinson used to run his rafts
+from the wreck, and when the escaped prisoner came to that, he plunged
+in, and though the tide was full, with less than thirty powerful
+strokes he reached the other side, and with long easy strides
+continued his run. Of the men in pursuit, two also plunged in and swam
+through, but less quickly than the man escaping, being more blown with
+running, because of what they had eaten before starting. The third man
+stopped altogether, and went back the way he came.
+
+Seeing the turn things were taking, it seemed to Robinson that now had
+come his chance to get a servant, and he resolved to try to save the
+life of the man who was fleeing from the cannibals. At once he hurried
+down the ladder, snatched up his two guns, and running as fast as he
+could, got between the man and his pursuers, calling out to him at the
+same time to stop. The man looked back, and the sight of Robinson
+seemed to frighten him at first as much as did the men who were trying
+to catch him. But Robinson again spoke, and signed to him with his
+hand to come back, and in the meantime went slowly towards the other
+men, who were now coming near. Then, rushing at the foremost, he
+knocked him senseless with the butt of his gun, for it seemed to him
+safer not to fire, lest the noise should bring the other cannibals
+around.
+
+The second man, seeing his comrade fall, hesitated, and stopped, but
+Robinson saw when nearer to him that the savage had in his hands a bow
+and arrow with which he was just about to shoot. There was then no
+choice but to fire first, which Robinson did, killing the man on the
+spot.
+
+Thereupon the man who had been chased by the others was so terrified
+by the flash and noise of the gun, and at seeing his enemy fall dead,
+that he stood stock still, trembling, and it was with great difficulty
+that Robinson coaxed him to come near. This at last he did, stopping
+every few paces and kneeling down. At length, coming close to
+Robinson, he again knelt, kissed the ground, and taking hold of
+Robinson's foot, set it on his head as it rested on the sand.
+
+While this was going on, Robinson noticed that the savage whom he had
+knocked down had begun to move, and to come to his senses. To this he
+drew the attention of the man whom he had rescued, who said some words
+that Robinson could not understand, but which sounded pleasant to an
+ear that had heard no voice but his own for more than twenty-five
+years. Next he made a motion with his hand, as if asking for the
+cutlass that hung at Robinson's belt, and when the weapon was given to
+him he ran at his enemy, and with one clean blow cut off his head.
+Then, laughing, he brought the head, and laid it with the cutlass at
+Robinson's feet.
+
+But what caused most wonder to the man was how the savage whom
+Robinson shot had been killed at so great a distance, and he went to
+look as the body, turning it over and over, and looking long at the
+wound in the breast that the bullet had made, evidently much puzzled.
+
+Robinson then turned to go away, beckoning to the savage to follow,
+but the man made signs that he would bury the two bodies in the sand,
+so that the others might not find them if they followed. With his
+hands he soon scraped holes deep enough to cover the bodies, and in
+less than a quarter of an hour there was hardly a trace left of what
+had happened.
+
+Calling him away, Robinson now took him, not to his castle, but to the
+cave, where he gave him food and water; and then he made signs for him
+to lie down and rest, pointing to a bundle of rice straw.
+
+Soon the man was sound asleep. He was, Robinson thought, a handsome
+and well-made man; the muscles of his arms and back and legs showed
+great strength, and all his limbs were beautifully formed. As near as
+Robinson could guess, he was about twenty-six years of age, with a
+good and manly face, and long black hair. His nose and lips were like
+those of a European, and his teeth were white and even. In color he
+was not black, but of a sort of rich chocolate brown, the skin shining
+with health, and pleasant to look upon.
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+ROBINSON TRAINS FRIDAY, AND THEY BUILD A LARGE BOAT; THEY RESCUE TWO
+PRISONERS FROM THE CANNIBALS
+
+
+In a little while Robinson began to speak to him, and to try to teach
+him things. First he made him understand that his name was to be
+"Friday" (that being the day of the week when Robinson had saved him
+from a horrible death). Then he taught him the meaning of "Yes," and
+"No," and to call Robinson "Master."
+
+Friday showed great quickness in learning. He seemed to be happy and
+contented, and free from trouble, except that the clothes which
+Robinson made him wear gave him at first great discomfort, for in
+those warm parts of the world the natives are not used to clothes, but
+always go about naked.
+
+The day following that on which Robinson had saved Friday, they went
+out together to see if there were any signs of the cannibals still
+being on the island, but it was evident that they had gone away
+without troubling about the two men whom Robinson had killed.
+
+For some time Robinson did not trust Friday, and did not allow him to
+sleep in the same part of his castle with himself, but kept him at
+night in a little tent outside the fence.
+
+Friday was quite faithful, never sulky nor lazy, but always merry, and
+ready to do anything that Robinson told him.
+
+At first when they went out in the woods together, Friday was
+terrified each time that Robinson's gun was fired. He had never seen
+anything like it, and it was more than he could understand how things
+could be killed merely by the noise and the flash of fire.
+
+Friday told Robinson much about his country, and about his people, who
+he said were Caribs. And a great way "beyond the moon," by which he
+meant to the west, he said that white men lived who had beards such as
+Robinson wore. These white men, he said, had killed very many natives,
+from which Robinson fancied that they must be Spaniards, who about
+that time were very cruel to the people whose countries they had
+taken.
+
+Robinson asked if Friday could tell him how he might get over to where
+the white men lived, and Friday said it would be very easy, if they
+had a big canoe, and again Robinson began to make plans and to hope to
+escape from the island.
+
+Some time after this Robinson and Friday chanced to be on the high
+hill at the east end of the island. The day was very clear. Friday
+gazed long over the sea, and then began to jump and dance, pointing to
+the dim blue coast. "There my country! See! There my people live!" he
+said, his eyes sparkling with joy, and an eager light on his face.
+
+After this, for a time Robinson was not easy in his mind about Friday.
+He had little doubt that if he could get back to his tribe, he would
+soon forget all he had been taught, might even return with a hundred
+or two of his friends, and kill and eat his master. But in this
+Robinson was very unjust to Friday, who had no such thoughts in his
+mind as those of which he was suspected. And this Robinson soon found
+out. One day he asked Friday if he would not be glad to be once more
+in his own land.
+
+"Yes" said Friday; "very glad."
+
+"Would you eat man's flesh again?"
+
+"No, never," said Friday.
+
+Then Robinson asked why he did not go back. Friday said he would go if
+Robinson came too.
+
+Then Robinson, who thought if he could reach other white men, he would
+finally reach England, began to build a boat in which to leave the
+island. Together he and Friday went to work to fell a tree, and Friday
+soon showed that he knew far better than Robinson the kind of tree
+best suited for boat-making. Robinson showed him how to use tools, and
+in a little more than a month the boat was finished. After the boat
+was put into the water, Robinson was astonished at Friday's skill in
+paddling so large a canoe.
+
+"Will she do to go over in?" he asked, and Friday, grinning, said,
+"Yes, even if big wind blow." But Robinson did not mean to depend on
+paddling, and fitted the boat with a mast, sails and rudder.
+
+Twenty-six years had passed since Robinson came to the island, and he
+still went on digging and sowing. One morning he sent Friday down to
+the beach for a turtle. Back he came in a great hurry, crying out,
+"Master! Master! over yonder, one, two, three canoe." Loading his
+guns, Robinson gave them to Friday to carry, while he armed himself
+with muskets, a cutlass, and a hatchet.
+
+When all was ready he went up the hill with his telescope, and saw
+that there were in all twenty-one savages, with three prisoners, one
+of whom was a white man.
+
+Robinson knew the savages had landed on the island to kill and eat
+their prisoners, so he resolved to prevent them if possible. To get at
+the savages without being seen, they had to go nearly a mile out of
+their way, and being heavily laden they could not go very fast.
+Reaching the place, they saw, from behind a clump of bushes, the white
+man bound hand and foot on the sand. There was no time to lose, and
+their first shot killed three and wounded five of the savages.
+Snatching up fresh guns, both fired again, before the savages who were
+not hurt could get on their feet, for they were so taken by surprise,
+that the poor wretches hardly knew what was happening. This time only
+two dropped, but many more were wounded.
+
+While Friday kept on firing, Robinson ran to the white prisoner and
+cut his bonds. The man said he was a Spaniard and began to thank
+Robinson for what he had done. Robinson handed him the cutlass and a
+pistol, telling him, if he had any strength left, to go and do what he
+could against the savages. As soon as the man got the weapons in his
+hands, he ran with fury at the cannibals and cut two down, and with
+equal fury attacked the rest. With the Spaniard to help them, Robinson
+and Friday were soon able to clear the place of these dreadful
+cannibals, many of whom jumped into the sea.
+
+Friday advised Robinson to take a canoe and go after them lest they
+return with hundreds of others to avenge the death of their friends.
+So the two ran to the beach and began to shove off a canoe. But to
+their surprise, on the bottom of the canoe lay another prisoner, an
+old man, tied so hard, neck and heels, that even when his bonds were
+cut he could not move.
+
+No sooner did Friday look at him and hear him speak, than he began to
+dance and shout and laugh, and then kneeling down, rubbed noses with
+the savage (which is what these folks do instead of kissing each
+other), and he was so excited that for some time he could not explain
+what was the matter. As soon as he could speak, he told Robinson that
+the man whom they had found was his father.
+
+Both Friday's father and the Spaniard, who was worn out with fighting,
+had to be carried up to the castle.
+
+No cannibals were ever again known to visit this island.
+
+
+
+
+VII
+
+ARRIVAL OF AN ENGLISH SHIP; ROBINSON SAILS FOR HOME
+
+
+Soon after this Robinson had a long talk with the Spaniard, who told
+him how he and his comrades had been wrecked four years since, on that
+part of the coast where Friday's tribe lived. He said that they were
+well treated by the natives, but that they were put to very great
+straits now for want of clothes, that their powder was finished, and
+that they had lost all hope of ever getting back to their own country.
+He himself, he said, had been captured in one of the many small wars
+that are always taking place among the various tribes.
+
+It struck Robinson that it might be possible for him to get these men
+over to his island, provided that he could be sure of their good
+faith, and that when they came, they did not take the island from him
+by treachery. It was a risk, he thought, but then, if he got so many
+men, it would not be difficult to build a small ship that could carry
+them all to England.
+
+So he asked the Spaniard if he would promise, and if he thought he
+could get his comrades to take an oath that, if Robinson helped them,
+they would look on him as their captain, and would swear to obey him
+in all things. The Spaniard readily promised for himself, and said
+that he was sure his comrades would keep faith.
+
+It was arranged, therefore, that in about six months, when the next
+harvest was reaped, and there would be plenty of food for so many
+extra men, the Spaniard and Friday's father should go over to the
+mainland in one of the canoes which had been taken from the savages.
+
+Meantime, all hands set about the curing of very large quantities of
+raisins, and much other work was done to be in readiness for the
+coming of these men.
+
+When the harvest was reaped, Robinson gave the Spaniard and Friday's
+father each a musket and a supply of powder and bullets, and loaded
+the canoe with food, enough to last them and the others about a
+fortnight, and the two men set off for the mainland in fine weather,
+and with a fair wind.
+
+It was about eight days after this, and when Robinson had begun to
+look out for their return, that one morning very early, when Robinson
+was asleep, Friday came running in, shouting, "Master! Master! They
+come." Up jumped Robinson, and hurrying on his clothes, ran out.
+
+Looking towards the sea, he soon made out a sailing-boat making for
+the shore, coming from the south end of the island, but still some
+miles away. This was not the direction from which the Spaniard and his
+comrades would come, nor were they likely to be in a sailing-boat. So
+Robinson took his telescope, and went to the top of the hill to see if
+he could make out who were on board, before they landed.
+
+Hardly had he got on to the hill when he noticed a ship at anchor some
+distance from the shore. She looked like an English vessel, he
+thought, and the boat like an English long-boat.
+
+This was a wonderful sight to Robinson, but yet he was not easy in his
+mind. It was not a part of the world where an English ship was likely
+to come, because in those days they were nearly all Spanish vessels
+that traded in these seas, and the English and Spaniards were bitter
+enemies. What could an English ship be doing here? There had been no
+storm to drive her out of her course.
+
+Robinson feared that if she was English there must be something wrong
+about her. Perhaps, he thought, she was a pirate. So he was careful
+not to show himself or Friday.
+
+Presently, as he watched, he saw the men in the boat run her ashore
+and draw her up on the beach, about half a mile from his castle. When
+they had landed, he could easily see through his glass that they were
+Englishmen.
+
+There were eleven men, but three of them had their hands tied behind
+their backs, and were evidently prisoners. When the first four or five
+men had jumped ashore, they brought out these three, all the while
+ill-treating them, and behaving as if they meant to kill their
+prisoners. Friday was sure that they meant to eat them.
+
+Soon, without further harming the three men, the others scattered
+about among the trees near the shore, leaving the three sitting on the
+ground very sad-looking, but with their hands now untied.
+
+At the time the boat was run aground, it was just high-water, and the
+two sailors who had been left in charge of her, and who had evidently
+been drinking too much rum, went to sleep, and never noticed that the
+tide was going out. When they woke, the boat was high and dry, and
+with all the strength of the whole crew they could not move her,
+because the sand at that part of the beach was very soft. This did not
+seem to trouble any of them very much, for Robinson heard one of the
+sailors shout, "Let her alone, Jack, can't ye? She'll float next
+tide."
+
+All forenoon Robinson watched, and when the hottest time of the day
+had come, he noticed the sailors throw themselves down under the
+trees, and go to sleep, some distance away from the three prisoners.
+
+Then Robinson and Friday, taking their muskets and pistols, stole down
+cautiously behind the three men, to try to speak to them without the
+others knowing.
+
+Robinson had put on his goatskin coat and the great hairy hat that he
+had made for himself; and with his cutlass and pistols in his belt,
+and a gun over each shoulder, he looked very fierce.
+
+The men did not see him till he spoke, and they were so startled by
+his wild look, and by the sight of two men armed to the teeth, that
+they nearly ran away. But Robinson told them not to be alarmed; he was
+an Englishman, and a friend, and would help them if they would show
+him how it could be done.
+
+Then they explained to him what had happened. One of the three was
+Captain of the ship that lay at anchor off the island. Of the others,
+one was mate of the ship, and the third man was a passenger. The crew
+had mutinied, the Captain told Robinson, and had put him and the other
+two in irons, and the ringleaders in the mutiny had proposed to kill
+them. Now they meant to leave them on the island to perish.
+
+The Captain was so astonished at finding anybody there who proposed to
+help him, that he said in his wonder: "Am I talking to a man, or to an
+angel from heaven?"
+
+"If the Lord had sent an angel, sir," said Robinson, "he would
+probably have come better clothed."
+
+Then he asked if the boat's crew had any firearms, and was told that
+they had only two muskets, one of which was left in the boat. "The
+rest should be easy, then," Robinson said; "we can either kill them
+all, or take them prisoners, as we please."
+
+The Captain was unwilling to see the men killed, for he said if two of
+the worst of them were got rid of, he believed the rest would return
+to their duty.
+
+Robinson made a bargain that if he saved the Captain from the
+mutineers, and recovered the ship, he and Friday were to be taken home
+to England in her, free of cost; and to this the Captain and the
+others agreed.
+
+Then Robinson gave each of them a musket, with powder and ball, after
+which the Captain and the mate and the passenger marched towards the
+spot where the mutinous sailors lay asleep. One of the men heard them
+advance, and turning round, saw them, and cried out to his companions.
+But it was too late, the mate and the passenger fired, and one of the
+ringleaders fell dead. A second man also fell, but jumped up
+immediately and called to the others to help him. But the Captain
+knocked him down with the butt of his musket, and the rest of the
+men, seeing Robinson and Friday coming, and knowing they had no chance
+against five armed men, begged for mercy. Three others who had been
+straying about among the trees came back on hearing the shots, and
+were also taken, and thus the whole crew of the boat was captured.
+
+The Captain and Robinson now began to think how they might recover the
+ship. There were on board, the Captain said, several men on whom he
+thought he could depend, and who had been forced by the others into
+the mutiny against their wills. But it would be no easy thing to
+retake the ship, for there were still twenty-six men on board, and as
+they were guilty of mutiny, all of them, if taken back to England,
+would most likely be hanged. Thus they were certain to make a fight
+for it.
+
+The first thing that Robinson and the others now did was to take
+everything out of the boat--oars, and mast, and sail, and rudder; then
+they knocked a hole in her bottom, so that she could not float. While
+they were doing this, and drawing her still further up on the beach,
+they heard first one gun and then another fired by the ship as signals
+to the boat to return.
+
+As she of course did not move, Robinson saw through his glass another
+boat with ten men on board, armed with muskets, leave the ship, coming
+to bring the others back.
+
+This was serious enough, for now Robinson and his party had to make
+plans whereby they might capture also this fresh boat's crew.
+Accordingly, they tied the hands of all the men they had first taken,
+and sent the worst of them to the cave under the charge of Friday and
+of one of the men that the Captain said was to be trusted, with orders
+to shoot any who tried to give an alarm or to escape. Then Robinson
+took his party and the rest of the prisoners into the castle, where,
+from the rock, they watched for the landing of the second boat.
+
+The Captain and mate were very nervous, and despaired of taking this
+fresh body of men, but Robinson was quite confident of success, and
+put heart into them by his cheerfulness.
+
+Of the prisoners in his castle, there were two whom the Captain
+believed to be honest men, and on their promising solemnly to keep
+faith, and to fight for him, Robinson released them.
+
+The crew of the second boat, when they landed, were terribly
+surprised to find the first boat empty and stove in, and they were
+seen anxiously consulting what to do. Then they hallooed and fired
+volleys. Getting no reply, they were evidently alarmed, for they all
+jumped into their boat and began to pull off to the ship. In a few
+minutes, however, they seemed to change their minds, for again they
+landed, this time leaving three men in charge of the boat, and keeping
+her in the water. The other seven came ashore, and started in a body
+across the island to look for their lost comrades. But they did not
+care to go far, and soon stopped, again firing volleys and hallooing.
+Getting again no reply, they began to march back to the sea. Whereupon
+Robinson ordered Friday and the mate to go over the creek to the west
+and halloo loudly, and wait till the sailors answered. Then Friday and
+the mate were to go further away and again halloo, thus gradually
+getting the men to follow them away from shore.
+
+This plan succeeded very well, for when the sailors, thinking they
+heard their missing friends hail, ran to find them, their way was
+stopped by the creek, over which they had to get the boat to carry
+them. They took with them, then, one of the three men whom they had
+left in the boat, and ordered the others to moor the boat to a tree,
+and remain there.
+
+This was just what Robinson wanted. And, moreover, one of the men
+played still further into his hands, for he left the boat and lay down
+under a tree to sleep. On him the Captain rushed, and knocked him down
+as he tried to rise to his feet, whereupon the sailor left in the boat
+yielded, and more readily that he had joined the mutineers very
+unwillingly, and was now glad of the chance to rejoin his Captain.
+
+Meantime Friday and the mate, by hallooing and answering, drew the
+rest of the boat's crew from hill to hill through the woods, till at
+last they had got them so far astray that it was not possible for them
+to find their way back before dark. When they did get back to where
+the boat had been left, and found the men whom they had left in her
+gone, they were in a terrible fright.
+
+It was not difficult for Robinson and his men to surround them, and
+it chanced that the boatswain of the ship, who was the greatest
+villain of the lot, and the chief cause of all the trouble, walked in
+the darkness close to the Captain, who jumped up and shot him dead.
+The others then surrendered, believing what they were told, that they
+were surrounded by fifty armed men. All begged hard for their lives,
+and a few whom the Captain said he could trust were set at liberty on
+promising to help retake the ship. The others were bound and put in
+the cave.
+
+Robinson and Friday remained on shore to look after the prisoners,
+while the Captain and the mate and the passenger, with those of the
+crew who were trustworthy, having patched up the damaged boat, pulled
+off in her and in the other to the ship, which they reached about
+midnight. When they were a short distance off, the Captain made one of
+the crew hail the ship and say that they had brought off the boat and
+the men they had gone in search of. Then both boats ran alongside at
+once, one on each side of the vessel, and before the mutineers knew
+what was happening they were overpowered, one or two of them being
+killed. Only one of the Captain's party was hurt, the mate, whose arm
+was broken by a musket-ball.
+
+As soon as the ship was secured, the Captain ordered seven guns to be
+fired, that being the signal he had agreed to make to let Robinson
+know if he succeeded in taking the ship.
+
+Robinson's stay in the island had now come to an end, after more than
+twenty-eight years, for in a few days he and Friday sailed for England
+in the ship. Some of the mutineers were left on the island, and were
+afterwards joined by the Spaniard and his comrades, for whom Robinson
+left a letter.
+
+Robinson did not forget, when he left, to take with him the money and
+gold bars he had got from the wreck of the Spanish ship, and he took
+also, as a memento, the goatskin coat and the great hairy hat. But the
+Captain was able before the ship sailed to give him proper clothing,
+the wearing of which at first put him to dreadful discomfort.
+
+The voyage was a long one, but they sighted the English coast at last.
+
+It was thirty-five years since Robinson had set foot in England. And
+that morning, when at last, after the weary years of exile, he again
+saw his native land, he laid his head down on his arms and cried like
+a child.
+
+And, may be, you too some day may know the joy of coming home, out of
+the land of bondage.
+
+
+
+
+CANTERBURY TALES
+
+By GEOFFREY CHAUCER
+
+ADAPTED BY JANET HARVEY KELMAN
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+DORIGEN
+
+
+Once upon a time a young knight, whose name was Arviragus, dwelt in
+Brittany. In the same country lived a beautiful lady called Dorigen.
+And the knight loved the lady.
+
+For years Arviragus did not know whether she loved him or not. She was
+a great lady and very fair, and he was afraid to ask her. But she knew
+that he loved her, for when he rode past her window on his way to the
+wars, she could see her colors streaming from his helmet. At first she
+did not think much of this, for many knights fought for love of her;
+but as she heard of new and greater deeds that this noble knight did
+year by year, she began to care for him a great deal. When she thought
+of his goodness and of the honor in which he held her, she knew that
+there was no one else that she could love as she loved Arviragus. And
+when Arviragus knew that she loved him and was willing to be his wife,
+his heart was full of joy. So greatly did he wish to make Dorigen
+happy with him, that he said to her that he would obey her and do what
+she wished as gladly all his life as he had done while he was trying
+to win her love. To this she replied:
+
+"Sir, since in thy great gentleness thou givest me so high a place, I
+pray to God that there may never be strife between us two by any fault
+of mine. Sir, I will be thy true and humble wife until I die!"
+
+Then Arviragus took his bride home with him to his castle by the sea.
+He honored Dorigen as much as he had done before his marriage, and
+tried to fulfil her wishes in everything. Dorigen was just as eager to
+please Arviragus as he was to please her, and they were happy together
+in all their work and play.
+
+Arviragus stayed quietly at home for a year, but after that he grew
+restless. He felt that no true knight had a right to live on quietly
+at home, with nothing to do except to order his castle and to hunt. So
+he sailed away to England that he might win honor and renown in the
+wars there.
+
+Dorigen stood by the castle and watched his sails disappear in the
+north. Poor Dorigen! her husband was gone, and she did not know if he
+would ever come back to her. For weeks she wept and mourned. At night
+she could not rest, and by day she would not eat. All the things that
+she had cared most to do were now dull and worthless to her because
+Arviragus was away.
+
+Her friends saw her sorrow, and tried to comfort her in every way they
+could. When they found she would not be comforted, they spoke harshly
+to her, and told her that it was very wrong of her to kill herself
+with sorrow, when Arviragus hoped to come home again strong and
+famous. Then they began to comfort her again, and to try to make her
+forget her sadness.
+
+After a long time Dorigen's sorrow began to grow quieter. She could
+not have lived if she had always felt her grief as deeply as she did
+at first. Indeed, as it was, this sorrow would have broken her heart,
+if letters had not come from Arviragus. They brought her tidings of
+his doings, and of the glory he had won. But what comforted her most
+was that they told her that he would soon return.
+
+When Dorigen's friends saw that she was less hopeless, they begged her
+to come and roam with them to drive away the last of her dark fears.
+This she did. Often she walked with them by the edge of the cliffs on
+which her castle stood. But there she saw the white ships and the
+brown barges sailing, one north, another south, to the havens for
+which they were bound. Then she would turn away from her friends and
+say to herself:
+
+"Alas! of all the ships I see, is there never one that will bring my
+lord home? Then should I need no comfort. My heart would be cured of
+this bitter smart."
+
+At times as she sat and thought, she leaned down and looked over the
+brink of the cliffs. But, when she saw the grisly, black rocks, her
+very heart trembled within her. Then she would sink down on the grass
+and wail:
+
+"O God, men say Thou hast made nothing in vain, but, Lord, why hast
+Thou made these black, grisly rocks? No man nor beast is helped by
+them in all the world. Rocks have destroyed a hundred thousand men,
+and which of all Thy works is so fair as man? No doubt wise men will
+say, 'All is for the best.' But, oh Thou God, who makest the winds to
+blow, keep Thou my lord! And--would to God that these black rocks were
+sunk in the deep for his sake! They slay my heart with fear."
+
+Dorigen's friends saw that the sea brought back her sorrow. They led
+her then by rivers and springs, and took her to every lovely place
+they knew, from which there was no glimpse of the sea.
+
+In the valley, to landward of the castle, lay many beautiful gardens.
+One day in May, when the soft showers of spring had painted in
+brightest colors the leaves and flowers, they spent the whole day in
+the fairest of these gardens. They had games there, and they dined
+under a spreading tree. The breath of the fresh green leaves and the
+sweet scent of the flowers blew round them.
+
+After dinner they began to dance and sing--every one except Dorigen.
+She had no heart to sing, and she would not dance because, of all who
+joined in the dance, not one was Arviragus. But, though she would not
+dance, she watched her friends and sometimes forgot her sorrow for a
+little.
+
+Among the dancers there was a young squire named Aurelius. He was much
+beloved because he was young, and strong, and handsome. Men thought
+him wise and good, but he was not always wise and good.
+
+When the dancing was over, Aurelius came up to Dorigen and asked her
+to give him a beautiful jewel that she wore on her breast. He said to
+her, "Madam, of what use is thy jewel to thee when thou wearest it on
+thy bosom? Give it to me, and I will share with thee the price of it."
+
+Dorigen turned and gazed at him.
+
+"Is this what thou dost wish? I knew not what thou didst mean when
+thou didst look at me, but now I know. Listen, this is all I have to
+say to thee. I shall never part with my jewel, not though I were in
+rags and without food."
+
+Then she remembered how Arviragus had loved to see her wear her jewel,
+as she always did, on a chain of gold that he had given to her on her
+wedding day. She thought of the sea that separated him from her, and
+of the cruel black rocks, and said in play:
+
+"Aurelius, I will freely give thee my jewel when thou dost remove
+every rock on the shore from end to end of Brittany."
+
+Then her anger at the selfishness of Aurelius rose again, and she bade
+him begone.
+
+"Madam," he said, "it is impossible to move the rocks."
+
+With that word he turned away, and went home to his own house. There
+his brother Austin found him in a trance, for Aurelius wished
+Dorigen's jewel more than he wished anything else on earth, and the
+thought that he could not get it made him so sad that he became dazed.
+Austin carried him to bed, and tried to soothe him in his grief and
+vexation.
+
+The jewel that Aurelius wished to get from Dorigen was no common one.
+It had been given to her at her birth. It was clear as crystal, but
+far more rare, and it shone in the daylight like the sun. When Dorigen
+was a little child her mother told her of this wonderful stone. She
+told her that it would bring her joy and peace and the love of all who
+were good and true, if she kept it bright and pure; but that, if she
+ever gave it away, she would lose her youth and her beauty, and would
+be hidden away from all her friends and left alone in the world.
+
+Dorigen shuddered at the thought of parting with her jewel. She did
+not know how her mother's words could come to pass, if she did give it
+away, nor by what magic power she could be so lost that no one who
+loved her could find her again. But she was sure that what her mother
+had said must be true.
+
+And that was why Dorigen was so angry with Aurelius. She knew that he
+must have heard what sorrow she would suffer if she gave him her
+jewel, for all the court knew the story of the wonderful stone.
+
+Not long after this, Arviragus came home. He had won more honor than
+before, and was now the very flower of chivalry. I cannot tell you how
+great the joy was, with which he greeted Dorigen, nor how soon she
+forgot her fears of the sea and the grisly rocks.
+
+For two years, while they lived a joyful life together, Aurelius lay
+in bed unable to rise, with no one to take care of him except his
+brother Austin. This brother mourned over Aurelius in secret and wept
+at his unhappy fate, till one day he remembered a book of magic that
+he had seen when he was a student in Orleans. In that book he had read
+of the strange ways in which Magicians can make things seem what they
+are not. His heart leapt up. He said to himself, "My brother shall be
+cured. I am sure I have heard of stranger things than that the rocks
+should seem to vanish. Once I heard of a Magician who made every one
+believe that a great brown barge was rowing up and down a sheet of
+water inside the hall of a castle! If he could do that, then surely we
+shall be able to find a Magician who will make those black rocks seem
+to vanish. Then Dorigen will have to keep her promise and give
+Aurelius her wonderful jewel."
+
+Austin then ran to his brother's room and told him about the book of
+magic at Orleans. No sooner had Aurelius heard him than he leapt out
+of bed. In less time than one would think possible he was ready to
+start on the long ride to Orleans.
+
+When they came near the city they met a Magician. They knew him to be
+a Magician because of the strange look in his eyes, and because of his
+curious dress. When they rode up to him he bowed before them and
+wished them "Good day." Then he began to tell them why they had come
+to Orleans. Aurelius wondered how it was that this stranger knew so
+much about him and his errand. He thought he must be a very wise man
+indeed, and leaping from his horse in surprise and joy, he went home
+with the Magician to his house. His brother went too.
+
+The house was the finest that Aurelius had ever seen. When he entered
+the study he looked in wonder at the rows of books that lined the
+walls, and at the quaint pictures and the strange old armor.
+
+In one corner a curious light burned. It was not like the light of a
+lamp or of a candle, but cold and blue. Above it hung a map of the
+stars, and other strange drawings. Below the light stood a table, and
+on it lay a great book which was chained to the wall.
+
+Austin saw Aurelius look at this book. He whispered to him, "It is the
+same book from which I read long ago."
+
+This corner with its blue light made Aurelius frightened. A shudder
+passed over him when he saw the Magician cross over into the circle of
+the light and wave his wand.
+
+In a moment Aurelius forgot all about the Magician and his own fear,
+for he and his brother saw before them the edge of a forest with a
+park stretching from the trees far, far away.
+
+The sun shone, and the branches waved a little in the breeze. In the
+park the brothers saw herds of deer. Beautiful animals they were, with
+the highest antlers deer ever had. At first the deer fed in peace and
+safety. Then archers, clad in green, came to the edge of the forest.
+They glided out and in among the trees to see where they could best
+take aim with their arrows. When the archers had let their arrows fly,
+hounds broke out from behind them, and soon there was not one living
+deer of all the herd left in sight.
+
+In a moment a calm river flowed where the park had been. In the
+shallow water at the river's edge tall herons stood. They watched for
+the little fishes that swam in the river. Again, into this quiet place
+a hunter came. He had no arrows. He had no dogs. But on his wrist he
+had an iron bracelet to which one end of a chain was fastened. The
+other end of the chain was round a hawk's foot, and the hawk sat on
+his master's wrist. When the hunter came near the river he loosed the
+chain from the bird's foot. The hawk flew over the river and swooped
+down among the herons. In a moment they had all vanished.
+
+Aurelius had scarcely time to sigh, when the river itself was gone,
+and a plain lay where it had been. There he saw the knights of King
+Arthur's Table jousting. Beautiful ladies sat and watched the
+struggle, and one more fair than all held the prizes the knights might
+win.
+
+Then the figures of the knights began to grow dim and uncertain. The
+plain changed into a great hall where knights and ladies danced.
+Everything was bright and sparkling. Mirrors lined the walls, and
+their cut edges flashed back the light that fell on them. As Aurelius
+watched the dance, he started. There, before him, more beautiful than
+ever, was Dorigen. His heart gave a great leap, for, as he watched
+her, he saw that she no longer wore her jewel. In his delight he
+swayed to the music of the dance. Clap! clap! went the Magician's
+hands, and all was gone.
+
+The great room that had seemed so splendid to Aurelius when he entered
+it, looked cold and plain now when he returned to it from fairyland.
+
+The Magician called his servant and asked for supper. Then he led the
+brothers away and feasted them royally.
+
+After supper the three men began to talk about what the Magician
+should get from Aurelius if he made the rocks vanish. The Magician
+said, "I cannot take less than a thousand pounds, and I am not sure if
+I can do it for that!" Aurelius was too delighted to bargain about
+what the cost would be. He said gladly: "What is a thousand pounds? I
+would give thee the whole round world, if I were lord of it. The
+bargain is made. Thou shalt be paid in full. But do not delay. Let us
+start to-morrow morning without fail."
+
+"Thou mayest count on me to-morrow," said the Magician.
+
+They went to bed, and Aurelius slept soundly and well; because of the
+hope he had that the Magician would make the rocks vanish.
+
+Next morning they rose early. It was Christmas time, and the air was
+cold and frosty as they rode away. The very sunlight was pale, and the
+trees were bare. When they reached home the neighbors gathered round
+and wished them a Merry Christmas. "Noel, Noel," they said, but they
+would not have done so had they known what sorrow the riders brought
+to their beautiful lady Dorigen.
+
+For many days the Magician worked with his maps and figures. Aurelius
+waited impatiently. There was nothing for him to do except to make the
+Magician as comfortable as he could, and to show him as much kindness
+as possible.
+
+One morning Aurelius looked from his window towards the sea. He saw
+the Magician standing on the shore. As Aurelius gazed out to sea, the
+rocks vanished from north to south. His heart stood still. Then he
+rushed out and away to the edge of the cliffs for fear some rocks
+might still lie close to the land. But no, there was not one.
+
+He went to meet the Magician and fell at his feet with the words,
+"Thanks to thee, my lord, thanks to thee, my cares are gone!"
+
+After he had thanked the Wise Man, he hurried away to meet Dorigen.
+When he saw her he trembled. She was so pure and beautiful. His heart
+sank. Then he looked out to sea and saw the smooth surface of the
+water, and he grew selfish again.
+
+Dorigen came quietly on. She had not noticed that the rocks had
+vanished, for Arviragus was safe on land, and she did not fear the sea
+any more. She had almost forgotten Aurelius and his selfish, greedy
+words. It was more than two years since she had seen him, and she had
+not heard of him since then.
+
+She started back when he greeted her. Before she had time to speak he
+said, "My lady, give me thy jewel."
+
+He saw Dorigen's face grow cold and angry, and said, "Think well lest
+thou break thy word, for, madam, thou knowest well what thou didst
+say. In yonder garden in the month of May thou didst promise to give
+me thy jewel when I should move the rocks. I speak to save thine
+honor. I have done as thou didst command me. Go thou and see if thou
+wilt, but well I know the rocks are vanished."
+
+He left her then. She stood still, white and sick. She had never
+dreamt that such a trap as this could close on her.
+
+"Alas," she said, "that such a thing could happen! I never thought a
+thing so strange and unheard-of could come to pass!"
+
+Home she went in sadness and dismay. She was so weak with fear that
+she could scarcely walk. She had to suffer her sorrow alone for three
+days, for Arviragus was away, and she would tell no one but him. Her
+ladies saw her distress, but they could not comfort her. To herself
+she moaned, "Alas, O Fortune, I lay the blame on thee; thou hast so
+bound me in thy chain, that I see no help nor escape save only in
+death."
+
+Arviragus came home on the third day after the rocks had vanished. He
+came at night, so he noticed nothing strange about the shore. Though
+every one was talking of the curious thing that had happened, no one
+liked to tell him. They knew he would not like to hear of it. He would
+think his country was bewitched.
+
+Arviragus looked for Dorigen in the hall. When he could not see her
+there, he hurried to her room, to make sure that she was safe and
+well. As he sprang up the broad staircase, the sheath of his sword and
+the spurs at his heels clanked harshly on the stone steps.
+
+Dorigen heard him, but, instead of going to meet him, she buried her
+head deeper in her cushions and wept. Arviragus crossed the room to
+where she sat, and knelt before her. He drew her hands from her eyes
+and said, "Dorigen, what is it? Why dost thou weep like this, my
+beloved?"
+
+For a little time Dorigen's tears only fell the faster, then she said
+brokenly: "Alas, that ever I was born! I have said it! Arviragus! I
+have promised!"
+
+"What hast thou promised, my wife?"
+
+Then Dorigen told Arviragus all that had happened; told him that she
+had promised to give her jewel to Aurelius when he would take all the
+rocks away.
+
+Arviragus leapt up and went to the window. The moon had burst through
+a cloud, and everything was bright and clear. He looked away north, as
+Dorigen had so often looked to watch for his coming. In the moonlight
+Arviragus saw the sea lie smooth and cold. His eyes swept the skyline.
+It seemed as as if all the rocks had sunk into his heart, it was so
+heavy.
+
+He turned towards Dorigen, and saw how great was her sorrow.
+
+Then he said very gently: "Is there aught else than this, that thou
+shouldst weep, Dorigen?"
+
+"Nay, nay, this is indeed too much already," she sighed.
+
+"Dear wife," he said, "something as wonderful as the sinking of the
+rocks may happen to save us yet. God grant it! But whether or not,
+thou must keep thy troth. I had rather that my great love for thee
+caused me to die, than that thou shouldest break thy promise. Truth is
+the highest thing that man may keep."
+
+Then his courage broke down, and he began to sob and weep along with
+Dorigen.
+
+Next morning he was strong and brave again. He said to Dorigen, "I
+will bear up under this great sorrow."
+
+He bade her farewell, and she set out with only a maid and a squire to
+follow her.
+
+Arviragus could not bear to see Dorigen as she went down from the
+castle, so he hid himself in an inner room. But some one saw her go
+out. It was Aurelius. For three days he had watched the castle gate to
+see what she did, and where she went. He came forward and said,
+"Whither goest thou?"
+
+Dorigen was almost mad with misery, but she said bravely, "To thee, to
+keep my troth, and give my jewel to thee, as my husband bids me. Alas!
+alas!"
+
+Aurelius was full of wonder when he heard this. He began to be sorry
+for Dorigen, and for Arviragus the worthy knight, who would rather
+lose his wife than have her break her word. He could be cruel no
+longer.
+
+"Madam," he said, "say to thy lord Arviragus that since I see his
+great honor and thy sad distress, I had rather bear my own sorrow than
+drive thee away from him and all thy friends. I give thee back thy
+promise. I shall never trouble thee more. Farewell, farewell! thou
+truest woman and best that I have ever seen."
+
+Down on her knees, on the roadway, fell Dorigen to thank Aurelius. Her
+blessing followed him as he turned and left her.
+
+But how can I tell of Dorigen's return? She seemed to be treading on
+air. When she reached the room where her husband sat with his head
+sunk on his arms, she paused. She had not known the greatness of his
+love till then. He looked old and forlorn after the night of sorrow.
+
+She spoke, and he raised his eyes to gaze on her, as if she had been a
+lady in a dream. But when she told him all, when he knew that she was
+there herself, and for always, he could not speak for joy.
+
+Aurelius wished he had never been born when he thought of the thousand
+pounds of pure gold that he owed to the Magician.
+
+He said to himself, "What shall I do? I am undone! I must sell my
+house and be a beggar. I will not stay here and make my friends
+ashamed of me, unless I can get the Magician to give me time. I will
+ask him to let me pay him part of my debt year by year till all is
+paid. If he will, my gratitude will know no bounds, and I will pay him
+every penny I owe."
+
+With a sore heart he went to his coffer and took out five hundred
+pounds of gold. These he took to the Wise Man, and begged him to grant
+him time to pay the rest.
+
+"Master," said he, "I can say truly, I never yet failed to keep a
+promise. My debt shall be paid to thee, even if I go begging in rags.
+But if thou wilt be so gracious as to allow me two years, or three, in
+which to pay the, rest, I will rejoice. If not, I must sell my house;
+there is no other way."
+
+When the Magician heard this he said, "Have not I kept my promise to
+thee?"
+
+"Yes, certainly, well and truly!"
+
+"Hast thou not thy jewel?"
+
+"No, no," said Aurelius, and sighed deeply.
+
+"Tell me, if thou mayest, what is the cause of this?"
+
+"Arviragus in his honor had rather die in sorrow and distress than
+that his wife should break her word. Dorigen would rather die than
+lose her husband and wander alone on the earth. She did not mean to
+give me her promise. She thought the rocks would never move. I pitied
+them so much that I gave her back her promise as freely as she brought
+her jewel to me. That is the whole story!"
+
+The Magician answered, "Dear brother, you have each behaved nobly.
+Thou art a squire, he is a knight, but by God's grace I can do a noble
+deed as well as another. Sir, thou art free from thy debt to me, as
+free as if thou hadst this moment crept out of the ground, and hadst
+never known me till now. For, sir, I will not take a penny from thee
+for all my skill, nor for all my work. It is enough! Farewell! Good
+day to thee!"
+
+Whereupon the Magician bowed once and again, mounted his horse, and
+rode away.
+
+Dorigen and Arviragus were walking on the cliffs as the Magician
+parted from Aurelius. They noticed the two men, and when the horseman
+rode away they saw a strange white mist rise from the sea and follow
+the rider.
+
+Dorigen caught her husband's arm, for there, there, out at sea, and
+close by the cliffs, were the rocks, grisly and black and fearsome as
+before. The sunlight fell on her jewel, and it shone more brightly
+than of old, nor did its light ever grow dim in all the happy years
+that followed.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+EMELIA
+
+
+Emelia the Radiant lived in a great castle in Athens.
+
+Hippolyta, Emelia's sister, had once been queen of the Warrior Women,
+and had led her armies to battle. But Emelia had never fought in these
+battles. When she was still a child, Duke Theseus of Athens had fought
+with Hippolyta and conquered her. Instead of sending his royal captive
+to prison, Theseus married her, and took her home to Athens with him.
+When he took her there, he took Emelia with her. He was very kind to
+them both, and the castle in Athens was a happy home for Hippolyta and
+her little sister.
+
+As Emelia grew up she became most beautiful. She was more graceful
+than a lily on its stem, and the flush on her cheeks was more delicate
+than the hue of the rose-petals in the old Greek castle garden. Her
+golden hair fell in heavy masses round her face, and lay in a great
+plait down her back. It caught all the light that fell on it, and sent
+it out again to make glad the hearts of those who looked on her. So
+men called her Emelia the Radiant, and all who met her smiled for joy
+at the sight of so beautiful a maid.
+
+One May morning Emelia went into the castle garden to bathe her face
+in the early dew. Everything was dim and gray in the twilight. She
+looked up at the great dungeon tower which overshadowed the garden,
+and thought of the two young princes who were prisoners there. Duke
+Theseus had brought them from Thebes. He was very proud of them, and
+would not give them up, although the people of their land offered to
+give him gold and jewels for their ransom. The princes were cousins,
+and were the last of the royal line of Thebes. In the stillness Emelia
+murmured their names to herself, "Palamon and Arcite, Palamon and
+Arcite. How miserable they must be in their narrow cell!" she thought.
+Then she sighed that life should be so sad for them while it was so
+bright for her!
+
+As she roamed up and down and gathered roses white and red to make a
+garland for her hair, the sun broke through the mist and shone into
+the garden. Once more she raised her eyes to the tower. This time she
+did not look at it, but at the sunlit clouds beyond. The light from
+the east fell on her. Her hair shone like gold, and her face was
+radiant with happiness.
+
+Palamon at that moment came to the narrow iron-barred window through
+which alone he and his cousin could see the sky and the fields and the
+city. He saw the morning light fall on the fair buildings of Athens,
+and on the plains and hills beyond. Then a glad song which burst from
+Emelia's happy heart floated up to him. He looked down. Before him
+stood the maiden bathed in sunlight.
+
+She seemed to him the very Spirit of Beauty. He thought of all the joy
+and life and freedom that he could never have. He started back from
+the window and cried aloud.
+
+His cousin Arcite sprang from his couch and said, "My cousin, what
+aileth thee? I pray thee that thou bear our imprisonment in patience.
+Sad it is in truth, but we must abide it. We can do nought else."
+
+But Palamon said: "Thou art mistaken. Prison walls drew not that cry
+from me. An arrow hath entered my heart through mine eye, and I am
+wounded. What life can give is bound up for me in the fairness of a
+maiden who roams in yonder garden. Be she Spirit or woman I know not!
+But this I know, was never woman nor Spirit half so fair before."
+
+"Spirit of Beauty," he cried, "if thou choosest to take the form of a
+radiant woman here before me in this garden, pity my wretchedness!
+Save us from this prison, and if that may not be, have pity on our
+country and help our fallen friends."
+
+Arcite pressed forward and leant over Palamon's shoulder. The window
+was only a narrow slit, and the wall through which it was cut was
+thick, so it was not easy for Arcite to see into the garden. At last
+he caught a glimpse of Emelia.
+
+"Oh, how lovely she is!" he said. "I shall die of my wish to serve
+her. Most beautiful of maidens she is, truly."
+
+When Palamon heard this, he turned on Arcite, looked coldly at him and
+asked, "Sayest thou so in earnest or in jest?"
+
+"Nay, truly in earnest, my cousin; I have little will to jest!"
+
+Palamon looked fiercely at him and said, "Little honor to thee then!
+Hast thou forgotten thine oath of truest brotherhood to me, and mine
+to thee? Hast thou forgotten thy promise to help me in all I do? How,
+then, canst thou dream of claiming to love my lady? This thou shalt
+not do, false Arcite! I loved her first, and told thee, and thou must
+help me to win her if ever we escape. Thine honor demands this of
+thee. Otherwise thou art no true knight."
+
+But Arcite drew himself up scornfully and said, "Rather it is thou
+that art false! A moment ago thou didst not know whether she were
+maiden or Spirit! I loved her first for what she is, and told thee as
+my brother! But even if thou hadst loved her first, could I, because
+of that, refuse to love the fairest of maidens? Besides, why should we
+strive? Thou knowest too well that thou shalt never win her smile, nor
+yet shall I! These prison walls so thick and black leave no hope for
+us. We fight as did the fabled dogs for the bone. They fought all day,
+yet neither won. There came a kite while they raged, and carried off
+the bone. Love thou the maid if thou wilt. I shall love her till I
+die."
+
+The prison had been narrow and bare and cold before, but now it seemed
+ten times more dismal. The world from which it shut them in was so
+much more sweet because of the maiden who dwelt there, and the
+friendship for each other which had cheered them through many evil
+days was broken.
+
+But Emelia the Radiant sang her gay songs and stepped lightly among
+the flowers, with never another thought of the weary eyes that watched
+her.
+
+One day the greatest friend that Duke Theseus of Athens had, came to
+see him. This friend had known Arcite in Thebes, and had loved the
+handsome boy. He begged Theseus to forgive him, and to let him go
+free. Theseus was glad to find something he could do to please his
+dear friend, so one morning he took him with him to the prison where
+Palamon and Arcite were. The attendants could scarcely follow, for the
+royal robes filled all the dingy little space! A streak of light from
+the window fell on the Duke's mantle and his jewels. They looked
+strangely bright in that dark room beside the faded clothes of the two
+young prisoners.
+
+Arcite and the friend of Theseus greeted each other joyously, and the
+heart of Arcite beat wildly with hope, but when he heard the words of
+Theseus the Duke it sank like lead.
+
+"Arcite," said he, "by the desire of my friend, I grant to thee thy
+freedom. I grant it on one condition only. Thou must wander away far
+beyond my kingdom. If ever thou art seen for one moment on any
+furthest corner of my land, that moment shall be thy last. By the
+sword thou shalt die."
+
+Homeward to Thebes sped Arcite with a sad heart.
+
+"Woe is me for the day that I was born!" he moaned; "woe is me that
+ever I knew the friend of Theseus! Had he not known me, I might even
+now be gazing on the maiden I serve, from the window in the Duke's
+tower. Ah, Palamon, thou art the victor now! Day by day thou gazest on
+her, and kind fortune may grant to thee thy freedom and her favor
+while I am banished for ever! Ah, why do we complain against our
+fortune? We know that we seek happiness, but know not the road
+thither! Think how I dreamt and longed for freedom, and thought that
+if I were only out of prison my joy would be perfect. Behold, my
+freedom is my banishment, and my hope my undoing!"
+
+As for Palamon, when he saw that Arcite was gone, he made the great
+tower walls re-echo with his howls of misery. The very fetters on his
+ankles were wet with his salt tears.
+
+"Alas," he groaned, "Arcite, my cousin, thou hast borne off the prize
+in this strife of ours! Thou walkest now at liberty in Thebes. Little
+thou thinkest of me and of my sorrow! Strong thou art, and wise.
+Doubtless thou art even now gathering together the people of Thebes to
+invade this land and win the sister of the Duke for thy wife, while I
+die here in this prison like a caged lion. The prison walls heed my
+weeping and my wailing not at all."
+
+He could not even rejoice in the sight of Emelia when she walked in
+the garden, so fearful was he lest Arcite should win her.
+
+Meanwhile Arcite passed his days in Thebes in grief. He wandered about
+alone, and wailed and made moan to himself. He cared not to eat, and
+sleep forsook him. His spirits were so feeble that the sound of music
+brought fresh tears to his eyes. He grew gaunt and thin, and his voice
+was hollow with sadness.
+
+At last, when he was nearly dazed with sorrow, he dreamt one night
+that a beautiful winged boy with golden curls stood before him. "Go
+thou to Athens," said the boy; "the end of all thy sorrow awaits thee
+there!"
+
+Arcite started up wide awake and said, "I will to Athens, to my lady.
+It were good even to die in her presence."
+
+He caught up a mirror. He had not cared to look in one for many
+months, but now that he meant to return to his lady, he wished to see
+if he looked strong and young as ever. At first he was shocked to see
+how great a change had passed over his face. Then he thought, "If I do
+not say who I am, I may live unknown in Athens for years. Then I shall
+see my lady day by day."
+
+Quickly he called to him a squire, and told him all his will, and
+bound him to keep his name a secret and to answer no questions about
+himself or his master. Then Arcite sent his squire to find clothes
+such as the laborers in Athens wore. When he returned, Arcite and he
+put on the clothes and set out by the straight road to Athens.
+
+In Athens no one took any notice of the two poor men.
+
+Before they came to the castle the squire left his master and found a
+house to live in, where he could do Arcite's bidding at any time. But
+Arcite hurried on to the courtyard gate. There he waited till the
+master of the servants who waited on Emelia came out. Then he said to
+him, "Take me, I pray thee, into thy service. Drudge I will and draw
+water, yea, and in all thou dost command I will obey."
+
+The master of the servants asked Arcite what was his name.
+"Philostrate, my lord," said Arcite, and as "Philostrate" he entered
+that part of the castle where Emelia's home was.
+
+He could hew wood and carry water well, but he was not long left to do
+such rough work. The master of the house saw that whatever he trusted
+to Philostrate's care was rightly done, so he gave him less humble
+work to do, and made him a page in the house of Emelia. The lords and
+ladies of the castle began to notice what a gentle and kind page this
+Philostrate was. They spoke to Theseus about him, and said that he
+deserved to have a higher place that he might show his goodness and
+courage in knightly deeds. To please them, Theseus made him one of his
+own squires.
+
+Seven years passed away, and Palamon was still in prison. This year,
+however, in the May-time, a friend of his, who heard where he was,
+helped him to escape. During the short night he fled as fast as he
+could, but when the early dawn began to break he strode tremblingly to
+a grove of trees, that he might hide there all day. When the darkness
+fell once more he meant to go on again to Thebes, there to gather his
+old armies to make war on Theseus. He wished either to win Emelia or
+to die. He cared little for his life if he might not spend it with
+her.
+
+As Palamon lay beside a bush in the grove, he watched the sunbeams
+drying up the dew drops on the leaves and flowers near him, and
+listened to the joyous song of a lark that poured forth its welcome to
+the morning.
+
+The same lark that Palamon heard awakened Arcite. He was now the chief
+knight in the Duke's house, and served him with honor in peace and
+war. He sprang up and looked out on the fresh green fields. Everything
+called to him to come out. He loosed his horse from the stall and
+galloped over hill and dale. He came to the edge of a grove, and tied
+up his steed to a tree. Then he wandered down a woodland path to
+gather honeysuckle and hawthorn to weave a garland for himself. Little
+he thought of the snare into which he was walking. As he roamed he
+sang--
+
+ "O May, of every month the queen,
+ With thy sweet flowers and forests green,
+ Right welcome be thou, fair fresh May."
+
+The grove was the one in which Palamon lay beside a pool of water.
+When he heard the song of Arcite, cold fear took hold on him. He did
+not know that it was Arcite who sang, but he knew that the horse must
+belong to a knight of the court, and he crouched down to the ground
+lest he should be seen and taken back to prison.
+
+Soon Arcite's joyous mood passed away, and he grew sorrowful. He
+sighed and threw himself down not far from the spot where Palamon lay.
+
+"Alas, alas!" said Arcite, "for the royal blood of Thebes! Alas that I
+should humbly serve my mortal enemy! Alas that I dare not claim my
+noble name, but must be known, forsooth, as Philostrate, a name worth
+not a straw! Of all our princely house not one is left save only me
+and Palamon, whom Theseus slays in prison. Even I, free though I am,
+am helpless to win Emelia. What am I to her but an humble squire?"
+
+Palamon was so angry when he heard this, that he forgot his own
+danger. He started out from his hiding-place and faced Arcite.
+
+"False Arcite," he cried, "now art thou caught indeed! Thou hast
+deceived Duke Theseus and hast falsely changed thy name, hast thou?
+Then surely I or thou must die. I will suffer no man to love my lady,
+save myself alone. For I am Palamon, thy mortal foe. I have no weapon
+in this place, for only last night did I escape from prison. Yet I
+fear thee not. Thou shalt die, or thou shalt cease to love my lady.
+Choose as thou wilt!"
+
+Then Arcite rose up in his wrath and drew his sword. He said, "Were it
+not that thou art ill and mad with grief, and that thou hast no
+weapon here, thou shouldest never step from where thou standest. I
+deny the bond thou claimest! Fool! how can I help thee to win the lady
+I fain would wed myself? But because thou art a worthy knight and a
+gentle, and art ready to fight for thy lady, accept my promise.
+To-morrow I will not fail to wait for thee here without the knowledge
+of any other. Also I will bring armor and weapons for thee and me, and
+thou shalt choose of them what thou wilt, ere I arm myself! Food and
+drink will I bring to thee this night into the grove. If so be that
+thou slay me here to-morrow, then indeed thou mayest win thy lady if
+thou canst!"
+
+Then Palamon answered, "Let it be so."
+
+Next morning Arcite rode to the wood alone. He met Palamon on the
+woodland path where the flowers he had gathered the day before lay
+withered on the ground. No word nor greeting passed between them, but
+each helped to arm the other in silence. As the buckles were tightened
+and the armor slipped into its place, the color came and went in the
+faces of the two princes. They deemed that this would be the last of
+all fights to one of them.
+
+When they were ready they fenced together for a little, and then the
+real fight began. So fierce was it that the men seemed like wild
+animals in their rage. Palamon sprang at Arcite like a strong lion,
+and Arcite glanced aside and darted at him again like a cruel tiger.
+In the midst of this they heard a sound of the galloping of horses
+that brought the royal hunters to the spot. In a moment the sword of
+Theseus flashed between the fighters, and his voice thundered out,
+"Ho! no more, on pain of death. Who are ye who dare to fight here
+alone, with none to see justice done?"
+
+The princes turned and saw Theseus, Duke of Athens. Behind him rode
+Hippolyta with her sister, Emelia the Radiant, and many knights and
+ladies.
+
+Palamon answered the Duke's question swiftly, before Arcite had time
+to speak. "Sire, what need of words? Both of us deserve death. Two
+wretches are we, burdened with our lives. As thou art a just judge,
+give to us neither mercy nor refuge, but slay us both. Thou knowrest
+not that this knight, Philostrate, is thy mortal foe, whom thou hast
+banished. He is Arcite, who hath deceived thee for that he loveth
+Emelia. And I too love her. I too am thy mortal foe, for I am Palamon,
+and I have broken from my prison. Slay us then, here before fair
+Emelia."
+
+"That is easily granted," said Theseus. "Ye judge yourselves. Ye shall
+die."
+
+Then the queen began to weep, and Emelia too. They were sad to think
+that these two princes should die so young, and all for the service
+they wished to do to the queen's sister.
+
+The other ladies of the court begged the Duke to forgive the fighters.
+"Have mercy, sire," they urged, "on us women, and save the princes!"
+
+At first Theseus was too angry to listen to them, but soon he thought
+that he would have done as the princes had done, if he had been in
+their place, so he said, "Arcite and Palamon, ye could both have lived
+in peace and safety in Thebes, yet love has brought you here to Athens
+into my power, who am your deadly foe. Here then for the sake of
+Hippolyta, my queen, and of Emelia the Radiant, our dear sister, I
+forgive you both. Promise never to make war on my land, but to yield
+me your friendship evermore." Joyfully the princes promised this, and
+thanked the Duke for his grace.
+
+Then Theseus said, "Both of you are noble. Either might wed Emelia the
+Radiant, but she cannot wed you both. Therefore I appoint a tournament
+in this place a year hence. Come here then, ye Princes of Thebes, each
+of you, with a hundred knights of the bravest, and that one of you,
+who shall slay or capture the other, he shall wed Emelia."
+
+Whose face could be brighter than was Palamon's when he heard those
+words, and who could step more lightly than did Arcite? Every one
+thanked the Duke for his kindness to the princes, while they rode off
+to Thebes with high hopes and light hearts.
+
+When the day of the tournament came, great buildings stood in a circle
+on the plain beside the grove. Within them stretched an immense arena
+in which the knights must fight. Great marble gates opened on to the
+space at either side.
+
+Palamon and Arcite found it easy to bring a hundred knights to Athens.
+So splendid were the preparations for the tournament that every one
+was eager to fight in it.
+
+Emelia alone was sad as the day of the fighting came nearer. Her
+maidens heard her say, "Oh that I might not wed at all! I love the
+free life of the woods. I love to hunt, and to ride, and to roam. Why
+cannot Palamon and Arcite love each other as they used to do long ago,
+and leave me free?"
+
+On the morning of the tournament Duke Theseus and his queen sat with
+Emelia on a high seat overlooking the lists. When the trumpet sounded,
+Arcite and his knights rode in through the western gate. His red
+banner shone bright against the white marble pillars. At the same
+moment Palamon entered from the east, and his white banner floated out
+against the blue sky.
+
+Soon the heralds ceased galloping up and down, and the whole space was
+left to the warriors.
+
+The trumpets sounded "Advance," and the fray began. Through the bright
+sunshine they fought, advancing here, and beaten back there, till at
+last Palamon was hurled from his horse and taken prisoner.
+
+The trumpets sounded, and all stood still while Theseus called out,
+"Ho! no more. All is over. Arcite of Thebes khall wed Emelia." Then
+the people shouted till it seemed that the great marble gates would
+fall.
+
+In the eagerness of the fight Emelia had begun to like the warriors
+who fought for her, and her liking grew ever stronger as they showed
+their worth. When Arcite rode towards her with glowing face she was
+proud of him, and leant forward to welcome him gladly.
+
+But as he galloped, his horse started aside and he was thrown to the
+ground. He was too much hurt to rise. So he was lifted by his knights
+and carried to the palace. There he was cared for in every way, but
+nothing could save him.
+
+Before he died, he called for Emelia and Palamon.
+
+"No words can tell the sorrow I bear because I must leave thee, my
+lady! Alas, death tears me from thee! Farewell, my wife! farewell, my
+Emelia! Ah, take me softly in thine arms, and listen while I speak!
+For years I have had strife with my dear cousin Palamon. Yet now I say
+to thee, in all this world I never have met with one so worthy to be
+loved as Palamon, that hath served thee, and will serve thee, his life
+long. Ah, if ever thou dost wed, let it be Palamon!"
+
+His voice began to fail. "Emelia!" he said, and died.
+
+Emelia mourned sadly for her valiant knight. As for Palamon, all his
+old love for Arcite came back, and he wept for him as bitterly as he
+had bewailed his own sorrow in the dungeon.
+
+When all the Greeks had ceased to mourn for Arcite, Palamon still
+grieved for the death of his friend, and for the strife that had been
+between them.
+
+After two years Theseus sent one day for Palamon and Emelia. Palamon
+came to the court in his black robes of mourning; but Emelia was
+dressed in white, as she had been on the May morning in the garden
+years before. She had ceased to mourn for Arcite, and was Emelia the
+Radiant once more.
+
+Palamon caught his breath. He had not seen her since they parted after
+Arcite's death.
+
+Duke Theseus said, "Sister, I desire thee now to take the noble knight
+Palamon to be thy husband. Have pity on his long service, and accept
+him."
+
+Then he said to Palamon, "It will not need much speech to gain thy
+consent! Come, take thy lady by the hand."
+
+Then, in the presence of all the court, they were wed. When all was
+over, Emelia fled from the noise and tumult of the hall, and beckoned
+to Palamon to follow. Out at the great hall doors she led him, and
+down the pathway to the garden beneath the tower. When he joined her,
+she pointed to the dungeon window, and told him of the day when she
+had looked at the prison in the morning mist, and murmured to herself
+the names of the captive princes, "Palamon and Arcite, Palamon and
+Arcite."
+
+But it was not till many years of joyous life had passed over their
+home that Palamon told Emelia that he had seen her first on that very
+morning when she had thought so sadly of his misery.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+GRISELDA
+
+
+Once upon a time there lived a fair young girl whose name was
+Griselda. Her home was in an Italian village. There she dwelt in a
+lowly cottage with her father, Janicola. He was too old and weak to
+work for her, or even for himself.
+
+All round the village lay the fruitful fields and vineyards of the
+plain, and on the slopes near grew olive-trees laden with fruit. Far
+in the distance rose the snow-capped mountains of the North.
+
+Even in so rich a land it was not easy for this young Griselda to make
+her father's life as pleasant as she would have wished it to be. She
+lived plainly and barely. She was busy all day long. Now she was
+herding a few sheep on the broken ground near the village, and
+spinning as she watched her flock. Again she fetched the water from
+the well or gathered roots and herbs from which to make drugs.
+
+Griselda was not unhappy though her life was hard, because she was so
+glad that she could serve her father and show her love to him,
+forgetting about herself and her own wishes.
+
+One day as she sat watching her sheep her eyes fell on the white
+towers of a castle that stood not far from the village where she
+lived. It was the castle of the Marquis Walter, who was lord of all
+that land. Griselda looked kindly at the white towers. She thought
+that their master was the best and greatest man in the world. She knew
+that he was kind also, and courteous. When she saw him ride towards
+her, her face lighted up, and she rose to courtesy to him. She hoped
+he would draw up his horse beside her, and greet her, and ask for her
+father Janicola.
+
+This morning, as she looked at the castle, she saw a company of men
+hurrying along the road that led to its gate. Farmers were there in
+dull and homely clothes, and knights in armor that flashed back the
+sunlight, and lords in gay colors that glanced and gleamed among the
+olive-trees under the blue Italian sky.
+
+Griselda knew why they were going to Lord Walter, and she wondered
+what they would do and say when they reached him. She could not go
+after them, for her sheep would have wandered away if she had left
+them.
+
+When the men that Griselda had watched reached the courtyard gate,
+they met Lord Walter. He was on horseback ready for the hunt. The
+foremost of the company prayed him to grant them a little time that
+they might tell him why they had come.
+
+Lord Walter threw the reins to a squire, and led his people into the
+great hall of the castle. There he seated himself in state to listen
+to their grievance whatever it might be.
+
+Then the same man who had spoken before said to him:
+
+"Noble Marquis, thy generous kindness in times past giveth us courage
+to come before thee. Truly, sire, thou and all thou dost art so dear
+to us that, save in one thing, we cannot wish for better fortune than
+to live under thy government. One thing alone disturbs the peace of
+thy faithful people. Though thou art young and strong, yet age creeps
+on! Time flies and waits for no man. Death threatens young and old
+alike. We pray thee, sire, that thou wilt wed, for if swift death
+should lay thee low ere a son be born to thee, then alack for us and
+for our children! In the power of a stranger then would lie our fair
+lands and even our lives. Grant us this boon, noble Marquis, and, if
+thou wilt, we will choose for thee a wife. Noble shall she be, and
+good, so that thou shalt have honor and gladness in thy wedding."
+
+Then the Marquis said:
+
+"My people, loyal and true, ye ask of me that which I thought not to
+grant, for the free life of the forest and the hunt pleaseth me well.
+Yet will I do this thing that ye desire. Only to me myself must fall
+the choice of her whom I will wed. On you I lay this command that, be
+she who she may, yet shall ye honor her as if she were an Emperor's
+daughter through all her life. Nor shall ye raise one word against the
+maiden of my choice. Unless ye agree to this, I will not wed!"
+
+Gladly the people promised. But ere they left the Marquis, they begged
+him to fix a day for the marriage lest he should put off too long. The
+Marquis granted their request, and farmers, knights, and lords trooped
+joyfully home.
+
+When the morning of the day that was fixed for the wedding came, the
+castle of the Marquis was gaily decorated. Flags floated out from the
+towers, and garlands trailed over the doorway and the gate. Within in
+the great hall a royal feast was spread, and there lay royal robes and
+gems.
+
+In the courtyard and on the terraces lords and ladies stood in groups.
+Wonder and doubt were on every face. The wedding-feast was prepared,
+the guests were come, but there was no bride.
+
+A trumpet sounded "to horse," and all was hurry and noise. Then Lord
+Walter rode out through the castle gate. He was followed by bearers,
+who carried the beautiful robes and gems that had lain in the hall.
+
+They rode out by the same road along which Griselda had watched the
+people go to ask the Marquis to wed, many months before. Now she saw
+the bridal train ride down from the castle. "Ah," she said, "they ride
+this way to fetch the bride. I shall work more busily than ever to-day
+that I may be free to stand and watch Lord Walter's fair bride as the
+riders return with her to the castle!"
+
+Then she went to the well to fetch water. When she came back she found
+Lord Walter at her father's door. In the narrow lane beside the
+cottage stood lords and ladies, while their horses impatiently pawed
+the ground.
+
+Quickly Griselda set her pitcher in a trough near the cottage door,
+and knelt before the Marquis to hear his will.
+
+"Where is thy father?" Lord Walter asked.
+
+"Close at hand, my Lord," said Griselda, and went to bring him without
+delay.
+
+"My faithful servant," said Lord Walter to the old man, "grant me thy
+daughter for my wife!"
+
+Janicola knew not what to say for surprise. At last he answered, "My
+will is thine! Do as thou wilt, my own dear Lord!"
+
+"Then must I ask Griselda if she will be my wife; but stay thou by us.
+Thou shalt hear her answer."
+
+Griselda was amazed. She did not know what the meaning of Lord
+Walter's visit was, and when she stood before him her face was full
+of fear. Her wonder was very great when she heard him say:
+
+"Griselda, I am come for thee. Thee only will I wed. Thy father also
+is willing. But ere thou tell me whether or no thou wilt be my bride,
+listen to the demand I make. Art thou ready to obey me in everything,
+and to let me do to thee evil or good as I will without so much as
+turning to me a frowning face?"
+
+This seemed a strange request to Grisdda, but she loved and trusted
+Lord Walter so truly that she said:
+
+"Lord, I am not worthy of this honor. Verily in all things thy will
+shall be mine. Life is sweet, but I will die rather than displease
+thee."
+
+"Enough, Griselda!" he said.
+
+Then Lord Walter turned to the courtiers and the people of the village
+who had gathered round:
+
+"Behold my wife! Let all show their love to me by the honor and love
+they bear to her."
+
+The ladies of the court were commanded to take off Griselda's old
+clothes and to array her in the costly robes they had brought with
+them. They did not like to touch the poor soiled clothes she wore, nor
+to move about in the little cottage with their sweeping gowns; but the
+gentleness of Griselda made it pleasant to help her. They caught up
+Griselda's royal robes with great clasps of gold set with gems, and
+put a crown on her beautiful hair.
+
+She came out and stood in the low doorway, where she had so often
+stood before. But now the people scarcely knew her: she looked so fair
+in her new robes and with the love-light shining in her eyes.
+
+Lord Walter did not wait till he reached the castle. He was married to
+Griselda at her father's cottage door. The villagers gathered round
+and gazed at the simple wedding. They saw Lord Walter put a great ring
+on Griselda's finger, and lift her on to a milk-white steed. Then they
+led her with joy towards the castle. Wedding-bells rang out gladly
+across the plain, and ever as the wedding-party drew near to the white
+towers with their floating flags, happy bands of people came to meet
+and welcome Griselda.
+
+Very soon the fame of Lord Walter's beautiful wife spread through the
+land. Nor was it only for her beauty that men praised her. Gracious
+she was and wise, able to rule her home, and to bend fiery spirits to
+her will.
+
+From all the countryside men came to her in trouble. Every one
+rejoiced in the good fortune that had come to their land, and some
+even called her an angel from heaven come to right all wrong.
+
+After some time a daughter was born to Griselda. Then she thought she
+was the happiest woman in the world. She thought of the care that she
+would give her child as she grew up, and of Lord Walter's delight in
+his little daughter when the time should come that she could talk and
+ride with him.
+
+But before the baby was a year old, all Griselda's dreams were broken.
+Lord Walter said to himself, "It is easy for Griselda to keep her
+promise when I ask of her nothing that is not just and right. How can
+I trust her until I know that she will obey me in everything? I wonder
+whether she would be patient still if I hurt our little daughter."
+
+These thoughts came back to his mind so often that at last he resolved
+to try Griselda's patience by taking away her baby from her.
+
+One evening Griselda was playing with her little child. The baby
+laughed in her arms and looked sweeter than ever. At that moment the
+curtain at the doorway was drawn aside and Lord Walter came into the
+room. His face was sad and drawn, and as Griselda looked up at him she
+feared that some great blow had fallen on him, or that some enemy had
+entered the country.
+
+Lord Walter said to her:
+
+"Griselda, thou hast not forgotten the day on which I brought thee
+from thy father's lowly cottage to this my castle. Although thou art
+most dear to me, thou art not dear to my nobles. They say that it is
+hard that they should serve one so lowly born as thou. Since thy
+daughter was born they have said this more and more, I doubt not. As
+thou knowest, my will is to live with my people in joy and peace.
+Therefore must I do to my child not as I wish myself, but as my
+nobles wish. Show then to me the obedience that thou didst promise to
+show when thou wert wed in the village street."
+
+As Griselda heard these words she made no moan. Neither did she let
+the pain that caught at her heart be seen in her face. When she could
+speak, she said:
+
+"Lord, we are thine! My child is thine. I also am thine. With thine
+own thou mayest ever do as pleaseth thee best."
+
+The Marquis was full of joy because of the patience and humbleness of
+Griselda; but he appeared to be sad, and left her with a troubled
+face.
+
+Soon after this, Griselda started as she heard a heavy footstep on the
+stairway. Then an evil-looking man walked into the quiet room.
+
+"Madam," he said, "I must obey my lord's will. He bids me take this
+child. Thou knowest we must obey, although we may complain and mourn."
+
+Then the soldier took the child so roughly that it seemed as if he
+would kill it before her. Griselda said:
+
+"Pray, sir, do thou suffer me to kiss my child ere it die." He gave it
+back to her. Gently she gathered it in her arms. She blessed it, and
+lulled it, and kissed it. Then she said in her sweet voice: "Farewell,
+my child, I shall see thee never again. The blessing of Him who died
+on a cross of wood for us, rest on thee. To Him I give thy soul, my
+little one! To-night thou must die because of me."
+
+To the rough soldier she said:
+
+"Take again the child and obey my Lord. But if it please my Lord, then
+of thy kindness bury thou the little body where no cruel bird nor
+beast can harm it!"
+
+But in silence the soldier carried away the child.
+
+Then Lord Walter looked to see if Griselda would fret or be less kind
+to him. He watched, but could see no change in her. She was as busy
+and loving and cheerful as ever. Neither in earnest nor in play did
+she name her child.
+
+After four years a son was born to Griselda. The people were very glad
+because there was now an heir to rule the land at the death of Lord
+Walter. Griselda too was happy, though her heart longed for the
+little maid who might have been playing with her brother.
+
+When the boy was two years old, Lord Walter began to wish once more to
+try the patience of Griselda.
+
+This time he said to her:
+
+"Wife, I have told thee before how ill the people bear our marriage.
+Now that a son is born they are more wrathful than before. My heart is
+weary with the thought of their complaints. They say, 'When Lord
+Walter is gone, the grandson of Janicola shall rule us!' Therefore I
+shall do with my son as I did with his sister. Be patient, I pray
+thee."
+
+"Thou art my Lord," said Griselda. "My will and my freedom lie in my
+father's cottage with the poor soiled clothes I left there on the day
+thou didst bring me hither. Could I know thy will before thou didst
+tell it to me, it would be done, though it were death to do it. Life
+cannot compare with thy love."
+
+Lord Walter looked down to the ground. He could not look at his wife
+lest he should not have heart to do as he wished.
+
+Again the rude soldier came to Griselda. He was even harsher than
+before, and carried off the child without a kind word to the patient
+mother.
+
+When the little boy was gone, the people said very bitter things about
+Lord Walter. The love they had given him before was turned into hatred
+because he had treated his beautiful wife so unkindly, and because he
+had murdered his children.
+
+Though Lord Walter saw this, he wished to try his wife once more. He
+knew that he could send away his wife and marry another if he got a
+letter from the Pope to say that he might. He sent a messenger to
+Rome, where the Pope lived. This messenger was told to bring back a
+letter, not from the Pope, but as like one of his as possible.
+
+The letter came. It said that because of the anger of Lord Walter's
+people at the lowly birth of his wife Griselda, the Marquis might send
+her away and marry another.
+
+The news of the letter spread throughout the land. Every one believed
+that it had really come from the Pope.
+
+Griselda's heart was very sore when she heard of this letter. But she
+went on quietly with each day's work. She did not even speak of the
+letter to her husband.
+
+At last Lord Walter spoke before all his court, and with no knightly
+gentleness.
+
+"Griselda," he said, "there is no freedom in the life of one who
+rules. I may not act after my own wish as any laborer on my land may
+do. As thou knowest, my people hate thy presence, and demand of me
+that I wed another. The Pope's letter thou hast heard. Return then,
+swiftly and without complaint, to thy father's cottage, for already my
+bride cometh hither."
+
+"My Lord, it is no new thought to me, that I am unworthy to be thy
+servant--far more unworthy to be thy wife. In this great house of
+which thou didst make me queen, I have not acted as mistress, but only
+as lowly handmaid to thee. For these years of thy kindness, I thank
+thee. Gladly do I go to my father's house. There he tended me when I
+was but a child. Now I will stay with him till death enters the
+cottage door. To thee and to thy bride be joy. To her I willingly
+yield the place where I have been so happy. Since thou, who once wert
+all my joy, wilt have me go, I go!"
+
+Lord Walter turned away in sadness. He could scarcely speak for pity,
+but he held to his purpose.
+
+Then Griselda drew her wedding-ring from her finger, and laid it down.
+Beside it she put the gems that Lord Walter had given her. Her
+beautiful robes she laid aside. In the simplest gown she could find,
+and with head and feet all bare, Griselda went down through the olive
+trees towards her father's house.
+
+Many of Lord Walter's people followed her, weeping and bewailing the
+fickleness of fortune. Griselda did not turn to them, nor speak, nor
+weep. She quietly went on her way.
+
+When the tidings reached her father, he wished that he had never been
+born, so sad was he in the sorrow of his beautiful daughter. He
+hastened out to meet her, and wrapped her tenderly in her old cloak,
+and led her home with tears.
+
+Griselda spoke no word of complaint, nor did she speak of her former
+happiness. Once more she tended the sheep on the common. Once more she
+carried water from the well. Once more she thought first of her
+father.
+
+After some weeks Lord Walter sent for Griselda. She went to the castle
+and greeted him humbly as of old. She showed no grudge because of his
+unkindness.
+
+"Griselda," he said, "thou knowest, as doth no other, how all this
+castle should be ordered for my pleasure. Stay thou then, and have all
+in readiness for the fair young bride whom I shall wed to-morrow. It
+is my will that she be welcomed royally."
+
+"My whole desire is to serve thee, my Lord. Neither weal nor woe shall
+ever make me cease to love thee with all my heart."
+
+At once Griselda took control of all who worked in the castle. Of them
+all she was the neatest and the quickest. Soon every room in the tower
+was sweet and clean. The great hall was decked for the wedding-feast,
+and the table glittered with silver.
+
+Early next morning many horsemen came to the castle. Among them was a
+beautiful girl dressed in a shimmering white robe. Near her rode a
+charming boy younger than the maiden. Round them were many nobles, and
+a guard of soldiers, who had brought them to Lord Walter's court.
+
+The people crowded round the gates. So charmed were they with the fair
+young maid, that some of them forgot their love for Griselda, and were
+ready to welcome the bride whose coming caused her so much sorrow.
+
+Still Griselda moved about the castle in her old worn clothes. She
+went to the gate to welcome the bride. Then she received the guests
+and greeted each of them according to his degree.
+
+The stranger nobles wondered who Griselda could be. She was so wise
+and gentle, and yet so meanly dressed.
+
+Before the feast began, Lord Walter called Griselda to him. Then he
+asked her, "What dost thou think of my wife? Is she beautiful?"
+
+"Never have I seen a fairer," said Griselda. "Joy be with you both
+evermore! But oh! I beg of thee, torment not this child as thou didst
+me. She has been tenderly cared for. She could not bear what I have
+borne."
+
+When Lord Walter saw her great patience, and thought of the pain he
+had caused her, his heart went out to her in great pity, and he
+cried, "It is enough, Griselda; fear no more, nor be thou longer sad.
+I have tried thy faith and thy sweetness, as faith and sweetness have
+never before been tried."
+
+His arms were around her, and he kissed her. Griselda looked at him in
+wonder. She could not understand.
+
+"Griselda," he said, "thou art my wife. I have no other. This is thy
+daughter; her brother is my heir. Thine are they both. Take them
+again, and dream not that thou art bereft of thy children."
+
+When Griselda heard all this she fainted away in her great joy. When
+she woke again she called her children to her. Timidly they came, but
+soon they were caught close to her breast. While she fondled them, and
+kissed them, her hot tears of joy fell on their fair faces, and on
+their hair. Then she looked at Lord Walter, and said, "Death cannot
+harm me now, since thou lovest me still." Then she turned back to the
+children.
+
+"Oh tender, oh dear, oh little ones, my children! Your sorrowful
+mother thought that cruel dogs or other fearsome beasts had torn you!
+but God has kept you safe."
+
+Once again the ladies of the court dressed Griselda in royal robes.
+Once again they set a golden crown upon her head. Once again the
+wedding-ring slipped into its own place on her finger.
+
+Ere she entered the hall of feasting again, swift messengers had
+brought her old father, Janicola, to the castle, never to leave it
+again.
+
+Then Griselda sat with her children beside her husband. To her feet
+came lords and nobles, peasants and farmers, eager to kiss her hand
+and to show the joy they felt in her return.
+
+Never had the walls of the castle reechoed the laughter of so glad a
+people. All day long till the stars shone in the cool clear sky the
+feasting went on.
+
+For Griselda this was the first of many happy days, happier than she
+had known before.
+
+In her home sounded the gay voices of happy children as they played
+with, and cared for, the old grandfather whom their mother loved so
+dearly. And ever as she moved about the castle she met the eyes of
+Lord Walter, that told her again and yet again that he trusted her
+utterly.
+
+
+
+
+THE PILGRIM'S PROGRESS
+
+By JOHN BUNYAN
+
+ADAPTED BY MARY MACGREGOR
+
+
+As I slept I dreamed a dream. I dreamed, and behold, I saw a man
+clothed with rags, standing in a certain place, with his face away
+from his own house, a book in his hand, and a great burden upon his
+back. I looked, and saw him open the book, and read therein, and as he
+read, he wept and trembled. His fear was so great that he brake out
+with a mournful cry, saying, "What shall I do?"
+
+In this plight therefore he went home, and did all he could to hide
+his distress from his wife and children. But he could not be silent
+long, because his trouble increased. Wherefore at length he began to
+talk to his wife and children thus: "O my dear wife," said he, "and
+you my children, I am in despair by reason of a burden that lieth
+heavy on me. Moreover I am for certain told that this our city will be
+burned with fire from heaven, when both myself, with thee, my wife,
+and you, my sweet babes, shall be ruined, except some way of escape
+can be found." At this his wife and children were sore amazed, not
+because they believed that what he had said to them was true, but
+because they thought he must be ill to talk in so strange a way.
+Therefore, as it was evening, and they hoped sleep might soothe him,
+with all haste they got him to bed. But the night was as troublesome
+to him as the day, wherefore instead of sleeping he spent it in sighs
+and tears.
+
+So when the morning was come, they asked him how he did. He told them,
+"Worse and worse," and began to talk to them again in the same strange
+manner, but they began to be careless of his words. They also thought
+to drive away his fancies by harsh and rough behavior to him.
+Sometimes they would mock, sometimes they would scold, and sometimes
+they would quite neglect him. Wherefore he began to stay in his room
+to pray for and pity them, and also to comfort his own misery. He
+would also walk alone in the fields, sometimes reading and sometimes
+praying, and thus for some days he spent his time.
+
+Now I saw in my dream that when he was walking in the fields, he was
+reading his book and greatly distressed in mind. And as he read, he
+burst out crying, "What shall I do to be saved?" I saw also that he
+looked this way and that way, as if he would run. Yet he stood still,
+because, as I saw, he could not tell which way to go. I looked then,
+and saw a man, named Evangelist, coming to him, who asked, "Wherefore
+dost thou cry?"
+
+He answered, "Sir, I see by the book in my hand that I am condemned to
+die, and after that to be judged. And I find I am not willing to die,
+nor able to be judged."
+
+Then said Evangelist, "Why not willing to die, since in this life you
+are so unhappy?"
+
+The man answered, "Because I fear this burden will sink me lower than
+the grave, and the thought of that makes me cry."
+
+Then said Evangelist, "If this be thy fear, why standest thou still?"
+
+He answered, "Because I know not whither to go."
+
+So Evangelist gave him a parchment roll, and there was written within,
+"Fly from the wrath to come." The man therefore read it, and looking
+upon Evangelist very carefully, said, "Whither must I fly!"
+
+Then said Evangelist, pointing with his finger over a very wide field,
+"Do you see yonder Wicket-gate?"
+
+The man said, "No."
+
+"Well," said the other, "do you see yonder shining light?"
+
+He said, "I think I do."
+
+Then said Evangelist, "Keep that light in thine eye, and go up
+directly thereto, so shalt thou see the gate. When thou knockest, it
+shall be told thee what thou shalt do."
+
+So I saw in my dream that the man began to run. Now he had not run far
+from his own door when his wife and children, seeing it, began to cry
+after him to return. But the man put his fingers in his ears, and ran
+on, crying, "Life, life, eternal life!" So he looked not behind him,
+but fled towards the middle of the plain. The neighbors also came out
+to see him run. And as he ran some mocked, others threatened, and some
+cried after him to return. Among those that did so were two that were
+resolved to fetch him back by force. The name of the one was
+Obstinate, and the name of the other was Pliable. Now by this time the
+man was got a good distance from them, but they had made up their
+minds to follow him, which they did, and in a little time overtook
+him.
+
+Then said the man, "Neighbors, wherefore are you come?"
+
+They said, "To persuade you to go back with us."
+
+But he said, "That can by no means be. You dwell in the City of
+Destruction, the place where I was born. Be content, good neighbors,
+and go along with me."
+
+"What!" said Obstinate, "and leave our friends and our comforts behind
+us!"
+
+"Yes," said Christian, for that was his name.
+
+"What do you seek, since you leave all the world to find it?" said
+Obstinate.
+
+"I seek a treasure that never fades away. It is laid up in heaven and
+is safe there," said Christian. "Read it so, if you will, in my book."
+
+"Tush!" said Obstinate, "away with your book. Will you go back with us
+or no?"
+
+"No, not I," said the other, "because I have just set out."
+
+"Come then, Neighbor Pliable, let us turn again and go home without
+him."
+
+Then said Pliable, "If what the good Christian says is true, the
+things he looks after are better than ours. My heart makes me wish to
+go with him. But, my good Christian, do you know the way you are
+going?"
+
+"I am directed by a man, whose name is Evangelist, to speed me to a
+little gate that is before us, where we shall be told about the way."
+
+"Come then, good neighbor," said Pliable, "let us be going." Then they
+went both together.
+
+"And I will go back to my place," said Obstinate. "I will be no
+companion of such mistaken and foolish fellows."
+
+Now I saw in my dream that when Obstinate was gone back, Christian and
+Pliable went talking over the plain. "I will tell you what my book
+says of the country to which we are going, and of the people we shall
+meet there," said Christian.
+
+"But do you think the words of your book are certainly true?" said
+Pliable.
+
+"Yes," said Christian, "for it was written by Him who cannot lie."
+
+"Well," said Pliable, "tell me about this country."
+
+"In this country," said Christian, "we shall live for ever. There are
+crowns of glory to be given us, and garments that will make us shine
+like the sun."
+
+"This is excellent," said Pliable; "and what else?"
+
+"There shall be no more crying nor sorrow, for He that is the Owner of
+the place will wipe all tears from our eyes," said Christian.
+
+"And what companions shall we have there?" asked Pliable.
+
+"There we shall be with those that will dazzle your eyes to look on.
+There also you shall meet with thousands and tens of thousands that
+have gone before us to that place. None of of them are hurtful, but
+loving and holy. In a word, there shall we see some with their golden
+crowns, there we shall see maidens with golden harps, there we shall
+see men that here were cut in pieces, burnt in flames, eaten by
+beasts, and drowned in the seas, all for the love they bare to the
+Lord of this place. Now they are all well, and clothed with beautiful
+garments."
+
+And as Pliable heard of the excellence of the country and of the
+company to which they were going, he said, "Well, my good companion,
+glad I am to hear of these things. Come on, let us go with more
+speed."
+
+"I cannot go as fast as I would by reason of this burden that is on my
+back," said Christian.
+
+Now I saw in my dream that just as they ended their talk, they drew
+nigh to a bog that was in the midst of the plain, and they being
+heedless did both fall suddenly into it. The name of this bog was the
+Slough of Despond. Here therefore they struggled for a time, being
+grievously covered with dirt. And Christian, because of the burden
+that was on his back, began to sink in the mire. Then said Pliable,
+"Ah, Neighbor Christian, where are you now?"
+
+"Truly," said Christian, "I do not know."
+
+At this Pliable began to be offended, and said angrily, "Is this the
+happiness you have told me of all this while? If I get out again with
+my life, you shall possess the wonderful country alone."
+
+And with that he gave a desperate struggle or two, and got out of the
+mire on that side of the bog which was next to his own house. So away
+he went, and Christian saw him no more. Wherefore Christian was left
+to tumble in the Slough of Despond alone. But still he tried to
+struggle to that side of the Slough that was further from his own
+house, and next to the Wicket-gate. But he could not get out because
+of the burden that was upon his back.
+
+And I beheld in my dream that a man came to him, whose name was Help,
+and asked him what he did there. "Sir," said Christian, "I was bid to
+go this way by a man called Evangelist, who directed me also to yonder
+gate, and as I was going thither I fell in here."
+
+"Why did you not look for the steps?" said Help.
+
+"I was so full of fear," answered Christian, "that I fled the next way
+and fell in."
+
+Then said Help, "Give me thy hand." So Christian gave him his hand,
+and he drew him out and set him upon sound ground, and bid him go on
+his way.
+
+Now in my dream I stepped up to the man that plucked Christian out,
+and said:
+
+"Sir, wherefore, since over this place is the way from the City of
+Destruction to the Wicket-gate, is it that this Slough is not mended,
+that poor travelers might go over in more safety?"
+
+And he said to me, "This place cannot be mended, yet it is not the
+pleasure of the King that it should remain so bad. His laborers also
+have for more than sixteen hundred years been employed on this patch
+of ground, in the hope that it might perhaps be mended. There has
+been swallowed up here twenty thousand cartloads of the best material
+in the attempt to mend the place. But it is the Slough of Despond
+still; and still will be so, when they have done all they can. It is
+true that there are some good and strong steps even through the very
+midst of this mire. But men through the dizziness of their head miss
+the steps and so tumble into the mire, but the ground is good when
+they have once got in at the gate."
+
+Then I saw in my dream that by this time Pliable was got home to his
+house. So his neighbors came to visit him, and some of them called him
+wise man for coming back, and some called him fool for going with
+Christian. Others again did mock at his cowardliness, saying, "Surely
+since you began to go, you need not have been so base as to have given
+out for a few difficulties." So Pliable sat like a coward among them.
+
+Now as Christian was walking alone, he espied one afar off, come
+crossing over the field to meet him. The gentleman's name was Mr.
+Worldly Wiseman. He dwelt in a very great town, close by the one from
+which Christian came. This man, then, meeting with Christian, began
+thus to enter into some talk with him: "How now, good fellow, whither
+are you going in this burdened manner?"
+
+"A burdened manner indeed," said Christian. "I am going, sir, to
+yonder Wicket-gate before me, for there, I am told, I shall be put
+into a way to be rid of my heavy burden."
+
+"Hast thou a wife and children?" asked Mr. Worldly Wiseman.
+
+"Yes, but I am so laden with this burden that I cannot take that
+pleasure in them as formerly."
+
+"Will you hearken to me if I give thee counsel?"
+
+"If it be good, I will, for I stand in need of good counsel."
+
+"I would advise thee, then, that thou with all speed get thyself rid
+of thy burden, for thou wilt never be contented till then."
+
+"That is what I seek for, even to be rid of this heavy burden, but get
+it off myself I cannot, nor is there any man living in our country who
+can take it off my shoulders. Therefore I am going this way, as I told
+you, that I may be rid of my burden."
+
+"Who bid thee go this way to be rid of thy burden?"
+
+"A man that appeared to me a very great and honorable person. His
+name, as I remember, is Evangelist."
+
+"He has given thee foolish counsel. There is not a more dangerous and
+troublesome way in the world than is that unto which he hath directed
+thee. Thou hast met with some danger already, for I see the mud of the
+Slough of Despond is upon thee. Hear me, I am older than thou. Thou
+art likely to meet with, in the way which thou goest, painfulness,
+hunger, nakedness, sword, lions, dragons, darkness, and death."
+
+"Why, sir, this burden upon my back is more terrible to me than all
+these things."
+
+"But why wilt thou seek for ease this way, seeing so many dangers
+attend it? Hadst thou but patience to listen, I could direct thee how
+to get what thou desirest, without the danger that thou in this way
+wilt run thyself into."
+
+"Sir, I pray that thou wilt tell me this secret."
+
+"Why, in yonder village there dwells a gentleman, who is very wise,
+and who has skill to help men off with burdens like thine from their
+shoulders. To him thou mayest go to be helped at once. His house is
+not quite a mile from this place, and if thou dost not desire to go
+back to the City of Destruction, as indeed I would not wish thee, thou
+mayest send for thy wife and children to come to thee to this village.
+There are houses now standing empty, one of which thou mayest have
+without great cost. Food is there also, cheap and good, and what will
+make thy life the more happy is, that thou shalt live beside honest
+neighbors, in respect and comfort."
+
+Now the Christian puzzled, but he thought, "If what Mr. Worldly
+Wiseman says is true, my wisest plan is to take his advice."
+
+"Sir," said Christian, "which is my way to this honest man's house?"
+
+"Do you see yonder high hill?"
+
+"Yes, very well."
+
+"By that hill you must go, and the first house you come to is his."
+
+So Christian turned out of his way to go to the house for help. But
+behold, when he was now close to the hill, it seemed so steep, and
+also that side of it that was next the wayside did hang so much over,
+that Christian was afraid to venture farther, lest the hill should
+fall on his head. Wherefore he stood still, and knew not what to do.
+Also his burden now seemed heavier to him than while he was in his
+way. There came also flashes of fire out of the hill, that made
+Christian afraid that he should be burned. Here therefore he did quake
+for fear. And now he began to be sorry that he had taken Mr. Worldly
+Wiseman's counsel. Then he saw Evangelist coming to meet him, at the
+sight also of whom he began to blush for shame. So Evangelist drew
+nearer and nearer, and coming up to him, he looked upon him with a
+severe and dreadful countenance.
+
+"What dost thou here, Christian?" said he. At which words Christian
+knew not what to answer, wherefore at first he stood speechless before
+him. Then said Evangelist, "Art not thou the man I found crying
+without the walls of the City of Destruction?"
+
+"Yes," said Christian, "I am the man."
+
+"Did I not direct thee the way to the little Wicket-gate?"
+
+"Yes," said Christian.
+
+"How is it, then, that thou art so quickly turned out of the way?"
+
+"I met with a gentleman as soon as I had got over the Slough of
+Despond, who told me that in yonder village I might find a man who
+could take off my burden."
+
+"What was he like?"
+
+"He looked like a gentleman, and talked much to me, and got me at last
+to believe his words. So I came hither, but when I beheld this hill
+and how it hangs over the way, I suddenly stood still lest it should
+fall on my head."
+
+"What said that gentleman to you?"
+
+"Why, he asked me whither I was going, and if I had a wife and
+children, and he bid me make speed to get rid of my burden. And I
+said, 'I am going to yonder gate to be told how I may get rid of it.'
+
+"So he said he would show me a better and a shorter way, and not so
+full of difficulties as the way that you directed me. But when I came
+to this place, I stopped for fear of danger, and now I know not what
+to do!" So Christian stood trembling before Evangelist.
+
+Then said Evangelist, "Give heed to the things I shall tell thee. Mr.
+Worldly Wiseman sought to turn thee out of the way and to bring thee
+into danger. In yonder village has no man ever yet got rid of his
+burden, nor is he ever likely to lose it there. Therefore, Mr. Worldly
+Wiseman and his friend are deceivers, and cannot help thee."
+
+After this there came words and fire out of the mountain under which
+Christian stood. Now Christian looked for nothing but death, and began
+to cry out, saying he would he had never met Mr. Worldly Wiseman or
+that he had never listened to him. Then he turned to Evangelist and
+said, "Sir, what do you think? Is there any hope? May I now go back
+and go up to the Wicket-gate? Or shall I be sent back from the gate
+ashamed? I am sorry I have listened to this man's counsel, but may my
+sins be forgiven?"
+
+Evangelist said to him, "Thy sin is very great. Thou hast left the
+good way and walked in forbidden paths. Yet will the man at the gate
+receive thee, for he has good will for men. Only," said he, "take heed
+that thou turn not aside again."
+
+Then did Christian prepare to go back. And Evangelist, after he had
+kissed him, gave him one smile, and bid him Godspeed. So Christian
+went on with haste, neither spake he to any man by the way. Even if
+any one spoke to him, he would not venture an answer. He walked like
+one that was all the while treading on forbidden ground, and could by
+no means think himself safe, till again he had got into the way which
+he had left to follow Mr. Worldly Wiseman's counsel. So in process of
+time Christian got up to the gate. Now over the gate there was
+written, "Knock, and it shall be opened unto you." He knocked
+therefore more than once or twice. At last there came a grave person
+to the gate, named Good-will. He asked who was there, and whence he
+came, and what he desired.
+
+"I am a sinner," said Christian; "I come from the City of Destruction,
+but am going to Mount Zion. I am told that by this gate is the way
+thither, and I would know if you are willing to let me in."
+
+"I am willing with all my heart," said Good-will, and he opened the
+gate. So when Christian was stepping in, the other gave him a pull.
+
+"Why do you do that?" said Christian.
+
+Then Good-will told him, "A little distance from this gate a strong
+castle has been built, of which Beelzebub is the captain. And he and
+those that are with him shoot arrows at those that come up to this
+gate, hoping they may die before they enter in."
+
+So when Christian had come in, Good-will asked him who had directed
+him to the gate.
+
+"Evangelist bid me come here and knock, as I did. And he said that
+you, sir, would tell me what I must do."
+
+Then Good-will said, "Come a little way with me, good Christian, and I
+will teach thee about the way thou must go. Look before thee; dost
+thou see this narrow way? That is the way thou must go, and it is as
+straight as a rule can make it. This is the way thou must go."
+
+"But," said Christian, "are there no turnings, nor windings, by which
+a stranger may lose his way?"
+
+"Yes, there are many ways join this, but they are crooked and wide.
+Thou mayest know the right from the wrong way, for the right way is
+always strait and narrow."
+
+Then I saw in my dream that Christian asked him if he could not help
+him off with his burden that was upon his back. For as yet he had not
+got rid of it, nor could he get it off without help. But Good-will
+said, "Thou must be content to bear it, until thou comest to a place
+where stands a Cross, for there it will fall from thy back of itself."
+
+Then Christian began to get ready to continue his journey. So
+Good-will told him that when he had gone some distance from the gate,
+he would come to the house of the Interpreter, at whose door he should
+knock, and he would show him wonderful things. Then Christian took
+leave of his friend, and he again bid him Godspeed. Now Christian went
+on till he came to the house of the Interpreter, where he knocked over
+and over. At last one came to the door and asked who was there.
+
+"Sir," said Christian, "I am a traveler who was told by Good-will to
+call here. I would therefore speak with the master of the house." So
+he called for the master of the house, who, after a little time, came
+to Christian and asked what he would have.
+
+"Sir," said Christian, "I am a man that has come from the City of
+Destruction, and I am going to Mount Zion. I was told by the man that
+stands at the Wicket-gate that if I called here you would show me
+things that would help me on my journey."
+
+Then said the Interpreter, "Come in, and I will show thee what will
+help thee." So he commanded his man to light the candle, and bid
+Christian follow him. Then he took him into a private room, and bid
+his man open a door. And Christian saw the picture of a very grave
+person hung up against the wall. He had eyes lifted up to heaven, the
+best of books in his hand, and a crown of gold did hang over his head.
+
+Then said Christian, "What means this?"
+
+"The man whose picture this is," answered the Interpreter, "is one of
+a thousand. He is the only man who may be thy guide in all difficult
+places thou mayest meet with in the way. Wherefore be very careful to
+remember whom thou hast seen."
+
+Then the Interpreter led him into a very large parlor that was full of
+dust, because it was never swept, and after he had looked at it for a
+little while, the Interpreter called for a man to sweep. Now when he
+began to sweep, the dust began to fly about, so that Christian was
+almost choked. Then said the Interpreter to a damsel that stood near,
+"Bring hither the water and sprinkle the room." And when this was done
+the room was swept and cleansed.
+
+Then said Christian, "What does this mean?"
+
+The Interpreter answered, "This parlor is like the heart of an evil
+man. The dust is his sin, and the damsel that sprinkles the water is
+the Gospel."
+
+I saw moreover in my dream, that the Interpreter took Christian by the
+hand and led him into a little room, where sat two little children,
+each one in his chair. The name of the eldest was Passion, and the
+name of the other Patience. Passion seemed to be very discontented,
+but Patience was very quiet.
+
+Then Christian asked, "What is the reason of the discontent of
+Passion?"
+
+The Interpreter answered, "The governor of the children would have
+them wait for their new toys, till the beginning of next year, but
+Passion wishes to have them all now, while Patience, is willing to
+wait." Then the Interpreter took Christian to a place where there was
+a fire burning against a wall, and one standing near it, always
+casting much water upon it to quench it, yet did the fire burn higher
+and hotter. But afterwards the Interpreter took him to the back of the
+wall, where he saw a man with a vessel of oil in his hand, and he
+poured the oil continually, but secretly, into the fire.
+
+"What does this mean?" asked Christian.
+
+The Interpreter answered, "The fire is a picture of the grace God puts
+into the heart. He that casts water on it to put it out is the Evil
+One. And the man who pours oil on the fire to keep it alight is
+Christ."
+
+I saw also that the Interpreter took Christian again by the hand and
+led him into a place, where was builded a stately palace, beautiful to
+behold, at the sight of which Christian was greatly delighted. He saw
+also upon the top of the palace certain persons walking, and they were
+clothed all in gold.
+
+Then said Christian, "May we go in here?" So the Interpreter took him
+and led him toward the door of the palace. Now before they came up to
+the door, they passed a man, sitting at a table, with a book and his
+inkhorn before him, to take down the name of any who should enter.
+And, behold, at the door stood a great company of men, who wished to
+go in, but did not dare to enter, for within the doorway stood many
+men in armor to guard it. Now, these men in armor were determined to
+do any who would enter as much harm and mischief as they could.
+Christian was amazed. At last, when every man started back for fear of
+the armed men, Christian saw a man with a very strong face come up to
+the man that sat at the table, saying:
+
+"Set down my name, sir."
+
+And when this was done, Christian saw the strong man draw his sword
+and put an helmet on his head, and rush toward the door upon the
+armed men. The armed men fought with great strength, but the man with
+the strong face was not at all discouraged, but fought most fiercely.
+So after he had received and given many wounds to those that tried to
+keep him out, he cut his way through them all, and pressed forward
+into the palace. Then there was a pleasant voice heard from those that
+walked upon the top of the palace, saying:
+
+ "Come in, come in;
+ Eternal glory thou shalt win."
+
+So he went in and was clothed in such garments as they.
+
+"Now," said Christian, "let me go."
+
+And the Interpreter said, "Hast thou understood these things?"
+
+"Yes," said Christian, and he began to get ready to go on his journey.
+
+Then said the Interpreter, "God be always with thee, good Christian,
+to guide thee in the way that leads to Mount Zion."
+
+Now I saw in my dream that the highway up which Christian was to go
+was fenced on either side with a wall. Up this way therefore, did
+Christian run, but not without great difficulty, because of the load
+on his back. He ran thus till he came to a steeper place, and upon
+that place stood a Cross, and a little below, a Sepulcher. So I saw in
+my dream that just as Christian came up to the Cross his burden fell
+from off his back, and began to tumble till it came to the mouth of
+the Sepulcher, where it fell in and I saw it no more. Then was
+Christian glad and happy, and he stood for a while to look and wonder,
+for it was surprising to him to see that the Cross should make him
+lose his burden. Now as he stood looking, behold three Shining Ones
+came to him and greeted him.
+
+The first said to him, "Thy sins be forgiven thee." The second took
+away all his rags and clothed him in new raiment. The third set a mark
+on his forehead and gave him a roll with a seal on it, which he should
+give in at the Celestial Gate. So they went their way.
+
+Then Christian gave three leaps for joy and went on singing. I saw
+then in my dream that as he walked he saw two men come tumbling over
+the wall into the narrow way.
+
+"Gentlemen, where do you come from and whither do you go?" said
+Christian.
+
+They told him, "We were born in a land called Vainglory, and we are
+going to Mount Zion."
+
+"Why came you not in at the gate?" said Christian.
+
+They said that to go to the gate was too far, so they had taken a
+short cut and climbed over the wall.
+
+"But," said Christian, "will the Lord of the City to which we are
+going be pleased that you should come into the way over the wall?"
+
+But the men said he need not trouble his head about that, for what
+they did had been done many times before. It had been a custom for
+more than a thousand years. And besides, said they, "If we get into
+the way, what does it matter how we get in? You came in by the
+Wicket-gate, and are in the way, and we came tumbling over the wall
+and are in the way, so now we are all in the same condition."
+
+"But," said Christian, "I walk by the Rule of my Master, and you walk
+just as you like best."
+
+Then said they, "We see not how thou art different to us, except by
+the coat thou wearest, and that, we suppose, was given thee by some of
+thy neighbors, to hide thy rags."
+
+"Well," said Christian, "the Lord of the City to which I go gave me
+this coat the day that he took away from me my rags. He will surely
+know me, since I have His coat on my back. I have also a mark in my
+forehead, which you may not have noticed, and this was given to me by
+one of my Lord's friends, on the day my burden fell off my shoulders.
+I will tell you too, that I had a roll given me, to comfort me by
+reading, as I go on the way. I am also to give in the roll at the
+Celestial Gate. All these things I think you are without, because you
+came not in at the gate."
+
+To these things they gave him no answer, only they looked at each
+other and laughed. I beheld then, that they all went on without
+talking much together, till they came to the foot of the hill
+Difficulty, at the bottom of which was a spring. The narrow way lay
+right up the hill, but there were also two other ways here. One turned
+to the left hand and the other to the right at the bottom of the hill.
+Christian now went to the spring and drank to refresh himself, and
+then began to go up the narrow path that led to the top of the hill.
+The other two also came to the foot of the hill. But when they saw
+that the hill was steep and high, they made up their minds to go in
+the other paths that lay round the side of the hill. So one took the
+way that was called Danger, which led him into a great wood, and the
+other took the way called Destruction, which led him into a wide
+field, full of dark mountains, where he stumbled and fell and rose no
+more. I looked then to Christian to see him go up the hill, and then I
+saw that he had begun to clamber upon his hands and his knees, because
+of the steepness of the place. Now about midway to the top of the hill
+was a pleasant arbor, made by the Lord of the hill for the refreshing
+of weary travelers. When Christian got there he sat down to rest, then
+he pulled out his roll and read in it to comfort himself, and he began
+again to look at the garment that was given to him at the Cross. Thus
+he at last fell into a slumber, and then into a sound sleep, which
+kept him in that place, until it was almost night, and in his sleep
+his roll fell out of his hand. Now, as he was sleeping, there came one
+to him and awaked him. Then Christian suddenly started up and sped on
+his way till he came to the top of the hill.
+
+When he was got to the top of the hill, there came two men running to
+meet him. The name of the one was Timorous, and the other Mistrust.
+
+"Sirs," said Christian, "what is the matter? You run the wrong way."
+
+Timorous answered that they were going to the City of Zion and had got
+up that difficult place. "But," said he, "the farther we go, the more
+danger we meet with, wherefore we turned and are going back again."
+
+"Yes," said Mistrust; "for just before us lie a couple of lions in the
+way, whether sleeping or waking we know not, but we thought if we came
+within reach, they would pull us in pieces."
+
+Then said Christian, "You make me afraid, but yet I will go forward."
+So Mistrust and Timorous ran down the hill, and Christian went on his
+way. And as he went he thought again of what he heard from the men.
+Then he felt for his roll, that he might read and be comforted, but he
+felt and found it not.
+
+Now was Christian in great distress and knew not what to do. At last
+he bethought himself that he had slept in the arbor that was on the
+side of the hill, and then he went back to look for his roll. But all
+the way he went back, who can tell the sorrow of Christian's heart?
+Sometimes he sighed, sometimes he wept, and often he chid himself for
+being so foolish as to fall asleep. Thus therefore he went back,
+carefully looking on this side and on that all the way as he went. For
+he hoped to find the roll that had been his comfort so many times in
+his journey. He went back till he came again within sight of the arbor
+where he had sat and slept, but that sight renewed his sorrow again,
+by reminding him how eagerly he had slept there. And as he went
+towards the arbor, he sighed over his sleepiness, saying, "Oh, foolish
+man that I was, why did I sleep in the daytime? oh, that I had not
+slept."
+
+Now, by the time he was come to the arbor again, for a while he sat
+down and wept, but, at last, looking sorrowfully down under the
+settle, he espied his roll, which with trembling haste he caught up.
+But who can tell how joyful Christian was when he had got his roll
+again, or with what joy and tears he began to go up the hill again.
+And, oh, how nimbly did he go up! Yet before he reached the top the
+sun went down. Now Christian remembered the story that Mistrust and
+Timorous had told him, how they were frightened with the sight of the
+lions. And he said to himself, "If these beasts meet me in the dark,
+how shall I escape being by them torn in pieces?"
+
+But while he was in this fright, he lifted up his eyes, and behold,
+there was a very stately palace before him, the name of which was
+Beautiful, and it stood by the highway side. So I saw in my dream that
+he made haste, that if possible he might get lodging there. Now before
+he had gone far, he entered into a very narrow passage; and looking
+before him as he went, he espied two lions in the way. The lions were
+chained, but Christian did not see the chains. Then he was afraid and
+thought he would go back, but the porter at the lodge, whose name is
+Watchful, seeing Christian stop, as if he would go back, cried, "Fear
+not the lions, for they are chained."
+
+Then I saw that Christian went on till he came and stood before the
+gate where the porter was. And Christian said to the porter, "Sir,
+what house is this? May I lodge here to-night?"
+
+The porter answered, "This house was built by the Lord of the hill,
+for the safety of pilgrims."
+
+So Watchful the porter rang a bell, at the sound of which a grave and
+beautiful damsel came out of the door. When she saw Christian she
+brought him into the Palace Beautiful, and she and her sisters talked
+with him until supper was ready. Now all their talk at table was about
+the Lord of the hill, and, by what they said, I knew that He had been
+a great Warrior, and that He had fought and slain Death, but not
+without great danger to Himself, which made me love Him the more. They
+talked together till late at night, and after they had committed
+themselves to their Lord for protection, they went to bed. The room in
+which the pilgrim slept had a window opening towards the sunrising,
+and the name of the room was Peace. In the morning they all got up,
+and after some more talk, they told him that they would take him to
+the armory before he left them. So they did, and when he came out, he
+was harnessed from head to foot, lest he should be attacked in the
+way. Then Christian walked with his friends to the gate, and there he
+asked the porter if he had seen any pilgrims pass.
+
+The porter answered, "Yes, a pilgrim called Faithful has passed this
+way."
+
+"Oh," said Christian, "I know him. He comes from the place where I was
+born. How far do you think he has got?"
+
+"By this time he is below the hill," said the porter.
+
+Then Christian began to go down the hill into the Valley of
+Humiliation, where it is difficult not to slip. He went down very
+warily, yet he slipped once or twice. Now in the valley Christian had
+a hard fight with a fiend called Apollyon. Apollyon was a monster and
+hideous to behold. He was clothed with scales like a fish, he had
+wings like a dragon, feet like a bear, and his mouth was as the mouth
+of a lion, and out of it came fire and smoke. When he came up to
+Christian he looked at him with rage in his face, and said, "Prepare
+thyself to die, for thou shalt go no farther." And he threw a flaming
+dart at him, but Christian had a shield in his hand, which caught the
+dart, so that it did him no harm. Then did Christian draw his sword,
+but Apollyon threw darts at him as thick as hail, and wounded him in
+his head, his hand, and foot. This great combat lasted half a day,
+till Christian was almost worn out.
+
+Then Apollyon came close to Christian, and wrestled with him and gave
+him a dreadful fall, and Christian's sword flew out of his hand.
+
+"I am sure of thee now," said Apollyon. But while he was taking a last
+blow to kill this good man altogether, Christian nimbly stretched out
+his hand for his sword, and caught it. Then he gave Apollyon a deadly
+thrust, and Apollyon spread his wings and sped him away, so that
+Christian saw him no more. In this combat no man could imagine, unless
+he had seen and heard as I did, what yelling and roaring Apollyon made
+all the time of the fight. He spake like a dragon. On the other side,
+sighs and groans burst from Christian's heart. I never saw him give so
+much as a pleasant look, till he saw that he had wounded Apollyon with
+his two-edged sword. Then indeed he did smile and look upward, but it
+was the dreadfulest sight that ever I saw.
+
+So when the battle was over, Christian said, "I will give thanks to
+Him that did help me against Apollyon."
+
+He also sat down in that place to eat and drink, so being refreshed,
+he again began his journey, with his sword drawn in his hand, "For,"
+said he, "I do not know if some other enemy may not be at hand."
+
+Now at the end of this valley was another, called the Valley of the
+Shadow of Death. Through it Christian must go, because the way to the
+Celestial City lay through it. Now this valley is a very lonely place.
+It is like a wilderness or a desert full of pits. No man dwells in it,
+and no man but a Christian passeth through it. Here Christian had a
+worse time than even in his fight with Apollyon. I saw then in my
+dream that when Christian had reached the borders of this valley,
+there met him two men, making haste to go back.
+
+Christian said to them, "Whither are you going?"
+
+"Back, back," they cried, "as you will go, if you prize life or
+peace!"
+
+"Why, what is the matter?" said Christian.
+
+"Matter!" said they. "We were going the way you are going, and we went
+as far as we dared. But had we gone a little farther we had not been
+here to bring the news to thee."
+
+"But what have you met with?" said Christian.
+
+"Why, we were almost in the Valley of the Shadow of Death, but by good
+chance we looked before us and saw the danger before we came to it."
+
+"But what have you seen?" said Christian.
+
+"Seen!" said the men, "why, the valley itself was as dark as pitch. We
+also saw hobgoblins and dragons, and we heard a continual howling and
+yelling as of people in great misery. Death also doth always spread
+his wings over it. In a word, it is altogether dreadful, being utterly
+without order."
+
+"But," said Christian, "this is the way to the Celestial City."
+
+"Be it your way, then; we will not choose it for ours." So they
+parted. Christian went on his way, but still with his sword drawn in
+his hand, lest he should be attacked.
+
+I saw then in my dream, that as far as this valley reached, there was
+on the right hand a very deep ditch. Again, behold, on the left hand,
+there was a very dangerous mire, into which if a man falls he finds no
+bottom for his foot to stand on. The pathway here was also exceeding
+narrow, and therefore Christian was the more distressed. For when he
+sought in the dark to shun the ditch on the one hand, he was ready to
+tumble over into the mire on the other, and when he sought to escape
+the mire, without great carefulness he would nearly fall into the
+ditch. Then he went on, and I heard him sigh bitterly. For besides
+these dangers, the pathway was here so dark, that when he lifted up
+his foot to go forward, he knew not where, nor upon what he should
+set it next. About the middle of this valley I saw the mouth of hell
+to be, and it stood close to the wayside.
+
+"Now," thought Christian, "what shall I do?"
+
+And ever and anon the flame and smoke came out in such abundance, with
+sparks and hideous noises, that he was forced to put away his sword
+and betake himself to another weapon, called All-prayer.
+
+Then he cried out in my hearing, "O Lord, I beseech thee, deliver my
+soul." Thus he went on a great while, yet still the flames would be
+rushing towards him. Also he heard doleful voices and rushings to and
+fro, so that sometimes he thought he should be torn in pieces, or
+trodden down like mire in the streets.
+
+This frightful sight was seen, and these dreadful noises were heard by
+him for several miles together. Then Christian came to a place where
+he thought he heard a company of fiends coming forward to meet him,
+and he stopped and began to think what it would be best for him to do.
+Sometimes he thought he would go back, but again he thought he might
+be half-way through the valley. So he resolved to go on, yet the
+fiends seemed to come nearer and nearer. But when they were come
+almost close to him, he cried out in a loud voice, "I will walk in the
+strength of the Lord God." Then the fiends went back and came no
+farther.
+
+Now Christian thought he heard the voice of a man going before him,
+saying, "Though I walk through the Valley of the Shadow of Death, I
+will fear no evil, for Thou art with me." Then he was glad, for he
+thought that some one who feared God was in this valley, as well as
+himself, and he hoped to overtake him and have company by and by.
+
+Now morning being come, he looked back to see by the light of day what
+dangers he had gone through in the night. So he saw more plainly the
+ditch that was on the one hand, and the mire that was on the other,
+also how narrow the way was that lay between them both. He saw, too,
+the hobgoblins and dragons, but all afar off, for after break of day
+they came not nigh.
+
+About this time the sun was rising, and this was a great help to
+Christian, for you must know that though the first part of the Valley
+of the Shadow of Death was dangerous, yet this second part, through
+which he had to go, was, if possible, far more dangerous. For, from
+the place where he now stood, even to the end of the valley, the way
+was all along so full of snares, traps, and nets here, so full of
+pits, pitfalls, and deep holes down there, that if it had been dark,
+he would almost surely have been lost, but as I said just now, the sun
+was rising. In this light, therefore, he came to the end of the
+valley.
+
+Now as Christian went on his way, he came to a little hill, and going
+up he looked forward and saw Faithful before him. Then said Christian,
+"Stay, and I will be your companion."
+
+And when he overtook Faithful they went very lovingly on together, and
+talked of all that had happened to them in their pilgrimage. Then I
+saw in my dream that when they got out of the wilderness they saw a
+town before them, and the name of that town was Vanity, and at the
+town there was a fair kept, called Vanity Fair. It was kept all the
+year long.
+
+At this fair there were sold houses, lands, trades, husbands, wives,
+children, silver, gold, pearls, and precious stones. And, moreover, at
+this fair, there were at all times cheats and jugglers and knaves and
+rogues.
+
+Now the way to the Celestial City lay just through this town, so the
+pilgrims had to go through the fair.
+
+The Prince of princes Himself, when here, went through this town to
+his own country, and that on a fair-day too. And, I think, it was
+Beelzebub the chief lord of this fair that invited the Prince to buy
+of his vanities. Beelzebub even said he would have made Him lord of
+the fair, if He would have done him reverence as He went through the
+town. Yea, because the Prince was so great a person, Beelzebub took
+Him from street to street and showed Him all his kingdoms, that he
+might, if possible, tempt the Prince to buy some of his vanities. But
+the Blessed One did not wish any of these vanities, and therefore left
+the town without spending so much as one farthing upon these vanities.
+
+Now these pilgrims, Christian and Faithful, as I said, had to go
+through this fair.
+
+Well, so they did, but behold, whenever they entered into the fair,
+it and the town itself were in a hubbub about them. For the pilgrims
+were clothed with raiment that was very different from the raiment of
+any that traded in that fair. The people gazed upon Christian and
+Faithful and called them outlandish men.
+
+Then also, they wondered at the pilgrim's speech, as few could
+understand what they said, for they spoke the language of the
+Celestial City. But those that kept the fair spoke the language of the
+city of Vanity Fair, and they could not understand one another.
+
+Now when these pilgrims would not buy their wares and would not even
+look at them, the sellers were angry and mocked these men, and some
+called on others to smite them. At last the master of the fair told
+his men to question the pilgrims. And when Christian and Faithful told
+the men that they were strangers in the world and were going to the
+Celestial City, the men thought they were mad. Therefore they took
+them and beat them and threw mud at them, and then they put them in a
+cage to be a show to the people at the fair. But when they were tired
+of mocking them, these two pilgrims were again examined and charged as
+guilty of the great disturbance in the fair. So they beat them
+pitilessly, and hanged irons upon them, and led them in chains up and
+down the fair. Then Christian and Faithful behaved so wisely and
+patiently, that the others were still more angry, and said they would
+put these men to death.
+
+Therefore, after a trial, Faithful was brought out, to do with him
+according to their law. And first they scourged him, then they
+buffeted him, then they stoned him with stones, then they pricked him
+with their swords, and last of all they burned him to ashes at the
+stake. Now I saw behind the people a chariot and a couple of horses
+waiting for Faithful, who was taken by it through the clouds, the
+nearest way to the Celestial City. Then was Christian sent back to the
+prison, where he dwelt for a time, till he escaped and went again on
+his way. But he did not go alone, for there was one whose name was
+Hopeful, who left the town of Vanity, and was a companion to Christian
+in his pilgrimage. They went on their way till they came to a
+pleasant river. Now their way lay just along the bank of the river,
+and Christian and his companion walked there with great delight. They
+drank also of the river, and ate of the fruit that grew on the trees
+by its bank. On either side of the river was also a meadow, very
+beautiful with lilies, and it was green all the year long. In this
+meadow they lay down and slept, for here they might lie safely. Now I
+beheld in my dream that they had not journeyed far, when the river and
+the way parted, and at this they were very sorry, yet they dare not go
+out of the way.
+
+A little before them was a meadow and a stile to go over into it. Then
+said Christian, "If this meadow lies along by our path, let us go
+over." He went to the stile to see, and behold, a path lay alongside
+of the way, on the other side of the fence.
+
+"That is as I wish," said Christian. "Come, good Hopeful, and let us
+go over.
+
+"But," said Hopeful, "what if this path should lead us out of the
+way?"
+
+"That is not likely," said the other. "Look, it goes along by the
+wayside." So Hopeful, being persuaded by Christian, went after him
+over the stile. When they had gone over and had got into the path,
+they found it very easy for their feet. And as they looked before them
+they saw a man walking as they did, and his name was Vain-confidence.
+So they called after him, and asked where this way led.
+
+He said, "To the Celestial City."
+
+"Look," said Christian to Hopeful, "did I not tell you so? You see, we
+are right after all." So they followed Vain-confidence, and he went
+before them.
+
+But behold, the night came on, and it was very dark, so that they that
+went behind lost sight of him that went before. Vain-confidence then
+went on, not seeing the way before him, and fell into a deep pit which
+was there. This pit was made by the Prince of those grounds on
+purpose, to catch such foolish men as Vain-confidence. He, then, fell
+into the pit and was dashed to pieces with his fall. Now Christian and
+Hopeful heard him fall, so they called to know what was the matter,
+but there was none to answer, only they heard a groaning.
+
+Then said Hopeful, "Where are we now?" But Christian was silent, for
+he began to be afraid that he had led Hopeful out of the way.
+
+Now it began to rain and thunder and lighten in a very dreadful
+manner, and the river flowed over the banks.
+
+And Hopeful groaned, "Oh that I had kept on my way."
+
+By this time the waters were greatly risen, so that to go back was
+very dangerous. Yet they tried to go back, but it was so dark, and the
+flood was so high, that as they went they were nearly drowned nine or
+ten times, and they could not reach the stile again that night.
+Wherefore at last, coming to a little shelter, they sat down, but
+being weary they fell asleep. Now there was, not far from the place
+where they lay, a castle, called Doubting Castle, and the owner of the
+castle was Giant Despair, and it was in his grounds the pilgrims were
+now sleeping. Wherefore the giant, getting up early, and walking up
+and down in his fields, caught Christian and Hopeful asleep. Then with
+a grim and surly voice he woke them, and asked them what they were
+doing in his grounds. They told him they were pilgrims and had lost
+their way.
+
+The giant said, "You have trampled on my ground, and slept on it, and
+therefore you must go along with me." So they were forced to go,
+because he was stronger than they. Also they said very little, for
+they knew they had done wrong.
+
+The giant therefore drove them before him, and put them into his
+castle, into a very dark dungeon. Here, then, they lay, from Wednesday
+morning till Saturday night, without one bit of bread or drop of
+drink, or light, or any one to speak to them. Now Giant Despair had a
+wife, and he told her he had taken a couple of men prisoners, because
+they were sleeping on his grounds. Then she told him that, when he
+arose in the morning, he should beat them without mercy.
+
+So Giant Despair got a cudgel, and went down to the dungeon and beat
+Christian and Hopeful fearfully, so that they could not move. Then the
+giant left them, and they spent their time in sighs and bitter tears.
+
+The next night Giant Despair again talked to his wife, and she said,
+"Tell your prisoners to kill themselves, for they will never escape
+from the dungeon."
+
+So when morning came, the giant went to them in a surly manner, and
+seeing they still ached with the stripes he had given them, he told
+them to poison themselves, for they would never get away from him in
+any other way. But they asked the giant to let them go. That made him
+so angry that he rushed on them and would have killed them, but he
+fell into a fit and lost for a time the use of his hand, wherefore he
+withdrew and left them as before. Well, towards evening the giant went
+down again to the dungeon to see if his prisoners had followed his
+advice and poisoned themselves. He found them alive, but because of
+their wounds and for want of bread and water they could do little but
+breathe.
+
+Now at night the giant's wife said: "Take the prisoners into the
+castle yard to-morrow, and show them the bones and skulls of those
+prisoners you have already killed. Tell them that in a week you will
+tear them to pieces, as you have torn your other prisoners."
+
+When the morning was come, the giant went to them again and took them
+into the castle yard, and showed them all his wife had bidden him.
+
+"These," said he, "were pilgrims once as you are, but they walked in
+my grounds as you have done. And when I thought fit, I tore them in
+pieces, and so within ten days I will do to you, Get you down to your
+den again," and he beat them all the way there.
+
+That night, about midnight, Christian and Hopeful began to pray, and
+they prayed till dawn of day.
+
+Now just at dawn Christian spoke in sudden amazement. "How foolish we
+are to lie here, when we might be free after all. I have a key in my
+pocket called Promise, that will, I am persuaded, open any lock in
+Doubting Castle."
+
+Then said Hopeful, "That is good news, pull it out of your pocket and
+try."
+
+Christian pulled it out and began to try the dungeon door, and the
+bolt, as he turned the key, yielded, and the door flew open, and
+Christian and Hopeful both came out. Then he went to the door that
+led to the castle yard, and with his key opened that door also. After
+that he went to the iron gate, for that must be opened too. That lock
+was terribly hard, yet the key did open it. Then they thrust open the
+gate to make their escape in haste, but, as it opened, that gate made
+such a creaking that it waked Giant Despair, who got up hastily to
+follow his prisoners, but he could not run after them, for again he
+took one of his fits. Then Christian and Hopeful went on till they
+came to the King's highway and so were safe, because they were out of
+the giant's grounds. Now when they had got over the stile, they began
+to wonder what they should do to keep other pilgrims from falling into
+the hands of Giant Despair. So they agreed to put up there a pillar,
+and to write on it this sentence: "Over this stile is the way to
+Doubting Castle, which is kept by Giant Despair, who despiseth the
+King of the Celestial Country and seeks to destroy His holy pilgrims."
+
+Many pilgrims, that came after, read what was written and escaped
+Giant Despair. They then went on till they came to the Delectable
+Mountains. These mountains belonged to the Lord of the steep hill
+which Christian had climbed. So they went up these mountains to behold
+the gardens and orchards, the vineyards and fountains. There, too,
+they drank and washed themselves and ate the fruit of the vineyards.
+Now there were Shepherds on the mountains, who welcomed them lovingly
+and showed them many wonders. First they took them to the top of a
+hill which was very steep on one side, and bid them look down to the
+bottom. So Christian and Hopeful looked down, and saw at the bottom
+several men dashed all to pieces by a fall that they had had from the
+top.
+
+"These," said the Shepherds, "are for an example to others to be
+careful not to clamber too high, or to come too near the brink of this
+mountain." The name of this mountain was Error.
+
+Then the Shepherds took them to the top of another mountain, and the
+name of it was Caution, and the Shepherds bid them look afar off. When
+the pilgrims did this, they saw, as they thought, several men walking
+up and down among the tombs that were there. And they saw that the men
+were blind, because they stumbled sometimes upon the tombs, and
+because they could not get out from among them.
+
+Then said Christian, "What means this?"
+
+The Shepherds then answered, "Did you see a little below these
+mountains a stile that led into a meadow?"
+
+They answered, "Yes."
+
+"From that stile," said the Shepherds, "there goes a path that leads
+straight to Doubting Castle, which is kept by Giant Despair. These
+men," and the Shepherds pointed to those among the tombs, "came once
+on a pilgrimage as you do now. But when they came to the stile,
+because the right way was rough, they went over it into the meadow.
+Here they were taken by Giant Despair and cast into Doubting Castle.
+After they had been kept some time in the dungeon, he at last did put
+out their eyes. Then he led them among those tombs, and left them to
+wander there till this very day."
+
+Then Christian and Hopeful thought of their escape from Doubting
+Castle, and they looked at one another with tears in their eyes. But
+yet they said nothing to the Shepherds. Now I saw in my dream that the
+Shepherds brought them to another place, where was a door in the side
+of a hill, and they opened the door and bid the pilgrims look in. They
+looked in therefore and saw that within it was very dark and smoky.
+They also thought that they heard there a rumbling noise as of fire,
+and a cry as of some in trouble.
+
+Then said Christian, "What means this?"
+
+The Shepherds said, "This is a byway to hell."
+
+And the Shepherds said one to another, "Let us show the pilgrims the
+gates of the Celestial City, if they have skill to look through our
+glass."
+
+So they took Christian and Hopeful to the top of another high hill,
+called Clear, and gave them the glass to look. They tried to look, but
+the remembrance of that last thing the Shepherds had showed them made
+their hands shake, so that they could not look steadily through the
+glass. Yet they thought they saw something like the gate, and also
+some of the beauty of the place. When they were about to depart, one
+of the Shepherds gave them a note of the way. Another of them bid
+them beware when they met the Flatterer. The third bid them take heed
+that they did not sleep upon the Enchanted Ground. And the fourth bid
+them "Godspeed." So I awoke from my dream.
+
+And I slept and dreamed again, and I saw the same two pilgrims going
+down the mountains and along the highway. They went on then till they
+came to a place where they saw another path that seemed to be as
+straight as the way which they should go. And here they knew not which
+of the two to take, for both seemed straight before them, therefore
+here they stood still to think.
+
+And as they were thinking about the way, behold, a man, black of
+flesh, but covered with a very light robe, came to them, and asked
+them why they stood there.
+
+They answered they were going to the Celestial City, but knew not
+which of these ways to take.
+
+"Follow me," said the man. "It is there I am going."
+
+So they followed him in the path that had joined the way, and this
+path slowly turned, and at last turned them so far from the City that
+they wished to go to, that in a little time their faces were turned
+away from it. Yet they still followed him. But by and by before they
+knew what had happened, he led them both into a net, in which they
+were so entangled that they knew not what to do. Then the white robe
+fell off the black man's back, and they knew that he was the Flatterer
+and had brought them into his net. Wherefore there they lay, crying
+some time, for they could not get themselves out. And as they lay
+weeping in the net, they saw a Shining One coming toward them with a
+whip of small cord in his hand. When he was come to the place where
+they were, he asked them whence they came, and what they were doing
+there.
+
+They told him that they were poor pilgrims going to Zion, but were led
+out of their way by a black man clothed in white. "He bid us," said
+they, "follow him, for he was going thither too."
+
+Then said the Shining One, "It is a Flatterer that has clothed himself
+like an angel of light." So he rent the net and let the men out. And
+he said to the pilgrims, "Follow me," and he led them back to the way
+which they had left when they followed the Flatterer.
+
+The one with the whip then asked them where they slept last night.
+
+They said, "With the Shepherds on the Delectable Mountains."
+
+He asked them if the Shepherds had not given them a note, telling them
+about the way. They answered, "Yes," but they had forgotten to read
+it. He asked them also if the Shepherds did not tell them to beware of
+the Flatterer. They answered, "Yes," but they did not think that this
+man who spoke so well could be he. Then I saw in my dream that the
+Shining One commanded them to lie down. And he took his whip, and when
+he had whipped them he said, "As many as I love I rebuke and punish,
+be careful therefore and repent."
+
+This done, he bid them go on their way and take good heed to the other
+directions of the Shepherds. So they thanked the Shining One for all
+his kindness, and went gladly along the right way. Now I saw in my
+dream that when the pilgrims had got safely over the Enchanted Ground,
+they entered a beautiful country where the air was very sweet and
+pleasant. Every day they heard continually the singing of birds, and
+every day they saw the flowers appear in the earth. In this country
+the sun shineth night and day, and here they were within sight of the
+City to which they went. So I saw that as they went on, there met them
+two men in raiment that shone like gold, also their faces shone as the
+light. These men asked the pilgrims where they came from, and they
+told them. They also asked them where they had lodged, what
+difficulties and dangers, what comforts and pleasures they had met in
+the way, and they told them.
+
+Then said the men that met them, "You have but two difficulties more
+to meet and then you are in the City." So they all walked together
+till they came in sight of the gate.
+
+Now I saw that between them and the gate was a river, but there was no
+bridge to go over, and the river was deep. At the sight of the river
+Christian and Hopeful were stunned, but the men that went with them
+said, "You must go through, or you cannot come in at the gate."
+
+The pilgrims then, especially Christian, began to be afraid, and
+looked this way and that way, but could find no way by which to escape
+the river. Then they entered the river, and Christian began to sink
+and to cry out to his friend Hopeful, saying, "I sink in deep waters,
+the billows go over my head."
+
+But Hopeful cheered Christian, and said he felt the ground under his
+feet. Yet a great horror and darkness fell upon Christian, for he
+thought he should never reach the Celestial City, and Hopeful had much
+difficulty to keep his friend's head above water. Then I saw in my
+dream that at last Christian took courage, and soon he found ground to
+stand upon, and the rest of the river was shallow. Thus they got over.
+Now upon the bank of the river, on the other side, they saw the two
+shining men again, who waited there for them, and led them toward the
+gate.
+
+The City stood upon a mighty hill, but the pilgrims went up that with
+ease, talking gladly to their shining companions, and thus they came
+up to the gate.
+
+And over the gate there were written in letters of gold "Blessed are
+they that do the King's Commandments and may enter in through the
+gates into the City."
+
+I saw in my dream that these two men went in at the gate, and lo! as
+they entered they were transfigured. And they had raiment put on that
+shone like gold. They had harps given to them to praise on, and crowns
+were given to them in token of honor.
+
+Then I heard in my dream that all the bells in the City rang again for
+joy, and that it was said, "Enter ye into the joy of your Lord."
+
+Now just as the gates were opened to let in the men, I looked in after
+them, and behold, the City shone like the sun, the streets also were
+paved with gold. And I heard many voices saying, "Holy, holy, holy is
+the Lord."
+
+And after that they shut up the gates, and when I had seen this, I
+wished I myself were within. So I awoke, and behold it was a dream.
+
+
+
+
+TALES FROM SHAKESPEARE
+
+By CHARLES AND MARY LAMB
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+THE TEMPEST
+
+
+There was a certain island in the sea, the only inhabitants of which
+were an old man, whose name was Prospero, and his daughter Miranda, a
+very beautiful young lady. She came to this island so young, that she
+had no memory of having seen any other human face than her father's.
+
+They lived in a cave or cell, made out of a rock; it was divided into
+several apartments, one of which Prospero called his study; there he
+kept his books, which chiefly treated of magic, a study at that time
+much affected by all learned men: and the knowledge of this art he
+found very useful to him; for being thrown by a strange chance upon
+this island, which had been enchanted by a witch called Sycorax, who
+died there a short time before his arrival, Prospero, by virtue of his
+art, released many good spirits that Sycorax had imprisoned in the
+bodies of large trees, because they had refused to execute her wicked
+commands. These gentle spirits were ever after obedient to the will of
+Prospero. Of these Ariel was the chief.
+
+The lively little sprite Ariel had nothing mischievous in his nature,
+except that he took rather too much pleasure in tormenting an ugly
+monster called Caliban, for he owed him a grudge because he was the
+son of his old enemy Sycorax. This Caliban, Prospero found in the
+woods, a strange misshapen thing, far less human in form than an ape:
+he took him home to his cell, and taught him to speak; and Prospero
+would have been very kind to him, but the bad nature which Caliban
+inherited from his mother Sycorax, would not let him learn anything
+good or useful: therefore he was employed like a slave, to fetch
+wood, and do the most laborious offices; and Ariel had the charge of
+compelling him to these services.
+
+When Caliban was lazy and neglected his work, Ariel (who was invisible
+to all eyes but Prospero's) would come slily and pinch him, and
+sometimes tumble him down in the mire; and then Ariel, in the likeness
+of an ape, would make mouths at him. Then swiftly changing his shape,
+in the likeness of a hedgehog, he would lie tumbling in Caliban's way,
+who feared the hedgehog's sharp quills would prick his bare feet. With
+a variety of such-like vexatious tricks Ariel would often torment him,
+whenever Caliban neglected the work which Prospero commanded him to
+do.
+
+Having these powerful spirits obedient to his will, Prospero could by
+their means command the winds, and the waves of the sea. By his orders
+they raised a violent storm, in the midst of which, and struggling
+with the wild sea-waves that every moment threatened to swallow it up,
+he showed his daughter a fine large ship, which he told her was full
+of living beings like themselves. "O my dear father," said she, "if by
+your art you have raised this dreadful storm, have pity on their sad
+distress. See! the vessel will be dashed to pieces. Poor souls! they
+will all perish. If I had power, I would sink the sea beneath the
+earth, rather than the good ship should be destroyed, with all the
+precious souls within her."
+
+"Be not so amazed, daughter Miranda," said Prospero; "there is no harm
+done. I have so ordered it, that no person in the ship shall receive
+any hurt. What I have done has been in care of you, my dear child. You
+are ignorant who you are, or where you came from, and you know no more
+of me, but that I am your father, and live in this poor cave. Can you
+remember a time before you came to this cell? I think you cannot, for
+you were not then three years of age."
+
+"Certainly I can, sir," replied Miranda.
+
+"By what?" asked Prospero; "by any other house or person? Tell me what
+you can remember, my child."
+
+Miranda said, "It seems to me like the recollection of a dream. But
+had I not once four or five women who attended upon me?"
+
+Prospero answered, "You had, and more. How is it that this still lives
+in your mind? Do you remember how you came here?"
+
+"No, sir," said Miranda, "I remember nothing more."
+
+"Twelve years ago, Miranda," continued Prospero, "I was duke of Milan,
+and you were a princess, and my only heir. I had a younger brother,
+whose name was Antonio, to whom I trusted everything; and as I was
+fond of retirement and deep study, I commonly left the management of
+my state affairs to your uncle, my false brother (for so indeed he
+proved). I, neglecting all worldly ends buried among my books, did
+dedicate my whole time to the bettering of my mind. My brother Antonio
+being thus in possession of my power, began to think himself the duke
+indeed. The opportunity I gave him of making himself popular among my
+subjects awakened in his bad nature a proud ambition to deprive me of
+my dukedom: this he soon effected with the aid of the king of Naples,
+a powerful prince, who was my enemy."
+
+"Wherefore," said Miranda, "did they not that hour destroy us?"
+
+"My child," answered her father, "they durst not, so dear was the love
+that my people bore me. Antonio carried us on board a ship, and when
+we were some leagues out at sea, he forced us into a small boat,
+without either tackle, sail, or mast: there he left us, as he thought,
+to perish. But a kind lord of my court, one Gonzalo, who loved me, had
+privately placed in the boat, water, provisions, apparel, and some
+books which I prize above my dukedom."
+
+"O my father," said Miranda, "what a trouble must I have been to you
+then!"
+
+"No, my love," said Prospero, "you were a little cherub that did
+preserve me. Your innocent smiles made me bear up against my
+misfortunes. Our food lasted till we landed on this desert island,
+since then my chief delight has been in teaching you, Miranda, and
+well have you profited by my instructions."
+
+"Heaven thank you, my dear father," said Miranda. "Now pray tell me,
+sir, your reason for raising this sea-storm?"
+
+"Know then," said her father, "that by means of this storm, my
+enemies, the king of Naples, and my cruel brother, are cast ashore
+upon this island."
+
+Having so said, Prospero gently touched his daughter with his magic
+wand, and she fell fast asleep; for the spirit Ariel just then
+presented himself before his master, to give an account of the
+tempest, and how he had disposed of the ship's company, and though the
+spirits were always invisible to Miranda, Prospero did not choose she
+should hear him holding converse (as would seem to her) with the empty
+air.
+
+"Well, my brave spirit," said Prospero to Ariel, "how have you
+performed your task?"
+
+Ariel gave a lively description of the storm, and of the terrors of
+the mariners; and how the king's son, Ferdinand, was the first who
+leaped into the sea; and his father thought he saw his dear son
+swallowed up by the waves and lost. "But he is safe," said Ariel, "in
+a corner of the isle, sitting with his arms folded, sadly lamenting
+the loss of the king, his father, whom he concludes drowned. Not a
+hair of his head is injured, and his princely garments, though
+drenched in the sea-waves, look fresher than before."
+
+"That's my delicate Ariel," said Prospero. "Bring him hither: my
+daughter must see this young prince. Where is the king, and my
+brother?"
+
+"I left them," answered Ariel, "searching for Ferdinand, whom, they
+have little hopes of finding, thinking they saw him perish. Of the
+ship's crew not one is missing; though each one thinks himself the
+only one saved: and the ship, though invisible to them, is safe in the
+harbor."
+
+"Ariel," said Prospero, "thy charge is faithfully performed: but there
+is more work yet."
+
+"Is there more work?" said Ariel. "Let me remind you, master, you have
+promised me my liberty. I pray, remember, I have done you worthy
+service, told you no lies, made no mistakes, served you without grudge
+or grumbling."
+
+"How now!" said Prospero. "You do not recollect what a torment I freed
+you from. Have you forgot the wicked witch Sycorax, who with age and
+envy was almost bent double? Where was she born? Speak; tell me."
+
+"Sir, in Algiers," said Ariel.
+
+"O, was she so?" said Prospero. "I must recount what you have been,
+which I find you do not remember. This bad witch, Sycorax, for her
+witchcrafts, too terrible to enter human hearing, was banished from
+Algiers, and here left by the sailors; and because you were a spirit
+too delicate to execute her wicked commands, she shut you up in a
+tree, where I found you howling. This torment, remember, I did free
+you from."
+
+"Pardon me, dear master," said Ariel, ashamed to seem ungrateful; "I
+will obey your commands."
+
+"Do so," said Prospero, "and I will set you free." He then gave orders
+what further he would have him do; and away went Ariel, first to where
+he had left Ferdinand, and found him still sitting on the grass in the
+same melancholy posture.
+
+"O my young gentleman," said Ariel, when he saw him, "I will soon move
+you. You must be brought, I find, for the Lady Miranda to have a sight
+of your pretty person. Come, sir, follow me." He then began singing,
+
+ "Full fathom five thy father lies;
+ Of his bones are coral made;
+ Those are pearls that were his eyes:
+ Nothing of him that doth fade
+ But doth suffer a sea-change
+ Into something rich and strange.
+ Sea-nymphs hourly ring his knell:
+ Hark! now I hear them--Ding-dong, bell."
+
+This strange news of his lost father soon aroused the prince from the
+stupid fit into which he had fallen. He followed in amazement the
+sound of Ariel's voice, till it led him to Prospero and Miranda, who
+were sitting under the shade of a large tree. Now Miranda had never
+seen a man before, except her own father.
+
+"Miranda," said Prospero, "tell me what you are looking at yonder."
+
+"O father," said Miranda, in a strange surprise, "surely that is a
+spirit. How it looks about! Believe me, sir, it is a beautiful
+creature. Is it not a spirit?"
+
+"No, girl," answered her father; "it eats, and sleeps, and has senses
+such as we have. This young man you see was in the ship. He is
+somewhat altered by grief, or you might call him a handsome person. He
+has lost his companions, and is wandering about to find them."
+
+Miranda, who thought all men had grave faces and gray beards like her
+father, was delighted with the appearance of this beautiful young
+prince; and Ferdinand, seeing such a lovely lady in this desert place,
+and from the strange sounds he had heard, expecting nothing but
+wonders, thought he was upon an enchanted island, and that Miranda was
+the goddess of the place, and as such he began to address her.
+
+She timidly answered, she was no goddess, but a simple maid, and was
+going to give him an account of herself, when Prospero interrupted
+her. He was well pleased to find they admired each other, for he
+plainly perceived they had (as we say) fallen in love at first sight:
+but to try Ferdinand's constancy, he resolved to throw some
+difficulties in their way: therefore advancing forward, he addressed
+the prince with a stern air, telling him, he came to the island as a
+spy, to take it from him who was the lord of it. "Follow me," said he,
+"I will tie you neck and feet together. You shall drink sea-water;
+shell-fish, withered roots, and husks of acorns shall be your food."
+"No," said Ferdinand, "I will resist such entertainment, till I see a
+more powerful enemy," and drew his sword; but Prospero, waving his
+magic wand, fixed him to the spot where he stood, so that he had no
+power to move.
+
+Miranda hung upon her father, saying, "Why are you so ungentle? Have
+pity, sir; I will be his surety. This is the second man I ever saw,
+and to me he seems a true one."
+
+"Silence," said the father: "one word more will make me chide you,
+girl! What! an advocate for an impostor! You think there are no more
+such fine men, having seen only him and Caliban. I tell you, foolish
+girl, most men as far excel this, as he does Caliban." This he said to
+prove his daughter's constancy; and she replied, "My affections are
+most humble. I have no wish to see a goodlier man."
+
+"Come on, young man," said Prospero to the prince; "you have no power
+to disobey me."
+
+"I have not indeed," answered Ferdinand; and not knowing that it was
+by magic he was deprived of all power of resistance, he was astonished
+to find himself so strangely compelled to follow Prospero: looking
+back on Miranda as long as he could see her, he said, as he went after
+Prospero into the cave, "My spirits are all bound up, as if I were in
+a dream: but this man's threats, and the weakness which I feel, would
+seem light to me if from my prison I might once a day behold this fair
+maid."
+
+Prospero kept Ferdinand not long confined within the cell: he soon
+brought out his prisoner, and set him a severe task to perform, taking
+care to let his daughter know the hard labor he had imposed on him,
+and then pretending to go into his study, he secretly watched them
+both.
+
+Prospero had commanded Ferdinand to pile up some heavy logs of wood.
+King's sons not being much used to laborious work, Miranda soon after
+found her lover almost dying with fatigue. "Alas!" said she, "do not
+work so hard; my father is at his studies, he is safe for these three
+hours; pray rest yourself."
+
+"O my dear lady," said Ferdinand, "I dare not. I must finish my task
+before I take my rest."
+
+"If you will sit down," said Miranda, "I will carry your logs the
+while." But this Ferdinand would by no means agree to. Instead of a
+help Miranda became a hindrance, for they began a long conversation,
+so that the business of log-carrying went on very slowly.
+
+Prospero, who had enjoined Ferdinand this task merely as a trial of
+his love, was not at his books, as his daughter supposed, but was
+standing by them invisible, to overhear what they said.
+
+Ferdinand inquired her name, which she told, saying it was against her
+father's express command she did so.
+
+Prospero only smiled at this first instance of his daughter's
+disobedience, for having by his magic art caused his daughter to fall
+in love so suddenly, he was not angry that she showed her love by
+forgetting to obey his commands. And he listened well pleased to a
+long speech of Ferdinand's, in which he professed to love her above
+all the ladies he ever saw.
+
+In answer to his praises of her beauty, which he said exceeded all the
+women in the world, she replied, "I do not remember the face of any
+woman, nor have I seen any more men than you, my good friend, and my
+dear father. How features are abroad, I know not; but, believe me,
+sir, I would not wish any companion in the world but you, nor can my
+imagination form any shape but yours that I could like. But, sir, I
+fear I talk to you too freely, and my father's precepts I forget."
+
+At this Prospero smiled, and nodded his head, as much as to say, "This
+goes on exactly as I could wish; my girl will be queen of Naples."
+
+And then Ferdinand, in another fine long speech (for young princes
+speak in courtly phrases), told the innocent Miranda he was heir to
+the crown of Naples, and that she should be his queen.
+
+"Ah! sir," said she, "I am a fool to weep at what I am glad of. I will
+answer you in plain and holy innocence. I am your wife if you will
+marry me."
+
+Prospero prevented Ferdinand's thanks by appearing visible before
+them.
+
+"Fear nothing, my child," said he; "I have overheard, and approve of
+all you have said. And, Ferdinand, if I have too severely used you, I
+will make you rich amends, by giving you my daughter. All your
+vexations were but trials of your love, and you have nobly stood the
+test. Then as my gift, which your true love has worthily purchased,
+take my daughter, and do not smile that I boast she is above all
+praise." He then, telling them that he had business which required his
+presence, desired they would sit down and talk together till he
+returned; and this command Miranda seemed not at all disposed to
+disobey.
+
+When Prospero left them, he called his spirit Ariel, who quickly
+appeared before him, eager to relate what he had done with Prospero's
+brother and the king of Naples. Ariel said he had left them almost out
+of their senses with fear, at the strange things he had caused them to
+see and hear. When fatigued with wandering about, and famished for
+want of food, he had suddenly set before them a delicious banquet, and
+then, just as they were going to eat, he appeared visible before them
+in the shape of a harpy, a voracious monster with wings, and the
+feast vanished away. Then, to their utter amazement, this seeming
+harpy spoke to them, reminding them of their cruelty in driving
+Prospero from his dukedom, and leaving him and his infant daughter to
+perish in the sea; saying, that for this cause these terrors were
+suffered to afflict them.
+
+The king of Naples, and Antonio the false brother, repented the
+injustice they had done to Prospero: and Ariel told his master he was
+certain their penitence was sincere, and that he, though a spirit,
+could not but pity them.
+
+"Then bring them hither, Ariel," said Prospero: "if you, who are but a
+spirit, feel for their distress, shall not I, who am a human being
+like themselves, have compassion on them? Bring them, quickly, my
+dainty Ariel."
+
+Ariel soon returned with the king, Antonio, and old Gonzalo in their
+train, who had followed him, wondering at the wild music he played in
+the air to draw them on to his master's presence. This Gonzalo was the
+same who had so kindly provided Prospero formerly with books and
+provisions, when his wicked brother left him, as he thought, to perish
+in an open boat in the sea.
+
+Grief and terror had so stupefied their senses, that they did not know
+Prospero. He first discovered himself to the good old Gonzalo, calling
+him the preserver of his life; and then his brother and the king knew
+that he was the injured Prospero.
+
+Antonio with tears, and sad words of sorrow and true repentance,
+implored his brother's forgiveness, and the king expressed his sincere
+remorse for having assisted Antonio to depose his brother: and
+Prospero forgave them; and, upon their engaging to restore his
+dukedom, he said to the king of Naples, "I have a gift in store for
+you too;" and opening a door, showed him his son Ferdinand playing at
+chess with Miranda.
+
+Nothing could exceed the joy of the father and the son at this
+unexpected meeting, for they each thought the other drowned in the
+storm.
+
+"O wonder!" said Miranda, "what noble creatures these are! It must
+surely be a brave world that has such people in it."
+
+The king of Naples was almost as much astonished at the beauty and
+excellent graces of the young Miranda, as his son had been. "Who is
+this maid?" said he; "she seems the goddess that has parted us, and
+brought us thus together." "No, sir," answered Ferdinand, smiling to
+find his father had fallen into the same mistake that he had done when
+he first saw Miranda, "she is a mortal, but by immortal Providence she
+is mine; I chose her when I could not ask you, my father, for your
+consent, not thinking you were alive. She is the daughter to this
+Prospero, who is the famous duke of Milan, of whose renown I have
+heard so much, but never saw him till now: of him I have received a
+new life: he has made himself to me a second father, giving me this
+dear lady."
+
+"Then I must be her father," said the king; "but oh! how oddly will it
+sound, that I must ask my child forgiveness."
+
+"No more of that," said Prospero: "let us not remember our troubles
+past, since they so happily have ended." And then Prospero embraced
+his brother, and again assured him of his forgiveness; and said that a
+wise overruling Providence had permitted that he should be driven from
+his poor dukedom of Milan, that his daughter might inherit the crown
+of Naples, for that by their meeting in this desert island, it had
+happened that the king's son had loved Miranda.
+
+These kind words which Prospero spoke, meaning to comfort his brother,
+so filled Antonio with shame and remorse, that he wept and was unable
+to speak; and the kind old Gonzalo wept to see this joyful
+reconciliation, and prayed for blessings on the young couple.
+
+Prospero now told them that their ship was safe in the harbor, and the
+sailors all on board her, and that he and his daughter would accompany
+them home the next morning. "In the meantime," says he, "partake of
+such refreshments as my poor cave affords; and for your evening's
+entertainment I will relate the history of my life from my first
+landing in this desert island." He then called for Caliban to prepare
+some food, and set the cave in order; and the company were astonished
+at the uncouth form and savage appearance of this ugly monster, who
+(Prospero said) was the only attendant he had to wait upon him.
+
+Before Prospero left the island, he dismissed Ariel from his service,
+to the great joy of that lively little spirit; who, though he had been
+a faithful servant to his master, was always longing to enjoy his free
+liberty, to wander uncontrolled in the air, like a wild bird, under
+green trees, among pleasant fruits, and sweet-smelling flowers. "My
+quaint Ariel," said Prospero to the little sprite when he made him
+free, "I shall miss you; yet you shall have your freedom." "Thank you,
+my dear master," said Ariel; "but give me leave to attend your ship
+home with prosperous gales, before you bid farewell to the assistance
+of your faithful spirit; and then, master, when I am free, how merrily
+I shall live!" Here Ariel sung this pretty song:
+
+ "Where the bee sucks, there suck I;
+ In a cowslip's bell I lie:
+ There I crouch when owls do cry.
+ On the bat's back I do fly
+ After summer Merrily.
+ Merrily, merrily shall I live now
+ Under the blossom that hangs on the bough."
+
+Prospero then buried deep in the earth his magical books and wand, for
+he was resolved never more to make use of the magic art. And having
+thus overcome his enemies, and being reconciled to his brother and the
+king of Naples, nothing now remained to complete his happiness, but to
+revisit his native land, to take possession of his dukedom, and to
+witness the happy nuptials of his daughter and Prince Ferdinand, which
+the king said should be instantly celebrated with great splendor on
+their return to Naples. At which place, under the safe convoy of the
+spirit Ariel, they, after a pleasant voyage, soon arrived.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+A MIDSUMMER NIGHT'S DREAM
+
+
+There was a law in the city of Athens which gave to its citizens the
+power of compelling their daughters to marry whomsoever they pleased;
+for upon a daughter's refusing to marry the man her father had chosen
+to be her husband, the father was empowered by this law to cause her
+to be put to death; but as fathers do not often desire the death of
+their own daughters, even though they do happen to prove a little
+refractory, this law was seldom or never put in execution, though
+perhaps the young ladies of that city were not unfrequently threatened
+by their parents with the terrors of it.
+
+There was one instance, however, of an old man, whose name was Egeus,
+who actually did come before Theseus (at that time the reigning duke
+of Athens), to complain that his daughter Hermia, whom he had
+commanded to marry Demetrius, a young man of a noble Athenian family,
+refused to obey him, because she loved another young Athenian, named
+Lysander. Egeus demanded justice of Theseus, and desired that this
+cruel law might be put in force against his daughter.
+
+Hermia pleaded in excuse for her disobedience, that Demetrius had
+formerly professed love for her dear friend Helena, and that Helena
+loved Demetrius to distraction; but this honorable reason, which
+Hermia gave for not obeying her father's command, moved not the stern
+Egeus.
+
+Theseus, though a great and merciful prince, had no power to alter the
+laws of his country; therefore he could only give Hermia four days to
+consider of it: and at the end of that time, if she still refused to
+marry Demetrius, she was to be put to death.
+
+When Hermia was dismissed from the presence of the duke, she went to
+her lover Lysander, and told him the peril she was in, and that she
+must either give him up and marry Demetrius, or lose her life in four
+days.
+
+Lysander was in great affliction at hearing these evil tidings; but
+recollecting that he had an aunt who lived at some distance from
+Athens, and that at the place where she lived the cruel law could not
+be put in force against Hermia (this law not extending beyond the
+boundaries of the city), he proposed to Hermia that she should steal
+out of her father's house that night, and go with him to his aunt's
+house, where he would marry her. "I will meet you," said Lysander, "in
+the wood a few miles without the city; in that delightful wood where
+we have so often walked with Helena in the pleasant month of May."
+
+To this proposal Hermia joyfully agreed; and she told no one of her
+intended flight but her friend Helena. Helena (as maidens will do
+foolish things for love) very ungenerously resolved to go and tell
+this to Demetrius, though she could hope no benefit from betraying her
+friend's secret, but the poor pleasure of following her faithless
+lover to the wood: for she well knew that Demetrius would go thither
+in pursuit of Hermia.
+
+The wood in which Lysander and Hermia proposed to meet, was the
+favorite haunt of those little beings known by the name of _Fairies_.
+
+Oberon the king, and Titania the queen of the Fairies, with all their
+tiny train of followers, in this wood held their midnight revels.
+
+Between this little king and queen of sprites there happened, at this
+time, a sad disagreement: they never met by moonlight in the shady
+walks of this pleasant wood, but they were quarreling, till all their
+fairy elves would creep into acorn-cups and hide themselves for fear.
+
+The cause of this unhappy disagreement was Titania's refusing to give
+Oberon a little changeling boy, whose mother had been Titania's
+friend; and upon her death the fairy queen stole the child from its
+nurse, and brought him up in the woods.
+
+The night on which the lovers were to meet in this wood, as Titania
+was walking with some of her maids of honor, she met Oberon attended
+by his train of fairy courtiers.
+
+"Ill met by moonlight, proud Titania," said the fairy king. The queen
+replied, "What, jealous Oberon, is it you? Fairies, skip hence; I have
+forsworn his company." "Tarry, rash fairy," said Oberon; "am not I thy
+lord? Why does Titania cross her Oberon? Give me your little
+changeling boy to be my page."
+
+"Set your heart at rest," answered the queen; "your whole fairy
+kingdom buys not the boy of me." She then left her lord in great
+anger. "Well, go your way," said Oberon: "before the morning dawns I
+will torment you for this injury."
+
+Oberon then sent for Puck, his chief favorite and privy counselor.
+
+Puck (or as he was sometimes called, Robin Goodfellow) was a shrewd
+and knavish sprite, that used to play comical pranks in the
+neighboring villages; sometimes getting into the dairies and skimming
+the milk, sometimes plunging his light and airy form into the
+butter-churn, and while he was dancing his fantastic shape in the
+churn, in vain the dairy-maid would labor to change her cream into
+butter: nor had the village swains any better success; whenever Puck
+chose to play his freaks in the brewing copper, the ale was sure to be
+spoiled. When a few good neighbors were met to drink some comfortable
+ale together, Puck would jump into the bowl of ale in the likeness of
+a roasted crab, and when some old goody was going to drink he would
+bob against her lips, and spill the ale over her withered chin; and
+presently after, when the same old dame was gravely seating herself to
+tell her neighbors a sad and melancholy story, Puck would slip her
+three-legged stool from under her, and down toppled the poor old
+woman, and then the old gossips would hold their sides and laugh at
+her, and swear they never wasted a merrier hour.
+
+"Come hither, Puck," said Oberon to this little merry wanderer of the
+night; "fetch me the flower which maids call _Love in Idleness_; the
+juice of that little purple flower laid on the eyelids of those who
+sleep, will make them, when they awake, dote on the first thing they
+see. Some of the juice of that flower I will drop on the eyelids of my
+Titania when she is asleep; and the first thing she looks upon when
+she opens her eyes she will fall in love with, even though it be a
+lion or a bear, a meddling monkey, or a busy ape; and before I will
+take this charm from off her sight, which I can do with another charm
+I know of, I will make her give me that boy to be my page."
+
+Puck, who loved mischief to his heart, was highly diverted with this
+intended frolic of his master, and ran to seek the flower; and while
+Oberon was waiting the return of Puck, he observed Demetrius and
+Helena enter the wood: he overheard Demetrius reproaching Helena for
+following him, and after many unkind words on his part, and gentle
+expostulations from Helena, reminding him of his former love and
+professions of true faith to her, he left her (as he said) to the
+mercy of the wild beasts, and she ran after him as swiftly as she
+could.
+
+The fairy king, who was always friendly to true lovers, felt great
+compassion for Helena; and perhaps, as Lysander said they used to walk
+by moonlight in this pleasant wood, Oberon might have seen Helena in
+those happy times when she was beloved by Demetrius. However that
+might be, when Puck returned with the little purple flower, Oberon
+said to his favorite, "Take a part of this flower; there has been a
+sweet Athenian lady here, who is in love with a disdainful youth; if
+you find him sleeping, drop some of the love-juice in his eyes, but
+contrive to do it when she is near him, that the first thing he sees
+when he awakes may be this despised lady. You will know the man by the
+Athenian garments which he wears." Puck promised to manage this matter
+very dexterously: and then Oberon went, unperceived by Titania, to her
+bower, where she was preparing to go to rest. Her fairy bower was a
+bank, where grew wild thyme, cowslips, and sweet violets, under a
+canopy of woodbine, musk-roses, and eglantine. There Titania always
+slept some part of the night; her coverlet the enameled skin of a
+snake, which, though a small mantle, was wide enough to wrap a fairy
+in.
+
+He found Titania giving orders to her fairies, how they were to employ
+themselves while she slept. "Some of you," said her majesty, "must
+kill cankers in the musk-rose buds, and some wage war with the bats
+for their leathern wings, to make my small elves coats; and some of
+you keep watch that the clamorous owl, that nightly hoots, come not
+near me: but first sing me to sleep. Then they began to sing this
+song:
+
+ "You spotted snakes with double tongue,
+ Thorny hedgehogs, be not seen;
+ Newts and blindworms do no wrong,
+ Come not near our Fairy Queen.
+ Philomel, with melody,
+ Sing in our sweet lullaby,
+ Lulla, lulla, lullaby; lulla, lulla, lullaby;
+ Never harm, nor spell, nor charm,
+ Come our lovely lady nigh;
+ So good night with lullaby."
+
+When the fairies had sung their queen asleep with this pretty lullaby,
+they left her to perform the important services she had enjoined them.
+Oberon then softly drew near his Titania, and dropped some of the
+love-juice on her eyelids, saying,
+
+ "What thou seest when them dost wake,
+ Do it for thy true-love take."
+
+But to return to Hermia, who made her escape out of her father's house
+that night, to avoid the death she was doomed to for refusing to marry
+Demetrius. When she entered the wood, she found her dear Lysander
+waiting for her, to conduct her to his aunt's house; but before they
+had passed half through the wood, Hermia was so much fatigued, that
+Lysander, who was very careful of this dear lady, who had proved her
+affection for him even by hazarding her life for his sake, persuaded
+her to rest till morning on a bank of soft moss, and lying down
+himself on the ground at some little distance, they soon fell fast
+asleep. Here they were found by Puck, who, seeing a handsome young man
+asleep, and perceiving that his clothes were made in the Athenian
+fashion, and that a pretty lady was sleeping near him, concluded that
+this must be the Athenian maid and her disdainful lover whom Oberon
+had sent him to seek; and he naturally enough conjectured that, as
+they were alone together, she must be the first thing he would see
+when he awoke; so, without more ado, he proceeded to pour some of the
+juice of the little purple flower into his eyes. But it so fell out,
+that Helena came that way, and, instead of Hermia, was the first
+object Lysander beheld when he opened his eyes; and strange to relate,
+so powerful was the love-charm, all his love for Hermia vanished away,
+and Lysander fell in love with Helena.
+
+Had he first seen Hermia when he awoke, the blunder Puck committed
+would have been of no consequence, for he could not love that faithful
+lady too well; but for poor Lysander to be forced by a fairy
+love-charm, to forget his own true Hermia, and to run after another
+lady, and leave Hermia asleep quite alone in a wood at midnight, was a
+sad chance indeed.
+
+Thus this misfortune happened. Helena, as has been before related,
+endeavored to keep pace with Demetrius when he ran away so rudely from
+her; but she could not continue this unequal race long, men being
+always better runners in a long race than ladies. Helena soon lost
+sight of Demetrius; and as she was wandering about, dejected and
+forlorn, she arrived at the place where Lysander was sleeping. "Ah!"
+said she, "this is Lysander lying on the ground: is he dead or
+asleep?" Then, gently touching him, she said, "Good sir, if you are
+alive, awake." Upon this Lysander opened his eyes, and (the love-charm
+beginning to work) immediately addressed her in terms of extravagant
+love and admiration; telling her she as much excelled Hermia in beauty
+as a dove does a raven, and that he would run through fire for her
+sweet sake; and many more such lover-like speeches. Helena, knowing
+Lysander was her friend Hermia's lover, and that he was solemnly
+engaged to marry her, was in the utmost rage when she heard herself
+addressed in this manner; for she thought (as well she might) that
+Lysander was making a jest of her. "Oh!" said she, "why was I born to
+be mocked and scorned by every one? Is it not enough, is it not
+enough, young man, that I can never get a sweet look or a kind word
+from Demetrius; but you, sir, must pretend in this disdainful manner
+to court me? I thought, Lysander, you were a lord of more true
+gentleness." Saying these words in great anger, she ran away; and
+Lysander followed her, quite forgetful of his own Hermia, who was
+still asleep.
+
+When Hermia awoke, she was in a sad fright at finding herself alone.
+She wandered about the wood, not knowing what was become of Lysander,
+or which way to go to seek for him. In the meantime Demetrius not
+being able to find Hermia and his rival Lysander, and fatigued with
+his fruitless search, was observed by Oberon fast asleep. Oberon had
+learnt by some questions he had asked of Puck, that he had applied the
+love-charm to the wrong person's eyes; and now having found the person
+first intended, he touched the eyelids of the sleeping Demetrius with
+the love-juice, and he instantly awoke; and the first thing he saw
+being Helena, he, as Lysander had done before, began to address
+love-speeches to her; and just as that moment Lysander, followed by
+Hermia (for through Puck's unlucky mistake it was now become Hermia's
+turn to run after her lover), made his appearance; and then Lysander
+and Demetrius, both speaking together, made love to Helena, they being
+each one under the influence of the same potent charm.
+
+The astonished Helena thought that Demetrius, Lysander, and her once
+dear friend Hermia, were all in a plot together to make a jest of her.
+
+Hermia was as much surprised as Helena: she knew not why Lysander and
+Demetrius, who both before loved her, were now become the lovers of
+Helena; and to Hermia the matter seemed to be no jest.
+
+The ladies, who before had always been the dearest of friends, now
+fell to high words together.
+
+"Unkind Hermia," said Helena, "it is you who have set Lysander to vex
+me with mock praises; and your other lover Demetrius, who used almost
+to spurn me with his foot, have you not bid him call me Goddess,
+Nymph, rare, precious, and celestial? He would not speak thus to me,
+whom he hates, if you did not set him on to make a jest of me. Unkind
+Hermia, to join with men in scorning your poor friend. Have you forgot
+our school-day friendship? How often, Hermia, have we two, sitting on
+one cushion, both singing one song, with our needles working the same
+flower, both on the same sampler wrought; growing up together in
+fashion of a double cherry, scarcely seeming parted! Hermia, it is not
+friendly in you, it is not maidenly to join with men in scorning your
+poor friend."
+
+"I am amazed at your passionate words," said Hermia: "I scorn you not;
+it seems you scorn me." "Ay, do," returned Helena, "persevere,
+counterfeit serious looks, and make mouths at me when I turn my back;
+then wink at each other, and hold the sweet jest up. If you had any
+pity, grace, or manners, you would not use me thus."
+
+While Helena and Hermia were speaking these angry words to each other,
+Demetrius and Lysander left them, to fight together in the wood for
+the love of Helena.
+
+When they found the gentlemen had left them, they departed, and once
+more wandered weary in the wood in search of their lovers.
+
+As soon as they were gone, the fairy king, who with little Puck had
+been listening to their quarrels, said to him, "This is your
+negligence, Puck; or did you do this wilfully?" "Believe me, king of
+shadows," answered Puck, "it was a mistake; did not you tell me I
+should know the man by his Athenian garments? However, I am not sorry
+this has happened, for I think their jangling makes excellent sport."
+"You heard," said Oberon, "that Demetrius and Lysander are gone to
+seek a convenient place to fight in. I command you to overhang the
+night with a thick fog, and lead these quarrelsome lovers so astray in
+the dark, that they shall not be able to find each other. Counterfeit
+each of their voices to the other, and with bitter taunts provoke them
+to follow you, while they think it is their rival's tongue they hear.
+See you do this, till they are so weary they can go no farther; and
+when you find they are asleep, drop the juice of this other flower
+into Lysander's eyes, and when he awakes he will forget his new love
+for Helena, and return to his old passion for Hermia; and then the two
+fair ladies may each one be happy with the man she loves, and they
+will think all that has passed a vexatious dream. About this quickly,
+Puck, and I will go and see what sweet love my Titania has found."
+
+Titania was still sleeping, and Oberon seeing a clown near her, who
+had lost his way in the wood, and was likewise asleep: "This fellow,"
+said he, "shall be my Titania's true love;" and clapping an ass's head
+over the clown's, it seemed to fit him as well as if it had grown upon
+his own shoulders. Though Oberon fixed the ass's head on very gently,
+it awakened him, and rising up, unconscious of what Oberon had done to
+him, he went towards the bower where the fairy queen slept.
+
+"Ah! what angel is that I see?" said Titania, opening her eyes, and
+the juice of the little purple flower beginning to take effect: "are
+you as wise as you are beautiful?"
+
+"Why, mistress," said the foolish clown, "if I have wit enough to find
+the way out of this wood, I have enough to serve my turn."
+
+"Out of the wood do not desire to go," said the enamored queen. "I am
+a spirit of no common rate. I love you. Go with me, and I will give
+you fairies to attend upon you."
+
+She then called four of her fairies: their names were, Pease-blossom,
+Cobweb, Moth, and Mustard-seed.
+
+"Attend," said the queen, "upon this sweet gentleman; hop in his
+walks, and gambol in his sight; feed him with grapes and apricots, and
+steal for him the honey-bags from the bees. Come, sit with me," said
+she to the clown, "and let me play with your amiable hairy cheeks, my
+beautiful ass! and kiss your fair large ears, my gentle joy!"
+
+"Where is Pease-blossom?" said the ass-headed clown, not much
+regarding the fairy queen's courtship, but very proud of his new
+attendants.
+
+"Here, sir," said little Pease-blossom.
+
+"Scratch my head," said the clown. "Where is Cobweb?"
+
+"Here, sir," said Cobweb.
+
+"Good Mr. Cobweb," said the foolish clown, "kill me the red humblebee
+on the top of that thistle yonder; and, good Mr. Cobweb, bring me the
+honey-bag. Do not fret yourself too much in the action, Mr. Cobweb,
+and take care the honey-bag break not; I should be sorry to have you
+overflown with a honey-bag. Where is Mustard-seed?"
+
+"Here, sir," said Mustard-seed: "what is your will?"
+
+"Nothing," said the clown, "good Mr. Mustard-seed, but to help Mr.
+Pease-blossom to scratch; I must go to a barber's, Mr. Mustard-seed,
+for methinks I am marvelous hairy about the face."
+
+"My sweet love," said the queen, "what will you have to eat? I have a
+venturous fairy shall seek the squirrel's hoard, and fetch you some
+new nuts."
+
+"I had rather have a handful of dried pease," said the clown, who with
+his ass's head had got an ass's appetite. "But, I pray, let none of
+your people disturb me, for I have a mind to sleep."
+
+"Sleep, then," said the queen, "and I will wind you in my arms. O how
+I love you! how I dote upon you!"
+
+When the fairy king saw the clown sleeping in the arms of his queen,
+he advanced within her sight, and reproached her with having lavished
+her favors upon an ass.
+
+This she could not deny, as the clown was then sleeping within her
+arms, with his ass's head crowned by her with flowers.
+
+When Oberon had teased her for some time, he again demanded the
+changeling boy; which she, ashamed of being discovered by her lord
+with her new favorite, did not dare to refuse him.
+
+Oberon, having thus obtained the little boy he had so long wished for
+to be his page, took pity on the disgraceful situation into which, by
+his merry contrivance, he had brought his Titania, and threw some of
+the juice of the other flower into her eyes; and the fairy queen
+immediately recovered her senses, and wondered at her late dotage,
+saying how she now loathed the sight of the strange monster.
+
+Oberon likewise took the ass's head from off the clown, and left him
+to finish his nap with his own fool's head upon his shoulders.
+
+Oberon and his Titania being now perfectly reconciled, he related to
+her the history of the lovers, and their midnight quarrels; and she
+agreed to go with him and see the end of their adventures.
+
+The fairy king and queen found the lovers and their fair ladies, at no
+great distance from each other, sleeping on a grass-plot; for Puck, to
+make amends for his former mistake, had contrived with the utmost
+diligence to bring them all to the same spot, unknown to each other;
+and he had carefully removed the charm from off the eyes of Lysander
+with the antidote the fairy king gave to him.
+
+Hermia first awoke, and finding her lost Lysander asleep so near her,
+was looking at him and wondering at his strange inconstancy. Lysander
+presently opening his eyes, and seeing his dear Hermia, recovered his
+reason which the fairy charm had before clouded, and with his reason,
+his love for Hermia; and they began to talk over the adventures of the
+night, doubting if these things had really happened, or if they had
+both been dreaming the same bewildering dream.
+
+Helena and Demetrius were by this time awake; and a sweet sleep having
+quieted Helena's disturbed and angry spirits, she listened with
+delight to the professions of love which Demetrius still made to her,
+and which, to her surprise as well as pleasure, she began to perceive
+were sincere.
+
+These fair night-wandering ladies, now no longer rivals, became once
+more true friends; all the unkind words which had passed were
+forgiven, and they calmly consulted together what was best to be done
+in their present situation. It was soon agreed that, as Demetrius had
+given up his pretensions to Hermia, he should endeavor to prevail upon
+her father to revoke the cruel sentence of death which had been passed
+against her. Demetrius was preparing to return to Athens for this
+friendly purpose, when they were surprised with the sight of Egeus,
+Hermia's father, who came to the wood in pursuit of his runaway
+daughter.
+
+When Egeus understood that Demetrius would not now marry his daughter,
+he no longer opposed her marriage with Lysander, but gave his consent
+that they should be wedded on the fourth day from that time, being the
+same day on which Hermia had been condemned to lose her life; and on
+that same day Helena joyfully agreed to marry her beloved and now
+faithful Demetrius.
+
+The fairy king and queen, who were invisible spectators of this
+reconciliation, and now saw the happy ending of the lovers' history,
+brought about through the good offices of Oberon, received so much
+pleasure, that these kind spirits resolved to celebrate the
+approaching nuptials with sports and revels throughout their fairy
+kingdom.
+
+And now, if any are offended with this story of fairies and their
+pranks, as judging it incredible and strange, they have only to think
+that they have been asleep and dreaming, and that all these adventures
+were visions which they saw in their sleep; and I hope none of my
+readers will be so unreasonable as to be offended with a pretty
+harmless Midsummer Night's Dream.
+
+
+
+
+OLD-FASHIONED STORIES
+
+
+
+
+SIMPLE SUSAN
+
+By MARIA EDGEWORTH
+
+ADAPTED BY LOUEY CHISHOLM
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+QUEEN OF THE MAY
+
+
+Simple Susan lived one hundred years ago. Mr. Price was Susan's
+father. He rented a small farm and was always hard at work. No more
+honest man could be found far or near, and he loved his little
+daughter from the bottom of his big heart.
+
+Mrs. Price was Susan's mother. She was a good woman who was always
+busy cooking, or cleaning, or sewing. The bread and cakes made by her
+were better than those made by any one else in the village. When she
+was not doing household work, she earned money by taking in plain
+needlework. All who knew Mrs. Price liked her and were sorry she was
+so far from strong. That no girl had a better mother than Susan, every
+one agreed.
+
+John and William were Susan's little brothers. They were quite sure
+that no other boys in all the world had such a good sister as theirs.
+
+Our story begins on the evening before the first of May. Now one
+hundred years ago, Mayday was looked forward to with glee by all
+English children living in the country. Early that morning the lads
+and lasses of the village, gaily decked with flowers, would go merrily
+singing from house to house. In their midst would walk the Queen of
+the May, or sometimes, seated in a chair twined round with blossom,
+she would be carried from door to door by her little companions. With
+a wreath of their gayest flowers they would crown her their Queen, and
+for her would be woven the fairest garlands. After the May carols were
+sung, cake, coppers, or small coins would be given to the boys and
+girls.
+
+To choose their Queen and to arrange their flowers the children would
+meet on the last day of April. This they did in the village where
+Susan lived, and their meeting-place was in a corner of a field close
+by a large pink hawthorn. A shady lane ran past one side of the bush.
+On another side a sweetbrier hedge separated it from the garden
+belonging to an attorney.
+
+This attorney was a very cross man, so cross that the village people
+were always in fear of him. Although he had hedged and fenced his
+garden, it sometimes happened that there would stray into it a pig, or
+a dog, or a goat, or a goose belonging to a poor neighbor. Then the
+attorney would go to the owner of the stray animal and in a harsh
+voice demand money to pay for the damage it had done.
+
+Nor did this cruel man let people walk along the paths through his
+meadows, although they did no harm. He blocked up the stiles with
+stones and prickly shrubs, so that not even a gosling could squeeze
+under them nor a giant climb over. Even the village children were
+afraid to fly their kites near his fields, lest they should get
+entangled in his trees or fall on his ground.
+
+Mr. Case was the name of this attorney, and he had one son and a
+daughter called Barbara.
+
+For long the father paid no attention to the education of his
+children, for all his time and thought were given to money-making.
+Meanwhile Barbara and her brother ran wild with the village children.
+But suddenly Mr. Case decided to send his son to a tutor to learn
+Latin, and to employ a maid to wait upon Barbara. At the same time he
+gave strict orders that his children should no longer play with their
+old companions.
+
+The village children were not at all sorry when they heard this.
+Barbara had not been a favorite among them, for she had always wanted
+to rule them and to secure for herself the chief part in their games.
+When Barbara saw that she was not missed by her old friends she was
+vexed, and she became angry when she found that they paid no attention
+to the grand air with which she now spoke nor to the fine frocks which
+she wore.
+
+To one girl Barbara had a special dislike. This was none other than
+Susan Price, the sweetest-tempered and busiest lass in the village,
+and the pride and delight of all who knew her. The farm rented by
+Susan's father was near the house in which Mr. Case lived, and Barbara
+from her window used to watch Susan at work.
+
+Sometimes the little girl was raking the garden-plots in her neat
+garden; sometimes she was weeding the paths; sometimes she was
+kneeling at her beehive with fresh flowers for her bees, and sometimes
+she was in the hen-yard scattering corn among the eager little
+chickens. In the evening Barbara often saw her sitting in the
+summer-house over which sweet honeysuckle crept, and there, with a
+clean three-legged pine table before her upon which to lay her work,
+Susan would sew busily. Her seams were even and neat, for Mrs. Price
+had taught her daughter that what is worth doing is worth doing well.
+
+Both Susan and her mother were great favorites in the village. It was
+at Mrs. Price's door that the children began their Mayday rounds, and
+it was Susan who was usually Queen of the May.
+
+It was now time for the village children to choose their queen. The
+setting sun was shining full upon the pink blossoms of the hawthorn
+when the merry group met to make their plans for the morrow.
+
+Barbara Case, sulkily walking alone in her father's garden, heard the
+happy voices and, crouching behind the hedge that divided her from the
+other children, she listened to their plans.
+
+"Where is Susan?" were the first words she overheard.
+
+"Yes, where is Susan?" repeated a boy called Philip, stopping short in
+a tune he was playing on his pipe: "I want her to sing me this air, I
+can't remember how it goes."
+
+"And I wish Susan would come, I'm sure," cried Mary, a little girl
+whose lap was full of primroses. "She will give me some thread to tie
+up my nosegays, and she will show me where the fresh violets grow, and
+she has promised to give me a great bunch of her cowslips to wear
+to-morrow. I wish she would come."
+
+"Nothing can be done without Susan!" cried another child. "She always
+shows us where the nicest flowers are to be found in the lanes and
+meadows."
+
+"Susan must help to weave the garlands," said another.
+
+"Susan must be Queen of the May!" shouted several together.
+
+"Why does she not come?" grumbled Philip.
+
+Rose, who was Susan's special friend, now came forward to remind them
+that when Susan was late it was always because she was needed at home.
+
+"Go, Rose, and tell her to make haste," cried the impatient Philip.
+"Attorney Case is dining at the Abbey to-day, and if he comes home and
+finds us here, perhaps he will drive us away. He says this bit of
+ground belongs to his garden, but that is not true, for Farmer Price
+says we have all as much right to it as he has. He wants to rob us of
+our playground. I wish he and Bab, or Miss Barbara, as I suppose we
+must now call her, were a hundred miles away, I do. Just yesterday she
+knocked down my ninepins on purpose as she passed with her gown
+trailing in the dust."
+
+"Yes," cried Mary, "her gown is always trailing. She does not hold it
+up nicely like Susan, and in spite of all her fine clothes she never
+looks half so neat. Mamma says she hopes I shall grow like Susan, and
+so do I. I should not like to be vain like Barbara were I ever so
+rich."
+
+"Rich or poor," said Philip, "it does not become a girl to be vain,
+much less bold, as Barbara was the other day. She stood at her
+father's door, and stared at a strange gentleman who stopped near by,
+to let his horse drink. I know what he thought of Bab, by his looks,
+and of Susan too; for Susan was in her garden, bending down a branch
+of the laburnum-tree, looking at its yellow flowers which had just
+come out, and when the gentleman asked her how many miles it was to
+the next village, she answered him modestly, not bashfully as if she
+had never seen any one before, but just right. Then she pulled on her
+straw hat that had fallen back while she was looking up at the
+laburnum, and went her way home, and the gentleman said to me after
+she was gone, 'Pray, who is that neat, modest girl?' But I wish,"
+cried Philip, interrupting himself, "I wish Susan would come!"
+
+Barbara, still crouching on the other side of the hedge, heard
+everything that was said.
+
+Susan was all this time, as her friend Rose had guessed, busy at home.
+She had been kept by her father's returning later than usual. His
+supper was ready for him nearly an hour before he came home, and Susan
+swept the hearth twice, and twice put on wood to make a cheerful blaze
+for him. At last, when he did come in, he took no notice of the blaze
+or of Susan; and when his wife asked him how he was, he made no
+answer, but stood with his back to the fire, looking very gloomy.
+Susan put his supper upon the table, and set his own chair for him,
+but he pushed away the chair and turned from the table, saying, "I
+shall eat nothing, child. Why have you such a fire to roast me at this
+time of year?"
+
+"You said yesterday, father, I thought, that you liked a little
+cheerful wood-fire in the evening, and there was a great shower of
+hail. Your coat is quite wet. We must dry it."
+
+"Take it, then, child," he said, pulling it off, "I shall soon have no
+coat to dry. Take my hat, too," he went on, throwing it upon the
+ground.
+
+Susan hung up his hat, put his coat over the back of a chair to dry,
+and then stood looking at her mother, who was not well. She had tired
+herself with baking, and now, alarmed by her husband's strange
+conduct, she sat down pale and trembling. The father threw himself
+into a chair, folded his arms, and gazed into the fire.
+
+Susan was the first who ventured to break the silence. Fondling her
+father, she tried to coax him to eat the supper prepared for him.
+This, however, she could not persuade him to do, but he said, with a
+faint smile, that he thought he could eat one of her guinea-hen's
+eggs. Susan thanked him, and showed her eagerness to please her dear
+father by running as fast as she could to her neat chicken-yard. Alas!
+the guinea-fowl was not there. It had strayed into the garden of Mr.
+Case. She could see it through the paling. Going to the garden-gate,
+Susan timidly opened it, and seeing Miss Barbara walk slowly by, she
+asked if she might come in and take her guinea-fowl.
+
+Barbara, who at that moment was thinking of all she had heard the
+village children say, started when she heard Susan's voice.
+
+"Shut the gate," she said crossly, "you have no business in our
+garden. As for the hen, I shall keep it; it is always flying in here
+and plaguing us, and my father told me I might catch it and keep it
+the next time it got in, and it is in now." Then Barbara called to her
+maid Betty and bid her catch the mischievous bird.
+
+"Oh, my guinea-hen! my pretty guinea-hen!" cried Susan, as mistress
+and maid hunted the frightened, screaming creature from corner to
+corner.
+
+"Now we have it!" said Betty, holding it fast by the legs.
+
+"Then pay damages, Queen Susan, or you may say good-by to your pretty
+guinea-hen," said Barbara in a rude tone.
+
+"It has done no damage," said Susan; "but tell me what I must pay."
+
+"A shilling," said Barbara.
+
+"Oh, if only sixpence would do!" said Susan; "I have but sixpence of
+my own in the world, and here it is."
+
+"It won't do," said Barbara, turning her back.
+
+"Nay, but hear me," cried Susan, "let me at least come in to look for
+its eggs. I only want one for my father's supper. You shall have all
+the rest."
+
+"What is your father or his supper to us; is he so particular that he
+can eat none but guinea-hen's eggs?" said Barbara. "If you want your
+hen and your eggs, pay for them, and you shall have them."
+
+"I have only sixpence and you say that won't do," said Susan with a
+sigh, as she looked at her favorite which was in the maid's cruel
+hands, struggling and screaming in vain.
+
+Susan went away feeling very sad. At the door of her father's cottage
+she saw her friend Rose, who had just come to summon her to the
+hawthorn-bush.
+
+"They are all at the hawthorn, and I have come for you. We can do
+nothing without you, dear Susan," cried Rose, running to meet her the
+moment she saw her, "You are chosen Queen of the May--come, make
+haste. But what is the matter? Why do you look so sad?"
+
+"Ah!" said Susan, "don't wait for me; I can't come to you, but," she
+added, pointing to the tuft of cowslips in the garden, "gather those
+for little Mary; I promised them to her, and tell her the violets are
+under a hedge just beside the stile, on the right as we go to church.
+Good-by! never mind me; I can't come--I can't stay, for my father
+wants me."
+
+"But don't turn away your face; I won't keep you a moment; only tell
+me what is the matter," said her friend, following her into the
+cottage.
+
+"Oh, nothing, not much," said Susan; "if I had not wanted the egg in a
+great hurry for father, it would not have vexed me--to be sure I
+should have clipped my guinea-hen's wings, and then she could not have
+flown over the hedge; but let us think no more about it now," she
+added, trying to hide a tear.
+
+When Rose, however, learned that her friend's guinea-hen was kept a
+prisoner by Barbara, she was hot with indignation, and at once ran
+back to tell the story to her companions.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+BAD NEWS
+
+
+As Susan entered the cottage parlor, Farmer Price drew his chair close
+to his wife. "You see there is something amiss with me," he said; "I
+must tell you what it is." Her father lowered his voice, and Susan,
+who was not sure that he wished her to hear what he was going to say,
+moved from behind his chair.
+
+"Susan, don't go; sit down here, sweet Susan," he said, making room
+for her beside him. "I am afraid I was cross when I came in to-night,
+but I had something to vex me, as you shall hear."
+
+Then the farmer told how, a fortnight before, lots had been drawn in
+the nearest town, to see which men there and in the surrounding
+villages should leave home to be trained as soldiers. For a hundred
+years ago it was in this way that men were found to defend their
+country. Only if they were under eighteen or above forty years of age
+could they escape drawing lots.
+
+"Now, as I would be forty in ten days," said the farmer, "I was told
+just to call myself forty then and there; but the truth is the truth,
+and should be spoken at all times, come what may. And when the lots
+were drawn, it fell to me among others to leave home to be trained to
+fight. I was thinking how unhappy we should be to part, when I heard
+that if I paid nine guineas to another man, he would take my place,
+and I could remain at home with you. I had not the money, for you know
+the bad luck we had with the sheep this year, and how they died one
+after the other. But I went to Mr. Case and asked him to lend me the
+money. He said he would if I handed over to him my lease, for he said,
+'If you do not repay me the guineas I shall keep the lease until you
+do.'"
+
+"That was a fortnight ago, and to-night Attorney Case tells me he has
+discovered that, owing to some mistake in the lease, we may be turned
+out of the farm at any time. But I've not come to the worst part yet."
+
+Here Farmer Price stopped short, and his wife and Susan gazed
+anxiously into his face.
+
+"The truth must be told," he said with a deep sigh, "I must now leave
+you in three days."
+
+"Must you?" said his wife faintly. "Susan dear, open the window."
+Susan ran to do as she was bid, and then returned to her mother's
+side. The fresh air soon revived the poor woman, and she begged her
+husband to go on with his story, and to hide nothing from her.
+
+Farmer Price had no wish to hide anything from those he loved so well.
+He believed that the truth should be spoken at all times, but never
+had he found it so difficult as at this moment. What had happened was
+this. Attorney Case had met Farmer Price that evening. The farmer was
+coming home, whistling, from a new-plowed field. The Attorney was on
+horseback, and had just dined at the Abbey with Sir Arthur Somers.
+The Abbey had until lately belonged to Sir Arthur's elder brother,
+but now that he was dead, Sir Arthur owned the estate.
+
+Attorney Case had looked after the property for the elder brother, and
+was anxious to be employed by Sir Arthur. There were many farms on the
+estate, and it had been part of the Attorney's work to look after the
+repairs and to collect the rents. Unfortunately, he had an unpleasant
+way of dealing with the farmers, ordering them as he had no right to
+do, and being harsh with those who, through misfortune, had not enough
+money to to pay their rent in full. As the Attorney met Farmer Price
+he stopped him, saying, "A word with you, Farmer Price, if you please.
+Walk alongside my horse, and listen. You know the field with the pink
+hawthorn where the village children play? I am going to add it to my
+garden. I hear you say it does not belong to me. What do you mean by
+that?"
+
+"I mean what I say," said Price; "the field is not yours." So angry
+was the Attorney on hearing this, that he at once made up his mind to
+hurt the farmer as much as he could.
+
+"My good man," he said, "you will remember that a fortnight ago I lent
+you nine guineas. To-morrow morning you must return them to me."
+
+"Those guineas," replied the farmer, "I paid, as you know, to the man
+who said he would go instead of me to be trained as a soldier. But he
+has not yet gone, and I can still get the guineas back from him and go
+myself to be trained."
+
+The Attorney was not prepared for this answer. "I do not want to drive
+you to that," he said, pretending to be kind. "Now about the
+field--you do not want to add it to the farm, do you?"
+
+"Certainly not, for it is not mine."
+
+"Then why object to my having it?"
+
+"Because it is not yours. The children who play there have the right.
+It belongs to the village. Truth is truth."
+
+"And a debt is a debt," shouted the angry Attorney, "and must be paid.
+Bring me my nine guineas!"
+
+With a heavy heart Farmer Price walked on. He passed the door of his
+cottage and went in search of the man to whom he had paid the money.
+The man was quite willing to return it, as there were many others, he
+said, who would be willing to give him the same sum or more for his
+services. The moment Price got the money he took it straight to Mr.
+Case, laid it on his desk and was going away, when the Attorney called
+out, "Not so fast, you have forgotten your lease."
+
+"Ah yes! my lease, I had forgotten it. Let me have it."
+
+"Pardon me," said the Attorney with a cruel smile, "but I cannot let
+you have it. On reading it over I find that owing to a mistake you may
+be turned out of the farm at any time. I must keep it to show to Sir
+Arthur. I have no doubt he will want me to look after things for him
+as I did for his brother. Now perhaps you wish you had quietly let me
+add the field to my garden."
+
+Farmer Price said nothing, but dragged himself home a sad man.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+SUSAN'S GUINEA-FOWL
+
+
+When Susan had heard her father's story, she quite forgot the loss of
+her guinea-hen, and thought only of her poor mother who, try as she
+might, could not bear the bad news. In the middle of the night Susan
+was roused, as Mrs. Price had become ill, and it was not until early
+morning that the poor woman fell asleep, her daughter's hand locked
+fast in hers. Susan remained sitting by the bedside, breathing
+quietly. Then seeing the candle burn low, she gently withdrew her
+hand, and on tiptoe went to put out the light, lest the unpleasant
+smell should wake her mother. All was silent. The gray light of dawn
+stole into the little room; the sun rose slowly, and Susan peered
+through the small panes of the lattice window at the glorious sight. A
+few birds began to chirp, and as the little girl listened to them, her
+mother started and spoke in her sleep. Susan quickly hung up a white
+apron before the window to keep out the light, and at the same moment
+she heard in the distance the voices of the village children singing
+their Mayday songs. Soon she could see them, Philip leading the way
+playing upon his pipe and tabor, the others following with nosegays
+and garlands in their hands. They were coming towards the cottage.
+Quickly but quietly Susan unlatched the door and ran to meet them.
+
+"Here she is!--here's Susan!" they exclaimed joyfully.
+
+"Here's the Queen of the May!"
+
+"And here's her crown!" cried Rose, pressing forward.
+
+But Susan put her finger to her lips, and pointed to her mother's
+window. Philip's pipe stopped at once.
+
+"Thank you," said Susan, "but my mother is ill. I can't leave her, you
+know." Then as she gently put aside the crown, her companions asked
+her to say who should wear it for her.
+
+"Will you, dear Rose?" she said, placing the garland upon her friend's
+head. "It's a charming May morning," she added, with a smile;
+"good-by. We shall not hear your voices or the pipe when you have
+turned the corner into the village, so you need only stop till then,
+Philip."
+
+"I shall stop for all day," said Philip: "I've no wish to play any
+more."
+
+"Good-by, poor Susan! It is a pity you can't come with us," said all
+the children.
+
+Little Mary ran after Susan to the cottage door. "I forgot to thank
+you," she said, "for the cowslips. Look how pretty they are, and smell
+how sweet the violets are that I wear, and kiss me quick or I shall be
+left behind."
+
+Susan kissed the little breathless girl, and returned softly to the
+side of her mother's bed. "How grateful that child is to me for a
+cowslip only! How can I be grateful enough to such a mother as this?"
+she said to herself, as she bent over the pale face of her sleeping
+mother.
+
+Her mother's unfinished knitting lay upon a table near the bed, and
+Susan sat down in her wicker armchair, and went on with the row, in
+the middle of which Mrs. Price had stopped the evening before. "She
+taught me to knit, she taught me everything that I know," thought
+Susan, "and best of all, she taught me to love her, to wish to be like
+her." Mrs. Price, when she awoke, felt much better, but slowly there
+came back to her memory the sad news she had heard the evening before.
+She asked herself if it could have been a dream, but no, it was all
+too true. She could recall her husband's look as he had said, "I must
+leave you in three days." Then suddenly she roused herself. "Why!
+he'll want, he'll want a hundred things," she said. "I must get his
+linen ready for him. I'm afraid it's very late. Susan, why did you let
+me sleep so long?"
+
+"Everything shall be ready, dear mother; only don't hurry," said
+Susan. And indeed her mother was not able to bear any hurry, or to do
+any work that day. Susan's loving help was never more wanted. She
+understood so well, she obeyed so exactly, and when she was left to
+herself, judged so wisely, that her mother had little trouble in
+directing her. She said that Susan never did too little or too much.
+
+Susan was mending her father's linen, when Rose tapped softly at the
+window, and beckoned to her to come out. She went.
+
+"How is your mother, in the first place?" said Rose.
+
+"Better, thank you."
+
+"That is nice, and I have a little bit of good news for you
+besides--here," she said, pulling out a purse, in which there was
+money. "We'll get the guinea-hen back again--we have all agreed about
+it. This is the money that has been given to us in the village this
+May morning. At every door they gave silver. See how generous they
+have been--twelve shillings. Now we are a match for Miss Barbara. You
+won't like to leave home, so I'll go to her, and you shall see your
+guinea-hen in ten minutes."
+
+Rose hurried away, filled with joy at the thought that soon she would
+return to Susan with her lost bird.
+
+Miss Barbara's maid, Betty, was the first person she saw on reaching
+the Attorney's house. Rose said she must see Barbara and was shown
+into a parlor where the young lady sat reading a book.
+
+"How you startled me! Is it only you?" she said, looking up and seeing
+no one but the maid. Then, as she caught sight of Rose, she went on,
+"You should have said I was not at home. Pray, my good girl, what do
+you want?" she said, turning to Rose. "Is it to borrow or to beg that
+you are here?"
+
+"The person from whom I come does not wish either to borrow or to beg,
+but to pay for what she asks," answered Rose. Then opening her
+well-filled purse, she held out to Barbara a bright shilling, saying,
+"Now please be so good as to give me Susan's guinea-hen."
+
+"You may keep your shilling," replied Barbara. "It would have been
+enough if it had been paid yesterday when I asked for it, but I told
+Susan that as it was not paid then I should keep the hen, and I shall.
+You may go back and tell her so."
+
+While Barbara spoke she had been looking into the open purse in Rose's
+hand. She thought she could count at least ten shillings. Could she
+not manage to get at least five of them for the guinea-hen, she
+wondered?
+
+Rose little guessed what was going on in Barbara's mind, and exclaimed
+angrily, "We must have Susan's favorite hen, whatever it costs. If one
+shilling won't do, take two. If two won't do, take three," and she
+flung the coins one after the other on the table.
+
+"Three won't do," said Barbara.
+
+"Then take four."
+
+Barbara shook her head.
+
+A fifth shilling was offered, but Barbara, seeing that she had the
+game in her own hands, was silent.
+
+Then Rose threw down shilling after shilling, till twelve bright
+pieces lay on the table, and her purse was empty.
+
+"Now you may take the guinea-hen," said Barbara.
+
+Rose pushed the money towards the greedy girl, but at the same moment
+remembered that it had not belonged to herself alone. At once she
+seized the silver coins, and saying that she must first see if the
+friends with whom she shared them were willing to part with them, she
+ran off.
+
+When the children heard Rose's story, they were amazed, that even
+Barbara could be so mean, but they all agreed that at any cost the
+guinea-fowl must be set free. In a body they went to Susan and told
+her so, at the same time handing her the purse. Then they ran off
+without waiting to be thanked. Rose only stayed behind. Susan knew
+that she must accept the present gladly, just as she would give one
+gladly. She was much touched by the kindness of her friends, but she
+took the purse as simply as she would have given it.
+
+"Well," said Rose, "shall I go back for the guinea-hen?"
+
+"The guinea-hen!" said Susan, starting from a dream into which she had
+fallen as she looked at the purse. "Certainly I do long to see my
+pretty guinea-hen once more; but I was not thinking of her just
+then--I was thinking of my father."
+
+Now Susan had often that day heard her mother wish that she had but
+money enough in the world to pay to the man who was willing to be
+trained to fight instead of her husband.
+
+"This, to be sure, will go but a little way," thought Susan; "but
+still it may be of some use." She told her thought to Rose, and ended
+by saying that if the money was given to her to spend as she pleased,
+she would give it to her father.
+
+"It is all yours, my dear, good Susan!" cried Rose. "This is so like
+you!--but I'm sorry that Miss Bab must keep your guinea-hen. I would
+not be her for all the guinea-hens, or guineas either, in the whole
+world. Why, the guinea-hen won't make her happy, and you'll be happy
+even without it, because you are good. Let me come and help you
+to-morrow," she went on, looking at Susan's work, "if you have any
+more mending to do--I never liked work till I worked with you. I won't
+forget my thimble or my scissors," she added, laughing--"though I used
+to forget them when I was a wilder girl. I assure you I am clever with
+my needle now--try me."
+
+Susan told her friend that she would most gladly accept her help, but
+that she had finished all the needlework that was wanted at present.
+"But do you know," she went on, "I shall be very busy to-morrow. I
+won't tell you what it is that I have to do, for I am afraid I shall
+not succeed, but if I do succeed, I'll come and tell you directly,
+because you will be so glad."
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+SUSAN VISITS THE ABBEY
+
+
+Susan, who had always been attentive to what her mother taught her,
+and who had often helped her when she was baking bread and cakes for
+the family at the Abbey, now thought that she could herself bake a
+batch of bread. One of the new servants from the Abbey had been sent
+all round the village in the morning in search of loaves, and had not
+been able to procure any that were eatable. Mrs. Price's last baking
+had failed for want of good yeast. She was not now strong enough to
+attempt another herself, and when the brewer's boy came to tell her
+that he had some fine fresh yeast, she thanked him, but sighed and
+said she feared it would be of little use to her. But Susan went to
+work with great care, and the next morning when her bread came out of
+the oven, it was excellent: at least her mother said so, and she was a
+good judge. It was sent to the Abbey, and as the family had not tasted
+any good bread since they had come there, they also were warm in its
+praise. With some surprise, they heard from the housekeeper that this
+excellent bread was made by a young girl only twelve years old. The
+housekeeper, who had known Susan since she was a child, was pleased to
+have a chance to speak about her.
+
+"She is the busiest little creature, ma'am, in the world," she said to
+her mistress. "I can't so well call her little now though, since she's
+grown tall and slender to look at; and glad I am she is grown up good
+to look at; for handsome is that handsome does, ma'am. She thinks no
+more of her being handsome than I do myself; yet she has as proper a
+respect for herself, ma'am, as you have; and I always see her neat,
+and she is always with her mother, or fit people, as a girl should be.
+As for her mother, she dotes upon her, as well she may; for I should
+myself if I had half such a daughter, ma'am; and then she has two
+little brothers, and she's as good to them and, my boy Philip says,
+taught them to read more than the school-mistress did; but I beg your
+pardon, ma'am, I cannot stop myself when I once begin to talk of
+Susan."
+
+"You have really said enough to make me wish to see her," said her
+mistress. "Pray send for her now; we can see her before we go out to
+walk."
+
+The kind housekeeper gladly sent off her boy Philip for Susan, who was
+never so untidy that she could not come at once when sent for. She had
+been very busy, but orderly people can be busy and neat at the same
+time. Putting on her usual straw hat, she set out for the Abbey. On
+the way she overtook Rose's mother, who was going there too with a
+basket of fresh muslin. When Susan reached the Abbey, her simple dress
+and manners and the good sense with which she answered the questions
+put to her, pleased the ladies greatly. They saw that the housekeeper
+had not spoken too highly of the farmer's daughter.
+
+These two ladies were the sisters of Sir Arthur Somers. They were kind
+and wise; kind in wishing to spread happiness among their poor
+neighbors, and wise in wishing these people to be happy in their own
+way. They did not wish to manage them, but only to help them. As Sir
+Arthur was always willing to aid his sisters, it seemed as if they
+would prove a blessing in in the village near which they had come to
+live. When Susan took leave of the ladies, she was told they would
+call at her home that evening at six o'clock. Such a grand event as
+Susan's visit to the Abbey soon became known to Barbara Case and her
+maid, and together they watched for her return.
+
+"There she is! She has just gone into her garden," cried Bab; "we'll
+run in at once and hear all about it."
+
+Susan was gathering some marigolds and parsley for her mother's soup.
+"Well, Susan, and how are things going with you to-day?" asked
+Barbara.
+
+"My mother is rather better, she says; thank you, ma'am."
+
+"'Ma'am, how polite we have grown all of a sudden!" said Bab, winking
+at her maid. "One can see you have been in good company. Come, tell us
+all about it."
+
+"Did you see the ladies themselves," asked Betty, "or only the
+housekeeper?"
+
+"What room were you in?" went on Bab. "Did you see Miss Somers or Sir
+Arthur?"
+
+"Miss Somers," replied Susan.
+
+"Betty, she saw Miss Somers! I must hear about it. Susan, stop
+gathering those things, and have a chat with us."
+
+"I can't indeed, Miss Barbara, for my mother wants her soup, and I am
+in a hurry." And Susan ran home.
+
+"Would you believe it, her head is full of soup now?" said Bab to her
+maid. "She seems to think nothing of her visit to the Abbey. My papa
+may well call her _Simple Susan_. But simple or not I mean to get what
+I want out of her. Maybe when she has settled the grand matter of the
+soup, she'll be able to speak. I'll step in and ask to see her mother.
+That will put her in a good humor in a trice."
+
+Barbara went to the cottage and found Susan standing over a pot on the
+fire. "Is the soup ready?" she asked. "I'll wait till you take it in
+to your mother and go in with you. I want to ask her how she is,
+myself."
+
+"Sit down then, miss," said Susan, "I have put in the parsley, so the
+soup is nearly ready."
+
+Barbara sat down and plied Susan with questions. How was Miss Somers
+dressed? Were the sisters dressed alike? What were they having for
+dinner at the Abbey? Above all, what could Miss Somers mean by saying
+she would call at Farmer Price's cottage at six o'clock that evening?
+"What do you think she could mean?" asked Barbara.
+
+"What she said," replied Susan, "that she would be here at six
+o'clock."
+
+"That's plain enough," said Barbara, "but what else do you think she
+meant? People, you know, often mean more or less than they say."
+
+"They do," answered Susan, with a smile that made Barbara guess of
+whom she was thinking.
+
+But Bab did not mean Susan to know that she guessed, so she said, "I
+suppose you think that Miss Somers meant more than she said?"
+
+"I was not thinking of Miss Somers when I said what I did," replied
+Susan.
+
+There was a pause, and then Bab remarked, "How nice the soup looks!"
+
+Susan had poured it into a basin, and as she dropped over it the
+bright yellow marigold, it looked very tempting. She tasted it and
+added a little salt; tasted it again, and added a little more. Then
+she thought it was just as her mother liked it.
+
+"Oh, I must taste it!" said Bab, seizing the basin greedily.
+
+"Won't you take a spoon?" said Susan, trembling as she saw the big
+mouthfuls Barbara took with a loud noise.
+
+"Take a spoon, indeed!" exclaimed Bab. "How dare you, how dare you
+speak so to me? 'Take a spoon, pig!' was what you meant to say! I'll
+never enter your cottage again!" And she flounced out of the house.
+
+Susan stood still, amazed at the beginning of Barbara's speech, but
+her last words explained the sudden outburst.
+
+Some years before this time, when Susan was a very little girl and
+could scarcely speak, as she was eating a basin of bread and milk for
+supper at the cottage door, a great pig came up and put his nose into
+the basin. Susan was willing that the pig should have some share of
+the bread and milk, but as she ate with a spoon and he with his large
+mouth, she soon found that he was likely to have more than his share;
+and she said to him, "Take a poon, pig." The saying became a proverb
+in the village, and Susan's little companions quoted it when any one
+claimed more than his share of anything good. Barbara, who was then
+not Miss Barbara, but plain Bab, and who played with all the poor
+children in the village, was often reproved by Susan's proverb. Susan,
+as she grew up, forgot the childish saying, but Barbara remembered it,
+and it was this that she thought was in Susan's mind when she asked
+her to take a spoon.
+
+"Indeed, miss," said Betty, when she found Barbara in a passion upon
+her return from the cottage, "indeed I wonder you set your foot within
+the door. Your own papa has been at the Abbey all morning, and you can
+hear all you wish to know from him."
+
+Barbara at once ran to her father's parlor, but saw at a glance that
+he was in no mood to answer questions. Instead of leaving him alone,
+she did all in her power to find out why he had been at the Abbey, and
+what he had seen and heard there. And when she found that her father
+would tell her nothing, she ran back to her maid, saying, "Papa is so
+cross! I cannot put up with him."
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+SUSAN'S PET LAMB
+
+
+It is true that Attorney Case was not in a happy mood. His visit to
+the Abbey had made him feel sure that Sir Arthur and he would not
+agree about the treatment of the farmers who lived on the estate. One
+matter they had talked about was Sir Arthur's wish to enlarge his
+grounds and make a drive round them. A map of the estate lay upon the
+table and they looked at it together.
+
+"Ah! but I see this new road for the drive would run through Farmer
+Price's garden," said Sir Arthur. "That would never do."
+
+"It need not trouble you," said Attorney Case, "you may do as you like
+with Price's land."
+
+"How so?" asked Sir Arthur. "His lease will not be out for ten years,
+I believe."
+
+"True, that would have been the case had there not been a mistake in
+it. I have the lease and can show you." The heartless man then went on
+to explain to Sir Arthur what the mistake was.
+
+Sir Arthur remained silent.
+
+"Oh! I see," said the Attorney. "You do not wish to annoy Farmer
+Price. But just put the matter into my hands and I will manage it for
+you."
+
+"You seem to forget that to take the farm out of this poor man's hands
+would be to ruin him," replied Sir Arthur, quietly.
+
+"Indeed," said the wicked Attorney, "indeed I should be sorry for
+that, if it were not that Farmer Price is such an unruly, stubborn
+man."
+
+"An unruly man, is he? If that be so, the sooner he leaves the place
+the better. When you go home, you will be good enough to send me the
+lease that I may, for myself, see the mistake."
+
+Attorney Case got up to go. But before he went, he thought he must try
+to find out if Sir Arthur was going to employ him to look after the
+estate, that is, if he was to be the agent. "I will not trouble you
+about this lease, Sir Arthur," he said, "but will hand it to your
+agent, if you will inform me who is to have that post."
+
+"I mean to be my own agent," answered Sir Arthur, "and will myself
+look after the happiness of the people among whom I have come to
+live."
+
+It was the surprise of this reply that had sent Attorney Case home so
+cross that Barbara had said to Betty she could not put up with him.
+
+When his daughter had left him atone, the Attorney walked up and down
+the room deep in thought. "At any rate," he said to himself at last,
+"if Sir Arthur means to manage the estate himself in summer, he at
+least will need an agent in winter. I must try to get the post." And
+he still walked up and down, trying to think of some plan by which he
+would find favor at the Abbey. Now that morning he had heard the
+housekeeper at the Abbey ask the servants if any lamb were to be had
+in the village, as Sir Arthur would like to have it one day soon for
+dinner.
+
+Knowing that he himself treated those farmers best who from time to
+time gave him presents, Attorney Case thought that if he sent a gift
+to Sir Arthur, it might help him to get what he wished.
+
+No sooner had the idea struck him than the Attorney went to the
+kitchen. Standing at the door was a shepherd-boy. Barbara, too, was
+there.
+
+"Do you know of a nice fat lamb?" the Attorney asked the lad.
+
+Before the shepherd-boy could answer, Barbara exclaimed, "I know of
+one. Susan Price has a pet lamb that is as fat as fat can be."
+
+At once Attorney Case walked over to Farmer Price's cottage. He found
+Susan packing her father's little wardrobe, and as she looked up, he
+saw she had been in tears.
+
+"How is your mother to-day, Susan?" inquired the Attorney.
+
+"Worse, sir. My father goes to-morrow."
+
+"That's a pity."
+
+"It can't be helped," said Susan, with a sigh.
+
+"It can't be helped--how do you know that?" said Mr. Case.
+
+"Sir, dear sir!" cried she, looking up at him, and a sudden ray of
+hope beamed in her sweet face.
+
+"What if you could help it, Susan?" he said.
+
+Susan clasped her hands in silence.
+
+"You can help it, Susan." She started up. "What would you give now to
+have your father at home for a whole week longer?"
+
+"Anything!--but I have nothing."
+
+"Yes, you have a lamb," said the hard-hearted Attorney.
+
+"My poor little Daisy!" said Susan; "but what good can she do?"
+
+"What good can any lamb do? Is not lamb good to eat? Why do you look
+so pale, girl? Are not sheep killed every day, and don't you eat
+mutton? Is your lamb better than anybody else's, think you?"
+
+"I don't know," said Susan, "but I love her dearly."
+
+"More silly you," said he.
+
+"She feeds out of my hand, she follows me about; I have always taken
+care of her; my mother gave her to me."
+
+"Well, say no more about it, then; if you love your lamb better than
+both your father and your mother, keep it, and good morning to you."
+
+"Stay, oh stay!" cried Susan, catching his coat with an eager,
+trembling hand--"a whole week, did you say? My mother may get better
+in that time. No, I do not love Daisy half so well." The struggle in
+her mind ceased, and with a calm voice she said, "Take the lamb."
+
+"Where is it?" said the Attorney.
+
+"Grazing in the meadow, by the river-side."
+
+"It must be brought up before nightfall for the butcher, remember."
+
+"I shall not forget it," said Susan, steadily.
+
+As soon, however, as the cruel man turned his back and left the house,
+Susan sat down, and hid her face in her hands. She was soon roused by
+the sound of her mother's feeble voice calling her from the inner room
+where she lay. Susan went in.
+
+"Are you there, love? I thought I heard some strange voice just now
+talking to my child. Something's amiss, Susan," her mother went on,
+raising herself as well as she could in bed, to look at her daughter's
+face.
+
+"Would you think it amiss, then, my dear mother," said Susan, stooping
+to kiss her--"would you think it amiss if my father was to stay with
+us a week longer?"
+
+"Susan! you don't say so?"
+
+"He is, indeed, a whole week--but how burning hot your hand is
+still."
+
+"Are you sure he will stay?" asked her mother. "How do you know? Who
+told you so? Tell me all quick!"
+
+"Attorney Case told me so; he can get him leave for a week longer, and
+he has promised he will."
+
+"God bless him for it for ever and ever!" said the poor woman, joining
+her hands. "May the blessing of Heaven be with him!"
+
+Susan was silent. The next moment she was called out of the room, for
+a messenger had come from the Abbey for the bread-bill. Susan always
+made out the bills, for although she had not had many writing-lessons,
+she had taken great pains to learn, and wrote in a neat, clear hand.
+It is true she was in no mood to write or add now, but the work must
+be done. Having carefully ruled lines for the pounds, shillings and
+pence, she made out the bill and gave it to the boy who waited for it.
+Then she said to herself she would make out the other bills, for many
+of the people in the village had bought a few loaves and rolls of her
+making. "And when these are done, I may go down to the meadow to take
+leave of my poor lamb."
+
+But Susan could not find her slate, and when she did find it many of
+the figures were blurred, for Barbara had sat upon it. And then the
+numbers seemed to dance before her, and each time that she added, the
+answer was different. She went over and over the sums until her head
+ached. The table was covered with little square bits of paper on which
+she had written the bills when her father came in, holding in his hand
+an account.
+
+"Look at this, Susan!" he said, handing it to her. "How could you be
+so careless, child? What have you been thinking about to let a bill
+like that go to the Abbey? Luckily, I met the messenger and asked to
+see how much it was. Look at it."
+
+Susan looked and blushed. Instead of "loaves" she had written "lambs."
+She altered the mistake and handed the bill to her father. He,
+meantime, was looking at the papers lying on the table.
+
+"What are all these, child?" he asked.
+
+"Some of them were wrong, and I wrote them out again."
+
+"Some of them! All of them as far as I can see," said her father
+rather angrily, pointing to the papers.
+
+Susan read the bills. Most of them were for lambs instead of for
+loaves or rolls. Her thoughts had indeed been running upon the pet she
+was to part with so soon.
+
+Once more she wrote the bills, and her father, who was struck by the
+patient way she set to work, said he would himself collect the money.
+He would be proud to be able to say to the neighbors that it was all
+earned by his own little daughter. Susan heard him sigh as he passed
+the knapsack she had packed for him, but she thought she would keep
+the pleasure of telling him of his week's leave until he came home. He
+had said he would have supper in her mother's room. She would tell the
+good news then. "How delighted he will be when he hears," she said to
+herself, "but I know he will be sorry too for poor Daisy."
+
+Susan thought she would now have time to run down to the meadow by the
+river-side to see her favorite, but just as she had tied on her straw
+hat the clock struck four. This was the hour at which she always went
+to fetch her brothers from the school near the village. So, as she
+knew that the little boys would be sorry if she were late, she put off
+her visit to the lamb and went at once to meet them.
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+THE BLIND HARPER
+
+
+The dame-school, which was about a mile from the village, was a long,
+low house with a thatched roof. It was sheltered by a few old oaks,
+under which the grandparents and great-grandparents of the children
+now at school had played long ago. The play-green sloped down from the
+front of the school, and was enclosed by a rough paling. The children
+obeyed and loved the dame who taught them, for she was ever quick to
+praise them when they did well, and to give them all the pleasure she
+could. Susan had been taught by her, and the dame often told her
+little pupils that they must try to be like her, wise and modest,
+gentle and kind. As she now opened the gate, she heard the merry
+voices of the little ones, and saw them streaming out of the narrow
+door and scattering over the green.
+
+"Oh, there's Susan!" cried her two little brothers, running, leaping
+and bounding up to her; and many of the other rosy boys and girls
+crowded round her to tell of their games.
+
+Susan always liked to hear of all that made others happy, but she had
+to tell the children that if they all spoke at once she would not be
+able to hear what any of them said. The voices were still raised one
+above the other, all eager to tell about ninepins, or marbles, or
+tops, or bows and arrows, when suddenly music was heard. The children
+at once became silent, and looked round to see whence the sound came.
+Susan pointed to the great oak-tree, and they saw, sitting under its
+shade, an old man playing upon his harp. The children all drew near
+quietly, for the music was solemn; but as the harper heard little
+footsteps coming towards him, he played one of his more lively tunes.
+The merry troop pressed nearer and nearer to the old man. Then some of
+those who were in front whispered to each other, "He is blind." "What
+a pity!" "He looks very poor." "What a ragged coat he wears!" "He must
+be very old, for his hair is white; and he must have come a long way,
+for his shoes are quite worn out."
+
+All this was said while the harper tuned his harp. When he once more
+began to play, not a word was spoken, but every now and again there
+was a cry of delight. The old man then let the children name the airs
+they would like best to hear. Each, time Susan spoke, he turned his
+face quickly to where she stood, and played the tune she asked for
+over and over again.
+
+"I am blind," he said, "and cannot see your faces, but I can tell
+something about each of you by your voices."
+
+"Can you indeed?" cried Susan's little brother William, who was now
+standing between the old man's knees. "It was my sister Susan who
+spoke last. Can you tell us something about her?"
+
+"That I can, I think," said the harper, lifting the little boy on his
+knee. "Your sister Susan is good-natured."
+
+William clapped his hands.
+
+"And good-tempered."
+
+"Right," said little William, clapping louder than before.
+
+"And very fond of the little boy who sits on my knee."
+
+"Oh! right, right, quite right!" exclaimed the child, and "quite
+right" echoed on all sides.
+
+"But how do you know so much, when you are blind?" said William,
+looking hard at the old man.
+
+"Hush!" whispered John, who was a year older than his brother and very
+wise, "you should not remind him that he is blind."
+
+"Though I am blind," said the harper, "I can hear, you know, and I
+heard from your sister herself all that I told you of her, that she
+was good-tempered and good-natured and fond of you."
+
+"Oh, that's wrong--you did not hear all that from her, I'm sure," said
+John, "for nobody ever hears her praising herself."
+
+"Did not I hear her tell you," said the harper, "when you first came
+round me, that she was in a great hurry to go home, but that she would
+stay a little while, since you wished it so much? Was not that
+good-natured? And when you said you did not like the tune she liked
+best, she was not angry with you, but said, 'Then play William's
+first, if you please.' Was not that good-tempered?"
+
+"Oh, yes," said William, "it's all true; but how did you find out she
+was fond of me?"
+
+"That is such a hard question," said the harper, "that I must take
+time to think."
+
+He tuned his harp, as he thought, or seemed to think, and at this
+instant two boys, who had been searching for birds' nests in the
+hedges and who had heard the sound of the harp, came blustering up,
+and pushing their way through the circle, one of them exclaimed,
+"What's going on here? Who are you, my old fellow? A blind harper!
+Well, play us a tune, if you can play a good one--play--let's see,
+what shall he play, Bob?" added he, turning to his companion. "Play
+'Bumper Squire Jones.'"
+
+The old man, though he did not seem quite pleased with the way in
+which he was asked, played "Bumper Squire Jones." Several tunes were
+afterwards named by the same rough voice.
+
+The little children shrunk back shyly, as they looked at the bold boy.
+He was the son of Attorney Case, and as his father had not cured his
+temper when he was a child, it became worse and worse as he grew up.
+All who were younger and weaker than himself were afraid of him and
+disliked him. When the old harper was so tired that he could play no
+more, a lad who usually carried his harp for him came up, and held his
+master's hat to those around, saying, "Will you please remember us?"
+The children readily gave their halfpence to this poor, good-natured
+man, who had taken so much pains to amuse them. It pleased them better
+even than to give them to the gingerbread-woman, whose stall they
+loved to visit. The hat was held to the Attorney's son before he chose
+to see it. At last he put his hand into his pocket and pulled out a
+shilling. There was sixpenny-worth of halfpence in the hat. "I'll take
+these halfpence," said he, "and here's a shilling for you."
+
+"God bless you, sir," said the lad; but as he took the shilling which
+the young gentleman had slyly put into the blind man's hand, he saw
+that it was not worth one farthing. "I am afraid It is not good, sir,"
+said the lad, whose business it was to look at the money for his
+master.
+
+"I am afraid, then, you'll get no other," said young Case, with a rude
+laugh.
+
+"It never will do, sir, look at it yourself; the edges are all yellow.
+You can see the copper through it quite plain. Sir, nobody will take
+it from us."
+
+"I have nothing to do with that," said the rude boy, pushing away his
+hand. "You may pass it, you know, as well as I do, if you look sharp.
+You have taken it from me, and I shan't take it back again, I can tell
+you."
+
+A whisper of "that's very unjust," was heard.
+
+"Who says it's unjust?" cried the Attorney's son sternly, looking down
+upon his judges.
+
+"Is any one here among yourselves a judge of silver?" said the old
+man.
+
+"Yes, here's the butcher's boy," said the Attorney's son; "show it to
+him."
+
+He was a quiet, timid boy, and young Case fancied that he would be
+afraid to say what he thought. However, after turning the shilling
+round several times, the butcher's lad said that so far as he could
+tell, although he would not like to be quite sure of it, the coin was
+not a good one. Then, seeing the Attorney's son scowl angrily at him,
+he turned to Susan saying that she knew more than he did about money,
+as so much passed through her hands in payment of the bread she made.
+
+"I'll leave it to her," said the old harper. "If she says the shilling
+is good, we will keep it."
+
+The coin was then handed to Susan, who had not yet spoken, but now
+that she was called upon she did not shrink from telling the truth. In
+a gentle but firm tone she said, "I think the shilling is a bad one."
+
+"There's another then," cried the Attorney's son; "I have plenty of
+shillings and sixpences. They are nothing to me." And he walked away.
+
+The children now all started for their homes, and the old harper
+begged that Susan would show him the way to the village, if she were
+going there. The lad took up the harp and little William led the old
+man by the hand, while John ran on before to gather buttercups in the
+meadows. When they reached a little brook which they must cross by a
+narrow plank, Susan was afraid to leave the harper to the care of his
+little guide, so she herself took his hand and led him safely to the
+other side.
+
+Soon they reached the road, and Susan told the boy who carried his
+master's harp that he could not now lose his way. She then said
+good-by to the harper, adding that she and her brothers must take the
+short path across the fields, which would not be so pleasant for him
+because of the stiles.
+
+"I am afraid Miss Somers will be waiting," said Susan to to her
+brothers as they ran along together. "You know she said she would call
+at six o'clock, and I am sure by the length of our shadows that it is
+getting late."
+
+
+
+
+VII
+
+GOOD NEWS
+
+
+When they came to their own cottage-door, they heard voices, and they
+saw, when they entered, two ladies standing in the kitchen.
+
+"Come in, Susan," said Miss Somers, "I fancy you forgot that we
+promised to pay you a visit this evening; but you need not blush so
+much, there is no great harm done; we have only been here about five
+minutes and we have been admiring your neat garden and your tidy
+shelves. Is it you, Susan, who keeps these things in such nice order?"
+went on Miss Somers, looking round the kitchen.
+
+Before Susan could reply, little William pushed forward and answered,
+"Yes, ma'am, it is my sister Susan that keeps everything neat; and she
+always comes to school for us too, which was what caused her to be so
+late."
+
+"Because," went on John, "she would not refuse to let us hear a blind
+man play on the harp. It was we who kept her, and we hope, ma'am, as
+you seem so good, you won't take it amiss."
+
+Miss Somers and her sister smiled as they listened to Susan's little
+brothers, but what they heard made them feel sure that Susan was
+indeed as kind a sister as the housekeeper had said.
+
+When the ladies left the cottage, they took Susan with them through
+the village.
+
+"I fancy we shall find what we want here," said Miss Somers, stopping
+before a shop-window where ribbons of all colors were displayed, and
+where lace collars, glass buttons and sheets of pins were laid out in
+order. They went in, and on the shelves behind the counter saw gay,
+neat linens and calicoes.
+
+"Now, Susan, choose yourself a gown," said Miss Somers. "Because you
+are a busy girl and behave well, we wish others to see that such is
+the conduct we approve."
+
+The shopkeeper was the father of Susan's friend, Rose. He stretched
+his arm to the highest shelf, then dived into drawers beneath the
+counter, sparing no pains to show the best goods to his customers.
+
+Susan did not show the interest that might have been expected. She was
+thinking much of her lamb and more of her father. Miss Somers had put
+a bright guinea into her hand and told her to pay for her own gown.
+But Susan felt that this was a great deal of money to spend upon a
+frock for herself, and yet she did not know how to ask if she might
+keep it for a better purpose. Although Susan said nothing, Miss Somers
+read in her face that she was perplexed. "She does not like any of
+these things," whispered the lady to her sister.
+
+"She seems to be thinking of something else," was the low reply.
+
+"If you do not fancy any of these calicoes," said the shopkeeper to
+Susan, "we shall have a larger choice soon."
+
+"Oh," answered Susan, with a smile, and a blush, "these are all too
+good for me, but--"
+
+"But what, Susan?" asked Miss Somers. "Tell us what is passing in your
+little mind."
+
+Susan said nothing.
+
+"Well then, it does not matter. You do not know us very well yet. When
+you do, you will not, I am sure, be afraid to be frank. Put the guinea
+in your pocket and make what use of it you please. From what we know
+and from what we have heard of you, we are sure you will make a good
+use of it."
+
+"I think, madam," said the shopkeeper, "I have a pretty good guess
+what will become of that guinea, but I say nothing."
+
+"No, that is right," said Miss Somers; "we leave Susan to do just as
+she likes with it, and now we must not keep her any longer. Good
+night, Susan, we shall soon come again to your neat cottage."
+
+Susan courtesied and looked gratefully at the ladies, but did not
+speak. She wished to say, "I cannot explain to you here, with people
+around, what I want to do with my guinea, but when you come to our
+cottage you shall know all."
+
+After Susan had left, Miss Somers turned to the obliging shopkeeper
+who was folding up all the goods he had opened. "You have had a great
+deal of trouble," she said, "and as Susan will not choose a gown for
+herself, I must find one for her," and she chose the prettiest.
+
+While the man rolled up the parcel, Miss Somers asked him many
+questions about Susan, and he was only too glad to be able to tell
+what he knew about the good girl.
+
+"No later than last May morning," he said, "Susan acted as it will
+please you to hear. She was to have been Queen of the May, which among
+the children in our village is a thing a good deal thought of. But
+Susan's mother was ill, and Susan, after being up with her all night,
+would not go out in the morning, even when they brought the crown to
+her. She put it upon my daughter Rose's head with her own hands, and
+to be sure Rose loves her as well as if she were her own sister. If I
+praise Susan it is not that I am any relation of the Prices, but just
+that I wish her well, as does every one that knows her. I'll send the
+parcel up to the Abbey, shall I, ma'am?"
+
+"If you please," said Miss Somers, "and as soon as your new goods come
+in, let us know. You will, I hope, find us good customers and
+well-wishers," she added, with a smile, "for those who wish others
+well surely deserve to have well-wishers themselves."
+
+But to return to Susan. When she left the shop she carefully put the
+bright guinea into the purse with the twelve shillings her little
+friends had given her on Mayday. She next added, as far as she could
+remember them, the bills for bread that were owing to her, and found
+they came to about thirty-eight shillings. Then she hoped that by some
+means or other she might, during the week her father was to remain at
+home, make up the nine guineas that would enable him to stay with them
+altogether. "If that could but be," she said to herself, "how happy it
+would make my mother! She is already a great deal better since I told
+her my father would stay for a week longer. Ah! but she would not have
+blessed Attorney Case, if she had known about my poor Daisy." Susan
+had now reached the path that led to the meadow by the river-side. She
+wanted to go there alone and take leave of her lamb. But her little
+brothers, who were watching for her return, ran after her as soon as
+they saw her and overtook her as she reached the meadow.
+
+"What did that good lady want with you?" cried William; but looking up
+in his sister's face, he saw tears in her eyes, and he was silent and
+walked on quietly. Susan saw her lamb by the water-side.
+
+"Who are those two men?" said William. "What are they going to do with
+Daisy?"
+
+The two men were Attorney Case and the butcher. The butcher was
+feeling whether the lamb was fat.
+
+Susan sat down upon the bank in silent sorrow. Her little brothers ran
+up to the butcher and asked whether he was going to do any harm to the
+lamb. The butcher did not answer, but the Attorney replied, "It is not
+your sister's lamb any longer; it's mine."
+
+"Yours!" cried the children with terror; "and will you kill it?"
+
+"No, that is what the butcher will do."
+
+The little boys now burst into loud cries. They pushed away the
+butcher's hand; they threw their arms round the neck of the lamb; they
+kissed its forehead. It bleated. "It will not bleat to-morrow!" said
+William, and he wept bitterly.
+
+The butcher looked aside, and hastily rubbed his eyes with the corner
+of his blue apron. The Attorney stood unmoved; he pulled up the head
+of the lamb, which had just stooped to crop a mouthful of clover. "I
+have no time to waste," he said. "Butcher, I leave it to you. If it's
+fat--the sooner the better. I've nothing more to say." And he walked
+off, deaf to the prayers of the poor children. As soon as the Attorney
+was out of sight, Susan rose from the bank where she was seated, came
+up to her lamb, and stooped to gather some of the fresh dewy clover,
+that she might feed her pet for the last time. Poor Daisy licked the
+well-known hand.
+
+"Now, let us go," said Susan.
+
+"I'll wait as long as you please," said the butcher.
+
+Susan thanked him, but walked away quickly, without looking back. Her
+little brothers begged the man to stay a few minutes, for they had
+gathered a handful of blue speedwell and yellow crowsfoot, and they
+were decking the poor animal. As it followed the boys through the
+village, the children looked after them as they passed, and the
+butcher's own son was among the number. The boy remembered Susan's
+firmness about the shilling, for it had saved him a beating. He went
+at once to his father to beg him to spare the lamb.
+
+"I was thinking about it myself," said the butcher. "It's a sin to
+kill a pet lamb, I'm thinking. Anyway, it's what I'm not used to, and
+don't fancy doing. But I've a plan in my head and I'm going
+straightway to Attorney Case. But he's a hard man, so we'll say
+nothing to the boys, lest nothing comes of it. Come, lads," he went
+on, turning to the crowd of children, "it is time you were going your
+ways home. Turn the lamb in here, John, into the paddock for the
+night." The butcher then went to the Attorney.
+
+"If it's a good, fat, tender lamb you want for Sir Arthur," he said,
+"I could let you have one as good or better than Susan's and fit to
+eat to-morrow."
+
+As Mr. Case wished to give the present to Sir Arthur as soon as he
+could, he said he would not wait for Susan's lamb, but would take the
+one offered by the butcher. In the meantime Susan's brothers ran home
+to tell her that the lamb was put into the paddock for the night. This
+was all they knew, but even this was some comfort to the poor girl.
+Rose was at Farmer Price's cottage that evening, and was to have the
+pleasure of hearing Susan tell her father the good news that he might
+stay at home for one week longer. Mrs. Price was feeling better and
+said that she would sit up to supper in her wicker armchair. As Susan
+began to get ready the meal, little William, who was standing at the
+house-door watching for his father's return, called out suddenly,
+"Susan, why here is our old man!"
+
+"Yes," said the blind harper, "I have found my way to you. The
+neighbors were kind enough to show me where-abouts you lived; for,
+though I didn't know your name, they guessed who I meant by what I
+said of you all."
+
+Susan came to the door, and the old man was delighted to hear her
+speak again. "If it would not be too bold," said he, "I'm a stranger
+in this part of the country, and come from afar off. My boy has got a
+bed for himself here in the village; but I have no place. Could you be
+so kind as to give an old blind man a night's lodging?"
+
+Susan said she would step in and ask her mother, and she soon returned
+with an answer that he was heartily welcome, if he could sleep upon
+the children's bed, which was but small.
+
+The old man entered thankfully, and, as he did so, struck his head
+against the low roof. "Many roofs that are twice as high do not
+shelter folk so kind," he said. For he had just come from the house of
+Mr. Case, and Barbara, who had been standing at the hall-door, said he
+could have no help there. The old man's harp was set down in Farmer
+Price's kitchen, and he promised to play a tune for the boys before
+they went to bed, as their mother had given them leave to sit up to
+supper with their father.
+
+The farmer came home with a sad face, but how soon did it brighten,
+when Susan, with a smile, said to him, "Father, we've good news for
+you! good news for us all!--You have a whole week longer to stay with
+us; and perhaps," she went on, putting her little purse into his
+hands--"perhaps with what's here, and the bread-bills, and what may
+somehow be got together before a week's at an end, we may make up the
+nine guineas. Who knows, dearest mother, but we may keep him with us
+for ever!" As she spoke, she threw her arms round her father, who
+pressed her to him without speaking, for his heart was full. It was
+some little time before he could believe that what he heard was true;
+but the smiles of his wife, the noisy joy of his little boys, and the
+delight that shone in Susan's face at last convinced him that he was
+not in a dream.
+
+As they sat down to supper, the old harper was made welcome to his
+share of the simple meal.
+
+Susan's father, as soon as supper was finished, even before he would
+let the harper play a tune for his boys, opened the little purse which
+Susan had given him. He was surprised at the sight of the twelve
+shillings, and still more, when he came to the bottom of the purse to
+see the bright golden guinea.
+
+"How did you come by all this money, Susan?" said he.
+
+"How, I can't make out, except by the baking," said her proud mother.
+"Hey, Susan, is this your first baking?"
+
+"Oh, no, no," said her father, "I have the money for her first baking
+snug here, besides, in my pocket. I kept it for a surprise, to do your
+mother's heart good, Susan. Here's twenty-nine shillings, and the
+Abbey bill, which is not paid yet, comes to ten more. What think you
+of this, wife? Have we not a right to be proud of our Susan? Why," he
+went on, turning to the harper, "I ask your pardon for speaking before
+strangers in praise of my own child; but the truth is the fittest
+thing to be spoken, I think, at all times. Here's your good health,
+Susan. Why, by and by she'll be worth her weight in gold--in silver at
+least. But tell us, child, how came you by all this wealth, and how
+comes it that I don't go to-morrow? The happy news makes me so gay,
+I'm afraid I shall hardly understand it rightly. Speak on, child--but
+first bring us a bottle of the good mead you made last year from your
+own honey."
+
+Susan did not like to tell the story of her guinea-hen, of the gown,
+and of her poor lamb. Part of this would seem as if she were speaking
+of her own good deeds, and part of it she did not like to remember.
+But her mother begged to know the whole, and she told it as simply as
+she could. When she came to the story of her lamb, her voice faltered,
+and everybody present was touched. The old harper sighed once, and
+cleared his throat several times. He then asked for his harp, and
+after tuning it for long, he played the air he had promised to the
+boys.
+
+
+
+
+VIII
+
+BARBARA VISITS THE ABBEY
+
+
+The old blind man had come from the mountains of Wales to try to gain
+a prize of ten guineas. This prize was to be awarded to the harper who
+should play the best at a large town about five miles from the village
+where Susan lived. In the evening, after the prize-giving was over,
+there was to be a ball in the town, so the events of the day were
+looked forward to by many around. Barbara was one of those who grew
+more and more excited as the time for the prize-giving and ball drew
+near. She longed to be asked to go there by some of the rich neighbors
+who could drive her in their carriage. So how pleased she was when,
+on the evening that her father and the butcher were talking about
+Susan's lamb, a servant in livery from the Abbey left a note for Mr.
+and Miss Barbara Case! It was to invite them to dinner and tea at the
+Abbey next day.
+
+"Now they will find out," cried Bab, "that I am indeed a genteel
+person, and they will wish to take me to the ball. At any rate, I
+shall do my best to be asked."
+
+"To be sure," said Betty, "a lady who would visit Susan Price might
+well be glad to take you in her carriage."
+
+"Then pray, Betty, do not forget to send to town first thing to-morrow
+for my new bonnet. Without that the ladies of the Abbey will think
+nothing of me. And I must coax Papa to buy me a new gown for the ball.
+I shall look well at all the ladies' dresses at the Abbey to-morrow
+and find out the fashion. And Betty, I have thought of a charming
+present to take Miss Somers. I shall give her Susan's guinea-hen. It's
+of no use to me, so carry it up early in the morning to the Abbey,
+with my compliments."
+
+Feeling quite sure that her bonnet and the guinea-fowl would make Miss
+Somers think well of her, Barbara paid her first visit to the Abbey.
+She expected to see wonders, but when she was shown into the room
+where Miss Somers and other ladies were sitting, simply dressed, and
+with work, books and drawings on the table before them, she was
+surprised and vexed. There was nothing grand to be seen anywhere.
+
+When Miss Somers tried to find out what would interest her, and talked
+of walks, and flowers and gardens, Miss Barbara was offended. "I will
+show them," she said to herself, "that I can talk of other things." So
+in a grand tone she spoke of what she did not understand, until her
+mistaken airs of gentility made the ladies of the Abbey feel first
+amused and then ashamed. One by one the ladies left the room, and when
+Miss Somers went to change her dress for dinner, Barbara was left
+alone with some pretty drawings to amuse her. But the silly girl paid
+no heed to these. She could think only of the ball. Suddenly she
+remembered that nothing had been said about the guinea-hen. The truth
+was that Betty, in the hurry of dressing Barbara for her visit to the
+Abbey, had forgotten the bird, but it arrived just as Miss Somers was
+dressing. The housekeeper went to her mistress's room to say it had
+come.
+
+"Ma'am," she said, "here's a beautiful guinea-hen just come with Miss
+Barbara Case's compliments."
+
+Miss Somers thought by the housekeeper's tone that she was not quite
+pleased, and she soon found she was right in thinking so. The woman
+came close up to the dressing-table, and said, "I never like to speak
+till I'm sure, ma'am, and I'm not quite sure in this case, ma'am, but
+still I think it right to tell you what crossed my mind about this
+same guinea-hen, ma'am, and you can ask about it or do as you feel
+best, ma'am. Some time ago we had guinea-fowls of our own, and not
+knowing they were going to die as they have done, ma'am, I made bold
+to give a couple last Christmas to Susan Price, and very proud of them
+she was, ma'am, and I'm sure would never have parted with the hen of
+her own will. But if my eyes don't deceive me, ma'am, this guinea-hen
+that Miss Barbara sends to you with her compliments is the same that I
+gave to Susan. How Miss Barbara came by it, I can't tell, ma'am, but
+if my boy Philip was at home, he might know, for he's often at Farmer
+Price's cottage. If you wish it, ma'am, I'll ask him when he comes
+home to-night."
+
+"I think the best way will be for me to ask Miss Case herself about it
+this evening," said Miss Somers.
+
+Dinner was now served. Attorney Case expected to smell mint sauce, and
+as the covers were taken off the dishes he looked around for lamb, but
+no lamb did he see.
+
+Among other things talked of at table was a carving-knife that Sir
+Arthur had made for his sister. From this the conversation passed to
+carving. "Now is my chance to find out about my present," thought the
+Attorney. "Pray, may I ask," he said to Sir Arthur, "how you carve a
+fore quarter of lamb?"
+
+Sir Arthur at once saw what the Attorney wanted to hear. Having
+answered his question, he went on to thank him for the present he had
+offered, but added, "I am sorry I cannot accept it, as it is my rule
+never to accept gifts from my neighbors. The reason is that our poor
+tenants cannot show their good will in this way, as they have little
+or nothing to offer."
+
+Attorney Case listened with surprise. He was annoyed and angry, for he
+did not understand Sir Arthur's just mind and kind heart. After the
+ladies left the dining-room and were walking up and down the large
+hall, one of them remarked that it would be a charming place for
+music. Barbara, who like her father always seized any chance of
+turning the conversation as best pleased herself, said what a fine
+instrument was the harp. Then she spoke of the prize-giving to the
+harpers and of the ball that was to follow. "I know a good deal about
+the ball," she said, "because a lady in the town where it is to be
+held offered to take me with her, but although she has a carriage,
+Papa did not like to let her send it so far." At this point Barbara
+fixed her eyes on Miss Somers, that she might, if possible, read her
+thoughts, but as the lady was at that moment letting down the veil of
+her hat, her face was not seen.
+
+"Shall we go for a little walk before tea?" said Miss Somers to the
+other ladies. "I have a pretty guinea-hen to show you." Barbara now
+felt hopeful, and when even among the pheasants and peacocks the
+guinea-hen was much admired, she was sure that Miss Somers must indeed
+be proud to accept her gift.
+
+At this moment Philip came running by on an errand for his mother. As
+his eye fell upon the guinea-hen, he exclaimed before he knew, "Why,
+that is Susan's guinea-hen!"
+
+"No, it is not Susan's guinea-hen," said Miss Barbara, coloring
+furiously, "it is mine, and I have made a present of it to Miss
+Somers."
+
+At the sound of Bab's voice, Philip turned round, his face ablaze with
+anger.
+
+"What is the matter, Philip?" asked Miss Somers in a soothing voice,
+but Philip was not in the mood to be soothed.
+
+"Why, ma'am, may I speak out?" he asked, and without waiting for leave
+he gave a full account of the loss of Susan's guinea-fowl, of Rose's
+visit to Barbara, and of Barbara's greedy and cruel conduct.
+
+Barbara denied all that Philip said, and told quite another tale. When
+she could find no more to say she blushed deeply, for she saw that her
+story was not believed. One might have thought she was covered with
+shame, had it not been that the moment Philip was out of sight, she
+exclaimed, "I am sure I wish I had never seen this wretched
+guinea-hen! It is all Susan's fault for letting it stray into our
+garden."
+
+Barbara was too angry to notice that she was admitting the truth of
+Philip's story.
+
+"Perhaps," said Miss Somers, "Susan will be more careful now that she
+has had so hard a lesson. Shall we see? Philip will, I am sure, carry
+the guinea-hen back to her, if we wish it."
+
+"If you please, ma'am," said Barbara sulkily.
+
+So the guinea-hen was given to Philip, who set off with joy and was
+soon in sight of Farmer Price's cottage.
+
+
+
+
+IX
+
+A SURPRISE FOR SUSAN
+
+
+When Philip came to the door he stopped suddenly, for the idea struck
+him that it would give Rose great pleasure to carry the guinea-fowl to
+Susan. So he ran into the village.
+
+All the children who had given up their Mayday money to Susan were
+playing on the green. They were delighted to see the guinea-hen once
+more. Philip took his pipe and tabor and they all marched together
+towards the whitewashed cottage.
+
+As they passed the butcher's house, his boy came out. They told him
+where they were going.
+
+"Let me come with you, let me come with you," he said. "But wait one
+moment, for my father has something to say to you," and he darted into
+the house. The children waited. In a few moments they heard the
+bleating of a lamb, and soon they saw it being gently led by the
+butcher from the paddock.
+
+"It is Daisy!" exclaimed Rose.
+
+"It is Daisy!" they all shouted with joy, "Susan's lamb! Susan's
+lamb!"
+
+"Well, for my part," said the good butcher, as soon as he could be
+heard, "for my part I would not be so cruel as Attorney Case for the
+whole world. It's true the lamb did not know what was before it, but
+poor Susan did, and to wring her gentle heart was what I call cruel.
+But at any rate, here it is, safe and sound now. I'd have taken it to
+her sooner, but was off early this morning to the fair, and am but
+just come back. Daisy, though, was as well off in my paddock as in the
+field by the water-side."
+
+The troop of happy children went on their way with the guinea-fowl and
+the lamb. As they passed the shop where Susan had been shown the
+pretty calicoes, the shopkeeper, who, you remember, was Rose's father,
+came out. When he saw the lamb, and learned whose it was and heard its
+story, he gave the children some pieces of colored ribbon, with which
+Rose decorated Susan's favorite.
+
+The children now once more moved on, led by Philip, who played
+joyfully upon his pipe and tabor. Susan was working in her
+summer-house, with her little pine table before her. When she heard
+the sound of the music, she put down her work and listened. She saw
+the crowd of children coming nearer and nearer. They had closed round
+Daisy, so she did not see her pet, but as they came up to the
+garden-gate she saw that Rose beckoned to her. Philip played as loud
+as he could, that she might not hear, until the proper moment, the
+bleating of the lamb. As Susan opened the gate, the children divided,
+and first she saw, in the midst of her taller friends, little smiling
+Mary, with the guinea-hen in her arms.
+
+"Come on! come on!" cried Mary, as Susan started with joyful surprise;
+"you have more to see."
+
+At this instant the music paused. Susan heard the bleating of a lamb,
+and pressing eagerly forward, she beheld poor Daisy. She burst into
+tears. "I did not shed one tear when I parted with you, my dear little
+Daisy," she said, "it was for my father and mother. I would not have
+parted with you for any one else in the whole world. Thank you, thank
+you all," she added to her companions, who were even gladder for her
+in her joy than they had been sorry for her in her sorrow. "Now, if my
+father was not to go away from us next week, and if my mother were
+quite strong, I should be the happiest person in the world." As Susan
+finished speaking, a voice behind the listening crowd cried, in a
+rough tone, "Let us pass, if you please; you have no right to block
+the road." This was the voice of Attorney Case, who was returning
+with Barbara from his visit to the Abbey. He saw the lamb and tried to
+whistle as he went on. Barbara also saw the guinea-hen and turned her
+head another way. Even her new bonnet, in which she had expected to be
+so much admired, now only served to hide her blushing face.
+
+"I am glad she saw the guinea-hen," cried Rose, who now held it in her
+hands.
+
+"Yes," said Philip, "she'll not forget Mayday in a hurry."
+
+"Nor I either, I hope," said Susan, looking round upon her companions
+with a most loving smile: "I hope, while I live, I shall never forget
+your goodness to me last Mayday. Now that I've my pretty guinea-hen
+safe once more, I should think of returning your money."
+
+"No! no! no!" was the cry, "we don't want the money--keep it--keep
+it--you want it for your father."
+
+"Well," said Susan, "I am not too proud to accept it. I will keep your
+money for my father. Perhaps some time or other I may be able to
+earn----"
+
+"Oh," said Philip, "don't let us talk of earning; don't let her talk
+to us of money now; she hasn't had time hardly to look at poor Daisy
+and her guinea-hen. Come, we had better go and let her have them all
+to herself."
+
+The children moved away, but Philip himself was the very last to stir
+from the garden-gate. He stayed, first, to tell Susan that it was Rose
+who tied the ribbons on Daisy's head. Then he stayed a little longer
+to let her hear the story of the guinea-fowl, and to tell her who it
+was that brought the hen home from the Abbey.
+
+As Philip finished speaking, Susan was already feeding her long-lost
+favorite. "My pretty guinea-hen," said Susan, "my naughty guinea-hen
+that flew away from me, you shall never serve me so again. I must cut
+your nice wings, but I won't hurt you."
+
+"Take care!" cried Philip, "you'd better, indeed you'd better let me
+hold her, while you cut her wings."
+
+When this was done, which it certainly never could have been had
+Philip not held the hen for Susan, he remembered his mother had given
+him a message for Mrs. Price. This led to another quarter of an hour's
+delay, for Philip had the whole story of the guinea-hen to tell over
+again to Mrs. Price, and as the farmer came in while it was going on,
+it was only polite to begin at the beginning once more. Farmer Price
+was so pleased to see Susan happy again with her two favorites, that
+he said he must himself see Daisy fed, and Philip found that he was
+wanted to hold the jug of milk, from which Susan's father now filled
+the pan for Daisy. When Philip at last left the cottage, Bab and her
+maid Betty were staring out of the window as usual. Seeing them after
+he had left the garden, he at once turned back to see if he had shut
+the gate fast, lest the guinea-hen might stray out and again fall into
+Barbara's hands.
+
+
+
+
+X
+
+BARBARA'S ACCIDENT
+
+
+As the day went on, Miss Barbara became more and more annoyed that her
+meanness had been found out, but she had no wish to cure herself of
+the fault. The ball was still her first thought.
+
+"Well," she said to Betty, "you have heard how things have turned out,
+but if Miss Somers does not ask me to go with, her, I think I know
+some one else who will."
+
+Now, some officers were quartered at the town where the ball was to be
+held. And because they had got into trouble with a tradesman there,
+out of which Mr. Case had undertaken to help them, they sometimes
+invited the Attorney to mess. The officers thought that if they showed
+some attention to Mr. Case, he would not charge them so much for his
+help. One of them even asked his wife to take, sometimes, a little
+notice of Miss Barbara. The name of this officer's wife was Mrs.
+Strathspey. It was of Mrs. Strathspey that Barbara was thinking when
+she said to Betty that if Miss Somers did not take her to the ball,
+she thought she knew of some one else who would.
+
+"Mrs. Strathspey and the officers are to breakfast here to-morrow,"
+said Bab. "One of them dined at the Abbey to-day and he said they
+would all come. They are going somewhere into the country and
+breakfast here on the way. Pray, Betty, don't forget that Mrs.
+Strathspey can't breakfast without honey. I heard her say so myself."
+
+"Then, indeed," said Betty, "I'm afraid Mrs. Strathspey will have to
+go without breakfast here, for not a spoonful of honey have we, let
+her long for it ever so much."
+
+"But, surely," said Bab, "we can contrive to get some honey in the
+neighborhood."
+
+"There's none to be bought, that I know of," said Betty.
+
+"But is there none to be begged or borrowed?" said Bab, laughing. "Do
+you forget Susan's beehive? Step over to her in the morning with my
+compliments, and see what you can do. Tell her it's for Mrs.
+Strathspey."
+
+In the morning Betty went with Miss Barbara's compliments to Susan, to
+beg some honey for Mrs. Strathspey, who could not breakfast without
+it. Susan did not like to part with her honey, because her mother
+loved it, and she therefore gave Betty only a little. When Barbara saw
+how little Susan sent, she called her a miser, and she said she must
+have some more for Mrs. Strathspey. "I'll go myself and speak to her.
+Come with me, Betty," said the young lady, who seemed to forget she
+had said, on the day that she was asked to "take a spoon," that she
+never would pay Susan another visit.
+
+"Susan," she said to the poor girl whom she had done everything in her
+power to hurt, "I must beg a little more honey from you for Mrs.
+Strathspey's breakfast. You know, at a great time such as this, we
+should help one another."
+
+"To be sure we should," added Betty.
+
+Susan, though she was generous, was not weak; she was willing to give
+to those she loved, but would not let anything be taken from her or
+coaxed out of her by those whom she could not respect. She answered
+that she was sorry she had no more honey to spare.
+
+Barbara grew angry. "I'll tell you what, Susan Price," she said, "the
+honey I will have, so you may as well give it to me by fair means. Yes
+or no? Speak! Will you give it to me or not? Will you give me that
+piece of the honeycomb that lies there?"
+
+"That bit of honeycomb is for my mother's breakfast," said Susan; "I
+cannot give it you."
+
+"Can't you?" said Bab, "then see if I don't take it."
+
+She stretched across Susan and grasped, but she did not reach far
+enough. She made a second dart at the honeycomb and, in her effort to
+get it, she overset the beehive. The bees swarmed about her. Her maid
+Betty screamed and ran away. Susan, who was sheltered by a
+laburnum-tree, called to Barbara, upon whom the black clusters of bees
+were now settling, and begged her to stand still and not to beat them
+away, "If you stand quietly you won't be stung, perhaps."
+
+But instead of standing quietly, Bab flung about her arms, and stamped
+and roared, and the bees stung her terribly. Her arms and her face
+swelled in a frightful manner. She was helped home by poor Susan and
+Betty. The maid, now that the mischief was done, thought only of how
+she could excuse herself to her master.
+
+"Indeed, Miss Barbara," said she, "it was quite wrong of you to go and
+get yourself into such a scrape. I shall be turned away for it, you'll
+see."
+
+"I don't care whether you are turned away or not," said Barbara; "I
+never felt such pain in my life. Can't you do something for me? I
+don't mind the pain either so much as being such a fright. Pray, how
+am I to be fit to appear at breakfast with Mrs. Strathspey; and I
+suppose I can't go to the ball either to-morrow, after all."
+
+"No, that you can't expect to do, indeed," said Betty. "You need not
+think of balls, for those lumps and swellings won't go off your face
+this week. That's not what I mind; I'm thinking of what your papa will
+say to me when he sees you, miss."
+
+Susan, seeing she could be of no further use, was about to leave the
+house, when at the door she met Mr. Case coming in. Now, since his
+second visit to the Abbey, the Attorney had been thinking things over.
+It was clear that both Sir Arthur and Miss Somers thought highly of
+the Price family, so perhaps it was a mistake on his part not to be on
+friendly terms with them too. He felt sure that if the story of
+Susan's lamb ever reached the Abbey, Sir Arthur would have no more to
+do with him. It would therefore be well to get into the good graces
+of the farmer and his family. So when Mr. Case met Susan at the door
+he smiled and said, "How is your mother? Have you called for something
+that may be of use to her? Barbara, Barbara--Bab, come downstairs,
+child, and see what you can do for Susan Price." But no Barbara
+answered, and her father stalked upstairs to her room. There he stood
+still, amazed at the sight of his daughter's swollen face.
+
+Before Mr. Case could speak, Betty began to tell the story of
+Barbara's mishap in her own way. Barbara spoke at the same time,
+giving quite another account of what had happened. The Attorney turned
+the maid away on the spot, and turning to Barbara asked how she dared
+to treat Susan Price so ill, "when," as he said, "she was kind enough
+to give you some of her honey. I will not let you treat her so."
+Susan, who could not but hear all that was said, now went to beg the
+angry father to forgive his daughter.
+
+"You are too good to her, as indeed you are to everybody," he said. "I
+forgive her for your sake."
+
+Susan courtesied in great surprise, but she could not forget the
+Attorney's treatment of Daisy, and she left his house as soon as she
+could to get ready her mother's breakfast. Mr. Case saw that Simple
+Susan was not to be taken in by a few simple words, and when he tried
+in the same way to approach her father, the blunt, honest farmer
+looked at him with disdain.
+
+
+
+
+XI
+
+THE PRIZE-GIVING
+
+
+So matters stood on the day of the long-expected prize-giving and
+ball. Miss Barbara Case, stung by Susan's bees, could not, after all
+her efforts, go with Mrs. Strathspey to the ball. The ballroom was
+filled early in the evening. There was a large gathering. The harpers
+who tried for the prize were placed under the music-gallery at the
+lower end of the room. Among them was our old blind friend, who, as he
+was not so well clad as the others, seemed to be looked down upon by
+many of the onlookers. Six ladies and six gentlemen were chosen to be
+judges of the performance. They were seated opposite to the harpers.
+The Misses Somers, who were fond of music, were among the ladies, and
+the prize was in the hands of Sir Arthur.
+
+There was now silence. The first harp sounded, and as each harper
+tried his skill, those who listened seemed to think that he deserved
+the prize. The old blind man was the last. He tuned his harp, and such
+a simple, sad strain was heard as touched every heart. All were
+delighted, and when the music ceased there was still silence for some
+moments.
+
+The silence was followed by loud cheers. The judges were all agreed
+that the old blind harper, who had played last, deserved the prize.
+The simple, sad air, which had moved all who listened, was composed by
+himself. He was asked to give the words belonging to the music, and at
+last he modestly said he would repeat them, as he could not see to
+write. Miss Somers took her pencil, and as the old harper repeated his
+ballad, she wrote the words. He called it "Susan's Lamentation for her
+Lamb." Miss Somers looked at her brother from time to time, as she
+wrote, and Sir Arthur, as soon as the old man had finished, took him
+aside and asked him some questions, which brought to light the whole
+story of Susan's lamb and of Attorney Case's cruelty.
+
+The Attorney himself was present when the harper began to repeat his
+ballad. His color, as Sir Arthur steadily looked at him, changed from
+red to white, and from white to red, until at length he suddenly
+shrunk back through the crowd and left the room. We shall not follow
+him. We had rather follow our old friend the harper. No sooner had he
+received the prize of ten guineas, than he went to a small room
+belonging to the people of the house, asked for pen, ink, and paper,
+and dictated, in a low voice to his boy, a letter, which he ordered
+him to put at once into the post-office. The boy ran off with the
+letter and was but just in time, for the postman's horn was sounding.
+The next morning Farmer Price was sitting beside his wife and Susan
+sorrowing that his week's leave was nearly at an end, and that they
+had not enough money to give to the man who was willing to go in his
+place, when a knock was heard at the door. Then the person who
+delivered the letters in the village put one into Susan's hand,
+saying, "A penny, if you please--here's a letter for your father."
+
+"For me!" said Farmer Price; "here's the penny then; but who can it be
+from, I wonder? Who can think of writing to me, in this world?" He
+tore open the letter, but the hard name at the bottom of the page
+puzzled him--"your obliged friend, Llewellyn."
+
+"And what's this?" he said, opening a paper that was enclosed in the
+letter. "It's a song, seemingly; it must be somebody that has a mind
+to make an April fool of me."
+
+"But it is not April, it is May, father," said Susan.
+
+"Well, let us read the letter, and we shall come to the truth all in
+good time."
+
+Farmer Price then sat down in his own chair, and read as follows:
+
+ "MY WORTHY FRIEND--I am sure you will be glad to hear that I
+ have had success this night. I have won the ten-guinea prize,
+ and for that I am much indebted to your sweet daughter Susan;
+ as you will see by a little ballad I enclose for her. Your
+ kindness to me has let me learn something of your family
+ history. You do not, I hope, forget that I was present when
+ you were counting the treasure in Susan's little purse, and
+ that I heard for what purpose it was all saved. You have not,
+ I know, yet made up the full sum you need; therefore, I will
+ be glad if you will use the five-guinea bank-note which you
+ will find within the ballad. Pay me the money again when it
+ suits you, and if it never suits you to pay it, I shall never
+ ask for it. I shall go my rounds again through this country,
+ I believe, about the same time next year, and will call to
+ see how you are, and to play the new tune for Susan and the
+ dear little boys.
+
+ "I should just add, to set your heart at rest about the
+ money, that it does not distress me at all to lend it to you.
+ I am not quite so poor as I appear to be. But it is my wish
+ to go about as I do. I see more of the world under my
+ tattered clothes than, perhaps, I should ever see in a
+ better dress. There are many of us like this, and we are
+ glad, when we can, to do any kindness to such a worthy family
+ as yours.--So fare ye well.
+
+ "Your obliged Friend,
+ LLEWELLYN."
+
+Susan now, at her father's bidding, opened the ballad. He took the
+five-guinea bank-note, while she read, with surprise, "Susan's
+Lamentation for her Lamb." Her mother leaned over her shoulder to read
+the words, but they were stopped before they had finished the first
+verse by another knock at the door.
+
+
+
+
+XII
+
+ATTORNEY CASE IN TROUBLE
+
+
+It was not the postman with another letter. It was Sir Arthur and his
+sisters.
+
+They came meaning to lend the farmer and his good family the money to
+pay the man who was willing to go away in the farmer's place. But they
+found their help was not needed.
+
+"Still, since we are here," said Sir Arthur, "there is something I
+should like to speak about. Mr. Price, will you come out with me, and
+let me show you a piece of your land through which I want to make a
+road. Look there," said Sir Arthur, pointing to the spot, "I am laying
+out a drive round my estate, and that bit of land of yours stops me."
+
+"Why, sir, true enough it's mine, but you are welcome to it. I can
+trust you to find me another bit worth the same, or to make up the
+value of it in some other way. I need say no more."
+
+Sir Arthur was silent for a few moments. Then he said, "What is this I
+hear about some mistake in your lease?"
+
+"Well, sir," replied the farmer, "the truth is the fit thing to be
+spoken at all times. I can show you a letter from your brother who had
+the estate before you, and who let the farm to me. That letter shows
+what he meant, Sir Arthur, and if in the writing of the lease it was
+otherwise said, it is, as you say, a mistake, sir. Now a mistake is a
+mistake all the world over, and should be treated as such, but
+Attorney Case says in the matter of a lease you must abide by the
+mistake as though it were the truth."
+
+"You seem," said Sir Arthur, "to have some quarrel with this Attorney
+of whom you talk so often. Now would you mind telling me frankly what
+is the matter between you?"
+
+"The matter between us, sir, is this," said Price. "You know the
+corner of the field with the pink hawthorn near Mr. Case's house? The
+lane runs past one side of it and a sweetbrier hedge separates it on
+the other from his garden. Well, sir, the Attorney wishes to enclose
+that bit of ground with his own, and as it belongs to the village, and
+moreover is a play-green for the children, and it has been their
+custom to meet by the hawthorn every Mayday for as many years as I can
+remember, I was loth to see them turned out of it."
+
+"Let us go together and look at this piece of ground," said Sir
+Arthur. "It is not far off, is it?"
+
+"Oh, no, sir, close by."
+
+When they reached the ground, Mr. Case saw them from his garden and
+hurried to the spot. He was afraid of what the farmer might tell Sir
+Arthur. But this time the Attorney was too late, for the truth had
+already been told.
+
+"Is this the place you speak of?" asked Sir Arthur.
+
+"Yes, sir," answered Price.
+
+"Why, Sir Arthur," said Attorney Case, seeing that he was too late,
+"let there be no dispute about the ground. Let it belong to the
+village if you will. I give up all claim to it."
+
+"But you know well, Mr. Case, that a man cannot give up claim to a
+place which is not his. You cannot give up this piece of land, for you
+have no claim to it, as I can prove to you by a look at my maps. This
+field used to belong to the farm on the other side of the road, but
+was cut off from it when the lane was made."
+
+"Indeed you must know best," said the trembling Attorney, who was
+afraid of Sir Arthur and enraged to be shown in the wrong before
+Farmer Price.
+
+"Then," said Sir Arthur to the farmer, "you understand that this
+little green is to be a playground for the village children, and I
+hope they may gather hawthorn from their favorite bush for many a
+Mayday to come."
+
+Farmer Price bowed low, which he seldom did, even when he received a
+kindness for himself, but he was now overjoyed to think of the
+children's delight when he should tell them the good news.
+
+"And now, Mr. Case," said Sir Arthur, turning to the Attorney, "you
+sent me a lease to look over."
+
+"Yes, I thought it my duty to do so. I hope it will not hurt the good
+farmer."
+
+"No, it will not hurt him," said Sir Arthur. "I am willing to write a
+new one for him when he pleases. He has a letter from my brother who
+let the farm to him, which shows exactly what was meant, even if there
+was a mistake made in making out the lease. I hope I shall never treat
+any one unfairly."
+
+"No, indeed," said the Attorney, "but I always thought if there was a
+mistake in a lease it was fair to take advantage of it."
+
+"Then you shall be judged by your own words," answered Sir Arthur.
+"You meant to send me Farmer Price's lease, but your son has somehow
+brought me yours instead. I have found a bad mistake in it."
+
+"A bad mistake in my lease!" gasped the alarmed Attorney.
+
+"Yes," replied Sir Arthur, pulling the lease out of his pocket. "Here
+it is. You will see it has not been signed."
+
+"But you won't take advantage of a mistake, surely!" said the
+Attorney, who seemed to forget that he had shortly before said that it
+was fair to do so.
+
+"I shall not take advantage of you as you would have done of this
+honest man," replied Sir Arthur. "You shall be paid the value of your
+house and land upon condition that you leave the parish within one
+month."
+
+The Attorney knew it was useless to reply. He therefore turned and
+sneaked away.
+
+
+
+
+XIII
+
+SUSAN'S BIRTHDAY
+
+
+"You write a good hand, you can keep accounts, cannot you?" said Sir
+Arthur to Mr. Price, as they walked towards the cottage. "I think I
+saw a bill of your little daughter's drawing out the other day, which
+was very neatly written. Did you teach her to write?"
+
+"No, sir," said Price, "I can't say I did that, for she mostly taught
+it to herself; but I taught her a few sums, as far as I knew, on
+winter nights when I had nothing else to do."
+
+"Your daughter shows that she has been well taught," said Sir Arthur;
+"and her good conduct is a credit to you and her mother."
+
+"You are very good, very good indeed, sir, to speak in this way," said
+the delighted father.
+
+"But I mean to do more than pay you with words," said Sir Arthur. "You
+are attached to your own family, perhaps you may become attached to
+me, when you know me, and we shall have many chances of judging one
+another. I want no one to do my hard work. I only want a steady,
+honest man, like you, to collect my rents, and I hope, Mr. Price, you
+will do that for me."
+
+"I hope, sir," said Price, with joy and gratitude glowing in his
+honest face, "that I'll never give you cause to regret your goodness
+to me."
+
+"And what are my sisters about here?" said Sir Arthur, entering the
+cottage and going behind the two ladies, who were busy measuring a
+pretty colored calico.
+
+"It is for Susan, my dear brother. I knew she did not keep that guinea
+for herself," said Miss Somers. "I have just asked her mother to tell
+me what became of it. Susan gave it to her father; but she must not
+refuse a gown of our choosing this time; and I am sure she will not,
+because her mother, I see, likes it. And, Susan, I hear that instead
+of becoming Queen of the May this year, you were sitting in your
+mother's room as she was ill. Your mother has a little color in her
+cheeks now."
+
+"Oh, ma'am," said Mrs. Price, "I'm a different being. Joy, I think,
+has done it."
+
+"Then," said Miss Somers, "I hope you will be able to come out on your
+daughter's birthday, which, I hear, is on the twenty-fifth of this
+month. Make haste and get quite well before that day, for my brother
+means that all the boys and girls of the village shall have a dance on
+Susan's birthday."
+
+"Yes," said Sir Arthur, "and I hope on that day, Susan, you will be
+very happy with your little friends upon their play-green. I shall
+tell them that it is your good conduct which has won it for them; and
+if you have anything to ask, any little favor for any of your friends,
+which we can grant, ask now, Susan."
+
+"Sir," said Susan, after glancing at her mother, "there is, to be
+sure, a favor I should like to ask; it is for Rose."
+
+"Well, I don't know who Rose is," said Sir Arthur, smiling; "but go
+on."
+
+"Ma'am, you have seen her, I believe; she is a very good girl indeed,"
+said Mrs. Price to Miss Somers.
+
+"And works very neatly, ma'am," continued Susan eagerly, "and she and
+her mother heard you were looking out for some one to wait upon you."
+
+"Say no more," said Miss Somers; "your wish is granted. Tell Rose to
+come to the Abbey to-morrow morning, or rather come with her yourself,
+for our housekeeper, I know, wants to talk to you about a certain
+cake. She wishes, Susan, that you should be the maker of the cake for
+the dance, and she has good things looked out for it already, I know.
+It must be large enough for everybody to have a slice, and the
+housekeeper will ice it for you. I only hope your cake will be as good
+as your bread. Good-by."
+
+"How I do wish, now," said Farmer Price, "how I do wish, wife, that
+our good friend the harper was only here at this time. It would do his
+warm old heart good. Well, the best of it is, we shall be able next
+year, when he comes his rounds, to pay him his money with thanks,
+being all the time and for ever as much obliged to him as if we kept
+it. I long to see him in this house again, drinking, as he did, a
+glass of Susan's mead, just on this spot."
+
+"Yes," said Susan, "and the next time he comes, I can give him one of
+my guinea-hen's eggs, and I shall show him Daisy."
+
+"True, love," said her mother, "and he will play that tune and sing
+that pretty ballad. Where is it? I have not finished it."
+
+"Rose ran away with it, mother, but I'll run after her, and bring it
+back to you this minute," said Susan.
+
+Susan found her friend Rose at the hawthorn, in the midst of a crowd
+of children, to whom she was reading "Susan's Lamentation for her
+Lamb."
+
+"The words are something, but the tune--the tune--I must have the
+tune," cried Philip. "I'll ask my mother to ask Sir Arthur to try and
+find out which way that good old man went after the ball; and if he's
+to be found, we'll have him back by Susan's birthday, and he shall sit
+here--just exactly here--by our bush, and he shall play--I mean, if he
+will--that same tune for us, and I shall learn it--I mean, if I
+can--in a minute."
+
+The good news that Farmer Price was to collect the rents and that
+Attorney Case was to leave the parish in a month soon spread over the
+village. Many came out of their houses to have the pleasure of hearing
+the joyful tidings from Susan herself. The crowd on the play-green
+grew bigger every minute.
+
+"Yes," cried Philip, "I tell you it's quite true, every word of it.
+Susan's too modest to say it herself, but I tell you all, that Sir
+Arthur has given us this play-green just because she is so good."
+
+
+
+
+LIMBY LUMPY
+
+I
+
+
+LIMBY LUMPY was the only son of his mother. His father was called the
+"Pavior's Assistant," for he was so large and heavy that, when he used
+to walk through the streets, the men who were ramming the stones down
+with a large wooden rammer would say, "Please to walk over these
+stones, sir," and then the men would get a rest.
+
+Limby was born on April 1--I do not know how long ago; but before he
+came into the world such preparations were made! There was a beautiful
+cradle, and a bunch of coral with bells on it, and lots of little
+caps, and a fine satin hat, and tops and bottoms for pap, and two
+nurses to take care of him. He was, too, to have a little chaise, when
+he grew big enough; after that, he was to have a donkey, and then a
+pony. In short, he was to have the moon for a plaything, if it could
+be got; and, as to the stars, he would have had them, if they had not
+been too high to reach.
+
+Limby made a rare to-do when he was a little baby. But he never was a
+_little_ baby--he was always a big baby; nay, he was a big baby till
+the day of his death.
+
+"Baby Big," his mother used to call him; he was "a noble baby," said
+his aunt; he was "a sweet baby," said old Mrs. Tomkins, the nurse; he
+was "a dear baby," said his papa--and so he was, for he _cost_ a good
+deal. He was "a darling baby," said his aunt, by the mother's side;
+"there never was such a fine child," said everybody, before the
+parents; when they were at another place they called him, "a great,
+ugly fat child."
+
+Limby was almost as broad as he was long. He had what some people
+called an open countenance--that is, one as broad as a full moon. He
+had what his mother called beautiful auburn locks, but what other
+people said were carroty--not before the mother, of course.
+
+Limby had a flattish nose and a widish mouth, and his eyes were a
+little out of the right line. Poor little dear, he could not help that
+and therefore it was not right to laugh at him.
+
+Everybody, however, laughed to see him eat his pap, for he would not
+be fed with the patent silver pap-spoon which his father bought him,
+but used to lay himself flat on his back, and seize the pap-boat with
+both hands, and never let go of it till its contents were fairly in
+his dear little stomach.
+
+So Limby grew bigger and bigger every day, till at last he could
+scarcely draw his breath, and was very ill; so his mother sent for
+three apothecaries and two physicians, who looked at him, and told his
+mother there were no hopes: the poor child was dying of overfeeding.
+The physicians, however, prescribed for him--a dose of castor-oil.
+
+His mother attempted to give him the castor-oil, but Limby, although
+he liked tops and bottoms, and cordial, and pap, and sweetbread, and
+oysters, and other things nicely dished up, had no fancy for
+castor-oil, and struggled and kicked and fought every time his nurse
+or mother attempted to give it him.
+
+"Limby, my darling boy," said his mother, "my sweet cherub, my only
+dearest, do take its oily-poily, there's a ducky-deary, and it shall
+ride in a coachy-poachy."
+
+"Oh, the dear baby!" said the nurse; "take it for nursey. It will take
+it for nursey, that it will."
+
+The nurse had got the oil in a silver medicine-spoon, so contrived
+that, if you could get it into the child's mouth, the medicine must go
+down. Limby, however, took care that no spoon should go into his
+mouth, and when the nurse tried the experiment for the nineteenth
+time, gave a plunge and a kick, and sent the spoon up to the ceiling,
+knocked off the nurse's spectacles, upset the table on which all the
+bottles and glasses were, and came down whack on the floor.
+
+His mother picked him up, clasped him to her breast, and almost
+smothered him with kisses.
+
+"Oh, my dear boy!" said she; "it shan't take the nasty oil! it won't
+take it, the darling! Naughty nurse to hurt baby! It shall not take
+nasty physic!"
+
+And then she kissed him again.
+
+Poor Limby, although only two years old, knew what he was at--he was
+trying to be the master of his mother. He felt he had gained his
+point, and gave another kick and a squall, at the same time planting a
+blow on his mother's eye.
+
+"Dear little creature!" said she; "he is in a state of high
+convulsions and fever. He will never recover!"
+
+But Limby did recover, and in a few days was running about the house,
+and the master of it. There was nobody to be considered, nobody to be
+consulted, nobody to be attended to, but Limby Lumpy.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+
+Limby grew up big and strong; he had everything his own way. One day,
+when he was at dinner with his father and mother, perched upon a
+double chair, with his silver knife and fork, and silver mug to drink
+from, he amused himself by playing drums on his plate with the mug.
+
+"Don't make that noise, Limby, my dear," said his father.
+
+"Dear little lamb!" said his mother; "let him amuse himself. Limby,
+have some pudding?"
+
+"No, Limby no pudding!"
+
+_Drum! drum! drum!_
+
+A piece of pudding was, however, put on Limby's plate, but he kept on
+drumming as before. At last he drummed the bottom of the mug into the
+soft pudding, to which it stuck, and by which means it was scattered
+all over the carpet.
+
+"Limby, my darling!" said his mother; and the servant was called to
+wipe Limby's mug and pick the pudding up from the floor.
+
+Limby would not have his mug wiped, and floundered about, and upset
+the cruet-stand and the mustard on the table-cloth.
+
+"Oh, Limby Lumpy--naughty boy!" said his father.
+
+"Don't speak so cross to the child: he is but a child," said his
+mother. "I don't like to hear you speak so cross to the child."
+
+"I tell you what it is," said his father, "I think the boy does as he
+likes. But I don't want to interfere."
+
+Limby now sat still, resolving what to do next. He was not hungry,
+having been stuffed with a large piece of pound-cake about an hour
+before dinner; but he wanted something to do, and could not sit still.
+
+Presently a saddle of mutton was brought on the table. When Limby saw
+this he set up a crow of delight.
+
+"Limby ride," said he--"Limby ride!" and rose up in his chair, as if
+to reach the dish.
+
+"Yes, my ducky, it shall have some mutton," said his mother, and
+immediately gave him a slice, cut up into small morsels.
+
+That was not it. Limby pushed that on the floor, and cried out: "Limby
+on meat! Limby on meat!"
+
+His mother could not think what he meant. At last, however, his father
+recollected that he had been in the habit of giving him a ride
+occasionally, first on his foot, sometimes on the scroll end of the
+sofa, at other times on the top of the easy chair. Once he put him on
+a dog, and more than once on the saddle; in short, he had been in the
+habit of perching him on various things, and now Limby, hearing this
+was a _saddle_ of mutton, wanted to take a ride on it.
+
+"Limby on! Limby ride on bone!" said the child in a whimper.
+
+"Did you _ever hear_?" said the father.
+
+"What an extraordinary child!" said the mother. "How clever to know it
+was like a saddle, the little dear! No, no, Limby; grease frock,
+Limby."
+
+But Limby cared nothing about a greasy frock, not he--he was used
+enough to that--and therefore roared out more lustily for a ride on
+the mutton.
+
+"Did you ever know such a child? What a dear, determined spirit!"
+
+"He is a child of an uncommon mind," said his mother. "Limby,
+dear--Limby, dear, silence! silence!"
+
+The truth was, Limby made such a roaring that neither father nor
+mother could get their dinners, and scarcely knew whether they were
+eating beef or mutton.
+
+"It is impossible to let him ride on the mutton," said his
+father--"quite impossible!"
+
+"Well, but you might just put him astride the dish, just to satisfy
+him. You can take care his legs or clothes do not go into the gravy."
+
+"Anything for a quiet life," said the father. "What does Limby want?
+Limby ride?"
+
+"Limby on bone! Limby on meat!"
+
+"Shall I put him across?" said Mr. Lumpy.
+
+"Just for one moment," said his mother; "it won't hurt the mutton."
+
+The father rose, and took Limby from his chair, and, with the greatest
+caution, held his son's legs astride, so that they might hang on each
+side of the dish without touching it--"just to satisfy him," as he
+said, "that they might dine in quiet--" and was about to withdraw him
+from it immediately.
+
+But Limby was not to be cheated in that way. He wished to feel the
+saddle _under_ him, and accordingly forced himself down upon it; but
+feeling it rather warmer than was agreeable, started, and lost his
+balance, and fell down among the dishes, soused in melted butter,
+cauliflower, and gravy, floundering, and kicking, and screaming, to
+the detriment of glasses, jugs, dishes, and everything else on the
+table.
+
+"My child! my child!" said his mother. "Oh, save my child!"
+
+She snatched him up, and pressed his begreased garments close to the
+bosom of her best silk gown.
+
+Neither father nor mother wanted any more dinner after this. As to
+Limby, he was as frisky afterwards as if nothing had happened, and
+about half an hour from the time of this disaster _cried for his
+dinner._
+
+
+
+
+THE SORE TONGUE
+
+By JANE TAYLOR
+
+
+There was a little girl called Fanny, who had the misfortune one day
+to bite her tongue as she was eating her breakfast. It hurt her so
+much that she could scarcely help crying; and even when the first
+smart was over, it continued so sore that whenever she spoke it pained
+her considerably. Finding this to be the case, she said very pitifully
+to her mother, "Mamma, you can't think how it hurts me when I speak!"
+"Does it?" replied her mother; "then I'll tell you what I would advise
+you to do. Resolve all this day to say nothing but what is either
+necessary or useful; this will give your tongue a fine holiday, and
+may answer more purposes than one."
+
+Fanny, knowing that she had the character of being somewhat
+loquacious, could not help laughing at this, and said, "Well, I will
+try for once; so, mum! I am going to begin now, mamma."
+
+_Mother_. Do so; and whenever you are beginning to speak, be sure you
+ask yourself whether what you were going to say was likely to be of
+any use, or whether it was necessary.
+
+_Fanny_. Yes, yes, I will! but don't talk to me, mamma, for fear. So
+saying, she screwed up her lips, and taking her work, sat for about
+five minutes as still as a mouse. She then looked up, smiled and
+nodded at her mother, as much as to say, "See how well I can hold my
+tongue," still screwing her lips very tight for fear she should speak.
+Soon, however, she began to feel a great inclination to say something;
+and was glad to recollect that if she could but think of anything
+either useful or necessary, she might speak. Whereupon she endeavored
+to find something to say that would come "within the act." To aid her
+invention, she looked all round the room.
+
+_Fanny_. Mamma, don't you think the fire wants stirring? (This
+question, she thought, savored of both qualifications.)
+
+_Mother_. Not at present, my dear.
+
+Then followed another long silence; for Fanny found it vastly more
+difficult than she had any previous idea of, to think of anything
+useful to talk about; and she knew her mamma would laugh at her if she
+said what was obviously idle or silly, just now. She was beginning to
+repent having made such an agreement, when her three elder sisters
+entered the room. She now thought it quite reasonable, if not
+absolutely necessary, to tell them of her misfortune; which she did at
+considerable length, and with many needless digressions (the usual
+custom with great talkers); upon which they all laughed, prophesying
+that her resolution would not last half an hour, and rallying her for
+telling such a long story with a sore tongue.
+
+Soon after, some ladies called to pay their mother a morning visit.
+This gave Fanny's tongue such a long rest that the moment they were
+gone it seemed irresistibly to resume its wonted functions.
+
+_Fanny_. What a while old Mrs. W. has had that brown satin pelisse!
+Really, poor old lady, I am quite tired of seeing her in it!
+
+_Mother_. How is your tongue, Fanny?
+
+_Fanny_. Oh, better, mamma, thank you--almost well.
+
+_Mother_. I am sorry for it: I was in hopes it would have been sore
+enough at least to prevent your making impertinent remarks upon
+anybody all this day.
+
+_Fanny_. No, but really, mamma, is it not an old rubbishing thing?
+
+_Mother_. I don't know, indeed. It is no business of mine; therefore I
+took no notice of it.
+
+A silence ensued after this; but conversation revived when Caroline,
+who had stood for some time with her eyes fixed on their opposite
+neighbor's window, suddenly exclaimed, "I do believe the Joneses are
+going to have company again to-day! The servant has just been lighting
+the fire in the drawing-room; and there is Miss Jones now gone up to
+dress. I saw her draw down the blinds in her room this instant." "So
+she is," said Lucy, looking up: "I never knew such people in my life!
+they are always having company."
+
+"I wonder whom they are expecting to-day," said Eliza;
+"dinner-company, I suppose."
+
+The proceedings of their neighbors, the Joneses, continued to furnish
+matter for various sagacious conjectures and remarks for a
+considerable time. At length Caroline exclaimed with the eagerness of
+discovery, "Look! look! there's the baker now at the door, with a
+whole tray full of tarts and things. Make haste, or he'll be gone in."
+
+_Lucy_. So he is, I declare; it is a dinner-party then. Well, we shall
+see presently, I hope, who are coming.
+
+_Caroline_. Oh, no, they never dine till five when they have company.
+
+_Eliza_. And it will be dark then; how tiresome!
+
+_Lucy_. If Miss Jones is not dressed already! She is this instant come
+into the drawing-room.
+
+_Caroline_. Stand back, stand back! Don't let her see us all staring.
+Ah, there she is,--got on her pink sarcenet body and sleeves to-day.
+How pretty that dress is, to be sure!
+
+_Eliza_. And how nicely she has done her hair! Look, Caroline--braided
+behind.
+
+_Lucy_. There, she is putting down the sash. That chimney smokes, I
+know, with this wind.
+
+_Fanny_. And there is that little figure, Martha Jones, come down now.
+Do look--as broad as she is long! What a little fright that child is,
+to be sure!
+
+_Mother_. Pray, Fanny, was that remark useful or necessary?
+
+_Fanny_. Oh, but mamma, I assure you, my tongue is quite well now.
+
+_Mother_. I am sorry for it, my dear. Do you know, I should think it
+well worth while to bite my tongue every day if there were no other
+means of keeping it in order.
+
+At this the girls laughed; but their mother, resuming her gravity,
+thus continued:
+
+"My dear girls, I should before now have put a stop to this idle
+gossiping, if I had not hoped to convince you of the folly of it. It
+is no wonder, I confess, that at your age you should learn to imitate
+a style of remark which is but too prevalent in society. Nothing,
+indeed, is more contagious. But let me also tell you, that girls of
+your age, and of your advantages, are capable of seeing the meanness
+of it, and ought to despise it. It is the chief end of education to
+raise the minds of women above such trifling as this. But if a young
+person who has been taught to think, whose taste has been cultivated,
+and who might therefore possess internal resources, has as much idle
+curiosity about the affairs of her neighbors, and is as fond of
+retailing petty scandal concerning them, as an uneducated woman, it
+proves that her mind is incurably mean and vulgar, and that
+cultivation is lost upon her.
+
+"This sort of gossiping, my dear girls, is the disgrace of our sex.
+The pursuits of women lie necessarily within a narrow sphere, and they
+naturally sink, unless raised by refinement, or by strong principle,
+into that littleness of character, for which even their own husbands
+and fathers (if they are men of sense) are tempted to despise them.
+The minds of men, from their engagements in business, necessarily take
+a larger range; and they are, in general, too much occupied with
+concerns comparatively important to enter into the minute details
+which amuse women. But women of education have no such plea to urge.
+When your father and I direct you to this or that pursuit, it is not
+so much for the sake of your possessing that particular branch of
+knowledge, but that by knowledge in general you may become intelligent
+and superior, and that you may be furnished with resources which will
+save you from the miserable necessity of seeking amusement from
+intercourse with your neighbors, and an acquaintance with their
+affairs.
+
+"Let us suppose, now, that this morning you had been all more
+industriously inclined; and had been engaged in any of your
+employments with that ardor which some happy young people manifest in
+the acquisition of knowledge; would you, in that case, have felt any
+desire to know the date of Mrs. W.'s pelisse, or any curiosity in the
+proceedings of our neighbors the Joneses? No, you would then have
+thought it a most impertinent interruption, if any one had attempted
+to entertain you with such particulars. But when the mind is indolent
+and empty, then it can receive amusement from the most contemptible
+sources. Learn, then, to check this mean propensity. Despise such
+thoughts whenever you are tempted to indulge them. Recollect that this
+low curiosity is the combined result of idleness, ignorance,
+emptiness, and ill-nature; and fly to useful occupation, as the most
+successful antidote against the evil. Nor let it be forgotten that
+such impertinent remarks as these come directly under the description
+of those 'idle words,' of which an account must be given in the day of
+judgment. Yes, this vulgar trifling is as inconsistent with the spirit
+of Christian benevolence, and with the grand rule of 'doing to others
+as we would that they should do to us,' as it is with refinement of
+taste and dignity of character."
+
+"Who would have thought," said little Fanny, "that my happening to
+bite my tongue this morning would have led to all this?"
+
+"It would be a fortunate bite for you, Fanny," said her mother, "and
+for your neighbors, if it should make you more careful in the use of
+it. If we were liable to such a misfortune whenever we use our tongues
+improperly, some persons would be in a constant agony. Now, if our
+consciences were but half as sensitive as our nerves, they would
+answer the purpose much better. Foolish talking pains a good
+conscience, just as continual speaking hurts a sore tongue; and if we
+did but regard one smart as much as the other, it would act as a
+constant check upon the unruly member."
+
+
+
+
+EYES AND NO EYES, OR THE ART OF SEEING
+
+By JOHN AIKIN and MRS. BARBAULD
+
+
+"Well, Robert, where have you been walking this after noon?" said Mr.
+Andrews, to one of his pupils at the close of a holiday.
+
+_R._ I have been, sir, to Broom heath, and so round by the windmill
+upon Camp-mount, and home through the meadows by the river-side.
+
+_Mr. A._ Well, that's a pleasant round.
+
+_R._ I thought it very dull, sir; I scarcely met with a single person.
+I had rather by half have gone along the turnpike road.
+
+_Mr. A._ Why, if seeing men and horses is your object, you would,
+indeed, be better entertained on the highroad. But did you see
+William?
+
+_R._ We set out together, but he lagged behind in the lane, so I
+walked on and left him.
+
+_Mr. A._ That was a pity. He would have been company for you.
+
+_R._ Oh, he is so tedious, always stopping to look at this thing and
+that! I had rather walk alone. I dare say he is not got home yet.
+
+_Mr. A._ Here he comes. Well, William, where have you been?
+
+_W._ Oh, sir, the pleasantest walk! I went all over Broom-heath, and
+so up to the mill at the top of the hill, and then down among the
+green meadows by the side of the river.
+
+_Mr. A._ Why, that is just the round Robert has been taking, and he
+complains of its dullness, and prefers the highroad.
+
+_W._ I wonder at that. I am sure I hardly took a step that did not
+delight me, and I have brought home my handkerchief full of
+curiosities.
+
+_Mr. A._ Suppose, then, you give us some account of what amused you so
+much. I fancy it will be as new to Robert as to me.
+
+_W._ I will, sir. The lane leading to the heath, you know, is close
+and sandy, so I did not mind it much, but made the best of my way.
+However, I spied a curious thing enough in the hedge. It was an old
+crab-tree, out of which grew a great bunch of something green, quite
+different from the tree itself. Here is a branch of it.
+
+_Mr. A._ Ah! this is mistletoe, a plant of great fame for the use made
+of it by the Druids of old in their religious rites and incantations.
+It bears a very slimy white berry, of which birdlime may be made,
+whence its Latin name of _Viscus_. It is one of those plants which do
+not grow In the ground by a root of their own, but fix themselves upon
+other plants; whence they have been humorously styled _parasitical_,
+as being hangers-on, or dependents. It was the mistletoe of the oak
+that the Druids particularly honored.
+
+_W._ A little farther on I saw a green woodpecker fly to a tree, and
+run up the trunk like a cat.
+
+_Mr. A._ That was to seek for insects in the bark, on which they live.
+They bore holes with their strong bills for that purpose, and do much
+damage to the trees by it.
+
+_W._ What beautiful birds they are!
+
+_Mr. A._ Yes; they have been called, from their color and size, the
+English parrot.
+
+_W._ When I got upon the open heath, how charming it was! The air
+seemed so fresh, and the prospect on every side so free and unbounded!
+Then it was all covered with gay flowers, many of which I had never
+observed before. There were at least three kinds of heath (I have got
+them In my handkerchief here), and gorse, and broom, and bellflower,
+and many others of all colors, that I will beg you presently to tell
+me the names of.
+
+_Mr. A._ That I will readily.
+
+_W._ I saw, too, several birds that were new to me. There was a pretty
+grayish one, of the size of a lark, that was hopping about some great
+stones; and when he flew he showed a great deal of white above his
+tail.
+
+_Mr. A._ That was a wheatear. They are reckoned very delicious birds
+to eat, and frequent the open downs in Sussex, and some other
+countries, in great numbers.
+
+_W_. There was a flock of lapwings upon a marshy part of the heath,
+that amused me much. As I came near them, some of them kept flying
+round and round just over my head, and crying _pewet_ so distinctly
+one might fancy they almost spoke, I thought I should have caught one
+of them, for he flew as if one of his wings was broken, and often
+tumbled close to the ground: but as I came near, he always made a
+shift to get away.
+
+_Mr. A._ Ha, ha! you were finely taken in then! This was all an
+artifice of the bird's to entice you away from its nest; for they
+build upon the bare ground, and their nests would easily be observed,
+did they not draw off the attention of intruders by their loud cries
+and counterfeit lameness.
+
+_W._ I wish I had known that, for he led me a long chase, often over
+shoes in water. However, it was the cause of my falling in with an old
+man and a boy who were cutting and piling up turf for fuel, and I had
+a good deal of talk with them about the manner of preparing the turf,
+and the price it sells at. They gave me, too, a creature I never saw
+before--a young viper, which they had just killed, together with its
+dam. I have seen several common snakes, but this is thicker in
+proportion, and of a darker color than they are.
+
+_Mr. A._ True. Vipers frequent those turfy, boggy grounds pretty much,
+and I have known several turf-cutters bitten by them.
+
+_W._ They are very venomous, are they not?
+
+_Mr. A._ Enough so to make their wounds painful and dangerous, though
+they seldom prove fatal.
+
+_W._ Well--I then took my course up to the windmill on the mount. I
+climbed up the steps of the mill in order to get a better view of the
+country round. What an extensive prospect! I counted fifteen church
+steeples; and I saw several gentlemen's houses peeping out from the
+midst of green woods and plantations; and I could trace the windings
+of the river all along the low grounds, till it was lost behind a
+ridge of hills. But I'll tell you what I mean to do, sir, if you will
+give me leave.
+
+_Mr. A._ What is that?
+
+_W._ I will go again, and take with me Carey's county map, by which I
+shall probably be able to make out most of the places.
+
+_Mr. A._ You shall have it, and I will go with you, and take my pocket
+spying-glass.
+
+_W._ I shall be very glad of that. Well--a thought struck me, that as
+the hill is called _Camp-mount,_ there might probably be some remains
+of ditches and mounds with which I have read that camps were
+surrounded. And I really believe I discovered something of that sort
+running round one side of the mount.
+
+_Mr, A._ Very likely you might. I know antiquaries have described such
+remains as existing there, which some suppose to be Roman, others
+Danish. We will examine them further, when we go.
+
+_W._ From the hill I went straight down to the meadows below, and
+walked on the side of a brook that runs into the river. It was all
+bordered with reeds and flags and tall flowering plants, quite
+different from those I had seen on the heath. As I was getting down
+the bank to reach one of them, I heard something plunge into the water
+near me. It was a large water-rat, and I saw it swim over to the other
+side, and go into its hole. There were a great many large dragon-flies
+all about the stream. I caught one of the finest, and have got him
+here in a leaf. But how I longed to catch a bird that I saw hovering
+over the water, and every now and then darting down into it! It was
+all over a mixture of the most beautiful green and blue, with some
+orange color. It was somewhat less than a thrush, and had a large head
+and bill, and a short tail.
+
+_Mr. A._ I can tell you what that bird was--a kingfisher, the
+celebrated halcyon of the ancients, about which so many tales are
+told. It lives on fish, which it catches in the manner you saw. It
+builds in holes in the banks, and is a shy, retired bird, never to be
+seen far from the stream where it inhabits.
+
+_W_. I must try to get another sight at him, for I never saw a bird
+that pleased me so much. Well--I followed this little brook till it
+entered the river, and then took the path that runs along the bank.
+On the opposite side I observed several little birds running along the
+shore, and making a piping noise. They were brown and white, and about
+as big as a snipe.
+
+_Mr. A_. I suppose they were sandpipers, one of the numerous family of
+birds that get their living by wading among the shallows, and picking
+up worms and insects.
+
+_W_. There were a great many swallows, too, sporting upon the surface
+of the water, that entertained me with their motions. Sometimes they
+dashed into the stream; sometimes they pursued one another so quick,
+that the eye could scarcely follow them. In one place where a high
+steep sand-bank rose directly above the river, I observed many of them
+go in and out of holes with which the bank was bored full.
+
+_Mr. A_. Those were sand-martins, the smallest of our species of
+swallows. They are of a mouse color above, and white beneath. They
+make their nests and bring up their young in these holes, which run a
+great depth, and by their situation are secure from all plunderers.
+
+_W_. A little farther I saw a man in a boat, who was catching eels in
+an odd way. He had a long pole with broad iron prongs at the end, just
+like Neptune's trident, only there were five instead of three. This he
+pulled straight down among the mud in the deepest parts of the river,
+and fetched up the eels sticking between the prongs.
+
+_Mr. A_. I have seen this method. It is called spearing of eels.
+
+_W_. While I was looking at him, a heron came flying over my head,
+with his large flagging wings. He lit at the next turn of the river,
+and I crept softly behind the bank to watch his motions. He had waded
+into the water as far as his long legs would carry him, and was
+standing with his neck drawn in, looking intently on the stream.
+Presently he darted his long bill as quick as lightning into the
+water, and drew out a fish, which he swallowed. I saw him catch
+another in the same manner. He then took alarm at some noise I made,
+and flew away slowly to a wood at some distance, where he settled.
+
+_Mr. A_. Probably his nest was there, for herons build upon the
+loftiest trees they can find, and sometimes in society together like
+rooks. Formerly, when these birds were valued for the amusement of
+hawking, many gentlemen had their _heronries_, and a few are still
+remaining.
+
+_W_. I think they are the largest wild birds we have.
+
+_Mr. A_. They are of a great length and spread of wing, but their
+bodies are comparatively small.
+
+_W_. I then turned homeward across the meadows, where I stopped awhile
+to look at a large flock of starlings which kept flying about at no
+great distance. I could not tell at first what to make of them; for
+they rose all together from the ground as thick as a swarm of bees,
+and formed themselves into a kind of black cloud, hovering over the
+field. After taking a short round, they settled again, and presently
+rose again in the same manner, I dare say there were hundreds of them.
+
+_Mr. A_. Perhaps so; for in the fenny countries their flocks are so
+numerous as to break down whole acres of reeds by settling on them.
+This disposition of starlings to fly in close swarms was remarked even
+by Homer, who compares the foe flying from one of his heroes to a
+_cloud_ of starlings retiring dismayed at the approach of the hawk.
+
+_W_. After I had left the meadows, I crossed the cornfields and got to
+the high field next our house just as the sun was setting, and I stood
+looking at it till it was quite lost. What a glorious sight! The
+clouds were tinged with purple and crimson and yellow of all shades
+and hues, and the clear sky varied from blue to a fine green at the
+horizon. But how large the sun appears just as it sets! I think it
+seems twice as big as when it is overhead.
+
+_Mr. A_. It does so; and you may probably have observed the same
+apparent enlargement of the moon at its rising.
+
+_W_. I have; but pray what is the reason of this?
+
+_Mr. A_. It is an optical deception, depending upon principles which I
+cannot well explain to you till you know more of that branch of
+science. But what a number of new ideas this afternoon's walk has
+afforded you! I do not wonder that you found it amusing; It has been
+very instructive, too. Did _you_ see nothing of all these sights,
+Robert?
+
+_R_. I saw some of them, but I did not take particular notice of them.
+
+_Mr. A_. Why not?
+
+_R_. I don't know. I did not care about them, and I made the best of
+my way home.
+
+_Mr. A_. That would have been right if you had been sent of a message;
+but as you only walked for amusement it would have been wiser to have
+sought out as many sources of it as possible. But so it is--one man
+walks through the world with his eyes open, and another with them
+shut; and upon this difference depends all the superiority of
+knowledge the one acquires above the other. I have known sailors, who
+had been in all quarters of the world, and could tell you nothing but
+the signs of the tippling-houses they frequented in different ports,
+and the price and quality of the liquor. On the other hand, a Franklin
+could not cross the channel without making some observations useful to
+mankind. While many a vacant, thoughtless youth is whirled throughout
+Europe without gaining a single idea worth crossing a street for, the
+observing eye and inquiring mind find matter of improvement and
+delight in every ramble in town or country. Do _you_ then, William,
+continue to make use of your eyes; and _you_, Robert, learn that eyes
+were given you to use.
+
+
+
+
+PRINCE LIFE
+
+By G.P.R. JAMES
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+
+Once upon a time there was a young Prince who met with a very curious
+kind of misfortune. Most people want something which they cannot get;
+and because they cannot get it, they generally desire it more than
+anything else, which is very foolish, for it would be much better to
+be contented with what they have.
+
+He was a wise fox, my dear Charlie, who thought the grapes were sour
+when he could not reach them. Now the Prince's misfortune consisted in
+this, that he had everything on earth he could want or desire, and a
+little more. He had a fine palace and a fine country, obedient
+subjects and servants, and true friends. When he got up in the
+morning, there was some one ready to put on his clothes for him; when
+he went to bed at night, some one to take them off again. A fairy
+called Prosperity gave him everything he desired as soon as he desired
+it. If he wanted peaches at Christmas, or cool air at mid-summer, the
+first came instantly from his hothouses, and the second was produced
+by an enormous fan, which hung from the top of the room, and was moved
+by two servants.
+
+But strange to say, the Prince got weary of all this; he was tired of
+wanting nothing. When he sat down to dinner he had but little
+appetite, because he had had such a good breakfast; he hardly knew
+which coat to put on, they were all so beautiful; and when he went to
+bed at night, though the bed was as soft as a white cloud, he could
+not sleep, for he was not tired.
+
+There was only one ugly thing in the whole palace, which was a little,
+drowsy, gray dwarf, left there by the fairy Prosperity. He kept
+yawning all day, and very often set the Prince yawning, too, only to
+look at him. This dwarf they called Satiety, and he followed the
+Prince about wherever he went.
+
+One day the Prince asked him what he was yawning for, and Satiety
+answered:
+
+"Because I have nothing to do, and nothing to wish for, my Prince."
+
+"I suppose that is the reason why I yawn too," replied the Prince.
+
+"Rather is it having me always with you,".answered Satiety.
+
+"Then get away and leave me," said the Prince.
+
+"I cannot do that," answered Satiety. "You can go from me, but I
+cannot go from you; I can never leave you as long as you remain in the
+palace of Prosperity."
+
+"Then I will have you turned out," said the Prince.
+
+"No one can do that," said Satiety, "but Misfortune, and he is a very
+capricious person. Though he is a very disagreeable monster, some
+people seem to court him, but cannot get him to come near them; while
+to a great many he comes unawares, and catches them, though they fly
+from him eagerly. I tell you, Prince, you can go from me, but I cannot
+go from you as long as you remain in the palace of Prosperity."
+
+That night, when he went to his soft bed, the Prince thought very much
+as to the conversation he had held with Satiety, and he resolved to go
+out of the palace for a time, just to get rid of the ugly little gray,
+yawning dwarf.
+
+The very resolution seemed to do him good, and he slept better that
+night after he had made it than he had done for many a night before.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+
+The next morning when he rose he felt quite refreshed, and he said to
+a groom: "Bring me my stout horse, Expedition; I am going out to take
+a ride all alone."
+
+The groom answered not a word, for in that palace every one obeyed the
+Prince at once, and nobody troubled him but the ugly little dwarf,
+Satiety. As he went away, however, the groom said to himself with a
+sigh: "It is a sad thing to be in the wide world all alone. My Prince
+does not know what it is. But let him try; it may be better for him."
+
+He accordingly brought the horse to the palace-door. But when the
+Prince came down he felt quite well, and, looking about among all his
+attendants, he could only catch a distant glimpse of Satiety standing
+yawning behind. For a minute he was half inclined not to go, for he
+did not mind seeing Satiety at a distance if he did not come near. But
+the groom, whose name was Resolution, seeing him hesitate, said: "You
+had better go, my Prince, as you determined; it may do you good." And
+a chamberlain called Effort helped him on his horse.
+
+At first, as the Prince rode along, everything was quite delightful to
+him. He seemed to breathe more freely now that he was no more troubled
+with Satiety. The flowers looked bright, and the sky beautiful, for a
+cloud or two here and there only gave variety. The very air seemed
+fresher than it had been in the sheltered gardens of the palace, and
+the Prince said to himself: "What a delightful country this is, just
+on the verge of the land of Prosperity."
+
+Just then he saw a countryman gathering grapes in a vineyard, and
+every now and then putting some into his mouth, and the Prince asked
+him whose fine estate it was that he was passing through.
+
+"It belongs to a gentleman and lady equally, sir," replied the good
+man; "they are called Activity and Ease. They are the happiest couple
+ever seen. When Activity is tired, Ease takes his head upon her lap;
+and soon as she is weary of her burden, Activity jumps up and relieves
+her from it."
+
+"But to whom does that more barren country just beyond belong?" asked
+the Prince. "And what is that great thick wood I see farther on
+still?"
+
+"That is the land of Labor and the Forest of Adversity," said the man.
+"I would advise you to get through them as soon as possible, for the
+first you will find very wearisome, and the second exceedingly
+unpleasant, although people do say that there is a great deal of very
+good fruit in the forest; only one gets well-nigh torn to pieces with
+the thorns before one can reach it."
+
+The Prince determined to follow his advice, and rode on. There was not
+anything very tempting to him as he passed through the land of Labor,
+and it seemed a long and weary way from the beginning to the end of
+it. But the forest, even at its entrance, was very dark and gloomy
+indeed. Thick trees crossed each other overhead, and shut out the
+bright, cheerful daylight. He could hardly see his way along the
+narrow, tortuous paths, and the thorns which the peasant had spoken of
+ran into him continually, for they grew high as well as thick, and
+crossed the path in every direction. He began heartily to repent that
+he had quitted the palace of Prosperity, and wished himself back again
+with all his heart, thinking that he should care little about yawning
+Satiety if he could but get out of the thorns of Adversity. Indeed, he
+tried to turn his horse back; but he found it more difficult than he
+imagined, for, as I have told you, the road was very narrow and those
+thorns hedged it on every side. There was nothing for it, in short,
+but to try and force his way on through the wood, in the hope of
+finding something better beyond.
+
+The Prince did not know which way to take, indeed, and he tried a
+great number of paths, but in vain. Still there were the same thorns
+and the same gloomy darkness. He was hungry and thirsty, and he looked
+round for those fruits he had heard of; but he could see none of them
+at the time, and the more he sought his way out, the deeper he seemed
+to get into the forest. The air was very sultry and oppressive, too;
+he grew weary and faint, quite sick at heart, and even the limbs of
+his good horse seemed to be failing him, and hardly able to carry him
+on.
+
+Dark as it all was, it at length began to grow darker, and he
+perceived that night was coming, so that the poor Prince began to give
+up all hope, and to think that there would be nothing for him but to
+lie down and die in despair, when suddenly he caught a sort of
+twinkling light through the thick bushes, which seemed to lie in the
+way he was going, and on he went, slowly enough, poor man! But still
+the light was before him, till suddenly he came to a great rock,
+overgrown in many places with briers and brambles. In the midst of
+it, however, was the mouth of a large cave, with great masses of
+stone hanging over, as if ready to fall on a traveler's head. It was a
+very stern and gloomy looking place indeed, with clefts and crevices
+and ragged crags all around. But a few steps in the cave some one
+seemed to have built himself a house; for it was blocked up with
+large, unhewn boards of wood, and in this partition there was a door
+and a window, through which came the light he had seen. The Prince
+dismounted from his horse, and though he did not know who might be
+within, he thought it best to knock at the door, and ask for food and
+shelter.
+
+The moment he knocked a loud, hoarse voice cried: "Come in!" and tying
+his horse to a tree, he opened the door.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+
+Now, whatever the poor Prince had expected to find, he was certainly
+disappointed; for that thicket of Adversity is full of disappointments,
+as every one knows who has traveled through it. He had thought he
+should see some poor woodman or honest peasant, who would welcome him
+to his homely hut in the rock with kindness and benevolence; but
+instead of that he beheld, seated at the table, carving away at a
+piece of stick by the light of a very small twinkling candle, one of
+the most tremendous monsters ever man's eyes lighted upon. In shape he
+was like a man, but he was a great deal stronger than any man. His
+face looked as if it were cast in iron, so hard and rigid were all the
+features; and there was an ever-lasting frown planted on his brow. His
+hands were long and sinewy, with terrible sharp claws upon them; and
+his feet were so large and heavy that they seemed as if they would
+crush anything they would set upon to pieces.
+
+The poor Prince, though he was a very brave young man, stopped and
+hesitated at the sight of this giant; but the monster, without ever
+turning his head, cried out again: "Come in! Why do you pause? All men
+must obey me, and I am the only one that all men do obey."
+
+"You must be a mighty monarch, then," said the young Prince, taking
+courage, "Pray, what is your name?"
+
+"My name is Necessity," answered the other in his thundering voice;
+"and some people give me bad names, and call me 'Hard Necessity' and
+'Dire Necessity;' but, nevertheless, I often lead men to great things
+and teach them useful arts if they do but struggle with me valiantly."
+
+"Then I wish you would lead me to where I can get some rest," said the
+Prince, "and teach me how I can procure food for myself and my poor
+famishing horse."
+
+The monster rose up almost as tall as a steeple and suddenly laid his
+great clutches upon the Prince's shoulders, saying: "I will do both,
+if you do but wrestle with me courageously. You must do it, for there
+is no other way of escaping from my hands."
+
+The Prince had never been handled so roughly before, and as he was
+brave, strong, and active, he made a great effort to free himself, and
+tried a thousand ways, but to no purpose. The giant did not hurt him,
+however, though he pressed him very hard, and at length he cried out:
+"Ho, ho! you are a brave young man! Leave off struggling, and you
+shall have some food and drink, such as you would never have tasted
+had you not come to me."
+
+Thereupon he led him to his own coarse wooden table, and set before
+him half of a hard brown loaf and a pitcher of water; but so hungry
+and thirsty was the Prince that the bread seemed to him the best he
+had ever eaten, and the water sweeter than any in the world.
+
+"Unfasten your horse's bridle," said Necessity, when the Prince had
+done, "and I will soon teach him where to find something to feed
+upon."
+
+The Prince did as the giant told him at once, and then his
+stern-looking companion pointed to a wooden bedstead in a dark corner
+of the cave, which looked as hard as his own face, saying: "There, lie
+down and sleep."
+
+"I can never sleep on that thing," said the Prince.
+
+"Ho, ho!" cried the other; "Necessity can make any bed soft," and
+taking a bundle of straw, he threw it down on the bedstead.
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+
+Sleep was sweeter to the Prince that night than it had ever been upon
+a bed of down, and when he rose the next morning the monster's
+features did not seem half so stern and forbidding as they had done at
+first. The inside of the cave, too, looked much more light and
+blithesome, though it was a dark and frowning place enough still, with
+hard rock all round, and nothing but one window to let in a little
+sunshine.
+
+Necessity, however, did not intend to keep the Prince there, and as
+soon as he was up the giant said to him: "Come, trudge; you must quit
+my cave, and go on."
+
+"You must open the door for me, then," said the Prince; "for the bolt
+is so high up I cannot reach it."
+
+"You cannot get out by the door through which you came in," said the
+giant, "for it is the door of Idleness. There is but one way for you
+to get out, and that I will show you."
+
+So, taking him by the hand, he led him on into a very dark part of the
+cave, which went a long way under ground, and then said to him: "You
+must now go on until you come to a great house, where you will find an
+old woman, who will give you your meals at least."
+
+"But I want to return to my own palace of Prosperity," replied the
+Prince.
+
+"She will show you the way," replied the monster, "and without her you
+will never find it. Go on at once, and don't stand talking."
+
+"But I cannot see the path," said the Prince.
+
+"You must find it," said Necessity, and gave him a great push, which
+sent him on at a very rapid rate.
+
+For some time he continued to grope his way almost in darkness, but
+soon a light began to shine before him, which grew bigger and bigger
+as he advanced, and he perceived that he was coming to another mouth
+of the cave, leading to an open but very rough country. The Prince was
+very glad indeed to issue forth and breathe the fresh air, and he
+looked at the clear sky with great satisfaction. Just before him,
+however, there was a large house, with a great number of doors and
+windows; and as he felt very hungry, he determined to knock, and see
+if he could get any breakfast.
+
+Almost as soon as he had touched the knocker the door was opened by a
+little old woman, plainly dressed, but neat and tidy: and when the
+Prince told her who he was, and what he wanted, she answered him with
+a good-humored smile, very different from the frown of stern
+Necessity: "Every one can have food in my house who chooses to work
+for it; nobody without. I can help you on your way, too; and as for
+your poor horse you talk about, he shall be provided for. My name is
+Industry, and Industry always takes care of her beasts. Come in, young
+man; come in."
+
+The Prince went in with a glad step, and found the house quite full of
+people, all as busy as bees in a field of clover, and all looking as
+bright and cheerful as if they had washed their faces in sunshine.
+
+It would take me an hour to tell you all the different things they
+were employed in, every one working by himself on his separate task,
+although two or three were often seen doing different pieces of the
+same work. But there were two very nice, pretty girls there whom I
+must speak of, who seemed to be handmaidens to the mistress of the
+house. One was a thoughtful-looking, careful girl, who was busy in
+every part of the room alternately, picking up all the little odds and
+ends which were left after any piece of work was completed--little
+bits of string, ends of tape or thread, stray nails, chips of wood, or
+pieces of paper. These, as soon as she had gathered them up, she put
+safely by, where she could find them again; and it is wonderful how
+often she was called upon by the workmen for some little scrap or
+another, just sufficient to complete what they were about. Her name
+was Economy.
+
+The other was a brighter, quicker-looking person, with very clear
+eyes, like two stars, who went continually through the room, putting
+everything to rights. If a chair was out of its place, or a table
+turned awry, or a tool put down where it should not be, she could not
+bear to see it for a minute, but put all things straight again, so
+that nobody was at a loss where to find anything, She was called
+Order.
+
+The hungry Prince was somewhat mortified to find a good, large piece
+of work assigned him to do before he could get his breakfast, and at
+first he was exceedingly awkward, and did not know how to set about
+it; but Industry showed him the way, Order helped him a good deal, and
+Economy supplied him with the materials.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+
+At the end of an hour he had completed his task, and the old lady
+patted him on the shoulder, saying, "Well done; you are a very good
+young man. Now Industry will give you your breakfast, and help you on
+the way to a very nice place, where you will get all you desire."
+
+Thus saying, she led him into a great hall, where there was a vast
+number of people, all eating rich fruits, with a somewhat hard-favored
+dame, whom they called Labor, scattering sugar on the different
+dishes.
+
+When the Prince heard her name, he asked one of the people near if
+that was really Labor, saying, "I passed through her land not long
+ago, and it seemed so poor and hard a country that I should have
+thought it produced nothing good."
+
+"That is a mistake," said the other. "That is the land where grows the
+sugar-cane, and Labor always sweetens the food of Industry."
+
+As soon as his breakfast was over, the Prince was taken to another
+door, and shown a road which was very narrow at first, but seemed to
+grow wider and wider as it went on.
+
+"You have nothing to do but to walk straight forward," said Industry,
+"neither to turn to the right nor to the left. Keep yourself upright,
+so that you may have that distant mountain peak before your eyes, and
+don't suffer yourself to grow faint or get tired. If you should have
+any doubt or difficulty, you will find some one on the road who will
+show you the way. But only remember always to keep straight forward,
+and don't be tempted to turn aside."
+
+"What is the name of this road?" asked the Prince.
+
+"It is called the 'Right Path'" was the reply; and on he set upon his
+way with a stout heart. Nevertheless, he began to get somewhat tired
+before an hour was over, although the road was pleasant enough to walk
+in. There were beautiful green meadows on every side, and richly
+colored flowers, and what seemed very delicious fruit; and here and
+there, at a little distance, were pleasant groves, with a number of
+gay birds, singing very sweetly.
+
+At the end of an hour and a half the Prince became hungry and thirsty
+again, as well as tired, and he said to himself, "There could be no
+great harm surely in going across that meadow and gathering some of
+that fruit, to eat under the shade of the trees, while the birds sing
+over my head. I do not know how far I have to go. I see no end to this
+long, straight road. I think I will try and rest for a little under
+those trees. I can easily find my way back again."
+
+But just at that moment, luckily for himself, the Prince spied a man
+trudging on before him, and he hurried after, saying to himself, "I
+will ask him how far I have to go, and whether I have time to stop."
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+
+The man did not walk very fast, but he kept steadily on, with a great
+pikestaff in his hand; and though the Prince called after him as soon
+as he was within hearing, he did not halt for a moment, or even turn
+his head, but trudged onward, saying, "Come along, come along; one
+never gets to the end of one's journey if one stops to chatter by the
+way."
+
+At length the Prince came up with him, and said in a civil tone, "Pray
+can you tell me whither this road leads, and if it will be very long
+before I get to some house where I can find rest and food?"
+
+"It leads to a very fine and beautiful castle," replied the other
+somewhat doggedly, and still walking on. "I think, if you come along
+with me, you will get there in time. I am generally well received
+there, and in some sort may call myself the master of the house, so
+that those who go with me are generally made welcome by my lady, who,
+though she is sometimes a little whimsical, is the most charming
+person in the world when she smiles upon me. But you must keep on
+steadily with me; for if you stop or turn aside, a thousand to one you
+will be lost."
+
+When the Prince found him so communicative, he asked him if they could
+not cross one of the meadows to refresh themselves a little, and told
+him how he had been tempted to do so just before he saw him.
+
+"Lucky you did not," answered the other; "for those meadows are full
+of swamps and quagmires, the groves filled with snakes, and many of
+the fruits poisonous. You might have got yourself into such troubles
+that not even I could have helped you out of them."
+
+"If it is not improper, may I ask your name?" said the Prince.
+
+"Come along," answered the other, "Names matter little; but if you
+want to know mine, it is Perseverance."
+
+Not long after the Prince began to think he saw several tall towers
+glittering before him in the distance, with some misty clouds round
+about them, which only seemed to make them look the more beautiful.
+
+"What a fine castle!" he exclaimed.
+
+"That is where I am leading you," answered the other; "and the first
+prospect is always very charming. But we have some way to go yet, I
+can tell you, and not a little to overcome. You would never get there
+without me; so come on, and do not be daunted at anything you see."
+
+The Prince soon found that his companion's warning was just. The way
+did seem very long; and sometimes, as they went over hill and dale,
+the sight of the beautiful castle, which cheered him so much, was
+quite shut out from his eyes, and at length, when they were coming
+very near it, with nothing but one valley between them and the
+building, he perceived that the road went over a narrow drawbridge,
+and saw two terrible monsters lying close beside the way. Their bodies
+were like those of lions, very large and very strong, but they had
+necks like that of a snake, and from each neck issued a hundred
+horrible heads, all differing in kind from one another.
+
+The poor Prince was alarmed, and said to his companion: "Do you see
+those horrible brutes? Is there no other way into the castle but
+between them?"
+
+"There are a thousand ways into the castle," replied his companion,
+"but every way is guarded by monsters just like those. But do not be
+alarmed. Go on with me, and I will help you. Besides, some one will
+come out of the castle, most likely, to give us assistance."
+
+
+
+
+VII
+
+
+Upon these words, the Prince went on more cheerfully, especially when
+he saw a man come running down from the gate of the castle as they
+approached the drawbridge.
+
+"Ay," said his companion, stepping on without stopping a moment,
+"there comes my friend Courage to help us. He is a good, serviceable
+fellow."
+
+Just as he spoke, the two monsters sprang forward, and the one which
+was nearest to Perseverance growled terribly at him; but he struck him
+a blow with his pikestaff, which knocked him down and cowed him
+entirely; and there he lay, with all his hundred heads prostrated in a
+manner which the Prince could hardly have thought possible. The other
+brute sprang right at the Prince himself, as if to destroy him, so
+that he was inclined to draw back; but the man Courage, who had run
+down from the castle, put his foot upon the creature's snaky neck, and
+crushed it into the earth.
+
+"Go on, go on, young man!" he cried. "These are terrible monsters
+truly, but you see our friend Perseverance has vanquished Difficulty,
+and I have trampled upon Danger."
+
+As he spoke, the Prince passed on rapidly over the drawbridge; and
+when he stood under the gate of the castle, Perseverance took him by
+the hand with a smiling air, and led him in, saying: "Now I will
+conduct you to my lady, Success."
+
+At the very sound the poor Prince seemed quite refreshed, forgot all
+the weary way he had traveled, the dark forest of Adversity, the grim
+frown of Necessity, the faintness and the weariness, and
+hundred-headed Difficulty and Danger. But he was more rejoiced still
+when, on entering the building, he found himself suddenly, all at
+once, in the great hall of his own palace of Prosperity, with a
+beautiful lady, all smiles, standing ready to receive him with a crown
+in her hand.
+
+"Come hither, Prince," she said, "and receive this crown, which I
+never bestow on any but my greatest favorites. It is called the crown
+of Contentment. I reserve it for those who, led on by Perseverance,
+come to me by the Right Path, in spite of Difficulty and Danger. Those
+who arrive at my presence by any of the many other roads that are open
+to mankind I give over to the charge of some of my inferior
+attendants, such as Pride, Vanity, or Ambition, who amuse themselves
+by making them play all manner of strange tricks."
+
+Thus saying, she put the crown upon his head, and the Prince found the
+most delightful tranquil feeling spread through his whole body.
+Nevertheless, he could not help looking about almost instantly for the
+figure of the ugly little gray dwarf; and, as he could not see him
+anywhere, he said to the beautiful lady: "Where is that hideous,
+yawning Satiety? I hope he has left the palace."
+
+"He may be hanging about in some dark corners of the palace," answered
+the lady, "or hiding among the roses in your garden of Pleasure; but
+he will never appear in your presence again, so long as you wear that
+crown upon your head; for there is a rich jewel called Moderation in
+the crown of Contentment which is too bright and pure to be looked
+upon by Satiety."
+
+
+
+
+THE FRUITS OF DISOBEDIENCE
+
+OR THE KIDNAPPED CHILD
+
+
+In a beautiful villa on the banks of the Medway resided a gentleman
+whose name was Darnley, who had, during the early part of life, filled
+a post of some importance about the Court, and even in its decline
+preserved that elegance of manners which so peculiarly marks a
+finished gentleman.
+
+The loss of a beloved wife had given a pensive cast to his features,
+and a seriousness to his deportment, which many people imagined
+proceeded from haughtiness of disposition, yet nothing could be
+further from Mr. Darnley's character, for he was affable, gentle,
+benevolent, and humane.
+
+His family consisted of an only sister, who, like himself, had lost
+the object of her tenderest affection, but who, in dividing her
+attention between her brother and his amiable children, endeavored to
+forget her own misfortunes.
+
+Mr. Darnley's fortune was sufficiently great to enable him to place
+his daughters in the first school in London, but he preferred having
+them under his immediate instruction, and as Mrs. Collier offered to
+assist him in their education he resolved for some years not to engage
+a governess, as Nurse Chapman was one of those worthy creatures to
+whose care he could securely trust them.
+
+An old friend of Mr. Darnley's had recently bought a house at
+Rochester, and that gentleman and his sister were invited to pass a
+few days there, and as Emily grew rather too big for the nurse's
+management Mrs. Collier resolved to make her of the party, leaving
+Sophia, Amanda, and Eliza under that good woman's protection.
+
+It was Mr. Darnley's wish that the young folks should rise early and
+take a long walk every morning before breakfast, but they were
+strictly ordered never to go beyond their own grounds unless their
+aunt or father accompanied them. This order they had frequently
+endeavored to persuade Nurse Chapman to disregard, but, faithful to
+the trust reposed in her, she always resisted their urgent entreaties.
+
+The morning after Mr. Darnley went to Rochester the poor woman found
+herself thoroughly indisposed, and wholly incapable of rising at the
+accustomed hour. The children, however, were dressed for walking, and
+the nurse-maid charged not to go beyond the shrubbery, and they all
+sallied out in high good humor.
+
+"Now, Susan," said Sophia, as soon as they entered the garden, "this
+is the only opportunity you may ever have of obliging us. Do let us
+walk to the village, and then you know you can see your father and
+mother."
+
+"La, missy!" replied the girl, "why, you know 'tis as much as my place
+is worth if Nurse Chapman should find out."
+
+"Find it out indeed," said Amanda; "how do you think she is to find it
+out? Come, do let us go, there's a dear, good creature."
+
+"Yes, dear, dear Susan, do let us go," said Eliza, skipping on before
+them, "and I'll show you the way, for I walked there last summer with
+father."
+
+Whether it was the wish of obliging the young ladies, or the desire of
+seeing her parents, I cannot pretend to say, but in a luckless hour
+Susan yielded, and the party soon reached the village.
+
+Susan's mother was delighted at seeing her, and highly honored by the
+young ladies' presence.
+
+"Oh, sweet, dear creatures!" said the old woman, "I must get something
+for them to eat after their long walk, and my oven's quite hot, and I
+can bake them a little cake in a quarter of an hour, and I'll milk
+Jenny in ten minutes."
+
+The temptation of her hot cake and new milk was not to be withstood,
+and Susan began taking down some smart china cups, which were arranged
+in form upon the mantelpiece, and carefully dusted them for the young
+ladies' use.
+
+Eliza followed the old woman into the cow-house, and began asking a
+thousand questions, when her attention was suddenly attracted by the
+appearance of a tame lamb, who went up bleating to its mistress with
+a view of asking its accustomed breakfast.
+
+"You must wait a little, Billy," said the woman, "and let your betters
+be served before you. Don't you see that we have got gentlefolks to
+breakfast with us this morning?"
+
+Eliza was so delighted with the beauty of the little animal that she
+wanted to kiss it, and attempted to restrain it for that purpose,
+while Billy, ungrateful for her intended kindness, gave a sudden
+spring and frisked away.
+
+Eliza followed in hopes of being able to catch him, but he ran baaing
+along into the high road.
+
+A woman whose appearance was descriptive of poverty but whose smiling
+countenance indicated good nature, at that moment happened to pass,
+and, accosting Eliza in a tone of familiarity, said: "That's not half
+such a pretty lamb, miss, as I have got at home, and not a quarter so
+tame, for if you did but say, 'Bob' he'd follow you from one end of
+the town to the other, and then he'll fetch and carry like a dog,
+stand up on his hind legs, when my husband says 'Up' for the thing,
+and play more tricks than a young kitten."
+
+"Oh, the pretty creature," replied Eliza, "how I should like to see
+it!"
+
+"Well, come along with me, miss," said the woman, "for I only lives
+just across the next field, but you must run as hard as you can,
+because my husband is going to work, and he generally takes Bob with
+him."
+
+"Well, make haste, then," said Eliza.
+
+"Give me your hand, miss," replied the woman; "for we can run faster
+together. But there goes my husband, I declare; and there's Bob, as
+usual, skipping on before."
+
+"Where? where?" exclaimed Eliza, stretching her little neck as far as
+she possibly could, to see if she could discern the lamb.
+
+"You are not tall enough," said the artful creature; "but let me lift
+you up, miss, and then I dare say you will see them;" and, instantly
+catching her up, she cried out: "Look directly towards the steeple,
+miss; but I'll run with you in my arms, and I warrant we'll soon
+overtake them."
+
+Eliza looked, but looked in vain, and, perceiving the woman had soon
+carried her out of sight of the cottage, begged she would set her
+down, as she dare not go any farther.
+
+The vile creature was absolutely incapable of replying, for her breath
+was nearly exhausted by the rapidity of the motion, and Eliza
+continued entreating her to stop, and struggled violently to elude her
+grasp.
+
+At length, after a quarter of an hour's exertion, the woman found
+herself incapable of proceeding, and stopped suddenly, sat down on a
+bank, keeping tight hold of Eliza's arms, who cried dreadfully, and
+besought her to let her go.
+
+"Let you go!" she replied; "what, after all the plague I've had to
+knap you? No, no, you don't catch me at that, I promise you; but be a
+good girl, and don't cry, and then you may see Bob by and by,
+perhaps."
+
+"Oh, my sisters! my sisters! Let me go to my sisters!" cried the
+child.
+
+"I'll find plenty of sisters for you in a few days," said the vile
+creature; "but they won't know you in them there fine clothes; so
+let's pull them off in a minute, and then we'll have another run after
+Bob."
+
+So saying, she stripped off the white frock, hat, and tippet. The rest
+of the things shared the same fate, and Eliza was compelled to put on
+some old rags which the inhuman creature took out of a bag she carried
+under her petticoat; then, taking a bottle of liquid from the same
+place, she instantly began washing Eliza's face with it, and,
+notwithstanding all her remonstrances, cut her beautiful hair close to
+her head.
+
+Thus metamorphosed, it would have been impossible even for Mr. Darnley
+to have known his child, and they proceeded onward until her little
+legs would carry her no farther. At this period they were overtaken by
+the Canterbury wagon, and for a mere trifle the driver consented to
+let them ride to London. Eliza's tears continued to flow, but she
+dared not utter a complaint, as her inhuman companion protested she
+would break every bone in her skin if she ventured to make the least
+noise.
+
+When they arrived in town, she was dragged (for to walk she was
+unable) to a miserable hole down several steps, where they gave her
+some bread and butter to eat, and then desired her to go to bed.
+
+The bed, if such it might be called, was little else than a bundle of
+rags thrown into a corner of the room, with a dirty blanket spread
+across it; and there she was left by her inhuman kidnapper to mourn
+her misfortunes and lament having disregarded her fathers'
+injunctions.
+
+The next morning she was forced to rise the moment it was light, and
+to walk as far as her little legs would carry her before they stopped
+anywhere to take refreshment. The second night was passed in a barn,
+and about five o'clock the third afternoon they knocked at the door of
+a neat-looking cottage, where nine or ten children were sitting in a
+little room making lace.
+
+"Why, Peggy," said the woman, as she opened the door, "I thought you
+never would have come again! However, I see you have got me a hand at
+last, and God knows I'm enough in want of her; for two of my brats
+have thought proper to fall sick, and I have more to do than ever I
+had in my life."
+
+On the following day Eliza's filthy rags were all taken off, and she
+was dressed in a tidy brown-stuff gown, a nice clean round-eared cap,
+and a little colored bib and apron; and she was ordered, if any person
+asked her name, to say it was Biddy Bullen, and that she was niece to
+the woman who employed her.
+
+The severity with which all this wretch's commands were enforced
+wholly prevented any of the helpless victims who were under her
+protection from daring to disobey them; and though most of them were
+placed under her care by the same vile agent who had decoyed Eliza,
+yet they were all tutored to relate similar untruths.
+
+But I now think it is high time to carry my little readers back to the
+cottage scene, where Susan was arranging things in order for
+breakfast, and Sophia and her sister were anxiously watching the
+moment when the cake was pronounced completely ready.
+
+The old woman soon returned with the milk-pail on her arm, and Susan
+eagerly demanded: "Where's Miss Eliza?"
+
+"Oh, the pretty creature!" replied her mother, "she'll be here in a
+minute, I warrant her; but she has gone skipping after our Billy, and
+the two sweet innocents they are together."
+
+She then went to the oven, produced the cake, and began buttering it
+with all expedition, while Sophia joyously ran to the door of the
+cow-house, and began loudly calling her sister Eliza.
+
+No answer being returned, Susan began to feel alarmed, but the young
+ladies told her not to be frightened, as they knew it was only one of
+Eliza's pranks. But, alas! too soon were they convinced it was no
+joke, but some dreadful misfortune must have happened.
+
+"Miss Eliza! Miss Eliza!" was vociferated through the village, not
+only by Susan and her mother, but by all the neighbors who had heard
+of the calamity, while her sisters ran about frantic with grief,
+crying, "Eliza, my love! my darling! Oh, if you are hid, for pity's
+sake speak!"
+
+Nurse Chapman got up about half-past nine, and, hearing the children
+were not returned from their walk, sent the housemaid directly after
+them.
+
+The garden, the shrubbery, and the lawn were all searched without
+success; and just as Betty was returning to inform the nurse they were
+not to be found, she perceived Susan and the two children enter a
+little green gate at the bottom of the shrubbery.
+
+"Where's Miss Eliza?" called Betty, in a voice as loud as she could
+articulate.
+
+"God knows! God knows!" replied the careless girl, sobbing so loud she
+could scarcely speak.
+
+"How! where! when!" said the others. "Why, poor nurse will go stark,
+staring mad!"
+
+By that time the poor woman had quitted her room, and walked into the
+garden to see what had become of her little charges; and, not directly
+missing Eliza from the group, which was then fast approaching towards
+the house, she called out:
+
+"Come, my dear children--come along! I thought you would never have
+returned again." And, observing Eliza was not with them, she
+continued: "But, Susan, what's become of my sweet bird? Where's my
+little darling, Miss Eliza?"
+
+"Oh, nurse! nurse!" said Sophia, "my sister's lost! indeed she's
+lost!"
+
+"Lost!" exclaimed the poor old woman--"lost! What do you tell me? What
+do I hear? Oh, my master! my dear master! never shall I bear to see
+his face again!"
+
+Susan then repeated every circumstance just as has been related, and
+with sighs and tears bewailed her own folly in suffering herself to be
+over-persuaded. And the children declared they dare not encounter
+their father's displeasure.
+
+The men servants were instantly summoned and sent on horseback
+different ways. That she had been stolen admitted of no doubt, as
+there was no water near the cottage; and had any accident happened,
+they must have found her, as they had searched every part of the
+village before they ventured to return home.
+
+One servant was sent to Rochester, another towards London, and a third
+and fourth across the country roads; but no intelligence could be
+obtained, nor the slightest information gathered, by which the
+unfortunate child could be found, or her wicked decoyer's footsteps
+traced.
+
+When Mr. Darnley was apprised of the calamitous event, the agitation
+of his mind may be easily conceived, but can never be described.
+
+Handbills were instantly circulated all over the country, the child's
+person described, and a reward of five hundred guineas offered for her
+restoration.
+
+Sophia and Amanda were inconsolable, and Susan was ordered to be
+discharged before Mr. Darnley returned home, which he did not for more
+than a month after the melancholy circumstance happened, as he was not
+satisfied with sending messengers in pursuit of his lost treasure, but
+went himself to all those wretched parts of London where poverty and
+vice are known to dwell, in the hope of meeting the object of his
+solicitude, and at length gave up the interesting pursuit, because he
+found his health rendered him incapable of continuing it.
+
+Nine tedious months passed away without any intelligence of the lost
+Eliza; and time, which is a general remedy for all misfortunes, had
+not softened the severity of their affliction. Mrs. Collier had
+engaged a lady to be governess to her nieces, as her attention had
+been wholly devoted to her unfortunate brother, whose agitated state
+of mind had produced a bodily complaint which demanded her unremitting
+care and tenderness.
+
+Although Emily loved Eliza with the fondest affection, yet her grief
+was much less poignant than either of her sisters', as she could not
+accuse herself with being accessory to her loss.
+
+"Never, never shall I forgive myself," Sophia would often say, "for
+having deviated from my dear father's command! Oh, so good and
+indulgent as he is to us, how wicked it was to transgress his will! I
+was the eldest, and ought to have known better, and my poor Eliza is
+the sufferer for my crime!"
+
+Thus would she bewail her folly and imprudence, until, agonized by the
+torture of her own reflections, she would sink down in a chair quite
+exhausted, and burst into a flood of tears.
+
+While the family at Darnley Hall were thus a prey to unavailing
+sorrow, the lovely little girl who had occasioned it was beginning to
+grow more reconciled to the cruelty of her destiny, and to support her
+different mode of life with resignation and composure. She had
+acquired such a degree of skill in the art of lacemaking (which was
+the business her employer followed) as generally to be able to perform
+the tasks which were allotted her; and if it so happened she was
+incapable of doing it, Sally Butchell, a child almost two years older
+than herself, of whom she was very fond, was always kind enough to
+complete it for her.
+
+The cottage in which the vile Mrs. Bullen resided was situated about a
+quarter of a mile from High Wycombe; and whenever she was obliged to
+go to that place, either to purchase or to dispose of her goods, she
+always went either before her family were up, or after they had
+retired to rest, locking the door constantly after her, and putting
+the key in her pocket, so that the poor little souls had no
+opportunity of telling their misfortunes to any human creature.
+
+One intense hot afternoon, in the month of August, as the children
+were sitting hard at work with the door open for the sake of air, an
+elderly lady and gentleman walked up to it, and begged to be
+accommodated with a seat, informing Mrs. Bullen their carriage had
+broken down a mile distant, and they had been obliged to walk in the
+heat of the sun.
+
+The appearance of so many children, all industriously employed, was a
+sight particularly pleasing to the liberal-minded Mrs. Montague, and
+she immediately began asking the woman several questions about them;
+but there was something of confusion in her manner of replying that
+called forth Mrs. Montague's surprise and astonishment.
+
+"They really are lovely children, my dear," said she, turning to Mr.
+Montague, who had stood at the door watching the approach of the
+carriage, which he perceived coming forward; "and as to that little
+creature with the mole under her left eye, I declare I think it is a
+perfect beauty."
+
+Mr. Montague turned his head, and regarded Eliza with a look that at
+once proved that his sentiments corresponded with those of his lady.
+
+"What is your name, my love?" said he, in a tone of kindness which
+poor Eliza had long been a stranger to.
+
+The child colored like scarlet, and looked immediately at her inhuman
+employer, who, catching the contagion, replied with evident marks of
+confusion:
+
+"Her name is Biddy Bullen, sir; she's my niece; but 'tis a poor timid
+little fool, and is always in a fright when gentlefolks happen to
+speak to her. Go, Biddy," she continued--"go up into my bedroom, and
+mind that thread which you'll find upon the reel."
+
+"You should try to conquer that timidity," said Mr. Montague, "by
+making her answer every stranger who speaks to her; but by taking that
+office upon yourself, you absolutely encourage the shyness you
+complain of. Come hither, my little girl," continued he, observing she
+was retiring upstairs, "and tell the lady what your name is."
+
+Encouraged by the kindness of Mr. Montague's address, the agitated
+child obeyed the summons, although Mrs. Bullen attempted to force her
+into resistance.
+
+"Well," continued the old gentleman, patting her on the cheek, "and
+where did you get that pretty mole?"
+
+"My mother gave it me, sir," replied the blushing child; "but I did
+not see her do it, because Nurse Chapman told me she went to heaven as
+soon as I was born."
+
+"Your mother! And what was your mother's name?" said Mr. Montague.
+
+"Darnley, sir," said the child, and suddenly recollecting the lesson
+that had been taught her--"but my name is Biddy Bullen, and that is my
+aunt."
+
+"Darnley!" exclaimed Mrs. Montague--"the very child that has been for
+these twelve months past advertised in all the papers"--then turning
+to convince herself of the fact--"and the very mole confirms it."
+
+Mr. Montague immediately attempted to secure the woman, but her
+activity eluded his grasp, and darting out at the back door she was
+out of sight in a few moments.
+
+"Is she really gone? Is she gone?" all the little voices at once
+demanded, and upon Mr. Montague's assuring them she was really gone
+for ever, their joy broke out in a thousand different ways--some
+cried, some laughed, and others jumped. In short, there never was a
+scene more completely calculated to interest the feelings of a
+benevolent heart.
+
+Mr. Montague's carriage at this period arrived, and the footman was
+desired to fetch a magistrate from Wycombe, while the worthy clergyman
+resolved to remain there until his arrival, and began questioning all
+the children. Two had been there from so early a period that they
+could give no account of their name or origin, but all the rest were
+so clear in their description that the benevolent Mr. Montague had no
+doubt of being able to restore them to their afflicted parents.
+
+The magistrate soon arrived, attended by the worthy rector of the
+place, who, hearing from Mr. Montague's servant that a child had been
+stolen, came with the intent of offering his services.
+
+All but Eliza were immediately put under his protection, but Mrs.
+Montague was so anxious she should be their earliest care that she
+begged her husband to order a post-chaise directly, and set off
+immediately for town. This request was willingly complied with, and by
+three o'clock the next afternoon the party arrived at Darnley Hall.
+
+Mrs. Collier was standing at the window when the carriage stopped, and
+looking earnestly at her niece suddenly exclaimed in a tone of
+rapture: "My child! My child! My lost Eliza!"
+
+Mr. Darnley, who was reading, sprang from his seat, and flew to the
+door in a ecstasy of joy. In less than a minute he returned folding
+his Eliza to his throbbing heart. The joyful intelligence ran through
+the house, and the other children impatiently flew to this scene of
+transport.
+
+To describe their feelings or express their felicity would require the
+aid of the most descriptive pen, and even then would be but faintly
+told, and therefore had much better be passed over.
+
+From that moment the children all unanimously agreed strictly to
+attend to their father's orders, and never in the slightest instance
+act in opposition to his will.
+
+Mr. and Mrs. Montague were laden with caresses, and earnestly
+entreated to remain Mr. Darnley's guests. The hospitable invitation
+would have been gladly accepted had not the thoughts of the poor
+children who were still at Wycombe seemed to claim his immediate
+attention, and so great was the philanthropy of Mr. Montague's
+character that he could never rest satisfied if a single duty remained
+unfulfilled.
+
+
+
+
+DICKY RANDOM
+
+OR GOOD NATURE IS NOTHING WITHOUT GOOD CONDUCT
+
+
+ "In festive play this maxim prize--
+ Be always merry--always WISE!"
+
+"Do you know what hour it is when you see a clock?" said Mr. Random to
+his little son Richard.
+
+"Yes, father," said Richard; "for I can count it all round. When both
+hands are at the top of the clock, then I know it is time to leave
+school."
+
+"Then go and see what time it is," said his father.
+
+Away ran Richard, and brought back word in a moment that it was
+exactly six o'clock.
+
+In a few minutes after came in a friend with a young lady, the former
+of whom asked Mr. Random why he was not ready to go with them to the
+concert that evening, as he had promised. Mr. Random replied that it
+was but six o'clock, which, however, he was soon convinced was a
+mistake of Richard's, who, on being asked what he saw when he looked
+on the clock, replied, "I saw the two hands together close to the six,
+and that made me say it was six, for I always call it twelve when they
+are right opposite."
+
+"Remember, my dear," said his father, "that the long hand never tells
+the hour, except on the stroke of twelve. You ought to know that the
+minute hand overtakes its fellow somewhat later every hour, till at
+noon and midnight they again start exactly even; and when a bigger boy
+I shall expect you to tell me how much difference is increased every
+time they come into conjunction. You now see, Dicky, that through such
+a mistake I must make my friends wait; pray, therefore, mind better
+another time."
+
+In a few minutes after his father bid him go into the dining-room, and
+bring down a bottle of wine, which stood in the _hither_ corner of
+the cellaret, that he might help the gentleman, and lady to a glass.
+
+"Yes, father," said little Dick, and up he went. On the stairs he met
+puss, and stopped to play with her, during which he forgot what had
+been told him. Having gotten a bottle, downstairs he came, and,
+pouring out a couple of glasses, he returned with it. But, when on the
+landing-place, he naughtily drew out the cork to have a taste himself.
+It was not only very vulgar to drink out of the neck of a bottle, but
+wrong to make free slily with that which he was merely entrusted to
+serve out. However, it rushed so fast into his mouth, and was so hot,
+that he was afraid of being strangled. It happened that he had bitten
+his cheek that morning, and the liquor bathing the sore place made it
+smart so that he put down the bottle on the floor, when, in stamping
+about, it rolled downstairs and made a fine clatter. His father ran
+out on hearing the noise, but was stopped in the way by seeing the
+young lady almost gasping for breath, and it was some minutes before
+she could say that he had given her brandy instead of wine.
+
+Mr. Random next proceeded upstairs, where little Dick was picking up
+the pieces of broken glass, in doing which he cut a deep gash in his
+hand.
+
+"Where did you take the bottle from?"
+
+"Out of the _farther_ side of the cellaret," said Dicky.
+
+"I told you to take it from the _hither_ side," replied Mr. Random.
+"But, however, you shall smart for your neglect: what remains of the
+brandy will serve to bathe your hand, and I hope the pain will make
+you reflect that the loss is the same to me, whether you spilt it from
+design or inattention."
+
+He one day made his mother look very simple at table, for which he
+deserved to have suffered much more than her good nature required.
+Young Random was to have a grand rout in the evening with some of his
+little favorites. A few nice tarts, custards, etc., had been made in
+the morning for the occasion, and had been most temptingly baked in
+the forenoon.
+
+It happened that two gentlemen called on Mr. Random about two o'clock,
+and he insisted upon their staying to dinner; in consequence of which
+his lady had the pastry removed from the side board to the
+china-closet.
+
+All children must frequently have heard their mothers say, when they
+wish to have anything saved for another occasion, "My friends, you see
+your dinner before you; I hope you will consider yourselves at home
+and not spare." This is always thought to be a sufficient excuse for
+not bringing anything of another sort to table.
+
+When the meat was nearly done with, Mrs. Random made the above remark
+to her visitors, who declared that nothing more was requisite. She
+then bid the servant put the cheese on the table.
+
+"What, mother," said Richard, "is there nothing else?"
+
+"No, my love," said his mother; "I am sure you want nothing more."
+
+"Why, yes, mother. Where are the tarts and custards you put into the
+closet?"
+
+"Surely you dream?" said his mother.
+
+"No, I don't indeed," replied Dicky. "You put them away directly the
+gentlemen said they would stay to dine, and observed what a deal of
+trouble visitors do give."
+
+Any one will easily believe that this made Mrs. Random look very
+confused. She hardly knew what to reply, but she turned it off in the
+best manner she could, and said:
+
+"It is you, Richard, who trouble me more than the visits of my
+friends. I am happy to see them always, but on some days more than
+others. To-day, you know, we have been preparing for _your_ company,
+and therefore the reserve I have kept would not have been made but on
+your account. The pastry was intended for _your_ visitors, and not
+your father's. However, if you are such a child that you cannot wait
+till night, they shall be brought to table now; but, remember, I will
+not order any more to be made, and you shall provide for your
+playmates out of the money put by to purchase the magic-lantern and
+the books."
+
+Richard looked quite down when he heard this sentence, and more so
+when he saw the pastry placed on the table.
+
+Dear me, how soon had the tarts and custards disappeared, if one of
+each had been served round to the company! But the gentlemen were too
+polite even to taste them, and father and mother declined eating any.
+Richard's sister said she could very well wait till supper; hence they
+were all saved. But Dicky was afterwards very severely taken to task
+for speaking out of time, when he was not spoken to.
+
+When evening came, and the little visitors were assembled, Richard,
+who had seen some of the sports at a country fair, would show his
+dexterity to amuse his young party. He took up the poker, and,
+supposing it to be a pole, performed some imitations. But, unable long
+to preserve it upright from its weight, the sooty end fell on Master
+Snapper's book, who was reading a little work upon "Affability." The
+blow fairly knocked it out of his hand, and made a great smear on his
+frilled shirt, at which a loud laugh ensued. Now Master Snapper could
+not bear to be laughed at, and was so much out of humor all the
+evening that he would not play.
+
+Little Dick never once, all this time, thought that if it had fallen
+on his playfellow's toe, it might have lamed him, and he would at
+least have had to carry him a pick-a-back home; nor did he think who
+was to have paid the doctor; but, pleased with the mirth he had made,
+he went upstairs and fetched down one of the pistols, which his father
+kept in a private drawer. Then, pulling in his rocking-horse, he
+fancied he was one of the Light Horse, and mounted it to show the
+sword exercise, and how he could shoot a Frenchman or a Turk at full
+gallop. He had no business with a rocking-horse or a pistol among
+young ladies, but he never thought if it were proper or not, and much
+less if the pistol were loaded.
+
+While he was going on a full canter, he gave the words, "Present!
+fire!" and off it went, knocked him backwards, and shivered a
+beautiful mirror into a thousand pieces. Oh, what a sad scene of
+confusion ensued! Some of the young ladies screamed out with fright.
+Miss Timid, knocked down by Dicky in falling backwards, lay on the
+ground bleeding at the nose. Some were employed in picking up the
+pieces of glass, or pinning their handkerchiefs over the fracture, to
+prevent its being seen while they stayed; but such a hope was vain.
+
+The noise brought Mr. and Mrs. Random and all the servants upstairs,
+who too soon found out the havoc that had been made, and demanded how
+it happened. All the children would willingly have screened Dicky,
+because they knew he had not done it to frighten, but to amuse them.
+Master Snapper, however, now thinking it was his turn, in a very
+ill-natured speech made the worst of the story. But the spiteful way
+in which he spoke did little Dick no harm, as he seemed more rejoiced
+at his misfortune than sorry for Mr. Random's loss; hence it had the
+effect not to increase the latter's anger.
+
+"Playing with balancing poles and pistols," said Mr. Random in a stern
+accent to his son, "is very well in a proper place, but quite
+inadmissible in a room full of company. Now, sir, what business had
+you to take this pistol out of my room?"
+
+"Indeed, father," said Dicky, crying, "I did not know it was loaded."
+
+"It is but last week," continued his father, "that you were told never
+to take such a thing without asking, and not even then till some one
+had tried if it were loaded. So many accidents have happened with
+firearms which have been supposed not to be loaded, that he who
+unguardedly shoots another ought to take a similar chance for his own
+life; for you know the Scripture says: 'An eye for an eye, and a tooth
+for a tooth.' Think, Richard, that if I had been standing before the
+mirror, what would have been the consequence. You would have shot your
+father! Your mother would have died of grief, and you and Letitia have
+been orphans!"
+
+"Ah, then I should have died too!" said Dicky, wiping the tears from
+his eyes with the back of his hand. "But how came you to load the
+pistol last night, father?"
+
+"Because," replied his father, "I thought I heard something fall in
+the parlor, and the passage-door being directly after shut to in a
+still manner. I loaded the pistols, thinking that thieves had broken
+into the house, and pushed up the sash to shoot the first that came
+out."
+
+"Then it was lucky," said Richard, "I did not come out again, or you
+might have killed me; for I got up in the night to let Juno out of the
+shed, where I had tied her up, and she was making a sad howling.
+Indeed, before I was aware, she ran into the parlor, and, as it was
+quite dark, I tumbled over her."
+
+"And broke the geranium tree," added his father.
+
+"Yes, I did indeed," said Dicky, "but I did not go to do it. After
+that I turned Juno into the yard, and this I dare say is all the noise
+you heard."
+
+"There is an old saying, my dear little friends," said Mr. Random,
+"which I wish you to attend to, because it has a great deal of truth
+in it: '_The pitcher that goes often safe to the well may come home
+broken at last_.' And so, though the thoughtless and giddy may go on
+for a long while without danger, it will overtake them sooner or
+later. Here is a strong instance of escape from the consequences which
+might have attended Richard's thoughtlessness; besides which, his
+mother could get no more sleep all night, and I, after running the
+risk of catching cold in searching over the house, have this morning
+been at the expense of new fastenings to the doors and windows. The
+next time, however, you rise, Richard, to alarm the family, you shall
+in future roost with the hens or bed in the stable."
+
+Dicky now thought that his parent's resentment had subsided, and, upon
+the latter's calling to him to come, he sprang across the room with
+the greatest alertness; but how suddenly was his smile cast down when
+Mr, Random, taking his hand, ordered him to wish his young friends
+much mirth and a good appetite, while he was going to be punished for
+his misconduct. At once were all their little hands put out to prevent
+Mr. Random's resolution of taking him away, but all their petitions
+were in vain. Richard was forced into an empty cellar, and left with
+no other companion than a glimmering rushlight. Here he was told he
+might do as much mischief as he pleased. The iron bars kept him from
+getting out on one side, and the door was padlocked on the other. In
+this dilemma he marched round and round, crying, with his little
+candle, and saw stuck on the walls the following lines:
+
+ "Empty caves and commons wild
+ Best befit a thoughtless child,
+ A solid wall, an earthen floor,
+ Prison lights, a padlock'd door,
+ Where's no plaything which he may
+ Turn to harm by random play,
+ For in such sport too oft is found
+ A penny-toy will cost a pound.
+ Be wise and merry;---play, but think;
+ For danger stands on folly's brink."
+
+After having been kept in confinement nearly half an hour, Mr. Random
+could no longer resist the pressing solicitations of his son's guests,
+who declined partaking of the supper till Richard was returned to
+them.
+
+Having learned the above lines by heart, he repeated them to his young
+company, and, on his promising to remember their contents, he was
+permitted to sit down to table.
+
+The rest of the evening was spent in innocent cheerfulness, and for
+some time after little Random played with more caution.
+
+We must omit many of the less important neglects of young Random, such
+as letting the toast fall in handling it, shooting his arrow through
+the window, riding a long stick where it might throw persons down,
+leaving things in the way at dark, etc., and proceed to relate a
+good-natured fancy of his which tended more than any of the preceding
+events, to show him the folly of taking any step without first looking
+to what it might lead.
+
+In Mr. Random's garden was a fine tall pear-tree, and that year a very
+fine pear grew on the topmost twig. His mother and sister had several
+times wished for the luscious fruit, but it seemed to bid defiance to
+every attack that was not aided by a tall ladder. "Oh!" thought Dicky,
+"if I can get it down and present it to my mother, how pleased she
+will be!" So, when he was alone, he picked out some large stones and
+threw at it, but without any success. The next day he renewed his
+attack in the evening, and to insure a better chance employed several
+large pieces of brick and tile.
+
+Now all these dangerous weapons went over into a poor man's garden,
+where his son and some other boys were weeding it. One of them fell
+upon the little fellow's leg, and cut it in so desperate a manner that
+he cried out, quite terrified at the blow and sight of the blood. The
+other boys directly took the alarm, and picking up some stones as
+large as that which had done the mischief, they mounted on a high
+bench, and discharged such a well-directed volley at the person of
+Master Random that he was most violently struck upon the nose, and
+knocked backwards into a glass cucumber-frame.
+
+Here he lay in a most pitiable condition, calling upon his mother,
+while the wounded boy on the other side joined in the concert of woe.
+
+"Oh, it served you rightly!" exclaimed the young assailants, who were
+looking over the wall, and ran away as soon as they saw Mr. Random
+come into the garden to inquire the cause of the uproar.
+
+His first concern was to carry Dicky indoors, and then, having wiped
+away the blood and tears, he asked him how it happened.
+
+"I was only trying to get a pear for my mother," said Richard, "when
+these boys threw stones at me, and hit me!"
+
+"That was very cruel," said his father, "to meddle with you when you
+were doing nothing to them, and if I can find them out they shall be
+punished for it."
+
+Mr. Random immediately set off to the next house, but was met at his
+own door by the father of the wounded boy, who was coming with him in
+his arms to demand satisfaction. This brought the whole truth out, and
+the artful little fellow was found to have concealed a part of the
+real case. Instead of saying "he was only getting a pear," he should
+have said that he was throwing large stones at the topmost pear on the
+tree, and that every stone went over the wall, he could not tell
+where.
+
+"Ah, Richard," said his father, "it is little better than
+story-telling to conceal a part of the truth. The affair now wears
+quite a new face. It was you that gave the first assault, and will
+have to answer for all the bad consequences. It is my duty to see that
+this unoffending boy is taken care of; but if his leg be so cut or
+bruised that he cannot get so good a living when he comes to be a man
+as he might otherwise have done, how would you like to make up the
+deficiency? You cannot doubt that he has a demand upon you equal to
+the damage you may have done to him. He is poor, and his father must
+send him to the hospital, but it would be unjust of me to suffer it.
+No, on the contrary, I shall prevent this by taking him home and
+sending you there, where Dr. Hardheart makes his patients smart before
+he cures them. Come, get ready to go, for delays in wounds of the head
+are not to be trifled with."
+
+Mr. Random then ordered the servant to go for a coach, in which Dicky
+most certainly would have been sent off had not word been brought back
+that there was not a coach on the stand. During this time Dicky had
+fallen on his knees, entreating that he might remain at home, and
+offering promises to be less heedless in future; nay, he was willing
+to yield up all his toys to the maimed little gardener.
+
+The boy's father, though but a laboring man, had a generous mind; he
+wanted nothing of this kind, but only wished him to be more cautious
+in future, as the same stones, thrown at random, might have either
+blinded his son or fractured his skull, instead of merely hurting his
+leg. Mr. Random then insisted on Richard's giving him half-a-crown,
+and asking pardon for the misfortune occasioned by his carelessness.
+
+This heavy sum was directly taken out of the hoard which had been laid
+by for the purchase of a set of drawing instruments, but he had a yet
+heavier account to settle with his father for damaging the
+cucumber-frame. He had broken as much of it as would come to fifteen
+shillings to mend, and as payment was insisted on, or close
+confinement until the whole was settled, he was compelled to transfer
+to his father all his receipts for the ensuing five months before he
+could again resume his scheme of laying by an adequate sum to purchase
+the drawing utensils. Independently of which he always carried a
+strong memorial of his folly on his nose, which was so scarred that he
+endured many a joke, as it were, to keep alive in his memory the
+effect of his folly. Indeed, he never looked in the glass without
+seeing his reproach in his face, and thus at length learned never to
+play without first thinking if it were at a proper time and in a
+proper place.
+
+
+
+
+EMBELLISHMENT
+
+By JACOB ABBOTT
+
+
+One day Beechnut, who had been ill, was taken by Phonny and Madeline
+for a drive. When Phonny and Madeline found themselves riding quietly
+along in the wagon in Beechnut's company, the first thought which
+occurred to them, after the interest and excitement awakened by the
+setting out had passed in some measure away, was that they would ask
+him to tell them a story. This was a request which they almost always
+made in similar circumstances. In all their rides and rambles
+Beechnut's stories were an unfailing resource, furnishing them with an
+inexhaustible fund of amusement sometimes, and sometimes of
+instruction.
+
+"Well," said Beechnut, in answer to their request, "I will tell you
+now about my voyage across the Atlantic Ocean."
+
+"Yes," exclaimed Madeline, "I should like to hear about that very much
+indeed."
+
+"Shall I tell the story to you just as it was," asked Beechnut, "as a
+sober matter of fact, or shall I embellish it a little?"
+
+"I don't know what you mean by embellishing it," said Madeline.
+
+"Why, not telling exactly what is true," said Beechnut, "but inventing
+something to add to it, to make it interesting."
+
+"I want to have it true," said Madeline, "and interesting, too."
+
+"But sometimes," replied Beechnut, "interesting things don't happen,
+and in such cases, if we should only relate what actually does happen,
+the story would be likely to be dull."
+
+"I think you had better embellish the story a little," said
+Phonny--"just a _little_, you know."
+
+"I don't think I can do that very well," replied Beechnut. "If I
+attempt to relate the actual acts, I depend simply on my memory, and I
+can confine myself to what my memory teaches; but if I undertake to
+follow my invention, I must go wherever it leads me."
+
+"Well," said Phonny, "I think you had better embellish the story, at
+any rate, for I want it to be interesting."
+
+"So do I," said Madeline.
+
+"Then," said Beechnut, "I will give you an embellished account of my
+voyage across the Atlantic. But, in the first place, I must tell you
+how it happened that my father decided to leave Paris and come to
+America. It was mainly on my account. My father was well enough
+contented with his situation so far as he himself was concerned, and
+he was able to save a large part of his salary, so as to lay up a
+considerable sum of money every year; but he was anxious about me.
+
+"There seemed to be nothing," continued Beechnut, "for me to do, and
+nothing desirable for me to look forward to, when I should become a
+man. My father thought, therefore, that, though it would perhaps be
+better for _him_ to remain in France, It would probably be better for
+_me_ if he should come to America, where he said people might rise in
+the world, according to their talents, thrift, and industry. He was
+sure, he said, that I should rise, for, you must understand, he
+considered me an extraordinary boy."
+
+"Well," said Phonny, "_I_ think you were an extraordinary boy."
+
+"Yes, but my father thought," rejoined Beechnut, "that I was something
+very extraordinary indeed. He thought I was a genius."
+
+"So do I," said Phonny.
+
+"He said," continued Beechnut, "he thought it would in the end be a
+great deal better for him to come to America, where I might become a
+man of some consequence in the world, and he said that he should enjoy
+his own old age a great deal better, even in a strange land, if he
+could see me going on prosperously in life, than to remain all his
+days in that porter's lodge.
+
+"All the money that my father had saved," Beechnut continued, "he got
+changed into gold at an office in the Bouleyard; but then he was very
+much perplexed to decide how it was best to carry it."
+
+"Why did he not pack it up in his chest?" asked Phonny.
+
+"He was afraid," replied Beechnut, "that his chest might be broken
+open, or unlocked by false keys, on the voyage, and that the money
+might be thus stolen away; so he thought that he would try to hide it
+somewhere in some small thing that he could keep with him all the
+voyage."
+
+"Could not he keep his chest with him all the voyage?" asked Phonny.
+
+"No," said Beechnut; "the chests, and all large parcels of baggage
+belonging to the passengers, must be sent down into the hold of the
+ship out of the way. It is only a very little baggage that the people
+are allowed to keep with them between the decks. My father wished very
+much to keep his gold with him, and yet he was afraid to keep it in a
+bag, or in any other similar package, in his little trunk, for then
+whoever saw it would know that it was gold, and so perhaps form some
+plan to rob him of it.
+
+"While we were considering what plan it would be best to adopt for the
+gold, Arielle, who was the daughter of a friend of ours, proposed to
+hide it in my _top_. I had a very large top which my father had made
+for me. It was painted yellow outside, with four stripes of bright
+blue passing down over it from the stem to the point. When the top was
+in motion, both the yellow ground and the blue stripes entirely
+disappeared, and the top appeared to be of a uniform green color.
+Then, when it came to its rest again, the original colors would
+reappear."
+
+"How curious!" said Madeline. "Why would it do so?" "Why, when it was
+revolving," said Beechnut, "the yellow and the blue were blended
+together in the eye, and that made green. Yellow and blue always make
+green. Arielle colored my top, after my father had made it, and then
+my father varnished it over the colors, and that fixed them.
+
+"This top of mine was a monstrous large one, and being hollow, Arielle
+thought that the gold could all be put inside. She said she thought
+that that would be a very safe hiding-place, too, since nobody would
+think of looking into a top for gold. But my father said that he
+thought that the space would not be quite large enough, and then if
+anybody should happen to see the top, and should touch it, the weight
+of it would immediately reveal the secret.
+
+"At last my father thought of a plan which he believed would answer
+the purpose very perfectly. We had a very curious old clock. It was
+made by my grandfather, who was a clockmaker in Geneva. There was a
+little door in the face of the clock, and whenever the time came for
+striking the hours, this door would open, and a little platform would
+come out with a tree upon it. There was a beautiful little bird upon
+the tree, and when the clock had done striking, the bird would flap
+its wings and sing. Then the platform would slide back into its place,
+the door would shut, and the clock go on ticking quietly for another
+hour.
+
+"This clock was made to go," continued Beechnut, "as many other clocks
+are, by two heavy weights, which were hung to the wheel-work by strong
+cords. The cords were wound round some of the wheels, and as they
+slowly descended by their weight, they made the wheels go round. There
+was a contrivance inside the clock to make the wheels go slowly and
+regularly, and not spin round too fast, as they would have done if the
+weights had been left to themselves. This is the way that clocks are
+often made.
+
+"Now, my father," continued Beechnut, "had intended to take this old
+family clock with him to America, and he now conceived the idea of
+hiding his treasure in the weights. The weights were formed of two
+round tin canisters filled with something very heavy. My father said
+he did not know whether it was shot or sand. He unsoldered the bottom
+from these canisters, and found that the filling was shot. He poured
+out the shot, put his gold pieces in in place of it, and then filled
+up all the interstices between and around the gold pieces with sand,
+to prevent the money from jingling. Then he soldered the bottom of the
+canisters on again, and no one would have known that the weights were
+anything more than ordinary clock-weights. He then packed the clock in
+a box, and put the box in his trunk. It did not take up a great deal
+of room, for he did not take the case of the clock, but only the face
+and the works and the two weights, which last he packed carefully and
+securely in the box, one on each side of the clock itself.
+
+"When we got to Havre, all our baggage was examined at the Custom
+House, and the officers allowed it all to pass. When they came to the
+clock, my father showed them the little door and the bird inside, and
+they said it was very curious. They did not pay any attention to the
+weights at all.
+
+"When we went on board of the vessel our chests were put by the side
+of an immense heap of baggage upon the deck, where some seamen were at
+work lowering it down into the hold through a square opening in the
+deck of the ship. As for the trunk, my father took that with him to
+the place where he was going to be himself during the voyage. This
+place was called the steerage. It was crowded full of men, women, and
+children, all going to America. Some talked French, some German, some
+Dutch, and there were ever so many babies that were too little to talk
+at all. Pretty soon the vessel sailed.
+
+"We did not meet with anything remarkable on the voyage, except that
+once we saw an iceberg."
+
+"What is that?" asked Madeline.
+
+"It is a great mountain of ice," replied Beechnut, "floating about in
+the sea on the top of the water. I don't know how it comes to be
+there."
+
+"I should not think it would float upon the top of the water," said
+Phonny. "All the ice that I ever saw in the water sinks into it."
+
+"It does not sink to the bottom," said Madeline.
+
+"No," replied Phonny, "but it sinks down until the top of the ice is
+just level with the water. But Beechnut says that his iceberg rose up
+like a mountain."
+
+"Yes," said Beechnut, "it was several hundred feet high above the
+water, all glittering in the sun. And I think that if you look at any
+small piece of ice floating in the water, you will see that a small
+part of it rises above the surface."
+
+"Yes," said Phenny, "a very little."
+
+"It is a certain proportion of the whole mass," rejoined Beechnut.
+"They told us on board our vessel that about one-tenth part of the
+iceberg was above the water; the rest--that is, nine-tenths--was under
+it; so you see what an enormous big piece of ice it must have been to
+have only one-tenth part of it tower up so high.
+
+"There was one thing very curious and beautiful about our iceberg,"
+said Beechnut. "We came in sight of it one day about sunset, just
+after a shower. The cloud, which was very large and black, had passed
+off into the west, and there was a splendid rainbow upon it. It
+happened, too, that when we were nearest to the iceberg it lay toward
+the west, and, of course, toward the cloud, and it appeared directly
+under the rainbow, and the iceberg and the rainbow made a most
+magnificent spectacle. The iceberg, which was very bright and dazzling
+in the evening sun, looked like an enormous diamond, with the rainbow
+for the setting."
+
+"How curious!" said Phonny.
+
+"Yes," said Beechnut, "and to make it more remarkable still, a whale
+just then came along directly before the iceberg, and spouted there
+two or three times; and as the sun shone very brilliantly upon the jet
+of water which the whale threw into the air, it made a sort of silver
+rainbow below in the center of the picture."
+
+"How beautiful it must have been!" said Phonny.
+
+"Yes," rejoined Beechnut, "very beautiful indeed. We saw a great many
+beautiful spectacles on the sea; but then, on the other hand, we saw
+some that were dreadful.
+
+"Did you?" asked Phonny. "What?"
+
+"Why, we had a terrible storm and shipwreck at the end," said
+Beechnut. "For three days and three nights the wind blew almost a
+hurricane. They took in all the sails, and let the ship drive before
+the gale under bare poles. She went on over the seas for five hundred
+miles, howling all the way like a frightened dog."
+
+"Were you frightened?" asked Phonny.
+
+"Yes," said Beechnut. "When the storm first came on, several of the
+passengers came up the hatchways and got up on the deck to see it; and
+then we could not get down again, for the ship gave a sudden pitch
+just after we came up, and knocked away the step-ladder. We were
+terribly frightened. The seas were breaking over the forecastle and
+sweeping along the decks, and the shouts and outcries of the captain
+and the sailors made a dreadful din. At last they put the step-ladder
+in its place again, and we got down. Then they put the hatches on, and
+we could not come out any more."
+
+"The hatches?" said Phonny. "What are they?"
+
+"The hatches," replied Beechnut, "are a sort of scuttle-doors that
+cover over the square openings in the deck of a ship. They always have
+to put them on and fasten them down in a great storm."
+
+Just at this time the party happened to arrive at a place where two
+roads met, and as there was a broad and level space of ground at the
+junction, where it would be easy to turn the wagon, Beechnut said that
+he thought it would be better to make that the end of their ride, and
+so turn round and go home. Phonny and Madeline were quite desirous of
+going a little farther, but Beechnut thought that he should be tired
+by the time he reached the house again.
+
+"But you will not have time to finish the story," said Phonny.
+
+"Yes," replied Beechnut; "there is very little more to tell. It is
+only to give an account of our shipwreck."
+
+"Why, did you have a shipwreck?" exclaimed Phonny.
+
+"Yes," said Beechnut. "When you have turned the wagon, I will tell you
+about it."
+
+So Phonny, taking a great sweep, turned the wagon round, and the party
+set their faces toward home. The Marshal was immediately going to set
+out upon a trot, but Phonny held him back by pulling upon the reins
+and saying:
+
+"Steady, Marshal! steady! You have got to walk all the way home."
+
+"The storm drove us upon the Nova Scotia coast," said Beechnut,
+resuming his story. "We did not know anything about the great danger
+that we were in until just before the ship went ashore. When we got
+near the shore the sailors put down all the anchors; but they would
+not hold, and at length the ship struck. Then there followed a
+dreadful scene of consternation and confusion. Some jumped into the
+sea in their terror, and were drowned. Some cried and screamed, and
+acted as if they were insane. Some were calm, and behaved rationally.
+The sailors opened the hatches and let the passengers come up, and we
+got into the most sheltered places that we could find about the decks
+and rigging, and tied ourselves to whatever was nearest at hand. My
+father opened his trunk and took out his two clock-weights, and gave
+me one of them; the other he kept himself. He told me that we might as
+well try to save them, though he did not suppose that we should be
+able to do so.
+
+"Pretty soon after we struck the storm seemed to abate a little. The
+people of the country came down to the shore and stood upon the rocks
+to see if they could do anything to save us. We were very near the
+shore, but the breakers and the boiling surf were so violent between
+us and the land that whoever took to the water was sure to be dashed
+in pieces. So everybody clung to the ship, waiting for the captain to
+contrive some way to get us to the shore."
+
+"And what did he do?" asked Phonny.
+
+"He first got a long line and a cask, and he fastened the end of the
+long line to the cask, and then threw the cask overboard. The other
+end of the line was kept on board the ship. The cask was tossed about
+upon the waves, every successive surge driving it in nearer and nearer
+to the shore, until at last it was thrown up high upon the rocks. The
+men upon the shore ran to seize it, but before they could get hold of
+it the receding wave carried it back again among the breakers, where
+it was tossed about as if it had been a feather, and overwhelmed with
+the spray. Presently away it went again up upon the shore, and the men
+again attempted to seize it. This was repeated two or three times. At
+last they succeeded in grasping hold of it, and they ran up with it
+upon the rocks, out of the reach of the seas.
+
+"The captain then made signs to the men to pull the line in toward the
+shore. He was obliged to use signs, because the roaring and thundering
+of the seas made such a noise that nothing could be heard. The sailors
+had before this, under the captain's direction, fastened a much
+stronger line--a small cable, in fact--to the end of the line which
+had been attached to the barrel. Thus, by pulling upon the smaller
+line, the men drew one end of the cable to the shore. The other end
+remained on board the ship, while the middle of it lay tossing among
+the breakers between the ship and the shore.
+
+"The seamen then carried that part of the cable which was on shipboard
+up to the masthead, while the men on shore made their end fast to a
+very strong post which they set in the ground. The seamen drew the
+cable as tight as they could, and fastened their end very strongly to
+the masthead. Thus the line of the cable passed in a gentle slope from
+the top of the mast to the land, high above all the surges and spray.
+The captain then rigged what he called a sling, which was a sort of
+loop of ropes that a person could be put into and made to slide down
+in it on the cable to the shore. A great many of the passengers were
+afraid to go in this way, but they were still more afraid to remain on
+board the ship."
+
+"What were they afraid of?" asked Phonny.
+
+"They were afraid," replied Beechnut, "that the shocks of the seas
+would soon break the ship to pieces, and then they would all be thrown
+into the sea together. In this case they would certainly be destroyed,
+for if they were not drowned, they would be dashed to pieces on the
+rocks which lined the shore.
+
+"Sliding down the line seemed thus a very dangerous attempt, but they
+consented one after another to make the trial, and thus we all escaped
+safe to land."
+
+"And did you get the clock-weights safe to the shore?" asked Phonny.
+
+"Yes," replied Beechnut, "and as soon as we landed we hid them in the
+sand. My father took me to a little cove close by, where there was not
+much surf, as the place was protected by a rocky point of land which
+bounded it on one side. Behind this point of land the waves rolled up
+quietly upon a sandy beach. My father went down upon the slope of this
+beach, to a place a little below where the highest waves came, and
+began to dig a hole in the sand. He called me to come and help him.
+The waves impeded our work a little, but we persevered until we had
+dug a hole about a foot deep. We put our clock-weights into this hole
+and covered them over. We then ran back up upon the beach. The waves
+that came up every moment over the place soon smoothed the surface of
+the sand again, and made it look as if nothing had been done there. My
+father measured the distance from the place where he had deposited his
+treasure up to a certain great white rock upon the shore exactly
+opposite to it, so as to be able to find the place again, and then we
+went back to our company. They were collected on the rocks in little
+groups, wet and tired, and in great confusion, but rejoiced at having
+escaped with their lives. Some of the last of the sailors were then
+coming over in the sling. The captain himself came last of all.
+
+"There were some huts near the place on the shore, where the men made
+good fires, and we warmed and dried ourselves. The storm abated a
+great deal in a few hours, and the tide went down, so that we could go
+off to the ship before night to get some provisions. The next morning
+the men could work at the ship very easily, and they brought all the
+passengers' baggage on shore. My father got his trunk with the clock
+in it. A day or two afterward some sloops came to the place, and took
+us all away to carry us to Quebec. Just before we embarked on board
+the sloops, my father and I, watching a good opportunity, dug up our
+weights out of the sand, and put them back safely in their places in
+the clock-box."
+
+"Is that the end?" asked Phonny, when Beechnut paused.
+
+"Yes," replied Beechnut, "I believe I had better make that the end."
+
+"I think it is a very interesting and well-told story," said Madeline.
+"And do you feel very tired?"
+
+"No," said Beechnut. "On the contrary, I feel all the better for my
+ride. I believe I will sit up a little while."
+
+So saying, he raised himself in the wagon and sat up, and began to
+look about him.
+
+"What a wonderful voyage you had, Beechnut!" said Phonny. "But I never
+knew before that you were shipwrecked."
+
+"Well, in point of fact," replied Beechnut, "I never was
+shipwrecked."
+
+"Never was!" exclaimed Phonny. "Why, what is all this story that you
+have been telling us, then?"
+
+"Embellishment," said Beechnut quietly.
+
+"Embellishment!" repeated Phonny, more and more amazed.
+
+"Yes," said Beechnut.
+
+"Then you were not wrecked at all?" said Phonny.
+
+"No," replied Beechnut.
+
+"And how did you get to the land?" asked Phonny.
+
+"Why, we sailed quietly up the St. Lawrence," replied Beechnut, "and
+landed safely at Quebec, as other vessels do."
+
+"And the clock-weights?" asked Phonny.
+
+"All embellishment," said Beechnut. "My father had no such clock, in
+point of fact. He put his money in a bag, his bag in his chest, and
+his chest in the hold, and it came as safe as the captain's sextant."
+
+"And the iceberg and the rainbow?" said Madeline.
+
+"Embellishment, all embellishment," said Beechnut.
+
+"Dear me!" said Phonny, "I thought it was all true."
+
+"Did you?" said Beechnut. "I am sorry that you were so deceived, and I
+am sure it was not my fault, for I gave you your choice of a true
+story or an invention, and you chose the invention."
+
+"Yes," said Phonny, "so we did."
+
+
+
+
+THE OYSTER PATTIES
+
+
+There was once a little boy who perhaps might have been a good little
+fellow if his friends had taken pains to make him so; but--I do not
+know how it was--instead of teaching him to be good, they gave him
+everything he cried for; so, whenever he wished to have anything, he
+had only to cry, and if he did not get it directly, he cried louder
+and louder till at last he got it. By this means Alfred was not only
+very naughty, but very unhappy. He was crying from morning till night.
+He had no pleasure in anything; he was in everybody's way, and nobody
+liked to be with him.
+
+Well, one day his mother thought she would give him a day of pleasure,
+and make him very happy indeed, so she told him he should have a
+feast, and dine under the great cedar tree that stood upon the lawn,
+and that his cousins should be invited to dine with him, and that he
+should have whatever he chose for his dinner. So she rang the bell,
+and she told the servants to take out tables and chairs and to lay the
+cloth upon the table under the tree, and she ordered her two footmen
+to be ready to wait upon him.
+
+She desired the butler to tell the cook to prepare the dinner, and to
+get all sorts of nice dishes for the feast; but she said to Alfred:
+
+"What shall you like best of all, my dear boy?"
+
+So Alfred tried to think of something that he had never had before,
+and he recollected that one day he had heard a lady, who was dining
+with his father and mother, say that the oyster patties were the best
+she had ever eaten. Now Alfred had never tasted oyster patties, so he
+said he would have oyster patties for dinner.
+
+"Oyster patties, my dear boy? You cannot have oyster patties at this
+time of the year; there are no oysters to be had," his mother said to
+him. "Try, love, to think of something else."
+
+But naughty Alfred said:
+
+"No, I can think of nothing else."
+
+So the cook was sent for, and desired to think of something that he
+might like as well. The cook proposed first a currant pie, then a
+barberry pie, or a codlin pie with custard.
+
+"No, no, no!" said Alfred, shaking his head.
+
+"Or a strawberry tart, my sweet boy? or apricot jam?" said his mother,
+in a soothing tone of voice.
+
+But Alfred said:
+
+"No, mother, no. I don't like strawberries. I don't like apricot jam.
+I want oysters."
+
+"But you cannot have oysters, my little master," said the cook.
+
+"But I will have oysters," said the little boy, "and you shan't say
+that I can't have them--shall she, mother?"
+
+And he began to scream and to cry.
+
+"Do not cry, my sweet soul," said his mother, "and we will see what we
+can do. Dry up your tears, my little man, and come with me, and, the
+cook, I dare say, will be able to get some oysters before dinner. It
+is a long time to dinner, you know, and I have some pretty toys for
+you upstairs, if you will come with me till dinner is ready."
+
+So she took the little crying boy by the hand and led him up to her
+room, and she whispered to the cook, as she passed, not to say
+anything more about it now, and that she hoped he would forget the
+oyster patties by the time dinner was ready. In the meantime she took
+all the pains she could to amuse and please him, and as fast as he
+grew tired of one toy she brought out another.
+
+At last, after some hours, she gave him a beautiful toy for which she
+had paid fifteen shillings. It was a sand toy of a woman sitting at a
+spinning-wheel, and when it was turned up the little figure began
+spinning away, and the wheel turned round and round as fast as if the
+woman who turned it had been alive. Alfred wanted to see how it was
+done, but, instead of going to his mother to ask her if she would be
+so good as to explain it to him, he began pulling it to pieces to look
+behind it. For some time he was very busy, and he had just succeeded
+in opening the large box at the back of the figure when all the sand
+that was in it came pouring out upon the floor, and when he tried to
+make the little woman spin again, he found she would not do it any
+more. She could not, for it was the sand dropping down that had made
+her move before.
+
+Now, do you know that Alfred was so very silly that he began to be
+angry even with the toy, and he said, "Spin, I say! spin directly!"
+and then he shook it very hard, but in vain. The little hands did not
+move, and the wheel stood still. So then he was very angry indeed,
+and, setting up a loud cry, he threw the toy to the other end of the
+room. Just at this very moment the servant opened the door and said
+that dinner was ready, and that Alfred's cousins were arrived.
+
+"Come, my dear child; you are tired of your toys, I see," said his
+mother, "so come to dinner, darling. It is all ready under the tree."
+
+So away they went, leaving the room all strewed with toys, with broken
+pieces, and the sand all spilt in a heap upon the floor. When they
+went under the dark spreading branches of the fine old cedar-tree,
+there they saw the table covered with dishes and garnished with
+flowers. There were chickens, and ham, and tongue, and lobsters,
+besides tarts, and custards, and jellies, and cakes, and cream, and I
+do not know how many nice things besides. There was Alfred's high
+chair at the head of the table, and he was soon seated in it, as
+master of the feast, with his mother sitting by him, his cousins
+opposite to him, his nurse standing on the other side, and the two
+footmen waiting besides.
+
+As soon as his cousins were helped to what they liked best, his mother
+said:
+
+"What will you eat first, Alfred, my love? A wing of a chicken?"
+
+"No," said Alfred, pushing it away.
+
+"A slice of ham, darling?" said nurse.
+
+"No," said Alfred, in a louder tone.
+
+"A little bit of lobster, my dear?"
+
+"No, no," replied the naughty boy.
+
+"Well, what _will_ you have, then?" said his mother, who was almost
+tired of him.
+
+"I will have oyster patties," said he.
+
+"That is the only thing you cannot have, my love, you know, so do not
+think of it any more, but taste a bit of this pie. I am sure you will
+like it."
+
+"You _said_ I should have oyster patties by dinner-time," said Alfred,
+"and so I will have nothing else."
+
+"I am sorry you are such a sad, naughty child," said his mother. "I
+thought you would have been so pleased with all these nice things to
+eat."
+
+"They are _not_ nice," said the child, who was not at all grateful for
+all that his mother had done, but was now in such a passion that he
+took the piece of currant tart which his nurse again offered to him,
+and, squeezing, up as much as his two little hands could hold, he
+threw it at his nurse, and stained her nice white handkerchief and
+apron with the red juice.
+
+Just at this moment his father came into the garden, and walked up to
+the table.
+
+"What is all his?" said he. "Alfred, you seem to be a very naughty boy
+indeed; and I must tell you, sir, I shall allow this no longer. Get
+down from your chair, sir, and beg your nurse's pardon."
+
+Alfred had hardly ever heard his father speak so before, and he felt
+so frightened that he left off crying and did as he was bid. Then his
+father took him by the hand and led him away.
+
+His mother said she was sure he would now be good and eat the currant
+tart; but his father said:
+
+"No, no, it is now too late; he must come with me."
+
+So he led him away, without saying another word.
+
+He took him into the village, and he stopped at the door, of a poor
+cottage.
+
+"May we come in?" said his father.
+
+"Oh yes, and welcome," said a poor woman, who was standing at a table
+with a saucepan in her hand.
+
+"What are you doing, my good woman?"
+
+"Only putting out the children's supper, your honor."
+
+"And what have you got for their supper?"
+
+"Only some potatoes, please you, sir; but they be nicely boiled, and
+here come the hungry boys! They are coming in from their work, and
+they will soon make an end of them, I warrant."
+
+As she said these words in came John, and William, and Thomas, all
+with rosy cheeks and smiling faces. They sat down--one on a wooden
+stool, one on a broken chair, and one on the corner of the table--and
+they all began to eat the potatoes very heartily.
+
+But Alfred's father said:
+
+"Stop, my good boys; do not eat any more, but come with me."
+
+The boys stared, but their mother told them to do as they were bid, so
+they left off eating and followed the gentleman.
+
+Alfred and his father walked on till they arrived once more under the
+cedar-tree in the garden, and there was the fine feast all standing
+just as they had left it, for Alfred's cousins were gone away, and his
+mother would not have the dinner taken away, because she hoped that
+Alfred would come back to it.
+
+"Now, boys," said the gentleman, "you may all sit down to this table
+and eat whatever you like."
+
+John, William, and Thomas sat down as quickly as they could, and began
+to devour the chickens and tarts, and all the good things, at a great
+rate; and Alfred, who now began to be very hungry, would gladly have
+been one of the party; but when he was going to sit down, his father
+said:
+
+"No, sir; this feast is not for _you_. There is nothing here that you
+like to eat, you know; so you will wait upon these boys, if you
+please, who seem as if they would find plenty that they will like."
+
+Alfred at this began to cry again, and said he wanted to go to his
+mother; but his father did not mind his crying, and said he should not
+go to his mother again till he was quite a good boy.
+
+"So now, sir, hand this bread to John, and now take a clean plate to
+Thomas, and now stand ready to carry this custard to William. There
+now, wait till they have all done."
+
+It was of no use now to cry or scream; he was obliged to do it all.
+
+When the boys had quite finished their supper they went home, and
+Alfred was led by his father into the house. Before he went to bed, a
+cup of milk and water and a piece of brown bread were put before him,
+and his father said:
+
+"That is your supper, Alfred."
+
+Alfred began to cry again, and said he did not want such a supper as
+that.
+
+"Very well," said his father, "then go to bed without, and it shall be
+saved for your breakfast."
+
+Alfred cried and screamed louder than ever, so his father ordered the
+maid to put him to bed. When he was in bed, he thought his mother
+would come and see him and bring him something nice, and he lay awake
+a long while; but she did not come, and he cried and cried till at
+last he fell asleep.
+
+In the morning, when he awoke, he was so hungry he could hardly wait
+to be dressed, but asked for his breakfast every minute. When he saw
+the maid bring in the brown bread again without any butter, and some
+milk and water, he was very near crying again; but he thought if he
+did he should perhaps lose his breakfast as he had lost his supper, so
+he checked his tears, and ate a hearty meal.
+
+"Well," said his father, who came into the room just as he was eating
+the last bit of bread, "I am glad to see the little boy who could not
+yesterday find anything good enough for him at a feast eating such
+simple fare as this so heartily. Come, Alfred, now you may come to
+your dear mother."
+
+
+
+
+TWO LITTLE BOYS
+
+By THOMAS DAY
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+THE GOOD-NATURED LITTLE BOY
+
+
+A little boy went out one morning to walk to a village about five
+miles from the place where he lived, and carried with him in a basket
+the provision that was to serve him the whole day. As he was walking
+along a poor little half-starved dog came up to him, wagging his tail
+and seeming to entreat him to take compassion on him.
+
+The little boy at first took no notice of him, but at length,
+remarking how lean and famished the creature seemed to be, he said:
+"This animal is certainly in very great necessity. If I give him part
+of my provision I shall be obliged to go home hungry myself; however,
+as he seems to want it more than I do, he shall partake with me."
+Saying this, he gave the dog part of what he had in his basket, who
+ate as if he had not tasted victuals for a fortnight.
+
+The little boy went on a little further, his dog still following him
+and fawning upon him with the greatest gratitude and affection, when
+he saw a poor old horse lying upon the ground, and groaning as if he
+was very ill. He went up to him, and saw that he was almost starved,
+and so weak that he was unable to rise. "I am very much afraid," said
+the little boy, "if I stay to assist this horse that it will be dark
+before I can return, and I have heard there are several thieves in the
+neighborhood. However, I will try. It is doing a good action to
+attempt to relieve him, and God Almighty will take care of me." He
+then went and gathered some grass, which he brought to the horse's
+mouth, who immediately began to eat with as much relish as if his
+chief disease was hunger. He then fetched some water in his hat,
+which the animal drank up, and seemed immediately to be so much
+refreshed that after a few trials he got up and began grazing.
+
+He then went on a little further, and saw a man wading about in a pool
+of water without being able to get out, in spite of all his endeavors.
+"What is the matter, good man?" said the little boy to him. "Can't you
+find your way out of this pond?" "No, God bless you, my worthy master,
+or miss," said the man, "for such I take you to be by your voice. I
+have fallen into this pond, and know not how to get out again, as I am
+quite blind, and I am almost afraid to move for fear of being
+drowned." "Well," said the little boy, "though I shall be wetted to
+the skin, if you will throw me your stick, I will try to help you out
+of it."
+
+The blind man then threw the stick on to that side on which he heard
+the voice; the little boy caught it, and went into the water, feeling
+very carefully before him, lest he should unguardedly go beyond his
+depth. At length he reached the blind man, took him very carefully by
+the hand, and led him out. The blind man then gave him a thousand
+blessings, and told him he could grope his way home, and the little
+boy ran on as hard as he could to prevent being benighted.
+
+But he had not proceeded far when he saw a poor sailor, that had lost
+both his legs in an engagement by sea, hopping along upon crutches.
+
+"God bless you, my little master!" said the sailor. "I have fought
+many a battle with the French to defend poor old England, but now I am
+crippled, as you see, and have neither victuals nor money, although I
+am almost famished." The little boy could not resist his inclination
+to relieve him, so he gave him all his remaining victuals, and said:
+"God help you, poor man! This is all I have, otherwise you should have
+more."
+
+He then ran along, and presently arrived at the town he was going to,
+did his business, and returned towards his own home with all the
+expedition he was able.
+
+But he had not gone much more than half-way before the night shut in
+extremely dark, without either moon or stars to light him. The poor
+little boy did all he could to find his way, but unfortunately missed
+it in turning down a lane which brought him into a wood, where he
+wandered about a great while without being able to find any path to
+lead him out.
+
+Tired out at last and hungry, he felt himself so feeble that he could
+go no further, but sat himself down upon the ground, crying most
+bitterly. In this situation he remained for some time, till at last
+the little dog, who had never forsaken him, came up to him, wagging
+his tail, and holding something in his mouth. The little, boy took it
+from him, and saw it was a handkerchief nicely pinned together, which
+someone had dropped and the dog had picked up; and upon opening it he
+found several slices of bread and meat, which the little boy ate with
+great satisfaction, and felt himself extremely refreshed with his
+meal. "So," said the little boy, "I see that if I have given you a
+breakfast you have given me a supper, and a good turn is never lost,
+not even to a dog."
+
+He then once more attempted to escape from the woods, but it was to no
+purpose; he only scratched his legs with the briars, and slipped down
+in the dirt, without being able to find his way out. He was just going
+to give up all further attempts in despair, when he happened to see a
+horse feeding before him, and going up to him saw, by the light of the
+moon which just then began to shine a little, that it was the very
+same horse he had fed in the morning. "Perhaps," said the little boy,
+"this creature that I have been so good to will let me get upon his
+back, and he may bring me out of the wood, as he is accustomed to feed
+in this neighborhood."
+
+The little boy then went up to the horse, speaking to him and stroking
+him, and the horse let him mount his back without opposition, and then
+proceeded slowly through the wood, grazing as he went, till he brought
+him to an opening which led to the high road. The little boy was much
+rejoiced at this and said: "If I hadn't saved the creature's life in
+the morning I should have been obliged to have stayed here all the
+night. I see by this that a good deed is never lost."
+
+But the poor little boy had yet a greater danger to undergo, for as he
+was going along a solitary lane two men rushed out upon him, laid hold
+of him, and were going to strip him of his clothes; but just as they
+were beginning to do it the little dog bit the leg of one of the men
+with so much violence that he left the little boy and pursued the dog,
+which ran howling and barking away. In this instant a voice was heard
+that cried out: "There are the rascals! Let us knock them down!" which
+frightened the remaining man so much that he ran away, and his
+companion followed him.
+
+The little boy then looked up, and saw that it was the sailor whom he
+had relieved in the morning, carried upon the shoulders of the blind
+man whom he had helped out of the pond. "There, my little dear!" said
+the sailor. "God be thanked! we have come in time to do you a service
+in return for what you did us in the morning. As I lay under a hedge I
+heard these villains talk of robbing a little boy that from the
+description I concluded must be you; but I was so lame that I should
+not have been able to come time enough to help you if I had not met
+this honest blind man, who took me upon his back, while I showed him
+the way." The little boy thanked them very gratefully for thus
+defending him, and they went all together to his father's house, which
+was not far off, where they were all kindly entertained with a supper
+and bed.
+
+The little boy took care of his faithful dog as long as he lived, and
+never forgot the importance and necessity of doing good to others if
+we wish them to do the same to us.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+THE ILL-NATURED LITTLE BOY
+
+
+There was once a little boy who was so unfortunate as to have a very
+bad man for his father, who was always surly and ill-tempered, and
+never gave his children either good instruction or good example. In
+consequence of this, this little boy, who might otherwise have been
+happier and better, became ill-natured and quarrelsome, and
+disagreeable to every one. He very often was severely beaten for his
+impertinence by boys that were bigger than himself, and sometimes by
+boys that were less; for though he was very abusive and quarrelsome,
+he did not much like fighting, and generally trusted more to his heels
+than his courage when he had engaged himself in a quarrel. This little
+boy had a cur dog that was the exact image of himself; he was the most
+troublesome, surly creature imaginable, always barking at the heels of
+every horse he came near, and worrying every sheep he could meet with,
+for which reason both the dog and the boy were disliked by all the
+neighborhood.
+
+One morning his father got up early to go to the ale-house, where he
+intended to stay till night, as it was a holiday; but before he went
+out he gave his son some bread and cold meat and sixpence, and told
+him he might go and divert himself as he would the whole day. The
+little boy was very much pleased with this liberty, and as it was a
+very fine morning he called his dog Tiger to follow him, and began his
+walk.
+
+He had not proceeded far before he met a boy that was driving a flock
+of sheep towards a gate that he wanted them to enter. "Pray, master,"
+said the little boy, "stand still, and keep your dog close to you, for
+fear you frighten my sheep." "Oh yes, to be sure," answered the
+ill-natured little boy. "I am to wait here all the morning till you
+and your sheep have passed, I suppose! Here, Tiger, seize them, boy"!
+Tiger at this sprang forth into the middle of the flock, barking and
+biting on every side, and the sheep, in a general consternation,
+hurried each a separate way.
+
+Tiger seemed to enjoy this sport equally with his master, but in the
+midst of his triumph he happened unguardedly to attack an old ram that
+had more courage than the rest of the flock. He, instead of running
+away, faced about and aimed a blow with his forehead at his enemy with
+so much force and dexterity that he knocked Tiger over and over,
+butting him several times while he was down, and obliged him to limp
+howling away.
+
+The ill-natured little boy, who was not capable of loving anything,
+had been very much diverted with the trepidation of the flock of
+sheep, but now he laughed heartily at the misfortune of his dog, and
+he would have laughed much longer had not the other little boy, his
+patience provoked at this treatment, thrown a stone at him, which hit
+him full upon the temples and almost knocked him down. He immediately
+began to cry in concert with his dog, when, perceiving a man coming
+towards them, whom he fancied might be the owner of the sheep, he
+thought it most prudent to escape as speedily as possible.
+
+But he had scarcely recovered from the smart which the blow had
+occasioned when his former mischievous disposition returned, which he
+determined to gratify to the utmost. He had not gone far before he saw
+a little girl standing by a stile, with a large pot of milk at her
+feet. "Pray," said the little girl, "help me with this pot of milk. My
+mother sent me out to fetch it this morning, and I have brought it
+alone a mile on my head; but I am so tired that I have been obliged to
+stop at this stile to rest me, and if I don't return home presently we
+shall have no pudding to-day, and, besides, my mother will be very
+angry with me."
+
+"What," said the boy, "you are to have a pudding to-day, are you,
+miss?" "Yes," said the girl, "and a fine piece of roast beef, for
+there's Uncle Will, and Uncle John, and grandfather, and all my
+cousins, to dine with us, and we shall all be very merry in the
+evening, I can assure you; so pray help me up as speedily as
+possible." "That I will, miss," said the boy, taking up the jug, and
+pretending to fix it upon her head. Just as she had hold of it he gave
+it a little push, as if he had stumbled, and overturned it upon her.
+The little girl began to cry violently, but the mischievous boy ran
+away, laughing heartily, and saying: "Good-by, little miss! Give my
+humble service to your Uncle Will, and grandfather, and the dear
+little cousins."
+
+This prank encouraged him very much indeed, for he then felt that now
+he had certainly escaped without any bad consequences; so he went on
+applauding his own ingenuity, and came to a farm where several little
+boys were at play. He desired leave to play with them, which they
+allowed him to do. But he could not be contented long without exerting
+his evil disposition, so taking an opportunity when it was his turn to
+fling the ball, instead of flinging it the way he ought to have done,
+he threw it into a muddy ditch. The little boys ran in a great hurry
+to see what was become of it, and as they were standing all together
+upon the brink he gave the outermost boy a violent push against his
+neighbor; he, not being able to resist the violence, tumbled against
+the next, that against the next, and that next against another, by
+which means they all soused into the ditch together.
+
+They soon scrambled out, although in a dirty plight, and were going to
+have punished him for all his ill behavior; but he patted Tiger upon
+the back, who began snarling and growling in such a manner as made
+them desist. Thus this little mischievous boy escaped a second time
+with impunity.
+
+The next thing he met with was a poor jackass feeding very quietly in
+a ditch. The little boy, seeing that nobody was within sight, thought
+this was an opportunity of plaguing an animal that was not to be lost,
+so he went and cut a large branch of thorns, which he contrived to fix
+to the poor beast's tail, and then, setting Tiger at him, he was
+extremely diverted to see the fright and agony the creature was in.
+But it did not fare so well with Tiger, who while he was baying and
+biting the animal's heels receive so severe a kick upon his head as
+laid him dead upon the spot.
+
+The boy, who had no affection for his dog, left him with the greatest
+unconcern when he saw what had happened, and, finding himself hungry,
+sat down by the wayside to eat his dinner. He had not long been there
+before a poor blind man came groping his way out with a couple of
+sticks. "Good morning to you," said the boy. "Pray did you see a
+little girl come this road with a basket of eggs upon her head,
+dressed in a green gown, with a straw hat upon her head?" "God bless
+you, master!" said the beggar, "I am so blind I can see nothing,
+either in heaven above or in the earth below. I have been blind these
+twenty years, and they call me 'poor old blind Richard.'"
+
+Though the poor old man was such an object of charity and compassion,
+yet the little boy determined, as usual, to play him some trick, and
+as he was a great liar and deceiver, he spoke to him thus: "Poor old
+Richard, I am heartily sorry for you with all my heart. I am just
+eating my breakfast, and if you will sit down by me I will give you
+part, and feed you myself." "Thank you with all my heart!" said the
+poor man; "and if you will give me your hand I will sit by you with
+great pleasure, my dear good little master."
+
+The little boy then gave him his hand, and, pretending to direct him,
+guided him to sit down in a large heap of wet mud that lay by the
+roadside. "There," said he, "now you are nicely seated I am going to
+feed you." So, taking a little of the dirt in his fingers, he was
+going to put it into the blind man's mouth; but the man, who now
+perceived the trick that had been played him, made a sudden snap at
+his fingers, and getting them between his teeth bit them so severely
+that the wicked boy roared out for mercy, and promised never more to
+be guilty of such wickedness. At last the blind man, after he had put
+him to very severe pain, consented to let him go, saying as he went:
+"Are you not ashamed, you little scoundrel, to attempt to do hurt to
+those who have never injured you, and to want to add to the suffering
+of those who already are sufficiently miserable? Although you escape
+now, be assured, sir, that if you do not repent and mend your manners,
+you will meet with a severe punishment for your bad behavior."
+
+One would think that this punishment would have cured him entirely of
+this mischievous disposition, but, unfortunately nothing is so
+difficult to overcome as bad habits that have been long indulged. He
+had not gone far before he saw a lame beggar that had just made a
+shift to support himself by the means of a couple of sticks. The
+beggar asked him to give him something, and the mischievous little
+boy, pulling out his sixpence, threw it down before him, as if he
+intended to make him a present of it; but while the poor man was
+stooping with difficulty to pick it up, the wicked little boy knocked
+the stick away, by which means the beggar fell down upon his face; and
+then snatching up the sixpence, the little boy ran away laughing very
+heartily at the accident.
+
+This was the last trick this ungrateful boy had it in his power to
+play, for seeing two men come up to the beggar and enter into
+discourse with him, he was afraid of being pursued, and therefore ran
+as fast as he was able over several fields. At last he came into a
+lane which led to a farmer's orchard, and as he was preparing to
+clamber over the fence a large dog seized him by the leg and held him
+fast. He cried out in an agony of terror, which brought the farmer
+out, who called the dog off, but seized the boy very roughly, saying:
+"So, sir, you are caught at last, are you? You thought you might come
+day after day and steal my apples without detection; but it seems you
+are mistaken, and now you shall receive the punishment you have so
+long deserved." The farmer then began to chastise him very severely
+with a whip he had in his hand, and the boy in vain protested he was
+innocent, and begged for mercy. At last the farmer asked him who he
+was and where he lived; but when he heard his name, he cried out:
+"What! are you the little rascal that frightened my sheep this
+morning, by which means several of them are lost? and do you think to
+escape?" Saying this he lashed him more severely than before, in spite
+of all his cries and protestations. At length, thinking he had
+punished him enough, he turned him out of the orchard, bade him go
+home, and frighten sheep again if he liked the consequences.
+
+The little boy slunk away crying very bitterly, for he had been very
+severely beaten, and now began to find out that no one can long hurt
+others with impunity; so he determined to go away quietly home, and
+behave better for the future.
+
+But his sufferings were not yet at an end, for as he jumped down from
+a stile he felt himself very roughly seized, and, looking up, found
+that he was in the power of the lame beggar whom he had thrown upon
+his face. It was in vain that he now cried, entreated, and begged for
+pardon; the man, who had been much hurt by his fall, thrashed him very
+severely with his stick before he would part with him.
+
+He now again went on crying and roaring with pain, but at least
+expected to escape without any further damage. But here he was
+mistaken, for as he was walking slowly through a lane, just as he
+turned a corner he found himself in the middle of the very troop of
+boys that he had used so ill in the morning. They all set up a shout
+as soon as they saw him, their enemy, in their power, without his dog,
+and began persecuting him in a thousand various ways. Some pulled him
+by the hair, others pinched him, some whipped his legs with their
+handkerchiefs, while others covered him with handfuls of dirt. In vain
+did he attempt to escape; they were still at his heels, and,
+surrounding him on every side, continued their persecutions.
+
+At length, while he was in this disagreeable situation, he happened to
+come up to the same jackass he had seen in the morning, and, making a
+sudden spring, jumped upon his back, hoping by this means to escape.
+The boys immediately renewed their shouts, and the ass, who was
+frightened at the noise, began galloping with all his might, and
+presently bore him from the reach of his enemies.
+
+But he had little reason to rejoice at this escape, for he found it
+impossible to stop the animal, and was every instant afraid of being
+thrown off and dashed upon the ground. After he had been thus hurried
+along a considerable time the ass on a sudden stopped short at the
+door of a cottage, and began kicking and prancing with so much fury
+that the little boy was presently thrown to the ground, and broke his
+leg in the fall.
+
+His cries immediately brought the family out, among whom was the very
+little girl he had used so ill in the morning. But she, with the
+greatest good nature, seeing him in such a pitiable situation,
+assisted in bringing him in and laying him upon the bed. There this
+unfortunate boy had leisure to recollect himself and reflect upon his
+own bad behavior, which in one day's time had exposed him to such a
+variety of misfortunes; and he determined with great sincerity that if
+ever he recovered from his present accident he would be as careful to
+take every opportunity of doing good as he had before been to commit
+every species of mischief.
+
+
+
+
+THE PURPLE JAR
+
+By MARIA EDGEWORTH
+
+
+Rosamond, a little girl about seven years old, was walking with her
+mother in the streets of London. As she passed along she looked in at
+the windows of several shops, and saw a great variety of different
+sorts of things, of which she did not know the use, or even the names.
+She wished to stop to look at them, but there was a great number of
+people in the streets, and a great many carts, carriages, and
+wheelbarrows, and she was afraid to let go her mother's hand.
+
+"Oh, mother, how happy I should be," she said, as she passed a
+toy-shop, "if I had all these pretty things!"
+
+"What, all! Do you wish for them all, Rosamond?"
+
+"Yes, mamma, all."
+
+As she spoke they came to a milliner's shop, the windows of which were
+decorated with ribbons and lace, and festoons of artificial flowers.
+
+"Oh, mamma, what beautiful roses! Won't you buy some of them?"
+
+"No, my dear."
+
+"Why?"
+
+"Because I don't want them, my dear."
+
+They went a little farther, and came to another shop, which caught
+Rosamond's eye. It was a jeweler's shop, and in it were a great many
+pretty baubles, ranged in drawers behind glass.
+
+"Mamma, will you buy some of these?"
+
+"Which of them, Rosamond?"
+
+"Which? I don't know which; any of them will do, for they are all
+pretty."
+
+"Yes, they are all pretty; but of what use would they be to me?"
+
+"Use! Oh, I am sure you could find some use or other for them if you
+would only buy them first."
+
+"But I would rather find out the use first."
+
+"Well, then, mamma, there are buckles; you know that buckles are
+useful things, very useful things."
+
+"I have a pair of buckles; I don't want another pair," said her
+mother, and walked on.
+
+Rosamond was very sorry that her mother wanted nothing. Presently,
+however, they came to a shop, which appeared to her far more beautiful
+than the rest. It was a chemist's shop, but she did not know that.
+
+"Oh, mother, oh!" cried she, pulling her mother's hand, "look, look!
+blue, green, red, yellow, and purple! Oh, mamma, what beautiful
+things! Won't you buy some of these?"
+
+Still her mother answered, as before, "Of what use would they be to
+me, Rosamond?"
+
+"You might put flowers in them, mamma, and they would look so pretty
+on the chimney-piece. I wish I had one of them."
+
+"You have a flower-pot," said her mother, "and that is not a
+flower-pot."
+
+"But I could use it for a flower-pot, mamma, you know."
+
+"Perhaps if you were to see it nearer, if you were to examine it you
+might be disappointed."
+
+"No, indeed, I'm sure I should not; I should like it exceedingly."
+
+Rosamond kept her head turned to look at the purple vase, till she
+could see it no longer.
+
+"Then, mother," said she, after a pause, "perhaps you have no money."
+
+"Yes, I have."
+
+"Dear me, if I had money I would buy roses, and boxes, and buckles,
+and purple flower-pots, and everything." Rosamond was obliged to pause
+in the midst of her speech.
+
+"Oh, mamma, would you stop a minute for me? I have got a stone in my
+shoe; it hurts me very much."
+
+"How came there to be a stone in your shoe?"
+
+"Because of this great hole, mamma,--it comes in there; my shoes are
+quite worn out. I wish you would be so very good as to give me another
+pair."
+
+"Nay, Rosamond, but I have not money enough to buy shoes, and
+flower-pots, and buckles, and boxes, and everything."
+
+Rosamond thought that was a great pity. But now her foot, which had
+been hurt by the stone, began to give her so much pain that she was
+obliged to hop every other step, and she could think of nothing else.
+They came to a shoemaker's shop soon afterwards.
+
+"There, there! mamma, there are shoes; there are little shoes that
+would just fit me, and you know shoes would be really of use to me."
+
+"Yes, so they would, Rosamond. Come in."
+
+She followed her mother into the shop.
+
+Mr. Sole the shoemaker, had a great many customers, and his shop was
+full, so they were obliged to wait.
+
+"Well, Rosamond," said her mother, "you don't think this shop so
+pretty as the rest?"
+
+"No, not nearly; it is black and dark, and there are nothing but shoes
+all round; and, besides, there's a very disagreeable smell."
+
+"That smell is the smell of new leather."
+
+"Is it? Oh!" said Rosamond, looking round, "there is a pair of little
+shoes; they'll just fit me, I'm sure."
+
+"Perhaps they might; but you cannot be sure till you have tried them
+on, any more than you can be quite sure that you should like the
+purple vase exceedingly, till you have examined it more attentively."
+
+"Why, I don't know about the shoes, certainly, till I have tried; but,
+mamma, I am quite sure that I should like the flower-pot."
+
+"Well, which would you rather have, a jar or a pair of shoes? I will
+buy either for you."
+
+"Dear mamma, thank you--but if you could buy both?"
+
+"No, not both."
+
+"Then the jar, if you please."
+
+"But I should tell you, that in that case I shall not give you another
+pair of shoes this month."
+
+"This month! that's a very long time, indeed! You can't think how
+these hurt me; I believe I'd better have the new shoes. Yet, that
+purple flower-pot. Oh, indeed, mamma, these shoes are not so very,
+very bad! I think I might wear them a little longer, and the month
+will soon be over. I can make them last till the end of the month,
+can't I? Don't you think so, mamma?"
+
+"Nay, my dear, I want you to think for yourself; you will have time
+enough to consider the matter, while I speak to Mr. Sole about my
+clogs."
+
+Mr. Sole was by this time at leisure, and while her mother was
+speaking to him, Rosamond stood in profound meditation, with one shoe
+on, and the other in her hand.
+
+"Well, my dear, have you decided?"
+
+"Mamma!--yes,--I believe I have. If you please, I should like to have
+the flower-pot; that is, if you won't think me very silly, mamma."
+
+"Why, as to that, I can't promise you, Rosamond; but when you have to
+judge for yourself you should choose what would make you happy, and
+then it would not signify who thought you silly."
+
+"Then, mamma, if that's all, I'm sure the flower-pot would make me
+happy," said she, putting on her old shoe again; "so I choose the
+flower-pot."
+
+"Very well, you shall have it; clasp your shoe and come home."
+
+Rosamond clasped her shoe and ran after her mother. It was not long
+before the shoe came down at the heel, and many times she was obliged
+to stop to take the stones out of it, and she often limped with pain;
+but still the thoughts of the purple flower-pot prevailed, and she
+persisted in her choice.
+
+When they came to the shop with the large window, Rosamond felt much
+pleasure upon hearing her mother desire the servant, who was with
+them, to buy the purple jar, and bring it home. He had other
+commissions, so he did not return with them. Rosamond, as soon as she
+got in, ran to gather all her own flowers, which she kept in a corner
+of her mother's garden.
+
+"I am afraid they'll be dead before the flower-pot comes, Rosamond,"
+said her mother to her, as she came in with the flowers in her lap.
+
+"No, indeed, mamma, it will come home very soon, I dare say. I shall
+be very happy putting them into the purple flower-pot."
+
+"I hope so, my dear."
+
+The servant was much longer returning home than Rosamond had expected;
+but at length he came, and brought with him the long-wished-for jar.
+The moment it was set down upon the table, Rosamond ran up to it with
+an exclamation of joy: "I may have it now, mamma?"
+
+"Yes, my dear, it is yours."
+
+Rosamond poured the flowers from her lap upon the carpet, and seized
+the purple flower-pot.
+
+"Oh, dear, mother!" cried she, as soon as she had taken off the top,
+"but there's something dark in it which smells very disagreeably. What
+is it? I didn't want this black stuff."
+
+"Nor I, my dear."
+
+"But what shall I do with it, mamma?"
+
+"That I cannot tell."
+
+"It will be of no use to me, mamma."
+
+"That I cannot help."
+
+"But I must pour it out, and fill the flower-pot with water."
+
+"As you please, my dear."
+
+"Will you lend me a bowl to pour it into, mamma?"
+
+"That was more than I promised you, my dear; but I will lend you a
+bowl."
+
+The bowl was produced, and Rosamond proceeded to empty the purple
+vase. But she experienced much surprise and disappointment, on
+finding, when it was entirely empty, that it was no longer a purple
+vase. It was a plain white glass jar, which had appeared to have that
+beautiful color merely from the liquor with which it had been filled.
+
+Little Rosamond burst into tears.
+
+"Why should you cry, my dear?" said her mother; "it will be of as much
+use to you now as ever, for a flower-pot."
+
+"But it won't look so pretty on the chimney-piece. I am sure, if I
+had known that it was not really purple, I should not have wished to
+have it so much."
+
+"But didn't I tell you that you had not examined it; and that perhaps
+you would be disappointed?"
+
+"And so I am disappointed, indeed. I wish I had believed you at once.
+Now I had much rather have the shoes, for I shall not be able to walk
+all this month; even walking home that little way hurt me exceedingly.
+Mamma, I will give you the flower-pot back again, and that purple
+stuff and all, if you'll only give me the shoes."
+
+"No, Rosamond; you must abide by your own choice; and now the best
+thing you can possibly do is to bear your disappointment with good
+humor."
+
+"I will bear it as well as I can," said Rosamond, wiping her eyes; and
+she began slowly and sorrowfully to fill the vase with flowers.
+
+But Rosamond's disappointment did not end here. Many were the
+difficulties and distresses into which her imprudent choice brought
+her, before the end of the month.
+
+Every day her shoes grew worse and worse, till as last she could
+neither run, dance, jump, nor walk in them.
+
+Whenever Rosamond was called to see anything, she was detained pulling
+her shoes up at the heels, and was sure to be too late.
+
+Whenever her mother was going out to walk, she could not take Rosamond
+with her, for Rosamond had no soles to her shoes; and at length, on
+the very last day of the month, it happened that her father proposed
+to take her with her brother to a glass-house, which she had long
+wished to see. She was very happy; but, when she was quite ready, had
+her hat and gloves on, and was making haste downstairs to her brother
+and father, who were waiting for her at the hall door, the shoe
+dropped off. She put it on again in a great hurry, but, as she was
+going across the hall, her father turned round.
+
+"Why are you walking slipshod? no one must walk slipshod with me. Why,
+Rosamond," said he, looking at her shoes with disgust, "I thought that
+you were always neat; no, I cannot take you with me."
+
+Rosamond colored and retired.
+
+"Oh, mamma," said she as she took off her hat, "how I wish that I had
+chosen the shoes! They would have been of so much more use to me than
+that jar: however, I am sure, no, not quite sure, but I hope I shall
+be wiser another time."
+
+
+
+
+THE THREE CAKES
+
+By ARMAND BERQUIN
+
+
+"There was a little boy named Henry," said Mr Glassington "about your
+age. His parents had but lately fixed him at a boarding-school.
+
+"He was a special boy, forever at his book, and happened once to get
+the highest place at exercises. His mother was told it. She could
+nohow keep from dreaming of the pleasure; and when morning came, she
+got up early, went to speak with the cook and said as follows:
+
+"'Cook, you are to make a cake for Henry, who yesterday was very good
+at school.'
+
+"'With all my heart,' replied the cook, and set immediately about it.
+It was as big as--let me see--as big as--as a hat when flapped. The
+cook had stuffed it with nice almonds, large pistachio nuts, and
+candied lemon-peel, and iced it over with a coat of sugar, so that it
+was very smooth and a perfect white. The cake no sooner was come home
+from baking than the cook put on her things, and carried it to school.
+
+"When Henry first saw it, he jumped up and down like any Merry Andrew.
+He was not so patient as to wait till they could let him have a knife,
+but fell upon it tooth and nail. He ate and ate till school began, and
+after school was over he ate again; at night, too, it was the same
+thing till bedtime--nay, a little fellow that Henry had for a playmate
+told me that he put the cake upon his bolster when he went to bed, and
+waked and waked a dozen times, that he might take a bit. I cannot so
+easily believe this last particular; but, then, it is very true, at
+least, that on the morrow, when the day was hardly broke, he set about
+his favorite business once again, continuing at it all the morning,
+and by noon had eaten it up. The dinner-bell now rung; but Henry, as
+one may fancy, had no stomach, and was vexed to see how heartily the
+other children ate. It was, however, worse than this at five o'clock,
+when school was over.
+
+"His companions asked him if he would not play at cricket, tan, or
+kits. Alas! he could not; so they played without him. In the meantime
+Henry could hardly stand upon his legs; he went and sat down in a
+corner very gloomily, while the children said one to another: 'What is
+the matter with poor Henry, who used to skip about and be so merry?
+See how pale and sorrowful he is!'
+
+"The master came himself, and, seeing him, was quite alarmed. It was
+all lost labor to interrogate him. Henry could not be brought to speak
+a single word.
+
+"By great good luck, a boy at length came forward in the secret; and
+his information was that Henry's mother had sent him a great cake the
+day before, which he had swallowed in an instant, as it were, and that
+his present sickness was occasioned only by his gluttony. On this, the
+master sent for an apothecary, who ordered him a quantity of physic,
+phial after phial. Henry, as one would fancy, found it very nauseous,
+but was forced to take the whole for fear of dying, which, had he
+omitted it, would certainly have been the case. When some few days of
+physic and strict regimen had passed, his health was re-established as
+before; but his mother protested that she would never let him have
+another cake."
+
+_Percival_. He did not merit so much as the smell of such a thing. But
+this is but one cake, father; and you informed me that there were
+three, if you remember, in your story.
+
+_Mr. G._ Patience! patience! Here is another cake in what I am now
+going to tell.
+
+"Henry's master had another scholar, whose name was Francis. He had
+written his mother a very pretty letter, and it had not so much as a
+blotted stroke; in recompense for which she sent him likewise a great
+cake, and Francis thus addressed himself: 'I will not, like that
+glutton Henry, eat up my cake at once, and so be sick as he was; no, I
+will make my pleasure last a great deal longer.' So he took the cake,
+which he could hardly lift by reason of its weight, and watched the
+opportunity of slipping up into his chamber with it, where his box
+was, and in which he put it under lock and key. At playtime every day
+he slipped away from his companions, went upstairs a-tiptoe, cut a
+tolerable slice off, swallowed it, put by the rest, and then came down
+and mixed again with his companions. He continued this clandestine
+business all the week, and even then the cake was hardly half
+consumed. But what ensued? At last the cake grew dry, and quickly
+after moldy; nay, the very maggots got into it, and by that means had
+their share; on which account it was not then worth eating, and our
+young curmudgeon was compelled to fling the rest away with great
+reluctance. However, no one grieved for him."
+
+_Percival_. No, indeed; nor I, father. What, keep a cake locked up
+seven days together, and not give one's friends a bit! That is
+monstrous! But let us have the other now.
+
+"There was another little gentleman who went to school with Henry and
+Francis likewise, and his name was Gratian. His mother sent him a cake
+one day, because she loved him, and, indeed, he loved her also very
+much. It was no sooner come than Gratian thus addressed his young
+companions: 'Come and look at what mother has sent me; you must every
+one eat with me.' They scarcely needed such a welcome piece of
+information twice, but all got round the cake, as you have doubtless
+seen the bees resorting to a flower just blown. As Gratian was
+provided with a knife, he cut a great piece off, and then divided it
+into as many shares as he had brought boys together by such a
+courteous invitation. Gratian then took up the rest, and told them
+that he would eat his piece next day; on which he put it up, and went
+to play with his companions, who were all solicitous to have him
+choose whatever game he thought might entertain him most.
+
+"A quarter of an hour had scarcely passed as they were playing, when a
+poor old man, who had a fiddle, came into the yard.
+
+"He had a very long white beard, and, being blind, was guided by a
+little dog, who went before him with a collar round his neck. To this
+a cord was fastened, which the poor blind man held in his hand.
+
+"It was noticed with how much dexterity the little dog conducted him,
+and how he shook a bell, which, I forgot to say, hung underneath his
+collar, when he came near any one, as if he had designed to say by
+such an action, 'Do not throw down or run against my master.' Being
+come into the yard, he sat him down upon a stone, and, hearing several
+children talking round him, 'My dear little gentlemen,' said he, 'I
+will play you all the pretty tunes that I know, if you will give me
+leave.' The children wished for nothing half so much. He put his
+violin in tune, and then thrummed over several jigs and other scraps
+of music, which, it was easy to conjecture, had been new in former
+times.
+
+"Little Gratian saw that while he played his merriest airs, a tear
+would now and then roll down his cheeks, on which he stopped to ask
+him why he wept?
+
+"'Because,' said the musician, 'I am very hungry. I have no one in the
+world that will give my dog or me a bit of of anything to eat. I wish
+I could but work, and get for both of us a morsel of something; but I
+have lost my strength and sight. Alas! I labored hard till I was old,
+and now I want bread.'
+
+"The generous Gratian, hearing this, wept too. He did not say a word,
+but ran to fetch the cake which he had designed to eat himself. He
+brought it out with joy, and, as he ran along, began: 'Here, good old
+man, here is some cake for you.'
+
+"'Where?' replied the poor musician, feeling with his hands; 'where is
+it? For I am blind, and cannot see you.'
+
+"Gratian put the cake into his hand, when, laying down his fiddle on
+the ground, he wiped his eyes, and then began to eat. At every piece
+he put into his mouth, he gave his faithful little dog a bit, who came
+and ate out of his hand; and Gratian, standing by him, smiled with
+pleasure at the thought of having fed the poor old man when he was
+hungry."
+
+_Percival_. Oh, the good, good Gratian! Let me have your knife,
+father.
+
+_Mr. G._ Here, Percival; but why my knife?
+
+_Percival_. I will tell you. I have only nibbled here a little of my
+cake, so pleased I was in listening to you! So I will cut it smooth.
+There, see how well I have ordered it! These scraps, together with the
+currants, will be more than I shall want for breakfast; and the first
+poor man that I meet going home shall have the rest, even though he
+should not play upon the violin.
+
+
+
+
+AMENDMENT
+
+
+Charles Grant lived in a good house, and wore fine clothes, and had a
+great many pretty toys to play with; yet Charles was seldom happy or
+pleased; for he was never good. He did not mind what his mother said
+to him, and would not learn to read, though he was now seven years
+old.
+
+He called the servants names, pinched and beat his little sister
+Clara, and took away her playthings, and was not kind and good to her,
+as a brother should be. "Oh, what a sad boy Charles is!" was his
+mother's daily bitter exclamation.
+
+His father was a proud, bad man, who let Charles have his own way,
+because he was his only son, and he thought him handsome. But how
+could anyone be handsome that was so naughty? I am sure that when he
+was froward, and put out his lip, and frowned, he looked quite ugly.
+Mother told him so, and said that no one was pretty that was not good;
+but Charles did not mind his mother, and was so vain he would stand
+before the looking-glass half the day, instead of learning his
+lessons; and was so silly he would say, "What a pretty little boy I
+am! I am glad I am not a shabby boy, like Giles Bloomfield, our
+cowboy." At such times his mother would say to him: "I wish, Charles,
+you were only half as good as Giles; he is not much older than you,
+yet he can read in the Bible quite well; he works hard for his poor
+mother, and never vexes her, as you do me; and when he comes home of
+an evening, he nurses the baby, and is kind to all his sisters. I dare
+say he never pinched nor beat any of them in his life."
+
+"Oh!" said that wicked Charles, "I hate him for all that, for he wears
+ragged clothes, and has no toys to play with."
+
+"Oh fie, Charles!" said his mother; "you are a wicked boy: have not I
+often told you that God made the poor as well as the rich, and He will
+hate those who despise them? Now, Charles, if God, to punish you for
+your pride, were to take away your father and me, and you had no money
+to buy food, and your clothes became old and ragged, you would then
+be a poor, shabby boy, and worse off than Giles; for you could not
+earn your own living, as he does; and you would consequently be
+starved to death if God did not take care of you. And if, while you
+were rich, you hated the poor, how could you expect God to care for
+you when you grew poor, like those you had scorned?"
+
+But Charles, however, was so naughty he would not stay to hear what
+his mother said, but ran away into the fields.
+
+Then Charles's mother was so vexed that she could not help crying at
+his being such a wicked, proud boy; and she could not sleep all that
+night for the grief his conduct had occasioned her. The next day she
+was forced to take a long journey to visit a friend who was very ill,
+and who lived in London. She was very sorry to leave her children, for
+she knew if Charles behaved naughty when she was with him, he would be
+a sad boy indeed when he was left to himself, and had none to correct
+him and tell him of his faults.
+
+When the carriage that was to take Mrs. Grant to London drove to the
+door, she kissed her children a great many times, and begged that they
+would be very good while she was away from them.
+
+"You, my dear Clara, I know, will mind what nurse says to you, and
+will try to be good while I am gone; for you know that God will see
+everything you do amiss, if I do not; and I hope you will never forget
+to say your prayers to Him night and morning."
+
+Clara kissed her dear mother, and promised that she would attend to
+all she said; and her mother was satisfied, for she knew that Clara
+never told stories, though she was but a little girl.
+
+Then Mrs. Grant turned to Charles, and said: "As for you, Charles, I
+cannot help feeling great pain at leaving you; for you are such a bad,
+wilful boy that I shall not have a happy moment while I am away from
+you, lest you should do anything amiss. But if you love me, you will
+try to be good; and whenever you are about to do anything wrong, say
+to yourself, 'How much this would grieve my poor mother if she knew
+it! and how much it will offend God, who does see, and knows, not
+only everything I do, but even my most secret thoughts! And He will
+one day bring me to an account for all I do or say against His holy
+will and my kind parents' commands.'"
+
+Charles, who knew he was a bad boy, hung down his head, for he did not
+like to be told of his faults.
+
+Then his mother said: "My dear Charles, do try and be good, and I will
+love you dearly."
+
+"But what will you bring me from London," said Charles, "if I am a
+good boy? for I never will behave well for nothing."
+
+"Do you call the love of God and of dear mother nothing?" said Clara;
+"I will behave well, even if mother forgets to bring me the great wax
+doll, and the chest of drawers to keep her clothes in, which she told
+me about yesterday."
+
+Mrs. Grant smiled fondly on her little girl, but made no reply to
+Charles; and soon the coach drove away from the door.
+
+Charles was very glad when his mother was gone, and he said: "Now
+mother is gone to London, I will do just as I please: I will learn no
+ugly lessons, but play all day long. How happy I shall be! I hope
+mother may not come for a whole month."
+
+But Charles soon found he was not so happy as he thought he should
+have been; he did not know the reason, but I will tell you why he was
+not happy. No one can be happy who is not good, and Charles was so
+naughty as to resolve not to obey his kind mother, who loved him so
+much.
+
+Charles brought out all his toys to play with, but he soon grew weary
+of them, and he kicked them under the table, saying, "Nasty dull toys,
+I hate you, for you do not amuse me or make me happy. I will go to
+father, and ask him to give me something to please me that I am not
+used to."
+
+But father was busy with some friends in the study, and could not
+attend to his wants. Charles was a rude, tiresome boy; so he stood by
+his father, and shook his chair, and pulled his sleeve, and teased him
+so much that his father at last grew angry, and turned him out of the
+room.
+
+Then Charles stood and kicked at the door, and screamed with all his
+might, when one of the gentlemen said to him: "If you were my little
+boy, I would give you something to cry for." So Charles's father told
+him if he did not go away, he would come out of the study and whip
+him.
+
+When Charles heard this, he ran away, for he was afraid of being
+beaten; but, instead of playing quietly with his toys, he went and
+laid under the great table in the hall and sulked and fretted till
+dinner-time.
+
+When nurse came to call him to dinner, he said: "I won't come; Go
+away, ugly nurse!"
+
+Then said nurse: "Master Charles, if you like to punish yourself by
+going without your dinner, no one will prevent you, I am sure."
+
+Then Charles began to cry aloud, and tried to tear nurse's apron; but
+nurse told him he was a bad boy, and left him.
+
+Now, when Clara sat down to dinner, she said to nurse: "Where is
+brother Charles? Why is he not here?"
+
+"Miss Clara, he is a naughty child," said nurse, "and chooses to go
+without his dinner, thinking to vex us; but he hurts no one but
+himself with his perverse temper."
+
+"Then," said Clara, "I do not like to dine while Charles goes without;
+so I will try and persuade him to come and eat some pie."
+
+"Well, Miss Clara," said nurse, "you may go, if you please; but I
+would leave the bad boy to himself."
+
+When Clara came to Charles, and asked him if he would come and eat his
+dinner, he poked out his head, and made such an ugly face that she was
+quite frightened at him, and ran away.
+
+Nurse did not take the trouble of calling him to tea; and, though he
+was very hungry, he was too sulky to come without being asked; so he
+lay under the table, and cried aloud till bedtime. But when it grew
+dark, he was afraid to stay by himself, for bad children are always
+fearful; so he came upstairs and said in a cross, rude tone of voice:
+"Nurse, give me something to eat."
+
+Nurse said: "Master Charles, if you had been good, you would have had
+some chicken and some apple-pie for your dinner, and bread and butter
+and cake for your tea; but as you were such a bad boy, and would not
+come to your meals, I shall only give you a piece of dry bread and a
+cup of milk, and you do not deserve even that."
+
+Then Charles made one of his very worst faces, and threw the bread on
+the ground, and spilt the milk.
+
+Nurse told him that there were many poor children in the world who
+would be glad of the smallest morsel of what he so much despised, and
+that the time would come when he might want the very worst bit of it;
+and she bade him kneel down and say his prayers, and ask God to
+forgive him for having been such a wicked boy all day.
+
+But Charles did not mind what she said, and went crying to bed. Thus
+ended the first day of Charles Grant's happiness.
+
+He awoke very early the next morning, and told nurse to get him his
+breakfast, for he was very hungry. But nurse said he must wait till
+eight o'clock, which was the breakfast hour.
+
+He now found it was of no use sulking, as no one seemed to care for
+his tempers; so he looked about for something to eat, but found
+nothing but the piece of bread he had thrown on the ground the night
+before; and he was glad to eat that, and only wished there had been
+more of it.
+
+As soon as breakfast was over, Clara brought her books, and began to
+learn her lessons, and nurse asked Charles if he would do the same.
+But Charles said, "No, indeed! I do not mean to learn any lessons
+while mother is away, for I mean to please myself and be happy."
+
+"You did as you pleased yesterday, Master Charles," said nurse; "yet I
+do not think you were so very happy, unless happiness consists in
+lying under a table and crying all day, and going without dinner and
+tea, merely to indulge a sullen, froward temper."
+
+Now, Charles hated to be told of his faults, so he left nurse, and
+went into the garden to try and amuse himself. When there, instead of
+keeping in the walks, as he ought to have done, he ran on the beds,
+trampled down the flowers, and pulled the blossoms from the
+fruit-trees.
+
+The gardener's boy earnestly requested Charles not to do so much
+mischief; but Charles told him he was a gentleman's son, and would do
+as he pleased. So he again ran over the new-raked borders, and pulled
+up the flowers; and the poor boy was sadly vexed to see his nice work
+all spoiled.
+
+Charles did not care for that, and would have behaved still worse, had
+not the gardener, who then came up, taken him in his arms, and carried
+him into the house, in spite of his kicking and screaming. He cried
+for a long time, and made a sad noise; but, finding that no one paid
+any regard to him, he became quiet, and went into the nursery, and
+asked Clara to come and play with him.
+
+"I cannot come just now, brother Charles," said she; "for I want to
+finish this frock that I am making for Giles Bloomfield's little
+sister."
+
+"I am sure," said Charles, "if I were you, I would much rather play
+than sit still and sew."
+
+"Not if you knew what pleasure there is in doing good," said Clara;
+"but if you will wait till I have finished it, you shall go with me
+and give it to the poor woman, and then you will see how pleased she
+will be, and how nicely the baby will look when she is dressed in this
+pretty frock, instead of her old faded, ragged one."
+
+Charles did not know how to amuse himself, so he sat down on his
+little stool, and watched his sister while she worked.
+
+When Clara had finished making the frock, she said: "Thank you, dear
+nurse, for cutting out and fixing the frock for me." So she threw her
+arms round nurse's neck, and kissed her cheek; and nurse put on
+Clara's tippet and her new bonnet, and walked with Charles and her to
+Dame Bloomfield's cottage.
+
+The good woman took the baby out of the cradle, and laid it on Clara's
+lap, and Clara had the pleasure of dressing it herself in the nice new
+frock; and the baby looked so neat and pretty, and the poor mother was
+so pleased, that Clara was much happier than if she had spent her time
+in playing or working for her doll.
+
+While Clara was nursing and caressing the baby, Charles went into the
+little garden, where he found Giles Bloomfield, who had just returned
+from working in the fields, with a beautiful milk-white rabbit in his
+arms, which he had taken out of the hutch, and was nursing with much
+affection.
+
+"Oh, what a pretty rabbit!" said Charles. "Giles, will you sell it to
+me?"
+
+"No, Master Charles," said Giles, "I cannot sell my pretty Snowball."
+
+"And why not?" asked Charles in a fretful tone.
+
+"Because, Master Charles, the old doe, its mother, died when Snowball
+was only a week old, and I reared it by feeding it with warm milk and
+bran; and it is now so fond of me that I would not part with it for a
+great deal."
+
+So saying, he stroked his pretty favorite, who licked his hand all
+over, and rubbed her soft white head against his fingers.
+
+Then Giles said: "My dear Snowball, I would not sell you for the
+world."
+
+"But you shall sell Snowball to me," said Charles, making one of his
+ugly faces. "I will give you a shilling for her; and if you do not let
+me carry her home this very day, I will tell father of you, and he
+will turn you out of the cottage."
+
+When Giles's mother heard Charles say so, she came out of the house,
+and said: "Pray, Giles, let Master Charles have the rabbit."
+
+"Dear mother," said Giles, "Master Charles has a pony and a dog, and a
+great many fine toys to play with, and I have only my pretty Snowball;
+and it will break my heart to part with her."
+
+"Then," said his mother, "would you rather see your mother and sisters
+turned out of doors than part with your rabbit? You know, Giles, that
+I had so many expenses with your poor father's illness and death that
+I have not paid the rent due last quarter-day; and you know it is in
+our landlord's power to turn us into the streets to-morrow."
+
+"Well, mother," cried Giles, bursting into tears, "Master Charles must
+have the rabbit. But oh!" continued he, "he does not love you as I do,
+my pretty Snowball; he will not feed and take care of you as I have
+done, and you will soon die, and I shall never see you again." And his
+tears fell fast on the white head of his little pet as he spoke.
+
+Clara was quite grieved, and begged her naughty brother not to
+deprive poor Giles of his rabbit; but Charles was a wicked and
+covetous boy; he therefore took Snowball from Giles, and carried her
+home in his arms, and put her in a box. He went into the fields and
+gathered some green herbs for her to eat, and said: "I am glad I have
+got Snowball; now I shall be quite happy."
+
+But how could Charles be happy when he had broken God's holy
+commandment, which says, "Thou shalt not covet?" Nurse and Clara told
+him so, and begged him to give Snowball back again to Giles. But
+Charles said he would not, for he meant to keep her all his life; but
+the next morning, when he went into the stable to look at her, he
+found her stretched at the bottom of the box. He called her, but
+Snowball did not stir; he then took her out of the box to see what
+ailed her; but she was quite cold and dead.
+
+Oh dear! how Charles did cry! But it was of no use. He had better not
+have taken her away from Giles, for he did not know what to feed her
+with, and had given her among the greens he had gathered a herb called
+hemlock, which is poisonous and will kill whatever eats of it; and it
+had killed poor Snowball.
+
+The coachman told Charles so when he saw how swollen she was, and
+Charles cried the more. Giles cried too when he heard what a sad death
+poor Snowball had died; but he had been a good dutiful boy in parting
+with her when his mother wished it, though it had cost him much pain
+and many tears.
+
+Well, Charles's mother was gone a long time, more than a month, and it
+would quite shock you to be told how naughty Charles was all that
+time; at last a letter came to say she was very ill, and then another
+to tell them she was dead.
+
+What would Charles then have given if he had not grieved her so often
+with his perverse temper and wicked conduct? He now said when he saw
+her again, he would beg her to forgive him; but when Charles did see
+his poor mother again she was in her coffin and could not hear him;
+and he cried exceedingly, and wished he had been good. Clara, though
+she cried as much as Charles for her dear mother, was glad she had
+obeyed her, and been so good while she was away.
+
+"And I will always be as good as if dear mother could see me, and love
+me for it too," said she to nurse the day after her mother was buried.
+
+"My dear young lady," said nurse, "your mother _will_ see it, and love
+you for doing your duty."
+
+"How can dear mother see me? Her eyes are closed, and she is in the
+dark grave," said Clara.
+
+"But she will see you from heaven, Miss Clara, where she is gone to
+receive the reward of her good conduct in this world; for though her
+body is in the earth, her spirit is in heaven."
+
+"And shall I never see my own dear mother again?" said Clara.
+
+"Yes, Miss Clara; if you are good, you will go to heaven when you die,
+and become an angel like her."
+
+"Then," said Clara, "I will pray to God to make me good, and when I am
+going to do anything wrong I will say to myself, 'If I do this, I
+shall never go to heaven, and see my dear mother when I die.'"
+
+"I wish," said nurse, "that Master Charles was like you, and would try
+to be good."
+
+But though Charles was sometimes sorry for his bad behavior, he did
+not try to mend, because he thought it was too much trouble to be
+good, and said he did not care, because he was the son of a gentleman.
+
+Charles did not know that at this very time his father had spent all
+his money, and owed a great many debts to different people; and at
+last he ran away that he might not be put in prison; and the people to
+whom he owed so much money came and seized his fine house and gardens,
+and the coach, and all the furniture, and sold them by auction, to
+raise money to pay the debts; so Charles found that, instead of being
+rich, he was now very, very poor.
+
+When the auction was over and all the things were sold, and it was
+getting quite dark (for it was in the month of November), Clara and
+Charles stood in one of the empty parlors, and wondered what they
+should do for supper, and where they should sleep that night; for all
+the beds were sold, and they saw the servants go away one after
+another.
+
+At last nurse came in with her bonnet and cloak, and said: "Miss
+Clara, I am going away to my own cottage, and as you have always been
+a kind, good child, you shall go with me, and I will take care of
+you."
+
+Then Clara said, "Thank you; but will you not take Charles also?"
+
+"No," said nurse; "he has always been such a proud bad boy that I will
+not take him. I have very little to spare, for I am a poor woman, and
+what I have is not more than will keep my own children and you, Miss
+Clara."
+
+Saying this, she got into the cart, and took Clara on her lap, and one
+of the footmen got in after her, and drove away from the door.
+
+Charles stood on the step of the door, and looked after them till they
+were out of sight; and then he began to cry as if his heart would
+break. The servant of the gentleman who had purchased the house came
+and locked the door, so Charles could not get in any more, and he sat
+down on the stone steps, and covered his face with his hands, and
+cried bitterly.
+
+"Unhappy child that I am," sobbed he; "what will become of me? Oh, if
+I had but been good like Clara, I should have found a friend, as she
+has; but no one cares what becomes of me, because I have been so
+wicked. I used to despise the poor, and God, to punish me, has made me
+poor indeed."
+
+It was very cold, and the snow began to fall fast, and it grew quite
+dark. Charles rested his head on his knees, and was afraid to look
+round; his clothes were almost wet through, and his limbs were
+benumbed with cold; he had no place where he could ask shelter, for no
+one loved him; and he thought he should be obliged to stay there all
+night, and perhaps be frozen to death.
+
+Just then some one softly touched his hand, and said: "Master Charles,
+I have been looking for you for more than an hour."
+
+Charles looked up; but when he saw it was Giles Bloomfield who had
+come to seek him in his distress, he remembered how ill he had behaved
+to him, so he hid his face, and began to weep afresh.
+
+Then Giles sat down by him on the steps, and said: "Dear Master
+Charles, you must not stay here. See how fast it snows. You will catch
+your death of cold."
+
+"Yes, I am very cold and hungry," sobbed Charles, "but I have no home
+now; I have nowhere else to go, and must stay here all night."
+
+"No, Master Charles," said Giles, "you shall come home with me, and
+shall share my supper and my bed, though it is not such as you have
+been used to; notwithstanding we are very poor, we will do our best to
+make you comfortable."
+
+"Oh, Giles!" said Charles, throwing his arms round Giles's neck, "I do
+not deserve this kindness; I have been such a proud, wicked boy, and
+have treated you so ill. I am sure you can never forgive me for having
+taken your pretty Snowball; and if _you_ forgive me, I can never
+forgive myself."
+
+"Dear Master Charles, do not think of that now," said Giles, taking
+both Charles's cold hands in his. "Indeed, Master Charles, I should
+never dare say my prayers if I was so wicked as to bear malice; and,
+now you are in distress, I would do anything in my power to serve you.
+So pray come home with me, and warm yourself, and get some supper."
+
+But Charles hid his face on Giles's bosom, and cried the more; at last
+he said:
+
+"Giles, I am so ashamed of having behaved so cruelly to you, that I
+can never go to your home, and eat the food that you are obliged to
+labor so hard for."
+
+"Master Charles," said Giles, "that is because you are so proud."
+
+"Oh no, no!" sobbed Charles, "I am not proud now, and I think I shall
+never be proud again." So he kissed Giles, and they both went home to
+Dame Bloomfield's cottage together.
+
+When Giles's mother saw Charles, she said: "Why did you bring this
+proud, cross, young gentleman here, Giles?"
+
+Charles, when he heard her say so, thought he should be turned out
+again into the cold, and began to cry afresh; but Giles said:
+
+"Dear mother, Master Charles has no home to go to now; he is cold and
+hungry; I am sure you will let him stay here, and share my bed and my
+supper."
+
+"He can stay here if he likes," said Dame Bloomfield; "but you know,
+Giles, we are forced to work hard for what food we have, and I am sure
+we cannot afford to maintain Master Charles."
+
+"Then," said Giles, "he shall have my supper to-night: he wants it
+more than I do, for he has had no food all day."
+
+"You may please yourself about that, Giles: but remember, if you give
+your food to Master Charles, you must go without yourself."
+
+"Well," said Giles, "I shall feel more pleasure in giving my supper to
+Master Charles than in eating it myself."
+
+So he brought a stool, and, placing it in the warmest corner by the
+fire, made Charles sit down, and chafed his cold frozen hands, and
+tried to comfort him; for Charles was greatly afflicted when he saw
+that everyone hated him; but he knew that it was his own fault, and a
+just punishment for his pride and bad conduct.
+
+When Giles brought his basin of hot milk and bread for his supper, he
+could not thank him for crying; and he was ashamed to eat it while
+Giles went without; but he was so hungry, and the milk looked so nice,
+that he did not know how to refuse it; and Giles begged him so
+earnestly to eat that at last he did so, and once more felt warm and
+comfortable.
+
+Then Giles said to him: "Now, Master Charles, will you go to bed? Mine
+is but a coarse, hard bed, but it is very clean." So he took the lamp
+to show Charles the way to the chamber in which he was to sleep.
+
+Charles was surprised at seeing no staircase, but only a ladder. Giles
+laughed when he saw how Charles stared, and he said:
+
+"You have been used to live in a grand house, Master Charles, and know
+nothing of the shifts the poor are forced to make."
+
+Then Charles climbed up the ladder, and Giles showed him a little
+room, not much larger than a closet, with no furniture in it, but a
+stump bed without any hangings, and covered with a coarse, woolen
+rug. Charles Grant had never even seen such a bed before, but he was
+thankful that he could get any place to sleep in, out of the cold and
+snow.
+
+Giles helped Charles to undress, for Charles was so helpless he did
+not know how to undress himself. When he was going to step into bed,
+Giles exclaimed:
+
+"Will you not say your prayers before you go to bed, Master Charles?"
+
+Charles blushed and hung down his head, for he had been so naughty
+that he had not said his prayers for a long time past, and had almost
+forgotten what his dear mother had taught him; and he told Giles so at
+last.
+
+"Dear, dear!" said Giles, "I never dare go to bed without saying
+mine."
+
+Then Charles said: "I am sorry I have been so naughty as to forget my
+prayers; will you teach me yours, and I will never forget them again?"
+
+Then they both knelt down by the side of the little bed, and Giles
+taught Charles such prayers as he knew, and Charles went to bed much
+happier than he had been for a long time.
+
+Though the bed was hard, and the sheets brown and coarse, Charles was
+so weary that he soon fell asleep, and slept so soundly that he did
+not awake till it was broad day, and Giles was up and gone to work in
+the fields.
+
+When Charles looked round he thought he had never seen such a shabby
+room in his life. There was not so much as a chair or table or carpet
+in it; he could see all the thatch and the rafters in the roof, for
+the chamber was not even ceiled, but showed the thatch and rafters,
+and, as I said before, there was not a single article of furniture in
+the room, except the bed. How different from the pretty little chamber
+in which Charles used to sleep, with the nice white dimity
+window-curtains and hangings and mahogany tent-bed, with such
+comfortable bedding and handsome white counterpane! However, he now
+thought himself very fortunate that he had any roof to shelter him, or
+any bed, however homely it might be, on which he could sleep.
+
+He thought he should like to get up and go downstairs, but he had
+always been used to have a servant to dress him, and he did not know
+how to dress himself, so while he was considering what he should do
+Giles came into the chamber. He had returned to get his breakfast, and
+not seeing Charles downstairs he concluded the cause of his absence,
+and came to assist him to dress. Charles observed how this matter was
+arranged, and resolved to do it for himself the next morning.
+
+When he was dressed they both knelt down by the bedside and said their
+prayers, for though Giles had said his at the dawn of day, yet he
+never omitted an opportunity of repeating his thanksgivings and
+praises to his heavenly Father for the mercies and blessings which he
+enjoyed through His grace, for Giles possessed a grateful and
+contented heart, which made him look upon that state of life unto
+which it had pleased God to call him, as that which was meet and fit
+for him, so he worked hard, and ate the bread of labor with
+cheerfulness and satisfaction.
+
+When Charles and Giles joined the family below Dame Bloomfield set a
+porringer of milk and a piece of brown bread for every one but
+Charles, who looked ready to cry, but Giles put his porringer before
+him, and gave him another spoon, and said: "Master Charles, we will
+eat together, for there will be enough for both of us." The tears came
+into Charles's eyes, and he whispered: "Dear Giles, you are very
+good." So these boys ate out of the same porringer, and broke of the
+same bread.
+
+After breakfast Giles went out to work, and Charles thought it very
+dull till he returned to dinner. When Dame Bloomfield gave her
+children their dinners there was a dumpling for everyone but Charles;
+then Giles cut his dumpling in half, and gave one part to Charles, and
+ate the other half himself. Now this was very good of Giles, for he
+was very hungry himself, but he could not bear to see Charles sad and
+hungry while he was eating, and Giles liked to do good because he knew
+it was pleasing to God.
+
+As soon as dinner was over, Giles went out to work again, and Charles
+was as dull as he had been in the morning, for all the family were at
+work in some way or other, and could not spare time to amuse or talk
+to him, and he did nothing but sigh and fret to himself till evening,
+when Giles came home from work.
+
+Giles's eldest sister made a bright fire, and they all sat round it
+and talked and told stories, and Giles nursed the baby, and played
+with the other little ones, and seemed quite happy, and so he was, for
+he had done his duty, and every one loved him for being so good.
+
+After supper Giles taught those of his sisters who were old enough to
+read and write, and when they had finished learning their tasks
+Charles took up the book, and said: "Giles, will you teach me to
+read?" and Giles said: "Certainly, Master Charles, but I am sure you
+must know how to read a great deal better than such a poor boy as I
+am."
+
+"I might have done so," said Charles, "but Giles, I was a sad,
+naughty, perverse boy, and hated to learn any thing that was good; but
+I hope I know better now, and if you will only take the trouble of
+teaching me I will try and make up for my lost time."
+
+So Giles gave Charles a lesson that very night, and every evening
+after supper he heard him read and spell what he had learned during
+the day, and Charles took such pains that he soon began to read so
+well that he used to amuse himself by reading pretty stories, and by
+teaching little Betty, one of Giles's youngest sisters, to read.
+
+Still Charles used to be exceedingly hungry, for he had not more than
+half the quantity of food he was used to eat, and Giles was hungry
+too, and grew pale and thin.
+
+Then Charles said to himself: "It is not right for me to eat the bread
+which poor Giles works so hard to earn; I will try and get my own
+living, for why should I not do so, as well as Giles?" So one morning,
+when Giles rose, as usual, at five o'clock, Charles got up too. Then
+Giles said:
+
+"Why do you rise so early this cold morning, Master Charles?"
+
+"Because I am going out to work with you, Giles, if you will permit
+me," answered Charles.
+
+"Oh, Master Charles, such work as I do is not fit for a young
+gentleman like you," said Giles.
+
+"You must not call me a young gentleman _now_, for I am only a poor
+boy, and poorer than other poor boys, for they can earn their own
+living, while I should have been starved to death had not you given me
+half of the bread you work so hard for. But I will not be a burthen to
+you any longer, but learn to work and get my own living as you do."
+
+Charles now meant to keep his word, and they both went out into the
+fields, and worked together at picking stones off the young crops of
+wheat and clover, and before breakfast. Giles had picked up two
+bushels of stones and Charles one, and the farmer gave them a penny
+per bushel for gathering them up.
+
+Then they made haste back to the cottage, and Giles gave his mother
+the money he had earned, and Charles did the same, and when the dame
+poured out the milk for the family Charles saw that she filled a
+porringer for him also, and they had all a good breakfast that
+morning, and Charles felt quite happy because he had not eaten the
+bread of idleness. So he went out to work with Giles again, and earned
+twopence before dinner.
+
+When Dame Bloomfield took up the dumplings Charles saw there was one
+for him, and he felt happy that poor Giles had not to deprive himself
+of half his food that he might eat.
+
+Charles went out to work every day with Giles, and in the evening he
+learned to read and write. He became quite good and gentle, and
+enjoyed more happiness than he had experienced in his life before, And
+why was Charles happy? I will tell you, my dear children. Because he
+was no longer a proud, froward boy as he had been, but was kind and
+sweet-tempered to every one, and did his duty both to God and himself.
+
+The winter passed swiftly away, and the spring came, and the birds
+began to sing, and the trees looked green and gay, and the pretty
+flowers bloomed in the gardens and covered the meadows all over, and
+scented the air with their fragrance, and Charles thought it very
+pleasant to work in the fields, and hear the birds sing as they tended
+their young, or built their nests among the green boughs or in the
+hedges.
+
+One day Giles said to Charles: "Master Charles, we cannot work
+together in the fields any more; I have got a new employment"
+
+"But why cannot I work with you?" asked Charles.
+
+"Because, sir, you will not like to work where I am going," answered
+Giles. Charles asked where that was. "In the garden of the great
+house, Master Charles, where you used to live," said Giles.
+
+Charles looked very sorrowful, and remained silent for some minutes;
+at last he said: "Well, Giles, I will go with you; my clothes are
+grown shabby now, and nobody will know me, and if they did I hope I am
+too wise to be ashamed of doing my duty, so let us go directly."
+
+Then Giles took Charles into the garden, and the gardener gave them
+each a hoe and a rake, and told them to hoe up the weeds on the flower
+borders, and then rake them neatly over, and promised if they worked
+well he would give them eight-pence per day.
+
+Now this was much pleasanter than picking stones in the field, but
+Charles was very sad, and could not refrain from shedding tears when
+he thought of the time when he used to play in that very garden, and
+he thought, too, of his dear mamma who was dead, and of his sister
+Clara, whom he had not seen for so many months, but he worked as hard
+as he could, and the gardener praised them both, and he gave them a
+basket to put the weeds in, and showed them how to rake the borders
+smooth.
+
+Just as they had finished the job, and Charles was saying to Giles,
+"How neat our work looks!" a little boy, dressed very fine, came into
+the garden, and, as he passed them, said: "I am glad I am a
+gentleman's son, and not obliged to work like these dirty boys."
+
+When Charles thought the little boy was out of hearing, he said to
+Giles: "That little boy is as wicked as I used to be, and I doubt not
+but that God will punish him in the same way if he does not mend his
+manners."
+
+The little boy, who had overheard what Charles said, was very angry,
+and made ugly faces, and ran into the newly-raked beds, and covered
+them with footmarks. Then Charles said: "I am sorry for you, young
+gentleman, for I see you are not good."
+
+"How dare you say I am not good?" said this naughty child. "I am a
+great deal better than you, for I am a gentleman, and you are only a
+poor boy."
+
+"Yes," said Charles, his eyes filling with tears as he spoke, "I am,
+indeed, only a poor boy _now_, but I was once rich like you, and lived
+in this very house, and wore fine clothes, and had plenty of toys and
+money, and was just as proud and naughty as you are, but God, to
+punish me, took away my parents and all those things that I had been
+so proud of, and that I had made such a bad use of, and reduced me to
+a poor boy, as you see."
+
+When the little boy heard this he looked very serious, and said: "I
+have been very naughty, but I will do so no more," and he went into
+the house, and never teased Charles or Giles again.
+
+A few months after this, when Charles and Giles were working as usual
+in the garden, they saw a gentleman come down one of the walks,
+leading by the hand a little girl dressed in a black silk frock and
+bonnet trimmed with crape.
+
+"Ah, Giles," said Charles, "how like that young lady is to my sister
+Clara. I wonder whether I shall ever see my dear sister Clara again."
+
+"Brother Charles, dear brother Charles, you have not then quite
+forgotten your sister Clara," said the little girl, throwing her arms
+round his neck as she spoke.
+
+When Charles saw that it was, indeed, his own dear sister Clara, he
+kissed her and cried with joy.
+
+Then he told Clara all that had happened to him since the day they had
+parted, and how sorry he had been for all his past conduct, and he
+asked her who the gentleman was that had brought her into the garden.
+
+"It is our uncle, dear Charles. You know our dear mother had a brother
+who lived in India that she used frequently to talk about. Well, when
+he came home, and heard that mother was dead, and we were in distress,
+he came to nurse's cottage, and took me home to his house, and has
+now come to find you, for he is very good and kind, and loves us both
+for our dear mother's sake."
+
+"And will he take me home too?" said Charles.
+
+"Yes, my boy," said Charles's uncle, taking him by the hand, "because
+you are good and kind, and are no longer cross and proud, as I heard
+you used to be. You shall come home with me this very day, if you
+please, and I will teach you everything that a young gentleman should
+know, and you and Clara shall be my children so long as you continue
+to be deserving of my love, and are not unkind, nor despise those who
+are beneath you in situation."
+
+"Indeed, uncle," said Charles, "I can now feel for the poor, and I
+would rather remain as I am than be rich if I thought I should ever
+behave as I used to do."
+
+"My dear child," said his uncle, kissing him with great affection,
+"continue to think so, and you will never act amiss. The first and
+greatest step toward amendment is acknowledging our faults. What is
+passed shall be remembered no more, and I doubt not but that we shall
+all be happy for the time to come."
+
+"But uncle," said Charles, laying his hand on his uncle's arm, "I have
+something to ask of you."
+
+"Well, Charles, and what would you have of me?" said his uncle.
+
+Then Charles led Giles to his uncle, and related all he had done for
+him; how he had taken him to his own home, and given him half of his
+food and his bed, and taught him to read and to work; he, likewise,
+told his uncle how ill he had behaved to Giles in depriving him of his
+pretty Snowball, and he said: "Dear uncle, will you allow Giles to
+share my good fortune, for I cannot be happy while he is in want, and
+he is better than me, for he returned good for evil."
+
+Then his uncle said: "Charles, I should not have loved you had you
+forgotten your kind friend." And he asked Giles if he would like to go
+to his house and live with him, and spend his time in learning to read
+and write, and in improving his mind, instead of hard labor.
+
+"I should like it very much indeed, sir," said Giles, "but I cannot
+accept your kind offer."
+
+"And why not, my good little friend?"
+
+"Because, sir," said Giles, bursting into tears, "my poor mother and
+sisters must go to the workhouse or starve if I did not stay and work
+for them, and I could not be happy if I lived in a fine house, and
+knew they were in want of a bit of bread to eat."
+
+"Then," said the gentleman smiling, "for your sake they shall never
+want anything, for I will put them into a cottage of my own, and will
+take care of them, and you shall live with me, and I will love you as
+if you were my own child, and remember, Giles, I do this as a reward
+for your kindness to Charles when he was unhappy and in great
+distress."
+
+Charles's uncle was as good as his word, and Giles received the
+blessings of a good education, while his mother and sisters were
+maintained by the benevolence of his benefactor.
+
+Charles was so careful not to relapse into his former errors that he
+became as remarkable for his gentleness and the goodness of his heart
+as he had formerly been for his pride and unkindness, and in the
+diligent performance of his duty, both to God and man, he proved to
+his uncle the sincerity of his amendment.
+
+
+
+
+TRIAL
+
+_Of a Complaint made against Sundry Persons for Breaking in the
+Windows of Dorothy Careful, Widow and Dealer in Gingerbread_
+
+By JOHN AIKIN AND MRS. BARBAULD
+
+
+The court being sat, there appeared in person the widow Dorothy
+Careful to make a complaint against Henry Luckless, and other person
+or persons unknown, for breaking three panes of glass, value
+ninepence, in the house of the said widow. Being directed to tell her
+case to the court, she made a curtsey and began as follows:
+
+"Please, your lordship, I was sitting at work by my fireside between
+the hours of six and seven in the evening, just as it was growing
+dusk, and little Jack was spinning beside me, when all at once crack
+went the window, and down fell a little basket of cakes that was set
+up against it. I started up and cried to Jack: 'Bless me, what's the
+matter?' 'So,' says Jack, 'sombody has thrown a stone and broke the
+window, and I dare say it is some of the schoolboys.' With that I ran
+out of the house, and saw some boys making off as fast as they could
+go. So I ran after them as quick as my old legs would carry me, but I
+should never have come near them if one had not happened to fall down.
+Him I caught and brought back to my house, when Jack knew him at once
+to be Master Henry Luckless. So I told him I would complain of him the
+next day, and I hope your worship will make him pay the damage, and I
+think he deserves a good whipping into the bargain for injuring a poor
+widow woman."
+
+The Judge, having heard Mrs. Careful's story, desired her to sit down,
+and then calling up Master Luckless, asked him what he had to say for
+himself. Luckless appeared with his face a good deal scratched, and
+looking very ruefully. After making his bow and sobbing two or three
+times, he said:
+
+"My lord, I am as innocent of this matter as any boy in the school,
+and I am sure I have suffered enough about it already. My lord, Billy
+Thompson and I were playing in the lane near Mrs. Careful's house when
+we heard the window crash, and directly after she came running out
+towards us. Upon this Billy ran away, and I ran too, thinking I might
+bear the blame. But after running a little way I stumbled over
+something that lay in the road, and before I could get up again she
+overtook me, and caught me by the hair, and began lugging and cuffing
+me. I told her it was not I that broke her window, but it did not
+signify; so she dragged me to the light, lugging and scratching me all
+the while, and then said she would inform against me. And that is all
+I know of the matter."
+
+"I find, good woman," said the Judge, "you were willing to revenge
+yourself without waiting for the justice of this court."
+
+"My lord, I must confess I was put into a passion, and did not
+properly consider what I was doing."
+
+"Well, where is Billy Thompson?"
+
+"Here, my lord."
+
+"You have heard what Henry Luckless says. Declare upon your honor
+whether he has spoken the truth."
+
+"My lord," said Billy, "I am sure neither he nor I had any concern in
+breaking the window. We were standing together at the time, and I ran
+on hearing the door open, for fear of being charged with it, and he
+followed; but what became of him I did not stay to see."
+
+"So you let your friend," the Judge remarked, "shift for himself, and
+thought only of saving yourself. But did you see any other person
+about the house or in the lane?"
+
+"My lord, I thought I heard some one creeping along the other side of
+the hedge a little before the window was broken, but I saw nobody."
+
+"You hear, good woman, what is alleged in behalf of the person you
+have accused. Have you any other evidence against him?"
+
+"One might be sure," the widow replied, "they would deny it, and tell
+lies for one another; but I hope I am not to be put off in that
+manner."
+
+"I must tell you, mistress, that you give too much liberty to your
+tongue, and are as guilty of as much injustice as that of which you
+complain. I should be sorry indeed if the young gentlemen of this
+school deserved the general character of liars. You will find among
+us, I hope, as just a sense of what is right and honorable as among
+those who are older, and our worthy master would certainly not permit
+us to try offences in this manner if he thought us capable of bearing
+false witness in each other's favor."
+
+"I ask your lordship's pardon; I did not mean to offend; but it is a
+heavy loss for a poor woman, and though I did not catch the boy in the
+act, he was the nearest when it was done."
+
+"As that is no more than a suspicion, and he has the positive evidence
+of his schoolfellow in his favor, it will be impossible to convict him
+consistently with the rules of justice. Have you discovered any other
+circumstance that may point out the offender?"
+
+"My lord, next morning Jack found on the floor this top, which I
+suppose the window was broke with."
+
+"Hand it up. Here, gentlemen of the jury, please to examine it, and
+see if you can discover anything of its owner."
+
+"Here is 'P.R.' cut upon it."
+
+"Yes," said another boy, "I am sure I remember Peter Riot having just
+such a one."
+
+"So do I," still another remarked.
+
+"Master Riot, is this your top?"
+
+"I don't know, my lord," said Riot; "perhaps it may be mine. I have
+had a great many tops, and when I have done with them I throw them
+away, and any body may pick them up that pleases. You see, it has lost
+its peg."
+
+"Very well, sir. Mrs. Careful, you may retire."
+
+"And must I have no amends, my lord?"
+
+"Have patience; leave everything to the court. We shall do you all the
+justice in our power."
+
+As soon as the widow was gone the Judge rose from his seat, and with
+much solemnity thus addressed the assembly:
+
+"Gentlemen, this business, I confess, gives me much dissatisfaction. A
+poor woman has been insulted and injured in her property, apparently
+without provocation, and although she has not been able to convict the
+offender, it cannot be doubted that she, as well as the world in
+general, will impute the crime to some of our society. Though I am in
+my own mind convinced that in her passion she charged an innocent
+person, yet the circumstance of the top is a strong suspicion--indeed,
+almost a proof--that the perpetrator of this unmanly mischief was one
+of our body.
+
+"The owner of the top has justly observed that its having been his
+property is no certain proof against him.
+
+"Since, therefore, in the present defect of evidence the whole school
+must remain burdened with both the discredit of this action and share
+in the guilt of it, I think fit, in the first place, to decree that
+restitution shall be made to the sufferer out of the public chest,
+and, next, that a Court of Inquiry be instituted for the express
+purpose of searching thoroughly into the affair, with the power to
+examine all persons upon honor who are thought likely to be able to
+throw light upon it. I hope, gentlemen, these measures meet with your
+concurrence."
+
+The whole court bowed to the Judge, and expressed their entire
+satisfaction with his determination.
+
+It was then ordered that the Public Treasurer should go to the Widow
+Careful's house, and pay her a sum of one shilling, making at the same
+time a handsome apology in the name of the school; and six persons
+were taken by lot of the jury to compose the Court of Inquiry, which
+was to sit in the evening.
+
+The Court then adjourned.
+
+On the meeting of the Court of Inquiry the first thing proposed by the
+President was that the persons who usually played with Master Riot
+should be sent for. Accordingly Tom Frisk and Bob Loiter were
+summoned, when the President asked them upon their honor if they knew
+the top to have been Riot's.
+
+They said they did. They were then asked if they remembered when Riot
+had it in his possession.
+
+"He had it," said Frisk, "the day before yesterday, and split a top of
+mine with it."
+
+"Yes," said Loiter, "and then as he was making a stroke at mine the
+peg flew out."
+
+"What did he do with it?"
+
+"He put it into his pocket, and said as it was a strong top he would
+have it mended."
+
+"Then he did not throw it away, or give it to any one?"
+
+"Yes; a day or two before he went to the Widow Careful's shop for some
+gingerbread; but as he already owed her sixpence, she would not let
+him have any till he had paid his debts."
+
+"How did he take the disappointment?"
+
+"He said he would be revenged on her."
+
+"Are you sure he used such words?"
+
+"Yes. Loiter heard him as well as myself."
+
+"I did, sir," said Loiter.
+
+"Do either of you know any more of this affair?"
+
+"No, sir," replied both boys together.
+
+"You may go," said the President, adding "that these witnesses had
+done a good deal in establishing proof against Riot; for it was pretty
+certain that no one but himself could have been in possession of the
+top at the time the crime was committed, and it also appeared that he
+had declared a malicious intention against the woman, which it was
+highly probable he would put into execution. As the court were
+debating about the next step to be taken they were acquainted that
+Jack, the widow's son, was waiting at the school-door for admission;
+and a person being sent out for him, Riot was found threatening the
+boy, and bidding him go home about his business. The boy, however, was
+conveyed safely into the room, when he thus addressed himself to the
+President:
+
+"Sir, and please your worship," said Jack, "as I was looking about
+this morning for sticks in the hedge over against our house, I found
+this buckle. So I thought to myself, 'Sure this must belong to the
+rascal that broke our window.' So I have brought it to see if any one
+in the school would own it."
+
+"On which side of the hedge did you find it?"
+
+"On the other side from our house, in the close."
+
+"Let us see it Gentlemen," said the President, "this is so smart a
+buckle that I am sure I remember it at once, and I dare say you all
+do."
+
+"It is Riot's!" exclaimed all together.
+
+"Has anybody observed Riot's shoes to-day?" the President asked.
+
+"Yes; he has got them tied with strings," a boy replied.
+
+"Very well, then, gentlemen, we have nothing more to do than to draw
+up the evidence we have heard, and lay it before his lordship. Jack,
+you may go home."
+
+"Pray, sir, let somebody go with me, for I am afraid of Riot, who has
+just been threatening me at the door."
+
+"Master Bold will please to go along with the boy."
+
+The minutes of the court were then drawn up, and the President took
+them to the Judge's chamber. After the Judge had perused them, he
+ordered an indictment to be drawn up against Peter Riot: "For that he
+meanly and clandestinely and with malice aforethought had broken three
+panes in the window of Widow Careful with a certain instrument called
+a top, whereby he had committed an atrocious injury upon an innocent
+person, and had brought a disgrace upon the society to which he
+belonged."
+
+At the same time he sent an officer to inform Master Riot that his
+trial would come on the next morning.
+
+Riot, who was with some of his gay companions, affected to treat the
+matter with great indifference, and even to make a jest of it.
+However, in the morning he thought it best to endeavor to make it up,
+and accordingly, when the court was assembled, he sent one of his
+friends with a shilling, saying that he would not trouble them with
+further inquiries, but would pay the sum that had been issued out of
+the public stock. On the receipt of this message the Judge rose with
+much severity in his countenance, and observing that by such
+contemptuous behavior towards the court the criminal had greatly added
+to his offence, he ordered two officers with their staves immediately
+to go and bring in Riot, and to use force if he should resist them.
+
+The culprit, thinking it best to submit, was presently led in between
+the two officers, when, being placed at the bar, the Judge then
+addressed him: "I am sorry, sir, that any member of this society can
+be so little sensible of the nature of a crime and so little
+acquainted with the principles of a court of justice as you have shown
+yourself to be by the proposal you took the improper liberty of
+sending us. If you mean it as a confession of your guilt, you
+certainly ought to have waited to receive from us the penalty we
+thought proper to inflict, and not to have imagined that an offer of
+the mere payment of damages would satisfy the claims of justice
+against you. If you had only broken the window by accident, and on
+your own accord offered restitution, nothing less than the full
+damages could have been accepted; but you now stand charged with
+having done this mischief meanly, secretly, and maliciously, and
+thereby have added a great deal of criminal intention to the act. Can
+you, then, think that a court like this, designed to watch over the
+morals, as well as protect the property of our community, can so
+slightly pass over such aggravated offences? You can claim no merit
+from confessing the crime now that you know so much evidence will
+appear against you. And if you choose still to plead not guilty, you
+are at liberty to do it, and we will proceed immediately to the trial
+without taking any advantage of the confession implied by your offer
+of payment."
+
+Riot stood silent for some time, and then begged to be allowed to
+consult with his friends what was the best for him to do. This was
+agreed to, and he was permitted to retire, though under guard of an
+officer. After a short absence he returned with more humility in his
+looks, and said that he pleaded guilty, and threw himself on the mercy
+of the court. The Judge then made a speech of some length, for the
+purpose of convincing the prisoner, as well as the bystanders, of the
+enormity of his crime. He then pronounced the following sentence:
+
+"You, Peter Riot, are hereby sentenced to pay to the public treasury
+the sum of half a crown as a satisfaction for this mischief you have
+done, and your attempt to conceal it.
+
+"You are to repair to the house of Widow Careful, accompanied by such
+witnesses as we shall appoint, and then, having first paid her the
+sum you owe her, you shall ask her pardon for the insult you offered
+her. You shall likewise to-morrow after school stand up in your place
+and before all the scholars ask pardon for the disgrace you have been
+the means of bringing upon the society, and in particular you shall
+apologize to Master Luckless for the disagreeable circumstances you
+were the means of bringing him into. Till after this is complied with
+you shall not presume to come into the playground or join in any of
+the diversions of the school, and all persons are hereby admonished
+not to keep you company till this is done."
+
+Riot was then dismissed to his room, and in the afternoon he was taken
+to the widow, who was pleased to receive his submission graciously,
+and at the same time to apologize for her own improper treatment of
+Master Luckless, to whom she sent a present of a nice ball by way of
+amends.
+
+Thus ended this important business.
+
+
+
+
+A PLOT OF GUNPOWDER:
+AN OLD LADY SEIZED FOR A GUY
+
+Ascribed to WILLIAM MARTIN ("PETER PARLEY")
+
+
+Gunpowder! Yes, it is a dreadful thing, and many a little boy has lost
+his eyesight by it. Next to playing with fire, I do not know anything
+so bad as playing with gunpowder.
+
+Every one knows of the fifth of November, the day set apart for
+commemorating the deliverance of King James and his Parliament from
+the horrible plot to blow them up with gunpowder, and how on that day
+Guido Fawkes, who was to have put the plan in execution, has his
+effigy paraded about.
+
+Well, it was on the fifth of November, in the year 1789, when Peter
+Parley was a boy, that the circumstances took place of which I am
+going to give a relation. The boys of those days, I think, were more
+fond of Guy Fawkes, and bonfires, and squibs, and crackers than they
+are now.
+
+I remember it was the first of November, early in the morning, that a
+lad, who was on a visit to my father, and who was my second cousin,
+got out of bed and said to me (for we both slept in one room):
+
+"Peter," said he, "do you have a guy in this town? I had a famous one
+last year, and such a bonfire as you never saw, for we burnt down a
+haystack. I should like to have a guy this year; do let us make one."
+
+I was only about twelve years old, and very fond of a bit of fun, and
+so I said:
+
+"That is a good idea. I was thinking of the same thing last night,
+because the clerk gave out in the church that there would be prayers
+on the fifth of November, on account of the Gunpowder Plot; and, as I
+came out of the church porch I saw a very old woman sitting there. She
+looked just like an old witch, and I said to myself, 'I should like to
+seize her for a guy.'"
+
+"Seize an old woman for a guy! Well, that would be the drollest thing
+that ever happened," said he; "and I should like to go you halves.
+Shall we go partners in it? We can easily get a chair and tie her down
+in it, and get a dark lantern and some matches and all that."
+
+"But she must be dressed like a man," said I; "there never was a
+female Guy Fawkes. The people would laugh at us."
+
+"So much the better," said he; "that is just what we want. I like
+something original, out of the common way. Now, a female Guy Fawkes is
+a thing that few persons ever saw, or even heard of."
+
+"But shall we not be taken up," said I, "perhaps put in prison, and
+get ourselves into a hobble?"
+
+"Well, what if we do? But we shall not do that. I am sure it is all
+right enough. But, however, to be quite certain, if you like we will
+ask Ephraim Quidd. You know, his father is a lawyer, and he will tell
+us in a minute. So when we go to school we will ask him, shall we?"
+
+"With all my heart," said I. And so with that we began to dress
+ourselves, and went downstairs to breakfast. I was so full of the
+matter that I sat and thought of it all the time I was eating my food;
+and at last my imagination painted the old woman sitting in a chair,
+calling out, "I am no guy! I am no guy!" the mob laughing, and the
+boys hurrahing so vividly that I burst into a fit of laughter myself.
+
+"Why, Peter," said my father, "'what is the matter now?"
+
+Instead of telling him I continued to laugh, till at last he grew very
+angry with me, and ordered me from the breakfast-table. I then took my
+hat and bag, and went off to school. Simon Sapskull--for that was my
+cousin's name--soon followed me.
+
+When he came up with me he said:
+
+"I thought what you were laughing at. It will be good fun. Let us make
+haste and see Quidd before he goes in. It will be good fun, won't
+it?"
+
+And here Master Simon jumped and capered about with delight.
+
+When we came to the schoolyard there were several boys assembled and
+Quidd among them. Simon immediately ran up to him.
+
+"Quidd," said he, "I want to ask you a question. You know the law, do
+you not? Your father is the town clerk, and you ought."
+
+"I do know the law," said Quidd. "Have I not been bred to it? And is
+not my father to be made Recorder next year?"
+
+"Well, then, answer me this," said Simon. "Is there any law against
+_seizing an old woman for a guy_?"
+
+The next morning Sapskull and myself, with Thomas Hardy and half a
+dozen other boys, met with a view to talk about the intended exploit.
+We withdrew to the backyard of the schoolroom, and there, in a corner
+where we thought we could not be overheard, we began to plot against
+the liberty of Dame Clackett.
+
+Hardy was one of the rarest boys for making fireworks I ever knew in
+my life. He had bought a book called "Every Boy his own Squib-Maker,"
+in which were directions for making squibs, crackers, rockets, Roman
+candles, serpents, slow fire, blue lights, and other descriptions of
+fireworks. This he nearly knew by heart. Sapskull said:
+
+"Look in your book and see if there is not in it how to make a guy."
+
+So Hardy looked all over the book, but to no purpose; there was no
+description of a guy manufactory. It was of no consequence; we had a
+guy in our head, and we only now wished to know how we should get hold
+of the old lady, and what we should do on this joyful occasion.
+
+Hardy said he had several pounds of gunpowder, and would sell us all
+squibs and crackers. But these we did not so much want. What we wanted
+was an old chair, an old jacket, hat, and other matters to dress up
+the old lady when we could catch her. But how to get her into the
+chair was the difficulty, and some proposed one thing and some
+another. Sapskull said, "We must make her merry with some beer."
+Hardy said, "We must tie her down." But I proposed to ask her to sit
+for her picture as a guy, and then to carry her off. Master Quidd was,
+however, more cunning than any of us, and said, "I know how to nab
+her; I have a plan, and a capital one it is, too."
+
+"What is it? what is it?" said all of us.
+
+The fact was old Dame Clackett was a very staunch churchwoman, and
+used always to go both on Wednesdays and Fridays, Rain or sunshine,
+hot or cold, nothing could keep her away from her church, and we silly
+boys laughed at her for it. Poor old creature! she felt more real
+pleasure in this than we could imagine.
+
+"I will tell you what we will do," said Quidd. "There is in our
+outhouse an old wheeled chair which my mother used to ride about in
+when she was so long ill, a year or two ago. Now, I know old Dame
+Clackett is very lame just now, from having let fall her fender on her
+foot. I will take this chair down, and offer to draw her to church in
+it, and then, when we have once got her in the chair, we can do as we
+like with her. Hurrah!"
+
+"Won't that be fun?" continued Quidd. "Let us do it--let us do it.
+There is no law against it; the thing was never thought of. It is just
+like the law that was never made among the Romans that I read about in
+my lessons yesterday: there was no law against a child killing his own
+father. I tell you," said he, "if there were twenty old women to be
+seized and burnt, nobody could be hurt for it. But you do not mean to
+burn her, I suppose, do you?"
+
+"Oh no," said we; "we only want to have some fun. We should like to
+make a guy of her, that is all, and rare fun it will be."
+
+"Let me join you," said one; "Let me join," said another, till at last
+the whole school entered into the plot.
+
+We all forgot what we should have remembered--namely, that, instead of
+despising or ridiculing people who are old and helpless and poor, we
+ought to treat them with kindness, respect, and consideration. We
+forgot that we, if suffered to live long enough, should also become
+old, and that it would be hard for us to bear the coldness and neglect
+of the world, but much harder to endure the ridicule and ill-behavior
+of wicked children. Ay, we were thoughtless lads, and so we suffered
+for it, as you will afterwards hear.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+The old lady whom I had seen sitting in the church porch, who was so
+ugly, as I thought, and so withered and old, was a very poor widow.
+Her husband had died in battle long ago, and she had from year to year
+supported herself by her spinning wheel and the little relief she had
+from the parish. She lived in a little hut on a piece of waste ground,
+and kept a little poultry, and now and then a pig or two.
+
+Among other animals, the old lady kept an enormous goat, or, rather,
+he kept himself. It was one her husband had brought her from abroad,
+of the Syrian breed. It was quite young when it came over, but at last
+grew and grew so, as to become a very formidable animal, so strong and
+fierce, that every dog was afraid of it, being, no doubt, terrified by
+the sight of its large horns and undaunted aspect. The name of this
+dread animal was Hannibal.
+
+Poor old Goody Clackett--for that was her name--had little thoughts of
+ever being "smugged," as it was termed, by our schoolfellows to make a
+guy on the fifth of November, and sat quietly enough spinning her
+wheel and drawing out her yarn. Sometimes the thrum of the old wheel
+would send her soundly to sleep, and then she never dreamed of such a
+thing as was to happen to her.
+
+Every boy was delighted with this proposition, and it was arranged
+that on the following evening I and my cousin Simon should assist in
+the endeavor to get the chair from the outhouse to a convenient place,
+while Hardy was to provide lantern, matches, cap, and feathers, with
+red and black paint to disfigure the features of the poor old
+creature.
+
+"We will make her amends," said Quidd, "all the money we get shall be
+hers."
+
+"Oh yes; that is quite fair," said I.
+
+When the evening came and it was quite dark, Simon and I went to the
+back part of Quidd's father's house. After waiting some little time we
+heard a knock. Presently Quidd opened the gates and came out.
+
+"There, get it," said he. "Look about to see if anybody is coming, and
+you can take it away."
+
+We did so. The coast was clear, and out rolled the chair.
+
+Simon and I took hold of it, one behind and one before at the
+handle-stick. Away we went, as had been preconcerted between us in the
+stable-yard of another schoolfellow of ours in the plot, who placed it
+near the gate and covered it over with loose straw, so that no one
+could see it.
+
+The next evening, which was the fourth of November, we met again by
+appointment at the dark hollow of the churchyard. This meeting was for
+the purpose of determining about the way in which Dame Clackett should
+be dressed in her triumphal entry to the Town Hall, the place where
+the bonfires were usually made. Hardy had brought what was of
+essential service--namely, an old coat which had formerly belonged to
+his father when in the yeomanry cavalry, an old helmet, a
+cartridge-box, and a pair of boots.
+
+"We shall never get the boots on," said I.
+
+Another boy brought an old lantern with the horn burnt out, a third a
+bunch of matches; then there was a mask and a lath-sword and a drum,
+with sticks and straw in abundance. They were all deposited in the
+same place with the chair. The conspirators (for conspirators we were)
+then made a promise to each other not to split, as they call it--that
+is, not to betray each other, and to go through with our work like
+_Britons;_ so we all shook hands and parted.
+
+The next morning was a holiday, and we were up betimes. After a
+consultation it was determined that I and Quidd should go to the old
+dame and see how she was, and if she was determined to go to church,
+and if there would be any difficulty to get her to accept of the
+convenience of our vehicle; so off we set. In less than half-an-hour
+we reached the old dame's cottage, and found her at that very moment
+dressing her foot.
+
+Quidd was the first who spoke.
+
+"Good morning, Goody," said he. "What, is not your foot well yet?
+Why, I hear you have not been to church lately. The curate was at
+father's last night, and said if you were so lame that you could not
+walk, you might have our easy four-wheeled chair. But I suppose you
+won't go to church to-day--it is only the fifth of November?"
+
+"Not go to church!" said the old woman--"not go to church! I have
+always gone on the fifth of November for forty years. My poor husband
+was in a French prison, and he knew well enough what the Jacobites
+are. Was he not blown up, poor fellow, in the 'Glorious?' and were not
+King James and all his people to have been blown up so high by the
+horrid Papist plot that I suppose they would not have been down by
+this time? No Popery, I say! I would sooner crawl to church on my
+hands and knees than not go to-day, young gentlemen. And then Mr.
+Hassock, the kind, good curate, to ask for me!"
+
+"Yes, and then there is the 'coal money' given on the fifth, that all
+the widows in the parish may have a good fire through the winter, you
+know, Goody."
+
+"Yes, I must go to church," said Mrs. Clackett.
+
+"That you must," said Quidd, "and I will tell you what these young
+gentlemen and I will do. We will bring down the chair, and take you
+there ourselves. I am sure it would please Mr. Hassock. Would it not,
+Parley?"
+
+"Yes, and the rector also," said I. "And I have no doubt but the
+churchwardens would like to see Goody at church, for the tickets for
+flannel petticoats are to be given away to-day."
+
+"What is that?" said Mrs. Clackett. "Oh, yes, I could not keep away
+from my church! Good young gentlemen, I shall never forget your
+kindness."
+
+We stopped to hear no more. We were overjoyed with the success of our
+plot. Away we ran to our companions, and, without stopping to explain,
+cried out:
+
+"The chair! the chair! We shall have a guy, the best in the whole
+country!"
+
+So away we ran with the chair, and all our other preparations for
+dressing and tying and securing.
+
+The whole party surrounded the chair, some pushing, some pulling.
+When, however, we got within a convenient distance of the old lady's
+hut, Hardy and the others stepped on one side, and placed the helmet,
+coat, lantern, matches, etc., under a hedge, to be ready when
+required, while Quidd, Sapskull, and myself went with the chair to the
+old lady's cottage.
+
+When we got there we found her spruce and prim with her best black
+silk bonnet, something in shape like a coal-scuttle, her stick in her
+hand, and her shoes on her feet. We drove up the chair in fine style.
+There were several cottages close by, and the neighbors came out to
+see the old lady ride. At last some one who knew Quidd said:
+
+"Why, that is the lawyer's son. Sure enough old Goody has got some
+money left her."
+
+So then there was a talking and surmising, and before Goody got to
+church it was reported all over the town that she was made the
+possessor of several thousand pounds prize-money; that she was to be a
+lady, and ride in her carriage. Being sent for, as it was supposed, by
+the lawyer must be for something--a large legacy, no doubt.
+
+The chair wheeled on with Goody in it. The boys looked as if they were
+up to something, and sure enough they were. When they came to that
+part of the lane at which the various habiliments had been left, the
+chair stopped, and out rushed the other conspirators.
+
+"Do not be alarmed, Goody," said Hardy. "We are only going to make a
+guy of you for an hour or two. No one shall harm you, and you shall
+have all the money we get."
+
+"I want to go to church--I want to go to church!" said the old lady,
+and tried to get out of the chair.
+
+Hardy, however, very dexterously threw some cord round the arms, and
+tied the poor old creature down.
+
+"We won't hurt you, Goody," said he. "We only want you for a guy. You
+shall have all the money."
+
+"I won't be a guy! I won't be a guy!" said Goody. "I do not want any
+money. Let me out! let me out!"
+
+She then made a blow with her broomstick, and struck Master Hardy on
+the nose, from which the blood flowed freely. This, however, only made
+him the more determined, and in a few minutes the poor old woman's
+arms were secured as well as her legs.
+
+"Oh, help, neighbors! They are going to burn me!" said the old lady,
+and then she fell coughing, for she had long suffered from asthma.
+
+While convulsed with this fit, the boys took the opportunity to
+besmear her face with red and black paint, and to place the helmet on
+her head, and the coat round her, so that the arms hung on each side
+with nothing on them. The chair was then crammed with straw, and the
+lantern and the matches suspended from it. In this state the chair was
+wheeled rapidly along in the direction of the town.
+
+Other boys soon joined, and surrounded the vehicle, shouting and
+laughing. The old lady, made several ineffectual attempts to get out
+of the chair. She called out, "A plot! a plot! a Popery plot! No
+Popery! Oh! I shall be killed!" and many such exclamations. The
+populace took this as a part of the character, and laughed most
+heartily. The greatest number of persons thought the guy to be a boy
+dressed up, and cried out that he acted his part well. No one
+suspected it was old Dame Clackett.
+
+Away they went in the midst of the hubbub, up one street and down
+another, over the market-place and by the church. Just as the clock
+struck twelve the boys of the Free School came from the latter place,
+and joined the procession. It was now a national affair, and, as it
+proceeded from the church doors, it was thought to be the church Guy
+Fawkes--and so it was.
+
+"Hurrah! hurrah!" shouted a hundred voices; and while Hardy and his
+companions held on the chair, Quidd and I went about with our hats to
+collect as much money as we could.
+
+The old lady was vociferous, and struggled to get out. She flung her
+arms about, and cried out, "Deliver me from the flames! Save me from
+being burnt!" and everybody thought that the part of guy was acted to
+perfection.
+
+Quidd and I got a great deal of money--silver, and copper, and even
+gold. Seven-shilling pieces were in circulation at that time, and the
+squire and Mr. Hassock passing us, one threw sixpence and the other a
+seven-shilling piece to us, for which we gave a louder cheer than
+usual. In short, our hats were very nearly half full of money.
+
+The old woman began to be more pacified as she saw the money coming
+in, particularly as we put it all into her lap, and told her it should
+be hers. But the sight of the squire and the curate, and the
+seven-shilling piece, which latter we put into her mouth, seemed quite
+to reconcile her to her fate. She became then as gentle as a lamb. She
+said:
+
+"Do as you like--do as you like, only don't burn me for a guy; and
+give me a drop of something to drink."
+
+"Oh yes," said Quidd, "here is something for you. Hold up your head."
+
+And half a pint of good strong ale soon found its way down the throat
+of the dame. After this the chair again moved on, till at last it came
+to the market-place, opposite the Town Hall, where an enormous bonfire
+was in preparation, over which stood a gallows.
+
+The old lady, when she saw the gallows, screamed "Murder! fire!
+brimstone!" and all sorts of horrid cries; but nobody took any heed of
+it, except to laugh. They thought it was in keeping with her
+character.
+
+"We will not hurt you, we will not hurt you," said I.
+
+But it was of no use; the old lady refused to be pacified.
+
+Just at this moment Quidd felt a severe blow from behind, which sent
+him sprawling. I also received a push or a drive, and a loud laugh
+burst from those around.
+
+When I turned to see what was the cause of the laughter, what should I
+observe but Hannibal, the goat, who had, it appeared, followed his
+mistress, and, being excited by her cries, dashed at my schoolfellow
+in the way described. Several of the spectators now tried to seize the
+goat, but he being of extraordinary strength, butted and pushed so
+vigorously that several measured their length upon the earth, to the
+no small merriment of the clownish persons who had collected together
+to the burning of the guy.
+
+During all this time Dame Clackett cried out loudly, and in the
+confusion her chair was upset, and she became liberated from her
+duress. As soon as she was free, she laid about on all sides of her
+with her stick, pulled off the helmet and jacket in which she had been
+nearly smothered, and cried out at the top of her voice:
+
+"I am no guy! I am Dame Clackett! For goodness' sake do not burn me
+for a witch!"
+
+She, however, kept her apron close in which the money was, and took
+care not to let the seven-shilling piece fall out of her mouth.
+
+The mob cheered. It would have been well if this had been all, but no:
+as soon as ever the old lady told her story that she had been seized
+for a guy, an effort was immediately made to secure the offenders. The
+constable, who happened to be present, laid hold of me and cousin
+Simon; several others were seized by the bystanders; and the whole,
+with the exception of Quidd, were dragged off to what in the country
+is called the goose-house--that is, the cage. Quidd, lawyer-like,
+contrived to get out of the scrape, leaving others in it. So we were
+all put into the cage, and bolted and barred. It was very dark, and as
+we were terribly frightened, we all began to howl most hideously.
+
+As to Quidd, he went homewards, as if nothing had happened, and soon
+made his reappearance, prepared for the usual squibbing and cracking,
+with his pockets full of squibs and crackers. He was so pleased with
+the success of the scheme in which he had been so forward an actor
+that he determined to have more fun before he went to bed; so he
+looked about, and it was not long before he saw a fit object, as he
+thought.
+
+At the corner of the street leading to the market-place sat poor old
+Hannah Grimly, as she was called. She had sold roasted chestnuts on
+the fifth of November for a score of years, and many a pinch of
+gunpowder had been put under the lid of the saucepan upon which the
+chestnuts were laid. Quidd determined to have a good explosion, and
+took the opportunity, while the chestnuts were being put into his
+hand, to introduce a packet of gunpowder into the kettle. He thought
+to run away before it should ignite, but there being a small hole in
+the paper, the moment it touched the fire the whole went off with a
+loud explosion. Quidd's hand was shattered to pieces, and he fell
+stunned with the effects of the powder. He was taken home senseless,
+and put to bed.
+
+The rest of the conspirators, including myself, were kept in the cage
+all night in bitter tears. The next morning we were taken before the
+magistrates. The chairman, who happened to be the very squire who had
+given us the seven-shilling piece, looked very severely at us, and
+said:
+
+"This is the most horrible plot I ever heard of--seizing an old woman
+for a guy! Gentlemen," said he to those around him, "if this be
+permitted none of us are safe."
+
+Some people used to call the magistrates old women, and so this raised
+a laugh.
+
+He then called to the clerk to look over the Act of Parliament to see
+what could be the punishment for such an offence, but found none.
+Quidd was right--there was no law against seizing an old woman for a
+guy. The bench were puzzled what to do. At last Quidd's father said we
+should be indicted for stealing his chair, and be put on our trial for
+robbery and sacrilege--the first for the abduction of the chair, the
+second for keeping the old lady _from church._
+
+Our fathers and mothers, however, pleaded so eloquently that, after a
+severe admonition, we got off upon payment of the costs and a handsome
+compensation to Dame Clackett. When I reached home my father took me
+into the stable and gave me a sound whipping, and at the conclusion of
+the flagellation said:
+
+"Now, Peter Parley, I think you will not again seize an old woman for
+a guy!"
+
+And I never did.
+
+
+
+
+UNCLE DAVID'S NONSENSICAL STORY ABOUT GIANTS AND FAIRIES
+
+By KATHERINE SINCLAIR
+
+
+In the days of yore children were not all such clever, good, sensible
+people as they are now. Lessons were then considered rather a plague,
+sugar-plums were still in demand, holidays continued yet in fashion,
+and toys were not then made to teach mathematics, nor storybooks to
+give instruction in chemistry and navigation. These were very strange
+times, and there existed at that period a very idle, greedy, naughty
+boy, such as we never hear of in the present day. His father and
+mother were--no matter who, and he lived--no matter where. His name
+was Master No-book, and he seemed to think his eyes were made for
+nothing but to stare out of the windows, and his mouth for no other
+purpose but to eat. This young gentleman hated lessons like mustard,
+both of which brought tears into his eyes, and during school hours he
+sat gazing at his books, pretending to be busy, while his mind
+wandered away to wish impatiently for dinner, and to consider where he
+could get the nicest pies, pastry, ices, and jellies, while he smacked
+his lips at the very thoughts of them.
+
+Whenever Master No-book spoke it was always to ask for something, and
+you might continually hear him say in a whining tone of voice:
+"Father, may I take this piece of cake?" "Aunt Sarah, will you give me
+an apple?" "Mother, do send me the whole of that plum-pudding."
+Indeed, very frequently, when he did not get permission to gormandize,
+this naughty glutton helped himself without leave. Even his dreams
+were like his waking hours, for he had often a horrible nightmare
+about lessons, thinking he was smothered with Greek lexicons or pelted
+out of the school with a shower of English grammars, while one night
+he fancied himself sitting down to devour an enormous plum-cake, and
+all on a sudden it became transformed into a Latin dictionary.
+
+One afternoon Master No-book, having played truant all day from
+school, was lolling on his mother's best sofa in the drawing-room,
+with his leather boots tucked up on the satin cushions, and nothing to
+do but to suck a few oranges, and nothing to think of but how much
+sugar to put upon them, when suddenly an event took place which filled
+him with astonishment.
+
+A sound of soft music stole into the room, becoming louder and louder
+the longer he listened, till at length, in a few moments afterwards, a
+large hole burst open in the wall of his room, and there stepped into
+his presence two magnificent fairies, just arrived from their castles
+in the air, to pay him a visit. They had traveled all the way on
+purpose to have some conversation with Master No-book, and immediately
+introduced themselves in a very ceremonious manner.
+
+The fairy Do-nothing was gorgeously dressed with a wreath of flaming
+gas round her head, a robe of gold tissue, a necklace of rubies, and a
+bouquet in her hand of glittering diamonds. Her cheeks were rouged to
+the very eyes, her teeth were set in gold, and her hair was of a most
+brilliant purple; in short, so fine and fashionable-looking a fairy
+never was seen in a drawing-room before. The fairy Teach-all, who
+followed next, was simply dressed in white muslin, with bunches of
+natural flowers in her light-brown hair, and she carried in her hand a
+few neat small volumes, which Master No-book looked at with a shudder
+of aversion.
+
+The two fairies now informed him that they very often invited large
+parties of children to spend some time at their palaces, but as they
+lived in quite an opposite direction, it was necessary for their young
+guests to choose which it would be best to visit first; therefore they
+had now come to inquire of Master No-book whom he thought it would be
+most agreeable to accompany on the present occasion.
+
+"In my house," said the fairy Teach-all, speaking with a very sweet
+smile and a soft, pleasing voice, "you shall be taught to find
+pleasure in every sort of exertion, for I delight in activity and
+diligence. My young friends rise at seven every morning, and amuse
+themselves with working in a beautiful garden of flowers, rearing
+whatever fruit they wish to eat, visiting among the poor, associating
+pleasantly together, studying the arts and sciences, and learning to
+know the world in which they live, and to fulfil the purposes for
+which they have been brought into it. In short, all our amusements
+tend to some useful object, either for our own improvement or the good
+of others, and you will grow wiser, better, and happier every day you
+remain in the palace of Knowledge."
+
+"But in Castle Needless, where I live," interrupted the fairy
+Do-nothing, rudely pushing her companion aside with an angry,
+contemptuous look, "we never think of exerting ourselves for anything.
+You may put your head in your pocket and your hands in your sides as
+long as you choose to stay. No one is ever asked a question, that he
+may be spared the trouble of answering. We lead the most fashionable
+life imaginable, for nobody speaks to anybody. Each of my visitors is
+quite an exclusive, and sits with his back to as many of the company
+as possible, in the most comfortable arm-chair that can be contrived.
+There, if you are only so good as to take the trouble of wishing for
+anything, it is yours without even turning an eye round to look where
+it comes from. Dresses are provided of the most magnificent kind,
+which go on themselves, without your having the smallest annoyance
+with either buttons or strings; games which you can play without an
+effort of thought; and dishes dressed by a French cook, smoking hot
+under your nose, from morning till night; while any rain we have is
+either made of lemonade or lavender-water, and in winter it generally
+snows iced punch for an hour during the forenoon."
+
+Nobody need be told which fairy Master No-book preferred, and quite
+charmed at his own good fortune in receiving so agreeable an
+invitation, he eagerly gave his hand to the splendid new acquaintance
+who promised him so much pleasure and ease, and gladly proceeded in a
+carriage lined with velvet, stuffed with downy pillows, and drawn by
+milk-white swans, to that magnificent residence, Castle Needless,
+which was lighted by a thousand windows during the day, and by a
+million of lamps every night.
+
+Here Master No-book enjoyed a constant holiday and a constant feast,
+while a beautiful lady covered with jewels was ready to tell him
+stories from morning till night, and servants waited to pick up his
+playthings if they fell, or to draw out his purse or his
+pocket-handkerchief when he wished to use them.
+
+Thus Master No-book lay dozing for hours and days on rich embroidered
+cushions, never stirring from his place, but admiring the view of
+trees covered with the richest burnt almonds, grottoes of sugar-candy,
+a _jet d'eau_ of champagne, a wide sea which tasted of sugar instead
+of salt, and a bright, clear pond, filled with gold fish that let
+themselves be caught whenever he pleased. Nothing could be more
+complete, and yet, very strange to say, Master No-book did not seem
+particularly happy. This appears exceedingly unreasonable, when so
+much trouble was taken to please him; but the truth is that every day
+he became more fretful and peevish. No sweetmeats were worth the
+trouble of eating, nothing was pleasant to play at, and in the end he
+wished it were possible to sleep all day, as well as all night.
+
+Not a hundred miles from the fairy Do-nothing's palace there lived a
+most cruel monster called the giant Snap-'em-up, who looked, when he
+stood up, like the tall steeple of a great church, raising his head so
+high that he could peep over the loftiest mountains, and was obliged
+to climb up a ladder to comb his own hair.
+
+Every morning regularly this prodigiously great giant walked round the
+world before breakfast for an appetite, after which he made tea in a
+large lake, used the sea as a slop-basin, and boiled his kettle on
+Mount Vesuvius. He lived in great style, and his dinners were most
+magnificent, consisting very often of an elephant roasted whole,
+ostrich patties, a tiger smothered in onions, stewed lions, and whale
+soup; but for a side-dish his greatest favorite consisted of little
+boys, as fat as possible, fried in crumbs of bread, with plenty of
+pepper and salt.
+
+No children were so well fed or in such good condition for eating as
+those in the fairy Do-nothing's garden, who was a very particular
+friend of the giant Snap-'em-up's, and who sometimes laughingly said
+she would give him a license, and call her own garden his "preserve,"
+because she always allowed him to help himself, whenever he pleased,
+to as many of her visitors as he chose, without taking the trouble to
+even count them; and in return for such extreme civility, the giant
+very frequently invited her to dinner.
+
+Snap-'em-up's favorite sport was to see how many brace of little boys
+he could bag in a morning; so, in passing along the streets, he peeped
+into all the drawing-rooms, without having occasion to get upon
+tiptoe, and picked up every young gentleman who was idly looking out
+of the windows, and even a few occasionally who were playing truant
+from school; but busy children seemed always somehow quite out of his
+reach.
+
+One day, when Master No-book felt even more lazy, more idle, and more
+miserable than ever, he lay beside a perfect mountain of toys and
+cakes, wondering what to wish for next, and hating the very sight of
+everything and everybody. At last he gave so loud a yawn of weariness
+and disgust that his jaw very nearly fell out of joint, and then he
+sighed so deeply that the giant Snap-'em-up heard the sound as he
+passed along the road after breakfast, and instantly stepped into the
+garden, with his glass at his eye, to see what was the matter.
+Immediately, on observing a large, fat, overgrown boy, as round as a
+dumpling, lying on a bed of roses, he gave a cry of delight, followed
+by a gigantic peal of laughter, which was heard three miles off, and
+picking up Master No-book between his finger and thumb, with a pinch
+that very nearly broke his ribs, he carried him rapidly towards his
+own castle, while the fairy Do-nothing laughingly shook her head as he
+passed, saying:
+
+"That little man does me great credit. He has only been fed for a
+week, and is as fat already as a prize ox. What a dainty morsel he
+will be! When do you dine to-day, in case I should have time to look
+in upon you?"
+
+On reaching home the giant immediately hung up Master No-book by the
+hair of his head, on a prodigious hook in the larder, having first
+taken some large lumps of nasty suet, forcing them down his throat to
+make him become still fatter, and then stirring the fire, that he
+might be almost melted with heat, to make his liver grow larger. On a
+shelf quite near Master No-book perceived the bodies of six other
+boys, whom he remembered to have seen fattening in the fairy
+Do-nothing's garden, while he recollected how some of them had
+rejoiced at the thoughts of leading a long, useless, idle life, with
+no one to please but themselves.
+
+The enormous cook now seized hold of Master No-book, brandishing her
+knife with an aspect of horrible determination, intending to kill him,
+while he took the trouble of screaming and kicking in the most
+desperate manner, when the giant turned gravely round, and said that,
+as pigs were considered a much greater dainty when whipped to death
+than killed in any other way, he meant to see whether children might
+not be improved by it also; therefore she might leave that great hog
+of a boy till he had time to try the experiment, especially as his own
+appetite would be improved by the exercise. This was a dreadful
+prospect for the unhappy prisoner, but meantime it prolonged his life
+a few hours, as he was immediately hung up in the larder and left to
+himself. There, in torture of mind and body, like a fish upon a hook,
+the wretched boy began at last to reflect seriously upon his former
+ways, and to consider what a happy home he might have had, if he could
+only have been satisfied with business and pleasure succeeding each
+other, like day and night, while lessons might have come in as a
+pleasant sauce to his play-hours, and his play-hours as a sauce to his
+lessons.
+
+In the midst of many reflections, which were all very sensible, though
+rather too late, Master No-book's attention became attracted by the
+sound of many voices laughing, talking, and singing, which caused him
+to turn his eyes in a new direction, when, for the first time, he
+observed that the fairy Teach-all's garden lay upon a beautiful
+sloping bank not far off. There a crowd of merry, noisy, rosy-cheeked
+boys were busily employed, and seemed happier than the day was long,
+while poor Master No-book watched them during his own miserable hours,
+envying the enjoyment with which they raked the flower-borders,
+gathered the fruit, carried baskets of vegetables to the poor, worked
+with carpenter's tools, drew pictures, shot with bows-and-arrows,
+played at cricket, and then sat in the sunny arbors learning their
+tasks, or talking agreeably together, till at length, a dinner-bell
+having been rung, the whole party sat merrily down with hearty
+appetites and cheerful good humor, to an entertainment of plain roast
+meat and pudding, where the fairy Teach-all presided herself, and
+helped her guests moderately to as much as was good for each.
+
+Large tears rolled down the cheeks of Master No-book while watching
+this scene, and remembering that if he had known what was best for
+him, he might have been as happy as the happiest of these excellent
+boys, instead of suffering ennui and weariness, as he had done at the
+fairy Do-nothing's, ending in a miserable death. But his attention was
+soon after most alarmingly roused by hearing the giant Snap-'em-up
+again in conversation with his cook, who said that, if he wished for a
+good large dish of scolloped children at dinner, it would be necessary
+to catch a few more, as those he had already provided would scarcely
+be a mouthful.
+
+As the giant kept very fashionable hours, and always waited dinner for
+himself till nine o'clock, there was still plenty of time; so, with a
+loud grumble about the trouble, he seized a large basket in his hand,
+and set off at a rapid pace towards the fairy Teach-all's garden. It
+was very seldom that Snap-'em-up ventured to think of foraging in this
+direction, as he never once succeeded in carrying off a single captive
+from the enclosure, it was so well fortified and so bravely defended;
+but on this occasion, being desperately hungry, he felt as bold as a
+lion, and walked, with outstretched hands, straight towards the fairy
+Teach-all's dinner-table, taking such prodigious strides that he
+seemed almost as if he would trample on himself.
+
+A cry of consternation arose the instant this tremendous giant
+appeared, and, as usual on such occasions, when he had made the same
+attempt before, a dreadful battle took place. Fifty active little boys
+bravely flew upon the enemy, armed with their dinner-knives, and
+looked like a nest of hornets, stinging him in every direction, till
+he roared with pain, and would have run away; but the fairy Teach-all,
+seeing his intention, rushed forward with the carving-knife, and
+brandishing it high over her head, she most courageously stabbed him
+to the heart.
+
+If a great mountain had fallen to the earth it would have seemed like
+nothing in comparison with the giant Snap-em-up, who crushed two or
+three houses to powder beneath him, and upset several fine monuments
+that were to have made people remembered for ever. But all this would
+have seemed scarcely worth mentioning had it not been for a still
+greater event which occurred on the occasion, no less than the death
+of the fairy Do-nothing, who had been indolently looking on at this
+great battle without taking the trouble to interfere, or even to care
+who was victorious; but being also lazy about running away, when the
+giant fell, his sword came with so violent a stroke on her head that
+she instantly expired.
+
+Thus, luckily for the whole world, the fairy Teach-all got possession
+of immense property, which she proceeded without delay to make the
+best use of in her power.
+
+In the first place, however, she lost no time in liberating Master
+No-book from his hook in the larder, and gave him a lecture on
+activity, moderation, and good conduct, which he never afterwards
+forgot; and it was astonishing to see the change that took place
+immediately in his whole thoughts and actions. From this very hour
+Master No-book became the most diligent, active, happy boy in the
+fairy Teach-all's garden; and on returning home a month afterwards, he
+astonished all the masters at school by his extraordinary reformation.
+The most difficult lessons were a pleasure to him, he scarcely ever
+stirred without a book in his hand, never lay on a sofa again, would
+scarcely even sit on a chair with a back to it, but preferred a
+three-legged stool, detested holidays, never thought any exertion a
+trouble, preferred climbing over the top of a hill to creeping round
+the bottom, always ate the plainest food in very small quantities,
+joined a temperance society, and never tasted a morsel till he had
+worked very hard and got an appetite.
+
+Not long after this an old uncle, who had formerly been ashamed of
+Master No-book's indolence and gluttony, became so pleased at the
+wonderful change that on his death he left him a magnificent estate,
+desiring that he should take his name; therefore, instead of being
+any longer one of the No-book family, he is now called Sir Timothy
+Blue-stocking, a pattern to the whole country around for the good he
+does to everyone, and especially for his extraordinary activity,
+appearing as if he could do twenty things at once. Though generally
+very good-natured and agreeable, Sir Timothy is occasionally observed
+in a violent passion, laying about him with his walking-stick in the
+most terrific manner, and beating little boys within an inch of their
+lives; but on inquiry it invariably appears that he has found them out
+to be lazy, idle, or greedy; for all the industrious boys in the
+parish are sent to get employment from him, while he assures them that
+they are far happier breaking stones on the road than if they were
+sitting idly in a drawing-room with nothing to do.
+
+
+
+
+THE INQUISITIVE GIRL
+
+
+Dr. Hammond was a physician in great practice in the West of England.
+He resided in a small market-town and his family consisted of one son,
+named Charles, and two daughters, Louisa and Sophy.
+
+Sophy possessed many amiable qualities, and did not want for sense,
+but every better feeling was lost in her extreme inquisitiveness. Her
+faculties were all occupied in peeping and prying about, and, provided
+she could gratify her own curiosity, she never cared how much vexation
+she caused to others.
+
+This propensity began when she was so very young that it had become a
+habit before her parents perceived it. She was a very little creature
+when she was once nearly squeezed to death between two double doors as
+she was peeping through the keyhole of one of them to see who was in
+the drawing-room; and another time she was locked up for several hours
+in a closet in which she had hid herself for the purpose of
+overhearing what her mother was saying to one of the servants.
+
+When Sophy was eleven and her sister about sixteen years old their
+mother died. Louisa was placed at the head of her father's house, and
+the superintendence of Sophy's education necessarily devolved on her.
+The care of such a family was a great charge for a young person of
+Miss Hammond's age, and more especially as her father was obliged to
+be so much from home that she could not always have his counsel and
+advice even when she most needed it. By this means she fell into an
+injudicious mode of treating her sister.
+
+If Louisa received a note she carefully locked it up, and never spoke
+of its contents before Sophy. If a message was brought to her she
+always went out of the room to receive it, and never suffered the
+servant to speak in her sister's hearing. When any visitors came
+Louisa commonly sent Sophy out of the room, or if they were intimate
+friends she would converse with them in whispers; in short, it was her
+chief study that everything which passed in the family should be a
+secret from Sophy. Alas! this procedure, instead of repressing Sophy's
+curiosity, only made it the more keen; her eyes and ears were always
+on the alert, and what she could not see, hear, or thoroughly
+comprehend she made out by guesses.
+
+The worst consequence of Louisa's conduct was that as Sophy had no
+friend and companion in her sister, who treated her with such constant
+suspicion and reserve, she necessarily was induced to find a friend
+and companion among the servants, and she selected the housemaid
+Sally, a good-natured, well-intentioned girl, but silly and ignorant
+and inquisitive like herself, and it may be easily supposed how much
+mischief these two foolish creatures occasioned, not only in the
+family, but also among their neighbors.
+
+It happened soon after, that for an offence which was the cause of
+very great vexation to her brother, and was the occasion of his being
+for a time deprived of the friendship of Sir Henry and Lady Askham,
+two of Dr. Hammond's nearest and most intimate neighbors, her father
+ordered Sophy, as a still further punishment, to be locked up in her
+own room till the Sunday following. This was on Friday, and Sophy had
+two days of solitude and imprisonment before her. The first day she
+passed very dismally, but yet not unprofitably, for she felt truly
+ashamed and sorry for her fault, and made many good resolutions of
+endeavoring to cure herself of her mischievous propensity. The second
+day she began to be somewhat more composed, and by degrees she was
+able to amuse herself with watching the people in the street, which
+was overlooked by the windows of her apartment, and she began, almost
+unconsciously to herself, to indulge in her old habit of trying to
+find out what everybody was doing, and in guessing where they were
+going.
+
+She had not long been engaged in watching her neighbors before her
+curiosity was excited by the appearance of a servant on horseback, who
+rode up to the door, and, after giving a little three-cornered note to
+Dr. Hammond's footman, rode off. The servant she knew to be Mrs.
+Arden's, an intimate friend of her father, and the note she
+conjectured was an invitation to dinner, and the guessing what day the
+invitation was for, and who were to be the company, and whether she
+was included in the invitation, was occupying her busy fancy, when she
+saw her sister going out of the house with the three-cornered note in
+her hand, and cross the street to Mr. McNeal's stocking shop, which
+was opposite. Almost immediately afterwards Mr. McNeal's shopman came
+out of the shop, and, running down the street, was presently out of
+sight, but soon returned with Mr. McNeal himself. She saw Louisa
+reading the note to Mr. McNeal, and in a few minutes afterwards return
+home. Here was a matter of wonder and conjecture. Sophy forgot all her
+good resolutions, and absolutely wearied herself with her useless
+curiosity.
+
+At length the term of her imprisonment was over, and Sophy was
+restored to the society of her family. At first she kept a tolerable
+guard over herself. Once she saw her father and sister whispering, and
+did not, though she longed much to do it, hold her breath that she
+might hear what they were saying. Another time she passed Charles's
+door when it was ajar and the little study open, and she had so much
+self-command that she passed by without peeping in, and she began to
+think she was cured of her faults. But in reality this was far from
+being the case, and whenever she recollected Mrs. Arden's mysterious
+note she felt her inquisitive propensities as strong as ever. Her eyes
+and ears were always on the alert, in hopes of obtaining some clue to
+the knowledge she coveted, and if Mrs, Arden's or Mr. McNeal's names
+were mentioned she listened with trembling anxiety in the hope of
+hearing some allusion to the note.
+
+At last, when she had almost given up the matter in despair, an
+unlooked-for chance put her in possession of a fragment of this very
+note to which she attached so much importance.
+
+One day Louisa wanted to wind a skein of silk, and in looking for a
+piece of paper to wind it upon she opened her writing-box, and took
+out Mrs. Arden's note. Sophy knew it again in an instant from its
+three-cornered shape. She saw her sister tear the note in two, throw
+one-half under the grate, and fold the other part up to wind her silk
+upon. Sophy kept her eye upon the paper that lay under the grate in
+the greatest anxiety, lest a coal should drop upon it and destroy it,
+when it seemed almost within her grasp. Louisa was called out of the
+room, and Sophy, overpowered by the greatness of the temptation,
+forgot all the good resolutions she had so lately made, and at the
+risk of setting fire to her sleeve, snatched the paper from among the
+ashes, and concealed it in her pocket. She then flew to her own room
+to examine it at her ease. The note had been torn the lengthway of the
+paper, and that part of it of which Sophy had possessed herself
+contained the first half of each line of the note. Bolting her door
+for fear of interruption, she read, with trembling impatience, as
+follows:
+
+ Will you
+ be kind enough to go to
+ Mr. McNeal, and tell him
+ he has made a great mistake
+ the last stockings he sent;
+ charging them as silk) he has cheated
+ of several pounds.--I am sorry to say
+ that he has behaved very ill
+ And Mr. Arden tells me that
+ it must end in his being hanged
+ I am exceedingly grieved
+ but fear this will be the end
+
+When Sophy had read these broken sentences she fancied that she fully
+comprehended the purport of the whole note, and she now saw the reason
+of her sister's hastening to Mr. McNeal's immediately on the receipt
+of the note, and of the hurry in which he had been summoned back to
+his shop. It appeared very clear to her that he had defrauded Mrs.
+Arden of a considerable sum of money, and that he was no longer that
+honest tradesman he had been supposed. The weight of this important
+discovery quite overburdened her, and, forgetful of her past
+punishment, and regardless of future consequences, she imparted the
+surprising secret to Sally. Sally was not one who could keep such a
+piece of news to herself; it was therefore soon circulated through
+half the town that Mr. McNeal had defrauded Mrs. Arden, and that Mr.
+Arden declared he would have him hanged for it. Several persons in
+consequence avoided Mr. McNeal's shop, who saw his customers forsaking
+him without being able to know why they did so. Thus the conduct of
+this inconsiderate girl took away the good name of an honest
+tradesman, on no better foundation than her own idle conjectures,
+drawn from the torn fragments of a letter.
+
+Mr. McNeal at length became informed of the injurious report that was
+circulated about him. He immediately went to Mrs. Arden to tell her of
+the report, and to ask her if any inadvertency of his own in regard to
+her dealings at his shop occasioned her speaking so disadvantageously
+of him. Mrs. Arden was much astonished at what he told her, as she
+might well be, and assured him that she had never either spoken of him
+or thought of him but as thoroughly an honorable and honest tradesman.
+Mrs. Arden was exceedingly hurt that her name should be attached to
+such a cruel calumny, and, on consulting with Sir Henry Askham, it was
+agreed that he and Mrs. Arden should make it their business to trace
+it back to its authors. They found no real difficulty in tracing it
+back to Sally, Dr. Hammond's servant. She was accordingly sent for to
+Mr. McNeal's, where Sir Henry Askham and Mr. Arden, with some other
+gentlemen, were assembled on this charitable investigation. Sally, on
+being questioned who had told her of the report, replied, without
+hesitation, that she had been told by Miss Sophy, who had seen all the
+particulars in Mrs. Arden's handwriting.
+
+Mr. Arden was greatly astonished at hearing this assertion, and felt
+confident that the whole must have originated from some strange
+blunder. He and the other gentlemen immediately proceeded to Dr.
+Hammond's, and having explained their business to him, desired to see
+Sophy. She, on being asked, confirmed what Sally had said, adding that
+to satisfy them she could show them Mrs. Arden's own words, and she
+accordingly produced the fragment of the note. Miss Hammond, the
+instant she saw the paper recollected it again, and winding off the
+silk from the other half of Mrs. Arden's note, presented it to Mr.
+Arden, who, laying the two pieces of paper together read as follows:
+
+ "MY DEAR MISS HAMMOND,--Will you as soon as you receive this
+ be kind enough to go to your opposite neighbor, Mr. McNeal,
+ and tell him I find by looking at his bill he has made a
+ great mistake as to the price of the last stockings he sent;
+ and it seems to me (by not charging them as silk) he has
+ cheated himself, as he'll see, of several pounds.--I am sorry
+ to say of our new dog, that he has behaved very ill and
+ worried two sheep, and Mr. Arden tells me he very much fears
+ it must end in his being hanged or he'll kill all the flock.
+ I am exceedingly grieved, for he is a noble animal, but fear
+ this will be the end of my poor dog.
+
+ "I am, dear Louisa, yours truly
+
+ "MARY ARDEN."
+
+Thus by the fortunate preservation of the last half of the note the
+whole affair was cleared up, Mrs. Arden's character vindicated from
+the charge of being a defamer, and Mr. McNeal from all suspicion of
+dishonesty. And all their friends were pleased and satisfied. But how
+did Sophy feel? She did feel at last both remorse and humiliation. She
+had no one to blame but herself; she had no one to take her part, for
+even her father and her brother considered it due to public justice
+that she should make a public acknowledgment of her fault to Mr.
+McNeal, and to ask his pardon.
+
+
+
+
+BUSY IDLENESS
+
+By JANE TAYLOR
+
+
+Mrs. Dawson being obliged to leave home for six weeks, her daughters,
+Charlotte and Caroline, received permission to employ the time of her
+absence as they pleased; that is, she did not require of them the
+usual strict attention to particular hours and particular studies, but
+allowed them to choose their own employments--only recommending them
+to make a good use of the license, and apprising them, that, on her
+return, she should require an exact account of the manner in which the
+interval had been employed.
+
+The carriage that conveyed their mother away was scarcely out of
+hearing, when Charlotte, delighted with her freedom, hastened upstairs
+to the schoolroom, where she looked around on books, globes, maps,
+drawings, to select some new employment for the morning. Long before
+she had decided upon any, her sister had quietly seated herself at her
+accustomed station, thinking that she could do nothing better than
+finish the French exercise she had begun the day before. Charlotte,
+however, declined attending to French that day, and after much
+indecision, and saying "I have a great mind to" three several times
+without finishing the sentence, she at last took down a volume of
+Cowper, and read in different parts for about half an hour. Then
+throwing it aside, she said she had a great mind to put the
+bookshelves in order--a business which she commenced with great
+spirit. But in the course of her laudable undertaking, she met with a
+manuscript in shorthand; whereupon she exclaimed to her sister,
+"Caroline, don't you remember that old Mr. Henderson once promised he
+would teach us shorthand? How much I should like to learn! Only, mamma
+thought we had not time. But now, this would be such a good
+opportunity. I am sure I could learn it well in six weeks; and how
+convenient it would be! One could take down sermons, or anything; and
+I could make Rachel learn, and then how very pleasant it would be to
+write to each other in shorthand! Indeed, it would be convenient in a
+hundred ways." So saying, she ran upstairs, without any further delay,
+and putting on her hat and spencer, set off to old Mr. Henderson's.
+
+Mr. Henderson happened to be at dinner. Nevertheless, Charlotte
+obtained admittance on the plea of urgent business; but she entered
+his apartment so much out of breath, and in such apparent agitation,
+that the old gentleman, rising hastily from table, and looking
+anxiously at her over his spectacles, inquired in a tremulous tone
+what was the matter. When, therefore, Charlotte explained her
+business, he appeared a little disconcerted; but having gently
+reproved her for her undue eagerness, he composedly resumed his knife
+and fork, though his hand shook much more than usual during the
+remainder of his meal. However, being very good-natured, as soon as he
+had dined he cheerfully gave Charlotte her first lesson in shorthand,
+promising to repeat it regularly every morning.
+
+Charlotte returned home in high glee. She at this juncture considered
+shorthand as one of the most useful, and decidedly the most
+interesting of acquirements; and she continued to exercise herself in
+it all the rest of the day. She was exceedingly pleased at being able
+already to write two or three words which neither her sister nor even
+her father could decipher. For three successive mornings Charlotte
+punctually kept her appointment with Mr. Henderson; but on the fourth
+she sent a shabby excuse to her kind master; and, if the truth must be
+told, he from that time saw no more of his scholar. Now the cause of
+this desertion was twofold: first, and principally, her zeal for
+shorthand, which for the last eight-and-forty hours had been sensibly
+declining in its temperature, was, on the above morning, within half a
+degree of freezing point; and, second, a new and far more arduous and
+important undertaking had by this time suggested itself to her mind.
+Like many young persons of desultory inclinations, Charlotte often
+amused herself with writing verses; and it now occurred to her that an
+abridged history of England in verse was still a desideratum in
+literature. She commenced this task with her usual diligence; but was
+somewhat discouraged in the outset by the difficulty of finding a
+rhyme to Saxon, whom she indulged the unpatriotic wish that the Danes
+had laid a tax on. But, though she got over this obstacle by a new
+construction of the line, she found these difficulties occur so
+continually that she soon felt a more thorough disgust at this
+employment than at the preceding one. So the epic stopped short, some
+hundred years before the Norman conquest. Difficulty, which quickens
+the ardor of industry, always damps, and generally extinguishes, the
+false zeal of caprice and versatility.
+
+Charlotte's next undertaking was, to be sure, a rapid descent from the
+last in the scale of dignity. She now thought, that, by working very
+hard during the remainder of the time, she should be able to
+accomplish a patch-work counterpane, large enough for her own little
+tent bed; and the ease of this employment formed a most agreeable
+contrast in her mind with the extreme difficulty of the last.
+Accordingly, as if commissioned with a search warrant, she ransacked
+all her mother's drawers, bags, and bundles in quest of new pieces;
+and these spoils proving very insufficient, she set off to tax all her
+friends, and to tease all the linen drapers in the town for their odds
+and ends, urging that she wanted some particularly. As she was posting
+along the street on this business, she espied at a distance a person
+whom she had no wish to encounter, namely, old Mr. Henderson. To avoid
+the meeting she crossed over. But this maneuver did not succeed; for
+no sooner had they come opposite to each other, than, to her great
+confusion, he called out across the street, in his loud and tremulous
+voice, and shaking his stick at her, "How d'ye do, Miss Shorthand? I
+thought how it would be! Oh, fie! Oh, fie!"
+
+Charlotte hurried on; and her thoughts soon returned to the idea of
+the splendid radiating star which she designed for the centerpiece of
+her counterpane. While she was arranging the different patterns, and
+forming the alternations of light and shade, her interest continued
+nearly unabated; but when she came to the practical part of sewing
+piece to piece with unvarying sameness, it began, as usual, to flag.
+She sighed several times, and cast many disconsolate looks at the
+endless hexagons and octagons, before she indulged any distinct idea
+of relinquishing her task. At length, however, it did forcibly occur
+to her that, after all, she was not obliged to go on with it; and
+that, really, patchwork was a thing that was better done by degrees,
+when one happens to want a job, than to be finished all at once. So,
+with this thought (which would have been a very good one if it had
+occurred in proper time), she suddenly drew out her needle, thrust all
+her pieces, arranged and unarranged, into a drawer, and began to
+meditate a new project.
+
+Fortunately, just at this juncture some young ladies of their
+acquaintance called upon Charlotte and Caroline. They were attempting
+to establish a society among their young friends for working for the
+poor, and came to request their assistance. Caroline very cheerfully
+entered into the design; but as for Charlotte, nothing could exceed
+the forwardness of her zeal. She took it up so warmly that Caroline's
+appeared, in comparison, only lukewarm. It was proposed that each
+member of the society should have an equal proportion of the work to
+do at her own house; but when the articles came to be distributed,
+Charlotte, in the heat of her benevolence, desired that a double
+portion might be allotted to her. Some of the younger ones admired her
+industrious intentions, but the better judging advised her not to
+undertake too much at once. However, she would not be satisfied till
+her request was complied with. When the parcels of work arrived,
+Charlotte with exultation seized the larger one, and without a
+minute's delay commenced her charitable labors. The following morning
+she rose at four o'clock, to resume the employment; and not a little
+self-complacency did she feel, when, after nearly two hours' hard
+work, she still heard Caroline breathing in a sound sleep. But, alas!
+Charlotte soon found that work is work, of whatever nature, or for
+whatever purpose. She now inwardly regretted that she had asked for
+more than her share; and the cowardly thought that after all she was
+not obliged to do it next occurred to her. For the present, therefore,
+she squeezed all the things, done and undone, into what she called
+her "Dorcas bag;" and to banish unpleasant thoughts, she opened the
+first book that happened to lie within reach. It proved to be "An
+Introduction to Botany." Of this she had not read more than a page and
+a half before she determined to collect some specimens herself; and
+having found a blank copy-book she hastened into the garden, where,
+gathering a few common flowers, she proceeded to dissect them, not, it
+is to be feared, with much scientific nicety. Perhaps as many as three
+pages of this copy-book were bespread with her specimens before she
+discovered that botany was a dry study.
+
+It would be too tedious to enumerate all the subsequent ephemeral
+undertakings which filled up the remainder of the six weeks. At the
+expiration of that time Mrs. Dawson returned. On the next morning
+after her arrival she reminded her daughters of the account she
+expected of their employments during her absence, and desired them to
+set out on two tables in the schoolroom everything they had done that
+could be exhibited, together with the books they had been reading.
+Charlotte would gladly have been excused her part of the exhibition;
+but this was not permitted; and she reluctantly followed her sister to
+make the preparation.
+
+When the two tables were spread, their mother was summoned to attend.
+Caroline's, which was first examined, contained, first, her various
+exercises in the different branches of study, regularly executed the
+same as usual. And there were papers placed in the books she was
+reading in school hours, to show how far she had proceeded in them.
+Besides these, she had read in her leisure time, in French, Florian's
+"Numa Pompilius," and in English, Mrs. More's "Practical Piety," and
+some part of Johnson's "Lives of the Poets." All the needlework which
+had been left to do or not, at her option, was neatly finished; and
+her parcel of linen for the poor was also completely and well done.
+The only instance in which Caroline had availed herself of her
+mother's license, was that she had prolonged her drawing lessons a
+little every day, in order to present her mother with a pretty pair of
+screens, with flowers copied from nature. These were, last of all,
+placed on the table with an affectionate note, requesting her
+acceptance of them.
+
+Mrs. Dawson, having carefully examined this table, proceeded to the
+other, which was quite piled up with different articles. Here, amid
+the heap, were Charlotte's three pages of shorthand; several scraps of
+paper containing fragments of her poetical history; the piece (not
+large enough for a doll's cradle) of her patchwork counterpane; her
+botanical specimens; together with the large unfinished pile out of
+the Dorcas bag, many of the articles of which were begun, but not one
+quite finished. There was a baby's cap with no border, a frock body
+without sleeves, and the skirt only half hemmed at the bottom; and
+slides, tapes, and buttonholes were all, without exception, omitted.
+After these, followed a great variety of thirds, halves, and quarters
+of undertakings, each perhaps good in itself, but quite useless in its
+unfinished state.
+
+The examination being at length ended, Mrs. Dawson retired, without a
+single comment, to her dressing-room; where, in about an hour
+afterwards, she summoned the girls to attend her. Here also were two
+tables laid out, with several articles on each. Their mother then
+leading Caroline to the first, told her that, as the reward of her
+industry and perseverance, the contents of the table were her own.
+Here, with joyful surprise, she beheld, first, a little gold watch,
+which Mrs. Dawson said she thought a suitable present for one who had
+made a good use of her time; a small telescope next appeared; and
+lastly, Paley's "Natural Theology," neatly bound. Charlotte was then
+desired to take possession of the contents of the other table, which
+were considerably more numerous. The first prize she drew out was a
+very beautiful French fan; but upon opening it, it stretched out in an
+oblong shape, for want of the pin to confine the sticks at bottom.
+Then followed a new parasol; but when unfurled there was no catch to
+confine it, so that it would not remain spread. A penknife handle
+without a blade, and the blade without the handle, next presented
+themselves to her astonished gaze. In great confusion she then
+unrolled a paper which discovered a telescope apparently like her
+sister's; but on applying it to her eye, she found it did not contain
+a single lens--so that it was no better than a roll of pasteboard. She
+was, however, greatly encouraged to discover that the last remaining
+article was a watch; for, as she heard it tick, she felt no doubt that
+this at least was complete; but upon examination she discovered that
+there was no hour hand, the minute hand alone pursuing its lonely and
+useless track.
+
+Charlotte, whose conscience had very soon explained to her the moral
+of all this, now turned from the tantalizing table in confusion, and
+burst into an agony of tears. Caroline wept also; and Mrs. Dawson,
+after an interval of silence, thus addressed her daughters:
+
+"It is quite needless for me to explain my reasons for making you such
+presents, Charlotte. I assure you your papa and I have had a very
+painful employment the past hour in spoiling them all for you. If I
+had found on your table in the schoolroom any one thing that had been
+properly finished, you would have received one complete present to
+answer it; but this you know was not the case. I should be very glad
+if this disappointment should teach you what I have hitherto vainly
+endeavored to impress upon you--that as all those things, pretty or
+useful as they are in themselves, are rendered totally useless for
+want of completeness, so exertion without perseverance is no better
+than busy idleness. That employment does not deserve the name of
+industry which requires the stimulus of novelty to keep it going.
+Those who will only work so long as they are amused will do no more
+good in the world, either to themselves or others, than those who
+refuse to work at all. If I had required you to pass the six weeks of
+my absence in bed or in counting your fingers, you would, I suppose,
+have thought it a sad waste of time; and yet I appeal to you whether
+(with the exception of an hour or two of needlework) the whole mass of
+articles on your table could produce anything more useful. And thus,
+my dears, may life be squandered away, in a succession of busy
+nothings.
+
+"I have now a proposal to make to you. These presents, which you are
+to take possession of as they are, I advise you to lay by carefully.
+Whenever you can show me anything that you have begun, and voluntarily
+finished, you may at the same time bring with you one of these things,
+beginning with those of least value, to which I will immediately add
+the part that is deficient. Thus, by degrees, you may have them all
+completed; and if by this means you should acquire the wise and
+virtuous habit of perseverance, it will be far more valuable to you
+than the richest present you could possibly receive."
+
+
+
+
+THE RENOWNED HISTORY OF LITTLE GOODY TWO-SHOES
+
+Ascribed to OLIVER GOLDSMITH
+
+
+
+
+INTRODUCTION
+
+
+All the world must allow that Two-Shoes was not her real name. No; her
+father's name was Meanwell; and he was for many years a considerable
+farmer in the parish where Margery was born; but by the misfortunes
+which he met with in business, and the wicked persecutions of Sir
+Timothy Gripe, and an overgrown farmer called Graspall, he was
+effectually ruined.
+
+The case was thus: The parish of Mould well, where they lived, had for
+many ages been let by the lord of the manor in twelve different farms,
+in which the tenants lived comfortably, brought up large families, and
+carefully supported the poor people who labored for them, until the
+estate by marriage and by death came into the hands of Sir Timothy.
+
+This, gentleman, who loved himself better than all his neighbors,
+thought it was less trouble to write one receipt for his rent than
+twelve; and Farmer Graspall offering to take all the farms as the
+leases expired, Sir Timothy agreed with him, and in process of time he
+was possessed of every farm but that occupied by little Margery's
+father, which he also wanted; for as Mr. Meanwell was a charitable,
+good man, he stood up for the poor at the parish meetings, and was
+unwilling to have them oppressed by Sir Timothy and this avaricious
+farmer. Judge, O kind, humane, and courteous reader, what a terrible
+situation the poor must be in, when this covetous man was perpetual
+overseer, and everything for their maintenance was drawn from his hard
+heart and cruel hand. But he was not only perpetual overseer, but
+perpetual churchwarden; and judge, O ye Christians, what state the
+church must be in, when supported by a man without religion or
+virtue. He was also perpetual surveyor of the highways, and what sort
+of roads he kept up for the convenience of travelers, those best knew
+who have had the misfortune to pass through that parish. Complaints
+indeed were made, but to what purpose are complaints, when brought
+against a man who can hunt, drink, and smoke, without the lord of the
+manor, who is also the justice of peace?
+
+The opposition which Little Margery's father made to this man's
+tyranny gave offense to Sir Timothy, who endeavored to force him out
+of his farm; and, to oblige him to throw up the lease, ordered both a
+brick-kiln and a dog kennel to be erected in the farmer's orchard.
+This was contrary to law, and a suit was commenced, in which Margery's
+father got the better. The same offense was again committed three
+different times, and as many actions brought, in all of which the
+farmer had a verdict, and costs paid him; but notwithstanding these
+advantages, the law was so expensive, that he was ruined in the
+contest, and obliged to give up all he had to his creditors; which
+effectually answered the purpose of Sir Timothy, who erected those
+nuisances in the farmer's orchard with that intention. Ah, my dear
+reader, we brag of liberty, and boast of our laws; but the blessings
+of the one, and the protection of the other, seldom fall to the lot of
+the poor; and especially when a rich man is their adversary. How, in
+the name-of goodness, can a poor wretch obtain redress, when thirty
+pounds are insufficient to try his cause? Where is he to find money to
+fee counsel, or how can he plead his cause himself (even if he was
+permitted) when our laws are so obscure and so multiplied that an
+abridgment of them cannot be contained in fifty volumes folio?
+
+As soon as Mr. Meanwell had called together his creditors, Sir Timothy
+seized for a year's rent, and turned the farmer, his wife, Little
+Margery, and her brother out of doors, without any of the necessaries
+of life to support them.
+
+This elated the heart of Mr. Graspall, this crowned his hopes, and
+filled the measure of his iniquity; for, besides gratifying his
+revenge, this man's overthrow gave him the sole dominion over the
+poor, whom he depressed and abused in a manner too horrible to
+mention.
+
+Margery's father flew into another parish for succor, and all those
+who were able to move left their dwellings and sought employment
+elsewhere, as they found it would be impossible to live under the
+tyranny of two such people. The very old, the very lame, and the blind
+were obliged to stay behind, and whether they were starved, or what
+became of them, history does not say; but the characters of the great
+Sir Timothy, and the avaricious tenant, were so infamous, that nobody
+would work for them by the day, and servants were afraid to engage
+themselves by the year, lest any unforseen accident should leave them
+parishioners in a place where they knew they must perish miserably; so
+that great part of the land lay untilled for some years, which was
+deemed a just reward for such diabolical proceedings.
+
+But what, says the reader, can occasion all this? do you intend this
+for children? Permit me to inform you, that this is not the book, sir,
+mentioned in the title, but an introduction to that book; and it is
+intended, sir, not for that sort of children, but for children of six
+feet high, of which, as my friend has justly observed, there are many
+millions in the kingdom; and these reflections, sir, have been
+rendered necessary by the unaccountable and diabolical scheme which
+many gentlemen now give in to, of laying a number of farms into one,
+and very often a whole parish into one farm; which in the end must
+reduce the common people to a stage of vassalage, worse than that
+under the barons of old, or of the clans in Scotland, and will in time
+depopulate the kingdom. But as you are tired of the subject, I shall
+take myself away, and you may visit Little Margery.
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+HOW AND ABOUT LITTLE MARGERY AND HER BROTHER
+
+
+Care and discontent shortened the days of Little Margery's father. He
+was forced from his family, and seized with a violent fever in a place
+where Dr. James's powder was not to be had, and where he died
+miserably. Margery's poor mother survived the loss of her husband but
+a few days, and died of a broken heart, leaving Margery and her little
+brother to the wide world; but, poor woman, it would have melted your
+heart to have seen how frequently she heaved her head, while she lay
+speechless, to survey with languishing looks her little orphans, as
+much as to say, "Do, Tommy, do, Margery, come with me." They cried,
+poor things, and she sighed away her soul; and I hope is happy.
+
+It would both have excited your pity, and have done your heart good,
+to have seen how these two little ones were so fond of each other, and
+how hand in hand they trotted about.
+
+They were both very ragged, and Tommy had no shoes, and Margery had
+but one. They had nothing, poor things, to support them (not being in
+their own parish) but what they picked from the hedges, or got from
+the poor people, and they lay every night in a barn. Their relations
+took no notice of them; no, they were rich, and ashamed to own such a
+poor little ragged girl as Margery, and such a dirty little
+curly-pated boy as Tommy. Our relations and friends seldom take notice
+of us when we are poor; but as we grow rich they grow fond. And this
+will always be the case, while people love money better than they do
+God Almighty. But such wicked folks who love nothing but money, and
+are proud and despise the poor, never come to any good in the end, as
+we shall see by and by.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+HOW AND ABOUT MR. SMITH
+
+
+Mr. Smith was a very worthy clergyman, who lived in the parish where
+Little Margery and Tommy were born; and having a relation come to see
+him, who was a charitable, good man, he sent for these children to
+come to him. The gentleman ordered Little Margery a new pair of shoes,
+gave Mr. Smith some money to buy her clothes, and said he would take
+Tommy and make him a little sailor.
+
+After some days the gentleman intended to go to London, and take
+little Tommy with him, of whom you will know more by and by, for we
+shall at a proper time present you with his history, his travels, and
+adventures.
+
+The parting between these little children was very affecting. Tommy
+cried, and they kissed each other an hundred times: at last Tommy thus
+wiped off her tears with the end of his jacket, and bid her cry no
+more, for that he would come to her again when he returned from sea.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+HOW LITTLE MARGERY OBTAINED THE NAME OF GOODY TWO-SHOES, AND WHAT
+HAPPENED IN THE PARISH
+
+
+As soon as Little Margery got up in the morning, which was very early,
+she ran all round the village, crying for her brother; and after some
+time returned greatly distressed.
+
+However, at this instant, the shoemaker very opportunely came in with
+the new shoes, for which she had been measured by the gentleman's
+order.
+
+Nothing could have supported Little Margery under the affliction she
+was in for the loss of her brother, but the pleasure she took in her
+two shoes. She ran out to Mrs. Smith as soon as they were put on, and
+stroking down her ragged apron thus cried out, "Two shoes, ma'am, see
+two shoes." And so she behaved to all the people she met, and by that
+means obtained the name of Goody Two-Shoes.
+
+Little Margery was very happy in being with Mr. and Mrs. Smith, who
+were very charitable and good to her, and had agreed to bring her up
+with their family: but as soon as that tyrant of the parish, that
+Graspall, heard of her being there, he applied first to Mr. Smith, and
+threatened to reduce his tithes if he kept her; and after that he
+spoke to Sir Timothy, who sent Mr. Smith a peremptory message by his
+servant, that he should send back Meanwell's girl to be kept by her
+relations, and not harbor her in the parish. This so distressed Mr.
+Smith, that he shed tears, and cried, "Lord, have mercy on the poor!"
+
+The prayers of the righteous fly upwards, and reach unto the throne of
+heaven, as will be seen by the sequel.
+
+Mrs. Smith was also greatly concerned at being thus obliged to
+discard poor Little Margery. She kissed her, and cried, as did also
+Mr. Smith; but they were obliged to send her away, for the people who
+had ruined her father could at any time have ruined them.
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+HOW LITTLE MARGERY LEARNED TO READ, AND BY DEGREES TAUGHT OTHERS
+
+
+Little Margery saw how good and how wise Mr. Smith was, and concluded
+that this was owing to his great learning, therefore she wanted of all
+things to learn to read. For this purpose she used to meet the little
+boys as they came from school, borrow their books, and sit down and
+read till they returned. By this means she got more learning than any
+of her playmates, and laid the following scheme for instructing those
+who were more ignorant than herself. She found that only the following
+letters were required to spell all the words; but as some of these
+letters are large, and some small, she with her knife cut out of
+several pieces of wood ten sets of each of these:
+
+a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z.
+
+And having got an old spelling book, she made her companions set up
+all the words they wanted to spell, and after that she taught them to
+compose sentences. "You know what a sentence is, my dear. 'I will be
+good' is a sentence; and is made up, as you see, of several words."
+
+I once went her rounds with her, and was highly diverted, as you may
+see, if you please to look into the next chapter.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+HOW LITTLE TWO-SHOES BECAME A TROTTING TUTORESS, AND HOW SHE TAUGHT
+HER YOUNG PUPILS
+
+
+It was about seven o'clock in the morning when we set out on this
+important business, and the first house we came to was Farmer
+Wilson's. Here Margery stopped, and ran up to the door, tap, tap, tap.
+"Who's there?" "Only Little Goody Two-Shoes," answered Margery, "come
+to teach Billy." "Oh! Little Goody," says Mrs. Wilson, with pleasure
+in her face, "I am glad to see you Billy wants you sadly for he has
+learned his lesson." Then out came the little boy. "How do, Doody
+Two-Shoes," says he, not able to speak plain. Yet this little boy had
+learned all his letters; for she threw down this alphabet mixed
+together thus:
+
+b d f h k m o q s u w y x f a c e g i l n p r t v z j,
+
+and he picked them up, called them by their right names, and put them
+all in order thus:
+
+a b c d e f g h i j k i m n o p q r s t u v w x y z.
+
+The next place we came to was Farmer Simpson's.
+
+"Bow, wow, wow," says the dog at the door. "Sirrah," says his
+mistress, "what do you bark at Little Two-Shoes? come in, Madge; here,
+Sally wants you sadly, she has learned all her lesson." "Yes, that's
+what I have," replied the little one, in the country manner: and
+immediately taking the letters she set up these syllables:
+
+ ba be bi bo bu, ca ce ci co cu,
+
+ da de di do du, fa fe fi fo fu,
+
+and gave them their exact sounds as she composed them.
+
+After this, Little Two-Shoes taught her to spell words of one
+syllable, and she soon set up pear, plumb, top, ball, pin, puss, dog,
+hog, fawn, buck, doe, lamb, sheep, ram, cow, bull, cock, hen, and many
+more.
+
+The next place we came to was Gaffer Cook's cottage. Here a number of
+poor children were met to learn, who all came round Little Margery at
+once, who having pulled out her letters, asked the little boy next her
+what he had for dinner? Who answered, "Bread" (the poor children in
+many places live very hard). "Well then," says she, "set up the first
+letter." He put up the B, to which the next added r, and the next e,
+the next a, the next d, and it stood thus, Bread.
+
+And what had you, Polly Comb, for your dinner? "Apple Pie," answered
+the little girl; upon which the next in turn set up a great A, the two
+next a p each, and so on, till the two words Apple and Pie were united
+and stood thus, Apple Pie.
+
+The next had potatoes, the next beef and turnips; which were spelled,
+with many others, till the game of spelling was finished. She then set
+them another task, and we proceeded.
+
+The next place we came to was Farmer Thomson's, where there was a
+great many little ones waiting for her.
+
+"So, Little Mrs. Goody Two-Shoes," says one of them, "where have you
+been so long?" "I have been teaching," says she, "longer than I
+intended, and am, I am afraid, come too soon for you now." "No, but
+indeed you are not," replied the other; "for I have got my lesson, and
+so has Sally Dawson, and so has Harry Wilson, and so have we all;" and
+they capered about as if they were overjoyed to see her. "Why, then,"
+says she, "you are all very good, and God Almighty will love you; so
+let us begin our lessons." They all huddled round her, and though at
+the other place they were employed about words and syllables, here we
+had people of much greater understanding who dealt only in sentences.
+
+The letters being brought upon the table, one of the little ones set
+up the following sentence:
+
+"The Lord have mercy upon me, and grant that I may be always good, and
+say my prayers, and love the Lord my God with all my heart, with all
+my soul, and with all my strength; and honor the King and all good men
+in authority under him."
+
+Then the next took the letters, and composed this sentence:
+
+"Lord, have mercy upon me, and grant that I may love my neighbor as
+myself, and do unto all men as I would have them do unto me, and tell
+no lies; but be honest and just in all my dealings."
+
+LESSON FOR THE CONDUCT OF LIFE
+
+ He that would thrive,
+ Must rise by five.
+ He that hath thriven,
+ May lay till seven.
+ Truth may be blamed
+ But can't be shamed.
+ Tell me with whom you go,
+ And I'll tell what you do.
+ A friend in your need,
+ Is a friend indeed.
+ They never can be wise,
+ Who good counsel despise.
+
+As we were returning home, we saw a gentleman, who was very ill,
+sitting under a shady tree at the corner of the rookery. Though ill,
+he began to joke with Little Margery, and said, laughing, "So, Goody
+Two-Shoes, they tell me you are a cunning little baggage; pray can you
+tell me what I shall do to get well?" "Yes, sir," says she, "go to bed
+when your rooks do and get up with them in the morning; earn, as they
+do, every day what you eat, and eat and drink no more than you earn:
+and you'll get health and keep it. What should induce the rooks to
+frequent gentlemen's houses, only but to tell them how to lead a
+prudent life? they never build under cottages or farmhouses, because
+they see that these people know how to live without their admonition.
+
+ "Thus wealth and wit you may improve.
+ Taught by tenants of the grove."
+
+The gentleman, laughing, gave Margery sixpence, and told her she was a
+sensible hussy.
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+HOW THE WHOLE PARISH WAS FRIGHTENED
+
+
+Who does not know Lady Ducklington, or who does not know that she was
+buried at this parish church? Well, I never saw a grander funeral in
+all my life; but the money they squandered away would have been better
+laid out in little books for children, or in meat, drink, and clothes
+for the poor.
+
+All the country round came to see the burying, and it was late before
+the corpse was interred. After which, in the night, or rather about
+two o'clock in the morning, the bells were heard to jingle in the
+steeple, which frightened the people prodigiously, who all thought it
+was Lady Ducklington's ghost dancing among the bell ropes. The people
+flocked to Will Dobbins, the clerk, and wanted him to go to see what
+it was; but William said he was sure it was a ghost, and that he would
+not offer to open the door. At length Mr. Long, the rector, hearing
+such an uproar in the village, went to the clerk, to know why he did
+not go into the church, and see who was there. "I go, sir?" says
+William; "why, the ghost would frighten me out of my wits!" Mrs.
+Dobbins, too, cried, and laying hold of her husband, said he should
+not be eat up by the ghost. "A ghost, you blockhead," says Mr. Long,
+in a pet; "did either of you ever see a ghost in a church, or know
+anybody that did?" "Yes," says the clerk, "my father did once in the
+shape of a windmill, and it walked all around the church in a trice,
+with jack boots on, and had a gun by its side, instead of a sword." "A
+fine picture of a ghost, truly," says Mr. Long; "give me the key of
+the church, you monkey, for I tell you there is no such thing now,
+whatever may have been formerly." Then taking the key, he went to the
+church, all the people following him. As soon as he had opened the
+door, what sort of a ghost do you think appeared? Why, Little
+Two-Shoes, who being weary had fallen asleep in one of the pews during
+the funeral service, and was shut in all night. She immediately asked
+Mr. Long's pardon for the trouble she had given him, told him she had
+been locked into the church, and said she should not have rung the
+bells, but that she was very cold, and hearing Farmer Boult's man go
+whistling by with his horses, she was in hopes he would have gone to
+the clerk for the key to let her out.
+
+
+
+
+VII
+
+CONTAINING AN ACCOUNT OF ALL THE SPIRITS OR THINGS SHE SAW IN THE
+CHURCH
+
+
+The people were ashamed to ask Little Madge any questions before Mr.
+Long, but as soon as he was gone, they all got round her to satisfy
+their curiosity, and desired she would give them a particular account
+of all that she had heard or seen.
+
+
+HER TALE
+
+
+"I went to the church," said she, "as most of you did last night, to
+see the burying, and, being very weary, I sat me down in Mr. Johns's
+pew, and fell fast asleep. At eleven of the clock I awoke; which I
+believe was in some measure occasioned by the clock's striking, for I
+heard it. I started up, and could not at first tell where I was; but
+after some time I recollected the funeral, and soon found that I was
+shut in the church. It was dismal dark, and I could see nothing; but
+while I was standing in the pew, something jumped up upon me behind,
+and laid, as I thought, its hands over my shoulders. I own I was a
+little afraid at first; however, I considered that I had always been
+constant at prayers, and at church, and that I had done nobody any
+harm, but had endeavored to do what good I could; and then thought I,
+what have I to fear? Yet I kneeled down to say my prayers. As soon as
+I was on my knees, something very cold, as cold as marble, ay, as cold
+as ice, touched my neck, which made me start, however, I continued my
+prayers, and having begged protection from Almighty God, I found my
+spirits come, and I was sensible I had nothing to fear; for God
+Almighty protects not only all those that are good, but also all those
+who endeavor to be good--nothing can withstand the power, and exceed
+the goodness of God Almighty. Armed with the confidence of his
+protection; I walked down the church aisle, when I heard something
+pit, pat, pit, pat, pit, pat, come after me, and something touched my
+hand, which seemed as cold as a marble monument. I could not think
+what this was, yet I knew that it could not hurt me, and therefore I
+made myself easy; but being very cold, and the church being paved with
+stones, which were very damp, I felt my way, as well as I could, to
+the pulpit; in doing which something rushed by me and almost threw me
+down, However, I was not frightened, for I knew that God Almighty
+would suffer nothing to hurt me.
+
+"At last I found out the pulpit, and having shut the door, I laid me
+down on the mat and cushion to sleep; when something thrust and pulled
+the door, as I thought, for admittance, which prevented my going to
+sleep. At last it cries, 'Bow, wow, wow;' and I concluded it must be
+Mr. Saunderson's dog, which had followed me from their house to
+church; so I opened the door, and called Snip, Snip, and the dog
+jumped upon me immediately. After this, Snip and I lay down together,
+and had a comfortable nap; for when I awoke again it was almost light.
+I then walked up and down all the aisles of the church to keep myself
+warm; and though I went into the vaults, and trod on Lady
+Ducklington's coffin, I saw nothing, and I believe it was owing to the
+reason Mr. Long has given you, namely, that there is no such thing to
+be seen. As to my part, I would as soon lie all night in a church as
+in any other place; and I am sure that any little boy or girl, who is
+good and loves God Almighty, and keeps his commandments, may as safely
+lie in the church, or the churchyard, as anywhere else, if they take
+care not to get cold, for I am sure there are no things either to hurt
+or to frighten them; though any one possessed of fear might have taken
+Neighbor Saunderson's dog with his cold nose for a ghost; and if they
+had not been undeceived, as I was, would never have thought
+otherwise." All the company acknowledged the justness of the
+observation, and thanked Little Two-Shoes for her advice.
+
+
+
+
+REFLECTION
+
+
+After this, my dear children, I hope you will not believe any foolish
+stories that ignorant, weak, or designing people may tell you about
+ghosts; for the tales of ghosts, witches, and fairies are the frolics
+of a distempered brain. No wise man ever saw either of them. Little
+Margery was not afraid; no, she had good sense, and a good conscience,
+which is a cure for all these imaginary evils.
+
+
+
+
+VIII
+
+OF SOMETHING WHICH HAPPENED TO LITTLE MARGERY TWO-SHOES IN A BARN,
+MORE DREADFUL THAN THE GHOST IN THE CHURCH; AND HOW SHE RETURNED GOOD
+FOR EVIL TO HER ENEMY, SIR TIMOTHY.
+
+
+Some days after this, a more dreadful accident befell Little Madge.
+She happened to be coming late from teaching, when it rained,
+thundered, and lightened and therefore she took shelter in a farmer's
+barn at a distance from the village. Soon after, the tempest drove in
+four thieves, who not seeing such a little creep-mouse girl as
+Two-Shoes, lay down on the hay next to her, and began to talk over
+their exploits, and to settle plans for future robberies. Little
+Margery, on hearing them, covered herself with straw. To be sure she
+was frightened, but her good sense taught her that the only security
+she had was in keeping herself concealed; therefore she lay very still
+and breathed very softly. About four o'clock these wicked people came
+to a resolution to break both Sir William Dove's house and Sir Timothy
+Gripe's, and by force of arms to carry off all their money, plate, and
+jewels; but as it was thought then too late, they all agreed to defer
+it till the next night. After laying his scheme, they all set out upon
+their pranks, which greatly rejoiced Margery, as it would any other
+little girl in her situation. Early in the morning she went to Sir
+William, and told him the whole of their conversation. Upon which he
+asked her name, then gave her something, and bid her call at his house
+the day following. She also went to Sir Timothy, notwithstanding he
+had used her so ill, for she knew it was her duty to do good for evil.
+As soon as he was informed who she was, he took no notice of her; upon
+which she desired to speak to Lady Gripe, and having informed her
+ladyship of the affair she went away. This lady had more sense than
+her husband which indeed is not a singular case; for instead of
+despising Little Margery and her information, she privately set people
+to guard the house. The robbers divided themselves, and went about the
+time mentioned to both houses, and were surprised by the guards and
+taken. Upon examining these wretches (one of which turned evidence),
+both Sir William and Sir Timothy found that they owed their lives to
+the discovery made by Little Margery; and the first took great notice
+of her and would no longer let her lie in a barn; but Sir Timothy only
+said that he was ashamed to owe his life to the daughter of one who
+was his enemy; so true it is, "That a proud man seldom forgives those
+he has injured."
+
+
+
+
+IX
+
+HOW LITTLE MARGERY WAS MADE PRINCIPAL OF A COUNTRY COLLEGE
+
+
+Mrs. Williams, who kept a college for instructing little gentlemen and
+ladies in the science of A, B, C, was at this time very old and
+infirm, and wanted to decline this important trust. This being told to
+Sir William Dove, who lived in the parish, he sent for Mrs. Williams,
+and desired she would examine Little Two-Shoes, and see whether she
+was qualified for the office. This was done, and Mrs. Williams made
+the following report in her favor, namely, that Little Margery was the
+best scholar, and had the best head and the best heart of any one she
+had examined. All the country had a great opinion of Mrs. Williams,
+and this character gave them also a great opinion of Mrs. Margery, for
+so we must now call her.
+
+This Mrs. Margery thought the happiest period of her life; but more
+happiness was in store for her. God Almighty heaps up blessings for
+all those who love him, and though for a time he may suffer them to be
+poor, and distressed, and hide his good purposes from human sight, yet
+in the end they are generally crowned with happiness here, and no one
+can doubt their being so hereafter.
+
+
+
+
+THE RENOWNED HISTORY OF MRS. MARGERY TWO-SHOES
+
+PART TWO
+
+
+In the first part of this work the young student has read, and I hope
+with pleasure and improvement, the history of this lady, while she was
+known and distinguished by the name of LITTLE TWO-SHOES. We are now
+come to a period of her life when that name was discarded, and a more
+eminent one bestowed upon her; I mean that of MRS. MARGERY TWO-SHOES;
+for as she was now president of the A, B, C college, it became
+necessary to exalt her in title as in place.
+
+No sooner was she settled in this office, but she laid every possible
+scheme to promote the welfare and happiness of all her neighbors, and
+especially of her little ones, in whom she took great delight; and all
+those whose parents could not afford to pay for their education, she
+taught for nothing but the pleasure she had in their company; for you
+are to observe that they were very good, or were soon made so by her
+good management.
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+OF HER SCHOOL, HER USHERS, OR ASSISTANTS, AND HER MANNER OF TEACHING
+
+
+We have already informed the reader, that the school where she taught
+was that which was before kept by Mrs. Williams. The room was very
+large and spacious, and as she knew that nature intended children
+should be always in action, she placed her different letters, or
+alphabets, all round the school, so that every one was obliged to get
+up and fetch a letter, or to spell a word when it came to their turn;
+which not only kept them in health, but fixed the letters and points
+firmly in their minds.
+
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+A SCENE OF DISTRESS IN A SCHOOL
+
+
+It happened one day, when Mrs. Two-Shoes was diverting the children
+after dinner, as she usually did, with some innocent games, or
+entertaining and instructive stories, that a man arrived with the
+melancholy news of Sally Jones's father being thrown from his horse,
+and thought past all recovery; nay, the messenger said, that he was
+seemingly dying when he came away. Poor Sally was greatly distressed,
+as indeed were all in the school, for she dearly loved her father, and
+Mrs. Two-Shoes and all her children dearly loved her.
+
+At this instant something was heard to flap at the window, at which
+the children were surprised; but Mrs. Margery, knowing what it was,
+opened the casement, and drew in a pigeon with a letter.
+
+As soon as he was placed upon the table, he walked up to little Sally,
+and dropping the letter, cried "Co, co, coo;" as much as to say,
+"There, read it."
+
+ "My dear Sally--God Almighty has been very merciful and
+ restored your papa to us again, who is now so well as to be
+ able to sit up. I hear you are a good girl, my dear, and I
+ hope you will never forget to praise the Lord for that his
+ great goodness and mercy to us. What a sad thing it would
+ have been if your father had died, and left both you and me,
+ and little Tommy in distress, and without a friend. Your
+ father sends his blessing with mine. Be good, my dear child,
+ and God Almighty will also bless you, whose blessing is above
+ all things.
+
+ "I am, my dear Sally,
+
+ "Your affectionate mother,
+
+ "MARTHA JONES."
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+OF THE AMAZING SAGACITY AND INSTINCT OF A LITTLE DOG
+
+
+Soon after this, a very dreadful accident happened in the school. It
+was on a Thursday morning, I very well remember, when the children
+having learned their lessons soon, she had given them leave to play,
+and they were all running about the school, and diverting themselves
+with the birds and the lamb; at this time the dog, all of a sudden,
+laid hold of his mistress's apron, and endeavored to pull her out of
+the school. She was at first surprised; however, she followed him, to
+see what he intended. No sooner had he led her back into the garden,
+but he ran back, and pulled out one of the children in the same
+manner; upon which she ordered them all to leave the school
+immediately, and they had not been out five minutes before the top of
+the house fell in. What a miraculous deliverance was here! How
+gracious! How good was God Almighty to save all these children from
+destruction, and to make use of such an instrument as a little
+sagacious animal to accomplish his divine will! I should have observed
+that, as soon as they were all in the garden, the dog came leaping
+round them to express his joy, and when the house was fallen, laid
+himself down quietly by his mistress.
+
+Some of the neighbors who saw the school fall, and who were in great
+pain for Margery and her little ones, soon spread the news through the
+village, and all the parents, terrified for their children, came
+crowding in abundance; they had, however, the satisfaction to find
+them all safe, and upon their knees with their mistress, giving God
+thanks for their happy deliverance.
+
+You are not to wonder, my dear reader, that this little dog should
+have more sense than you, or your father, or your grandfather.
+
+Though God Almighty has made man the lord of the creation and endowed
+him with reason; yet in many respects he has been altogether as
+bountiful to other creatures of his forming. Some of the senses of
+other animals are more acute than ours, as we find by daily
+experience.
+
+The downfall of the school was a great misfortune to Mrs. Margery; for
+she not only lost all her books, but was destitute of a place to teach
+in; but Sir William Dove, being informed of this, ordered it to be
+built at his own expense, and till that could be done, Farmer Grove
+was so kind as to let her have his large hall to teach in.
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+WHAT HAPPENED AT FARMER GROVE'S, AND HOW SHE GRATIFIED HIM FOR THE USE
+OF HIS ROOM
+
+
+While at Mr. Grove's, which was in the heart of the village, she not
+only taught the children in the daytime, but the farmer's servants and
+all the neighbors to read and write in the evening; and it was a
+constant practice, before they went away, to make them all go to
+prayers and sing psalms. By this means the people grew extremely
+regular, his servants were always at home instead of being at the
+alehouse, and he had more work done than ever. This gave not only Mr.
+Grove, but all the neighbors, a high opinion of her good sense and
+prudent behavior; and she was so much esteemed that the most of the
+differences in the parish were left to her decision; and if a man and
+wife quarreled (which sometimes happened in that part of the kingdom),
+both parties certainly came to her for advice. Everybody knows that
+Martha Wilson was a passionate, scolding jade, and that John her
+husband was a surly, ill-tempered fellow. These were one day brought
+by the neighbors for Margery to talk to them, when they talked before
+her, and were going to blows; but she, stepping between them, thus
+addressed the husband: "John," says she, "you are a man, and ought to
+have more sense than to fly in a passion at every word that is said
+amiss by your wife: and Martha," says she, "you ought to know your
+duty better than to say anything to aggravate your husband's
+resentment. These frequent quarrels arise from the indulgence of your
+violent passions; for I know you both love each other, notwithstanding
+what has passed between you. Now, pray tell me, John, and tell me,
+Martha, when you have had a quarrel over night, are you not both sorry
+for it the next day?" They both declared that they were. "Why, then,"
+says she, "I'll tell you how to prevent this for the future, if you
+promise to take my advice." They both promised her. "You know," says
+she, "that a small spark will set fire to tinder, and that tinder
+properly placed will set fire to a house: an angry word is with you as
+that spark, for you are both as touchy as tinder, and very often make
+your own house too hot to hold you. To prevent this, therefore, and to
+live happily for the future, you must solemnly agree, that if one
+speaks an angry word, the other will not answer, till he or she has
+distinctly called over the alphabet, and the other not reply till he
+has told twenty; by this means your passions will be stifled, and
+reason will have time to take the rule."
+
+This is the best recipe that was ever given for a married couple to
+live in peace. Though John and his wife frequently attempted to
+quarrel afterwards, they never could get their passions to a
+considerable height; for there was something so droll in thus carrying
+on the dispute, that, before they got to the end of the argument, they
+saw the absurdity of it, laughed, kissed, and were friends.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+THE CASE OF MRS. MARGERY
+
+
+Mrs. Margery was always doing good, and thought she could never
+sufficiently gratify those who had done anything to serve her. These
+generous sentiments naturally led her to consult the interest of Mr.
+Grove, and the rest of her neighbors; and as most of their lands were
+meadow, and they depended much on their hay, which had been for many
+years greatly damaged by the wet weather, she contrived an instrument
+to direct them when to mow their grass with safety, and prevent their
+hay being spoiled. They all came to her for advice, and by that means
+got in their hay without damage, while most of that in the neighboring
+village was spoiled.
+
+This occasioned a very great noise in the country, and so greatly
+provoked were the people who resided in the other parishes, that they
+absolutely sent old Gaffer Goosecap (a busy fellow in other people's
+concerns) to find out evidence against her. The wiseacre happened to
+come to her to school, when she was walking about with a raven on one
+shoulder, a pigeon on the other, a lark on her hand, and a lamb and a
+dog by her side; which indeed made a droll figure, and so surprised
+the man that he cried out, "A witch! a witch! a witch!"
+
+Upon this she, laughing, answered, "a conjurer! a conjurer! a
+conjurer!" and so they parted; but it did not end thus, for a warrant
+was issued out against Mrs. Margery, and she was carried to a meeting
+of the justices.
+
+At the meeting, one of the justices who knew little of life, and less
+of the law, behaved very idly; and, though nobody was able to prove
+anything against her, asked who she could bring to her character. "Who
+can you bring against my character, sir?" says she. "There are people
+enough who would appear in my defense, were it necessary: but I never
+supposed that any one here could be so weak as to believe there was
+any such thing as a witch. If I am a witch, this is my charm; and"
+(laying a barometer or weather-glass on the table) "it is with this,"
+says she, "that I have taught my neighbor to know the state of the
+weather." All the company laughed; and Sir William Dove, who was on
+the bench, asked her accusers how they could be such fools as to think
+there was any such thing as a witch?
+
+After this, Sir William inveighed against the absurd and foolish
+notions which the country people had imbibed concerning witches and
+witchcraft, and having proved that there was no such thing, but that
+all were the effects of folly and ignorance, he gave the court such an
+account of Mrs. Margery, and her virtue, good sense, and prudent
+behavior, that the gentlemen present were enamored with her, and
+returned her public thanks for the great service she had done the
+country. One gentleman in particular, I mean Sir Charles Jones, had
+conceived such a high opinion of her that he offered her a
+considerable sum to take care of his family, and the education of his
+daughter, which, however, she refused; but this gentleman sending for
+her afterwards, when he had a dangerous fit of illness, she went, and
+behaved so prudently in the family, and so tenderly to him and his
+daughter, that he would not permit her to leave his house, but soon
+after made her proposals of marriage. She was truly sensible of the
+honor he intended her, but, though poor, she would not consent to be
+made a lady till he had effectually provided for his daughter; for she
+told him that power was a dangerous thing to be trusted with, and that
+a good man or woman would never throw themselves into the road of
+temptation.
+
+All things being settled, and the day fixed, the neighbors came in
+crowds to see the wedding; for they were all glad that one who had
+been such a good little girl, and was become such a virtuous and good
+woman, was going to be made a lady; but just as the clergyman had
+opened his book, a gentleman richly dressed ran into the church and
+cried, "Stop! stop!" This greatly alarmed the congregation,
+particularly the intended bride and bridegroom, whom he first accosted
+and desired to speak with them apart. After they had been talking some
+little time, the people were greatly surprised to see Sir Charles
+stand motionless, and his bride cry and faint away in the stranger's
+arms. This seeming grief, however, was only a prelude to a flood of
+joy which immediately succeeded; for you must know, gentle reader,
+that this gentleman, so richly dressed, was that identical little boy,
+whom you before saw in the sailor's habit; in short, it was Mrs.
+Margery's brother, who was just come from sea, where he had, after a
+desperate engagement, taken a rich prize; and hearing, as soon as he
+landed, of his sister's intended wedding, had rode post to see that a
+proper settlement was made on her, which she was now entitled to, as
+he himself was both able and willing to give her an ample fortune.
+They soon returned to the communion table, and were married in tears,
+but they were tears of joy.
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+THE TRUE USE OF RICHES
+
+
+About this time she heard that Mr. Smith was oppressed by Sir Timothy
+Gripe and his friend Graspall; upon which she, in conjunction with her
+brother, defended him in Westminster Hall, where Mr. Smith gained a
+verdict. As a justice of the peace he was struck off the list, and no
+longer permitted to act in that capacity. A relation of his who had a
+right to the Mouldwell estate, finding that it was possible to get the
+better at law of a rich man, laid claim to it, brought his action, and
+recovered the whole manor of Mouldwell; and being afterwards inclined
+to sell it, he in consideration of the aid Lady Margery had lent him
+during his distress, made her the first offer, and she purchased the
+whole. This mortified Sir Timothy and his friend Graspall, who
+experienced nothing but misfortunes, and was in a few years so
+dispossessed of his ill-gotten wealth, that his family were reduced to
+seek subsistance from the parish, at which those who had felt the
+weight of his iron hand rejoiced; but Lady Margery desired that his
+children might be treated with care and tenderness; "for they" (says
+she) "are noways accountable for the actions of their father." At her
+first coming into power, she took care to gratify her old friends,
+especially Mr. and Mrs. Smith, whose family she made happy.
+
+
+
+
+LIST OF BEST BOOKS OF CLASSIC TALES AND OLD-FASHIONED STORIES
+
+ABBOTT, JACOB _Franconia Stories_
+ABBOTT, JACOB _Jonas Stories_
+ABBOTT, JACOB _Rollo Books_
+ADDISON, STEELE, BUDGELL _Papers of Roger de Coverley_
+AIKIN, JOHN, AND BARBAULD, ANNA LETITIA _Evenings at Home_
+AGUILAR, GRACE _Home Influence_
+AGUILAR, GRACE _The Mother's Recompense_
+ARABIAN NIGHTS
+BARBAULD, MRS. _Juvenile Forget-me-not_
+BARNARD, MRS. CAROLINE _The Parent's Offering_
+BROOKE, HENRY _The Fool of Quality_
+BUNYAN, JOHN _Pilgrim's Progress_
+CERVANTES, MIGUEL _Don Quixote_
+CHAUCER, GEOFFREY _Canterbury Tales_
+DAY, THOMAS _Sandford and Merton_
+DAY, THOMAS _The History of Little Jack_
+DEFOE, DANIEL _Robinson Crusoe_
+EDGEWORTH, MARIA _Parent's Assistant_
+EDGEWORTH, MARIA _Harry and Lucy_
+EDGEWORTH, MARIA _Moral Tales_
+ELIOT, GEORGE _Silas Marner_
+FIELDING, SARAH _The Adventures of David Simple_
+GODWIN, MRS. WILLIAM _The Stories of Old Daniel_
+GOLDSMITH, OLIVER _The Vicar of Wakefield_
+GOODRICH, S.G. _Fagots for the Fireside_
+HOMER _The Iliad_
+HOMER _The Odyssey_
+HOWITT, MARY _Treasury of Tales_
+HUGO, VICTOR _Les Misérables_
+JAMES, G.P.R. _Prince Life_
+LAMB, CHARLES _Mrs. Leicester's School_
+LAMB, CHARLES AND MARY _Tales from Shakespeare_
+LUCAS, E.V. (Ed.) _Old-Fashioned Tales_
+LUCAS, E.V. (Ed.) _Forgotten Tales of Long Ago_
+MARTIN, WILLIAM _Peter Parley's Annual_
+MANT, ALICIA CATHERINE _Tales for Ellen_
+MORE, HANNAH _Coelebs in Search of a Wife_
+PEARSON, MISS _A Few Weeks at Clairmont Castle_
+RASPE, RODOLPH ERIC _The Travels of Baron Munchausen_
+SHERWOOD, MRS. _The Fairchild Family_
+SINCLAIR, KATHERINE _Holiday House_
+SWIFT, JONATHAN _Gulliver's Travels_
+WAKEFIELD, PRISCILLA _Juvenile Anecdotes_
+WYSS, JOHANN RUDOLPH _Swiss Family Robinson_
+
+
+
+***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK YOUNG FOLKS TREASURY, VOLUME 3 (OF
+12)***
+
+
+******* This file should be named 15560-8.txt or 15560-8.zip *******
+
+
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/1/5/5/6/15560
+
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+https://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at https://www.gutenberg.org/about/contact
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit:
+https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ https://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
diff --git a/15560-8.zip b/15560-8.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8a1503a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-8.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h.zip b/15560-h.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dd38ecf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/15560-h.htm b/15560-h/15560-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bf6f2c2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/15560-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,24127 @@
+<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Transitional//EN"
+ "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-transitional.dtd">
+<html>
+<head>
+<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1" />
+<title>The Project Gutenberg eBook of Young Folks Treasury, Volume 3 (of 12), by Various</title>
+ <style type="text/css">
+ /*<![CDATA[*/
+
+ <!--
+ body {margin-left:8%; margin-right:9%; max-width: 40em;
+ }
+ p {text-align: justify;}
+ blockquote {text-align: justify;}
+ h1,h2,h3,h4,h5,h6 {text-align: center;}
+ h1 {margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 2em}
+ h2 {margin-top: 4em; margin-bottom: 2em}
+ h3 {margin-top: 2em; margin-bottom: 2em}
+
+ pre {font-size: 0.7em;}
+
+ hr {text-align: center; width: 50%;}
+ html>body hr {margin-right: 25%; margin-left: 25%; width: 50%;}
+ hr.full {width: 100%;}
+ html>body hr.full {margin-right: 0%; margin-left: 0%; width: 100%;}
+ hr.short {text-align: center; width: 20%;}
+ html>body hr.short {margin-right: 40%; margin-left: 40%; width: 20%;}
+
+ .note {margin-left: 10%; margin-right: 10%; font-size: 0.9em;}
+
+ span.pagenum {position: absolute; left: 1%; right: 91%; font-size: 8pt;}
+
+ .poem {margin-left:10%; margin-right:10%; margin-bottom: 1em;
+ text-align: left;}
+ .poem .stanza {margin: 1em 0em 1em 0em;}
+ .poem p {margin: 0; padding-left: 3em; text-indent: -3em;}
+ .poem p.i2 {margin-left: 1em;}
+ .poem p.i4 {margin-left: 2em;}
+ .poem p.i6 {margin-left: 3em;}
+ .poem p.i8 {margin-left: 4em;}
+ .poem p.i10 {margin-left: 5em;}
+
+ .figure, .figcenter, .figright, .figleft
+ {padding: 1em; margin: 0; text-align: center; font-variant: small-caps;}
+ .figure img, .figcenter img, .figright img, .figleft img
+ {border: none;}
+ .figure p, .figcenter p, .figright p, .figleft p
+ {margin: 0; text-indent: 1em;}
+ .figcenter {margin: auto;}
+ .figright {float: right;}
+ .figleft {float: left;}
+ ol.inside, ul.inside {
+ list-style-position: inside;
+ margin-left: -2.5em; /* For everybody but MSIE 5, boo */}
+ .off { list-style-type: none; }
+ ol.TOC { /* styling the Table of Contents */
+ list-style-type: upper-roman; /* a list with no symbol */
+ position: relative; /* makes a "container" for span.tocright */
+ /* margin-right: 5%; pulls the page#s in a skosh */
+ }
+ ol.TOC li {font-variant: small-caps;
+ }
+ ul.TOC { /* styling the Table of Contents */
+ list-style-type: none; /* a list with no symbol */
+ padding: 0; margin: 0;
+ position: relative; /* makes a "container" for span.tocright */
+ /* margin-right: 5%; pulls the page#s in a skosh */
+ }
+ ul.TOCSub { /* sub-entries in the TOC */
+ list-style-type: none;
+ position: relative; /* makes a "container" for span.tocright */
+ /* margin-right: 10%; pulls these page#s in even more */
+ }
+ span.tocright { /* use absolute positioning to move page# right */
+ position: absolute; right: -5%;
+ }
+ span.story { /* use for titles of stories */
+ font-weight: bold;
+ }
+ ul.LOI { /* styling the List of Illustrations */
+ list-style-type: none;
+ position: relative; /* makes a "container" for span.tocright */
+ margin-right: 5%; /* pulls the page#s in a skosh */
+ }
+ ul.LOI li {margin-bottom: 0.5em; font-variant: small-caps;
+ }
+ ul.helpers {list-style-type: none;
+ }
+ ul.helpers li {margin-bottom: 0.3em; margin-left: 6em; text-indent: -6em;
+ }
+ .inline {border: none; vertical-align: middle;
+ }
+
+ .footnote {font-size: 0.9em; margin-right: 10%; margin-left: 10%;
+ }
+ div.trans-note {border-style: solid; border-width: 1px;
+ margin: 3em 15%; padding: 1em; text-align: center; font-size: small;
+ }
+ .author {text-align: right; font-variant: small-caps; margin-top: -1em; margin-right: 5%;
+ }
+ .ctr {text-align: center;
+ }
+ .editor {text-align: center; margin-top: -2em;
+ }
+ .sc {font-variant: small-caps;
+ }
+ a:link {color: blue; text-decoration: none;
+ }
+ link {color: blue; text-decoration: none;
+ }
+ a:visited {color: blue; text-decoration: none;
+ }
+ a:hover {color: red;
+ }
+ -->
+ /*]]>*/
+ </style>
+</head>
+<body>
+<h1>The Project Gutenberg eBook, Young Folks Treasury, Volume 3 (of 12), by
+Various, Edited by Hamilton Wright Mabie</h1>
+<pre>
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at <a href = "https://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a></pre>
+<p>Title: Young Folks Treasury, Volume 3 (of 12)</p>
+<p> Classic Tales And Old-Fashioned Stories</p>
+<p>Author: Various</p>
+<p>Editor: Hamilton Wright Mabie</p>
+<p>Release Date: April 6, 2005 [eBook #15560]</p>
+<p>Language: English</p>
+<p>Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1</p>
+<p>***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK YOUNG FOLKS TREASURY, VOLUME 3 (OF 12)***</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<h3>E-text prepared by Juliet Sutherland, Sandra Brown,<br />
+ and the Project Gutenberg Online Distributed Proofreading Team</h3>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+ <div class="trans-note">
+ Transcriber's Note: Click on an illustration to see it enlarged.
+ </div>
+<hr class="full" />
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h2>YOUNG FOLKS' TREASURY</h2>
+
+ <h4>In 12 Volumes</h4>
+
+ <h3>HAMILTON WRIGHT MABIE</h3>
+
+ <p class="editor"><i>Editor</i></p>
+
+ <h3>EDWARD EVERETT HALE</h3>
+
+ <p class="editor"><i>Associate Editor</i></p>
+
+ <h1>Classic Tales and Old-Fashioned Stories</h1>
+
+ <h3>HAMILTON WRIGHT MABIE</h3>
+
+ <p class="editor"><i>Editor</i></p>
+
+ <h3>DANIEL EDWIN WHEELER</h3>
+
+ <p class="editor"><i>Assistant Editor</i></p>
+
+ <h4>VOLUME III</h4>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h4>New York</h4>
+
+ <h3>THE UNIVERSITY SOCIETY INC.</h3>
+
+ <h5><i>Publishers</i></h5>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/frontis.jpg" name="figfrontiss"
+ id="figfrontiss"><img width="300" src="images/frontiss.jpg"
+ alt="THE HORSE FLEW THROUGH THE AIR" /></a><br />
+ the horse flew through the air
+ </div>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h2>PARTIAL LIST OF EDITORS AND CONTRIBUTORS</h2>
+ <hr class="short" />
+
+ <h3>HAMILTON WRIGHT MABIE</h3>
+
+ <p class="editor"><i>Editor</i></p>
+
+ <h3>EDWARD EVERETT HALE</h3>
+
+ <p class="editor"><i>Associate Editor</i></p>
+
+ <h3>DANIEL EDWIN WHEELER</h3>
+
+ <p class="editor"><i>Managing Editor</i></p>
+ <hr class="short" />
+
+ <p><i>Partial List of Contributors, Assistant Editors and
+ Advisers</i>:</p>
+
+ <ul class="helpers">
+ <li>NICHOLAS MURRAY BUTLER, President Columbia
+ University.</li>
+
+ <li>WILLIAM R. HARPER, Late President Chicago
+ University.</li>
+
+ <li>Hon. THEODORE ROOSEVELT, Ex-President of the United
+ States.</li>
+
+ <li>Hon. GROVER CLEVELAND, Late President of the United
+ States.</li>
+
+ <li>JAMES CARDINAL GIBBONS, American Roman Catholic
+ prelate.</li>
+
+ <li>LAWRENCE J. BURPEE, Librarian Ottawa Public Library;
+ author of "Canadian Life in Town and Country," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>BLISS CARMAN, poet, essayist, and editor.</li>
+
+ <li>THOMAS B. FLINT, Clerk House of Commons, Canada; editor
+ "Parliamentary Practice and Procedure."</li>
+
+ <li>AGNES C. LAUT, author "Lords of the North," "Hudson's
+ Bay Company," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>BECKLES WILLSON, author of "The Romance of Canada,"
+ "Life and Letters of James Wolfe," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>EDWARD W. BOK, editor "Ladies' Home Journal."</li>
+
+ <li>HENRY VAN DYKE, author, poet, and Professor of English
+ Literature, Princeton University.</li>
+
+ <li>LYMAN ABBOTT, author, editor of "The Outlook."</li>
+
+ <li>JACOB A. RIIS, author and journalist.</li>
+
+ <li>EDWARD EVERETT HALE, JR., Professor at Union
+ College.</li>
+
+ <li>CHARLES G.D. ROBERTS, writer of animal stories.</li>
+
+ <li>JANET H. KELMAN, author "Stories from the Crusades," "A
+ Book of Butterflies," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>VAUTIER GOLDING, author "Life of Henry M. Stanley,"
+ etc.</li>
+
+ <li>LENA DALKEITH, author "A Book of Beasts," "Stories from
+ French History," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>H.E. MARSHALL, author "A Child's History of England."
+ "History of English Literature," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>JOEL CHANDLER HARRIS, creator of "Uncle Remus."</li>
+
+ <li>GEORGE CARY EGGLESTON, novelist and journalist.</li>
+
+ <li>WILLIAM BLAIKIE, author of "How to Get Strong and How
+ to Stay So."</li>
+
+ <li>JOSEPH JACOBS, folklore writer and editor of the
+ "Jewish Encyclopedia."</li>
+
+ <li>Mrs. VIRGINIA TERHUNE ("Marlon Harland"), author of
+ "Common Sense in the Household," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>A.D. INNES, author "England Under the Tudors,"
+ "England's Industrial Development," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>EDMUND F. SELLAR, author "Life of Nelson," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>MARY MACGREGOR, author "King Arthur's Knights,"
+ etc.</li>
+
+ <li>JEANIE LANG, author "Life of General Gordon," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>Rev. THEODORE WOOD, F.E.S., writer on natural
+ history.</li>
+
+ <li>MARGARET E. SANGSTER, author of "The Art of
+ Home-Making," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>HERBERT T. WADE, editor and writer on physics.</li>
+
+ <li>JOHN H. CLIFFORD, editor and writer.</li>
+
+ <li>ERNEST INGERSOLL, naturalist and author.</li>
+
+ <li>IDA PRENTICE WHITCOMB, author of "Young People's Story
+ of Music," "Heroes of History," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>MARK HAMBOURG, pianist and composer.</li>
+
+ <li>Mme. BLANCHE MARCHESI, opera singer and teacher.</li>
+
+ <li>ELBRIDGE S. BROOKS, author "Historic Boys," etc.</li>
+
+ <li>PAULINE C. BOUVÉ, author "Stories of American Heroes
+ for Boys and Girls," etc.</li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <h2>CONTENTS</h2>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li>
+ <span class="story">Introduction</span><a href="#pagexv"><span class="tocright">
+ xv</span></a></li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <h3>CLASSIC TALES</h3>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li><span class="story">Don
+ Quixote</span><span class="tocright">1-35</span></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Miguel Cervantes. Adapted by
+ John Lang</li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <ol class="TOC">
+ <li>how don quixote was
+ knighted<a href="#page1"><span class="tocright">1</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how don quixote rescued andres; and how he returned
+ home
+ <a href="#page6"><span class="tocright">6</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how don quixote and sancho panza started on their
+ search for adventures; and how don quixote fought with the
+ windmills
+ <a href="#page10"><span class="tocright">10</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how don quixote won a helmet; how he fought with two
+ armies; and how sancho's ass was stolen
+ <a href="#page14"><span class="tocright">14</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how don quixote saw dulcinea
+ <a href="#page18"><span class="tocright">18</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how don quixote fought with a lion; and how he defeated
+ the moors
+ <a href="#page21"><span class="tocright">21</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>the battle with the bulls; the fight with the knight of
+ the white moon; and how don quixote died
+ <a href="#page29"><span class="tocright">29</span></a></li>
+ </ol>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li><span class="story">Gulliver's Travels: Voyage to
+ Lilliput</span><span class="tocright">36-58</span></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Jonathan Swift. Adapted by
+ John Lang</li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <ol class="TOC">
+ <li>gulliver's birth and early
+ voyages<a href="#page36"><span class="tocright">36</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>gulliver is wrecked on the coast of
+ lilliput<a href="#page37"><span class="tocright">37</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>gulliver is taken as a prisoner to the capital of
+ lilliput<a href="#page42"><span class="tocright">42</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>gulliver is freed, and captures the blefuscan
+ fleet<a href="#page47"><span class="tocright">47</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>gulliver's escape from lilliput and return to
+ england<a href="#page54"><span class="tocright">54</span></a></li>
+ </ol>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li><span class="story">The Arabian
+ Nights</span><span class="tocright">59-94</span></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">Adapted by Amy Steedman</li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <ol class="TOC">
+ <li>aladdin and the wonderful
+ lamp<a href="#page59"><span class="tocright">59</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>the enchanted
+ horse<a href="#page73"><span class="tocright">73</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>sindbad the
+ sailor<a href="#page80"><span class="tocright">80</span></a></li>
+ </ol>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li><span class="story">The Iliad of
+ Homer</span><span class="tocright">95-118</span></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">Adapted by Jeanie Lang</li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <ol class="TOC">
+ <li>the story of what led to the siege of
+ troy<a href="#page95"><span class="tocright">95</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>the
+ council<a href="#page97"><span class="tocright">97</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>the fight between paris and
+ menelaus<a href="#page102"><span class="tocright">102</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>hector and
+ andromache<a href="#page107"><span class="tocright">107</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how patroclus fought and
+ died<a href="#page110"><span class="tocright">110</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>the rousing of
+ achilles<a href="#page114"><span class="tocright">114</span></a></li>
+ </ol>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li><span class="story">The Odyssey of
+ Homer</span><span class="tocright">119-135</span></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">Adapted by Jeanie Lang</li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <ol class="TOC">
+ <li>what happened in ithaca while odysseus was
+ away<a href="#page119"><span class="tocright">119</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how odysseus came
+ home<a href="#page126"><span class="tocright">126</span></a></li>
+ </ol>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li><span class="story">Robinson
+ Crusoe</span><span class="tocright">136-170</span></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Daniel Defoe. Adapted by
+ John Lang</li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <ol class="TOC">
+ <li>how robinson first went to sea; and how he was
+ shipwrecked<a href="#page136"><span class="tocright">136</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>robinson works hard at making himself a
+ home<a href="#page140"><span class="tocright">140</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>the earthquake and hurricane; and how robinson built a
+ boat<a href="#page144"><span class="tocright">144</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>robinson builds a second boat, in which he is swept out
+ to sea
+ <a href="#page148"><span class="tocright">148</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>robinson sees a footprint on the sand, finds a cave,
+ and rescues friday
+ <a href="#page152"><span class="tocright">152</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>robinson trains friday and they build a large boat;
+ they rescue two prisoners from the cannibals
+ <a href="#page160"><span class="tocright">160</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>arrival of an english ship: robinson sails for home
+ <a href="#page163"><span class="tocright">163</span></a></li>
+ </ol>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li><span class="story">Canterbury
+ Tales</span><span class="tocright">171-202</span></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Geoffrey Chaucer. Adapted by
+ Janet Harvey Kelman</li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <ol class="TOC">
+ <li>
+ dorigen<a href="#page171"><span class="tocright">171</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>
+ emelia<a href="#page182"><span class="tocright">182</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>
+ griselda<a href="#page193"><span class="tocright">193</span></a></li>
+ </ol>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li><span class="story">The Pilgrim's
+ Progress</span><a href="#page203"><span class="tocright">203</span></a></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By John Bunyan. Adapted by Mary
+ Macgregor</li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">Tales from
+ Shakespeare</span><span class="tocright">233-254</span></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Charles and Mary Lamb</li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <ol class="TOC">
+ <li>the tempest
+ <a href="#page233"><span class="tocright">233</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>a midsummer night's dream
+ <a href="#page243"><span class="tocright">243</span></a></li>
+ </ol>
+
+ <h3>OLD-FASHIONED STORIES</h3>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li><span class="story">Simple
+ Susan</span><span class="tocright">257-308</span></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Maria Edgeworth. Adapted by
+ Louey Chisholm</li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <ol class="TOC">
+ <li>queen of the may
+ <a href="#page257"><span class="tocright">257</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>bad news
+ <a href="#page263"><span class="tocright">263</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>susan's guinea-fowl
+ <a href="#page266"><span class="tocright">266</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>susan visits the abbey
+ <a href="#page270"><span class="tocright">270</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>susan's pet lamb
+ <a href="#page274"><span class="tocright">274</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>the blind harper
+ <a href="#page279"><span class="tocright">279</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>good news
+ <a href="#page283"><span class="tocright">283</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>barbara visits the abbey
+ <a href="#page290"><span class="tocright">290</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>a surprise for susan
+ <a href="#page294"><span class="tocright">294</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>barbara's accident
+ <a href="#page297"><span class="tocright">297</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>the prize-giving
+ <a href="#page300"><span class="tocright">300</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>attorney case in trouble
+ <a href="#page303"><span class="tocright">303</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>susan's birthday
+ <a href="#page306"><span class="tocright">306</span></a></li>
+ </ol>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li><span class="story">Limby Lumpy</span>
+ <a href="#page309"><span class="tocright">309</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">The Sore Tongue</span>
+ <a href="#page314"><span class="tocright">314</span></a></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Jane Taylor</li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">Eyes and No Eyes, or The Art of
+ Seeing</span><a href="#page319"><span class="tocright">319</span></a></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By John Aikin and Mrs.
+ Barbauld</li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">Prince Life</span>
+ <a href="#page326"><span class="tocright">326</span></a></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By G.P.R. James</li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">The Fruits of Disobedience, or The
+ Kidnapped
+ Child</span><a href="#page339"><span class="tocright">339</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">Dicky Random, or Good Nature Is
+ Nothing Without Good Conduct</span>
+ <a href="#page350"><span class="tocright">350</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">Embellishment</span>
+ <a href="#page359"><span class="tocright">359</span></a></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Jacob Abbott</li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">The Oyster Patties</span>
+ <a href="#page370"><span class="tocright">370</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">Two Little
+ Boys</span><span class="tocright">376-385</span></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Thomas Day</li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <ol class="TOC">
+ <li>the good-natured little boy
+ <a href="#page376"><span class="tocright">376</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>the ill-natured little boy
+ <a href="#page379"><span class="tocright">379</span></a></li>
+ </ol>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li><span class="story">The Purple Jar</span>
+ <a href="#page386"><span class="tocright">386</span></a></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Maria Edgeworth</li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">The Three
+ Cakes</span><a href="#page393"><span class="tocright">393</span></a></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Armand Berquin</li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li>
+ <span class="story">Amendment</span><a href="#page398"><span class="tocright">
+ 398</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">Trial</span>
+ <a href="#page418"><span class="tocright">418</span></a></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By John Aikin and Mrs.
+ Barbauld</li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">A Plot of Gunpowder: An Old Lady
+ Seized for a Guy</span>
+ <a href="#page426"><span class="tocright">426</span></a></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">Ascribed to William Martin
+ ("Peter Parley")</li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">Uncle David's Nonsensical Story
+ About Giants and Fairies</span>
+ <a href="#page438"><span class="tocright">438</span></a></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Katherine Sinclair</li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">The Inquisitive Girl</span>
+ <a href="#page447"><span class="tocright">447</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">Busy Idleness</span>
+ <a href="#page453"><span class="tocright">453</span></a></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">By Jane Taylor</li>
+
+ <li>&nbsp;</li>
+
+ <li><span class="story">The Renowned History of Little
+ Goody
+ Two-Shoes</span><span class="tocright">461-482</span></li>
+
+ <li style="margin-left:4em">Ascribed to Oliver
+ Goldsmith</li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <ol class="TOC" start="0">
+ <li class="off">introduction
+ <a href="#page461"><span class="tocright">461</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how and about little margery and her brother
+ <a href="#page463"><span class="tocright">463</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how and about mr. smith
+ <a href="#page464"><span class="tocright">464</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how little margery obtained the name of goody
+ two-shoes, and what happened in the parish
+ <a href="#page465"><span class="tocright">465</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how little margery learned to read, and by degrees
+ taught
+ others<a href="#page466"><span class="tocright">466</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how little two-shoes became a trotting tutoress, and
+ how she taught her young
+ pupils<a href="#page466"><span class="tocright">466</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how the whole parish was frightened
+ <a href="#page469"><span class="tocright">469</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>containing an account of all the spirits or things she
+ saw in the church
+ <a href="#page470"><span class="tocright">470</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>of something which happened to little margery two-shoes
+ in a barn, more dreadful than the ghost in the church; and
+ how she returned good for evil to her enemy, sir timothy
+ <a href="#page472"><span class="tocright">472</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>how little margery was made principal of a country
+ college
+ <a href="#page474"><span class="tocright">474</span></a></li>
+ </ol>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li><span class="story">(Part Two.) The Renowned History of
+ Mrs. Margery
+ Two-Shoes</span><a href="#page474"><span class="tocright">474</span></a></li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <ol class="TOC">
+ <li>I. of her school, her ushers, or assistants, and her
+ manner of teaching
+ <a href="#page475"><span class="tocright">475</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>ii. a scene of distress in a school
+ <a href="#page475"><span class="tocright">475</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>iii. of the amazing sagacity and instinct of a little
+ dog
+ <a href="#page476"><span class="tocright">476</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>iv. what happened at farmer grove's, and how she
+ gratified him for the use of his room
+ <a href="#page477"><span class="tocright">477</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>v. the case of mrs. margery
+ <a href="#page479"><span class="tocright">479</span></a></li>
+
+ <li>vi. the true use of riches
+ <a href="#page481"><span class="tocright">481</span></a></li>
+ </ol>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h3>ILLUSTRATIONS</h3>
+ <hr class="short" />
+
+ <h5>VOLUME III</h5>
+
+ <ul class="LOI">
+ <li><a href="#figfrontiss">the horse flew through the
+ air</a><span class="tocright"><i>Frontispiece</i></span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig6s">"pay at once, you
+ scoundrel"</a><span class="tocright">6</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig12s">horse and man were sent rolling on
+ the ground</a><span class="tocright">12</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig30s">the bulls had run right over him and
+ rozinante</a><span class="tocright">30</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig38s">he found that his arms and legs were
+ tightly fastened to the
+ ground</a><span class="tocright">38</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig48s">gulliver in
+ lilliput</a><span class="tocright">48</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig54s">on this occasion, gulliver ate more
+ than usual</a><span class="tocright">54</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig62s">aladdin and the
+ magician</a><span class="tocright">62</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig80s">hindbad was carrying a very heavy
+ load</a><span class="tocright">80</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig96s">from far and wide did the greek hosts
+ gather</a><span class="tocright">96</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig110s">andromache in
+ captivity</a><span class="tocright">110</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig124s">telemachus knelt where the gray
+ water broke on the
+ sand</a><span class="tocright">124</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig140s">the escape from the
+ shipwreck</a><span class="tocright">140</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig152s">he saw the mark of a naked foot on
+ the sand</a><span class="tocright">152</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig162s">robinson ran to the white prisoner
+ and cut his bonds</a><span class="tocright">162</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig172s">alas! of all the ships i see, is
+ there never one that will bring my lord
+ home?</a><span class="tocright">172</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig196s">the curtain at the doorway was drawn
+ aside</a><span class="tocright">196</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig220s">then did christian draw his
+ sword</a><span class="tocright">220</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig234s">miranda watching the
+ storm</a><span class="tocright">234</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig246s">the fairies sing titania to
+ sleep</a><span class="tocright">246</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig260s">bending down a branch of the
+ laburnum-tree</a><span class="tocright">260</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig262s">"it won't do," said barbara, turning
+ her back</a><span class="tocright">262</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig266s">"and here's her crown!" cried
+ rose</a><span class="tocright">266</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig290s">she spoke of what she did not
+ understand</a><span class="tocright">290</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig296s">he was wanted to hold the jug of
+ milk</a><span class="tocright">296</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig374s">he took the currant tart, and ...
+ threw it at his
+ nurse</a><span class="tocright">374</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig390s">rosamond ran up to it with an
+ exclamation of
+ joy</a><span class="tocright">390</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig418s">widow dorothy careful made a
+ curtsey</a><span class="tocright">418</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig436s">the goat dashed in among them and
+ the chair was
+ upset</a><span class="tocright">436</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig440s">each of my visitors is quite an
+ exclusive</a><span class="tocright">440</span></li>
+
+ <li><a href="#fig448s">if louisa received a note, she
+ carefully locked it
+ up</a><span class="tocright">448</span></li>
+ </ul>
+
+ <p>(<i>Many of the illustrations in this volume are reproduced
+ by special permission of E.P. Dutton &amp; Company, owners of
+ American rights</i>.)</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="pagexv"
+ id="pagexv"></a>[pg xv]</span>
+
+ <h2>INTRODUCTION</h2>
+
+ <h3>I</h3>
+
+ <h3>CLASSIC TALES</h3>
+
+ <p>After our boys and girls have read the first half of this
+ volume, containing selected and simplified stories from some of
+ the greatest books of all time, their authors will cease to be
+ merely names. Homer, Shakespeare, Chaucer, Cervantes and Bunyan
+ will be found here as familiar and easy in style as
+ "Cinderella" or "The Three Bears." True enough, the first word
+ in "Classic Tales" may look somewhat alarming to the eyes of
+ youthful seekers after romance and adventure, but we challenge
+ them to turn to any one of these selections from immortal
+ masterpieces and not become spellbound and, moreover, impatient
+ for more. And, believing now that they have grown very much
+ interested in these famous books, of course we also believe
+ they want to learn something about them.</p>
+
+ <p>Following the order of our stories we must begin with "Don
+ Quixote." Its author wrote it under great difficulties and
+ distress; but one would never think so, as it is full of
+ laughable doings. When you read our selections you must not
+ think that Don Quixote was merely a silly old man, for indeed
+ he was a very noble gentleman and tried with all his might to
+ do what he believed to be his duty, and in no act of his life
+ was there ever a stain of dishonor or of meanness. As for his
+ queer fancies, you will find in your own experience that many
+ things are not as they seem.</p>
+
+ <p>Next comes one of Gulliver's voyages. Under all this account
+ of a tiny race of people there is fun poked at government and
+ its ministers. But we do not concern ourselves with such
+ matters&mdash;all we think about is the wonderful deeds of
+ Gulliver in the land of the Lilliputians. Do not think such
+ people are impossible, for did not Stanley, the explorer, find
+ in Africa a race of dwarfs so little that he called them
+ pygmies? And perhaps when some of our young readers grow up,
+ they, too, may discover small folks in the world.</p>
+
+ <p>In regard to the "Arabian Nights," from which we give you
+ three choice stories, you ought to know the way they came to be
+ told. Once upon a time, a Sultan of Arabia thought that all
+ women were of not much use, so every day he married a new wife,
+ and before twenty-four hours were over he ordered that she have
+ her head cut off. One brave woman thought of a clever plan by
+ which she could end this cruelty. She went to the palace and
+ offered to marry the Sultan, and that night she began to tell
+ him such fascinating stories that when morning came he still
+ wished to hear more. He commanded that she should not be
+ beheaded until all her stories were told. Then for a thousand
+ and one nights, night after night, she gave him fresh stories,
+ and by the end of that time the Sultan had fallen very much in
+ love with her. Naturally, they lived happily forever after.
+ Perhaps these three stories which we have selected will compel
+ you to seek out all the rest, and if you do, we are quite sure
+ you will not wonder that the brave lady won the heart of the
+ wicked Sultan and made him good.</p>
+
+ <p>From the "Iliad" and the "Odyssey" of Homer, we have given
+ you some soul-stirring happenings. Several thousand years ago
+ these stories were sung by a blind minstrel named Homer. Some
+ day you may read Homer's sublime poetry in the original Greek,
+ and the selections which we give you will help you to remember
+ the stories when you are struggling with that difficult
+ language.</p>
+
+ <p>Parts of the old favorite "Robinson Crusoe" follow the
+ Grecian tales, and we trust its simple language will make the
+ little ones love it more than ever. You will remember that
+ Defoe wrote this nearly two hundred years ago. Everybody liked
+ long stories in those days, but we have all heard children of
+ to-day ask when a somewhat lengthy book would end, no matter
+ how interesting, and many grown-ups are guilty of reading the
+ close of a story before they have gone very far in it. So with
+ that in mind we have put down in brief form most of Robinson
+ Crusoe's important adventures during his twenty-eight years on
+ the desert island.</p>
+
+ <p>Here we also give three splendid stories from Chaucer's
+ "Canterbury Tales," which were supposedly told to one another
+ by a party of pilgrims on their way to Canterbury. According to
+ our gentle author, who was one of them, they stopped over night
+ at a house in England called the Tabard Inn, and here they
+ passed the hours repeating fine stories. Afterward Chaucer
+ wrote these down in a book in quaint old English. One might
+ look at these words all day long and not know in the least what
+ what some of them meant, though they do hold such beautiful
+ tales.</p>
+
+ <p>Now about "Pilgrim's Progress." More than two hundred years
+ ago a tinker named John Bunyan was in jail, but one night this
+ poor man left his prison and wandered into the land of dreams.
+ There he saw wonderful sights and heard marvelous things, and
+ as there was no one to listen to his dream, John Bunyan wrote
+ it down, and had it made into a book. And this he called "The
+ Pilgrim's Progress." It was about the journey and adventures of
+ a pilgrim and his companions. In our version we have given most
+ of the dream, but when the boys and girls grow older they will
+ want to read it all in Bunyan's own language, and we hope this
+ account will lead them to do so.</p>
+
+ <p>Shakespeare is a magic name to grown-ups, but to children it
+ does not mean much. All they know is, that sometimes this name
+ is spelled on the back of one fat volume, sometimes on three,
+ sometimes on a dozen or more, but of the inside they know
+ almost nothing, and when they hear persons say that Shakespeare
+ is the greatest writer that ever lived, they wonder about it.
+ If they take down a volume containing one of his plays, they
+ think it very dull, but here in simple language we present the
+ stories of two of the most fairy-like and beautiful plays, as
+ retold for children by Charles and Mary Lamb.</p>
+
+ <p class="author">Daniel Edwin Wheeler.</p>
+
+ <h2>INTRODUCTION</h2>
+
+ <h3>II</h3>
+
+ <h3>OLD-FASHIONED STORIES</h3>
+
+ <p>There is much truth in the saying that "old things are best,
+ old books are best, old friends are best." We like to connect
+ in thought our best-loved books and our best-loved friends. A
+ good friend must have some of the wisdom of a good book, though
+ good books often talk to us with wisdom and also with humor and
+ courtesy greater than any living friend may show. "Sometimes we
+ think books are the best friends; they never interrupt or
+ contradict or criticise us."</p>
+
+ <p>Every year in our own country about ten thousand books are
+ published. Most of them die in early life. Three hundred years
+ from now every one of this year's ten thousand books will be
+ dead and forgotten, except possibly thirty or forty. The very
+ best books do not die young. The books written about three
+ hundred years ago that are read to-day&mdash;like Shakespeare's
+ plays&mdash;are as a rule the books that deserve to live
+ forever. And, "Gentle Reader," if you are wise you will see
+ <i>why</i> the old books are best: they are the wheat, and the
+ winds of time have blown only the chaff away.</p>
+
+ <p>Is it not strange that in the olden times so few poems or
+ books or stories were written for children? The "Iliad," the
+ stories of King Arthur, the "Canterbury Tales," and "Gulliver's
+ Travels" and "Robinson Crusoe," were written for men and
+ women.</p>
+
+ <p>But happily this is the children's age, and now nearly half
+ of all the books written are written for children. You must
+ remember, however, that all boys and girls are
+ children&mdash;in the eyes of the law&mdash;till they are
+ twenty-one years old.</p>
+
+ <p>We know a little boy who read last week a very modern story.
+ The book was bound in red cloth. It had a gilt top and very
+ modern pictures drawn by a great artist and printed in three or
+ four colors. How different from the books of one hundred years
+ ago, with their black covers and queer pictures!</p>
+
+ <p>This story read by the little New York boy last week has
+ been read by many little boys in Iowa, and by many little girls
+ in Georgia. It tells about an orphan boy who was "bound out" to
+ a farmer who treated him cruelly. He ran away to the Rocky
+ Mountain region, where he had many adventures with robbers and
+ Indians and blizzards. He was strong and heroic; he could shoot
+ straight and ride the swiftest horses, and nothing ever hurt
+ him very much.</p>
+
+ <p>This, as I have said, is a modern story. It does not tell
+ the reader to be truthful and good. It just tells him a story
+ of thrilling adventures and daring escapes from danger. But the
+ old-fashioned story is different; and now we are getting close
+ to our subject.</p>
+
+ <p>I will tell you all about the old-fashioned stories in a
+ moment; but I must remind you that these old stories were
+ written about a hundred years ago. They were usually written to
+ teach a moral lesson. Dear old John Aikin, or his sister Anna
+ Letitia Barbauld, or Maria Edgeworth, or Jane Taylor would say
+ some morning&mdash;at any rate, so it seems to me&mdash;"I will
+ write a story to-day to teach boys and girls to be
+ industrious." And so "Busy Idleness" was written. Or one of
+ these old authors would decide to write a story the main object
+ of which was to teach little girls not to be too curious, and
+ so "The Inquisitive Girl" was written. Both of these stories,
+ and many others equally good, are found in this volume.</p>
+
+ <p>I could really tell you many interesting things about these
+ old-fashioned stories but I will do something better&mdash;urge
+ you to read them yourself. They are quaint, delightful, and
+ entertaining stories, besides teaching a moral. You boys and
+ girls should read every one of them, and then read them again,
+ out loud, to your mothers or to anybody else who will
+ listen.</p>
+
+ <p>Among all the old-fashioned stories in this volume I find
+ only one that seems to me "really funny," and that is "Uncle
+ David's Nonsensical Story about the Giants and Fairies." Think
+ of a giant so tall that "he was obliged to climb up a ladder to
+ comb his own hair." But this bit of humor is not so good as a
+ very modern nonsense-story entitled "The Giant's Shoes," which
+ I read the other day, and from which the Managing Editor
+ permits me to quote this little passage:</p>
+
+ <p>"The Giant slept for three weeks at a time, and two days
+ after he woke his breakfast was brought to him, consisting of
+ bright brown horses sprinkled on his bread and butter. Besides
+ his boots, the Giant had a pair of shoes, and in one of them
+ his wife lived when she was at home; on other occasions she
+ lived in the other shoe. She was a sensible, practical kind of
+ woman, with two wooden legs and a clothes-horse, but in other
+ respects not rich. The wooden legs were kept pointed at both
+ ends, in order that if the Giant were dissatisfied with his
+ breakfast, he might pick up any stray people that were within
+ reach, using his wife as a fork; this annoyed the inhabitants
+ of the district, so that they built their church in a
+ southwesterly direction from the castle, behind the Giant's
+ back, that he might not be able to pick them up as they went
+ in. But those who stayed outside to play pitch-and-toss were
+ exposed to great danger and sufferings."</p>
+
+ <p class="author">
+ G.J.B.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page1"
+ id="page1"></a>[pg 1]</span>
+
+ <h2>CLASSIC TALES</h2>
+
+ <h3>DON QUIXOTE<br />
+ <br />
+ By MIGUEL CERVANTES</h3>
+
+ <h4>ADAPTED BY JOHN LANG</h4>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW DON QUIXOTE WAS KNIGHTED</h4>
+
+ <p>Some three or four hundred years ago, there lived in sunny
+ Spain an old gentleman named Quixada, who owned a house and a
+ small property near a village in La Mancha.</p>
+
+ <p>With him lived his niece, a housekeeper, and a man who
+ looked after Quixada's farm and his one old white horse, which,
+ though its master imagined it to be an animal of great strength
+ and beauty, was really as lean as Quixada himself and as broken
+ down as any old cab horse.</p>
+
+ <p>Quixada had nothing in the world to do in the shape of work,
+ and so, his whole time was taken up in reading old books about
+ knights and giants, and ladies shut up in enchanted castles by
+ wicked ogres. In time, so fond did he become of such tales that
+ he passed his days, and even the best part of his nights, in
+ reading them. His mind was so wholly taken up in this way that
+ at last he came to believe that he himself lived in a land of
+ giants and of ogres, and that it was his duty to ride forth on
+ his noble steed, to the rescue of unhappy Princesses.</p>
+
+ <p>In the lumber-room of Quixada's house there had lain, ever
+ since he was born, a rusty old suit of armor, which had
+ belonged to his great-grandfather. This was now got out, and
+ Quixada spent many days in polishing and putting it in
+ order.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page2"
+ id="page2"></a>[pg 2]</span>
+
+ <p>Unfortunately, there was no more than half of the helmet to
+ be found, and a knight cannot ride forth without a helmet.</p>
+
+ <p>So Quixada made the other half of strong pasteboard; and to
+ prove that it was strong enough, when finished, he drew his
+ sword and gave the helmet a great slash. Alas! a whole week's
+ work was ruined by that one stroke; the pasteboard flew into
+ pieces. This troubled Quixada sadly, but he set to work at once
+ and made another helmet of pasteboard, lining it with thin
+ sheets of iron, and it looked so well that, this time, he put
+ it to no test with his sword.</p>
+
+ <p>Now that his armor was complete, it occurred to him that he
+ must give his horse a name&mdash;every knight's horse should
+ have a good name&mdash;and after four days thought he decided
+ that "Rozinante" would best suit the animal.</p>
+
+ <p>Then, for himself, after eight days of puzzling, he resolved
+ that he should be called Don Quixote de la Mancha.</p>
+
+ <p>There was but one thing more. Every knight of olden time had
+ a lady, whom he called the Mistress of his Heart, whose glove
+ he wore in his helmet; and if anybody dared to deny that this
+ lady was the most beautiful woman in the whole world, then the
+ knight made him prove his words by fighting.</p>
+
+ <p>So it was necessary that Don Quixote should select some lady
+ as the Mistress of his Heart.</p>
+
+ <p>Near La Mancha there lived a stout country lass, for whom
+ some years before Don Quixote had had a kind of liking. Who,
+ therefore, could better take the place of Mistress of his
+ Heart? To whom could he better send the defeated knights and
+ ogres whom he was going out to fight? It was true that her
+ name. Aldonza Lorenzo, did not sound like that of a Princess or
+ lady of high birth; so he determined in future to call her
+ Dulcinea del Toboso. No Princess could have a sweeter name!</p>
+
+ <p>All being now ready, one morning Don Quixote got up before
+ daylight, and without saying a word to anybody, put on his
+ armor, took his sword, and spear, and shield, saddled
+ "Rozinante," and started on his search for adventures.</p>
+
+ <p>But before he had gone very far, a dreadful thought struck
+ him. He had not been knighted! Moreover, he had read in his
+ books that until a knight had done some great deed, he must
+ wear <span class="pagenum"><a name="page3" id="page3"></a>[pg
+ 3]</span> white armor, and be without any device or coat of
+ arms on his shield. What was to be done? He was so staggered by
+ this thought that he almost felt that he must turn back. But
+ then he remembered that he had read how adventurers were
+ sometimes knighted by persons whom they happened to meet on the
+ road. And as to his armor, why, he thought he might scour and
+ polish that till nothing could be whiter. So he rode on,
+ letting "Rozinante" take which road he pleased, that being, he
+ supposed, as good a way as any of looking for adventures.</p>
+
+ <p>All day he rode, to his sorrow without finding anything
+ worth calling an adventure.</p>
+
+ <p>At last as evening began to fall, and when he and his horse
+ were both very weary, they came in sight of an inn. Don Quixote
+ no sooner saw the inn than he fancied it to be a great castle,
+ and he halted at some distance from it, expecting that, as in
+ days of old, a dwarf would certainly appear on the battlements,
+ and, by sounding a trumpet, give notice of the arrival of a
+ knight. But no dwarf appeared, and as "Rozinante" showed great
+ haste to reach the stable, Don Quixote began to move towards
+ the inn.</p>
+
+ <p>At this moment it happened that a swineherd in a field near
+ at hand sounded his horn to bring his herd of pigs home to be
+ fed. Don Quixote, imagining that this must be the dwarf at last
+ giving notice of his coming, rode quickly up to the inn door,
+ beside which it chanced that there stood two very impudent
+ young women, whom the Knight imagined to be two beautiful
+ ladies taking the air at the castle gate.</p>
+
+ <p>Astonished at the sight of so strange a figure, and a little
+ frightened, the girls turned to run away. But Don Quixote
+ stopped them.</p>
+
+ <p>"I beseech ye, ladies, do not fly," he said. "I will harm no
+ one, least of all maidens of rank so high as yours."</p>
+
+ <p>And much more he said, whereat the young women laughed so
+ loud and so long that Don Quixote became very angry, and there
+ is no saying what he might not have done had not the innkeeper
+ at that moment come out. This innkeeper was very fat and
+ good-natured, and anxious not to offend anybody, but even he
+ could hardly help laughing when he saw Don Quixote.
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page4" id="page4"></a>[pg
+ 4]</span> However, he very civilly asked the Knight to dismount
+ and offered him everything that the inn could provide.</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote being by this time both tired and hungry, with
+ some difficulty got off his horse and handed it to the
+ innkeeper (to whom he spoke as governor of the castle), asking
+ him to take the greatest care of "Rozinante," for in the whole
+ world there was no better steed.</p>
+
+ <p>When the landlord returned from the stable, he found Don
+ Quixote in a room, where, with the help of the two young women,
+ he was trying to get rid of his armor. His back and
+ breastplates had been taken off, but by no means could his
+ helmet be removed without cutting the green ribbons with which
+ he had tied it on, and this the Knight would not allow.</p>
+
+ <p>There was nothing for it, therefore, but to keep his helmet
+ on all night, and to eat and drink in it, which was more than
+ he could do without help. However, one of the young women fed
+ him, and the innkeeper having made a kind of funnel, through it
+ poured the wine into his mouth, and Don Quixote ate his supper
+ in great peace of mind.</p>
+
+ <p>There was but one thing that still vexed him. He had not yet
+ been knighted.</p>
+
+ <p>On this subject he thought long and deeply, and at last he
+ asked the innkeeper to come with him to the stable. Having shut
+ the door, Don Quixote threw himself at the landlord's feet,
+ saying, "I will never rise from this place, most valorous
+ Knight, until you grant me a boon."</p>
+
+ <p>The innkeeper was amazed, but as he could not by any means
+ make Don Quixote rise, he promised to do whatever was
+ asked.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then, noble sir," said Don Quixote, "the boon which I crave
+ is that to-morrow you will be pleased to grant me the honor of
+ knighthood."</p>
+
+ <p>The landlord, when he heard such talk, thought that the
+ wisest thing he could do was to humor his guest, and he readily
+ promised. Thereupon Don Quixote very happily rose to his feet,
+ and after some further talk he said to the innkeeper that this
+ night he would "watch his armor" in the chapel of the castle,
+ it being the duty of any one on whom the honor of knighthood
+ was to be conferred, to stand on his feet in the chapel,
+ praying, <span class="pagenum"><a name="page5"
+ id="page5"></a>[pg 5]</span> until the morning. The innkeeper,
+ thinking that great sport might come of this, encouraged Don
+ Quixote, but as his own chapel had lately&mdash;so he
+ said&mdash;been pulled down in order that a better might be
+ built, he advised Don Quixote to watch that night in the
+ courtyard. This was "lawful in a case where a chapel was not at
+ hand. And in the morning," he said, "I will knight you."</p>
+
+ <p>"Have you any money?" then asked the innkeeper.</p>
+
+ <p>"Not a penny," said Don Quixote, "for I never yet read of
+ any knight who carried money with him."</p>
+
+ <p>"You are greatly mistaken," answered the innkeeper. "Most
+ knights had squires, who carried their money and clean shirts
+ and other things. But when a knight had no squire, he always
+ carried his money and his shirts, and salve for his wounds, in
+ a little bag behind his saddle. I must therefore advise you
+ never in future to go anywhere without money."</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote promised to remember this. Then taking his
+ armor, he went into the inn yard and laid it in a
+ horse-trough.</p>
+
+ <p>Backwards and forwards, spear in hand, he marched in the
+ moonlight, very solemnly keeping his eyes on his armor, while
+ the innkeeper's other guests, laughing, looked on from a
+ distance.</p>
+
+ <p>Now it happened that a carrier who lodged at the inn came
+ into the yard to water his mules, and this he could not do
+ while the armor lay in the horse-trough. As Don Quixote saw the
+ man come up, "Take heed, rash Knight," he cried. "Defile not by
+ a touch the armor of the most brave knight-errant that ever
+ wore a sword."</p>
+
+ <p>But the mule-driver took no notice of Don Quixote. He picked
+ up the armor and threw it away.</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote no sooner saw this than, raising his eyes to
+ heaven, and calling on his Lady Dulcinea del Toboso, he lifted
+ up his spear with both hands and gave the mule-driver such a
+ whack over the head that the man fell down senseless. Then,
+ picking up his armor and putting it back in the horse-trough,
+ he went on with his march, taking no further notice of the poor
+ mule-driver.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon up came another carrier who also wanted to water his
+ mules.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page6"
+ id="page6"></a>[pg 6]</span>
+
+ <p>Not a word did Don Quixote say this time, but he lifted up
+ his spear and smote so heavily that he broke the man's head in
+ three or four places. The poor wretch made such an outcry that
+ all the people in the inn came running, and the friends of the
+ two carriers began to pelt Don Quixote with stones. But drawing
+ his sword, and holding his shield in front of him, he defied
+ them all, crying, "Come on, base knaves! Draw nearer if you
+ dare!"</p>
+
+ <p>The landlord now came hurrying up and stopped the
+ stone-throwing; then, having calmed Don Quixote, he said that
+ there was no need for him to watch his armor any longer; to
+ finish the ceremony it would now be enough if he were touched
+ on the neck and shoulders with a sword. Don Quixote was quite
+ satisfied, and prayed the innkeeper to get the business over as
+ quickly as possible, "for," said he, "if I were but knighted,
+ and should see myself attacked, I believe that I should not
+ leave a man alive in this castle."</p>
+
+ <p>The innkeeper, a good deal alarmed at this, and anxious to
+ get rid of him, hurried off and got the book in which he kept
+ his accounts, which he pretended was a kind of book of prayer.
+ Having also brought the two young women, and a boy to hold a
+ candle, he ordered Don Quixote to kneel. Then muttering from
+ his book, as if he were reading, he finished by giving Don
+ Quixote a good blow on the neck, and a slap on the back, with
+ the flat of a sword. After this, one of the young women belted
+ the sword round the newly made knight's waist, while the other
+ buckled on his spurs, and having at once saddled "Rozinante."
+ Don Quixote was ready to set out.</p>
+
+ <p>The innkeeper was only too glad to see him go, even without
+ paying for his supper.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/6.jpg" name="fig6s"
+ id="fig6s"><img width="300" src="images/6s.jpg"
+ alt="'PAY AT ONCE, YOU SCOUNDREL'" /></a><br />
+ "pay at once, you scoundrel"
+ </div>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW DON QUIXOTE RESCUED ANDRES; AND HOW HE RETURNED
+ HOME</h4>
+
+ <p>As he rode along in the early morning light, Don Quixote
+ began to think that it would be well that he should return home
+ for a little, there to lay in a stock of money and of clean
+ shirts, <span class="pagenum"><a name="page7"
+ id="page7"></a>[pg 7]</span> and he turned his willing horse's
+ head in the direction of his village.</p>
+
+ <p>But ere he had gone far on his way, coming from a thicket he
+ fancied that he heard cries of distress.</p>
+
+ <p>"Certainly these are the moans of some poor creature in want
+ of help," thought Don Quixote. "I thank Heaven for so soon
+ giving me the chance to perform my duty as a knight."</p>
+
+ <p>And he rode quickly towards the sounds. No sooner had he
+ reached the wood than he saw a horse tied to a tree, and bound
+ to another was a lad of fifteen, all naked above the waist. By
+ his side stood a countryman beating him with a strap, and with
+ every blow calling out, "I'll teach you to keep your eyes open,
+ you young scamp. I'll teach you to keep your mouth shut."</p>
+
+ <p>The boy howled with pain. Quickly Don Quixote rode up to the
+ man.</p>
+
+ <p>"Sir Knight," said he angrily, "I would have thee to know
+ that it is an unworthy act to strike one who cannot defend
+ himself. Mount thy steed, therefore, take thy spear, and I will
+ teach thee that thou art a coward."</p>
+
+ <p>The countryman gave himself up for lost, and he gasped out
+ very humbly that the boy was his servant, through whose
+ carelessness many of the sheep that he should have watched had
+ been lost, and that therefore he was giving him a sound
+ beating. "And," said he, "because I beat him for his
+ carelessness, he says I do it to cheat him out of his
+ wages."</p>
+
+ <p>"What!" shouted Don Quixote, "do you dare to lie to me? By
+ the sun above us, I have a mind to run you through with my
+ spear. Pay the boy this instant, and let him go free. What does
+ he owe you, boy?"</p>
+
+ <p>The boy said that the man owed him nine months' wages.</p>
+
+ <p>"Pay at once, you scoundrel, unless you want to be killed,"
+ roared Don Quixote.</p>
+
+ <p>The poor man, trembling with fear, said that there was a
+ mistake; he did not owe nearly so much, and besides, he had no
+ money with him. But if Andres would go home with him he would
+ pay every penny.</p>
+
+ <p>"Go home with him!" cried the boy. "I know a trick
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page8" id="page8"></a>[pg
+ 8]</span> worth two of that. No sooner will he have me home
+ than he'll take the skin off me. No, no, not I!"</p>
+
+ <p>"He will not dare to touch you," said the Knight. "I command
+ him, and that is enough. If he swears by his order of
+ knighthood to do this thing, I will let him go, and he will pay
+ you your wages."</p>
+
+ <p>"Of course I will," said the man. "Come along with me.
+ Andres, and I swear I'll give you all I owe."</p>
+
+ <p>"Remember, then, what you have promised, for I am Don
+ Quixote de la Mancha, the righter of wrongs, and it is at your
+ peril to disobey me."</p>
+
+ <p>So saying, Don Quixote clapped spurs to his horse, and
+ galloped off through the trees.</p>
+
+ <p>The countryman watched till the Knight was out of sight.
+ Then, turning, he said "Come, my lad, and I'll pay thee what I
+ owe, and more."</p>
+
+ <p>"Ay," answered the boy, "see that you do, for if you do not,
+ that brave man will come back and make you."</p>
+
+ <p>"I dare swear that," said the man. "And just to show how
+ much I love you, I am going to increase the debt, so that I may
+ pay you more. Come here!"</p>
+
+ <p>And with that he caught the boy by the arm, tied him again
+ to the tree, and belted him till his arm was tired.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now go," he said, "and tell your righter of wrongs. I wish
+ I had flayed you alive, you young whelp."</p>
+
+ <p>And so ended Don Quixote's first attempt to right
+ wrongs.</p>
+
+ <p>As the Knight cantered along, very well pleased with
+ himself, about two miles from where he had freed the boy he saw
+ riding towards him six men, each shading himself under a large
+ umbrella. With them were four mounted servants, and three on
+ foot.</p>
+
+ <p>No sooner did Don Quixote see this party than it struck him
+ that here was the chance for which, above all others, he had
+ been longing.</p>
+
+ <p>Posting himself in the middle of the road, he waited till
+ the men were at no great distance. Then, "Halt!" shouted he.
+ "Let all know that no man shall pass further till he owns that
+ in the whole world there is no damsel more beautiful than the
+ peerless Dulcinea del
+ Toboso."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page9"
+ id="page9"></a>[pg 9]</span>
+
+ <p>"But," said the men (who were merchants of Toledo, on their
+ way to buy silks), "we do not know the lady. We have never seen
+ her. How then can we say that she is beautiful?"</p>
+
+ <p>"What!" roared Don Quixote in a terrible rage, "not know the
+ beauteous Lady Dulcinea del Toboso! That only makes matters
+ worse. Do you dare to argue?"</p>
+
+ <p>And with that he couched his spear, drove his spurs into
+ "Rozinante," and rode furiously at the nearest merchant.</p>
+
+ <p>What he would have done it is not possible to say. But as he
+ galloped, it chanced that "Rozinante" stumbled and fell
+ heavily, rolling Don Quixote over and over. There the Knight
+ lay helpless, the weight of his armor preventing him from
+ rising to his feet. But as he lay, he continued to cry out at
+ the top of his voice, "Stop, you rascals! Do not fly. It is my
+ horse's fault that I lie here, you cowards!"</p>
+
+ <p>One of the grooms, hearing his master called a rascal and a
+ coward, thereupon ran up and snatched away Don Quixote's spear,
+ which he broke in pieces. Then with each piece he belabored the
+ poor Knight till the broken lance flew into splinters. The
+ merchants then rode away, leaving Don Quixote lying where he
+ fell, still shouting threats, but quite unable to rise.</p>
+
+ <p>There he was found by a man who knew him well, and who with
+ great difficulty mounted him on his donkey and took him home.
+ When at last they reached Don Quixote's house, the poor Knight
+ was put to bed, where he lay for many days, raving, and very
+ ill.</p>
+
+ <p>During this time the Curate of the village and the Barber
+ came and burned nearly all the books which Don Quixote had so
+ loved.</p>
+
+ <p>"For," said they, "it is by reading these books that the
+ poor gentleman has lost his mind, and if he reads them again he
+ will never get better."</p>
+
+ <p>So a bonfire was made of the books, and the door of Don
+ Quixote's study was bricked up.</p>
+
+ <p>When the Knight was again able to go about, he made at once
+ for his study and his beloved books. Up and down the house he
+ searched without saying a word, and often he would stand where
+ the door of the study used to be, feeling with his
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page10" id="page10"></a>[pg
+ 10]</span> hands and gazing about. At last he asked his
+ housekeeper to show him the study.</p>
+
+ <p>"Study!" cried the woman, "what study? There is no study in
+ this house now, nor any books."</p>
+
+ <p>"No," said his niece. "When you were away, a famous
+ enchanter came along, mounted on a dragon, and he went into
+ your study. What he did there we know not. But after a time he
+ flew out of the roof, leaving the house full of smoke, and ever
+ since then we have not been able to find either books or
+ study."</p>
+
+ <p>"Ha!" said Don Quixote. "That must have been Freston. He is
+ a famous enchanter, and my bitter enemy. But when I am again
+ well I shall get the better of him."</p>
+
+ <h4>III</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW DON QUIXOTE AND SANCHO PANZA STARTED ON THEIR SEARCH
+ FOR ADVENTURES; AND HOW DON QUIXOTE FOUGHT WITH THE
+ WINDMILLS</h4>
+
+ <p>For some weeks the poor Knight stayed very quietly at home.
+ But he had not forgotten the things for which he had come back
+ to his village.</p>
+
+ <p>There was a farm laborer who lived near by, a fat,
+ good-natured, simple man. To him Don Quixote talked long and
+ often, and made many promises; among others that if he would
+ but come with him as squire, he should be made governor of any
+ island which the Knight might happen to conquer during his
+ search after adventures.</p>
+
+ <p>This seemed so grand a thing to the man (whose name was
+ Sancho Panza), that he willingly promised to come.</p>
+
+ <p>Having got together some money, and having made other
+ preparations, Don Quixote and Sancho Panza one dark night stole
+ out of the village without a word to any one, and began their
+ adventures.</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote rode "Rozinante;" Sancho Panza was mounted on an
+ ass. That his squire should ride an ass at first troubled the
+ Knight not a little, for in none of his books could he remember
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page11" id="page11"></a>[pg
+ 11]</span> to have read of any squire being so mounted.
+ However, he gave Sancho leave to bring the ass, thinking that
+ in no great time a better mount would surely be found for
+ him.</p>
+
+ <p>As they rode along in the cool of the morning, Sancho Panza
+ spoke to his master about their journey, and asked him to be
+ sure not to forget his promise about the governorship of the
+ island.</p>
+
+ <p>"It may even happen," answered Don Quixote, "that I may by
+ some strange chance conquer a kingdom. And then presently, I
+ may be able to crown thee King."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why," said Sancho, "if by some such miracle as your worship
+ speaks of, I am made a King, then would my wife be Queen?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Certainly," answered Don Quixote, "who can doubt it?"</p>
+
+ <p>"I doubt it," replied Sancho, "for I think if it should rain
+ kingdoms upon the face of the earth, not one of them would sit
+ well on my wife's head. For I must tell you, sir, she's not
+ worth two brass jacks to make a Queen of. No, no! countess will
+ be quite good enough; that's as much as she could well
+ manage."</p>
+
+ <p>"Nay," said Don Quixote, "leave the matter in the hands of
+ Providence, and be not tempted by anything less than the title
+ of Viceroy."</p>
+
+ <p>Thus talking, they came over the brow of a hill, and looking
+ down on the plain below, Don Quixote saw there thirty or forty
+ windmills.</p>
+
+ <p>"Ha!" cried he. "Fortune directs our affairs better than we
+ ourselves could do. Look yonder, friend Sancho, there are at at
+ least thirty outrageous giants whom I must now fight."</p>
+
+ <p>"Giants!" gasped Sancho Panza, "what giants?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Those whom you see over there with their long arms,"
+ answered Don Quixote. "Some of that horrible race, I have
+ heard, have arms near two leagues in length."</p>
+
+ <p>"But, sir," said Sancho, "these are no giants. They are only
+ windmills, and the things you think are arms are but their
+ sails, whereby the wind drives them."</p>
+
+ <p>"That is but a sign," answered Don Quixote, "whereby
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page12" id="page12"></a>[pg
+ 12]</span> one may see how little you know of adventures. I
+ tell you they are giants: and I shall fight against them all.
+ If you are afraid, go aside and say your prayers."</p>
+
+ <p>So saying, and without paying any heed to the bawlings of
+ Sancho Panza, he put spurs to his horse and galloped furiously
+ at the windmills, shouting aloud, "Stand, cowards! stand your
+ ground, and fly not from a single Knight."</p>
+
+ <p>Just at this moment the wind happened to rise, causing the
+ arms of the windmills to move.</p>
+
+ <p>"Base scoundrels!" roared the Knight, "though you wave as
+ many arms as the giant Briareus, you shall pay for your
+ pride."</p>
+
+ <p>And with couched lance, and covering himself with his
+ shield, he rushed "Rozinante" at top speed on the nearest
+ windmill. Round whirled the sails, and as Don Quixote's lance
+ pierced one of them, horse and man were sent rolling on the
+ ground. There Sancho Panza came to help his sorely bruised
+ master.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/12.jpg" name="fig12s"
+ id="fig12s"><img width="300" src="images/12s.jpg"
+ alt="HORSE AND MAN WERE SENT ROLLING ON THE GROUND" />
+ </a><br />
+ horse and man were sent rolling on the ground
+ </div>
+
+ <p>"Mercy o' me!" cried Sancho, "did not I tell you they were
+ windmills?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Peace, friend Sancho," answered Don Quixote. "It is the
+ fortune of war. I know very well it is that accursed wizard
+ Freston, the enemy who took from me my study and my books, who
+ has changed these giants into windmills to take from me the
+ honor of the victory. But in the end I shall yet surely get the
+ better of him."</p>
+
+ <p>"Amen! say I" quoth Sancho: and heaving the poor Knight on
+ to his legs, once more he got him seated on "Rozinante."</p>
+
+ <p>As they now rode along, it was a great sorrow to Don Quixote
+ that his spear had been broken to pieces in this battle with
+ the windmill.</p>
+
+ <p>"I have read," said he to Sancho, "that a certain Spanish
+ knight, having broken his sword in a fight, pulled up by the
+ roots a huge oak-tree, or at least tore down a great branch,
+ and with it did such wonderful deeds that he was ever after
+ called 'The Bruiser.' I tell you this because I intend to tear
+ up the next oak-tree we meet, and you may think yourself
+ fortunate that you will see the deeds I shall perform with
+ it."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page13"
+ id="page13"></a>[pg 13]</span>
+
+ <p>"Heaven grant you may!" said Sancho. "But, an' it please
+ you, sit a little more upright in your saddle; you are all to
+ one side. But that, mayhap, comes from your hurts?"</p>
+
+ <p>"It does so," answered Don Quixote, "and if I do not
+ complain of the pain, it is because a knight-errant must never
+ complain of his wounds, though they be killing him."</p>
+
+ <p>"I have no more to say," replied Sancho. "Yet Heaven knows I
+ should be glad to hear your honor complain a bit, now and then,
+ when something ails you. For my part, I always cry out when I'm
+ hurt, and I am glad the rule about not complaining doesn't
+ extend to squires."</p>
+
+ <p>That night they spent under the trees, from one of which Don
+ Quixote tore down a branch, to which he fixed the point of his
+ spear, and in some sort that served him for a lance. Don
+ Quixote neither ate nor slept all the night, but passed his
+ time, as he had learned from his books that a knight should do,
+ in thoughts of the Lady Dulcinea. As for Sancho Panza, he had
+ brought with him a big bottle of wine, and some food in his
+ wallet, and he stuffed himself as full as he could hold, and
+ slept like a top.</p>
+
+ <p>As they rode along next day, they came to the Pass of
+ Lapice.</p>
+
+ <p>"Here, Sancho," said Don Quixote, "is the spot where
+ adventures should begin. Now may we hope to thrust our hands,
+ as it were, up to the very elbows in adventures. But remember
+ this! However sore pressed and in danger I may be when fighting
+ with another knight, you must not offer to draw your sword to
+ help me. It is against the laws of chivalry for a squire to
+ attack a knight."</p>
+
+ <p>"Never fear me, master," said Sancho. "I'll be sure to obey
+ you; I have ever loved peace. But if a knight offers to set
+ upon me first, there is no rule forbidding me to hit him back,
+ is there?"</p>
+
+ <p>"None," answered Don Quixote, "only do not help me."</p>
+
+ <p>"I will not," said Sancho. "Never trust me if I don't keep
+ that commandment as well as I do the
+ Sabbath."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page14"
+ id="page14"></a>[pg 14]</span>
+
+ <h4>IV</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW DON QUIXOTE WON A HELMET; HOW HE FOUGHT WITH TWO
+ ARMIES; AND HOW SANCHO'S ASS WAS STOLEN</h4>
+
+ <p>Many were the adventures that now befell Don Quixote and
+ Sancho Panza. In the very first, wherein he fought with a man
+ from Biscay, whom he left lying in a pool of blood, Don Quixote
+ lost part of his helmet, and had the half of one of his ears
+ sliced off by the Biscayan's sword. The accident to the helmet
+ was a great grief to him, and he swore an oath that until he
+ had taken from some other knight as good a helmet as that which
+ was now made useless to him, he would never again eat his food
+ on a table-cloth.</p>
+
+ <p>One day as they rode along a highway between two villages
+ Don Quixote halted and looked eagerly at something.</p>
+
+ <p>"Sancho," said he, "dost thou not see yonder knight that
+ comes riding this way on a dapple-gray steed, with a helmet of
+ gold on his head?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Not a thing can I see," answered Sancho, "but a fellow on
+ just such another ass as mine, with something that glitters on
+ top of his head."</p>
+
+ <p>"Can you not see," asked Don Quixote, "that it is a helmet?
+ Do you stand back, and let me deal with him. Soon now shall I
+ possess myself of the helmet that I need."</p>
+
+ <p>Now, in those far-away days, when doctors were few, if
+ anybody needed to be bled for a fever or any other illness (for
+ it was then thought that "letting blood" was the cure for most
+ illnesses), it was the custom for the barber to bleed the sick
+ person. For the purpose of catching the blood that ran from a
+ vein when it had been cut, a brass dish was carried, a dish
+ with part of it cut away from one side, so that it might the
+ more easily be held close to the patient's arm or body. A small
+ dish like this you may sometimes still see hanging as a sign at
+ the end of a pole outside barbers' shops. Barbers in those days
+ of old were called barber-surgeons, for the reason that they
+ bled people, as well as shaved them or cut their
+ hair.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page15"
+ id="page15"></a>[pg 15]</span>
+
+ <p>And the truth of the matter was this, that the man whom Don
+ Quixote now believed to be a knight, wearing a golden helmet,
+ was a barber riding on his ass to bleed a sick man. And because
+ it was raining, he had put his brass dish on his head, in order
+ to keep his new hat from being spoiled.</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote did not wait to speak to the man, but, couching
+ his lance, galloped at him as hard as "Rozinante" could go,
+ shouting as he rode, "Defend thyself, base wretch!"</p>
+
+ <p>The barber no sooner saw this terrible figure charging down
+ on him, than, to save himself from being run through, he flung
+ himself on to the ground, and then jumping to his feet, ran for
+ his life, leaving his ass and the brass basin behind him. Then
+ Don Quixote ordered Sancho to pick up the helmet.</p>
+
+ <p>"O' my word," said Sancho, as he gave it to his master, "it
+ is a fine basin."</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote at once put it on his head, saying, "It is a
+ famous helmet, but the head for which it was made must have
+ been of great size. The worst of it is that at least one-half
+ of it is gone. What is the fool grinning at now?" he cried, as
+ Sancho laughed.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, master," answered Sancho, "it is a barber's
+ basin."</p>
+
+ <p>"It has indeed some likeness to a basin," said Don Quixote,
+ "but I tell you it is an enchanted helmet of pure gold, and for
+ the sake of a little wretched money some one has melted down
+ the half of it. When we come to a town where there is an
+ armorer, I will have it altered to fit my head. Meantime I
+ shall wear it as it is."</p>
+
+ <p>As they rode along one day talking of many things, Don
+ Quixote beheld a cloud of dust rising right before them.</p>
+
+ <p>"Seest thou that cloud of dust, Sancho?" he asked. "It is
+ raised by a great army marching this way."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, master," said Sancho, "there must be two armies there,
+ for yonder is just such another cloud of dust."</p>
+
+ <p>The knight looked, and was overjoyed, believing that two
+ armies were about to meet and fight in the plain.</p>
+
+ <p>"What are we to do, master?" asked Sancho.</p>
+
+ <p>"Do!" said Don Quixote, "why, what can we do but help the
+ weaker side? Look yonder, Sancho, that knight whom thou
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page16" id="page16"></a>[pg
+ 16]</span> seest in the gilded armory with a lion crouching at
+ the feet of a lady painted on his shield, that is the valiant
+ Laurcalco. That other, the giant on his right, Brandabarbaran."
+ And he ran over a long list of names of knights whom he
+ believed that he saw.</p>
+
+ <p>Sancho listened, as dumb as a fish; but at last he gasped.
+ "Why, master, you might as well tell me that it snows. Never a
+ knight, nor a giant, nor a man can I see."</p>
+
+ <p>"How!" answered Don Quixote, "canst thou not hear their
+ horses neigh, and their drums beating?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Drums!" said Sancho. "Not I! I hear only the bleating of
+ sheep."</p>
+
+ <p>"Since you are afraid," said the Knight, "stand aside, and I
+ will go by myself to fight."</p>
+
+ <p>With that, he galloped down on to the plain, shouting,
+ leaving Sancho bawling to him, "Hold, sir! Stop! For Heaven's
+ sake come back. As sure as I'm a sinner, they are only harmless
+ sheep. Come back, I say."</p>
+
+ <p>But Don Quixote, paying not the least heed, galloped on
+ furiously and charged into the middle of the sheep, spearing
+ them right and left, trampling the living and the dead under
+ "Rozinante's" feet. The shepherds, finding that he took no
+ notice of their shouts, now hurled stones at him from their
+ slings, and one big stone presently hit the Knight fair in his
+ ribs and doubled him up in the saddle.</p>
+
+ <p>Gasping for breath, with all speed Don Quixote got from his
+ wallet a bottle filled with a mixture he had made, a mixture
+ which he firmly believed to be a certain cure for all wounds.
+ Of this he took a long gulp, but just at that moment another
+ big stone hit him such a rap on the mouth that the bottle was
+ smashed into a thousand pieces, and half of his teeth were
+ knocked out.</p>
+
+ <p>Down dropped the Knight on the ground, and the shepherds
+ thinking that he was killed, ran away, taking with them seven
+ dead sheep which he had slain.</p>
+
+ <p>Sancho Panza found his master in a very bad way, with nearly
+ all the teeth gone from one side of his mouth, and with a
+ terrible pain under his
+ ribs.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page17"
+ id="page17"></a>[pg 17]</span>
+
+ <p>"Ah! master," he said, "I told you they were sheep. Why
+ would not you listen to me?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Sheep! Sancho. No, no! There is nothing so easy for a
+ wizard like Freston as to change things from one shape to the
+ other. I will wager if you now mount your ass and ride over the
+ hill after them, you will find no sheep there, but the knights
+ and squires come back to their own shape, and the armies
+ marching as when we first saw them."</p>
+
+ <p>Now, after this and many other adventures (about which,
+ perhaps, you may some day read for yourself), Don Quixote and
+ Sancho Panza rode away into the mountains, for the Knight was
+ sorely in need of a quiet place in which to rest.</p>
+
+ <p>So weary were he and his squire, that one night, when they
+ had ridden into a wood, and it chanced that the horse and the
+ ass stood still, both Don Quixote and Sancho Panza fell sound
+ asleep without even getting out of their saddles. There sat the
+ Knight, leaning on his lance; and Sancho, doubled over the
+ pommel, snored as loud as if he had been in a four-post feather
+ bed.</p>
+
+ <p>It happened that a wandering thief saw them as he
+ passed.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now," thought he, "I want something to ride upon, for I'm
+ tired of walking in these abominable mountains. Here's a chance
+ of a good ass. But how am I to get it, without waking its
+ master?"</p>
+
+ <p>Very quietly he cut four long sticks. One after the other he
+ placed these under each side of Sancho's saddle; then loosening
+ the girths, he gradually raised the sticks till the saddle was
+ clear of the animal's back.</p>
+
+ <p>Gently, in the moonlight, he led the tired ass away, and
+ Sancho, undisturbed, snored on.</p>
+
+ <p>When it was broad daylight, the squire awoke, and without
+ opening his eyes, stretched himself. Down fell the sticks; down
+ with a terrible bump fell Sancho.</p>
+
+ <p>"Body o' me!" he yelled, "where is my ass?" And with many
+ tears he searched high and low, but no ass was then to be
+ found, nor for many months afterwards. And how at last Sancho
+ got back the ass you must read for yourself in the History of
+ Don Quixote. For yourself, too, you must read of
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page18" id="page18"></a>[pg
+ 18]</span> Don Quixote's adventures in the mountains; how he
+ there did penance; and of many other things, till at last the
+ Curate and the Barber of La Mancha took him home in a cart
+ which the Knight believed to be an enchanted chariot.</p>
+
+ <h4>V</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW DON QUIXOTE SAW DULCINEA</h4>
+
+ <p>Now a third time did Don Quixote set off on his search for
+ adventures, and as he and Sancho Panza rode again away from
+ their village, it seemed to Don Quixote that certainly it was
+ his duty as a knight-errant to visit the Mistress of his Heart,
+ the beautiful Dulcinea.</p>
+
+ <p>It was midnight when they reached Toboso, and the whole town
+ was still, everybody in bed and asleep.</p>
+
+ <p>"Lead me to her palace, Sancho," said Don Quixote.</p>
+
+ <p>"Palace?" cried Sancho, "What palace do you mean? Body o'
+ me! When last I saw her, she lived in a little cottage in a
+ blind alley. And even if it were a palace, we can't go and
+ thunder at the door at this time o' night."</p>
+
+ <p>"When we find it, I will tell thee what to do. But, here!
+ What is this?" said the Knight, riding up to a huge building,
+ and knocking at the door. "This indeed, without doubt, must be
+ her palace."</p>
+
+ <p>But it was only the great Church of Toboso. Hunt as he
+ would, he found no Dulcinea's palace, and as morning began to
+ break, Sancho persuaded him to come and rest in a grove of
+ trees two miles outside the town. From there Sancho was again
+ sent to look for Dulcinea, bearing many messages from his
+ sorrowful master.</p>
+
+ <p>"Cheer up, sir," said Sancho. "I'll be back in a trice.
+ Don't be cast down. Faint heart never won fair lady."</p>
+
+ <p>And Sancho rode away, leaving the Knight sitting on his
+ horse, very full of melancholy. But he had not ridden far,
+ when, turning round and finding that his master was no longer
+ in sight, the squire dismounted, and lying down under a shady
+ tree, began to think the matter
+ over.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page19"
+ id="page19"></a>[pg 19]</span>
+
+ <p>"Friend Sancho," said he to himself, "what's this you are
+ doing?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, hunting for a Princess, who, my master says, is the
+ Sun of Beauty, and all sorts of other fine things, and who
+ lives in a King's palace, or great castle, somewhere or
+ other."</p>
+
+ <p>"And how are you going to find her?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, it's like looking for a needle in a bundle of hay, to
+ look for Dulcinea all over Toboso. My master's mad, there's no
+ doubt of that; and perhaps I'm not very much better, for they
+ say birds of a feather flock together. But if he's so mad as to
+ mistake windmills for giants, and flocks of sheep for armies,
+ why, it shouldn't be so very hard to make him believe that the
+ first country lass I meet is the Lady Dulcinea. If he won't
+ believe, I'll swear it, and stand to it, so that he'll think
+ some of those wicked wizards of his have played another trick
+ on him, and have changed her into some other shape just to
+ spite him."</p>
+
+ <p>Having thus settled his plans, Sancho lay there till the
+ evening, so that his master might think that all the day had
+ been spent in going to and from Toboso, and in looking for
+ Dulcinea.</p>
+
+ <p>As luck would have it, just as he mounted his ass to ride
+ back to Don Quixote, he spied coming that way three country
+ lasses mounted on asses. As soon as Sancho saw the girls, he
+ made haste to get to his master.</p>
+
+ <p>"What news, Sancho?" asked the Knight. "Has your fortune
+ been good?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Ay, marry has it, sir," answered Sancho, "you have no more
+ to do but to clap spurs to 'Rozinante' and get into the open
+ fields, and you'll meet my Lady Dulcinea del Toboso with two of
+ her damsels coming to see you."</p>
+
+ <p>"Blessed Heaven!" cried the Knight. "What do you say, my
+ dear Sancho? Is it possible?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Possible!" said Sancho. "Why should I play a trick on you?
+ Come, sir, and you will see her presently, all dressed up and
+ decked with jewels. Her damsels and she are all covered with
+ diamonds, and rubies, and cloth of gold. And what is more, they
+ are riding three flea-bitten gambling hags, the like of which
+ won't be seen again."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page20"
+ id="page20"></a>[pg 20]</span>
+
+ <p>"Ambling nags, thou meanest, Sancho," said Don Quixote.</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, well, master, gambling hags or ambling nags, it's all
+ one and the same thing. Any way, I'm sure I never set eyes on
+ more beautiful ladies than those that sit upon them."</p>
+
+ <p>"Let us be moving then, Sancho. And as a reward for your
+ good news, I promise you the very best things I get in our next
+ adventure. And if that is not enough, then I will give you the
+ three colts that I have at home in La Mancha."</p>
+
+ <p>"Thank you for the colts," said Sancho. "As for the other
+ things, I'm not sure that they will be worth so very much."</p>
+
+ <p>They were now out of the wood, and could see the three
+ country lasses at a little distance.</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote looked long towards Toboso, but seeing no one
+ anywhere but these girls, he was much troubled in his mind, and
+ asked Sancho if he were sure that the Princess had left the
+ city.</p>
+
+ <p>"Left the city!" cried Sancho. "Why where are your eyes,
+ sir? In the name of wonder, do you not see her and her maidens
+ coming towards us now, as bright as the sun at midday?"</p>
+
+ <p>"I see nothing, Sancho, but three country wenches riding on
+ asses."</p>
+
+ <p>"Now Heaven help me," cried Sancho, "is it possible that you
+ can mistake three what do you call 'ems&mdash;ambling nags as
+ white as snow, for three asses! Pull my beard out by the roots
+ if it is not so."</p>
+
+ <p>"Believe me, Sancho, they are asses."</p>
+
+ <p>"Come, sir," answered Sancho, "do but clear your eyes, and
+ go and speak to the Mistress of your Heart, for she is near you
+ now."</p>
+
+ <p>So saying, Sancho hurried up to one of the girls, and,
+ jumping off his ass, fell on his knees before her, gabbling a
+ lot of nonsense.</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote followed, and also knelt down, gazing with
+ doubting and sorrowful eyes on the creature that Sancho had
+ told him was the beautiful Dulcinea. He was lost in wonder, for
+ she was a flat-nosed, blubber-cheeked, bouncing country girl,
+ and Don Quixote could not utter a word.</p>
+
+ <p>"Come! get out of the way," screamed the girl, "and let us
+ go about our business. We're in a
+ hurry."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page21"
+ id="page21"></a>[pg 21]</span>
+
+ <p>"Rise, Sancho," said Don Quixote when he heard the girl's
+ voice. "I am now convinced that misfortune has not yet finished
+ with me. O most beautiful lady! a spiteful enchanter puts mists
+ before my eyes, and hides from me your loveliness."</p>
+
+ <p>"My grandmother take him!" cried the girl. "Listen to his
+ gibberish! Get out of the way, and let us alone." And kicking
+ her donkey in the ribs, she galloped away with her friends. Don
+ Quixote followed them long with his eyes.</p>
+
+ <p>"O the spite of those wicked enchanters!" he sighed, "to
+ turn my beautiful Dulcinea into so vile a shape as that: to
+ take from her the sweet and delicate scent of fragrant flowers,
+ and give to her what she has. For, to tell the truth, Sancho,
+ she gave me such a whiff of raw onions that it was like to
+ upset me altogether."</p>
+
+ <p>"O the vile and evil-minded enchanters!" cried Sancho. "Oh
+ that I might see the lot of you threaded on one string, and
+ hung up in the smoke like so many herrings." And Sancho turned
+ away to hide his laughter.</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote rode on, very sad, and letting "Rozinante" go
+ where he pleased.</p>
+
+ <h4>VI</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW DON QUIXOTE FOUGHT WITH A LION; AND HOW HE DEFEATED THE
+ MOORS</h4>
+
+ <p>As Don Quixote and Sancho Panza went along, they were
+ overtaken by a gentleman in a fine green coat, who rode a very
+ good mare. This gentleman stared very hard at Don Quixote, and
+ the two began to speak together about knight-errantry, and were
+ so interested in what they were saying, that Sancho took the
+ opportunity of riding over to ask for a little milk from some
+ shepherds, who were milking their ewes near at hand.</p>
+
+ <p>While he was thus away from his master, a wagon, on top of
+ which fluttered little yellow and red flags, came along the
+ road towards them. Don Quixote at once imagined this to be some
+ new adventure, and he called to Sancho for his helmet. At
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page22" id="page22"></a>[pg
+ 22]</span> the moment, Sancho was bargaining with the shepherds
+ for some curds. Hearing his master call, he had not time to
+ wait till the shepherds could give him a bowl in which to carry
+ them, and not wishing to lose his bargain (for he had paid the
+ shepherds), he poured the curds into the Knight's helmet, and
+ galloped off to see what his master wanted.</p>
+
+ <p>"Give me my helmet," said Don Quixote, "for if I know
+ anything of my business, here is an adventure for which I must
+ be ready."</p>
+
+ <p>The gentleman in green, hearing what Don Quixote said,
+ looked everywhere, but he could see nothing except the wagon
+ coming towards them, and as that had on it the King of Spain's
+ colors, he thought that no doubt it was one of his Majesty's
+ treasure-vans. He said as much to Don Quixote, but the Knight
+ answered: "Sir, I cannot tell when, or where, or in what shape,
+ my enemies will attack me. It is always wise to be ready.
+ Fore-warned is fore-armed. Give me my helmet, Sancho!"</p>
+
+ <p>Snatching it out of Sancho's unwilling hands, he clapped it
+ on his head without looking into it.</p>
+
+ <p>"What is this, Sancho?" he cried, as the whey ran down his
+ face. "What is the matter with me? Is my brain melting, or am I
+ breaking out in a cold sweat? If I am, it is not from fear.
+ This must be a dreadful adventure that is coming. Quick.
+ Sancho! give me something to wipe away the torrent of sweat,
+ for I am almost blinded."</p>
+
+ <p>Without a word, Sancho handed to his master a cloth. Don
+ Quixote dried himself, and then took off his helmet to see what
+ it was that felt so cold on his head.</p>
+
+ <p>"What is this white stuff?" said he, putting some of the
+ curds to his nose. "Sancho, you vile traitor, you have been
+ putting curds in my helmet!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Curds!&mdash;I?" cried Sancho. "Nay, the devil must have
+ put them there. Would I dare to make such a mess in your
+ helmet, sir? It must have been one of those vile enchanters.
+ Where could I get curds? I would sooner put them in my stomach
+ than in your helmet."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, that's true, I dare say," said Don Quixote. "There's
+ something in that."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page23"
+ id="page23"></a>[pg 23]</span>
+
+ <p>Then again he put on the helmet, and made ready for the
+ adventure.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now come what may, I dare meet it," he cried.</p>
+
+ <p>The wagon had now come near to them. On top was seated a
+ man, and the driver rode one of the mules that drew it. Don
+ Quixote rode up.</p>
+
+ <p>"Whither go ye, my friends?" said he. "What wagon is this,
+ and what have you in it? What is the meaning of the flags?"</p>
+
+ <p>"The wagon is mine," said the driver, "and I have in it a
+ lion that is being sent to the King, and the flags are flying
+ to let the people know that it is the King's property."</p>
+
+ <p>"A lion!" cried Don Quixote, "Is it a large one?"</p>
+
+ <p>"The biggest I ever saw," said the man on top of the wagon.
+ "I am the keeper, and I have had charge of many lions, but I
+ never saw one so large as this. Pray get out of the way, sir,
+ for we must hurry on to our stopping-place. It is already past
+ his feeding-time; he is beginning to get hungry, and they are
+ always savage when they are hungry."</p>
+
+ <p>"What!" cried Don Quixote, "lion whelps against me! I'll let
+ those gentlemen know who send lions this way, that I am not to
+ be scared by any of their lions. So, Mr. Keeper, just jump down
+ and open his cage, and let him out. In spite of all the
+ enchanters in the world that have sent him to try me, I'll let
+ the animal see who Don Quixote de la Mancha is."</p>
+
+ <p>Up ran Sancho to the gentleman in green.</p>
+
+ <p>"O good, dear sir," he cried, "don't let my master get at
+ the lion, or we shall all be torn to pieces."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why," said the gentleman, "is your master so mad that you
+ fear he'll set upon such a dangerous brute."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh no, sir, he's not mad; he's only rash, very, very rash,"
+ cried Sancho.</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," said the gentleman, "I'll see to it," and up he went
+ to Don Quixote, who was trying to get the keeper to open the
+ cage.</p>
+
+ <p>"Sir," said he, "knight-errants ought not to engage in
+ adventures from which there is no hope of coming off in safety.
+ That is more like madness than courage. Besides, this is the
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page24" id="page24"></a>[pg
+ 24]</span> King's wagon; it will never do to stop that. And
+ after all, the lion has not been sent against you; it is a
+ present to the King."</p>
+
+ <p>"Pray, sir," cried Don Quixote, "will you attend to your own
+ business? This is mine, and I know best whether this lion has
+ been sent against me or not. Now you, sir," he cried to the
+ keeper, "either open that cage at once, or I'll pin you to your
+ wagon with my spear."</p>
+
+ <p>"For mercy's sake, sir," cried the driver, "do but let me
+ take my mules out of harm's way before the lion gets out. My
+ cart and my mules are all I have in the world, and I shall be
+ ruined if harm comes to them."</p>
+
+ <p>"Take them out quickly, then," said Don Quixote, "and take
+ them where you please."</p>
+
+ <p>On this the driver made all the haste he could to unharness
+ his mules, while the keeper called aloud, "Take notice,
+ everybody, that it is against my will that I am forced to let
+ loose the lion, and that this gentleman here is to blame for
+ all the damage that will be done. Get out of the way,
+ everybody: look out for yourselves."</p>
+
+ <p>Once more the gentleman in green tried to persuade Don
+ Quixote not to be so foolish, but the Knight only said, "I know
+ very well what I am doing. If you are afraid, and do not care
+ to see the fight, just put spurs to your mare and take yourself
+ where you think you will be safe."</p>
+
+ <p>Sancho now hurried up, and with tears in his eyes begged his
+ master not to put himself in so great danger, but Don Quixote
+ only said, "Take yourself away, Sancho, and leave me alone. If
+ I am killed, go, as I have so often told you, to the beautiful
+ Dulcinea, and tell her&mdash;you know what to tell her."</p>
+
+ <p>The gentleman in green, finding that words were thrown away
+ on Don Quixote, now quickly followed the driver, who had
+ hastily taken his mules as far away as he could beyond the brow
+ of the hill. Sancho hurried after them at the top speed of his
+ ass, kicking him in the ribs all the while to make him go even
+ faster, and loudly bewailing his master's coming death. The
+ keeper made one more attempt to turn Don Quixote from his
+ folly, but again finding it useless, very unwillingly opened
+ the cage door.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page25"
+ id="page25"></a>[pg 25]</span>
+
+ <p>Meantime the Knight had been thinking whether it would be
+ best to fight the lion on foot or on horseback, and he had made
+ up his mind to fight on foot, for the reason that "Rozinante"
+ would probably be too much afraid to face the lion. So he got
+ off his horse, drew his sword, and holding his shield in front
+ of him, marched slowly up to the cage. The keeper, having
+ thrown the door wide open, now quickly got himself out of
+ harm's way.</p>
+
+ <p>The lion, seeing the cage open, and Don Quixote standing in
+ front, turned round and stretched out his great paws. Then he
+ opened his enormous mouth, and, letting out a tongue as long as
+ a man's arm, licked the dust off his face. Now rising to his
+ feet, he thrust his head out of the door and glared around with
+ eyes like burning coals.</p>
+
+ <p>It was a sight to make any man afraid; but Don Quixote
+ calmly waited for the animal to jump out and come within reach
+ of his sword.</p>
+
+ <p>The lion looked at him for a moment with its great yellow
+ eyes&mdash;then, slowly turning, it strolled to the back of the
+ cage, gave a long, weary yawn, and lay quietly down.</p>
+
+ <p>"Force him to come out," cried Don Quixote to the keeper,
+ "beat him."</p>
+
+ <p>"Not I," said the man. "I dare not for my life. He would
+ tear me to pieces. And let me advise you, sir, to be content
+ with your day's work. I beseech you, go no further. You have
+ shown how brave you are. No man can be expected to do more than
+ challenge his enemy and wait ready for him. If he does not
+ come, the fault and the disgrace are his."</p>
+
+ <p>"'Tis true," said the Knight. "Shut the door, my friend, and
+ give me the best certificate you can of what you have seen me
+ do; how you opened the door, and how I waited for the lion to
+ come out, and how he turned tail and lay down. I am obliged to
+ do no more."</p>
+
+ <p>So saying, Don Quixote put on the end of his spear the cloth
+ with which he had wiped the curds from his face, and began to
+ wave to the others to come back.</p>
+
+ <p>"I'll be hanged," cried Sancho when he saw this signal, "if
+ my master has not killed the lion." And they all hurried up to
+ the wagon where the keeper gave them a long account of
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page26" id="page26"></a>[pg
+ 26]</span> what had happened, adding, that when he got to court
+ he would tell the King of Don Quixote's bravery.</p>
+
+ <p>"If his Majesty should happen to ask who did this thing,
+ tell him," said Don Quixote, "that it was the Knight of the
+ Lions, for that is the name by which I shall now call
+ myself."</p>
+
+ <p>Sancho and his master now rode with the gentleman in green
+ to his house, where they stopped some days, to the great
+ contentment of Sancho. And of the wedding at which they were
+ present, of the feast where Sancho so greatly enjoyed himself,
+ as well as of other matters, you must read for yourself.</p>
+
+ <p>When the Knight and his squire again began their travels, it
+ chanced that they stopped one night at an inn. To this inn,
+ while Don Quixote was outside, waiting for supper, there came a
+ man, all dressed in chamois leather, and wearing over his left
+ eye, and part of his face, a green patch.</p>
+
+ <p>"Have you any lodgings, landlord?" he cried in a loud voice;
+ "for here comes the fortune-telling ape, and the great
+ puppet-show of Melisendra's Deliverance."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, bless me!" cried the innkeeper, "if here isn't Master
+ Peter. Now we shall have a merry night of it. You are welcome,
+ with all my heart. Where is the ape, Peter?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Coming presently," said Master Peter. "I only came on
+ before to see if lodgings were to be had."</p>
+
+ <p>"Lodgings!" cried the landlord. "Why, I'd turn out the Duke
+ of Alva himself rather than you should want room. Bring on the
+ monkey and the show, for I have guests in the inn to-night who
+ will pay well to see the performance."</p>
+
+ <p>"That's good news," said Peter, going off to hurry up his
+ cart.</p>
+
+ <p>"Who is this Peter?" asked Don Quixote.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, sir," answered the landlord, "he has been going about
+ the country this long time with his play of Melisendra and Don
+ Gayferos, one of the very best shows that ever was seen. Then
+ he has the cleverest ape in the world. You have only to ask it
+ a question and it will jump on its master's shoulder and
+ whisper the answer in his ear, and then Master Peter will tell
+ you what it says. It's true, he isn't always right, but he so
+ often hits the nail on the head that we sometimes think Satan
+ is in him."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page27"
+ id="page27"></a>[pg 27]</span>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote no sooner saw the ape, than he marched up to it,
+ and asked a question.</p>
+
+ <p>"Ah!" said Master Peter, "the animal can't tell what is
+ going to happen; only what has already happened."</p>
+
+ <p>"I wouldn't give a brass centesimo," cried Sancho, "to know
+ what is past. Who can tell that better than myself? Tell me
+ what my wife Teresa is doing at home just now."</p>
+
+ <p>Master Peter tapped his shoulder: the ape at once sprang on
+ to it, and putting its head at his ear, began to
+ chatter&mdash;as apes do&mdash;for a minute. Then it skipped
+ down again, and immediately Master Peter ran to Don Quixote and
+ fell on his knees before him.</p>
+
+ <p>"O glorious restorer of knight-errantry!" he cried, "who can
+ say enough in praise of the great Don Quixote de la Mancha, the
+ righter of wrongs, the comfort of the afflicted and
+ unhappy?"</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote was amazed at these words, for he was certain
+ that he was unknown to any one at the inn. He did not guess
+ that Master Peter was a clever rogue, who, before giving a
+ performance, always made it his business to find out about
+ those who were likely to be looking on.</p>
+
+ <p>As for Sancho, he quaked with fear.</p>
+
+ <p>"And thou, honest Sancho," went on Master Peter, "the best
+ squire to the best knight in the world, be not unhappy about
+ your wife. She is well, and at this moment is dressing flax. By
+ the same token, she has at her left hand, to cheer her, a
+ broken-mouthed jug of wine."</p>
+
+ <p>"That's like enough," said Sancho.</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," cried Don Quixote, "if I had not seen it with my own
+ eyes, nothing should have made me believe that apes have the
+ gift of second sight. I am in very truth the Don Quixote de la
+ Mancha that this wonderful animal has told you about."</p>
+
+ <p>But he was not quite pleased at the idea of the ape having
+ such powers, and taking Sancho aside he spoke to him seriously
+ on the subject.</p>
+
+ <p>While they spoke, the showman came to tell them that the
+ puppet-show was now ready to begin, and Don Quixote and Sancho
+ went into the room where it stood, with candles burning all
+ round it. Master Peter got inside in order to move the
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page28" id="page28"></a>[pg
+ 28]</span> puppets, and a boy standing in front explained what
+ was going on.</p>
+
+ <p>The story that was acted by the puppets was that of a
+ certain Don Gayferos, who rescued his wife Melisendra from
+ captivity by the Moors in the city of Saragossa. Melisendra was
+ imprisoned in the castle, and the story goes that Don Gayferos,
+ when riding past, in his search, spied her on the balcony.
+ Melisendra, with the help of a rope, lets herself down to her
+ husband, mounts behind him, and the two gallop away from the
+ city. But Melisendra's flight has been noticed, and the city
+ bells ring an alarm. The Moors rush out like angry wasps, start
+ in pursuit, and the capture and death of Don Gayferos and
+ Melisendra seem certain.</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote listened and looked with growing excitement and
+ anger, but when he saw the Moors gallop in pursuit and about to
+ close on Don Gayferos and Melisendra, he could keep quiet no
+ longer. Starting up, "It shall never be said," cried he, "that
+ in my presence I suffered such a wrong to be done to so famous
+ a knight as Don Gayferos. Stop your unjust pursuit, ye base
+ rascals! Stop! or prepare to meet me in battle."</p>
+
+ <p>Then, drawing his sword, with one spring he fell with fury
+ on the Moors, hacking some in pieces, beheading others, and
+ sending the rest flying into every corner. And had not Master
+ Peter ducked and squatted down on the ground behind part of the
+ show, Don Quixote would certainly have chopped off his head
+ also.</p>
+
+ <p>"Hold! hold, sir!" cried Master Peter, "for mercy's sake,
+ hold! These are not real Moors. You will ruin me if you destroy
+ my show."</p>
+
+ <p>But Don Quixote paid not the slightest heed. He went on
+ slashing and hacking till the whole show was a wreck. Everybody
+ ran to get out of harm's way, and the ape scampered,
+ chattering, on to the roof of the house. Sancho himself quaked
+ with fear, for he had never before seen his master in such a
+ fury.</p>
+
+ <p>All the puppet Moors being now cut to pieces, Don Quixote
+ became calmer, saying aloud, "How miserable had been the fate
+ of poor Don Gayferos and Melisendra his wife if I had not been
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page29" id="page29"></a>[pg
+ 29]</span> in time to save them from those infidel Moors! Long
+ live knight-errantry!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Ay, ay," moaned Master Peter in a doleful voice, "it may
+ live long enough. As for me, I may as well die, for I am a
+ ruined man and a beggar now."</p>
+
+ <p>Sancho Panza took pity on the showman.</p>
+
+ <p>"Come, come! Master Peter," said he, "don't cry. Don't be
+ cast down. My master will pay you when he comes to know that he
+ has done you an injury."</p>
+
+ <p>"Truly," said Peter, "if his honor will pay for my
+ puppets.'ll ask no more."</p>
+
+ <p>"How!" cried Don Quixote. "I do not see that I have injured
+ you, good Master Peter."</p>
+
+ <p>"Not injured me!" cried Master Peter. "Do but look at those
+ figures lying there, all hacked to bits."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," said Don Quixote, "now I know for certain a truth I
+ have suspected before, that those accursed enchanters do
+ nothing but put before my eyes things as they are, and then
+ presently after change them as they please. Really and truly
+ gentlemen, I vow and protest that all that was acted here
+ seemed to me to be real. I could not contain my fury, and I
+ acted as I thought was my duty. But if Master Peter will tell
+ me the value of the figures, I will pay for them all."</p>
+
+ <p>"Heaven bless your worship!" whined Master Peter. But had
+ Don Quixote known that this same Master Peter was the very man
+ who stole Sancho Panza's ass, perhaps he might have paid him in
+ another way.</p>
+
+ <h4>VII</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE BATTLE WITH THE BULLS; THE FIGHT WITH THE KNIGHT OF THE
+ WHITE MOON; AND HOW DON QUIXOTE DIED</h4>
+
+ <p>Soon after this, Don Quixote and Sancho Panza rode forth in
+ search of other adventures.</p>
+
+ <p>They had ridden no great way when they happened upon some
+ young people who had gaily dressed themselves as shepherds
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page30" id="page30"></a>[pg
+ 30]</span> and shepherdesses, and were having a picnic in the
+ woods. These people invited Don Quixote and Sancho to join
+ their feast.</p>
+
+ <p>When they had eaten and drunk, the Knight rose, and said
+ that there was no sin worse than that of ingratitude, and that
+ to show how grateful he was for the kindness that had been
+ shown to him and to Sancho, he had only one means in his
+ power.</p>
+
+ <p>"Therefore," said he, "I will maintain for two whole days,
+ in the middle of this high road leading to Saragossa, that
+ these ladies here, disguised as shepherdesses, are the most
+ beautiful damsels in the world, except only the peerless
+ Dulcinea del Toboso, the mistress of my heart."</p>
+
+ <p>So, mounting "Rozinante" he rode into the middle of the
+ highway and there took his stand, ready to challenge all
+ comers. He had sat there no long time when there appeared on
+ the road coming towards him a number of riders, some with
+ spears in their hands, all riding very fast and close together.
+ In front of them thundered a drove of wild bulls, bellowing and
+ tossing their horns. At once all the shepherds and the
+ shepherdesses ran behind trees, but Don Quixote sat bravely
+ where he was.</p>
+
+ <p>When the horsemen came near, "Get out of the way!" bawled
+ one of them. "Stand clear, or these bulls will have you in
+ pieces in no time."</p>
+
+ <p>"Halt, scoundrels!" roared the Knight. "What are bulls to
+ Don Quixote de la Mancha, if they were the fiercest that ever
+ lived? Stop, hangdogs!"</p>
+
+ <p>But the herdsmen had no time to answer, nor Don Quixote to
+ get out of the way had he wanted to do so, for before any one
+ knew what was happening, the bulls had run right over him and
+ "Rozinante," leaving them and Sancho and "Dapple," his ass,
+ stunned and bruised, rolling in the dust.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/30.jpg" name="fig30s"
+ id="fig30s"><img width="300" src="images/30s.jpg"
+ alt="THE BULLS HAD RUN RIGHT OVER HIM AND ROZINANTE" />
+ </a><br />
+ the bulls had run right over him and rozinante
+ </div>
+
+ <p>As soon as Don Quixote came to his senses he got up in great
+ haste, stumbling here and falling there, and began to run after
+ the herd.</p>
+
+ <p>"Stop, you scoundrels!" he bawled. "Stop! It is a single
+ knight that defies
+ you."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page31"
+ id="page31"></a>[pg 31]</span>
+
+ <p>But no one took the least notice of him, and he sat sadly
+ down on the road, waiting till Sancho brought "Rozinante" to
+ him. Then master and man went on their way, Don Quixote sore
+ ashamed of his defeat, hurt as much in mind as in body.</p>
+
+ <p>That evening they dismounted at the door of an inn, and put
+ up "Rozinante" and "Dapple" in the stable. Sancho asked the
+ landlord what he could give them for supper.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why," said the man, "you may have anything you choose to
+ call for. The inn can provide fowls of the air, birds of the
+ earth, and fishes of the sea."</p>
+
+ <p>"There's no need for all that," said Sancho. "If you roast a
+ couple of chickens it will be enough, for my master eats but
+ little, and for myself, I have no great appetite."</p>
+
+ <p>"Chickens?" said the host. "I am sorry I have no chickens
+ just now. The hawks have killed them all."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, then, roast us a pullet, if it be tender."</p>
+
+ <p>"A pullet? Well, now, that is unlucky. I sent away fifty to
+ the market only yesterday. But, putting pullets aside, ask for
+ anything you like."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, then," said Sancho, pondering, "let us have some veal,
+ or a bit of kid."</p>
+
+ <p>"Sorry sir, we are just out of veal and kid also. Next week
+ we shall have enough and to spare."</p>
+
+ <p>"That helps us nicely," said Sancho. "But at any rate, let
+ us have some eggs and bacon."</p>
+
+ <p>"Eggs!" cried the landlord. "Now didn't I tell him I had no
+ hens or pullets, and how then can I have eggs? No, no! Ask for
+ anything you please in the way of dainties, but don't ask for
+ hens."</p>
+
+ <p>"Body o' me!" said Sancho, "let us have something. Tell me
+ what you have, and have done."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, what I really and truly have is a pair of cow-heels
+ that look like calves'-feet, or a pair of calves'-feet that
+ look like cow-heels. You can have that and some bacon."</p>
+
+ <p>"They are mine," cried Sancho. "I don't care whether they
+ are feet or heels."</p>
+
+ <p>And as Don Quixote had supper with some other guests who
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page32" id="page32"></a>[pg
+ 32]</span> carried with them their own cook and their own
+ larder, Sancho and the landlord supped well on the
+ cow-heels.</p>
+
+ <p>Some days after this, the Knight and his squire reached
+ Barcelona. Neither of them had ever before been near the sea,
+ and the galleys that they saw in the distance being rowed about
+ in the bay sorely puzzled Sancho, who thought that the oars
+ were their legs, and that they must be some strange kind of
+ beast.</p>
+
+ <p>Now, one morning, when Don Quixote rode out, fully armed as
+ usual, to take the air on the seashore, he saw a knight riding
+ towards him, armed like himself, and having a bright moon
+ painted on his shield. As soon as this knight came within
+ hearing he halted, and in a loud voice called out:</p>
+
+ <p>"Illustrious Don Quixote de la Mancha, I am the Knight of
+ the White Moon, of whose doings you may have heard. I am come
+ to fight with you and to make you own that the Lady of my
+ Heart, whoever she may be, is more beautiful by far than the
+ Lady Dulcinea del Toboso. Which truth, if you will confess, I
+ will not slay you. And if we fight, and I should conquer you,
+ then I ask no more than that you shall go to your own home, and
+ for the space of one year give up carrying arms or searching
+ for adventures. But if you should conquer me, then my head
+ shall be at your disposal, my horse and arms shall be your
+ spoils, and the fame of my deeds shall be yours. Consider what
+ I say, and let your answer be quick."</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote was amazed at hearing these words.</p>
+
+ <p>"Knight of the White Moon," said he very solemnly, "the fame
+ of whose doings has not yet come to my ears, I dare swear that
+ thou hast never seen the beautiful Dulcinea, for hadst thou
+ ever viewed her, thou wouldst have been careful not to make
+ this challenge. The sight of her would have made thee know that
+ there never has been, nor can be, beauty to match hers. And
+ therefore, without giving thee the lie, I only tell thee thou
+ art mistaken. I accept your challenge, on your conditions, and
+ at once, except that I am content with the fame of my own
+ deeds, and want not yours. Choose then whichever side of the
+ field you please, and let us set to."</p>
+
+ <p>The two knights then turned their horses to take ground
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page33" id="page33"></a>[pg
+ 33]</span> for their charge, but at this moment up rode, with
+ some friends, the Governor of the city of Barcelona, who knew
+ Don Quixote, and who fancied that perhaps this was some new
+ trick being played on him. The Governor, seeing both knights
+ ready to turn for their charge, asked the Knight of the White
+ Moon what was the cause of the combat, and having heard his
+ answer, could not believe that the affair was not a joke, and
+ so stood aside.</p>
+
+ <p>Instantly the two knights charged at top speed. But the
+ horse of the Knight of the White Moon was by far the bigger and
+ heavier and faster, and he came with such a shock into poor old
+ "Rozinante" that Don Quixote and his horse were hurled to the
+ ground with terrible force, and lay stunned and helpless. In a
+ moment the Knight of the White Moon was off his horse and
+ holding his spear at Don Quixote's throat.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yield, Sir Knight!" he cried, "or you are a dead man."</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote, sorely hurt, but with steadfast look, gasped in
+ a faint voice:</p>
+
+ <p>"I do not yield. Dulcinea del Toboso is the most beautiful
+ woman in the whole world. Press on with your spear, Sir Knight,
+ and kill me."</p>
+
+ <p>"Nay," said the Knight of the White Moon. "That will I not
+ do. I am content if the great Don Quixote return to his home
+ for a year, as we agreed before we fought."</p>
+
+ <p>And Don Quixote answered very faintly that as nothing was
+ asked of him to the hurt of Dulcinea, he would carry out all
+ the rest faithfully and truly. The Knight of the White Moon
+ then galloped away toward the city, where one of the Governor's
+ friends followed him, in order to find out who he was. The
+ victorious knight was Samson Carrasco, who, some months before,
+ had fought with and had been beaten by Don Quixote. And he
+ explained to the Governor's friend that all he wanted in
+ fighting was, not to harm Don Quixote, but to make him promise
+ to go home, and stop there for a year, by which time he hoped
+ that his madness about knight-errantry might be cured.</p>
+
+ <p>They raised Don Quixote and took off his helmet. His face
+ was very pale, and he was covered with a cold sweat.
+ "Rozinante" <span class="pagenum"><a name="page34"
+ id="page34"></a>[pg 34]</span> was in as bad plight as his
+ master, and lay where he had fallen. Sancho, in great grief,
+ could speak no word, and knew not what to do; to him it was all
+ as a bad dream.</p>
+
+ <p>Don Quixote was carried on a stretcher to the town, where
+ for a week he lay in bed without ever raising his head,
+ stricken to the soul by the disgrace of his defeat.</p>
+
+ <p>Sancho tried to comfort him.</p>
+
+ <p>"Pluck up your heart and be of good cheer, sir," he cried,
+ "and thank Heaven you have broken no bones. They that give must
+ take. Let us go home and give up looking for adventures."</p>
+
+ <p>"After all, Sancho," said Don Quixote, "it is only for a
+ year. After that I can begin again, and perhaps then I may be
+ able to make thee an Earl."</p>
+
+ <p>"Heaven grant it" said Sancho.</p>
+
+ <p>So when the Knight was once more able to move they set out
+ for home, Don Quixote riding "Rozinante" Sancho walking, for
+ "Dapple" carried the armor.</p>
+
+ <p>But all the way Don Quixote did not recover from his
+ melancholy, and when at last they reached his village:</p>
+
+ <p>"Help me to bed," he said, "for I think that I am not very
+ well."</p>
+
+ <p>He was put to bed, and carefully nursed. But a fever had
+ taken hold of him, and for many days Sancho Panza never left
+ his master's bedside. On the sixth day, the doctor told him he
+ was in great danger. Don Quixote listened very calmly, and then
+ asked that he might be left by himself for a little&mdash;he
+ had a mind to sleep. His niece and Sancho left the room weeping
+ bitterly, and Don Quixote fell into a deep sleep.</p>
+
+ <p>When he awoke, with a firm voice he cried:</p>
+
+ <p>"Blessed be God! My mind is is now clear, and the clouds
+ have rolled away which those detestable books of
+ knight-errantry cast over me. Now can I see their nonsense and
+ deceit. I am at the point of death, and I would meet it so that
+ I may not leave behind me the character of a madman. Send for
+ the lawyer, that I may make my will."</p>
+
+ <p>Excepting only a small sum of money which he gave to Sancho
+ Panza, he left all to his
+ niece.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page35"
+ id="page35"></a>[pg 35]</span>
+
+ <p>Thereafter he fell back in bed, and lay unconscious and
+ without movement till the third day, when death very gently
+ took him.</p>
+
+ <p>So died Don Quixote de la Mancha, a good man and a brave
+ gentleman to the end.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page36"
+ id="page36"></a>[pg 36]</span>
+
+ <h2>GULLIVER'S TRAVELS</h2>
+
+ <h3><i>VOYAGE TO LILLIPUT</i></h3>
+
+ <h3>By JONATHAN SWIFT</h3>
+
+ <h4>ADAPTED BY JOHN LANG</h4>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <h4>GULLIVER'S BIRTH AND EARLY VOYAGES</h4>
+
+ <p>Two hundred years ago, a great deal of the world as we now
+ know it was still undiscovered; there were yet very many
+ islands, small and great, on which the eyes of white men had
+ never looked, seas in which nothing bigger than an Indian canoe
+ had ever sailed.</p>
+
+ <p>A voyage in those days was not often a pleasant thing, for
+ ships then were very bluff-bowed and slow-sailing, and, for a
+ long voyage, very ill-provided with food. There were no tinned
+ meats two hundred years ago, no luxuries for use even in the
+ cabin. Sailors lived chiefly on salt junk, as hard as leather,
+ on biscuit that was generally as much weevil as biscuit, and
+ the water that they drank was evil-smelling and bad when it had
+ been long in the ship's casks.</p>
+
+ <p>So, when a man said good-by to his friends and sailed away
+ into the unknown, generally very many years passed before he
+ came back&mdash;if ever he came back at all. For the dangers of
+ the seas were then far greater than they now are, and if a ship
+ was not wrecked some dark night on an unknown island or
+ uncharted reef, there was always the probability of meeting a
+ pirate vessel and of having to fight for life and liberty.
+ Steam has nowadays nearly done away with pirates, except on the
+ China coast and in a few other out-of-the-way places. But
+ things were different long ago, before steamers were invented;
+ and sailors then, when they came home, had many very surprising
+ things to tell their friends, many astonishing
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page37" id="page37"></a>[pg
+ 37]</span> adventures to speak of, among the strange peoples
+ that they said they had met in far-off lands. One man, who saw
+ more wonderful things than any one else, was named Lemuel
+ Gulliver, and I will try to tell you a little about one of his
+ voyages.</p>
+
+ <p>Gulliver was born in Nottinghamshire, and when he was only
+ fourteen years old he was sent to Emanuel College, Cambridge.
+ There he remained till he was seventeen, but his father had not
+ money enough to keep him any longer at the University. So, as
+ was then the custom for those who meant to become doctors, he
+ was bound apprentice to a surgeon in London, under whom he
+ studied for four years. But all the time, as often as his
+ father sent him money, he spent some of it in learning
+ navigation (which means the art of finding your way across the
+ sea, far from land). He had always had a great longing to
+ travel, and he thought that a knowledge of navigation would be
+ of use to him if he should happen to go a voyage.</p>
+
+ <p>After leaving London, he went to Germany, and there studied
+ medicine for some years, with the view of being appointed
+ surgeon of a ship. And by the help of his late master in
+ London, such a post he did get on board the "Swallow" on which
+ vessel he made several voyages. But tiring of this, he settled
+ in London, and, having married, began practise as a doctor.</p>
+
+ <p>He did not, however, make much money at that, and so for six
+ years he again went to sea as a surgeon, sailing both to the
+ East and to the West Indies.</p>
+
+ <p>Again tiring of the sea, he once more settled on shore, this
+ time at Wapping, because in that place there are always many
+ sailors, and he hoped to make money by doctoring them.</p>
+
+ <p>But this turned out badly, and on May 4, 1699, he sailed
+ from Bristol for the South Seas as surgeon of a ship named the
+ "Antelope."</p>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <h4>GULLIVER IS WRECKED ON THE COAST OF LILLIPUT</h4>
+
+ <p>At first, everything went well, but after leaving the South
+ Seas, when steering for the East Indies, the ship was driven by
+ a great storm far to the south. The gale lasted so long that
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page38" id="page38"></a>[pg
+ 38]</span> twelve of the crew died from the effects of the hard
+ work and the bad food, and all the others were worn out and
+ weak. On a sailing ship, when the weather is very heavy, all
+ hands have to be constantly on deck, and there is little rest
+ for the men. Perhaps a sail, one of the few that can still be
+ carried in such a gale, may be blown to ribbons by the furious
+ wind, and a new one has to be bent on.</p>
+
+ <p>The night, perhaps, is dark, the tattered canvas is
+ thrashing with a noise like thunder, the ship burying her decks
+ under angry black seas every few minutes. The men's hands are
+ numb with the cold and the wet, and the hard, dangerous work
+ aloft. There is no chance of going below when their job is
+ done, to "turn in" between warm, dry blankets in a snug berth.
+ Possibly even those who belong to the "watch below" may have to
+ remain on deck. Or, if they have the good fortune to be allowed
+ to go below, they may no sooner have dropped off asleep (rolled
+ round in blankets which perhaps have been wet ever since the
+ gale began) than there is a thump, thump overhead, and one of
+ the watch on deck bellows down the forecastle-hatch, "All hands
+ shorten sail." And out they must tumble again, once more to
+ battle with the hungry, roaring seas and the raging wind. So,
+ when there has been a long spell of bad weather, it is no
+ wonder that the men are worn out. And when, as was the case
+ with Gulliver's ship, the food also is bad, it is easy to
+ understand why so many of the crew had died.</p>
+
+ <p>It was on the 5th of November, the beginning of summer in
+ latitudes south of the equator. The storm had not yet cleared
+ off, and the weather was very thick, the wind coming in furious
+ squalls that drove the ship along at great speed, when suddenly
+ from the lookout man came a wild cry&mdash;"Breakers
+ ahead!"</p>
+
+ <p>But so close had the vessel come to the rocks before they
+ were seen through the thick driving spray, that immediately,
+ with, a heavy plunge, she crashed into the reef, and split her
+ bows.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/38.jpg" name="fig38s"
+ id="fig38s"><img width="400" src="images/38s.jpg"
+ alt="HE FOUND THAT HIS ARMS AND LEGS WERE TIGHTLY" />
+ </a><br />
+ he found that his arms and legs were tightly fastened to
+ the ground
+ </div>
+
+ <p>Gulliver and six of the crew lowered a boat and got clear of
+ the wreck and of the breakers. But the men were so weak from
+ overwork that they could not handle the boat in such a sea, and
+ very soon, during a fierce squall, she sank. What became of the
+ men Gulliver never knew, for he saw none of them again.
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page39" id="page39"></a>[pg
+ 39]</span> Probably they were drowned at once, for they were
+ too weak to keep long afloat in a sea breaking so heavily.</p>
+
+ <p>And indeed, Gulliver himself was like to have been lost. He
+ swam till no strength or feeling was left in his arms and legs,
+ swam bravely, his breath coming in great sobs, his eyes blinded
+ with the salt seas that broke over his head. Still he struggled
+ on, utterly spent, until at last, in a part where the wind
+ seemed to have less force, and the seas swept over him less
+ furiously, on letting down his legs he found that he was within
+ his depth. But the shore shelved so gradually that for nearly a
+ mile he had to wade wearily through shallow water, till,
+ fainting almost with fatigue, he reached dry land.</p>
+
+ <p>By this time darkness was coming on, and there were no signs
+ of houses or of people. He staggered forward but a little
+ distance, and then, on the short, soft turf, sank down
+ exhausted and slept.</p>
+
+ <p>When he woke, the sun was shining, and he tried to rise; but
+ not by any means could he stir hand or foot. Gulliver had
+ fallen asleep lying on his back, and now he found that his arms
+ and legs were tightly fastened to the ground. Across his body
+ were numbers of thin but strong cords, and even his hair, which
+ was very long, was pegged down so securely that he could not
+ turn his head.</p>
+
+ <p>All round about him there was a confused sound of voices,
+ but he could see nothing except the sky, and the sun shone so
+ hot and fierce into his eyes that he could scarcely keep them
+ open.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon he felt something come gently up his left leg, and
+ forward on to his breast almost to his chin. Looking down as
+ much as possible, he saw standing there a very little man, not
+ more than six inches high, armed with a bow and arrows.</p>
+
+ <p>Then many more small men began to swarm over him. Gulliver
+ let out such a roar of wonder and fright that they all turned
+ and ran, many of them getting bad falls in their hurry to get
+ out of danger. But very quickly the little people came back
+ again.</p>
+
+ <p>This time, with a great struggle Gulliver managed to break
+ the cords that fastened his left arm, and at the same time, by
+ a <span class="pagenum"><a name="page40" id="page40"></a>[pg
+ 40]</span> violent wrench that hurt him dreadfully, he slightly
+ loosened the strings that fastened his hair, so that he was
+ able to turn his head a little to one side. But the little men
+ were too quick for him, and got out of reach before he could
+ catch any of them.</p>
+
+ <p>Then he heard a great shouting, followed by a shrill little
+ voice that called sharply, "<i>Tolgo phonac</i>," and
+ immediately, arrows like needles were shot into his hand, and
+ another volley struck him in the face. Poor Gulliver covered
+ his face with his hand, and lay groaning with pain.</p>
+
+ <p>Again he struggled to get loose. But the harder he fought
+ for freedom, the more the little men shot arrows into him, and
+ some of them even tried to run their spears into his sides.</p>
+
+ <p>When he found that the more he struggled the more he was
+ hurt, Gulliver lay still, thinking to himself that at night at
+ least, now that his left hand was free, he could easily get rid
+ of the rest of his bonds. As soon as the little people saw that
+ he struggled no more, they ceased shooting at him; but he knew
+ from the increasing sound of voices that more and more of the
+ little soldiers were coming round him.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon, a few yards from him, on the right, he heard a
+ continued sound of hammering, and on turning his head to that
+ side as far as the strings would let him, he saw that a small
+ wooden stage was being built. On to this, when it was finished,
+ there climbed by ladders four men, and one of them (who seemed
+ to be a very important person, for a little page boy attended
+ to hold up his train) immediately gave an order. At once about
+ fifty of the soldiers ran forward and cut the strings that tied
+ Gulliver's hair on the left side, so that he could turn his
+ head easily to the right.</p>
+
+ <p>Then the person began to make a long speech, not one word of
+ which could Gulliver understand, but it seemed to him that
+ sometimes the little man threatened, and sometimes made offers
+ of kindness.</p>
+
+ <p>As well as he could, Gulliver made signs that he submitted.
+ Then, feeling by this time faint with hunger, he pointed with
+ his fingers many times to his mouth, to show that he wanted
+ something to eat.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page41"
+ id="page41"></a>[pg 41]</span>
+
+ <p>They understood him very well. Several ladders were put
+ against Gulliver's sides, and about a hundred little people
+ climbed up and carried to his mouth all kinds of bread and
+ meat. There were things shaped like legs, and shoulders, and
+ saddles of mutton. Very good they were, Gulliver thought, but
+ very small, no bigger than a lark's wing; and the loaves of
+ bread were about the size of bullets, so that he could take
+ several at a mouthful. The people wondered greatly at the
+ amount that he ate.</p>
+
+ <p>When he signed that he was thirsty, they slung up on to his
+ body two of their biggest casks of wine, and having rolled them
+ forward to his hand they knocked out the heads of the casks.
+ Gulliver drank them both off at a draught, and asked for more,
+ for they held only about a small tumblerful each. But there was
+ no more to be had.</p>
+
+ <p>As the small people walked to and fro over his body,
+ Gulliver was sorely tempted to seize forty or fifty of them and
+ dash them on the ground, and then to make a further struggle
+ for liberty. But the pain he had already suffered from their
+ arrows made him think better of it, and he wisely lay
+ quiet.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon another small man, who from his brilliant uniform
+ seemed to be an officer of very high rank, marched with some
+ others on to Gulliver's chest and held up to his eyes a paper
+ which Gulliver understood to be an order from the King of the
+ country. The officer made a long speech, often pointing towards
+ something a long way off, and (as Gulliver afterwards learned)
+ told him that he was to be taken as a prisoner to the city, the
+ capital of the country.</p>
+
+ <p>Gulliver asked, by signs, that his bonds might be loosed.
+ The officer shook his head and refused, but he allowed some of
+ his soldiers to slack the cords on one side, whereby Gulliver
+ was able to feel more comfortable. After this, the little
+ people drew out the arrows that still stuck in his hands and
+ face, and rubbed the wounds with some pleasant-smelling
+ ointment, which so soothed his pain that very soon he fell
+ sound asleep. And this was no great wonder, for, as he
+ afterwards understood, the King's physicians had mixed a very
+ strong sleeping draught with the wine that had been given
+ him.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page42"
+ id="page42"></a>[pg 42]</span>
+
+ <p>Gulliver awoke with a violent fit of sneezing, and with the
+ feeling of small feet running away from off his chest.</p>
+
+ <p>Where was he? Bound still, without doubt, but no longer did
+ he find himself lying on the ground. It puzzled him greatly
+ that now he lay on a sort of platform. How had he got
+ there?</p>
+
+ <p>Soon he began to realize what had happened; and later, when
+ he understood the language, he learned all that had been done
+ to him while he slept. Before he dropped asleep, he had heard a
+ rumbling as of wheels, and the shouts of many drivers. This, it
+ seemed, was caused by the arrival of a huge kind of trolley, a
+ few inches high, but nearly seven feet long, drawn by fifteen
+ hundred of the King's largest horses.</p>
+
+ <p>On this it was meant that he should be taken to the city. By
+ the use of strong poles fixed in the ground, to which were
+ attached many pulleys, and the strongest ropes to be found in
+ the country, nine hundred men managed to hoist him as he slept.
+ They then put him on the trolley, where they again tied him
+ fast.</p>
+
+ <p>It was when they were far on their way to the city that
+ Gulliver awoke. The trolley had stopped for a little to breathe
+ the horses, and one of the officers of the King's Guard who had
+ not before seen Gulliver, climbed with some friends up his
+ body. While looking at his face, the officer could not resist
+ the temptation of putting the point of his sword up Gulliver's
+ nose, which tickled him so that he woke, sneezing
+ violently.</p>
+
+ <h4>III</h4>
+
+ <h4>GULLIVER IS TAKEN AS A PRISONER TO THE CAPITAL OF
+ LILLIPUT</h4>
+
+ <p>The city was not reached till the following day, and
+ Gulliver had to spend the night lying where he was, guarded on
+ each side by five hundred men with torches and bows and arrows,
+ ready to shoot him if he should attempt to move.</p>
+
+ <p>In the morning, the King and all his court, and thousands of
+ the people, came out to gaze on the wonderful sight. The
+ trolley, with Gulliver on it, stopped outside the walls,
+ alongside a very large building which had once been used as a
+ temple, <span class="pagenum"><a name="page43"
+ id="page43"></a>[pg 43]</span> but the use of which had been
+ given up owing to a murder having been committed in it.</p>
+
+ <p>The door of this temple was quite four feet high and about
+ two feet wide, and on each side, about six inches from the
+ ground, was a small window. Inside the building the King's
+ blacksmiths fastened many chains, which they then brought
+ through one of these little windows and padlocked round
+ Gulliver's left ankle. Then his bonds were cut, and he was
+ allowed to get up. He found that he could easily creep through
+ the door, and that there was room inside to lie down.</p>
+
+ <p>His chains were nearly six feet long, so that he could get a
+ little exercise by walking backwards and forwards outside.
+ Always when he walked, thousands of people thronged around to
+ look at him; even the King himself used to come and gaze by the
+ hour from a high tower which stood opposite.</p>
+
+ <p>One day, just as Gulliver had crept out from his house and
+ had got on his feet, it chanced that the King, who was a very
+ fine-looking man, taller than any of his people, came riding
+ along on his great white charger. When the horse saw Gulliver
+ move it was terrified, and plunged and reared so madly that the
+ people feared that a terrible accident was going to happen, and
+ several of the King's guards ran in to seize the horse by the
+ head. But the King was a good horseman, and managed the animal
+ so well that very soon it got over its fright, and he was able
+ to dismount.</p>
+
+ <p>Then he gave orders that food should be brought for
+ Gulliver, twenty little carts full, and ten of wine; and he and
+ his courtiers, all covered with gold and silver, stood around
+ and watched him eating. After the King had gone away the people
+ of the city crowded round, and some of them began to behave
+ very badly, one man even going so far as to shoot an arrow at
+ Gulliver which was not far from putting out one of his eyes.
+ But the officer in command of the soldiers who were on guard
+ ordered his men to bind and push six of the worst behaved of
+ the crowd within reach of Gulliver, who at once seized five of
+ them and put them in his coat pocket. The sixth he held up to
+ his mouth and made as if he meant to eat him, whereupon the
+ wretched little creature shrieked aloud with terror, and when
+ Gulliver took out his knife,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page44" id="page44"></a>[pg
+ 44]</span> all the people, even the soldiers, were dreadfully
+ alarmed. But Gulliver only cut the man's bonds, and let him run
+ away, which he did in a great hurry. And when he took the
+ others out of his pocket, one by one, and treated them in the
+ same way, the crowd began to laugh. After that the people
+ always behaved very well to Gulliver, and he became a great
+ favorite. From all over the kingdom crowds flocked to see the
+ Great Man Mountain.</p>
+
+ <p>In the meantime, as Gulliver learned later, there were
+ frequent meetings of the King's council to discuss the question
+ of what was to be done with him. Some of the councilors feared
+ lest he might break loose and cause great damage in the city.
+ Some were of opinion that to keep and feed so huge a creature
+ would cause a famine in the land, or, at the least, that the
+ expense would be greater than the public funds could bear; they
+ advised, therefore, that he should be killed&mdash;shot in the
+ hands and face with poisoned arrows. Others, however, argued
+ that if this were done it would be a very difficult thing to
+ get rid of so large a dead body, which might cause a pestilence
+ to break out if it lay long unburied so near the city.</p>
+
+ <p>Finally, the King and his council gave orders that each
+ morning the surrounding villages should send into the city for
+ Gulliver's daily use six oxen, forty sheep, and a sufficient
+ quantity of bread and wine.</p>
+
+ <p>It was also commanded that six hundred persons should act as
+ his servants; that three hundred tailors were to make for him a
+ suit of clothes; and that six professors from the University
+ were to teach him the language of the country.</p>
+
+ <p>When Gulliver could speak the language, he learned a great
+ deal about the land in which he now found himself. It was
+ called Lilliput, and the people, Lilliputians. These
+ Lilliputians believed that their kingdom and the neighboring
+ country of Blefuscu were the whole world. Blefuscu lay far over
+ the sea, to these little people dim and blue on the horizon,
+ though to Gulliver the distance did not seem to be more than a
+ mile. The Lilliputians knew of no land beyond Blefuscu. And as
+ for Gulliver himself, they believed that he had fallen from the
+ moon, or from one of the stars; it was impossible, they said,
+ that so big a race of men could live on the earth. It was quite
+ certain <span class="pagenum"><a name="page45"
+ id="page45"></a>[pg 45]</span> that there could not be food
+ enough for them. They did not believe Gulliver's story. He must
+ have fallen from the moon!</p>
+
+ <p>Almost the first thing that Gulliver did when he knew the
+ language fairly well, was to send a petition to the King,
+ praying that his chains might be taken off and that he might be
+ free to walk about. But this he was told could not then be
+ granted. He must first, the King's council said, "swear a
+ peace" with the kingdom of Lilliput, and afterwards, if by
+ continued good behavior he gained their confidence, he might be
+ freed.</p>
+
+ <p>Meantime, by the King's orders, two high officers of state
+ were sent to search him, Gulliver lifted up these officers in
+ his hand and put them into each of his pockets, one after the
+ other, and they made for the King a careful list of everything
+ found there.</p>
+
+ <p>Gulliver afterward saw this inventory. His snuff-box they
+ had described as a "huge silver chest, full of a sort of dust."
+ Into that dust one of them stepped, and the snuff, flying up in
+ his face, caused him nearly to sneeze his head off. His pistols
+ they called "hollow pillars of iron, fastened to strong pieces
+ of timber," and the use of his bullets, and of his powder
+ (which he had been lucky enough to bring ashore dry, owing to
+ his pouch being water-tight), they could not understand, while
+ of his watch they could make nothing. They called it "a
+ wonderful kind of engine, which makes an incessant noise like a
+ water-wheel." But some fancied that it was perhaps a kind of
+ animal. Certainly it was alive.</p>
+
+ <p>All these things, together with his sword, which he carried
+ slung to a belt round his waist, Gulliver had to give up,
+ first, as well as he could, explaining the use of them. The
+ Lilliputians could not understand the pistols, and to show his
+ meaning, Gulliver was obliged to fire one of them. At once
+ hundreds of little people fell down as if they had been struck
+ dead by the noise. Even the King, though he stood his ground,
+ was sorely frightened. Most of Gulliver's property was returned
+ to him; but the pistols and powder and bullets, and his sword,
+ were taken away and put, for safety, under strict guard.</p>
+
+ <p>As the King and his courtiers gained more faith in Gulliver,
+ and became less afraid of his breaking loose and doing some
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page46" id="page46"></a>[pg
+ 46]</span> mischief, they began to treat him in a more friendly
+ way than they had hitherto done, and showed him more of the
+ manners and customs of the country. Some of these were very
+ curious.</p>
+
+ <p>One of the sports of which they were most fond was
+ rope-dancing, and there was no more certain means of being
+ promoted to high office and power in the state than to possess
+ great cleverness in that art. Indeed, it was said that the Lord
+ High Treasurer had gained and kept his post chiefly through his
+ great skill in turning somersaults on the tight rope. The Chief
+ Secretary for private affairs ran him very close, and there was
+ hardly a Minister of State who did not owe his position to such
+ successes. Few of them, indeed, had escaped without severe
+ accidents at one time or another, while trying some specially
+ difficult feat, and many had been lamed for life. But however
+ many and bad the falls, there were always plenty of other
+ persons to attempt the same or some more difficult jump.</p>
+
+ <p>Taught by his narrow escape from a serious accident when his
+ horse first saw Gulliver, the King now gave orders that the
+ horses of his army, as well as those from the Royal stables,
+ should be exercised daily close to the Man Mountain. Soon they
+ became so used to the sight of him that they would come right
+ up to his foot without starting or shying. Often the riders
+ would jump their chargers over Gulliver's hand as he held it on
+ the ground; and once the King's huntsman, better mounted than
+ most of the others, actually jumped over his foot, shoe and
+ all&mdash;a wonderful leap.</p>
+
+ <p>Gulliver saw that it was wise to amuse the King in this and
+ other ways, because the more his Majesty was pleased with him
+ the sooner was it likely that his liberty would be granted. So
+ he asked one day that some strong sticks, about two feet in
+ height, should be brought to him. Several of these he fixed
+ firmly in the ground, and across them, near the top, he lashed
+ four other sticks, enclosing a square space of about two and a
+ half feet. Then to the uprights, about five inches lower than
+ the crossed sticks, he tied his pocket-handkerchief, and
+ stretched it tight as a drum.</p>
+
+ <p>When the work was finished, he asked the King to let a troop
+ exercise on this stage. His Majesty was delighted with the
+ idea, <span class="pagenum"><a name="page47"
+ id="page47"></a>[pg 47]</span> and for several days nothing
+ pleased him more than to see Gulliver lift up the men and
+ horses, and to watch them go through their drill on this
+ platform. Sometimes he would even be lifted up himself and give
+ the words of command; and once he persuaded the Queen, who was
+ rather timid, to let herself be held up in her chair within
+ full view of the scene. But a fiery horse one day, pawing with
+ his hoof, wore a hole in the handkerchief, and came down
+ heavily on its side, and after this Gulliver could no longer
+ trust the strength of his stage.</p>
+
+ <h4>IV</h4>
+
+ <h4>GULLIVER IS FREED, AND CAPTURES THE BLEFUSCAN FLEET</h4>
+
+ <p>By this time Gulliver's clothes were almost in rags. The
+ three hundred tailors had not yet been able to finish his new
+ suit, and he had no hat at all, for that had been lost as he
+ came ashore from the wreck. So he was greatly pleased one day
+ when an express message came to the King from the coast, saying
+ that some men had found on the shore a great, black,
+ strangely-shaped mass, as high as a man; it was not alive, they
+ were certain. It had never moved, though for a time they had
+ watched, before going closer. After making certain that it was
+ not likely to injure them, by mounting on each other's
+ shoulders they had got on the top, which they found was flat
+ and smooth, and, by the sound when stamped upon, they judged
+ that it was hollow. It was thought that the object might
+ possibly be something belonging to the Man Mountain, and they
+ proposed by the help of five horses to bring it to the
+ city.</p>
+
+ <p>Gulliver was sure that it must be his hat, and so it turned
+ out. Nor was it very greatly damaged, either by the sea or by
+ being drawn by the horses over the ground all the way from the
+ coast, except that two holes had been bored in the brim, to
+ which a long cord had been fixed by hooks. Gulliver was much
+ pleased to have it once more.</p>
+
+ <p>Two days after this the King took into his head a curious
+ fancy. He ordered a review of troops to be held, and he
+ directed <span class="pagenum"><a name="page48"
+ id="page48"></a>[pg 48]</span> that Gulliver should stand with
+ his legs very wide apart, while under him both horse and foot
+ were commanded to march. Over three thousand infantry and one
+ thousand cavalry passed through the great arch made by his
+ legs, colors flying and bands playing. The King and Queen
+ themselves sat in their State Coach at the saluting point, near
+ to his left leg, and all the while Gulliver dared not move a
+ hair's-breadth, lest he should injure some of the soldiers.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/48.jpg" name="fig48s"
+ id="fig48s"><img width="300" src="images/48s.jpg"
+ alt="GULLIVER IN LILLIPUT" /></a><br />
+ gulliver in lilliput
+ </div>
+
+ <p>Shortly after this, Gulliver was set free. There had been a
+ meeting of the King's Council on the subject, and the Lord High
+ Admiral was the only member in favor of still keeping him
+ chained. This great officer to the end was Gulliver's bitter
+ enemy, and though on this occasion he was out-voted, yet he was
+ allowed to draw up the conditions which Gulliver was to sign
+ before his chains were struck off.</p>
+
+ <p>The conditions were:</p>
+
+ <p>First, that he was not to quit the country without leave
+ granted under the King's Great Seal.</p>
+
+ <p>Second, that he was not to come into the city without
+ orders; at which times the people were to have two hours'
+ notice to keep indoors.</p>
+
+ <p>Third, that he should keep to the high roads, and not walk
+ or lie down in a meadow.</p>
+
+ <p>Fourth, that he was to take the utmost care not to trample
+ on anybody, or on any horses or carriages, and that he was not
+ to lift any persons in his hand against their will.</p>
+
+ <p>Fifth, that if at any time an express had to be sent in
+ great haste, he was to carry the messenger and his horse in his
+ pocket a six-days' journey, and to bring them safely back.</p>
+
+ <p>Sixth, that he should be the King's ally against the
+ Blefuscans, and that he should try to destroy their fleet,
+ which was said to be preparing to invade Lilliput.</p>
+
+ <p>Seventh, that he should help the workmen to move certain
+ great stones which were needed to repair some of the public
+ buildings.</p>
+
+ <p>Eighth, that he should in "two moons' time" make an exact
+ survey of the kingdom, by counting how many of his own paces it
+ took him to go all round the
+ coast.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page49"
+ id="page49"></a>[pg 49]</span>
+
+ <p>Lastly, on his swearing to the above conditions, it was
+ promised that he should have a daily allowance of meat and
+ drink equal to the amount consumed by seventeen hundred and
+ twenty-four of the Lilliputians, for they estimated that
+ Gulliver's size was about equal to that number of their own
+ people.</p>
+
+ <p>Though one or two of the conditions did not please him,
+ especially that about helping the workmen (which he thought was
+ making him too much a servant), yet Gulliver signed the
+ document at once, and swore to observe its conditions.</p>
+
+ <p>After having done so, and having had his chains removed, the
+ first thing he asked was to be allowed to see the city (which
+ was called Mildendo). He found that it was surrounded by a
+ great wall about two and a half feet high, broad enough for one
+ of their coaches and four to be driven along, and at every ten
+ feet there were strong flanking towers.</p>
+
+ <p>Gulliver took off his coat, lest the tails might do damage
+ to the roofs or chimneys of the houses, and he then stepped
+ over the wall and very carefully walked down the finest of the
+ streets, one quite five feet wide. Wherever he went, the tops
+ of the houses and the attic windows were packed with wondering
+ spectators, and he reckoned that the town must hold quite half
+ a million of people.</p>
+
+ <p>In the center of the city, where the two chief streets met,
+ stood the King's Palace, a very fine building surrounded by a
+ wall. But he was not able to see the whole palace that day,
+ because the part in which were the royal apartments was shut
+ off by another wall nearly five feet in height, which he could
+ not get over without a risk of doing damage.</p>
+
+ <p>Some days later he climbed over by the help of two stools
+ which he made from some of the largest trees in the Royal Park,
+ trees nearly seven feet high, which he was allowed to cut down
+ for the purpose. By putting one of the stools at each side of
+ the wall Gulliver was able to step across. Then, lying down on
+ his side, and putting his face close to the open windows, he
+ looked in and saw the Queen and all the young Princes. The
+ Queen smiled, and held her hand out of one of the windows, that
+ he might kiss it. She was very pleasant and friendly.</p>
+
+ <p>One day, about a fortnight after this, there came to call on
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page50" id="page50"></a>[pg
+ 50]</span> him, Reldresal, the King's Chief Secretary, a very
+ great man, one who had always been Gulliver's very good friend.
+ This person had a long and serious talk with Gulliver about the
+ state of the country.</p>
+
+ <p>He said that though to the outward eye things in Lilliput
+ seemed very settled and prosperous, yet in reality there were
+ troubles, both internal and external, that threatened the
+ safety of the kingdom.</p>
+
+ <p>There had been in Lilliput for a very long time two parties
+ at bitter enmity with each other, so bitter that they would
+ neither eat, drink, nor talk together, and what one party did,
+ the other would always try to undo. Each professed to believe
+ that nothing good could come from the other. Any measure
+ proposed by the party in power was by the other always looked
+ upon as foolish or evil. And any new law passed by the
+ Government party was said by the Opposition to be either a
+ wicked attack on the liberties of the people, or something
+ undertaken solely for the purpose of keeping that party in, and
+ the Opposition out, of power. To such a pitch had things now
+ come, said the Chief Secretary, entirely owing to the folly of
+ the Opposition, that the business of the kingdom was almost at
+ a standstill.</p>
+
+ <p>Meantime the country was in danger of an invasion by the
+ Blefuscans, who were now fitting out a great fleet, which was
+ almost ready to sail to attack Lilliput. The war with Blefuscu
+ had been raging for some years, and the losses by both nations
+ of ships and of men had been very heavy.</p>
+
+ <p>This war had broken out in the following way. It had always
+ been the custom in Lilliput, as far back as history went, for
+ people when breaking an egg at breakfast to do so at the big
+ end. But it had happened, said the Chief Secretary, that the
+ present King's grandfather, when a boy, had once when breaking
+ his egg in the usual way, severely cut his finger. Whereupon
+ his father at once gave strict commands that in future all his
+ subjects should break their eggs at the small end.</p>
+
+ <p>This greatly angered the people, who thought that the King
+ had no right to give such an order, and they refused to obey.
+ As a consequence no less than six rebellions had taken place:
+ thousands of the Lilliputians had had their heads cut off,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page51" id="page51"></a>[pg
+ 51]</span> or had been cast into prison, and thousands had fled
+ for refuge to Blefuscu, rather than obey the hated order.</p>
+
+ <p>These "Big endians," as they were called, had been very well
+ received at the Court of Blefuscu, and finally the Emperor of
+ that country had taken upon himself to interfere in the affairs
+ of Lilliput, thus bringing on war.</p>
+
+ <p>The Chief Secretary ended the talk by saying that the King,
+ having great faith in Gulliver's strength, and depending on the
+ oath which he had sworn before being released, expected him now
+ to help in defeating the Blefuscan fleet.</p>
+
+ <p>Gulliver was very ready to do what he could, and he at once
+ thought of a plan whereby he might destroy the whole fleet at
+ one blow. He told all his ideas on the subject to the King, who
+ gave orders that everything he might need should be supplied
+ without delay. Then Gulliver went to the oldest seamen in the
+ navy, and learned from them the depth of water between Lilliput
+ and Blefuscu. It was, they said, nowhere deeper than seventy
+ <i>glumgluffs</i> (which is equal to about six feet) at high
+ water, and there was no great extent so deep.</p>
+
+ <p>After this he walked to the coast opposite Blefuscu, and
+ lying down there behind a hillock, so that he might not be seen
+ should any of the enemy's ships happen to be cruising near, he
+ looked long through a small pocket-telescope across the
+ channel. With the naked eye he could easily see the cliffs of
+ Blefuscu, and soon with his telescope he made out where the
+ fleet lay&mdash;fifty great men-of-war, and many transports,
+ waiting for a fair wind.</p>
+
+ <p>Coming back to the city, he gave orders for a great length
+ of the strongest cable, and a quantity of bars of iron. The
+ cable was little thicker than ordinary pack-thread, and the
+ bars of iron much about the length and size of
+ knitting-needles. Gulliver twisted three of the iron bars
+ together and bent them to a hook at one end. He trebled the
+ cable for greater strength, and thus made fifty shorter cables,
+ to which he fastened the hooks.</p>
+
+ <p>Then, carrying these in his hand, he walked back to the
+ coast and waded into the sea, a little before high water. When
+ he came to mid-channel, he had to swim, but for no great
+ distance.</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as they noticed Gulliver coming wading through the
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page52" id="page52"></a>[pg
+ 52]</span> water towards their ships, the Blefuscan sailors all
+ jumped overboard and swam ashore in a terrible fright. Never
+ before had any of them seen or dreamt of so monstrous a giant,
+ nor had they heard of his being in Lilliput.</p>
+
+ <p>Gulliver then quietly took his cables and fixed one securely
+ in the bows of each of the ships of war, and finally he tied
+ the cables together at his end. But while he was doing this the
+ Blefuscan soldiers on the shore plucked up courage and began to
+ shoot arrows at him, many of which stuck in his hands and face.
+ He was very much afraid lest some of these might put out his
+ eyes; but he remembered, luckily, that in his inner pocket were
+ his spectacles, which he put on, and then finished his work
+ without risk to his eyes.</p>
+
+ <p>On pulling at the cables, however, not a ship could he move.
+ He had forgotten that their anchors were all down. So he was
+ forced to go in closer and with his knife to cut the vessels
+ free. While doing this he was of course exposed to a furious
+ fire from the enemy, and hundreds of arrows struck him, some
+ almost knocking off his spectacles. But again he hauled, and
+ this time drew the whole fifty vessels after him.</p>
+
+ <p>The Blefuscans had thought that it was his intention merely
+ to cast the vessels adrift, so that they might run aground, but
+ when they saw their great fleet being steadily drawn out to
+ sea, their grief was terrible. For a great distance Gulliver
+ could hear their cries of despair.</p>
+
+ <p>When he had got well away from the land, he stopped in order
+ to pick the arrows from his face and hands, and to put on some
+ of the ointment that had been rubbed on his wounds when first
+ the Lilliputians fired into him. By this time the tide had
+ fallen a little, and he was able to wade all the way across the
+ channel.</p>
+
+ <p>The King and his courtiers stood waiting on the shore. They
+ could see the vessels steadily drawing nearer, but they could
+ not for some time see Gulliver, because only his head was above
+ water. At first some imagined that he had been drowned, and
+ that the fleet was now on its way to attack Lilliput.</p>
+
+ <p>There was great joy when Gulliver was seen hauling the
+ vessels; and when he landed, the King was so pleased that on
+ the <span class="pagenum"><a name="page53" id="page53"></a>[pg
+ 53]</span> spot he created him a <i>Nardac</i>, the highest
+ honor that it was in his power to bestow.</p>
+
+ <p>His great success over the Blefuscans, however, turned out
+ to be but the beginning of trouble for Gulliver. The King was
+ so puffed up by the victory that he formed plans for capturing
+ in the same way the whole of the enemy's ships of every kind.
+ And it was now his wish to crush Blefuscu utterly, and to make
+ it nothing but a province depending on Lilliput. Thus, he
+ thought, he himself would then be monarch of the whole
+ world.</p>
+
+ <p>In this scheme Gulliver refused to take any part, and he
+ very plainly said that he would give no help in making slaves
+ of the Blefuscans. This refusal angered the King very much, and
+ more than once he artfully brought the matter up at a State
+ Council. Now, several of the councilors, though they pretended
+ to be Gulliver's friends so long as he was in favor with the
+ King, were really his secret enemies, and nothing pleased these
+ persons better than to see that the King was no longer pleased
+ with him. So they did all in their power to nurse and increase
+ the King's anger, and to make him believe that Gulliver was a
+ traitor.</p>
+
+ <p>About this time there came to Lilliput ambassadors from
+ Blefuscu, suing for peace. When a treaty had been made and
+ signed (very greatly to the advantage of Lilliput), the
+ Blefuscan ambassadors asked to see the Great Man Mountain, of
+ whom they had heard so much, and they paid Gulliver a formal
+ call. After asking him to give them some proofs of his
+ strength, they invited him to visit their Emperor, which
+ Gulliver promised to do.</p>
+
+ <p>Accordingly, the next time that he met the King, he asked,
+ as he was bound to do by the paper he had signed, for
+ permission to leave the country for a time, in order to visit
+ Blefuscu. The King did not refuse, but his manner was so cold
+ that Gulliver could not help noticing it. Afterwards he learned
+ from a friend that his enemies in the council had told the King
+ lying tales of his meetings with the Blefuscan ambassadors,
+ which had had the effect of still further rousing his
+ anger.</p>
+
+ <p>It happened too, most unfortunately, at this time, that
+ Gulliver had offended the Queen by a well-meant, but
+ badly-managed, <span class="pagenum"><a name="page54"
+ id="page54"></a>[pg 54]</span> effort to do her a service, and
+ thus he lost also her friendship. But though he was now out of
+ favor at court, he was still an object of great interest to
+ every one.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/54.jpg" name="fig54s"
+ id="fig54s"><img width="300" src="images/54s.jpg"
+ alt="ON THIS OCCASION, GULLIVER ATE MORE THAN USUAL" />
+ </a><br />
+ on this occasion, gulliver ate more than usual
+ </div>
+
+ <h4>V</h4>
+
+ <h4>GULLIVER'S ESCAPE FROM LILLIPUT AND RETURN TO ENGLAND</h4>
+
+ <p>Gulliver had three hundred cooks to dress his food and these
+ men, with their families, lived in small huts which had been
+ built for them near his house.</p>
+
+ <p>He had made for himself a chair and a table. On to this
+ table it was his custom to lift twenty waiters, and these men
+ then drew up by ropes and pulleys all his food, and his wine in
+ casks, which one hundred other servants had in readiness on the
+ ground. Gulliver would often eat his meal with many hundreds of
+ people looking on.</p>
+
+ <p>One day the King, who had not seen him eat since this table
+ had been built, sent a message that he and the Queen desired to
+ be present that day while Gulliver dined. They arrived just
+ before his dinner hour, and he at once lifted the King and
+ Queen and the Princes, with their attendants and guards, on to
+ the table.</p>
+
+ <p>Their Majesties sat in their chairs of state all the time,
+ watching with deep interest the roasts of beef and mutton, and
+ whole flocks of geese and turkeys and fowls disappear into
+ Gulliver's mouth. A roast of beef of which he had to make more
+ than two mouthfuls was seldom seen, and he ate them bones and
+ all. A goose or a turkey was but one bite.</p>
+
+ <p>Certainly, on this occasion, Gulliver ate more than usual,
+ thinking by so doing to amuse and please the court.</p>
+
+ <p>But in this he erred, for it was turned against him.
+ Flimnap, the Lord High Treasurer, who had always been one of
+ his enemies, pointed out to the King the great daily expense of
+ such meals, and told how this huge man had already cost the
+ country over a million and a half of <i>sprugs</i> (the largest
+ Lilliputian gold coin). Things, indeed, were beginning to go
+ very ill with
+ Gulliver.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page55"
+ id="page55"></a>[pg 55]</span>
+
+ <p>Now it happened about this time that one of the King's
+ courtiers, to whom Gulliver had been very kind, came to him by
+ night very privately in a closed chair, and asked to have a
+ talk, without any one else being present.</p>
+
+ <p>Gulliver gave to a servant whom he could trust orders that
+ no one else was to be admitted, and having put the courtier and
+ his chair upon the table, so that he might better hear all that
+ was said, he sat down to listen.</p>
+
+ <p>Gulliver was told that there had lately been several secret
+ meetings of the King's Privy Council, on his account. The Lord
+ High Admiral (who now hated him because of his success against
+ the Blefuscan fleet), Flimnap, the High Treasurer, and others
+ of his enemies, had drawn up against him charges of treason and
+ other crimes. The courtier had brought with him a copy of these
+ charges, and Gulliver now read them.</p>
+
+ <p>It was made a point against him that, when ordered to do so
+ by the King, he had refused to seize all the other Blefuscan
+ ships. It was also said that he would not join in utterly
+ crushing the empire of Blefuscu, nor give aid when it was
+ proposed to put to death not only all the Big endians who had
+ fled for refuge to that country, but all the Blefuscans
+ themselves who were friends of the Big-endians. For this he was
+ said to be a traitor.</p>
+
+ <p>He was also accused of being over-friendly with the
+ Blefuscan ambassadors; and it was made a grave charge against
+ him that though his Majesty had not given him written leave to
+ visit Blefuscu, he yet was getting ready to go to that country,
+ in order to give help to the Emperor against Lilliput.</p>
+
+ <p>There had been many debates on these charges, said the
+ courtier, and the Lord High Admiral had made violent speeches,
+ strongly advising that the Great Man Mountain should be put to
+ death. In this he was joined by Flimnap, and by others, so that
+ actually the greater part of the council was in favor of
+ instant death by the most painful means that could be used.</p>
+
+ <p>The less unfriendly members of the council, however, while
+ saying that they had no doubt of Gulliver's guilt, were yet of
+ the opinion that, as his services to the kingdom of Lilliput
+ had been great, the punishment of death was too severe. They
+ thought it would be enough if his eyes were put out. This,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page56" id="page56"></a>[pg
+ 56]</span> they said, would not prevent him from being still
+ made useful.</p>
+
+ <p>Then began a most excited argument, the Admiral and those
+ who sided with him insisting that Gulliver should be killed at
+ once.</p>
+
+ <p>At last the Secretary rose and said that he had a middle
+ course to suggest. This was, that Gulliver's eyes should be put
+ out, and that thereafter his food should be gradually so
+ reduced in quantity that in the course of two or three months
+ he would die of starvation. By which time, said the Secretary,
+ his body would be wasted to an extent that would make it easy
+ for five or six hundred men, in a few days, to cut off the
+ flesh and take it away in cart-loads to be buried at a
+ distance. Thus there would be no danger of a pestilence
+ breaking out from the dead body lying near the city. The
+ skeleton, he said, could then be put in the National
+ Museum.</p>
+
+ <p>It was finally decided that this sentence should be carried
+ out, and twenty of the King's surgeons were ordered to be
+ present in three days' time to see the operation of putting out
+ Gulliver's eyes properly done. Sharp-pointed arrows were to be
+ shot into the balls of his eyes.</p>
+
+ <p>The courtier now left the house, as privately as he had
+ come, and Gulliver was left to decide what he should do.</p>
+
+ <p>At first he thought of attacking the city, and destroying
+ it. But by doing this he must have destroyed, with the city, a
+ great many thousands of innocent people, which he could not
+ make up his mind to do.</p>
+
+ <p>At last he wrote a letter to the Chief Secretary, saying
+ that as the King had himself told him that he might visit
+ Blefuscu, he had decided to do so that morning.</p>
+
+ <p>Without waiting for an answer, he set out for the coast,
+ where he seized a large man-of-war which was at anchor there,
+ tied a cable to her bow, and then putting his clothes and his
+ blanket on board, he drew the ship after him to Blefuscu. There
+ he was well received by the Emperor. But as there happened to
+ be no house big enough for him, he was forced, during his stay,
+ to sleep each night on the ground, wrapped in his blanket.</p>
+
+ <p>Three days after his arrival, when walking along the
+ seashore, he noticed something in the water which looked not
+ unlike <span class="pagenum"><a name="page57"
+ id="page57"></a>[pg 57]</span> a boat floating bottom up.
+ Gulliver waded and swam out, and found that he was right. It
+ was a boat. By the help of some of the Blefsucan ships, with
+ much difficulty he got it ashore. When the tide had fallen, two
+ thousand of the Emperor's dockyard men helped him to turn it
+ over, and Gulliver found that but little damage had been
+ done.</p>
+
+ <p>He now set to work to make oars and mast and sail for the
+ boat, and to fit it out and provision it for a voyage.</p>
+
+ <p>While this work was going on, there came from Lilliput a
+ message demanding that Gulliver should be bound hand and foot
+ and returned to that country as a prisoner, there to be
+ punished as a traitor. To this message the Emperor replied that
+ it was not possible to bind him; that moreover the Great Man
+ Mountain had found a vessel of size great enough to carry him
+ over the sea, and that it was his purpose to leave the Empire
+ of Blefuscu in the course of a few weeks.</p>
+
+ <p>Gulliver did not delay his work, and in less than a month he
+ was ready to sail.</p>
+
+ <p>He put on board the boat the carcasses of one hundred oxen
+ and three hundred sheep, with a quantity of bread and wine, and
+ as much meat ready cooked as four hundred cooks could
+ prepare.</p>
+
+ <p>He also took with him a herd of six live black cows and two
+ bulls, and a flock of sheep, meaning to take them with him to
+ England, if ever he should get there. As food for these animals
+ he took a quantity of hay and corn.</p>
+
+ <p>Gulliver would have liked to take with him some of the
+ people, but this the Emperor would not permit.</p>
+
+ <p>Everything being ready, he sailed from Blefuscu on 24th
+ September 1701, and the same night anchored on the lee side of
+ an island which seemed to be uninhabited. Leaving this island
+ on the following morning, he sailed to the eastward for two
+ days. On the evening of the second day he sighted a ship, on
+ reaching which, to his great joy, he found that she was an
+ English vessel on her way home from Japan.</p>
+
+ <p>Putting his cattle and sheep in his coat-pockets, he went on
+ board with all his cargo of provisions. The captain received
+ him very kindly, and asked him from whence he had come, and how
+ he happened to be at sea in an open
+ boat.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page58"
+ id="page58"></a>[pg 58]</span>
+
+ <p>Gulliver told his tale in as few words as possible. The
+ captain stared with wonder, and would not believe his story.
+ But Gulliver then took from his pockets the black cattle and
+ the sheep, which of course clearly showed that he had been
+ speaking truth. He also showed gold coins which the Emperor of
+ Blefuscu had given him, some of which he presented to the
+ captain.</p>
+
+ <p>The vessel did not arrive at the port of London till April,
+ 1702, but there was no loss of the live stock, excepting that
+ the rats on board carried off and ate one of the sheep. All the
+ others were got safely ashore, and were put to graze on a
+ bowling-green at Greenwich, where they throve very well.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page59"
+ id="page59"></a>[pg 59]</span>
+
+ <h3>THE ARABIAN NIGHTS</h3>
+
+ <h4>ADAPTED BY AMY STEEDMAN</h4>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <h4>ALADDIN AND THE WONDERFUL LAMP</h4>
+
+ <p>Far away on the other side of the world, in one of the great
+ wealthy cities of China, there once lived a poor tailor called
+ Mustapha. He had a wife whom he loved dearly and an only son
+ whose name was Aladdin.</p>
+
+ <p>But, sad to say, although the tailor was good and
+ industrious, his son was so idle and bad that his father and
+ mother did not know what to do with him. All day long he played
+ in the streets with other idle boys, and when he grew big
+ enough to learn a trade he said he did not mean to work at all.
+ His poor father was very much troubled, and ordered Aladdin to
+ come to the workshop to learn to be a tailor, but Aladdin only
+ laughed, and ran away so swiftly that neither his father nor
+ mother could catch him.</p>
+
+ <p>"Alas!" said Mustapha sadly, "I can do nothing with this
+ idle boy."</p>
+
+ <p>And he grew so sad about it, that at last he fell ill and
+ died.</p>
+
+ <p>Then the poor widow was obliged to sell the little workshop,
+ and try to make enough money for herself and Aladdin by
+ spinning.</p>
+
+ <p>Now it happened that one day when Aladdin was playing as
+ usual with the idle street boys, a tall, dark, old man stood
+ watching him, and when the game was finished he made a sign to
+ Aladdin to come to him.</p>
+
+ <p>"What is thy name, my boy?" asked this old man, who, though
+ he appeared so kind, was really an African Magician.</p>
+
+ <p>"My name is Aladdin," answered the boy, wondering who this
+ stranger could be.</p>
+
+ <p>"And what is thy father's name?" asked the
+ Magician.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page60"
+ id="page60"></a>[pg 60]</span>
+
+ <p>"My father was Mustapha the tailor, but he has been dead a
+ long time now," answered Aladdin.</p>
+
+ <p>"Alas!" cried the wicked old Magician, pretending to weep,
+ "he was my brother, and thou must be my nephew. I am thy
+ long-lost uncle!" and he threw his arms round Aladdin's neck
+ and embraced him.</p>
+
+ <p>"Tell thy dear mother that I will come and see her this very
+ day," he cried, "and give her this small present." And he
+ placed in Aladdin's hands five gold pieces.</p>
+
+ <p>Aladdin ran home in great haste to tell his mother the story
+ of the long-lost uncle.</p>
+
+ <p>"It must be a mistake," she said, "thou hast no uncle."</p>
+
+ <p>But when she saw the gold she began to think that this
+ stranger must be a relation, and so she prepared a grand supper
+ to welcome him when he came.</p>
+
+ <p>They had not long to wait before the African Magician
+ appeared, bringing with him all sorts of fruits and delicious
+ sweets for desert.</p>
+
+ <p>"Tell me about my poor brother," he said, as he embraced
+ Aladdin and his mother. "Show me exactly where he used to
+ sit."</p>
+
+ <p>Then the widow pointed to a seat on the sofa, and the
+ Magician knelt down and began to kiss the place and weep over
+ it.</p>
+
+ <p>The poor widow was quite touched, and began to believe that
+ this really must be her husband's brother, especially when he
+ began to show the kindest interest in Aladdin.</p>
+
+ <p>"What is thy trade?" he asked the boy.</p>
+
+ <p>"Alas!" said the widow, "he will do nothing but play in the
+ streets."</p>
+
+ <p>Aladdin hung his head with shame as his uncle gravely shook
+ his head.</p>
+
+ <p>"He must begin work at once," he said. "How would it please
+ thee to have a shop of thy own? I could buy one for thee, and
+ stock it with silks and rich stuffs."</p>
+
+ <p>Aladdin danced with joy at the very idea, and next day set
+ out with his supposed uncle, who bought him a splendid suit of
+ clothes, and took him all over the city to show him the
+ sights.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page61"
+ id="page61"></a>[pg 61]</span>
+
+ <p>The day after, the Magician again took Aladdin out with him,
+ but this time they went outside the city, through beautiful
+ gardens, into the open country. They walked so far that Aladdin
+ began to grow weary, but the Magician gave him a cake and some
+ delicious fruit and told him such wonderful tales that he
+ scarcely noticed how far they had gone. At last they came to a
+ deep valley between two mountains, and there the Magician
+ paused.</p>
+
+ <p>"Stop!" he cried, "this is the very place I am in search of.
+ Gather some sticks that we may make a fire."</p>
+
+ <p>Aladdin quickly did as he was bid, and had soon gathered
+ together a great heap of dry sticks. The Magician then set fire
+ to them, and the heap blazed up merrily. With great care the
+ old man now sprinkled some curious-looking powder on the
+ flames, and muttered strange words. In an instant the earth
+ beneath their feet trembled, and they heard a rumbling like
+ distant thunder. Then the ground opened in front of them, and
+ showed a great square slab of stone with a ring in it.</p>
+
+ <p>By this time Aladdin was so frightened that he turned to run
+ home as fast as he could, but the Magician caught him, and gave
+ him such a blow that he fell to the earth.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why dost thou strike me, uncle?" sobbed Aladdin.</p>
+
+ <p>"Do as I bid thee," said the Magician, "and then thou shalt
+ be well treated. Dost thou see that stone? Beneath it is a
+ treasure which I will share with thee. Only obey me, and it
+ will soon be ours."</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as Aladdin heard of a treasure, he jumped up and
+ forgot all his fears. He seized the ring as the Magician
+ directed, and easily pulled up the stone.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now," said the old man, "look in and thou wilt see stone
+ steps leading downwards. Thou shalt descend those steps until
+ thou comest to three great halls. Pass through them, but take
+ care to wrap thy coat well round thee that thou mayest touch
+ nothing, for if thou dost, thou wilt die instantly. When thou
+ hast passed through the halls thou wilt come into a garden of
+ fruit-trees. Go through it until thou seest a niche with a
+ lighted lamp in it. Put the light out, pour forth the oil, and
+ bring the lamp to
+ me."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page62"
+ id="page62"></a>[pg 62]</span>
+
+ <p>So saying the Magician placed a magic ring upon Aladdin's
+ finger to guard him, and bade the boy begin his search.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/62.jpg" name="fig62s"
+ id="fig62s"><img width="300" src="images/62s.jpg"
+ alt="ALADDIN AND THE MAGICIAN" /></a><br />
+ aladdin and the magician
+ </div>
+
+ <p>Aladdin did exactly as he was told and found everything just
+ as the Magician had said. He went through the halls and the
+ garden until he came to the lamp, and when he had poured out
+ the oil and placed the lamp carefully inside his coat he began
+ to look about him.</p>
+
+ <p>He had never seen such a lovely garden before, even in his
+ dreams. The fruits that hung upon the trees were of every color
+ of the rainbow. Some were clear and shining like crystal, some
+ sparkled with a crimson light and others were green, blue,
+ violet, and orange, while the leaves that shaded them were
+ silver and gold. Aladdin did not guess that these fruits were
+ precious stones, diamonds, rubies, emeralds, and sapphires, but
+ they looked so pretty that he filled all his pockets with them
+ as he passed back through the garden.</p>
+
+ <p>The Magician was eagerly peering down the stone steps when
+ Aladdin began to climb up.</p>
+
+ <p>"Give me the lamp," he cried, stretching his hand for
+ it.</p>
+
+ <p>"Wait until I get out," answered Aladdin, "and then I will
+ give it thee."</p>
+
+ <p>"Hand it up to me at once," screamed the old man
+ angrily.</p>
+
+ <p>"Not till I am safely out," repeated Aladdin.</p>
+
+ <p>Then the Magician stamped with rage, and rushing to the fire
+ threw on it some more of the curious powder, uttered the same
+ strange words as before, and instantly the stone slipped back
+ into its place, the earth closed over it, and Aladdin was left
+ in darkness.</p>
+
+ <p>This showed indeed that the wicked old man was not Aladdin's
+ uncle. By his magic arts in Africa he had found out all about
+ the lamp, which was a wonderful treasure, as you will see. But
+ he knew that he could not get it himself, that another hand
+ must fetch it to him. This was the reason why he had fixed upon
+ Aladdin to help him, and had meant, as soon as the lamp was
+ safely in his hand, to kill the boy.</p>
+
+ <p>As his plan had failed he went back to Africa, and was not
+ seen again for a long, long time.</p>
+
+ <p>But there was poor Aladdin shut up underground, with no
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page63" id="page63"></a>[pg
+ 63]</span> way of getting out! He tried to find his way back to
+ the great halls and the beautiful garden of shining fruits, but
+ the walls had closed up, and there was no escape that way
+ either. For two days the poor boy sat crying and moaning in his
+ despair, and just as he had made up his mind that he must die,
+ he clasped his hands together, and in doing so rubbed the ring
+ which the Magician had put upon his finger.</p>
+
+ <p>In an instant a huge figure rose out of the earth and stood
+ before him.</p>
+
+ <p>"What is thy will, my master?" it said. "I am the Slave of
+ the Ring, and must obey him who wears the ring."</p>
+
+ <p>"Whoever or whatever you are," cried Aladdin, "take me out
+ of this dreadful place."</p>
+
+ <p>Scarcely had he said these words when the earth opened, and
+ the next moment Aladdin found himself lying at his mother's
+ door. He was so weak for want of food, and his joy at seeing
+ his mother was so great, that he fainted away, but when he came
+ to himself he promised to tell her all that had happened.</p>
+
+ <p>"But first give me something to eat," he cried, "for I am
+ dying of hunger."</p>
+
+ <p>"Alas!" said his mother, "I have nothing in the house except
+ a little cotton, which I will go out and sell."</p>
+
+ <p>"Stop a moment," cried Aladdin, "rather let us sell this old
+ lamp which I have brought back with me."</p>
+
+ <p>Now the lamp looked so old and dirty that Aladdin's mother
+ began to rub it, wishing to brighten it a little that it might
+ fetch a higher price.</p>
+
+ <p>But no sooner had she given it the first rub than a huge
+ dark figure slowly rose from the floor like a wreath of smoke
+ until it reached the ceiling, towering above them.</p>
+
+ <p>"What is thy will?" it asked. "I am the Slave of the Lamp,
+ and must do the bidding of him who holds the Lamp."</p>
+
+ <p>The moment the figure began to rise from the ground
+ Aladdin's mother was so terrified that she fainted away, but
+ Aladdin managed to snatch the lamp from her, although he could
+ scarcely hold it in his own shaking hand.</p>
+
+ <p>"Fetch me something to eat," he said in a trembling voice,
+ for the terrible Genie was glaring down upon
+ him.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page64"
+ id="page64"></a>[pg 64]</span>
+
+ <p>The Slave of the Lamp disappeared in a cloud of smoke, but
+ in an instant he was back again, bringing with him a most
+ delicious breakfast, served upon plates and dishes of pure
+ gold.</p>
+
+ <p>By this time Aladdin's mother had recovered, but she was
+ almost too frightened to eat, and begged Aladdin to sell the
+ lamp at once, for she was sure it had something to do with evil
+ spirits. But Aladdin only laughed at her fears, and said he
+ meant to make use of the magic lamp and wonderful ring, now
+ that he knew their worth.</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as they again wanted money they sold the golden
+ plates and dishes, and when these were all gone Aladdin ordered
+ the Genie to bring more, and so they lived in comfort for
+ several years.</p>
+
+ <p>Now Aladdin had heard a great deal about the beauty of the
+ Sultan's daughter, and he began to long so greatly to see her
+ that he could not rest. He thought of a great many plans, but
+ they all seemed impossible, for the Princess never went out
+ without a veil, which covered her entirely. At last, however,
+ he managed to enter the palace and hide himself behind a door,
+ peeping through a chink when the Princess passed to go to her
+ bath.</p>
+
+ <p>The moment Aladdin's eyes rested upon the beautiful Princess
+ he loved her with all his heart, for she was as fair as the
+ dawn of a summer morning.</p>
+
+ <p>"Mother," he cried when he reached home, "I have seen the
+ Princess, and I have made up my mind to marry her. Thou shalt
+ go at once to the Sultan, and beg him to give me his
+ daughter."</p>
+
+ <p>Aladdin's mother stared at her son, and then began to laugh
+ at such a wild idea. She was almost afraid that Aladdin must be
+ mad, but he gave her no peace until she did as he wished.</p>
+
+ <p>So the next day she very unwillingly set out for the palace,
+ carrying the magic fruit wrapped up in a napkin, to present to
+ the Sultan. There were many other people offering their
+ petitions that day, and the poor woman was so frightened that
+ she dared not go forward, and so no one paid any attention to
+ her as she stood there patiently holding her bundle. For a
+ whole week she had gone every day to the palace, before the
+ Sultan noticed her.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page65"
+ id="page65"></a>[pg 65]</span>
+
+ <p>"Who is that poor woman who comes every day carrying a white
+ bundle?" he asked.</p>
+
+ <p>Then the Grand Vizier ordered that she should be brought
+ forward, and she came bowing herself to the ground.</p>
+
+ <p>She was almost too terrified to speak, but when the Sultan
+ spoke so kindly to her she took courage, and told him of
+ Aladdin's love for the Princess, and of his bold request, "He
+ sends you this gift," she continued, and opening the bundle she
+ presented the magic fruit.</p>
+
+ <p>A cry of wonder went up from all those who stood around, for
+ never had they beheld such exquisite jewels before. They shone
+ and sparkled with a thousand lights and colors, and dazzled the
+ eyes that gazed upon them.</p>
+
+ <p>The Sultan was astounded, and spoke to the Grand Vizier
+ apart.</p>
+
+ <p>"Surely it is fit that I should give my daughter to one who
+ can present such a wondrous gift?" he said....</p>
+
+ <p>Now when three months were ended, Aladdin's mother again
+ presented herself before the Sultan, and reminded him of his
+ promise, that the Princess should wed her son.</p>
+
+ <p>"I ever abide by my royal word," said the Sultan; "but he
+ who marries my daughter must first send me forty golden basins
+ filled to the brim with precious stones. These basins must be
+ carried by forty black slaves, each led by a white slave
+ dressed as befits the servants of the Sultan."</p>
+
+ <p>Aladdin's mother returned home in great distress when she
+ heard this, and told Aladdin what the Sultan had said.</p>
+
+ <p>"Alas, my son!" she cried, "thy hopes are ended."</p>
+
+ <p>"Not so, mother," answered Aladdin. "The Sultan shall not
+ have long to wait for his answer."</p>
+
+ <p>Then he rubbed the magic lamp, and when the Genie appeared,
+ he bade him provide the forty golden basins filled with jewels,
+ and all the slaves which the Sultan had demanded.</p>
+
+ <p>Now when this splendid procession passed through the streets
+ on its way to the palace, all the people came out to see the
+ sight, and stood amazed when they saw the golden basins filled
+ with sparkling gems carried on the heads of the great black
+ slaves. And when the palace was reached, and the slaves
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page66" id="page66"></a>[pg
+ 66]</span> presented the jewels to the Sultan, he was so
+ surprised and delighted that he was more than willing that
+ Aladdin should marry the Princess at once.</p>
+
+ <p>"Go, fetch thy son," he said to Aladdin's mother, who was
+ waiting near. "Tell him that this day he shall wed my
+ daughter."</p>
+
+ <p>But when Aladdin heard the news he refused to hasten at once
+ to the palace, as his mother advised. First he called the
+ Genie, and told him to bring a scented bath, and a robe worked
+ in gold, such as a King might wear. After this he called for
+ forty slaves to attend him, and six to walk before his mother,
+ and a horse more beautiful than the Sultan's, and lastly, for
+ ten thousand pieces of gold put up in ten purses.</p>
+
+ <p>When all these things were ready, and Aladdin was dressed in
+ his royal robe, he set out for the palace. As he rode along on
+ his beautiful horse, attended by his forty slaves, he scattered
+ the golden pieces out of the ten purses among the crowd, and
+ all the people shouted with joy and delight. No one knew that
+ this was the idle boy who used to play about the streets but
+ they thought he was some great foreign Prince.</p>
+
+ <p>Thus Aladdin arrived at the palace in great state, and when
+ the Sultan had embraced him, he ordered that the wedding feast
+ should be prepared at once, and that the marriage should take
+ place that day.</p>
+
+ <p>"Not so, your Majesty," said Aladdin; "I will not marry the
+ Princess until I have built a palace fit for the daughter of
+ the Sultan."</p>
+
+ <p>Then he returned home, and once more called up the Slave of
+ the Lamp.</p>
+
+ <p>"Build me the fairest palace ever beheld by mortal eye,"
+ ordered Aladdin. "Let it be built of marble and jasper and
+ precious stones. In the midst I would have a great hall, whose
+ walls shall be of gold and silver, lighted by four-and-twenty
+ windows. These windows shall all be set with diamonds, rubies,
+ and other precious stones, and one only shall be left
+ unfinished. There must also be stables with horses, and slaves
+ to serve in the palace. Begone, and do thy work quickly."</p>
+
+ <p>And lo! in the morning when Aladdin looked out, there
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page67" id="page67"></a>[pg
+ 67]</span> stood the most wonderful palace that ever was built.
+ Its marble walls were flushed a delicate pink in the morning
+ light, and the jewels flashed from every window.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Aladdin and his mother set off for the Sultan's palace,
+ and the wedding took place that day. The Princess loved Aladdin
+ as soon as she saw him, and great were the rejoicings
+ throughout the city.</p>
+
+ <p>The next day Aladdin invited the Sultan to visit the new
+ palace, and when he entered the great hall, whose walls were of
+ gold and silver and whose windows were set with jewels, he was
+ filled with admiration and astonishment.</p>
+
+ <p>"It is the wonder of the world," he cried. "Never before
+ have mortal eyes beheld such a beautiful palace. One thing
+ alone surprises me. Why is there one window left
+ unfinished?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Your Majesty," answered Aladdin, "this has been done with a
+ purpose, for I wished that thine own royal hand should have the
+ honor of putting the finishing touch to my palace."</p>
+
+ <p>The Sultan was so pleased when he heard this, that he sent
+ at once for all the court jewelers and ordered them to finish
+ the window like the rest.</p>
+
+ <p>The court jewelers worked for many days, and then sent to
+ tell the Sultan that they had used up all the jewels they
+ possessed, and still the window was not half finished. The
+ Sultan commanded that his own jewels should be given to
+ complete the work; even when these were used the window was not
+ finished.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Aladdin ordered the jewelers to stop their work, and to
+ take back all the Sultan's jewels as well as their own. And
+ that night he called up the Slave of the Lamp once more, and
+ bade him finish the window. This was done before the morning,
+ and great was the surprise of the Sultan and all his
+ workmen.</p>
+
+ <p>Now Aladdin did not grow proud of his great riches but was
+ gentle and courteous to all, and kind to the poor, so that the
+ people all loved him dearly. He fought and won many battles for
+ the Sultan, and was the greatest favorite in the land.</p>
+
+ <p>But far away in Africa there was trouble brewing for
+ Aladdin. The wicked old Magician who had pretended to be
+ Aladdin's uncle found out by his magic powers that the boy had
+ not <span class="pagenum"><a name="page68" id="page68"></a>[pg
+ 68]</span> perished when he left him underground, but had
+ somehow managed to escape and become rich and powerful.</p>
+
+ <p>"He must have discovered the secret of the lamp," shrieked
+ the Magician, tearing his hair with rage. "I will not rest day
+ or night until I shall have found some way of taking it from
+ him."</p>
+
+ <p>So he journeyed from Africa to China, and when he came to
+ the city where Aladdin lived and saw the wonderful palace, he
+ nearly choked with fury to see all its splendor and richness.
+ Then he disguised himself as a merchant, and bought a number of
+ copper lamps, and with these went from street to street,
+ crying, "New lamps for old."</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as the people heard his cry, they crowded round him,
+ laughing and jeering, for they thought he must be mad to make
+ such an offer.</p>
+
+ <p>Now it happened that Aladdin was out hunting, and the
+ Princess sat alone in the hall of the jeweled windows. When,
+ therefore, she heard the noise that was going on in the street
+ outside, she called to her slaves to ask what it meant.</p>
+
+ <p>Presently one of the slaves came back, laughing so much that
+ she could hardly speak.</p>
+
+ <p>"It is a curious old man who offers to give new lamps for
+ old," she cried. "Did any one ever hear before of such a
+ strange way of trading?"</p>
+
+ <p>The Princess laughed too, and pointed to an old lamp which
+ hung in a niche close by.</p>
+
+ <p>"There is an old enough lamp," she said. "Take it and see if
+ the old man will really give a new one for it."</p>
+
+ <p>The slave took it down and ran out to the street once more,
+ and when the Magician saw that it was indeed what he wanted, he
+ seized the Magic Lamp with both his hands.</p>
+
+ <p>"Choose any lamp you like," he said, showing her those of
+ bright new copper. He did not care now what happened. She might
+ have all the new lamps if she wanted them.</p>
+
+ <p>Then he went a little way outside the city, and when he was
+ quite alone he took out the Magic Lamp and rubbed it gently.
+ Immediately the Genie stood before him and asked what was his
+ will.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page69"
+ id="page69"></a>[pg 69]</span>
+
+ <p>"I order thee to carry off the palace of Aladdin, with the
+ Princess inside, and set it down in a lonely spot in
+ Africa."</p>
+
+ <p>And in an instant the palace, with every one in it, had
+ disappeared, and when the Sultan happened to look out of his
+ window, lo! there was no longer a palace to be seen.</p>
+
+ <p>"This must be enchantment," he cried.</p>
+
+ <p>Then he ordered his men to set out and bring Aladdin to him
+ in chains.</p>
+
+ <p>The officers met Aladdin as he was returning from the hunt,
+ and they immediately seized him, loaded him with chains, and
+ carried him off to the Sultan. But as he was borne along, the
+ people gathered around him, for they loved him dearly, and
+ vowed that no harm should befall him.</p>
+
+ <p>The Sultan was beside himself with rage when he saw Aladdin,
+ and gave orders that his head should be cut off at once. But
+ the people had begun to crowd into the palace, and they were so
+ fierce and threatening that he dared not do as he wished. He
+ was obliged to order the chains to be taken off, and Aladdin to
+ be set free.</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as Aladdin was allowed to speak he asked why all
+ this was done to him.</p>
+
+ <p>"Wretch!" exclaimed the Sultan, "come hither, and I will
+ show thee."</p>
+
+ <p>Then he led Aladdin to the window and showed him the empty
+ space where his palace had once stood.</p>
+
+ <p>"Think not that I care for thy vanished palace," he said.
+ "But where is the Princess, my daughter?"</p>
+
+ <p>So astonished was Aladdin that for some time he could only
+ stand speechless, staring at the place where his palace ought
+ to have been.</p>
+
+ <p>At last he turned to the Sultan.</p>
+
+ <p>"Your Majesty," he said, "grant me grace for one month, and
+ if by that time I have not brought back thy daughter to thee,
+ then put me to death as I deserve."</p>
+
+ <p>So Aladdin was set free, and for three days he went about
+ like a madman, asking every one he met where his palace was.
+ But no one could tell him, and all laughed at his misery. Then
+ he went to the river to drown himself; but as he knelt on the
+ bank <span class="pagenum"><a name="page70" id="page70"></a>[pg
+ 70]</span> and clasped his hands to say his prayers before
+ throwing himself in, he once more rubbed the Magic Ring.
+ Instantly the Genie of the Ring stood before him.</p>
+
+ <p>"What is thy will, O master?" it asked.</p>
+
+ <p>"Bring back my Princess and my palace," cried Aladdin, "and
+ save my life."</p>
+
+ <p>"That I cannot do," said the Slave of the Ring. "Only the
+ Slave of the Lamp has power to bring back thy palace."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then take me to the place where my palace now stands," said
+ Aladdin, "and put me down beneath the window of the
+ Princess."</p>
+
+ <p>And almost before Aladdin had done speaking he found himself
+ in Africa, beneath the windows of his own palace.</p>
+
+ <p>He was so weary that he lay down and fell fast asleep; but
+ before long, when day dawned, he was awakened by the song of
+ the birds, and as he looked around his courage returned. He was
+ now sure that all his misfortunes must have been caused by the
+ loss of the Magic Lamp, and he determined to find out as soon
+ as possible who had stolen it.</p>
+
+ <p>That same morning the Princess awoke feeling happier than
+ she had felt since she had been carried off. The sun was
+ shining so brightly, and the birds were singing so gaily, that
+ she went to the window to greet the opening day. And who should
+ she see standing beneath her window but Aladdin!</p>
+
+ <p>With a cry of joy she threw open the casement and the sound
+ made Aladdin look up. It was not long before he made his way
+ through a secret door and held her in his arms.</p>
+
+ <p>"Tell me, Princess," said Aladdin, when they had joyfully
+ embraced each other many times, "what has become of the old
+ lamp which hung in a niche of the great hall?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Alas! my husband," answered the Princess, "I fear my
+ carelessness has been the cause of all our misfortunes."</p>
+
+ <p>Then she told him how the wicked old Magician had pretended
+ to be a merchant, and had offered new lamps for old, and how he
+ had thus managed to secure the Magic Lamp.</p>
+
+ <p>"He has it still," she added, "for I know that he carries it
+ always, hidden in his robe."</p>
+
+ <p>"Princess," said Aladdin, "I must recover this lamp, and
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page71" id="page71"></a>[pg
+ 71]</span> thou shalt help me. To-night when the Magician dines
+ with thee, dress thyself in thy costliest robes, and be kind
+ and gracious to him. Then bid him fetch some of the wines of
+ Africa, and when he is gone, I will tell thee what thou shalt
+ do."</p>
+
+ <p>So that night the Princess put on her most beautiful robes,
+ and looked so lovely and was so kind when the Magician came in,
+ that he could scarcely believe his eyes. For she had been sad
+ and angry ever since he had carried her off.</p>
+
+ <p>"I believe now that Aladdin must be dead," she said, "and I
+ have made up my mind to mourn no longer. Let us begin our
+ feast. But see! I grow weary of these wines of China, fetch me
+ instead the wine of thy own country."</p>
+
+ <p>Now Aladdin had meanwhile prepared a powder which he
+ directed the Princess to place in her own wine-cup. So when the
+ Magician returned with the African wine, she filled her cup and
+ offered it to him in token of friendship. The Magician drank it
+ up eagerly, and scarcely had he finished when he dropped down
+ dead.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Aladdin came out of the next chamber where he had
+ hidden himself, and searched in the Magician's robe until he
+ found the Magic Lamp. He rubbed it joyfully, and when the Genie
+ appeared, ordered that the palace should be carried back to
+ China, and set down in its own place.</p>
+
+ <p>The following morning, when the Sultan rose early, for he
+ was too sad to take much rest, he went to the window to gaze on
+ the place where Aladdin's palace had once stood. He rubbed his
+ eyes, and stared wildly about.</p>
+
+ <p>"This must be a dream," he cried, for there stood the palace
+ in all its beauty, looking fairer than ever in the morning
+ light.</p>
+
+ <p>Not a moment did the Sultan lose, but he rode over to the
+ palace at once, and when he had embraced Aladdin and his
+ daughter, they told him the whole story of the African
+ Magician. Then Aladdin showed him the dead body of the wicked
+ old man, and there was peace between them once more.</p>
+
+ <p>But there was still trouble in store for Aladdin. The
+ African Magician had a younger brother who also dealt in magic,
+ and who was if possible even more wicked than his elder
+ brother.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page72"
+ id="page72"></a>[pg 72]</span>
+
+ <p>Full of revenge, this younger brother started for China,
+ determined to punish Aladdin and steal the Magic Lamp for
+ himself. As soon as he arrived he went in secret to the cell of
+ a holy woman called Fatima, and obliged her to give him her
+ robe and veil as a disguise. Then to keep the secret safe he
+ killed the poor woman.</p>
+
+ <p>Dressed in the robe and veil, the wicked Magician walked
+ through the streets near Aladdin's palace, and all the people
+ as he passed by knelt and kissed his robe, for they thought he
+ was indeed the holy woman.</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as the Princess heard that Fatima was passing by in
+ the street, she sent and commanded her to be brought into the
+ hall, and she treated the supposed holy woman with great
+ respect and kindness, for she had often longed to see her.</p>
+
+ <p>"Is not this a fine hall?" she asked, as they sat together
+ in the hall of the jeweled windows.</p>
+
+ <p>"It is indeed most beautiful," answered the Magician, who
+ kept his veil carefully down, "but to my mind there is one
+ thing wanting. If only thou couldst have a roc's egg hung in
+ the dome it would be perfect."</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as the Princess heard these words she became
+ discontented and miserable, and when Aladdin came in, she
+ looked so sad that he at once asked what was the matter.</p>
+
+ <p>"I can never be happy until I have a roc's egg hanging from
+ the dome of the great hall," she answered.</p>
+
+ <p>"In that case thou shalt soon be happy," said Aladdin gaily,
+ and taking down the lamp, he summoned the Genie.</p>
+
+ <p>But when the Slave of the Lamp heard the order his face grew
+ terrible with rage, and his eyes gleamed like burning
+ coals.</p>
+
+ <p>"Vile wretch!" he shrieked, "have I not given thee all thy
+ wishes, and now dost thou ask me to kill my master, and hang
+ him as an ornament in thy palace? Thou deservest truly to die;
+ but I know that the request cometh not from thine own heart,
+ but was the suggestion of that wicked Magician who pretends to
+ be a holy woman."</p>
+
+ <p>With these words the Genie vanished, and. Aladdin went at
+ once to the room where the Princess was awaiting
+ him.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page73"
+ id="page73"></a>[pg 73]</span>
+
+ <p>"I have a headache," he said. "Call the holy woman, that she
+ may place her hand upon my forehead and ease the pain."</p>
+
+ <p>But the moment that the false Fatima appeared Aladdin sprang
+ up and plunged his dagger into that evil heart.</p>
+
+ <p>"What hast thou done?" cried the Princess. "Alas! thou hast
+ slain the holy woman."</p>
+
+ <p>"This is no holy woman," answered Aladdin, "but an evil
+ Magician whose purpose was to destroy us both."</p>
+
+ <p>So Aladdin was saved from the wicked design of the two
+ Magicians, and there was no one left to disturb his peace. He
+ and the Princess lived together in great happiness for many
+ years, and when the Sultan died they succeeded to the throne,
+ and ruled both wisely and well. And so there was great peace
+ throughout the land.</p>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE ENCHANTED HORSE</h4>
+
+ <p>It was New Year's day in Persia, the most splendid feast-day
+ of all the year, and the King had been entertained, hour after
+ hour, by the wonderful shows prepared for him by his people.
+ Evening was drawing on and the court was just about to retire,
+ when an Indian appeared, leading a horse which he wished to
+ show to the King. It was not a real horse, but it was so
+ wonderfully made that it looked exactly as if it were
+ alive.</p>
+
+ <p>"Your Majesty," cried the Indian, as he bowed himself to the
+ ground, "I beg thou wilt look upon this wonder. Nothing thou
+ hast seen to-day can equal this horse of mine. I have only to
+ mount upon its back and wish myself in any part of the world,
+ and it carries me there in a few minutes." Now the King of
+ Persia was very fond of curious and clever things, so he looked
+ at the horse with great interest.</p>
+
+ <p>"It seems only a common horse," he said, "but thou shalt
+ show us what it can do."</p>
+
+ <p>Then he pointed to a distant mountain, and bade the Indian
+ to fetch a branch from the palm-trees which grew near its
+ foot.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page74"
+ id="page74"></a>[pg 74]</span>
+
+ <p>The Indian vaulted into the saddle, turned a little peg in
+ the horse's neck, and in a moment was flying so swiftly through
+ the air that he soon disappeared from sight. In less than a
+ quarter of an hour he reappeared, and laid the palm-branch at
+ the King's feet.</p>
+
+ <p>"Thou art right," cried the King; "thy enchanted horse is
+ the most wonderful thing I have yet seen. What is its price? I
+ must have it for my own."</p>
+
+ <p>The Indian shook his head.</p>
+
+ <p>"Your Majesty," he said, "this horse can never be sold for
+ money, but can only be exchanged for something of equal value.
+ It shall be thine only if thou wilt give me instead the
+ Princess, your daughter, for my wife."</p>
+
+ <p>At these words the King's son sprang to his feet.</p>
+
+ <p>"Sire," he cried, "thou wilt never dream of granting such a
+ request."</p>
+
+ <p>"My son," answered the King, "at whatever cost I must have
+ this wonderful horse. But before I agree to the exchange, I
+ would wish thee to try the horse, and tell me what thou
+ thinkest of it."</p>
+
+ <p>The Indian, who stood listening to what they said, was quite
+ willing that the Prince should try the Enchanted Horse, and
+ began to give him directions how to guide it. But as soon as
+ the Prince was in the saddle and saw the peg which made the
+ horse start, he never waited to hear more. He turned the screw
+ at once, and went flying off through the air.</p>
+
+ <p>"Alas!" cried the Indian, "he has gone off without learning
+ how to come back. Never will he be able to stop the horse
+ unless he finds the second peg."</p>
+
+ <p>The King was terribly frightened when he heard the Indian's
+ words, for, by this time, the Prince had disappeared from
+ sight.</p>
+
+ <p>"Wretch," he cried, "thou shalt be cast into prison, and
+ unless my son returns in safety, thou shalt be put to
+ death."</p>
+
+ <p>Meanwhile the Prince had gone gaily sailing up into the air
+ until he reached the clouds, and could no longer see the earth
+ below. This was very pleasant, and he felt that he had never
+ had such a delicious ride in his life before. But presently he
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page75" id="page75"></a>[pg
+ 75]</span> began to think it was time to descend. He screwed
+ the peg round and round, backwards and forwards, but it seemed
+ to make no difference. Instead of coming down he sailed higher
+ and higher, until he thought he was going to knock his head
+ against the blue sky.</p>
+
+ <p>What was to be done? The Prince began to grow a little
+ nervous, and he felt over the horse's neck to see if there was
+ another peg to be found anywhere. To his joy, just behind the
+ ear. He touched a small screw, and when he turned it, he felt
+ he was going slower and slower, and gently turning round. Then
+ he shouted with joy as the Enchanted Horse flew downwards
+ through the starry night, and he saw, stretched out before him,
+ a beautiful city gleaming white through the purple mantle of
+ the night.</p>
+
+ <p>Everything was strange to him, and he did not know in what
+ direction to guide the horse, so he let it go where it would,
+ and presently it stopped on the roof of a great marble palace.
+ There was a gallery running round the roof, and at the end of
+ the gallery there was a door leading down some white marble
+ steps.</p>
+
+ <p>The Prince began at once to descend the steps, and found
+ himself in a great hall where a row of black slaves were
+ sleeping soundly, guarding the entrance to a room beyond.</p>
+
+ <p>Very softly the Prince crept past the guards, and lifting
+ the curtain from the door, looked in.</p>
+
+ <p>And there he saw a splendid room lighted by a thousand
+ lights and filled with sleeping slaves, and in the middle, upon
+ a sofa, was the most beautiful Princess his eyes had ever gazed
+ upon.</p>
+
+ <p>She was so lovely that the Prince held his breath with
+ admiration as he looked at her. Then he went softly to her
+ side, and, kneeling by the sofa, gently touched her hand. The
+ Princess sighed and opened her eyes, but before she could cry
+ out, he begged her in a whisper to be silent and fear
+ nothing.</p>
+
+ <p>"I am a Prince," he said, "the son of the King of Persia. I
+ am in danger of my life here, and crave thy protection."</p>
+
+ <p>Now this Princess was no other than the daughter of the King
+ of Bengal, who happened to be staying alone in her summer
+ palace outside the city.</p>
+
+ <p>"I will protect thee," said the Princess kindly, giving him
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page76" id="page76"></a>[pg
+ 76]</span> her hand. Then she awoke her slaves and bade them
+ give the stranger food and prepare a sleeping-room for him.</p>
+
+ <p>"I long to hear thy adventures and how thou camest here,"
+ she said to the Prince, "but first thou must rest and refresh
+ thyself."</p>
+
+ <p>Never before had the Princess seen any one so gallant and
+ handsome as this strange young Prince. She dressed herself in
+ her loveliest robes, and twined her hair with her most precious
+ jewels, that she might appear as beautiful as possible in his
+ eyes. And when the Prince saw her again, he thought her the
+ most charming Princess in all the world, and he loved her with
+ all his heart. But when he had told her all his adventures she
+ sighed to think that he must now leave her and return to his
+ father's court.</p>
+
+ <p>"Do not grieve," he said, "I will return in state as befits
+ a Prince, and demand thy hand in marriage from the King thy
+ father."</p>
+
+ <p>"Stay but a few days ere thou goest," replied the Princess.
+ "I cannot part with thee so soon."</p>
+
+ <p>The Prince was only too willing to wait a while, and the
+ Princess entertained him so well with feasts and
+ hunting-parties that day after day slipped by, and still he
+ lingered.</p>
+
+ <p>At last, however, the thought of his home and his father's
+ grief made him decide to return at once.</p>
+
+ <p>"My Princess," he said, "since it is so hard to part, wilt
+ thou not ride with me upon the Enchanted Horse? When we are
+ once more in Persia our marriage shall take place, and then we
+ will return to the King thy father."</p>
+
+ <p>So together they mounted the Enchanted Horse and the Prince
+ placed his arm around the Princess and turned the magic peg. Up
+ and up they flew over land and sea, and then the Prince turned
+ the other screw, and they landed just outside his father's
+ city. He guided the horse to a palace outside the gates, and
+ there he left the Princess, for he wished to go alone to
+ prepare his father.</p>
+
+ <p>Now when the Prince reached the court he found every one
+ dressed in brown, and all the bells of the city were tolling
+ mournfully.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page77"
+ id="page77"></a>[pg 77]</span>
+
+ <p>"Why is every one so sad?" he asked of one of the
+ guards.</p>
+
+ <p>"The Prince, the Prince!" cried the man. "The Prince has
+ come back."</p>
+
+ <p>And soon the joyful news spread over the town, and the bells
+ stopped tolling and rang a joyful peal.</p>
+
+ <p>"My beloved son!" cried the King, as he embraced him. "We
+ thought thou wert lost for ever, and we have mourned for thee
+ day and night."</p>
+
+ <p>Without waiting to hear more, the Prince began to tell the
+ King all his adventures, and how the Princess of Bengal awaited
+ him in the palace outside the gates.</p>
+
+ <p>"Let her be brought here instantly," cried the King, "and
+ the marriage shall take place to-day."</p>
+
+ <p>Then he ordered that the Indian should be set free at once
+ and allowed to depart with the Enchanted Horse.</p>
+
+ <p>Great was the surprise of the Indian when, instead of having
+ his head cut off as he had expected, he was allowed to go free
+ with his wonderful horse. He asked what adventures had befallen
+ the Prince, and when he heard of the Princess who was waiting
+ in the palace outside the gates, a wicked plan came into his
+ head.</p>
+
+ <p>He took the Enchanted Horse, and went straight to the palace
+ before the King's messengers could reach it.</p>
+
+ <p>"Tell the Princess," he said to the slaves, "that the Prince
+ of Persia has sent me to bring her to his father's palace upon
+ the Enchanted Horse."</p>
+
+ <p>The Princess was very glad when she heard this message, and
+ she quickly made herself ready to go with the messenger.</p>
+
+ <p>But alas! as soon as the Indian turned the peg and the horse
+ flew through the air, she found she was being carried off, far
+ away from Persia and her beloved Prince.</p>
+
+ <p>All her prayers and entreaties were in vain. The Indian only
+ mocked at her, and told her he meant to marry her himself.</p>
+
+ <p>Meanwhile the Prince and his attendants had arrived at the
+ palace outside the gates, only to find that the Indian had been
+ there before them and had carried off the Princess.</p>
+
+ <p>The Prince was nearly beside himself with grief, but he
+ still <span class="pagenum"><a name="page78"
+ id="page78"></a>[pg 78]</span> hoped to find his bride. He
+ disguised himself as a dervish and set off to seek for her,
+ vowing that he would find her, or perish in the attempt.</p>
+
+ <p>By this time the Enchanted Horse had traveled many hundreds
+ of miles. Then, as the Indian was hungry, it was made to
+ descend into a wood close to a town of Cashmere.</p>
+
+ <p>Here the Indian went in search of food, and when he returned
+ with some fruit he shared it with the Princess, who was faint
+ and weary.</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as the Princess had eaten a little she felt stronger
+ and braver, and as she heard horses galloping past, she called
+ out loudly for help.</p>
+
+ <p>The men on horseback came riding at once to her aid, and she
+ quickly told them who she was, and how the Indian had carried
+ her off against her will. Then the leader of the horsemen, who
+ was the Sultan of Cashmere, ordered his men to cut off the
+ Indian's head. But he placed the Princess upon his horse and
+ led her to his palace.</p>
+
+ <p>Now the Princess thought that her troubles were all at an
+ end, but she was much mistaken. The Sultan had no sooner seen
+ her than he made up his mind to marry her, and he ordered the
+ wedding preparations to be begun without loss of time.</p>
+
+ <p>In vain the Princess begged to be sent back to Persia. The
+ Sultan only smiled and fixed the wedding-day. Then when she saw
+ that nothing would turn him from his purpose, she thought of a
+ plan to save herself. She began talking all the nonsense she
+ could think of and behaving as if she were mad, and so well did
+ she pretend, that the wedding was put off, and all the doctors
+ were called in to see if they could cure her.</p>
+
+ <p>But whenever a doctor came near the Princess she became so
+ wild and violent that he dared not even feel her pulse, so none
+ of them discovered that she was only pretending.</p>
+
+ <p>The Sultan was in great distress, and sent far and near for
+ the cleverest doctors. But none of them seemed to be able to
+ cure the Princess of her madness.</p>
+
+ <p>All this time the Prince of Persia was wandering about in
+ search of his Princess, and when he came to one of the great
+ cities of India, he heard every one talking about the sad
+ illness <span class="pagenum"><a name="page79"
+ id="page79"></a>[pg 79]</span> of the Princess of Bengal who
+ was to have married the Sultan. He at once disguised himself as
+ a doctor and went to the palace, saying he had come to cure the
+ Princess.</p>
+
+ <p>The Sultan received the new doctor with joy, and led him at
+ once to the room where the Princess sat alone, weeping and
+ wringing her hands.</p>
+
+ <p>"Your Majesty," said the disguised Prince, "no one else must
+ enter the room with me, or the cure will fail."</p>
+
+ <p>So the Sultan left him, and the Prince went close to the
+ Princess, and gently touched her hand.</p>
+
+ <p>"My beloved Princess," he said, "dost thou not know me?"</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as the Princess heard that dear voice she threw
+ herself into the Prince's arms, and her joy was so great that
+ she could not speak.</p>
+
+ <p>"We must at once plan our escape," said the Prince. "Canst
+ thou tell me what has become of the Enchanted Horse?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Naught can I tell thee of it, dear Prince," answered the
+ Princess, "but since the Sultan knows its value, no doubt he
+ has kept it in some safe place."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then first we must persuade the Sultan that thou art almost
+ cured," said the Prince. "Put on thy costliest robes and dine
+ with him to-night, and I will do the rest."</p>
+
+ <p>The Sultan was charmed to find the Princess so much better,
+ and his joy knew no bounds when the new doctor told him that he
+ hoped by the next day to complete the cure.</p>
+
+ <p>"I find that the Princess has somehow been infected by the
+ magic of the Enchanted Horse," he said. "If thou wilt have the
+ horse brought out into the great square, and place the Princess
+ upon its back, I will prepare some magic perfumes which will
+ dispel the enchantment. Let all the people be gathered together
+ to see the sight, and let the Princess be arrayed in her
+ richest dress and decked with all her jewels."</p>
+
+ <p>So next morning the Enchanted Horse was brought out into the
+ crowded square, and the Princess was mounted upon its back.
+ Then the disguised Prince placed four braziers of burning coals
+ round the horse and threw into them a perfume of a most
+ delicious scent. The smoke of the perfume rose in thick clouds,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page80" id="page80"></a>[pg
+ 80]</span> almost hiding the Princess, and at that moment the
+ Prince leaped into the saddle behind her, turned the peg, and
+ sailed away into the blue sky.</p>
+
+ <p>But as he swept past the Sultan, he cried aloud, "Sultan of
+ Cashmere, next time thou dost wish to wed a Princess, ask her
+ first if she be willing to wed thee."</p>
+
+ <p>So this was the manner in which the Prince of Persia carried
+ off the Princess of Bengal for the second time. The Enchanted
+ Horse never stopped until it had carried them safely back to
+ Persia, and there they were married amid great rejoicings.</p>
+
+ <p>But what became of the Enchanted Horse? Ah! that is a
+ question which no one can answer.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/80.jpg" name="fig80s"
+ id="fig80s"><img width="300" src="images/80s.jpg"
+ alt="HINDBAD WAS CARRYING A VERY HEAVY LOAD" /></a><br />
+ hindbad was carrying a very heavy load
+ </div>
+
+ <h4>III</h4>
+
+ <h4>SINDBAD THE SAILOR</h4>
+
+ <p>In the city of Bagdad, far away in Persia, there lived a
+ poor man called Hindbad. He was a porter, and one hot
+ afternoon, as he was carrying a very heavy load, he stopped to
+ rest in a quiet street near a beautiful house which he had
+ never seen before. The pavement outside was sprinkled with
+ rose-water, which felt very cool and pleasant to his hot, weary
+ feet, and from the open windows came the most delicious scents
+ which perfumed all the air.</p>
+
+ <p>Hindbad wondered who lived in this beautiful house, and
+ presently he went up to one of the splendidly dressed servants,
+ who was standing at the door, and asked to whom it belonged.
+ The servant stared in amazement.</p>
+
+ <p>"Dost thou indeed live in Bagdad and knowest not my master's
+ name?" he said. "He is the great Sindbad the Sailor, the man
+ who has sailed all round the world, and who has had the most
+ wonderful adventures under the sun."</p>
+
+ <p>Now Hindbad had often heard of this wonderful man and of his
+ great riches, and as he looked at the beautiful palace and saw
+ the splendidly dressed servants it made him feel sad and
+ envious. As he turned away sighing, to take up his load again,
+ he looked up into the blue sky, and said
+ aloud:</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page81"
+ id="page81"></a>[pg 81]</span>
+
+ <p>"What a difference there is between this man's lot and mine.
+ He has all that he wants, and nothing to do but to spend money
+ and enjoy a pleasant life, while I have to work hard to get dry
+ bread enough to keep myself and my children alive. What has he
+ done that he should be so lucky, and what have I done that I
+ should be so miserable?"</p>
+
+ <p>Just then one of the servants touched him on the shoulder,
+ and said to him: "My noble master wishes to see thee, and has
+ bidden me fetch thee to him."</p>
+
+ <p>The poor porter was frightened at first, for he thought some
+ one might have overheard what he had been saying, but the
+ servant took his arm and led him into the great dining-hall.
+ There were many guests seated round the table, on which was
+ spread a most delicious feast, and at the head of the table sat
+ a grave, stately old man with a long white beard. This was
+ Sindbad the Sailor. He smiled kindly on poor frightened
+ Hindbad, and made a sign that he should come and sit at his
+ right hand. Then all the most delicious things on the table
+ were offered by the servants to Hindbad, and his glass was
+ filled with the choicest wine, so that he began to feel it must
+ all be a dream.</p>
+
+ <p>But when the feast was over Sindbad turned to him and asked
+ him what it was he had been saying outside the window just
+ before he came in.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Hindbad was very much ashamed, and hung his head as he
+ answered: "My lord, I was tired and ill-tempered, and I said
+ foolish words, which I trust thou wilt now pardon."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh," replied Sindbad, "I am not so unjust as to blame thee.
+ I am indeed only sorry for thee. But thou wert wrong in
+ thinking that I have always led an easy life, and that these
+ riches came to me without trouble or suffering. I have won them
+ by years of toil and danger."</p>
+
+ <p>Then turning to his other guests he said, "Yes, my friends,
+ the tale of my adventures is enough to warn every one of you
+ never to go in search of wealth. I have never told you the
+ story of my voyages, but if you will listen I will begin this
+ very night."</p>
+
+ <p>So the servants were ordered to carry home the porter's
+ load, that he might stay in Sindbad's palace that evening and
+ listen to the story.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page82"
+ id="page82"></a>[pg 82]</span>
+
+ <p>"My father left me a great deal of money when I was a young
+ man, but I spent it so quickly and foolishly that I began to
+ see it would soon all be gone. This made me stop and think, for
+ I did not like the idea of being poor. So I counted up all the
+ money that remained, and made up my mind that I would trade
+ with it. I joined a company of merchants, and we set sail in a
+ good ship, meaning to go from place to place, and sell or
+ exchange our goods at whatever towns we stopped. And so began
+ my first voyage.</p>
+
+ <p>"For the first few days I could think of nothing but the
+ heaving of the waves; but by and by I began to feel better, and
+ never again was I at all unhappy upon the sea. One afternoon,
+ when the wind had suddenly dropped and we were lying becalmed,
+ we found ourselves near a little low green island, which looked
+ like a meadow, and only just showed above the sea. The captain
+ of the ship gave us permission to land, and presently we were
+ all enjoying ourselves on the green meadow. We walked about for
+ some time and then sat down to rest, and some of us set to work
+ to light a fire, that we might make our evening meal.</p>
+
+ <p>"But scarcely had the fire begun to burn, when we heard loud
+ shouts from the ship warning us to come back at once, for what
+ we had taken to be an island was indeed the back of a sleeping
+ whale. My companions all rushed to the boats, but before I
+ could follow them the great monster dived down and disappeared,
+ leaving me struggling in the water.</p>
+
+ <p>"I clung to a piece of wood which we had brought from the
+ ship to make the fire, and I could only hope that I would soon
+ be picked up by my companions. But alas! there was so much
+ confusion on board that no one missed me, and as a wind sprang
+ up the captain set sail, and I was left alone at the mercy of
+ the waves.</p>
+
+ <p>"All night long I floated, and when morning came I was so
+ tired and weak that I thought I must die. But just then a great
+ wave lifted me up and threw me against the steep side of an
+ island, and to my joy I managed to climb the cliff and rest on
+ the green grass above.</p>
+
+ <p>"Soon I began to feel better, and as I was very hungry I
+ went <span class="pagenum"><a name="page83" id="page83"></a>[pg
+ 83]</span> to look for something to eat. I found some plants
+ which tasted good, and a spring of clear water, and having made
+ a good meal, I walked about the island to see what I would find
+ next.</p>
+
+ <p>"Before long I came to a great meadow where a horse was
+ tied, and as I stood looking at it, I heard men's voices which
+ sounded as if they came from under the earth. Then from an
+ underground cave a man appeared, who asked me who I was and
+ where I came from. He took me into the cave where his
+ companions were, and they told me they were the grooms
+ belonging to the King of the island, whose horses they brought
+ to feed in the meadow. They gave me a good meal, and told me it
+ was very lucky that I had come just then, for next day, they
+ meant to return to their master, and would show me the way,
+ which I could never have found for myself.</p>
+
+ <p>"So we set off together early next morning, and when we
+ reached the city I was very kindly received by the King. He
+ listened to the story of my adventures, and then bade his
+ servants see that I wanted for nothing.</p>
+
+ <p>"As I was a merchant I took great interest in the shipping,
+ and often went down to the quay to see the boats unload. One
+ day when I was looking over a cargo which had just been landed,
+ what was my astonishment to see a number of bales with my own
+ name marked on them. I went at once to the captain and asked
+ him who was the owner of these bales of goods.</p>
+
+ <p>"'Ah!' replied the captain, 'they belonged to a merchant of
+ Bagdad called Sindbad. But he, alas! perished in a dreadful way
+ soon after we sailed, for with a number of people belonging to
+ my ship he landed on what looked like a green island, but which
+ was really the back of a great sleeping whale. As soon as the
+ monster felt the warmth of the fire which they had lighted on
+ his back, he woke up and dived below the sea. Many of my men
+ were drowned, and among them poor Sindbad. Now I mean to sell
+ his goods that I may give the money to his relations when I
+ find them.'</p>
+
+ <p>"'Captain,' said I, 'these bales are mine, for I am that
+ Sindbad who thou sayest was drowned.'</p>
+
+ <p>"'What wickedness there is in the world,' cried the captain.
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page84" id="page84"></a>[pg
+ 84]</span> 'How canst thou pretend to be Sindbad when I saw him
+ drowned before my eyes?'</p>
+
+ <p>"But presently, when I had told him all that had happened to
+ me, and when the other merchants from the ship knew me to be
+ the true Sindbad, he was overjoyed, and ordered that the bales
+ should be at once given to me.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now I was able to give the King a handsome present, and
+ after I had traded with my goods for sandal-wood, nutmegs,
+ ginger, pepper and cloves, I set sail once more with the kind
+ old captain. On the way home I was able to sell all my spices
+ at a good price, so that when I landed I found I had a hundred
+ thousand sequins.</p>
+
+ <p>"My family were delighted to see me again, and I soon bought
+ some land and built a splendid house, in which I meant to live
+ happily and forget all the troubles through which I had
+ passed."</p>
+
+ <p>Here Sindbad ended the story of his first voyage. He ordered
+ the music to strike up and the feast to go on, and when it was
+ over he gave the poor porter Hindbad a hundred gold pieces and
+ told him to come back at the same time next evening if he
+ wished to hear the tale of the second voyage.</p>
+
+ <p>Hindbad went joyfully home, and you can imagine how happy
+ the poor family were that night.</p>
+
+ <p>Next evening he set out once more for Sindbad's house,
+ dressed in his best clothes. There he enjoyed a splendid supper
+ as before, and when it was over Sindbad said:</p>
+
+ <p>"I was very happy for some time at home, but before long I
+ began to grow weary of leading an idle life. I longed to be
+ upon the sea again, to feel the good ship bounding over the
+ waves, and to hear the wind whistling through the rigging.</p>
+
+ <p>"So I set to work at once and bought all kinds of goods that
+ I might sell again in foreign lands, and then, having found a
+ suitable ship, I set sail with other merchants, and so began my
+ second voyage.</p>
+
+ <p>"We stopped at many places, and sold our goods at a great
+ profit, and all went well until one day when we landed on a new
+ island. It was a most beautiful place, fair as the garden of
+ Eden, where exquisite flowers made a perfect rainbow of color
+ and delicious fruits hung in ripe clusters
+ above.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page85"
+ id="page85"></a>[pg 85]</span>
+
+ <p>"Here, under the shadow of the tree, I sat down to rest and
+ to feast my eyes upon all the loveliness around. I ate the food
+ I had brought with me, drank my wine, and then closed my eyes.
+ The soft music of the stream which flowed close by was like a
+ song in my ears, and, before I knew what I was doing, I fell
+ asleep.</p>
+
+ <p>"I cannot tell how long I slept, but when at last I opened
+ my eyes, I could not see my companions anywhere, and when I
+ looked towards the sea, to my horror I found the ship was gone.
+ It was sailing away, a white speck in the distance, and here
+ was I, left alone upon this desert island. I cried aloud and
+ wrung my hands with grief, and wished with all my heart that I
+ had stayed safely at home. But what was the use of wishing that
+ now?</p>
+
+ <p>"So I climbed into a high tree, and looked around to see if
+ I could by any means find a way of escape from the island.
+ First I looked towards the sea, but there was no hope for me
+ there, and then I turned and looked inland. The first thing
+ that caught my eye was a huge white dome, that seemed to rise
+ from the center of the island, unlike anything I had ever seen
+ before.</p>
+
+ <p>"I climbed down the tree, and made my way towards the white
+ dome as quickly as I could, but when I reached it, it puzzled
+ me more than ever. It was like a great smooth ball, much too
+ slippery to climb, and into it there was no door or entrance of
+ any sort. I walked round and round it, wondering what it could
+ be, when suddenly a dark shadow fell upon everything and it
+ grew black as night.</p>
+
+ <p>"I gazed upwards in great fear, and knew that the shadow was
+ cast by a great bird with outspread wings hovering over the
+ place where I stood and shutting out heaven's light. As I
+ looked, it suddenly came swooping down, and sat upon the white
+ dome.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then it flashed into my mind that this must be the bird
+ which I had heard sailors talk of, called a roc, and the smooth
+ white ball must be its egg.</p>
+
+ <p>"Quick as thought, I unbound my turban, and twisted it into
+ a rope. Then I wound it round and round my waist, and
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page86" id="page86"></a>[pg
+ 86]</span> tied the two ends tightly round the roc's leg, which
+ was close to where I stood.</p>
+
+ <p>"'It will fly away soon, and carry me away with it off this
+ desert island,' I said to myself joyfully.</p>
+
+ <p>"And sure enough, before very long I felt myself lifted off
+ the ground, and carried up and up until it seemed as if we had
+ reached the clouds. Then the huge bird began to sink down
+ again, and when it reached the ground I quickly untied my
+ turban, and set myself free.</p>
+
+ <p>"I was so small, compared to the roc, that it had never even
+ noticed me, but darted off towards a great black object lying
+ near, which it seized with its beak and carried off. Imagine my
+ horror when I looked again and saw other dark objects, and
+ discovered that they were great black snakes.</p>
+
+ <p>"Here was I, in a deep valley, with mountains rising sheer
+ up on every side, and nothing to be seen among the rocks but
+ those terrible black snakes.</p>
+
+ <p>"'Oh!' I cried, 'why did I ever try to leave the desert
+ island? I have indeed only come into worse misfortune.'</p>
+
+ <p>"As I looked around, I noticed that the ground was strewn
+ with sparkling stones, which seemed to quiver with light, and
+ when I looked nearer, I found they were diamonds of
+ extraordinary size, although lying about like common pebbles.
+ At first I was delighted, but they soon ceased to please me,
+ for I feared each moment I might be seized by one of the
+ terrible snakes.</p>
+
+ <p>"These snakes were so large that they could easily have
+ swallowed an elephant, and although they lay quiet during the
+ day, and hid themselves for fear of the roc, at night they came
+ out in search of food. I managed to find a cave among the rocks
+ before nightfall, and there I sat in fear and trembling until
+ morning, when I once more went out into the valley.</p>
+
+ <p>"As I sat thinking what I should do next, I saw a great
+ piece of raw meat come bounding down into the valley, from rock
+ to rock. Then another piece followed, and another, until
+ several large pieces lay at my feet.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then I remembered a tale which travelers had told me about
+ the famous Diamond Valley. They said that every
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page87" id="page87"></a>[pg
+ 87]</span> year, when the young eagles were hatched, merchants
+ went to the heights above, and rolled down great pieces of raw
+ meat into the valley. The diamonds on which the meat fell would
+ often stick into the soft flesh, and then when the eagles came,
+ and carried off the meat to feed their young ones, the
+ merchants would beat them off their nests, and take the
+ diamonds out of the meat.</p>
+
+ <p>"I had never believed this wonderful tale, but now indeed I
+ knew it to be true, and felt sure that I was in the famous
+ Diamond Valley.</p>
+
+ <p>"I had quite given up all hope of escape, for there was no
+ possible way of climbing out of the valley, but as I watched
+ the eagles carry off the lumps of raw meat, I thought of a
+ plan, and hope revived.</p>
+
+ <p>"First of all I searched around, and filled all my pockets
+ with the biggest diamonds I could find. Then I chose out the
+ largest piece of meat and fastened myself securely to it, with
+ the rope made out of my turban. I knew that the eagles would
+ soon come for more food, so I lay flat on the ground, with the
+ meat uppermost, and holding on tightly, I waited for what would
+ happen next. I had not long to wait before a gigantic eagle
+ came swooping down. It seized the meat and carried it and me
+ swiftly up, until it reached its nest high among the mountain
+ rocks. And no sooner had it dropped me into the nest, than a
+ man climbed out from behind the rock, and with loud cries
+ frightened the eagle away. Then this man, who was the merchant
+ to whom the nest belonged, came eagerly to look for his piece
+ of meat. When he saw me, he started back in surprise and
+ anger.</p>
+
+ <p>"'What doest thou here?' he asked roughly. 'How dost thou
+ dare to try and steal my diamonds?'</p>
+
+ <p>"'Have patience,' I answered calmly, 'I am no thief, and
+ when thou hast heard my story thou wilt pity and not blame me.
+ As for diamonds, I have some here which will more than make up
+ to thee for thy disappointment.'</p>
+
+ <p>"Then I told him and the other merchants all my adventures,
+ and they cast up their eyes to heaven in surprise at my
+ courage, and the wonderful manner in which I had managed to
+ escape <span class="pagenum"><a name="page88"
+ id="page88"></a>[pg 88]</span> so many dangers. Pulling out a
+ handful of diamonds, I then passed the precious stones round
+ among them, and they all declared them to be the finest they
+ had ever seen.</p>
+
+ <p>"'Thou shalt choose one, to make up for thy disappointment,'
+ I said to the merchant who had found me.</p>
+
+ <p>"'I will choose this small one,' he replied, picking out one
+ of the least of the glistening heap.</p>
+
+ <p>"I urged him to take a larger one, but he only shook his
+ head.</p>
+
+ <p>"'This one will bring me all the wealth I can desire,' he
+ said, 'and I need no longer risk my life seeking for more.'</p>
+
+ <p>"Then we all set off for the nearest port, where we found a
+ ship ready to carry us home. We had many adventures on the way,
+ but at last we reached our journey's end, and when I had sold
+ my diamonds, I had so much money that I gave a great deal to
+ the poor, and lived in even greater splendor than before."</p>
+
+ <p>Here Sindbad paused, and ordered that another hundred gold
+ pieces should be given to Hindbad, and that he should depart.
+ But next evening when the guests had all assembled and Hindbad
+ had also returned, Sindbad began once more to tell them a story
+ of his adventures.</p>
+
+ <p>"This time," began Sindbad, "I stayed at home for the space
+ of a whole year, and then I prepared to set out on another
+ voyage. My friends and relations did all in their power to
+ prevent my going, but I could not be persuaded, and before long
+ I set sail in a ship which was about to make a very long
+ voyage.</p>
+
+ <p>"Nothing went well with us from the beginning. We were
+ driven out of our course by storms and tempests, and the
+ captain and pilot knew not where we were. When at last they
+ found out in which direction we had drifted, things seemed in a
+ worse state than ever. We were alarmed to see the captain
+ suddenly pull off his turban, tear the hair from his beard, and
+ beat his head as if he were mad.</p>
+
+ <p>"'What is the matter?' we asked, gathering round him.</p>
+
+ <p>"'Alas!' he cried, 'we are lost. The ship is now caught in a
+ dangerous current from which nothing can save her and
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page89" id="page89"></a>[pg
+ 89]</span> us. In a very few moments we shall all be dashed to
+ pieces.'</p>
+
+ <p>"No sooner had he spoken than the ship was carried along at
+ a tremendous speed straight on to a rocky shore which lay at
+ the foot of a steep mountain.</p>
+
+ <p>"But although the ship was dashed to pieces, we all managed
+ to escape, and were thrown with our goods and some provisions
+ high on to the rocky strip of shore. Here we found the
+ scattered remains of many wrecks, and quantities of bones
+ bleached white in the sun.</p>
+
+ <p>"'We may prepare ourselves for death,' said the captain
+ mournfully. 'No man has ever escaped from this shore, for it is
+ impossible to climb the mountain behind us, and no ship dare
+ approach to save us.'</p>
+
+ <p>"But nevertheless he divided the provisions among us, that
+ we might live as long as possible.</p>
+
+ <p>"One thing that surprised me greatly was a river of fresh
+ water which flowed out of the mountain, and, instead of running
+ into the sea, disappeared into a rocky cavern on the other side
+ of the shore. As I gazed into the mouth of this cavern I saw
+ that it was lined with sparkling gems, and that the bed of the
+ river was studded with rubies and diamonds and all manner of
+ precious stones. Great quantities of these were also scattered
+ around, and treasures from the wrecked ships lay in every
+ corner of the shore.</p>
+
+ <p>"One by one my companions died as they came to the end of
+ their food, and one by one I buried them, until at last I was
+ left quite alone. I was able to live on very little, and so my
+ food had lasted longer.</p>
+
+ <p>"'Woe is me!' I cried, 'who shall bury me when I die? Why,
+ oh! why was I not content to remain safe and happy at
+ home?'</p>
+
+ <p>"As I bemoaned my evil fate I wandered to the banks of the
+ river, and as I watched it disappear into the rocky cave a
+ happy thought came to me. Surely if this stream entered the
+ mountain it must have an opening somewhere, and if I could only
+ follow its course I might yet escape.</p>
+
+ <p>"Eagerly I began to make a strong raft of the wood and
+ planks which were scattered all over the shore. Then I
+ collected as many diamonds and rubies and as much wrecked
+ treasure as <span class="pagenum"><a name="page90"
+ id="page90"></a>[pg 90]</span> my raft would hold, and took my
+ last little store of food. I launched the raft with great care,
+ and soon found myself floating swiftly along until I
+ disappeared into the dark passage of the cavern.</p>
+
+ <p>"On and on I went through the thick darkness, the passage
+ seeming to grow smaller and narrower until I was obliged to lie
+ flat on the raft for fear of striking my head. My food was now
+ all gone, and I gave myself up for lost, and then mercifully I
+ fell into a deep sleep which must have lasted many hours. I was
+ awakened by the sound of strange voices, and jumping up, what
+ was my joy to find I was once more in heaven's sunshine.</p>
+
+ <p>"The river was flowing gently through a green, pleasant
+ land, and the sounds I had heard were the voices of a company
+ of negroes who were gently guiding my raft to the bank.</p>
+
+ <p>"I could not understand the language these negroes spoke,
+ until at last one of their number began to speak to me in
+ Arabic.</p>
+
+ <p>"Peace be to thee!' he said. 'Who art thou, and whence hast
+ thou come? We are the people of this country, and were working
+ in our fields when we found thee asleep upon the raft. Tell us,
+ then, how thou hast come to this place.'</p>
+
+ <p>"I pray thee, by Allah." I cried, 'give me food, and then I
+ will tell thee all.'</p>
+
+ <p>"Then the men gave me food, and I ate until my strength
+ returned and my soul was refreshed, and I could tell them of
+ all my adventures.</p>
+
+ <p>"'We must take him to the King,' they cried with one
+ voice.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then they told me that the King of Serendib was the richest
+ and greatest king on earth, and I went with them willingly,
+ taking with me my bales and treasures.</p>
+
+ <p>"Never had I seen such splendor and richness as at the court
+ of the King of Serendib, and great was his kindness towards me.
+ He listened to the tale of my adventures with interest, and
+ when I begged to be allowed to return home, he ordered that a
+ ship should be made ready at once. Then he wrote a letter with
+ his own hand to the Caliph, our sovereign lord, and loaded me
+ with costly gifts.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page91"
+ id="page91"></a>[pg 91]</span>
+
+ <p>"Thus, when I arrived at Bagdad, I went at once to the court
+ of the Caliph, and presented the letter and the gift which the
+ King had sent.</p>
+
+ <p>"This gift was a cup made out of a single ruby lined inside
+ with precious stones, also a skin of the serpent that swallows
+ elephants, which had spots upon its back like pieces of gold,
+ and which could cure all illnesses.</p>
+
+ <p>"The Caliph was delighted with the letter and the gift.</p>
+
+ <p>"'Tell me, O Sindbad,' he said, 'is this King as great and
+ rich as it is reported of him?'</p>
+
+ <p>"'O my Lord,' I said, 'no words can give you an idea of his
+ riches. His throne is set upon a huge elephant and a thousand
+ horsemen ride around him, clad in cloth of gold. His mace is of
+ gold studded with emeralds, and indeed his splendor is as great
+ as that of King Solomon.'</p>
+
+ <p>"The Caliph listened attentively to my words, and then,
+ giving me a present, he allowed me to depart. I returned home
+ swiftly to my family and friends, and when I had sold my
+ treasures and given much to the poor, I lived in such peace and
+ happiness that my evil adventures soon seemed like a far-off
+ dream."</p>
+
+ <p>So Sindbad finished the story, and bade his guests return
+ the next evening as usual. And next day, when all the guests
+ were once more seated at the table and had finished their
+ feasting, Sindbad began the story of his last voyage.</p>
+
+ <p>"I had now made up my mind that nothing would tempt me to
+ leave my home again, and that I would seek for no more
+ adventures.</p>
+
+ <p>"One day, however, as I was feasting with my friends, one of
+ my servants came to tell me that a messenger from the Caliph
+ awaited my pleasure.</p>
+
+ <p>"'What is thy errand?' I asked when the messenger was
+ presented to me.</p>
+
+ <p>"'The Caliph desires thy presence at once,' answered the
+ messenger.</p>
+
+ <p>"Thus was I obliged to set out immediately for the
+ palace.</p>
+
+ <p>"'Sindbad,' said the Caliph, when I had bowed myself to the
+ ground before him, 'I have need of thy services. I desire
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page92" id="page92"></a>[pg
+ 92]</span> to send a letter and a gift to the King of Serendib,
+ and thou shalt be the bearer of them.'</p>
+
+ <p>"Then indeed did my face fall, and I became pale as
+ death.</p>
+
+ <p>"'Commander of the Faithful,' I cried, 'do with me as thou
+ wilt, but I have made a vow never to leave my home again.'</p>
+
+ <p>"Then I told him all my adventures, which caused him much
+ astonishment. Nevertheless, he urged me to do as he wished, and
+ seeing that there was no escape, I consented.</p>
+
+ <p>"I set sail at the Caliph's command, and after a good voyage
+ I at last reached the island of Serendib, where I received a
+ hearty welcome. I told the officers of the court what my errand
+ was, and they led me to the palace, where I bowed myself to the
+ ground before the great King.</p>
+
+ <p>"'Sindbad,' he said kindly, 'thou art welcome. I have often
+ thought of thee, and wished to see thy face again.'</p>
+
+ <p>"So I presented the Caliph's letter, and the rich present he
+ had sent, which pleased the King well. When a few days had
+ passed, I begged to be allowed to depart, and after receiving
+ many gifts I once more set sail for home.</p>
+
+ <p>"But alas! the return journey began badly. We had not sailed
+ many days, when we were pursued by pirates, who captured the
+ ship, and took prisoners all those who were not killed. I,
+ among others, was carried ashore and sold by a pirate to a rich
+ merchant.</p>
+
+ <p>"'What is thy trade?' asked the merchant when he had bought
+ me.</p>
+
+ <p>"'I am a merchant,' I answered, 'and know no trade.'</p>
+
+ <p>"'Canst thou shoot with a bow and arrow?' asked my
+ master.</p>
+
+ <p>"This I said I could do, and putting one in my hand he led
+ me out to a great forest and bade me climb into a high
+ tree.</p>
+
+ <p>"'Watch there,' he said, 'until thou shalt see a herd of
+ elephants pass by. Then try to shoot one, and if thou art
+ fortunate, come at once and tell me.'</p>
+
+ <p>"All night I watched, and saw nothing, but in the morning a
+ great number of elephants came thundering by, and I shot
+ several arrows among them. One big elephant fell to the
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page93" id="page93"></a>[pg
+ 93]</span> ground, and lay there while the rest passed on; so,
+ as soon as it was safe, I climbed down and carried the news to
+ my master. Together we buried the huge animal and marked the
+ place, so that we might return to fetch the tusks.</p>
+
+ <p>"I continued this work for some time, and killed many
+ elephants, until one night I saw to my horror that the
+ elephants, instead of passing on, had surrounded the tree in
+ which I sat, and were stamping and trumpeting, until the very
+ earth shook. Then one of them seized the tree with his trunk,
+ and tore it up by the roots, laying it flat on the ground.</p>
+
+ <p>"I was almost senseless with terror, but the next moment I
+ felt myself gently lifted up by an elephant's trunk, and placed
+ on his back. I clung on with all my might, as the elephant
+ carried me through the forest, until at last we came to the
+ slope of a hill, which was covered with bleached bones and
+ tusks.</p>
+
+ <p>"Here the elephant gently laid me down, and left me alone. I
+ gazed around on this great treasure of ivory, and I could not
+ help wondering at the wisdom of these animals. They had
+ evidently brought me here to show me that I could get ivory
+ without killing any more of their number. For this, I felt
+ sure, was the elephants' burying-place.</p>
+
+ <p>"I did not stay long on the hill, but gathering a few tusks
+ together I sped back to the town, that I might tell my tale to
+ the merchant. 'My poor Sindbad,' he cried, when he saw me, I
+ thought thou wert dead, for I found the uprooted tree, and
+ never expected to look upon thy face again.'</p>
+
+ <p>"Great was his delight when I told him of the Hill of Ivory,
+ and when we had gone there together, and he saw for himself the
+ wonders I had described, he was filled with astonishment.</p>
+
+ <p>"'Sindbad,' he cried, 'thou too shalt have a share of this
+ great wealth. And first of all I shall give thee thy, freedom.
+ Until now, year by year have all my slaves been killed by the
+ elephants, but now we need no longer run any risks, for here is
+ ivory enough to enrich the whole island.'</p>
+
+ <p>"So I was set free, and loaded with honors, and when the
+ trade winds brought the ships that traded in ivory, I bade
+ good-by to the island, and set sail for home, carrying with me
+ a great cargo of ivory and other
+ treasures.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page94"
+ id="page94"></a>[pg 94]</span>
+
+ <p>"As soon as I landed I went to the Caliph, who was overjoyed
+ to see me.</p>
+
+ <p>"'Great has been my anxiety, O Sindbad,' he said, 'for I
+ feared some evil had befallen thee.'</p>
+
+ <p>"When, therefore, I had told him of my adventures, he was
+ the more astonished, and ordered that all my story should be
+ written in letters of gold, and placed among his treasures.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then I returned to my own house, and ever since have
+ remained at home in peace and safety."</p>
+
+ <p>Thus Sindbad finished the story of his voyages, and turning
+ to Hindbad, he said: "And now, friend Hindbad, what dost thou
+ think of the way I have earned my riches? Is it not just that I
+ should live in enjoyment and ease?"</p>
+
+ <p>"O my lord," cried Hindbad, bowing before Sindbad, and
+ kissing his hand, "great have been thy labors and perils, and
+ truly dost thou deserve thy riches. My troubles are as nothing
+ compared to thine. Long mayest thou live and prosper!"</p>
+
+ <p>Sindbad was well pleased with this answer, and he ordered
+ that Hindbad should dine every day at his table, and receive
+ his golden pieces, so that all his life he might have reason to
+ remember the adventures of Sindbad the Sailor.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page95"
+ id="page95"></a>[pg 95]</span>
+
+ <h3>THE ILIAD OF HOMER</h3>
+
+ <h4>ADAPTED BY JEANIE LANG</h4>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE STORY OF WHAT LED TO THE SIEGE OF TROY</h4>
+
+ <p>In the deep forest that clothes Mount Ida, not far from the
+ strong city of Troy, Paris, son of King Priam, watched his
+ father's flocks by night.</p>
+
+ <p>Suddenly through the dim woods he saw a light, as if the
+ golden sun and silver moon shone both together.</p>
+
+ <p>And, lo! in the radiance of this light there stood before
+ him the three fairest of the godesses&mdash;queenly Hera, wise
+ Athene, and lovely Aphrodite.</p>
+
+ <p>Like music stealing through the trees came the soft voice of
+ Hera:</p>
+
+ <p>"Of all mortal men thou art the most beautiful, Paris, and
+ to thee do we come for judgment. Tell us which of us is the
+ fairest of all, and to that one whom thou so deemest, give this
+ golden apple."</p>
+
+ <p>So spake Hera, and placed in the hand of Paris an apple of
+ purest gold.</p>
+
+ <p>Again she spake: "If to me, Hera, queen of goddesses, and
+ wife of mighty Zeus, king of all the gods, thou dost grant the
+ prize of loveliness, Power immeasurable shall be thine. King
+ shalt thou be of the lands where the gray dawn rises, and king
+ even to where the red sun goes down. A hundred peoples shall
+ call thee lord."</p>
+
+ <p>She was silent, and the voice of Athene, fair and pure as a
+ silver moonbeam, broke the stillness of the starless night.</p>
+
+ <p>"To me award the prize," she said, "and wise as the gods
+ shalt thou be. With me as thy friend and guide, all things will
+ be possible to thee."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page96"
+ id="page96"></a>[pg 96]</span>
+
+ <p>Last of all, standing in a rosy light, as of the dawning
+ sunlight in the spring, spoke Aphrodite.</p>
+
+ <p>"What are Power and Wisdom, fair Paris?" she pled. "Wisdom
+ and Power bring no joy at last. I will give thee Love, and for
+ thy wife thou shalt have the fairest woman in all the
+ world."</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/96.jpg" name="fig96s"
+ id="fig96s"><img width="300" src="images/96s.jpg"
+ alt="FROM FAR AND WIDE DID THE GREEK HOSTS GATHER" />
+ </a><br />
+ from far and wide did the greek hosts gather
+ </div>
+
+ <p>And Paris, the melody of her voice still in his ears, as he
+ gazed spellbound on her face of wondrous beauty, handed to
+ Aphrodite the golden prize.</p>
+
+ <p>So was it that the wrath of the gods came upon Paris, son of
+ Priam. For Hera and Athene, filled with rage, vowed to be
+ revenged upon Paris and all his race, and made all the gods
+ pledge themselves to aid them in their vengeance.</p>
+
+ <p>Across far seas sailed Paris, with Aphrodite as his guide,
+ to Sparta, where Menelaus was king.</p>
+
+ <p>A brave king was Menelaus, and happily he lived in his
+ kingdom with Helen, his queen, fairest of all women. One child
+ they had, a little maid, Hermione.</p>
+
+ <p>When to Sparta there came Paris, with eyes blue as the sea,
+ and hair that gleamed like gold on his purple robe, gallant and
+ brave, and more beautiful than any mortal man, glad was the
+ welcome that he had from Menelaus.</p>
+
+ <p>And when Paris gazed on Helen's face, he knew that in all
+ the world there was no woman half so fair as the wife of
+ Menelaus.</p>
+
+ <p>Then did Aphrodite cast her magic upon Helen.</p>
+
+ <p>No longer did she love her husband, nor did she remember
+ little Hermione, her own dear child.</p>
+
+ <p>When Paris spoke to her words of love, and begged her to
+ flee with him, and to be his wife, she knew only that she loved
+ Paris more than all else. Gladly she went with him, and in his
+ red-prowed ship together they sailed across the green waves to
+ Troyland, where Mount Ida showed her snowy crown high above the
+ forests.</p>
+
+ <p>An angry man was Menelaus when he found that Paris had
+ stolen from him the fair wife who was to him as his own
+ heart.</p>
+
+ <p>To his elder brother Agamemnon, overlord of all the Greeks,
+ he went and told his grievous
+ tale.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page97"
+ id="page97"></a>[pg 97]</span>
+
+ <p>And from far and wide did the Greek hosts gather, until a
+ hundred thousand men and eleven hundred fourscore and six ships
+ were ready to cross the seas to Troyland.</p>
+
+ <p>Many were the heroes who sailed away from Greece to punish
+ Paris and his kin, and to bring back fair Helen to her own
+ land.</p>
+
+ <p>Few there were who came home, for ten long years of woe and
+ of spilling of blood came to the men of Greece and of Troy from
+ the fatal beauty of Helen the queen.</p>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE COUNCIL</h4>
+
+ <p>That night both gods and men slept long; only Zeus, king of
+ the gods, lay wakeful, pondering in his heart how best he might
+ do honor to Achilles. "I shall send a Dream to beguile
+ Agamemnon," at length he resolved.</p>
+
+ <p>Then did he call to a Dream, for by Dreams the gods sent
+ their messages to mortal men.</p>
+
+ <p>"Go now, thou evil Dream," said Zeus, "go to where Agamemnon
+ sleeps in his tent near to his fleet ships, and tell him every
+ word as I shall tell it thee. Bid him call to arms with speed
+ his warriors, for now he shall take the strong city of
+ Troy."</p>
+
+ <p>To the tent of Agamemnon sped the Dream. Taking the form of
+ the old warrior who had striven to make peace between Agamemnon
+ and Achilles, the Dream stooped over the sleeping warrior, and
+ thus to him it spoke:</p>
+
+ <p>"Sleepest thou, Agamemnon? Ill fits it for the overlord of
+ so mighty a host to sleep all through the night. From Zeus I
+ come, and to thee he sends this message: 'Call to arms with
+ speed thy warriors, Agamemnon, for now shalt thou take the
+ strong city of Troy.'"</p>
+
+ <p>Off then sped the Dream, winging its way like a strip of
+ gray mist aloft to Mount Olympus.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Agamemnon awoke from sleep, and the voice of the Dream
+ still rang in his
+ ears.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page98"
+ id="page98"></a>[pg 98]</span>
+
+ <p>Speedily he arose from his bed, donned his fair tunic, cast
+ around him his great cloak, and bound his sandals on his feet.
+ Then over his shoulder he cast his silver-studded sword, and
+ with the scepter of his house, token of his overlordship, in
+ his hand, he went down to where the Greek ships lay, and called
+ a council together.</p>
+
+ <p>To his lords he told what had befallen him as they
+ slept.</p>
+
+ <p>"Call to arms!" had been the message from Zeus. "Call to
+ arms! for victory shall be thine."</p>
+
+ <p>Then said the old warrior in whose likeness the Dream had
+ come:</p>
+
+ <p>"My friends, had any other told us this dream we might deem
+ it false; but to our overlord the Dream hath come. Let us then
+ call our men to arms."</p>
+
+ <p>So did all the lords follow his counsel, and quickly did the
+ Greeks obey their summons. Like bees that pour from out their
+ nests in some hollow rock, and fly to where the spring flowers
+ grow most sweet, even so did the warriors pour forth from their
+ ships and their huts by the sea. Loudly they shouted as they
+ came, till all the earth echoed. Nine heralds sought to quiet
+ them, but it was long before they would cease their noise, and
+ sit silent to listen to the voice of Agamemnon their lord.</p>
+
+ <p>Then did Agamemnon prove his people. "Ill hath Zeus dealt
+ with us, my friends," he said. "To us he promised ere we sailed
+ hither that victory should be ours. But nine years have passed
+ away, and our ships' timbers have rotted, and the rigging is
+ worn. In our halls our wives and children still sit awaiting
+ us, yet are we no nearer victory than we were on the day that
+ we came hither. Come then, let us flee with our ships to our
+ dear native land, for never shall Troy be ours."</p>
+
+ <p>So spake Agamemnon, and stirred the hearts of all that had
+ not heard his secret council.</p>
+
+ <p>As the high sea-waves are swayed by the winds that rush upon
+ them from the east and from the south, even so the Greek host
+ was swayed. And even as the west wind sweeps over a cornfield
+ and all the ears bow down before the blast, so were the
+ warriors stirred.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page99"
+ id="page99"></a>[pg 99]</span>
+
+ <p>Shouting, they hastened down to their ships. And the dust
+ rose up in clouds from under their hurrying feet.</p>
+
+ <p>Quickly did they prepare their ships, and gladly did they
+ make them ready to sail homeward across the bright salt
+ sea.</p>
+
+ <p>Then would the Greeks have returned, even though fate willed
+ it not. But Hera spoke to Athene.</p>
+
+ <p>"Shall we indeed allow the Greeks thus to flee homeward?"
+ she cried. "Shame it will be to us if Helen is left, in Troy,
+ and Paris goes unpunished. Haste, then, and with thy gentle
+ words hold back the men from setting forth in their ships for
+ their own homeland."</p>
+
+ <p>Down from the peaks of Olympus darted the bright-eyed
+ Athene, clown to where the dark ships were being dragged to the
+ launching ways.</p>
+
+ <p>By his ship stood Odysseus of the many devices, and heavy of
+ heart was he.</p>
+
+ <p>As one who speaks aloud the thoughts of another, so then to
+ Odysseus spake the fair goddess who was ever his guide.</p>
+
+ <p>"Will ye indeed fling yourselves upon your ships and flee
+ homeward to your own land?" she said. "Will brave Odysseus
+ leave Helen, for whose sake so many Greeks have died, to be the
+ boast of the men of Troy? Hasten, then, and suffer not the
+ Greeks to drag their ships down to the sea."</p>
+
+ <p>At the sound of the voice of Athene, Odysseus cast away his
+ mantle and ran to meet Agamemnon. From him he received the
+ scepter of overlordship, and bearing it he went among the
+ ships.</p>
+
+ <p>Whenever he saw a chief, he would say to him with gentle
+ words:</p>
+
+ <p>"Good sir, it fits thee ill to be a coward. Stay, now, for
+ thou knowest not what is the will of Agamemnon. He is only
+ making trial of thee. Hold back then thy people, and anger him
+ not."</p>
+
+ <p>But when Odysseus met a common man hasting to the ships,
+ with his scepter he smote him, saying:</p>
+
+ <p>"Sit still, sir, and listen to the words of thy betters. No
+ warrior art thou, but a weakling. One king only hath Zeus given
+ to us. Hearken then to the will of
+ Agamemnon!"</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page100"
+ id="page100"></a>[pg 100]</span>
+
+ <p>Thus did Odysseus rule the people, driving them back from
+ the ships to where sat Agamemnon.</p>
+
+ <p>And the noise they made in returning was as the noise of
+ mighty waves of the sea, when they crash upon the beach and
+ drive their roaring echoes far abroad.</p>
+
+ <p>Silence came upon them as they sat themselves down before
+ Agamemnon and their lords. Upon all but one did silence fall.
+ Thersites, bandy-legged, round-shouldered, lame of one foot,
+ with ugly head covered with scanty stubble, most ill-favored of
+ all men in the host, would not hold his peace.</p>
+
+ <p>Shrilly he poured his upbraidings upon Agamemnon.</p>
+
+ <p>"What lackest thou now?" he cried. "Surely thy huts are full
+ of the spoils we have brought to thee each time we have taken a
+ town. What more dost thou want? Soft fools, women, not men, are
+ ye Greeks, else would ye return home now with the ships, and
+ leave this fellow here in Troyland gorging himself on the
+ spoils for which he himself hath never fought. To brave
+ Achilles hath he done dishonor, a far better man than he!"</p>
+
+ <p>Straight to the side of Thersites came the goodly
+ Odysseus.</p>
+
+ <p>"Hold thy peace," he sternly said. "Plainly I tell thee that
+ if ever again I find thee raving as thou hast raved now, I
+ myself will strip off thy mantle and tunic, with shameful blows
+ beat thee out of the assembly, and send thee back weeping to
+ the ships."</p>
+
+ <p>So spake Odysseus, and with his scepter smote Thersites on
+ his back and shoulders. And Thersites bowed down, and big tears
+ fell from his eyes, and a bloody weal from the golden scepter
+ stood up from his back. Amazed he sat down, and in pain and
+ amazement he wiped away a tear. The others, though they were
+ sorry, laughed at his bewilderment.</p>
+
+ <p>"Many are the good deeds of Odysseus," said they, "but never
+ did he do a better deed than when he stopped the tongue of this
+ prating railer."</p>
+
+ <p>Then spake Odysseus, scepter in hand.</p>
+
+ <p>"Surely it is the wish of the Greeks to make thee the most
+ despised of all kings, great Agamemnon," he said, "for like
+ young children or mourning women do they wail that they must
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page101" id="page101"></a>[pg
+ 101]</span> go home. Nine years have we stayed in this land,
+ and small wonder is it that we long for our homes again. Yet
+ shameful would it be to wait so long and to return with empty
+ hands. Be of good heart, my friends, and wait a little, for
+ surely Troy shall be ours. Do ye forget, on the day that we set
+ sail for Troyland, the mighty portent that we saw? As we
+ offered sacrifices to the gods beneath a fair plane-tree whence
+ flowed clear water, a snake, blood-red on the back and dreadful
+ to look upon, glided from beneath the altar and darted to the
+ tree. On the tree's topmost bough was a sparrow's nest, and in
+ it eight tender nestlings, over which the mother bird spread
+ her wings. Pitifully did the little ones cheep as the snake
+ swallowed them all, and pitifully cried the mother as she
+ fluttered over her nestlings. But of her, too, did the snake
+ lay hold, coiling himself round her and crushing her life out.
+ Then did the god who sent this sign show us that a sign from
+ the gods in truth it was, for he turned the snake into stone.
+ And Chalcas, our soothsayer, told us then the meaning of the
+ sign. 'Nine years,' said he&mdash;for nine birds did the snake
+ slay&mdash;'shall ye fight in Troyland, but in the tenth year
+ the city shall fall before you.' So then, let us abide here,
+ until we have taken the great city!"</p>
+
+ <p>When Odysseus had ceased to speak, the Greeks shouted aloud,
+ until the ships echoed the praises of the goodly Odysseus.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Agamemnon:</p>
+
+ <p>"Go now, all of you, and eat, that ye may be ready for
+ battle. Let each man sharpen well his spear and see to his
+ shield, and see to it that the horses are well fed and the
+ chariots prepared. And whomsoever I see minded to stay far away
+ from the fight, beside the ships here by the sea, for him shall
+ there be no hope hereafter, but he shall be food for dogs and
+ for birds of prey."</p>
+
+ <p>And when Agamemnon had spoken, the shouts of the Greeks were
+ as the thunder of mighty breakers on a reef when the winds blow
+ high.</p>
+
+ <p>Quickly then they scattered, and kindled fires, and made
+ their evening meal, and offered sacrifices to the gods, praying
+ for escape from death in the coming
+ battle.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page102"
+ id="page102"></a>[pg 102]</span>
+
+ <p>To Zeus did Agamemnon offer his sacrifice and to the mighty
+ god he prayed:</p>
+
+ <p>"Great Zeus, god of the storm-cloud, let not the sun set nor
+ the darkness fall until I have laid low the palaces of Troy and
+ burned down its walls with fire."</p>
+
+ <p>So he prayed, but as yet Zeus heeded not his prayer. Then
+ did the Greeks gather themselves together to battle, and among
+ them went the bright-eyed Athene, urging on each one, and
+ rousing in each man's heart the joy of strength and of
+ battle.</p>
+
+ <p>As the red and golden blaze of a fire that devours a mighty
+ forest is seen from afar, so was seen from afar the dazzling
+ gleam of their bronze armor as they marched.</p>
+
+ <p>Like wild geese and cranes and swans that in long-drawn
+ strings fly tirelessly onward, so poured they forth, while the
+ earth echoed terribly under the tread of men and horses.</p>
+
+ <p>As flies that swarm in the spring when the herdsmen's
+ milk-pails are full, so did the Greeks throng to battle,
+ unnumbered as the leaves and the flowers upon which they trod
+ in the flowery plain by the banks of the river Scamander.</p>
+
+ <h4>III</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE FIGHT BETWEEN PARIS AND MENELAUS</h4>
+
+ <p>To meet the great Greek host came the men of Troy. With loud
+ shouting and clamor they came, noisy as the flocks of cranes
+ that fly to far-off seas before the coming of winter and sudden
+ rain.</p>
+
+ <p>But in silence marched the Greeks, shoulder to shoulder,
+ their hearts full of courage.</p>
+
+ <p>Like the mist that rolls from the crest of the mountains
+ until no man can see in front of him further than the cast of a
+ stone, so did the dust rise in clouds under the tread of the
+ warriors' feet as they marched across the plain.</p>
+
+ <p>Front to front did the two armies stand at last, and from
+ the Trojan ranks strode forth Paris the godlike, he who robbed
+ Menelaus of her who was to him most
+ dear.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page103"
+ id="page103"></a>[pg 103]</span>
+
+ <p>From the shoulders of Paris swung a panther's skin. He bore
+ a curved bow and sword, and, brandishing two bronze-headed
+ spears, he challenged all the chieftains of the Greek host to
+ fight him, man to man, in mortal fight.</p>
+
+ <p>As a hungry lion rejoices to see a great-horned stag coming
+ to be his prey, even so did Menelaus rejoice when he saw Paris,
+ the golden-haired and blue-eyed, stride proudly forth.</p>
+
+ <p>Straightway, in his armor, did Menelaus leap from his
+ chariot to the ground.</p>
+
+ <p>But when Paris saw him to whom he had done so sore a wrong,
+ his heart was smitten.</p>
+
+ <p>As a man who, in a mountain glen, suddenly sees a deadly
+ snake and shrinks away from it with shaking limbs, even so did
+ Paris shrink back among his comrades.</p>
+
+ <p>Scornfully did Hector his brother behold him.</p>
+
+ <p>"Fair in face thou art!" said Hector, "but shamed I am by
+ thee! I ween these long-haired Greeks make sport of us because
+ we have for champion one whose face and form are beautiful, but
+ in whose heart is neither strength nor courage. Art thou a
+ coward? and yet thou daredst to sail across the sea and steal
+ from her husband the fair woman who hath brought us so much
+ harm. Thou shalt see what sort of warrior is he whose lovely
+ wife thou hast taken. Thy harp and thy golden locks and fair
+ face, and all the graces given to thee by Aphrodite, shall
+ count for little when thou liest in the dust! Cowards must we
+ Trojans be, else thou hadst been stoned to death ere this, for
+ all the evil thou hast wrought."</p>
+
+ <p>Then answered Paris:</p>
+
+ <p>"No word hast thou said that I do not deserve, brave Hector.
+ Yet scorn not the gifts of golden Aphrodite, for by his own
+ desire can no man win the love and beauty that the goddess
+ gives. But let me now do battle with Menelaus. Make the Trojans
+ and the men of Greece sit down, while Menelaus and I fight for
+ Helen. Let him who is conqueror have her and all that is hers
+ for his own, and let the others take an oath of friendship so
+ that the Greeks may depart in peace to their own land, and in
+ peace the Trojans dwell in Troy."</p>
+
+ <p>Greatly did Hector rejoice at his brother's word. His
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page104" id="page104"></a>[pg
+ 104]</span> spear grasped by the middle, he went through the
+ Trojan ranks and bid the warriors hold back.</p>
+
+ <p>But as he went, the Greeks shot arrows at brave Hector and
+ cast stones.</p>
+
+ <p>"Hold! hold! ye Greeks," called Agamemnon. "Hector of the
+ glancing helm hath somewhat to say to us."</p>
+
+ <p>In silence, then, the two armies stood, while Hector told
+ them the words of Paris his brother.</p>
+
+ <p>When they had heard him, Menelaus spoke:</p>
+
+ <p>"Many ills have ye endured," he said, "for my sake and
+ because of the sins of Paris. Yet now, I think, the end of this
+ long war hath come. Let us fight, then, and death and fate
+ shall decide which of us shall die. Let us offer sacrifice now
+ to Zeus, and call hither Priam, King of Troy. I fear for the
+ faith of his sons, Paris and Hector, but Priam is an old man
+ and will not break faith."</p>
+
+ <p>Then were the Greeks and the Trojans glad. They came down
+ from their chariots, and took off their arms, and laid them on
+ the ground, while heralds went to tell Priam and to fetch lambs
+ and a ram for the sacrifice.</p>
+
+ <p>While they went, Hera sent to Troy Iris, her messenger, in
+ the guise of the fairest daughter of Priam.</p>
+
+ <p>To the hall where Helen sat came lovely Iris. And there she
+ found Helen, fairest of women, her white arms swiftly moving
+ back and forward as she wove a great purple web of double wool,
+ and wrought thereon pictures of many battles of the Greeks and
+ the men of Troy.</p>
+
+ <p>"Come hither, dear lady," said Iris, "and see a wondrous
+ thing. For they that so fiercely fought with each other, now
+ sit in silence. The battle is stayed; they lean upon their
+ shields, and their tall spears are thrust in the earth by their
+ sides. But for thee are Menelaus and Paris now going to fight,
+ and thou shalt be the wife of the conqueror."</p>
+
+ <p>So spake lovely Iris, and into the sleeping heart of Helen
+ there came remembrance, and a hungry longing for her old home,
+ and for Menelaus, and her father and mother, and for little
+ Hermione, her child.</p>
+
+ <p>The tears rolled down her cheeks, but quickly she hid her
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page105" id="page105"></a>[pg
+ 105]</span> face with a veil of fair linen, and hastened out,
+ with her two handmaidens, to the place where the two armies
+ lay.</p>
+
+ <p>At the Scćan gates sat Priam and other old warriors.</p>
+
+ <p>As Helen, in her fair white robes, drew near, the old men
+ marveled at her loveliness.</p>
+
+ <p>"Small wonder is it," said they, "that Trojans and Greeks
+ should suffer hardships and lay down their lives for one so
+ beautiful. Yet well would it be for her to sail away upon the
+ Greek ships rather than stay here to bring trouble upon us now,
+ and upon our children hereafter."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Priam called to Helen:</p>
+
+ <p>"Come hither, dear child, and sit beside me, that thou
+ may'st see the man who once was thy husband, and thy kinsmen,
+ and thy friends. No blame do I give to thee for all our woes,
+ but only to the gods who have chosen thee to be the cause of
+ all this bloodshed."</p>
+
+ <p>Then did Priam ask her the names of the mighty heroes who
+ stood by their spears in the Grecian ranks, and Helen, making
+ answer to him, said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear father of Paris, my lord, would that I had died ere I
+ left my own land and my little child, and all those that I
+ loved, and followed thy son hither. Agamemnon, a goodly king
+ and a mighty spearsman, is the Greek warrior whose name thou
+ dost ask. Brother of him who was my husband is he. Ah!
+ shameless me, who did leave mine own."</p>
+
+ <p>Of Odysseus also, and of many another warrior of great
+ stature and brave looks, did Priam make inquiry. And Helen told
+ him all she knew, while tears of longing stood in her eyes.</p>
+
+ <p>"My two brethren, Castor, tamer of horses, and Polydeuces,
+ the skilful boxer, I do not see," she said; "mayhap they have
+ not crossed the sea." For she knew not that her two brothers
+ lay dead in her own beautiful land.</p>
+
+ <p>Then was the sacrifice to Zeus offered, and the vows made
+ between Agamemnon and Priam, King of Troy.</p>
+
+ <p>When the sacrifice and vows were accomplished, Priam in
+ haste mounted his chariot and drove away.</p>
+
+ <p>"Verily will I return to windy Ilios," said the old man,
+ "for I cannot bear to watch the fight between Menelaus and my
+ own <span class="pagenum"><a name="page106"
+ id="page106"></a>[pg 106]</span> dear son. But only Zeus and
+ the gods know which one of them is to fall."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Hector and Odysseus marked out a space for the fight,
+ and into a bronze helmet Hector placed two pebbles and shook
+ them in the helmet, looking behind him. And the pebble of Paris
+ leapt out the first, so that to him fell the lot to cast first
+ his spear of bronze.</p>
+
+ <p>Then did Paris arm himself. Greaves of beauteous fashioning
+ he placed upon his legs, and fastened them with silver
+ ankle-clasps. Over his shoulders he put his silver-studded
+ sword of bronze and his great shield. On his head he placed a
+ helmet with nodding crest of horsehair, and in his hand he
+ grasped his strong spear. In like manner did Menelaus arm
+ himself.</p>
+
+ <p>One moment did they stand face to face, wrath and hatred in
+ their hearts, their spears gripped firm in their hands.</p>
+
+ <p>Then did Paris hurl his spear and smite the shield of
+ Menelaus. But the shield was strong and the spear could not
+ pierce it.</p>
+
+ <p>His hand lifted up for the cast, Menelaus looked upwards and
+ called to Zeus.</p>
+
+ <p>"Grant me revenge, great Zeus!" he cried. "On him that hath
+ done me grievous wrong, grant me vengeance, so that all men
+ hereafter may shudder to wrong one who hath treated him as his
+ honored guest."</p>
+
+ <p>Then hurled he his mighty spear. Through the bright shield
+ it went, and through the shining breastplate, tearing the tunic
+ of Paris on his thigh. But Paris swerved aside, and so escaped
+ death.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Menelaus drew his silver-studded sword and drove it
+ crashing down upon the helmet of Paris. But in four pieces was
+ the sword shattered, and fell from the hand of Menelaus.</p>
+
+ <p>"Surely art thou the most cruel of all the gods, Zeus!"
+ angrily he cried. "My spear is cast in vain, and my sword
+ shattered, and my vengeance is still to come!"</p>
+
+ <p>So saying, he leapt upon Paris. By the crest on his helmet
+ he seized him, and, swinging him round, he dragged him towards
+ the Greek host. The embroidered strap beneath the helmet of
+ Paris strangled him, and so he would have shamefully died, had
+ not Aphrodite marked his plight. Swiftly did she burst
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page107" id="page107"></a>[pg
+ 107]</span> the leather strap, and the helmet was left empty in
+ the grasp of Menelaus.</p>
+
+ <p>Casting the empty helmet, with a swing, to his comrades,
+ Menelaus sprang back, ready, with another spear, to slay his
+ enemy.</p>
+
+ <p>But Aphrodite snatched Paris up, and in thick mist she hid
+ him, and bore him away to his own home. Like a wild beast
+ Menelaus strode through the host, searching for him. But no
+ Trojan would have hidden him, for with a bitter hatred did the
+ men of Troy hate Paris, most beautiful of mortal men.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Agamemnon:</p>
+
+ <p>"Hearken to me, ye Trojans. Now hath Menelaus gained the
+ victory. Give us back Helen, and all that is hers, and pay me
+ the recompense that ye owe me for all the evil days that are
+ gone."</p>
+
+ <p>So spake he, and glad were the shouts of the Greeks as they
+ heard the words of their king.</p>
+
+ <h4>IV</h4>
+
+ <h4>HECTOR AND ANDROMACHE</h4>
+
+ <p>From where the battle still raged went Hector, son of Priam.
+ At the oak-tree by the gates of Troy there came running to meet
+ him wives and daughters of those who fought. For eagerly did
+ they long for tidings of many a warrior who now lay dead on the
+ field.</p>
+
+ <p>When he reached the beautiful, many-pillared palace of his
+ father, his mother came to meet him.</p>
+
+ <p>His hand she took in hers, and gently spoke she to him.</p>
+
+ <p>"Art thou wearied that thou hast left the battle, Hector, my
+ son?" she said. "Let me bring thee wine that thou may'st be
+ refreshed and yet gain strength."</p>
+
+ <p>"Bring me no wine, dear mother," said Hector, "lest it take
+ from me the strength and courage that I have. Rather go thou to
+ the temple of Athene and offer her sacrifices, beseeching that
+ she will have mercy on Troy and on the wives of the Trojans and
+ their little children. So may she hold back Diomedes the
+ destroyer. I go to Paris&mdash;would that he were dead!"</p>
+
+ <p>And the mother of Hector straightway, with other old women,
+ the mothers of heroes, offered sacrifices and prayers to
+ Athene. But Athene paid no
+ heed.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page108"
+ id="page108"></a>[pg 108]</span>
+
+ <p>To the palace of Paris, his mighty bronze spear in his hand,
+ then strode Hector.</p>
+
+ <p>Paris, the golden-haired, sat in a room with Helen, idly
+ handling his shining shield and breastplate and curved bow.</p>
+
+ <p>In bitter scorn spoke Hector to his brother.</p>
+
+ <p>"Our people die in battle for thy sake!" he cried, "while
+ here thou sittest idle. Up then, ere the enemies that thou hast
+ made for us burn our city to the ground!"</p>
+
+ <p>And Paris answered:</p>
+
+ <p>"Justly dost thou chide me, Hector. Even now hath Helen
+ urged me to play the man and go back to battle. Only let me put
+ on my armor, and soon will I overtake thee."</p>
+
+ <p>Never a word did Hector answer him.</p>
+
+ <p>But to Hector did Helen then speak:</p>
+
+ <p>"Brother Hector," she said, "unworthy am I to be sister of
+ thine. Would that I had died on the day I was born, or would
+ that the gods who have brought me this evil had given me for a
+ husband one who was shamed by reproach and who feared dishonor.
+ Rest thee here, my brother, who hast suffered so much for the
+ sake of wretched me and for the sin of Paris. Well I know that
+ for us cometh punishment of which men will sing in the far-off
+ years that are yet to come."</p>
+
+ <p>"Of thy love, ask me not to stay, Helen," answered Hector.
+ "For to help the men of Troy is my whole heart set, and they
+ are now in want of me. But rouse this fellow, and make him
+ hasten after me. I go now to see my dear wife and my babe, for
+ I know not whether I shall return to them again."</p>
+
+ <p>In his own house Hector found not his fair wife Andromache,
+ nor their little babe.</p>
+
+ <p>"Whither went thy mistress?" he asked in eagerness of the
+ serving-women.</p>
+
+ <p>"Truly, my lord," answered one, "tidings came to us that the
+ Trojans were sorely pressed and that with the Greeks was the
+ victory. So then did Andromache, like one frenzied, hasten with
+ her child and his nurse to the walls that she might see
+ somewhat of what befell. There, on the tower, she stands now,
+ weeping and wailing."</p>
+
+ <p>Back through the streets by which he had come then hastened
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page109" id="page109"></a>[pg
+ 109]</span> Hector. And as he drew near the gates, Andromache,
+ who had spied him from afar, ran to meet him.</p>
+
+ <p>As, hand clasped in hand, Andromache and Hector stood,
+ Hector looked silently at the beautiful babe in his nurse's
+ arms, and smiled.</p>
+
+ <p>Astyanax, "The City King," those of Troy called the child,
+ because it was Hector his father who saved the city.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Andromache:</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear lord, thy courage will bring thee death. Hast thou no
+ pity for this babe nor for thy wife, who so soon shall be thy
+ widow? Better would it be for me to die if to thee death should
+ come. For if I lose thee, then sorrow must for evermore be
+ mine. No father nor mother have I, and on one day were my seven
+ brothers slain. Father and mother and brother art thou to me,
+ Hector, and my dear loved husband as well. Have pity now, and
+ stay with thy wife and thy little child."</p>
+
+ <p>"All these things know I well, my wife," answered Hector,
+ "but black shame would be mine were I to shrink like a coward
+ from battle. Ever it hath been mine to be where the fight was
+ fiercest, and to win glory for my father's name, and for my
+ own. But soon will that glory be gone, for my heart doth tell
+ me that Troy must fall. Yet for the sorrows of the Trojans, and
+ of my own father and mother and brethren, and of the many
+ heroes that must perish, grieve I less bitterly than for the
+ anguish that must come upon thee on that day when thou no
+ longer hast a husband to fight for thee and a Greek leads thee
+ away a prisoner. May the earth be heaped up high above me ere I
+ hear thy crying, Andromache!"</p>
+
+ <p>So spake Hector, and stretched out his arms to take his
+ boy.</p>
+
+ <p>But from his father's bronze helmet with its fiercely
+ nodding plume of horsehair the babe shrank back in terror and
+ hid his face in his nurse's breast. Then did the little City
+ King's father and his sweet mother laugh aloud, and on the
+ ground Hector laid his helmet, and taking his little son in his
+ arms he kissed him and gently dandled him. And as he did so,
+ thus Hector prayed to Zeus and all the gods:</p>
+
+ <p>"O Zeus and all ye gods, grant that my son may be a brave
+ warrior and a great king in Troyland. Let men say of him
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page110" id="page110"></a>[pg
+ 110]</span> when he returns from battle, 'Far greater is he
+ than his father,' and may he gladden his mother's heart."</p>
+
+ <p>Then did Hector lay his babe in Andromache's arms, and she
+ held him to her bosom, smiling through her tears.</p>
+
+ <p>Full of love and pity and tenderness was the heart of
+ Hector, and gently he caressed her and said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear one, I pray thee be not of over-sorrowful heart. No
+ man shall slay me ere the time appointed for my death hath
+ come. Go home and busy thyself with loom and distaff and see to
+ the work of thy maidens. But war is for us men, and of all
+ those who dwell in Troyland, most of all for me."</p>
+
+ <p>So spake Hector, and on his head again he placed his crested
+ helmet. And his wife went home, many times looking back to
+ watch him she loved going forth to battle, with her eyes half
+ blinded by her tears.</p>
+
+ <p>Not far behind Hector followed Paris, his armor glittering
+ like the sun, and with a laugh on the face that was more full
+ of beauty than that of any other man on earth. Like a noble
+ charger that has broken its bonds and gallops exultingly across
+ the plain, so did Paris stride onward.</p>
+
+ <p>"I fear I have delayed thee," he said to his brother when he
+ overtook him.</p>
+
+ <p>"No man can speak lightly of thy courage," answered Hector,
+ "only thou hast brought shame on thyself by holding back from
+ battle. But now let us go forward, and may the gods give the
+ Greeks into our hands."</p>
+
+ <p>So went Hector and Paris together into battle, and many a
+ Greek fell before them on that day.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/110.jpg" name="fig110s"
+ id="fig110s"><img width="300" src="images/110s.jpg"
+ alt="ANDROMACHE IN CAPTIVITY" /></a><br />
+ andromache in captivity
+ </div>
+
+ <h4>V</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW PATROCLUS FOUGHT AND DIED</h4>
+
+ <p>While round the dark ships of Greece the fierce fight raged,
+ Achilles, from afar, listened unmoved to the din of battle, and
+ watched with stony eyes the men of Greece as they fell and died
+ on the reddened ground.</p>
+
+ <p>To him came
+ Patroclus.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page111"
+ id="page111"></a>[pg 111]</span>
+
+ <p>"Why dost thou weep, Patroclus?" asked Achilles. "Like a
+ fond little maid art thou that runs by her mother's side,
+ plucking at her gown, hindering her as she walks, and with
+ tearful eyes looking up at her until the mother lifts her in
+ her arms. Like her, Patroclus, dost thou softly weep."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Patroclus, heavily groaning, made answer:</p>
+
+ <p>"Among the ships lie the bravest and best of the men of
+ Greece, sore wounded or dead. Pitiless art thou, Achilles,
+ pitiless and unforgiving. Yet if thou dost still hold back from
+ the battle, give me, I pray thee, thine armor, and send me
+ forth in thy stead. Perchance the Trojans may take me for the
+ mighty Achilles, and even now the victory be ours."</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Achilles, and heavy was his heart within him:</p>
+
+ <p>"These Greeks took from me my well-won prize, Patroclus. Yet
+ let the past be past; no man may keep his anger for ever. I
+ have said that until the men of Troy come to burn my own ships
+ I will hold me back from the battle. But take you my armor;
+ lead my men in the fight, and drive from the ships the men of
+ Troy. But to others leave it to chase them across the
+ plain."</p>
+
+ <p>Even as Achilles spoke, the strength of mighty Ajax had come
+ to an end, and with furious rush did the Trojans board the
+ ships. In their hands they bore blazing torches, and up to the
+ sky rushed the fiercely roaring flames.</p>
+
+ <p>Then cried Achilles, smiting his thighs:</p>
+
+ <p>"Haste thee, Patroclus! They burn the ships! Arm thyself
+ speedily, and I will call my men!"</p>
+
+ <p>Corslet and shield and helmet did Patroclus swiftly don, and
+ girded on the silver-studded sword and took two strong lances
+ in his hand.</p>
+
+ <p>In the chariot of Achilles he mounted, and Automedon, best
+ and bravest of charioteers, took the reins.</p>
+
+ <p>Swift as the wild west wind were Bayard and Piebald, the two
+ horses of Achilles, and in the side harness was Pedasus, a
+ horse only less swift than they.</p>
+
+ <p>Gladly did the men of Achilles meet his call to arms, for
+ fierce as wolves were they.</p>
+
+ <p>"Many times hast thou blamed me," cried Achilles,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page112" id="page112"></a>[pg
+ 112]</span> "because in my wrath I kept ye back from battle.
+ Here for ye now is a mighty fight, such as ye love."</p>
+
+ <p>To battle they went, and while Patroclus led them forth,
+ Achilles in his tent offered up an offering to Zeus.</p>
+
+ <p>Like wasps that pour forth from their nests by the wayside
+ to sting the boys who have stoned them, so now did the Greeks
+ swarm from their ships.</p>
+
+ <p>Before the sword of Patroclus fell a mighty warrior, and
+ when the men of Troy saw the shining armor of Achilles in his
+ own chariot their hearts sank within them.</p>
+
+ <p>Out of the ships were they driven, the fire was quenched,
+ and back to the trench rolled the tide of battle. In the trench
+ writhed many a horse and many a man in dying agonies. But clear
+ across it leaped the horses of Achilles, and close to the walls
+ of Troy did Patroclus drive brave Hector before him.</p>
+
+ <p>His chariot then he turned, and headed off the fleeing
+ Trojans, driving them down to the ships. Before the furious
+ rush of his swift steeds, other horses were borne off their
+ feet, other chariots cast in ruins on the ground, and men
+ crushed to death under his wheels. Chief after chief did
+ Patroclus slay. A mighty destroyer was he that day.</p>
+
+ <p>One only of the chiefs of Troy kept his courage before the
+ destroyer who wore the shining arms of Achilles.</p>
+
+ <p>"Shame on ye!" cried Sarpedon to his men, "whither do ye
+ flee? I myself will fight this man who deals death and
+ destruction to the Trojan host."</p>
+
+ <p>From their chariots leaped Sarpedon and Patroclus.</p>
+
+ <p>With the first cast of his spear Patroelus missed Sarpedon,
+ but slew his charioteer. Then did Sarpedon cast, and his spear
+ whizzed past Patroclus, and smote the good horse Pedasus. With
+ a dreadful scream Pedasus fell, kicking and struggling, in the
+ dust. This way and that did the other two horses plunge and
+ rear, until the yoke creaked and the reins became entangled.
+ But the charioteer leaped down, with his sword slashed clear
+ the traces from Pedasus, and the horses righted themselves.</p>
+
+ <p>Once again did Sarpedon cast his spear, and the point flew
+ over the left shoulder of Patroclus. But Patroclus missed not.
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page113" id="page113"></a>[pg
+ 113]</span> Through the heart of Sarpedon sped the fiercely
+ hurled spear, and like a slim tree before the axe of the
+ wood-cutter he fell, his dying hands clutching at the bloody
+ dust.</p>
+
+ <p>Furious was the combat then over the body of Sarpedon. One
+ brave warrior after another did Patroclus lay dead.</p>
+
+ <p>And more terrible still was the fight because in the ranks
+ of the men of Troy there fought now, in all-devouring wrath,
+ the god Apollo.</p>
+
+ <p>Nine men, good warriors all, did Patroclus slay; then,
+ waxing bolder, he tried to climb the very walls of Troy.</p>
+
+ <p>Three times did Apollo thrust him back, and when, a fourth
+ time, he attacked, the god cried aloud to him in anger, warning
+ him not to dare so much.</p>
+
+ <p>Against Patroclus did Hector then drive his war-horses, but
+ Patroclus, leaping from his chariot, hurled at Hector a jagged
+ stone. In the eyes it smote the charioteer of Hector, and the
+ slain man dropped to the ground.</p>
+
+ <p>"How nimble a man is this!" jeered Patroclus. "How lightly
+ he diveth! Were this the sea, how good an oyster-seeker would
+ this fellow be!"</p>
+
+ <p>Then from his chariot leaped Hector and met Patroclus, and
+ the noise of the battle was as the noise of a mighty gale in
+ the forest when great trees fall crashing to the ground.</p>
+
+ <p>When the sun went down, victory was with the Greeks. Three
+ mighty charges did Patroclus make, and each time he slew nine
+ men. But when, a fourth time, he charged, Apollo met him. In
+ thick mist he met him, and Patroclus knew not that he fought
+ with a god. With a fierce down-stroke from behind, Apollo smote
+ his broad shoulders, and from off his head the helmet of
+ Achilles fell with a clang, rattling under the hoofs of the
+ horses. Before the smiting of the god, Patroclus stood
+ stricken, stupid and amazed. Shattered in his hands was the
+ spear of Achilles, and his mighty shield clanged on the
+ ground.</p>
+
+ <p>Ere he could know who was the smiter, a Trojan ally drove a
+ spear between his shoulders, and Patroclus, sore wounded, fell
+ back.</p>
+
+ <p>Marking his dismay, Hector pressed forward, and clean
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page114" id="page114"></a>[pg
+ 114]</span> through his body drove his bronze spear. With a
+ crash Patroclus fell.</p>
+
+ <p>"Thou that didst boast that thou wouldst sack my town, here
+ shall vultures devour thee!" cried Hector.</p>
+
+ <p>And in a faint voice Patroclus made answer:</p>
+
+ <p>"Not to thee do I owe my doom, great Hector. Twenty such as
+ thou would I have fought and conquered, but the gods have slain
+ me. Yet verily I tell thee that thou thyself hast not long to
+ live. Even now doth Death stand beside thee!"</p>
+
+ <p>As he spoke, the shadow of Death fell upon Patroclus. No
+ more in his ears roared the din of battle; still and silent for
+ ever he lay.</p>
+
+ <h4>VI</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE ROUSING OF ACHILLES</h4>
+
+ <p>Fierce had been the fight before Patroclus died. More
+ fiercely yet it raged when he lay dead.</p>
+
+ <p>From his body did Hector take the arms of Achilles, and the
+ dead Patroclus would the Trojans fain have dragged to their
+ city, there to bring shame to him and to all the Greek
+ host.</p>
+
+ <p>But for him fought the Greeks, until the earth was wet with
+ blood and the very skies echoed the clang of battle.</p>
+
+ <p>To Achilles came Antilochos, a messenger fleet of foot.</p>
+
+ <p>"Fallen is Patroclus!" he cried, "and around his naked body
+ do they fight, for his armor is held by Hector."</p>
+
+ <p>Then did Achilles moan aloud. On the ground he lay, and in
+ his hair he poured black ashes. And the sound of his terrible
+ lament was heard by his mother, Thetis, the goddess, as she sat
+ in her palace down under the depths of the green sea.</p>
+
+ <p>Up from under the waves swiftly came she to Achilles, and
+ tenderly did she listen while he poured forth to her the tale
+ of the death of his dear comrade.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Thetis:</p>
+
+ <p>"Not long, methinks, shall Hector glory in the armor that
+ was thine, for Death presseth hard upon him. Go not forth
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page115" id="page115"></a>[pg
+ 115]</span> to battle, my son, until I return, bearing with me
+ new and fair armor for thee."</p>
+
+ <p>But when Thetis had departed, to Achilles in his sorrow came
+ Iris, fair messenger of the gods.</p>
+
+ <p>"Unto windy Ilios will the Trojans drag the body of
+ Patroclus unless thou comest now. Thou needst not fight,
+ Achilles, only show thyself to the men of Troy, for sore is the
+ need of Patroclus thy friend."</p>
+
+ <p>Then, all unarmed, did Achilles go forth, and stood beside
+ the trench. With a mighty voice he shouted, and at the sound of
+ his voice terror fell upon the Trojans. Backward in flight they
+ went, and from among the dead did the Greeks draw the body of
+ Patroclus, and hot were the tears that Achilles shed for the
+ friend whom he had sent forth to battle.</p>
+
+ <p>All that night, in the house of the Immortals, resounded the
+ clang of hammer on anvil as Hephaistus, the lame god, fashioned
+ new arms for Achilles.</p>
+
+ <p>Bronze and silver and gold he threw in his fire, and golden
+ handmaidens helped their master to wield the great bellows, and
+ to send on the crucibles blasts that made the ruddy flames
+ dance.</p>
+
+ <p>No fairer shield was ever borne by man than that which
+ Hephaistus made for Achilles. For him also he wrought a corslet
+ brighter than a flame of fire, and a helmet with a golden
+ crest.</p>
+
+ <p>And in the morning light did Thetis dart down from snowy
+ Olympus, bearing in her arms the splendid gift of a god.</p>
+
+ <p>Glad was Achilles as he put on the armor, and terrible was
+ his war-cry as he roused the Greek warriors. No man, however
+ sore his wounds, held back when the voice of Achilles called
+ him to the fight once again. Wounded was Agamemnon, overlord of
+ the Greeks, but forth also came he. And there, while the sun
+ rose on many a warrior who would fight no more, did Achilles
+ and Agamemnon speak as friends once again, their long strife
+ ended.</p>
+
+ <p>Hungry for war, with Achilles as their leader, did the
+ Greeks then meet the Trojans on the plain. And as a fierce fire
+ rages through the forest, its flames driven by the wind, so did
+ Achilles in his wrath drive through the host of
+ Troy.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page116"
+ id="page116"></a>[pg 116]</span>
+
+ <p>Down to the Scamander he drove the fleeing Trojans, and the
+ water reddened with blood, as he smote and spared not.</p>
+
+ <p>Merciless was Achilles; pitilessly did he exult as one brave
+ man after another was sent by him to dye red the swift flood of
+ the Scamander.</p>
+
+ <p>At length, at his lack of mercy, did even the river grow
+ wrathful.</p>
+
+ <p>"Choked is my stream with dead men!" it cried, "and still
+ thou slayest!"</p>
+
+ <p>But when Achilles heeded not, in fierce flood the river
+ up-rose against him, sweeping the slain before it, and in
+ furious spate seeking to destroy Achilles. But as its waves
+ smote against his shield, Achilles grasped a tall elm, and
+ uprooting it, cast it into the river to dam the torrent. For
+ the moment only was the angry river stayed. In fear did
+ Achilles flee across the plain, but with a mighty roar it
+ pursued him, and caught him.</p>
+
+ <p>To the gods then cried Achilles, and to his aid came Athene,
+ and close to the walls of Troy again did Achilles chase the
+ Trojan men.</p>
+
+ <p>From the city walls old Priam saw the dreadful things
+ Achilles wrought.</p>
+
+ <p>And when, his armor blazing like the brightest stars of the
+ sky, he drew near, and Hector would have gone to meet him, in
+ grief did Priam cry to his dearly loved son:</p>
+
+ <p>"Hector, beloved son, I pray thee go not alone to meet this
+ man; mightier far than thou is he."</p>
+
+ <p>But all eager for the fight was Hector. Of all the men of
+ Troy he alone still stood unafraid. Then did the mother of
+ Hector beseech him to hold back from what must surely mean
+ death. Yet Hector held not back, but on his shining shield
+ leaned against a tower, awaiting the coming of the great
+ destroyer.</p>
+
+ <p>And at last they met, face to face, spear to spear. As a
+ shooting-star in the darkness so flashed the spear of Achilles
+ as he hurled it home to pierce the neck of Hector. Gods and men
+ had deserted Hector, and alone before the walls of Troy he fell
+ and died.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page117"
+ id="page117"></a>[pg 117]</span>
+
+ <p>Thus ended the fight.</p>
+
+ <p>For twelve days did the Greek host rejoice, and all through
+ the days Hector's body lay unburied. For at the heels of swift
+ horses had the Greeks dragged him to the ships, while from the
+ battlements his mother and his wife Andromache watched, wailing
+ in agony, with hearts that broke.</p>
+
+ <p>Then at length went old Priam to the camp of the Greeks. And
+ before Achilles he fell, beseeching him to have mercy and to
+ give him back the body of his son.</p>
+
+ <p>So was the heart of Achilles moved, and the body of Hector
+ ransomed; and with wailing of women did the people of Troy
+ welcome home their hero.</p>
+
+ <p>Over him lamented his old mother, for of all her sons was he
+ to her most dear, and over him wept, with burning tears, his
+ wife Andromache.</p>
+
+ <p>And to his bier came Helen, and with breaking heart did she
+ sob forth her sorrow:</p>
+
+ <p>"Dearest of my brothers," she said, "from thee have I heard
+ neither reproach nor evil word. With kind words and gentle
+ heart hast thou ever stood by me. Lost, lost is my one true
+ friend. No more in Troyland is any left to pity me."</p>
+
+ <p>On lofty funeral pyre then laid they the dead Hector, and
+ when the flames had consumed his body his comrades placed his
+ white bones in a golden urn, and over it with great stones did
+ they raise a mighty mound that all might see where he
+ rested.</p>
+
+ <p>Yet still was the warfare between Greeks and Trojans not
+ ended.</p>
+
+ <p>To Achilles death came in a shaft from the bow of Paris. By
+ a poisoned arrow driven at venture and at dark midnight from
+ the bow of an outcast leper was fair Paris slain. While winter
+ snow lay white on Ida, in Helen's arms did his life ebb
+ away.</p>
+
+ <p>Then came there a day when the Greeks burned their camp and
+ sailed homeward across the gray water.</p>
+
+ <p>Behind them they left a mighty horse of wood, and the men of
+ Troy came and drew it into the city as trophy and sign of
+ victory over those who had made it. But inside the horse were
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page118" id="page118"></a>[pg
+ 118]</span> hidden many of the bravest warriors of Greece, and
+ at night, when the Trojans feasted, the Greeks came out of
+ their hiding-place and threw open the gates.</p>
+
+ <p>And up from the sea came the Greek host, and in fire and in
+ blood fell the city of Troy.</p>
+
+ <p>Yet did not Helen perish. Back to his own kingdom by the sea
+ Menelaus took her, to reign, in peace, a queen, she who had
+ brought grief and death to so many, and to the city of Troy
+ unutterable woe.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page119"
+ id="page119"></a>[pg 119]</span>
+
+ <h3>THE ODYSSEY OF HOMER</h3>
+
+ <h4>ADAPTED BY JEANIE LANG</h4>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <h4>WHAT HAPPENED IN ITHACA WHILE ODYSSEUS WAS AWAY</h4>
+
+ <p>While Odysseus was fighting far away in Troyland, his baby
+ son grew to be a big boy. And when years passed and Odysseus
+ did not return, the boy, Telemachus, grew to be a man.</p>
+
+ <p>Telemachus loved his beautiful mother, Penelope, but his
+ heart always longed for the hero father whom he could only
+ dimly remember. As time went on, he longed more and more, for
+ evil things came to pass in the kingdom of Odysseus.</p>
+
+ <p>The chiefs and lords of Ithaca admired Penelope for her
+ beauty. They also coveted her money and her lands, and when
+ Odysseus did not return, each one of these greedy and wicked
+ men wished to marry her and make his own all that had belonged
+ to brave Odysseus.</p>
+
+ <p>"Odysseus is surely dead," they said, "and Telemachus is
+ only a lad and cannot harm us."</p>
+
+ <p>So they came to the palace where Penelope and Telemachus
+ lived, and there they stayed, year in, year out, feasting and
+ drinking and wasting the goods of Odysseus. Their roughness and
+ greed troubled Penelope, but still more did they each one daily
+ torment her by rudely asking: "Wilt thou marry me?"</p>
+
+ <p>At last she fell on a plan to stop them from talking to her
+ of marriage.</p>
+
+ <p>In the palace hall she set up a great web, beautiful and
+ fine of woof.</p>
+
+ <p>Then she said, "When I have finished weaving this robe I
+ shall give you my answer."</p>
+
+ <p>Each day she worked at it, but each night, when the wooers
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page120" id="page120"></a>[pg
+ 120]</span> slept, she undid all that she had done during the
+ day. So it seemed to the wooers as if the robe would never be
+ finished.</p>
+
+ <p>Penelope's heart was heavy, and heavy, too, was the heart of
+ Telemachus. For three weary years, while Odysseus was
+ imprisoned on the island of Calypso, the mother and son pined
+ together.</p>
+
+ <p>One day Telemachus sat at the door of the palace sadly
+ watching the wooers as they drank and reveled. He was thinking
+ of the brave father that he feared was dead, when there walked
+ up to the door of the courtyard a stranger dressed like a
+ warrior from another land.</p>
+
+ <p>The stranger was the goddess Athene. At the same time that
+ she gained leave from the gods to set Odysseus free, they had
+ agreed that she should go to Ithaca and help Telemachus. But
+ she came dressed as a warrior, and not as a beautiful,
+ gray-eyed, golden-haired goddess with golden sandals on her
+ feet.</p>
+
+ <p>Telemachus rose up and shook her kindly by the hand, and led
+ her into the hall. He took from her the heavy bronze spear that
+ she carried, and made her sit down on one of the finest of the
+ chairs, in a place where the noise of the rough wooers should
+ not disturb her.</p>
+
+ <p>"Welcome, stranger," he said. "When thou hast had food, then
+ shalt thou tell us in what way we can help thee."</p>
+
+ <p>He then made servants bring a silver basin and golden ewer
+ that she might wash her hands, and he fetched her food and wine
+ of the best.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon the wooers entered, and noisily ate they and drank, and
+ roughly jested.</p>
+
+ <p>Telemachus watched them and listened with an angry heart.
+ Then, in a low voice, he said to Athene:</p>
+
+ <p>"These men greedily eat and drink, and waste my father's
+ goods. They think the bones of Odysseus bleach out in the rain
+ in a far land, or are tossed about by the sea. But did my
+ father still live, and were he to come home, the cowards would
+ flee before him. Tell me, stranger, hast thou come from a
+ far-off country? Hast thou ever seen my father?"</p>
+
+ <p>Athene answered: "Odysseus still lives. He is a prisoner
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page121" id="page121"></a>[pg
+ 121]</span> on a sea-girt island, but it will not be long ere
+ he escapes and comes home. Thou art like Odysseus, my son. Thou
+ hast a head like his, and the same beautiful eyes."</p>
+
+ <p>When Athene spoke to him so kindly and so hopefully,
+ Telemachus told her all that was in his heart. And when the
+ wickedness and greed of the wooers was made known to her,
+ Athene grew very angry.</p>
+
+ <p>"Thou art in sore need of Odysseus," she said. "If Odysseus
+ were to come to the door now with lance in hand, soon would he
+ scatter those shameless ones before him."</p>
+
+ <p>Then she told Telemachus what he must do.</p>
+
+ <p>"To-morrow," said she, "call thy lords to a council meeting,
+ and tell the wooers to return to their homes."</p>
+
+ <p>For himself, she told him to fit out a ship with twenty
+ oars-men, that he might sail to a land where he should get
+ tidings of his father.</p>
+
+ <p>"Thou art tall and handsome, my friend," she said. "Be
+ brave, that even in days to come men may praise thy name."</p>
+
+ <p>"Thou speakest as a father to a son. I will never forget
+ what thou hast said," said Telemachus.</p>
+
+ <p>He begged Athene to stay longer, and wished to give her a
+ costly gift. But she would not stay, nor accept any present. To
+ Telemachus she had given a gift, though he did not know it. For
+ into his heart she had put strength and courage, so that when
+ she flew away like a beautiful bird across the sea she left
+ behind her, not a frightened, unhappy boy, but a strong, brave
+ man.</p>
+
+ <p>The wooers took no notice of the comings and goings of the
+ strange warrior, so busy were they with their noisy feast. As
+ they feasted a minstrel played to them on his lyre, and sang a
+ song of the return of the warriors from Troyland when the
+ fighting was over.</p>
+
+ <p>From her room above, Penelope heard the song, and came down.
+ For a little, standing by the door, she listened. Then she
+ could bear it no longer, and, weeping, she said to the
+ minstrel:</p>
+
+ <p>"Sing some other song, and do not sing a song of return from
+ Troyland to me, whose husband never
+ returned."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page122"
+ id="page122"></a>[pg 122]</span>
+
+ <p>Then Telemachus, in a new and manly way that made her
+ wonder, spoke to his mother:</p>
+
+ <p>"Blame not the minstrel, dear mother," he said. "It is not
+ his fault that he sings sad songs, but the fault of the gods
+ who allow sad things to be. Thou art not the only one who hast
+ lost a loved one in Troyland. Go back to thy room, and let me
+ order what shall be, for I am now the head of the house."</p>
+
+ <p>In the same fearless, manly way he spoke to the wooers:</p>
+
+ <p>"Ye may feast to-night," he said; "only let there be no
+ brawling. To-morrow meet with me. For once and for all it must
+ be decided if ye are to go on wasting my goods, or if I am to
+ be master of my own house and king in mine own land."</p>
+
+ <p>The wooers bit their lips with rage, and some of them
+ answered him rudely; but Telemachus paid no heed, and when at
+ last they returned to their houses, he went upstairs to his own
+ room. The old woman who had nursed him when he was a child
+ carried torches before him to show him the way. When he sat
+ down on his bed and took off his doublet, she folded and
+ smoothed it and hung it up. Then she shut the door with its
+ silver handle, and left Telemachus, wrapped in a soft fleece of
+ wool, thinking far into the night of all that Athene had said
+ to him.</p>
+
+ <p>When day dawned he dressed and buckled on his sword, and
+ told heralds to call the lords to a council meeting. When all
+ were assembled he went into the hall. In his hand he carried a
+ bronze spear, and two of his hounds followed him, and when he
+ went up to his father's seat and sat down there, the oldest men
+ gave place to him. For Athene had shed on him such a wondrous
+ grace that he looked like a young god.</p>
+
+ <p>"Never since brave Odysseus sailed away to Troyland have we
+ had a council meeting," said one old lord. "I think the man who
+ hath called this meeting is a true man&mdash;good luck go with
+ him! May the gods give him his heart's desire."</p>
+
+ <p>So good a beginning did this seem that Telemachus was glad,
+ and, burning to say all that had been in his heart for so long,
+ he rose to his feet and spoke.</p>
+
+ <p>Of the loss of his father he spoke sadly, and then, with
+ burning words, of the cowardly wooers, of their feastings and
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page123" id="page123"></a>[pg
+ 123]</span> revelings and wasting of his goods, and of their
+ insolence to Penelope and himself.</p>
+
+ <p>When he had thus spoken in rage and grief, he burst into
+ tears.</p>
+
+ <p>For a little there was silence, then one of the wooers said
+ angrily:</p>
+
+ <p>"Penelope is to blame, and no other. For three years she has
+ deceived us. 'I will give you my answer when I have finished
+ weaving this robe,' she said, and so we waited and waited. But
+ now that three years have gone and a fourth has begun, it is
+ told us by one of her maids that each night she has undone all
+ she has woven during the day. She can deceive us no longer. She
+ must now finish the robe, and tell us whom she will marry. For
+ we will not leave this place until she has chosen a
+ husband."</p>
+
+ <p>Then, once again, with pleading words, Telemachus tried to
+ move the hearts of the wooers.</p>
+
+ <p>"If ye will not go," at last he said, "I will ask the gods
+ to reward you for your wickedness."</p>
+
+ <p>As he spoke, two eagles flew, fleet as the wind, from the
+ mountain crest. Side by side they flew until they were above
+ the place of the council meeting. Then they wheeled about,
+ darted with fury at each other, and tore with their savage
+ talons at each other's heads and necks. Flapping their great
+ wings, they then went swiftly away and were lost in the far
+ distance.</p>
+
+ <p>Said a wise old man: "It is an omen. Odysseus will return,
+ and woe will come upon the wooers. Let us make an end of these
+ evil doings and keep harm away from us."</p>
+
+ <p>"Go home, old man," angrily mocked the wooers. "Prophesy to
+ thine own children. Odysseus is dead. Would that thou hadst
+ died with him. Then thou couldst not have babbled nonsense, and
+ tried to hound on Telemachus in the hope that he may give thee
+ a gift."</p>
+
+ <p>To Telemachus they said again:</p>
+
+ <p>"We will go on wasting thy goods until Penelope weds one of
+ us."</p>
+
+ <p>Only one other beside the old man was brave enough to speak
+ for Telemachus. Fearlessly and nobly did his friend
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page124" id="page124"></a>[pg
+ 124]</span> Mentor blame the wooers for their shamelessness.
+ But they jeered at him, and laughed aloud when Telemachus told
+ them he was going to take a ship and go to look for his
+ father.</p>
+
+ <p>"He will never come back," said one, "and even were Odysseus
+ himself to return, we should slay him when he came."</p>
+
+ <p>Then the council meeting broke up, and the wooers went again
+ to revel in the palace of Odysseus.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/124.jpg" name="fig124s"
+ id="fig124s"><img width="300" src="images/124s.jpg"
+ alt="TELEMACHUS KNELT WHERE THE GRAY WATER BROKE ON THE SAND" />
+ </a><br />
+ telemachus knelt where the gray water broke on the sand
+ </div>
+
+ <p>Down to the seashore went Telemachus and knelt where the
+ gray water broke in little white wavelets on the sand.</p>
+
+ <p>"Hear me," he cried, "thou who didst speak with me
+ yesterday. I know now that thou art a god. Tell me, I pray
+ thee? how shall I find a ship to sail across the misty sea and
+ find my father? For there is none to help me."</p>
+
+ <p>Swiftly, in answer to his cry, came Athene.</p>
+
+ <p>"Be brave. Be thy father's son," she said. "Go back to thy
+ house and get ready corn and wine for the voyage. I will choose
+ the best of all the ships in Ithaca for thee, and have her
+ launched, and manned by a crew, all of them willing men."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Telemachus returned to the palace. In the courtyard the
+ wooers were slaying goats and singeing swine and making ready a
+ great feast.</p>
+
+ <p>"Here comes Telemachus, who is planning to destroy us," they
+ mocked. "Telemachus, who speaks so proudly&mdash;- angry
+ Telemachus."</p>
+
+ <p>Said one youth:</p>
+
+ <p>"Who knows but what if he goes on a voyage he will be like
+ Odysseus, and never return. Then will we have all his riches to
+ divide among ourselves, and his house will belong to the man
+ who weds Penelope."</p>
+
+ <p>Telemachus shook off the jeering crowd, and went down to the
+ vaulted chamber where his father's treasures were kept. Gold
+ and bronze lay there in piles, and there were great boxes of
+ splendid clothes, and casks of wine. The heavy folding doors of
+ the treasure chamber were shut day and night, and the old nurse
+ was the keeper of the treasures.</p>
+
+ <p>Telemachus bade her get ready corn and wine for the
+ voyage.</p>
+
+ <p>"When my mother has gone to rest I will take them away," he
+ said, "for this night I go to seek my father across the
+ sea."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page125"
+ id="page125"></a>[pg 125]</span>
+
+ <p>At this the old nurse began to cry.</p>
+
+ <p>"Do not go, dear child," she wailed. "Thou art our only one,
+ and we love thee so well. Odysseus is dead, and what canst thou
+ do, sailing far away across the deep sea? As soon as thou art
+ gone, those wicked men will begin to plot evil against thee. Do
+ not go. Do not go. There is no need for thee to risk thy life
+ on the sea and go wandering far from home."</p>
+
+ <p>"Take heart, nurse," said Telemachus. "The goddess Athene
+ has told me to go, so all will be well. But promise me not to
+ tell my dear mother that I am gone until she misses me. For I
+ do not wish to mar her fair face with tears."</p>
+
+ <p>The nurse promised, and began to make ready all that
+ Telemachus wished.</p>
+
+ <p>Meantime Athene, in the likeness of Telemachus, found a
+ swift-sailing ship, and men to sail it. When darkness fell, she
+ sent sleep on the wooers and led Telemachus down to the shore
+ where his men sat by their oars.</p>
+
+ <p>To the palace, where every one slept and all was still and
+ quiet, Telemachus brought his men. None but the old nurse knew
+ he was going away, but they found the food and wine that she
+ had got ready and carried it down to the ship. Then Athene went
+ on board, and Telemachus sat beside her. A fresh west wind
+ filled the sails and went singing over the waves. The dark
+ water surged up at the bow as the ship cut through it. And all
+ night long and till the dawn, the ship sailed happily on her
+ way.</p>
+
+ <p>At sunrise they came to land, and Athene and Telemachus went
+ on shore. The rulers of the country welcomed them and treated
+ them well, but could tell nothing of Odysseus after the siege
+ of Troy was over. Athene gave Telemachus into their care, then,
+ turning herself into a sea-eagle, she flew swiftly away,
+ leaving them amazed because they knew she must be one of the
+ gods.</p>
+
+ <p>While Telemachus sought for news of his father in this
+ kingdom, and the kingdoms near it, the wooers began to miss him
+ at their feasts. They fancied he was away hunting, until, one
+ day, as they played games in front of the palace, the man whose
+ ship Athene had borrowed came to them.</p>
+
+ <p>"When will Telemachus return with my ship?" he
+ asked.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page126"
+ id="page126"></a>[pg 126]</span>
+
+ <p>"I need it that I may cross over to where I keep my horses.
+ I wish to catch one and break him in."</p>
+
+ <p>When the wooers heard from him that Telemachus had sailed
+ away with twenty brave youths, in the swiftest ship in Ithaca,
+ they were filled with rage.</p>
+
+ <p>At once they got a ship and sailed to where they might meet
+ Telemachus in a strait between Ithaca and another rocky
+ island.</p>
+
+ <p>"We will slay him there," said they. "We will give him a
+ woful end to his voyage in search of his father."</p>
+
+ <p>When Penelope heard this, and knew that her son was perhaps
+ sailing to his doom, her heart well-nigh broke. She wept
+ bitterly, and reproached her maidens with not having told her
+ that Telemachus had gone.</p>
+
+ <p>"Slay me if thou wilt," said the old nurse, "but I alone
+ knew it. Telemachus made me promise not to tell thee, that thy
+ fair face might not be marred by weeping. Do not fear, the
+ goddess Athene will take care of him."</p>
+
+ <p>Thus she comforted her mistress, and although she lay long
+ awake that night, Penelope fell asleep at last. In her dreams
+ Athene came to her and told her that Telemachus would come
+ safely home, and so Penelope's sad heart was cheered.</p>
+
+ <p>While she slept the wooers sailed away in a swift, black
+ ship, with spears in their hands and murder in their hearts. On
+ a little rocky isle they landed until the ship of Telemachus
+ should pass, and there they waited, that they might slay him
+ when he came.</p>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW ODYSSEUS CAME HOME</h4>
+
+ <p>While yet Telemachus sought news of his father, Odysseus was
+ well-nigh home. On that misty morning when he found himself in
+ Ithaca, and did not know it, because the gray fog made
+ everything seem strange and unfriendly, Odysseus was very sad
+ as he sat beside the moaning sea.</p>
+
+ <p>Then came Athene, and drove the mist before her, and
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page127" id="page127"></a>[pg
+ 127]</span> Odysseus saw again the land that he loved, and knew
+ that his wanderings were past. She told him the tale of the
+ wooers, and of the unhappiness of Penelope and Telemachus, and
+ the heart of Odysseus grew hot within him.</p>
+
+ <p>"Stand by me!" he said to the goddess. "If thou of thy grace
+ wilt help me, I myself will fight three hundred men."</p>
+
+ <p>"Truly I will stand by thee," said Athene, "and many of the
+ greedy wooers shall stain the earth with their blood."</p>
+
+ <p>She then told Odysseus how the wooers were to be destroyed,
+ and Odysseus gladly agreed to her plans. First she made him
+ hide far in the darkness of the cave, under the olive-tree, all
+ the gold and bronze ornaments and beautiful clothes that had
+ been given to him in the land of Nausicaa.</p>
+
+ <p>Then she touched him with her golden wand. In a moment his
+ yellow hair fell off his head; his bright eyes were dim; his
+ skin was withered and wrinkled, and he had a stooping back and
+ tottering legs like a feeble old man. His clothes of purple and
+ silver she changed into torn and filthy old rags, and over his
+ shoulders she threw the old skin of a stag with the hair worn
+ off.</p>
+
+ <p>"Go now," said Athene, "to where thy faithful swineherd sits
+ on the hill, watching his swine as they grub among the acorns
+ and drink of the clear spring. He has always been true to thee
+ and to thy wife and son. Stay with him and hear all that he has
+ to tell, and I will go and fetch home Telemachus."</p>
+
+ <p>"When thou didst know all, why didst thou not tell
+ Telemachus?" asked Odysseus. "Is he, too, to go wandering over
+ stormy seas, far from his own land?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Telemachus will be a braver man for what he has gone
+ through," said Athene. "No harm shall come to him, although the
+ wooers in their black ship wait to slay him."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Athene flew across the sea, and Odysseus climbed up a
+ rough track through the woods to where the swineherd had built
+ himself a hut. The hut was made of stones and thorn-branches,
+ and beside it were sties for the swine made in the same way.
+ The wooers had eaten many swine at their daily feasts, but
+ thousands remained. These the swineherd tended, with three men
+ and four fierce dogs to help
+ him.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page128"
+ id="page128"></a>[pg 128]</span>
+
+ <p>At an open space on the hill, from whence he could look down
+ at the woods and the sea, Odysseus found the swineherd sitting
+ at the door of his hut making himself a pair of sandals out of
+ brown ox-hide.</p>
+
+ <p>When the swineherd's dogs saw a dirty, bent old man toiling
+ up the hill, they rushed at him, barking furiously. Up they
+ leapt on him and would have torn him to pieces if their master
+ had not cast away his ox-hide, dashed after them, scolded them
+ and beaten them, and then driven them off with showers of
+ stones.</p>
+
+ <p>"If my dogs had killed thee I should have been for ever
+ ashamed," he said to Odysseus, "and without that I have enough
+ sorrow. For while my noble master may be wandering in a strange
+ land and lacking food, I have to feed his fat swine for others
+ to eat."</p>
+
+ <p>So speaking, he led Odysseus to his hut. He laid some
+ brushwood on the floor, spread over it the soft, shaggy skin of
+ a wild goat, and bade Odysseus be seated. Then he went out to
+ the sties, killed two sucking pigs, and roasted them daintily.
+ When they were ready he cut off the choicest bits and gave them
+ to Odysseus, with a bowl of honey-sweet wine.</p>
+
+ <p>While Odysseus ate and drank, the swineherd talked to him of
+ the greed and wastefulness of the wooers, and in silence
+ Odysseus listened, planning in his heart how he might punish
+ them.</p>
+
+ <p>"Tell me thy master's name," he said at length. "I have
+ traveled in many lands. Perchance I may have seen him, and may
+ give thee news of him."</p>
+
+ <p>But the swineherd answered:</p>
+
+ <p>"Each vagrant who comes straying to the land of Ithaca goes
+ to my mistress with lying tales of how he has seen or heard of
+ my master. She receives them all kindly, and asks many
+ questions, while tears run down her cheeks. You, too, old man,
+ would quickly make up a story if any one would give thee some
+ new clothes. My master is surely dead, and wherever I may go I
+ shall never again find a lord so gentle."</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Odysseus:</p>
+
+ <p>"My friend, I swear to thee that Odysseus shall return.
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page129" id="page129"></a>[pg
+ 129]</span> In this year, as the old moon wanes and the new is
+ born, he shall return to his home."</p>
+
+ <p>When the other herds returned that evening they found
+ Odysseus and their master still deep in talk. At night the
+ swineherd made a feast of the best that he had, and still they
+ talked, almost until dawn. The night was black and stormy, and
+ a drenching rain blotted out the moon, but the swineherd,
+ leaving Odysseus lying in the bed he had made for him, with his
+ own thick mantle spread over him, went outside and lay under a
+ rock that sheltered him from the storm, keeping guard on the
+ white-tusked boars that slept around him. And Odysseus knew
+ that he had still at least one servant who was faithful and
+ true.</p>
+
+ <p>While Odysseus dwelt with the swineherd, Athene sought
+ Telemachus and bade him hasten home. Speedily Telemachus went
+ back to his ship and his men. The hawsers were loosed, the
+ white sail hauled up, and Athene sent a fresh breeze that made
+ the ship cut through the water like a white-winged bird. It was
+ night when they passed the island where the wooers awaited
+ their coming, and in the darkness none saw them go by.</p>
+
+ <p>By daybreak they reached Ithaca, and Telemachus, as Athene
+ had bidden him, sent on the men to the harbor with the ship,
+ but made them put him ashore on the woody coast near the
+ swineherd's dwelling.</p>
+
+ <p>With his bronze-shod spear in his hand, Telemachus strode up
+ the rocky path. Odysseus and the swineherd had kindled a fire,
+ and were preparing the morning meal, when Odysseus heard the
+ noise of footsteps. He looked out and saw a tall lad with
+ yellow hair and bright eyes, and a fearless, noble face.
+ "Surely here is a friend," he said to the swineherd. "Thy dogs
+ are not barking, but jump up and fawn on him."</p>
+
+ <p>The swineherd looked, and when he saw his young master he
+ wept for joy.</p>
+
+ <p>"I thought I should never see thee more, sweet light of my
+ eyes," he said. "Come into my hut, that I may gladden my heart
+ with the sight of thee."</p>
+
+ <p>He then spread before him the best he had, and the three
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page130" id="page130"></a>[pg
+ 130]</span> men ate together. Although Odysseus seemed only a
+ poor, ragged, old beggar, Telemachus treated him with such
+ gentleness and such courtesy that Odysseus was proud and glad
+ of his noble son. Soon Telemachus sent the swineherd to tell
+ Penelope of his safe return, and while he was gone Athene
+ entered the hut. She made herself invisible to Telemachus, but
+ beckoned to Odysseus to go outside.</p>
+
+ <p>"The time is come for thee to tell thy son who thou art,"
+ she said, and touched him with her golden wand.</p>
+
+ <p>At once Odysseus was again a strong man, dressed in fine
+ robes, and radiant and beautiful as the sun.</p>
+
+ <p>When he went back into the hut Telemachus thought he was a
+ god.</p>
+
+ <p>"No god am I," said Odysseus; "I am thy father,
+ Telemachus."</p>
+
+ <p>And Odysseus took his son in his arms and kissed him, and
+ the tears that he had kept back until now ran down his cheeks.
+ Telemachus flung his arms round his father's neck, and he, too,
+ wept like a little child, so glad was he that Odysseus had come
+ home.</p>
+
+ <p>All day they spoke of the wooers and plotted how to slay
+ them.</p>
+
+ <p>When the swineherd returned, and Athene had once more
+ changed Odysseus into an old beggar-man, he told Telemachus
+ that the wooers had returned, and were so furious with
+ Telemachus for escaping from them, that they were going to kill
+ him next day.</p>
+
+ <p>At this Telemachus smiled to his father, but neither said a
+ word.</p>
+
+ <p>Next morning Telemachus took his spear and said to the
+ swineherd:</p>
+
+ <p>"I go to the palace to see my mother. As for this old
+ beggar-man, lead him to the city, that he may beg there."</p>
+
+ <p>And Odysseus, still pretending to be a beggar, said:</p>
+
+ <p>"It is better to beg in the town than in the fields. My
+ garments are very poor and thin, and this frosty air chills me;
+ but as soon as I am warmed at the fire and the sun grows hot, I
+ will gladly set
+ out."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page131"
+ id="page131"></a>[pg 131]</span>
+
+ <p>Down the hill to the city strode Telemachus. When he came to
+ the palace, his old nurse, whom he found busy in the hall, wept
+ for joy. And when Penelope heard his voice, she came from her
+ room and cast her arms round him and kissed his face and his
+ eyes, and said, while tears ran down her cheeks:</p>
+
+ <p>"Thou art come, sweet light of my eyes. I thought I should
+ never see thee more."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Telemachus, looking like a young god, with his spear in
+ his hand and his two hounds following at his heels, went to the
+ hall where the wooers sat. To his friend Mentor he told his
+ adventures, but he looked on the wooers with silence and
+ scorn.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon Odysseus and the swineherd followed him to the city. A
+ beggar's bag, all tattered, was slung round the shoulders of
+ Odysseus. In his hand he carried a staff. Men who saw him,
+ tattered and feeble, mocked at him and his guide. But Odysseus
+ kept down the anger in his heart, and they went on to the
+ palace. Near the doorway, lying in the dirt, thin and old and
+ rough of coat, lay Argos, the dog that long ago had been the
+ best and fleetest that had hunted the hares and deer with
+ Odysseus.</p>
+
+ <p>When he heard his master's voice he wagged his tail and
+ tried to crawl near him. But he was too feeble to move. He
+ could only look up with loving, wistful eyes that were almost
+ blind, and thump his tail gladly. So glad was he that his
+ faithful heart broke for joy, and before Odysseus could pat his
+ head or speak a kind word to him, old Argos rolled over
+ dead.</p>
+
+ <p>There were tears in the eyes of Odysseus as he walked past
+ the body of his friend. He sat down on the threshold leaning on
+ his staff, and when Telemachus sent him bread and meat from his
+ table he ate hungrily. When the meal was over he went round the
+ hall begging from the wooers. Some gave him scraps of broken
+ meats, others called him hard names and bade him begone, and
+ one of them seized a footstool and struck him with it.</p>
+
+ <p>But Odysseus still kept down the anger in his heart, and
+ went back to his seat on the threshold with his beggar's bag
+ full of the scraps that had been given to
+ him.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page132"
+ id="page132"></a>[pg 132]</span>
+
+ <p>As he sat there, a common beggar, well known for his greed
+ and impudence, came to the palace.</p>
+
+ <p>"Get thee hence, old man," said he to Odysseus, "else I
+ shall knock all thy teeth from thy head."</p>
+
+ <p>More, too, he said, rudely and roughly, and at last he
+ struck Odysseus.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Odysseus could bear no more, and smote him such a blow
+ on his neck that the bones were broken, and he fell on the
+ ground with blood gushing from his mouth. Odysseus dragged him
+ outside by the heels, and propped him, with his staff in his
+ hands, against the courtyard wall.</p>
+
+ <p>"Sit there," he said, "and scare off dogs and swine."</p>
+
+ <p>The wooers laughed and enjoyed the sport, and gave gifts of
+ food to the sturdy old beggar, as they took Odysseus to be. All
+ evening they feasted and drank, but when night fell they went
+ to their own homes.</p>
+
+ <p>When they were gone Odysseus and Telemachus carried all the
+ helmets and swords and sharp-pointed spears that stood in the
+ hall, away to the armory and hid them there.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Telemachus went to his room to rest, but Odysseus sat
+ in the hall where the servants were clearing away the remains
+ of the feast. While he sat there, Penelope came with her maids
+ and rested on a chair In front of the glowing wood fire on
+ which the servants had piled fresh logs.</p>
+
+ <p>She talked kindly and gently to the old beggar-man, and bade
+ the old nurse bring water to wash his weary feet.</p>
+
+ <p>Now, once long ago, a wild boar that he hunted had torn the
+ leg of Odysseus with his tusk, and as the old nurse washed his
+ feet she saw the scar. In a moment she knew her master, and
+ cried out. The brazen bath fell with a clang on the floor, and
+ the water was spilt.</p>
+
+ <p>"Thou art Odysseus," she said; "I did not know thee, my dear
+ child, until I found the scar."</p>
+
+ <p>Penelope must have heard her glad cry, had not Athene at
+ that moment made her deep in thoughts of other things. Quickly
+ Odysseus bade the old nurse be silent, and the old woman obeyed
+ him.</p>
+
+ <p>Before Penelope went to rest she said sadly to Odysseus:
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page133" id="page133"></a>[pg
+ 133]</span> "I feel that the end is drawing near. Soon I shall
+ be parted from the house of Odysseus. My husband, who was
+ always the best and bravest, used to set up the twelve axes ye
+ see standing here, and between each axe he shot an arrow. I
+ have told the wooers that I shall marry whichever one of them
+ can do the like. Then I shall leave this house, which must be
+ for ever most dear to me."</p>
+
+ <p>Then answered the old beggar-man: "Odysseus will be here
+ when they shoot. It will be Odysseus who shoots between the
+ axes."</p>
+
+ <p>Penelope, longing for his words to be true, went up to her
+ room and lay crying on her bed until her pillows were wet. Then
+ Athene sent sleep upon her eyelids and made her forget all her
+ sorrows.</p>
+
+ <p>Odysseus, too, would have tossed all night wide awake, with
+ a heart full of anger and revenge, had not Athene gently laid
+ her hands on his eyes and made him fall asleep.</p>
+
+ <p>Next day the wooers came to the palace, and with rough jest
+ and rude word they greeted Odysseus.</p>
+
+ <p>"Who harms this man must fight with me," said Telemachus,
+ and at that the wooers shouted with laughter.</p>
+
+ <p>But a stranger who sat among them cried out in a voice of
+ fear:</p>
+
+ <p>"I see your hands and knees shrouded in blackness! I see
+ your cheeks wet with tears! The walls and the pillars drip
+ blood; the porch is full of shadows, and pale ghosts are
+ hastening out of the gray mist that fills the palace."</p>
+
+ <p>At this the wooers laughed the more, for they thought the
+ man was mad. But, as in a dream, he had seen truly what was to
+ come to pass.</p>
+
+ <p>Weeping, Penelope then brought forth from the armory the
+ great bow with which Odysseus had shot in years that were past.
+ Her heart was full of love for Odysseus, and she could not bear
+ to wed another.</p>
+
+ <p>Telemachus then threw aside his red cloak and ranged out the
+ bronze axes.</p>
+
+ <p>One by one the wooers tried to move the great bow and make
+ it drive a swift arrow before it. One by one they
+ failed.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page134"
+ id="page134"></a>[pg 134]</span>
+
+ <p>And when it seemed as if no man there was strong enough to
+ move it, Odysseus took it in his hands, and between each axe he
+ shot an arrow. When the last arrow was shot he tore off his
+ rags, and in a voice that rang through the palace he cried to
+ Telemachus: "Now is it time to prepare supper for the wooers!
+ Now, at last, is this terrible trial ended. I go to shoot at
+ another mark!"</p>
+
+ <p>With that he shot an arrow at the wooer who had ever been
+ the most insolent and the most cruel. It smote him in the
+ throat, his blood dripped red on the ground, and he fell
+ dead.</p>
+
+ <p>The others gave a great cry of rage, but Odysseus looked at
+ them with burning eyes, and with a voice that made them tremble
+ he cried:</p>
+
+ <p>"Ye dogs! ye said I should never return, and, like the
+ traitors ye are, ye have wasted my goods and insulted my queen.
+ But now death has come for you, and none shall escape."</p>
+
+ <p>In vain did the cowards, their faces pale with fear, beg for
+ mercy. Mercy there was none that day. It was useless for those
+ who drew their swords and rushed on Odysseus to try to slay
+ him, for ere their swords could touch him, his bow had driven
+ sharp arrows into their hearts.</p>
+
+ <p>One of the servants of the palace treacherously climbed into
+ the armory and brought spears and shields and helmets for the
+ wooers. But even that did not daunt Odysseus and his son.
+ Telemachus, with his spear, slew man after man. When his arrows
+ were done Odysseus also snatched a spear, and they fought side
+ by side. Beside them fought the swineherd and one other man,
+ and they all fought the more fearlessly because, all the time,
+ Athene put fresh courage in their hearts.</p>
+
+ <p>There were four men to very many others when that fight
+ began. When it was ended the floor ran with blood, and
+ Odysseus, like a lion at bay, stood with the dead bodies of the
+ wooers piled in heaps around him and his face and hands stained
+ with blood.</p>
+
+ <p>When all lay dead, the old nurse gave a great cry of
+ joy.</p>
+
+ <p>"Rejoice in thy heart, old nurse," said Odysseus. "It is an
+ unholy thing to rejoice openly over slain
+ men."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page135"
+ id="page135"></a>[pg 135]</span>
+
+ <p>The nurse hastened to Penelope's room.</p>
+
+ <p>"Penelope, dear child!" she cried, "Odysseus is come home,
+ and all the wooers lie dead."</p>
+
+ <p>At first Penelope would not believe her. Too good did it
+ seem to be true. Even when she came down and saw Odysseus
+ leaning against a tall pillar in the light of the fire, she
+ would not believe what her own eyes saw.</p>
+
+ <p>"Surely, mother, thy heart is as hard as stone," said
+ Telemachus. "Dost thou not know my father?"</p>
+
+ <p>But Penelope saw only a ragged beggar-man, soiled with the
+ blood of the men he had slain, old and ugly and poor.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Athene shed her grace upon Odysseus, and once more he
+ was tall and strong and gallant to look upon, with golden hair
+ curling like hyacinth flowers around his head. And Penelope ran
+ to him and threw out her arms, and they held each other close
+ and wept together like those who have suffered shipwreck, and
+ have been tossed for long by angry seas, and yet have won
+ safely home at last.</p>
+
+ <p>And when the sun went down that night on the little rocky
+ island of Ithaca in the far seas, the heart of Odysseus was
+ glad, for he knew that his wanderings were ended.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page136"
+ id="page136"></a>[pg 136]</span>
+
+ <h3>ROBINSON CRUSOE</h3>
+
+ <h3>By DANIEL DEFOE</h3>
+
+ <h4>ADAPTED BY JOHN LANG</h4>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW ROBINSON FIRST WENT TO SEA; AND HOW HE WAS
+ SHIPWRECKED</h4>
+
+ <p>Long, long ago, before even your grandfather's father was
+ born, there lived in the town of York a boy whose name was
+ Robinson Crusoe. Though he never even saw the sea till he was
+ quite a big boy, he had always wanted to be a sailor, and to go
+ away in a ship to visit strange, foreign, far-off lands; and he
+ thought that if he could only do that, he would be quite
+ happy.</p>
+
+ <p>But his father wanted him to be a lawyer, and he often
+ talked to Robinson, and told him of the terrible things that
+ might happen to him if he went away, and how people who stopped
+ at home were always the happiest. He told him, too, how
+ Robinson's brother had gone away, and had been killed in the
+ wars.</p>
+
+ <p>So Robinson promised at last that he would give up wanting
+ to be a sailor. But in a few days the longing came back as bad
+ as ever, and he asked his mother to try to coax his father to
+ let him go just one voyage. But his mother was very angry, and
+ his father said, "If he goes abroad he will be the most
+ miserable wretch that ever was born. I can give no consent to
+ it."</p>
+
+ <p>Robinson stopped at home for another year, till he was
+ nineteen years old, all the time thinking and thinking of the
+ sea. But one day when he had gone on a visit to Hull, a big
+ town by the sea, to say good-by to one of his friends who was
+ going to London, he could not resist the chance. Without even
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page137" id="page137"></a>[pg
+ 137]</span> sending a message to his father and mother, he went
+ on board his friend's ship, and sailed away.</p>
+
+ <p>But as soon as the wind began to blow and the waves to rise,
+ poor Robinson was very frightened and seasick, and he said to
+ himself that if ever he got on shore he would go straight home
+ and never again leave it.</p>
+
+ <p>He was very solemn till the wind stopped blowing. His friend
+ and the sailors laughed at him, and called him a fool, and he
+ very soon forgot, when the weather was fine and the sun
+ shining, all he had thought about going back to his father and
+ mother.</p>
+
+ <p>But in a few days, when the ship had sailed as far as
+ Yarmouth Roads on her way to London, they had to anchor, and
+ wait for a fair wind. In those days there were no steamers, and
+ vessels had only their sails to help them along; so if it was
+ calm, or the wind blew the wrong way, they had just to wait
+ where they were till a fair wind blew.</p>
+
+ <p>While they lay at Yarmouth the weather became very bad, and
+ there was a great storm. The sea was so heavy and Robinson's
+ ship was in such danger, that at last they had to cut away the
+ masts in order to ease her and to stop her from rolling so
+ terribly. The Captain fired guns to show that his ship wanted
+ help. So a boat from another ship was lowered, and came with
+ much difficulty and took off Robinson and all the crew, just
+ before their vessel sank; and they got ashore at last, very wet
+ and miserable, having lost all their clothes except what they
+ had on.</p>
+
+ <p>But Robinson had some money in his pocket, and he went on to
+ London by land, thinking that if he returned home now, people
+ would laugh at him.</p>
+
+ <p>In London he made friends with a ship's captain, who had not
+ long before come home from a voyage to the Guinea Coast, as
+ that part of Africa was then called; and the Captain was so
+ pleased with the money he had made there, that he easily
+ persuaded Robinson to go with him on his next voyage.</p>
+
+ <p>So Robinson took with him toys, and beads, and other things,
+ to sell to the natives in Africa, and he got there, in exchange
+ for these things, so much gold-dust that he thought he was soon
+ going in that way to make his
+ fortune.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page138"
+ id="page138"></a>[pg 138]</span>
+
+ <p>And therefore he went on a second voyage.</p>
+
+ <p>But this time he was not so lucky, for before they reached
+ the African coast, one morning, very early, they sighted
+ another ship, which they were sure was a pirate. So fast did
+ this other vessel sail, that before night she had come up to
+ Robinson's ship, which did not carry nearly so many men nor so
+ many guns as the pirate, and which therefore did not want to
+ fight; and the pirates soon took prisoner Robinson and all the
+ crew of his ship who were not killed, and made slaves of
+ them.</p>
+
+ <p>The pirate captain took Robinson as his own slave, and made
+ him dig in his garden and work in his house. Sometimes, too, he
+ made him look after his ship when she was in port, but he never
+ took him away on a voyage.</p>
+
+ <p>For two years Robinson lived like this, very unhappy, and
+ always thinking how he might escape.</p>
+
+ <p>At last, when the Captain happened one time to be at home
+ longer than usual, he began to go out fishing in a boat two or
+ three times a week, taking Robinson, who was a very good
+ fisher, and a black boy named Xury, with him.</p>
+
+ <p>One day he gave Robinson orders to put food and water, and
+ some guns, and powder and shot, on a big boat that the pirates
+ had taken out of an English ship, and to be ready to go with
+ him and some of his friends on a fishing trip.</p>
+
+ <p>But at the last moment the Captain's friends could not come,
+ and so Robinson was told to go out in the boat with one of the
+ Captain's servants who was not a slave, and with Xury, to catch
+ fish for supper.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Robinson thought that his chance to escape had
+ come.</p>
+
+ <p>He spoke to the servant, who was not very clever, and
+ persuaded him to put more food and water on the boat, for, said
+ Robinson, "we must not take what was meant for our master." And
+ then he got the servant to bring some more powder and shot,
+ because, Robinson said, they might as well kill some birds to
+ eat.</p>
+
+ <p>When they had gone out about a mile, they hauled down the
+ sail and began to fish. But Robinson pretended that he could
+ not catch anything there, and he said that they ought to go
+ further out. When they had gone so far that nobody on shore
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page139" id="page139"></a>[pg
+ 139]</span> could see what they were doing, Robinson again
+ pretended to fish. But this time he watched his chance, and
+ when the servant was not looking, came behind him and threw him
+ overboard, knowing that the man could swim so well that he
+ could easily reach the land.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Robinson sailed away with Xury down the coast to the
+ south. He did not know to what country he was steering, but
+ cared only to get away from the pirates, and to be free once
+ more.</p>
+
+ <p>Long days and nights they sailed, sometimes running in close
+ to the land, but they were afraid to go ashore very often,
+ because of the wild beasts and the natives. Many times they saw
+ great lions come roaring down on to the beach, and once
+ Robinson shot one that he saw lying asleep, and took its skin
+ to make a bed for himself on the boat.</p>
+
+ <p>At last, after some weeks, when they had got south as far as
+ the great cape that is called Cape Verde, they saw a Portuguese
+ vessel, which took them on board. It was not easy for Robinson
+ to tell who he was, because he could not talk Portuguese, but
+ everybody was very kind to him, and they bought his boat and
+ his guns and everything that he had. They even bought poor
+ Xury, who, of course, was a black slave, and could be sold just
+ like a horse or a dog.</p>
+
+ <p>So, when they got to Brazil, where the vessel was bound,
+ Robinson had enough money to buy a plantation; and he grew
+ sugar and tobacco there for four years, and was very happy and
+ contented for a time, and made money.</p>
+
+ <p>But he could never be contented for very long. So when some
+ of his neighbors asked him if he would go in a ship to the
+ Guinea Coast to get slaves for them, he went, only making a
+ bargain that he was to be paid for his trouble, and to get some
+ of the slaves to work on his plantation when he came back.</p>
+
+ <p>Twelve days after the ship sailed, a terrible storm blew,
+ and they were driven far from where they wanted to go. Great,
+ angry, foaming seas broke over the deck, sweeping everything
+ off that could be moved, and a man and a boy were carried
+ overboard and drowned. No one on the ship expected to be
+ saved.</p>
+
+ <p>This storm was followed by another, even worse. The wind
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page140" id="page140"></a>[pg
+ 140]</span> howled and roared through the rigging, and the
+ weather was thick with rain and flying spray.</p>
+
+ <p>Then early one morning land was dimly seen through the
+ driving rain, but almost at once the vessel struck on a
+ sand-bank. In an instant the sails were blown to bits, and
+ flapped with such uproar that no one could hear the Captain's
+ orders. Waves poured over the decks, and the vessel bumped on
+ the sand so terribly that the masts broke off near the deck,
+ and fell over the side into the sea.</p>
+
+ <p>With great difficulty the only boat left on the ship was put
+ in the water, and everybody got into her. They rowed for the
+ shore, hoping to get perhaps into some bay, or to the mouth of
+ a river, where the sea would be quiet.</p>
+
+ <p>But before they could reach the land, a huge gray wave, big
+ like the side of a house, came foaming and thundering up behind
+ them, and before any one could even cry out, it upset the boat,
+ and they were all left struggling in the water.</p>
+
+ <p>Robinson was a very good swimmer, but no man could swim in
+ such a sea, and it was only good fortune that brought him at
+ last safely to land. Big wave after big wave washed him further
+ and further up the beach, rolling him over and over, once
+ leaving him helpless, and more than half drowned, beside a
+ rock.</p>
+
+ <p>But before the next wave could come up, perhaps to drag him
+ back with it into the sea, he was able to jump up and run for
+ his life.</p>
+
+ <p>And so he got safely out of the reach of the water, and lay
+ down upon the grass. But of all on board the ship, Robinson was
+ the only one who was not drowned.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/140.jpg" name="fig140s"
+ id="fig140s"><img width="300" src="images/140s.jpg"
+ alt="THE ESCAPE FROM THE SHIPWRECK" /></a><br />
+ the escape from the shipwreck
+ </div>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <h4>ROBINSON WORKS HARD AT MAKING HIMSELF A HOME</h4>
+
+ <p>When he had rested a little, Robinson got up and began to
+ walk about very sadly, for darkness was coming on; he was wet,
+ and cold, and hungry, and he did not know where to sleep,
+ because he was afraid of wild beasts coming out of the woods
+ and killing him during the
+ night.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page141"
+ id="page141"></a>[pg 141]</span>
+
+ <p>But he found that he still had his knife in his pocket, so
+ he cut a big stick to protect himself with. Then he climbed
+ into a tree which had very thick leaves, and there he fixed
+ himself among the branches as well as he could, and fell sound
+ asleep.</p>
+
+ <p>In the morning when he awoke, the storm was past, and the
+ sea quieter. To his surprise, he saw that the ship had been
+ carried in the night, by the great seas, much nearer to the
+ shore than she had been when the boat left her, and was now
+ lying not far from the rock where Robinson had first been
+ washed up.</p>
+
+ <p>By midday the sea was quite calm, and the tide had gone so
+ far out that he could walk very near to the ship. So he took
+ off his clothes and swam the rest of the way to her. But it was
+ not easy to get on board, because the ship was resting on the
+ sand, and lay so high out of the water that Robinson could not
+ reach anything by which he could pull himself up.</p>
+
+ <p>At last, after swimming twice round the vessel, he saw a
+ rope hanging over, near the bow, and by its help he climbed on
+ board.</p>
+
+ <p>Everything in the stern of the ship was dry, and in pretty
+ good order, and the water had not hurt the provisions much. So
+ he took some biscuits, and ate them as he looked about, and
+ drank some rum, and then he felt better, and stronger, and more
+ fit to begin work.</p>
+
+ <p>First of all, he took a few large spars of wood, and a spare
+ topmast or two, that were on the deck. These he pushed
+ overboard, tying each with a rope to keep it from drifting
+ away. Then he went over the side of the ship, and tied all the
+ spars together so as to make a raft, and on top he put pieces
+ of plank across. But it was long before he could make the raft
+ fit to carry the things he wanted to take on shore.</p>
+
+ <p>At last, after much hard work, he got on to it three of the
+ seamen's chests, which he had broken open, and emptied, and he
+ filled these with bread, and rice, and cheese, and whatever he
+ could find to eat, and with all sorts of things that he thought
+ he might need. He found, too, the carpenter's tool-chest, and
+ put it on the raft; and nothing on the whole ship was of more
+ use to him than that.</p>
+
+ <p>Then he set about looking for clothes, for while he had been
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page142" id="page142"></a>[pg
+ 142]</span> on the ship, the tide had risen and had washed away
+ his coat and waistcoat and shirt, which he had left lying on
+ the sand.</p>
+
+ <p>Guns and pistols also, and powder and shot, he took, and two
+ rusty old cutlasses.</p>
+
+ <p>Now the trouble was to reach land, for the raft had no mast
+ nor sail nor rudder, and was too heavy and clumsy to be pulled
+ by Robinson with the broken oars that he had found. But the
+ tide was rising, and slowly she drifted nearer and nearer, and
+ at last was carried up the mouth of a little river which
+ Robinson had not seen when he was on shore.</p>
+
+ <p>There was a strong tide running up, which once carried the
+ raft against a point of land, where she stuck for a time, and
+ very nearly upset all the things into deep water. But as the
+ tide rose higher, Robinson was able to push her into a little
+ bay where the water was shallow and the ground beneath flat,
+ and when the tide went out there she was left high and dry, and
+ he got everything safely ashore.</p>
+
+ <p>The next thing that Robinson did was to climb a hill, that
+ he might see what sort of country he was in, and find out if
+ there were any other people in it. But when he got to the top,
+ he saw to his sorrow that he was on an island, with no other
+ land in sight except some rocks, and two smaller islands far
+ over the sea. There were no signs of any people, and he saw
+ nothing living except great numbers of birds, one of which he
+ shot. But it was not fit to eat, being some kind of hawk.</p>
+
+ <p>After this, with the chests and boards that he had brought
+ on shore, he made a kind of hut to sleep in that night, and he
+ lay there on the sand very comfortably.</p>
+
+ <p>Day by day now for some time Robinson swam out to the ship,
+ and made fresh rafts, loading them with many stores, powder and
+ shot, and lead for bullets, seven muskets, a great barrel of
+ bread, three casks of rum, a quantity of flour, some grain, a
+ box of sugar, sails and ropes and twine, bags of nails, and
+ many hatchets. With one of the sails he made himself a good
+ tent, in which he put everything that could be spoiled by rain
+ or sun. Around it he piled all the casks and other heavy
+ things, so that no wild beast could very easily get at him.</p>
+
+ <p>In about a fortnight the weather changed; it blew very hard
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page143" id="page143"></a>[pg
+ 143]</span> one night, and in the morning the ship had broken
+ up, and was no more to be seen. But that did not so much
+ matter, for Robinson had got out of her nearly everything that
+ he could use.</p>
+
+ <p>Now Robinson thought it time to find some better place for
+ his tent. The land where it then stood was low and near the
+ sea, and the only water he could get to drink tasted rather
+ salt. Looking about, he found a little plain, about a hundred
+ yards across, on the side of a hill, and at the end of the
+ plain was a great rock partly hollowed out, but not so as quite
+ to make a cave. Here he pitched his tent, close to the hollow
+ place in the rock. Round in front of the tent he drove two rows
+ of strong stakes, about eighteen inches apart, sharpened at
+ top; and he made this fence so strong that when it was finished
+ he was sure that nothing could get at him, for he left no door,
+ but climbed in and out by a ladder, which he always hauled up
+ after him.</p>
+
+ <p>Before closing up the end, Robinson hauled inside this fence
+ all his stores, his food and his guns, his powder and shot, and
+ he rigged inside a double tent, so better to keep off the hot
+ sun and the rain.</p>
+
+ <p>Then he began to dig into the rock, which was not very hard,
+ and soon behind his tent he had a cave in which he thought it
+ wise to stow his gunpowder, about one hundred and forty pounds
+ in all, packed in small parcels; for, he thought, if a big
+ thunderstorm were to come, a flash of lightning might explode
+ it all, and blow him to bits, if he kept the whole of it in his
+ tent.</p>
+
+ <p>Robinson was now very comfortable, and as he had saved from
+ the wreck two cats and a dog, he did not feel quite so lonely.
+ He had got, also, ink and pens and paper, so that he could keep
+ a diary; and he set up a large wooden cross, on which he cut
+ with his knife the date of his landing on the island&mdash;
+ September 30, 1659; and every day he cut a notch on the post,
+ with a longer one each Sunday, so that he might always know how
+ the months and years passed.</p>
+
+ <p>As for food, he found that there were many goats on the
+ island, and numbers of pigeons, and he had no difficulty in
+ shooting as many as he needed.</p>
+
+ <p>But now he saw that his tent and cave were too small for all
+ the things he had stowed in them, so he began to make the cave
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page144" id="page144"></a>[pg
+ 144]</span> bigger, bringing out all the rock and soil that he
+ cut down, and making with it a kind of terrace round the inside
+ of his stockade. And as he was sure that there were no wild
+ beasts on the island to harm him, he went on tunneling to the
+ right hand till he broke through the rock outside his
+ fence.</p>
+
+ <p>Then he began to hang things up against the side of the
+ cave, and he even made shelves, and a door for the outside
+ entrance. This was a very difficult job, and took him a long
+ time; for, to make a board, he was forced to cut down a whole
+ tree, and chop away with his axe till one side was flat, and
+ then cut at the other side till the board was thin enough, when
+ he smoothed it with his adze. But in this way, out of each tree
+ he would only get one plank. He made for himself also a table
+ and a chair, and finally got his castle, as he called it, in
+ very good order.</p>
+
+ <p>With all his care, however, there was one thing that he
+ forgot, and that was, when he had made the cave so much bigger,
+ to prop it, so as to keep the roof from falling in. And so one
+ day he got a terrible fright, and was nearly killed, by a huge
+ bit of the soft rock which fell and buried many of his things.
+ It took weeks of hard work afterwards to clear away the fallen
+ rubbish, and to cut beams strong enough to prop the roof.</p>
+
+ <p>Every day, all this time, he used to climb up the hill and
+ look around over the lonely waters, hoping, always hoping, that
+ some morning he might see the sails of a ship that would take
+ him home. But none ever came, and sometimes the tears ran down
+ his cheeks because of the sorrow he felt at being so utterly
+ alone. At times even, he thought in his misery that if he only
+ had any kind of a boat, it would be better to sail away, and
+ chance reaching other land, rather than to stop where he was.
+ By and by, however, he grew less unhappy, for he had plenty of
+ work to do.</p>
+
+ <h4>III</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE EARTHQUAKE AND HURRICANE; AND HOW ROBINSON BUILT A
+ BOAT</h4>
+
+ <p>Now about this time, when Robinson had been some months on
+ the island, heavy and constant rain began to fall, and
+ sometimes <span class="pagenum"><a name="page145"
+ id="page145"></a>[pg 145]</span> weeks would pass without a
+ single dry day. He found that instead of there being spring,
+ summer, autumn, and winter, as in England, the seasons in his
+ island were divided into the wet and the dry. There was no cold
+ weather, no winter. It chanced that just before this first rain
+ began, Robinson had emptied out some refuse from bags which had
+ once held rice, and other grain, and he had forgotten all about
+ having emptied them. So he was very much astonished to find,
+ some time afterwards, both barley and rice growing near his
+ tent, in the shade of the rock. The ears, when ripe, he kept to
+ sow again, and from this very small beginning, in the course of
+ a few seasons, he had a great quantity of grain, both for food
+ and for sowing. But this meant every year much hard work, for
+ he had no plow nor harrow, and all the ground had to be dug
+ with a clumsy spade, made from a very hard, heavy wood that
+ grew on the island.</p>
+
+ <p>At first Robinson could not grind the grain that he grew,
+ nor make bread from it. If he could have found a large stone,
+ slightly hollow on top, he might, by pounding the grain on it
+ with another round stone, have made very good meal. But all the
+ stones he could find were too soft, and in the end he had to
+ make a sort of mill of hard wood, in which he burnt a hollow
+ place, and on that he pounded the grain into meal with a heavy
+ stick.</p>
+
+ <p>Baking he did by building a big fire, then raking away the
+ ashes, and putting the dough on the hot place, covered with a
+ kind of basin made of clay, over which he heaped the red ashes.
+ In this way very good bread can be made.</p>
+
+ <p>Before the rainy season was over, and just after he had
+ finished the fence round his tent, one day when Robinson was at
+ work in the cave, all of a sudden the earth began to fall from
+ the roof, and the strong props he had put in cracked in a way
+ which frightened him terribly. At the same time there was a
+ curious moaning, rumbling noise, that he could not understand.
+ He rushed out, and so afraid was he that the roof was falling
+ in, and that he should be buried, that he got over the fence
+ and began to run.</p>
+
+ <p>But he was even more frightened when he found that all the
+ ground was shaking. Then he knew that this was an
+ earthquake.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page146"
+ id="page146"></a>[pg 146]</span>
+
+ <p>Three times there came violent shocks; a huge rock about
+ half a mile away fell with a great noise like thunder, and the
+ sea was churned up as if by a whirlwind. Robinson was sick with
+ the movement of the ground, and trembling with the dread of
+ being swallowed by the earth as it cracked and gaped; and after
+ the noise and shaking were over, he was too frightened to go
+ back to his tent, but sat where he was, all the time expecting
+ another shock.</p>
+
+ <p>Suddenly a furious wind began to blow, tearing up trees by
+ the roots, and lashing the water till nothing could be seen but
+ foam and flying spray. The air was full of branches and leaves
+ torn off by the hurricane, and birds in hundreds were swept
+ helpless out to sea. In about three hours, as suddenly as it
+ had begun, the wind fell, and there was a dead calm, followed
+ by rain such as Robinson had never before seen, which soaked
+ him to the skin, and forced him to return to the cave, where he
+ sat in great fear.</p>
+
+ <p>For long after this he was very uneasy, and made up his mind
+ to shift his quarters as soon as he could find a better place
+ for his tent. But the earthquake had one good result, for what
+ remained of the wreck was again thrown up by the sea, and
+ Robinson got more things out of it which were useful to him,
+ and for days he worked hard at that. One day, too, when he was
+ on his way to the remains of the ship, he came on a large
+ turtle, which he killed, and this gave him plenty of good food,
+ for besides the flesh, there were, inside the animal, many
+ eggs, which she had come to the shore to lay in the sand, as is
+ the habit of turtles, and which Robinson thought were even
+ better than hen's eggs.</p>
+
+ <p>Now a few days after he had got so wet in the heavy rain,
+ though the weather was hot, Robinson felt very cold and
+ shivery, and had pains all over his body, and at night he
+ dreamed terrible dreams. The following day, and many days, he
+ lay very ill with fever and ague, and hardly knew what he was
+ doing. So weak was he, that he believed he was dying, and there
+ was no one to give him water to quench his thirst, nor to help
+ him in any way. His only medicine was rum, in which he had
+ soaked tobacco. It was very nasty, and made him sick, but it
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page147" id="page147"></a>[pg
+ 147]</span> also made him sleep for more than a whole day and a
+ night, and he woke much better, and able to walk about a
+ little, though for a fortnight he was too weak to work. From
+ this illness he learned not to go out more than he could help
+ during the rainy season.</p>
+
+ <p>When he was again quite strong, Robinson started to explore
+ the island better than he had yet done, and he found many
+ things growing, of which he made great use afterwards, tobacco,
+ sugar-cane, and all manner of fruits, among them grapes, which
+ he used to dry to raisins in the sun in great quantities.</p>
+
+ <p>Near the spot where the most fruit grew, he built a hut, and
+ round it, for safety, he put a double fence made of stakes cut
+ from some of the trees near at hand. During the next rainy
+ season these stakes took root, and grew so fast that soon
+ nothing of the hut could be seen from outside the hedge, and it
+ made so good a hiding-place, that Robinson cut more stakes of
+ the same kind, and planted them outside the fence around his
+ first dwelling; and in a year or two that also was quite hidden
+ from view. The twigs of this tree, too, were good for making
+ baskets, of which he had been in great need.</p>
+
+ <p>When he had finished all this work, he started again to go
+ over the rest of the island, and on his way across, from a
+ hill, the day being very clear, he saw high land a great way
+ off over the water, but whether it was another island, or the
+ coast of America, he could not be sure.</p>
+
+ <p>When he reached the other side of his island Robinson found
+ the beach covered with turtles in astonishing numbers, and he
+ thought how much better off he would have been if he had been
+ cast ashore here, for not only would the turtles have supplied
+ him with plenty of food, but there were far more birds than on
+ the part of the island where he had been living, and far more
+ goats.</p>
+
+ <p>During the journey back to his castle he caught a young
+ parrot, which, after a long time, he taught to speak and to
+ call him by his name. It was so long since he had heard any
+ voice, that it was a comfort to listen even to a parrot
+ talking.</p>
+
+ <p>Now, the sight which Robinson had had of the far distant
+ land raised in him again the great longing to get away from
+ this <span class="pagenum"><a name="page148"
+ id="page148"></a>[pg 148]</span> island where he had been so
+ long alone, and he wished greatly for a boat. He went over to
+ the remains of the boat in which he and the others had tried to
+ come ashore when their ship struck on the sand-bank, and which
+ had been flung far up on the beach by the sea, and he worked
+ for weeks trying to repair her and to get her into the water.
+ But it was all of no use; he could not move her.</p>
+
+ <p>Then, he thought, "I'll cut down a tree, and make a new
+ boat." This he fancied would be easy, for he had heard how the
+ Indians make canoes by felling a tree and burning out the
+ inside. "If they can do it, then surely I can do it even
+ better," he thought. So he looked about, and chose a huge tree
+ which stood about a hundred yards from the water, and with
+ great labor in about three weeks he had cut it down.</p>
+
+ <p>Four months Robinson worked at this boat, thinking all the
+ time of what he would do when he reached the far distant land,
+ and much pleased with himself for the beautiful boat he was
+ making. Day after day he trimmed and shaped it, and very proud
+ he was when it was finished and lay there on the ground, big
+ enough to carry twenty men.</p>
+
+ <p>Then he started to get her into the water. But that was
+ quite another thing. By no means in his power could he move her
+ an inch, try as he might. She was far too big. Then he began to
+ dig a canal from the sea to the boat; but before he had got
+ much of that work done, he saw clearly that there was so much
+ earth to dig away, that, without some one to help him, it must
+ take years and years before he could get the water to the boat.
+ So he gave it up, and left her to lie and rot in the sun and
+ the rain&mdash;a great grief to him.</p>
+
+ <h4>IV</h4>
+
+ <h4>ROBINSON BUILDS A SECOND BOAT, IN WHICH HE IS SWEPT OUT TO
+ SEA</h4>
+
+ <p>By the time that Robinson had been four years on the island,
+ all his clothes had become very ragged, and he had hardly
+ anything that could be called a hat. Clothes he must have,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page149" id="page149"></a>[pg
+ 149]</span> for he could not go naked without getting his skin
+ blistered by the hot sun, and he was afraid of getting a
+ sunstroke if he went about without a hat.</p>
+
+ <p>Now he had kept all the skins of the goats, and other
+ animals, such as hares and foxes, that he had shot; and from
+ these, after many failures, at last he made a hat and coat of
+ goatskin, and a pair of short trousers, all with the hair
+ outside, so as to shoot off the wet when it rained. The hat was
+ very tall, and came to a sharp peak on top, and it had a flap
+ which hung down the back of his neck. Robinson also, with much
+ trouble, made of the skins an umbrella which he could open and
+ shut; and if his clothes and his umbrella, and especially his
+ hat, were not very good to look at, they were useful, and he
+ could now go about in any weather.</p>
+
+ <p>During the next five years nothing out of the common
+ happened, and Robinson's time was mostly taken up with the
+ getting of food, the yearly sowing and reaping of his crops,
+ and the curing of his raisins. But towards the end of that time
+ he made another attempt to build a boat, and this time he made
+ one much smaller than the first, and though it took him nearly
+ two years to finish, in the end he got her into the sea. She
+ was not big enough for him to try to sail in to the far-off
+ land that he had seen, and he used her only for cruising about
+ the shores of his own island, and for fishing. In her he fixed
+ a little mast, on which he rigged a small sail, made from a bit
+ of one of the old ship's sails, and, using a paddle to steer
+ with, he found that she sailed very well. Over the stern he
+ fixed his big umbrella, to shade him from the sun, like an
+ awning.</p>
+
+ <p>Eager to go all round the island, one day Robinson put a lot
+ of food on board, and, taking his gun, started on a voyage. All
+ went well till he came to the east end of the island, where he
+ found that a ledge of rocks, and beyond that a sand-bank,
+ stretched out to sea for eight or nine miles. Robinson did not
+ like the idea of venturing so far in a boat so small, and he
+ therefore ran the boat ashore, and climbed a hill, to get a
+ good view of the rocks and shoals before going near them. From
+ the hill, he saw that a strong current was sweeping past the
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page150" id="page150"></a>[pg
+ 150]</span> sand-bank, which showed just clear of the water,
+ and on which the sea was breaking; but he thought there was an
+ eddy which would swing him safely round the point, without
+ bringing him near the breakers. However, that day and the next,
+ there was a good deal of wind blowing in the direction contrary
+ to the current, which, of course, raised a sea too big for a
+ small boat, so Robinson stopped on shore where he was.</p>
+
+ <p>On the third day it was calm, and he set off. But no sooner
+ had he come abreast of the sand-bank than he found himself in
+ very deep water, with a current running like a mill-race, which
+ carried the boat further and further away from the land, in
+ spite of all that he could do with his paddle. There was no
+ wind, and the sail was useless.</p>
+
+ <p>Now he gave himself up for lost, for the harder he worked,
+ only the further away seemed the boat to be swept. The island
+ was soon so far off that Robinson could hardly see it, and he
+ was quite exhausted with the hard struggle to paddle the boat
+ against the current. He was in despair, and giving up paddling,
+ left the boat to drift where she would. Just then a faint puff
+ of wind touched his cheek, and Robinson hurriedly hoisted his
+ sail. Soon a good breeze blew, which carried him past a
+ dangerous reef of rocks. Here the current seemed to divide, the
+ part in which he now was began to swing round towards the
+ island, and he plucked up heart again, and with his paddle did
+ all he could to help the sail. Robinson felt like a man who is
+ set free after he has been told that he must die; he could
+ almost have wept for joy. Miles and miles he sailed, steadily
+ getting nearer to the land, and late in the evening at last he
+ got ashore, but on the other side of the point that he had
+ tried to round in the morning. He drew up his boat on the shore
+ of a little cove that he found, and when he had made her fast,
+ so that the tide could not carry her away, there among the
+ trees he lay down, and slept sound, quite worn out.</p>
+
+ <p>In the morning he again got on board, and coasted along
+ close inshore, till he came to a bay with a little river
+ running into it, which made a very good harbor for the boat.
+ Here he left her, and went on
+ foot.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page151"
+ id="page151"></a>[pg 151]</span>
+
+ <p>Soon he found that he was not far from a spot that he had
+ once before visited, and by afternoon he arrived at the hut
+ which he called his country-house. Robinson got over the fence
+ by the ladder, as usual, pulling it up after him, and then he
+ lay down to rest in the shade, for he was still very weary from
+ the hard work of the day before. Soon he fell asleep. But what
+ was his surprise in a little time to be awakened by a voice
+ calling, "Robin! Robin Crusoe! where are you?"</p>
+
+ <p>At first he thought he was dreaming. But still the voice
+ went on calling:</p>
+
+ <p>"Where are you, Robin?"</p>
+
+ <p>Up he jumped, trembling with fright and wonder, for it was
+ so long since he had heard any voice but his own that he
+ fancied it must be something more than human that he now
+ listened to. But no sooner had he risen than he saw, sitting on
+ the tree near to him, his parrot, which must have flown all the
+ way from Robinson's other house, where it had been left. It was
+ talking away at a great rate, very excited at again seeing its
+ master, and Robinson hardly knew whether to be more relieved or
+ disappointed that it was only the bird that had called him.</p>
+
+ <p>For about a year after this Robinson kept to his own side of
+ the island, and employed his time chiefly in working on his
+ land, and in making dishes and pots of clay. These he had now
+ learned to burn properly. Pipes, too, he made, and they were a
+ great comfort to him, for he managed to cure very good tobacco
+ from the wild plants that grew around. And as he feared lest
+ his powder might begin to run short, he thought much over ways
+ whereby he could trap goats for food, instead of shooting them.
+ After many trials, the best plan, he decided, was to dig holes,
+ which he covered with thin branches and leaves, on which he
+ sprinkled earth, so that when anything heavy passed over, it
+ must fall into the pit. By this means he caught many, and the
+ kids he kept and tamed, so that in no great time he had quite a
+ large herd of goats. These he kept in various small fields,
+ round which from time to time he had put
+ fences.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page152"
+ id="page152"></a>[pg 152]</span>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/152.jpg" name="fig152s"
+ id="fig152s"><img width="300" src="images/152s.jpg"
+ alt="HE SAW THE MARK OF A NAKED FOOT ON THE SAND" />
+ </a><br />
+ he saw the mark of a naked foot on the sand
+ </div>
+
+ <h4>V</h4>
+
+ <h4>ROBINSON SEES A FOOTPRINT ON THE SAND, FINDS A CAVE, AND
+ RESCUES FRIDAY</h4>
+
+ <p>All this time Robinson had never gone near his canoe, but
+ now the longing came on him to go over to where he had left
+ her, though he felt that he should be afraid again to put to
+ sea in her. This time, however, when he got to the hill from
+ which he had watched the set of the current the day that he had
+ been carried out to sea, he noticed that there was no current
+ to be seen, from which he concluded that it must depend on the
+ ebb and flow of the tide. Still, he was afraid to venture far
+ in the canoe, though he stopped some time at his country-house,
+ and went out sailing very often.</p>
+
+ <p>One day when Robinson was walking along the sand towards his
+ boat, suddenly, close to the water, he stopped as if he had
+ been shot, and, with thumping heart, stood staring in wonder
+ and fear at something that he saw. The mark of a naked foot on
+ the sand! It could not be his own, he knew, for the shape was
+ quite different. Whose could it be?</p>
+
+ <p>He listened, he looked about, but nothing could he hear or
+ see. To the top of a rising ground he ran, and looked all
+ around. There was nothing to be seen. And though he searched
+ everywhere on the beach for more footmarks, he found none.</p>
+
+ <p>Whose footprint could it be? That of some man, perhaps, he
+ thought, who might come stealing on him out from the trees, or
+ murder him while he slept.</p>
+
+ <p>Back to his house he hurried, all the way in a state of
+ terror, starting every now and again and facing round, thinking
+ he was being followed, and fancying often that a stump or a
+ bush was a man, waiting to spring on him. That night he slept
+ not at all, and so shaken was his nerve that every cry of a
+ night-bird, even every sound made by an insect or a frog,
+ caused him to start with fear, so that the perspiration ran
+ down his brow.</p>
+
+ <p>As day followed day, however, and nothing happened, Robinson
+ began to be less uneasy in his mind, and went about
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page153" id="page153"></a>[pg
+ 153]</span> his usual work again. But he strengthened the fence
+ round his castle, and cut in it seven small loopholes, in
+ which, fixed on frames, he placed loaded muskets, all ready to
+ fire if he should be attacked. And some distance from the
+ outside of the fence he planted a thick belt of small stakes,
+ so that in a few years' time a perfect thicket of trees and
+ bushes hid all trace of his dwelling.</p>
+
+ <p>Years passed quietly, and nothing further happened to
+ disturb Robinson, or to make him think more of the footprint
+ that had frightened him so much. But he kept more than formerly
+ to the interior of the island, and lost no chance of looking
+ for good places to hide in, if he should ever need them. And he
+ always carried a cutlass now, as well as his gun and a couple
+ of pistols.</p>
+
+ <p>One day it chanced, however, that he had gone further to the
+ west of the island than he had ever done before, and, looking
+ over the sea, he fancied that he saw, at a great distance,
+ something like a boat or a long canoe, but it was so far off
+ that he he could not be sure what it was. This made him
+ determine that always in future he would bring with him to his
+ lookout-place the telescope which he had saved from the
+ wreck.</p>
+
+ <p>The sight of this supposed boat brought back his uneasiness
+ to some extent, but he went on down to the beach, and there he
+ saw a sight which filled him with horror. All about the shore
+ were scattered men's skulls and bones, and bits of burnt flesh,
+ and in one place were the remains of a big fire. Robinson stood
+ aghast, feeling deadly sick. It was easy for him to know the
+ meaning of the terrible sight. It meant that cannibals had been
+ there, killing and eating their prisoners; for when the natives
+ of some parts of the world go to war, and catch any of their
+ enemies, it is their habit to build a fire, then to kill the
+ prisoners and feast on their roasted bodies, eating till they
+ can eat no more. Sometimes, if the man they are going to eat is
+ too thin, they keep him, and feed him up, till they think he is
+ fat enough.</p>
+
+ <p>Now Robinson knew all this, though he had never yet met any
+ cannibals. And when he looked around he saw many bones lying
+ about. They were so old that it seemed certain
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page154" id="page154"></a>[pg
+ 154]</span> to him that all those years he had been living on
+ an island which was a regular place for the natives to come to
+ for such feasts. Then he saw what a mercy it was that he had
+ been wrecked on the other side of the island, to which, he
+ supposed, the cannibals never came, because the beach was not
+ so good for them to land on.</p>
+
+ <p>Full of horror, Robinson hurried back to his house, and for
+ almost two years he never again came near that part of the
+ island where the bones lay, nor ever visited his boat. But all
+ the time he kept thinking how he might some day kill those
+ cannibals while they were at their feast, and perhaps save some
+ of the poor men whom they had not yet killed.</p>
+
+ <p>Now one day when Robinson was down in the bottom of the
+ valley, cutting thick branches to burn for charcoal, he cleared
+ away some undergrowth at the foot of a great rock, in which,
+ near the ground, there was a sort of hole, or opening. Into
+ this hole Robinson squeezed, not very easily, and found himself
+ in a cave of good size, high enough, at least, to stand up in.
+ It was quite dark, of course, to him coming in from the
+ sunlight, and he turned his back to the entrance to feel his
+ way further in, when suddenly, from the back of the cave he saw
+ two great fiery eyes glaring at him. His very hair bristled
+ with fright, for he could only think that it must be the Devil
+ at least that he saw; and through the mouth of the cave he fled
+ with a yell.</p>
+
+ <p>But when he got into the bright sunshine he began to feel
+ ashamed of his panic, and to reason with himself that what he
+ had seen must be only his own fancy. So, taking up a big
+ burning branch from his fire, in he went again.</p>
+
+ <p>Before Robinson had taken three steps he stopped, in almost
+ as great a fright as at first. Close to him he heard a great
+ sigh, as if of some one in pain, then a sound like a muttering,
+ as of words that he could not understand; again another deep
+ sigh. Cold sweat broke out all over him, and he stepped back
+ trembling, yet determined this time not to run away.</p>
+
+ <p>Holding his torch well over his head, he looked around, and
+ there on the floor of the cave lay a huge old he goat, gasping
+ for breath, dying, seemingly of mere old age.</p>
+
+ <p>He stirred him with his toe to see if he could get him out
+ of <span class="pagenum"><a name="page155" id="page155"></a>[pg
+ 155]</span> the cave, but the poor beast could not rise, and
+ Robinson left him to die where he was.</p>
+
+ <p>Now that he had got over his fright, Robinson looked
+ carefully about him. The cave was small, not more than twelve
+ feet across at its widest, but he noticed at the far end
+ another opening. This was so low down, however, that he had to
+ creep on his hands and knees to get in, and without a better
+ light than the burning torch, he could not see how far it went.
+ So he made up his mind to come again.</p>
+
+ <p>Robinson had long before this made a good supply of very
+ fair candles from the tallow of the goats he had killed, and
+ next day he returned to the cave with six of these, and his
+ tinder-box to light them with. In those days there were no
+ matches, and men used to strike a light with a flint and steel,
+ and tinder, which was a stuff that caught fire very easily from
+ a spark.</p>
+
+ <p>Entering the cave, Robinson found, on lighting a candle,
+ that the goat was now dead. Moving it aside, to be buried
+ later, he went down on his hands and knees, and crawled about
+ ten yards through the small passage, till at last he found
+ himself in a great chamber, the roof of which was quite twenty
+ feet high. On every side the walls reflected the light of his
+ candle, and glittered like gold, or almost like diamonds, he
+ thought. The floor was perfectly dry and level, even on the
+ walls there was no damp, and Robinson was delighted with his
+ discovery. Its only drawback was the low entrance; but, as he
+ decided to use the cave chiefly as a place to retreat to if he
+ should ever be attacked, that was in reality an advantage,
+ because one man, if he had firearms could easily defend it
+ against hundreds.</p>
+
+ <p>At once Robinson set about storing in it all his powder,
+ except three or four pounds, all his lead for making bullets,
+ and his spare guns and muskets. When moving the powder, he
+ thought he might as well open a barrel which had drifted ashore
+ out of the wreck 'after the earthquake, and though water had
+ got into it, there was not a great deal of damage done, for the
+ powder had crusted on the outside only, and in the inside there
+ was about sixty pounds weight, quite dry and good. This, with
+ what remained of the first lot, gave him a very large supply,
+ enough to last all his
+ life.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page156"
+ id="page156"></a>[pg 156]</span>
+
+ <p>For more than two-and-twenty years Robinson had now been in
+ the island, and he had grown quite used to it, and to his
+ manner of living. If he could only have been sure that no
+ savages would come near him, he felt almost that he would be
+ content to spend all the rest of his days there, to die at
+ last, as the goat he found in the cave had died, of old
+ age.</p>
+
+ <p>At times, when his spirits were more than usually low, when
+ the burden of the lonely years pressed most heavily upon him,
+ Robinson used to think that surely if the savages could come to
+ his land, he could go to theirs. How far did they come? Where
+ was their country? What kind of boats had they? And so eager to
+ go was he sometimes, that he forgot to think of what he would
+ do when he got there, or what would become of him if he fell
+ into the hands of the savages. His mind was utterly taken up
+ with the one thought of getting to the mainland, and even his
+ dreams were of little else.</p>
+
+ <p>One night, when he had put himself almost into a fever with
+ the trouble of his mind, he had lain long awake, tossing and
+ moaning, but at last he had fallen asleep. And he dreamed, not
+ as he had usually done of late, that he was sailing to the
+ mainland, but that as he was leaving his castle in the morning
+ he saw on the shore two canoes and eleven savages landing, and
+ that they had with them another man, whom they were just about
+ to kill and eat, when suddenly the prisoner jumped up and ran
+ for his life. And in his dream Robinson fancied that the man
+ came running to hide in the thicket round the castle, and that
+ thereupon he went out to help him. Then in the dream, the
+ savage kneeled down, as if begging for mercy, and Robinson took
+ him over the ladder into the castle, saying to himself, "Now
+ that I've got this fellow, I can certainly go to the mainland,
+ for he will show me what course to steer, and where to go when
+ we land." And he woke, with the joyful feeling that now at last
+ all was well. But when he was wide awake, and knew that it was
+ only a dream after all, poor Robinson was more cast down than
+ ever, and more unhappy than he had been during all the years he
+ had lived on the island.</p>
+
+ <p>The dream had, however, this result; that he saw his only
+ plan to get away was, if possible, to rescue some day one of
+ the <span class="pagenum"><a name="page157"
+ id="page157"></a>[pg 157]</span> prisoners whom the cannibals
+ were about to kill, and in time get the man to help him to
+ navigate his canoe across the sea.</p>
+
+ <p>With this idea, he set himself to watch, more closely than
+ ever he had done before, for the savages to land, and during
+ more than a year and a half he went nearly every day to his
+ lookout-place, and swept the sea with his telescope, in the
+ hope of seeing canoes coming. But none came, and Robinson was
+ getting terribly tired of the constant watch. Still he did not
+ give up, for he knew that sooner or later the savages would
+ land again.</p>
+
+ <p>Yet many months passed, and still they did not come, till
+ one morning, very early, almost to his surprise, he saw no
+ fewer than five canoes hauled up on the shore on his own side
+ of the island. The savages who had come in them were nowhere to
+ be seen. Now, he knew that always from four to six men came in
+ each canoe, which meant that at least twenty, and perhaps as
+ many as thirty men had landed.</p>
+
+ <p>This was a greater number than he cared to face, so he kept
+ inside his castle, in great doubt what to do, but ready to
+ fight, in case they should attack him.</p>
+
+ <p>When he had waited a long time and still could hear nothing
+ of the savages, he climbed up his ladder and got to the top of
+ the rock, taking great care not to show himself against the
+ skyline. Looking through his glass, he saw that there were at
+ least thirty savages, dancing wildly round a fire.</p>
+
+ <p>As he looked, some of the men left the others, and going
+ over to the canoes dragged from' them two prisoners. One of
+ these almost at once fell forward on his face, knocked down
+ from behind, as it seemed to Robinson, with a wooden club, and
+ two or three of the cannibals at once cut him open to be ready
+ for cooking, while for a moment or two they left the other
+ prisoner standing by himself.</p>
+
+ <p>Seeing a chance of escape, the man made a dash for his life,
+ running with tremendous speed along the sands straight for that
+ part of the beach near Robinson's castle.</p>
+
+ <p>Now this alarmed Robinson very much, for it seemed to him
+ that the whole of the savages started after the prisoner. He
+ could not help thinking it likely that, as in his dream, this
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page158" id="page158"></a>[pg
+ 158]</span> man would take shelter in the thicket round the
+ castle, in which case Robinson was likely soon to have more
+ fighting than he would relish, for the whole body of the
+ cannibals would be on him at once.</p>
+
+ <p>As he watched the poor man racing for life, however, he was
+ relieved to see that he ran much faster than his pursuers, of
+ whom only three continued to run after him. If he could hold
+ out for another mile or two there was little doubt that he
+ would escape. Between the castle and the runners was the creek
+ up which Robinson used to run his rafts from the wreck, and
+ when the escaped prisoner came to that, he plunged in, and
+ though the tide was full, with less than thirty powerful
+ strokes he reached the other side, and with long easy strides
+ continued his run. Of the men in pursuit, two also plunged in
+ and swam through, but less quickly than the man escaping, being
+ more blown with running, because of what they had eaten before
+ starting. The third man stopped altogether, and went back the
+ way he came.</p>
+
+ <p>Seeing the turn things were taking, it seemed to Robinson
+ that now had come his chance to get a servant, and he resolved
+ to try to save the life of the man who was fleeing from the
+ cannibals. At once he hurried down the ladder, snatched up his
+ two guns, and running as fast as he could, got between the man
+ and his pursuers, calling out to him at the same time to stop.
+ The man looked back, and the sight of Robinson seemed to
+ frighten him at first as much as did the men who were trying to
+ catch him. But Robinson again spoke, and signed to him with his
+ hand to come back, and in the meantime went slowly towards the
+ other men, who were now coming near. Then, rushing at the
+ foremost, he knocked him senseless with the butt of his gun,
+ for it seemed to him safer not to fire, lest the noise should
+ bring the other cannibals around.</p>
+
+ <p>The second man, seeing his comrade fall, hesitated, and
+ stopped, but Robinson saw when nearer to him that the savage
+ had in his hands a bow and arrow with which he was just about
+ to shoot. There was then no choice but to fire first, which
+ Robinson did, killing the man on the spot.</p>
+
+ <p>Thereupon the man who had been chased by the others was
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page159" id="page159"></a>[pg
+ 159]</span> so terrified by the flash and noise of the gun, and
+ at seeing his enemy fall dead, that he stood stock still,
+ trembling, and it was with great difficulty that Robinson
+ coaxed him to come near. This at last he did, stopping every
+ few paces and kneeling down. At length, coming close to
+ Robinson, he again knelt, kissed the ground, and taking hold of
+ Robinson's foot, set it on his head as it rested on the
+ sand.</p>
+
+ <p>While this was going on, Robinson noticed that the savage
+ whom he had knocked down had begun to move, and to come to his
+ senses. To this he drew the attention of the man whom he had
+ rescued, who said some words that Robinson could not
+ understand, but which sounded pleasant to an ear that had heard
+ no voice but his own for more than twenty-five years. Next he
+ made a motion with his hand, as if asking for the cutlass that
+ hung at Robinson's belt, and when the weapon was given to him
+ he ran at his enemy, and with one clean blow cut off his head.
+ Then, laughing, he brought the head, and laid it with the
+ cutlass at Robinson's feet.</p>
+
+ <p>But what caused most wonder to the man was how the savage
+ whom Robinson shot had been killed at so great a distance, and
+ he went to look as the body, turning it over and over, and
+ looking long at the wound in the breast that the bullet had
+ made, evidently much puzzled.</p>
+
+ <p>Robinson then turned to go away, beckoning to the savage to
+ follow, but the man made signs that he would bury the two
+ bodies in the sand, so that the others might not find them if
+ they followed. With his hands he soon scraped holes deep enough
+ to cover the bodies, and in less than a quarter of an hour
+ there was hardly a trace left of what had happened.</p>
+
+ <p>Calling him away, Robinson now took him, not to his castle,
+ but to the cave, where he gave him food and water; and then he
+ made signs for him to lie down and rest, pointing to a bundle
+ of rice straw.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon the man was sound asleep. He was, Robinson thought, a
+ handsome and well-made man; the muscles of his arms and back
+ and legs showed great strength, and all his limbs were
+ beautifully formed. As near as Robinson could guess, he was
+ about twenty-six years of age, with a good and manly face,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page160" id="page160"></a>[pg
+ 160]</span> and long black hair. His nose and lips were like
+ those of a European, and his teeth were white and even. In
+ color he was not black, but of a sort of rich chocolate brown,
+ the skin shining with health, and pleasant to look upon.</p>
+
+ <h4>VI</h4>
+
+ <h4>ROBINSON TRAINS FRIDAY, AND THEY BUILD A LARGE BOAT; THEY
+ RESCUE TWO PRISONERS FROM THE CANNIBALS</h4>
+
+ <p>In a little while Robinson began to speak to him, and to try
+ to teach him things. First he made him understand that his name
+ was to be "Friday" (that being the day of the week when
+ Robinson had saved him from a horrible death). Then he taught
+ him the meaning of "Yes," and "No," and to call Robinson
+ "Master."</p>
+
+ <p>Friday showed great quickness in learning. He seemed to be
+ happy and contented, and free from trouble, except that the
+ clothes which Robinson made him wear gave him at first great
+ discomfort, for in those warm parts of the world the natives
+ are not used to clothes, but always go about naked.</p>
+
+ <p>The day following that on which Robinson had saved Friday,
+ they went out together to see if there were any signs of the
+ cannibals still being on the island, but it was evident that
+ they had gone away without troubling about the two men whom
+ Robinson had killed.</p>
+
+ <p>For some time Robinson did not trust Friday, and did not
+ allow him to sleep in the same part of his castle with himself,
+ but kept him at night in a little tent outside the fence.</p>
+
+ <p>Friday was quite faithful, never sulky nor lazy, but always
+ merry, and ready to do anything that Robinson told him.</p>
+
+ <p>At first when they went out in the woods together, Friday
+ was terrified each time that Robinson's gun was fired. He had
+ never seen anything like it, and it was more than he could
+ understand how things could be killed merely by the noise and
+ the flash of fire.</p>
+
+ <p>Friday told Robinson much about his country, and about his
+ people, who he said were Caribs. And a great way
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page161" id="page161"></a>[pg
+ 161]</span> "beyond the moon," by which he meant to the west,
+ he said that white men lived who had beards such as Robinson
+ wore. These white men, he said, had killed very many natives,
+ from which Robinson fancied that they must be Spaniards, who
+ about that time were very cruel to the people whose countries
+ they had taken.</p>
+
+ <p>Robinson asked if Friday could tell him how he might get
+ over to where the white men lived, and Friday said it would be
+ very easy, if they had a big canoe, and again Robinson began to
+ make plans and to hope to escape from the island.</p>
+
+ <p>Some time after this Robinson and Friday chanced to be on
+ the high hill at the east end of the island. The day was very
+ clear. Friday gazed long over the sea, and then began to jump
+ and dance, pointing to the dim blue coast. "There my country!
+ See! There my people live!" he said, his eyes sparkling with
+ joy, and an eager light on his face.</p>
+
+ <p>After this, for a time Robinson was not easy in his mind
+ about Friday. He had little doubt that if he could get back to
+ his tribe, he would soon forget all he had been taught, might
+ even return with a hundred or two of his friends, and kill and
+ eat his master. But in this Robinson was very unjust to Friday,
+ who had no such thoughts in his mind as those of which he was
+ suspected. And this Robinson soon found out. One day he asked
+ Friday if he would not be glad to be once more in his own
+ land.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes" said Friday; "very glad."</p>
+
+ <p>"Would you eat man's flesh again?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, never," said Friday.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Robinson asked why he did not go back. Friday said he
+ would go if Robinson came too.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Robinson, who thought if he could reach other white
+ men, he would finally reach England, began to build a boat in
+ which to leave the island. Together he and Friday went to work
+ to fell a tree, and Friday soon showed that he knew far better
+ than Robinson the kind of tree best suited for boat-making.
+ Robinson showed him how to use tools, and in a little more than
+ a month the boat was finished. After the boat was put into the
+ water, Robinson was astonished at Friday's skill in paddling so
+ large a canoe.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page162"
+ id="page162"></a>[pg 162]</span>
+
+ <p>"Will she do to go over in?" he asked, and Friday, grinning,
+ said, "Yes, even if big wind blow." But Robinson did not mean
+ to depend on paddling, and fitted the boat with a mast, sails
+ and rudder.</p>
+
+ <p>Twenty-six years had passed since Robinson came to the
+ island, and he still went on digging and sowing. One morning he
+ sent Friday down to the beach for a turtle. Back he came in a
+ great hurry, crying out, "Master! Master! over yonder, one,
+ two, three canoe." Loading his guns, Robinson gave them to
+ Friday to carry, while he armed himself with muskets, a
+ cutlass, and a hatchet.</p>
+
+ <p>When all was ready he went up the hill with his telescope,
+ and saw that there were in all twenty-one savages, with three
+ prisoners, one of whom was a white man.</p>
+
+ <p>Robinson knew the savages had landed on the island to kill
+ and eat their prisoners, so he resolved to prevent them if
+ possible. To get at the savages without being seen, they had to
+ go nearly a mile out of their way, and being heavily laden they
+ could not go very fast. Reaching the place, they saw, from
+ behind a clump of bushes, the white man bound hand and foot on
+ the sand. There was no time to lose, and their first shot
+ killed three and wounded five of the savages. Snatching up
+ fresh guns, both fired again, before the savages who were not
+ hurt could get on their feet, for they were so taken by
+ surprise, that the poor wretches hardly knew what was
+ happening. This time only two dropped, but many more were
+ wounded.</p>
+
+ <p>While Friday kept on firing, Robinson ran to the white
+ prisoner and cut his bonds. The man said he was a Spaniard and
+ began to thank Robinson for what he had done. Robinson handed
+ him the cutlass and a pistol, telling him, if he had any
+ strength left, to go and do what he could against the savages.
+ As soon as the man got the weapons in his hands, he ran with
+ fury at the cannibals and cut two down, and with equal fury
+ attacked the rest. With the Spaniard to help them, Robinson and
+ Friday were soon able to clear the place of these dreadful
+ cannibals, many of whom jumped into the sea.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/162.jpg" name="fig162s"
+ id="fig162s"><img width="300" src="images/162s.jpg"
+ alt="ROBINSON RAN TO THE WHITE PRISONER AND CUT HIS BONDS" />
+ </a><br />
+ robinson ran to the white prisoner and cut his bonds
+ </div>
+
+ <p>Friday advised Robinson to take a canoe and go after them
+ lest they return with hundreds of others to avenge the death of
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page163" id="page163"></a>[pg
+ 163]</span> their friends. So the two ran to the beach and
+ began to shove off a canoe. But to their surprise, on the
+ bottom of the canoe lay another prisoner, an old man, tied so
+ hard, neck and heels, that even when his bonds were cut he
+ could not move.</p>
+
+ <p>No sooner did Friday look at him and hear him speak, than he
+ began to dance and shout and laugh, and then kneeling down,
+ rubbed noses with the savage (which is what these folks do
+ instead of kissing each other), and he was so excited that for
+ some time he could not explain what was the matter. As soon as
+ he could speak, he told Robinson that the man whom they had
+ found was his father.</p>
+
+ <p>Both Friday's father and the Spaniard, who was worn out with
+ fighting, had to be carried up to the castle.</p>
+
+ <p>No cannibals were ever again known to visit this island.</p>
+
+ <h4>VII</h4>
+
+ <h4>ARRIVAL OF AN ENGLISH SHIP; ROBINSON SAILS FOR HOME</h4>
+
+ <p>Soon after this Robinson had a long talk with the Spaniard,
+ who told him how he and his comrades had been wrecked four
+ years since, on that part of the coast where Friday's tribe
+ lived. He said that they were well treated by the natives, but
+ that they were put to very great straits now for want of
+ clothes, that their powder was finished, and that they had lost
+ all hope of ever getting back to their own country. He himself,
+ he said, had been captured in one of the many small wars that
+ are always taking place among the various tribes.</p>
+
+ <p>It struck Robinson that it might be possible for him to get
+ these men over to his island, provided that he could be sure of
+ their good faith, and that when they came, they did not take
+ the island from him by treachery. It was a risk, he thought,
+ but then, if he got so many men, it would not be difficult to
+ build a small ship that could carry them all to England.</p>
+
+ <p>So he asked the Spaniard if he would promise, and if he
+ thought he could get his comrades to take an oath that, if
+ Robinson helped them, they would look on him as their captain,
+ and <span class="pagenum"><a name="page164"
+ id="page164"></a>[pg 164]</span> would swear to obey him in all
+ things. The Spaniard readily promised for himself, and said
+ that he was sure his comrades would keep faith.</p>
+
+ <p>It was arranged, therefore, that in about six months, when
+ the next harvest was reaped, and there would be plenty of food
+ for so many extra men, the Spaniard and Friday's father should
+ go over to the mainland in one of the canoes which had been
+ taken from the savages.</p>
+
+ <p>Meantime, all hands set about the curing of very large
+ quantities of raisins, and much other work was done to be in
+ readiness for the coming of these men.</p>
+
+ <p>When the harvest was reaped, Robinson gave the Spaniard and
+ Friday's father each a musket and a supply of powder and
+ bullets, and loaded the canoe with food, enough to last them
+ and the others about a fortnight, and the two men set off for
+ the mainland in fine weather, and with a fair wind.</p>
+
+ <p>It was about eight days after this, and when Robinson had
+ begun to look out for their return, that one morning very
+ early, when Robinson was asleep, Friday came running in,
+ shouting, "Master! Master! They come." Up jumped Robinson, and
+ hurrying on his clothes, ran out.</p>
+
+ <p>Looking towards the sea, he soon made out a sailing-boat
+ making for the shore, coming from the south end of the island,
+ but still some miles away. This was not the direction from
+ which the Spaniard and his comrades would come, nor were they
+ likely to be in a sailing-boat. So Robinson took his telescope,
+ and went to the top of the hill to see if he could make out who
+ were on board, before they landed.</p>
+
+ <p>Hardly had he got on to the hill when he noticed a ship at
+ anchor some distance from the shore. She looked like an English
+ vessel, he thought, and the boat like an English long-boat.</p>
+
+ <p>This was a wonderful sight to Robinson, but yet he was not
+ easy in his mind. It was not a part of the world where an
+ English ship was likely to come, because in those days they
+ were nearly all Spanish vessels that traded in these seas, and
+ the English and Spaniards were bitter enemies. What could an
+ English ship be doing here? There had been no storm to drive
+ her out of her
+ course.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page165"
+ id="page165"></a>[pg 165]</span>
+
+ <p>Robinson feared that if she was English there must be
+ something wrong about her. Perhaps, he thought, she was a
+ pirate. So he was careful not to show himself or Friday.</p>
+
+ <p>Presently, as he watched, he saw the men in the boat run her
+ ashore and draw her up on the beach, about half a mile from his
+ castle. When they had landed, he could easily see through his
+ glass that they were Englishmen.</p>
+
+ <p>There were eleven men, but three of them had their hands
+ tied behind their backs, and were evidently prisoners. When the
+ first four or five men had jumped ashore, they brought out
+ these three, all the while ill-treating them, and behaving as
+ if they meant to kill their prisoners. Friday was sure that
+ they meant to eat them.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon, without further harming the three men, the others
+ scattered about among the trees near the shore, leaving the
+ three sitting on the ground very sad-looking, but with their
+ hands now untied.</p>
+
+ <p>At the time the boat was run aground, it was just
+ high-water, and the two sailors who had been left in charge of
+ her, and who had evidently been drinking too much rum, went to
+ sleep, and never noticed that the tide was going out. When they
+ woke, the boat was high and dry, and with all the strength of
+ the whole crew they could not move her, because the sand at
+ that part of the beach was very soft. This did not seem to
+ trouble any of them very much, for Robinson heard one of the
+ sailors shout, "Let her alone, Jack, can't ye? She'll float
+ next tide."</p>
+
+ <p>All forenoon Robinson watched, and when the hottest time of
+ the day had come, he noticed the sailors throw themselves down
+ under the trees, and go to sleep, some distance away from the
+ three prisoners.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Robinson and Friday, taking their muskets and pistols,
+ stole down cautiously behind the three men, to try to speak to
+ them without the others knowing.</p>
+
+ <p>Robinson had put on his goatskin coat and the great hairy
+ hat that he had made for himself; and with his cutlass and
+ pistols in his belt, and a gun over each shoulder, he looked
+ very fierce.</p>
+
+ <p>The men did not see him till he spoke, and they were so
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page166" id="page166"></a>[pg
+ 166]</span> startled by his wild look, and by the sight of two
+ men armed to the teeth, that they nearly ran away. But Robinson
+ told them not to be alarmed; he was an Englishman, and a
+ friend, and would help them if they would show him how it could
+ be done.</p>
+
+ <p>Then they explained to him what had happened. One of the
+ three was Captain of the ship that lay at anchor off the
+ island. Of the others, one was mate of the ship, and the third
+ man was a passenger. The crew had mutinied, the Captain told
+ Robinson, and had put him and the other two in irons, and the
+ ringleaders in the mutiny had proposed to kill them. Now they
+ meant to leave them on the island to perish.</p>
+
+ <p>The Captain was so astonished at finding anybody there who
+ proposed to help him, that he said in his wonder: "Am I talking
+ to a man, or to an angel from heaven?"</p>
+
+ <p>"If the Lord had sent an angel, sir," said Robinson, "he
+ would probably have come better clothed."</p>
+
+ <p>Then he asked if the boat's crew had any firearms, and was
+ told that they had only two muskets, one of which was left in
+ the boat. "The rest should be easy, then," Robinson said; "we
+ can either kill them all, or take them prisoners, as we
+ please."</p>
+
+ <p>The Captain was unwilling to see the men killed, for he said
+ if two of the worst of them were got rid of, he believed the
+ rest would return to their duty.</p>
+
+ <p>Robinson made a bargain that if he saved the Captain from
+ the mutineers, and recovered the ship, he and Friday were to be
+ taken home to England in her, free of cost; and to this the
+ Captain and the others agreed.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Robinson gave each of them a musket, with powder and
+ ball, after which the Captain and the mate and the passenger
+ marched towards the spot where the mutinous sailors lay asleep.
+ One of the men heard them advance, and turning round, saw them,
+ and cried out to his companions. But it was too late, the mate
+ and the passenger fired, and one of the ringleaders fell dead.
+ A second man also fell, but jumped up immediately and called to
+ the others to help him. But the Captain knocked him down with
+ the butt of his musket, and
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page167" id="page167"></a>[pg
+ 167]</span> the rest of the men, seeing Robinson and Friday
+ coming, and knowing they had no chance against five armed men,
+ begged for mercy. Three others who had been straying about
+ among the trees came back on hearing the shots, and were also
+ taken, and thus the whole crew of the boat was captured.</p>
+
+ <p>The Captain and Robinson now began to think how they might
+ recover the ship. There were on board, the Captain said,
+ several men on whom he thought he could depend, and who had
+ been forced by the others into the mutiny against their wills.
+ But it would be no easy thing to retake the ship, for there
+ were still twenty-six men on board, and as they were guilty of
+ mutiny, all of them, if taken back to England, would most
+ likely be hanged. Thus they were certain to make a fight for
+ it.</p>
+
+ <p>The first thing that Robinson and the others now did was to
+ take everything out of the boat&mdash;oars, and mast, and sail,
+ and rudder; then they knocked a hole in her bottom, so that she
+ could not float. While they were doing this, and drawing her
+ still further up on the beach, they heard first one gun and
+ then another fired by the ship as signals to the boat to
+ return.</p>
+
+ <p>As she of course did not move, Robinson saw through his
+ glass another boat with ten men on board, armed with muskets,
+ leave the ship, coming to bring the others back.</p>
+
+ <p>This was serious enough, for now Robinson and his party had
+ to make plans whereby they might capture also this fresh boat's
+ crew. Accordingly, they tied the hands of all the men they had
+ first taken, and sent the worst of them to the cave under the
+ charge of Friday and of one of the men that the Captain said
+ was to be trusted, with orders to shoot any who tried to give
+ an alarm or to escape. Then Robinson took his party and the
+ rest of the prisoners into the castle, where, from the rock,
+ they watched for the landing of the second boat.</p>
+
+ <p>The Captain and mate were very nervous, and despaired of
+ taking this fresh body of men, but Robinson was quite confident
+ of success, and put heart into them by his cheerfulness.</p>
+
+ <p>Of the prisoners in his castle, there were two whom the
+ Captain believed to be honest men, and on their promising
+ solemnly to keep faith, and to fight for him, Robinson released
+ them.</p>
+
+ <p>The crew of the second boat, when they landed, were
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page168" id="page168"></a>[pg
+ 168]</span> terribly surprised to find the first boat empty and
+ stove in, and they were seen anxiously consulting what to do.
+ Then they hallooed and fired volleys. Getting no reply, they
+ were evidently alarmed, for they all jumped into their boat and
+ began to pull off to the ship. In a few minutes, however, they
+ seemed to change their minds, for again they landed, this time
+ leaving three men in charge of the boat, and keeping her in the
+ water. The other seven came ashore, and started in a body
+ across the island to look for their lost comrades. But they did
+ not care to go far, and soon stopped, again firing volleys and
+ hallooing. Getting again no reply, they began to march back to
+ the sea. Whereupon Robinson ordered Friday and the mate to go
+ over the creek to the west and halloo loudly, and wait till the
+ sailors answered. Then Friday and the mate were to go further
+ away and again halloo, thus gradually getting the men to follow
+ them away from shore.</p>
+
+ <p>This plan succeeded very well, for when the sailors,
+ thinking they heard their missing friends hail, ran to find
+ them, their way was stopped by the creek, over which they had
+ to get the boat to carry them. They took with them, then, one
+ of the three men whom they had left in the boat, and ordered
+ the others to moor the boat to a tree, and remain there.</p>
+
+ <p>This was just what Robinson wanted. And, moreover, one of
+ the men played still further into his hands, for he left the
+ boat and lay down under a tree to sleep. On him the Captain
+ rushed, and knocked him down as he tried to rise to his feet,
+ whereupon the sailor left in the boat yielded, and more readily
+ that he had joined the mutineers very unwillingly, and was now
+ glad of the chance to rejoin his Captain.</p>
+
+ <p>Meantime Friday and the mate, by hallooing and answering,
+ drew the rest of the boat's crew from hill to hill through the
+ woods, till at last they had got them so far astray that it was
+ not possible for them to find their way back before dark. When
+ they did get back to where the boat had been left, and found
+ the men whom they had left in her gone, they were in a terrible
+ fright.</p>
+
+ <p>It was not difficult for Robinson and his men to surround
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page169" id="page169"></a>[pg
+ 169]</span> them, and it chanced that the boatswain of the
+ ship, who was the greatest villain of the lot, and the chief
+ cause of all the trouble, walked in the darkness close to the
+ Captain, who jumped up and shot him dead. The others then
+ surrendered, believing what they were told, that they were
+ surrounded by fifty armed men. All begged hard for their lives,
+ and a few whom the Captain said he could trust were set at
+ liberty on promising to help retake the ship. The others were
+ bound and put in the cave.</p>
+
+ <p>Robinson and Friday remained on shore to look after the
+ prisoners, while the Captain and the mate and the passenger,
+ with those of the crew who were trustworthy, having patched up
+ the damaged boat, pulled off in her and in the other to the
+ ship, which they reached about midnight. When they were a short
+ distance off, the Captain made one of the crew hail the ship
+ and say that they had brought off the boat and the men they had
+ gone in search of. Then both boats ran alongside at once, one
+ on each side of the vessel, and before the mutineers knew what
+ was happening they were overpowered, one or two of them being
+ killed. Only one of the Captain's party was hurt, the mate,
+ whose arm was broken by a musket-ball.</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as the ship was secured, the Captain ordered seven
+ guns to be fired, that being the signal he had agreed to make
+ to let Robinson know if he succeeded in taking the ship.</p>
+
+ <p>Robinson's stay in the island had now come to an end, after
+ more than twenty-eight years, for in a few days he and Friday
+ sailed for England in the ship. Some of the mutineers were left
+ on the island, and were afterwards joined by the Spaniard and
+ his comrades, for whom Robinson left a letter.</p>
+
+ <p>Robinson did not forget, when he left, to take with him the
+ money and gold bars he had got from the wreck of the Spanish
+ ship, and he took also, as a memento, the goatskin coat and the
+ great hairy hat. But the Captain was able before the ship
+ sailed to give him proper clothing, the wearing of which at
+ first put him to dreadful discomfort.</p>
+
+ <p>The voyage was a long one, but they sighted the English
+ coast at last.</p>
+
+ <p>It was thirty-five years since Robinson had set foot in
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page170" id="page170"></a>[pg
+ 170]</span> England. And that morning, when at last, after the
+ weary years of exile, he again saw his native land, he laid his
+ head down on his arms and cried like a child.</p>
+
+ <p>And, may be, you too some day may know the joy of coming
+ home, out of the land of bondage.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page171"
+ id="page171"></a>[pg 171]</span>
+
+ <h3>CANTERBURY TALES</h3>
+
+ <h3>By GEOFFREY CHAUCER</h3>
+
+ <h4>ADAPTED BY JANET HARVEY KELMAN</h4>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <h4>DORIGEN</h4>
+
+ <p>Once upon a time a young knight, whose name was Arviragus,
+ dwelt in Brittany. In the same country lived a beautiful lady
+ called Dorigen. And the knight loved the lady.</p>
+
+ <p>For years Arviragus did not know whether she loved him or
+ not. She was a great lady and very fair, and he was afraid to
+ ask her. But she knew that he loved her, for when he rode past
+ her window on his way to the wars, she could see her colors
+ streaming from his helmet. At first she did not think much of
+ this, for many knights fought for love of her; but as she heard
+ of new and greater deeds that this noble knight did year by
+ year, she began to care for him a great deal. When she thought
+ of his goodness and of the honor in which he held her, she knew
+ that there was no one else that she could love as she loved
+ Arviragus. And when Arviragus knew that she loved him and was
+ willing to be his wife, his heart was full of joy. So greatly
+ did he wish to make Dorigen happy with him, that he said to her
+ that he would obey her and do what she wished as gladly all his
+ life as he had done while he was trying to win her love. To
+ this she replied:</p>
+
+ <p>"Sir, since in thy great gentleness thou givest me so high a
+ place, I pray to God that there may never be strife between us
+ two by any fault of mine. Sir, I will be thy true and humble
+ wife until I die!"</p>
+
+ <p>Then Arviragus took his bride home with him to his castle
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page172" id="page172"></a>[pg
+ 172]</span> by the sea. He honored Dorigen as much as he had
+ done before his marriage, and tried to fulfil her wishes in
+ everything. Dorigen was just as eager to please Arviragus as he
+ was to please her, and they were happy together in all their
+ work and play.</p>
+
+ <p>Arviragus stayed quietly at home for a year, but after that
+ he grew restless. He felt that no true knight had a right to
+ live on quietly at home, with nothing to do except to order his
+ castle and to hunt. So he sailed away to England that he might
+ win honor and renown in the wars there.</p>
+
+ <p>Dorigen stood by the castle and watched his sails disappear
+ in the north. Poor Dorigen! her husband was gone, and she did
+ not know if he would ever come back to her. For weeks she wept
+ and mourned. At night she could not rest, and by day she would
+ not eat. All the things that she had cared most to do were now
+ dull and worthless to her because Arviragus was away.</p>
+
+ <p>Her friends saw her sorrow, and tried to comfort her in
+ every way they could. When they found she would not be
+ comforted, they spoke harshly to her, and told her that it was
+ very wrong of her to kill herself with sorrow, when Arviragus
+ hoped to come home again strong and famous. Then they began to
+ comfort her again, and to try to make her forget her
+ sadness.</p>
+
+ <p>After a long time Dorigen's sorrow began to grow quieter.
+ She could not have lived if she had always felt her grief as
+ deeply as she did at first. Indeed, as it was, this sorrow
+ would have broken her heart, if letters had not come from
+ Arviragus. They brought her tidings of his doings, and of the
+ glory he had won. But what comforted her most was that they
+ told her that he would soon return.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/172.jpg" name="fig172s"
+ id="fig172s"><img width="300" src="images/172s.jpg"
+ alt="ALAS! OF ALL THE SHIPS I SEE, IS THERE NEVER ONE THAT WILL BRING MY LORD HOME?" />
+ </a><br />
+ alas! of all the ships i see, is there never one that will
+ bring my lord home?
+ </div>
+
+ <p>When Dorigen's friends saw that she was less hopeless, they
+ begged her to come and roam with them to drive away the last of
+ her dark fears. This she did. Often she walked with them by the
+ edge of the cliffs on which her castle stood. But there she saw
+ the white ships and the brown barges sailing, one north,
+ another south, to the havens for which they were bound. Then
+ she would turn away from her friends and say to
+ herself:</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page173"
+ id="page173"></a>[pg 173]</span>
+
+ <p>"Alas! of all the ships I see, is there never one that will
+ bring my lord home? Then should I need no comfort. My heart
+ would be cured of this bitter smart."</p>
+
+ <p>At times as she sat and thought, she leaned down and looked
+ over the brink of the cliffs. But, when she saw the grisly,
+ black rocks, her very heart trembled within her. Then she would
+ sink down on the grass and wail:</p>
+
+ <p>"O God, men say Thou hast made nothing in vain, but, Lord,
+ why hast Thou made these black, grisly rocks? No man nor beast
+ is helped by them in all the world. Rocks have destroyed a
+ hundred thousand men, and which of all Thy works is so fair as
+ man? No doubt wise men will say, 'All is for the best.' But, oh
+ Thou God, who makest the winds to blow, keep Thou my lord!
+ And&mdash;would to God that these black rocks were sunk in the
+ deep for his sake! They slay my heart with fear."</p>
+
+ <p>Dorigen's friends saw that the sea brought back her sorrow.
+ They led her then by rivers and springs, and took her to every
+ lovely place they knew, from which there was no glimpse of the
+ sea.</p>
+
+ <p>In the valley, to landward of the castle, lay many beautiful
+ gardens. One day in May, when the soft showers of spring had
+ painted in brightest colors the leaves and flowers, they spent
+ the whole day in the fairest of these gardens. They had games
+ there, and they dined under a spreading tree. The breath of the
+ fresh green leaves and the sweet scent of the flowers blew
+ round them.</p>
+
+ <p>After dinner they began to dance and sing&mdash;every one
+ except Dorigen. She had no heart to sing, and she would not
+ dance because, of all who joined in the dance, not one was
+ Arviragus. But, though she would not dance, she watched her
+ friends and sometimes forgot her sorrow for a little.</p>
+
+ <p>Among the dancers there was a young squire named Aurelius.
+ He was much beloved because he was young, and strong, and
+ handsome. Men thought him wise and good, but he was not always
+ wise and good.</p>
+
+ <p>When the dancing was over, Aurelius came up to Dorigen and
+ asked her to give him a beautiful jewel that she wore on her
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page174" id="page174"></a>[pg
+ 174]</span> breast. He said to her, "Madam, of what use is thy
+ jewel to thee when thou wearest it on thy bosom? Give it to me,
+ and I will share with thee the price of it."</p>
+
+ <p>Dorigen turned and gazed at him.</p>
+
+ <p>"Is this what thou dost wish? I knew not what thou didst
+ mean when thou didst look at me, but now I know. Listen, this
+ is all I have to say to thee. I shall never part with my jewel,
+ not though I were in rags and without food."</p>
+
+ <p>Then she remembered how Arviragus had loved to see her wear
+ her jewel, as she always did, on a chain of gold that he had
+ given to her on her wedding day. She thought of the sea that
+ separated him from her, and of the cruel black rocks, and said
+ in play:</p>
+
+ <p>"Aurelius, I will freely give thee my jewel when thou dost
+ remove every rock on the shore from end to end of
+ Brittany."</p>
+
+ <p>Then her anger at the selfishness of Aurelius rose again,
+ and she bade him begone.</p>
+
+ <p>"Madam," he said, "it is impossible to move the rocks."</p>
+
+ <p>With that word he turned away, and went home to his own
+ house. There his brother Austin found him in a trance, for
+ Aurelius wished Dorigen's jewel more than he wished anything
+ else on earth, and the thought that he could not get it made
+ him so sad that he became dazed. Austin carried him to bed, and
+ tried to soothe him in his grief and vexation.</p>
+
+ <p>The jewel that Aurelius wished to get from Dorigen was no
+ common one. It had been given to her at her birth. It was clear
+ as crystal, but far more rare, and it shone in the daylight
+ like the sun. When Dorigen was a little child her mother told
+ her of this wonderful stone. She told her that it would bring
+ her joy and peace and the love of all who were good and true,
+ if she kept it bright and pure; but that, if she ever gave it
+ away, she would lose her youth and her beauty, and would be
+ hidden away from all her friends and left alone in the
+ world.</p>
+
+ <p>Dorigen shuddered at the thought of parting with her jewel.
+ She did not know how her mother's words could come to pass, if
+ she did give it away, nor by what magic power she could be so
+ lost that no one who loved her could find her again. But she
+ was sure that what her mother had said must be
+ true.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page175"
+ id="page175"></a>[pg 175]</span>
+
+ <p>And that was why Dorigen was so angry with Aurelius. She
+ knew that he must have heard what sorrow she would suffer if
+ she gave him her jewel, for all the court knew the story of the
+ wonderful stone.</p>
+
+ <p>Not long after this, Arviragus came home. He had won more
+ honor than before, and was now the very flower of chivalry. I
+ cannot tell you how great the joy was, with which he greeted
+ Dorigen, nor how soon she forgot her fears of the sea and the
+ grisly rocks.</p>
+
+ <p>For two years, while they lived a joyful life together,
+ Aurelius lay in bed unable to rise, with no one to take care of
+ him except his brother Austin. This brother mourned over
+ Aurelius in secret and wept at his unhappy fate, till one day
+ he remembered a book of magic that he had seen when he was a
+ student in Orleans. In that book he had read of the strange
+ ways in which Magicians can make things seem what they are not.
+ His heart leapt up. He said to himself, "My brother shall be
+ cured. I am sure I have heard of stranger things than that the
+ rocks should seem to vanish. Once I heard of a Magician who
+ made every one believe that a great brown barge was rowing up
+ and down a sheet of water inside the hall of a castle! If he
+ could do that, then surely we shall be able to find a Magician
+ who will make those black rocks seem to vanish. Then Dorigen
+ will have to keep her promise and give Aurelius her wonderful
+ jewel."</p>
+
+ <p>Austin then ran to his brother's room and told him about the
+ book of magic at Orleans. No sooner had Aurelius heard him than
+ he leapt out of bed. In less time than one would think possible
+ he was ready to start on the long ride to Orleans.</p>
+
+ <p>When they came near the city they met a Magician. They knew
+ him to be a Magician because of the strange look in his eyes,
+ and because of his curious dress. When they rode up to him he
+ bowed before them and wished them "Good day." Then he began to
+ tell them why they had come to Orleans. Aurelius wondered how
+ it was that this stranger knew so much about him and his
+ errand. He thought he must be a very wise man indeed, and
+ leaping from his horse in surprise and joy, he went home with
+ the Magician to his house. His brother went
+ too.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page176"
+ id="page176"></a>[pg 176]</span>
+
+ <p>The house was the finest that Aurelius had ever seen. When
+ he entered the study he looked in wonder at the rows of books
+ that lined the walls, and at the quaint pictures and the
+ strange old armor.</p>
+
+ <p>In one corner a curious light burned. It was not like the
+ light of a lamp or of a candle, but cold and blue. Above it
+ hung a map of the stars, and other strange drawings. Below the
+ light stood a table, and on it lay a great book which was
+ chained to the wall.</p>
+
+ <p>Austin saw Aurelius look at this book. He whispered to him,
+ "It is the same book from which I read long ago."</p>
+
+ <p>This corner with its blue light made Aurelius frightened. A
+ shudder passed over him when he saw the Magician cross over
+ into the circle of the light and wave his wand.</p>
+
+ <p>In a moment Aurelius forgot all about the Magician and his
+ own fear, for he and his brother saw before them the edge of a
+ forest with a park stretching from the trees far, far away.</p>
+
+ <p>The sun shone, and the branches waved a little in the
+ breeze. In the park the brothers saw herds of deer. Beautiful
+ animals they were, with the highest antlers deer ever had. At
+ first the deer fed in peace and safety. Then archers, clad in
+ green, came to the edge of the forest. They glided out and in
+ among the trees to see where they could best take aim with
+ their arrows. When the archers had let their arrows fly, hounds
+ broke out from behind them, and soon there was not one living
+ deer of all the herd left in sight.</p>
+
+ <p>In a moment a calm river flowed where the park had been. In
+ the shallow water at the river's edge tall herons stood. They
+ watched for the little fishes that swam in the river. Again,
+ into this quiet place a hunter came. He had no arrows. He had
+ no dogs. But on his wrist he had an iron bracelet to which one
+ end of a chain was fastened. The other end of the chain was
+ round a hawk's foot, and the hawk sat on his master's wrist.
+ When the hunter came near the river he loosed the chain from
+ the bird's foot. The hawk flew over the river and swooped down
+ among the herons. In a moment they had all vanished.</p>
+
+ <p>Aurelius had scarcely time to sigh, when the river itself
+ was gone, and a plain lay where it had been. There he saw the
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page177" id="page177"></a>[pg
+ 177]</span> knights of King Arthur's Table jousting. Beautiful
+ ladies sat and watched the struggle, and one more fair than all
+ held the prizes the knights might win.</p>
+
+ <p>Then the figures of the knights began to grow dim and
+ uncertain. The plain changed into a great hall where knights
+ and ladies danced. Everything was bright and sparkling. Mirrors
+ lined the walls, and their cut edges flashed back the light
+ that fell on them. As Aurelius watched the dance, he started.
+ There, before him, more beautiful than ever, was Dorigen. His
+ heart gave a great leap, for, as he watched her, he saw that
+ she no longer wore her jewel. In his delight he swayed to the
+ music of the dance. Clap! clap! went the Magician's hands, and
+ all was gone.</p>
+
+ <p>The great room that had seemed so splendid to Aurelius when
+ he entered it, looked cold and plain now when he returned to it
+ from fairyland.</p>
+
+ <p>The Magician called his servant and asked for supper. Then
+ he led the brothers away and feasted them royally.</p>
+
+ <p>After supper the three men began to talk about what the
+ Magician should get from Aurelius if he made the rocks vanish.
+ The Magician said, "I cannot take less than a thousand pounds,
+ and I am not sure if I can do it for that!" Aurelius was too
+ delighted to bargain about what the cost would be. He said
+ gladly: "What is a thousand pounds? I would give thee the whole
+ round world, if I were lord of it. The bargain is made. Thou
+ shalt be paid in full. But do not delay. Let us start to-morrow
+ morning without fail."</p>
+
+ <p>"Thou mayest count on me to-morrow," said the Magician.</p>
+
+ <p>They went to bed, and Aurelius slept soundly and well;
+ because of the hope he had that the Magician would make the
+ rocks vanish.</p>
+
+ <p>Next morning they rose early. It was Christmas time, and the
+ air was cold and frosty as they rode away. The very sunlight
+ was pale, and the trees were bare. When they reached home the
+ neighbors gathered round and wished them a Merry Christmas.
+ "Noel, Noel," they said, but they would not have done so had
+ they known what sorrow the riders brought to their beautiful
+ lady Dorigen.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page178"
+ id="page178"></a>[pg 178]</span>
+
+ <p>For many days the Magician worked with his maps and figures.
+ Aurelius waited impatiently. There was nothing for him to do
+ except to make the Magician as comfortable as he could, and to
+ show him as much kindness as possible.</p>
+
+ <p>One morning Aurelius looked from his window towards the sea.
+ He saw the Magician standing on the shore. As Aurelius gazed
+ out to sea, the rocks vanished from north to south. His heart
+ stood still. Then he rushed out and away to the edge of the
+ cliffs for fear some rocks might still lie close to the land.
+ But no, there was not one.</p>
+
+ <p>He went to meet the Magician and fell at his feet with the
+ words, "Thanks to thee, my lord, thanks to thee, my cares are
+ gone!"</p>
+
+ <p>After he had thanked the Wise Man, he hurried away to meet
+ Dorigen. When he saw her he trembled. She was so pure and
+ beautiful. His heart sank. Then he looked out to sea and saw
+ the smooth surface of the water, and he grew selfish again.</p>
+
+ <p>Dorigen came quietly on. She had not noticed that the rocks
+ had vanished, for Arviragus was safe on land, and she did not
+ fear the sea any more. She had almost forgotten Aurelius and
+ his selfish, greedy words. It was more than two years since she
+ had seen him, and she had not heard of him since then.</p>
+
+ <p>She started back when he greeted her. Before she had time to
+ speak he said, "My lady, give me thy jewel."</p>
+
+ <p>He saw Dorigen's face grow cold and angry, and said, "Think
+ well lest thou break thy word, for, madam, thou knowest well
+ what thou didst say. In yonder garden in the month of May thou
+ didst promise to give me thy jewel when I should move the
+ rocks. I speak to save thine honor. I have done as thou didst
+ command me. Go thou and see if thou wilt, but well I know the
+ rocks are vanished."</p>
+
+ <p>He left her then. She stood still, white and sick. She had
+ never dreamt that such a trap as this could close on her.</p>
+
+ <p>"Alas," she said, "that such a thing could happen! I never
+ thought a thing so strange and unheard-of could come to
+ pass!"</p>
+
+ <p>Home she went in sadness and dismay. She was so weak
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page179" id="page179"></a>[pg
+ 179]</span> with fear that she could scarcely walk. She had to
+ suffer her sorrow alone for three days, for Arviragus was away,
+ and she would tell no one but him. Her ladies saw her distress,
+ but they could not comfort her. To herself she moaned, "Alas, O
+ Fortune, I lay the blame on thee; thou hast so bound me in thy
+ chain, that I see no help nor escape save only in death."</p>
+
+ <p>Arviragus came home on the third day after the rocks had
+ vanished. He came at night, so he noticed nothing strange about
+ the shore. Though every one was talking of the curious thing
+ that had happened, no one liked to tell him. They knew he would
+ not like to hear of it. He would think his country was
+ bewitched.</p>
+
+ <p>Arviragus looked for Dorigen in the hall. When he could not
+ see her there, he hurried to her room, to make sure that she
+ was safe and well. As he sprang up the broad staircase, the
+ sheath of his sword and the spurs at his heels clanked harshly
+ on the stone steps.</p>
+
+ <p>Dorigen heard him, but, instead of going to meet him, she
+ buried her head deeper in her cushions and wept. Arviragus
+ crossed the room to where she sat, and knelt before her. He
+ drew her hands from her eyes and said, "Dorigen, what is it?
+ Why dost thou weep like this, my beloved?"</p>
+
+ <p>For a little time Dorigen's tears only fell the faster, then
+ she said brokenly: "Alas, that ever I was born! I have said it!
+ Arviragus! I have promised!"</p>
+
+ <p>"What hast thou promised, my wife?"</p>
+
+ <p>Then Dorigen told Arviragus all that had happened; told him
+ that she had promised to give her jewel to Aurelius when he
+ would take all the rocks away.</p>
+
+ <p>Arviragus leapt up and went to the window. The moon had
+ burst through a cloud, and everything was bright and clear. He
+ looked away north, as Dorigen had so often looked to watch for
+ his coming. In the moonlight Arviragus saw the sea lie smooth
+ and cold. His eyes swept the skyline. It seemed as as if all
+ the rocks had sunk into his heart, it was so heavy.</p>
+
+ <p>He turned towards Dorigen, and saw how great was her
+ sorrow.</p>
+
+ <p>Then he said very gently: "Is there aught else than this,
+ that thou shouldst weep,
+ Dorigen?"</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page180"
+ id="page180"></a>[pg 180]</span>
+
+ <p>"Nay, nay, this is indeed too much already," she sighed.</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear wife," he said, "something as wonderful as the sinking
+ of the rocks may happen to save us yet. God grant it! But
+ whether or not, thou must keep thy troth. I had rather that my
+ great love for thee caused me to die, than that thou shouldest
+ break thy promise. Truth is the highest thing that man may
+ keep."</p>
+
+ <p>Then his courage broke down, and he began to sob and weep
+ along with Dorigen.</p>
+
+ <p>Next morning he was strong and brave again. He said to
+ Dorigen, "I will bear up under this great sorrow."</p>
+
+ <p>He bade her farewell, and she set out with only a maid and a
+ squire to follow her.</p>
+
+ <p>Arviragus could not bear to see Dorigen as she went down
+ from the castle, so he hid himself in an inner room. But some
+ one saw her go out. It was Aurelius. For three days he had
+ watched the castle gate to see what she did, and where she
+ went. He came forward and said, "Whither goest thou?"</p>
+
+ <p>Dorigen was almost mad with misery, but she said bravely,
+ "To thee, to keep my troth, and give my jewel to thee, as my
+ husband bids me. Alas! alas!"</p>
+
+ <p>Aurelius was full of wonder when he heard this. He began to
+ be sorry for Dorigen, and for Arviragus the worthy knight, who
+ would rather lose his wife than have her break her word. He
+ could be cruel no longer.</p>
+
+ <p>"Madam," he said, "say to thy lord Arviragus that since I
+ see his great honor and thy sad distress, I had rather bear my
+ own sorrow than drive thee away from him and all thy friends. I
+ give thee back thy promise. I shall never trouble thee more.
+ Farewell, farewell! thou truest woman and best that I have ever
+ seen."</p>
+
+ <p>Down on her knees, on the roadway, fell Dorigen to thank
+ Aurelius. Her blessing followed him as he turned and left
+ her.</p>
+
+ <p>But how can I tell of Dorigen's return? She seemed to be
+ treading on air. When she reached the room where her husband
+ sat with his head sunk on his arms, she paused. She had not
+ known the greatness of his love till then. He looked old and
+ forlorn after the night of
+ sorrow.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page181"
+ id="page181"></a>[pg 181]</span>
+
+ <p>She spoke, and he raised his eyes to gaze on her, as if she
+ had been a lady in a dream. But when she told him all, when he
+ knew that she was there herself, and for always, he could not
+ speak for joy.</p>
+
+ <p>Aurelius wished he had never been born when he thought of
+ the thousand pounds of pure gold that he owed to the
+ Magician.</p>
+
+ <p>He said to himself, "What shall I do? I am undone! I must
+ sell my house and be a beggar. I will not stay here and make my
+ friends ashamed of me, unless I can get the Magician to give me
+ time. I will ask him to let me pay him part of my debt year by
+ year till all is paid. If he will, my gratitude will know no
+ bounds, and I will pay him every penny I owe."</p>
+
+ <p>With a sore heart he went to his coffer and took out five
+ hundred pounds of gold. These he took to the Wise Man, and
+ begged him to grant him time to pay the rest.</p>
+
+ <p>"Master," said he, "I can say truly, I never yet failed to
+ keep a promise. My debt shall be paid to thee, even if I go
+ begging in rags. But if thou wilt be so gracious as to allow me
+ two years, or three, in which to pay the, rest, I will rejoice.
+ If not, I must sell my house; there is no other way."</p>
+
+ <p>When the Magician heard this he said, "Have not I kept my
+ promise to thee?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, certainly, well and truly!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Hast thou not thy jewel?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, no," said Aurelius, and sighed deeply.</p>
+
+ <p>"Tell me, if thou mayest, what is the cause of this?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Arviragus in his honor had rather die in sorrow and
+ distress than that his wife should break her word. Dorigen
+ would rather die than lose her husband and wander alone on the
+ earth. She did not mean to give me her promise. She thought the
+ rocks would never move. I pitied them so much that I gave her
+ back her promise as freely as she brought her jewel to me. That
+ is the whole story!"</p>
+
+ <p>The Magician answered, "Dear brother, you have each behaved
+ nobly. Thou art a squire, he is a knight, but by God's grace I
+ can do a noble deed as well as another. Sir, thou art free from
+ thy debt to me, as free as if thou hadst this moment crept out
+ of the ground, and hadst never known me
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page182" id="page182"></a>[pg
+ 182]</span> till now. For, sir, I will not take a penny from
+ thee for all my skill, nor for all my work. It is enough!
+ Farewell! Good day to thee!"</p>
+
+ <p>Whereupon the Magician bowed once and again, mounted his
+ horse, and rode away.</p>
+
+ <p>Dorigen and Arviragus were walking on the cliffs as the
+ Magician parted from Aurelius. They noticed the two men, and
+ when the horseman rode away they saw a strange white mist rise
+ from the sea and follow the rider.</p>
+
+ <p>Dorigen caught her husband's arm, for there, there, out at
+ sea, and close by the cliffs, were the rocks, grisly and black
+ and fearsome as before. The sunlight fell on her jewel, and it
+ shone more brightly than of old, nor did its light ever grow
+ dim in all the happy years that followed.</p>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <h4>EMELIA</h4>
+
+ <p>Emelia the Radiant lived in a great castle in Athens.</p>
+
+ <p>Hippolyta, Emelia's sister, had once been queen of the
+ Warrior Women, and had led her armies to battle. But Emelia had
+ never fought in these battles. When she was still a child, Duke
+ Theseus of Athens had fought with Hippolyta and conquered her.
+ Instead of sending his royal captive to prison, Theseus married
+ her, and took her home to Athens with him. When he took her
+ there, he took Emelia with her. He was very kind to them both,
+ and the castle in Athens was a happy home for Hippolyta and her
+ little sister.</p>
+
+ <p>As Emelia grew up she became most beautiful. She was more
+ graceful than a lily on its stem, and the flush on her cheeks
+ was more delicate than the hue of the rose-petals in the old
+ Greek castle garden. Her golden hair fell in heavy masses round
+ her face, and lay in a great plait down her back. It caught all
+ the light that fell on it, and sent it out again to make glad
+ the hearts of those who looked on her. So men called her Emelia
+ the Radiant, and all who met her smiled for joy at the sight of
+ so beautiful a maid.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page183"
+ id="page183"></a>[pg 183]</span>
+
+ <p>One May morning Emelia went into the castle garden to bathe
+ her face in the early dew. Everything was dim and gray in the
+ twilight. She looked up at the great dungeon tower which
+ overshadowed the garden, and thought of the two young princes
+ who were prisoners there. Duke Theseus had brought them from
+ Thebes. He was very proud of them, and would not give them up,
+ although the people of their land offered to give him gold and
+ jewels for their ransom. The princes were cousins, and were the
+ last of the royal line of Thebes. In the stillness Emelia
+ murmured their names to herself, "Palamon and Arcite, Palamon
+ and Arcite. How miserable they must be in their narrow cell!"
+ she thought. Then she sighed that life should be so sad for
+ them while it was so bright for her!</p>
+
+ <p>As she roamed up and down and gathered roses white and red
+ to make a garland for her hair, the sun broke through the mist
+ and shone into the garden. Once more she raised her eyes to the
+ tower. This time she did not look at it, but at the sunlit
+ clouds beyond. The light from the east fell on her. Her hair
+ shone like gold, and her face was radiant with happiness.</p>
+
+ <p>Palamon at that moment came to the narrow iron-barred window
+ through which alone he and his cousin could see the sky and the
+ fields and the city. He saw the morning light fall on the fair
+ buildings of Athens, and on the plains and hills beyond. Then a
+ glad song which burst from Emelia's happy heart floated up to
+ him. He looked down. Before him stood the maiden bathed in
+ sunlight.</p>
+
+ <p>She seemed to him the very Spirit of Beauty. He thought of
+ all the joy and life and freedom that he could never have. He
+ started back from the window and cried aloud.</p>
+
+ <p>His cousin Arcite sprang from his couch and said, "My
+ cousin, what aileth thee? I pray thee that thou bear our
+ imprisonment in patience. Sad it is in truth, but we must abide
+ it. We can do nought else."</p>
+
+ <p>But Palamon said: "Thou art mistaken. Prison walls drew not
+ that cry from me. An arrow hath entered my heart through mine
+ eye, and I am wounded. What life can give is bound up for me in
+ the fairness of a maiden who roams in yonder
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page184" id="page184"></a>[pg
+ 184]</span> garden. Be she Spirit or woman I know not! But this
+ I know, was never woman nor Spirit half so fair before."</p>
+
+ <p>"Spirit of Beauty," he cried, "if thou choosest to take the
+ form of a radiant woman here before me in this garden, pity my
+ wretchedness! Save us from this prison, and if that may not be,
+ have pity on our country and help our fallen friends."</p>
+
+ <p>Arcite pressed forward and leant over Palamon's shoulder.
+ The window was only a narrow slit, and the wall through which
+ it was cut was thick, so it was not easy for Arcite to see into
+ the garden. At last he caught a glimpse of Emelia.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, how lovely she is!" he said. "I shall die of my wish to
+ serve her. Most beautiful of maidens she is, truly."</p>
+
+ <p>When Palamon heard this, he turned on Arcite, looked coldly
+ at him and asked, "Sayest thou so in earnest or in jest?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Nay, truly in earnest, my cousin; I have little will to
+ jest!"</p>
+
+ <p>Palamon looked fiercely at him and said, "Little honor to
+ thee then! Hast thou forgotten thine oath of truest brotherhood
+ to me, and mine to thee? Hast thou forgotten thy promise to
+ help me in all I do? How, then, canst thou dream of claiming to
+ love my lady? This thou shalt not do, false Arcite! I loved her
+ first, and told thee, and thou must help me to win her if ever
+ we escape. Thine honor demands this of thee. Otherwise thou art
+ no true knight."</p>
+
+ <p>But Arcite drew himself up scornfully and said, "Rather it
+ is thou that art false! A moment ago thou didst not know
+ whether she were maiden or Spirit! I loved her first for what
+ she is, and told thee as my brother! But even if thou hadst
+ loved her first, could I, because of that, refuse to love the
+ fairest of maidens? Besides, why should we strive? Thou knowest
+ too well that thou shalt never win her smile, nor yet shall I!
+ These prison walls so thick and black leave no hope for us. We
+ fight as did the fabled dogs for the bone. They fought all day,
+ yet neither won. There came a kite while they raged, and
+ carried off the bone. Love thou the maid if thou wilt. I shall
+ love her till I die."</p>
+
+ <p>The prison had been narrow and bare and cold before, but now
+ it seemed ten times more dismal. The world from which
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page185" id="page185"></a>[pg
+ 185]</span> it shut them in was so much more sweet because of
+ the maiden who dwelt there, and the friendship for each other
+ which had cheered them through many evil days was broken.</p>
+
+ <p>But Emelia the Radiant sang her gay songs and stepped
+ lightly among the flowers, with never another thought of the
+ weary eyes that watched her.</p>
+
+ <p>One day the greatest friend that Duke Theseus of Athens had,
+ came to see him. This friend had known Arcite in Thebes, and
+ had loved the handsome boy. He begged Theseus to forgive him,
+ and to let him go free. Theseus was glad to find something he
+ could do to please his dear friend, so one morning he took him
+ with him to the prison where Palamon and Arcite were. The
+ attendants could scarcely follow, for the royal robes filled
+ all the dingy little space! A streak of light from the window
+ fell on the Duke's mantle and his jewels. They looked strangely
+ bright in that dark room beside the faded clothes of the two
+ young prisoners.</p>
+
+ <p>Arcite and the friend of Theseus greeted each other
+ joyously, and the heart of Arcite beat wildly with hope, but
+ when he heard the words of Theseus the Duke it sank like
+ lead.</p>
+
+ <p>"Arcite," said he, "by the desire of my friend, I grant to
+ thee thy freedom. I grant it on one condition only. Thou must
+ wander away far beyond my kingdom. If ever thou art seen for
+ one moment on any furthest corner of my land, that moment shall
+ be thy last. By the sword thou shalt die."</p>
+
+ <p>Homeward to Thebes sped Arcite with a sad heart.</p>
+
+ <p>"Woe is me for the day that I was born!" he moaned; "woe is
+ me that ever I knew the friend of Theseus! Had he not known me,
+ I might even now be gazing on the maiden I serve, from the
+ window in the Duke's tower. Ah, Palamon, thou art the victor
+ now! Day by day thou gazest on her, and kind fortune may grant
+ to thee thy freedom and her favor while I am banished for ever!
+ Ah, why do we complain against our fortune? We know that we
+ seek happiness, but know not the road thither! Think how I
+ dreamt and longed for freedom, and thought that if I were only
+ out of prison my joy would be perfect. Behold, my freedom is my
+ banishment, and my hope my undoing!"</p>
+
+ <p>As for Palamon, when he saw that Arcite was gone, he made
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page186" id="page186"></a>[pg
+ 186]</span> the great tower walls re-echo with his howls of
+ misery. The very fetters on his ankles were wet with his salt
+ tears.</p>
+
+ <p>"Alas," he groaned, "Arcite, my cousin, thou hast borne off
+ the prize in this strife of ours! Thou walkest now at liberty
+ in Thebes. Little thou thinkest of me and of my sorrow! Strong
+ thou art, and wise. Doubtless thou art even now gathering
+ together the people of Thebes to invade this land and win the
+ sister of the Duke for thy wife, while I die here in this
+ prison like a caged lion. The prison walls heed my weeping and
+ my wailing not at all."</p>
+
+ <p>He could not even rejoice in the sight of Emelia when she
+ walked in the garden, so fearful was he lest Arcite should win
+ her.</p>
+
+ <p>Meanwhile Arcite passed his days in Thebes in grief. He
+ wandered about alone, and wailed and made moan to himself. He
+ cared not to eat, and sleep forsook him. His spirits were so
+ feeble that the sound of music brought fresh tears to his eyes.
+ He grew gaunt and thin, and his voice was hollow with
+ sadness.</p>
+
+ <p>At last, when he was nearly dazed with sorrow, he dreamt one
+ night that a beautiful winged boy with golden curls stood
+ before him. "Go thou to Athens," said the boy; "the end of all
+ thy sorrow awaits thee there!"</p>
+
+ <p>Arcite started up wide awake and said, "I will to Athens, to
+ my lady. It were good even to die in her presence."</p>
+
+ <p>He caught up a mirror. He had not cared to look in one for
+ many months, but now that he meant to return to his lady, he
+ wished to see if he looked strong and young as ever. At first
+ he was shocked to see how great a change had passed over his
+ face. Then he thought, "If I do not say who I am, I may live
+ unknown in Athens for years. Then I shall see my lady day by
+ day."</p>
+
+ <p>Quickly he called to him a squire, and told him all his
+ will, and bound him to keep his name a secret and to answer no
+ questions about himself or his master. Then Arcite sent his
+ squire to find clothes such as the laborers in Athens wore.
+ When he returned, Arcite and he put on the clothes and set out
+ by the straight road to Athens.</p>
+
+ <p>In Athens no one took any notice of the two poor
+ men.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page187"
+ id="page187"></a>[pg 187]</span>
+
+ <p>Before they came to the castle the squire left his master
+ and found a house to live in, where he could do Arcite's
+ bidding at any time. But Arcite hurried on to the courtyard
+ gate. There he waited till the master of the servants who
+ waited on Emelia came out. Then he said to him, "Take me, I
+ pray thee, into thy service. Drudge I will and draw water, yea,
+ and in all thou dost command I will obey."</p>
+
+ <p>The master of the servants asked Arcite what was his name.
+ "Philostrate, my lord," said Arcite, and as "Philostrate" he
+ entered that part of the castle where Emelia's home was.</p>
+
+ <p>He could hew wood and carry water well, but he was not long
+ left to do such rough work. The master of the house saw that
+ whatever he trusted to Philostrate's care was rightly done, so
+ he gave him less humble work to do, and made him a page in the
+ house of Emelia. The lords and ladies of the castle began to
+ notice what a gentle and kind page this Philostrate was. They
+ spoke to Theseus about him, and said that he deserved to have a
+ higher place that he might show his goodness and courage in
+ knightly deeds. To please them, Theseus made him one of his own
+ squires.</p>
+
+ <p>Seven years passed away, and Palamon was still in prison.
+ This year, however, in the May-time, a friend of his, who heard
+ where he was, helped him to escape. During the short night he
+ fled as fast as he could, but when the early dawn began to
+ break he strode tremblingly to a grove of trees, that he might
+ hide there all day. When the darkness fell once more he meant
+ to go on again to Thebes, there to gather his old armies to
+ make war on Theseus. He wished either to win Emelia or to die.
+ He cared little for his life if he might not spend it with
+ her.</p>
+
+ <p>As Palamon lay beside a bush in the grove, he watched the
+ sunbeams drying up the dew drops on the leaves and flowers near
+ him, and listened to the joyous song of a lark that poured
+ forth its welcome to the morning.</p>
+
+ <p>The same lark that Palamon heard awakened Arcite. He was now
+ the chief knight in the Duke's house, and served him with honor
+ in peace and war. He sprang up and looked out on the fresh
+ green fields. Everything called to him to come out. He loosed
+ his horse from the stall and galloped over hill and dale.
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page188" id="page188"></a>[pg
+ 188]</span> He came to the edge of a grove, and tied up his
+ steed to a tree. Then he wandered down a woodland path to
+ gather honeysuckle and hawthorn to weave a garland for himself.
+ Little he thought of the snare into which he was walking. As he
+ roamed he sang&mdash;</p>
+
+ <div class="poem">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p>"O May, of every month the queen,</p>
+
+ <p>With thy sweet flowers and forests green,</p>
+
+ <p>Right welcome be thou, fair fresh May."</p>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+
+ <p>The grove was the one in which Palamon lay beside a pool of
+ water. When he heard the song of Arcite, cold fear took hold on
+ him. He did not know that it was Arcite who sang, but he knew
+ that the horse must belong to a knight of the court, and he
+ crouched down to the ground lest he should be seen and taken
+ back to prison.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon Arcite's joyous mood passed away, and he grew
+ sorrowful. He sighed and threw himself down not far from the
+ spot where Palamon lay.</p>
+
+ <p>"Alas, alas!" said Arcite, "for the royal blood of Thebes!
+ Alas that I should humbly serve my mortal enemy! Alas that I
+ dare not claim my noble name, but must be known, forsooth, as
+ Philostrate, a name worth not a straw! Of all our princely
+ house not one is left save only me and Palamon, whom Theseus
+ slays in prison. Even I, free though I am, am helpless to win
+ Emelia. What am I to her but an humble squire?"</p>
+
+ <p>Palamon was so angry when he heard this, that he forgot his
+ own danger. He started out from his hiding-place and faced
+ Arcite.</p>
+
+ <p>"False Arcite," he cried, "now art thou caught indeed! Thou
+ hast deceived Duke Theseus and hast falsely changed thy name,
+ hast thou? Then surely I or thou must die. I will suffer no man
+ to love my lady, save myself alone. For I am Palamon, thy
+ mortal foe. I have no weapon in this place, for only last night
+ did I escape from prison. Yet I fear thee not. Thou shalt die,
+ or thou shalt cease to love my lady. Choose as thou wilt!"</p>
+
+ <p>Then Arcite rose up in his wrath and drew his sword. He
+ said, "Were it not that thou art ill and mad with grief, and
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page189" id="page189"></a>[pg
+ 189]</span> that thou hast no weapon here, thou shouldest never
+ step from where thou standest. I deny the bond thou claimest!
+ Fool! how can I help thee to win the lady I fain would wed
+ myself? But because thou art a worthy knight and a gentle, and
+ art ready to fight for thy lady, accept my promise. To-morrow I
+ will not fail to wait for thee here without the knowledge of
+ any other. Also I will bring armor and weapons for thee and me,
+ and thou shalt choose of them what thou wilt, ere I arm myself!
+ Food and drink will I bring to thee this night into the grove.
+ If so be that thou slay me here to-morrow, then indeed thou
+ mayest win thy lady if thou canst!"</p>
+
+ <p>Then Palamon answered, "Let it be so."</p>
+
+ <p>Next morning Arcite rode to the wood alone. He met Palamon
+ on the woodland path where the flowers he had gathered the day
+ before lay withered on the ground. No word nor greeting passed
+ between them, but each helped to arm the other in silence. As
+ the buckles were tightened and the armor slipped into its
+ place, the color came and went in the faces of the two princes.
+ They deemed that this would be the last of all fights to one of
+ them.</p>
+
+ <p>When they were ready they fenced together for a little, and
+ then the real fight began. So fierce was it that the men seemed
+ like wild animals in their rage. Palamon sprang at Arcite like
+ a strong lion, and Arcite glanced aside and darted at him again
+ like a cruel tiger. In the midst of this they heard a sound of
+ the galloping of horses that brought the royal hunters to the
+ spot. In a moment the sword of Theseus flashed between the
+ fighters, and his voice thundered out, "Ho! no more, on pain of
+ death. Who are ye who dare to fight here alone, with none to
+ see justice done?"</p>
+
+ <p>The princes turned and saw Theseus, Duke of Athens. Behind
+ him rode Hippolyta with her sister, Emelia the Radiant, and
+ many knights and ladies.</p>
+
+ <p>Palamon answered the Duke's question swiftly, before Arcite
+ had time to speak. "Sire, what need of words? Both of us
+ deserve death. Two wretches are we, burdened with our lives. As
+ thou art a just judge, give to us neither mercy nor refuge, but
+ slay us both. Thou knowrest not that this knight,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page190" id="page190"></a>[pg
+ 190]</span> Philostrate, is thy mortal foe, whom thou hast
+ banished. He is Arcite, who hath deceived thee for that he
+ loveth Emelia. And I too love her. I too am thy mortal foe, for
+ I am Palamon, and I have broken from my prison. Slay us then,
+ here before fair Emelia."</p>
+
+ <p>"That is easily granted," said Theseus. "Ye judge
+ yourselves. Ye shall die."</p>
+
+ <p>Then the queen began to weep, and Emelia too. They were sad
+ to think that these two princes should die so young, and all
+ for the service they wished to do to the queen's sister.</p>
+
+ <p>The other ladies of the court begged the Duke to forgive the
+ fighters. "Have mercy, sire," they urged, "on us women, and
+ save the princes!"</p>
+
+ <p>At first Theseus was too angry to listen to them, but soon
+ he thought that he would have done as the princes had done, if
+ he had been in their place, so he said, "Arcite and Palamon, ye
+ could both have lived in peace and safety in Thebes, yet love
+ has brought you here to Athens into my power, who am your
+ deadly foe. Here then for the sake of Hippolyta, my queen, and
+ of Emelia the Radiant, our dear sister, I forgive you both.
+ Promise never to make war on my land, but to yield me your
+ friendship evermore." Joyfully the princes promised this, and
+ thanked the Duke for his grace.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Theseus said, "Both of you are noble. Either might wed
+ Emelia the Radiant, but she cannot wed you both. Therefore I
+ appoint a tournament in this place a year hence. Come here
+ then, ye Princes of Thebes, each of you, with a hundred knights
+ of the bravest, and that one of you, who shall slay or capture
+ the other, he shall wed Emelia."</p>
+
+ <p>Whose face could be brighter than was Palamon's when he
+ heard those words, and who could step more lightly than did
+ Arcite? Every one thanked the Duke for his kindness to the
+ princes, while they rode off to Thebes with high hopes and
+ light hearts.</p>
+
+ <p>When the day of the tournament came, great buildings stood
+ in a circle on the plain beside the grove. Within them
+ stretched an immense arena in which the knights must fight.
+ Great marble gates opened on to the space at either
+ side.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page191"
+ id="page191"></a>[pg 191]</span>
+
+ <p>Palamon and Arcite found it easy to bring a hundred knights
+ to Athens. So splendid were the preparations for the tournament
+ that every one was eager to fight in it.</p>
+
+ <p>Emelia alone was sad as the day of the fighting came nearer.
+ Her maidens heard her say, "Oh that I might not wed at all! I
+ love the free life of the woods. I love to hunt, and to ride,
+ and to roam. Why cannot Palamon and Arcite love each other as
+ they used to do long ago, and leave me free?"</p>
+
+ <p>On the morning of the tournament Duke Theseus and his queen
+ sat with Emelia on a high seat overlooking the lists. When the
+ trumpet sounded, Arcite and his knights rode in through the
+ western gate. His red banner shone bright against the white
+ marble pillars. At the same moment Palamon entered from the
+ east, and his white banner floated out against the blue
+ sky.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon the heralds ceased galloping up and down, and the whole
+ space was left to the warriors.</p>
+
+ <p>The trumpets sounded "Advance," and the fray began. Through
+ the bright sunshine they fought, advancing here, and beaten
+ back there, till at last Palamon was hurled from his horse and
+ taken prisoner.</p>
+
+ <p>The trumpets sounded, and all stood still while Theseus
+ called out, "Ho! no more. All is over. Arcite of Thebes khall
+ wed Emelia." Then the people shouted till it seemed that the
+ great marble gates would fall.</p>
+
+ <p>In the eagerness of the fight Emelia had begun to like the
+ warriors who fought for her, and her liking grew ever stronger
+ as they showed their worth. When Arcite rode towards her with
+ glowing face she was proud of him, and leant forward to welcome
+ him gladly.</p>
+
+ <p>But as he galloped, his horse started aside and he was
+ thrown to the ground. He was too much hurt to rise. So he was
+ lifted by his knights and carried to the palace. There he was
+ cared for in every way, but nothing could save him.</p>
+
+ <p>Before he died, he called for Emelia and Palamon.</p>
+
+ <p>"No words can tell the sorrow I bear because I must leave
+ thee, my lady! Alas, death tears me from thee! Farewell, my
+ wife! farewell, my Emelia! Ah, take me softly in thine arms,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page192" id="page192"></a>[pg
+ 192]</span> and listen while I speak! For years I have had
+ strife with my dear cousin Palamon. Yet now I say to thee, in
+ all this world I never have met with one so worthy to be loved
+ as Palamon, that hath served thee, and will serve thee, his
+ life long. Ah, if ever thou dost wed, let it be Palamon!"</p>
+
+ <p>His voice began to fail. "Emelia!" he said, and died.</p>
+
+ <p>Emelia mourned sadly for her valiant knight. As for Palamon,
+ all his old love for Arcite came back, and he wept for him as
+ bitterly as he had bewailed his own sorrow in the dungeon.</p>
+
+ <p>When all the Greeks had ceased to mourn for Arcite, Palamon
+ still grieved for the death of his friend, and for the strife
+ that had been between them.</p>
+
+ <p>After two years Theseus sent one day for Palamon and Emelia.
+ Palamon came to the court in his black robes of mourning; but
+ Emelia was dressed in white, as she had been on the May morning
+ in the garden years before. She had ceased to mourn for Arcite,
+ and was Emelia the Radiant once more.</p>
+
+ <p>Palamon caught his breath. He had not seen her since they
+ parted after Arcite's death.</p>
+
+ <p>Duke Theseus said, "Sister, I desire thee now to take the
+ noble knight Palamon to be thy husband. Have pity on his long
+ service, and accept him."</p>
+
+ <p>Then he said to Palamon, "It will not need much speech to
+ gain thy consent! Come, take thy lady by the hand."</p>
+
+ <p>Then, in the presence of all the court, they were wed. When
+ all was over, Emelia fled from the noise and tumult of the
+ hall, and beckoned to Palamon to follow. Out at the great hall
+ doors she led him, and down the pathway to the garden beneath
+ the tower. When he joined her, she pointed to the dungeon
+ window, and told him of the day when she had looked at the
+ prison in the morning mist, and murmured to herself the names
+ of the captive princes, "Palamon and Arcite, Palamon and
+ Arcite."</p>
+
+ <p>But it was not till many years of joyous life had passed
+ over their home that Palamon told Emelia that he had seen her
+ first on that very morning when she had thought so sadly of his
+ misery.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page193"
+ id="page193"></a>[pg 193]</span>
+
+ <h4>III</h4>
+
+ <h4>GRISELDA</h4>
+
+ <p>Once upon a time there lived a fair young girl whose name
+ was Griselda. Her home was in an Italian village. There she
+ dwelt in a lowly cottage with her father, Janicola. He was too
+ old and weak to work for her, or even for himself.</p>
+
+ <p>All round the village lay the fruitful fields and vineyards
+ of the plain, and on the slopes near grew olive-trees laden
+ with fruit. Far in the distance rose the snow-capped mountains
+ of the North.</p>
+
+ <p>Even in so rich a land it was not easy for this young
+ Griselda to make her father's life as pleasant as she would
+ have wished it to be. She lived plainly and barely. She was
+ busy all day long. Now she was herding a few sheep on the
+ broken ground near the village, and spinning as she watched her
+ flock. Again she fetched the water from the well or gathered
+ roots and herbs from which to make drugs.</p>
+
+ <p>Griselda was not unhappy though her life was hard, because
+ she was so glad that she could serve her father and show her
+ love to him, forgetting about herself and her own wishes.</p>
+
+ <p>One day as she sat watching her sheep her eyes fell on the
+ white towers of a castle that stood not far from the village
+ where she lived. It was the castle of the Marquis Walter, who
+ was lord of all that land. Griselda looked kindly at the white
+ towers. She thought that their master was the best and greatest
+ man in the world. She knew that he was kind also, and
+ courteous. When she saw him ride towards her, her face lighted
+ up, and she rose to courtesy to him. She hoped he would draw up
+ his horse beside her, and greet her, and ask for her father
+ Janicola.</p>
+
+ <p>This morning, as she looked at the castle, she saw a company
+ of men hurrying along the road that led to its gate. Farmers
+ were there in dull and homely clothes, and knights in armor
+ that flashed back the sunlight, and lords in gay colors that
+ glanced and gleamed among the olive-trees under the blue
+ Italian sky.</p>
+
+ <p>Griselda knew why they were going to Lord Walter, and she
+ wondered what they would do and say when they reached him.
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page194" id="page194"></a>[pg
+ 194]</span> She could not go after them, for her sheep would
+ have wandered away if she had left them.</p>
+
+ <p>When the men that Griselda had watched reached the courtyard
+ gate, they met Lord Walter. He was on horseback ready for the
+ hunt. The foremost of the company prayed him to grant them a
+ little time that they might tell him why they had come.</p>
+
+ <p>Lord Walter threw the reins to a squire, and led his people
+ into the great hall of the castle. There he seated himself in
+ state to listen to their grievance whatever it might be.</p>
+
+ <p>Then the same man who had spoken before said to him:</p>
+
+ <p>"Noble Marquis, thy generous kindness in times past giveth
+ us courage to come before thee. Truly, sire, thou and all thou
+ dost art so dear to us that, save in one thing, we cannot wish
+ for better fortune than to live under thy government. One thing
+ alone disturbs the peace of thy faithful people. Though thou
+ art young and strong, yet age creeps on! Time flies and waits
+ for no man. Death threatens young and old alike. We pray thee,
+ sire, that thou wilt wed, for if swift death should lay thee
+ low ere a son be born to thee, then alack for us and for our
+ children! In the power of a stranger then would lie our fair
+ lands and even our lives. Grant us this boon, noble Marquis,
+ and, if thou wilt, we will choose for thee a wife. Noble shall
+ she be, and good, so that thou shalt have honor and gladness in
+ thy wedding."</p>
+
+ <p>Then the Marquis said:</p>
+
+ <p>"My people, loyal and true, ye ask of me that which I
+ thought not to grant, for the free life of the forest and the
+ hunt pleaseth me well. Yet will I do this thing that ye desire.
+ Only to me myself must fall the choice of her whom I will wed.
+ On you I lay this command that, be she who she may, yet shall
+ ye honor her as if she were an Emperor's daughter through all
+ her life. Nor shall ye raise one word against the maiden of my
+ choice. Unless ye agree to this, I will not wed!"</p>
+
+ <p>Gladly the people promised. But ere they left the Marquis,
+ they begged him to fix a day for the marriage lest he should
+ put off too long. The Marquis granted their request, and
+ farmers, knights, and lords trooped joyfully
+ home.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page195"
+ id="page195"></a>[pg 195]</span>
+
+ <p>When the morning of the day that was fixed for the wedding
+ came, the castle of the Marquis was gaily decorated. Flags
+ floated out from the towers, and garlands trailed over the
+ doorway and the gate. Within in the great hall a royal feast
+ was spread, and there lay royal robes and gems.</p>
+
+ <p>In the courtyard and on the terraces lords and ladies stood
+ in groups. Wonder and doubt were on every face. The
+ wedding-feast was prepared, the guests were come, but there was
+ no bride.</p>
+
+ <p>A trumpet sounded "to horse," and all was hurry and noise.
+ Then Lord Walter rode out through the castle gate. He was
+ followed by bearers, who carried the beautiful robes and gems
+ that had lain in the hall.</p>
+
+ <p>They rode out by the same road along which Griselda had
+ watched the people go to ask the Marquis to wed, many months
+ before. Now she saw the bridal train ride down from the castle.
+ "Ah," she said, "they ride this way to fetch the bride. I shall
+ work more busily than ever to-day that I may be free to stand
+ and watch Lord Walter's fair bride as the riders return with
+ her to the castle!"</p>
+
+ <p>Then she went to the well to fetch water. When she came back
+ she found Lord Walter at her father's door. In the narrow lane
+ beside the cottage stood lords and ladies, while their horses
+ impatiently pawed the ground.</p>
+
+ <p>Quickly Griselda set her pitcher in a trough near the
+ cottage door, and knelt before the Marquis to hear his
+ will.</p>
+
+ <p>"Where is thy father?" Lord Walter asked.</p>
+
+ <p>"Close at hand, my Lord," said Griselda, and went to bring
+ him without delay.</p>
+
+ <p>"My faithful servant," said Lord Walter to the old man,
+ "grant me thy daughter for my wife!"</p>
+
+ <p>Janicola knew not what to say for surprise. At last he
+ answered, "My will is thine! Do as thou wilt, my own dear
+ Lord!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Then must I ask Griselda if she will be my wife; but stay
+ thou by us. Thou shalt hear her answer."</p>
+
+ <p>Griselda was amazed. She did not know what the meaning of
+ Lord Walter's visit was, and when she stood before him her
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page196" id="page196"></a>[pg
+ 196]</span> face was full of fear. Her wonder was very great
+ when she heard him say:</p>
+
+ <p>"Griselda, I am come for thee. Thee only will I wed. Thy
+ father also is willing. But ere thou tell me whether or no thou
+ wilt be my bride, listen to the demand I make. Art thou ready
+ to obey me in everything, and to let me do to thee evil or good
+ as I will without so much as turning to me a frowning
+ face?"</p>
+
+ <p>This seemed a strange request to Grisdda, but she loved and
+ trusted Lord Walter so truly that she said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Lord, I am not worthy of this honor. Verily in all things
+ thy will shall be mine. Life is sweet, but I will die rather
+ than displease thee."</p>
+
+ <p>"Enough, Griselda!" he said.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Lord Walter turned to the courtiers and the people of
+ the village who had gathered round:</p>
+
+ <p>"Behold my wife! Let all show their love to me by the honor
+ and love they bear to her."</p>
+
+ <p>The ladies of the court were commanded to take off
+ Griselda's old clothes and to array her in the costly robes
+ they had brought with them. They did not like to touch the poor
+ soiled clothes she wore, nor to move about in the little
+ cottage with their sweeping gowns; but the gentleness of
+ Griselda made it pleasant to help her. They caught up
+ Griselda's royal robes with great clasps of gold set with gems,
+ and put a crown on her beautiful hair.</p>
+
+ <p>She came out and stood in the low doorway, where she had so
+ often stood before. But now the people scarcely knew her: she
+ looked so fair in her new robes and with the love-light shining
+ in her eyes.</p>
+
+ <p>Lord Walter did not wait till he reached the castle. He was
+ married to Griselda at her father's cottage door. The villagers
+ gathered round and gazed at the simple wedding. They saw Lord
+ Walter put a great ring on Griselda's finger, and lift her on
+ to a milk-white steed. Then they led her with joy towards the
+ castle. Wedding-bells rang out gladly across the plain, and
+ ever as the wedding-party drew near to the white towers with
+ their floating flags, happy bands of people came to meet and
+ welcome Griselda.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page197"
+ id="page197"></a>[pg 197]</span>
+
+ <p>Very soon the fame of Lord Walter's beautiful wife spread
+ through the land. Nor was it only for her beauty that men
+ praised her. Gracious she was and wise, able to rule her home,
+ and to bend fiery spirits to her will.</p>
+
+ <p>From all the countryside men came to her in trouble. Every
+ one rejoiced in the good fortune that had come to their land,
+ and some even called her an angel from heaven come to right all
+ wrong.</p>
+
+ <p>After some time a daughter was born to Griselda. Then she
+ thought she was the happiest woman in the world. She thought of
+ the care that she would give her child as she grew up, and of
+ Lord Walter's delight in his little daughter when the time
+ should come that she could talk and ride with him.</p>
+
+ <p>But before the baby was a year old, all Griselda's dreams
+ were broken. Lord Walter said to himself, "It is easy for
+ Griselda to keep her promise when I ask of her nothing that is
+ not just and right. How can I trust her until I know that she
+ will obey me in everything? I wonder whether she would be
+ patient still if I hurt our little daughter."</p>
+
+ <p>These thoughts came back to his mind so often that at last
+ he resolved to try Griselda's patience by taking away her baby
+ from her.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/196.jpg" name="fig196s"
+ id="fig196s"><img width="300" src="images/196s.jpg"
+ alt="THE CURTAIN AT THE DOORWAY WAS DRAWN ASIDE" />
+ </a><br />
+ the curtain at the doorway was drawn aside
+ </div>
+
+ <p>One evening Griselda was playing with her little child. The
+ baby laughed in her arms and looked sweeter than ever. At that
+ moment the curtain at the doorway was drawn aside and Lord
+ Walter came into the room. His face was sad and drawn, and as
+ Griselda looked up at him she feared that some great blow had
+ fallen on him, or that some enemy had entered the country.</p>
+
+ <p>Lord Walter said to her:</p>
+
+ <p>"Griselda, thou hast not forgotten the day on which I
+ brought thee from thy father's lowly cottage to this my castle.
+ Although thou art most dear to me, thou art not dear to my
+ nobles. They say that it is hard that they should serve one so
+ lowly born as thou. Since thy daughter was born they have said
+ this more and more, I doubt not. As thou knowest, my will is to
+ live with my people in joy and peace. Therefore must I do to my
+ child not as I wish myself, but as my nobles
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page198" id="page198"></a>[pg
+ 198]</span> wish. Show then to me the obedience that thou didst
+ promise to show when thou wert wed in the village street."</p>
+
+ <p>As Griselda heard these words she made no moan. Neither did
+ she let the pain that caught at her heart be seen in her face.
+ When she could speak, she said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Lord, we are thine! My child is thine. I also am thine.
+ With thine own thou mayest ever do as pleaseth thee best."</p>
+
+ <p>The Marquis was full of joy because of the patience and
+ humbleness of Griselda; but he appeared to be sad, and left her
+ with a troubled face.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon after this, Griselda started as she heard a heavy
+ footstep on the stairway. Then an evil-looking man walked into
+ the quiet room.</p>
+
+ <p>"Madam," he said, "I must obey my lord's will. He bids me
+ take this child. Thou knowest we must obey, although we may
+ complain and mourn."</p>
+
+ <p>Then the soldier took the child so roughly that it seemed as
+ if he would kill it before her. Griselda said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Pray, sir, do thou suffer me to kiss my child ere it die."
+ He gave it back to her. Gently she gathered it in her arms. She
+ blessed it, and lulled it, and kissed it. Then she said in her
+ sweet voice: "Farewell, my child, I shall see thee never again.
+ The blessing of Him who died on a cross of wood for us, rest on
+ thee. To Him I give thy soul, my little one! To-night thou must
+ die because of me."</p>
+
+ <p>To the rough soldier she said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Take again the child and obey my Lord. But if it please my
+ Lord, then of thy kindness bury thou the little body where no
+ cruel bird nor beast can harm it!"</p>
+
+ <p>But in silence the soldier carried away the child.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Lord Walter looked to see if Griselda would fret or be
+ less kind to him. He watched, but could see no change in her.
+ She was as busy and loving and cheerful as ever. Neither in
+ earnest nor in play did she name her child.</p>
+
+ <p>After four years a son was born to Griselda. The people were
+ very glad because there was now an heir to rule the land at the
+ death of Lord Walter. Griselda too was happy, though her
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page199" id="page199"></a>[pg
+ 199]</span> heart longed for the little maid who might have
+ been playing with her brother.</p>
+
+ <p>When the boy was two years old, Lord Walter began to wish
+ once more to try the patience of Griselda.</p>
+
+ <p>This time he said to her:</p>
+
+ <p>"Wife, I have told thee before how ill the people bear our
+ marriage. Now that a son is born they are more wrathful than
+ before. My heart is weary with the thought of their complaints.
+ They say, 'When Lord Walter is gone, the grandson of Janicola
+ shall rule us!' Therefore I shall do with my son as I did with
+ his sister. Be patient, I pray thee."</p>
+
+ <p>"Thou art my Lord," said Griselda. "My will and my freedom
+ lie in my father's cottage with the poor soiled clothes I left
+ there on the day thou didst bring me hither. Could I know thy
+ will before thou didst tell it to me, it would be done, though
+ it were death to do it. Life cannot compare with thy love."</p>
+
+ <p>Lord Walter looked down to the ground. He could not look at
+ his wife lest he should not have heart to do as he wished.</p>
+
+ <p>Again the rude soldier came to Griselda. He was even harsher
+ than before, and carried off the child without a kind word to
+ the patient mother.</p>
+
+ <p>When the little boy was gone, the people said very bitter
+ things about Lord Walter. The love they had given him before
+ was turned into hatred because he had treated his beautiful
+ wife so unkindly, and because he had murdered his children.</p>
+
+ <p>Though Lord Walter saw this, he wished to try his wife once
+ more. He knew that he could send away his wife and marry
+ another if he got a letter from the Pope to say that he might.
+ He sent a messenger to Rome, where the Pope lived. This
+ messenger was told to bring back a letter, not from the Pope,
+ but as like one of his as possible.</p>
+
+ <p>The letter came. It said that because of the anger of Lord
+ Walter's people at the lowly birth of his wife Griselda, the
+ Marquis might send her away and marry another.</p>
+
+ <p>The news of the letter spread throughout the land. Every one
+ believed that it had really come from the Pope.</p>
+
+ <p>Griselda's heart was very sore when she heard of this
+ letter. <span class="pagenum"><a name="page200"
+ id="page200"></a>[pg 200]</span> But she went on quietly with
+ each day's work. She did not even speak of the letter to her
+ husband.</p>
+
+ <p>At last Lord Walter spoke before all his court, and with no
+ knightly gentleness.</p>
+
+ <p>"Griselda," he said, "there is no freedom in the life of one
+ who rules. I may not act after my own wish as any laborer on my
+ land may do. As thou knowest, my people hate thy presence, and
+ demand of me that I wed another. The Pope's letter thou hast
+ heard. Return then, swiftly and without complaint, to thy
+ father's cottage, for already my bride cometh hither."</p>
+
+ <p>"My Lord, it is no new thought to me, that I am unworthy to
+ be thy servant&mdash;far more unworthy to be thy wife. In this
+ great house of which thou didst make me queen, I have not acted
+ as mistress, but only as lowly handmaid to thee. For these
+ years of thy kindness, I thank thee. Gladly do I go to my
+ father's house. There he tended me when I was but a child. Now
+ I will stay with him till death enters the cottage door. To
+ thee and to thy bride be joy. To her I willingly yield the
+ place where I have been so happy. Since thou, who once wert all
+ my joy, wilt have me go, I go!"</p>
+
+ <p>Lord Walter turned away in sadness. He could scarcely speak
+ for pity, but he held to his purpose.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Griselda drew her wedding-ring from her finger, and
+ laid it down. Beside it she put the gems that Lord Walter had
+ given her. Her beautiful robes she laid aside. In the simplest
+ gown she could find, and with head and feet all bare, Griselda
+ went down through the olive trees towards her father's
+ house.</p>
+
+ <p>Many of Lord Walter's people followed her, weeping and
+ bewailing the fickleness of fortune. Griselda did not turn to
+ them, nor speak, nor weep. She quietly went on her way.</p>
+
+ <p>When the tidings reached her father, he wished that he had
+ never been born, so sad was he in the sorrow of his beautiful
+ daughter. He hastened out to meet her, and wrapped her tenderly
+ in her old cloak, and led her home with tears.</p>
+
+ <p>Griselda spoke no word of complaint, nor did she speak of
+ her former happiness. Once more she tended the sheep on the
+ common. Once more she carried water from the well. Once more
+ she thought first of her
+ father.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page201"
+ id="page201"></a>[pg 201]</span>
+
+ <p>After some weeks Lord Walter sent for Griselda. She went to
+ the castle and greeted him humbly as of old. She showed no
+ grudge because of his unkindness.</p>
+
+ <p>"Griselda," he said, "thou knowest, as doth no other, how
+ all this castle should be ordered for my pleasure. Stay thou
+ then, and have all in readiness for the fair young bride whom I
+ shall wed to-morrow. It is my will that she be welcomed
+ royally."</p>
+
+ <p>"My whole desire is to serve thee, my Lord. Neither weal nor
+ woe shall ever make me cease to love thee with all my
+ heart."</p>
+
+ <p>At once Griselda took control of all who worked in the
+ castle. Of them all she was the neatest and the quickest. Soon
+ every room in the tower was sweet and clean. The great hall was
+ decked for the wedding-feast, and the table glittered with
+ silver.</p>
+
+ <p>Early next morning many horsemen came to the castle. Among
+ them was a beautiful girl dressed in a shimmering white robe.
+ Near her rode a charming boy younger than the maiden. Round
+ them were many nobles, and a guard of soldiers, who had brought
+ them to Lord Walter's court.</p>
+
+ <p>The people crowded round the gates. So charmed were they
+ with the fair young maid, that some of them forgot their love
+ for Griselda, and were ready to welcome the bride whose coming
+ caused her so much sorrow.</p>
+
+ <p>Still Griselda moved about the castle in her old worn
+ clothes. She went to the gate to welcome the bride. Then she
+ received the guests and greeted each of them according to his
+ degree.</p>
+
+ <p>The stranger nobles wondered who Griselda could be. She was
+ so wise and gentle, and yet so meanly dressed.</p>
+
+ <p>Before the feast began, Lord Walter called Griselda to him.
+ Then he asked her, "What dost thou think of my wife? Is she
+ beautiful?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Never have I seen a fairer," said Griselda. "Joy be with
+ you both evermore! But oh! I beg of thee, torment not this
+ child as thou didst me. She has been tenderly cared for. She
+ could not bear what I have borne."</p>
+
+ <p>When Lord Walter saw her great patience, and thought of the
+ pain he had caused her, his heart went out to her in great
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page202" id="page202"></a>[pg
+ 202]</span> pity, and he cried, "It is enough, Griselda; fear
+ no more, nor be thou longer sad. I have tried thy faith and thy
+ sweetness, as faith and sweetness have never before been
+ tried."</p>
+
+ <p>His arms were around her, and he kissed her. Griselda looked
+ at him in wonder. She could not understand.</p>
+
+ <p>"Griselda," he said, "thou art my wife. I have no other.
+ This is thy daughter; her brother is my heir. Thine are they
+ both. Take them again, and dream not that thou art bereft of
+ thy children."</p>
+
+ <p>When Griselda heard all this she fainted away in her great
+ joy. When she woke again she called her children to her.
+ Timidly they came, but soon they were caught close to her
+ breast. While she fondled them, and kissed them, her hot tears
+ of joy fell on their fair faces, and on their hair. Then she
+ looked at Lord Walter, and said, "Death cannot harm me now,
+ since thou lovest me still." Then she turned back to the
+ children.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh tender, oh dear, oh little ones, my children! Your
+ sorrowful mother thought that cruel dogs or other fearsome
+ beasts had torn you! but God has kept you safe."</p>
+
+ <p>Once again the ladies of the court dressed Griselda in royal
+ robes. Once again they set a golden crown upon her head. Once
+ again the wedding-ring slipped into its own place on her
+ finger.</p>
+
+ <p>Ere she entered the hall of feasting again, swift messengers
+ had brought her old father, Janicola, to the castle, never to
+ leave it again.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Griselda sat with her children beside her husband. To
+ her feet came lords and nobles, peasants and farmers, eager to
+ kiss her hand and to show the joy they felt in her return.</p>
+
+ <p>Never had the walls of the castle reechoed the laughter of
+ so glad a people. All day long till the stars shone in the cool
+ clear sky the feasting went on.</p>
+
+ <p>For Griselda this was the first of many happy days, happier
+ than she had known before.</p>
+
+ <p>In her home sounded the gay voices of happy children as they
+ played with, and cared for, the old grandfather whom their
+ mother loved so dearly. And ever as she moved about the castle
+ she met the eyes of Lord Walter, that told her again and yet
+ again that he trusted her utterly.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page203"
+ id="page203"></a>[pg 203]</span>
+
+ <h3>THE PILGRIM'S PROGRESS</h3>
+
+ <h3>By JOHN BUNYAN</h3>
+
+ <h4>ADAPTED BY MARY MACGREGOR</h4>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <p>As I slept I dreamed a dream. I dreamed, and behold, I saw a
+ man clothed with rags, standing in a certain place, with his
+ face away from his own house, a book in his hand, and a great
+ burden upon his back. I looked, and saw him open the book, and
+ read therein, and as he read, he wept and trembled. His fear
+ was so great that he brake out with a mournful cry, saying,
+ "What shall I do?"</p>
+
+ <p>In this plight therefore he went home, and did all he could
+ to hide his distress from his wife and children. But he could
+ not be silent long, because his trouble increased. Wherefore at
+ length he began to talk to his wife and children thus: "O my
+ dear wife," said he, "and you my children, I am in despair by
+ reason of a burden that lieth heavy on me. Moreover I am for
+ certain told that this our city will be burned with fire from
+ heaven, when both myself, with thee, my wife, and you, my sweet
+ babes, shall be ruined, except some way of escape can be
+ found." At this his wife and children were sore amazed, not
+ because they believed that what he had said to them was true,
+ but because they thought he must be ill to talk in so strange a
+ way. Therefore, as it was evening, and they hoped sleep might
+ soothe him, with all haste they got him to bed. But the night
+ was as troublesome to him as the day, wherefore instead of
+ sleeping he spent it in sighs and tears.</p>
+
+ <p>So when the morning was come, they asked him how he did. He
+ told them, "Worse and worse," and began to talk to them again
+ in the same strange manner, but they began to be careless of
+ his words. They also thought to drive away his fancies by harsh
+ and rough behavior to him. Sometimes they would mock, sometimes
+ they would scold, and sometimes they
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page204" id="page204"></a>[pg
+ 204]</span> would quite neglect him. Wherefore he began to stay
+ in his room to pray for and pity them, and also to comfort his
+ own misery. He would also walk alone in the fields, sometimes
+ reading and sometimes praying, and thus for some days he spent
+ his time.</p>
+
+ <p>Now I saw in my dream that when he was walking in the
+ fields, he was reading his book and greatly distressed in mind.
+ And as he read, he burst out crying, "What shall I do to be
+ saved?" I saw also that he looked this way and that way, as if
+ he would run. Yet he stood still, because, as I saw, he could
+ not tell which way to go. I looked then, and saw a man, named
+ Evangelist, coming to him, who asked, "Wherefore dost thou
+ cry?"</p>
+
+ <p>He answered, "Sir, I see by the book in my hand that I am
+ condemned to die, and after that to be judged. And I find I am
+ not willing to die, nor able to be judged."</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Evangelist, "Why not willing to die, since in this
+ life you are so unhappy?"</p>
+
+ <p>The man answered, "Because I fear this burden will sink me
+ lower than the grave, and the thought of that makes me
+ cry."</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Evangelist, "If this be thy fear, why standest
+ thou still?"</p>
+
+ <p>He answered, "Because I know not whither to go."</p>
+
+ <p>So Evangelist gave him a parchment roll, and there was
+ written within, "Fly from the wrath to come." The man therefore
+ read it, and looking upon Evangelist very carefully, said,
+ "Whither must I fly!"</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Evangelist, pointing with his finger over a very
+ wide field, "Do you see yonder Wicket-gate?"</p>
+
+ <p>The man said, "No."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," said the other, "do you see yonder shining
+ light?"</p>
+
+ <p>He said, "I think I do."</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Evangelist, "Keep that light in thine eye, and go
+ up directly thereto, so shalt thou see the gate. When thou
+ knockest, it shall be told thee what thou shalt do."</p>
+
+ <p>So I saw in my dream that the man began to run. Now he had
+ not run far from his own door when his wife and children,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page205" id="page205"></a>[pg
+ 205]</span> seeing it, began to cry after him to return. But
+ the man put his fingers in his ears, and ran on, crying, "Life,
+ life, eternal life!" So he looked not behind him, but fled
+ towards the middle of the plain. The neighbors also came out to
+ see him run. And as he ran some mocked, others threatened, and
+ some cried after him to return. Among those that did so were
+ two that were resolved to fetch him back by force. The name of
+ the one was Obstinate, and the name of the other was Pliable.
+ Now by this time the man was got a good distance from them, but
+ they had made up their minds to follow him, which they did, and
+ in a little time overtook him.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said the man, "Neighbors, wherefore are you come?"</p>
+
+ <p>They said, "To persuade you to go back with us."</p>
+
+ <p>But he said, "That can by no means be. You dwell in the City
+ of Destruction, the place where I was born. Be content, good
+ neighbors, and go along with me."</p>
+
+ <p>"What!" said Obstinate, "and leave our friends and our
+ comforts behind us!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Christian, for that was his name.</p>
+
+ <p>"What do you seek, since you leave all the world to find
+ it?" said Obstinate.</p>
+
+ <p>"I seek a treasure that never fades away. It is laid up in
+ heaven and is safe there," said Christian. "Read it so, if you
+ will, in my book."</p>
+
+ <p>"Tush!" said Obstinate, "away with your book. Will you go
+ back with us or no?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, not I," said the other, "because I have just set
+ out."</p>
+
+ <p>"Come then, Neighbor Pliable, let us turn again and go home
+ without him."</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Pliable, "If what the good Christian says is true,
+ the things he looks after are better than ours. My heart makes
+ me wish to go with him. But, my good Christian, do you know the
+ way you are going?"</p>
+
+ <p>"I am directed by a man, whose name is Evangelist, to speed
+ me to a little gate that is before us, where we shall be told
+ about the way."</p>
+
+ <p>"Come then, good neighbor," said Pliable, "let us be going."
+ Then they went both
+ together.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page206"
+ id="page206"></a>[pg 206]</span>
+
+ <p>"And I will go back to my place," said Obstinate. "I will be
+ no companion of such mistaken and foolish fellows."</p>
+
+ <p>Now I saw in my dream that when Obstinate was gone back,
+ Christian and Pliable went talking over the plain. "I will tell
+ you what my book says of the country to which we are going, and
+ of the people we shall meet there," said Christian.</p>
+
+ <p>"But do you think the words of your book are certainly
+ true?" said Pliable.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Christian, "for it was written by Him who cannot
+ lie."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," said Pliable, "tell me about this country."</p>
+
+ <p>"In this country," said Christian, "we shall live for ever.
+ There are crowns of glory to be given us, and garments that
+ will make us shine like the sun."</p>
+
+ <p>"This is excellent," said Pliable; "and what else?"</p>
+
+ <p>"There shall be no more crying nor sorrow, for He that is
+ the Owner of the place will wipe all tears from our eyes," said
+ Christian.</p>
+
+ <p>"And what companions shall we have there?" asked
+ Pliable.</p>
+
+ <p>"There we shall be with those that will dazzle your eyes to
+ look on. There also you shall meet with thousands and tens of
+ thousands that have gone before us to that place. None of of
+ them are hurtful, but loving and holy. In a word, there shall
+ we see some with their golden crowns, there we shall see
+ maidens with golden harps, there we shall see men that here
+ were cut in pieces, burnt in flames, eaten by beasts, and
+ drowned in the seas, all for the love they bare to the Lord of
+ this place. Now they are all well, and clothed with beautiful
+ garments."</p>
+
+ <p>And as Pliable heard of the excellence of the country and of
+ the company to which they were going, he said, "Well, my good
+ companion, glad I am to hear of these things. Come on, let us
+ go with more speed."</p>
+
+ <p>"I cannot go as fast as I would by reason of this burden
+ that is on my back," said Christian.</p>
+
+ <p>Now I saw in my dream that just as they ended their talk,
+ they drew nigh to a bog that was in the midst of the plain, and
+ they being heedless did both fall suddenly into it. The name of
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page207" id="page207"></a>[pg
+ 207]</span> this bog was the Slough of Despond. Here therefore
+ they struggled for a time, being grievously covered with dirt.
+ And Christian, because of the burden that was on his back,
+ began to sink in the mire. Then said Pliable, "Ah, Neighbor
+ Christian, where are you now?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Truly," said Christian, "I do not know."</p>
+
+ <p>At this Pliable began to be offended, and said angrily, "Is
+ this the happiness you have told me of all this while? If I get
+ out again with my life, you shall possess the wonderful country
+ alone."</p>
+
+ <p>And with that he gave a desperate struggle or two, and got
+ out of the mire on that side of the bog which was next to his
+ own house. So away he went, and Christian saw him no more.
+ Wherefore Christian was left to tumble in the Slough of Despond
+ alone. But still he tried to struggle to that side of the
+ Slough that was further from his own house, and next to the
+ Wicket-gate. But he could not get out because of the burden
+ that was upon his back.</p>
+
+ <p>And I beheld in my dream that a man came to him, whose name
+ was Help, and asked him what he did there. "Sir," said
+ Christian, "I was bid to go this way by a man called
+ Evangelist, who directed me also to yonder gate, and as I was
+ going thither I fell in here."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why did you not look for the steps?" said Help.</p>
+
+ <p>"I was so full of fear," answered Christian, "that I fled
+ the next way and fell in."</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Help, "Give me thy hand." So Christian gave him
+ his hand, and he drew him out and set him upon sound ground,
+ and bid him go on his way.</p>
+
+ <p>Now in my dream I stepped up to the man that plucked
+ Christian out, and said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Sir, wherefore, since over this place is the way from the
+ City of Destruction to the Wicket-gate, is it that this Slough
+ is not mended, that poor travelers might go over in more
+ safety?"</p>
+
+ <p>And he said to me, "This place cannot be mended, yet it is
+ not the pleasure of the King that it should remain so bad. His
+ laborers also have for more than sixteen hundred years been
+ employed on this patch of ground, in the hope that it might
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page208" id="page208"></a>[pg
+ 208]</span> perhaps be mended. There has been swallowed up here
+ twenty thousand cartloads of the best material in the attempt
+ to mend the place. But it is the Slough of Despond still; and
+ still will be so, when they have done all they can. It is true
+ that there are some good and strong steps even through the very
+ midst of this mire. But men through the dizziness of their head
+ miss the steps and so tumble into the mire, but the ground is
+ good when they have once got in at the gate."</p>
+
+ <p>Then I saw in my dream that by this time Pliable was got
+ home to his house. So his neighbors came to visit him, and some
+ of them called him wise man for coming back, and some called
+ him fool for going with Christian. Others again did mock at his
+ cowardliness, saying, "Surely since you began to go, you need
+ not have been so base as to have given out for a few
+ difficulties." So Pliable sat like a coward among them.</p>
+
+ <p>Now as Christian was walking alone, he espied one afar off,
+ come crossing over the field to meet him. The gentleman's name
+ was Mr. Worldly Wiseman. He dwelt in a very great town, close
+ by the one from which Christian came. This man, then, meeting
+ with Christian, began thus to enter into some talk with him:
+ "How now, good fellow, whither are you going in this burdened
+ manner?"</p>
+
+ <p>"A burdened manner indeed," said Christian. "I am going,
+ sir, to yonder Wicket-gate before me, for there, I am told, I
+ shall be put into a way to be rid of my heavy burden."</p>
+
+ <p>"Hast thou a wife and children?" asked Mr. Worldly
+ Wiseman.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, but I am so laden with this burden that I cannot take
+ that pleasure in them as formerly."</p>
+
+ <p>"Will you hearken to me if I give thee counsel?"</p>
+
+ <p>"If it be good, I will, for I stand in need of good
+ counsel."</p>
+
+ <p>"I would advise thee, then, that thou with all speed get
+ thyself rid of thy burden, for thou wilt never be contented
+ till then."</p>
+
+ <p>"That is what I seek for, even to be rid of this heavy
+ burden, but get it off myself I cannot, nor is there any man
+ living in our country who can take it off my shoulders.
+ Therefore I am going this way, as I told you, that I may be rid
+ of my burden."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page209"
+ id="page209"></a>[pg 209]</span>
+
+ <p>"Who bid thee go this way to be rid of thy burden?"</p>
+
+ <p>"A man that appeared to me a very great and honorable
+ person. His name, as I remember, is Evangelist."</p>
+
+ <p>"He has given thee foolish counsel. There is not a more
+ dangerous and troublesome way in the world than is that unto
+ which he hath directed thee. Thou hast met with some danger
+ already, for I see the mud of the Slough of Despond is upon
+ thee. Hear me, I am older than thou. Thou art likely to meet
+ with, in the way which thou goest, painfulness, hunger,
+ nakedness, sword, lions, dragons, darkness, and death."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, sir, this burden upon my back is more terrible to me
+ than all these things."</p>
+
+ <p>"But why wilt thou seek for ease this way, seeing so many
+ dangers attend it? Hadst thou but patience to listen, I could
+ direct thee how to get what thou desirest, without the danger
+ that thou in this way wilt run thyself into."</p>
+
+ <p>"Sir, I pray that thou wilt tell me this secret."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, in yonder village there dwells a gentleman, who is
+ very wise, and who has skill to help men off with burdens like
+ thine from their shoulders. To him thou mayest go to be helped
+ at once. His house is not quite a mile from this place, and if
+ thou dost not desire to go back to the City of Destruction, as
+ indeed I would not wish thee, thou mayest send for thy wife and
+ children to come to thee to this village. There are houses now
+ standing empty, one of which thou mayest have without great
+ cost. Food is there also, cheap and good, and what will make
+ thy life the more happy is, that thou shalt live beside honest
+ neighbors, in respect and comfort."</p>
+
+ <p>Now the Christian puzzled, but he thought, "If what Mr.
+ Worldly Wiseman says is true, my wisest plan is to take his
+ advice."</p>
+
+ <p>"Sir," said Christian, "which is my way to this honest man's
+ house?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Do you see yonder high hill?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, very well."</p>
+
+ <p>"By that hill you must go, and the first house you come to
+ is his."</p>
+
+ <p>So Christian turned out of his way to go to the house for
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page210" id="page210"></a>[pg
+ 210]</span> help. But behold, when he was now close to the
+ hill, it seemed so steep, and also that side of it that was
+ next the wayside did hang so much over, that Christian was
+ afraid to venture farther, lest the hill should fall on his
+ head. Wherefore he stood still, and knew not what to do. Also
+ his burden now seemed heavier to him than while he was in his
+ way. There came also flashes of fire out of the hill, that made
+ Christian afraid that he should be burned. Here therefore he
+ did quake for fear. And now he began to be sorry that he had
+ taken Mr. Worldly Wiseman's counsel. Then he saw Evangelist
+ coming to meet him, at the sight also of whom he began to blush
+ for shame. So Evangelist drew nearer and nearer, and coming up
+ to him, he looked upon him with a severe and dreadful
+ countenance.</p>
+
+ <p>"What dost thou here, Christian?" said he. At which words
+ Christian knew not what to answer, wherefore at first he stood
+ speechless before him. Then said Evangelist, "Art not thou the
+ man I found crying without the walls of the City of
+ Destruction?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Christian, "I am the man."</p>
+
+ <p>"Did I not direct thee the way to the little
+ Wicket-gate?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Christian.</p>
+
+ <p>"How is it, then, that thou art so quickly turned out of the
+ way?"</p>
+
+ <p>"I met with a gentleman as soon as I had got over the Slough
+ of Despond, who told me that in yonder village I might find a
+ man who could take off my burden."</p>
+
+ <p>"What was he like?"</p>
+
+ <p>"He looked like a gentleman, and talked much to me, and got
+ me at last to believe his words. So I came hither, but when I
+ beheld this hill and how it hangs over the way, I suddenly
+ stood still lest it should fall on my head."</p>
+
+ <p>"What said that gentleman to you?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, he asked me whither I was going, and if I had a wife
+ and children, and he bid me make speed to get rid of my burden.
+ And I said, 'I am going to yonder gate to be told how I may get
+ rid of it.'</p>
+
+ <p>"So he said he would show me a better and a shorter way, and
+ not so full of difficulties as the way that you directed me.
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page211" id="page211"></a>[pg
+ 211]</span> But when I came to this place, I stopped for fear
+ of danger, and now I know not what to do!" So Christian stood
+ trembling before Evangelist.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Evangelist, "Give heed to the things I shall tell
+ thee. Mr. Worldly Wiseman sought to turn thee out of the way
+ and to bring thee into danger. In yonder village has no man
+ ever yet got rid of his burden, nor is he ever likely to lose
+ it there. Therefore, Mr. Worldly Wiseman and his friend are
+ deceivers, and cannot help thee."</p>
+
+ <p>After this there came words and fire out of the mountain
+ under which Christian stood. Now Christian looked for nothing
+ but death, and began to cry out, saying he would he had never
+ met Mr. Worldly Wiseman or that he had never listened to him.
+ Then he turned to Evangelist and said, "Sir, what do you think?
+ Is there any hope? May I now go back and go up to the
+ Wicket-gate? Or shall I be sent back from the gate ashamed? I
+ am sorry I have listened to this man's counsel, but may my sins
+ be forgiven?"</p>
+
+ <p>Evangelist said to him, "Thy sin is very great. Thou hast
+ left the good way and walked in forbidden paths. Yet will the
+ man at the gate receive thee, for he has good will for men.
+ Only," said he, "take heed that thou turn not aside again."</p>
+
+ <p>Then did Christian prepare to go back. And Evangelist, after
+ he had kissed him, gave him one smile, and bid him Godspeed. So
+ Christian went on with haste, neither spake he to any man by
+ the way. Even if any one spoke to him, he would not venture an
+ answer. He walked like one that was all the while treading on
+ forbidden ground, and could by no means think himself safe,
+ till again he had got into the way which he had left to follow
+ Mr. Worldly Wiseman's counsel. So in process of time Christian
+ got up to the gate. Now over the gate there was written,
+ "Knock, and it shall be opened unto you." He knocked therefore
+ more than once or twice. At last there came a grave person to
+ the gate, named Good-will. He asked who was there, and whence
+ he came, and what he desired.</p>
+
+ <p>"I am a sinner," said Christian; "I come from the City of
+ Destruction, but am going to Mount Zion. I am told that by
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page212" id="page212"></a>[pg
+ 212]</span> this gate is the way thither, and I would know if
+ you are willing to let me in."</p>
+
+ <p>"I am willing with all my heart," said Good-will, and he
+ opened the gate. So when Christian was stepping in, the other
+ gave him a pull.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why do you do that?" said Christian.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Good-will told him, "A little distance from this gate a
+ strong castle has been built, of which Beelzebub is the
+ captain. And he and those that are with him shoot arrows at
+ those that come up to this gate, hoping they may die before
+ they enter in."</p>
+
+ <p>So when Christian had come in, Good-will asked him who had
+ directed him to the gate.</p>
+
+ <p>"Evangelist bid me come here and knock, as I did. And he
+ said that you, sir, would tell me what I must do."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Good-will said, "Come a little way with me, good
+ Christian, and I will teach thee about the way thou must go.
+ Look before thee; dost thou see this narrow way? That is the
+ way thou must go, and it is as straight as a rule can make it.
+ This is the way thou must go."</p>
+
+ <p>"But," said Christian, "are there no turnings, nor windings,
+ by which a stranger may lose his way?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, there are many ways join this, but they are crooked
+ and wide. Thou mayest know the right from the wrong way, for
+ the right way is always strait and narrow."</p>
+
+ <p>Then I saw in my dream that Christian asked him if he could
+ not help him off with his burden that was upon his back. For as
+ yet he had not got rid of it, nor could he get it off without
+ help. But Good-will said, "Thou must be content to bear it,
+ until thou comest to a place where stands a Cross, for there it
+ will fall from thy back of itself."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Christian began to get ready to continue his journey.
+ So Good-will told him that when he had gone some distance from
+ the gate, he would come to the house of the Interpreter, at
+ whose door he should knock, and he would show him wonderful
+ things. Then Christian took leave of his friend, and he again
+ bid him Godspeed. Now Christian went on till he came to the
+ house of the Interpreter, where he knocked over and over. At
+ last one came to the door and asked who was
+ there.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page213"
+ id="page213"></a>[pg 213]</span>
+
+ <p>"Sir," said Christian, "I am a traveler who was told by
+ Good-will to call here. I would therefore speak with the master
+ of the house." So he called for the master of the house, who,
+ after a little time, came to Christian and asked what he would
+ have.</p>
+
+ <p>"Sir," said Christian, "I am a man that has come from the
+ City of Destruction, and I am going to Mount Zion. I was told
+ by the man that stands at the Wicket-gate that if I called here
+ you would show me things that would help me on my journey."</p>
+
+ <p>Then said the Interpreter, "Come in, and I will show thee
+ what will help thee." So he commanded his man to light the
+ candle, and bid Christian follow him. Then he took him into a
+ private room, and bid his man open a door. And Christian saw
+ the picture of a very grave person hung up against the wall. He
+ had eyes lifted up to heaven, the best of books in his hand,
+ and a crown of gold did hang over his head.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Christian, "What means this?"</p>
+
+ <p>"The man whose picture this is," answered the Interpreter,
+ "is one of a thousand. He is the only man who may be thy guide
+ in all difficult places thou mayest meet with in the way.
+ Wherefore be very careful to remember whom thou hast seen."</p>
+
+ <p>Then the Interpreter led him into a very large parlor that
+ was full of dust, because it was never swept, and after he had
+ looked at it for a little while, the Interpreter called for a
+ man to sweep. Now when he began to sweep, the dust began to fly
+ about, so that Christian was almost choked. Then said the
+ Interpreter to a damsel that stood near, "Bring hither the
+ water and sprinkle the room." And when this was done the room
+ was swept and cleansed.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Christian, "What does this mean?"</p>
+
+ <p>The Interpreter answered, "This parlor is like the heart of
+ an evil man. The dust is his sin, and the damsel that sprinkles
+ the water is the Gospel."</p>
+
+ <p>I saw moreover in my dream, that the Interpreter took
+ Christian by the hand and led him into a little room, where sat
+ two little children, each one in his chair. The name of the
+ eldest was Passion, and the name of the other Patience. Passion
+ seemed to be very discontented, but Patience was very
+ quiet.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page214"
+ id="page214"></a>[pg 214]</span>
+
+ <p>Then Christian asked, "What is the reason of the discontent
+ of Passion?"</p>
+
+ <p>The Interpreter answered, "The governor of the children
+ would have them wait for their new toys, till the beginning of
+ next year, but Passion wishes to have them all now, while
+ Patience, is willing to wait." Then the Interpreter took
+ Christian to a place where there was a fire burning against a
+ wall, and one standing near it, always casting much water upon
+ it to quench it, yet did the fire burn higher and hotter. But
+ afterwards the Interpreter took him to the back of the wall,
+ where he saw a man with a vessel of oil in his hand, and he
+ poured the oil continually, but secretly, into the fire.</p>
+
+ <p>"What does this mean?" asked Christian.</p>
+
+ <p>The Interpreter answered, "The fire is a picture of the
+ grace God puts into the heart. He that casts water on it to put
+ it out is the Evil One. And the man who pours oil on the fire
+ to keep it alight is Christ."</p>
+
+ <p>I saw also that the Interpreter took Christian again by the
+ hand and led him into a place, where was builded a stately
+ palace, beautiful to behold, at the sight of which Christian
+ was greatly delighted. He saw also upon the top of the palace
+ certain persons walking, and they were clothed all in gold.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Christian, "May we go in here?" So the Interpreter
+ took him and led him toward the door of the palace. Now before
+ they came up to the door, they passed a man, sitting at a
+ table, with a book and his inkhorn before him, to take down the
+ name of any who should enter. And, behold, at the door stood a
+ great company of men, who wished to go in, but did not dare to
+ enter, for within the doorway stood many men in armor to guard
+ it. Now, these men in armor were determined to do any who would
+ enter as much harm and mischief as they could. Christian was
+ amazed. At last, when every man started back for fear of the
+ armed men, Christian saw a man with a very strong face come up
+ to the man that sat at the table, saying:</p>
+
+ <p>"Set down my name, sir."</p>
+
+ <p>And when this was done, Christian saw the strong man draw
+ his sword and put an helmet on his head, and rush toward
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page215" id="page215"></a>[pg
+ 215]</span> the door upon the armed men. The armed men fought
+ with great strength, but the man with the strong face was not
+ at all discouraged, but fought most fiercely. So after he had
+ received and given many wounds to those that tried to keep him
+ out, he cut his way through them all, and pressed forward into
+ the palace. Then there was a pleasant voice heard from those
+ that walked upon the top of the palace, saying:</p>
+
+ <div class="poem">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p>"Come in, come in;</p>
+
+ <p>Eternal glory thou shalt win."</p>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+
+ <p>So he went in and was clothed in such garments as they.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now," said Christian, "let me go."</p>
+
+ <p>And the Interpreter said, "Hast thou understood these
+ things?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Christian, and he began to get ready to go on
+ his journey.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said the Interpreter, "God be always with thee, good
+ Christian, to guide thee in the way that leads to Mount
+ Zion."</p>
+
+ <p>Now I saw in my dream that the highway up which Christian
+ was to go was fenced on either side with a wall. Up this way
+ therefore, did Christian run, but not without great difficulty,
+ because of the load on his back. He ran thus till he came to a
+ steeper place, and upon that place stood a Cross, and a little
+ below, a Sepulcher. So I saw in my dream that just as Christian
+ came up to the Cross his burden fell from off his back, and
+ began to tumble till it came to the mouth of the Sepulcher,
+ where it fell in and I saw it no more. Then was Christian glad
+ and happy, and he stood for a while to look and wonder, for it
+ was surprising to him to see that the Cross should make him
+ lose his burden. Now as he stood looking, behold three Shining
+ Ones came to him and greeted him.</p>
+
+ <p>The first said to him, "Thy sins be forgiven thee." The
+ second took away all his rags and clothed him in new raiment.
+ The third set a mark on his forehead and gave him a roll with a
+ seal on it, which he should give in at the Celestial Gate. So
+ they went their way.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Christian gave three leaps for joy and went on singing.
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page216" id="page216"></a>[pg
+ 216]</span> I saw then in my dream that as he walked he saw two
+ men come tumbling over the wall into the narrow way.</p>
+
+ <p>"Gentlemen, where do you come from and whither do you go?"
+ said Christian.</p>
+
+ <p>They told him, "We were born in a land called Vainglory, and
+ we are going to Mount Zion."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why came you not in at the gate?" said Christian.</p>
+
+ <p>They said that to go to the gate was too far, so they had
+ taken a short cut and climbed over the wall.</p>
+
+ <p>"But," said Christian, "will the Lord of the City to which
+ we are going be pleased that you should come into the way over
+ the wall?"</p>
+
+ <p>But the men said he need not trouble his head about that,
+ for what they did had been done many times before. It had been
+ a custom for more than a thousand years. And besides, said
+ they, "If we get into the way, what does it matter how we get
+ in? You came in by the Wicket-gate, and are in the way, and we
+ came tumbling over the wall and are in the way, so now we are
+ all in the same condition."</p>
+
+ <p>"But," said Christian, "I walk by the Rule of my Master, and
+ you walk just as you like best."</p>
+
+ <p>Then said they, "We see not how thou art different to us,
+ except by the coat thou wearest, and that, we suppose, was
+ given thee by some of thy neighbors, to hide thy rags."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," said Christian, "the Lord of the City to which I go
+ gave me this coat the day that he took away from me my rags. He
+ will surely know me, since I have His coat on my back. I have
+ also a mark in my forehead, which you may not have noticed, and
+ this was given to me by one of my Lord's friends, on the day my
+ burden fell off my shoulders. I will tell you too, that I had a
+ roll given me, to comfort me by reading, as I go on the way. I
+ am also to give in the roll at the Celestial Gate. All these
+ things I think you are without, because you came not in at the
+ gate."</p>
+
+ <p>To these things they gave him no answer, only they looked at
+ each other and laughed. I beheld then, that they all went on
+ without talking much together, till they came to the foot of
+ the hill Difficulty, at the bottom of which was a spring. The
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page217" id="page217"></a>[pg
+ 217]</span> narrow way lay right up the hill, but there were
+ also two other ways here. One turned to the left hand and the
+ other to the right at the bottom of the hill. Christian now
+ went to the spring and drank to refresh himself, and then began
+ to go up the narrow path that led to the top of the hill. The
+ other two also came to the foot of the hill. But when they saw
+ that the hill was steep and high, they made up their minds to
+ go in the other paths that lay round the side of the hill. So
+ one took the way that was called Danger, which led him into a
+ great wood, and the other took the way called Destruction,
+ which led him into a wide field, full of dark mountains, where
+ he stumbled and fell and rose no more. I looked then to
+ Christian to see him go up the hill, and then I saw that he had
+ begun to clamber upon his hands and his knees, because of the
+ steepness of the place. Now about midway to the top of the hill
+ was a pleasant arbor, made by the Lord of the hill for the
+ refreshing of weary travelers. When Christian got there he sat
+ down to rest, then he pulled out his roll and read in it to
+ comfort himself, and he began again to look at the garment that
+ was given to him at the Cross. Thus he at last fell into a
+ slumber, and then into a sound sleep, which kept him in that
+ place, until it was almost night, and in his sleep his roll
+ fell out of his hand. Now, as he was sleeping, there came one
+ to him and awaked him. Then Christian suddenly started up and
+ sped on his way till he came to the top of the hill.</p>
+
+ <p>When he was got to the top of the hill, there came two men
+ running to meet him. The name of the one was Timorous, and the
+ other Mistrust.</p>
+
+ <p>"Sirs," said Christian, "what is the matter? You run the
+ wrong way."</p>
+
+ <p>Timorous answered that they were going to the City of Zion
+ and had got up that difficult place. "But," said he, "the
+ farther we go, the more danger we meet with, wherefore we
+ turned and are going back again."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Mistrust; "for just before us lie a couple of
+ lions in the way, whether sleeping or waking we know not, but
+ we thought if we came within reach, they would pull us in
+ pieces."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page218"
+ id="page218"></a>[pg 218]</span>
+
+ <p>Then said Christian, "You make me afraid, but yet I will go
+ forward." So Mistrust and Timorous ran down the hill, and
+ Christian went on his way. And as he went he thought again of
+ what he heard from the men. Then he felt for his roll, that he
+ might read and be comforted, but he felt and found it not.</p>
+
+ <p>Now was Christian in great distress and knew not what to do.
+ At last he bethought himself that he had slept in the arbor
+ that was on the side of the hill, and then he went back to look
+ for his roll. But all the way he went back, who can tell the
+ sorrow of Christian's heart? Sometimes he sighed, sometimes he
+ wept, and often he chid himself for being so foolish as to fall
+ asleep. Thus therefore he went back, carefully looking on this
+ side and on that all the way as he went. For he hoped to find
+ the roll that had been his comfort so many times in his
+ journey. He went back till he came again within sight of the
+ arbor where he had sat and slept, but that sight renewed his
+ sorrow again, by reminding him how eagerly he had slept there.
+ And as he went towards the arbor, he sighed over his
+ sleepiness, saying, "Oh, foolish man that I was, why did I
+ sleep in the daytime? oh, that I had not slept."</p>
+
+ <p>Now, by the time he was come to the arbor again, for a while
+ he sat down and wept, but, at last, looking sorrowfully down
+ under the settle, he espied his roll, which with trembling
+ haste he caught up. But who can tell how joyful Christian was
+ when he had got his roll again, or with what joy and tears he
+ began to go up the hill again. And, oh, how nimbly did he go
+ up! Yet before he reached the top the sun went down. Now
+ Christian remembered the story that Mistrust and Timorous had
+ told him, how they were frightened with the sight of the lions.
+ And he said to himself, "If these beasts meet me in the dark,
+ how shall I escape being by them torn in pieces?"</p>
+
+ <p>But while he was in this fright, he lifted up his eyes, and
+ behold, there was a very stately palace before him, the name of
+ which was Beautiful, and it stood by the highway side. So I saw
+ in my dream that he made haste, that if possible he might get
+ lodging there. Now before he had gone far, he entered into a
+ very narrow passage; and looking before him as he went, he
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page219" id="page219"></a>[pg
+ 219]</span> espied two lions in the way. The lions were
+ chained, but Christian did not see the chains. Then he was
+ afraid and thought he would go back, but the porter at the
+ lodge, whose name is Watchful, seeing Christian stop, as if he
+ would go back, cried, "Fear not the lions, for they are
+ chained."</p>
+
+ <p>Then I saw that Christian went on till he came and stood
+ before the gate where the porter was. And Christian said to the
+ porter, "Sir, what house is this? May I lodge here
+ to-night?"</p>
+
+ <p>The porter answered, "This house was built by the Lord of
+ the hill, for the safety of pilgrims."</p>
+
+ <p>So Watchful the porter rang a bell, at the sound of which a
+ grave and beautiful damsel came out of the door. When she saw
+ Christian she brought him into the Palace Beautiful, and she
+ and her sisters talked with him until supper was ready. Now all
+ their talk at table was about the Lord of the hill, and, by
+ what they said, I knew that He had been a great Warrior, and
+ that He had fought and slain Death, but not without great
+ danger to Himself, which made me love Him the more. They talked
+ together till late at night, and after they had committed
+ themselves to their Lord for protection, they went to bed. The
+ room in which the pilgrim slept had a window opening towards
+ the sunrising, and the name of the room was Peace. In the
+ morning they all got up, and after some more talk, they told
+ him that they would take him to the armory before he left them.
+ So they did, and when he came out, he was harnessed from head
+ to foot, lest he should be attacked in the way. Then Christian
+ walked with his friends to the gate, and there he asked the
+ porter if he had seen any pilgrims pass.</p>
+
+ <p>The porter answered, "Yes, a pilgrim called Faithful has
+ passed this way."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh," said Christian, "I know him. He comes from the place
+ where I was born. How far do you think he has got?"</p>
+
+ <p>"By this time he is below the hill," said the porter.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Christian began to go down the hill into the Valley of
+ Humiliation, where it is difficult not to slip. He went down
+ very warily, yet he slipped once or twice. Now in the valley
+ Christian had a hard fight with a fiend called Apollyon.
+ Apollyon <span class="pagenum"><a name="page220"
+ id="page220"></a>[pg 220]</span> was a monster and hideous to
+ behold. He was clothed with scales like a fish, he had wings
+ like a dragon, feet like a bear, and his mouth was as the mouth
+ of a lion, and out of it came fire and smoke. When he came up
+ to Christian he looked at him with rage in his face, and said,
+ "Prepare thyself to die, for thou shalt go no farther." And he
+ threw a flaming dart at him, but Christian had a shield in his
+ hand, which caught the dart, so that it did him no harm. Then
+ did Christian draw his sword, but Apollyon threw darts at him
+ as thick as hail, and wounded him in his head, his hand, and
+ foot. This great combat lasted half a day, till Christian was
+ almost worn out.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/220.jpg" name="fig220s"
+ id="fig220s"><img width="300" src="images/220s.jpg"
+ alt="THEN DID CHRISTIAN DRAW HIS SWORD" /></a><br />
+ then did christian draw his sword
+ </div>
+
+ <p>Then Apollyon came close to Christian, and wrestled with him
+ and gave him a dreadful fall, and Christian's sword flew out of
+ his hand.</p>
+
+ <p>"I am sure of thee now," said Apollyon. But while he was
+ taking a last blow to kill this good man altogether, Christian
+ nimbly stretched out his hand for his sword, and caught it.
+ Then he gave Apollyon a deadly thrust, and Apollyon spread his
+ wings and sped him away, so that Christian saw him no more. In
+ this combat no man could imagine, unless he had seen and heard
+ as I did, what yelling and roaring Apollyon made all the time
+ of the fight. He spake like a dragon. On the other side, sighs
+ and groans burst from Christian's heart. I never saw him give
+ so much as a pleasant look, till he saw that he had wounded
+ Apollyon with his two-edged sword. Then indeed he did smile and
+ look upward, but it was the dreadfulest sight that ever I
+ saw.</p>
+
+ <p>So when the battle was over, Christian said, "I will give
+ thanks to Him that did help me against Apollyon."</p>
+
+ <p>He also sat down in that place to eat and drink, so being
+ refreshed, he again began his journey, with his sword drawn in
+ his hand, "For," said he, "I do not know if some other enemy
+ may not be at hand."</p>
+
+ <p>Now at the end of this valley was another, called the Valley
+ of the Shadow of Death. Through it Christian must go, because
+ the way to the Celestial City lay through it. Now this valley
+ is a very lonely place. It is like a wilderness or a desert
+ full of pits. No man dwells in it, and no man but a Christian
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page221" id="page221"></a>[pg
+ 221]</span> passeth through it. Here Christian had a worse time
+ than even in his fight with Apollyon. I saw then in my dream
+ that when Christian had reached the borders of this valley,
+ there met him two men, making haste to go back.</p>
+
+ <p>Christian said to them, "Whither are you going?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Back, back," they cried, "as you will go, if you prize life
+ or peace!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, what is the matter?" said Christian.</p>
+
+ <p>"Matter!" said they. "We were going the way you are going,
+ and we went as far as we dared. But had we gone a little
+ farther we had not been here to bring the news to thee."</p>
+
+ <p>"But what have you met with?" said Christian.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, we were almost in the Valley of the Shadow of Death,
+ but by good chance we looked before us and saw the danger
+ before we came to it."</p>
+
+ <p>"But what have you seen?" said Christian.</p>
+
+ <p>"Seen!" said the men, "why, the valley itself was as dark as
+ pitch. We also saw hobgoblins and dragons, and we heard a
+ continual howling and yelling as of people in great misery.
+ Death also doth always spread his wings over it. In a word, it
+ is altogether dreadful, being utterly without order."</p>
+
+ <p>"But," said Christian, "this is the way to the Celestial
+ City."</p>
+
+ <p>"Be it your way, then; we will not choose it for ours." So
+ they parted. Christian went on his way, but still with his
+ sword drawn in his hand, lest he should be attacked.</p>
+
+ <p>I saw then in my dream, that as far as this valley reached,
+ there was on the right hand a very deep ditch. Again, behold,
+ on the left hand, there was a very dangerous mire, into which
+ if a man falls he finds no bottom for his foot to stand on. The
+ pathway here was also exceeding narrow, and therefore Christian
+ was the more distressed. For when he sought in the dark to shun
+ the ditch on the one hand, he was ready to tumble over into the
+ mire on the other, and when he sought to escape the mire,
+ without great carefulness he would nearly fall into the ditch.
+ Then he went on, and I heard him sigh bitterly. For besides
+ these dangers, the pathway was here so dark, that when he
+ lifted up his foot to go forward, he knew not where, nor
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page222" id="page222"></a>[pg
+ 222]</span> upon what he should set it next. About the middle
+ of this valley I saw the mouth of hell to be, and it stood
+ close to the wayside.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now," thought Christian, "what shall I do?"</p>
+
+ <p>And ever and anon the flame and smoke came out in such
+ abundance, with sparks and hideous noises, that he was forced
+ to put away his sword and betake himself to another weapon,
+ called All-prayer.</p>
+
+ <p>Then he cried out in my hearing, "O Lord, I beseech thee,
+ deliver my soul." Thus he went on a great while, yet still the
+ flames would be rushing towards him. Also he heard doleful
+ voices and rushings to and fro, so that sometimes he thought he
+ should be torn in pieces, or trodden down like mire in the
+ streets.</p>
+
+ <p>This frightful sight was seen, and these dreadful noises
+ were heard by him for several miles together. Then Christian
+ came to a place where he thought he heard a company of fiends
+ coming forward to meet him, and he stopped and began to think
+ what it would be best for him to do. Sometimes he thought he
+ would go back, but again he thought he might be half-way
+ through the valley. So he resolved to go on, yet the fiends
+ seemed to come nearer and nearer. But when they were come
+ almost close to him, he cried out in a loud voice, "I will walk
+ in the strength of the Lord God." Then the fiends went back and
+ came no farther.</p>
+
+ <p>Now Christian thought he heard the voice of a man going
+ before him, saying, "Though I walk through the Valley of the
+ Shadow of Death, I will fear no evil, for Thou art with me."
+ Then he was glad, for he thought that some one who feared God
+ was in this valley, as well as himself, and he hoped to
+ overtake him and have company by and by.</p>
+
+ <p>Now morning being come, he looked back to see by the light
+ of day what dangers he had gone through in the night. So he saw
+ more plainly the ditch that was on the one hand, and the mire
+ that was on the other, also how narrow the way was that lay
+ between them both. He saw, too, the hobgoblins and dragons, but
+ all afar off, for after break of day they came not nigh.</p>
+
+ <p>About this time the sun was rising, and this was a great
+ help to Christian, for you must know that though the first part
+ of <span class="pagenum"><a name="page223" id="page223"></a>[pg
+ 223]</span> the Valley of the Shadow of Death was dangerous,
+ yet this second part, through which he had to go, was, if
+ possible, far more dangerous. For, from the place where he now
+ stood, even to the end of the valley, the way was all along so
+ full of snares, traps, and nets here, so full of pits,
+ pitfalls, and deep holes down there, that if it had been dark,
+ he would almost surely have been lost, but as I said just now,
+ the sun was rising. In this light, therefore, he came to the
+ end of the valley.</p>
+
+ <p>Now as Christian went on his way, he came to a little hill,
+ and going up he looked forward and saw Faithful before him.
+ Then said Christian, "Stay, and I will be your companion."</p>
+
+ <p>And when he overtook Faithful they went very lovingly on
+ together, and talked of all that had happened to them in their
+ pilgrimage. Then I saw in my dream that when they got out of
+ the wilderness they saw a town before them, and the name of
+ that town was Vanity, and at the town there was a fair kept,
+ called Vanity Fair. It was kept all the year long.</p>
+
+ <p>At this fair there were sold houses, lands, trades,
+ husbands, wives, children, silver, gold, pearls, and precious
+ stones. And, moreover, at this fair, there were at all times
+ cheats and jugglers and knaves and rogues.</p>
+
+ <p>Now the way to the Celestial City lay just through this
+ town, so the pilgrims had to go through the fair.</p>
+
+ <p>The Prince of princes Himself, when here, went through this
+ town to his own country, and that on a fair-day too. And, I
+ think, it was Beelzebub the chief lord of this fair that
+ invited the Prince to buy of his vanities. Beelzebub even said
+ he would have made Him lord of the fair, if He would have done
+ him reverence as He went through the town. Yea, because the
+ Prince was so great a person, Beelzebub took Him from street to
+ street and showed Him all his kingdoms, that he might, if
+ possible, tempt the Prince to buy some of his vanities. But the
+ Blessed One did not wish any of these vanities, and therefore
+ left the town without spending so much as one farthing upon
+ these vanities.</p>
+
+ <p>Now these pilgrims, Christian and Faithful, as I said, had
+ to go through this fair.</p>
+
+ <p>Well, so they did, but behold, whenever they entered into
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page224" id="page224"></a>[pg
+ 224]</span> the fair, it and the town itself were in a hubbub
+ about them. For the pilgrims were clothed with raiment that was
+ very different from the raiment of any that traded in that
+ fair. The people gazed upon Christian and Faithful and called
+ them outlandish men.</p>
+
+ <p>Then also, they wondered at the pilgrim's speech, as few
+ could understand what they said, for they spoke the language of
+ the Celestial City. But those that kept the fair spoke the
+ language of the city of Vanity Fair, and they could not
+ understand one another.</p>
+
+ <p>Now when these pilgrims would not buy their wares and would
+ not even look at them, the sellers were angry and mocked these
+ men, and some called on others to smite them. At last the
+ master of the fair told his men to question the pilgrims. And
+ when Christian and Faithful told the men that they were
+ strangers in the world and were going to the Celestial City,
+ the men thought they were mad. Therefore they took them and
+ beat them and threw mud at them, and then they put them in a
+ cage to be a show to the people at the fair. But when they were
+ tired of mocking them, these two pilgrims were again examined
+ and charged as guilty of the great disturbance in the fair. So
+ they beat them pitilessly, and hanged irons upon them, and led
+ them in chains up and down the fair. Then Christian and
+ Faithful behaved so wisely and patiently, that the others were
+ still more angry, and said they would put these men to
+ death.</p>
+
+ <p>Therefore, after a trial, Faithful was brought out, to do
+ with him according to their law. And first they scourged him,
+ then they buffeted him, then they stoned him with stones, then
+ they pricked him with their swords, and last of all they burned
+ him to ashes at the stake. Now I saw behind the people a
+ chariot and a couple of horses waiting for Faithful, who was
+ taken by it through the clouds, the nearest way to the
+ Celestial City. Then was Christian sent back to the prison,
+ where he dwelt for a time, till he escaped and went again on
+ his way. But he did not go alone, for there was one whose name
+ was Hopeful, who left the town of Vanity, and was a companion
+ to Christian in his pilgrimage. They went on their way till
+ they <span class="pagenum"><a name="page225"
+ id="page225"></a>[pg 225]</span> came to a pleasant river. Now
+ their way lay just along the bank of the river, and Christian
+ and his companion walked there with great delight. They drank
+ also of the river, and ate of the fruit that grew on the trees
+ by its bank. On either side of the river was also a meadow,
+ very beautiful with lilies, and it was green all the year long.
+ In this meadow they lay down and slept, for here they might lie
+ safely. Now I beheld in my dream that they had not journeyed
+ far, when the river and the way parted, and at this they were
+ very sorry, yet they dare not go out of the way.</p>
+
+ <p>A little before them was a meadow and a stile to go over
+ into it. Then said Christian, "If this meadow lies along by our
+ path, let us go over." He went to the stile to see, and behold,
+ a path lay alongside of the way, on the other side of the
+ fence.</p>
+
+ <p>"That is as I wish," said Christian. "Come, good Hopeful,
+ and let us go over.</p>
+
+ <p>"But," said Hopeful, "what if this path should lead us out
+ of the way?"</p>
+
+ <p>"That is not likely," said the other. "Look, it goes along
+ by the wayside." So Hopeful, being persuaded by Christian, went
+ after him over the stile. When they had gone over and had got
+ into the path, they found it very easy for their feet. And as
+ they looked before them they saw a man walking as they did, and
+ his name was Vain-confidence. So they called after him, and
+ asked where this way led.</p>
+
+ <p>He said, "To the Celestial City."</p>
+
+ <p>"Look," said Christian to Hopeful, "did I not tell you so?
+ You see, we are right after all." So they followed
+ Vain-confidence, and he went before them.</p>
+
+ <p>But behold, the night came on, and it was very dark, so that
+ they that went behind lost sight of him that went before.
+ Vain-confidence then went on, not seeing the way before him,
+ and fell into a deep pit which was there. This pit was made by
+ the Prince of those grounds on purpose, to catch such foolish
+ men as Vain-confidence. He, then, fell into the pit and was
+ dashed to pieces with his fall. Now Christian and Hopeful heard
+ him fall, so they called to know what was the matter, but there
+ was none to answer, only they heard a
+ groaning.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page226"
+ id="page226"></a>[pg 226]</span>
+
+ <p>Then said Hopeful, "Where are we now?" But Christian was
+ silent, for he began to be afraid that he had led Hopeful out
+ of the way.</p>
+
+ <p>Now it began to rain and thunder and lighten in a very
+ dreadful manner, and the river flowed over the banks.</p>
+
+ <p>And Hopeful groaned, "Oh that I had kept on my way."</p>
+
+ <p>By this time the waters were greatly risen, so that to go
+ back was very dangerous. Yet they tried to go back, but it was
+ so dark, and the flood was so high, that as they went they were
+ nearly drowned nine or ten times, and they could not reach the
+ stile again that night. Wherefore at last, coming to a little
+ shelter, they sat down, but being weary they fell asleep. Now
+ there was, not far from the place where they lay, a castle,
+ called Doubting Castle, and the owner of the castle was Giant
+ Despair, and it was in his grounds the pilgrims were now
+ sleeping. Wherefore the giant, getting up early, and walking up
+ and down in his fields, caught Christian and Hopeful asleep.
+ Then with a grim and surly voice he woke them, and asked them
+ what they were doing in his grounds. They told him they were
+ pilgrims and had lost their way.</p>
+
+ <p>The giant said, "You have trampled on my ground, and slept
+ on it, and therefore you must go along with me." So they were
+ forced to go, because he was stronger than they. Also they said
+ very little, for they knew they had done wrong.</p>
+
+ <p>The giant therefore drove them before him, and put them into
+ his castle, into a very dark dungeon. Here, then, they lay,
+ from Wednesday morning till Saturday night, without one bit of
+ bread or drop of drink, or light, or any one to speak to them.
+ Now Giant Despair had a wife, and he told her he had taken a
+ couple of men prisoners, because they were sleeping on his
+ grounds. Then she told him that, when he arose in the morning,
+ he should beat them without mercy.</p>
+
+ <p>So Giant Despair got a cudgel, and went down to the dungeon
+ and beat Christian and Hopeful fearfully, so that they could
+ not move. Then the giant left them, and they spent their time
+ in sighs and bitter tears.</p>
+
+ <p>The next night Giant Despair again talked to his wife, and
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page227" id="page227"></a>[pg
+ 227]</span> she said, "Tell your prisoners to kill themselves,
+ for they will never escape from the dungeon."</p>
+
+ <p>So when morning came, the giant went to them in a surly
+ manner, and seeing they still ached with the stripes he had
+ given them, he told them to poison themselves, for they would
+ never get away from him in any other way. But they asked the
+ giant to let them go. That made him so angry that he rushed on
+ them and would have killed them, but he fell into a fit and
+ lost for a time the use of his hand, wherefore he withdrew and
+ left them as before. Well, towards evening the giant went down
+ again to the dungeon to see if his prisoners had followed his
+ advice and poisoned themselves. He found them alive, but
+ because of their wounds and for want of bread and water they
+ could do little but breathe.</p>
+
+ <p>Now at night the giant's wife said: "Take the prisoners into
+ the castle yard to-morrow, and show them the bones and skulls
+ of those prisoners you have already killed. Tell them that in a
+ week you will tear them to pieces, as you have torn your other
+ prisoners."</p>
+
+ <p>When the morning was come, the giant went to them again and
+ took them into the castle yard, and showed them all his wife
+ had bidden him.</p>
+
+ <p>"These," said he, "were pilgrims once as you are, but they
+ walked in my grounds as you have done. And when I thought fit,
+ I tore them in pieces, and so within ten days I will do to you,
+ Get you down to your den again," and he beat them all the way
+ there.</p>
+
+ <p>That night, about midnight, Christian and Hopeful began to
+ pray, and they prayed till dawn of day.</p>
+
+ <p>Now just at dawn Christian spoke in sudden amazement. "How
+ foolish we are to lie here, when we might be free after all. I
+ have a key in my pocket called Promise, that will, I am
+ persuaded, open any lock in Doubting Castle."</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Hopeful, "That is good news, pull it out of your
+ pocket and try."</p>
+
+ <p>Christian pulled it out and began to try the dungeon door,
+ and the bolt, as he turned the key, yielded, and the door flew
+ open, and Christian and Hopeful both came out. Then he
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page228" id="page228"></a>[pg
+ 228]</span> went to the door that led to the castle yard, and
+ with his key opened that door also. After that he went to the
+ iron gate, for that must be opened too. That lock was terribly
+ hard, yet the key did open it. Then they thrust open the gate
+ to make their escape in haste, but, as it opened, that gate
+ made such a creaking that it waked Giant Despair, who got up
+ hastily to follow his prisoners, but he could not run after
+ them, for again he took one of his fits. Then Christian and
+ Hopeful went on till they came to the King's highway and so
+ were safe, because they were out of the giant's grounds. Now
+ when they had got over the stile, they began to wonder what
+ they should do to keep other pilgrims from falling into the
+ hands of Giant Despair. So they agreed to put up there a
+ pillar, and to write on it this sentence: "Over this stile is
+ the way to Doubting Castle, which is kept by Giant Despair, who
+ despiseth the King of the Celestial Country and seeks to
+ destroy His holy pilgrims."</p>
+
+ <p>Many pilgrims, that came after, read what was written and
+ escaped Giant Despair. They then went on till they came to the
+ Delectable Mountains. These mountains belonged to the Lord of
+ the steep hill which Christian had climbed. So they went up
+ these mountains to behold the gardens and orchards, the
+ vineyards and fountains. There, too, they drank and washed
+ themselves and ate the fruit of the vineyards. Now there were
+ Shepherds on the mountains, who welcomed them lovingly and
+ showed them many wonders. First they took them to the top of a
+ hill which was very steep on one side, and bid them look down
+ to the bottom. So Christian and Hopeful looked down, and saw at
+ the bottom several men dashed all to pieces by a fall that they
+ had had from the top.</p>
+
+ <p>"These," said the Shepherds, "are for an example to others
+ to be careful not to clamber too high, or to come too near the
+ brink of this mountain." The name of this mountain was
+ Error.</p>
+
+ <p>Then the Shepherds took them to the top of another mountain,
+ and the name of it was Caution, and the Shepherds bid them look
+ afar off. When the pilgrims did this, they saw, as they
+ thought, several men walking up and down among the tombs that
+ were there. And they saw that the men were blind,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page229" id="page229"></a>[pg
+ 229]</span> because they stumbled sometimes upon the tombs, and
+ because they could not get out from among them.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Christian, "What means this?"</p>
+
+ <p>The Shepherds then answered, "Did you see a little below
+ these mountains a stile that led into a meadow?"</p>
+
+ <p>They answered, "Yes."</p>
+
+ <p>"From that stile," said the Shepherds, "there goes a path
+ that leads straight to Doubting Castle, which is kept by Giant
+ Despair. These men," and the Shepherds pointed to those among
+ the tombs, "came once on a pilgrimage as you do now. But when
+ they came to the stile, because the right way was rough, they
+ went over it into the meadow. Here they were taken by Giant
+ Despair and cast into Doubting Castle. After they had been kept
+ some time in the dungeon, he at last did put out their eyes.
+ Then he led them among those tombs, and left them to wander
+ there till this very day."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Christian and Hopeful thought of their escape from
+ Doubting Castle, and they looked at one another with tears in
+ their eyes. But yet they said nothing to the Shepherds. Now I
+ saw in my dream that the Shepherds brought them to another
+ place, where was a door in the side of a hill, and they opened
+ the door and bid the pilgrims look in. They looked in therefore
+ and saw that within it was very dark and smoky. They also
+ thought that they heard there a rumbling noise as of fire, and
+ a cry as of some in trouble.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said Christian, "What means this?"</p>
+
+ <p>The Shepherds said, "This is a byway to hell."</p>
+
+ <p>And the Shepherds said one to another, "Let us show the
+ pilgrims the gates of the Celestial City, if they have skill to
+ look through our glass."</p>
+
+ <p>So they took Christian and Hopeful to the top of another
+ high hill, called Clear, and gave them the glass to look. They
+ tried to look, but the remembrance of that last thing the
+ Shepherds had showed them made their hands shake, so that they
+ could not look steadily through the glass. Yet they thought
+ they saw something like the gate, and also some of the beauty
+ of the place. When they were about to depart, one of the
+ Shepherds gave them a note of the way. Another of them bid
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page230" id="page230"></a>[pg
+ 230]</span> them beware when they met the Flatterer. The third
+ bid them take heed that they did not sleep upon the Enchanted
+ Ground. And the fourth bid them "Godspeed." So I awoke from my
+ dream.</p>
+
+ <p>And I slept and dreamed again, and I saw the same two
+ pilgrims going down the mountains and along the highway. They
+ went on then till they came to a place where they saw another
+ path that seemed to be as straight as the way which they should
+ go. And here they knew not which of the two to take, for both
+ seemed straight before them, therefore here they stood still to
+ think.</p>
+
+ <p>And as they were thinking about the way, behold, a man,
+ black of flesh, but covered with a very light robe, came to
+ them, and asked them why they stood there.</p>
+
+ <p>They answered they were going to the Celestial City, but
+ knew not which of these ways to take.</p>
+
+ <p>"Follow me," said the man. "It is there I am going."</p>
+
+ <p>So they followed him in the path that had joined the way,
+ and this path slowly turned, and at last turned them so far
+ from the City that they wished to go to, that in a little time
+ their faces were turned away from it. Yet they still followed
+ him. But by and by before they knew what had happened, he led
+ them both into a net, in which they were so entangled that they
+ knew not what to do. Then the white robe fell off the black
+ man's back, and they knew that he was the Flatterer and had
+ brought them into his net. Wherefore there they lay, crying
+ some time, for they could not get themselves out. And as they
+ lay weeping in the net, they saw a Shining One coming toward
+ them with a whip of small cord in his hand. When he was come to
+ the place where they were, he asked them whence they came, and
+ what they were doing there.</p>
+
+ <p>They told him that they were poor pilgrims going to Zion,
+ but were led out of their way by a black man clothed in white.
+ "He bid us," said they, "follow him, for he was going thither
+ too."</p>
+
+ <p>Then said the Shining One, "It is a Flatterer that has
+ clothed himself like an angel of light." So he rent the net and
+ let the men out. And he said to the pilgrims, "Follow me," and
+ he <span class="pagenum"><a name="page231" id="page231"></a>[pg
+ 231]</span> led them back to the way which they had left when
+ they followed the Flatterer.</p>
+
+ <p>The one with the whip then asked them where they slept last
+ night.</p>
+
+ <p>They said, "With the Shepherds on the Delectable
+ Mountains."</p>
+
+ <p>He asked them if the Shepherds had not given them a note,
+ telling them about the way. They answered, "Yes," but they had
+ forgotten to read it. He asked them also if the Shepherds did
+ not tell them to beware of the Flatterer. They answered, "Yes,"
+ but they did not think that this man who spoke so well could be
+ he. Then I saw in my dream that the Shining One commanded them
+ to lie down. And he took his whip, and when he had whipped them
+ he said, "As many as I love I rebuke and punish, be careful
+ therefore and repent."</p>
+
+ <p>This done, he bid them go on their way and take good heed to
+ the other directions of the Shepherds. So they thanked the
+ Shining One for all his kindness, and went gladly along the
+ right way. Now I saw in my dream that when the pilgrims had got
+ safely over the Enchanted Ground, they entered a beautiful
+ country where the air was very sweet and pleasant. Every day
+ they heard continually the singing of birds, and every day they
+ saw the flowers appear in the earth. In this country the sun
+ shineth night and day, and here they were within sight of the
+ City to which they went. So I saw that as they went on, there
+ met them two men in raiment that shone like gold, also their
+ faces shone as the light. These men asked the pilgrims where
+ they came from, and they told them. They also asked them where
+ they had lodged, what difficulties and dangers, what comforts
+ and pleasures they had met in the way, and they told them.</p>
+
+ <p>Then said the men that met them, "You have but two
+ difficulties more to meet and then you are in the City." So
+ they all walked together till they came in sight of the
+ gate.</p>
+
+ <p>Now I saw that between them and the gate was a river, but
+ there was no bridge to go over, and the river was deep. At the
+ sight of the river Christian and Hopeful were stunned,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page232" id="page232"></a>[pg
+ 232]</span> but the men that went with them said, "You must go
+ through, or you cannot come in at the gate."</p>
+
+ <p>The pilgrims then, especially Christian, began to be afraid,
+ and looked this way and that way, but could find no way by
+ which to escape the river. Then they entered the river, and
+ Christian began to sink and to cry out to his friend Hopeful,
+ saying, "I sink in deep waters, the billows go over my
+ head."</p>
+
+ <p>But Hopeful cheered Christian, and said he felt the ground
+ under his feet. Yet a great horror and darkness fell upon
+ Christian, for he thought he should never reach the Celestial
+ City, and Hopeful had much difficulty to keep his friend's head
+ above water. Then I saw in my dream that at last Christian took
+ courage, and soon he found ground to stand upon, and the rest
+ of the river was shallow. Thus they got over. Now upon the bank
+ of the river, on the other side, they saw the two shining men
+ again, who waited there for them, and led them toward the
+ gate.</p>
+
+ <p>The City stood upon a mighty hill, but the pilgrims went up
+ that with ease, talking gladly to their shining companions, and
+ thus they came up to the gate.</p>
+
+ <p>And over the gate there were written in letters of gold
+ "Blessed are they that do the King's Commandments and may enter
+ in through the gates into the City."</p>
+
+ <p>I saw in my dream that these two men went in at the gate,
+ and lo! as they entered they were transfigured. And they had
+ raiment put on that shone like gold. They had harps given to
+ them to praise on, and crowns were given to them in token of
+ honor.</p>
+
+ <p>Then I heard in my dream that all the bells in the City rang
+ again for joy, and that it was said, "Enter ye into the joy of
+ your Lord."</p>
+
+ <p>Now just as the gates were opened to let in the men, I
+ looked in after them, and behold, the City shone like the sun,
+ the streets also were paved with gold. And I heard many voices
+ saying, "Holy, holy, holy is the Lord."</p>
+
+ <p>And after that they shut up the gates, and when I had seen
+ this, I wished I myself were within. So I awoke, and behold it
+ was a dream.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page233"
+ id="page233"></a>[pg 233]</span>
+
+ <h3>TALES FROM SHAKESPEARE</h3>
+
+ <h3>By CHARLES AND MARY LAMB</h3>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE TEMPEST</h4>
+
+ <p>There was a certain island in the sea, the only inhabitants
+ of which were an old man, whose name was Prospero, and his
+ daughter Miranda, a very beautiful young lady. She came to this
+ island so young, that she had no memory of having seen any
+ other human face than her father's.</p>
+
+ <p>They lived in a cave or cell, made out of a rock; it was
+ divided into several apartments, one of which Prospero called
+ his study; there he kept his books, which chiefly treated of
+ magic, a study at that time much affected by all learned men:
+ and the knowledge of this art he found very useful to him; for
+ being thrown by a strange chance upon this island, which had
+ been enchanted by a witch called Sycorax, who died there a
+ short time before his arrival, Prospero, by virtue of his art,
+ released many good spirits that Sycorax had imprisoned in the
+ bodies of large trees, because they had refused to execute her
+ wicked commands. These gentle spirits were ever after obedient
+ to the will of Prospero. Of these Ariel was the chief.</p>
+
+ <p>The lively little sprite Ariel had nothing mischievous in
+ his nature, except that he took rather too much pleasure in
+ tormenting an ugly monster called Caliban, for he owed him a
+ grudge because he was the son of his old enemy Sycorax. This
+ Caliban, Prospero found in the woods, a strange misshapen
+ thing, far less human in form than an ape: he took him home to
+ his cell, and taught him to speak; and Prospero would have been
+ very kind to him, but the bad nature which Caliban inherited
+ from his mother Sycorax, would not let him learn anything good
+ or useful: therefore he was employed like a slave,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page234" id="page234"></a>[pg
+ 234]</span> to fetch wood, and do the most laborious offices;
+ and Ariel had the charge of compelling him to these
+ services.</p>
+
+ <p>When Caliban was lazy and neglected his work, Ariel (who was
+ invisible to all eyes but Prospero's) would come slily and
+ pinch him, and sometimes tumble him down in the mire; and then
+ Ariel, in the likeness of an ape, would make mouths at him.
+ Then swiftly changing his shape, in the likeness of a hedgehog,
+ he would lie tumbling in Caliban's way, who feared the
+ hedgehog's sharp quills would prick his bare feet. With a
+ variety of such-like vexatious tricks Ariel would often torment
+ him, whenever Caliban neglected the work which Prospero
+ commanded him to do.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/234.jpg" name="fig234s"
+ id="fig234s"><img width="300" src="images/234s.jpg"
+ alt="MIRANDA WATCHING THE STORM" /></a><br />
+ miranda watching the storm
+ </div>
+
+ <p>Having these powerful spirits obedient to his will, Prospero
+ could by their means command the winds, and the waves of the
+ sea. By his orders they raised a violent storm, in the midst of
+ which, and struggling with the wild sea-waves that every moment
+ threatened to swallow it up, he showed his daughter a fine
+ large ship, which he told her was full of living beings like
+ themselves. "O my dear father," said she, "if by your art you
+ have raised this dreadful storm, have pity on their sad
+ distress. See! the vessel will be dashed to pieces. Poor souls!
+ they will all perish. If I had power, I would sink the sea
+ beneath the earth, rather than the good ship should be
+ destroyed, with all the precious souls within her."</p>
+
+ <p>"Be not so amazed, daughter Miranda," said Prospero; "there
+ is no harm done. I have so ordered it, that no person in the
+ ship shall receive any hurt. What I have done has been in care
+ of you, my dear child. You are ignorant who you are, or where
+ you came from, and you know no more of me, but that I am your
+ father, and live in this poor cave. Can you remember a time
+ before you came to this cell? I think you cannot, for you were
+ not then three years of age."</p>
+
+ <p>"Certainly I can, sir," replied Miranda.</p>
+
+ <p>"By what?" asked Prospero; "by any other house or person?
+ Tell me what you can remember, my child."</p>
+
+ <p>Miranda said, "It seems to me like the recollection of a
+ dream. But had I not once four or five women who attended upon
+ me?"</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page235"
+ id="page235"></a>[pg 235]</span>
+
+ <p>Prospero answered, "You had, and more. How is it that this
+ still lives in your mind? Do you remember how you came
+ here?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, sir," said Miranda, "I remember nothing more."</p>
+
+ <p>"Twelve years ago, Miranda," continued Prospero, "I was duke
+ of Milan, and you were a princess, and my only heir. I had a
+ younger brother, whose name was Antonio, to whom I trusted
+ everything; and as I was fond of retirement and deep study, I
+ commonly left the management of my state affairs to your uncle,
+ my false brother (for so indeed he proved). I, neglecting all
+ worldly ends buried among my books, did dedicate my whole time
+ to the bettering of my mind. My brother Antonio being thus in
+ possession of my power, began to think himself the duke indeed.
+ The opportunity I gave him of making himself popular among my
+ subjects awakened in his bad nature a proud ambition to deprive
+ me of my dukedom: this he soon effected with the aid of the
+ king of Naples, a powerful prince, who was my enemy."</p>
+
+ <p>"Wherefore," said Miranda, "did they not that hour destroy
+ us?"</p>
+
+ <p>"My child," answered her father, "they durst not, so dear
+ was the love that my people bore me. Antonio carried us on
+ board a ship, and when we were some leagues out at sea, he
+ forced us into a small boat, without either tackle, sail, or
+ mast: there he left us, as he thought, to perish. But a kind
+ lord of my court, one Gonzalo, who loved me, had privately
+ placed in the boat, water, provisions, apparel, and some books
+ which I prize above my dukedom."</p>
+
+ <p>"O my father," said Miranda, "what a trouble must I have
+ been to you then!"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, my love," said Prospero, "you were a little cherub that
+ did preserve me. Your innocent smiles made me bear up against
+ my misfortunes. Our food lasted till we landed on this desert
+ island, since then my chief delight has been in teaching you,
+ Miranda, and well have you profited by my instructions."</p>
+
+ <p>"Heaven thank you, my dear father," said Miranda. "Now pray
+ tell me, sir, your reason for raising this sea-storm?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Know then," said her father, "that by means of this storm,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page236" id="page236"></a>[pg
+ 236]</span> my enemies, the king of Naples, and my cruel
+ brother, are cast ashore upon this island."</p>
+
+ <p>Having so said, Prospero gently touched his daughter with
+ his magic wand, and she fell fast asleep; for the spirit Ariel
+ just then presented himself before his master, to give an
+ account of the tempest, and how he had disposed of the ship's
+ company, and though the spirits were always invisible to
+ Miranda, Prospero did not choose she should hear him holding
+ converse (as would seem to her) with the empty air.</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, my brave spirit," said Prospero to Ariel, "how have
+ you performed your task?"</p>
+
+ <p>Ariel gave a lively description of the storm, and of the
+ terrors of the mariners; and how the king's son, Ferdinand, was
+ the first who leaped into the sea; and his father thought he
+ saw his dear son swallowed up by the waves and lost. "But he is
+ safe," said Ariel, "in a corner of the isle, sitting with his
+ arms folded, sadly lamenting the loss of the king, his father,
+ whom he concludes drowned. Not a hair of his head is injured,
+ and his princely garments, though drenched in the sea-waves,
+ look fresher than before."</p>
+
+ <p>"That's my delicate Ariel," said Prospero. "Bring him
+ hither: my daughter must see this young prince. Where is the
+ king, and my brother?"</p>
+
+ <p>"I left them," answered Ariel, "searching for Ferdinand,
+ whom, they have little hopes of finding, thinking they saw him
+ perish. Of the ship's crew not one is missing; though each one
+ thinks himself the only one saved: and the ship, though
+ invisible to them, is safe in the harbor."</p>
+
+ <p>"Ariel," said Prospero, "thy charge is faithfully performed:
+ but there is more work yet."</p>
+
+ <p>"Is there more work?" said Ariel. "Let me remind you,
+ master, you have promised me my liberty. I pray, remember, I
+ have done you worthy service, told you no lies, made no
+ mistakes, served you without grudge or grumbling."</p>
+
+ <p>"How now!" said Prospero. "You do not recollect what a
+ torment I freed you from. Have you forgot the wicked witch
+ Sycorax, who with age and envy was almost bent double? Where
+ was she born? Speak; tell
+ me."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page237"
+ id="page237"></a>[pg 237]</span>
+
+ <p>"Sir, in Algiers," said Ariel.</p>
+
+ <p>"O, was she so?" said Prospero. "I must recount what you
+ have been, which I find you do not remember. This bad witch,
+ Sycorax, for her witchcrafts, too terrible to enter human
+ hearing, was banished from Algiers, and here left by the
+ sailors; and because you were a spirit too delicate to execute
+ her wicked commands, she shut you up in a tree, where I found
+ you howling. This torment, remember, I did free you from."</p>
+
+ <p>"Pardon me, dear master," said Ariel, ashamed to seem
+ ungrateful; "I will obey your commands."</p>
+
+ <p>"Do so," said Prospero, "and I will set you free." He then
+ gave orders what further he would have him do; and away went
+ Ariel, first to where he had left Ferdinand, and found him
+ still sitting on the grass in the same melancholy posture.</p>
+
+ <p>"O my young gentleman," said Ariel, when he saw him, "I will
+ soon move you. You must be brought, I find, for the Lady
+ Miranda to have a sight of your pretty person. Come, sir,
+ follow me." He then began singing,</p>
+
+ <div class="poem">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p>"Full fathom five thy father lies;</p>
+
+ <p class="i2">Of his bones are coral made;</p>
+
+ <p>Those are pearls that were his eyes:</p>
+
+ <p class="i2">Nothing of him that doth fade</p>
+
+ <p>But doth suffer a sea-change</p>
+
+ <p>Into something rich and strange.</p>
+
+ <p>Sea-nymphs hourly ring his knell:</p>
+
+ <p>Hark! now I hear them&mdash;Ding-dong, bell."</p>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+
+ <p>This strange news of his lost father soon aroused the prince
+ from the stupid fit into which he had fallen. He followed in
+ amazement the sound of Ariel's voice, till it led him to
+ Prospero and Miranda, who were sitting under the shade of a
+ large tree. Now Miranda had never seen a man before, except her
+ own father.</p>
+
+ <p>"Miranda," said Prospero, "tell me what you are looking at
+ yonder."</p>
+
+ <p>"O father," said Miranda, in a strange surprise, "surely
+ that is a spirit. How it looks about! Believe me, sir, it is a
+ beautiful creature. Is it not a spirit?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, girl," answered her father; "it eats, and sleeps, and
+ has senses such as we have. This young man you see was in
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page238" id="page238"></a>[pg
+ 238]</span> the ship. He is somewhat altered by grief, or you
+ might call him a handsome person. He has lost his companions,
+ and is wandering about to find them."</p>
+
+ <p>Miranda, who thought all men had grave faces and gray beards
+ like her father, was delighted with the appearance of this
+ beautiful young prince; and Ferdinand, seeing such a lovely
+ lady in this desert place, and from the strange sounds he had
+ heard, expecting nothing but wonders, thought he was upon an
+ enchanted island, and that Miranda was the goddess of the
+ place, and as such he began to address her.</p>
+
+ <p>She timidly answered, she was no goddess, but a simple maid,
+ and was going to give him an account of herself, when Prospero
+ interrupted her. He was well pleased to find they admired each
+ other, for he plainly perceived they had (as we say) fallen in
+ love at first sight: but to try Ferdinand's constancy, he
+ resolved to throw some difficulties in their way: therefore
+ advancing forward, he addressed the prince with a stern air,
+ telling him, he came to the island as a spy, to take it from
+ him who was the lord of it. "Follow me," said he, "I will tie
+ you neck and feet together. You shall drink sea-water;
+ shell-fish, withered roots, and husks of acorns shall be your
+ food." "No," said Ferdinand, "I will resist such entertainment,
+ till I see a more powerful enemy," and drew his sword; but
+ Prospero, waving his magic wand, fixed him to the spot where he
+ stood, so that he had no power to move.</p>
+
+ <p>Miranda hung upon her father, saying, "Why are you so
+ ungentle? Have pity, sir; I will be his surety. This is the
+ second man I ever saw, and to me he seems a true one."</p>
+
+ <p>"Silence," said the father: "one word more will make me
+ chide you, girl! What! an advocate for an impostor! You think
+ there are no more such fine men, having seen only him and
+ Caliban. I tell you, foolish girl, most men as far excel this,
+ as he does Caliban." This he said to prove his daughter's
+ constancy; and she replied, "My affections are most humble. I
+ have no wish to see a goodlier man."</p>
+
+ <p>"Come on, young man," said Prospero to the prince; "you have
+ no power to disobey me."</p>
+
+ <p>"I have not indeed," answered Ferdinand; and not knowing
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page239" id="page239"></a>[pg
+ 239]</span> that it was by magic he was deprived of all power
+ of resistance, he was astonished to find himself so strangely
+ compelled to follow Prospero: looking back on Miranda as long
+ as he could see her, he said, as he went after Prospero into
+ the cave, "My spirits are all bound up, as if I were in a
+ dream: but this man's threats, and the weakness which I feel,
+ would seem light to me if from my prison I might once a day
+ behold this fair maid."</p>
+
+ <p>Prospero kept Ferdinand not long confined within the cell:
+ he soon brought out his prisoner, and set him a severe task to
+ perform, taking care to let his daughter know the hard labor he
+ had imposed on him, and then pretending to go into his study,
+ he secretly watched them both.</p>
+
+ <p>Prospero had commanded Ferdinand to pile up some heavy logs
+ of wood. King's sons not being much used to laborious work,
+ Miranda soon after found her lover almost dying with fatigue.
+ "Alas!" said she, "do not work so hard; my father is at his
+ studies, he is safe for these three hours; pray rest
+ yourself."</p>
+
+ <p>"O my dear lady," said Ferdinand, "I dare not. I must finish
+ my task before I take my rest."</p>
+
+ <p>"If you will sit down," said Miranda, "I will carry your
+ logs the while." But this Ferdinand would by no means agree to.
+ Instead of a help Miranda became a hindrance, for they began a
+ long conversation, so that the business of log-carrying went on
+ very slowly.</p>
+
+ <p>Prospero, who had enjoined Ferdinand this task merely as a
+ trial of his love, was not at his books, as his daughter
+ supposed, but was standing by them invisible, to overhear what
+ they said.</p>
+
+ <p>Ferdinand inquired her name, which she told, saying it was
+ against her father's express command she did so.</p>
+
+ <p>Prospero only smiled at this first instance of his
+ daughter's disobedience, for having by his magic art caused his
+ daughter to fall in love so suddenly, he was not angry that she
+ showed her love by forgetting to obey his commands. And he
+ listened well pleased to a long speech of Ferdinand's, in which
+ he professed to love her above all the ladies he ever saw.</p>
+
+ <p>In answer to his praises of her beauty, which he said
+ exceeded all the women in the world, she replied, "I do not
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page240" id="page240"></a>[pg
+ 240]</span> remember the face of any woman, nor have I seen any
+ more men than you, my good friend, and my dear father. How
+ features are abroad, I know not; but, believe me, sir, I would
+ not wish any companion in the world but you, nor can my
+ imagination form any shape but yours that I could like. But,
+ sir, I fear I talk to you too freely, and my father's precepts
+ I forget."</p>
+
+ <p>At this Prospero smiled, and nodded his head, as much as to
+ say, "This goes on exactly as I could wish; my girl will be
+ queen of Naples."</p>
+
+ <p>And then Ferdinand, in another fine long speech (for young
+ princes speak in courtly phrases), told the innocent Miranda he
+ was heir to the crown of Naples, and that she should be his
+ queen.</p>
+
+ <p>"Ah! sir," said she, "I am a fool to weep at what I am glad
+ of. I will answer you in plain and holy innocence. I am your
+ wife if you will marry me."</p>
+
+ <p>Prospero prevented Ferdinand's thanks by appearing visible
+ before them.</p>
+
+ <p>"Fear nothing, my child," said he; "I have overheard, and
+ approve of all you have said. And, Ferdinand, if I have too
+ severely used you, I will make you rich amends, by giving you
+ my daughter. All your vexations were but trials of your love,
+ and you have nobly stood the test. Then as my gift, which your
+ true love has worthily purchased, take my daughter, and do not
+ smile that I boast she is above all praise." He then, telling
+ them that he had business which required his presence, desired
+ they would sit down and talk together till he returned; and
+ this command Miranda seemed not at all disposed to disobey.</p>
+
+ <p>When Prospero left them, he called his spirit Ariel, who
+ quickly appeared before him, eager to relate what he had done
+ with Prospero's brother and the king of Naples. Ariel said he
+ had left them almost out of their senses with fear, at the
+ strange things he had caused them to see and hear. When
+ fatigued with wandering about, and famished for want of food,
+ he had suddenly set before them a delicious banquet, and then,
+ just as they were going to eat, he appeared visible before them
+ in the shape of a harpy, a voracious monster with wings, and
+ the <span class="pagenum"><a name="page241"
+ id="page241"></a>[pg 241]</span> feast vanished away. Then, to
+ their utter amazement, this seeming harpy spoke to them,
+ reminding them of their cruelty in driving Prospero from his
+ dukedom, and leaving him and his infant daughter to perish in
+ the sea; saying, that for this cause these terrors were
+ suffered to afflict them.</p>
+
+ <p>The king of Naples, and Antonio the false brother, repented
+ the injustice they had done to Prospero: and Ariel told his
+ master he was certain their penitence was sincere, and that he,
+ though a spirit, could not but pity them.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then bring them hither, Ariel," said Prospero: "if you, who
+ are but a spirit, feel for their distress, shall not I, who am
+ a human being like themselves, have compassion on them? Bring
+ them, quickly, my dainty Ariel."</p>
+
+ <p>Ariel soon returned with the king, Antonio, and old Gonzalo
+ in their train, who had followed him, wondering at the wild
+ music he played in the air to draw them on to his master's
+ presence. This Gonzalo was the same who had so kindly provided
+ Prospero formerly with books and provisions, when his wicked
+ brother left him, as he thought, to perish in an open boat in
+ the sea.</p>
+
+ <p>Grief and terror had so stupefied their senses, that they
+ did not know Prospero. He first discovered himself to the good
+ old Gonzalo, calling him the preserver of his life; and then
+ his brother and the king knew that he was the injured
+ Prospero.</p>
+
+ <p>Antonio with tears, and sad words of sorrow and true
+ repentance, implored his brother's forgiveness, and the king
+ expressed his sincere remorse for having assisted Antonio to
+ depose his brother: and Prospero forgave them; and, upon their
+ engaging to restore his dukedom, he said to the king of Naples,
+ "I have a gift in store for you too;" and opening a door,
+ showed him his son Ferdinand playing at chess with Miranda.</p>
+
+ <p>Nothing could exceed the joy of the father and the son at
+ this unexpected meeting, for they each thought the other
+ drowned in the storm.</p>
+
+ <p>"O wonder!" said Miranda, "what noble creatures these are!
+ It must surely be a brave world that has such people in
+ it."</p>
+
+ <p>The king of Naples was almost as much astonished at the
+ beauty and excellent graces of the young Miranda, as his son
+ had <span class="pagenum"><a name="page242"
+ id="page242"></a>[pg 242]</span> been. "Who is this maid?" said
+ he; "she seems the goddess that has parted us, and brought us
+ thus together." "No, sir," answered Ferdinand, smiling to find
+ his father had fallen into the same mistake that he had done
+ when he first saw Miranda, "she is a mortal, but by immortal
+ Providence she is mine; I chose her when I could not ask you,
+ my father, for your consent, not thinking you were alive. She
+ is the daughter to this Prospero, who is the famous duke of
+ Milan, of whose renown I have heard so much, but never saw him
+ till now: of him I have received a new life: he has made
+ himself to me a second father, giving me this dear lady."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then I must be her father," said the king; "but oh! how
+ oddly will it sound, that I must ask my child forgiveness."</p>
+
+ <p>"No more of that," said Prospero: "let us not remember our
+ troubles past, since they so happily have ended." And then
+ Prospero embraced his brother, and again assured him of his
+ forgiveness; and said that a wise overruling Providence had
+ permitted that he should be driven from his poor dukedom of
+ Milan, that his daughter might inherit the crown of Naples, for
+ that by their meeting in this desert island, it had happened
+ that the king's son had loved Miranda.</p>
+
+ <p>These kind words which Prospero spoke, meaning to comfort
+ his brother, so filled Antonio with shame and remorse, that he
+ wept and was unable to speak; and the kind old Gonzalo wept to
+ see this joyful reconciliation, and prayed for blessings on the
+ young couple.</p>
+
+ <p>Prospero now told them that their ship was safe in the
+ harbor, and the sailors all on board her, and that he and his
+ daughter would accompany them home the next morning. "In the
+ meantime," says he, "partake of such refreshments as my poor
+ cave affords; and for your evening's entertainment I will
+ relate the history of my life from my first landing in this
+ desert island." He then called for Caliban to prepare some
+ food, and set the cave in order; and the company were
+ astonished at the uncouth form and savage appearance of this
+ ugly monster, who (Prospero said) was the only attendant he had
+ to wait upon him.</p>
+
+ <p>Before Prospero left the island, he dismissed Ariel from his
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page243" id="page243"></a>[pg
+ 243]</span> service, to the great joy of that lively little
+ spirit; who, though he had been a faithful servant to his
+ master, was always longing to enjoy his free liberty, to wander
+ uncontrolled in the air, like a wild bird, under green trees,
+ among pleasant fruits, and sweet-smelling flowers. "My quaint
+ Ariel," said Prospero to the little sprite when he made him
+ free, "I shall miss you; yet you shall have your freedom."
+ "Thank you, my dear master," said Ariel; "but give me leave to
+ attend your ship home with prosperous gales, before you bid
+ farewell to the assistance of your faithful spirit; and then,
+ master, when I am free, how merrily I shall live!" Here Ariel
+ sung this pretty song:</p>
+
+ <div class="poem">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p>"Where the bee sucks, there suck I;</p>
+
+ <p>In a cowslip's bell I lie:</p>
+
+ <p>There I crouch when owls do cry.</p>
+
+ <p>On the bat's back I do fly</p>
+
+ <p>After summer Merrily.</p>
+
+ <p>Merrily, merrily shall I live now</p>
+
+ <p>Under the blossom that hangs on the bough."</p>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+
+ <p>Prospero then buried deep in the earth his magical books and
+ wand, for he was resolved never more to make use of the magic
+ art. And having thus overcome his enemies, and being reconciled
+ to his brother and the king of Naples, nothing now remained to
+ complete his happiness, but to revisit his native land, to take
+ possession of his dukedom, and to witness the happy nuptials of
+ his daughter and Prince Ferdinand, which the king said should
+ be instantly celebrated with great splendor on their return to
+ Naples. At which place, under the safe convoy of the spirit
+ Ariel, they, after a pleasant voyage, soon arrived.</p>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <h4>A MIDSUMMER NIGHT'S DREAM</h4>
+
+ <p>There was a law in the city of Athens which gave to its
+ citizens the power of compelling their daughters to marry
+ whomsoever they pleased; for upon a daughter's refusing to
+ marry the man her father had chosen to be her husband, the
+ father was empowered by this law to cause her to be put to
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page244" id="page244"></a>[pg
+ 244]</span> death; but as fathers do not often desire the death
+ of their own daughters, even though they do happen to prove a
+ little refractory, this law was seldom or never put in
+ execution, though perhaps the young ladies of that city were
+ not unfrequently threatened by their parents with the terrors
+ of it.</p>
+
+ <p>There was one instance, however, of an old man, whose name
+ was Egeus, who actually did come before Theseus (at that time
+ the reigning duke of Athens), to complain that his daughter
+ Hermia, whom he had commanded to marry Demetrius, a young man
+ of a noble Athenian family, refused to obey him, because she
+ loved another young Athenian, named Lysander. Egeus demanded
+ justice of Theseus, and desired that this cruel law might be
+ put in force against his daughter.</p>
+
+ <p>Hermia pleaded in excuse for her disobedience, that
+ Demetrius had formerly professed love for her dear friend
+ Helena, and that Helena loved Demetrius to distraction; but
+ this honorable reason, which Hermia gave for not obeying her
+ father's command, moved not the stern Egeus.</p>
+
+ <p>Theseus, though a great and merciful prince, had no power to
+ alter the laws of his country; therefore he could only give
+ Hermia four days to consider of it: and at the end of that
+ time, if she still refused to marry Demetrius, she was to be
+ put to death.</p>
+
+ <p>When Hermia was dismissed from the presence of the duke, she
+ went to her lover Lysander, and told him the peril she was in,
+ and that she must either give him up and marry Demetrius, or
+ lose her life in four days.</p>
+
+ <p>Lysander was in great affliction at hearing these evil
+ tidings; but recollecting that he had an aunt who lived at some
+ distance from Athens, and that at the place where she lived the
+ cruel law could not be put in force against Hermia (this law
+ not extending beyond the boundaries of the city), he proposed
+ to Hermia that she should steal out of her father's house that
+ night, and go with him to his aunt's house, where he would
+ marry her. "I will meet you," said Lysander, "in the wood a few
+ miles without the city; in that delightful wood where we have
+ so often walked with Helena in the pleasant month of May."</p>
+
+ <p>To this proposal Hermia joyfully agreed; and she told no one
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page245" id="page245"></a>[pg
+ 245]</span> of her intended flight but her friend Helena.
+ Helena (as maidens will do foolish things for love) very
+ ungenerously resolved to go and tell this to Demetrius, though
+ she could hope no benefit from betraying her friend's secret,
+ but the poor pleasure of following her faithless lover to the
+ wood: for she well knew that Demetrius would go thither in
+ pursuit of Hermia.</p>
+
+ <p>The wood in which Lysander and Hermia proposed to meet, was
+ the favorite haunt of those little beings known by the name of
+ <i>Fairies</i>.</p>
+
+ <p>Oberon the king, and Titania the queen of the Fairies, with
+ all their tiny train of followers, in this wood held their
+ midnight revels.</p>
+
+ <p>Between this little king and queen of sprites there
+ happened, at this time, a sad disagreement: they never met by
+ moonlight in the shady walks of this pleasant wood, but they
+ were quarreling, till all their fairy elves would creep into
+ acorn-cups and hide themselves for fear.</p>
+
+ <p>The cause of this unhappy disagreement was Titania's
+ refusing to give Oberon a little changeling boy, whose mother
+ had been Titania's friend; and upon her death the fairy queen
+ stole the child from its nurse, and brought him up in the
+ woods.</p>
+
+ <p>The night on which the lovers were to meet in this wood, as
+ Titania was walking with some of her maids of honor, she met
+ Oberon attended by his train of fairy courtiers.</p>
+
+ <p>"Ill met by moonlight, proud Titania," said the fairy king.
+ The queen replied, "What, jealous Oberon, is it you? Fairies,
+ skip hence; I have forsworn his company." "Tarry, rash fairy,"
+ said Oberon; "am not I thy lord? Why does Titania cross her
+ Oberon? Give me your little changeling boy to be my page."</p>
+
+ <p>"Set your heart at rest," answered the queen; "your whole
+ fairy kingdom buys not the boy of me." She then left her lord
+ in great anger. "Well, go your way," said Oberon: "before the
+ morning dawns I will torment you for this injury."</p>
+
+ <p>Oberon then sent for Puck, his chief favorite and privy
+ counselor.</p>
+
+ <p>Puck (or as he was sometimes called, Robin Goodfellow) was a
+ shrewd and knavish sprite, that used to play comical
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page246" id="page246"></a>[pg
+ 246]</span> pranks in the neighboring villages; sometimes
+ getting into the dairies and skimming the milk, sometimes
+ plunging his light and airy form into the butter-churn, and
+ while he was dancing his fantastic shape in the churn, in vain
+ the dairy-maid would labor to change her cream into butter: nor
+ had the village swains any better success; whenever Puck chose
+ to play his freaks in the brewing copper, the ale was sure to
+ be spoiled. When a few good neighbors were met to drink some
+ comfortable ale together, Puck would jump into the bowl of ale
+ in the likeness of a roasted crab, and when some old goody was
+ going to drink he would bob against her lips, and spill the ale
+ over her withered chin; and presently after, when the same old
+ dame was gravely seating herself to tell her neighbors a sad
+ and melancholy story, Puck would slip her three-legged stool
+ from under her, and down toppled the poor old woman, and then
+ the old gossips would hold their sides and laugh at her, and
+ swear they never wasted a merrier hour.</p>
+
+ <p>"Come hither, Puck," said Oberon to this little merry
+ wanderer of the night; "fetch me the flower which maids call
+ <i>Love in Idleness</i>; the juice of that little purple flower
+ laid on the eyelids of those who sleep, will make them, when
+ they awake, dote on the first thing they see. Some of the juice
+ of that flower I will drop on the eyelids of my Titania when
+ she is asleep; and the first thing she looks upon when she
+ opens her eyes she will fall in love with, even though it be a
+ lion or a bear, a meddling monkey, or a busy ape; and before I
+ will take this charm from off her sight, which I can do with
+ another charm I know of, I will make her give me that boy to be
+ my page."</p>
+
+ <p>Puck, who loved mischief to his heart, was highly diverted
+ with this intended frolic of his master, and ran to seek the
+ flower; and while Oberon was waiting the return of Puck, he
+ observed Demetrius and Helena enter the wood: he overheard
+ Demetrius reproaching Helena for following him, and after many
+ unkind words on his part, and gentle expostulations from
+ Helena, reminding him of his former love and professions of
+ true faith to her, he left her (as he said) to the mercy of the
+ wild beasts, and she ran after him as swiftly as she could.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/246.jpg" name="fig246s"
+ id="fig246s"><img width="300" src="images/246s.jpg"
+ alt="THE FAIRIES SING TITANIA TO SLEEP" /></a><br />
+ the fairies sing titania to sleep
+ </div>
+
+ <p>The fairy king, who was always friendly to true lovers, felt
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page247" id="page247"></a>[pg
+ 247]</span> great compassion for Helena; and perhaps, as
+ Lysander said they used to walk by moonlight in this pleasant
+ wood, Oberon might have seen Helena in those happy times when
+ she was beloved by Demetrius. However that might be, when Puck
+ returned with the little purple flower, Oberon said to his
+ favorite, "Take a part of this flower; there has been a sweet
+ Athenian lady here, who is in love with a disdainful youth; if
+ you find him sleeping, drop some of the love-juice in his eyes,
+ but contrive to do it when she is near him, that the first
+ thing he sees when he awakes may be this despised lady. You
+ will know the man by the Athenian garments which he wears."
+ Puck promised to manage this matter very dexterously: and then
+ Oberon went, unperceived by Titania, to her bower, where she
+ was preparing to go to rest. Her fairy bower was a bank, where
+ grew wild thyme, cowslips, and sweet violets, under a canopy of
+ woodbine, musk-roses, and eglantine. There Titania always slept
+ some part of the night; her coverlet the enameled skin of a
+ snake, which, though a small mantle, was wide enough to wrap a
+ fairy in.</p>
+
+ <p>He found Titania giving orders to her fairies, how they were
+ to employ themselves while she slept. "Some of you," said her
+ majesty, "must kill cankers in the musk-rose buds, and some
+ wage war with the bats for their leathern wings, to make my
+ small elves coats; and some of you keep watch that the
+ clamorous owl, that nightly hoots, come not near me: but first
+ sing me to sleep. Then they began to sing this song:</p>
+
+ <div class="poem">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p>"You spotted snakes with double tongue,</p>
+
+ <p>Thorny hedgehogs, be not seen;</p>
+
+ <p>Newts and blindworms do no wrong,</p>
+
+ <p>Come not near our Fairy Queen.</p>
+
+ <p>Philomel, with melody,</p>
+
+ <p>Sing in our sweet lullaby,</p>
+
+ <p>Lulla, lulla, lullaby; lulla, lulla, lullaby;</p>
+
+ <p>Never harm, nor spell, nor charm,</p>
+
+ <p>Come our lovely lady nigh;</p>
+
+ <p>So good night with lullaby."</p>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+
+ <p>When the fairies had sung their queen asleep with this
+ pretty lullaby, they left her to perform the important services
+ she had enjoined them. Oberon then softly drew near his
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page248" id="page248"></a>[pg
+ 248]</span> Titania, and dropped some of the love-juice on her
+ eyelids, saying,</p>
+
+ <div class="poem">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p>"What thou seest when them dost wake,</p>
+
+ <p>Do it for thy true-love take."</p>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+
+ <p>But to return to Hermia, who made her escape out of her
+ father's house that night, to avoid the death she was doomed to
+ for refusing to marry Demetrius. When she entered the wood, she
+ found her dear Lysander waiting for her, to conduct her to his
+ aunt's house; but before they had passed half through the wood,
+ Hermia was so much fatigued, that Lysander, who was very
+ careful of this dear lady, who had proved her affection for him
+ even by hazarding her life for his sake, persuaded her to rest
+ till morning on a bank of soft moss, and lying down himself on
+ the ground at some little distance, they soon fell fast asleep.
+ Here they were found by Puck, who, seeing a handsome young man
+ asleep, and perceiving that his clothes were made in the
+ Athenian fashion, and that a pretty lady was sleeping near him,
+ concluded that this must be the Athenian maid and her
+ disdainful lover whom Oberon had sent him to seek; and he
+ naturally enough conjectured that, as they were alone together,
+ she must be the first thing he would see when he awoke; so,
+ without more ado, he proceeded to pour some of the juice of the
+ little purple flower into his eyes. But it so fell out, that
+ Helena came that way, and, instead of Hermia, was the first
+ object Lysander beheld when he opened his eyes; and strange to
+ relate, so powerful was the love-charm, all his love for Hermia
+ vanished away, and Lysander fell in love with Helena.</p>
+
+ <p>Had he first seen Hermia when he awoke, the blunder Puck
+ committed would have been of no consequence, for he could not
+ love that faithful lady too well; but for poor Lysander to be
+ forced by a fairy love-charm, to forget his own true Hermia,
+ and to run after another lady, and leave Hermia asleep quite
+ alone in a wood at midnight, was a sad chance indeed.</p>
+
+ <p>Thus this misfortune happened. Helena, as has been before
+ related, endeavored to keep pace with Demetrius when he ran
+ away so rudely from her; but she could not continue this
+ unequal race long, men being always better runners in a long
+ race than ladies. Helena soon lost sight of Demetrius; and as
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page249" id="page249"></a>[pg
+ 249]</span> she was wandering about, dejected and forlorn, she
+ arrived at the place where Lysander was sleeping. "Ah!" said
+ she, "this is Lysander lying on the ground: is he dead or
+ asleep?" Then, gently touching him, she said, "Good sir, if you
+ are alive, awake." Upon this Lysander opened his eyes, and (the
+ love-charm beginning to work) immediately addressed her in
+ terms of extravagant love and admiration; telling her she as
+ much excelled Hermia in beauty as a dove does a raven, and that
+ he would run through fire for her sweet sake; and many more
+ such lover-like speeches. Helena, knowing Lysander was her
+ friend Hermia's lover, and that he was solemnly engaged to
+ marry her, was in the utmost rage when she heard herself
+ addressed in this manner; for she thought (as well she might)
+ that Lysander was making a jest of her. "Oh!" said she, "why
+ was I born to be mocked and scorned by every one? Is it not
+ enough, is it not enough, young man, that I can never get a
+ sweet look or a kind word from Demetrius; but you, sir, must
+ pretend in this disdainful manner to court me? I thought,
+ Lysander, you were a lord of more true gentleness." Saying
+ these words in great anger, she ran away; and Lysander followed
+ her, quite forgetful of his own Hermia, who was still
+ asleep.</p>
+
+ <p>When Hermia awoke, she was in a sad fright at finding
+ herself alone. She wandered about the wood, not knowing what
+ was become of Lysander, or which way to go to seek for him. In
+ the meantime Demetrius not being able to find Hermia and his
+ rival Lysander, and fatigued with his fruitless search, was
+ observed by Oberon fast asleep. Oberon had learnt by some
+ questions he had asked of Puck, that he had applied the
+ love-charm to the wrong person's eyes; and now having found the
+ person first intended, he touched the eyelids of the sleeping
+ Demetrius with the love-juice, and he instantly awoke; and the
+ first thing he saw being Helena, he, as Lysander had done
+ before, began to address love-speeches to her; and just as that
+ moment Lysander, followed by Hermia (for through Puck's unlucky
+ mistake it was now become Hermia's turn to run after her
+ lover), made his appearance; and then Lysander and Demetrius,
+ both speaking together, made love to Helena, they being each
+ one under the influence of the same potent
+ charm.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page250"
+ id="page250"></a>[pg 250]</span>
+
+ <p>The astonished Helena thought that Demetrius, Lysander, and
+ her once dear friend Hermia, were all in a plot together to
+ make a jest of her.</p>
+
+ <p>Hermia was as much surprised as Helena: she knew not why
+ Lysander and Demetrius, who both before loved her, were now
+ become the lovers of Helena; and to Hermia the matter seemed to
+ be no jest.</p>
+
+ <p>The ladies, who before had always been the dearest of
+ friends, now fell to high words together.</p>
+
+ <p>"Unkind Hermia," said Helena, "it is you who have set
+ Lysander to vex me with mock praises; and your other lover
+ Demetrius, who used almost to spurn me with his foot, have you
+ not bid him call me Goddess, Nymph, rare, precious, and
+ celestial? He would not speak thus to me, whom he hates, if you
+ did not set him on to make a jest of me. Unkind Hermia, to join
+ with men in scorning your poor friend. Have you forgot our
+ school-day friendship? How often, Hermia, have we two, sitting
+ on one cushion, both singing one song, with our needles working
+ the same flower, both on the same sampler wrought; growing up
+ together in fashion of a double cherry, scarcely seeming
+ parted! Hermia, it is not friendly in you, it is not maidenly
+ to join with men in scorning your poor friend."</p>
+
+ <p>"I am amazed at your passionate words," said Hermia: "I
+ scorn you not; it seems you scorn me." "Ay, do," returned
+ Helena, "persevere, counterfeit serious looks, and make mouths
+ at me when I turn my back; then wink at each other, and hold
+ the sweet jest up. If you had any pity, grace, or manners, you
+ would not use me thus."</p>
+
+ <p>While Helena and Hermia were speaking these angry words to
+ each other, Demetrius and Lysander left them, to fight together
+ in the wood for the love of Helena.</p>
+
+ <p>When they found the gentlemen had left them, they departed,
+ and once more wandered weary in the wood in search of their
+ lovers.</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as they were gone, the fairy king, who with little
+ Puck had been listening to their quarrels, said to him, "This
+ is your negligence, Puck; or did you do this wilfully?"
+ "Believe me, king of shadows," answered Puck, "it was a
+ mistake; <span class="pagenum"><a name="page251"
+ id="page251"></a>[pg 251]</span> did not you tell me I should
+ know the man by his Athenian garments? However, I am not sorry
+ this has happened, for I think their jangling makes excellent
+ sport." "You heard," said Oberon, "that Demetrius and Lysander
+ are gone to seek a convenient place to fight in. I command you
+ to overhang the night with a thick fog, and lead these
+ quarrelsome lovers so astray in the dark, that they shall not
+ be able to find each other. Counterfeit each of their voices to
+ the other, and with bitter taunts provoke them to follow you,
+ while they think it is their rival's tongue they hear. See you
+ do this, till they are so weary they can go no farther; and
+ when you find they are asleep, drop the juice of this other
+ flower into Lysander's eyes, and when he awakes he will forget
+ his new love for Helena, and return to his old passion for
+ Hermia; and then the two fair ladies may each one be happy with
+ the man she loves, and they will think all that has passed a
+ vexatious dream. About this quickly, Puck, and I will go and
+ see what sweet love my Titania has found."</p>
+
+ <p>Titania was still sleeping, and Oberon seeing a clown near
+ her, who had lost his way in the wood, and was likewise asleep:
+ "This fellow," said he, "shall be my Titania's true love;" and
+ clapping an ass's head over the clown's, it seemed to fit him
+ as well as if it had grown upon his own shoulders. Though
+ Oberon fixed the ass's head on very gently, it awakened him,
+ and rising up, unconscious of what Oberon had done to him, he
+ went towards the bower where the fairy queen slept.</p>
+
+ <p>"Ah! what angel is that I see?" said Titania, opening her
+ eyes, and the juice of the little purple flower beginning to
+ take effect: "are you as wise as you are beautiful?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, mistress," said the foolish clown, "if I have wit
+ enough to find the way out of this wood, I have enough to serve
+ my turn."</p>
+
+ <p>"Out of the wood do not desire to go," said the enamored
+ queen. "I am a spirit of no common rate. I love you. Go with
+ me, and I will give you fairies to attend upon you."</p>
+
+ <p>She then called four of her fairies: their names were,
+ Pease-blossom, Cobweb, Moth, and Mustard-seed.</p>
+
+ <p>"Attend," said the queen, "upon this sweet gentleman;
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page252" id="page252"></a>[pg
+ 252]</span> hop in his walks, and gambol in his sight; feed him
+ with grapes and apricots, and steal for him the honey-bags from
+ the bees. Come, sit with me," said she to the clown, "and let
+ me play with your amiable hairy cheeks, my beautiful ass! and
+ kiss your fair large ears, my gentle joy!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Where is Pease-blossom?" said the ass-headed clown, not
+ much regarding the fairy queen's courtship, but very proud of
+ his new attendants.</p>
+
+ <p>"Here, sir," said little Pease-blossom.</p>
+
+ <p>"Scratch my head," said the clown. "Where is Cobweb?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Here, sir," said Cobweb.</p>
+
+ <p>"Good Mr. Cobweb," said the foolish clown, "kill me the red
+ humblebee on the top of that thistle yonder; and, good Mr.
+ Cobweb, bring me the honey-bag. Do not fret yourself too much
+ in the action, Mr. Cobweb, and take care the honey-bag break
+ not; I should be sorry to have you overflown with a honey-bag.
+ Where is Mustard-seed?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Here, sir," said Mustard-seed: "what is your will?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Nothing," said the clown, "good Mr. Mustard-seed, but to
+ help Mr. Pease-blossom to scratch; I must go to a barber's, Mr.
+ Mustard-seed, for methinks I am marvelous hairy about the
+ face."</p>
+
+ <p>"My sweet love," said the queen, "what will you have to eat?
+ I have a venturous fairy shall seek the squirrel's hoard, and
+ fetch you some new nuts."</p>
+
+ <p>"I had rather have a handful of dried pease," said the
+ clown, who with his ass's head had got an ass's appetite. "But,
+ I pray, let none of your people disturb me, for I have a mind
+ to sleep."</p>
+
+ <p>"Sleep, then," said the queen, "and I will wind you in my
+ arms. O how I love you! how I dote upon you!"</p>
+
+ <p>When the fairy king saw the clown sleeping in the arms of
+ his queen, he advanced within her sight, and reproached her
+ with having lavished her favors upon an ass.</p>
+
+ <p>This she could not deny, as the clown was then sleeping
+ within her arms, with his ass's head crowned by her with
+ flowers.</p>
+
+ <p>When Oberon had teased her for some time, he again
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page253" id="page253"></a>[pg
+ 253]</span> demanded the changeling boy; which she, ashamed of
+ being discovered by her lord with her new favorite, did not
+ dare to refuse him.</p>
+
+ <p>Oberon, having thus obtained the little boy he had so long
+ wished for to be his page, took pity on the disgraceful
+ situation into which, by his merry contrivance, he had brought
+ his Titania, and threw some of the juice of the other flower
+ into her eyes; and the fairy queen immediately recovered her
+ senses, and wondered at her late dotage, saying how she now
+ loathed the sight of the strange monster.</p>
+
+ <p>Oberon likewise took the ass's head from off the clown, and
+ left him to finish his nap with his own fool's head upon his
+ shoulders.</p>
+
+ <p>Oberon and his Titania being now perfectly reconciled, he
+ related to her the history of the lovers, and their midnight
+ quarrels; and she agreed to go with him and see the end of
+ their adventures.</p>
+
+ <p>The fairy king and queen found the lovers and their fair
+ ladies, at no great distance from each other, sleeping on a
+ grass-plot; for Puck, to make amends for his former mistake,
+ had contrived with the utmost diligence to bring them all to
+ the same spot, unknown to each other; and he had carefully
+ removed the charm from off the eyes of Lysander with the
+ antidote the fairy king gave to him.</p>
+
+ <p>Hermia first awoke, and finding her lost Lysander asleep so
+ near her, was looking at him and wondering at his strange
+ inconstancy. Lysander presently opening his eyes, and seeing
+ his dear Hermia, recovered his reason which the fairy charm had
+ before clouded, and with his reason, his love for Hermia; and
+ they began to talk over the adventures of the night, doubting
+ if these things had really happened, or if they had both been
+ dreaming the same bewildering dream.</p>
+
+ <p>Helena and Demetrius were by this time awake; and a sweet
+ sleep having quieted Helena's disturbed and angry spirits, she
+ listened with delight to the professions of love which
+ Demetrius still made to her, and which, to her surprise as well
+ as pleasure, she began to perceive were sincere.</p>
+
+ <p>These fair night-wandering ladies, now no longer rivals,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page254" id="page254"></a>[pg
+ 254]</span> became once more true friends; all the unkind words
+ which had passed were forgiven, and they calmly consulted
+ together what was best to be done in their present situation.
+ It was soon agreed that, as Demetrius had given up his
+ pretensions to Hermia, he should endeavor to prevail upon her
+ father to revoke the cruel sentence of death which had been
+ passed against her. Demetrius was preparing to return to Athens
+ for this friendly purpose, when they were surprised with the
+ sight of Egeus, Hermia's father, who came to the wood in
+ pursuit of his runaway daughter.</p>
+
+ <p>When Egeus understood that Demetrius would not now marry his
+ daughter, he no longer opposed her marriage with Lysander, but
+ gave his consent that they should be wedded on the fourth day
+ from that time, being the same day on which Hermia had been
+ condemned to lose her life; and on that same day Helena
+ joyfully agreed to marry her beloved and now faithful
+ Demetrius.</p>
+
+ <p>The fairy king and queen, who were invisible spectators of
+ this reconciliation, and now saw the happy ending of the
+ lovers' history, brought about through the good offices of
+ Oberon, received so much pleasure, that these kind spirits
+ resolved to celebrate the approaching nuptials with sports and
+ revels throughout their fairy kingdom.</p>
+
+ <p>And now, if any are offended with this story of fairies and
+ their pranks, as judging it incredible and strange, they have
+ only to think that they have been asleep and dreaming, and that
+ all these adventures were visions which they saw in their
+ sleep; and I hope none of my readers will be so unreasonable as
+ to be offended with a pretty harmless Midsummer Night's
+ Dream.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page257"
+ id="page257"></a>[pg 257]</span>
+
+ <h2>OLD-FASHIONED STORIES</h2>
+
+ <h3>SIMPLE SUSAN</h3>
+
+ <h3>By MARIA EDGEWORTH</h3>
+
+ <h4>ADAPTED BY LOUEY CHISHOLM</h4>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <h4>QUEEN OF THE MAY</h4>
+
+ <p>Simple Susan lived one hundred years ago. Mr. Price was
+ Susan's father. He rented a small farm and was always hard at
+ work. No more honest man could be found far or near, and he
+ loved his little daughter from the bottom of his big heart.</p>
+
+ <p>Mrs. Price was Susan's mother. She was a good woman who was
+ always busy cooking, or cleaning, or sewing. The bread and
+ cakes made by her were better than those made by any one else
+ in the village. When she was not doing household work, she
+ earned money by taking in plain needlework. All who knew Mrs.
+ Price liked her and were sorry she was so far from strong. That
+ no girl had a better mother than Susan, every one agreed.</p>
+
+ <p>John and William were Susan's little brothers. They were
+ quite sure that no other boys in all the world had such a good
+ sister as theirs.</p>
+
+ <p>Our story begins on the evening before the first of May. Now
+ one hundred years ago, Mayday was looked forward to with glee
+ by all English children living in the country. Early that
+ morning the lads and lasses of the village, gaily decked with
+ flowers, would go merrily singing from house to house. In their
+ midst would walk the Queen of the May, or sometimes,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page258" id="page258"></a>[pg
+ 258]</span> seated in a chair twined round with blossom, she
+ would be carried from door to door by her little companions.
+ With a wreath of their gayest flowers they would crown her
+ their Queen, and for her would be woven the fairest garlands.
+ After the May carols were sung, cake, coppers, or small coins
+ would be given to the boys and girls.</p>
+
+ <p>To choose their Queen and to arrange their flowers the
+ children would meet on the last day of April. This they did in
+ the village where Susan lived, and their meeting-place was in a
+ corner of a field close by a large pink hawthorn. A shady lane
+ ran past one side of the bush. On another side a sweetbrier
+ hedge separated it from the garden belonging to an
+ attorney.</p>
+
+ <p>This attorney was a very cross man, so cross that the
+ village people were always in fear of him. Although he had
+ hedged and fenced his garden, it sometimes happened that there
+ would stray into it a pig, or a dog, or a goat, or a goose
+ belonging to a poor neighbor. Then the attorney would go to the
+ owner of the stray animal and in a harsh voice demand money to
+ pay for the damage it had done.</p>
+
+ <p>Nor did this cruel man let people walk along the paths
+ through his meadows, although they did no harm. He blocked up
+ the stiles with stones and prickly shrubs, so that not even a
+ gosling could squeeze under them nor a giant climb over. Even
+ the village children were afraid to fly their kites near his
+ fields, lest they should get entangled in his trees or fall on
+ his ground.</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Case was the name of this attorney, and he had one son
+ and a daughter called Barbara.</p>
+
+ <p>For long the father paid no attention to the education of
+ his children, for all his time and thought were given to
+ money-making. Meanwhile Barbara and her brother ran wild with
+ the village children. But suddenly Mr. Case decided to send his
+ son to a tutor to learn Latin, and to employ a maid to wait
+ upon Barbara. At the same time he gave strict orders that his
+ children should no longer play with their old companions.</p>
+
+ <p>The village children were not at all sorry when they heard
+ this. Barbara had not been a favorite among them, for she had
+ always wanted to rule them and to secure for herself the chief
+ part in their games. When Barbara saw that she was not
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page259" id="page259"></a>[pg
+ 259]</span> missed by her old friends she was vexed, and she
+ became angry when she found that they paid no attention to the
+ grand air with which she now spoke nor to the fine frocks which
+ she wore.</p>
+
+ <p>To one girl Barbara had a special dislike. This was none
+ other than Susan Price, the sweetest-tempered and busiest lass
+ in the village, and the pride and delight of all who knew her.
+ The farm rented by Susan's father was near the house in which
+ Mr. Case lived, and Barbara from her window used to watch Susan
+ at work.</p>
+
+ <p>Sometimes the little girl was raking the garden-plots in her
+ neat garden; sometimes she was weeding the paths; sometimes she
+ was kneeling at her beehive with fresh flowers for her bees,
+ and sometimes she was in the hen-yard scattering corn among the
+ eager little chickens. In the evening Barbara often saw her
+ sitting in the summer-house over which sweet honeysuckle crept,
+ and there, with a clean three-legged pine table before her upon
+ which to lay her work, Susan would sew busily. Her seams were
+ even and neat, for Mrs. Price had taught her daughter that what
+ is worth doing is worth doing well.</p>
+
+ <p>Both Susan and her mother were great favorites in the
+ village. It was at Mrs. Price's door that the children began
+ their Mayday rounds, and it was Susan who was usually Queen of
+ the May.</p>
+
+ <p>It was now time for the village children to choose their
+ queen. The setting sun was shining full upon the pink blossoms
+ of the hawthorn when the merry group met to make their plans
+ for the morrow.</p>
+
+ <p>Barbara Case, sulkily walking alone in her father's garden,
+ heard the happy voices and, crouching behind the hedge that
+ divided her from the other children, she listened to their
+ plans.</p>
+
+ <p>"Where is Susan?" were the first words she overheard.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, where is Susan?" repeated a boy called Philip,
+ stopping short in a tune he was playing on his pipe: "I want
+ her to sing me this air, I can't remember how it goes."</p>
+
+ <p>"And I wish Susan would come, I'm sure," cried Mary, a
+ little girl whose lap was full of primroses. "She will give me
+ some thread to tie up my nosegays, and she will show me where
+ the fresh violets grow, and she has promised to give me a great
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page260" id="page260"></a>[pg
+ 260]</span> bunch of her cowslips to wear to-morrow. I wish she
+ would come."</p>
+
+ <p>"Nothing can be done without Susan!" cried another child.
+ "She always shows us where the nicest flowers are to be found
+ in the lanes and meadows."</p>
+
+ <p>"Susan must help to weave the garlands," said another.</p>
+
+ <p>"Susan must be Queen of the May!" shouted several
+ together.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why does she not come?" grumbled Philip.</p>
+
+ <p>Rose, who was Susan's special friend, now came forward to
+ remind them that when Susan was late it was always because she
+ was needed at home.</p>
+
+ <p>"Go, Rose, and tell her to make haste," cried the impatient
+ Philip. "Attorney Case is dining at the Abbey to-day, and if he
+ comes home and finds us here, perhaps he will drive us away. He
+ says this bit of ground belongs to his garden, but that is not
+ true, for Farmer Price says we have all as much right to it as
+ he has. He wants to rob us of our playground. I wish he and
+ Bab, or Miss Barbara, as I suppose we must now call her, were a
+ hundred miles away, I do. Just yesterday she knocked down my
+ ninepins on purpose as she passed with her gown trailing in the
+ dust."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," cried Mary, "her gown is always trailing. She does
+ not hold it up nicely like Susan, and in spite of all her fine
+ clothes she never looks half so neat. Mamma says she hopes I
+ shall grow like Susan, and so do I. I should not like to be
+ vain like Barbara were I ever so rich."</p>
+
+ <p>"Rich or poor," said Philip, "it does not become a girl to
+ be vain, much less bold, as Barbara was the other day. She
+ stood at her father's door, and stared at a strange gentleman
+ who stopped near by, to let his horse drink. I know what he
+ thought of Bab, by his looks, and of Susan too; for Susan was
+ in her garden, bending down a branch of the laburnum-tree,
+ looking at its yellow flowers which had just come out, and when
+ the gentleman asked her how many miles it was to the next
+ village, she answered him modestly, not bashfully as if she had
+ never seen any one before, but just right. Then she pulled on
+ her straw hat that had fallen back while she was looking up at
+ the <span class="pagenum"><a name="page261"
+ id="page261"></a>[pg 261]</span> laburnum, and went her way
+ home, and the gentleman said to me after she was gone, 'Pray,
+ who is that neat, modest girl?' But I wish," cried Philip,
+ interrupting himself, "I wish Susan would come!"</p>
+
+ <p>Barbara, still crouching on the other side of the hedge,
+ heard everything that was said.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/260.jpg" name="fig260s"
+ id="fig260s"><img width="300" src="images/260s.jpg"
+ alt="BENDING DOWN A BRANCH OF THE LABURNUM-TREE" />
+ </a><br />
+ bending down a branch of the laburnum-tree
+ </div>
+
+ <p>Susan was all this time, as her friend Rose had guessed,
+ busy at home. She had been kept by her father's returning later
+ than usual. His supper was ready for him nearly an hour before
+ he came home, and Susan swept the hearth twice, and twice put
+ on wood to make a cheerful blaze for him. At last, when he did
+ come in, he took no notice of the blaze or of Susan; and when
+ his wife asked him how he was, he made no answer, but stood
+ with his back to the fire, looking very gloomy. Susan put his
+ supper upon the table, and set his own chair for him, but he
+ pushed away the chair and turned from the table, saying, "I
+ shall eat nothing, child. Why have you such a fire to roast me
+ at this time of year?"</p>
+
+ <p>"You said yesterday, father, I thought, that you liked a
+ little cheerful wood-fire in the evening, and there was a great
+ shower of hail. Your coat is quite wet. We must dry it."</p>
+
+ <p>"Take it, then, child," he said, pulling it off, "I shall
+ soon have no coat to dry. Take my hat, too," he went on,
+ throwing it upon the ground.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan hung up his hat, put his coat over the back of a chair
+ to dry, and then stood looking at her mother, who was not well.
+ She had tired herself with baking, and now, alarmed by her
+ husband's strange conduct, she sat down pale and trembling. The
+ father threw himself into a chair, folded his arms, and gazed
+ into the fire.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan was the first who ventured to break the silence.
+ Fondling her father, she tried to coax him to eat the supper
+ prepared for him. This, however, she could not persuade him to
+ do, but he said, with a faint smile, that he thought he could
+ eat one of her guinea-hen's eggs. Susan thanked him, and showed
+ her eagerness to please her dear father by running as fast as
+ she could to her neat chicken-yard. Alas! the guinea-fowl was
+ not there. It had strayed into the garden of Mr. Case.
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page262" id="page262"></a>[pg
+ 262]</span> She could see it through the paling. Going to the
+ garden-gate, Susan timidly opened it, and seeing Miss Barbara
+ walk slowly by, she asked if she might come in and take her
+ guinea-fowl.</p>
+
+ <p>Barbara, who at that moment was thinking of all she had
+ heard the village children say, started when she heard Susan's
+ voice.</p>
+
+ <p>"Shut the gate," she said crossly, "you have no business in
+ our garden. As for the hen, I shall keep it; it is always
+ flying in here and plaguing us, and my father told me I might
+ catch it and keep it the next time it got in, and it is in
+ now." Then Barbara called to her maid Betty and bid her catch
+ the mischievous bird.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, my guinea-hen! my pretty guinea-hen!" cried Susan, as
+ mistress and maid hunted the frightened, screaming creature
+ from corner to corner.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now we have it!" said Betty, holding it fast by the
+ legs.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then pay damages, Queen Susan, or you may say good-by to
+ your pretty guinea-hen," said Barbara in a rude tone.</p>
+
+ <p>"It has done no damage," said Susan; "but tell me what I
+ must pay."</p>
+
+ <p>"A shilling," said Barbara.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, if only sixpence would do!" said Susan; "I have but
+ sixpence of my own in the world, and here it is."</p>
+
+ <p>"It won't do," said Barbara, turning her back.</p>
+
+ <p>"Nay, but hear me," cried Susan, "let me at least come in to
+ look for its eggs. I only want one for my father's supper. You
+ shall have all the rest."</p>
+
+ <p>"What is your father or his supper to us; is he so
+ particular that he can eat none but guinea-hen's eggs?" said
+ Barbara. "If you want your hen and your eggs, pay for them, and
+ you shall have them."</p>
+
+ <p>"I have only sixpence and you say that won't do," said Susan
+ with a sigh, as she looked at her favorite which was in the
+ maid's cruel hands, struggling and screaming in vain.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan went away feeling very sad. At the door of her
+ father's cottage she saw her friend Rose, who had just come to
+ summon her to the hawthorn-bush.</p>
+
+ <p>"They are all at the hawthorn, and I have come for you. We
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page263" id="page263"></a>[pg
+ 263]</span> can do nothing without you, dear Susan," cried
+ Rose, running to meet her the moment she saw her, "You are
+ chosen Queen of the May&mdash;come, make haste. But what is the
+ matter? Why do you look so sad?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Ah!" said Susan, "don't wait for me; I can't come to you,
+ but," she added, pointing to the tuft of cowslips in the
+ garden, "gather those for little Mary; I promised them to her,
+ and tell her the violets are under a hedge just beside the
+ stile, on the right as we go to church. Good-by! never mind me;
+ I can't come&mdash;I can't stay, for my father wants me."</p>
+
+ <p>"But don't turn away your face; I won't keep you a moment;
+ only tell me what is the matter," said her friend, following
+ her into the cottage.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, nothing, not much," said Susan; "if I had not wanted
+ the egg in a great hurry for father, it would not have vexed
+ me&mdash;to be sure I should have clipped my guinea-hen's
+ wings, and then she could not have flown over the hedge; but
+ let us think no more about it now," she added, trying to hide a
+ tear.</p>
+
+ <p>When Rose, however, learned that her friend's guinea-hen was
+ kept a prisoner by Barbara, she was hot with indignation, and
+ at once ran back to tell the story to her companions.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/262.jpg" name="fig262s"
+ id="fig262s"><img width="300" src="images/262s.jpg"
+ alt="'IT WON'T DO,' SAID BARBARA, TURNING HER BACK" />
+ </a><br />
+ "it won't do," said barbara, turning her back.
+ </div>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <h4>BAD NEWS</h4>
+
+ <p>As Susan entered the cottage parlor, Farmer Price drew his
+ chair close to his wife. "You see there is something amiss with
+ me," he said; "I must tell you what it is." Her father lowered
+ his voice, and Susan, who was not sure that he wished her to
+ hear what he was going to say, moved from behind his chair.</p>
+
+ <p>"Susan, don't go; sit down here, sweet Susan," he said,
+ making room for her beside him. "I am afraid I was cross when I
+ came in to-night, but I had something to vex me, as you shall
+ hear."</p>
+
+ <p>Then the farmer told how, a fortnight before, lots had been
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page264" id="page264"></a>[pg
+ 264]</span> drawn in the nearest town, to see which men there
+ and in the surrounding villages should leave home to be trained
+ as soldiers. For a hundred years ago it was in this way that
+ men were found to defend their country. Only if they were under
+ eighteen or above forty years of age could they escape drawing
+ lots.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now, as I would be forty in ten days," said the farmer, "I
+ was told just to call myself forty then and there; but the
+ truth is the truth, and should be spoken at all times, come
+ what may. And when the lots were drawn, it fell to me among
+ others to leave home to be trained to fight. I was thinking how
+ unhappy we should be to part, when I heard that if I paid nine
+ guineas to another man, he would take my place, and I could
+ remain at home with you. I had not the money, for you know the
+ bad luck we had with the sheep this year, and how they died one
+ after the other. But I went to Mr. Case and asked him to lend
+ me the money. He said he would if I handed over to him my
+ lease, for he said, 'If you do not repay me the guineas I shall
+ keep the lease until you do.'"</p>
+
+ <p>"That was a fortnight ago, and to-night Attorney Case tells
+ me he has discovered that, owing to some mistake in the lease,
+ we may be turned out of the farm at any time. But I've not come
+ to the worst part yet."</p>
+
+ <p>Here Farmer Price stopped short, and his wife and Susan
+ gazed anxiously into his face.</p>
+
+ <p>"The truth must be told," he said with a deep sigh, "I must
+ now leave you in three days."</p>
+
+ <p>"Must you?" said his wife faintly. "Susan dear, open the
+ window." Susan ran to do as she was bid, and then returned to
+ her mother's side. The fresh air soon revived the poor woman,
+ and she begged her husband to go on with his story, and to hide
+ nothing from her.</p>
+
+ <p>Farmer Price had no wish to hide anything from those he
+ loved so well. He believed that the truth should be spoken at
+ all times, but never had he found it so difficult as at this
+ moment. What had happened was this. Attorney Case had met
+ Farmer Price that evening. The farmer was coming home,
+ whistling, from a new-plowed field. The Attorney was on
+ horseback, and had just dined at the Abbey with Sir Arthur
+ Somers. The <span class="pagenum"><a name="page265"
+ id="page265"></a>[pg 265]</span> Abbey had until lately
+ belonged to Sir Arthur's elder brother, but now that he was
+ dead, Sir Arthur owned the estate.</p>
+
+ <p>Attorney Case had looked after the property for the elder
+ brother, and was anxious to be employed by Sir Arthur. There
+ were many farms on the estate, and it had been part of the
+ Attorney's work to look after the repairs and to collect the
+ rents. Unfortunately, he had an unpleasant way of dealing with
+ the farmers, ordering them as he had no right to do, and being
+ harsh with those who, through misfortune, had not enough money
+ to to pay their rent in full. As the Attorney met Farmer Price
+ he stopped him, saying, "A word with you, Farmer Price, if you
+ please. Walk alongside my horse, and listen. You know the field
+ with the pink hawthorn where the village children play? I am
+ going to add it to my garden. I hear you say it does not belong
+ to me. What do you mean by that?"</p>
+
+ <p>"I mean what I say," said Price; "the field is not yours."
+ So angry was the Attorney on hearing this, that he at once made
+ up his mind to hurt the farmer as much as he could.</p>
+
+ <p>"My good man," he said, "you will remember that a fortnight
+ ago I lent you nine guineas. To-morrow morning you must return
+ them to me."</p>
+
+ <p>"Those guineas," replied the farmer, "I paid, as you know,
+ to the man who said he would go instead of me to be trained as
+ a soldier. But he has not yet gone, and I can still get the
+ guineas back from him and go myself to be trained."</p>
+
+ <p>The Attorney was not prepared for this answer. "I do not
+ want to drive you to that," he said, pretending to be kind.
+ "Now about the field&mdash;you do not want to add it to the
+ farm, do you?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Certainly not, for it is not mine."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then why object to my having it?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Because it is not yours. The children who play there have
+ the right. It belongs to the village. Truth is truth."</p>
+
+ <p>"And a debt is a debt," shouted the angry Attorney, "and
+ must be paid. Bring me my nine guineas!"</p>
+
+ <p>With a heavy heart Farmer Price walked on. He passed the
+ door of his cottage and went in search of the man to whom he
+ had paid the money. The man was quite willing to return it, as
+ there were many others, he said, who would be willing to
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page266" id="page266"></a>[pg
+ 266]</span> give him the same sum or more for his services. The
+ moment Price got the money he took it straight to Mr. Case,
+ laid it on his desk and was going away, when the Attorney
+ called out, "Not so fast, you have forgotten your lease."</p>
+
+ <p>"Ah yes! my lease, I had forgotten it. Let me have it."</p>
+
+ <p>"Pardon me," said the Attorney with a cruel smile, "but I
+ cannot let you have it. On reading it over I find that owing to
+ a mistake you may be turned out of the farm at any time. I must
+ keep it to show to Sir Arthur. I have no doubt he will want me
+ to look after things for him as I did for his brother. Now
+ perhaps you wish you had quietly let me add the field to my
+ garden."</p>
+
+ <p>Farmer Price said nothing, but dragged himself home a sad
+ man.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/266.jpg" name="fig266s"
+ id="fig266s"><img width="300" src="images/266s.jpg"
+ alt="'AND HERE'S HER CROWN!' CRIED ROSE" /></a><br />
+ "and here's her crown!" cried rose
+ </div>
+
+ <h4>III</h4>
+
+ <h4>SUSAN'S GUINEA-FOWL</h4>
+
+ <p>When Susan had heard her father's story, she quite forgot
+ the loss of her guinea-hen, and thought only of her poor mother
+ who, try as she might, could not bear the bad news. In the
+ middle of the night Susan was roused, as Mrs. Price had become
+ ill, and it was not until early morning that the poor woman
+ fell asleep, her daughter's hand locked fast in hers. Susan
+ remained sitting by the bedside, breathing quietly. Then seeing
+ the candle burn low, she gently withdrew her hand, and on
+ tiptoe went to put out the light, lest the unpleasant smell
+ should wake her mother. All was silent. The gray light of dawn
+ stole into the little room; the sun rose slowly, and Susan
+ peered through the small panes of the lattice window at the
+ glorious sight. A few birds began to chirp, and as the little
+ girl listened to them, her mother started and spoke in her
+ sleep. Susan quickly hung up a white apron before the window to
+ keep out the light, and at the same moment she heard in the
+ distance the voices of the village children singing their
+ Mayday songs. Soon she could see them, Philip leading the way
+ playing upon his pipe and tabor, the others following with
+ nosegays and garlands in their hands. They were coming towards
+ the cottage. Quickly <span class="pagenum"><a name="page267"
+ id="page267"></a>[pg 267]</span> but quietly Susan unlatched
+ the door and ran to meet them.</p>
+
+ <p>"Here she is!&mdash;here's Susan!" they exclaimed
+ joyfully.</p>
+
+ <p>"Here's the Queen of the May!"</p>
+
+ <p>"And here's her crown!" cried Rose, pressing forward.</p>
+
+ <p>But Susan put her finger to her lips, and pointed to her
+ mother's window. Philip's pipe stopped at once.</p>
+
+ <p>"Thank you," said Susan, "but my mother is ill. I can't
+ leave her, you know." Then as she gently put aside the crown,
+ her companions asked her to say who should wear it for her.</p>
+
+ <p>"Will you, dear Rose?" she said, placing the garland upon
+ her friend's head. "It's a charming May morning," she added,
+ with a smile; "good-by. We shall not hear your voices or the
+ pipe when you have turned the corner into the village, so you
+ need only stop till then, Philip."</p>
+
+ <p>"I shall stop for all day," said Philip: "I've no wish to
+ play any more."</p>
+
+ <p>"Good-by, poor Susan! It is a pity you can't come with us,"
+ said all the children.</p>
+
+ <p>Little Mary ran after Susan to the cottage door. "I forgot
+ to thank you," she said, "for the cowslips. Look how pretty
+ they are, and smell how sweet the violets are that I wear, and
+ kiss me quick or I shall be left behind."</p>
+
+ <p>Susan kissed the little breathless girl, and returned softly
+ to the side of her mother's bed. "How grateful that child is to
+ me for a cowslip only! How can I be grateful enough to such a
+ mother as this?" she said to herself, as she bent over the pale
+ face of her sleeping mother.</p>
+
+ <p>Her mother's unfinished knitting lay upon a table near the
+ bed, and Susan sat down in her wicker armchair, and went on
+ with the row, in the middle of which Mrs. Price had stopped the
+ evening before. "She taught me to knit, she taught me
+ everything that I know," thought Susan, "and best of all, she
+ taught me to love her, to wish to be like her." Mrs. Price,
+ when she awoke, felt much better, but slowly there came back to
+ her memory the sad news she had heard the evening before. She
+ asked herself if it could have been a dream, but no, it was all
+ too true. She could recall her husband's look as he had said,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page268" id="page268"></a>[pg
+ 268]</span> "I must leave you in three days." Then suddenly she
+ roused herself. "Why! he'll want, he'll want a hundred things,"
+ she said. "I must get his linen ready for him. I'm afraid it's
+ very late. Susan, why did you let me sleep so long?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Everything shall be ready, dear mother; only don't hurry,"
+ said Susan. And indeed her mother was not able to bear any
+ hurry, or to do any work that day. Susan's loving help was
+ never more wanted. She understood so well, she obeyed so
+ exactly, and when she was left to herself, judged so wisely,
+ that her mother had little trouble in directing her. She said
+ that Susan never did too little or too much.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan was mending her father's linen, when Rose tapped
+ softly at the window, and beckoned to her to come out. She
+ went.</p>
+
+ <p>"How is your mother, in the first place?" said Rose.</p>
+
+ <p>"Better, thank you."</p>
+
+ <p>"That is nice, and I have a little bit of good news for you
+ besides&mdash;here," she said, pulling out a purse, in which
+ there was money. "We'll get the guinea-hen back again&mdash;we
+ have all agreed about it. This is the money that has been given
+ to us in the village this May morning. At every door they gave
+ silver. See how generous they have been&mdash;twelve shillings.
+ Now we are a match for Miss Barbara. You won't like to leave
+ home, so I'll go to her, and you shall see your guinea-hen in
+ ten minutes."</p>
+
+ <p>Rose hurried away, filled with joy at the thought that soon
+ she would return to Susan with her lost bird.</p>
+
+ <p>Miss Barbara's maid, Betty, was the first person she saw on
+ reaching the Attorney's house. Rose said she must see Barbara
+ and was shown into a parlor where the young lady sat reading a
+ book.</p>
+
+ <p>"How you startled me! Is it only you?" she said, looking up
+ and seeing no one but the maid. Then, as she caught sight of
+ Rose, she went on, "You should have said I was not at home.
+ Pray, my good girl, what do you want?" she said, turning to
+ Rose. "Is it to borrow or to beg that you are here?"</p>
+
+ <p>"The person from whom I come does not wish either to borrow
+ or to beg, but to pay for what she asks," answered Rose. Then
+ opening her well-filled purse, she held out to Barbara a
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page269" id="page269"></a>[pg
+ 269]</span> bright shilling, saying, "Now please be so good as
+ to give me Susan's guinea-hen."</p>
+
+ <p>"You may keep your shilling," replied Barbara. "It would
+ have been enough if it had been paid yesterday when I asked for
+ it, but I told Susan that as it was not paid then I should keep
+ the hen, and I shall. You may go back and tell her so."</p>
+
+ <p>While Barbara spoke she had been looking into the open purse
+ in Rose's hand. She thought she could count at least ten
+ shillings. Could she not manage to get at least five of them
+ for the guinea-hen, she wondered?</p>
+
+ <p>Rose little guessed what was going on in Barbara's mind, and
+ exclaimed angrily, "We must have Susan's favorite hen, whatever
+ it costs. If one shilling won't do, take two. If two won't do,
+ take three," and she flung the coins one after the other on the
+ table.</p>
+
+ <p>"Three won't do," said Barbara.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then take four."</p>
+
+ <p>Barbara shook her head.</p>
+
+ <p>A fifth shilling was offered, but Barbara, seeing that she
+ had the game in her own hands, was silent.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Rose threw down shilling after shilling, till twelve
+ bright pieces lay on the table, and her purse was empty.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now you may take the guinea-hen," said Barbara.</p>
+
+ <p>Rose pushed the money towards the greedy girl, but at the
+ same moment remembered that it had not belonged to herself
+ alone. At once she seized the silver coins, and saying that she
+ must first see if the friends with whom she shared them were
+ willing to part with them, she ran off.</p>
+
+ <p>When the children heard Rose's story, they were amazed, that
+ even Barbara could be so mean, but they all agreed that at any
+ cost the guinea-fowl must be set free. In a body they went to
+ Susan and told her so, at the same time handing her the purse.
+ Then they ran off without waiting to be thanked. Rose only
+ stayed behind. Susan knew that she must accept the present
+ gladly, just as she would give one gladly. She was much touched
+ by the kindness of her friends, but she took the purse as
+ simply as she would have given
+ it.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page270"
+ id="page270"></a>[pg 270]</span>
+
+ <p>"Well," said Rose, "shall I go back for the guinea-hen?"</p>
+
+ <p>"The guinea-hen!" said Susan, starting from a dream into
+ which she had fallen as she looked at the purse. "Certainly I
+ do long to see my pretty guinea-hen once more; but I was not
+ thinking of her just then&mdash;I was thinking of my
+ father."</p>
+
+ <p>Now Susan had often that day heard her mother wish that she
+ had but money enough in the world to pay to the man who was
+ willing to be trained to fight instead of her husband.</p>
+
+ <p>"This, to be sure, will go but a little way," thought Susan;
+ "but still it may be of some use." She told her thought to
+ Rose, and ended by saying that if the money was given to her to
+ spend as she pleased, she would give it to her father.</p>
+
+ <p>"It is all yours, my dear, good Susan!" cried Rose. "This is
+ so like you!&mdash;but I'm sorry that Miss Bab must keep your
+ guinea-hen. I would not be her for all the guinea-hens, or
+ guineas either, in the whole world. Why, the guinea-hen won't
+ make her happy, and you'll be happy even without it, because
+ you are good. Let me come and help you to-morrow," she went on,
+ looking at Susan's work, "if you have any more mending to
+ do&mdash;I never liked work till I worked with you. I won't
+ forget my thimble or my scissors," she added,
+ laughing&mdash;"though I used to forget them when I was a
+ wilder girl. I assure you I am clever with my needle
+ now&mdash;try me."</p>
+
+ <p>Susan told her friend that she would most gladly accept her
+ help, but that she had finished all the needlework that was
+ wanted at present. "But do you know," she went on, "I shall be
+ very busy to-morrow. I won't tell you what it is that I have to
+ do, for I am afraid I shall not succeed, but if I do succeed,
+ I'll come and tell you directly, because you will be so
+ glad."</p>
+
+ <h4>IV</h4>
+
+ <h4>SUSAN VISITS THE ABBEY</h4>
+
+ <p>Susan, who had always been attentive to what her mother
+ taught her, and who had often helped her when she was baking
+ bread and cakes for the family at the Abbey, now thought that
+ she could herself bake a batch of bread. One of the new
+ servants <span class="pagenum"><a name="page271"
+ id="page271"></a>[pg 271]</span> from the Abbey had been sent
+ all round the village in the morning in search of loaves, and
+ had not been able to procure any that were eatable. Mrs.
+ Price's last baking had failed for want of good yeast. She was
+ not now strong enough to attempt another herself, and when the
+ brewer's boy came to tell her that he had some fine fresh
+ yeast, she thanked him, but sighed and said she feared it would
+ be of little use to her. But Susan went to work with great
+ care, and the next morning when her bread came out of the oven,
+ it was excellent: at least her mother said so, and she was a
+ good judge. It was sent to the Abbey, and as the family had not
+ tasted any good bread since they had come there, they also were
+ warm in its praise. With some surprise, they heard from the
+ housekeeper that this excellent bread was made by a young girl
+ only twelve years old. The housekeeper, who had known Susan
+ since she was a child, was pleased to have a chance to speak
+ about her.</p>
+
+ <p>"She is the busiest little creature, ma'am, in the world,"
+ she said to her mistress. "I can't so well call her little now
+ though, since she's grown tall and slender to look at; and glad
+ I am she is grown up good to look at; for handsome is that
+ handsome does, ma'am. She thinks no more of her being handsome
+ than I do myself; yet she has as proper a respect for herself,
+ ma'am, as you have; and I always see her neat, and she is
+ always with her mother, or fit people, as a girl should be. As
+ for her mother, she dotes upon her, as well she may; for I
+ should myself if I had half such a daughter, ma'am; and then
+ she has two little brothers, and she's as good to them and, my
+ boy Philip says, taught them to read more than the
+ school-mistress did; but I beg your pardon, ma'am, I cannot
+ stop myself when I once begin to talk of Susan."</p>
+
+ <p>"You have really said enough to make me wish to see her,"
+ said her mistress. "Pray send for her now; we can see her
+ before we go out to walk."</p>
+
+ <p>The kind housekeeper gladly sent off her boy Philip for
+ Susan, who was never so untidy that she could not come at once
+ when sent for. She had been very busy, but orderly people can
+ be busy and neat at the same time. Putting on her usual straw
+ hat, she set out for the Abbey. On the way she overtook Rose's
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page272" id="page272"></a>[pg
+ 272]</span> mother, who was going there too with a basket of
+ fresh muslin. When Susan reached the Abbey, her simple dress
+ and manners and the good sense with which she answered the
+ questions put to her, pleased the ladies greatly. They saw that
+ the housekeeper had not spoken too highly of the farmer's
+ daughter.</p>
+
+ <p>These two ladies were the sisters of Sir Arthur Somers. They
+ were kind and wise; kind in wishing to spread happiness among
+ their poor neighbors, and wise in wishing these people to be
+ happy in their own way. They did not wish to manage them, but
+ only to help them. As Sir Arthur was always willing to aid his
+ sisters, it seemed as if they would prove a blessing in in the
+ village near which they had come to live. When Susan took leave
+ of the ladies, she was told they would call at her home that
+ evening at six o'clock. Such a grand event as Susan's visit to
+ the Abbey soon became known to Barbara Case and her maid, and
+ together they watched for her return.</p>
+
+ <p>"There she is! She has just gone into her garden," cried
+ Bab; "we'll run in at once and hear all about it."</p>
+
+ <p>Susan was gathering some marigolds and parsley for her
+ mother's soup. "Well, Susan, and how are things going with you
+ to-day?" asked Barbara.</p>
+
+ <p>"My mother is rather better, she says; thank you,
+ ma'am."</p>
+
+ <p>"'Ma'am, how polite we have grown all of a sudden!" said
+ Bab, winking at her maid. "One can see you have been in good
+ company. Come, tell us all about it."</p>
+
+ <p>"Did you see the ladies themselves," asked Betty, "or only
+ the housekeeper?"</p>
+
+ <p>"What room were you in?" went on Bab. "Did you see Miss
+ Somers or Sir Arthur?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Miss Somers," replied Susan.</p>
+
+ <p>"Betty, she saw Miss Somers! I must hear about it. Susan,
+ stop gathering those things, and have a chat with us."</p>
+
+ <p>"I can't indeed, Miss Barbara, for my mother wants her soup,
+ and I am in a hurry." And Susan ran home.</p>
+
+ <p>"Would you believe it, her head is full of soup now?" said
+ Bab to her maid. "She seems to think nothing of her visit to
+ the Abbey. My papa may well call her <i>Simple Susan</i>. But
+ simple or not I mean to get what I want out of her. Maybe
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page273" id="page273"></a>[pg
+ 273]</span> when she has settled the grand matter of the soup,
+ she'll be able to speak. I'll step in and ask to see her
+ mother. That will put her in a good humor in a trice."</p>
+
+ <p>Barbara went to the cottage and found Susan standing over a
+ pot on the fire. "Is the soup ready?" she asked. "I'll wait
+ till you take it in to your mother and go in with you. I want
+ to ask her how she is, myself."</p>
+
+ <p>"Sit down then, miss," said Susan, "I have put in the
+ parsley, so the soup is nearly ready."</p>
+
+ <p>Barbara sat down and plied Susan with questions. How was
+ Miss Somers dressed? Were the sisters dressed alike? What were
+ they having for dinner at the Abbey? Above all, what could Miss
+ Somers mean by saying she would call at Farmer Price's cottage
+ at six o'clock that evening? "What do you think she could
+ mean?" asked Barbara.</p>
+
+ <p>"What she said," replied Susan, "that she would be here at
+ six o'clock."</p>
+
+ <p>"That's plain enough," said Barbara, "but what else do you
+ think she meant? People, you know, often mean more or less than
+ they say."</p>
+
+ <p>"They do," answered Susan, with a smile that made Barbara
+ guess of whom she was thinking.</p>
+
+ <p>But Bab did not mean Susan to know that she guessed, so she
+ said, "I suppose you think that Miss Somers meant more than she
+ said?"</p>
+
+ <p>"I was not thinking of Miss Somers when I said what I did,"
+ replied Susan.</p>
+
+ <p>There was a pause, and then Bab remarked, "How nice the soup
+ looks!"</p>
+
+ <p>Susan had poured it into a basin, and as she dropped over it
+ the bright yellow marigold, it looked very tempting. She tasted
+ it and added a little salt; tasted it again, and added a little
+ more. Then she thought it was just as her mother liked it.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, I must taste it!" said Bab, seizing the basin
+ greedily.</p>
+
+ <p>"Won't you take a spoon?" said Susan, trembling as she saw
+ the big mouthfuls Barbara took with a loud noise.</p>
+
+ <p>"Take a spoon, indeed!" exclaimed Bab. "How dare you, how
+ dare you speak so to me? 'Take a spoon, pig!' was what
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page274" id="page274"></a>[pg
+ 274]</span> you meant to say! I'll never enter your cottage
+ again!" And she flounced out of the house.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan stood still, amazed at the beginning of Barbara's
+ speech, but her last words explained the sudden outburst.</p>
+
+ <p>Some years before this time, when Susan was a very little
+ girl and could scarcely speak, as she was eating a basin of
+ bread and milk for supper at the cottage door, a great pig came
+ up and put his nose into the basin. Susan was willing that the
+ pig should have some share of the bread and milk, but as she
+ ate with a spoon and he with his large mouth, she soon found
+ that he was likely to have more than his share; and she said to
+ him, "Take a poon, pig." The saying became a proverb in the
+ village, and Susan's little companions quoted it when any one
+ claimed more than his share of anything good. Barbara, who was
+ then not Miss Barbara, but plain Bab, and who played with all
+ the poor children in the village, was often reproved by Susan's
+ proverb. Susan, as she grew up, forgot the childish saying, but
+ Barbara remembered it, and it was this that she thought was in
+ Susan's mind when she asked her to take a spoon.</p>
+
+ <p>"Indeed, miss," said Betty, when she found Barbara in a
+ passion upon her return from the cottage, "indeed I wonder you
+ set your foot within the door. Your own papa has been at the
+ Abbey all morning, and you can hear all you wish to know from
+ him."</p>
+
+ <p>Barbara at once ran to her father's parlor, but saw at a
+ glance that he was in no mood to answer questions. Instead of
+ leaving him alone, she did all in her power to find out why he
+ had been at the Abbey, and what he had seen and heard there.
+ And when she found that her father would tell her nothing, she
+ ran back to her maid, saying, "Papa is so cross! I cannot put
+ up with him."</p>
+
+ <h4>V</h4>
+
+ <h4>SUSAN'S PET LAMB</h4>
+
+ <p>It is true that Attorney Case was not in a happy mood. His
+ visit to the Abbey had made him feel sure that Sir Arthur and
+ he would not agree about the treatment of the farmers who
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page275" id="page275"></a>[pg
+ 275]</span> lived on the estate. One matter they had talked
+ about was Sir Arthur's wish to enlarge his grounds and make a
+ drive round them. A map of the estate lay upon the table and
+ they looked at it together.</p>
+
+ <p>"Ah! but I see this new road for the drive would run through
+ Farmer Price's garden," said Sir Arthur. "That would never
+ do."</p>
+
+ <p>"It need not trouble you," said Attorney Case, "you may do
+ as you like with Price's land."</p>
+
+ <p>"How so?" asked Sir Arthur. "His lease will not be out for
+ ten years, I believe."</p>
+
+ <p>"True, that would have been the case had there not been a
+ mistake in it. I have the lease and can show you." The
+ heartless man then went on to explain to Sir Arthur what the
+ mistake was.</p>
+
+ <p>Sir Arthur remained silent.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh! I see," said the Attorney. "You do not wish to annoy
+ Farmer Price. But just put the matter into my hands and I will
+ manage it for you."</p>
+
+ <p>"You seem to forget that to take the farm out of this poor
+ man's hands would be to ruin him," replied Sir Arthur,
+ quietly.</p>
+
+ <p>"Indeed," said the wicked Attorney, "indeed I should be
+ sorry for that, if it were not that Farmer Price is such an
+ unruly, stubborn man."</p>
+
+ <p>"An unruly man, is he? If that be so, the sooner he leaves
+ the place the better. When you go home, you will be good enough
+ to send me the lease that I may, for myself, see the
+ mistake."</p>
+
+ <p>Attorney Case got up to go. But before he went, he thought
+ he must try to find out if Sir Arthur was going to employ him
+ to look after the estate, that is, if he was to be the agent.
+ "I will not trouble you about this lease, Sir Arthur," he said,
+ "but will hand it to your agent, if you will inform me who is
+ to have that post."</p>
+
+ <p>"I mean to be my own agent," answered Sir Arthur, "and will
+ myself look after the happiness of the people among whom I have
+ come to live."</p>
+
+ <p>It was the surprise of this reply that had sent Attorney
+ Case <span class="pagenum"><a name="page276"
+ id="page276"></a>[pg 276]</span> home so cross that Barbara had
+ said to Betty she could not put up with him.</p>
+
+ <p>When his daughter had left him atone, the Attorney walked up
+ and down the room deep in thought. "At any rate," he said to
+ himself at last, "if Sir Arthur means to manage the estate
+ himself in summer, he at least will need an agent in winter. I
+ must try to get the post." And he still walked up and down,
+ trying to think of some plan by which he would find favor at
+ the Abbey. Now that morning he had heard the housekeeper at the
+ Abbey ask the servants if any lamb were to be had in the
+ village, as Sir Arthur would like to have it one day soon for
+ dinner.</p>
+
+ <p>Knowing that he himself treated those farmers best who from
+ time to time gave him presents, Attorney Case thought that if
+ he sent a gift to Sir Arthur, it might help him to get what he
+ wished.</p>
+
+ <p>No sooner had the idea struck him than the Attorney went to
+ the kitchen. Standing at the door was a shepherd-boy. Barbara,
+ too, was there.</p>
+
+ <p>"Do you know of a nice fat lamb?" the Attorney asked the
+ lad.</p>
+
+ <p>Before the shepherd-boy could answer, Barbara exclaimed, "I
+ know of one. Susan Price has a pet lamb that is as fat as fat
+ can be."</p>
+
+ <p>At once Attorney Case walked over to Farmer Price's cottage.
+ He found Susan packing her father's little wardrobe, and as she
+ looked up, he saw she had been in tears.</p>
+
+ <p>"How is your mother to-day, Susan?" inquired the
+ Attorney.</p>
+
+ <p>"Worse, sir. My father goes to-morrow."</p>
+
+ <p>"That's a pity."</p>
+
+ <p>"It can't be helped," said Susan, with a sigh.</p>
+
+ <p>"It can't be helped&mdash;how do you know that?" said Mr.
+ Case.</p>
+
+ <p>"Sir, dear sir!" cried she, looking up at him, and a sudden
+ ray of hope beamed in her sweet face.</p>
+
+ <p>"What if you could help it, Susan?" he said.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan clasped her hands in silence.</p>
+
+ <p>"You can help it, Susan." She started up. "What would you
+ give now to have your father at home for a whole week
+ longer?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Anything!&mdash;but I have
+ nothing."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page277"
+ id="page277"></a>[pg 277]</span>
+
+ <p>"Yes, you have a lamb," said the hard-hearted Attorney.</p>
+
+ <p>"My poor little Daisy!" said Susan; "but what good can she
+ do?"</p>
+
+ <p>"What good can any lamb do? Is not lamb good to eat? Why do
+ you look so pale, girl? Are not sheep killed every day, and
+ don't you eat mutton? Is your lamb better than anybody else's,
+ think you?"</p>
+
+ <p>"I don't know," said Susan, "but I love her dearly."</p>
+
+ <p>"More silly you," said he.</p>
+
+ <p>"She feeds out of my hand, she follows me about; I have
+ always taken care of her; my mother gave her to me."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, say no more about it, then; if you love your lamb
+ better than both your father and your mother, keep it, and good
+ morning to you."</p>
+
+ <p>"Stay, oh stay!" cried Susan, catching his coat with an
+ eager, trembling hand&mdash;"a whole week, did you say? My
+ mother may get better in that time. No, I do not love Daisy
+ half so well." The struggle in her mind ceased, and with a calm
+ voice she said, "Take the lamb."</p>
+
+ <p>"Where is it?" said the Attorney.</p>
+
+ <p>"Grazing in the meadow, by the river-side."</p>
+
+ <p>"It must be brought up before nightfall for the butcher,
+ remember."</p>
+
+ <p>"I shall not forget it," said Susan, steadily.</p>
+
+ <p>As soon, however, as the cruel man turned his back and left
+ the house, Susan sat down, and hid her face in her hands. She
+ was soon roused by the sound of her mother's feeble voice
+ calling her from the inner room where she lay. Susan went
+ in.</p>
+
+ <p>"Are you there, love? I thought I heard some strange voice
+ just now talking to my child. Something's amiss, Susan," her
+ mother went on, raising herself as well as she could in bed, to
+ look at her daughter's face.</p>
+
+ <p>"Would you think it amiss, then, my dear mother," said
+ Susan, stooping to kiss her&mdash;"would you think it amiss if
+ my father was to stay with us a week longer?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Susan! you don't say so?"</p>
+
+ <p>"He is, indeed, a whole week&mdash;but how burning hot your
+ hand is still."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page278"
+ id="page278"></a>[pg 278]</span>
+
+ <p>"Are you sure he will stay?" asked her mother. "How do you
+ know? Who told you so? Tell me all quick!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Attorney Case told me so; he can get him leave for a week
+ longer, and he has promised he will."</p>
+
+ <p>"God bless him for it for ever and ever!" said the poor
+ woman, joining her hands. "May the blessing of Heaven be with
+ him!"</p>
+
+ <p>Susan was silent. The next moment she was called out of the
+ room, for a messenger had come from the Abbey for the
+ bread-bill. Susan always made out the bills, for although she
+ had not had many writing-lessons, she had taken great pains to
+ learn, and wrote in a neat, clear hand. It is true she was in
+ no mood to write or add now, but the work must be done. Having
+ carefully ruled lines for the pounds, shillings and pence, she
+ made out the bill and gave it to the boy who waited for it.
+ Then she said to herself she would make out the other bills,
+ for many of the people in the village had bought a few loaves
+ and rolls of her making. "And when these are done, I may go
+ down to the meadow to take leave of my poor lamb."</p>
+
+ <p>But Susan could not find her slate, and when she did find it
+ many of the figures were blurred, for Barbara had sat upon it.
+ And then the numbers seemed to dance before her, and each time
+ that she added, the answer was different. She went over and
+ over the sums until her head ached. The table was covered with
+ little square bits of paper on which she had written the bills
+ when her father came in, holding in his hand an account.</p>
+
+ <p>"Look at this, Susan!" he said, handing it to her. "How
+ could you be so careless, child? What have you been thinking
+ about to let a bill like that go to the Abbey? Luckily, I met
+ the messenger and asked to see how much it was. Look at
+ it."</p>
+
+ <p>Susan looked and blushed. Instead of "loaves" she had
+ written "lambs." She altered the mistake and handed the bill to
+ her father. He, meantime, was looking at the papers lying on
+ the table.</p>
+
+ <p>"What are all these, child?" he asked.</p>
+
+ <p>"Some of them were wrong, and I wrote them out again."</p>
+
+ <p>"Some of them! All of them as far as I can see," said her
+ father rather angrily, pointing to the
+ papers.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page279"
+ id="page279"></a>[pg 279]</span>
+
+ <p>Susan read the bills. Most of them were for lambs instead of
+ for loaves or rolls. Her thoughts had indeed been running upon
+ the pet she was to part with so soon.</p>
+
+ <p>Once more she wrote the bills, and her father, who was
+ struck by the patient way she set to work, said he would
+ himself collect the money. He would be proud to be able to say
+ to the neighbors that it was all earned by his own little
+ daughter. Susan heard him sigh as he passed the knapsack she
+ had packed for him, but she thought she would keep the pleasure
+ of telling him of his week's leave until he came home. He had
+ said he would have supper in her mother's room. She would tell
+ the good news then. "How delighted he will be when he hears,"
+ she said to herself, "but I know he will be sorry too for poor
+ Daisy."</p>
+
+ <p>Susan thought she would now have time to run down to the
+ meadow by the river-side to see her favorite, but just as she
+ had tied on her straw hat the clock struck four. This was the
+ hour at which she always went to fetch her brothers from the
+ school near the village. So, as she knew that the little boys
+ would be sorry if she were late, she put off her visit to the
+ lamb and went at once to meet them.</p>
+
+ <h4>VI</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE BLIND HARPER</h4>
+
+ <p>The dame-school, which was about a mile from the village,
+ was a long, low house with a thatched roof. It was sheltered by
+ a few old oaks, under which the grandparents and
+ great-grandparents of the children now at school had played
+ long ago. The play-green sloped down from the front of the
+ school, and was enclosed by a rough paling. The children obeyed
+ and loved the dame who taught them, for she was ever quick to
+ praise them when they did well, and to give them all the
+ pleasure she could. Susan had been taught by her, and the dame
+ often told her little pupils that they must try to be like her,
+ wise and modest, gentle and kind. As she now opened the gate,
+ she heard the merry voices of the little ones, and saw them
+ streaming out of the narrow door and scattering over the
+ green.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page280"
+ id="page280"></a>[pg 280]</span>
+
+ <p>"Oh, there's Susan!" cried her two little brothers, running,
+ leaping and bounding up to her; and many of the other rosy boys
+ and girls crowded round her to tell of their games.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan always liked to hear of all that made others happy,
+ but she had to tell the children that if they all spoke at once
+ she would not be able to hear what any of them said. The voices
+ were still raised one above the other, all eager to tell about
+ ninepins, or marbles, or tops, or bows and arrows, when
+ suddenly music was heard. The children at once became silent,
+ and looked round to see whence the sound came. Susan pointed to
+ the great oak-tree, and they saw, sitting under its shade, an
+ old man playing upon his harp. The children all drew near
+ quietly, for the music was solemn; but as the harper heard
+ little footsteps coming towards him, he played one of his more
+ lively tunes. The merry troop pressed nearer and nearer to the
+ old man. Then some of those who were in front whispered to each
+ other, "He is blind." "What a pity!" "He looks very poor."
+ "What a ragged coat he wears!" "He must be very old, for his
+ hair is white; and he must have come a long way, for his shoes
+ are quite worn out."</p>
+
+ <p>All this was said while the harper tuned his harp. When he
+ once more began to play, not a word was spoken, but every now
+ and again there was a cry of delight. The old man then let the
+ children name the airs they would like best to hear. Each, time
+ Susan spoke, he turned his face quickly to where she stood, and
+ played the tune she asked for over and over again.</p>
+
+ <p>"I am blind," he said, "and cannot see your faces, but I can
+ tell something about each of you by your voices."</p>
+
+ <p>"Can you indeed?" cried Susan's little brother William, who
+ was now standing between the old man's knees. "It was my sister
+ Susan who spoke last. Can you tell us something about her?"</p>
+
+ <p>"That I can, I think," said the harper, lifting the little
+ boy on his knee. "Your sister Susan is good-natured."</p>
+
+ <p>William clapped his hands.</p>
+
+ <p>"And good-tempered."</p>
+
+ <p>"Right," said little William, clapping louder than
+ before.</p>
+
+ <p>"And very fond of the little boy who sits on my
+ knee."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page281"
+ id="page281"></a>[pg 281]</span>
+
+ <p>"Oh! right, right, quite right!" exclaimed the child, and
+ "quite right" echoed on all sides.</p>
+
+ <p>"But how do you know so much, when you are blind?" said
+ William, looking hard at the old man.</p>
+
+ <p>"Hush!" whispered John, who was a year older than his
+ brother and very wise, "you should not remind him that he is
+ blind."</p>
+
+ <p>"Though I am blind," said the harper, "I can hear, you know,
+ and I heard from your sister herself all that I told you of
+ her, that she was good-tempered and good-natured and fond of
+ you."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, that's wrong&mdash;you did not hear all that from her,
+ I'm sure," said John, "for nobody ever hears her praising
+ herself."</p>
+
+ <p>"Did not I hear her tell you," said the harper, "when you
+ first came round me, that she was in a great hurry to go home,
+ but that she would stay a little while, since you wished it so
+ much? Was not that good-natured? And when you said you did not
+ like the tune she liked best, she was not angry with you, but
+ said, 'Then play William's first, if you please.' Was not that
+ good-tempered?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, yes," said William, "it's all true; but how did you
+ find out she was fond of me?"</p>
+
+ <p>"That is such a hard question," said the harper, "that I
+ must take time to think."</p>
+
+ <p>He tuned his harp, as he thought, or seemed to think, and at
+ this instant two boys, who had been searching for birds' nests
+ in the hedges and who had heard the sound of the harp, came
+ blustering up, and pushing their way through the circle, one of
+ them exclaimed, "What's going on here? Who are you, my old
+ fellow? A blind harper! Well, play us a tune, if you can play a
+ good one&mdash;play&mdash;let's see, what shall he play, Bob?"
+ added he, turning to his companion. "Play 'Bumper Squire
+ Jones.'"</p>
+
+ <p>The old man, though he did not seem quite pleased with the
+ way in which he was asked, played "Bumper Squire Jones."
+ Several tunes were afterwards named by the same rough
+ voice.</p>
+
+ <p>The little children shrunk back shyly, as they looked at the
+ bold boy. He was the son of Attorney Case, and as his father
+ had not cured his temper when he was a child, it became worse
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page282" id="page282"></a>[pg
+ 282]</span> and worse as he grew up. All who were younger and
+ weaker than himself were afraid of him and disliked him. When
+ the old harper was so tired that he could play no more, a lad
+ who usually carried his harp for him came up, and held his
+ master's hat to those around, saying, "Will you please remember
+ us?" The children readily gave their halfpence to this poor,
+ good-natured man, who had taken so much pains to amuse them. It
+ pleased them better even than to give them to the
+ gingerbread-woman, whose stall they loved to visit. The hat was
+ held to the Attorney's son before he chose to see it. At last
+ he put his hand into his pocket and pulled out a shilling.
+ There was sixpenny-worth of halfpence in the hat. "I'll take
+ these halfpence," said he, "and here's a shilling for you."</p>
+
+ <p>"God bless you, sir," said the lad; but as he took the
+ shilling which the young gentleman had slyly put into the blind
+ man's hand, he saw that it was not worth one farthing. "I am
+ afraid It is not good, sir," said the lad, whose business it
+ was to look at the money for his master.</p>
+
+ <p>"I am afraid, then, you'll get no other," said young Case,
+ with a rude laugh.</p>
+
+ <p>"It never will do, sir, look at it yourself; the edges are
+ all yellow. You can see the copper through it quite plain. Sir,
+ nobody will take it from us."</p>
+
+ <p>"I have nothing to do with that," said the rude boy, pushing
+ away his hand. "You may pass it, you know, as well as I do, if
+ you look sharp. You have taken it from me, and I shan't take it
+ back again, I can tell you."</p>
+
+ <p>A whisper of "that's very unjust," was heard.</p>
+
+ <p>"Who says it's unjust?" cried the Attorney's son sternly,
+ looking down upon his judges.</p>
+
+ <p>"Is any one here among yourselves a judge of silver?" said
+ the old man.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, here's the butcher's boy," said the Attorney's son;
+ "show it to him."</p>
+
+ <p>He was a quiet, timid boy, and young Case fancied that he
+ would be afraid to say what he thought. However, after turning
+ the shilling round several times, the butcher's lad said that
+ so far as he could tell, although he would not like to be
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page283" id="page283"></a>[pg
+ 283]</span> quite sure of it, the coin was not a good one.
+ Then, seeing the Attorney's son scowl angrily at him, he turned
+ to Susan saying that she knew more than he did about money, as
+ so much passed through her hands in payment of the bread she
+ made.</p>
+
+ <p>"I'll leave it to her," said the old harper. "If she says
+ the shilling is good, we will keep it."</p>
+
+ <p>The coin was then handed to Susan, who had not yet spoken,
+ but now that she was called upon she did not shrink from
+ telling the truth. In a gentle but firm tone she said, "I think
+ the shilling is a bad one."</p>
+
+ <p>"There's another then," cried the Attorney's son; "I have
+ plenty of shillings and sixpences. They are nothing to me." And
+ he walked away.</p>
+
+ <p>The children now all started for their homes, and the old
+ harper begged that Susan would show him the way to the village,
+ if she were going there. The lad took up the harp and little
+ William led the old man by the hand, while John ran on before
+ to gather buttercups in the meadows. When they reached a little
+ brook which they must cross by a narrow plank, Susan was afraid
+ to leave the harper to the care of his little guide, so she
+ herself took his hand and led him safely to the other side.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon they reached the road, and Susan told the boy who
+ carried his master's harp that he could not now lose his way.
+ She then said good-by to the harper, adding that she and her
+ brothers must take the short path across the fields, which
+ would not be so pleasant for him because of the stiles.</p>
+
+ <p>"I am afraid Miss Somers will be waiting," said Susan to to
+ her brothers as they ran along together. "You know she said she
+ would call at six o'clock, and I am sure by the length of our
+ shadows that it is getting late."</p>
+
+ <h4>VII</h4>
+
+ <h4>GOOD NEWS</h4>
+
+ <p>When they came to their own cottage-door, they heard voices,
+ and they saw, when they entered, two ladies standing in the
+ kitchen.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page284"
+ id="page284"></a>[pg 284]</span>
+
+ <p>"Come in, Susan," said Miss Somers, "I fancy you forgot that
+ we promised to pay you a visit this evening; but you need not
+ blush so much, there is no great harm done; we have only been
+ here about five minutes and we have been admiring your neat
+ garden and your tidy shelves. Is it you, Susan, who keeps these
+ things in such nice order?" went on Miss Somers, looking round
+ the kitchen.</p>
+
+ <p>Before Susan could reply, little William pushed forward and
+ answered, "Yes, ma'am, it is my sister Susan that keeps
+ everything neat; and she always comes to school for us too,
+ which was what caused her to be so late."</p>
+
+ <p>"Because," went on John, "she would not refuse to let us
+ hear a blind man play on the harp. It was we who kept her, and
+ we hope, ma'am, as you seem so good, you won't take it
+ amiss."</p>
+
+ <p>Miss Somers and her sister smiled as they listened to
+ Susan's little brothers, but what they heard made them feel
+ sure that Susan was indeed as kind a sister as the housekeeper
+ had said.</p>
+
+ <p>When the ladies left the cottage, they took Susan with them
+ through the village.</p>
+
+ <p>"I fancy we shall find what we want here," said Miss Somers,
+ stopping before a shop-window where ribbons of all colors were
+ displayed, and where lace collars, glass buttons and sheets of
+ pins were laid out in order. They went in, and on the shelves
+ behind the counter saw gay, neat linens and calicoes.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now, Susan, choose yourself a gown," said Miss Somers.
+ "Because you are a busy girl and behave well, we wish others to
+ see that such is the conduct we approve."</p>
+
+ <p>The shopkeeper was the father of Susan's friend, Rose. He
+ stretched his arm to the highest shelf, then dived into drawers
+ beneath the counter, sparing no pains to show the best goods to
+ his customers.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan did not show the interest that might have been
+ expected. She was thinking much of her lamb and more of her
+ father. Miss Somers had put a bright guinea into her hand and
+ told her to pay for her own gown. But Susan felt that
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page285" id="page285"></a>[pg
+ 285]</span> this was a great deal of money to spend upon a
+ frock for herself, and yet she did not know how to ask if she
+ might keep it for a better purpose. Although Susan said
+ nothing, Miss Somers read in her face that she was perplexed.
+ "She does not like any of these things," whispered the lady to
+ her sister.</p>
+
+ <p>"She seems to be thinking of something else," was the low
+ reply.</p>
+
+ <p>"If you do not fancy any of these calicoes," said the
+ shopkeeper to Susan, "we shall have a larger choice soon."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh," answered Susan, with a smile, and a blush, "these are
+ all too good for me, but&mdash;"</p>
+
+ <p>"But what, Susan?" asked Miss Somers. "Tell us what is
+ passing in your little mind."</p>
+
+ <p>Susan said nothing.</p>
+
+ <p>"Well then, it does not matter. You do not know us very well
+ yet. When you do, you will not, I am sure, be afraid to be
+ frank. Put the guinea in your pocket and make what use of it
+ you please. From what we know and from what we have heard of
+ you, we are sure you will make a good use of it."</p>
+
+ <p>"I think, madam," said the shopkeeper, "I have a pretty good
+ guess what will become of that guinea, but I say nothing."</p>
+
+ <p>"No, that is right," said Miss Somers; "we leave Susan to do
+ just as she likes with it, and now we must not keep her any
+ longer. Good night, Susan, we shall soon come again to your
+ neat cottage."</p>
+
+ <p>Susan courtesied and looked gratefully at the ladies, but
+ did not speak. She wished to say, "I cannot explain to you
+ here, with people around, what I want to do with my guinea, but
+ when you come to our cottage you shall know all."</p>
+
+ <p>After Susan had left, Miss Somers turned to the obliging
+ shopkeeper who was folding up all the goods he had opened. "You
+ have had a great deal of trouble," she said, "and as Susan will
+ not choose a gown for herself, I must find one for her," and
+ she chose the prettiest.</p>
+
+ <p>While the man rolled up the parcel, Miss Somers asked him
+ many questions about Susan, and he was only too glad to be able
+ to tell what he knew about the good girl.</p>
+
+ <p>"No later than last May morning," he said, "Susan acted
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page286" id="page286"></a>[pg
+ 286]</span> as it will please you to hear. She was to have been
+ Queen of the May, which among the children in our village is a
+ thing a good deal thought of. But Susan's mother was ill, and
+ Susan, after being up with her all night, would not go out in
+ the morning, even when they brought the crown to her. She put
+ it upon my daughter Rose's head with her own hands, and to be
+ sure Rose loves her as well as if she were her own sister. If I
+ praise Susan it is not that I am any relation of the Prices,
+ but just that I wish her well, as does every one that knows
+ her. I'll send the parcel up to the Abbey, shall I, ma'am?"</p>
+
+ <p>"If you please," said Miss Somers, "and as soon as your new
+ goods come in, let us know. You will, I hope, find us good
+ customers and well-wishers," she added, with a smile, "for
+ those who wish others well surely deserve to have well-wishers
+ themselves."</p>
+
+ <p>But to return to Susan. When she left the shop she carefully
+ put the bright guinea into the purse with the twelve shillings
+ her little friends had given her on Mayday. She next added, as
+ far as she could remember them, the bills for bread that were
+ owing to her, and found they came to about thirty-eight
+ shillings. Then she hoped that by some means or other she
+ might, during the week her father was to remain at home, make
+ up the nine guineas that would enable him to stay with them
+ altogether. "If that could but be," she said to herself, "how
+ happy it would make my mother! She is already a great deal
+ better since I told her my father would stay for a week longer.
+ Ah! but she would not have blessed Attorney Case, if she had
+ known about my poor Daisy." Susan had now reached the path that
+ led to the meadow by the river-side. She wanted to go there
+ alone and take leave of her lamb. But her little brothers, who
+ were watching for her return, ran after her as soon as they saw
+ her and overtook her as she reached the meadow.</p>
+
+ <p>"What did that good lady want with you?" cried William; but
+ looking up in his sister's face, he saw tears in her eyes, and
+ he was silent and walked on quietly. Susan saw her lamb by the
+ water-side.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page287"
+ id="page287"></a>[pg 287]</span>
+
+ <p>"Who are those two men?" said William. "What are they going
+ to do with Daisy?"</p>
+
+ <p>The two men were Attorney Case and the butcher. The butcher
+ was feeling whether the lamb was fat.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan sat down upon the bank in silent sorrow. Her little
+ brothers ran up to the butcher and asked whether he was going
+ to do any harm to the lamb. The butcher did not answer, but the
+ Attorney replied, "It is not your sister's lamb any longer;
+ it's mine."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yours!" cried the children with terror; "and will you kill
+ it?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, that is what the butcher will do."</p>
+
+ <p>The little boys now burst into loud cries. They pushed away
+ the butcher's hand; they threw their arms round the neck of the
+ lamb; they kissed its forehead. It bleated. "It will not bleat
+ to-morrow!" said William, and he wept bitterly.</p>
+
+ <p>The butcher looked aside, and hastily rubbed his eyes with
+ the corner of his blue apron. The Attorney stood unmoved; he
+ pulled up the head of the lamb, which had just stooped to crop
+ a mouthful of clover. "I have no time to waste," he said.
+ "Butcher, I leave it to you. If it's fat&mdash;the sooner the
+ better. I've nothing more to say." And he walked off, deaf to
+ the prayers of the poor children. As soon as the Attorney was
+ out of sight, Susan rose from the bank where she was seated,
+ came up to her lamb, and stooped to gather some of the fresh
+ dewy clover, that she might feed her pet for the last time.
+ Poor Daisy licked the well-known hand.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now, let us go," said Susan.</p>
+
+ <p>"I'll wait as long as you please," said the butcher.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan thanked him, but walked away quickly, without looking
+ back. Her little brothers begged the man to stay a few minutes,
+ for they had gathered a handful of blue speedwell and yellow
+ crowsfoot, and they were decking the poor animal. As it
+ followed the boys through the village, the children looked
+ after them as they passed, and the butcher's own son was among
+ the number. The boy remembered Susan's firmness about the
+ shilling, for it had saved him a beating. He went at once to
+ his father to beg him to spare the
+ lamb.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page288"
+ id="page288"></a>[pg 288]</span>
+
+ <p>"I was thinking about it myself," said the butcher. "It's a
+ sin to kill a pet lamb, I'm thinking. Anyway, it's what I'm not
+ used to, and don't fancy doing. But I've a plan in my head and
+ I'm going straightway to Attorney Case. But he's a hard man, so
+ we'll say nothing to the boys, lest nothing comes of it. Come,
+ lads," he went on, turning to the crowd of children, "it is
+ time you were going your ways home. Turn the lamb in here,
+ John, into the paddock for the night." The butcher then went to
+ the Attorney.</p>
+
+ <p>"If it's a good, fat, tender lamb you want for Sir Arthur,"
+ he said, "I could let you have one as good or better than
+ Susan's and fit to eat to-morrow."</p>
+
+ <p>As Mr. Case wished to give the present to Sir Arthur as soon
+ as he could, he said he would not wait for Susan's lamb, but
+ would take the one offered by the butcher. In the meantime
+ Susan's brothers ran home to tell her that the lamb was put
+ into the paddock for the night. This was all they knew, but
+ even this was some comfort to the poor girl. Rose was at Farmer
+ Price's cottage that evening, and was to have the pleasure of
+ hearing Susan tell her father the good news that he might stay
+ at home for one week longer. Mrs. Price was feeling better and
+ said that she would sit up to supper in her wicker armchair. As
+ Susan began to get ready the meal, little William, who was
+ standing at the house-door watching for his father's return,
+ called out suddenly, "Susan, why here is our old man!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said the blind harper, "I have found my way to you.
+ The neighbors were kind enough to show me where-abouts you
+ lived; for, though I didn't know your name, they guessed who I
+ meant by what I said of you all."</p>
+
+ <p>Susan came to the door, and the old man was delighted to
+ hear her speak again. "If it would not be too bold," said he,
+ "I'm a stranger in this part of the country, and come from afar
+ off. My boy has got a bed for himself here in the village; but
+ I have no place. Could you be so kind as to give an old blind
+ man a night's lodging?"</p>
+
+ <p>Susan said she would step in and ask her mother, and she
+ soon returned with an answer that he was heartily welcome,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page289" id="page289"></a>[pg
+ 289]</span> if he could sleep upon the children's bed, which
+ was but small.</p>
+
+ <p>The old man entered thankfully, and, as he did so, struck
+ his head against the low roof. "Many roofs that are twice as
+ high do not shelter folk so kind," he said. For he had just
+ come from the house of Mr. Case, and Barbara, who had been
+ standing at the hall-door, said he could have no help there.
+ The old man's harp was set down in Farmer Price's kitchen, and
+ he promised to play a tune for the boys before they went to
+ bed, as their mother had given them leave to sit up to supper
+ with their father.</p>
+
+ <p>The farmer came home with a sad face, but how soon did it
+ brighten, when Susan, with a smile, said to him, "Father, we've
+ good news for you! good news for us all!&mdash;You have a whole
+ week longer to stay with us; and perhaps," she went on, putting
+ her little purse into his hands&mdash;"perhaps with what's
+ here, and the bread-bills, and what may somehow be got together
+ before a week's at an end, we may make up the nine guineas. Who
+ knows, dearest mother, but we may keep him with us for ever!"
+ As she spoke, she threw her arms round her father, who pressed
+ her to him without speaking, for his heart was full. It was
+ some little time before he could believe that what he heard was
+ true; but the smiles of his wife, the noisy joy of his little
+ boys, and the delight that shone in Susan's face at last
+ convinced him that he was not in a dream.</p>
+
+ <p>As they sat down to supper, the old harper was made welcome
+ to his share of the simple meal.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan's father, as soon as supper was finished, even before
+ he would let the harper play a tune for his boys, opened the
+ little purse which Susan had given him. He was surprised at the
+ sight of the twelve shillings, and still more, when he came to
+ the bottom of the purse to see the bright golden guinea.</p>
+
+ <p>"How did you come by all this money, Susan?" said he.</p>
+
+ <p>"How, I can't make out, except by the baking," said her
+ proud mother. "Hey, Susan, is this your first baking?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, no, no," said her father, "I have the money for her
+ first baking snug here, besides, in my pocket. I kept it for a
+ surprise, to do your mother's heart good, Susan. Here's
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page290" id="page290"></a>[pg
+ 290]</span> twenty-nine shillings, and the Abbey bill, which is
+ not paid yet, comes to ten more. What think you of this, wife?
+ Have we not a right to be proud of our Susan? Why," he went on,
+ turning to the harper, "I ask your pardon for speaking before
+ strangers in praise of my own child; but the truth is the
+ fittest thing to be spoken, I think, at all times. Here's your
+ good health, Susan. Why, by and by she'll be worth her weight
+ in gold&mdash;in silver at least. But tell us, child, how came
+ you by all this wealth, and how comes it that I don't go
+ to-morrow? The happy news makes me so gay, I'm afraid I shall
+ hardly understand it rightly. Speak on, child&mdash;but first
+ bring us a bottle of the good mead you made last year from your
+ own honey."</p>
+
+ <p>Susan did not like to tell the story of her guinea-hen, of
+ the gown, and of her poor lamb. Part of this would seem as if
+ she were speaking of her own good deeds, and part of it she did
+ not like to remember. But her mother begged to know the whole,
+ and she told it as simply as she could. When she came to the
+ story of her lamb, her voice faltered, and everybody present
+ was touched. The old harper sighed once, and cleared his throat
+ several times. He then asked for his harp, and after tuning it
+ for long, he played the air he had promised to the boys.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/290.jpg" name="fig290s"
+ id="fig290s"><img width="300" src="images/290s.jpg"
+ alt="SHE SPOKE OF WHAT SHE DID NOT UNDERSTAND" /></a><br />
+ she spoke of what she did not understand
+ </div>
+
+ <h4>VIII</h4>
+
+ <h4>BARBARA VISITS THE ABBEY</h4>
+
+ <p>The old blind man had come from the mountains of Wales to
+ try to gain a prize of ten guineas. This prize was to be
+ awarded to the harper who should play the best at a large town
+ about five miles from the village where Susan lived. In the
+ evening, after the prize-giving was over, there was to be a
+ ball in the town, so the events of the day were looked forward
+ to by many around. Barbara was one of those who grew more and
+ more excited as the time for the prize-giving and ball drew
+ near. She longed to be asked to go there by some of the rich
+ neighbors who could drive her in their carriage. So how pleased
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page291" id="page291"></a>[pg
+ 291]</span> she was when, on the evening that her father and
+ the butcher were talking about Susan's lamb, a servant in
+ livery from the Abbey left a note for Mr. and Miss Barbara
+ Case! It was to invite them to dinner and tea at the Abbey next
+ day.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now they will find out," cried Bab, "that I am indeed a
+ genteel person, and they will wish to take me to the ball. At
+ any rate, I shall do my best to be asked."</p>
+
+ <p>"To be sure," said Betty, "a lady who would visit Susan
+ Price might well be glad to take you in her carriage."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then pray, Betty, do not forget to send to town first thing
+ to-morrow for my new bonnet. Without that the ladies of the
+ Abbey will think nothing of me. And I must coax Papa to buy me
+ a new gown for the ball. I shall look well at all the ladies'
+ dresses at the Abbey to-morrow and find out the fashion. And
+ Betty, I have thought of a charming present to take Miss
+ Somers. I shall give her Susan's guinea-hen. It's of no use to
+ me, so carry it up early in the morning to the Abbey, with my
+ compliments."</p>
+
+ <p>Feeling quite sure that her bonnet and the guinea-fowl would
+ make Miss Somers think well of her, Barbara paid her first
+ visit to the Abbey. She expected to see wonders, but when she
+ was shown into the room where Miss Somers and other ladies were
+ sitting, simply dressed, and with work, books and drawings on
+ the table before them, she was surprised and vexed. There was
+ nothing grand to be seen anywhere.</p>
+
+ <p>When Miss Somers tried to find out what would interest her,
+ and talked of walks, and flowers and gardens, Miss Barbara was
+ offended. "I will show them," she said to herself, "that I can
+ talk of other things." So in a grand tone she spoke of what she
+ did not understand, until her mistaken airs of gentility made
+ the ladies of the Abbey feel first amused and then ashamed. One
+ by one the ladies left the room, and when Miss Somers went to
+ change her dress for dinner, Barbara was left alone with some
+ pretty drawings to amuse her. But the silly girl paid no heed
+ to these. She could think only of the ball. Suddenly she
+ remembered that nothing had been said about the guinea-hen. The
+ truth was that Betty, in the hurry of dressing Barbara for her
+ visit to the Abbey, had forgotten the
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page292" id="page292"></a>[pg
+ 292]</span> bird, but it arrived just as Miss Somers was
+ dressing. The housekeeper went to her mistress's room to say it
+ had come.</p>
+
+ <p>"Ma'am," she said, "here's a beautiful guinea-hen just come
+ with Miss Barbara Case's compliments."</p>
+
+ <p>Miss Somers thought by the housekeeper's tone that she was
+ not quite pleased, and she soon found she was right in thinking
+ so. The woman came close up to the dressing-table, and said, "I
+ never like to speak till I'm sure, ma'am, and I'm not quite
+ sure in this case, ma'am, but still I think it right to tell
+ you what crossed my mind about this same guinea-hen, ma'am, and
+ you can ask about it or do as you feel best, ma'am. Some time
+ ago we had guinea-fowls of our own, and not knowing they were
+ going to die as they have done, ma'am, I made bold to give a
+ couple last Christmas to Susan Price, and very proud of them
+ she was, ma'am, and I'm sure would never have parted with the
+ hen of her own will. But if my eyes don't deceive me, ma'am,
+ this guinea-hen that Miss Barbara sends to you with her
+ compliments is the same that I gave to Susan. How Miss Barbara
+ came by it, I can't tell, ma'am, but if my boy Philip was at
+ home, he might know, for he's often at Farmer Price's cottage.
+ If you wish it, ma'am, I'll ask him when he comes home
+ to-night."</p>
+
+ <p>"I think the best way will be for me to ask Miss Case
+ herself about it this evening," said Miss Somers.</p>
+
+ <p>Dinner was now served. Attorney Case expected to smell mint
+ sauce, and as the covers were taken off the dishes he looked
+ around for lamb, but no lamb did he see.</p>
+
+ <p>Among other things talked of at table was a carving-knife
+ that Sir Arthur had made for his sister. From this the
+ conversation passed to carving. "Now is my chance to find out
+ about my present," thought the Attorney. "Pray, may I ask," he
+ said to Sir Arthur, "how you carve a fore quarter of lamb?"</p>
+
+ <p>Sir Arthur at once saw what the Attorney wanted to hear.
+ Having answered his question, he went on to thank him for the
+ present he had offered, but added, "I am sorry I cannot accept
+ it, as it is my rule never to accept gifts from my neighbors.
+ The reason is that our poor tenants cannot show their good will
+ in this way, as they have little or nothing to
+ offer."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page293"
+ id="page293"></a>[pg 293]</span>
+
+ <p>Attorney Case listened with surprise. He was annoyed and
+ angry, for he did not understand Sir Arthur's just mind and
+ kind heart. After the ladies left the dining-room and were
+ walking up and down the large hall, one of them remarked that
+ it would be a charming place for music. Barbara, who like her
+ father always seized any chance of turning the conversation as
+ best pleased herself, said what a fine instrument was the harp.
+ Then she spoke of the prize-giving to the harpers and of the
+ ball that was to follow. "I know a good deal about the ball,"
+ she said, "because a lady in the town where it is to be held
+ offered to take me with her, but although she has a carriage,
+ Papa did not like to let her send it so far." At this point
+ Barbara fixed her eyes on Miss Somers, that she might, if
+ possible, read her thoughts, but as the lady was at that moment
+ letting down the veil of her hat, her face was not seen.</p>
+
+ <p>"Shall we go for a little walk before tea?" said Miss Somers
+ to the other ladies. "I have a pretty guinea-hen to show you."
+ Barbara now felt hopeful, and when even among the pheasants and
+ peacocks the guinea-hen was much admired, she was sure that
+ Miss Somers must indeed be proud to accept her gift.</p>
+
+ <p>At this moment Philip came running by on an errand for his
+ mother. As his eye fell upon the guinea-hen, he exclaimed
+ before he knew, "Why, that is Susan's guinea-hen!"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, it is not Susan's guinea-hen," said Miss Barbara,
+ coloring furiously, "it is mine, and I have made a present of
+ it to Miss Somers."</p>
+
+ <p>At the sound of Bab's voice, Philip turned round, his face
+ ablaze with anger.</p>
+
+ <p>"What is the matter, Philip?" asked Miss Somers in a
+ soothing voice, but Philip was not in the mood to be
+ soothed.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, ma'am, may I speak out?" he asked, and without waiting
+ for leave he gave a full account of the loss of Susan's
+ guinea-fowl, of Rose's visit to Barbara, and of Barbara's
+ greedy and cruel conduct.</p>
+
+ <p>Barbara denied all that Philip said, and told quite another
+ tale. When she could find no more to say she blushed deeply,
+ for she saw that her story was not believed. One might have
+ thought she was covered with shame, had it not been that the
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page294" id="page294"></a>[pg
+ 294]</span> moment Philip was out of sight, she exclaimed, "I
+ am sure I wish I had never seen this wretched guinea-hen! It is
+ all Susan's fault for letting it stray into our garden."</p>
+
+ <p>Barbara was too angry to notice that she was admitting the
+ truth of Philip's story.</p>
+
+ <p>"Perhaps," said Miss Somers, "Susan will be more careful now
+ that she has had so hard a lesson. Shall we see? Philip will, I
+ am sure, carry the guinea-hen back to her, if we wish it."</p>
+
+ <p>"If you please, ma'am," said Barbara sulkily.</p>
+
+ <p>So the guinea-hen was given to Philip, who set off with joy
+ and was soon in sight of Farmer Price's cottage.</p>
+
+ <h4>IX</h4>
+
+ <h4>A SURPRISE FOR SUSAN</h4>
+
+ <p>When Philip came to the door he stopped suddenly, for the
+ idea struck him that it would give Rose great pleasure to carry
+ the guinea-fowl to Susan. So he ran into the village.</p>
+
+ <p>All the children who had given up their Mayday money to
+ Susan were playing on the green. They were delighted to see the
+ guinea-hen once more. Philip took his pipe and tabor and they
+ all marched together towards the whitewashed cottage.</p>
+
+ <p>As they passed the butcher's house, his boy came out. They
+ told him where they were going.</p>
+
+ <p>"Let me come with you, let me come with you," he said. "But
+ wait one moment, for my father has something to say to you,"
+ and he darted into the house. The children waited. In a few
+ moments they heard the bleating of a lamb, and soon they saw it
+ being gently led by the butcher from the paddock.</p>
+
+ <p>"It is Daisy!" exclaimed Rose.</p>
+
+ <p>"It is Daisy!" they all shouted with joy, "Susan's lamb!
+ Susan's lamb!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, for my part," said the good butcher, as soon as he
+ could be heard, "for my part I would not be so cruel as
+ Attorney Case for the whole world. It's true the lamb did not
+ know what was before it, but poor Susan did, and to wring her
+ gentle heart <span class="pagenum"><a name="page295"
+ id="page295"></a>[pg 295]</span> was what I call cruel. But at
+ any rate, here it is, safe and sound now. I'd have taken it to
+ her sooner, but was off early this morning to the fair, and am
+ but just come back. Daisy, though, was as well off in my
+ paddock as in the field by the water-side."</p>
+
+ <p>The troop of happy children went on their way with the
+ guinea-fowl and the lamb. As they passed the shop where Susan
+ had been shown the pretty calicoes, the shopkeeper, who, you
+ remember, was Rose's father, came out. When he saw the lamb,
+ and learned whose it was and heard its story, he gave the
+ children some pieces of colored ribbon, with which Rose
+ decorated Susan's favorite.</p>
+
+ <p>The children now once more moved on, led by Philip, who
+ played joyfully upon his pipe and tabor. Susan was working in
+ her summer-house, with her little pine table before her. When
+ she heard the sound of the music, she put down her work and
+ listened. She saw the crowd of children coming nearer and
+ nearer. They had closed round Daisy, so she did not see her
+ pet, but as they came up to the garden-gate she saw that Rose
+ beckoned to her. Philip played as loud as he could, that she
+ might not hear, until the proper moment, the bleating of the
+ lamb. As Susan opened the gate, the children divided, and first
+ she saw, in the midst of her taller friends, little smiling
+ Mary, with the guinea-hen in her arms.</p>
+
+ <p>"Come on! come on!" cried Mary, as Susan started with joyful
+ surprise; "you have more to see."</p>
+
+ <p>At this instant the music paused. Susan heard the bleating
+ of a lamb, and pressing eagerly forward, she beheld poor Daisy.
+ She burst into tears. "I did not shed one tear when I parted
+ with you, my dear little Daisy," she said, "it was for my
+ father and mother. I would not have parted with you for any one
+ else in the whole world. Thank you, thank you all," she added
+ to her companions, who were even gladder for her in her joy
+ than they had been sorry for her in her sorrow. "Now, if my
+ father was not to go away from us next week, and if my mother
+ were quite strong, I should be the happiest person in the
+ world." As Susan finished speaking, a voice behind the
+ listening crowd cried, in a rough tone, "Let us pass, if you
+ please; you have no right to block the road." This was the
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page296" id="page296"></a>[pg
+ 296]</span> voice of Attorney Case, who was returning with
+ Barbara from his visit to the Abbey. He saw the lamb and tried
+ to whistle as he went on. Barbara also saw the guinea-hen and
+ turned her head another way. Even her new bonnet, in which she
+ had expected to be so much admired, now only served to hide her
+ blushing face.</p>
+
+ <p>"I am glad she saw the guinea-hen," cried Rose, who now held
+ it in her hands.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Philip, "she'll not forget Mayday in a
+ hurry."</p>
+
+ <p>"Nor I either, I hope," said Susan, looking round upon her
+ companions with a most loving smile: "I hope, while I live, I
+ shall never forget your goodness to me last Mayday. Now that
+ I've my pretty guinea-hen safe once more, I should think of
+ returning your money."</p>
+
+ <p>"No! no! no!" was the cry, "we don't want the
+ money&mdash;keep it&mdash;keep it&mdash;you want it for your
+ father."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," said Susan, "I am not too proud to accept it. I will
+ keep your money for my father. Perhaps some time or other I may
+ be able to earn&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh," said Philip, "don't let us talk of earning; don't let
+ her talk to us of money now; she hasn't had time hardly to look
+ at poor Daisy and her guinea-hen. Come, we had better go and
+ let her have them all to herself."</p>
+
+ <p>The children moved away, but Philip himself was the very
+ last to stir from the garden-gate. He stayed, first, to tell
+ Susan that it was Rose who tied the ribbons on Daisy's head.
+ Then he stayed a little longer to let her hear the story of the
+ guinea-fowl, and to tell her who it was that brought the hen
+ home from the Abbey.</p>
+
+ <p>As Philip finished speaking, Susan was already feeding her
+ long-lost favorite. "My pretty guinea-hen," said Susan, "my
+ naughty guinea-hen that flew away from me, you shall never
+ serve me so again. I must cut your nice wings, but I won't hurt
+ you."</p>
+
+ <p>"Take care!" cried Philip, "you'd better, indeed you'd
+ better let me hold her, while you cut her wings."</p>
+
+ <p>When this was done, which it certainly never could have been
+ had Philip not held the hen for Susan, he remembered his
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page297" id="page297"></a>[pg
+ 297]</span> mother had given him a message for Mrs. Price. This
+ led to another quarter of an hour's delay, for Philip had the
+ whole story of the guinea-hen to tell over again to Mrs. Price,
+ and as the farmer came in while it was going on, it was only
+ polite to begin at the beginning once more. Farmer Price was so
+ pleased to see Susan happy again with her two favorites, that
+ he said he must himself see Daisy fed, and Philip found that he
+ was wanted to hold the jug of milk, from which Susan's father
+ now filled the pan for Daisy. When Philip at last left the
+ cottage, Bab and her maid Betty were staring out of the window
+ as usual. Seeing them after he had left the garden, he at once
+ turned back to see if he had shut the gate fast, lest the
+ guinea-hen might stray out and again fall into Barbara's
+ hands.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/296.jpg" name="fig296s"
+ id="fig296s"><img width="300" src="images/296s.jpg"
+ alt="HE WAS WANTED TO HOLD THE JUG OF MILK" /></a><br />
+ he was wanted to hold the jug of milk
+ </div>
+
+ <h4>X</h4>
+
+ <h4>BARBARA'S ACCIDENT</h4>
+
+ <p>As the day went on, Miss Barbara became more and more
+ annoyed that her meanness had been found out, but she had no
+ wish to cure herself of the fault. The ball was still her first
+ thought.</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," she said to Betty, "you have heard how things have
+ turned out, but if Miss Somers does not ask me to go with, her,
+ I think I know some one else who will."</p>
+
+ <p>Now, some officers were quartered at the town where the ball
+ was to be held. And because they had got into trouble with a
+ tradesman there, out of which Mr. Case had undertaken to help
+ them, they sometimes invited the Attorney to mess. The officers
+ thought that if they showed some attention to Mr. Case, he
+ would not charge them so much for his help. One of them even
+ asked his wife to take, sometimes, a little notice of Miss
+ Barbara. The name of this officer's wife was Mrs. Strathspey.
+ It was of Mrs. Strathspey that Barbara was thinking when she
+ said to Betty that if Miss Somers did not take her to the ball,
+ she thought she knew of some one else who would.</p>
+
+ <p>"Mrs. Strathspey and the officers are to breakfast here
+ to-morrow," said Bab. "One of them dined at the Abbey to-day
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page298" id="page298"></a>[pg
+ 298]</span> and he said they would all come. They are going
+ somewhere into the country and breakfast here on the way. Pray,
+ Betty, don't forget that Mrs. Strathspey can't breakfast
+ without honey. I heard her say so myself."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then, indeed," said Betty, "I'm afraid Mrs. Strathspey will
+ have to go without breakfast here, for not a spoonful of honey
+ have we, let her long for it ever so much."</p>
+
+ <p>"But, surely," said Bab, "we can contrive to get some honey
+ in the neighborhood."</p>
+
+ <p>"There's none to be bought, that I know of," said Betty.</p>
+
+ <p>"But is there none to be begged or borrowed?" said Bab,
+ laughing. "Do you forget Susan's beehive? Step over to her in
+ the morning with my compliments, and see what you can do. Tell
+ her it's for Mrs. Strathspey."</p>
+
+ <p>In the morning Betty went with Miss Barbara's compliments to
+ Susan, to beg some honey for Mrs. Strathspey, who could not
+ breakfast without it. Susan did not like to part with her
+ honey, because her mother loved it, and she therefore gave
+ Betty only a little. When Barbara saw how little Susan sent,
+ she called her a miser, and she said she must have some more
+ for Mrs. Strathspey. "I'll go myself and speak to her. Come
+ with me, Betty," said the young lady, who seemed to forget she
+ had said, on the day that she was asked to "take a spoon," that
+ she never would pay Susan another visit.</p>
+
+ <p>"Susan," she said to the poor girl whom she had done
+ everything in her power to hurt, "I must beg a little more
+ honey from you for Mrs. Strathspey's breakfast. You know, at a
+ great time such as this, we should help one another."</p>
+
+ <p>"To be sure we should," added Betty.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan, though she was generous, was not weak; she was
+ willing to give to those she loved, but would not let anything
+ be taken from her or coaxed out of her by those whom she could
+ not respect. She answered that she was sorry she had no more
+ honey to spare.</p>
+
+ <p>Barbara grew angry. "I'll tell you what, Susan Price," she
+ said, "the honey I will have, so you may as well give it to me
+ by fair means. Yes or no? Speak! Will you give it to me or not?
+ Will you give me that piece of the honeycomb that lies
+ there?"</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page299"
+ id="page299"></a>[pg 299]</span>
+
+ <p>"That bit of honeycomb is for my mother's breakfast," said
+ Susan; "I cannot give it you."</p>
+
+ <p>"Can't you?" said Bab, "then see if I don't take it."</p>
+
+ <p>She stretched across Susan and grasped, but she did not
+ reach far enough. She made a second dart at the honeycomb and,
+ in her effort to get it, she overset the beehive. The bees
+ swarmed about her. Her maid Betty screamed and ran away. Susan,
+ who was sheltered by a laburnum-tree, called to Barbara, upon
+ whom the black clusters of bees were now settling, and begged
+ her to stand still and not to beat them away, "If you stand
+ quietly you won't be stung, perhaps."</p>
+
+ <p>But instead of standing quietly, Bab flung about her arms,
+ and stamped and roared, and the bees stung her terribly. Her
+ arms and her face swelled in a frightful manner. She was helped
+ home by poor Susan and Betty. The maid, now that the mischief
+ was done, thought only of how she could excuse herself to her
+ master.</p>
+
+ <p>"Indeed, Miss Barbara," said she, "it was quite wrong of you
+ to go and get yourself into such a scrape. I shall be turned
+ away for it, you'll see."</p>
+
+ <p>"I don't care whether you are turned away or not," said
+ Barbara; "I never felt such pain in my life. Can't you do
+ something for me? I don't mind the pain either so much as being
+ such a fright. Pray, how am I to be fit to appear at breakfast
+ with Mrs. Strathspey; and I suppose I can't go to the ball
+ either to-morrow, after all."</p>
+
+ <p>"No, that you can't expect to do, indeed," said Betty. "You
+ need not think of balls, for those lumps and swellings won't go
+ off your face this week. That's not what I mind; I'm thinking
+ of what your papa will say to me when he sees you, miss."</p>
+
+ <p>Susan, seeing she could be of no further use, was about to
+ leave the house, when at the door she met Mr. Case coming in.
+ Now, since his second visit to the Abbey, the Attorney had been
+ thinking things over. It was clear that both Sir Arthur and
+ Miss Somers thought highly of the Price family, so perhaps it
+ was a mistake on his part not to be on friendly terms with them
+ too. He felt sure that if the story of Susan's lamb ever
+ reached the Abbey, Sir Arthur would have no more to do with
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page300" id="page300"></a>[pg
+ 300]</span> him. It would therefore be well to get into the
+ good graces of the farmer and his family. So when Mr. Case met
+ Susan at the door he smiled and said, "How is your mother? Have
+ you called for something that may be of use to her? Barbara,
+ Barbara&mdash;Bab, come downstairs, child, and see what you can
+ do for Susan Price." But no Barbara answered, and her father
+ stalked upstairs to her room. There he stood still, amazed at
+ the sight of his daughter's swollen face.</p>
+
+ <p>Before Mr. Case could speak, Betty began to tell the story
+ of Barbara's mishap in her own way. Barbara spoke at the same
+ time, giving quite another account of what had happened. The
+ Attorney turned the maid away on the spot, and turning to
+ Barbara asked how she dared to treat Susan Price so ill,
+ "when," as he said, "she was kind enough to give you some of
+ her honey. I will not let you treat her so." Susan, who could
+ not but hear all that was said, now went to beg the angry
+ father to forgive his daughter.</p>
+
+ <p>"You are too good to her, as indeed you are to everybody,"
+ he said. "I forgive her for your sake."</p>
+
+ <p>Susan courtesied in great surprise, but she could not forget
+ the Attorney's treatment of Daisy, and she left his house as
+ soon as she could to get ready her mother's breakfast. Mr. Case
+ saw that Simple Susan was not to be taken in by a few simple
+ words, and when he tried in the same way to approach her
+ father, the blunt, honest farmer looked at him with
+ disdain.</p>
+
+ <h4>XI</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE PRIZE-GIVING</h4>
+
+ <p>So matters stood on the day of the long-expected
+ prize-giving and ball. Miss Barbara Case, stung by Susan's
+ bees, could not, after all her efforts, go with Mrs. Strathspey
+ to the ball. The ballroom was filled early in the evening.
+ There was a large gathering. The harpers who tried for the
+ prize were placed under the music-gallery at the lower end of
+ the room. Among them was our old blind friend, who, as he was
+ not so well clad as the others, seemed to be looked down upon
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page301" id="page301"></a>[pg
+ 301]</span> by many of the onlookers. Six ladies and six
+ gentlemen were chosen to be judges of the performance. They
+ were seated opposite to the harpers. The Misses Somers, who
+ were fond of music, were among the ladies, and the prize was in
+ the hands of Sir Arthur.</p>
+
+ <p>There was now silence. The first harp sounded, and as each
+ harper tried his skill, those who listened seemed to think that
+ he deserved the prize. The old blind man was the last. He tuned
+ his harp, and such a simple, sad strain was heard as touched
+ every heart. All were delighted, and when the music ceased
+ there was still silence for some moments.</p>
+
+ <p>The silence was followed by loud cheers. The judges were all
+ agreed that the old blind harper, who had played last, deserved
+ the prize. The simple, sad air, which had moved all who
+ listened, was composed by himself. He was asked to give the
+ words belonging to the music, and at last he modestly said he
+ would repeat them, as he could not see to write. Miss Somers
+ took her pencil, and as the old harper repeated his ballad, she
+ wrote the words. He called it "Susan's Lamentation for her
+ Lamb." Miss Somers looked at her brother from time to time, as
+ she wrote, and Sir Arthur, as soon as the old man had finished,
+ took him aside and asked him some questions, which brought to
+ light the whole story of Susan's lamb and of Attorney Case's
+ cruelty.</p>
+
+ <p>The Attorney himself was present when the harper began to
+ repeat his ballad. His color, as Sir Arthur steadily looked at
+ him, changed from red to white, and from white to red, until at
+ length he suddenly shrunk back through the crowd and left the
+ room. We shall not follow him. We had rather follow our old
+ friend the harper. No sooner had he received the prize of ten
+ guineas, than he went to a small room belonging to the people
+ of the house, asked for pen, ink, and paper, and dictated, in a
+ low voice to his boy, a letter, which he ordered him to put at
+ once into the post-office. The boy ran off with the letter and
+ was but just in time, for the postman's horn was sounding. The
+ next morning Farmer Price was sitting beside his wife and Susan
+ sorrowing that his week's leave was nearly
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page302" id="page302"></a>[pg
+ 302]</span> at an end, and that they had not enough money to
+ give to the man who was willing to go in his place, when a
+ knock was heard at the door. Then the person who delivered the
+ letters in the village put one into Susan's hand, saying, "A
+ penny, if you please&mdash;here's a letter for your
+ father."</p>
+
+ <p>"For me!" said Farmer Price; "here's the penny then; but who
+ can it be from, I wonder? Who can think of writing to me, in
+ this world?" He tore open the letter, but the hard name at the
+ bottom of the page puzzled him&mdash;"your obliged friend,
+ Llewellyn."</p>
+
+ <p>"And what's this?" he said, opening a paper that was
+ enclosed in the letter. "It's a song, seemingly; it must be
+ somebody that has a mind to make an April fool of me."</p>
+
+ <p>"But it is not April, it is May, father," said Susan.</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, let us read the letter, and we shall come to the
+ truth all in good time."</p>
+
+ <p>Farmer Price then sat down in his own chair, and read as
+ follows:</p>
+
+ <blockquote>
+ <p>"<span class="sc">My Worthy Friend</span>&mdash;I am
+ sure you will be glad to hear that I have had success this
+ night. I have won the ten-guinea prize, and for that I am
+ much indebted to your sweet daughter Susan; as you will see
+ by a little ballad I enclose for her. Your kindness to me
+ has let me learn something of your family history. You do
+ not, I hope, forget that I was present when you were
+ counting the treasure in Susan's little purse, and that I
+ heard for what purpose it was all saved. You have not, I
+ know, yet made up the full sum you need; therefore, I will
+ be glad if you will use the five-guinea bank-note which you
+ will find within the ballad. Pay me the money again when it
+ suits you, and if it never suits you to pay it, I shall
+ never ask for it. I shall go my rounds again through this
+ country, I believe, about the same time next year, and will
+ call to see how you are, and to play the new tune for Susan
+ and the dear little boys.</p>
+
+ <p>"I should just add, to set your heart at rest about the
+ money, that it does not distress me at all to lend it to
+ you. I am not quite so poor as I appear to be. But it is my
+ wish to go about as I do. I see more of the world under my
+ tattered clothes than,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page303"
+ id="page303"></a>[pg 303]</span> perhaps, I should ever see
+ in a better dress. There are many of us like this, and we
+ are glad, when we can, to do any kindness to such a worthy
+ family as yours.&mdash;So fare ye well.</p>
+
+ <p class="ctr">"Your obliged Friend,</p>
+
+ <p class="author">Llewellyn."</p>
+ </blockquote>
+
+ <p>Susan now, at her father's bidding, opened the ballad. He
+ took the five-guinea bank-note, while she read, with surprise,
+ "Susan's Lamentation for her Lamb." Her mother leaned over her
+ shoulder to read the words, but they were stopped before they
+ had finished the first verse by another knock at the door.</p>
+
+ <h4>XII</h4>
+
+ <h4>ATTORNEY CASE IN TROUBLE</h4>
+
+ <p>It was not the postman with another letter. It was Sir
+ Arthur and his sisters.</p>
+
+ <p>They came meaning to lend the farmer and his good family the
+ money to pay the man who was willing to go away in the farmer's
+ place. But they found their help was not needed.</p>
+
+ <p>"Still, since we are here," said Sir Arthur, "there is
+ something I should like to speak about. Mr. Price, will you
+ come out with me, and let me show you a piece of your land
+ through which I want to make a road. Look there," said Sir
+ Arthur, pointing to the spot, "I am laying out a drive round my
+ estate, and that bit of land of yours stops me."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, sir, true enough it's mine, but you are welcome to it.
+ I can trust you to find me another bit worth the same, or to
+ make up the value of it in some other way. I need say no
+ more."</p>
+
+ <p>Sir Arthur was silent for a few moments. Then he said, "What
+ is this I hear about some mistake in your lease?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, sir," replied the farmer, "the truth is the fit thing
+ to be spoken at all times. I can show you a letter from your
+ brother who had the estate before you, and who let the farm to
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page304" id="page304"></a>[pg
+ 304]</span> me. That letter shows what he meant, Sir Arthur,
+ and if in the writing of the lease it was otherwise said, it
+ is, as you say, a mistake, sir. Now a mistake is a mistake all
+ the world over, and should be treated as such, but Attorney
+ Case says in the matter of a lease you must abide by the
+ mistake as though it were the truth."</p>
+
+ <p>"You seem," said Sir Arthur, "to have some quarrel with this
+ Attorney of whom you talk so often. Now would you mind telling
+ me frankly what is the matter between you?"</p>
+
+ <p>"The matter between us, sir, is this," said Price. "You know
+ the corner of the field with the pink hawthorn near Mr. Case's
+ house? The lane runs past one side of it and a sweetbrier hedge
+ separates it on the other from his garden. Well, sir, the
+ Attorney wishes to enclose that bit of ground with his own, and
+ as it belongs to the village, and moreover is a play-green for
+ the children, and it has been their custom to meet by the
+ hawthorn every Mayday for as many years as I can remember, I
+ was loth to see them turned out of it."</p>
+
+ <p>"Let us go together and look at this piece of ground," said
+ Sir Arthur. "It is not far off, is it?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, no, sir, close by."</p>
+
+ <p>When they reached the ground, Mr. Case saw them from his
+ garden and hurried to the spot. He was afraid of what the
+ farmer might tell Sir Arthur. But this time the Attorney was
+ too late, for the truth had already been told.</p>
+
+ <p>"Is this the place you speak of?" asked Sir Arthur.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, sir," answered Price.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, Sir Arthur," said Attorney Case, seeing that he was
+ too late, "let there be no dispute about the ground. Let it
+ belong to the village if you will. I give up all claim to
+ it."</p>
+
+ <p>"But you know well, Mr. Case, that a man cannot give up
+ claim to a place which is not his. You cannot give up this
+ piece of land, for you have no claim to it, as I can prove to
+ you by a look at my maps. This field used to belong to the farm
+ on the other side of the road, but was cut off from it when the
+ lane was made."</p>
+
+ <p>"Indeed you must know best," said the trembling Attorney,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page305" id="page305"></a>[pg
+ 305]</span> who was afraid of Sir Arthur and enraged to be
+ shown in the wrong before Farmer Price.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then," said Sir Arthur to the farmer, "you understand that
+ this little green is to be a playground for the village
+ children, and I hope they may gather hawthorn from their
+ favorite bush for many a Mayday to come."</p>
+
+ <p>Farmer Price bowed low, which he seldom did, even when he
+ received a kindness for himself, but he was now overjoyed to
+ think of the children's delight when he should tell them the
+ good news.</p>
+
+ <p>"And now, Mr. Case," said Sir Arthur, turning to the
+ Attorney, "you sent me a lease to look over."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, I thought it my duty to do so. I hope it will not hurt
+ the good farmer."</p>
+
+ <p>"No, it will not hurt him," said Sir Arthur. "I am willing
+ to write a new one for him when he pleases. He has a letter
+ from my brother who let the farm to him, which shows exactly
+ what was meant, even if there was a mistake made in making out
+ the lease. I hope I shall never treat any one unfairly."</p>
+
+ <p>"No, indeed," said the Attorney, "but I always thought if
+ there was a mistake in a lease it was fair to take advantage of
+ it."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then you shall be judged by your own words," answered Sir
+ Arthur. "You meant to send me Farmer Price's lease, but your
+ son has somehow brought me yours instead. I have found a bad
+ mistake in it."</p>
+
+ <p>"A bad mistake in my lease!" gasped the alarmed
+ Attorney.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," replied Sir Arthur, pulling the lease out of his
+ pocket. "Here it is. You will see it has not been signed."</p>
+
+ <p>"But you won't take advantage of a mistake, surely!" said
+ the Attorney, who seemed to forget that he had shortly before
+ said that it was fair to do so.</p>
+
+ <p>"I shall not take advantage of you as you would have done of
+ this honest man," replied Sir Arthur. "You shall be paid the
+ value of your house and land upon condition that you leave the
+ parish within one month."</p>
+
+ <p>The Attorney knew it was useless to reply. He therefore
+ turned and sneaked
+ away.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page306"
+ id="page306"></a>[pg 306]</span>
+
+ <h4>XIII</h4>
+
+ <h4>SUSAN'S BIRTHDAY</h4>
+
+ <p>"You write a good hand, you can keep accounts, cannot you?"
+ said Sir Arthur to Mr. Price, as they walked towards the
+ cottage. "I think I saw a bill of your little daughter's
+ drawing out the other day, which was very neatly written. Did
+ you teach her to write?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, sir," said Price, "I can't say I did that, for she
+ mostly taught it to herself; but I taught her a few sums, as
+ far as I knew, on winter nights when I had nothing else to
+ do."</p>
+
+ <p>"Your daughter shows that she has been well taught," said
+ Sir Arthur; "and her good conduct is a credit to you and her
+ mother."</p>
+
+ <p>"You are very good, very good indeed, sir, to speak in this
+ way," said the delighted father.</p>
+
+ <p>"But I mean to do more than pay you with words," said Sir
+ Arthur. "You are attached to your own family, perhaps you may
+ become attached to me, when you know me, and we shall have many
+ chances of judging one another. I want no one to do my hard
+ work. I only want a steady, honest man, like you, to collect my
+ rents, and I hope, Mr. Price, you will do that for me."</p>
+
+ <p>"I hope, sir," said Price, with joy and gratitude glowing in
+ his honest face, "that I'll never give you cause to regret your
+ goodness to me."</p>
+
+ <p>"And what are my sisters about here?" said Sir Arthur,
+ entering the cottage and going behind the two ladies, who were
+ busy measuring a pretty colored calico.</p>
+
+ <p>"It is for Susan, my dear brother. I knew she did not keep
+ that guinea for herself," said Miss Somers. "I have just asked
+ her mother to tell me what became of it. Susan gave it to her
+ father; but she must not refuse a gown of our choosing this
+ time; and I am sure she will not, because her mother, I see,
+ likes it. And, Susan, I hear that instead of becoming Queen of
+ the May this year, you were sitting in your mother's room as
+ she was ill. Your mother has a little color in her cheeks
+ now."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page307"
+ id="page307"></a>[pg 307]</span>
+
+ <p>"Oh, ma'am," said Mrs. Price, "I'm a different being. Joy, I
+ think, has done it."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then," said Miss Somers, "I hope you will be able to come
+ out on your daughter's birthday, which, I hear, is on the
+ twenty-fifth of this month. Make haste and get quite well
+ before that day, for my brother means that all the boys and
+ girls of the village shall have a dance on Susan's
+ birthday."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Sir Arthur, "and I hope on that day, Susan, you
+ will be very happy with your little friends upon their
+ play-green. I shall tell them that it is your good conduct
+ which has won it for them; and if you have anything to ask, any
+ little favor for any of your friends, which we can grant, ask
+ now, Susan."</p>
+
+ <p>"Sir," said Susan, after glancing at her mother, "there is,
+ to be sure, a favor I should like to ask; it is for Rose."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, I don't know who Rose is," said Sir Arthur, smiling;
+ "but go on."</p>
+
+ <p>"Ma'am, you have seen her, I believe; she is a very good
+ girl indeed," said Mrs. Price to Miss Somers.</p>
+
+ <p>"And works very neatly, ma'am," continued Susan eagerly,
+ "and she and her mother heard you were looking out for some one
+ to wait upon you."</p>
+
+ <p>"Say no more," said Miss Somers; "your wish is granted. Tell
+ Rose to come to the Abbey to-morrow morning, or rather come
+ with her yourself, for our housekeeper, I know, wants to talk
+ to you about a certain cake. She wishes, Susan, that you should
+ be the maker of the cake for the dance, and she has good things
+ looked out for it already, I know. It must be large enough for
+ everybody to have a slice, and the housekeeper will ice it for
+ you. I only hope your cake will be as good as your bread.
+ Good-by."</p>
+
+ <p>"How I do wish, now," said Farmer Price, "how I do wish,
+ wife, that our good friend the harper was only here at this
+ time. It would do his warm old heart good. Well, the best of it
+ is, we shall be able next year, when he comes his rounds, to
+ pay him his money with thanks, being all the time and for ever
+ as much obliged to him as if we kept it. I long to see him in
+ this house again, drinking, as he did, a glass of Susan's mead,
+ just on this spot."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page308"
+ id="page308"></a>[pg 308]</span>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Susan, "and the next time he comes, I can give
+ him one of my guinea-hen's eggs, and I shall show him
+ Daisy."</p>
+
+ <p>"True, love," said her mother, "and he will play that tune
+ and sing that pretty ballad. Where is it? I have not finished
+ it."</p>
+
+ <p>"Rose ran away with it, mother, but I'll run after her, and
+ bring it back to you this minute," said Susan.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan found her friend Rose at the hawthorn, in the midst of
+ a crowd of children, to whom she was reading "Susan's
+ Lamentation for her Lamb."</p>
+
+ <p>"The words are something, but the tune&mdash;the
+ tune&mdash;I must have the tune," cried Philip. "I'll ask my
+ mother to ask Sir Arthur to try and find out which way that
+ good old man went after the ball; and if he's to be found,
+ we'll have him back by Susan's birthday, and he shall sit
+ here&mdash;just exactly here&mdash;by our bush, and he shall
+ play&mdash;I mean, if he will&mdash;that same tune for us, and
+ I shall learn it&mdash;I mean, if I can&mdash;in a minute."</p>
+
+ <p>The good news that Farmer Price was to collect the rents and
+ that Attorney Case was to leave the parish in a month soon
+ spread over the village. Many came out of their houses to have
+ the pleasure of hearing the joyful tidings from Susan herself.
+ The crowd on the play-green grew bigger every minute.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," cried Philip, "I tell you it's quite true, every word
+ of it. Susan's too modest to say it herself, but I tell you
+ all, that Sir Arthur has given us this play-green just because
+ she is so good."</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page309"
+ id="page309"></a>[pg 309]</span>
+
+ <h3>LIMBY LUMPY</h3>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <p>LIMBY LUMPY was the only son of his mother. His father was
+ called the "Pavior's Assistant," for he was so large and heavy
+ that, when he used to walk through the streets, the men who
+ were ramming the stones down with a large wooden rammer would
+ say, "Please to walk over these stones, sir," and then the men
+ would get a rest.</p>
+
+ <p>Limby was born on April 1&mdash;I do not know how long ago;
+ but before he came into the world such preparations were made!
+ There was a beautiful cradle, and a bunch of coral with bells
+ on it, and lots of little caps, and a fine satin hat, and tops
+ and bottoms for pap, and two nurses to take care of him. He
+ was, too, to have a little chaise, when he grew big enough;
+ after that, he was to have a donkey, and then a pony. In short,
+ he was to have the moon for a plaything, if it could be got;
+ and, as to the stars, he would have had them, if they had not
+ been too high to reach.</p>
+
+ <p>Limby made a rare to-do when he was a little baby. But he
+ never was a <i>little</i> baby&mdash;he was always a big baby;
+ nay, he was a big baby till the day of his death.</p>
+
+ <p>"Baby Big," his mother used to call him; he was "a noble
+ baby," said his aunt; he was "a sweet baby," said old Mrs.
+ Tomkins, the nurse; he was "a dear baby," said his
+ papa&mdash;and so he was, for he <i>cost</i> a good deal. He
+ was "a darling baby," said his aunt, by the mother's side;
+ "there never was such a fine child," said everybody, before the
+ parents; when they were at another place they called him, "a
+ great, ugly fat child."</p>
+
+ <p>Limby was almost as broad as he was long. He had what some
+ people called an open countenance&mdash;that is, one as broad
+ as a full moon. He had what his mother called beautiful
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page310" id="page310"></a>[pg
+ 310]</span> auburn locks, but what other people said were
+ carroty&mdash;not before the mother, of course.</p>
+
+ <p>Limby had a flattish nose and a widish mouth, and his eyes
+ were a little out of the right line. Poor little dear, he could
+ not help that and therefore it was not right to laugh at
+ him.</p>
+
+ <p>Everybody, however, laughed to see him eat his pap, for he
+ would not be fed with the patent silver pap-spoon which his
+ father bought him, but used to lay himself flat on his back,
+ and seize the pap-boat with both hands, and never let go of it
+ till its contents were fairly in his dear little stomach.</p>
+
+ <p>So Limby grew bigger and bigger every day, till at last he
+ could scarcely draw his breath, and was very ill; so his mother
+ sent for three apothecaries and two physicians, who looked at
+ him, and told his mother there were no hopes: the poor child
+ was dying of overfeeding. The physicians, however, prescribed
+ for him&mdash;a dose of castor-oil.</p>
+
+ <p>His mother attempted to give him the castor-oil, but Limby,
+ although he liked tops and bottoms, and cordial, and pap, and
+ sweetbread, and oysters, and other things nicely dished up, had
+ no fancy for castor-oil, and struggled and kicked and fought
+ every time his nurse or mother attempted to give it him.</p>
+
+ <p>"Limby, my darling boy," said his mother, "my sweet cherub,
+ my only dearest, do take its oily-poily, there's a ducky-deary,
+ and it shall ride in a coachy-poachy."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, the dear baby!" said the nurse; "take it for nursey. It
+ will take it for nursey, that it will."</p>
+
+ <p>The nurse had got the oil in a silver medicine-spoon, so
+ contrived that, if you could get it into the child's mouth, the
+ medicine must go down. Limby, however, took care that no spoon
+ should go into his mouth, and when the nurse tried the
+ experiment for the nineteenth time, gave a plunge and a kick,
+ and sent the spoon up to the ceiling, knocked off the nurse's
+ spectacles, upset the table on which all the bottles and
+ glasses were, and came down whack on the floor.</p>
+
+ <p>His mother picked him up, clasped him to her breast, and
+ almost smothered him with kisses.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, my dear boy!" said she; "it shan't take the nasty
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page311" id="page311"></a>[pg
+ 311]</span> oil! it won't take it, the darling! Naughty nurse
+ to hurt baby! It shall not take nasty physic!"</p>
+
+ <p>And then she kissed him again.</p>
+
+ <p>Poor Limby, although only two years old, knew what he was
+ at&mdash;he was trying to be the master of his mother. He felt
+ he had gained his point, and gave another kick and a squall, at
+ the same time planting a blow on his mother's eye.</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear little creature!" said she; "he is in a state of high
+ convulsions and fever. He will never recover!"</p>
+
+ <p>But Limby did recover, and in a few days was running about
+ the house, and the master of it. There was nobody to be
+ considered, nobody to be consulted, nobody to be attended to,
+ but Limby Lumpy.</p>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <p>Limby grew up big and strong; he had everything his own way.
+ One day, when he was at dinner with his father and mother,
+ perched upon a double chair, with his silver knife and fork,
+ and silver mug to drink from, he amused himself by playing
+ drums on his plate with the mug.</p>
+
+ <p>"Don't make that noise, Limby, my dear," said his
+ father.</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear little lamb!" said his mother; "let him amuse himself.
+ Limby, have some pudding?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, Limby no pudding!"</p>
+
+ <p><i>Drum! drum! drum!</i></p>
+
+ <p>A piece of pudding was, however, put on Limby's plate, but
+ he kept on drumming as before. At last he drummed the bottom of
+ the mug into the soft pudding, to which it stuck, and by which
+ means it was scattered all over the carpet.</p>
+
+ <p>"Limby, my darling!" said his mother; and the servant was
+ called to wipe Limby's mug and pick the pudding up from the
+ floor.</p>
+
+ <p>Limby would not have his mug wiped, and floundered about,
+ and upset the cruet-stand and the mustard on the
+ table-cloth.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, Limby Lumpy&mdash;naughty boy!" said his father.</p>
+
+ <p>"Don't speak so cross to the child: he is but a child," said
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page312" id="page312"></a>[pg
+ 312]</span> his mother. "I don't like to hear you speak so
+ cross to the child."</p>
+
+ <p>"I tell you what it is," said his father, "I think the boy
+ does as he likes. But I don't want to interfere."</p>
+
+ <p>Limby now sat still, resolving what to do next. He was not
+ hungry, having been stuffed with a large piece of pound-cake
+ about an hour before dinner; but he wanted something to do, and
+ could not sit still.</p>
+
+ <p>Presently a saddle of mutton was brought on the table. When
+ Limby saw this he set up a crow of delight.</p>
+
+ <p>"Limby ride," said he&mdash;"Limby ride!" and rose up in his
+ chair, as if to reach the dish.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, my ducky, it shall have some mutton," said his mother,
+ and immediately gave him a slice, cut up into small
+ morsels.</p>
+
+ <p>That was not it. Limby pushed that on the floor, and cried
+ out: "Limby on meat! Limby on meat!"</p>
+
+ <p>His mother could not think what he meant. At last, however,
+ his father recollected that he had been in the habit of giving
+ him a ride occasionally, first on his foot, sometimes on the
+ scroll end of the sofa, at other times on the top of the easy
+ chair. Once he put him on a dog, and more than once on the
+ saddle; in short, he had been in the habit of perching him on
+ various things, and now Limby, hearing this was a <i>saddle</i>
+ of mutton, wanted to take a ride on it.</p>
+
+ <p>"Limby on! Limby ride on bone!" said the child in a
+ whimper.</p>
+
+ <p>"Did you <i>ever hear</i>?" said the father.</p>
+
+ <p>"What an extraordinary child!" said the mother. "How clever
+ to know it was like a saddle, the little dear! No, no, Limby;
+ grease frock, Limby."</p>
+
+ <p>But Limby cared nothing about a greasy frock, not
+ he&mdash;he was used enough to that&mdash;and therefore roared
+ out more lustily for a ride on the mutton.</p>
+
+ <p>"Did you ever know such a child? What a dear, determined
+ spirit!"</p>
+
+ <p>"He is a child of an uncommon mind," said his mother.
+ "Limby, dear&mdash;Limby, dear, silence!
+ silence!"</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page313"
+ id="page313"></a>[pg 313]</span>
+
+ <p>The truth was, Limby made such a roaring that neither father
+ nor mother could get their dinners, and scarcely knew whether
+ they were eating beef or mutton.</p>
+
+ <p>"It is impossible to let him ride on the mutton," said his
+ father&mdash;"quite impossible!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, but you might just put him astride the dish, just to
+ satisfy him. You can take care his legs or clothes do not go
+ into the gravy."</p>
+
+ <p>"Anything for a quiet life," said the father. "What does
+ Limby want? Limby ride?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Limby on bone! Limby on meat!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Shall I put him across?" said Mr. Lumpy.</p>
+
+ <p>"Just for one moment," said his mother; "it won't hurt the
+ mutton."</p>
+
+ <p>The father rose, and took Limby from his chair, and, with
+ the greatest caution, held his son's legs astride, so that they
+ might hang on each side of the dish without touching
+ it&mdash;"just to satisfy him," as he said, "that they might
+ dine in quiet&mdash;" and was about to withdraw him from it
+ immediately.</p>
+
+ <p>But Limby was not to be cheated in that way. He wished to
+ feel the saddle <i>under</i> him, and accordingly forced
+ himself down upon it; but feeling it rather warmer than was
+ agreeable, started, and lost his balance, and fell down among
+ the dishes, soused in melted butter, cauliflower, and gravy,
+ floundering, and kicking, and screaming, to the detriment of
+ glasses, jugs, dishes, and everything else on the table.</p>
+
+ <p>"My child! my child!" said his mother. "Oh, save my
+ child!"</p>
+
+ <p>She snatched him up, and pressed his begreased garments
+ close to the bosom of her best silk gown.</p>
+
+ <p>Neither father nor mother wanted any more dinner after this.
+ As to Limby, he was as frisky afterwards as if nothing had
+ happened, and about half an hour from the time of this disaster
+ <i>cried for his dinner.</i></p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page314"
+ id="page314"></a>[pg 314]</span>
+
+ <h3>THE SORE TONGUE</h3>
+
+ <h3>By JANE TAYLOR</h3>
+
+ <p>There was a little girl called Fanny, who had the misfortune
+ one day to bite her tongue as she was eating her breakfast. It
+ hurt her so much that she could scarcely help crying; and even
+ when the first smart was over, it continued so sore that
+ whenever she spoke it pained her considerably. Finding this to
+ be the case, she said very pitifully to her mother, "Mamma, you
+ can't think how it hurts me when I speak!" "Does it?" replied
+ her mother; "then I'll tell you what I would advise you to do.
+ Resolve all this day to say nothing but what is either
+ necessary or useful; this will give your tongue a fine holiday,
+ and may answer more purposes than one."</p>
+
+ <p>Fanny, knowing that she had the character of being somewhat
+ loquacious, could not help laughing at this, and said, "Well, I
+ will try for once; so, mum! I am going to begin now,
+ mamma."</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mother</i>. Do so; and whenever you are beginning to
+ speak, be sure you ask yourself whether what you were going to
+ say was likely to be of any use, or whether it was
+ necessary.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Fanny</i>. Yes, yes, I will! but don't talk to me, mamma,
+ for fear. So saying, she screwed up her lips, and taking her
+ work, sat for about five minutes as still as a mouse. She then
+ looked up, smiled and nodded at her mother, as much as to say,
+ "See how well I can hold my tongue," still screwing her lips
+ very tight for fear she should speak. Soon, however, she began
+ to feel a great inclination to say something; and was glad to
+ recollect that if she could but think of anything either useful
+ or necessary, she might speak. Whereupon she endeavored to find
+ something to say that would come "within the act." To aid her
+ invention, she looked all round the room.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Fanny</i>. Mamma, don't you think the fire wants
+ stirring? (This question, she thought, savored of both
+ qualifications.)</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page315"
+ id="page315"></a>[pg 315]</span>
+
+ <p><i>Mother</i>. Not at present, my dear.</p>
+
+ <p>Then followed another long silence; for Fanny found it
+ vastly more difficult than she had any previous idea of, to
+ think of anything useful to talk about; and she knew her mamma
+ would laugh at her if she said what was obviously idle or
+ silly, just now. She was beginning to repent having made such
+ an agreement, when her three elder sisters entered the room.
+ She now thought it quite reasonable, if not absolutely
+ necessary, to tell them of her misfortune; which she did at
+ considerable length, and with many needless digressions (the
+ usual custom with great talkers); upon which they all laughed,
+ prophesying that her resolution would not last half an hour,
+ and rallying her for telling such a long story with a sore
+ tongue.</p>
+
+ <p>Soon after, some ladies called to pay their mother a morning
+ visit. This gave Fanny's tongue such a long rest that the
+ moment they were gone it seemed irresistibly to resume its
+ wonted functions.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Fanny</i>. What a while old Mrs. W. has had that brown
+ satin pelisse! Really, poor old lady, I am quite tired of
+ seeing her in it!</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mother</i>. How is your tongue, Fanny?</p>
+
+ <p><i>Fanny</i>. Oh, better, mamma, thank you&mdash;almost
+ well.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mother</i>. I am sorry for it: I was in hopes it would
+ have been sore enough at least to prevent your making
+ impertinent remarks upon anybody all this day.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Fanny</i>. No, but really, mamma, is it not an old
+ rubbishing thing?</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mother</i>. I don't know, indeed. It is no business of
+ mine; therefore I took no notice of it.</p>
+
+ <p>A silence ensued after this; but conversation revived when
+ Caroline, who had stood for some time with her eyes fixed on
+ their opposite neighbor's window, suddenly exclaimed, "I do
+ believe the Joneses are going to have company again to-day! The
+ servant has just been lighting the fire in the drawing-room;
+ and there is Miss Jones now gone up to dress. I saw her draw
+ down the blinds in her room this instant." "So she is," said
+ Lucy, looking up: "I never knew such people in my life! they
+ are always having
+ company."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page316"
+ id="page316"></a>[pg 316]</span>
+
+ <p>"I wonder whom they are expecting to-day," said Eliza;
+ "dinner-company, I suppose."</p>
+
+ <p>The proceedings of their neighbors, the Joneses, continued
+ to furnish matter for various sagacious conjectures and remarks
+ for a considerable time. At length Caroline exclaimed with the
+ eagerness of discovery, "Look! look! there's the baker now at
+ the door, with a whole tray full of tarts and things. Make
+ haste, or he'll be gone in."</p>
+
+ <p><i>Lucy</i>. So he is, I declare; it is a dinner-party then.
+ Well, we shall see presently, I hope, who are coming.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Caroline</i>. Oh, no, they never dine till five when they
+ have company.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Eliza</i>. And it will be dark then; how tiresome!</p>
+
+ <p><i>Lucy</i>. If Miss Jones is not dressed already! She is
+ this instant come into the drawing-room.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Caroline</i>. Stand back, stand back! Don't let her see
+ us all staring. Ah, there she is,&mdash;got on her pink
+ sarcenet body and sleeves to-day. How pretty that dress is, to
+ be sure!</p>
+
+ <p><i>Eliza</i>. And how nicely she has done her hair! Look,
+ Caroline&mdash;braided behind.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Lucy</i>. There, she is putting down the sash. That
+ chimney smokes, I know, with this wind.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Fanny</i>. And there is that little figure, Martha Jones,
+ come down now. Do look&mdash;as broad as she is long! What a
+ little fright that child is, to be sure!</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mother</i>. Pray, Fanny, was that remark useful or
+ necessary?</p>
+
+ <p><i>Fanny</i>. Oh, but mamma, I assure you, my tongue is
+ quite well now.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mother</i>. I am sorry for it, my dear. Do you know, I
+ should think it well worth while to bite my tongue every day if
+ there were no other means of keeping it in order.</p>
+
+ <p>At this the girls laughed; but their mother, resuming her
+ gravity, thus continued:</p>
+
+ <p>"My dear girls, I should before now have put a stop to this
+ idle gossiping, if I had not hoped to convince you of the folly
+ of it. It is no wonder, I confess, that at your age you should
+ learn to imitate a style of remark which is but too prevalent
+ in society. Nothing, indeed, is more contagious. But
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page317" id="page317"></a>[pg
+ 317]</span> let me also tell you, that girls of your age, and
+ of your advantages, are capable of seeing the meanness of it,
+ and ought to despise it. It is the chief end of education to
+ raise the minds of women above such trifling as this. But if a
+ young person who has been taught to think, whose taste has been
+ cultivated, and who might therefore possess internal resources,
+ has as much idle curiosity about the affairs of her neighbors,
+ and is as fond of retailing petty scandal concerning them, as
+ an uneducated woman, it proves that her mind is incurably mean
+ and vulgar, and that cultivation is lost upon her.</p>
+
+ <p>"This sort of gossiping, my dear girls, is the disgrace of
+ our sex. The pursuits of women lie necessarily within a narrow
+ sphere, and they naturally sink, unless raised by refinement,
+ or by strong principle, into that littleness of character, for
+ which even their own husbands and fathers (if they are men of
+ sense) are tempted to despise them. The minds of men, from
+ their engagements in business, necessarily take a larger range;
+ and they are, in general, too much occupied with concerns
+ comparatively important to enter into the minute details which
+ amuse women. But women of education have no such plea to urge.
+ When your father and I direct you to this or that pursuit, it
+ is not so much for the sake of your possessing that particular
+ branch of knowledge, but that by knowledge in general you may
+ become intelligent and superior, and that you may be furnished
+ with resources which will save you from the miserable necessity
+ of seeking amusement from intercourse with your neighbors, and
+ an acquaintance with their affairs.</p>
+
+ <p>"Let us suppose, now, that this morning you had been all
+ more industriously inclined; and had been engaged in any of
+ your employments with that ardor which some happy young people
+ manifest in the acquisition of knowledge; would you, in that
+ case, have felt any desire to know the date of Mrs. W.'s
+ pelisse, or any curiosity in the proceedings of our neighbors
+ the Joneses? No, you would then have thought it a most
+ impertinent interruption, if any one had attempted to entertain
+ you with such particulars. But when the mind is indolent and
+ empty, then it can receive amusement from the most contemptible
+ sources. Learn, then, to check this mean propensity.
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page318" id="page318"></a>[pg
+ 318]</span> Despise such thoughts whenever you are tempted to
+ indulge them. Recollect that this low curiosity is the combined
+ result of idleness, ignorance, emptiness, and ill-nature; and
+ fly to useful occupation, as the most successful antidote
+ against the evil. Nor let it be forgotten that such impertinent
+ remarks as these come directly under the description of those
+ 'idle words,' of which an account must be given in the day of
+ judgment. Yes, this vulgar trifling is as inconsistent with the
+ spirit of Christian benevolence, and with the grand rule of
+ 'doing to others as we would that they should do to us,' as it
+ is with refinement of taste and dignity of character."</p>
+
+ <p>"Who would have thought," said little Fanny, "that my
+ happening to bite my tongue this morning would have led to all
+ this?"</p>
+
+ <p>"It would be a fortunate bite for you, Fanny," said her
+ mother, "and for your neighbors, if it should make you more
+ careful in the use of it. If we were liable to such a
+ misfortune whenever we use our tongues improperly, some persons
+ would be in a constant agony. Now, if our consciences were but
+ half as sensitive as our nerves, they would answer the purpose
+ much better. Foolish talking pains a good conscience, just as
+ continual speaking hurts a sore tongue; and if we did but
+ regard one smart as much as the other, it would act as a
+ constant check upon the unruly member."</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page319"
+ id="page319"></a>[pg 319]</span>
+
+ <h3>EYES AND NO EYES, OR THE ART OF SEEING</h3>
+
+ <h3>By JOHN AIKIN and MRS. BARBAULD</h3>
+
+ <p>"Well, Robert, where have you been walking this after noon?"
+ said Mr. Andrews, to one of his pupils at the close of a
+ holiday.</p>
+
+ <p><i>R.</i> I have been, sir, to Broom heath, and so round by
+ the windmill upon Camp-mount, and home through the meadows by
+ the river-side.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> Well, that's a pleasant round.</p>
+
+ <p><i>R.</i> I thought it very dull, sir; I scarcely met with a
+ single person. I had rather by half have gone along the
+ turnpike road.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> Why, if seeing men and horses is your object,
+ you would, indeed, be better entertained on the highroad. But
+ did you see William?</p>
+
+ <p><i>R.</i> We set out together, but he lagged behind in the
+ lane, so I walked on and left him.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> That was a pity. He would have been company
+ for you.</p>
+
+ <p><i>R.</i> Oh, he is so tedious, always stopping to look at
+ this thing and that! I had rather walk alone. I dare say he is
+ not got home yet.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> Here he comes. Well, William, where have you
+ been?</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> Oh, sir, the pleasantest walk! I went all over
+ Broom-heath, and so up to the mill at the top of the hill, and
+ then down among the green meadows by the side of the river.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> Why, that is just the round Robert has been
+ taking, and he complains of its dullness, and prefers the
+ highroad.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> I wonder at that. I am sure I hardly took a step
+ that did not delight me, and I have brought home my
+ handkerchief full of
+ curiosities.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page320"
+ id="page320"></a>[pg 320]</span>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> Suppose, then, you give us some account of
+ what amused you so much. I fancy it will be as new to Robert as
+ to me.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> I will, sir. The lane leading to the heath, you
+ know, is close and sandy, so I did not mind it much, but made
+ the best of my way. However, I spied a curious thing enough in
+ the hedge. It was an old crab-tree, out of which grew a great
+ bunch of something green, quite different from the tree itself.
+ Here is a branch of it.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> Ah! this is mistletoe, a plant of great fame
+ for the use made of it by the Druids of old in their religious
+ rites and incantations. It bears a very slimy white berry, of
+ which birdlime may be made, whence its Latin name of
+ <i>Viscus</i>. It is one of those plants which do not grow In
+ the ground by a root of their own, but fix themselves upon
+ other plants; whence they have been humorously styled
+ <i>parasitical</i>, as being hangers-on, or dependents. It was
+ the mistletoe of the oak that the Druids particularly
+ honored.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> A little farther on I saw a green woodpecker fly
+ to a tree, and run up the trunk like a cat.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> That was to seek for insects in the bark, on
+ which they live. They bore holes with their strong bills for
+ that purpose, and do much damage to the trees by it.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> What beautiful birds they are!</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> Yes; they have been called, from their color
+ and size, the English parrot.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> When I got upon the open heath, how charming it
+ was! The air seemed so fresh, and the prospect on every side so
+ free and unbounded! Then it was all covered with gay flowers,
+ many of which I had never observed before. There were at least
+ three kinds of heath (I have got them In my handkerchief here),
+ and gorse, and broom, and bellflower, and many others of all
+ colors, that I will beg you presently to tell me the names
+ of.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> That I will readily.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> I saw, too, several birds that were new to me.
+ There was a pretty grayish one, of the size of a lark, that was
+ hopping about some great stones; and when he flew he showed a
+ great deal of white above his
+ tail.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page321"
+ id="page321"></a>[pg 321]</span>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> That was a wheatear. They are reckoned very
+ delicious birds to eat, and frequent the open downs in Sussex,
+ and some other countries, in great numbers.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W</i>. There was a flock of lapwings upon a marshy part
+ of the heath, that amused me much. As I came near them, some of
+ them kept flying round and round just over my head, and crying
+ <i>pewet</i> so distinctly one might fancy they almost spoke, I
+ thought I should have caught one of them, for he flew as if one
+ of his wings was broken, and often tumbled close to the ground:
+ but as I came near, he always made a shift to get away.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> Ha, ha! you were finely taken in then! This
+ was all an artifice of the bird's to entice you away from its
+ nest; for they build upon the bare ground, and their nests
+ would easily be observed, did they not draw off the attention
+ of intruders by their loud cries and counterfeit lameness.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> I wish I had known that, for he led me a long
+ chase, often over shoes in water. However, it was the cause of
+ my falling in with an old man and a boy who were cutting and
+ piling up turf for fuel, and I had a good deal of talk with
+ them about the manner of preparing the turf, and the price it
+ sells at. They gave me, too, a creature I never saw
+ before&mdash;a young viper, which they had just killed,
+ together with its dam. I have seen several common snakes, but
+ this is thicker in proportion, and of a darker color than they
+ are.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> True. Vipers frequent those turfy, boggy
+ grounds pretty much, and I have known several turf-cutters
+ bitten by them.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> They are very venomous, are they not?</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> Enough so to make their wounds painful and
+ dangerous, though they seldom prove fatal.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> Well&mdash;I then took my course up to the
+ windmill on the mount. I climbed up the steps of the mill in
+ order to get a better view of the country round. What an
+ extensive prospect! I counted fifteen church steeples; and I
+ saw several gentlemen's houses peeping out from the midst of
+ green woods and plantations; and I could trace the windings of
+ the river all along the low grounds, till it was lost behind a
+ ridge of hills. But I'll tell you what I mean to do, sir, if
+ you will give me
+ leave.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page322"
+ id="page322"></a>[pg 322]</span>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> What is that?</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> I will go again, and take with me Carey's county
+ map, by which I shall probably be able to make out most of the
+ places.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> You shall have it, and I will go with you, and
+ take my pocket spying-glass.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> I shall be very glad of that. Well&mdash;a thought
+ struck me, that as the hill is called <i>Camp-mount,</i> there
+ might probably be some remains of ditches and mounds with which
+ I have read that camps were surrounded. And I really believe I
+ discovered something of that sort running round one side of the
+ mount.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr, A.</i> Very likely you might. I know antiquaries have
+ described such remains as existing there, which some suppose to
+ be Roman, others Danish. We will examine them further, when we
+ go.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W.</i> From the hill I went straight down to the meadows
+ below, and walked on the side of a brook that runs into the
+ river. It was all bordered with reeds and flags and tall
+ flowering plants, quite different from those I had seen on the
+ heath. As I was getting down the bank to reach one of them, I
+ heard something plunge into the water near me. It was a large
+ water-rat, and I saw it swim over to the other side, and go
+ into its hole. There were a great many large dragon-flies all
+ about the stream. I caught one of the finest, and have got him
+ here in a leaf. But how I longed to catch a bird that I saw
+ hovering over the water, and every now and then darting down
+ into it! It was all over a mixture of the most beautiful green
+ and blue, with some orange color. It was somewhat less than a
+ thrush, and had a large head and bill, and a short tail.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A.</i> I can tell you what that bird was&mdash;a
+ kingfisher, the celebrated halcyon of the ancients, about which
+ so many tales are told. It lives on fish, which it catches in
+ the manner you saw. It builds in holes in the banks, and is a
+ shy, retired bird, never to be seen far from the stream where
+ it inhabits.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W</i>. I must try to get another sight at him, for I
+ never saw a bird that pleased me so much. Well&mdash;I followed
+ this little brook till it entered the river, and then took the
+ path that runs <span class="pagenum"><a name="page323"
+ id="page323"></a>[pg 323]</span> along the bank. On the
+ opposite side I observed several little birds running along the
+ shore, and making a piping noise. They were brown and white,
+ and about as big as a snipe.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A</i>. I suppose they were sandpipers, one of the
+ numerous family of birds that get their living by wading among
+ the shallows, and picking up worms and insects.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W</i>. There were a great many swallows, too, sporting
+ upon the surface of the water, that entertained me with their
+ motions. Sometimes they dashed into the stream; sometimes they
+ pursued one another so quick, that the eye could scarcely
+ follow them. In one place where a high steep sand-bank rose
+ directly above the river, I observed many of them go in and out
+ of holes with which the bank was bored full.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A</i>. Those were sand-martins, the smallest of our
+ species of swallows. They are of a mouse color above, and white
+ beneath. They make their nests and bring up their young in
+ these holes, which run a great depth, and by their situation
+ are secure from all plunderers.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W</i>. A little farther I saw a man in a boat, who was
+ catching eels in an odd way. He had a long pole with broad iron
+ prongs at the end, just like Neptune's trident, only there were
+ five instead of three. This he pulled straight down among the
+ mud in the deepest parts of the river, and fetched up the eels
+ sticking between the prongs.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A</i>. I have seen this method. It is called spearing
+ of eels.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W</i>. While I was looking at him, a heron came flying
+ over my head, with his large flagging wings. He lit at the next
+ turn of the river, and I crept softly behind the bank to watch
+ his motions. He had waded into the water as far as his long
+ legs would carry him, and was standing with his neck drawn in,
+ looking intently on the stream. Presently he darted his long
+ bill as quick as lightning into the water, and drew out a fish,
+ which he swallowed. I saw him catch another in the same manner.
+ He then took alarm at some noise I made, and flew away slowly
+ to a wood at some distance, where he settled.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A</i>. Probably his nest was there, for herons build
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page324" id="page324"></a>[pg
+ 324]</span> upon the loftiest trees they can find, and
+ sometimes in society together like rooks. Formerly, when these
+ birds were valued for the amusement of hawking, many gentlemen
+ had their <i>heronries</i>, and a few are still remaining.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W</i>. I think they are the largest wild birds we
+ have.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A</i>. They are of a great length and spread of wing,
+ but their bodies are comparatively small.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W</i>. I then turned homeward across the meadows, where I
+ stopped awhile to look at a large flock of starlings which kept
+ flying about at no great distance. I could not tell at first
+ what to make of them; for they rose all together from the
+ ground as thick as a swarm of bees, and formed themselves into
+ a kind of black cloud, hovering over the field. After taking a
+ short round, they settled again, and presently rose again in
+ the same manner, I dare say there were hundreds of them.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A</i>. Perhaps so; for in the fenny countries their
+ flocks are so numerous as to break down whole acres of reeds by
+ settling on them. This disposition of starlings to fly in close
+ swarms was remarked even by Homer, who compares the foe flying
+ from one of his heroes to a <i>cloud</i> of starlings retiring
+ dismayed at the approach of the hawk.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W</i>. After I had left the meadows, I crossed the
+ cornfields and got to the high field next our house just as the
+ sun was setting, and I stood looking at it till it was quite
+ lost. What a glorious sight! The clouds were tinged with purple
+ and crimson and yellow of all shades and hues, and the clear
+ sky varied from blue to a fine green at the horizon. But how
+ large the sun appears just as it sets! I think it seems twice
+ as big as when it is overhead.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A</i>. It does so; and you may probably have observed
+ the same apparent enlargement of the moon at its rising.</p>
+
+ <p><i>W</i>. I have; but pray what is the reason of this?</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A</i>. It is an optical deception, depending upon
+ principles which I cannot well explain to you till you know
+ more of that branch of science. But what a number of new ideas
+ this afternoon's walk has afforded you! I do not wonder that
+ you found it amusing; It has been very instructive, too. Did
+ <i>you</i> see nothing of all these sights,
+ Robert?</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page325"
+ id="page325"></a>[pg 325]</span>
+
+ <p><i>R</i>. I saw some of them, but I did not take particular
+ notice of them.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A</i>. Why not?</p>
+
+ <p><i>R</i>. I don't know. I did not care about them, and I
+ made the best of my way home.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. A</i>. That would have been right if you had been
+ sent of a message; but as you only walked for amusement it
+ would have been wiser to have sought out as many sources of it
+ as possible. But so it is&mdash;one man walks through the world
+ with his eyes open, and another with them shut; and upon this
+ difference depends all the superiority of knowledge the one
+ acquires above the other. I have known sailors, who had been in
+ all quarters of the world, and could tell you nothing but the
+ signs of the tippling-houses they frequented in different
+ ports, and the price and quality of the liquor. On the other
+ hand, a Franklin could not cross the channel without making
+ some observations useful to mankind. While many a vacant,
+ thoughtless youth is whirled throughout Europe without gaining
+ a single idea worth crossing a street for, the observing eye
+ and inquiring mind find matter of improvement and delight in
+ every ramble in town or country. Do <i>you</i> then, William,
+ continue to make use of your eyes; and <i>you</i>, Robert,
+ learn that eyes were given you to use.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page326"
+ id="page326"></a>[pg 326]</span>
+
+ <h3>PRINCE LIFE</h3>
+
+ <h3>By G.P.R. JAMES</h3>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <p>Once upon a time there was a young Prince who met with a
+ very curious kind of misfortune. Most people want something
+ which they cannot get; and because they cannot get it, they
+ generally desire it more than anything else, which is very
+ foolish, for it would be much better to be contented with what
+ they have.</p>
+
+ <p>He was a wise fox, my dear Charlie, who thought the grapes
+ were sour when he could not reach them. Now the Prince's
+ misfortune consisted in this, that he had everything on earth
+ he could want or desire, and a little more. He had a fine
+ palace and a fine country, obedient subjects and servants, and
+ true friends. When he got up in the morning, there was some one
+ ready to put on his clothes for him; when he went to bed at
+ night, some one to take them off again. A fairy called
+ Prosperity gave him everything he desired as soon as he desired
+ it. If he wanted peaches at Christmas, or cool air at
+ mid-summer, the first came instantly from his hothouses, and
+ the second was produced by an enormous fan, which hung from the
+ top of the room, and was moved by two servants.</p>
+
+ <p>But strange to say, the Prince got weary of all this; he was
+ tired of wanting nothing. When he sat down to dinner he had but
+ little appetite, because he had had such a good breakfast; he
+ hardly knew which coat to put on, they were all so beautiful;
+ and when he went to bed at night, though the bed was as soft as
+ a white cloud, he could not sleep, for he was not tired.</p>
+
+ <p>There was only one ugly thing in the whole palace, which was
+ a little, drowsy, gray dwarf, left there by the fairy
+ Prosperity. He kept yawning all day, and very often set the
+ Prince <span class="pagenum"><a name="page327"
+ id="page327"></a>[pg 327]</span> yawning, too, only to look at
+ him. This dwarf they called Satiety, and he followed the Prince
+ about wherever he went.</p>
+
+ <p>One day the Prince asked him what he was yawning for, and
+ Satiety answered:</p>
+
+ <p>"Because I have nothing to do, and nothing to wish for, my
+ Prince."</p>
+
+ <p>"I suppose that is the reason why I yawn too," replied the
+ Prince.</p>
+
+ <p>"Rather is it having me always with you,".answered
+ Satiety.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then get away and leave me," said the Prince.</p>
+
+ <p>"I cannot do that," answered Satiety. "You can go from me,
+ but I cannot go from you; I can never leave you as long as you
+ remain in the palace of Prosperity."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then I will have you turned out," said the Prince.</p>
+
+ <p>"No one can do that," said Satiety, "but Misfortune, and he
+ is a very capricious person. Though he is a very disagreeable
+ monster, some people seem to court him, but cannot get him to
+ come near them; while to a great many he comes unawares, and
+ catches them, though they fly from him eagerly. I tell you,
+ Prince, you can go from me, but I cannot go from you as long as
+ you remain in the palace of Prosperity."</p>
+
+ <p>That night, when he went to his soft bed, the Prince thought
+ very much as to the conversation he had held with Satiety, and
+ he resolved to go out of the palace for a time, just to get rid
+ of the ugly little gray, yawning dwarf.</p>
+
+ <p>The very resolution seemed to do him good, and he slept
+ better that night after he had made it than he had done for
+ many a night before.</p>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <p>The next morning when he rose he felt quite refreshed, and
+ he said to a groom: "Bring me my stout horse, Expedition; I am
+ going out to take a ride all alone."</p>
+
+ <p>The groom answered not a word, for in that palace every one
+ obeyed the Prince at once, and nobody troubled him but the ugly
+ little dwarf, Satiety. As he went away, however, the groom said
+ to himself with a sigh: "It is a sad thing to be in
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page328" id="page328"></a>[pg
+ 328]</span> the wide world all alone. My Prince does not know
+ what it is. But let him try; it may be better for him."</p>
+
+ <p>He accordingly brought the horse to the palace-door. But
+ when the Prince came down he felt quite well, and, looking
+ about among all his attendants, he could only catch a distant
+ glimpse of Satiety standing yawning behind. For a minute he was
+ half inclined not to go, for he did not mind seeing Satiety at
+ a distance if he did not come near. But the groom, whose name
+ was Resolution, seeing him hesitate, said: "You had better go,
+ my Prince, as you determined; it may do you good." And a
+ chamberlain called Effort helped him on his horse.</p>
+
+ <p>At first, as the Prince rode along, everything was quite
+ delightful to him. He seemed to breathe more freely now that he
+ was no more troubled with Satiety. The flowers looked bright,
+ and the sky beautiful, for a cloud or two here and there only
+ gave variety. The very air seemed fresher than it had been in
+ the sheltered gardens of the palace, and the Prince said to
+ himself: "What a delightful country this is, just on the verge
+ of the land of Prosperity."</p>
+
+ <p>Just then he saw a countryman gathering grapes in a
+ vineyard, and every now and then putting some into his mouth,
+ and the Prince asked him whose fine estate it was that he was
+ passing through.</p>
+
+ <p>"It belongs to a gentleman and lady equally, sir," replied
+ the good man; "they are called Activity and Ease. They are the
+ happiest couple ever seen. When Activity is tired, Ease takes
+ his head upon her lap; and soon as she is weary of her burden,
+ Activity jumps up and relieves her from it."</p>
+
+ <p>"But to whom does that more barren country just beyond
+ belong?" asked the Prince. "And what is that great thick wood I
+ see farther on still?"</p>
+
+ <p>"That is the land of Labor and the Forest of Adversity,"
+ said the man. "I would advise you to get through them as soon
+ as possible, for the first you will find very wearisome, and
+ the second exceedingly unpleasant, although people do say that
+ there is a great deal of very good fruit in the forest; only
+ one gets well-nigh torn to pieces with the thorns before one
+ can reach it."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page329"
+ id="page329"></a>[pg 329]</span>
+
+ <p>The Prince determined to follow his advice, and rode on.
+ There was not anything very tempting to him as he passed
+ through the land of Labor, and it seemed a long and weary way
+ from the beginning to the end of it. But the forest, even at
+ its entrance, was very dark and gloomy indeed. Thick trees
+ crossed each other overhead, and shut out the bright, cheerful
+ daylight. He could hardly see his way along the narrow,
+ tortuous paths, and the thorns which the peasant had spoken of
+ ran into him continually, for they grew high as well as thick,
+ and crossed the path in every direction. He began heartily to
+ repent that he had quitted the palace of Prosperity, and wished
+ himself back again with all his heart, thinking that he should
+ care little about yawning Satiety if he could but get out of
+ the thorns of Adversity. Indeed, he tried to turn his horse
+ back; but he found it more difficult than he imagined, for, as
+ I have told you, the road was very narrow and those thorns
+ hedged it on every side. There was nothing for it, in short,
+ but to try and force his way on through the wood, in the hope
+ of finding something better beyond.</p>
+
+ <p>The Prince did not know which way to take, indeed, and he
+ tried a great number of paths, but in vain. Still there were
+ the same thorns and the same gloomy darkness. He was hungry and
+ thirsty, and he looked round for those fruits he had heard of;
+ but he could see none of them at the time, and the more he
+ sought his way out, the deeper he seemed to get into the
+ forest. The air was very sultry and oppressive, too; he grew
+ weary and faint, quite sick at heart, and even the limbs of his
+ good horse seemed to be failing him, and hardly able to carry
+ him on.</p>
+
+ <p>Dark as it all was, it at length began to grow darker, and
+ he perceived that night was coming, so that the poor Prince
+ began to give up all hope, and to think that there would be
+ nothing for him but to lie down and die in despair, when
+ suddenly he caught a sort of twinkling light through the thick
+ bushes, which seemed to lie in the way he was going, and on he
+ went, slowly enough, poor man! But still the light was before
+ him, till suddenly he came to a great rock, overgrown in many
+ places with briers and brambles. In the midst of it,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page330" id="page330"></a>[pg
+ 330]</span> however, was the mouth of a large cave, with great
+ masses of stone hanging over, as if ready to fall on a
+ traveler's head. It was a very stern and gloomy looking place
+ indeed, with clefts and crevices and ragged crags all around.
+ But a few steps in the cave some one seemed to have built
+ himself a house; for it was blocked up with large, unhewn
+ boards of wood, and in this partition there was a door and a
+ window, through which came the light he had seen. The Prince
+ dismounted from his horse, and though he did not know who might
+ be within, he thought it best to knock at the door, and ask for
+ food and shelter.</p>
+
+ <p>The moment he knocked a loud, hoarse voice cried: "Come in!"
+ and tying his horse to a tree, he opened the door.</p>
+
+ <h4>III</h4>
+
+ <p>Now, whatever the poor Prince had expected to find, he was
+ certainly disappointed; for that thicket of Adversity is full
+ of disappointments, as every one knows who has traveled through
+ it. He had thought he should see some poor woodman or honest
+ peasant, who would welcome him to his homely hut in the rock
+ with kindness and benevolence; but instead of that he beheld,
+ seated at the table, carving away at a piece of stick by the
+ light of a very small twinkling candle, one of the most
+ tremendous monsters ever man's eyes lighted upon. In shape he
+ was like a man, but he was a great deal stronger than any man.
+ His face looked as if it were cast in iron, so hard and rigid
+ were all the features; and there was an ever-lasting frown
+ planted on his brow. His hands were long and sinewy, with
+ terrible sharp claws upon them; and his feet were so large and
+ heavy that they seemed as if they would crush anything they
+ would set upon to pieces.</p>
+
+ <p>The poor Prince, though he was a very brave young man,
+ stopped and hesitated at the sight of this giant; but the
+ monster, without ever turning his head, cried out again: "Come
+ in! Why do you pause? All men must obey me, and I am the only
+ one that all men do obey."</p>
+
+ <p>"You must be a mighty monarch, then," said the young Prince,
+ taking courage, "Pray, what is your
+ name?"</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page331"
+ id="page331"></a>[pg 331]</span>
+
+ <p>"My name is Necessity," answered the other in his thundering
+ voice; "and some people give me bad names, and call me 'Hard
+ Necessity' and 'Dire Necessity;' but, nevertheless, I often
+ lead men to great things and teach them useful arts if they do
+ but struggle with me valiantly."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then I wish you would lead me to where I can get some
+ rest," said the Prince, "and teach me how I can procure food
+ for myself and my poor famishing horse."</p>
+
+ <p>The monster rose up almost as tall as a steeple and suddenly
+ laid his great clutches upon the Prince's shoulders, saying: "I
+ will do both, if you do but wrestle with me courageously. You
+ must do it, for there is no other way of escaping from my
+ hands."</p>
+
+ <p>The Prince had never been handled so roughly before, and as
+ he was brave, strong, and active, he made a great effort to
+ free himself, and tried a thousand ways, but to no purpose. The
+ giant did not hurt him, however, though he pressed him very
+ hard, and at length he cried out: "Ho, ho! you are a brave
+ young man! Leave off struggling, and you shall have some food
+ and drink, such as you would never have tasted had you not come
+ to me."</p>
+
+ <p>Thereupon he led him to his own coarse wooden table, and set
+ before him half of a hard brown loaf and a pitcher of water;
+ but so hungry and thirsty was the Prince that the bread seemed
+ to him the best he had ever eaten, and the water sweeter than
+ any in the world.</p>
+
+ <p>"Unfasten your horse's bridle," said Necessity, when the
+ Prince had done, "and I will soon teach him where to find
+ something to feed upon."</p>
+
+ <p>The Prince did as the giant told him at once, and then his
+ stern-looking companion pointed to a wooden bedstead in a dark
+ corner of the cave, which looked as hard as his own face,
+ saying: "There, lie down and sleep."</p>
+
+ <p>"I can never sleep on that thing," said the Prince.</p>
+
+ <p>"Ho, ho!" cried the other; "Necessity can make any bed
+ soft," and taking a bundle of straw, he threw it down on the
+ bedstead.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page332"
+ id="page332"></a>[pg 332]</span>
+
+ <h4>IV</h4>
+
+ <p>Sleep was sweeter to the Prince that night than it had ever
+ been upon a bed of down, and when he rose the next morning the
+ monster's features did not seem half so stern and forbidding as
+ they had done at first. The inside of the cave, too, looked
+ much more light and blithesome, though it was a dark and
+ frowning place enough still, with hard rock all round, and
+ nothing but one window to let in a little sunshine.</p>
+
+ <p>Necessity, however, did not intend to keep the Prince there,
+ and as soon as he was up the giant said to him: "Come, trudge;
+ you must quit my cave, and go on."</p>
+
+ <p>"You must open the door for me, then," said the Prince; "for
+ the bolt is so high up I cannot reach it."</p>
+
+ <p>"You cannot get out by the door through which you came in,"
+ said the giant, "for it is the door of Idleness. There is but
+ one way for you to get out, and that I will show you."</p>
+
+ <p>So, taking him by the hand, he led him on into a very dark
+ part of the cave, which went a long way under ground, and then
+ said to him: "You must now go on until you come to a great
+ house, where you will find an old woman, who will give you your
+ meals at least."</p>
+
+ <p>"But I want to return to my own palace of Prosperity,"
+ replied the Prince.</p>
+
+ <p>"She will show you the way," replied the monster, "and
+ without her you will never find it. Go on at once, and don't
+ stand talking."</p>
+
+ <p>"But I cannot see the path," said the Prince.</p>
+
+ <p>"You must find it," said Necessity, and gave him a great
+ push, which sent him on at a very rapid rate.</p>
+
+ <p>For some time he continued to grope his way almost in
+ darkness, but soon a light began to shine before him, which
+ grew bigger and bigger as he advanced, and he perceived that he
+ was coming to another mouth of the cave, leading to an open but
+ very rough country. The Prince was very glad indeed to issue
+ forth and breathe the fresh air, and he looked at the clear sky
+ with great satisfaction. Just before him, however, there was a
+ large house, with a great number of doors and windows;
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page333" id="page333"></a>[pg
+ 333]</span> and as he felt very hungry, he determined to knock,
+ and see if he could get any breakfast.</p>
+
+ <p>Almost as soon as he had touched the knocker the door was
+ opened by a little old woman, plainly dressed, but neat and
+ tidy: and when the Prince told her who he was, and what he
+ wanted, she answered him with a good-humored smile, very
+ different from the frown of stern Necessity: "Every one can
+ have food in my house who chooses to work for it; nobody
+ without. I can help you on your way, too; and as for your poor
+ horse you talk about, he shall be provided for. My name is
+ Industry, and Industry always takes care of her beasts. Come
+ in, young man; come in."</p>
+
+ <p>The Prince went in with a glad step, and found the house
+ quite full of people, all as busy as bees in a field of clover,
+ and all looking as bright and cheerful as if they had washed
+ their faces in sunshine.</p>
+
+ <p>It would take me an hour to tell you all the different
+ things they were employed in, every one working by himself on
+ his separate task, although two or three were often seen doing
+ different pieces of the same work. But there were two very
+ nice, pretty girls there whom I must speak of, who seemed to be
+ handmaidens to the mistress of the house. One was a
+ thoughtful-looking, careful girl, who was busy in every part of
+ the room alternately, picking up all the little odds and ends
+ which were left after any piece of work was
+ completed&mdash;little bits of string, ends of tape or thread,
+ stray nails, chips of wood, or pieces of paper. These, as soon
+ as she had gathered them up, she put safely by, where she could
+ find them again; and it is wonderful how often she was called
+ upon by the workmen for some little scrap or another, just
+ sufficient to complete what they were about. Her name was
+ Economy.</p>
+
+ <p>The other was a brighter, quicker-looking person, with very
+ clear eyes, like two stars, who went continually through the
+ room, putting everything to rights. If a chair was out of its
+ place, or a table turned awry, or a tool put down where it
+ should not be, she could not bear to see it for a minute, but
+ put all things straight again, so that nobody was at a loss
+ where to find anything, She was called
+ Order.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page334"
+ id="page334"></a>[pg 334]</span>
+
+ <p>The hungry Prince was somewhat mortified to find a good,
+ large piece of work assigned him to do before he could get his
+ breakfast, and at first he was exceedingly awkward, and did not
+ know how to set about it; but Industry showed him the way,
+ Order helped him a good deal, and Economy supplied him with the
+ materials.</p>
+
+ <h4>V</h4>
+
+ <p>At the end of an hour he had completed his task, and the old
+ lady patted him on the shoulder, saying, "Well done; you are a
+ very good young man. Now Industry will give you your breakfast,
+ and help you on the way to a very nice place, where you will
+ get all you desire."</p>
+
+ <p>Thus saying, she led him into a great hall, where there was
+ a vast number of people, all eating rich fruits, with a
+ somewhat hard-favored dame, whom they called Labor, scattering
+ sugar on the different dishes.</p>
+
+ <p>When the Prince heard her name, he asked one of the people
+ near if that was really Labor, saying, "I passed through her
+ land not long ago, and it seemed so poor and hard a country
+ that I should have thought it produced nothing good."</p>
+
+ <p>"That is a mistake," said the other. "That is the land where
+ grows the sugar-cane, and Labor always sweetens the food of
+ Industry."</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as his breakfast was over, the Prince was taken to
+ another door, and shown a road which was very narrow at first,
+ but seemed to grow wider and wider as it went on.</p>
+
+ <p>"You have nothing to do but to walk straight forward," said
+ Industry, "neither to turn to the right nor to the left. Keep
+ yourself upright, so that you may have that distant mountain
+ peak before your eyes, and don't suffer yourself to grow faint
+ or get tired. If you should have any doubt or difficulty, you
+ will find some one on the road who will show you the way. But
+ only remember always to keep straight forward, and don't be
+ tempted to turn aside."</p>
+
+ <p>"What is the name of this road?" asked the Prince.</p>
+
+ <p>"It is called the 'Right Path'" was the reply; and on he
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page335" id="page335"></a>[pg
+ 335]</span> set upon his way with a stout heart. Nevertheless,
+ he began to get somewhat tired before an hour was over,
+ although the road was pleasant enough to walk in. There were
+ beautiful green meadows on every side, and richly colored
+ flowers, and what seemed very delicious fruit; and here and
+ there, at a little distance, were pleasant groves, with a
+ number of gay birds, singing very sweetly.</p>
+
+ <p>At the end of an hour and a half the Prince became hungry
+ and thirsty again, as well as tired, and he said to himself,
+ "There could be no great harm surely in going across that
+ meadow and gathering some of that fruit, to eat under the shade
+ of the trees, while the birds sing over my head. I do not know
+ how far I have to go. I see no end to this long, straight road.
+ I think I will try and rest for a little under those trees. I
+ can easily find my way back again."</p>
+
+ <p>But just at that moment, luckily for himself, the Prince
+ spied a man trudging on before him, and he hurried after,
+ saying to himself, "I will ask him how far I have to go, and
+ whether I have time to stop."</p>
+
+ <h4>VI</h4>
+
+ <p>The man did not walk very fast, but he kept steadily on,
+ with a great pikestaff in his hand; and though the Prince
+ called after him as soon as he was within hearing, he did not
+ halt for a moment, or even turn his head, but trudged onward,
+ saying, "Come along, come along; one never gets to the end of
+ one's journey if one stops to chatter by the way."</p>
+
+ <p>At length the Prince came up with him, and said in a civil
+ tone, "Pray can you tell me whither this road leads, and if it
+ will be very long before I get to some house where I can find
+ rest and food?"</p>
+
+ <p>"It leads to a very fine and beautiful castle," replied the
+ other somewhat doggedly, and still walking on. "I think, if you
+ come along with me, you will get there in time. I am generally
+ well received there, and in some sort may call myself the
+ master of the house, so that those who go with me are generally
+ made welcome by my lady, who, though she is sometimes a
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page336" id="page336"></a>[pg
+ 336]</span> little whimsical, is the most charming person in
+ the world when she smiles upon me. But you must keep on
+ steadily with me; for if you stop or turn aside, a thousand to
+ one you will be lost."</p>
+
+ <p>When the Prince found him so communicative, he asked him if
+ they could not cross one of the meadows to refresh themselves a
+ little, and told him how he had been tempted to do so just
+ before he saw him.</p>
+
+ <p>"Lucky you did not," answered the other; "for those meadows
+ are full of swamps and quagmires, the groves filled with
+ snakes, and many of the fruits poisonous. You might have got
+ yourself into such troubles that not even I could have helped
+ you out of them."</p>
+
+ <p>"If it is not improper, may I ask your name?" said the
+ Prince.</p>
+
+ <p>"Come along," answered the other, "Names matter little; but
+ if you want to know mine, it is Perseverance."</p>
+
+ <p>Not long after the Prince began to think he saw several tall
+ towers glittering before him in the distance, with some misty
+ clouds round about them, which only seemed to make them look
+ the more beautiful.</p>
+
+ <p>"What a fine castle!" he exclaimed.</p>
+
+ <p>"That is where I am leading you," answered the other; "and
+ the first prospect is always very charming. But we have some
+ way to go yet, I can tell you, and not a little to overcome.
+ You would never get there without me; so come on, and do not be
+ daunted at anything you see."</p>
+
+ <p>The Prince soon found that his companion's warning was just.
+ The way did seem very long; and sometimes, as they went over
+ hill and dale, the sight of the beautiful castle, which cheered
+ him so much, was quite shut out from his eyes, and at length,
+ when they were coming very near it, with nothing but one valley
+ between them and the building, he perceived that the road went
+ over a narrow drawbridge, and saw two terrible monsters lying
+ close beside the way. Their bodies were like those of lions,
+ very large and very strong, but they had necks like that of a
+ snake, and from each neck issued a hundred horrible heads, all
+ differing in kind from one another.</p>
+
+ <p>The poor Prince was alarmed, and said to his companion:
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page337" id="page337"></a>[pg
+ 337]</span> "Do you see those horrible brutes? Is there no
+ other way into the castle but between them?"</p>
+
+ <p>"There are a thousand ways into the castle," replied his
+ companion, "but every way is guarded by monsters just like
+ those. But do not be alarmed. Go on with me, and I will help
+ you. Besides, some one will come out of the castle, most
+ likely, to give us assistance."</p>
+
+ <h4>VII</h4>
+
+ <p>Upon these words, the Prince went on more cheerfully,
+ especially when he saw a man come running down from the gate of
+ the castle as they approached the drawbridge.</p>
+
+ <p>"Ay," said his companion, stepping on without stopping a
+ moment, "there comes my friend Courage to help us. He is a
+ good, serviceable fellow."</p>
+
+ <p>Just as he spoke, the two monsters sprang forward, and the
+ one which was nearest to Perseverance growled terribly at him;
+ but he struck him a blow with his pikestaff, which knocked him
+ down and cowed him entirely; and there he lay, with all his
+ hundred heads prostrated in a manner which the Prince could
+ hardly have thought possible. The other brute sprang right at
+ the Prince himself, as if to destroy him, so that he was
+ inclined to draw back; but the man Courage, who had run down
+ from the castle, put his foot upon the creature's snaky neck,
+ and crushed it into the earth.</p>
+
+ <p>"Go on, go on, young man!" he cried. "These are terrible
+ monsters truly, but you see our friend Perseverance has
+ vanquished Difficulty, and I have trampled upon Danger."</p>
+
+ <p>As he spoke, the Prince passed on rapidly over the
+ drawbridge; and when he stood under the gate of the castle,
+ Perseverance took him by the hand with a smiling air, and led
+ him in, saying: "Now I will conduct you to my lady,
+ Success."</p>
+
+ <p>At the very sound the poor Prince seemed quite refreshed,
+ forgot all the weary way he had traveled, the dark forest of
+ Adversity, the grim frown of Necessity, the faintness and the
+ weariness, and hundred-headed Difficulty and Danger. But he was
+ more rejoiced still when, on entering the building,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page338" id="page338"></a>[pg
+ 338]</span> he found himself suddenly, all at once, in the
+ great hall of his own palace of Prosperity, with a beautiful
+ lady, all smiles, standing ready to receive him with a crown in
+ her hand.</p>
+
+ <p>"Come hither, Prince," she said, "and receive this crown,
+ which I never bestow on any but my greatest favorites. It is
+ called the crown of Contentment. I reserve it for those who,
+ led on by Perseverance, come to me by the Right Path, in spite
+ of Difficulty and Danger. Those who arrive at my presence by
+ any of the many other roads that are open to mankind I give
+ over to the charge of some of my inferior attendants, such as
+ Pride, Vanity, or Ambition, who amuse themselves by making them
+ play all manner of strange tricks."</p>
+
+ <p>Thus saying, she put the crown upon his head, and the Prince
+ found the most delightful tranquil feeling spread through his
+ whole body. Nevertheless, he could not help looking about
+ almost instantly for the figure of the ugly little gray dwarf;
+ and, as he could not see him anywhere, he said to the beautiful
+ lady: "Where is that hideous, yawning Satiety? I hope he has
+ left the palace."</p>
+
+ <p>"He may be hanging about in some dark corners of the
+ palace," answered the lady, "or hiding among the roses in your
+ garden of Pleasure; but he will never appear in your presence
+ again, so long as you wear that crown upon your head; for there
+ is a rich jewel called Moderation in the crown of Contentment
+ which is too bright and pure to be looked upon by Satiety."</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page339"
+ id="page339"></a>[pg 339]</span>
+
+ <h3>THE FRUITS OF DISOBEDIENCE</h3>
+
+ <h4>OR THE KIDNAPPED CHILD</h4>
+
+ <p>In a beautiful villa on the banks of the Medway resided a
+ gentleman whose name was Darnley, who had, during the early
+ part of life, filled a post of some importance about the Court,
+ and even in its decline preserved that elegance of manners
+ which so peculiarly marks a finished gentleman.</p>
+
+ <p>The loss of a beloved wife had given a pensive cast to his
+ features, and a seriousness to his deportment, which many
+ people imagined proceeded from haughtiness of disposition, yet
+ nothing could be further from Mr. Darnley's character, for he
+ was affable, gentle, benevolent, and humane.</p>
+
+ <p>His family consisted of an only sister, who, like himself,
+ had lost the object of her tenderest affection, but who, in
+ dividing her attention between her brother and his amiable
+ children, endeavored to forget her own misfortunes.</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Darnley's fortune was sufficiently great to enable him
+ to place his daughters in the first school in London, but he
+ preferred having them under his immediate instruction, and as
+ Mrs. Collier offered to assist him in their education he
+ resolved for some years not to engage a governess, as Nurse
+ Chapman was one of those worthy creatures to whose care he
+ could securely trust them.</p>
+
+ <p>An old friend of Mr. Darnley's had recently bought a house
+ at Rochester, and that gentleman and his sister were invited to
+ pass a few days there, and as Emily grew rather too big for the
+ nurse's management Mrs. Collier resolved to make her of the
+ party, leaving Sophia, Amanda, and Eliza under that good
+ woman's protection.</p>
+
+ <p>It was Mr. Darnley's wish that the young folks should rise
+ early and take a long walk every morning before breakfast, but
+ they were strictly ordered never to go beyond their own grounds
+ unless their aunt or father accompanied them. This
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page340" id="page340"></a>[pg
+ 340]</span> order they had frequently endeavored to persuade
+ Nurse Chapman to disregard, but, faithful to the trust reposed
+ in her, she always resisted their urgent entreaties.</p>
+
+ <p>The morning after Mr. Darnley went to Rochester the poor
+ woman found herself thoroughly indisposed, and wholly incapable
+ of rising at the accustomed hour. The children, however, were
+ dressed for walking, and the nurse-maid charged not to go
+ beyond the shrubbery, and they all sallied out in high good
+ humor.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now, Susan," said Sophia, as soon as they entered the
+ garden, "this is the only opportunity you may ever have of
+ obliging us. Do let us walk to the village, and then you know
+ you can see your father and mother."</p>
+
+ <p>"La, missy!" replied the girl, "why, you know 'tis as much
+ as my place is worth if Nurse Chapman should find out."</p>
+
+ <p>"Find it out indeed," said Amanda; "how do you think she is
+ to find it out? Come, do let us go, there's a dear, good
+ creature."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, dear, dear Susan, do let us go," said Eliza, skipping
+ on before them, "and I'll show you the way, for I walked there
+ last summer with father."</p>
+
+ <p>Whether it was the wish of obliging the young ladies, or the
+ desire of seeing her parents, I cannot pretend to say, but in a
+ luckless hour Susan yielded, and the party soon reached the
+ village.</p>
+
+ <p>Susan's mother was delighted at seeing her, and highly
+ honored by the young ladies' presence.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, sweet, dear creatures!" said the old woman, "I must get
+ something for them to eat after their long walk, and my oven's
+ quite hot, and I can bake them a little cake in a quarter of an
+ hour, and I'll milk Jenny in ten minutes."</p>
+
+ <p>The temptation of her hot cake and new milk was not to be
+ withstood, and Susan began taking down some smart china cups,
+ which were arranged in form upon the mantelpiece, and carefully
+ dusted them for the young ladies' use.</p>
+
+ <p>Eliza followed the old woman into the cow-house, and began
+ asking a thousand questions, when her attention was suddenly
+ attracted by the appearance of a tame lamb, who went up
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page341" id="page341"></a>[pg
+ 341]</span> bleating to its mistress with a view of asking its
+ accustomed breakfast.</p>
+
+ <p>"You must wait a little, Billy," said the woman, "and let
+ your betters be served before you. Don't you see that we have
+ got gentlefolks to breakfast with us this morning?"</p>
+
+ <p>Eliza was so delighted with the beauty of the little animal
+ that she wanted to kiss it, and attempted to restrain it for
+ that purpose, while Billy, ungrateful for her intended
+ kindness, gave a sudden spring and frisked away.</p>
+
+ <p>Eliza followed in hopes of being able to catch him, but he
+ ran baaing along into the high road.</p>
+
+ <p>A woman whose appearance was descriptive of poverty but
+ whose smiling countenance indicated good nature, at that moment
+ happened to pass, and, accosting Eliza in a tone of
+ familiarity, said: "That's not half such a pretty lamb, miss,
+ as I have got at home, and not a quarter so tame, for if you
+ did but say, 'Bob' he'd follow you from one end of the town to
+ the other, and then he'll fetch and carry like a dog, stand up
+ on his hind legs, when my husband says 'Up' for the thing, and
+ play more tricks than a young kitten."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, the pretty creature," replied Eliza, "how I should like
+ to see it!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, come along with me, miss," said the woman, "for I
+ only lives just across the next field, but you must run as hard
+ as you can, because my husband is going to work, and he
+ generally takes Bob with him."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, make haste, then," said Eliza.</p>
+
+ <p>"Give me your hand, miss," replied the woman; "for we can
+ run faster together. But there goes my husband, I declare; and
+ there's Bob, as usual, skipping on before."</p>
+
+ <p>"Where? where?" exclaimed Eliza, stretching her little neck
+ as far as she possibly could, to see if she could discern the
+ lamb.</p>
+
+ <p>"You are not tall enough," said the artful creature; "but
+ let me lift you up, miss, and then I dare say you will see
+ them;" and, instantly catching her up, she cried out: "Look
+ directly towards the steeple, miss; but I'll run with you in my
+ arms, and I warrant we'll soon overtake
+ them."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page342"
+ id="page342"></a>[pg 342]</span>
+
+ <p>Eliza looked, but looked in vain, and, perceiving the woman
+ had soon carried her out of sight of the cottage, begged she
+ would set her down, as she dare not go any farther.</p>
+
+ <p>The vile creature was absolutely incapable of replying, for
+ her breath was nearly exhausted by the rapidity of the motion,
+ and Eliza continued entreating her to stop, and struggled
+ violently to elude her grasp.</p>
+
+ <p>At length, after a quarter of an hour's exertion, the woman
+ found herself incapable of proceeding, and stopped suddenly,
+ sat down on a bank, keeping tight hold of Eliza's arms, who
+ cried dreadfully, and besought her to let her go.</p>
+
+ <p>"Let you go!" she replied; "what, after all the plague I've
+ had to knap you? No, no, you don't catch me at that, I promise
+ you; but be a good girl, and don't cry, and then you may see
+ Bob by and by, perhaps."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, my sisters! my sisters! Let me go to my sisters!" cried
+ the child.</p>
+
+ <p>"I'll find plenty of sisters for you in a few days," said
+ the vile creature; "but they won't know you in them there fine
+ clothes; so let's pull them off in a minute, and then we'll
+ have another run after Bob."</p>
+
+ <p>So saying, she stripped off the white frock, hat, and
+ tippet. The rest of the things shared the same fate, and Eliza
+ was compelled to put on some old rags which the inhuman
+ creature took out of a bag she carried under her petticoat;
+ then, taking a bottle of liquid from the same place, she
+ instantly began washing Eliza's face with it, and,
+ notwithstanding all her remonstrances, cut her beautiful hair
+ close to her head.</p>
+
+ <p>Thus metamorphosed, it would have been impossible even for
+ Mr. Darnley to have known his child, and they proceeded onward
+ until her little legs would carry her no farther. At this
+ period they were overtaken by the Canterbury wagon, and for a
+ mere trifle the driver consented to let them ride to London.
+ Eliza's tears continued to flow, but she dared not utter a
+ complaint, as her inhuman companion protested she would break
+ every bone in her skin if she ventured to make the least
+ noise.</p>
+
+ <p>When they arrived in town, she was dragged (for to walk
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page343" id="page343"></a>[pg
+ 343]</span> she was unable) to a miserable hole down several
+ steps, where they gave her some bread and butter to eat, and
+ then desired her to go to bed.</p>
+
+ <p>The bed, if such it might be called, was little else than a
+ bundle of rags thrown into a corner of the room, with a dirty
+ blanket spread across it; and there she was left by her inhuman
+ kidnapper to mourn her misfortunes and lament having
+ disregarded her fathers' injunctions.</p>
+
+ <p>The next morning she was forced to rise the moment it was
+ light, and to walk as far as her little legs would carry her
+ before they stopped anywhere to take refreshment. The second
+ night was passed in a barn, and about five o'clock the third
+ afternoon they knocked at the door of a neat-looking cottage,
+ where nine or ten children were sitting in a little room making
+ lace.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, Peggy," said the woman, as she opened the door, "I
+ thought you never would have come again! However, I see you
+ have got me a hand at last, and God knows I'm enough in want of
+ her; for two of my brats have thought proper to fall sick, and
+ I have more to do than ever I had in my life."</p>
+
+ <p>On the following day Eliza's filthy rags were all taken off,
+ and she was dressed in a tidy brown-stuff gown, a nice clean
+ round-eared cap, and a little colored bib and apron; and she
+ was ordered, if any person asked her name, to say it was Biddy
+ Bullen, and that she was niece to the woman who employed
+ her.</p>
+
+ <p>The severity with which all this wretch's commands were
+ enforced wholly prevented any of the helpless victims who were
+ under her protection from daring to disobey them; and though
+ most of them were placed under her care by the same vile agent
+ who had decoyed Eliza, yet they were all tutored to relate
+ similar untruths.</p>
+
+ <p>But I now think it is high time to carry my little readers
+ back to the cottage scene, where Susan was arranging things in
+ order for breakfast, and Sophia and her sister were anxiously
+ watching the moment when the cake was pronounced completely
+ ready.</p>
+
+ <p>The old woman soon returned with the milk-pail on her arm,
+ and Susan eagerly demanded: "Where's Miss
+ Eliza?"</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page344"
+ id="page344"></a>[pg 344]</span>
+
+ <p>"Oh, the pretty creature!" replied her mother, "she'll be
+ here in a minute, I warrant her; but she has gone skipping
+ after our Billy, and the two sweet innocents they are
+ together."</p>
+
+ <p>She then went to the oven, produced the cake, and began
+ buttering it with all expedition, while Sophia joyously ran to
+ the door of the cow-house, and began loudly calling her sister
+ Eliza.</p>
+
+ <p>No answer being returned, Susan began to feel alarmed, but
+ the young ladies told her not to be frightened, as they knew it
+ was only one of Eliza's pranks. But, alas! too soon were they
+ convinced it was no joke, but some dreadful misfortune must
+ have happened.</p>
+
+ <p>"Miss Eliza! Miss Eliza!" was vociferated through the
+ village, not only by Susan and her mother, but by all the
+ neighbors who had heard of the calamity, while her sisters ran
+ about frantic with grief, crying, "Eliza, my love! my darling!
+ Oh, if you are hid, for pity's sake speak!"</p>
+
+ <p>Nurse Chapman got up about half-past nine, and, hearing the
+ children were not returned from their walk, sent the housemaid
+ directly after them.</p>
+
+ <p>The garden, the shrubbery, and the lawn were all searched
+ without success; and just as Betty was returning to inform the
+ nurse they were not to be found, she perceived Susan and the
+ two children enter a little green gate at the bottom of the
+ shrubbery.</p>
+
+ <p>"Where's Miss Eliza?" called Betty, in a voice as loud as
+ she could articulate.</p>
+
+ <p>"God knows! God knows!" replied the careless girl, sobbing
+ so loud she could scarcely speak.</p>
+
+ <p>"How! where! when!" said the others. "Why, poor nurse will
+ go stark, staring mad!"</p>
+
+ <p>By that time the poor woman had quitted her room, and walked
+ into the garden to see what had become of her little charges;
+ and, not directly missing Eliza from the group, which was then
+ fast approaching towards the house, she called out:</p>
+
+ <p>"Come, my dear children&mdash;come along! I thought you
+ would never have returned again." And, observing Eliza was
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page345" id="page345"></a>[pg
+ 345]</span> not with them, she continued: "But, Susan, what's
+ become of my sweet bird? Where's my little darling, Miss
+ Eliza?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, nurse! nurse!" said Sophia, "my sister's lost! indeed
+ she's lost!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Lost!" exclaimed the poor old woman&mdash;"lost! What do
+ you tell me? What do I hear? Oh, my master! my dear master!
+ never shall I bear to see his face again!"</p>
+
+ <p>Susan then repeated every circumstance just as has been
+ related, and with sighs and tears bewailed her own folly in
+ suffering herself to be over-persuaded. And the children
+ declared they dare not encounter their father's
+ displeasure.</p>
+
+ <p>The men servants were instantly summoned and sent on
+ horseback different ways. That she had been stolen admitted of
+ no doubt, as there was no water near the cottage; and had any
+ accident happened, they must have found her, as they had
+ searched every part of the village before they ventured to
+ return home.</p>
+
+ <p>One servant was sent to Rochester, another towards London,
+ and a third and fourth across the country roads; but no
+ intelligence could be obtained, nor the slightest information
+ gathered, by which the unfortunate child could be found, or her
+ wicked decoyer's footsteps traced.</p>
+
+ <p>When Mr. Darnley was apprised of the calamitous event, the
+ agitation of his mind may be easily conceived, but can never be
+ described.</p>
+
+ <p>Handbills were instantly circulated all over the country,
+ the child's person described, and a reward of five hundred
+ guineas offered for her restoration.</p>
+
+ <p>Sophia and Amanda were inconsolable, and Susan was ordered
+ to be discharged before Mr. Darnley returned home, which he did
+ not for more than a month after the melancholy circumstance
+ happened, as he was not satisfied with sending messengers in
+ pursuit of his lost treasure, but went himself to all those
+ wretched parts of London where poverty and vice are known to
+ dwell, in the hope of meeting the object of his solicitude, and
+ at length gave up the interesting pursuit, because he found his
+ health rendered him incapable of continuing it.</p>
+
+ <p>Nine tedious months passed away without any intelligence
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page346" id="page346"></a>[pg
+ 346]</span> of the lost Eliza; and time, which is a general
+ remedy for all misfortunes, had not softened the severity of
+ their affliction. Mrs. Collier had engaged a lady to be
+ governess to her nieces, as her attention had been wholly
+ devoted to her unfortunate brother, whose agitated state of
+ mind had produced a bodily complaint which demanded her
+ unremitting care and tenderness.</p>
+
+ <p>Although Emily loved Eliza with the fondest affection, yet
+ her grief was much less poignant than either of her sisters',
+ as she could not accuse herself with being accessory to her
+ loss.</p>
+
+ <p>"Never, never shall I forgive myself," Sophia would often
+ say, "for having deviated from my dear father's command! Oh, so
+ good and indulgent as he is to us, how wicked it was to
+ transgress his will! I was the eldest, and ought to have known
+ better, and my poor Eliza is the sufferer for my crime!"</p>
+
+ <p>Thus would she bewail her folly and imprudence, until,
+ agonized by the torture of her own reflections, she would sink
+ down in a chair quite exhausted, and burst into a flood of
+ tears.</p>
+
+ <p>While the family at Darnley Hall were thus a prey to
+ unavailing sorrow, the lovely little girl who had occasioned it
+ was beginning to grow more reconciled to the cruelty of her
+ destiny, and to support her different mode of life with
+ resignation and composure. She had acquired such a degree of
+ skill in the art of lacemaking (which was the business her
+ employer followed) as generally to be able to perform the tasks
+ which were allotted her; and if it so happened she was
+ incapable of doing it, Sally Butchell, a child almost two years
+ older than herself, of whom she was very fond, was always kind
+ enough to complete it for her.</p>
+
+ <p>The cottage in which the vile Mrs. Bullen resided was
+ situated about a quarter of a mile from High Wycombe; and
+ whenever she was obliged to go to that place, either to
+ purchase or to dispose of her goods, she always went either
+ before her family were up, or after they had retired to rest,
+ locking the door constantly after her, and putting the key in
+ her pocket, so that the poor little souls had no opportunity of
+ telling their misfortunes to any human creature.</p>
+
+ <p>One intense hot afternoon, in the month of August, as the
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page347" id="page347"></a>[pg
+ 347]</span> children were sitting hard at work with the door
+ open for the sake of air, an elderly lady and gentleman walked
+ up to it, and begged to be accommodated with a seat, informing
+ Mrs. Bullen their carriage had broken down a mile distant, and
+ they had been obliged to walk in the heat of the sun.</p>
+
+ <p>The appearance of so many children, all industriously
+ employed, was a sight particularly pleasing to the
+ liberal-minded Mrs. Montague, and she immediately began asking
+ the woman several questions about them; but there was something
+ of confusion in her manner of replying that called forth Mrs.
+ Montague's surprise and astonishment.</p>
+
+ <p>"They really are lovely children, my dear," said she,
+ turning to Mr. Montague, who had stood at the door watching the
+ approach of the carriage, which he perceived coming forward;
+ "and as to that little creature with the mole under her left
+ eye, I declare I think it is a perfect beauty."</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Montague turned his head, and regarded Eliza with a look
+ that at once proved that his sentiments corresponded with those
+ of his lady.</p>
+
+ <p>"What is your name, my love?" said he, in a tone of kindness
+ which poor Eliza had long been a stranger to.</p>
+
+ <p>The child colored like scarlet, and looked immediately at
+ her inhuman employer, who, catching the contagion, replied with
+ evident marks of confusion:</p>
+
+ <p>"Her name is Biddy Bullen, sir; she's my niece; but 'tis a
+ poor timid little fool, and is always in a fright when
+ gentlefolks happen to speak to her. Go, Biddy," she
+ continued&mdash;"go up into my bedroom, and mind that thread
+ which you'll find upon the reel."</p>
+
+ <p>"You should try to conquer that timidity," said Mr.
+ Montague, "by making her answer every stranger who speaks to
+ her; but by taking that office upon yourself, you absolutely
+ encourage the shyness you complain of. Come hither, my little
+ girl," continued he, observing she was retiring upstairs, "and
+ tell the lady what your name is."</p>
+
+ <p>Encouraged by the kindness of Mr. Montague's address, the
+ agitated child obeyed the summons, although Mrs. Bullen
+ attempted to force her into
+ resistance.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page348"
+ id="page348"></a>[pg 348]</span>
+
+ <p>"Well," continued the old gentleman, patting her on the
+ cheek, "and where did you get that pretty mole?"</p>
+
+ <p>"My mother gave it me, sir," replied the blushing child;
+ "but I did not see her do it, because Nurse Chapman told me she
+ went to heaven as soon as I was born."</p>
+
+ <p>"Your mother! And what was your mother's name?" said Mr.
+ Montague.</p>
+
+ <p>"Darnley, sir," said the child, and suddenly recollecting
+ the lesson that had been taught her&mdash;"but my name is Biddy
+ Bullen, and that is my aunt."</p>
+
+ <p>"Darnley!" exclaimed Mrs. Montague&mdash;"the very child
+ that has been for these twelve months past advertised in all
+ the papers"&mdash;then turning to convince herself of the
+ fact&mdash;"and the very mole confirms it."</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Montague immediately attempted to secure the woman, but
+ her activity eluded his grasp, and darting out at the back door
+ she was out of sight in a few moments.</p>
+
+ <p>"Is she really gone? Is she gone?" all the little voices at
+ once demanded, and upon Mr. Montague's assuring them she was
+ really gone for ever, their joy broke out in a thousand
+ different ways&mdash;some cried, some laughed, and others
+ jumped. In short, there never was a scene more completely
+ calculated to interest the feelings of a benevolent heart.</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Montague's carriage at this period arrived, and the
+ footman was desired to fetch a magistrate from Wycombe, while
+ the worthy clergyman resolved to remain there until his
+ arrival, and began questioning all the children. Two had been
+ there from so early a period that they could give no account of
+ their name or origin, but all the rest were so clear in their
+ description that the benevolent Mr. Montague had no doubt of
+ being able to restore them to their afflicted parents.</p>
+
+ <p>The magistrate soon arrived, attended by the worthy rector
+ of the place, who, hearing from Mr. Montague's servant that a
+ child had been stolen, came with the intent of offering his
+ services.</p>
+
+ <p>All but Eliza were immediately put under his protection, but
+ Mrs. Montague was so anxious she should be their earliest care
+ that she begged her husband to order a post-chaise directly,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page349" id="page349"></a>[pg
+ 349]</span> and set off immediately for town. This request was
+ willingly complied with, and by three o'clock the next
+ afternoon the party arrived at Darnley Hall.</p>
+
+ <p>Mrs. Collier was standing at the window when the carriage
+ stopped, and looking earnestly at her niece suddenly exclaimed
+ in a tone of rapture: "My child! My child! My lost Eliza!"</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Darnley, who was reading, sprang from his seat, and flew
+ to the door in a ecstasy of joy. In less than a minute he
+ returned folding his Eliza to his throbbing heart. The joyful
+ intelligence ran through the house, and the other children
+ impatiently flew to this scene of transport.</p>
+
+ <p>To describe their feelings or express their felicity would
+ require the aid of the most descriptive pen, and even then
+ would be but faintly told, and therefore had much better be
+ passed over.</p>
+
+ <p>From that moment the children all unanimously agreed
+ strictly to attend to their father's orders, and never in the
+ slightest instance act in opposition to his will.</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. and Mrs. Montague were laden with caresses, and
+ earnestly entreated to remain Mr. Darnley's guests. The
+ hospitable invitation would have been gladly accepted had not
+ the thoughts of the poor children who were still at Wycombe
+ seemed to claim his immediate attention, and so great was the
+ philanthropy of Mr. Montague's character that he could never
+ rest satisfied if a single duty remained unfulfilled.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page350"
+ id="page350"></a>[pg 350]</span>
+
+ <h3>DICKY RANDOM</h3>
+
+ <h4>OR GOOD NATURE IS NOTHING WITHOUT GOOD CONDUCT</h4><br />
+
+
+ <div class="poem">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p>"In festive play this maxim prize&mdash;</p>
+
+ <p>Be always merry&mdash;always WISE!"</p>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+
+ <p>"Do you know what hour it is when you see a clock?" said Mr.
+ Random to his little son Richard.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, father," said Richard; "for I can count it all round.
+ When both hands are at the top of the clock, then I know it is
+ time to leave school."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then go and see what time it is," said his father.</p>
+
+ <p>Away ran Richard, and brought back word in a moment that it
+ was exactly six o'clock.</p>
+
+ <p>In a few minutes after came in a friend with a young lady,
+ the former of whom asked Mr. Random why he was not ready to go
+ with them to the concert that evening, as he had promised. Mr.
+ Random replied that it was but six o'clock, which, however, he
+ was soon convinced was a mistake of Richard's, who, on being
+ asked what he saw when he looked on the clock, replied, "I saw
+ the two hands together close to the six, and that made me say
+ it was six, for I always call it twelve when they are right
+ opposite."</p>
+
+ <p>"Remember, my dear," said his father, "that the long hand
+ never tells the hour, except on the stroke of twelve. You ought
+ to know that the minute hand overtakes its fellow somewhat
+ later every hour, till at noon and midnight they again start
+ exactly even; and when a bigger boy I shall expect you to tell
+ me how much difference is increased every time they come into
+ conjunction. You now see, Dicky, that through such a mistake I
+ must make my friends wait; pray, therefore, mind better another
+ time."</p>
+
+ <p>In a few minutes after his father bid him go into the
+ dining-room, and bring down a bottle of wine, which stood in
+ the <span class="pagenum"><a name="page351"
+ id="page351"></a>[pg 351]</span> <i>hither</i> corner of the
+ cellaret, that he might help the gentleman, and lady to a
+ glass.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, father," said little Dick, and up he went. On the
+ stairs he met puss, and stopped to play with her, during which
+ he forgot what had been told him. Having gotten a bottle,
+ downstairs he came, and, pouring out a couple of glasses, he
+ returned with it. But, when on the landing-place, he naughtily
+ drew out the cork to have a taste himself. It was not only very
+ vulgar to drink out of the neck of a bottle, but wrong to make
+ free slily with that which he was merely entrusted to serve
+ out. However, it rushed so fast into his mouth, and was so hot,
+ that he was afraid of being strangled. It happened that he had
+ bitten his cheek that morning, and the liquor bathing the sore
+ place made it smart so that he put down the bottle on the
+ floor, when, in stamping about, it rolled downstairs and made a
+ fine clatter. His father ran out on hearing the noise, but was
+ stopped in the way by seeing the young lady almost gasping for
+ breath, and it was some minutes before she could say that he
+ had given her brandy instead of wine.</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Random next proceeded upstairs, where little Dick was
+ picking up the pieces of broken glass, in doing which he cut a
+ deep gash in his hand.</p>
+
+ <p>"Where did you take the bottle from?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Out of the <i>farther</i> side of the cellaret," said
+ Dicky.</p>
+
+ <p>"I told you to take it from the <i>hither</i> side," replied
+ Mr. Random. "But, however, you shall smart for your neglect:
+ what remains of the brandy will serve to bathe your hand, and I
+ hope the pain will make you reflect that the loss is the same
+ to me, whether you spilt it from design or inattention."</p>
+
+ <p>He one day made his mother look very simple at table, for
+ which he deserved to have suffered much more than her good
+ nature required. Young Random was to have a grand rout in the
+ evening with some of his little favorites. A few nice tarts,
+ custards, etc., had been made in the morning for the occasion,
+ and had been most temptingly baked in the forenoon.</p>
+
+ <p>It happened that two gentlemen called on Mr. Random about
+ two o'clock, and he insisted upon their staying to dinner;
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page352" id="page352"></a>[pg
+ 352]</span> in consequence of which his lady had the pastry
+ removed from the side board to the china-closet.</p>
+
+ <p>All children must frequently have heard their mothers say,
+ when they wish to have anything saved for another occasion, "My
+ friends, you see your dinner before you; I hope you will
+ consider yourselves at home and not spare." This is always
+ thought to be a sufficient excuse for not bringing anything of
+ another sort to table.</p>
+
+ <p>When the meat was nearly done with, Mrs. Random made the
+ above remark to her visitors, who declared that nothing more
+ was requisite. She then bid the servant put the cheese on the
+ table.</p>
+
+ <p>"What, mother," said Richard, "is there nothing else?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, my love," said his mother; "I am sure you want nothing
+ more."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, yes, mother. Where are the tarts and custards you put
+ into the closet?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Surely you dream?" said his mother.</p>
+
+ <p>"No, I don't indeed," replied Dicky. "You put them away
+ directly the gentlemen said they would stay to dine, and
+ observed what a deal of trouble visitors do give."</p>
+
+ <p>Any one will easily believe that this made Mrs. Random look
+ very confused. She hardly knew what to reply, but she turned it
+ off in the best manner she could, and said:</p>
+
+ <p>"It is you, Richard, who trouble me more than the visits of
+ my friends. I am happy to see them always, but on some days
+ more than others. To-day, you know, we have been preparing for
+ <i>your</i> company, and therefore the reserve I have kept
+ would not have been made but on your account. The pastry was
+ intended for <i>your</i> visitors, and not your father's.
+ However, if you are such a child that you cannot wait till
+ night, they shall be brought to table now; but, remember, I
+ will not order any more to be made, and you shall provide for
+ your playmates out of the money put by to purchase the
+ magic-lantern and the books."</p>
+
+ <p>Richard looked quite down when he heard this sentence, and
+ more so when he saw the pastry placed on the table.</p>
+
+ <p>Dear me, how soon had the tarts and custards disappeared,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page353" id="page353"></a>[pg
+ 353]</span> if one of each had been served round to the
+ company! But the gentlemen were too polite even to taste them,
+ and father and mother declined eating any. Richard's sister
+ said she could very well wait till supper; hence they were all
+ saved. But Dicky was afterwards very severely taken to task for
+ speaking out of time, when he was not spoken to.</p>
+
+ <p>When evening came, and the little visitors were assembled,
+ Richard, who had seen some of the sports at a country fair,
+ would show his dexterity to amuse his young party. He took up
+ the poker, and, supposing it to be a pole, performed some
+ imitations. But, unable long to preserve it upright from its
+ weight, the sooty end fell on Master Snapper's book, who was
+ reading a little work upon "Affability." The blow fairly
+ knocked it out of his hand, and made a great smear on his
+ frilled shirt, at which a loud laugh ensued. Now Master Snapper
+ could not bear to be laughed at, and was so much out of humor
+ all the evening that he would not play.</p>
+
+ <p>Little Dick never once, all this time, thought that if it
+ had fallen on his playfellow's toe, it might have lamed him,
+ and he would at least have had to carry him a pick-a-back home;
+ nor did he think who was to have paid the doctor; but, pleased
+ with the mirth he had made, he went upstairs and fetched down
+ one of the pistols, which his father kept in a private drawer.
+ Then, pulling in his rocking-horse, he fancied he was one of
+ the Light Horse, and mounted it to show the sword exercise, and
+ how he could shoot a Frenchman or a Turk at full gallop. He had
+ no business with a rocking-horse or a pistol among young
+ ladies, but he never thought if it were proper or not, and much
+ less if the pistol were loaded.</p>
+
+ <p>While he was going on a full canter, he gave the words,
+ "Present! fire!" and off it went, knocked him backwards, and
+ shivered a beautiful mirror into a thousand pieces. Oh, what a
+ sad scene of confusion ensued! Some of the young ladies
+ screamed out with fright. Miss Timid, knocked down by Dicky in
+ falling backwards, lay on the ground bleeding at the nose. Some
+ were employed in picking up the pieces of glass, or pinning
+ their handkerchiefs over the fracture, to prevent its being
+ seen while they stayed; but such a hope was
+ vain.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page354"
+ id="page354"></a>[pg 354]</span>
+
+ <p>The noise brought Mr. and Mrs. Random and all the servants
+ upstairs, who too soon found out the havoc that had been made,
+ and demanded how it happened. All the children would willingly
+ have screened Dicky, because they knew he had not done it to
+ frighten, but to amuse them. Master Snapper, however, now
+ thinking it was his turn, in a very ill-natured speech made the
+ worst of the story. But the spiteful way in which he spoke did
+ little Dick no harm, as he seemed more rejoiced at his
+ misfortune than sorry for Mr. Random's loss; hence it had the
+ effect not to increase the latter's anger.</p>
+
+ <p>"Playing with balancing poles and pistols," said Mr. Random
+ in a stern accent to his son, "is very well in a proper place,
+ but quite inadmissible in a room full of company. Now, sir,
+ what business had you to take this pistol out of my room?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Indeed, father," said Dicky, crying, "I did not know it was
+ loaded."</p>
+
+ <p>"It is but last week," continued his father, "that you were
+ told never to take such a thing without asking, and not even
+ then till some one had tried if it were loaded. So many
+ accidents have happened with firearms which have been supposed
+ not to be loaded, that he who unguardedly shoots another ought
+ to take a similar chance for his own life; for you know the
+ Scripture says: 'An eye for an eye, and a tooth for a tooth.'
+ Think, Richard, that if I had been standing before the mirror,
+ what would have been the consequence. You would have shot your
+ father! Your mother would have died of grief, and you and
+ Letitia have been orphans!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Ah, then I should have died too!" said Dicky, wiping the
+ tears from his eyes with the back of his hand. "But how came
+ you to load the pistol last night, father?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Because," replied his father, "I thought I heard something
+ fall in the parlor, and the passage-door being directly after
+ shut to in a still manner. I loaded the pistols, thinking that
+ thieves had broken into the house, and pushed up the sash to
+ shoot the first that came out."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then it was lucky," said Richard, "I did not come out
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page355" id="page355"></a>[pg
+ 355]</span> again, or you might have killed me; for I got up in
+ the night to let Juno out of the shed, where I had tied her up,
+ and she was making a sad howling. Indeed, before I was aware,
+ she ran into the parlor, and, as it was quite dark, I tumbled
+ over her."</p>
+
+ <p>"And broke the geranium tree," added his father.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, I did indeed," said Dicky, "but I did not go to do it.
+ After that I turned Juno into the yard, and this I dare say is
+ all the noise you heard."</p>
+
+ <p>"There is an old saying, my dear little friends," said Mr.
+ Random, "which I wish you to attend to, because it has a great
+ deal of truth in it: '<i>The pitcher that goes often safe to
+ the well may come home broken at last</i>.' And so, though the
+ thoughtless and giddy may go on for a long while without
+ danger, it will overtake them sooner or later. Here is a strong
+ instance of escape from the consequences which might have
+ attended Richard's thoughtlessness; besides which, his mother
+ could get no more sleep all night, and I, after running the
+ risk of catching cold in searching over the house, have this
+ morning been at the expense of new fastenings to the doors and
+ windows. The next time, however, you rise, Richard, to alarm
+ the family, you shall in future roost with the hens or bed in
+ the stable."</p>
+
+ <p>Dicky now thought that his parent's resentment had subsided,
+ and, upon the latter's calling to him to come, he sprang across
+ the room with the greatest alertness; but how suddenly was his
+ smile cast down when Mr, Random, taking his hand, ordered him
+ to wish his young friends much mirth and a good appetite, while
+ he was going to be punished for his misconduct. At once were
+ all their little hands put out to prevent Mr. Random's
+ resolution of taking him away, but all their petitions were in
+ vain. Richard was forced into an empty cellar, and left with no
+ other companion than a glimmering rushlight. Here he was told
+ he might do as much mischief as he pleased. The iron bars kept
+ him from getting out on one side, and the door was padlocked on
+ the other. In this dilemma he marched round and round, crying,
+ with his little candle, and saw stuck on the walls the
+ following lines:</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page356"
+ id="page356"></a>[pg 356]</span>
+
+ <div class="poem">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p>"Empty caves and commons wild</p>
+
+ <p>Best befit a thoughtless child,</p>
+
+ <p>A solid wall, an earthen floor,</p>
+
+ <p>Prison lights, a padlock'd door,</p>
+
+ <p>Where's no plaything which he may</p>
+
+ <p>Turn to harm by random play,</p>
+
+ <p>For in such sport too oft is found</p>
+
+ <p>A penny-toy will cost a pound.</p>
+
+ <p>Be wise and merry;&mdash;-play, but think;</p>
+
+ <p>For danger stands on folly's brink."</p>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+
+ <p>After having been kept in confinement nearly half an hour,
+ Mr. Random could no longer resist the pressing solicitations of
+ his son's guests, who declined partaking of the supper till
+ Richard was returned to them.</p>
+
+ <p>Having learned the above lines by heart, he repeated them to
+ his young company, and, on his promising to remember their
+ contents, he was permitted to sit down to table.</p>
+
+ <p>The rest of the evening was spent in innocent cheerfulness,
+ and for some time after little Random played with more
+ caution.</p>
+
+ <p>We must omit many of the less important neglects of young
+ Random, such as letting the toast fall in handling it, shooting
+ his arrow through the window, riding a long stick where it
+ might throw persons down, leaving things in the way at dark,
+ etc., and proceed to relate a good-natured fancy of his which
+ tended more than any of the preceding events, to show him the
+ folly of taking any step without first looking to what it might
+ lead.</p>
+
+ <p>In Mr. Random's garden was a fine tall pear-tree, and that
+ year a very fine pear grew on the topmost twig. His mother and
+ sister had several times wished for the luscious fruit, but it
+ seemed to bid defiance to every attack that was not aided by a
+ tall ladder. "Oh!" thought Dicky, "if I can get it down and
+ present it to my mother, how pleased she will be!" So, when he
+ was alone, he picked out some large stones and threw at it, but
+ without any success. The next day he renewed his attack in the
+ evening, and to insure a better chance employed several large
+ pieces of brick and tile.</p>
+
+ <p>Now all these dangerous weapons went over into a poor man's
+ garden, where his son and some other boys were weeding
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page357" id="page357"></a>[pg
+ 357]</span> it. One of them fell upon the little fellow's leg,
+ and cut it in so desperate a manner that he cried out, quite
+ terrified at the blow and sight of the blood. The other boys
+ directly took the alarm, and picking up some stones as large as
+ that which had done the mischief, they mounted on a high bench,
+ and discharged such a well-directed volley at the person of
+ Master Random that he was most violently struck upon the nose,
+ and knocked backwards into a glass cucumber-frame.</p>
+
+ <p>Here he lay in a most pitiable condition, calling upon his
+ mother, while the wounded boy on the other side joined in the
+ concert of woe.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, it served you rightly!" exclaimed the young assailants,
+ who were looking over the wall, and ran away as soon as they
+ saw Mr. Random come into the garden to inquire the cause of the
+ uproar.</p>
+
+ <p>His first concern was to carry Dicky indoors, and then,
+ having wiped away the blood and tears, he asked him how it
+ happened.</p>
+
+ <p>"I was only trying to get a pear for my mother," said
+ Richard, "when these boys threw stones at me, and hit me!"</p>
+
+ <p>"That was very cruel," said his father, "to meddle with you
+ when you were doing nothing to them, and if I can find them out
+ they shall be punished for it."</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Random immediately set off to the next house, but was
+ met at his own door by the father of the wounded boy, who was
+ coming with him in his arms to demand satisfaction. This
+ brought the whole truth out, and the artful little fellow was
+ found to have concealed a part of the real case. Instead of
+ saying "he was only getting a pear," he should have said that
+ he was throwing large stones at the topmost pear on the tree,
+ and that every stone went over the wall, he could not tell
+ where.</p>
+
+ <p>"Ah, Richard," said his father, "it is little better than
+ story-telling to conceal a part of the truth. The affair now
+ wears quite a new face. It was you that gave the first assault,
+ and will have to answer for all the bad consequences. It is my
+ duty to see that this unoffending boy is taken care of; but if
+ his leg be so cut or bruised that he cannot get so good a
+ living when he comes to be a man as he might otherwise have
+ done, <span class="pagenum"><a name="page358"
+ id="page358"></a>[pg 358]</span> how would you like to make up
+ the deficiency? You cannot doubt that he has a demand upon you
+ equal to the damage you may have done to him. He is poor, and
+ his father must send him to the hospital, but it would be
+ unjust of me to suffer it. No, on the contrary, I shall prevent
+ this by taking him home and sending you there, where Dr.
+ Hardheart makes his patients smart before he cures them. Come,
+ get ready to go, for delays in wounds of the head are not to be
+ trifled with."</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Random then ordered the servant to go for a coach, in
+ which Dicky most certainly would have been sent off had not
+ word been brought back that there was not a coach on the stand.
+ During this time Dicky had fallen on his knees, entreating that
+ he might remain at home, and offering promises to be less
+ heedless in future; nay, he was willing to yield up all his
+ toys to the maimed little gardener.</p>
+
+ <p>The boy's father, though but a laboring man, had a generous
+ mind; he wanted nothing of this kind, but only wished him to be
+ more cautious in future, as the same stones, thrown at random,
+ might have either blinded his son or fractured his skull,
+ instead of merely hurting his leg. Mr. Random then insisted on
+ Richard's giving him half-a-crown, and asking pardon for the
+ misfortune occasioned by his carelessness.</p>
+
+ <p>This heavy sum was directly taken out of the hoard which had
+ been laid by for the purchase of a set of drawing instruments,
+ but he had a yet heavier account to settle with his father for
+ damaging the cucumber-frame. He had broken as much of it as
+ would come to fifteen shillings to mend, and as payment was
+ insisted on, or close confinement until the whole was settled,
+ he was compelled to transfer to his father all his receipts for
+ the ensuing five months before he could again resume his scheme
+ of laying by an adequate sum to purchase the drawing utensils.
+ Independently of which he always carried a strong memorial of
+ his folly on his nose, which was so scarred that he endured
+ many a joke, as it were, to keep alive in his memory the effect
+ of his folly. Indeed, he never looked in the glass without
+ seeing his reproach in his face, and thus at length learned
+ never to play without first thinking if it were at a proper
+ time and in a proper place.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page359"
+ id="page359"></a>[pg 359]</span>
+
+ <h3>EMBELLISHMENT</h3>
+
+ <h3>By JACOB ABBOTT</h3>
+
+ <p>One day Beechnut, who had been ill, was taken by Phonny and
+ Madeline for a drive. When Phonny and Madeline found themselves
+ riding quietly along in the wagon in Beechnut's company, the
+ first thought which occurred to them, after the interest and
+ excitement awakened by the setting out had passed in some
+ measure away, was that they would ask him to tell them a story.
+ This was a request which they almost always made in similar
+ circumstances. In all their rides and rambles Beechnut's
+ stories were an unfailing resource, furnishing them with an
+ inexhaustible fund of amusement sometimes, and sometimes of
+ instruction.</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," said Beechnut, in answer to their request, "I will
+ tell you now about my voyage across the Atlantic Ocean."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," exclaimed Madeline, "I should like to hear about that
+ very much indeed."</p>
+
+ <p>"Shall I tell the story to you just as it was," asked
+ Beechnut, "as a sober matter of fact, or shall I embellish it a
+ little?"</p>
+
+ <p>"I don't know what you mean by embellishing it," said
+ Madeline.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, not telling exactly what is true," said Beechnut, "but
+ inventing something to add to it, to make it interesting."</p>
+
+ <p>"I want to have it true," said Madeline, "and interesting,
+ too."</p>
+
+ <p>"But sometimes," replied Beechnut, "interesting things don't
+ happen, and in such cases, if we should only relate what
+ actually does happen, the story would be likely to be
+ dull."</p>
+
+ <p>"I think you had better embellish the story a little," said
+ Phonny&mdash;"just a <i>little</i>, you know."</p>
+
+ <p>"I don't think I can do that very well," replied Beechnut.
+ "If I attempt to relate the actual acts, I depend simply on my
+ memory, and I can confine myself to what my memory teaches;
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page360" id="page360"></a>[pg
+ 360]</span> but if I undertake to follow my invention, I must
+ go wherever it leads me."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," said Phonny, "I think you had better embellish the
+ story, at any rate, for I want it to be interesting."</p>
+
+ <p>"So do I," said Madeline.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then," said Beechnut, "I will give you an embellished
+ account of my voyage across the Atlantic. But, in the first
+ place, I must tell you how it happened that my father decided
+ to leave Paris and come to America. It was mainly on my
+ account. My father was well enough contented with his situation
+ so far as he himself was concerned, and he was able to save a
+ large part of his salary, so as to lay up a considerable sum of
+ money every year; but he was anxious about me.</p>
+
+ <p>"There seemed to be nothing," continued Beechnut, "for me to
+ do, and nothing desirable for me to look forward to, when I
+ should become a man. My father thought, therefore, that, though
+ it would perhaps be better for <i>him</i> to remain in France,
+ It would probably be better for <i>me</i> if he should come to
+ America, where he said people might rise in the world,
+ according to their talents, thrift, and industry. He was sure,
+ he said, that I should rise, for, you must understand, he
+ considered me an extraordinary boy."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," said Phonny, "<i>I</i> think you were an
+ extraordinary boy."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, but my father thought," rejoined Beechnut, "that I was
+ something very extraordinary indeed. He thought I was a
+ genius."</p>
+
+ <p>"So do I," said Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"He said," continued Beechnut, "he thought it would in the
+ end be a great deal better for him to come to America, where I
+ might become a man of some consequence in the world, and he
+ said that he should enjoy his own old age a great deal better,
+ even in a strange land, if he could see me going on
+ prosperously in life, than to remain all his days in that
+ porter's lodge.</p>
+
+ <p>"All the money that my father had saved," Beechnut
+ continued, "he got changed into gold at an office in the
+ Bouleyard; <span class="pagenum"><a name="page361"
+ id="page361"></a>[pg 361]</span> but then he was very much
+ perplexed to decide how it was best to carry it."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why did he not pack it up in his chest?" asked Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"He was afraid," replied Beechnut, "that his chest might be
+ broken open, or unlocked by false keys, on the voyage, and that
+ the money might be thus stolen away; so he thought that he
+ would try to hide it somewhere in some small thing that he
+ could keep with him all the voyage."</p>
+
+ <p>"Could not he keep his chest with him all the voyage?" asked
+ Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"No," said Beechnut; "the chests, and all large parcels of
+ baggage belonging to the passengers, must be sent down into the
+ hold of the ship out of the way. It is only a very little
+ baggage that the people are allowed to keep with them between
+ the decks. My father wished very much to keep his gold with
+ him, and yet he was afraid to keep it in a bag, or in any other
+ similar package, in his little trunk, for then whoever saw it
+ would know that it was gold, and so perhaps form some plan to
+ rob him of it.</p>
+
+ <p>"While we were considering what plan it would be best to
+ adopt for the gold, Arielle, who was the daughter of a friend
+ of ours, proposed to hide it in my <i>top</i>. I had a very
+ large top which my father had made for me. It was painted
+ yellow outside, with four stripes of bright blue passing down
+ over it from the stem to the point. When the top was in motion,
+ both the yellow ground and the blue stripes entirely
+ disappeared, and the top appeared to be of a uniform green
+ color. Then, when it came to its rest again, the original
+ colors would reappear."</p>
+
+ <p>"How curious!" said Madeline. "Why would it do so?" "Why,
+ when it was revolving," said Beechnut, "the yellow and the blue
+ were blended together in the eye, and that made green. Yellow
+ and blue always make green. Arielle colored my top, after my
+ father had made it, and then my father varnished it over the
+ colors, and that fixed them.</p>
+
+ <p>"This top of mine was a monstrous large one, and being
+ hollow, Arielle thought that the gold could all be put inside.
+ She said she thought that that would be a very safe
+ hiding-place, <span class="pagenum"><a name="page362"
+ id="page362"></a>[pg 362]</span> too, since nobody would think
+ of looking into a top for gold. But my father said that he
+ thought that the space would not be quite large enough, and
+ then if anybody should happen to see the top, and should touch
+ it, the weight of it would immediately reveal the secret.</p>
+
+ <p>"At last my father thought of a plan which he believed would
+ answer the purpose very perfectly. We had a very curious old
+ clock. It was made by my grandfather, who was a clockmaker in
+ Geneva. There was a little door in the face of the clock, and
+ whenever the time came for striking the hours, this door would
+ open, and a little platform would come out with a tree upon it.
+ There was a beautiful little bird upon the tree, and when the
+ clock had done striking, the bird would flap its wings and
+ sing. Then the platform would slide back into its place, the
+ door would shut, and the clock go on ticking quietly for
+ another hour.</p>
+
+ <p>"This clock was made to go," continued Beechnut, "as many
+ other clocks are, by two heavy weights, which were hung to the
+ wheel-work by strong cords. The cords were wound round some of
+ the wheels, and as they slowly descended by their weight, they
+ made the wheels go round. There was a contrivance inside the
+ clock to make the wheels go slowly and regularly, and not spin
+ round too fast, as they would have done if the weights had been
+ left to themselves. This is the way that clocks are often
+ made.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now, my father," continued Beechnut, "had intended to take
+ this old family clock with him to America, and he now conceived
+ the idea of hiding his treasure in the weights. The weights
+ were formed of two round tin canisters filled with something
+ very heavy. My father said he did not know whether it was shot
+ or sand. He unsoldered the bottom from these canisters, and
+ found that the filling was shot. He poured out the shot, put
+ his gold pieces in in place of it, and then filled up all the
+ interstices between and around the gold pieces with sand, to
+ prevent the money from jingling. Then he soldered the bottom of
+ the canisters on again, and no one would have known that the
+ weights were anything more than ordinary clock-weights. He then
+ packed the clock in a box, and put
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page363" id="page363"></a>[pg
+ 363]</span> the box in his trunk. It did not take up a great
+ deal of room, for he did not take the case of the clock, but
+ only the face and the works and the two weights, which last he
+ packed carefully and securely in the box, one on each side of
+ the clock itself.</p>
+
+ <p>"When we got to Havre, all our baggage was examined at the
+ Custom House, and the officers allowed it all to pass. When
+ they came to the clock, my father showed them the little door
+ and the bird inside, and they said it was very curious. They
+ did not pay any attention to the weights at all.</p>
+
+ <p>"When we went on board of the vessel our chests were put by
+ the side of an immense heap of baggage upon the deck, where
+ some seamen were at work lowering it down into the hold through
+ a square opening in the deck of the ship. As for the trunk, my
+ father took that with him to the place where he was going to be
+ himself during the voyage. This place was called the steerage.
+ It was crowded full of men, women, and children, all going to
+ America. Some talked French, some German, some Dutch, and there
+ were ever so many babies that were too little to talk at all.
+ Pretty soon the vessel sailed.</p>
+
+ <p>"We did not meet with anything remarkable on the voyage,
+ except that once we saw an iceberg."</p>
+
+ <p>"What is that?" asked Madeline.</p>
+
+ <p>"It is a great mountain of ice," replied Beechnut, "floating
+ about in the sea on the top of the water. I don't know how it
+ comes to be there."</p>
+
+ <p>"I should not think it would float upon the top of the
+ water," said Phonny. "All the ice that I ever saw in the water
+ sinks into it."</p>
+
+ <p>"It does not sink to the bottom," said Madeline.</p>
+
+ <p>"No," replied Phonny, "but it sinks down until the top of
+ the ice is just level with the water. But Beechnut says that
+ his iceberg rose up like a mountain."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Beechnut, "it was several hundred feet high
+ above the water, all glittering in the sun. And I think that if
+ you look at any small piece of ice floating in the water, you
+ will see that a small part of it rises above the surface."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Phenny, "a very little."</p>
+
+ <p>"It is a certain proportion of the whole mass," rejoined
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page364" id="page364"></a>[pg
+ 364]</span> Beechnut. "They told us on board our vessel that
+ about one-tenth part of the iceberg was above the water; the
+ rest&mdash;that is, nine-tenths&mdash;was under it; so you see
+ what an enormous big piece of ice it must have been to have
+ only one-tenth part of it tower up so high.</p>
+
+ <p>"There was one thing very curious and beautiful about our
+ iceberg," said Beechnut. "We came in sight of it one day about
+ sunset, just after a shower. The cloud, which was very large
+ and black, had passed off into the west, and there was a
+ splendid rainbow upon it. It happened, too, that when we were
+ nearest to the iceberg it lay toward the west, and, of course,
+ toward the cloud, and it appeared directly under the rainbow,
+ and the iceberg and the rainbow made a most magnificent
+ spectacle. The iceberg, which was very bright and dazzling in
+ the evening sun, looked like an enormous diamond, with the
+ rainbow for the setting."</p>
+
+ <p>"How curious!" said Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Beechnut, "and to make it more remarkable still,
+ a whale just then came along directly before the iceberg, and
+ spouted there two or three times; and as the sun shone very
+ brilliantly upon the jet of water which the whale threw into
+ the air, it made a sort of silver rainbow below in the center
+ of the picture."</p>
+
+ <p>"How beautiful it must have been!" said Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," rejoined Beechnut, "very beautiful indeed. We saw a
+ great many beautiful spectacles on the sea; but then, on the
+ other hand, we saw some that were dreadful.</p>
+
+ <p>"Did you?" asked Phonny. "What?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, we had a terrible storm and shipwreck at the end,"
+ said Beechnut. "For three days and three nights the wind blew
+ almost a hurricane. They took in all the sails, and let the
+ ship drive before the gale under bare poles. She went on over
+ the seas for five hundred miles, howling all the way like a
+ frightened dog."</p>
+
+ <p>"Were you frightened?" asked Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Beechnut. "When the storm first came on, several
+ of the passengers came up the hatchways and got up on the deck
+ to see it; and then we could not get down again,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page365" id="page365"></a>[pg
+ 365]</span> for the ship gave a sudden pitch just after we came
+ up, and knocked away the step-ladder. We were terribly
+ frightened. The seas were breaking over the forecastle and
+ sweeping along the decks, and the shouts and outcries of the
+ captain and the sailors made a dreadful din. At last they put
+ the step-ladder in its place again, and we got down. Then they
+ put the hatches on, and we could not come out any more."</p>
+
+ <p>"The hatches?" said Phonny. "What are they?"</p>
+
+ <p>"The hatches," replied Beechnut, "are a sort of
+ scuttle-doors that cover over the square openings in the deck
+ of a ship. They always have to put them on and fasten them down
+ in a great storm."</p>
+
+ <p>Just at this time the party happened to arrive at a place
+ where two roads met, and as there was a broad and level space
+ of ground at the junction, where it would be easy to turn the
+ wagon, Beechnut said that he thought it would be better to make
+ that the end of their ride, and so turn round and go home.
+ Phonny and Madeline were quite desirous of going a little
+ farther, but Beechnut thought that he should be tired by the
+ time he reached the house again.</p>
+
+ <p>"But you will not have time to finish the story," said
+ Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," replied Beechnut; "there is very little more to tell.
+ It is only to give an account of our shipwreck."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, did you have a shipwreck?" exclaimed Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Beechnut. "When you have turned the wagon, I
+ will tell you about it."</p>
+
+ <p>So Phonny, taking a great sweep, turned the wagon round, and
+ the party set their faces toward home. The Marshal was
+ immediately going to set out upon a trot, but Phonny held him
+ back by pulling upon the reins and saying:</p>
+
+ <p>"Steady, Marshal! steady! You have got to walk all the way
+ home."</p>
+
+ <p>"The storm drove us upon the Nova Scotia coast," said
+ Beechnut, resuming his story. "We did not know anything about
+ the great danger that we were in until just before the ship
+ went ashore. When we got near the shore the sailors put down
+ all the anchors; but they would not hold, and at length the
+ ship struck. Then there followed a dreadful scene of
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page366" id="page366"></a>[pg
+ 366]</span> consternation and confusion. Some jumped into the
+ sea in their terror, and were drowned. Some cried and screamed,
+ and acted as if they were insane. Some were calm, and behaved
+ rationally. The sailors opened the hatches and let the
+ passengers come up, and we got into the most sheltered places
+ that we could find about the decks and rigging, and tied
+ ourselves to whatever was nearest at hand. My father opened his
+ trunk and took out his two clock-weights, and gave me one of
+ them; the other he kept himself. He told me that we might as
+ well try to save them, though he did not suppose that we should
+ be able to do so.</p>
+
+ <p>"Pretty soon after we struck the storm seemed to abate a
+ little. The people of the country came down to the shore and
+ stood upon the rocks to see if they could do anything to save
+ us. We were very near the shore, but the breakers and the
+ boiling surf were so violent between us and the land that
+ whoever took to the water was sure to be dashed in pieces. So
+ everybody clung to the ship, waiting for the captain to
+ contrive some way to get us to the shore."</p>
+
+ <p>"And what did he do?" asked Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"He first got a long line and a cask, and he fastened the
+ end of the long line to the cask, and then threw the cask
+ overboard. The other end of the line was kept on board the
+ ship. The cask was tossed about upon the waves, every
+ successive surge driving it in nearer and nearer to the shore,
+ until at last it was thrown up high upon the rocks. The men
+ upon the shore ran to seize it, but before they could get hold
+ of it the receding wave carried it back again among the
+ breakers, where it was tossed about as if it had been a
+ feather, and overwhelmed with the spray. Presently away it went
+ again up upon the shore, and the men again attempted to seize
+ it. This was repeated two or three times. At last they
+ succeeded in grasping hold of it, and they ran up with it upon
+ the rocks, out of the reach of the seas.</p>
+
+ <p>"The captain then made signs to the men to pull the line in
+ toward the shore. He was obliged to use signs, because the
+ roaring and thundering of the seas made such a noise that
+ nothing could be heard. The sailors had before this, under
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page367" id="page367"></a>[pg
+ 367]</span> the captain's direction, fastened a much stronger
+ line&mdash;a small cable, in fact&mdash;to the end of the line
+ which had been attached to the barrel. Thus, by pulling upon
+ the smaller line, the men drew one end of the cable to the
+ shore. The other end remained on board the ship, while the
+ middle of it lay tossing among the breakers between the ship
+ and the shore.</p>
+
+ <p>"The seamen then carried that part of the cable which was on
+ shipboard up to the masthead, while the men on shore made their
+ end fast to a very strong post which they set in the ground.
+ The seamen drew the cable as tight as they could, and fastened
+ their end very strongly to the masthead. Thus the line of the
+ cable passed in a gentle slope from the top of the mast to the
+ land, high above all the surges and spray. The captain then
+ rigged what he called a sling, which was a sort of loop of
+ ropes that a person could be put into and made to slide down in
+ it on the cable to the shore. A great many of the passengers
+ were afraid to go in this way, but they were still more afraid
+ to remain on board the ship."</p>
+
+ <p>"What were they afraid of?" asked Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"They were afraid," replied Beechnut, "that the shocks of
+ the seas would soon break the ship to pieces, and then they
+ would all be thrown into the sea together. In this case they
+ would certainly be destroyed, for if they were not drowned,
+ they would be dashed to pieces on the rocks which lined the
+ shore.</p>
+
+ <p>"Sliding down the line seemed thus a very dangerous attempt,
+ but they consented one after another to make the trial, and
+ thus we all escaped safe to land."</p>
+
+ <p>"And did you get the clock-weights safe to the shore?" asked
+ Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," replied Beechnut, "and as soon as we landed we hid
+ them in the sand. My father took me to a little cove close by,
+ where there was not much surf, as the place was protected by a
+ rocky point of land which bounded it on one side. Behind this
+ point of land the waves rolled up quietly upon a sandy beach.
+ My father went down upon the slope of this beach, to a place a
+ little below where the highest waves came, and began to dig a
+ hole in the sand. He called me to come and help him. The waves
+ impeded our work a little, but we
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page368" id="page368"></a>[pg
+ 368]</span> persevered until we had dug a hole about a foot
+ deep. We put our clock-weights into this hole and covered them
+ over. We then ran back up upon the beach. The waves that came
+ up every moment over the place soon smoothed the surface of the
+ sand again, and made it look as if nothing had been done there.
+ My father measured the distance from the place where he had
+ deposited his treasure up to a certain great white rock upon
+ the shore exactly opposite to it, so as to be able to find the
+ place again, and then we went back to our company. They were
+ collected on the rocks in little groups, wet and tired, and in
+ great confusion, but rejoiced at having escaped with their
+ lives. Some of the last of the sailors were then coming over in
+ the sling. The captain himself came last of all.</p>
+
+ <p>"There were some huts near the place on the shore, where the
+ men made good fires, and we warmed and dried ourselves. The
+ storm abated a great deal in a few hours, and the tide went
+ down, so that we could go off to the ship before night to get
+ some provisions. The next morning the men could work at the
+ ship very easily, and they brought all the passengers' baggage
+ on shore. My father got his trunk with the clock in it. A day
+ or two afterward some sloops came to the place, and took us all
+ away to carry us to Quebec. Just before we embarked on board
+ the sloops, my father and I, watching a good opportunity, dug
+ up our weights out of the sand, and put them back safely in
+ their places in the clock-box."</p>
+
+ <p>"Is that the end?" asked Phonny, when Beechnut paused.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," replied Beechnut, "I believe I had better make that
+ the end."</p>
+
+ <p>"I think it is a very interesting and well-told story," said
+ Madeline. "And do you feel very tired?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No," said Beechnut. "On the contrary, I feel all the better
+ for my ride. I believe I will sit up a little while."</p>
+
+ <p>So saying, he raised himself in the wagon and sat up, and
+ began to look about him.</p>
+
+ <p>"What a wonderful voyage you had, Beechnut!" said Phonny.
+ "But I never knew before that you were shipwrecked."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, in point of fact," replied Beechnut, "I never was
+ shipwrecked."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page369"
+ id="page369"></a>[pg 369]</span>
+
+ <p>"Never was!" exclaimed Phonny. "Why, what is all this story
+ that you have been telling us, then?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Embellishment," said Beechnut quietly.</p>
+
+ <p>"Embellishment!" repeated Phonny, more and more amazed.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Beechnut.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then you were not wrecked at all?" said Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"No," replied Beechnut.</p>
+
+ <p>"And how did you get to the land?" asked Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, we sailed quietly up the St. Lawrence," replied
+ Beechnut, "and landed safely at Quebec, as other vessels
+ do."</p>
+
+ <p>"And the clock-weights?" asked Phonny.</p>
+
+ <p>"All embellishment," said Beechnut. "My father had no such
+ clock, in point of fact. He put his money in a bag, his bag in
+ his chest, and his chest in the hold, and it came as safe as
+ the captain's sextant."</p>
+
+ <p>"And the iceberg and the rainbow?" said Madeline.</p>
+
+ <p>"Embellishment, all embellishment," said Beechnut.</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear me!" said Phonny, "I thought it was all true."</p>
+
+ <p>"Did you?" said Beechnut. "I am sorry that you were so
+ deceived, and I am sure it was not my fault, for I gave you
+ your choice of a true story or an invention, and you chose the
+ invention."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Phonny, "so we did."</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page370"
+ id="page370"></a>[pg 370]</span>
+
+ <h3>THE OYSTER PATTIES</h3>
+
+ <p>There was once a little boy who perhaps might have been a
+ good little fellow if his friends had taken pains to make him
+ so; but&mdash;I do not know how it was&mdash;instead of
+ teaching him to be good, they gave him everything he cried for;
+ so, whenever he wished to have anything, he had only to cry,
+ and if he did not get it directly, he cried louder and louder
+ till at last he got it. By this means Alfred was not only very
+ naughty, but very unhappy. He was crying from morning till
+ night. He had no pleasure in anything; he was in everybody's
+ way, and nobody liked to be with him.</p>
+
+ <p>Well, one day his mother thought she would give him a day of
+ pleasure, and make him very happy indeed, so she told him he
+ should have a feast, and dine under the great cedar tree that
+ stood upon the lawn, and that his cousins should be invited to
+ dine with him, and that he should have whatever he chose for
+ his dinner. So she rang the bell, and she told the servants to
+ take out tables and chairs and to lay the cloth upon the table
+ under the tree, and she ordered her two footmen to be ready to
+ wait upon him.</p>
+
+ <p>She desired the butler to tell the cook to prepare the
+ dinner, and to get all sorts of nice dishes for the feast; but
+ she said to Alfred:</p>
+
+ <p>"What shall you like best of all, my dear boy?"</p>
+
+ <p>So Alfred tried to think of something that he had never had
+ before, and he recollected that one day he had heard a lady,
+ who was dining with his father and mother, say that the oyster
+ patties were the best she had ever eaten. Now Alfred had never
+ tasted oyster patties, so he said he would have oyster patties
+ for dinner.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oyster patties, my dear boy? You cannot have oyster patties
+ at this time of the year; there are no oysters to be had," his
+ mother said to him. "Try, love, to think of something
+ else."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page371"
+ id="page371"></a>[pg 371]</span>
+
+ <p>But naughty Alfred said:</p>
+
+ <p>"No, I can think of nothing else."</p>
+
+ <p>So the cook was sent for, and desired to think of something
+ that he might like as well. The cook proposed first a currant
+ pie, then a barberry pie, or a codlin pie with custard.</p>
+
+ <p>"No, no, no!" said Alfred, shaking his head.</p>
+
+ <p>"Or a strawberry tart, my sweet boy? or apricot jam?" said
+ his mother, in a soothing tone of voice.</p>
+
+ <p>But Alfred said:</p>
+
+ <p>"No, mother, no. I don't like strawberries. I don't like
+ apricot jam. I want oysters."</p>
+
+ <p>"But you cannot have oysters, my little master," said the
+ cook.</p>
+
+ <p>"But I will have oysters," said the little boy, "and you
+ shan't say that I can't have them&mdash;shall she, mother?"</p>
+
+ <p>And he began to scream and to cry.</p>
+
+ <p>"Do not cry, my sweet soul," said his mother, "and we will
+ see what we can do. Dry up your tears, my little man, and come
+ with me, and, the cook, I dare say, will be able to get some
+ oysters before dinner. It is a long time to dinner, you know,
+ and I have some pretty toys for you upstairs, if you will come
+ with me till dinner is ready."</p>
+
+ <p>So she took the little crying boy by the hand and led him up
+ to her room, and she whispered to the cook, as she passed, not
+ to say anything more about it now, and that she hoped he would
+ forget the oyster patties by the time dinner was ready. In the
+ meantime she took all the pains she could to amuse and please
+ him, and as fast as he grew tired of one toy she brought out
+ another.</p>
+
+ <p>At last, after some hours, she gave him a beautiful toy for
+ which she had paid fifteen shillings. It was a sand toy of a
+ woman sitting at a spinning-wheel, and when it was turned up
+ the little figure began spinning away, and the wheel turned
+ round and round as fast as if the woman who turned it had been
+ alive. Alfred wanted to see how it was done, but, instead of
+ going to his mother to ask her if she would be so good as to
+ explain it to him, he began pulling it to pieces to look behind
+ it. <span class="pagenum"><a name="page372"
+ id="page372"></a>[pg 372]</span> For some time he was very
+ busy, and he had just succeeded in opening the large box at the
+ back of the figure when all the sand that was in it came
+ pouring out upon the floor, and when he tried to make the
+ little woman spin again, he found she would not do it any more.
+ She could not, for it was the sand dropping down that had made
+ her move before.</p>
+
+ <p>Now, do you know that Alfred was so very silly that he began
+ to be angry even with the toy, and he said, "Spin, I say! spin
+ directly!" and then he shook it very hard, but in vain. The
+ little hands did not move, and the wheel stood still. So then
+ he was very angry indeed, and, setting up a loud cry, he threw
+ the toy to the other end of the room. Just at this very moment
+ the servant opened the door and said that dinner was ready, and
+ that Alfred's cousins were arrived.</p>
+
+ <p>"Come, my dear child; you are tired of your toys, I see,"
+ said his mother, "so come to dinner, darling. It is all ready
+ under the tree."</p>
+
+ <p>So away they went, leaving the room all strewed with toys,
+ with broken pieces, and the sand all spilt in a heap upon the
+ floor. When they went under the dark spreading branches of the
+ fine old cedar-tree, there they saw the table covered with
+ dishes and garnished with flowers. There were chickens, and
+ ham, and tongue, and lobsters, besides tarts, and custards, and
+ jellies, and cakes, and cream, and I do not know how many nice
+ things besides. There was Alfred's high chair at the head of
+ the table, and he was soon seated in it, as master of the
+ feast, with his mother sitting by him, his cousins opposite to
+ him, his nurse standing on the other side, and the two footmen
+ waiting besides.</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as his cousins were helped to what they liked best,
+ his mother said:</p>
+
+ <p>"What will you eat first, Alfred, my love? A wing of a
+ chicken?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No," said Alfred, pushing it away.</p>
+
+ <p>"A slice of ham, darling?" said nurse.</p>
+
+ <p>"No," said Alfred, in a louder tone.</p>
+
+ <p>"A little bit of lobster, my dear?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, no," replied the naughty
+ boy.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page373"
+ id="page373"></a>[pg 373]</span>
+
+ <p>"Well, what <i>will</i> you have, then?" said his mother,
+ who was almost tired of him.</p>
+
+ <p>"I will have oyster patties," said he.</p>
+
+ <p>"That is the only thing you cannot have, my love, you know,
+ so do not think of it any more, but taste a bit of this pie. I
+ am sure you will like it."</p>
+
+ <p>"You <i>said</i> I should have oyster patties by
+ dinner-time," said Alfred, "and so I will have nothing
+ else."</p>
+
+ <p>"I am sorry you are such a sad, naughty child," said his
+ mother. "I thought you would have been so pleased with all
+ these nice things to eat."</p>
+
+ <p>"They are <i>not</i> nice," said the child, who was not at
+ all grateful for all that his mother had done, but was now in
+ such a passion that he took the piece of currant tart which his
+ nurse again offered to him, and, squeezing, up as much as his
+ two little hands could hold, he threw it at his nurse, and
+ stained her nice white handkerchief and apron with the red
+ juice.</p>
+
+ <p>Just at this moment his father came into the garden, and
+ walked up to the table.</p>
+
+ <p>"What is all his?" said he. "Alfred, you seem to be a very
+ naughty boy indeed; and I must tell you, sir, I shall allow
+ this no longer. Get down from your chair, sir, and beg your
+ nurse's pardon."</p>
+
+ <p>Alfred had hardly ever heard his father speak so before, and
+ he felt so frightened that he left off crying and did as he was
+ bid. Then his father took him by the hand and led him away.</p>
+
+ <p>His mother said she was sure he would now be good and eat
+ the currant tart; but his father said:</p>
+
+ <p>"No, no, it is now too late; he must come with me."</p>
+
+ <p>So he led him away, without saying another word.</p>
+
+ <p>He took him into the village, and he stopped at the door, of
+ a poor cottage.</p>
+
+ <p>"May we come in?" said his father.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh yes, and welcome," said a poor woman, who was standing
+ at a table with a saucepan in her hand.</p>
+
+ <p>"What are you doing, my good woman?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Only putting out the children's supper, your
+ honor."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page374"
+ id="page374"></a>[pg 374]</span>
+
+ <p>"And what have you got for their supper?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Only some potatoes, please you, sir; but they be nicely
+ boiled, and here come the hungry boys! They are coming in from
+ their work, and they will soon make an end of them, I
+ warrant."</p>
+
+ <p>As she said these words in came John, and William, and
+ Thomas, all with rosy cheeks and smiling faces. They sat
+ down&mdash;one on a wooden stool, one on a broken chair, and
+ one on the corner of the table&mdash;and they all began to eat
+ the potatoes very heartily.</p>
+
+ <p>But Alfred's father said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Stop, my good boys; do not eat any more, but come with
+ me."</p>
+
+ <p>The boys stared, but their mother told them to do as they
+ were bid, so they left off eating and followed the
+ gentleman.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/374.jpg" name="fig374s"
+ id="fig374s"><img width="300" src="images/374s.jpg"
+ alt="HE TOOK THE CURRANT TART, AND ... THREW IT AT HIS NURSE" />
+ </a><br />
+ he took the currant tart, and ... threw it at his nurse
+ </div>
+
+ <p>Alfred and his father walked on till they arrived once more
+ under the cedar-tree in the garden, and there was the fine
+ feast all standing just as they had left it, for Alfred's
+ cousins were gone away, and his mother would not have the
+ dinner taken away, because she hoped that Alfred would come
+ back to it.</p>
+
+ <p>"Now, boys," said the gentleman, "you may all sit down to
+ this table and eat whatever you like."</p>
+
+ <p>John, William, and Thomas sat down as quickly as they could,
+ and began to devour the chickens and tarts, and all the good
+ things, at a great rate; and Alfred, who now began to be very
+ hungry, would gladly have been one of the party; but when he
+ was going to sit down, his father said:</p>
+
+ <p>"No, sir; this feast is not for <i>you</i>. There is nothing
+ here that you like to eat, you know; so you will wait upon
+ these boys, if you please, who seem as if they would find
+ plenty that they will like."</p>
+
+ <p>Alfred at this began to cry again, and said he wanted to go
+ to his mother; but his father did not mind his crying, and said
+ he should not go to his mother again till he was quite a good
+ boy.</p>
+
+ <p>"So now, sir, hand this bread to John, and now take a clean
+ plate to Thomas, and now stand ready to carry this custard to
+ William. There now, wait till they have all
+ done."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page375"
+ id="page375"></a>[pg 375]</span>
+
+ <p>It was of no use now to cry or scream; he was obliged to do
+ it all.</p>
+
+ <p>When the boys had quite finished their supper they went
+ home, and Alfred was led by his father into the house. Before
+ he went to bed, a cup of milk and water and a piece of brown
+ bread were put before him, and his father said:</p>
+
+ <p>"That is your supper, Alfred."</p>
+
+ <p>Alfred began to cry again, and said he did not want such a
+ supper as that.</p>
+
+ <p>"Very well," said his father, "then go to bed without, and
+ it shall be saved for your breakfast."</p>
+
+ <p>Alfred cried and screamed louder than ever, so his father
+ ordered the maid to put him to bed. When he was in bed, he
+ thought his mother would come and see him and bring him
+ something nice, and he lay awake a long while; but she did not
+ come, and he cried and cried till at last he fell asleep.</p>
+
+ <p>In the morning, when he awoke, he was so hungry he could
+ hardly wait to be dressed, but asked for his breakfast every
+ minute. When he saw the maid bring in the brown bread again
+ without any butter, and some milk and water, he was very near
+ crying again; but he thought if he did he should perhaps lose
+ his breakfast as he had lost his supper, so he checked his
+ tears, and ate a hearty meal.</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," said his father, who came into the room just as he
+ was eating the last bit of bread, "I am glad to see the little
+ boy who could not yesterday find anything good enough for him
+ at a feast eating such simple fare as this so heartily. Come,
+ Alfred, now you may come to your dear mother."</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page376"
+ id="page376"></a>[pg 376]</span>
+
+ <h3>TWO LITTLE BOYS</h3>
+
+ <h3>By THOMAS DAY</h3>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE GOOD-NATURED LITTLE BOY</h4>
+
+ <p>A little boy went out one morning to walk to a village about
+ five miles from the place where he lived, and carried with him
+ in a basket the provision that was to serve him the whole day.
+ As he was walking along a poor little half-starved dog came up
+ to him, wagging his tail and seeming to entreat him to take
+ compassion on him.</p>
+
+ <p>The little boy at first took no notice of him, but at
+ length, remarking how lean and famished the creature seemed to
+ be, he said: "This animal is certainly in very great necessity.
+ If I give him part of my provision I shall be obliged to go
+ home hungry myself; however, as he seems to want it more than I
+ do, he shall partake with me." Saying this, he gave the dog
+ part of what he had in his basket, who ate as if he had not
+ tasted victuals for a fortnight.</p>
+
+ <p>The little boy went on a little further, his dog still
+ following him and fawning upon him with the greatest gratitude
+ and affection, when he saw a poor old horse lying upon the
+ ground, and groaning as if he was very ill. He went up to him,
+ and saw that he was almost starved, and so weak that he was
+ unable to rise. "I am very much afraid," said the little boy,
+ "if I stay to assist this horse that it will be dark before I
+ can return, and I have heard there are several thieves in the
+ neighborhood. However, I will try. It is doing a good action to
+ attempt to relieve him, and God Almighty will take care of me."
+ He then went and gathered some grass, which he brought to the
+ horse's mouth, who immediately began to eat with as much relish
+ as if his chief disease was hunger. He then fetched some water
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page377" id="page377"></a>[pg
+ 377]</span> in his hat, which the animal drank up, and seemed
+ immediately to be so much refreshed that after a few trials he
+ got up and began grazing.</p>
+
+ <p>He then went on a little further, and saw a man wading about
+ in a pool of water without being able to get out, in spite of
+ all his endeavors. "What is the matter, good man?" said the
+ little boy to him. "Can't you find your way out of this pond?"
+ "No, God bless you, my worthy master, or miss," said the man,
+ "for such I take you to be by your voice. I have fallen into
+ this pond, and know not how to get out again, as I am quite
+ blind, and I am almost afraid to move for fear of being
+ drowned." "Well," said the little boy, "though I shall be
+ wetted to the skin, if you will throw me your stick, I will try
+ to help you out of it."</p>
+
+ <p>The blind man then threw the stick on to that side on which
+ he heard the voice; the little boy caught it, and went into the
+ water, feeling very carefully before him, lest he should
+ unguardedly go beyond his depth. At length he reached the blind
+ man, took him very carefully by the hand, and led him out. The
+ blind man then gave him a thousand blessings, and told him he
+ could grope his way home, and the little boy ran on as hard as
+ he could to prevent being benighted.</p>
+
+ <p>But he had not proceeded far when he saw a poor sailor, that
+ had lost both his legs in an engagement by sea, hopping along
+ upon crutches.</p>
+
+ <p>"God bless you, my little master!" said the sailor. "I have
+ fought many a battle with the French to defend poor old
+ England, but now I am crippled, as you see, and have neither
+ victuals nor money, although I am almost famished." The little
+ boy could not resist his inclination to relieve him, so he gave
+ him all his remaining victuals, and said: "God help you, poor
+ man! This is all I have, otherwise you should have more."</p>
+
+ <p>He then ran along, and presently arrived at the town he was
+ going to, did his business, and returned towards his own home
+ with all the expedition he was able.</p>
+
+ <p>But he had not gone much more than half-way before the night
+ shut in extremely dark, without either moon or stars to light
+ him. The poor little boy did all he could to find his way,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page378" id="page378"></a>[pg
+ 378]</span> but unfortunately missed it in turning down a lane
+ which brought him into a wood, where he wandered about a great
+ while without being able to find any path to lead him out.</p>
+
+ <p>Tired out at last and hungry, he felt himself so feeble that
+ he could go no further, but sat himself down upon the ground,
+ crying most bitterly. In this situation he remained for some
+ time, till at last the little dog, who had never forsaken him,
+ came up to him, wagging his tail, and holding something in his
+ mouth. The little, boy took it from him, and saw it was a
+ handkerchief nicely pinned together, which someone had dropped
+ and the dog had picked up; and upon opening it he found several
+ slices of bread and meat, which the little boy ate with great
+ satisfaction, and felt himself extremely refreshed with his
+ meal. "So," said the little boy, "I see that if I have given
+ you a breakfast you have given me a supper, and a good turn is
+ never lost, not even to a dog."</p>
+
+ <p>He then once more attempted to escape from the woods, but it
+ was to no purpose; he only scratched his legs with the briars,
+ and slipped down in the dirt, without being able to find his
+ way out. He was just going to give up all further attempts in
+ despair, when he happened to see a horse feeding before him,
+ and going up to him saw, by the light of the moon which just
+ then began to shine a little, that it was the very same horse
+ he had fed in the morning. "Perhaps," said the little boy,
+ "this creature that I have been so good to will let me get upon
+ his back, and he may bring me out of the wood, as he is
+ accustomed to feed in this neighborhood."</p>
+
+ <p>The little boy then went up to the horse, speaking to him
+ and stroking him, and the horse let him mount his back without
+ opposition, and then proceeded slowly through the wood, grazing
+ as he went, till he brought him to an opening which led to the
+ high road. The little boy was much rejoiced at this and said:
+ "If I hadn't saved the creature's life in the morning I should
+ have been obliged to have stayed here all the night. I see by
+ this that a good deed is never lost."</p>
+
+ <p>But the poor little boy had yet a greater danger to undergo,
+ for as he was going along a solitary lane two men rushed out
+ upon him, laid hold of him, and were going to strip him of his
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page379" id="page379"></a>[pg
+ 379]</span> clothes; but just as they were beginning to do it
+ the little dog bit the leg of one of the men with so much
+ violence that he left the little boy and pursued the dog, which
+ ran howling and barking away. In this instant a voice was heard
+ that cried out: "There are the rascals! Let us knock them
+ down!" which frightened the remaining man so much that he ran
+ away, and his companion followed him.</p>
+
+ <p>The little boy then looked up, and saw that it was the
+ sailor whom he had relieved in the morning, carried upon the
+ shoulders of the blind man whom he had helped out of the pond.
+ "There, my little dear!" said the sailor. "God be thanked! we
+ have come in time to do you a service in return for what you
+ did us in the morning. As I lay under a hedge I heard these
+ villains talk of robbing a little boy that from the description
+ I concluded must be you; but I was so lame that I should not
+ have been able to come time enough to help you if I had not met
+ this honest blind man, who took me upon his back, while I
+ showed him the way." The little boy thanked them very
+ gratefully for thus defending him, and they went all together
+ to his father's house, which was not far off, where they were
+ all kindly entertained with a supper and bed.</p>
+
+ <p>The little boy took care of his faithful dog as long as he
+ lived, and never forgot the importance and necessity of doing
+ good to others if we wish them to do the same to us.</p>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE ILL-NATURED LITTLE BOY</h4>
+
+ <p>There was once a little boy who was so unfortunate as to
+ have a very bad man for his father, who was always surly and
+ ill-tempered, and never gave his children either good
+ instruction or good example. In consequence of this, this
+ little boy, who might otherwise have been happier and better,
+ became ill-natured and quarrelsome, and disagreeable to every
+ one. He very often was severely beaten for his impertinence by
+ boys that were bigger than himself, and sometimes by boys that
+ were less; for though he was very abusive
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page380" id="page380"></a>[pg
+ 380]</span> and quarrelsome, he did not much like fighting, and
+ generally trusted more to his heels than his courage when he
+ had engaged himself in a quarrel. This little boy had a cur dog
+ that was the exact image of himself; he was the most
+ troublesome, surly creature imaginable, always barking at the
+ heels of every horse he came near, and worrying every sheep he
+ could meet with, for which reason both the dog and the boy were
+ disliked by all the neighborhood.</p>
+
+ <p>One morning his father got up early to go to the ale-house,
+ where he intended to stay till night, as it was a holiday; but
+ before he went out he gave his son some bread and cold meat and
+ sixpence, and told him he might go and divert himself as he
+ would the whole day. The little boy was very much pleased with
+ this liberty, and as it was a very fine morning he called his
+ dog Tiger to follow him, and began his walk.</p>
+
+ <p>He had not proceeded far before he met a boy that was
+ driving a flock of sheep towards a gate that he wanted them to
+ enter. "Pray, master," said the little boy, "stand still, and
+ keep your dog close to you, for fear you frighten my sheep."
+ "Oh yes, to be sure," answered the ill-natured little boy. "I
+ am to wait here all the morning till you and your sheep have
+ passed, I suppose! Here, Tiger, seize them, boy"! Tiger at this
+ sprang forth into the middle of the flock, barking and biting
+ on every side, and the sheep, in a general consternation,
+ hurried each a separate way.</p>
+
+ <p>Tiger seemed to enjoy this sport equally with his master,
+ but in the midst of his triumph he happened unguardedly to
+ attack an old ram that had more courage than the rest of the
+ flock. He, instead of running away, faced about and aimed a
+ blow with his forehead at his enemy with so much force and
+ dexterity that he knocked Tiger over and over, butting him
+ several times while he was down, and obliged him to limp
+ howling away.</p>
+
+ <p>The ill-natured little boy, who was not capable of loving
+ anything, had been very much diverted with the trepidation of
+ the flock of sheep, but now he laughed heartily at the
+ misfortune of his dog, and he would have laughed much longer
+ had not the other little boy, his patience provoked at this
+ treatment, <span class="pagenum"><a name="page381"
+ id="page381"></a>[pg 381]</span> thrown a stone at him, which
+ hit him full upon the temples and almost knocked him down. He
+ immediately began to cry in concert with his dog, when,
+ perceiving a man coming towards them, whom he fancied might be
+ the owner of the sheep, he thought it most prudent to escape as
+ speedily as possible.</p>
+
+ <p>But he had scarcely recovered from the smart which the blow
+ had occasioned when his former mischievous disposition
+ returned, which he determined to gratify to the utmost. He had
+ not gone far before he saw a little girl standing by a stile,
+ with a large pot of milk at her feet. "Pray," said the little
+ girl, "help me with this pot of milk. My mother sent me out to
+ fetch it this morning, and I have brought it alone a mile on my
+ head; but I am so tired that I have been obliged to stop at
+ this stile to rest me, and if I don't return home presently we
+ shall have no pudding to-day, and, besides, my mother will be
+ very angry with me."</p>
+
+ <p>"What," said the boy, "you are to have a pudding to-day, are
+ you, miss?" "Yes," said the girl, "and a fine piece of roast
+ beef, for there's Uncle Will, and Uncle John, and grandfather,
+ and all my cousins, to dine with us, and we shall all be very
+ merry in the evening, I can assure you; so pray help me up as
+ speedily as possible." "That I will, miss," said the boy,
+ taking up the jug, and pretending to fix it upon her head. Just
+ as she had hold of it he gave it a little push, as if he had
+ stumbled, and overturned it upon her. The little girl began to
+ cry violently, but the mischievous boy ran away, laughing
+ heartily, and saying: "Good-by, little miss! Give my humble
+ service to your Uncle Will, and grandfather, and the dear
+ little cousins."</p>
+
+ <p>This prank encouraged him very much indeed, for he then felt
+ that now he had certainly escaped without any bad consequences;
+ so he went on applauding his own ingenuity, and came to a farm
+ where several little boys were at play. He desired leave to
+ play with them, which they allowed him to do. But he could not
+ be contented long without exerting his evil disposition, so
+ taking an opportunity when it was his turn to fling the ball,
+ instead of flinging it the way he ought to have
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page382" id="page382"></a>[pg
+ 382]</span> done, he threw it into a muddy ditch. The little
+ boys ran in a great hurry to see what was become of it, and as
+ they were standing all together upon the brink he gave the
+ outermost boy a violent push against his neighbor; he, not
+ being able to resist the violence, tumbled against the next,
+ that against the next, and that next against another, by which
+ means they all soused into the ditch together.</p>
+
+ <p>They soon scrambled out, although in a dirty plight, and
+ were going to have punished him for all his ill behavior; but
+ he patted Tiger upon the back, who began snarling and growling
+ in such a manner as made them desist. Thus this little
+ mischievous boy escaped a second time with impunity.</p>
+
+ <p>The next thing he met with was a poor jackass feeding very
+ quietly in a ditch. The little boy, seeing that nobody was
+ within sight, thought this was an opportunity of plaguing an
+ animal that was not to be lost, so he went and cut a large
+ branch of thorns, which he contrived to fix to the poor beast's
+ tail, and then, setting Tiger at him, he was extremely diverted
+ to see the fright and agony the creature was in. But it did not
+ fare so well with Tiger, who while he was baying and biting the
+ animal's heels receive so severe a kick upon his head as laid
+ him dead upon the spot.</p>
+
+ <p>The boy, who had no affection for his dog, left him with the
+ greatest unconcern when he saw what had happened, and, finding
+ himself hungry, sat down by the wayside to eat his dinner. He
+ had not long been there before a poor blind man came groping
+ his way out with a couple of sticks. "Good morning to you,"
+ said the boy. "Pray did you see a little girl come this road
+ with a basket of eggs upon her head, dressed in a green gown,
+ with a straw hat upon her head?" "God bless you, master!" said
+ the beggar, "I am so blind I can see nothing, either in heaven
+ above or in the earth below. I have been blind these twenty
+ years, and they call me 'poor old blind Richard.'"</p>
+
+ <p>Though the poor old man was such an object of charity and
+ compassion, yet the little boy determined, as usual, to play
+ him some trick, and as he was a great liar and deceiver, he
+ spoke to him thus: "Poor old Richard, I am heartily sorry for
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page383" id="page383"></a>[pg
+ 383]</span> you with all my heart. I am just eating my
+ breakfast, and if you will sit down by me I will give you part,
+ and feed you myself." "Thank you with all my heart!" said the
+ poor man; "and if you will give me your hand I will sit by you
+ with great pleasure, my dear good little master."</p>
+
+ <p>The little boy then gave him his hand, and, pretending to
+ direct him, guided him to sit down in a large heap of wet mud
+ that lay by the roadside. "There," said he, "now you are nicely
+ seated I am going to feed you." So, taking a little of the dirt
+ in his fingers, he was going to put it into the blind man's
+ mouth; but the man, who now perceived the trick that had been
+ played him, made a sudden snap at his fingers, and getting them
+ between his teeth bit them so severely that the wicked boy
+ roared out for mercy, and promised never more to be guilty of
+ such wickedness. At last the blind man, after he had put him to
+ very severe pain, consented to let him go, saying as he went:
+ "Are you not ashamed, you little scoundrel, to attempt to do
+ hurt to those who have never injured you, and to want to add to
+ the suffering of those who already are sufficiently miserable?
+ Although you escape now, be assured, sir, that if you do not
+ repent and mend your manners, you will meet with a severe
+ punishment for your bad behavior."</p>
+
+ <p>One would think that this punishment would have cured him
+ entirely of this mischievous disposition, but, unfortunately
+ nothing is so difficult to overcome as bad habits that have
+ been long indulged. He had not gone far before he saw a lame
+ beggar that had just made a shift to support himself by the
+ means of a couple of sticks. The beggar asked him to give him
+ something, and the mischievous little boy, pulling out his
+ sixpence, threw it down before him, as if he intended to make
+ him a present of it; but while the poor man was stooping with
+ difficulty to pick it up, the wicked little boy knocked the
+ stick away, by which means the beggar fell down upon his face;
+ and then snatching up the sixpence, the little boy ran away
+ laughing very heartily at the accident.</p>
+
+ <p>This was the last trick this ungrateful boy had it in his
+ power to play, for seeing two men come up to the beggar and
+ enter into discourse with him, he was afraid of being pursued,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page384" id="page384"></a>[pg
+ 384]</span> and therefore ran as fast as he was able over
+ several fields. At last he came into a lane which led to a
+ farmer's orchard, and as he was preparing to clamber over the
+ fence a large dog seized him by the leg and held him fast. He
+ cried out in an agony of terror, which brought the farmer out,
+ who called the dog off, but seized the boy very roughly,
+ saying: "So, sir, you are caught at last, are you? You thought
+ you might come day after day and steal my apples without
+ detection; but it seems you are mistaken, and now you shall
+ receive the punishment you have so long deserved." The farmer
+ then began to chastise him very severely with a whip he had in
+ his hand, and the boy in vain protested he was innocent, and
+ begged for mercy. At last the farmer asked him who he was and
+ where he lived; but when he heard his name, he cried out:
+ "What! are you the little rascal that frightened my sheep this
+ morning, by which means several of them are lost? and do you
+ think to escape?" Saying this he lashed him more severely than
+ before, in spite of all his cries and protestations. At length,
+ thinking he had punished him enough, he turned him out of the
+ orchard, bade him go home, and frighten sheep again if he liked
+ the consequences.</p>
+
+ <p>The little boy slunk away crying very bitterly, for he had
+ been very severely beaten, and now began to find out that no
+ one can long hurt others with impunity; so he determined to go
+ away quietly home, and behave better for the future.</p>
+
+ <p>But his sufferings were not yet at an end, for as he jumped
+ down from a stile he felt himself very roughly seized, and,
+ looking up, found that he was in the power of the lame beggar
+ whom he had thrown upon his face. It was in vain that he now
+ cried, entreated, and begged for pardon; the man, who had been
+ much hurt by his fall, thrashed him very severely with his
+ stick before he would part with him.</p>
+
+ <p>He now again went on crying and roaring with pain, but at
+ least expected to escape without any further damage. But here
+ he was mistaken, for as he was walking slowly through a lane,
+ just as he turned a corner he found himself in the middle of
+ the very troop of boys that he had used so ill in the morning.
+ They all set up a shout as soon as they saw him, their enemy,
+ in their power, without his dog, and began persecuting him in
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page385" id="page385"></a>[pg
+ 385]</span> a thousand various ways. Some pulled him by the
+ hair, others pinched him, some whipped his legs with their
+ handkerchiefs, while others covered him with handfuls of dirt.
+ In vain did he attempt to escape; they were still at his heels,
+ and, surrounding him on every side, continued their
+ persecutions.</p>
+
+ <p>At length, while he was in this disagreeable situation, he
+ happened to come up to the same jackass he had seen in the
+ morning, and, making a sudden spring, jumped upon his back,
+ hoping by this means to escape. The boys immediately renewed
+ their shouts, and the ass, who was frightened at the noise,
+ began galloping with all his might, and presently bore him from
+ the reach of his enemies.</p>
+
+ <p>But he had little reason to rejoice at this escape, for he
+ found it impossible to stop the animal, and was every instant
+ afraid of being thrown off and dashed upon the ground. After he
+ had been thus hurried along a considerable time the ass on a
+ sudden stopped short at the door of a cottage, and began
+ kicking and prancing with so much fury that the little boy was
+ presently thrown to the ground, and broke his leg in the
+ fall.</p>
+
+ <p>His cries immediately brought the family out, among whom was
+ the very little girl he had used so ill in the morning. But
+ she, with the greatest good nature, seeing him in such a
+ pitiable situation, assisted in bringing him in and laying him
+ upon the bed. There this unfortunate boy had leisure to
+ recollect himself and reflect upon his own bad behavior, which
+ in one day's time had exposed him to such a variety of
+ misfortunes; and he determined with great sincerity that if
+ ever he recovered from his present accident he would be as
+ careful to take every opportunity of doing good as he had
+ before been to commit every species of mischief.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page386"
+ id="page386"></a>[pg 386]</span>
+
+ <h3>THE PURPLE JAR</h3>
+
+ <h3>By MARIA EDGEWORTH</h3>
+
+ <p>Rosamond, a little girl about seven years old, was walking
+ with her mother in the streets of London. As she passed along
+ she looked in at the windows of several shops, and saw a great
+ variety of different sorts of things, of which she did not know
+ the use, or even the names. She wished to stop to look at them,
+ but there was a great number of people in the streets, and a
+ great many carts, carriages, and wheelbarrows, and she was
+ afraid to let go her mother's hand.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, mother, how happy I should be," she said, as she passed
+ a toy-shop, "if I had all these pretty things!"</p>
+
+ <p>"What, all! Do you wish for them all, Rosamond?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, mamma, all."</p>
+
+ <p>As she spoke they came to a milliner's shop, the windows of
+ which were decorated with ribbons and lace, and festoons of
+ artificial flowers.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, mamma, what beautiful roses! Won't you buy some of
+ them?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, my dear."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Because I don't want them, my dear."</p>
+
+ <p>They went a little farther, and came to another shop, which
+ caught Rosamond's eye. It was a jeweler's shop, and in it were
+ a great many pretty baubles, ranged in drawers behind
+ glass.</p>
+
+ <p>"Mamma, will you buy some of these?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Which of them, Rosamond?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Which? I don't know which; any of them will do, for they
+ are all pretty."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, they are all pretty; but of what use would they be to
+ me?"</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page387"
+ id="page387"></a>[pg 387]</span>
+
+ <p>"Use! Oh, I am sure you could find some use or other for
+ them if you would only buy them first."</p>
+
+ <p>"But I would rather find out the use first."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, then, mamma, there are buckles; you know that buckles
+ are useful things, very useful things."</p>
+
+ <p>"I have a pair of buckles; I don't want another pair," said
+ her mother, and walked on.</p>
+
+ <p>Rosamond was very sorry that her mother wanted nothing.
+ Presently, however, they came to a shop, which appeared to her
+ far more beautiful than the rest. It was a chemist's shop, but
+ she did not know that.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, mother, oh!" cried she, pulling her mother's hand,
+ "look, look! blue, green, red, yellow, and purple! Oh, mamma,
+ what beautiful things! Won't you buy some of these?"</p>
+
+ <p>Still her mother answered, as before, "Of what use would
+ they be to me, Rosamond?"</p>
+
+ <p>"You might put flowers in them, mamma, and they would look
+ so pretty on the chimney-piece. I wish I had one of them."</p>
+
+ <p>"You have a flower-pot," said her mother, "and that is not a
+ flower-pot."</p>
+
+ <p>"But I could use it for a flower-pot, mamma, you know."</p>
+
+ <p>"Perhaps if you were to see it nearer, if you were to
+ examine it you might be disappointed."</p>
+
+ <p>"No, indeed, I'm sure I should not; I should like it
+ exceedingly."</p>
+
+ <p>Rosamond kept her head turned to look at the purple vase,
+ till she could see it no longer.</p>
+
+ <p>"Then, mother," said she, after a pause, "perhaps you have
+ no money."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, I have."</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear me, if I had money I would buy roses, and boxes, and
+ buckles, and purple flower-pots, and everything." Rosamond was
+ obliged to pause in the midst of her speech.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, mamma, would you stop a minute for me? I have got a
+ stone in my shoe; it hurts me very much."</p>
+
+ <p>"How came there to be a stone in your shoe?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Because of this great hole, mamma,&mdash;it comes in there;
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page388" id="page388"></a>[pg
+ 388]</span> my shoes are quite worn out. I wish you would be so
+ very good as to give me another pair."</p>
+
+ <p>"Nay, Rosamond, but I have not money enough to buy shoes,
+ and flower-pots, and buckles, and boxes, and everything."</p>
+
+ <p>Rosamond thought that was a great pity. But now her foot,
+ which had been hurt by the stone, began to give her so much
+ pain that she was obliged to hop every other step, and she
+ could think of nothing else. They came to a shoemaker's shop
+ soon afterwards.</p>
+
+ <p>"There, there! mamma, there are shoes; there are little
+ shoes that would just fit me, and you know shoes would be
+ really of use to me."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, so they would, Rosamond. Come in."</p>
+
+ <p>She followed her mother into the shop.</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Sole the shoemaker, had a great many customers, and his
+ shop was full, so they were obliged to wait.</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, Rosamond," said her mother, "you don't think this
+ shop so pretty as the rest?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, not nearly; it is black and dark, and there are nothing
+ but shoes all round; and, besides, there's a very disagreeable
+ smell."</p>
+
+ <p>"That smell is the smell of new leather."</p>
+
+ <p>"Is it? Oh!" said Rosamond, looking round, "there is a pair
+ of little shoes; they'll just fit me, I'm sure."</p>
+
+ <p>"Perhaps they might; but you cannot be sure till you have
+ tried them on, any more than you can be quite sure that you
+ should like the purple vase exceedingly, till you have examined
+ it more attentively."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, I don't know about the shoes, certainly, till I have
+ tried; but, mamma, I am quite sure that I should like the
+ flower-pot."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, which would you rather have, a jar or a pair of
+ shoes? I will buy either for you."</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear mamma, thank you&mdash;but if you could buy both?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, not both."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then the jar, if you please."</p>
+
+ <p>"But I should tell you, that in that case I shall not give
+ you another pair of shoes this
+ month."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page389"
+ id="page389"></a>[pg 389]</span>
+
+ <p>"This month! that's a very long time, indeed! You can't
+ think how these hurt me; I believe I'd better have the new
+ shoes. Yet, that purple flower-pot. Oh, indeed, mamma, these
+ shoes are not so very, very bad! I think I might wear them a
+ little longer, and the month will soon be over. I can make them
+ last till the end of the month, can't I? Don't you think so,
+ mamma?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Nay, my dear, I want you to think for yourself; you will
+ have time enough to consider the matter, while I speak to Mr.
+ Sole about my clogs."</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Sole was by this time at leisure, and while her mother
+ was speaking to him, Rosamond stood in profound meditation,
+ with one shoe on, and the other in her hand.</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, my dear, have you decided?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Mamma!&mdash;yes,&mdash;I believe I have. If you please, I
+ should like to have the flower-pot; that is, if you won't think
+ me very silly, mamma."</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, as to that, I can't promise you, Rosamond; but when
+ you have to judge for yourself you should choose what would
+ make you happy, and then it would not signify who thought you
+ silly."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then, mamma, if that's all, I'm sure the flower-pot would
+ make me happy," said she, putting on her old shoe again; "so I
+ choose the flower-pot."</p>
+
+ <p>"Very well, you shall have it; clasp your shoe and come
+ home."</p>
+
+ <p>Rosamond clasped her shoe and ran after her mother. It was
+ not long before the shoe came down at the heel, and many times
+ she was obliged to stop to take the stones out of it, and she
+ often limped with pain; but still the thoughts of the purple
+ flower-pot prevailed, and she persisted in her choice.</p>
+
+ <p>When they came to the shop with the large window, Rosamond
+ felt much pleasure upon hearing her mother desire the servant,
+ who was with them, to buy the purple jar, and bring it home. He
+ had other commissions, so he did not return with them.
+ Rosamond, as soon as she got in, ran to gather all her own
+ flowers, which she kept in a corner of her mother's garden.</p>
+
+ <p>"I am afraid they'll be dead before the flower-pot comes,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page390" id="page390"></a>[pg
+ 390]</span> Rosamond," said her mother to her, as she came in
+ with the flowers in her lap.</p>
+
+ <p>"No, indeed, mamma, it will come home very soon, I dare say.
+ I shall be very happy putting them into the purple
+ flower-pot."</p>
+
+ <p>"I hope so, my dear."</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/390.jpg" name="fig390s"
+ id="fig390s"><img width="300" src="images/390s.jpg"
+ alt="ROSAMOND RAN UP TO IT WITH AN EXCLAMATION OF JOY" />
+ </a><br />
+ rosamond ran up to it with an exclamation of joy
+ </div>
+
+ <p>The servant was much longer returning home than Rosamond had
+ expected; but at length he came, and brought with him the
+ long-wished-for jar. The moment it was set down upon the table,
+ Rosamond ran up to it with an exclamation of joy: "I may have
+ it now, mamma?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, my dear, it is yours."</p>
+
+ <p>Rosamond poured the flowers from her lap upon the carpet,
+ and seized the purple flower-pot.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, dear, mother!" cried she, as soon as she had taken off
+ the top, "but there's something dark in it which smells very
+ disagreeably. What is it? I didn't want this black stuff."</p>
+
+ <p>"Nor I, my dear."</p>
+
+ <p>"But what shall I do with it, mamma?"</p>
+
+ <p>"That I cannot tell."</p>
+
+ <p>"It will be of no use to me, mamma."</p>
+
+ <p>"That I cannot help."</p>
+
+ <p>"But I must pour it out, and fill the flower-pot with
+ water."</p>
+
+ <p>"As you please, my dear."</p>
+
+ <p>"Will you lend me a bowl to pour it into, mamma?"</p>
+
+ <p>"That was more than I promised you, my dear; but I will lend
+ you a bowl."</p>
+
+ <p>The bowl was produced, and Rosamond proceeded to empty the
+ purple vase. But she experienced much surprise and
+ disappointment, on finding, when it was entirely empty, that it
+ was no longer a purple vase. It was a plain white glass jar,
+ which had appeared to have that beautiful color merely from the
+ liquor with which it had been filled.</p>
+
+ <p>Little Rosamond burst into tears.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why should you cry, my dear?" said her mother; "it will be
+ of as much use to you now as ever, for a flower-pot."</p>
+
+ <p>"But it won't look so pretty on the chimney-piece. I
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page391" id="page391"></a>[pg
+ 391]</span> am sure, if I had known that it was not really
+ purple, I should not have wished to have it so much."</p>
+
+ <p>"But didn't I tell you that you had not examined it; and
+ that perhaps you would be disappointed?"</p>
+
+ <p>"And so I am disappointed, indeed. I wish I had believed you
+ at once. Now I had much rather have the shoes, for I shall not
+ be able to walk all this month; even walking home that little
+ way hurt me exceedingly. Mamma, I will give you the flower-pot
+ back again, and that purple stuff and all, if you'll only give
+ me the shoes."</p>
+
+ <p>"No, Rosamond; you must abide by your own choice; and now
+ the best thing you can possibly do is to bear your
+ disappointment with good humor."</p>
+
+ <p>"I will bear it as well as I can," said Rosamond, wiping her
+ eyes; and she began slowly and sorrowfully to fill the vase
+ with flowers.</p>
+
+ <p>But Rosamond's disappointment did not end here. Many were
+ the difficulties and distresses into which her imprudent choice
+ brought her, before the end of the month.</p>
+
+ <p>Every day her shoes grew worse and worse, till as last she
+ could neither run, dance, jump, nor walk in them.</p>
+
+ <p>Whenever Rosamond was called to see anything, she was
+ detained pulling her shoes up at the heels, and was sure to be
+ too late.</p>
+
+ <p>Whenever her mother was going out to walk, she could not
+ take Rosamond with her, for Rosamond had no soles to her shoes;
+ and at length, on the very last day of the month, it happened
+ that her father proposed to take her with her brother to a
+ glass-house, which she had long wished to see. She was very
+ happy; but, when she was quite ready, had her hat and gloves
+ on, and was making haste downstairs to her brother and father,
+ who were waiting for her at the hall door, the shoe dropped
+ off. She put it on again in a great hurry, but, as she was
+ going across the hall, her father turned round.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why are you walking slipshod? no one must walk slipshod
+ with me. Why, Rosamond," said he, looking at her shoes with
+ disgust, "I thought that you were always neat; no, I cannot
+ take you with me."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page392"
+ id="page392"></a>[pg 392]</span>
+
+ <p>Rosamond colored and retired.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, mamma," said she as she took off her hat, "how I wish
+ that I had chosen the shoes! They would have been of so much
+ more use to me than that jar: however, I am sure, no, not quite
+ sure, but I hope I shall be wiser another time."</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page393"
+ id="page393"></a>[pg 393]</span>
+
+ <h3>THE THREE CAKES</h3>
+
+ <h3>By ARMAND BERQUIN</h3>
+
+ <p>"There was a little boy named Henry," said Mr Glassington
+ "about your age. His parents had but lately fixed him at a
+ boarding-school.</p>
+
+ <p>"He was a special boy, forever at his book, and happened
+ once to get the highest place at exercises. His mother was told
+ it. She could nohow keep from dreaming of the pleasure; and
+ when morning came, she got up early, went to speak with the
+ cook and said as follows:</p>
+
+ <p>"'Cook, you are to make a cake for Henry, who yesterday was
+ very good at school.'</p>
+
+ <p>"'With all my heart,' replied the cook, and set immediately
+ about it. It was as big as&mdash;let me see&mdash;as big
+ as&mdash;as a hat when flapped. The cook had stuffed it with
+ nice almonds, large pistachio nuts, and candied lemon-peel, and
+ iced it over with a coat of sugar, so that it was very smooth
+ and a perfect white. The cake no sooner was come home from
+ baking than the cook put on her things, and carried it to
+ school.</p>
+
+ <p>"When Henry first saw it, he jumped up and down like any
+ Merry Andrew. He was not so patient as to wait till they could
+ let him have a knife, but fell upon it tooth and nail. He ate
+ and ate till school began, and after school was over he ate
+ again; at night, too, it was the same thing till
+ bedtime&mdash;nay, a little fellow that Henry had for a
+ playmate told me that he put the cake upon his bolster when he
+ went to bed, and waked and waked a dozen times, that he might
+ take a bit. I cannot so easily believe this last particular;
+ but, then, it is very true, at least, that on the morrow, when
+ the day was hardly broke, he set about his favorite business
+ once again, continuing at it all the morning, and by noon had
+ eaten it up. The dinner-bell now rung; but Henry, as one may
+ fancy, had no stomach, and was vexed to see how heartily the
+ other children ate. It <span class="pagenum"><a name="page394"
+ id="page394"></a>[pg 394]</span> was, however, worse than this
+ at five o'clock, when school was over.</p>
+
+ <p>"His companions asked him if he would not play at cricket,
+ tan, or kits. Alas! he could not; so they played without him.
+ In the meantime Henry could hardly stand upon his legs; he went
+ and sat down in a corner very gloomily, while the children said
+ one to another: 'What is the matter with poor Henry, who used
+ to skip about and be so merry? See how pale and sorrowful he
+ is!'</p>
+
+ <p>"The master came himself, and, seeing him, was quite
+ alarmed. It was all lost labor to interrogate him. Henry could
+ not be brought to speak a single word.</p>
+
+ <p>"By great good luck, a boy at length came forward in the
+ secret; and his information was that Henry's mother had sent
+ him a great cake the day before, which he had swallowed in an
+ instant, as it were, and that his present sickness was
+ occasioned only by his gluttony. On this, the master sent for
+ an apothecary, who ordered him a quantity of physic, phial
+ after phial. Henry, as one would fancy, found it very nauseous,
+ but was forced to take the whole for fear of dying, which, had
+ he omitted it, would certainly have been the case. When some
+ few days of physic and strict regimen had passed, his health
+ was re-established as before; but his mother protested that she
+ would never let him have another cake."</p>
+
+ <p><i>Percival</i>. He did not merit so much as the smell of
+ such a thing. But this is but one cake, father; and you
+ informed me that there were three, if you remember, in your
+ story.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. G.</i> Patience! patience! Here is another cake in
+ what I am now going to tell.</p>
+
+ <p>"Henry's master had another scholar, whose name was Francis.
+ He had written his mother a very pretty letter, and it had not
+ so much as a blotted stroke; in recompense for which she sent
+ him likewise a great cake, and Francis thus addressed himself:
+ 'I will not, like that glutton Henry, eat up my cake at once,
+ and so be sick as he was; no, I will make my pleasure last a
+ great deal longer.' So he took the cake, which he could hardly
+ lift by reason of its weight, and watched the opportunity of
+ slipping up into his chamber with it, where his box was, and
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page395" id="page395"></a>[pg
+ 395]</span> in which he put it under lock and key. At playtime
+ every day he slipped away from his companions, went upstairs
+ a-tiptoe, cut a tolerable slice off, swallowed it, put by the
+ rest, and then came down and mixed again with his companions.
+ He continued this clandestine business all the week, and even
+ then the cake was hardly half consumed. But what ensued? At
+ last the cake grew dry, and quickly after moldy; nay, the very
+ maggots got into it, and by that means had their share; on
+ which account it was not then worth eating, and our young
+ curmudgeon was compelled to fling the rest away with great
+ reluctance. However, no one grieved for him."</p>
+
+ <p><i>Percival</i>. No, indeed; nor I, father. What, keep a
+ cake locked up seven days together, and not give one's friends
+ a bit! That is monstrous! But let us have the other now.</p>
+
+ <p>"There was another little gentleman who went to school with
+ Henry and Francis likewise, and his name was Gratian. His
+ mother sent him a cake one day, because she loved him, and,
+ indeed, he loved her also very much. It was no sooner come than
+ Gratian thus addressed his young companions: 'Come and look at
+ what mother has sent me; you must every one eat with me.' They
+ scarcely needed such a welcome piece of information twice, but
+ all got round the cake, as you have doubtless seen the bees
+ resorting to a flower just blown. As Gratian was provided with
+ a knife, he cut a great piece off, and then divided it into as
+ many shares as he had brought boys together by such a courteous
+ invitation. Gratian then took up the rest, and told them that
+ he would eat his piece next day; on which he put it up, and
+ went to play with his companions, who were all solicitous to
+ have him choose whatever game he thought might entertain him
+ most.</p>
+
+ <p>"A quarter of an hour had scarcely passed as they were
+ playing, when a poor old man, who had a fiddle, came into the
+ yard.</p>
+
+ <p>"He had a very long white beard, and, being blind, was
+ guided by a little dog, who went before him with a collar round
+ his neck. To this a cord was fastened, which the poor blind man
+ held in his hand.</p>
+
+ <p>"It was noticed with how much dexterity the little dog
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page396" id="page396"></a>[pg
+ 396]</span> conducted him, and how he shook a bell, which, I
+ forgot to say, hung underneath his collar, when he came near
+ any one, as if he had designed to say by such an action, 'Do
+ not throw down or run against my master.' Being come into the
+ yard, he sat him down upon a stone, and, hearing several
+ children talking round him, 'My dear little gentlemen,' said
+ he, 'I will play you all the pretty tunes that I know, if you
+ will give me leave.' The children wished for nothing half so
+ much. He put his violin in tune, and then thrummed over several
+ jigs and other scraps of music, which, it was easy to
+ conjecture, had been new in former times.</p>
+
+ <p>"Little Gratian saw that while he played his merriest airs,
+ a tear would now and then roll down his cheeks, on which he
+ stopped to ask him why he wept?</p>
+
+ <p>"'Because,' said the musician, 'I am very hungry. I have no
+ one in the world that will give my dog or me a bit of of
+ anything to eat. I wish I could but work, and get for both of
+ us a morsel of something; but I have lost my strength and
+ sight. Alas! I labored hard till I was old, and now I want
+ bread.'</p>
+
+ <p>"The generous Gratian, hearing this, wept too. He did not
+ say a word, but ran to fetch the cake which he had designed to
+ eat himself. He brought it out with joy, and, as he ran along,
+ began: 'Here, good old man, here is some cake for you.'</p>
+
+ <p>"'Where?' replied the poor musician, feeling with his hands;
+ 'where is it? For I am blind, and cannot see you.'</p>
+
+ <p>"Gratian put the cake into his hand, when, laying down his
+ fiddle on the ground, he wiped his eyes, and then began to eat.
+ At every piece he put into his mouth, he gave his faithful
+ little dog a bit, who came and ate out of his hand; and
+ Gratian, standing by him, smiled with pleasure at the thought
+ of having fed the poor old man when he was hungry."</p>
+
+ <p><i>Percival</i>. Oh, the good, good Gratian! Let me have
+ your knife, father.</p>
+
+ <p><i>Mr. G.</i> Here, Percival; but why my knife?</p>
+
+ <p><i>Percival</i>. I will tell you. I have only nibbled here a
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page397" id="page397"></a>[pg
+ 397]</span> little of my cake, so pleased I was in listening to
+ you! So I will cut it smooth. There, see how well I have
+ ordered it! These scraps, together with the currants, will be
+ more than I shall want for breakfast; and the first poor man
+ that I meet going home shall have the rest, even though he
+ should not play upon the violin.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page398"
+ id="page398"></a>[pg 398]</span>
+
+ <h3>AMENDMENT</h3>
+
+ <p>Charles Grant lived in a good house, and wore fine clothes,
+ and had a great many pretty toys to play with; yet Charles was
+ seldom happy or pleased; for he was never good. He did not mind
+ what his mother said to him, and would not learn to read,
+ though he was now seven years old.</p>
+
+ <p>He called the servants names, pinched and beat his little
+ sister Clara, and took away her playthings, and was not kind
+ and good to her, as a brother should be. "Oh, what a sad boy
+ Charles is!" was his mother's daily bitter exclamation.</p>
+
+ <p>His father was a proud, bad man, who let Charles have his
+ own way, because he was his only son, and he thought him
+ handsome. But how could anyone be handsome that was so naughty?
+ I am sure that when he was froward, and put out his lip, and
+ frowned, he looked quite ugly. Mother told him so, and said
+ that no one was pretty that was not good; but Charles did not
+ mind his mother, and was so vain he would stand before the
+ looking-glass half the day, instead of learning his lessons;
+ and was so silly he would say, "What a pretty little boy I am!
+ I am glad I am not a shabby boy, like Giles Bloomfield, our
+ cowboy." At such times his mother would say to him: "I wish,
+ Charles, you were only half as good as Giles; he is not much
+ older than you, yet he can read in the Bible quite well; he
+ works hard for his poor mother, and never vexes her, as you do
+ me; and when he comes home of an evening, he nurses the baby,
+ and is kind to all his sisters. I dare say he never pinched nor
+ beat any of them in his life."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh!" said that wicked Charles, "I hate him for all that,
+ for he wears ragged clothes, and has no toys to play with."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh fie, Charles!" said his mother; "you are a wicked boy:
+ have not I often told you that God made the poor as well as the
+ rich, and He will hate those who despise them? Now, Charles, if
+ God, to punish you for your pride, were to take away your
+ father and me, and you had no money to buy food, and
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page399" id="page399"></a>[pg
+ 399]</span> your clothes became old and ragged, you would then
+ be a poor, shabby boy, and worse off than Giles; for you could
+ not earn your own living, as he does; and you would
+ consequently be starved to death if God did not take care of
+ you. And if, while you were rich, you hated the poor, how could
+ you expect God to care for you when you grew poor, like those
+ you had scorned?"</p>
+
+ <p>But Charles, however, was so naughty he would not stay to
+ hear what his mother said, but ran away into the fields.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Charles's mother was so vexed that she could not help
+ crying at his being such a wicked, proud boy; and she could not
+ sleep all that night for the grief his conduct had occasioned
+ her. The next day she was forced to take a long journey to
+ visit a friend who was very ill, and who lived in London. She
+ was very sorry to leave her children, for she knew if Charles
+ behaved naughty when she was with him, he would be a sad boy
+ indeed when he was left to himself, and had none to correct him
+ and tell him of his faults.</p>
+
+ <p>When the carriage that was to take Mrs. Grant to London
+ drove to the door, she kissed her children a great many times,
+ and begged that they would be very good while she was away from
+ them.</p>
+
+ <p>"You, my dear Clara, I know, will mind what nurse says to
+ you, and will try to be good while I am gone; for you know that
+ God will see everything you do amiss, if I do not; and I hope
+ you will never forget to say your prayers to Him night and
+ morning."</p>
+
+ <p>Clara kissed her dear mother, and promised that she would
+ attend to all she said; and her mother was satisfied, for she
+ knew that Clara never told stories, though she was but a little
+ girl.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Mrs. Grant turned to Charles, and said: "As for you,
+ Charles, I cannot help feeling great pain at leaving you; for
+ you are such a bad, wilful boy that I shall not have a happy
+ moment while I am away from you, lest you should do anything
+ amiss. But if you love me, you will try to be good; and
+ whenever you are about to do anything wrong, say to yourself,
+ 'How much this would grieve my poor mother if she knew it! and
+ how much it will offend God, who does see, and knows,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page400" id="page400"></a>[pg
+ 400]</span> not only everything I do, but even my most secret
+ thoughts! And He will one day bring me to an account for all I
+ do or say against His holy will and my kind parents'
+ commands.'"</p>
+
+ <p>Charles, who knew he was a bad boy, hung down his head, for
+ he did not like to be told of his faults.</p>
+
+ <p>Then his mother said: "My dear Charles, do try and be good,
+ and I will love you dearly."</p>
+
+ <p>"But what will you bring me from London," said Charles, "if
+ I am a good boy? for I never will behave well for nothing."</p>
+
+ <p>"Do you call the love of God and of dear mother nothing?"
+ said Clara; "I will behave well, even if mother forgets to
+ bring me the great wax doll, and the chest of drawers to keep
+ her clothes in, which she told me about yesterday."</p>
+
+ <p>Mrs. Grant smiled fondly on her little girl, but made no
+ reply to Charles; and soon the coach drove away from the
+ door.</p>
+
+ <p>Charles was very glad when his mother was gone, and he said:
+ "Now mother is gone to London, I will do just as I please: I
+ will learn no ugly lessons, but play all day long. How happy I
+ shall be! I hope mother may not come for a whole month."</p>
+
+ <p>But Charles soon found he was not so happy as he thought he
+ should have been; he did not know the reason, but I will tell
+ you why he was not happy. No one can be happy who is not good,
+ and Charles was so naughty as to resolve not to obey his kind
+ mother, who loved him so much.</p>
+
+ <p>Charles brought out all his toys to play with, but he soon
+ grew weary of them, and he kicked them under the table, saying,
+ "Nasty dull toys, I hate you, for you do not amuse me or make
+ me happy. I will go to father, and ask him to give me something
+ to please me that I am not used to."</p>
+
+ <p>But father was busy with some friends in the study, and
+ could not attend to his wants. Charles was a rude, tiresome
+ boy; so he stood by his father, and shook his chair, and pulled
+ his sleeve, and teased him so much that his father at last grew
+ angry, and turned him out of the room.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Charles stood and kicked at the door, and screamed with
+ all his might, when one of the gentlemen said to him: "If you
+ were my little boy, I would give you something to cry
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page401" id="page401"></a>[pg
+ 401]</span> for." So Charles's father told him if he did not go
+ away, he would come out of the study and whip him.</p>
+
+ <p>When Charles heard this, he ran away, for he was afraid of
+ being beaten; but, instead of playing quietly with his toys, he
+ went and laid under the great table in the hall and sulked and
+ fretted till dinner-time.</p>
+
+ <p>When nurse came to call him to dinner, he said: "I won't
+ come; Go away, ugly nurse!"</p>
+
+ <p>Then said nurse: "Master Charles, if you like to punish
+ yourself by going without your dinner, no one will prevent you,
+ I am sure."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Charles began to cry aloud, and tried to tear nurse's
+ apron; but nurse told him he was a bad boy, and left him.</p>
+
+ <p>Now, when Clara sat down to dinner, she said to nurse:
+ "Where is brother Charles? Why is he not here?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Miss Clara, he is a naughty child," said nurse, "and
+ chooses to go without his dinner, thinking to vex us; but he
+ hurts no one but himself with his perverse temper."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then," said Clara, "I do not like to dine while Charles
+ goes without; so I will try and persuade him to come and eat
+ some pie."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, Miss Clara," said nurse, "you may go, if you please;
+ but I would leave the bad boy to himself."</p>
+
+ <p>When Clara came to Charles, and asked him if he would come
+ and eat his dinner, he poked out his head, and made such an
+ ugly face that she was quite frightened at him, and ran
+ away.</p>
+
+ <p>Nurse did not take the trouble of calling him to tea; and,
+ though he was very hungry, he was too sulky to come without
+ being asked; so he lay under the table, and cried aloud till
+ bedtime. But when it grew dark, he was afraid to stay by
+ himself, for bad children are always fearful; so he came
+ upstairs and said in a cross, rude tone of voice: "Nurse, give
+ me something to eat."</p>
+
+ <p>Nurse said: "Master Charles, if you had been good, you would
+ have had some chicken and some apple-pie for your dinner, and
+ bread and butter and cake for your tea; but as you were such a
+ bad boy, and would not come to your meals, I shall
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page402" id="page402"></a>[pg
+ 402]</span> only give you a piece of dry bread and a cup of
+ milk, and you do not deserve even that."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Charles made one of his very worst faces, and threw the
+ bread on the ground, and spilt the milk.</p>
+
+ <p>Nurse told him that there were many poor children in the
+ world who would be glad of the smallest morsel of what he so
+ much despised, and that the time would come when he might want
+ the very worst bit of it; and she bade him kneel down and say
+ his prayers, and ask God to forgive him for having been such a
+ wicked boy all day.</p>
+
+ <p>But Charles did not mind what she said, and went crying to
+ bed. Thus ended the first day of Charles Grant's happiness.</p>
+
+ <p>He awoke very early the next morning, and told nurse to get
+ him his breakfast, for he was very hungry. But nurse said he
+ must wait till eight o'clock, which was the breakfast hour.</p>
+
+ <p>He now found it was of no use sulking, as no one seemed to
+ care for his tempers; so he looked about for something to eat,
+ but found nothing but the piece of bread he had thrown on the
+ ground the night before; and he was glad to eat that, and only
+ wished there had been more of it.</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as breakfast was over, Clara brought her books, and
+ began to learn her lessons, and nurse asked Charles if he would
+ do the same. But Charles said, "No, indeed! I do not mean to
+ learn any lessons while mother is away, for I mean to please
+ myself and be happy."</p>
+
+ <p>"You did as you pleased yesterday, Master Charles," said
+ nurse; "yet I do not think you were so very happy, unless
+ happiness consists in lying under a table and crying all day,
+ and going without dinner and tea, merely to indulge a sullen,
+ froward temper."</p>
+
+ <p>Now, Charles hated to be told of his faults, so he left
+ nurse, and went into the garden to try and amuse himself. When
+ there, instead of keeping in the walks, as he ought to have
+ done, he ran on the beds, trampled down the flowers, and pulled
+ the blossoms from the fruit-trees.</p>
+
+ <p>The gardener's boy earnestly requested Charles not to do so
+ much mischief; but Charles told him he was a gentleman's son,
+ and would do as he pleased. So he again ran over the new-raked
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page403" id="page403"></a>[pg
+ 403]</span> borders, and pulled up the flowers; and the poor
+ boy was sadly vexed to see his nice work all spoiled.</p>
+
+ <p>Charles did not care for that, and would have behaved still
+ worse, had not the gardener, who then came up, taken him in his
+ arms, and carried him into the house, in spite of his kicking
+ and screaming. He cried for a long time, and made a sad noise;
+ but, finding that no one paid any regard to him, he became
+ quiet, and went into the nursery, and asked Clara to come and
+ play with him.</p>
+
+ <p>"I cannot come just now, brother Charles," said she; "for I
+ want to finish this frock that I am making for Giles
+ Bloomfield's little sister."</p>
+
+ <p>"I am sure," said Charles, "if I were you, I would much
+ rather play than sit still and sew."</p>
+
+ <p>"Not if you knew what pleasure there is in doing good," said
+ Clara; "but if you will wait till I have finished it, you shall
+ go with me and give it to the poor woman, and then you will see
+ how pleased she will be, and how nicely the baby will look when
+ she is dressed in this pretty frock, instead of her old faded,
+ ragged one."</p>
+
+ <p>Charles did not know how to amuse himself, so he sat down on
+ his little stool, and watched his sister while she worked.</p>
+
+ <p>When Clara had finished making the frock, she said: "Thank
+ you, dear nurse, for cutting out and fixing the frock for me."
+ So she threw her arms round nurse's neck, and kissed her cheek;
+ and nurse put on Clara's tippet and her new bonnet, and walked
+ with Charles and her to Dame Bloomfield's cottage.</p>
+
+ <p>The good woman took the baby out of the cradle, and laid it
+ on Clara's lap, and Clara had the pleasure of dressing it
+ herself in the nice new frock; and the baby looked so neat and
+ pretty, and the poor mother was so pleased, that Clara was much
+ happier than if she had spent her time in playing or working
+ for her doll.</p>
+
+ <p>While Clara was nursing and caressing the baby, Charles went
+ into the little garden, where he found Giles Bloomfield, who
+ had just returned from working in the fields, with a beautiful
+ milk-white rabbit in his arms, which he had taken out of the
+ hutch, and was nursing with much
+ affection.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page404"
+ id="page404"></a>[pg 404]</span>
+
+ <p>"Oh, what a pretty rabbit!" said Charles. "Giles, will you
+ sell it to me?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, Master Charles," said Giles, "I cannot sell my pretty
+ Snowball."</p>
+
+ <p>"And why not?" asked Charles in a fretful tone.</p>
+
+ <p>"Because, Master Charles, the old doe, its mother, died when
+ Snowball was only a week old, and I reared it by feeding it
+ with warm milk and bran; and it is now so fond of me that I
+ would not part with it for a great deal."</p>
+
+ <p>So saying, he stroked his pretty favorite, who licked his
+ hand all over, and rubbed her soft white head against his
+ fingers.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Giles said: "My dear Snowball, I would not sell you for
+ the world."</p>
+
+ <p>"But you shall sell Snowball to me," said Charles, making
+ one of his ugly faces. "I will give you a shilling for her; and
+ if you do not let me carry her home this very day, I will tell
+ father of you, and he will turn you out of the cottage."</p>
+
+ <p>When Giles's mother heard Charles say so, she came out of
+ the house, and said: "Pray, Giles, let Master Charles have the
+ rabbit."</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear mother," said Giles, "Master Charles has a pony and a
+ dog, and a great many fine toys to play with, and I have only
+ my pretty Snowball; and it will break my heart to part with
+ her."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then," said his mother, "would you rather see your mother
+ and sisters turned out of doors than part with your rabbit? You
+ know, Giles, that I had so many expenses with your poor
+ father's illness and death that I have not paid the rent due
+ last quarter-day; and you know it is in our landlord's power to
+ turn us into the streets to-morrow."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, mother," cried Giles, bursting into tears, "Master
+ Charles must have the rabbit. But oh!" continued he, "he does
+ not love you as I do, my pretty Snowball; he will not feed and
+ take care of you as I have done, and you will soon die, and I
+ shall never see you again." And his tears fell fast on the
+ white head of his little pet as he spoke.</p>
+
+ <p>Clara was quite grieved, and begged her naughty brother
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page405" id="page405"></a>[pg
+ 405]</span> not to deprive poor Giles of his rabbit; but
+ Charles was a wicked and covetous boy; he therefore took
+ Snowball from Giles, and carried her home in his arms, and put
+ her in a box. He went into the fields and gathered some green
+ herbs for her to eat, and said: "I am glad I have got Snowball;
+ now I shall be quite happy."</p>
+
+ <p>But how could Charles be happy when he had broken God's holy
+ commandment, which says, "Thou shalt not covet?" Nurse and
+ Clara told him so, and begged him to give Snowball back again
+ to Giles. But Charles said he would not, for he meant to keep
+ her all his life; but the next morning, when he went into the
+ stable to look at her, he found her stretched at the bottom of
+ the box. He called her, but Snowball did not stir; he then took
+ her out of the box to see what ailed her; but she was quite
+ cold and dead.</p>
+
+ <p>Oh dear! how Charles did cry! But it was of no use. He had
+ better not have taken her away from Giles, for he did not know
+ what to feed her with, and had given her among the greens he
+ had gathered a herb called hemlock, which is poisonous and will
+ kill whatever eats of it; and it had killed poor Snowball.</p>
+
+ <p>The coachman told Charles so when he saw how swollen she
+ was, and Charles cried the more. Giles cried too when he heard
+ what a sad death poor Snowball had died; but he had been a good
+ dutiful boy in parting with her when his mother wished it,
+ though it had cost him much pain and many tears.</p>
+
+ <p>Well, Charles's mother was gone a long time, more than a
+ month, and it would quite shock you to be told how naughty
+ Charles was all that time; at last a letter came to say she was
+ very ill, and then another to tell them she was dead.</p>
+
+ <p>What would Charles then have given if he had not grieved her
+ so often with his perverse temper and wicked conduct? He now
+ said when he saw her again, he would beg her to forgive him;
+ but when Charles did see his poor mother again she was in her
+ coffin and could not hear him; and he cried exceedingly, and
+ wished he had been good. Clara, though she cried as much as
+ Charles for her dear mother, was glad she had obeyed her, and
+ been so good while she was
+ away.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page406"
+ id="page406"></a>[pg 406]</span>
+
+ <p>"And I will always be as good as if dear mother could see
+ me, and love me for it too," said she to nurse the day after
+ her mother was buried.</p>
+
+ <p>"My dear young lady," said nurse, "your mother <i>will</i>
+ see it, and love you for doing your duty."</p>
+
+ <p>"How can dear mother see me? Her eyes are closed, and she is
+ in the dark grave," said Clara.</p>
+
+ <p>"But she will see you from heaven, Miss Clara, where she is
+ gone to receive the reward of her good conduct in this world;
+ for though her body is in the earth, her spirit is in
+ heaven."</p>
+
+ <p>"And shall I never see my own dear mother again?" said
+ Clara.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, Miss Clara; if you are good, you will go to heaven
+ when you die, and become an angel like her."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then," said Clara, "I will pray to God to make me good, and
+ when I am going to do anything wrong I will say to myself, 'If
+ I do this, I shall never go to heaven, and see my dear mother
+ when I die.'"</p>
+
+ <p>"I wish," said nurse, "that Master Charles was like you, and
+ would try to be good."</p>
+
+ <p>But though Charles was sometimes sorry for his bad behavior,
+ he did not try to mend, because he thought it was too much
+ trouble to be good, and said he did not care, because he was
+ the son of a gentleman.</p>
+
+ <p>Charles did not know that at this very time his father had
+ spent all his money, and owed a great many debts to different
+ people; and at last he ran away that he might not be put in
+ prison; and the people to whom he owed so much money came and
+ seized his fine house and gardens, and the coach, and all the
+ furniture, and sold them by auction, to raise money to pay the
+ debts; so Charles found that, instead of being rich, he was now
+ very, very poor.</p>
+
+ <p>When the auction was over and all the things were sold, and
+ it was getting quite dark (for it was in the month of
+ November), Clara and Charles stood in one of the empty parlors,
+ and wondered what they should do for supper, and where they
+ should sleep that night; for all the beds were sold, and they
+ saw the servants go away one after
+ another.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page407"
+ id="page407"></a>[pg 407]</span>
+
+ <p>At last nurse came in with her bonnet and cloak, and said:
+ "Miss Clara, I am going away to my own cottage, and as you have
+ always been a kind, good child, you shall go with me, and I
+ will take care of you."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Clara said, "Thank you; but will you not take Charles
+ also?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No," said nurse; "he has always been such a proud bad boy
+ that I will not take him. I have very little to spare, for I am
+ a poor woman, and what I have is not more than will keep my own
+ children and you, Miss Clara."</p>
+
+ <p>Saying this, she got into the cart, and took Clara on her
+ lap, and one of the footmen got in after her, and drove away
+ from the door.</p>
+
+ <p>Charles stood on the step of the door, and looked after them
+ till they were out of sight; and then he began to cry as if his
+ heart would break. The servant of the gentleman who had
+ purchased the house came and locked the door, so Charles could
+ not get in any more, and he sat down on the stone steps, and
+ covered his face with his hands, and cried bitterly.</p>
+
+ <p>"Unhappy child that I am," sobbed he; "what will become of
+ me? Oh, if I had but been good like Clara, I should have found
+ a friend, as she has; but no one cares what becomes of me,
+ because I have been so wicked. I used to despise the poor, and
+ God, to punish me, has made me poor indeed."</p>
+
+ <p>It was very cold, and the snow began to fall fast, and it
+ grew quite dark. Charles rested his head on his knees, and was
+ afraid to look round; his clothes were almost wet through, and
+ his limbs were benumbed with cold; he had no place where he
+ could ask shelter, for no one loved him; and he thought he
+ should be obliged to stay there all night, and perhaps be
+ frozen to death.</p>
+
+ <p>Just then some one softly touched his hand, and said:
+ "Master Charles, I have been looking for you for more than an
+ hour."</p>
+
+ <p>Charles looked up; but when he saw it was Giles Bloomfield
+ who had come to seek him in his distress, he remembered how ill
+ he had behaved to him, so he hid his face, and began to weep
+ afresh.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page408"
+ id="page408"></a>[pg 408]</span>
+
+ <p>Then Giles sat down by him on the steps, and said: "Dear
+ Master Charles, you must not stay here. See how fast it snows.
+ You will catch your death of cold."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, I am very cold and hungry," sobbed Charles, "but I
+ have no home now; I have nowhere else to go, and must stay here
+ all night."</p>
+
+ <p>"No, Master Charles," said Giles, "you shall come home with
+ me, and shall share my supper and my bed, though it is not such
+ as you have been used to; notwithstanding we are very poor, we
+ will do our best to make you comfortable."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, Giles!" said Charles, throwing his arms round Giles's
+ neck, "I do not deserve this kindness; I have been such a
+ proud, wicked boy, and have treated you so ill. I am sure you
+ can never forgive me for having taken your pretty Snowball; and
+ if <i>you</i> forgive me, I can never forgive myself."</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear Master Charles, do not think of that now," said Giles,
+ taking both Charles's cold hands in his. "Indeed, Master
+ Charles, I should never dare say my prayers if I was so wicked
+ as to bear malice; and, now you are in distress, I would do
+ anything in my power to serve you. So pray come home with me,
+ and warm yourself, and get some supper."</p>
+
+ <p>But Charles hid his face on Giles's bosom, and cried the
+ more; at last he said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Giles, I am so ashamed of having behaved so cruelly to you,
+ that I can never go to your home, and eat the food that you are
+ obliged to labor so hard for."</p>
+
+ <p>"Master Charles," said Giles, "that is because you are so
+ proud."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh no, no!" sobbed Charles, "I am not proud now, and I
+ think I shall never be proud again." So he kissed Giles, and
+ they both went home to Dame Bloomfield's cottage together.</p>
+
+ <p>When Giles's mother saw Charles, she said: "Why did you
+ bring this proud, cross, young gentleman here, Giles?"</p>
+
+ <p>Charles, when he heard her say so, thought he should be
+ turned out again into the cold, and began to cry afresh; but
+ Giles said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear mother, Master Charles has no home to go to now;
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page409" id="page409"></a>[pg
+ 409]</span> he is cold and hungry; I am sure you will let him
+ stay here, and share my bed and my supper."</p>
+
+ <p>"He can stay here if he likes," said Dame Bloomfield; "but
+ you know, Giles, we are forced to work hard for what food we
+ have, and I am sure we cannot afford to maintain Master
+ Charles."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then," said Giles, "he shall have my supper to-night: he
+ wants it more than I do, for he has had no food all day."</p>
+
+ <p>"You may please yourself about that, Giles: but remember, if
+ you give your food to Master Charles, you must go without
+ yourself."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well," said Giles, "I shall feel more pleasure in giving my
+ supper to Master Charles than in eating it myself."</p>
+
+ <p>So he brought a stool, and, placing it in the warmest corner
+ by the fire, made Charles sit down, and chafed his cold frozen
+ hands, and tried to comfort him; for Charles was greatly
+ afflicted when he saw that everyone hated him; but he knew that
+ it was his own fault, and a just punishment for his pride and
+ bad conduct.</p>
+
+ <p>When Giles brought his basin of hot milk and bread for his
+ supper, he could not thank him for crying; and he was ashamed
+ to eat it while Giles went without; but he was so hungry, and
+ the milk looked so nice, that he did not know how to refuse it;
+ and Giles begged him so earnestly to eat that at last he did
+ so, and once more felt warm and comfortable.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Giles said to him: "Now, Master Charles, will you go to
+ bed? Mine is but a coarse, hard bed, but it is very clean." So
+ he took the lamp to show Charles the way to the chamber in
+ which he was to sleep.</p>
+
+ <p>Charles was surprised at seeing no staircase, but only a
+ ladder. Giles laughed when he saw how Charles stared, and he
+ said:</p>
+
+ <p>"You have been used to live in a grand house, Master
+ Charles, and know nothing of the shifts the poor are forced to
+ make."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Charles climbed up the ladder, and Giles showed him a
+ little room, not much larger than a closet, with no furniture
+ in it, but a stump bed without any hangings, and covered
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page410" id="page410"></a>[pg
+ 410]</span> with a coarse, woolen rug. Charles Grant had never
+ even seen such a bed before, but he was thankful that he could
+ get any place to sleep in, out of the cold and snow.</p>
+
+ <p>Giles helped Charles to undress, for Charles was so helpless
+ he did not know how to undress himself. When he was going to
+ step into bed, Giles exclaimed:</p>
+
+ <p>"Will you not say your prayers before you go to bed, Master
+ Charles?"</p>
+
+ <p>Charles blushed and hung down his head, for he had been so
+ naughty that he had not said his prayers for a long time past,
+ and had almost forgotten what his dear mother had taught him;
+ and he told Giles so at last.</p>
+
+ <p>"Dear, dear!" said Giles, "I never dare go to bed without
+ saying mine."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Charles said: "I am sorry I have been so naughty as to
+ forget my prayers; will you teach me yours, and I will never
+ forget them again?"</p>
+
+ <p>Then they both knelt down by the side of the little bed, and
+ Giles taught Charles such prayers as he knew, and Charles went
+ to bed much happier than he had been for a long time.</p>
+
+ <p>Though the bed was hard, and the sheets brown and coarse,
+ Charles was so weary that he soon fell asleep, and slept so
+ soundly that he did not awake till it was broad day, and Giles
+ was up and gone to work in the fields.</p>
+
+ <p>When Charles looked round he thought he had never seen such
+ a shabby room in his life. There was not so much as a chair or
+ table or carpet in it; he could see all the thatch and the
+ rafters in the roof, for the chamber was not even ceiled, but
+ showed the thatch and rafters, and, as I said before, there was
+ not a single article of furniture in the room, except the bed.
+ How different from the pretty little chamber in which Charles
+ used to sleep, with the nice white dimity window-curtains and
+ hangings and mahogany tent-bed, with such comfortable bedding
+ and handsome white counterpane! However, he now thought himself
+ very fortunate that he had any roof to shelter him, or any bed,
+ however homely it might be, on which he could sleep.</p>
+
+ <p>He thought he should like to get up and go downstairs,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page411" id="page411"></a>[pg
+ 411]</span> but he had always been used to have a servant to
+ dress him, and he did not know how to dress himself, so while
+ he was considering what he should do Giles came into the
+ chamber. He had returned to get his breakfast, and not seeing
+ Charles downstairs he concluded the cause of his absence, and
+ came to assist him to dress. Charles observed how this matter
+ was arranged, and resolved to do it for himself the next
+ morning.</p>
+
+ <p>When he was dressed they both knelt down by the bedside and
+ said their prayers, for though Giles had said his at the dawn
+ of day, yet he never omitted an opportunity of repeating his
+ thanksgivings and praises to his heavenly Father for the
+ mercies and blessings which he enjoyed through His grace, for
+ Giles possessed a grateful and contented heart, which made him
+ look upon that state of life unto which it had pleased God to
+ call him, as that which was meet and fit for him, so he worked
+ hard, and ate the bread of labor with cheerfulness and
+ satisfaction.</p>
+
+ <p>When Charles and Giles joined the family below Dame
+ Bloomfield set a porringer of milk and a piece of brown bread
+ for every one but Charles, who looked ready to cry, but Giles
+ put his porringer before him, and gave him another spoon, and
+ said: "Master Charles, we will eat together, for there will be
+ enough for both of us." The tears came into Charles's eyes, and
+ he whispered: "Dear Giles, you are very good." So these boys
+ ate out of the same porringer, and broke of the same bread.</p>
+
+ <p>After breakfast Giles went out to work, and Charles thought
+ it very dull till he returned to dinner. When Dame Bloomfield
+ gave her children their dinners there was a dumpling for
+ everyone but Charles; then Giles cut his dumpling in half, and
+ gave one part to Charles, and ate the other half himself. Now
+ this was very good of Giles, for he was very hungry himself,
+ but he could not bear to see Charles sad and hungry while he
+ was eating, and Giles liked to do good because he knew it was
+ pleasing to God.</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as dinner was over, Giles went out to work again,
+ and Charles was as dull as he had been in the morning, for all
+ the family were at work in some way or other, and could not
+ spare time to amuse or talk to him, and he did nothing but
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page412" id="page412"></a>[pg
+ 412]</span> sigh and fret to himself till evening, when Giles
+ came home from work.</p>
+
+ <p>Giles's eldest sister made a bright fire, and they all sat
+ round it and talked and told stories, and Giles nursed the
+ baby, and played with the other little ones, and seemed quite
+ happy, and so he was, for he had done his duty, and every one
+ loved him for being so good.</p>
+
+ <p>After supper Giles taught those of his sisters who were old
+ enough to read and write, and when they had finished learning
+ their tasks Charles took up the book, and said: "Giles, will
+ you teach me to read?" and Giles said: "Certainly, Master
+ Charles, but I am sure you must know how to read a great deal
+ better than such a poor boy as I am."</p>
+
+ <p>"I might have done so," said Charles, "but Giles, I was a
+ sad, naughty, perverse boy, and hated to learn any thing that
+ was good; but I hope I know better now, and if you will only
+ take the trouble of teaching me I will try and make up for my
+ lost time."</p>
+
+ <p>So Giles gave Charles a lesson that very night, and every
+ evening after supper he heard him read and spell what he had
+ learned during the day, and Charles took such pains that he
+ soon began to read so well that he used to amuse himself by
+ reading pretty stories, and by teaching little Betty, one of
+ Giles's youngest sisters, to read.</p>
+
+ <p>Still Charles used to be exceedingly hungry, for he had not
+ more than half the quantity of food he was used to eat, and
+ Giles was hungry too, and grew pale and thin.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Charles said to himself: "It is not right for me to eat
+ the bread which poor Giles works so hard to earn; I will try
+ and get my own living, for why should I not do so, as well as
+ Giles?" So one morning, when Giles rose, as usual, at five
+ o'clock, Charles got up too. Then Giles said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Why do you rise so early this cold morning, Master
+ Charles?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Because I am going out to work with you, Giles, if you will
+ permit me," answered Charles.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, Master Charles, such work as I do is not fit for a
+ young gentleman like you," said
+ Giles.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page413"
+ id="page413"></a>[pg 413]</span>
+
+ <p>"You must not call me a young gentleman <i>now</i>, for I am
+ only a poor boy, and poorer than other poor boys, for they can
+ earn their own living, while I should have been starved to
+ death had not you given me half of the bread you work so hard
+ for. But I will not be a burthen to you any longer, but learn
+ to work and get my own living as you do."</p>
+
+ <p>Charles now meant to keep his word, and they both went out
+ into the fields, and worked together at picking stones off the
+ young crops of wheat and clover, and before breakfast. Giles
+ had picked up two bushels of stones and Charles one, and the
+ farmer gave them a penny per bushel for gathering them up.</p>
+
+ <p>Then they made haste back to the cottage, and Giles gave his
+ mother the money he had earned, and Charles did the same, and
+ when the dame poured out the milk for the family Charles saw
+ that she filled a porringer for him also, and they had all a
+ good breakfast that morning, and Charles felt quite happy
+ because he had not eaten the bread of idleness. So he went out
+ to work with Giles again, and earned twopence before
+ dinner.</p>
+
+ <p>When Dame Bloomfield took up the dumplings Charles saw there
+ was one for him, and he felt happy that poor Giles had not to
+ deprive himself of half his food that he might eat.</p>
+
+ <p>Charles went out to work every day with Giles, and in the
+ evening he learned to read and write. He became quite good and
+ gentle, and enjoyed more happiness than he had experienced in
+ his life before, And why was Charles happy? I will tell you, my
+ dear children. Because he was no longer a proud, froward boy as
+ he had been, but was kind and sweet-tempered to every one, and
+ did his duty both to God and himself.</p>
+
+ <p>The winter passed swiftly away, and the spring came, and the
+ birds began to sing, and the trees looked green and gay, and
+ the pretty flowers bloomed in the gardens and covered the
+ meadows all over, and scented the air with their fragrance, and
+ Charles thought it very pleasant to work in the fields, and
+ hear the birds sing as they tended their young, or built their
+ nests among the green boughs or in the
+ hedges.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page414"
+ id="page414"></a>[pg 414]</span>
+
+ <p>One day Giles said to Charles: "Master Charles, we cannot
+ work together in the fields any more; I have got a new
+ employment"</p>
+
+ <p>"But why cannot I work with you?" asked Charles.</p>
+
+ <p>"Because, sir, you will not like to work where I am going,"
+ answered Giles. Charles asked where that was. "In the garden of
+ the great house, Master Charles, where you used to live," said
+ Giles.</p>
+
+ <p>Charles looked very sorrowful, and remained silent for some
+ minutes; at last he said: "Well, Giles, I will go with you; my
+ clothes are grown shabby now, and nobody will know me, and if
+ they did I hope I am too wise to be ashamed of doing my duty,
+ so let us go directly."</p>
+
+ <p>Then Giles took Charles into the garden, and the gardener
+ gave them each a hoe and a rake, and told them to hoe up the
+ weeds on the flower borders, and then rake them neatly over,
+ and promised if they worked well he would give them eight-pence
+ per day.</p>
+
+ <p>Now this was much pleasanter than picking stones in the
+ field, but Charles was very sad, and could not refrain from
+ shedding tears when he thought of the time when he used to play
+ in that very garden, and he thought, too, of his dear mamma who
+ was dead, and of his sister Clara, whom he had not seen for so
+ many months, but he worked as hard as he could, and the
+ gardener praised them both, and he gave them a basket to put
+ the weeds in, and showed them how to rake the borders
+ smooth.</p>
+
+ <p>Just as they had finished the job, and Charles was saying to
+ Giles, "How neat our work looks!" a little boy, dressed very
+ fine, came into the garden, and, as he passed them, said: "I am
+ glad I am a gentleman's son, and not obliged to work like these
+ dirty boys."</p>
+
+ <p>When Charles thought the little boy was out of hearing, he
+ said to Giles: "That little boy is as wicked as I used to be,
+ and I doubt not but that God will punish him in the same way if
+ he does not mend his manners."</p>
+
+ <p>The little boy, who had overheard what Charles said, was
+ very angry, and made ugly faces, and ran into the newly-raked
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page415" id="page415"></a>[pg
+ 415]</span> beds, and covered them with footmarks. Then Charles
+ said: "I am sorry for you, young gentleman, for I see you are
+ not good."</p>
+
+ <p>"How dare you say I am not good?" said this naughty child.
+ "I am a great deal better than you, for I am a gentleman, and
+ you are only a poor boy."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Charles, his eyes filling with tears as he
+ spoke, "I am, indeed, only a poor boy <i>now</i>, but I was
+ once rich like you, and lived in this very house, and wore fine
+ clothes, and had plenty of toys and money, and was just as
+ proud and naughty as you are, but God, to punish me, took away
+ my parents and all those things that I had been so proud of,
+ and that I had made such a bad use of, and reduced me to a poor
+ boy, as you see."</p>
+
+ <p>When the little boy heard this he looked very serious, and
+ said: "I have been very naughty, but I will do so no more," and
+ he went into the house, and never teased Charles or Giles
+ again.</p>
+
+ <p>A few months after this, when Charles and Giles were working
+ as usual in the garden, they saw a gentleman come down one of
+ the walks, leading by the hand a little girl dressed in a black
+ silk frock and bonnet trimmed with crape.</p>
+
+ <p>"Ah, Giles," said Charles, "how like that young lady is to
+ my sister Clara. I wonder whether I shall ever see my dear
+ sister Clara again."</p>
+
+ <p>"Brother Charles, dear brother Charles, you have not then
+ quite forgotten your sister Clara," said the little girl,
+ throwing her arms round his neck as she spoke.</p>
+
+ <p>When Charles saw that it was, indeed, his own dear sister
+ Clara, he kissed her and cried with joy.</p>
+
+ <p>Then he told Clara all that had happened to him since the
+ day they had parted, and how sorry he had been for all his past
+ conduct, and he asked her who the gentleman was that had
+ brought her into the garden.</p>
+
+ <p>"It is our uncle, dear Charles. You know our dear mother had
+ a brother who lived in India that she used frequently to talk
+ about. Well, when he came home, and heard that mother was dead,
+ and we were in distress, he came to nurse's
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page416" id="page416"></a>[pg
+ 416]</span> cottage, and took me home to his house, and has now
+ come to find you, for he is very good and kind, and loves us
+ both for our dear mother's sake."</p>
+
+ <p>"And will he take me home too?" said Charles.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, my boy," said Charles's uncle, taking him by the hand,
+ "because you are good and kind, and are no longer cross and
+ proud, as I heard you used to be. You shall come home with me
+ this very day, if you please, and I will teach you everything
+ that a young gentleman should know, and you and Clara shall be
+ my children so long as you continue to be deserving of my love,
+ and are not unkind, nor despise those who are beneath you in
+ situation."</p>
+
+ <p>"Indeed, uncle," said Charles, "I can now feel for the poor,
+ and I would rather remain as I am than be rich if I thought I
+ should ever behave as I used to do."</p>
+
+ <p>"My dear child," said his uncle, kissing him with great
+ affection, "continue to think so, and you will never act amiss.
+ The first and greatest step toward amendment is acknowledging
+ our faults. What is passed shall be remembered no more, and I
+ doubt not but that we shall all be happy for the time to
+ come."</p>
+
+ <p>"But uncle," said Charles, laying his hand on his uncle's
+ arm, "I have something to ask of you."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, Charles, and what would you have of me?" said his
+ uncle.</p>
+
+ <p>Then Charles led Giles to his uncle, and related all he had
+ done for him; how he had taken him to his own home, and given
+ him half of his food and his bed, and taught him to read and to
+ work; he, likewise, told his uncle how ill he had behaved to
+ Giles in depriving him of his pretty Snowball, and he said:
+ "Dear uncle, will you allow Giles to share my good fortune, for
+ I cannot be happy while he is in want, and he is better than
+ me, for he returned good for evil."</p>
+
+ <p>Then his uncle said: "Charles, I should not have loved you
+ had you forgotten your kind friend." And he asked Giles if he
+ would like to go to his house and live with him, and spend his
+ time in learning to read and write, and in improving his mind,
+ instead of hard
+ labor.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page417"
+ id="page417"></a>[pg 417]</span>
+
+ <p>"I should like it very much indeed, sir," said Giles, "but I
+ cannot accept your kind offer."</p>
+
+ <p>"And why not, my good little friend?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Because, sir," said Giles, bursting into tears, "my poor
+ mother and sisters must go to the workhouse or starve if I did
+ not stay and work for them, and I could not be happy if I lived
+ in a fine house, and knew they were in want of a bit of bread
+ to eat."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then," said the gentleman smiling, "for your sake they
+ shall never want anything, for I will put them into a cottage
+ of my own, and will take care of them, and you shall live with
+ me, and I will love you as if you were my own child, and
+ remember, Giles, I do this as a reward for your kindness to
+ Charles when he was unhappy and in great distress."</p>
+
+ <p>Charles's uncle was as good as his word, and Giles received
+ the blessings of a good education, while his mother and sisters
+ were maintained by the benevolence of his benefactor.</p>
+
+ <p>Charles was so careful not to relapse into his former errors
+ that he became as remarkable for his gentleness and the
+ goodness of his heart as he had formerly been for his pride and
+ unkindness, and in the diligent performance of his duty, both
+ to God and man, he proved to his uncle the sincerity of his
+ amendment.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page418"
+ id="page418"></a>[pg 418]</span>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/418.jpg" name="fig418s"
+ id="fig418s"><img width="300" src="images/418s.jpg"
+ alt="WIDOW DOROTHY CAREFUL MADE A CURTSEY" /></a><br />
+ widow dorothy careful made a curtsey
+ </div>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h3>TRIAL</h3>
+
+ <p><i>Of a Complaint made against Sundry Persons for Breaking
+ in the Windows of Dorothy Careful, Widow and Dealer in
+ Gingerbread</i></p>
+
+ <h3>By JOHN AIKIN AND MRS. BARBAULD</h3>
+
+ <p>The court being sat, there appeared in person the widow
+ Dorothy Careful to make a complaint against Henry Luckless, and
+ other person or persons unknown, for breaking three panes of
+ glass, value ninepence, in the house of the said widow. Being
+ directed to tell her case to the court, she made a curtsey and
+ began as follows:</p>
+
+ <p>"Please, your lordship, I was sitting at work by my fireside
+ between the hours of six and seven in the evening, just as it
+ was growing dusk, and little Jack was spinning beside me, when
+ all at once crack went the window, and down fell a little
+ basket of cakes that was set up against it. I started up and
+ cried to Jack: 'Bless me, what's the matter?' 'So,' says Jack,
+ 'sombody has thrown a stone and broke the window, and I dare
+ say it is some of the schoolboys.' With that I ran out of the
+ house, and saw some boys making off as fast as they could go.
+ So I ran after them as quick as my old legs would carry me, but
+ I should never have come near them if one had not happened to
+ fall down. Him I caught and brought back to my house, when Jack
+ knew him at once to be Master Henry Luckless. So I told him I
+ would complain of him the next day, and I hope your worship
+ will make him pay the damage, and I think he deserves a good
+ whipping into the bargain for injuring a poor widow woman."</p>
+
+ <p>The Judge, having heard Mrs. Careful's story, desired her to
+ sit down, and then calling up Master Luckless, asked him what
+ he had to say for himself. Luckless appeared with his
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page419" id="page419"></a>[pg
+ 419]</span> face a good deal scratched, and looking very
+ ruefully. After making his bow and sobbing two or three times,
+ he said:</p>
+
+ <p>"My lord, I am as innocent of this matter as any boy in the
+ school, and I am sure I have suffered enough about it already.
+ My lord, Billy Thompson and I were playing in the lane near
+ Mrs. Careful's house when we heard the window crash, and
+ directly after she came running out towards us. Upon this Billy
+ ran away, and I ran too, thinking I might bear the blame. But
+ after running a little way I stumbled over something that lay
+ in the road, and before I could get up again she overtook me,
+ and caught me by the hair, and began lugging and cuffing me. I
+ told her it was not I that broke her window, but it did not
+ signify; so she dragged me to the light, lugging and scratching
+ me all the while, and then said she would inform against me.
+ And that is all I know of the matter."</p>
+
+ <p>"I find, good woman," said the Judge, "you were willing to
+ revenge yourself without waiting for the justice of this
+ court."</p>
+
+ <p>"My lord, I must confess I was put into a passion, and did
+ not properly consider what I was doing."</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, where is Billy Thompson?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Here, my lord."</p>
+
+ <p>"You have heard what Henry Luckless says. Declare upon your
+ honor whether he has spoken the truth."</p>
+
+ <p>"My lord," said Billy, "I am sure neither he nor I had any
+ concern in breaking the window. We were standing together at
+ the time, and I ran on hearing the door open, for fear of being
+ charged with it, and he followed; but what became of him I did
+ not stay to see."</p>
+
+ <p>"So you let your friend," the Judge remarked, "shift for
+ himself, and thought only of saving yourself. But did you see
+ any other person about the house or in the lane?"</p>
+
+ <p>"My lord, I thought I heard some one creeping along the
+ other side of the hedge a little before the window was broken,
+ but I saw nobody."</p>
+
+ <p>"You hear, good woman, what is alleged in behalf of the
+ person you have accused. Have you any other evidence against
+ him?"</p>
+
+ <p>"One might be sure," the widow replied, "they would
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page420" id="page420"></a>[pg
+ 420]</span> deny it, and tell lies for one another; but I hope
+ I am not to be put off in that manner."</p>
+
+ <p>"I must tell you, mistress, that you give too much liberty
+ to your tongue, and are as guilty of as much injustice as that
+ of which you complain. I should be sorry indeed if the young
+ gentlemen of this school deserved the general character of
+ liars. You will find among us, I hope, as just a sense of what
+ is right and honorable as among those who are older, and our
+ worthy master would certainly not permit us to try offences in
+ this manner if he thought us capable of bearing false witness
+ in each other's favor."</p>
+
+ <p>"I ask your lordship's pardon; I did not mean to offend; but
+ it is a heavy loss for a poor woman, and though I did not catch
+ the boy in the act, he was the nearest when it was done."</p>
+
+ <p>"As that is no more than a suspicion, and he has the
+ positive evidence of his schoolfellow in his favor, it will be
+ impossible to convict him consistently with the rules of
+ justice. Have you discovered any other circumstance that may
+ point out the offender?"</p>
+
+ <p>"My lord, next morning Jack found on the floor this top,
+ which I suppose the window was broke with."</p>
+
+ <p>"Hand it up. Here, gentlemen of the jury, please to examine
+ it, and see if you can discover anything of its owner."</p>
+
+ <p>"Here is 'P.R.' cut upon it."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said another boy, "I am sure I remember Peter Riot
+ having just such a one."</p>
+
+ <p>"So do I," still another remarked.</p>
+
+ <p>"Master Riot, is this your top?"</p>
+
+ <p>"I don't know, my lord," said Riot; "perhaps it may be mine.
+ I have had a great many tops, and when I have done with them I
+ throw them away, and any body may pick them up that pleases.
+ You see, it has lost its peg."</p>
+
+ <p>"Very well, sir. Mrs. Careful, you may retire."</p>
+
+ <p>"And must I have no amends, my lord?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Have patience; leave everything to the court. We shall do
+ you all the justice in our power."</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as the widow was gone the Judge rose from his seat,
+ and with much solemnity thus addressed the
+ assembly:</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page421"
+ id="page421"></a>[pg 421]</span>
+
+ <p>"Gentlemen, this business, I confess, gives me much
+ dissatisfaction. A poor woman has been insulted and injured in
+ her property, apparently without provocation, and although she
+ has not been able to convict the offender, it cannot be doubted
+ that she, as well as the world in general, will impute the
+ crime to some of our society. Though I am in my own mind
+ convinced that in her passion she charged an innocent person,
+ yet the circumstance of the top is a strong
+ suspicion&mdash;indeed, almost a proof&mdash;that the
+ perpetrator of this unmanly mischief was one of our body.</p>
+
+ <p>"The owner of the top has justly observed that its having
+ been his property is no certain proof against him.</p>
+
+ <p>"Since, therefore, in the present defect of evidence the
+ whole school must remain burdened with both the discredit of
+ this action and share in the guilt of it, I think fit, in the
+ first place, to decree that restitution shall be made to the
+ sufferer out of the public chest, and, next, that a Court of
+ Inquiry be instituted for the express purpose of searching
+ thoroughly into the affair, with the power to examine all
+ persons upon honor who are thought likely to be able to throw
+ light upon it. I hope, gentlemen, these measures meet with your
+ concurrence."</p>
+
+ <p>The whole court bowed to the Judge, and expressed their
+ entire satisfaction with his determination.</p>
+
+ <p>It was then ordered that the Public Treasurer should go to
+ the Widow Careful's house, and pay her a sum of one shilling,
+ making at the same time a handsome apology in the name of the
+ school; and six persons were taken by lot of the jury to
+ compose the Court of Inquiry, which was to sit in the
+ evening.</p>
+
+ <p>The Court then adjourned.</p>
+
+ <p>On the meeting of the Court of Inquiry the first thing
+ proposed by the President was that the persons who usually
+ played with Master Riot should be sent for. Accordingly Tom
+ Frisk and Bob Loiter were summoned, when the President asked
+ them upon their honor if they knew the top to have been
+ Riot's.</p>
+
+ <p>They said they did. They were then asked if they remembered
+ when Riot had it in his
+ possession.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page422"
+ id="page422"></a>[pg 422]</span>
+
+ <p>"He had it," said Frisk, "the day before yesterday, and
+ split a top of mine with it."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes," said Loiter, "and then as he was making a stroke at
+ mine the peg flew out."</p>
+
+ <p>"What did he do with it?"</p>
+
+ <p>"He put it into his pocket, and said as it was a strong top
+ he would have it mended."</p>
+
+ <p>"Then he did not throw it away, or give it to any one?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes; a day or two before he went to the Widow Careful's
+ shop for some gingerbread; but as he already owed her sixpence,
+ she would not let him have any till he had paid his debts."</p>
+
+ <p>"How did he take the disappointment?"</p>
+
+ <p>"He said he would be revenged on her."</p>
+
+ <p>"Are you sure he used such words?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes. Loiter heard him as well as myself."</p>
+
+ <p>"I did, sir," said Loiter.</p>
+
+ <p>"Do either of you know any more of this affair?"</p>
+
+ <p>"No, sir," replied both boys together.</p>
+
+ <p>"You may go," said the President, adding "that these
+ witnesses had done a good deal in establishing proof against
+ Riot; for it was pretty certain that no one but himself could
+ have been in possession of the top at the time the crime was
+ committed, and it also appeared that he had declared a
+ malicious intention against the woman, which it was highly
+ probable he would put into execution. As the court were
+ debating about the next step to be taken they were acquainted
+ that Jack, the widow's son, was waiting at the school-door for
+ admission; and a person being sent out for him, Riot was found
+ threatening the boy, and bidding him go home about his
+ business. The boy, however, was conveyed safely into the room,
+ when he thus addressed himself to the President:</p>
+
+ <p>"Sir, and please your worship," said Jack, "as I was looking
+ about this morning for sticks in the hedge over against our
+ house, I found this buckle. So I thought to myself, 'Sure this
+ must belong to the rascal that broke our window.' So I have
+ brought it to see if any one in the school would own it."</p>
+
+ <p>"On which side of the hedge did you find it?"</p>
+
+ <p>"On the other side from our house, in the
+ close."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page423"
+ id="page423"></a>[pg 423]</span>
+
+ <p>"Let us see it Gentlemen," said the President, "this is so
+ smart a buckle that I am sure I remember it at once, and I dare
+ say you all do."</p>
+
+ <p>"It is Riot's!" exclaimed all together.</p>
+
+ <p>"Has anybody observed Riot's shoes to-day?" the President
+ asked.</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes; he has got them tied with strings," a boy replied.</p>
+
+ <p>"Very well, then, gentlemen, we have nothing more to do than
+ to draw up the evidence we have heard, and lay it before his
+ lordship. Jack, you may go home."</p>
+
+ <p>"Pray, sir, let somebody go with me, for I am afraid of
+ Riot, who has just been threatening me at the door."</p>
+
+ <p>"Master Bold will please to go along with the boy."</p>
+
+ <p>The minutes of the court were then drawn up, and the
+ President took them to the Judge's chamber. After the Judge had
+ perused them, he ordered an indictment to be drawn up against
+ Peter Riot: "For that he meanly and clandestinely and with
+ malice aforethought had broken three panes in the window of
+ Widow Careful with a certain instrument called a top, whereby
+ he had committed an atrocious injury upon an innocent person,
+ and had brought a disgrace upon the society to which he
+ belonged."</p>
+
+ <p>At the same time he sent an officer to inform Master Riot
+ that his trial would come on the next morning.</p>
+
+ <p>Riot, who was with some of his gay companions, affected to
+ treat the matter with great indifference, and even to make a
+ jest of it. However, in the morning he thought it best to
+ endeavor to make it up, and accordingly, when the court was
+ assembled, he sent one of his friends with a shilling, saying
+ that he would not trouble them with further inquiries, but
+ would pay the sum that had been issued out of the public stock.
+ On the receipt of this message the Judge rose with much
+ severity in his countenance, and observing that by such
+ contemptuous behavior towards the court the criminal had
+ greatly added to his offence, he ordered two officers with
+ their staves immediately to go and bring in Riot, and to use
+ force if he should resist them.</p>
+
+ <p>The culprit, thinking it best to submit, was presently led
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page424" id="page424"></a>[pg
+ 424]</span> in between the two officers, when, being placed at
+ the bar, the Judge then addressed him: "I am sorry, sir, that
+ any member of this society can be so little sensible of the
+ nature of a crime and so little acquainted with the principles
+ of a court of justice as you have shown yourself to be by the
+ proposal you took the improper liberty of sending us. If you
+ mean it as a confession of your guilt, you certainly ought to
+ have waited to receive from us the penalty we thought proper to
+ inflict, and not to have imagined that an offer of the mere
+ payment of damages would satisfy the claims of justice against
+ you. If you had only broken the window by accident, and on your
+ own accord offered restitution, nothing less than the full
+ damages could have been accepted; but you now stand charged
+ with having done this mischief meanly, secretly, and
+ maliciously, and thereby have added a great deal of criminal
+ intention to the act. Can you, then, think that a court like
+ this, designed to watch over the morals, as well as protect the
+ property of our community, can so slightly pass over such
+ aggravated offences? You can claim no merit from confessing the
+ crime now that you know so much evidence will appear against
+ you. And if you choose still to plead not guilty, you are at
+ liberty to do it, and we will proceed immediately to the trial
+ without taking any advantage of the confession implied by your
+ offer of payment."</p>
+
+ <p>Riot stood silent for some time, and then begged to be
+ allowed to consult with his friends what was the best for him
+ to do. This was agreed to, and he was permitted to retire,
+ though under guard of an officer. After a short absence he
+ returned with more humility in his looks, and said that he
+ pleaded guilty, and threw himself on the mercy of the court.
+ The Judge then made a speech of some length, for the purpose of
+ convincing the prisoner, as well as the bystanders, of the
+ enormity of his crime. He then pronounced the following
+ sentence:</p>
+
+ <p>"You, Peter Riot, are hereby sentenced to pay to the public
+ treasury the sum of half a crown as a satisfaction for this
+ mischief you have done, and your attempt to conceal it.</p>
+
+ <p>"You are to repair to the house of Widow Careful,
+ accompanied by such witnesses as we shall appoint, and then,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page425" id="page425"></a>[pg
+ 425]</span> having first paid her the sum you owe her, you
+ shall ask her pardon for the insult you offered her. You shall
+ likewise to-morrow after school stand up in your place and
+ before all the scholars ask pardon for the disgrace you have
+ been the means of bringing upon the society, and in particular
+ you shall apologize to Master Luckless for the disagreeable
+ circumstances you were the means of bringing him into. Till
+ after this is complied with you shall not presume to come into
+ the playground or join in any of the diversions of the school,
+ and all persons are hereby admonished not to keep you company
+ till this is done."</p>
+
+ <p>Riot was then dismissed to his room, and in the afternoon he
+ was taken to the widow, who was pleased to receive his
+ submission graciously, and at the same time to apologize for
+ her own improper treatment of Master Luckless, to whom she sent
+ a present of a nice ball by way of amends.</p>
+
+ <p>Thus ended this important business.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page426"
+ id="page426"></a>[pg 426]</span>
+
+ <h3>A PLOT OF GUNPOWDER:</h3>
+
+ <h3>AN OLD LADY SEIZED FOR A GUY</h3>
+
+ <h4>Ascribed to WILLIAM MARTIN ("PETER PARLEY")</h4>
+
+ <p>Gunpowder! Yes, it is a dreadful thing, and many a little
+ boy has lost his eyesight by it. Next to playing with fire, I
+ do not know anything so bad as playing with gunpowder.</p>
+
+ <p>Every one knows of the fifth of November, the day set apart
+ for commemorating the deliverance of King James and his
+ Parliament from the horrible plot to blow them up with
+ gunpowder, and how on that day Guido Fawkes, who was to have
+ put the plan in execution, has his effigy paraded about.</p>
+
+ <p>Well, it was on the fifth of November, in the year 1789,
+ when Peter Parley was a boy, that the circumstances took place
+ of which I am going to give a relation. The boys of those days,
+ I think, were more fond of Guy Fawkes, and bonfires, and
+ squibs, and crackers than they are now.</p>
+
+ <p>I remember it was the first of November, early in the
+ morning, that a lad, who was on a visit to my father, and who
+ was my second cousin, got out of bed and said to me (for we
+ both slept in one room):</p>
+
+ <p>"Peter," said he, "do you have a guy in this town? I had a
+ famous one last year, and such a bonfire as you never saw, for
+ we burnt down a haystack. I should like to have a guy this
+ year; do let us make one."</p>
+
+ <p>I was only about twelve years old, and very fond of a bit of
+ fun, and so I said:</p>
+
+ <p>"That is a good idea. I was thinking of the same thing last
+ night, because the clerk gave out in the church that there
+ would be prayers on the fifth of November, on account of the
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page427" id="page427"></a>[pg
+ 427]</span> Gunpowder Plot; and, as I came out of the church
+ porch I saw a very old woman sitting there. She looked just
+ like an old witch, and I said to myself, 'I should like to
+ seize her for a guy.'"</p>
+
+ <p>"Seize an old woman for a guy! Well, that would be the
+ drollest thing that ever happened," said he; "and I should like
+ to go you halves. Shall we go partners in it? We can easily get
+ a chair and tie her down in it, and get a dark lantern and some
+ matches and all that."</p>
+
+ <p>"But she must be dressed like a man," said I; "there never
+ was a female Guy Fawkes. The people would laugh at us."</p>
+
+ <p>"So much the better," said he; "that is just what we want. I
+ like something original, out of the common way. Now, a female
+ Guy Fawkes is a thing that few persons ever saw, or even heard
+ of."</p>
+
+ <p>"But shall we not be taken up," said I, "perhaps put in
+ prison, and get ourselves into a hobble?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, what if we do? But we shall not do that. I am sure it
+ is all right enough. But, however, to be quite certain, if you
+ like we will ask Ephraim Quidd. You know, his father is a
+ lawyer, and he will tell us in a minute. So when we go to
+ school we will ask him, shall we?"</p>
+
+ <p>"With all my heart," said I. And so with that we began to
+ dress ourselves, and went downstairs to breakfast. I was so
+ full of the matter that I sat and thought of it all the time I
+ was eating my food; and at last my imagination painted the old
+ woman sitting in a chair, calling out, "I am no guy! I am no
+ guy!" the mob laughing, and the boys hurrahing so vividly that
+ I burst into a fit of laughter myself.</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, Peter," said my father, "'what is the matter now?"</p>
+
+ <p>Instead of telling him I continued to laugh, till at last he
+ grew very angry with me, and ordered me from the
+ breakfast-table. I then took my hat and bag, and went off to
+ school. Simon Sapskull&mdash;for that was my cousin's
+ name&mdash;soon followed me.</p>
+
+ <p>When he came up with me he said:</p>
+
+ <p>"I thought what you were laughing at. It will be good fun.
+ Let us make haste and see Quidd before he goes in. It will be
+ good fun, won't it?"</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page428"
+ id="page428"></a>[pg 428]</span>
+
+ <p>And here Master Simon jumped and capered about with
+ delight.</p>
+
+ <p>When we came to the schoolyard there were several boys
+ assembled and Quidd among them. Simon immediately ran up to
+ him.</p>
+
+ <p>"Quidd," said he, "I want to ask you a question. You know
+ the law, do you not? Your father is the town clerk, and you
+ ought."</p>
+
+ <p>"I do know the law," said Quidd. "Have I not been bred to
+ it? And is not my father to be made Recorder next year?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Well, then, answer me this," said Simon. "Is there any law
+ against <i>seizing an old woman for a guy</i>?"</p>
+
+ <p>The next morning Sapskull and myself, with Thomas Hardy and
+ half a dozen other boys, met with a view to talk about the
+ intended exploit. We withdrew to the backyard of the
+ schoolroom, and there, in a corner where we thought we could
+ not be overheard, we began to plot against the liberty of Dame
+ Clackett.</p>
+
+ <p>Hardy was one of the rarest boys for making fireworks I ever
+ knew in my life. He had bought a book called "Every Boy his own
+ Squib-Maker," in which were directions for making squibs,
+ crackers, rockets, Roman candles, serpents, slow fire, blue
+ lights, and other descriptions of fireworks. This he nearly
+ knew by heart. Sapskull said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Look in your book and see if there is not in it how to make
+ a guy."</p>
+
+ <p>So Hardy looked all over the book, but to no purpose; there
+ was no description of a guy manufactory. It was of no
+ consequence; we had a guy in our head, and we only now wished
+ to know how we should get hold of the old lady, and what we
+ should do on this joyful occasion.</p>
+
+ <p>Hardy said he had several pounds of gunpowder, and would
+ sell us all squibs and crackers. But these we did not so much
+ want. What we wanted was an old chair, an old jacket, hat, and
+ other matters to dress up the old lady when we could catch her.
+ But how to get her into the chair was the difficulty, and some
+ proposed one thing and some another. Sapskull
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page429" id="page429"></a>[pg
+ 429]</span> said, "We must make her merry with some beer."
+ Hardy said, "We must tie her down." But I proposed to ask her
+ to sit for her picture as a guy, and then to carry her off.
+ Master Quidd was, however, more cunning than any of us, and
+ said, "I know how to nab her; I have a plan, and a capital one
+ it is, too."</p>
+
+ <p>"What is it? what is it?" said all of us.</p>
+
+ <p>The fact was old Dame Clackett was a very staunch
+ churchwoman, and used always to go both on Wednesdays and
+ Fridays, Rain or sunshine, hot or cold, nothing could keep her
+ away from her church, and we silly boys laughed at her for it.
+ Poor old creature! she felt more real pleasure in this than we
+ could imagine.</p>
+
+ <p>"I will tell you what we will do," said Quidd. "There is in
+ our outhouse an old wheeled chair which my mother used to ride
+ about in when she was so long ill, a year or two ago. Now, I
+ know old Dame Clackett is very lame just now, from having let
+ fall her fender on her foot. I will take this chair down, and
+ offer to draw her to church in it, and then, when we have once
+ got her in the chair, we can do as we like with her.
+ Hurrah!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Won't that be fun?" continued Quidd. "Let us do
+ it&mdash;let us do it. There is no law against it; the thing
+ was never thought of. It is just like the law that was never
+ made among the Romans that I read about in my lessons
+ yesterday: there was no law against a child killing his own
+ father. I tell you," said he, "if there were twenty old women
+ to be seized and burnt, nobody could be hurt for it. But you do
+ not mean to burn her, I suppose, do you?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh no," said we; "we only want to have some fun. We should
+ like to make a guy of her, that is all, and rare fun it will
+ be."</p>
+
+ <p>"Let me join you," said one; "Let me join," said another,
+ till at last the whole school entered into the plot.</p>
+
+ <p>We all forgot what we should have remembered&mdash;namely,
+ that, instead of despising or ridiculing people who are old and
+ helpless and poor, we ought to treat them with kindness,
+ respect, and consideration. We forgot that we, if suffered to
+ live long <span class="pagenum"><a name="page430"
+ id="page430"></a>[pg 430]</span> enough, should also become
+ old, and that it would be hard for us to bear the coldness and
+ neglect of the world, but much harder to endure the ridicule
+ and ill-behavior of wicked children. Ay, we were thoughtless
+ lads, and so we suffered for it, as you will afterwards
+ hear.</p>
+ <hr />
+
+ <p>The old lady whom I had seen sitting in the church porch,
+ who was so ugly, as I thought, and so withered and old, was a
+ very poor widow. Her husband had died in battle long ago, and
+ she had from year to year supported herself by her spinning
+ wheel and the little relief she had from the parish. She lived
+ in a little hut on a piece of waste ground, and kept a little
+ poultry, and now and then a pig or two.</p>
+
+ <p>Among other animals, the old lady kept an enormous goat, or,
+ rather, he kept himself. It was one her husband had brought her
+ from abroad, of the Syrian breed. It was quite young when it
+ came over, but at last grew and grew so, as to become a very
+ formidable animal, so strong and fierce, that every dog was
+ afraid of it, being, no doubt, terrified by the sight of its
+ large horns and undaunted aspect. The name of this dread animal
+ was Hannibal.</p>
+
+ <p>Poor old Goody Clackett&mdash;for that was her
+ name&mdash;had little thoughts of ever being "smugged," as it
+ was termed, by our schoolfellows to make a guy on the fifth of
+ November, and sat quietly enough spinning her wheel and drawing
+ out her yarn. Sometimes the thrum of the old wheel would send
+ her soundly to sleep, and then she never dreamed of such a
+ thing as was to happen to her.</p>
+
+ <p>Every boy was delighted with this proposition, and it was
+ arranged that on the following evening I and my cousin Simon
+ should assist in the endeavor to get the chair from the
+ outhouse to a convenient place, while Hardy was to provide
+ lantern, matches, cap, and feathers, with red and black paint
+ to disfigure the features of the poor old creature.</p>
+
+ <p>"We will make her amends," said Quidd, "all the money we get
+ shall be hers."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh yes; that is quite fair," said I.</p>
+
+ <p>When the evening came and it was quite dark, Simon and
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page431" id="page431"></a>[pg
+ 431]</span> I went to the back part of Quidd's father's house.
+ After waiting some little time we heard a knock. Presently
+ Quidd opened the gates and came out.</p>
+
+ <p>"There, get it," said he. "Look about to see if anybody is
+ coming, and you can take it away."</p>
+
+ <p>We did so. The coast was clear, and out rolled the
+ chair.</p>
+
+ <p>Simon and I took hold of it, one behind and one before at
+ the handle-stick. Away we went, as had been preconcerted
+ between us in the stable-yard of another schoolfellow of ours
+ in the plot, who placed it near the gate and covered it over
+ with loose straw, so that no one could see it.</p>
+
+ <p>The next evening, which was the fourth of November, we met
+ again by appointment at the dark hollow of the churchyard. This
+ meeting was for the purpose of determining about the way in
+ which Dame Clackett should be dressed in her triumphal entry to
+ the Town Hall, the place where the bonfires were usually made.
+ Hardy had brought what was of essential service&mdash;namely,
+ an old coat which had formerly belonged to his father when in
+ the yeomanry cavalry, an old helmet, a cartridge-box, and a
+ pair of boots.</p>
+
+ <p>"We shall never get the boots on," said I.</p>
+
+ <p>Another boy brought an old lantern with the horn burnt out,
+ a third a bunch of matches; then there was a mask and a
+ lath-sword and a drum, with sticks and straw in abundance. They
+ were all deposited in the same place with the chair. The
+ conspirators (for conspirators we were) then made a promise to
+ each other not to split, as they call it&mdash;that is, not to
+ betray each other, and to go through with our work like
+ <i>Britons;</i> so we all shook hands and parted.</p>
+
+ <p>The next morning was a holiday, and we were up betimes.
+ After a consultation it was determined that I and Quidd should
+ go to the old dame and see how she was, and if she was
+ determined to go to church, and if there would be any
+ difficulty to get her to accept of the convenience of our
+ vehicle; so off we set. In less than half-an-hour we reached
+ the old dame's cottage, and found her at that very moment
+ dressing her foot.</p>
+
+ <p>Quidd was the first who spoke.</p>
+
+ <p>"Good morning, Goody," said he. "What, is not your
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page432" id="page432"></a>[pg
+ 432]</span> foot well yet? Why, I hear you have not been to
+ church lately. The curate was at father's last night, and said
+ if you were so lame that you could not walk, you might have our
+ easy four-wheeled chair. But I suppose you won't go to church
+ to-day&mdash;it is only the fifth of November?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Not go to church!" said the old woman&mdash;"not go to
+ church! I have always gone on the fifth of November for forty
+ years. My poor husband was in a French prison, and he knew well
+ enough what the Jacobites are. Was he not blown up, poor
+ fellow, in the 'Glorious?' and were not King James and all his
+ people to have been blown up so high by the horrid Papist plot
+ that I suppose they would not have been down by this time? No
+ Popery, I say! I would sooner crawl to church on my hands and
+ knees than not go to-day, young gentlemen. And then Mr.
+ Hassock, the kind, good curate, to ask for me!"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, and then there is the 'coal money' given on the fifth,
+ that all the widows in the parish may have a good fire through
+ the winter, you know, Goody."</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, I must go to church," said Mrs. Clackett.</p>
+
+ <p>"That you must," said Quidd, "and I will tell you what these
+ young gentlemen and I will do. We will bring down the chair,
+ and take you there ourselves. I am sure it would please Mr.
+ Hassock. Would it not, Parley?"</p>
+
+ <p>"Yes, and the rector also," said I. "And I have no doubt but
+ the churchwardens would like to see Goody at church, for the
+ tickets for flannel petticoats are to be given away
+ to-day."</p>
+
+ <p>"What is that?" said Mrs. Clackett. "Oh, yes, I could not
+ keep away from my church! Good young gentlemen, I shall never
+ forget your kindness."</p>
+
+ <p>We stopped to hear no more. We were overjoyed with the
+ success of our plot. Away we ran to our companions, and,
+ without stopping to explain, cried out:</p>
+
+ <p>"The chair! the chair! We shall have a guy, the best in the
+ whole country!"</p>
+
+ <p>So away we ran with the chair, and all our other
+ preparations for dressing and tying and securing.</p>
+
+ <p>The whole party surrounded the chair, some pushing, some
+ pulling. When, however, we got within a convenient
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page433" id="page433"></a>[pg
+ 433]</span> distance of the old lady's hut, Hardy and the
+ others stepped on one side, and placed the helmet, coat,
+ lantern, matches, etc., under a hedge, to be ready when
+ required, while Quidd, Sapskull, and myself went with the chair
+ to the old lady's cottage.</p>
+
+ <p>When we got there we found her spruce and prim with her best
+ black silk bonnet, something in shape like a coal-scuttle, her
+ stick in her hand, and her shoes on her feet. We drove up the
+ chair in fine style. There were several cottages close by, and
+ the neighbors came out to see the old lady ride. At last some
+ one who knew Quidd said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Why, that is the lawyer's son. Sure enough old Goody has
+ got some money left her."</p>
+
+ <p>So then there was a talking and surmising, and before Goody
+ got to church it was reported all over the town that she was
+ made the possessor of several thousand pounds prize-money; that
+ she was to be a lady, and ride in her carriage. Being sent for,
+ as it was supposed, by the lawyer must be for something&mdash;a
+ large legacy, no doubt.</p>
+
+ <p>The chair wheeled on with Goody in it. The boys looked as if
+ they were up to something, and sure enough they were. When they
+ came to that part of the lane at which the various habiliments
+ had been left, the chair stopped, and out rushed the other
+ conspirators.</p>
+
+ <p>"Do not be alarmed, Goody," said Hardy. "We are only going
+ to make a guy of you for an hour or two. No one shall harm you,
+ and you shall have all the money we get."</p>
+
+ <p>"I want to go to church&mdash;I want to go to church!" said
+ the old lady, and tried to get out of the chair.</p>
+
+ <p>Hardy, however, very dexterously threw some cord round the
+ arms, and tied the poor old creature down.</p>
+
+ <p>"We won't hurt you, Goody," said he. "We only want you for a
+ guy. You shall have all the money."</p>
+
+ <p>"I won't be a guy! I won't be a guy!" said Goody. "I do not
+ want any money. Let me out! let me out!"</p>
+
+ <p>She then made a blow with her broomstick, and struck Master
+ Hardy on the nose, from which the blood flowed freely. This,
+ however, only made him the more determined, and
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page434" id="page434"></a>[pg
+ 434]</span> in a few minutes the poor old woman's arms were
+ secured as well as her legs.</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh, help, neighbors! They are going to burn me!" said the
+ old lady, and then she fell coughing, for she had long suffered
+ from asthma.</p>
+
+ <p>While convulsed with this fit, the boys took the opportunity
+ to besmear her face with red and black paint, and to place the
+ helmet on her head, and the coat round her, so that the arms
+ hung on each side with nothing on them. The chair was then
+ crammed with straw, and the lantern and the matches suspended
+ from it. In this state the chair was wheeled rapidly along in
+ the direction of the town.</p>
+
+ <p>Other boys soon joined, and surrounded the vehicle, shouting
+ and laughing. The old lady, made several ineffectual attempts
+ to get out of the chair. She called out, "A plot! a plot! a
+ Popery plot! No Popery! Oh! I shall be killed!" and many such
+ exclamations. The populace took this as a part of the
+ character, and laughed most heartily. The greatest number of
+ persons thought the guy to be a boy dressed up, and cried out
+ that he acted his part well. No one suspected it was old Dame
+ Clackett.</p>
+
+ <p>Away they went in the midst of the hubbub, up one street and
+ down another, over the market-place and by the church. Just as
+ the clock struck twelve the boys of the Free School came from
+ the latter place, and joined the procession. It was now a
+ national affair, and, as it proceeded from the church doors, it
+ was thought to be the church Guy Fawkes&mdash;and so it
+ was.</p>
+
+ <p>"Hurrah! hurrah!" shouted a hundred voices; and while Hardy
+ and his companions held on the chair, Quidd and I went about
+ with our hats to collect as much money as we could.</p>
+
+ <p>The old lady was vociferous, and struggled to get out. She
+ flung her arms about, and cried out, "Deliver me from the
+ flames! Save me from being burnt!" and everybody thought that
+ the part of guy was acted to perfection.</p>
+
+ <p>Quidd and I got a great deal of money&mdash;silver, and
+ copper, and even gold. Seven-shilling pieces were in
+ circulation at that time, and the squire and Mr. Hassock
+ passing us, one threw <span class="pagenum"><a name="page435"
+ id="page435"></a>[pg 435]</span> sixpence and the other a
+ seven-shilling piece to us, for which we gave a louder cheer
+ than usual. In short, our hats were very nearly half full of
+ money.</p>
+
+ <p>The old woman began to be more pacified as she saw the money
+ coming in, particularly as we put it all into her lap, and told
+ her it should be hers. But the sight of the squire and the
+ curate, and the seven-shilling piece, which latter we put into
+ her mouth, seemed quite to reconcile her to her fate. She
+ became then as gentle as a lamb. She said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Do as you like&mdash;do as you like, only don't burn me for
+ a guy; and give me a drop of something to drink."</p>
+
+ <p>"Oh yes," said Quidd, "here is something for you. Hold up
+ your head."</p>
+
+ <p>And half a pint of good strong ale soon found its way down
+ the throat of the dame. After this the chair again moved on,
+ till at last it came to the market-place, opposite the Town
+ Hall, where an enormous bonfire was in preparation, over which
+ stood a gallows.</p>
+
+ <p>The old lady, when she saw the gallows, screamed "Murder!
+ fire! brimstone!" and all sorts of horrid cries; but nobody
+ took any heed of it, except to laugh. They thought it was in
+ keeping with her character.</p>
+
+ <p>"We will not hurt you, we will not hurt you," said I.</p>
+
+ <p>But it was of no use; the old lady refused to be
+ pacified.</p>
+
+ <p>Just at this moment Quidd felt a severe blow from behind,
+ which sent him sprawling. I also received a push or a drive,
+ and a loud laugh burst from those around.</p>
+
+ <p>When I turned to see what was the cause of the laughter,
+ what should I observe but Hannibal, the goat, who had, it
+ appeared, followed his mistress, and, being excited by her
+ cries, dashed at my schoolfellow in the way described. Several
+ of the spectators now tried to seize the goat, but he being of
+ extraordinary strength, butted and pushed so vigorously that
+ several measured their length upon the earth, to the no small
+ merriment of the clownish persons who had collected together to
+ the burning of the guy.</p>
+
+ <p>During all this time Dame Clackett cried out loudly, and in
+ the confusion her chair was upset, and she became liberated
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page436" id="page436"></a>[pg
+ 436]</span> from her duress. As soon as she was free, she laid
+ about on all sides of her with her stick, pulled off the helmet
+ and jacket in which she had been nearly smothered, and cried
+ out at the top of her voice:</p>
+
+ <p>"I am no guy! I am Dame Clackett! For goodness' sake do not
+ burn me for a witch!"</p>
+
+ <p>She, however, kept her apron close in which the money was,
+ and took care not to let the seven-shilling piece fall out of
+ her mouth.</p>
+
+ <p>The mob cheered. It would have been well if this had been
+ all, but no: as soon as ever the old lady told her story that
+ she had been seized for a guy, an effort was immediately made
+ to secure the offenders. The constable, who happened to be
+ present, laid hold of me and cousin Simon; several others were
+ seized by the bystanders; and the whole, with the exception of
+ Quidd, were dragged off to what in the country is called the
+ goose-house&mdash;that is, the cage. Quidd, lawyer-like,
+ contrived to get out of the scrape, leaving others in it. So we
+ were all put into the cage, and bolted and barred. It was very
+ dark, and as we were terribly frightened, we all began to howl
+ most hideously.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/436.jpg" name="fig436s"
+ id="fig436s"><img width="300" src="images/436s.jpg"
+ alt="THE GOAT DASHED IN AMONG THEM AND THE CHAIR WAS UPSET" />
+ </a><br />
+ the goat dashed in among them and the chair was upset
+ </div>
+
+ <p>As to Quidd, he went homewards, as if nothing had happened,
+ and soon made his reappearance, prepared for the usual
+ squibbing and cracking, with his pockets full of squibs and
+ crackers. He was so pleased with the success of the scheme in
+ which he had been so forward an actor that he determined to
+ have more fun before he went to bed; so he looked about, and it
+ was not long before he saw a fit object, as he thought.</p>
+
+ <p>At the corner of the street leading to the market-place sat
+ poor old Hannah Grimly, as she was called. She had sold roasted
+ chestnuts on the fifth of November for a score of years, and
+ many a pinch of gunpowder had been put under the lid of the
+ saucepan upon which the chestnuts were laid. Quidd determined
+ to have a good explosion, and took the opportunity, while the
+ chestnuts were being put into his hand, to introduce a packet
+ of gunpowder into the kettle. He thought to run away before it
+ should ignite, but there being a small hole in the paper, the
+ moment it touched the fire the whole went off
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page437" id="page437"></a>[pg
+ 437]</span> with a loud explosion. Quidd's hand was shattered
+ to pieces, and he fell stunned with the effects of the powder.
+ He was taken home senseless, and put to bed.</p>
+
+ <p>The rest of the conspirators, including myself, were kept in
+ the cage all night in bitter tears. The next morning we were
+ taken before the magistrates. The chairman, who happened to be
+ the very squire who had given us the seven-shilling piece,
+ looked very severely at us, and said:</p>
+
+ <p>"This is the most horrible plot I ever heard
+ of&mdash;seizing an old woman for a guy! Gentlemen," said he to
+ those around him, "if this be permitted none of us are
+ safe."</p>
+
+ <p>Some people used to call the magistrates old women, and so
+ this raised a laugh.</p>
+
+ <p>He then called to the clerk to look over the Act of
+ Parliament to see what could be the punishment for such an
+ offence, but found none. Quidd was right&mdash;there was no law
+ against seizing an old woman for a guy. The bench were puzzled
+ what to do. At last Quidd's father said we should be indicted
+ for stealing his chair, and be put on our trial for robbery and
+ sacrilege&mdash;the first for the abduction of the chair, the
+ second for keeping the old lady <i>from church.</i></p>
+
+ <p>Our fathers and mothers, however, pleaded so eloquently
+ that, after a severe admonition, we got off upon payment of the
+ costs and a handsome compensation to Dame Clackett. When I
+ reached home my father took me into the stable and gave me a
+ sound whipping, and at the conclusion of the flagellation
+ said:</p>
+
+ <p>"Now, Peter Parley, I think you will not again seize an old
+ woman for a guy!"</p>
+
+ <p>And I never did.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page438"
+ id="page438"></a>[pg 438]</span>
+
+ <h3>UNCLE DAVID'S NONSENSICAL STORY ABOUT GIANTS AND
+ FAIRIES</h3>
+
+ <h3>By KATHERINE SINCLAIR</h3>
+
+ <p>In the days of yore children were not all such clever, good,
+ sensible people as they are now. Lessons were then considered
+ rather a plague, sugar-plums were still in demand, holidays
+ continued yet in fashion, and toys were not then made to teach
+ mathematics, nor storybooks to give instruction in chemistry
+ and navigation. These were very strange times, and there
+ existed at that period a very idle, greedy, naughty boy, such
+ as we never hear of in the present day. His father and mother
+ were&mdash;no matter who, and he lived&mdash;no matter where.
+ His name was Master No-book, and he seemed to think his eyes
+ were made for nothing but to stare out of the windows, and his
+ mouth for no other purpose but to eat. This young gentleman
+ hated lessons like mustard, both of which brought tears into
+ his eyes, and during school hours he sat gazing at his books,
+ pretending to be busy, while his mind wandered away to wish
+ impatiently for dinner, and to consider where he could get the
+ nicest pies, pastry, ices, and jellies, while he smacked his
+ lips at the very thoughts of them.</p>
+
+ <p>Whenever Master No-book spoke it was always to ask for
+ something, and you might continually hear him say in a whining
+ tone of voice: "Father, may I take this piece of cake?" "Aunt
+ Sarah, will you give me an apple?" "Mother, do send me the
+ whole of that plum-pudding." Indeed, very frequently, when he
+ did not get permission to gormandize, this naughty glutton
+ helped himself without leave. Even his dreams were like his
+ waking hours, for he had often a horrible nightmare about
+ lessons, thinking he was smothered with Greek lexicons or
+ pelted out of the school with a shower of English grammars,
+ while one night he fancied himself sitting down to devour an
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page439" id="page439"></a>[pg
+ 439]</span> enormous plum-cake, and all on a sudden it became
+ transformed into a Latin dictionary.</p>
+
+ <p>One afternoon Master No-book, having played truant all day
+ from school, was lolling on his mother's best sofa in the
+ drawing-room, with his leather boots tucked up on the satin
+ cushions, and nothing to do but to suck a few oranges, and
+ nothing to think of but how much sugar to put upon them, when
+ suddenly an event took place which filled him with
+ astonishment.</p>
+
+ <p>A sound of soft music stole into the room, becoming louder
+ and louder the longer he listened, till at length, in a few
+ moments afterwards, a large hole burst open in the wall of his
+ room, and there stepped into his presence two magnificent
+ fairies, just arrived from their castles in the air, to pay him
+ a visit. They had traveled all the way on purpose to have some
+ conversation with Master No-book, and immediately introduced
+ themselves in a very ceremonious manner.</p>
+
+ <p>The fairy Do-nothing was gorgeously dressed with a wreath of
+ flaming gas round her head, a robe of gold tissue, a necklace
+ of rubies, and a bouquet in her hand of glittering diamonds.
+ Her cheeks were rouged to the very eyes, her teeth were set in
+ gold, and her hair was of a most brilliant purple; in short, so
+ fine and fashionable-looking a fairy never was seen in a
+ drawing-room before. The fairy Teach-all, who followed next,
+ was simply dressed in white muslin, with bunches of natural
+ flowers in her light-brown hair, and she carried in her hand a
+ few neat small volumes, which Master No-book looked at with a
+ shudder of aversion.</p>
+
+ <p>The two fairies now informed him that they very often
+ invited large parties of children to spend some time at their
+ palaces, but as they lived in quite an opposite direction, it
+ was necessary for their young guests to choose which it would
+ be best to visit first; therefore they had now come to inquire
+ of Master No-book whom he thought it would be most agreeable to
+ accompany on the present occasion.</p>
+
+ <p>"In my house," said the fairy Teach-all, speaking with a
+ very sweet smile and a soft, pleasing voice, "you shall be
+ taught to find pleasure in every sort of exertion, for I
+ delight in <span class="pagenum"><a name="page440"
+ id="page440"></a>[pg 440]</span> activity and diligence. My
+ young friends rise at seven every morning, and amuse themselves
+ with working in a beautiful garden of flowers, rearing whatever
+ fruit they wish to eat, visiting among the poor, associating
+ pleasantly together, studying the arts and sciences, and
+ learning to know the world in which they live, and to fulfil
+ the purposes for which they have been brought into it. In
+ short, all our amusements tend to some useful object, either
+ for our own improvement or the good of others, and you will
+ grow wiser, better, and happier every day you remain in the
+ palace of Knowledge."</p>
+
+ <p>"But in Castle Needless, where I live," interrupted the
+ fairy Do-nothing, rudely pushing her companion aside with an
+ angry, contemptuous look, "we never think of exerting ourselves
+ for anything. You may put your head in your pocket and your
+ hands in your sides as long as you choose to stay. No one is
+ ever asked a question, that he may be spared the trouble of
+ answering. We lead the most fashionable life imaginable, for
+ nobody speaks to anybody. Each of my visitors is quite an
+ exclusive, and sits with his back to as many of the company as
+ possible, in the most comfortable arm-chair that can be
+ contrived. There, if you are only so good as to take the
+ trouble of wishing for anything, it is yours without even
+ turning an eye round to look where it comes from. Dresses are
+ provided of the most magnificent kind, which go on themselves,
+ without your having the smallest annoyance with either buttons
+ or strings; games which you can play without an effort of
+ thought; and dishes dressed by a French cook, smoking hot under
+ your nose, from morning till night; while any rain we have is
+ either made of lemonade or lavender-water, and in winter it
+ generally snows iced punch for an hour during the
+ forenoon."</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/440.jpg" name="fig440s"
+ id="fig440s"><img width="300" src="images/440s.jpg"
+ alt="EACH OF MY VISITORS IS QUITE AN EXCLUSIVE" />
+ </a><br />
+ each of my visitors is quite an exclusive
+ </div>
+
+ <p>Nobody need be told which fairy Master No-book preferred,
+ and quite charmed at his own good fortune in receiving so
+ agreeable an invitation, he eagerly gave his hand to the
+ splendid new acquaintance who promised him so much pleasure and
+ ease, and gladly proceeded in a carriage lined with velvet,
+ stuffed with downy pillows, and drawn by milk-white swans, to
+ that magnificent residence, Castle Needless, which was lighted
+ by a <span class="pagenum"><a name="page441"
+ id="page441"></a>[pg 441]</span> thousand windows during the
+ day, and by a million of lamps every night.</p>
+
+ <p>Here Master No-book enjoyed a constant holiday and a
+ constant feast, while a beautiful lady covered with jewels was
+ ready to tell him stories from morning till night, and servants
+ waited to pick up his playthings if they fell, or to draw out
+ his purse or his pocket-handkerchief when he wished to use
+ them.</p>
+
+ <p>Thus Master No-book lay dozing for hours and days on rich
+ embroidered cushions, never stirring from his place, but
+ admiring the view of trees covered with the richest burnt
+ almonds, grottoes of sugar-candy, a <i>jet d'eau</i> of
+ champagne, a wide sea which tasted of sugar instead of salt,
+ and a bright, clear pond, filled with gold fish that let
+ themselves be caught whenever he pleased. Nothing could be more
+ complete, and yet, very strange to say, Master No-book did not
+ seem particularly happy. This appears exceedingly unreasonable,
+ when so much trouble was taken to please him; but the truth is
+ that every day he became more fretful and peevish. No
+ sweetmeats were worth the trouble of eating, nothing was
+ pleasant to play at, and in the end he wished it were possible
+ to sleep all day, as well as all night.</p>
+
+ <p>Not a hundred miles from the fairy Do-nothing's palace there
+ lived a most cruel monster called the giant Snap-'em-up, who
+ looked, when he stood up, like the tall steeple of a great
+ church, raising his head so high that he could peep over the
+ loftiest mountains, and was obliged to climb up a ladder to
+ comb his own hair.</p>
+
+ <p>Every morning regularly this prodigiously great giant walked
+ round the world before breakfast for an appetite, after which
+ he made tea in a large lake, used the sea as a slop-basin, and
+ boiled his kettle on Mount Vesuvius. He lived in great style,
+ and his dinners were most magnificent, consisting very often of
+ an elephant roasted whole, ostrich patties, a tiger smothered
+ in onions, stewed lions, and whale soup; but for a side-dish
+ his greatest favorite consisted of little boys, as fat as
+ possible, fried in crumbs of bread, with plenty of pepper and
+ salt.</p>
+
+ <p>No children were so well fed or in such good condition for
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page442" id="page442"></a>[pg
+ 442]</span> eating as those in the fairy Do-nothing's garden,
+ who was a very particular friend of the giant Snap-'em-up's,
+ and who sometimes laughingly said she would give him a license,
+ and call her own garden his "preserve," because she always
+ allowed him to help himself, whenever he pleased, to as many of
+ her visitors as he chose, without taking the trouble to even
+ count them; and in return for such extreme civility, the giant
+ very frequently invited her to dinner.</p>
+
+ <p>Snap-'em-up's favorite sport was to see how many brace of
+ little boys he could bag in a morning; so, in passing along the
+ streets, he peeped into all the drawing-rooms, without having
+ occasion to get upon tiptoe, and picked up every young
+ gentleman who was idly looking out of the windows, and even a
+ few occasionally who were playing truant from school; but busy
+ children seemed always somehow quite out of his reach.</p>
+
+ <p>One day, when Master No-book felt even more lazy, more idle,
+ and more miserable than ever, he lay beside a perfect mountain
+ of toys and cakes, wondering what to wish for next, and hating
+ the very sight of everything and everybody. At last he gave so
+ loud a yawn of weariness and disgust that his jaw very nearly
+ fell out of joint, and then he sighed so deeply that the giant
+ Snap-'em-up heard the sound as he passed along the road after
+ breakfast, and instantly stepped into the garden, with his
+ glass at his eye, to see what was the matter. Immediately, on
+ observing a large, fat, overgrown boy, as round as a dumpling,
+ lying on a bed of roses, he gave a cry of delight, followed by
+ a gigantic peal of laughter, which was heard three miles off,
+ and picking up Master No-book between his finger and thumb,
+ with a pinch that very nearly broke his ribs, he carried him
+ rapidly towards his own castle, while the fairy Do-nothing
+ laughingly shook her head as he passed, saying:</p>
+
+ <p>"That little man does me great credit. He has only been fed
+ for a week, and is as fat already as a prize ox. What a dainty
+ morsel he will be! When do you dine to-day, in case I should
+ have time to look in upon you?"</p>
+
+ <p>On reaching home the giant immediately hung up Master
+ No-book by the hair of his head, on a prodigious hook in the
+ larder, having first taken some large lumps of nasty suet,
+ forcing <span class="pagenum"><a name="page443"
+ id="page443"></a>[pg 443]</span> them down his throat to make
+ him become still fatter, and then stirring the fire, that he
+ might be almost melted with heat, to make his liver grow
+ larger. On a shelf quite near Master No-book perceived the
+ bodies of six other boys, whom he remembered to have seen
+ fattening in the fairy Do-nothing's garden, while he
+ recollected how some of them had rejoiced at the thoughts of
+ leading a long, useless, idle life, with no one to please but
+ themselves.</p>
+
+ <p>The enormous cook now seized hold of Master No-book,
+ brandishing her knife with an aspect of horrible determination,
+ intending to kill him, while he took the trouble of screaming
+ and kicking in the most desperate manner, when the giant turned
+ gravely round, and said that, as pigs were considered a much
+ greater dainty when whipped to death than killed in any other
+ way, he meant to see whether children might not be improved by
+ it also; therefore she might leave that great hog of a boy till
+ he had time to try the experiment, especially as his own
+ appetite would be improved by the exercise. This was a dreadful
+ prospect for the unhappy prisoner, but meantime it prolonged
+ his life a few hours, as he was immediately hung up in the
+ larder and left to himself. There, in torture of mind and body,
+ like a fish upon a hook, the wretched boy began at last to
+ reflect seriously upon his former ways, and to consider what a
+ happy home he might have had, if he could only have been
+ satisfied with business and pleasure succeeding each other,
+ like day and night, while lessons might have come in as a
+ pleasant sauce to his play-hours, and his play-hours as a sauce
+ to his lessons.</p>
+
+ <p>In the midst of many reflections, which were all very
+ sensible, though rather too late, Master No-book's attention
+ be- came attracted by the sound of many voices laughing,
+ talking, and singing, which caused him to turn his eyes in a
+ new direction, when, for the first time, he observed that the
+ fairy Teach-all's garden lay upon a beautiful sloping bank not
+ far off. There a crowd of merry, noisy, rosy-cheeked boys were
+ busily employed, and seemed happier than the day was long,
+ while poor Master No-book watched them during his own miserable
+ hours, envying the enjoyment with which they raked the
+ flower-borders, gathered the fruit, carried baskets of
+ vegetables to the poor, <span class="pagenum"><a name="page444"
+ id="page444"></a>[pg 444]</span> worked with carpenter's tools,
+ drew pictures, shot with bows-and-arrows, played at cricket,
+ and then sat in the sunny arbors learning their tasks, or
+ talking agreeably together, till at length, a dinner-bell
+ having been rung, the whole party sat merrily down with hearty
+ appetites and cheerful good humor, to an entertainment of plain
+ roast meat and pudding, where the fairy Teach-all presided
+ herself, and helped her guests moderately to as much as was
+ good for each.</p>
+
+ <p>Large tears rolled down the cheeks of Master No-book while
+ watching this scene, and remembering that if he had known what
+ was best for him, he might have been as happy as the happiest
+ of these excellent boys, instead of suffering ennui and
+ weariness, as he had done at the fairy Do-nothing's, ending in
+ a miserable death. But his attention was soon after most
+ alarmingly roused by hearing the giant Snap-'em-up again in
+ conversation with his cook, who said that, if he wished for a
+ good large dish of scolloped children at dinner, it would be
+ necessary to catch a few more, as those he had already provided
+ would scarcely be a mouthful.</p>
+
+ <p>As the giant kept very fashionable hours, and always waited
+ dinner for himself till nine o'clock, there was still plenty of
+ time; so, with a loud grumble about the trouble, he seized a
+ large basket in his hand, and set off at a rapid pace towards
+ the fairy Teach-all's garden. It was very seldom that
+ Snap-'em-up ventured to think of foraging in this direction, as
+ he never once succeeded in carrying off a single captive from
+ the enclosure, it was so well fortified and so bravely
+ defended; but on this occasion, being desperately hungry, he
+ felt as bold as a lion, and walked, with outstretched hands,
+ straight towards the fairy Teach-all's dinner-table, taking
+ such prodigious strides that he seemed almost as if he would
+ trample on himself.</p>
+
+ <p>A cry of consternation arose the instant this tremendous
+ giant appeared, and, as usual on such occasions, when he had
+ made the same attempt before, a dreadful battle took place.
+ Fifty active little boys bravely flew upon the enemy, armed
+ with their dinner-knives, and looked like a nest of hornets,
+ stinging him in every direction, till he roared with pain, and
+ would have run away; but the fairy Teach-all, seeing his
+ intention, rushed <span class="pagenum"><a name="page445"
+ id="page445"></a>[pg 445]</span> forward with the
+ carving-knife, and brandishing it high over her head, she most
+ courageously stabbed him to the heart.</p>
+
+ <p>If a great mountain had fallen to the earth it would have
+ seemed like nothing in comparison with the giant Snap-em-up,
+ who crushed two or three houses to powder beneath him, and
+ upset several fine monuments that were to have made people
+ remembered for ever. But all this would have seemed scarcely
+ worth mentioning had it not been for a still greater event
+ which occurred on the occasion, no less than the death of the
+ fairy Do-nothing, who had been indolently looking on at this
+ great battle without taking the trouble to interfere, or even
+ to care who was victorious; but being also lazy about running
+ away, when the giant fell, his sword came with so violent a
+ stroke on her head that she instantly expired.</p>
+
+ <p>Thus, luckily for the whole world, the fairy Teach-all got
+ possession of immense property, which she proceeded without
+ delay to make the best use of in her power.</p>
+
+ <p>In the first place, however, she lost no time in liberating
+ Master No-book from his hook in the larder, and gave him a
+ lecture on activity, moderation, and good conduct, which he
+ never afterwards forgot; and it was astonishing to see the
+ change that took place immediately in his whole thoughts and
+ actions. From this very hour Master No-book became the most
+ diligent, active, happy boy in the fairy Teach-all's garden;
+ and on returning home a month afterwards, he astonished all the
+ masters at school by his extraordinary reformation. The most
+ difficult lessons were a pleasure to him, he scarcely ever
+ stirred without a book in his hand, never lay on a sofa again,
+ would scarcely even sit on a chair with a back to it, but
+ preferred a three-legged stool, detested holidays, never
+ thought any exertion a trouble, preferred climbing over the top
+ of a hill to creeping round the bottom, always ate the plainest
+ food in very small quantities, joined a temperance society, and
+ never tasted a morsel till he had worked very hard and got an
+ appetite.</p>
+
+ <p>Not long after this an old uncle, who had formerly been
+ ashamed of Master No-book's indolence and gluttony, became so
+ pleased at the wonderful change that on his death he left him a
+ magnificent estate, desiring that he should take his
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page446" id="page446"></a>[pg
+ 446]</span> name; therefore, instead of being any longer one of
+ the No-book family, he is now called Sir Timothy Blue-stocking,
+ a pattern to the whole country around for the good he does to
+ everyone, and especially for his extraordinary activity,
+ appearing as if he could do twenty things at once. Though
+ generally very good-natured and agreeable, Sir Timothy is
+ occasionally observed in a violent passion, laying about him
+ with his walking-stick in the most terrific manner, and beating
+ little boys within an inch of their lives; but on inquiry it
+ invariably appears that he has found them out to be lazy, idle,
+ or greedy; for all the industrious boys in the parish are sent
+ to get employment from him, while he assures them that they are
+ far happier breaking stones on the road than if they were
+ sitting idly in a drawing-room with nothing to do.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page447"
+ id="page447"></a>[pg 447]</span>
+
+ <h3>THE INQUISITIVE GIRL</h3>
+
+ <p>Dr. Hammond was a physician in great practice in the West of
+ England. He resided in a small market-town and his family
+ consisted of one son, named Charles, and two daughters, Louisa
+ and Sophy.</p>
+
+ <p>Sophy possessed many amiable qualities, and did not want for
+ sense, but every better feeling was lost in her extreme
+ inquisitiveness. Her faculties were all occupied in peeping and
+ prying about, and, provided she could gratify her own
+ curiosity, she never cared how much vexation she caused to
+ others.</p>
+
+ <p>This propensity began when she was so very young that it had
+ become a habit before her parents perceived it. She was a very
+ little creature when she was once nearly squeezed to death
+ between two double doors as she was peeping through the keyhole
+ of one of them to see who was in the drawing-room; and another
+ time she was locked up for several hours in a closet in which
+ she had hid herself for the purpose of overhearing what her
+ mother was saying to one of the servants.</p>
+
+ <p>When Sophy was eleven and her sister about sixteen years old
+ their mother died. Louisa was placed at the head of her
+ father's house, and the superintendence of Sophy's education
+ necessarily devolved on her. The care of such a family was a
+ great charge for a young person of Miss Hammond's age, and more
+ especially as her father was obliged to be so much from home
+ that she could not always have his counsel and advice even when
+ she most needed it. By this means she fell into an injudicious
+ mode of treating her sister.</p>
+
+ <p>If Louisa received a note she carefully locked it up, and
+ never spoke of its contents before Sophy. If a message was
+ brought to her she always went out of the room to receive it,
+ and never suffered the servant to speak in her sister's
+ hearing. When any visitors came Louisa commonly sent Sophy out
+ of the room, or if they were intimate friends she would
+ converse with them in whispers; in short, it was her chief
+ study <span class="pagenum"><a name="page448"
+ id="page448"></a>[pg 448]</span> that everything which passed
+ in the family should be a secret from Sophy. Alas! this
+ procedure, instead of repressing Sophy's curiosity, only made
+ it the more keen; her eyes and ears were always on the alert,
+ and what she could not see, hear, or thoroughly comprehend she
+ made out by guesses.</p>
+
+ <p>The worst consequence of Louisa's conduct was that as Sophy
+ had no friend and companion in her sister, who treated her with
+ such constant suspicion and reserve, she necessarily was
+ induced to find a friend and companion among the servants, and
+ she selected the housemaid Sally, a good-natured,
+ well-intentioned girl, but silly and ignorant and inquisitive
+ like herself, and it may be easily supposed how much mischief
+ these two foolish creatures occasioned, not only in the family,
+ but also among their neighbors.</p>
+
+ <p>It happened soon after, that for an offence which was the
+ cause of very great vexation to her brother, and was the
+ occasion of his being for a time deprived of the friendship of
+ Sir Henry and Lady Askham, two of Dr. Hammond's nearest and
+ most intimate neighbors, her father ordered Sophy, as a still
+ further punishment, to be locked up in her own room till the
+ Sunday following. This was on Friday, and Sophy had two days of
+ solitude and imprisonment before her. The first day she passed
+ very dismally, but yet not unprofitably, for she felt truly
+ ashamed and sorry for her fault, and made many good resolutions
+ of endeavoring to cure herself of her mischievous propensity.
+ The second day she began to be somewhat more composed, and by
+ degrees she was able to amuse herself with watching the people
+ in the street, which was overlooked by the windows of her
+ apartment, and she began, almost unconsciously to herself, to
+ indulge in her old habit of trying to find out what everybody
+ was doing, and in guessing where they were going.</p>
+
+ <div class="figcenter" style="width:100%;">
+ <a href="images/448.jpg" name="fig448s"
+ id="fig448s"><img width="300" src="images/448s.jpg"
+ alt="IF LOUISA RECEIVED A NOTE, SHE CAREFULLY LOCKED IT UP" />
+ </a><br />
+ if louisa received a note, she carefully locked it up
+ </div>
+
+ <p>She had not long been engaged in watching her neighbors
+ before her curiosity was excited by the appearance of a servant
+ on horseback, who rode up to the door, and, after giving a
+ little three-cornered note to Dr. Hammond's footman, rode off.
+ The servant she knew to be Mrs. Arden's, an intimate friend
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page449" id="page449"></a>[pg
+ 449]</span> of her father, and the note she conjectured was an
+ invitation to dinner, and the guessing what day the invitation
+ was for, and who were to be the company, and whether she was
+ included in the invitation, was occupying her busy fancy, when
+ she saw her sister going out of the house with the
+ three-cornered note in her hand, and cross the street to Mr.
+ McNeal's stocking shop, which was opposite. Almost immediately
+ afterwards Mr. McNeal's shopman came out of the shop, and,
+ running down the street, was presently out of sight, but soon
+ returned with Mr. McNeal himself. She saw Louisa reading the
+ note to Mr. McNeal, and in a few minutes afterwards return
+ home. Here was a matter of wonder and conjecture. Sophy forgot
+ all her good resolutions, and absolutely wearied herself with
+ her useless curiosity.</p>
+
+ <p>At length the term of her imprisonment was over, and Sophy
+ was restored to the society of her family. At first she kept a
+ tolerable guard over herself. Once she saw her father and
+ sister whispering, and did not, though she longed much to do
+ it, hold her breath that she might hear what they were saying.
+ Another time she passed Charles's door when it was ajar and the
+ little study open, and she had so much self-command that she
+ passed by without peeping in, and she began to think she was
+ cured of her faults. But in reality this was far from being the
+ case, and whenever she recollected Mrs. Arden's mysterious note
+ she felt her inquisitive propensities as strong as ever. Her
+ eyes and ears were always on the alert, in hopes of obtaining
+ some clue to the knowledge she coveted, and if Mrs, Arden's or
+ Mr. McNeal's names were mentioned she listened with trembling
+ anxiety in the hope of hearing some allusion to the note.</p>
+
+ <p>At last, when she had almost given up the matter in despair,
+ an unlooked-for chance put her in possession of a fragment of
+ this very note to which she attached so much importance.</p>
+
+ <p>One day Louisa wanted to wind a skein of silk, and in
+ looking for a piece of paper to wind it upon she opened her
+ writing-box, and took out Mrs. Arden's note. Sophy knew it
+ again in an instant from its three-cornered shape. She saw
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page450" id="page450"></a>[pg
+ 450]</span> her sister tear the note in two, throw one-half
+ under the grate, and fold the other part up to wind her silk
+ upon. Sophy kept her eye upon the paper that lay under the
+ grate in the greatest anxiety, lest a coal should drop upon it
+ and destroy it, when it seemed almost within her grasp. Louisa
+ was called out of the room, and Sophy, overpowered by the
+ greatness of the temptation, forgot all the good resolutions
+ she had so lately made, and at the risk of setting fire to her
+ sleeve, snatched the paper from among the ashes, and concealed
+ it in her pocket. She then flew to her own room to examine it
+ at her ease. The note had been torn the lengthway of the paper,
+ and that part of it of which Sophy had possessed herself
+ contained the first half of each line of the note. Bolting her
+ door for fear of interruption, she read, with trembling
+ impatience, as follows:</p>
+
+ <div class="poem">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p class="i6">Will you</p>
+
+ <p>be kind enough to go to</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. McNeal, and tell him</p>
+
+ <p>he has made a great mistake</p>
+
+ <p>the last stockings he sent;</p>
+
+ <p>charging them as silk) he has cheated</p>
+
+ <p>of several pounds.&mdash;I am sorry to say</p>
+
+ <p>that he has behaved very ill</p>
+
+ <p>And Mr. Arden tells me that</p>
+
+ <p>it must end in his being hanged</p>
+
+ <p>I am exceedingly grieved</p>
+
+ <p>but fear this will be the end</p>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+
+ <p>When Sophy had read these broken sentences she fancied that
+ she fully comprehended the purport of the whole note, and she
+ now saw the reason of her sister's hastening to Mr. McNeal's
+ immediately on the receipt of the note, and of the hurry in
+ which he had been summoned back to his shop. It appeared very
+ clear to her that he had defrauded Mrs. Arden of a considerable
+ sum of money, and that he was no longer that honest tradesman
+ he had been supposed. The weight of this important discovery
+ quite overburdened her, and, forgetful of her past punishment,
+ and regardless of future consequences, she imparted the
+ surprising secret to Sally. Sally was not one who could keep
+ such a piece of news to herself; it was therefore soon
+ circulated through half the town that Mr. McNeal had defrauded
+ Mrs. Arden, and that Mr. Arden declared he would have him
+ hanged for it. Several persons in
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page451" id="page451"></a>[pg
+ 451]</span> consequence avoided Mr. McNeal's shop, who saw his
+ customers forsaking him without being able to know why they did
+ so. Thus the conduct of this inconsiderate girl took away the
+ good name of an honest tradesman, on no better foundation than
+ her own idle conjectures, drawn from the torn fragments of a
+ letter.</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. McNeal at length became informed of the injurious report
+ that was circulated about him. He immediately went to Mrs.
+ Arden to tell her of the report, and to ask her if any
+ inadvertency of his own in regard to her dealings at his shop
+ occasioned her speaking so disadvantageously of him. Mrs. Arden
+ was much astonished at what he told her, as she might well be,
+ and assured him that she had never either spoken of him or
+ thought of him but as thoroughly an honorable and honest
+ tradesman. Mrs. Arden was exceedingly hurt that her name should
+ be attached to such a cruel calumny, and, on consulting with
+ Sir Henry Askham, it was agreed that he and Mrs. Arden should
+ make it their business to trace it back to its authors. They
+ found no real difficulty in tracing it back to Sally, Dr.
+ Hammond's servant. She was accordingly sent for to Mr.
+ McNeal's, where Sir Henry Askham and Mr. Arden, with some other
+ gentlemen, were assembled on this charitable investigation.
+ Sally, on being questioned who had told her of the report,
+ replied, without hesitation, that she had been told by Miss
+ Sophy, who had seen all the particulars in Mrs. Arden's
+ handwriting.</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Arden was greatly astonished at hearing this assertion,
+ and felt confident that the whole must have originated from
+ some strange blunder. He and the other gentlemen immediately
+ proceeded to Dr. Hammond's, and having explained their business
+ to him, desired to see Sophy. She, on being asked, confirmed
+ what Sally had said, adding that to satisfy them she could show
+ them Mrs. Arden's own words, and she accordingly produced the
+ fragment of the note. Miss Hammond, the instant she saw the
+ paper recollected it again, and winding off the silk from the
+ other half of Mrs. Arden's note, presented it to Mr. Arden,
+ who, laying the two pieces of paper together read as
+ follows:</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page452"
+ id="page452"></a>[pg 452]</span>
+
+ <blockquote>
+ <p>"<span class="sc">My dear Miss
+ Hammond</span>,&mdash;Will you as soon as you receive this
+ be kind enough to go to your opposite neighbor, Mr. McNeal,
+ and tell him I find by looking at his bill he has made a
+ great mistake as to the price of the last stockings he
+ sent; and it seems to me (by not charging them as silk) he
+ has cheated himself, as he'll see, of several
+ pounds.&mdash;I am sorry to say of our new dog, that he has
+ behaved very ill and worried two sheep, and Mr. Arden tells
+ me he very much fears it must end in his being hanged or
+ he'll kill all the flock. I am exceedingly grieved, for he
+ is a noble animal, but fear this will be the end of my poor
+ dog.</p>
+
+ <p class="ctr">"I am, dear Louisa, yours truly</p>
+
+ <p class="author">"Mary Arden."</p>
+ </blockquote>
+
+ <p>Thus by the fortunate preservation of the last half of the
+ note the whole affair was cleared up, Mrs. Arden's character
+ vindicated from the charge of being a defamer, and Mr. McNeal
+ from all suspicion of dishonesty. And all their friends were
+ pleased and satisfied. But how did Sophy feel? She did feel at
+ last both remorse and humiliation. She had no one to blame but
+ herself; she had no one to take her part, for even her father
+ and her brother considered it due to public justice that she
+ should make a public acknowledgment of her fault to Mr. McNeal,
+ and to ask his pardon.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page453"
+ id="page453"></a>[pg 453]</span>
+
+ <h3>BUSY IDLENESS</h3>
+
+ <h3>By JANE TAYLOR</h3>
+
+ <p>Mrs. Dawson being obliged to leave home for six weeks, her
+ daughters, Charlotte and Caroline, received permission to
+ employ the time of her absence as they pleased; that is, she
+ did not require of them the usual strict attention to
+ particular hours and particular studies, but allowed them to
+ choose their own employments&mdash;only recommending them to
+ make a good use of the license, and apprising them, that, on
+ her return, she should require an exact account of the manner
+ in which the interval had been employed.</p>
+
+ <p>The carriage that conveyed their mother away was scarcely
+ out of hearing, when Charlotte, delighted with her freedom,
+ hastened upstairs to the schoolroom, where she looked around on
+ books, globes, maps, drawings, to select some new employment
+ for the morning. Long before she had decided upon any, her
+ sister had quietly seated herself at her accustomed station,
+ thinking that she could do nothing better than finish the
+ French exercise she had begun the day before. Charlotte,
+ however, declined attending to French that day, and after much
+ indecision, and saying "I have a great mind to" three several
+ times without finishing the sentence, she at last took down a
+ volume of Cowper, and read in different parts for about half an
+ hour. Then throwing it aside, she said she had a great mind to
+ put the bookshelves in order&mdash;a business which she
+ commenced with great spirit. But in the course of her laudable
+ undertaking, she met with a manuscript in shorthand; whereupon
+ she exclaimed to her sister, "Caroline, don't you remember that
+ old Mr. Henderson once promised he would teach us shorthand?
+ How much I should like to learn! Only, mamma thought we had not
+ time. But now, this would be such a good opportunity. I am sure
+ I could learn it well in six weeks;
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page454" id="page454"></a>[pg
+ 454]</span> and how convenient it would be! One could take down
+ sermons, or anything; and I could make Rachel learn, and then
+ how very pleasant it would be to write to each other in
+ shorthand! Indeed, it would be convenient in a hundred ways."
+ So saying, she ran upstairs, without any further delay, and
+ putting on her hat and spencer, set off to old Mr.
+ Henderson's.</p>
+
+ <p>Mr. Henderson happened to be at dinner. Nevertheless,
+ Charlotte obtained admittance on the plea of urgent business;
+ but she entered his apartment so much out of breath, and in
+ such apparent agitation, that the old gentleman, rising hastily
+ from table, and looking anxiously at her over his spectacles,
+ inquired in a tremulous tone what was the matter. When,
+ therefore, Charlotte explained her business, he appeared a
+ little disconcerted; but having gently reproved her for her
+ undue eagerness, he composedly resumed his knife and fork,
+ though his hand shook much more than usual during the remainder
+ of his meal. However, being very good-natured, as soon as he
+ had dined he cheerfully gave Charlotte her first lesson in
+ shorthand, promising to repeat it regularly every morning.</p>
+
+ <p>Charlotte returned home in high glee. She at this juncture
+ considered shorthand as one of the most useful, and decidedly
+ the most interesting of acquirements; and she continued to
+ exercise herself in it all the rest of the day. She was
+ exceedingly pleased at being able already to write two or three
+ words which neither her sister nor even her father could
+ decipher. For three successive mornings Charlotte punctually
+ kept her appointment with Mr. Henderson; but on the fourth she
+ sent a shabby excuse to her kind master; and, if the truth must
+ be told, he from that time saw no more of his scholar. Now the
+ cause of this desertion was twofold: first, and principally,
+ her zeal for shorthand, which for the last eight-and-forty
+ hours had been sensibly declining in its temperature, was, on
+ the above morning, within half a degree of freezing point; and,
+ second, a new and far more arduous and important undertaking
+ had by this time suggested itself to her mind. Like many young
+ persons of desultory inclinations, Charlotte often amused
+ herself with writing verses; and it now occurred to her that an
+ abridged history of England in verse was still a desideratum
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page455" id="page455"></a>[pg
+ 455]</span> in literature. She commenced this task with her
+ usual diligence; but was somewhat discouraged in the outset by
+ the difficulty of finding a rhyme to Saxon, whom she indulged
+ the unpatriotic wish that the Danes had laid a tax on. But,
+ though she got over this obstacle by a new construction of the
+ line, she found these difficulties occur so continually that
+ she soon felt a more thorough disgust at this employment than
+ at the preceding one. So the epic stopped short, some hundred
+ years before the Norman conquest. Difficulty, which quickens
+ the ardor of industry, always damps, and generally
+ extinguishes, the false zeal of caprice and versatility.</p>
+
+ <p>Charlotte's next undertaking was, to be sure, a rapid
+ descent from the last in the scale of dignity. She now thought,
+ that, by working very hard during the remainder of the time,
+ she should be able to accomplish a patch-work counterpane,
+ large enough for her own little tent bed; and the ease of this
+ employment formed a most agreeable contrast in her mind with
+ the extreme difficulty of the last. Accordingly, as if
+ commissioned with a search warrant, she ransacked all her
+ mother's drawers, bags, and bundles in quest of new pieces; and
+ these spoils proving very insufficient, she set off to tax all
+ her friends, and to tease all the linen drapers in the town for
+ their odds and ends, urging that she wanted some particularly.
+ As she was posting along the street on this business, she
+ espied at a distance a person whom she had no wish to
+ encounter, namely, old Mr. Henderson. To avoid the meeting she
+ crossed over. But this maneuver did not succeed; for no sooner
+ had they come opposite to each other, than, to her great
+ confusion, he called out across the street, in his loud and
+ tremulous voice, and shaking his stick at her, "How d'ye do,
+ Miss Shorthand? I thought how it would be! Oh, fie! Oh,
+ fie!"</p>
+
+ <p>Charlotte hurried on; and her thoughts soon returned to the
+ idea of the splendid radiating star which she designed for the
+ centerpiece of her counterpane. While she was arranging the
+ different patterns, and forming the alternations of light and
+ shade, her interest continued nearly unabated; but when she
+ came to the practical part of sewing piece to piece with
+ unvarying sameness, it began, as usual, to flag. She sighed
+ several <span class="pagenum"><a name="page456"
+ id="page456"></a>[pg 456]</span> times, and cast many
+ disconsolate looks at the endless hexagons and octagons, before
+ she indulged any distinct idea of relinquishing her task. At
+ length, however, it did forcibly occur to her that, after all,
+ she was not obliged to go on with it; and that, really,
+ patchwork was a thing that was better done by degrees, when one
+ happens to want a job, than to be finished all at once. So,
+ with this thought (which would have been a very good one if it
+ had occurred in proper time), she suddenly drew out her needle,
+ thrust all her pieces, arranged and unarranged, into a drawer,
+ and began to meditate a new project.</p>
+
+ <p>Fortunately, just at this juncture some young ladies of
+ their acquaintance called upon Charlotte and Caroline. They
+ were attempting to establish a society among their young
+ friends for working for the poor, and came to request their
+ assistance. Caroline very cheerfully entered into the design;
+ but as for Charlotte, nothing could exceed the forwardness of
+ her zeal. She took it up so warmly that Caroline's appeared, in
+ comparison, only lukewarm. It was proposed that each member of
+ the society should have an equal proportion of the work to do
+ at her own house; but when the articles came to be distributed,
+ Charlotte, in the heat of her benevolence, desired that a
+ double portion might be allotted to her. Some of the younger
+ ones admired her industrious intentions, but the better judging
+ advised her not to undertake too much at once. However, she
+ would not be satisfied till her request was complied with. When
+ the parcels of work arrived, Charlotte with exultation seized
+ the larger one, and without a minute's delay commenced her
+ charitable labors. The following morning she rose at four
+ o'clock, to resume the employment; and not a little
+ self-complacency did she feel, when, after nearly two hours'
+ hard work, she still heard Caroline breathing in a sound sleep.
+ But, alas! Charlotte soon found that work is work, of whatever
+ nature, or for whatever purpose. She now inwardly regretted
+ that she had asked for more than her share; and the cowardly
+ thought that after all she was not obliged to do it next
+ occurred to her. For the present, therefore, she squeezed all
+ the things, done and undone, into what she called
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page457" id="page457"></a>[pg
+ 457]</span> her "Dorcas bag;" and to banish unpleasant
+ thoughts, she opened the first book that happened to lie within
+ reach. It proved to be "An Introduction to Botany." Of this she
+ had not read more than a page and a half before she determined
+ to collect some specimens herself; and having found a blank
+ copy-book she hastened into the garden, where, gathering a few
+ common flowers, she proceeded to dissect them, not, it is to be
+ feared, with much scientific nicety. Perhaps as many as three
+ pages of this copy-book were bespread with her specimens before
+ she discovered that botany was a dry study.</p>
+
+ <p>It would be too tedious to enumerate all the subsequent
+ ephemeral undertakings which filled up the remainder of the six
+ weeks. At the expiration of that time Mrs. Dawson returned. On
+ the next morning after her arrival she reminded her daughters
+ of the account she expected of their employments during her
+ absence, and desired them to set out on two tables in the
+ schoolroom everything they had done that could be exhibited,
+ together with the books they had been reading. Charlotte would
+ gladly have been excused her part of the exhibition; but this
+ was not permitted; and she reluctantly followed her sister to
+ make the preparation.</p>
+
+ <p>When the two tables were spread, their mother was summoned
+ to attend. Caroline's, which was first examined, contained,
+ first, her various exercises in the different branches of
+ study, regularly executed the same as usual. And there were
+ papers placed in the books she was reading in school hours, to
+ show how far she had proceeded in them. Besides these, she had
+ read in her leisure time, in French, Florian's "Numa
+ Pompilius," and in English, Mrs. More's "Practical Piety," and
+ some part of Johnson's "Lives of the Poets." All the needlework
+ which had been left to do or not, at her option, was neatly
+ finished; and her parcel of linen for the poor was also
+ completely and well done. The only instance in which Caroline
+ had availed herself of her mother's license, was that she had
+ prolonged her drawing lessons a little every day, in order to
+ present her mother with a pretty pair of screens, with flowers
+ copied from nature. These were, last of all, placed on the
+ table with an affectionate note, requesting her acceptance of
+ them.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page458"
+ id="page458"></a>[pg 458]</span>
+
+ <p>Mrs. Dawson, having carefully examined this table, proceeded
+ to the other, which was quite piled up with different articles.
+ Here, amid the heap, were Charlotte's three pages of shorthand;
+ several scraps of paper containing fragments of her poetical
+ history; the piece (not large enough for a doll's cradle) of
+ her patchwork counterpane; her botanical specimens; together
+ with the large unfinished pile out of the Dorcas bag, many of
+ the articles of which were begun, but not one quite finished.
+ There was a baby's cap with no border, a frock body without
+ sleeves, and the skirt only half hemmed at the bottom; and
+ slides, tapes, and buttonholes were all, without exception,
+ omitted. After these, followed a great variety of thirds,
+ halves, and quarters of undertakings, each perhaps good in
+ itself, but quite useless in its unfinished state.</p>
+
+ <p>The examination being at length ended, Mrs. Dawson retired,
+ without a single comment, to her dressing-room; where, in about
+ an hour afterwards, she summoned the girls to attend her. Here
+ also were two tables laid out, with several articles on each.
+ Their mother then leading Caroline to the first, told her that,
+ as the reward of her industry and perseverance, the contents of
+ the table were her own. Here, with joyful surprise, she beheld,
+ first, a little gold watch, which Mrs. Dawson said she thought
+ a suitable present for one who had made a good use of her time;
+ a small telescope next appeared; and lastly, Paley's "Natural
+ Theology," neatly bound. Charlotte was then desired to take
+ possession of the contents of the other table, which were
+ considerably more numerous. The first prize she drew out was a
+ very beautiful French fan; but upon opening it, it stretched
+ out in an oblong shape, for want of the pin to confine the
+ sticks at bottom. Then followed a new parasol; but when
+ unfurled there was no catch to confine it, so that it would not
+ remain spread. A penknife handle without a blade, and the blade
+ without the handle, next presented themselves to her astonished
+ gaze. In great confusion she then unrolled a paper which
+ discovered a telescope apparently like her sister's; but on
+ applying it to her eye, she found it did not contain a single
+ lens&mdash;so that it was no better than a roll of pasteboard.
+ She was, however, greatly encouraged to
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page459" id="page459"></a>[pg
+ 459]</span> discover that the last remaining article was a
+ watch; for, as she heard it tick, she felt no doubt that this
+ at least was complete; but upon examination she discovered that
+ there was no hour hand, the minute hand alone pursuing its
+ lonely and useless track.</p>
+
+ <p>Charlotte, whose conscience had very soon explained to her
+ the moral of all this, now turned from the tantalizing table in
+ confusion, and burst into an agony of tears. Caroline wept
+ also; and Mrs. Dawson, after an interval of silence, thus
+ addressed her daughters:</p>
+
+ <p>"It is quite needless for me to explain my reasons for
+ making you such presents, Charlotte. I assure you your papa and
+ I have had a very painful employment the past hour in spoiling
+ them all for you. If I had found on your table in the
+ schoolroom any one thing that had been properly finished, you
+ would have received one complete present to answer it; but this
+ you know was not the case. I should be very glad if this
+ disappointment should teach you what I have hitherto vainly
+ endeavored to impress upon you&mdash;that as all those things,
+ pretty or useful as they are in themselves, are rendered
+ totally useless for want of completeness, so exertion without
+ perseverance is no better than busy idleness. That employment
+ does not deserve the name of industry which requires the
+ stimulus of novelty to keep it going. Those who will only work
+ so long as they are amused will do no more good in the world,
+ either to themselves or others, than those who refuse to work
+ at all. If I had required you to pass the six weeks of my
+ absence in bed or in counting your fingers, you would, I
+ suppose, have thought it a sad waste of time; and yet I appeal
+ to you whether (with the exception of an hour or two of
+ needlework) the whole mass of articles on your table could
+ produce anything more useful. And thus, my dears, may life be
+ squandered away, in a succession of busy nothings.</p>
+
+ <p>"I have now a proposal to make to you. These presents, which
+ you are to take possession of as they are, I advise you to lay
+ by carefully. Whenever you can show me anything that you have
+ begun, and voluntarily finished, you may at the same time bring
+ with you one of these things, beginning with
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page460" id="page460"></a>[pg
+ 460]</span> those of least value, to which I will immediately
+ add the part that is deficient. Thus, by degrees, you may have
+ them all completed; and if by this means you should acquire the
+ wise and virtuous habit of perseverance, it will be far more
+ valuable to you than the richest present you could possibly
+ receive."</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page461"
+ id="page461"></a>[pg 461]</span>
+
+ <h3>THE RENOWNED HISTORY OF LITTLE GOODY TWO-SHOES</h3>
+
+ <h4>Ascribed to OLIVER GOLDSMITH</h4>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h4>INTRODUCTION</h4>
+
+ <p>All the world must allow that Two-Shoes was not her real
+ name. No; her father's name was Meanwell; and he was for many
+ years a considerable farmer in the parish where Margery was
+ born; but by the misfortunes which he met with in business, and
+ the wicked persecutions of Sir Timothy Gripe, and an overgrown
+ farmer called Graspall, he was effectually ruined.</p>
+
+ <p>The case was thus: The parish of Mould well, where they
+ lived, had for many ages been let by the lord of the manor in
+ twelve different farms, in which the tenants lived comfortably,
+ brought up large families, and carefully supported the poor
+ people who labored for them, until the estate by marriage and
+ by death came into the hands of Sir Timothy.</p>
+
+ <p>This, gentleman, who loved himself better than all his
+ neighbors, thought it was less trouble to write one receipt for
+ his rent than twelve; and Farmer Graspall offering to take all
+ the farms as the leases expired, Sir Timothy agreed with him,
+ and in process of time he was possessed of every farm but that
+ occupied by little Margery's father, which he also wanted; for
+ as Mr. Meanwell was a charitable, good man, he stood up for the
+ poor at the parish meetings, and was unwilling to have them
+ oppressed by Sir Timothy and this avaricious farmer. Judge, O
+ kind, humane, and courteous reader, what a terrible situation
+ the poor must be in, when this covetous man was perpetual
+ overseer, and everything for their maintenance was drawn from
+ his hard heart and cruel hand. But he was not only perpetual
+ overseer, but perpetual churchwarden; and judge, O ye
+ Christians, what state the church must be in, when
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page462" id="page462"></a>[pg
+ 462]</span> supported by a man without religion or virtue. He
+ was also perpetual surveyor of the highways, and what sort of
+ roads he kept up for the convenience of travelers, those best
+ knew who have had the misfortune to pass through that parish.
+ Complaints indeed were made, but to what purpose are
+ complaints, when brought against a man who can hunt, drink, and
+ smoke, without the lord of the manor, who is also the justice
+ of peace?</p>
+
+ <p>The opposition which Little Margery's father made to this
+ man's tyranny gave offense to Sir Timothy, who endeavored to
+ force him out of his farm; and, to oblige him to throw up the
+ lease, ordered both a brick-kiln and a dog kennel to be erected
+ in the farmer's orchard. This was contrary to law, and a suit
+ was commenced, in which Margery's father got the better. The
+ same offense was again committed three different times, and as
+ many actions brought, in all of which the farmer had a verdict,
+ and costs paid him; but notwithstanding these advantages, the
+ law was so expensive, that he was ruined in the contest, and
+ obliged to give up all he had to his creditors; which
+ effectually answered the purpose of Sir Timothy, who erected
+ those nuisances in the farmer's orchard with that intention.
+ Ah, my dear reader, we brag of liberty, and boast of our laws;
+ but the blessings of the one, and the protection of the other,
+ seldom fall to the lot of the poor; and especially when a rich
+ man is their adversary. How, in the name-of goodness, can a
+ poor wretch obtain redress, when thirty pounds are insufficient
+ to try his cause? Where is he to find money to fee counsel, or
+ how can he plead his cause himself (even if he was permitted)
+ when our laws are so obscure and so multiplied that an
+ abridgment of them cannot be contained in fifty volumes
+ folio?</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as Mr. Meanwell had called together his creditors,
+ Sir Timothy seized for a year's rent, and turned the farmer,
+ his wife, Little Margery, and her brother out of doors, without
+ any of the necessaries of life to support them.</p>
+
+ <p>This elated the heart of Mr. Graspall, this crowned his
+ hopes, and filled the measure of his iniquity; for, besides
+ gratifying his revenge, this man's overthrow gave him the sole
+ dominion over the poor, whom he depressed and abused in a
+ manner too horrible to
+ mention.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page463"
+ id="page463"></a>[pg 463]</span>
+
+ <p>Margery's father flew into another parish for succor, and
+ all those who were able to move left their dwellings and sought
+ employment elsewhere, as they found it would be impossible to
+ live under the tyranny of two such people. The very old, the
+ very lame, and the blind were obliged to stay behind, and
+ whether they were starved, or what became of them, history does
+ not say; but the characters of the great Sir Timothy, and the
+ avaricious tenant, were so infamous, that nobody would work for
+ them by the day, and servants were afraid to engage themselves
+ by the year, lest any unforseen accident should leave them
+ parishioners in a place where they knew they must perish
+ miserably; so that great part of the land lay untilled for some
+ years, which was deemed a just reward for such diabolical
+ proceedings.</p>
+
+ <p>But what, says the reader, can occasion all this? do you
+ intend this for children? Permit me to inform you, that this is
+ not the book, sir, mentioned in the title, but an introduction
+ to that book; and it is intended, sir, not for that sort of
+ children, but for children of six feet high, of which, as my
+ friend has justly observed, there are many millions in the
+ kingdom; and these reflections, sir, have been rendered
+ necessary by the unaccountable and diabolical scheme which many
+ gentlemen now give in to, of laying a number of farms into one,
+ and very often a whole parish into one farm; which in the end
+ must reduce the common people to a stage of vassalage, worse
+ than that under the barons of old, or of the clans in Scotland,
+ and will in time depopulate the kingdom. But as you are tired
+ of the subject, I shall take myself away, and you may visit
+ Little Margery.</p>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW AND ABOUT LITTLE MARGERY AND HER BROTHER</h4>
+
+ <p>Care and discontent shortened the days of Little Margery's
+ father. He was forced from his family, and seized with a
+ violent fever in a place where Dr. James's powder was not to be
+ had, and where he died miserably. Margery's poor mother
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page464" id="page464"></a>[pg
+ 464]</span> survived the loss of her husband but a few days,
+ and died of a broken heart, leaving Margery and her little
+ brother to the wide world; but, poor woman, it would have
+ melted your heart to have seen how frequently she heaved her
+ head, while she lay speechless, to survey with languishing
+ looks her little orphans, as much as to say, "Do, Tommy, do,
+ Margery, come with me." They cried, poor things, and she sighed
+ away her soul; and I hope is happy.</p>
+
+ <p>It would both have excited your pity, and have done your
+ heart good, to have seen how these two little ones were so fond
+ of each other, and how hand in hand they trotted about.</p>
+
+ <p>They were both very ragged, and Tommy had no shoes, and
+ Margery had but one. They had nothing, poor things, to support
+ them (not being in their own parish) but what they picked from
+ the hedges, or got from the poor people, and they lay every
+ night in a barn. Their relations took no notice of them; no,
+ they were rich, and ashamed to own such a poor little ragged
+ girl as Margery, and such a dirty little curly-pated boy as
+ Tommy. Our relations and friends seldom take notice of us when
+ we are poor; but as we grow rich they grow fond. And this will
+ always be the case, while people love money better than they do
+ God Almighty. But such wicked folks who love nothing but money,
+ and are proud and despise the poor, never come to any good in
+ the end, as we shall see by and by.</p>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW AND ABOUT MR. SMITH</h4>
+
+ <p>Mr. Smith was a very worthy clergyman, who lived in the
+ parish where Little Margery and Tommy were born; and having a
+ relation come to see him, who was a charitable, good man, he
+ sent for these children to come to him. The gentleman ordered
+ Little Margery a new pair of shoes, gave Mr. Smith some money
+ to buy her clothes, and said he would take Tommy and make him a
+ little sailor.</p>
+
+ <p>After some days the gentleman intended to go to London, and
+ take little Tommy with him, of whom you will know more
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page465" id="page465"></a>[pg
+ 465]</span> by and by, for we shall at a proper time present
+ you with his history, his travels, and adventures.</p>
+
+ <p>The parting between these little children was very
+ affecting. Tommy cried, and they kissed each other an hundred
+ times: at last Tommy thus wiped off her tears with the end of
+ his jacket, and bid her cry no more, for that he would come to
+ her again when he returned from sea.</p>
+
+ <h4>III</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW LITTLE MARGERY OBTAINED THE NAME OF GOODY TWO-SHOES,
+ AND WHAT HAPPENED IN THE PARISH</h4>
+
+ <p>As soon as Little Margery got up in the morning, which was
+ very early, she ran all round the village, crying for her
+ brother; and after some time returned greatly distressed.</p>
+
+ <p>However, at this instant, the shoemaker very opportunely
+ came in with the new shoes, for which she had been measured by
+ the gentleman's order.</p>
+
+ <p>Nothing could have supported Little Margery under the
+ affliction she was in for the loss of her brother, but the
+ pleasure she took in her two shoes. She ran out to Mrs. Smith
+ as soon as they were put on, and stroking down her ragged apron
+ thus cried out, "Two shoes, ma'am, see two shoes." And so she
+ behaved to all the people she met, and by that means obtained
+ the name of Goody Two-Shoes.</p>
+
+ <p>Little Margery was very happy in being with Mr. and Mrs.
+ Smith, who were very charitable and good to her, and had agreed
+ to bring her up with their family: but as soon as that tyrant
+ of the parish, that Graspall, heard of her being there, he
+ applied first to Mr. Smith, and threatened to reduce his tithes
+ if he kept her; and after that he spoke to Sir Timothy, who
+ sent Mr. Smith a peremptory message by his servant, that he
+ should send back Meanwell's girl to be kept by her relations,
+ and not harbor her in the parish. This so distressed Mr. Smith,
+ that he shed tears, and cried, "Lord, have mercy on the
+ poor!"</p>
+
+ <p>The prayers of the righteous fly upwards, and reach unto the
+ throne of heaven, as will be seen by the sequel.</p>
+
+ <p>Mrs. Smith was also greatly concerned at being thus obliged
+ to <span class="pagenum"><a name="page466" id="page466"></a>[pg
+ 466]</span> discard poor Little Margery. She kissed her, and
+ cried, as did also Mr. Smith; but they were obliged to send her
+ away, for the people who had ruined her father could at any
+ time have ruined them.</p>
+
+ <h4>IV</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW LITTLE MARGERY LEARNED TO READ, AND BY DEGREES TAUGHT
+ OTHERS</h4>
+
+ <p>Little Margery saw how good and how wise Mr. Smith was, and
+ concluded that this was owing to his great learning, therefore
+ she wanted of all things to learn to read. For this purpose she
+ used to meet the little boys as they came from school, borrow
+ their books, and sit down and read till they returned. By this
+ means she got more learning than any of her playmates, and laid
+ the following scheme for instructing those who were more
+ ignorant than herself. She found that only the following
+ letters were required to spell all the words; but as some of
+ these letters are large, and some small, she with her knife cut
+ out of several pieces of wood ten sets of each of these:</p>
+
+ <p>a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z.</p>
+
+ <p>And having got an old spelling book, she made her companions
+ set up all the words they wanted to spell, and after that she
+ taught them to compose sentences. "You know what a sentence is,
+ my dear. 'I will be good' is a sentence; and is made up, as you
+ see, of several words."</p>
+
+ <p>I once went her rounds with her, and was highly diverted, as
+ you may see, if you please to look into the next chapter.</p>
+
+ <h4>V</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW LITTLE TWO-SHOES BECAME A TROTTING TUTORESS, AND HOW
+ SHE TAUGHT HER YOUNG PUPILS</h4>
+
+ <p>It was about seven o'clock in the morning when we set out on
+ this important business, and the first house we came to was
+ Farmer Wilson's. Here Margery stopped, and ran up to the door,
+ tap, tap, tap. "Who's there?" "Only Little Goody
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page467" id="page467"></a>[pg
+ 467]</span> Two-Shoes," answered Margery, "come to teach
+ Billy." "Oh! Little Goody," says Mrs. Wilson, with pleasure in
+ her face, "I am glad to see you Billy wants you sadly for he
+ has learned his lesson." Then out came the little boy. "How do,
+ Doody Two-Shoes," says he, not able to speak plain. Yet this
+ little boy had learned all his letters; for she threw down this
+ alphabet mixed together thus:</p>
+
+ <p>b d f h k m o q s u w y x f a c e g i l n p r t v z j,</p>
+
+ <p>and he picked them up, called them by their right names, and
+ put them all in order thus:</p>
+
+ <p>a b c d e f g h i j k i m n o p q r s t u v w x y z.</p>
+
+ <p>The next place we came to was Farmer Simpson's.</p>
+
+ <p>"Bow, wow, wow," says the dog at the door. "Sirrah," says
+ his mistress, "what do you bark at Little Two-Shoes? come in,
+ Madge; here, Sally wants you sadly, she has learned all her
+ lesson." "Yes, that's what I have," replied the little one, in
+ the country manner: and immediately taking the letters she set
+ up these syllables:</p>
+
+ <div class="poem">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p>ba be bi bo bu, ca ce ci co cu,</p>
+ </div>
+
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p>da de di do du, fa fe fi fo fu,</p>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+
+ <p>and gave them their exact sounds as she composed them.</p>
+
+ <p>After this, Little Two-Shoes taught her to spell words of
+ one syllable, and she soon set up pear, plumb, top, ball, pin,
+ puss, dog, hog, fawn, buck, doe, lamb, sheep, ram, cow, bull,
+ cock, hen, and many more.</p>
+
+ <p>The next place we came to was Gaffer Cook's cottage. Here a
+ number of poor children were met to learn, who all came round
+ Little Margery at once, who having pulled out her letters,
+ asked the little boy next her what he had for dinner? Who
+ answered, "Bread" (the poor children in many places live very
+ hard). "Well then," says she, "set up the first letter." He put
+ up the B, to which the next added r, and the next e, the next
+ a, the next d, and it stood thus, Bread.</p>
+
+ <p>And what had you, Polly Comb, for your dinner? "Apple Pie,"
+ answered the little girl; upon which the next in turn set up a
+ great A, the two next a p each, and so on, till the two words
+ Apple and Pie were united and stood thus, Apple Pie.</p>
+
+ <p>The next had potatoes, the next beef and turnips; which
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page468" id="page468"></a>[pg
+ 468]</span> were spelled, with many others, till the game of
+ spelling was finished. She then set them another task, and we
+ proceeded.</p>
+
+ <p>The next place we came to was Farmer Thomson's, where there
+ was a great many little ones waiting for her.</p>
+
+ <p>"So, Little Mrs. Goody Two-Shoes," says one of them, "where
+ have you been so long?" "I have been teaching," says she,
+ "longer than I intended, and am, I am afraid, come too soon for
+ you now." "No, but indeed you are not," replied the other; "for
+ I have got my lesson, and so has Sally Dawson, and so has Harry
+ Wilson, and so have we all;" and they capered about as if they
+ were overjoyed to see her. "Why, then," says she, "you are all
+ very good, and God Almighty will love you; so let us begin our
+ lessons." They all huddled round her, and though at the other
+ place they were employed about words and syllables, here we had
+ people of much greater understanding who dealt only in
+ sentences.</p>
+
+ <p>The letters being brought upon the table, one of the little
+ ones set up the following sentence:</p>
+
+ <p>"The Lord have mercy upon me, and grant that I may be always
+ good, and say my prayers, and love the Lord my God with all my
+ heart, with all my soul, and with all my strength; and honor
+ the King and all good men in authority under him."</p>
+
+ <p>Then the next took the letters, and composed this
+ sentence:</p>
+
+ <p>"Lord, have mercy upon me, and grant that I may love my
+ neighbor as myself, and do unto all men as I would have them do
+ unto me, and tell no lies; but be honest and just in all my
+ dealings."</p>
+
+ <h4>LESSON FOR THE CONDUCT OF LIFE</h4>
+
+ <div class="poem">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p>He that would thrive,</p>
+
+ <p class="i2">Must rise by five.</p>
+
+ <p>He that hath thriven,</p>
+
+ <p class="i2">May lay till seven.</p>
+
+ <p>Truth may be blamed</p>
+
+ <p class="i2">But can't be shamed.</p>
+
+ <p>Tell me with whom you go,</p>
+
+ <p class="i2">And I'll tell what you do.</p>
+
+ <p>A friend in your need,</p>
+
+ <p class="i2">Is a friend indeed.</p>
+
+ <p>They never can be wise,</p>
+
+ <p class="i2">Who good counsel despise.</p>
+ </div>
+ </div><span class="pagenum"><a name="page469"
+ id="page469"></a>[pg 469]</span>
+
+ <p>As we were returning home, we saw a gentleman, who was very
+ ill, sitting under a shady tree at the corner of the rookery.
+ Though ill, he began to joke with Little Margery, and said,
+ laughing, "So, Goody Two-Shoes, they tell me you are a cunning
+ little baggage; pray can you tell me what I shall do to get
+ well?" "Yes, sir," says she, "go to bed when your rooks do and
+ get up with them in the morning; earn, as they do, every day
+ what you eat, and eat and drink no more than you earn: and
+ you'll get health and keep it. What should induce the rooks to
+ frequent gentlemen's houses, only but to tell them how to lead
+ a prudent life? they never build under cottages or farmhouses,
+ because they see that these people know how to live without
+ their admonition.</p>
+
+ <div class="poem">
+ <div class="stanza">
+ <p>"Thus wealth and wit you may improve.</p>
+
+ <p class="i2">Taught by tenants of the grove."</p>
+ </div>
+ </div>
+
+ <p>The gentleman, laughing, gave Margery sixpence, and told her
+ she was a sensible hussy.</p>
+
+ <h4>VI</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW THE WHOLE PARISH WAS FRIGHTENED</h4>
+
+ <p>Who does not know Lady Ducklington, or who does not know
+ that she was buried at this parish church? Well, I never saw a
+ grander funeral in all my life; but the money they squandered
+ away would have been better laid out in little books for
+ children, or in meat, drink, and clothes for the poor.</p>
+
+ <p>All the country round came to see the burying, and it was
+ late before the corpse was interred. After which, in the night,
+ or rather about two o'clock in the morning, the bells were
+ heard to jingle in the steeple, which frightened the people
+ prodigiously, who all thought it was Lady Ducklington's ghost
+ dancing among the bell ropes. The people flocked to Will
+ Dobbins, the clerk, and wanted him to go to see what it was;
+ but William said he was sure it was a ghost, and that he would
+ not offer to open the door. At length Mr. Long, the rector,
+ hearing such an uproar in the village, went to the clerk, to
+ know why he did not go into the church, and see who was there.
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page470" id="page470"></a>[pg
+ 470]</span> "I go, sir?" says William; "why, the ghost would
+ frighten me out of my wits!" Mrs. Dobbins, too, cried, and
+ laying hold of her husband, said he should not be eat up by the
+ ghost. "A ghost, you blockhead," says Mr. Long, in a pet; "did
+ either of you ever see a ghost in a church, or know anybody
+ that did?" "Yes," says the clerk, "my father did once in the
+ shape of a windmill, and it walked all around the church in a
+ trice, with jack boots on, and had a gun by its side, instead
+ of a sword." "A fine picture of a ghost, truly," says Mr. Long;
+ "give me the key of the church, you monkey, for I tell you
+ there is no such thing now, whatever may have been formerly."
+ Then taking the key, he went to the church, all the people
+ following him. As soon as he had opened the door, what sort of
+ a ghost do you think appeared? Why, Little Two-Shoes, who being
+ weary had fallen asleep in one of the pews during the funeral
+ service, and was shut in all night. She immediately asked Mr.
+ Long's pardon for the trouble she had given him, told him she
+ had been locked into the church, and said she should not have
+ rung the bells, but that she was very cold, and hearing Farmer
+ Boult's man go whistling by with his horses, she was in hopes
+ he would have gone to the clerk for the key to let her out.</p>
+
+ <h4>VII</h4>
+
+ <h4>CONTAINING AN ACCOUNT OF ALL THE SPIRITS OR THINGS SHE SAW
+ IN THE CHURCH</h4>
+
+ <p>The people were ashamed to ask Little Madge any questions
+ before Mr. Long, but as soon as he was gone, they all got round
+ her to satisfy their curiosity, and desired she would give them
+ a particular account of all that she had heard or seen.</p>
+
+ <h4>HER TALE</h4>
+
+ <p>"I went to the church," said she, "as most of you did last
+ night, to see the burying, and, being very weary, I sat me down
+ in Mr. Johns's pew, and fell fast asleep. At eleven of the
+ clock <span class="pagenum"><a name="page471"
+ id="page471"></a>[pg 471]</span> I awoke; which I believe was
+ in some measure occasioned by the clock's striking, for I heard
+ it. I started up, and could not at first tell where I was; but
+ after some time I recollected the funeral, and soon found that
+ I was shut in the church. It was dismal dark, and I could see
+ nothing; but while I was standing in the pew, something jumped
+ up upon me behind, and laid, as I thought, its hands over my
+ shoulders. I own I was a little afraid at first; however, I
+ considered that I had always been constant at prayers, and at
+ church, and that I had done nobody any harm, but had endeavored
+ to do what good I could; and then thought I, what have I to
+ fear? Yet I kneeled down to say my prayers. As soon as I was on
+ my knees, something very cold, as cold as marble, ay, as cold
+ as ice, touched my neck, which made me start, however, I
+ continued my prayers, and having begged protection from
+ Almighty God, I found my spirits come, and I was sensible I had
+ nothing to fear; for God Almighty protects not only all those
+ that are good, but also all those who endeavor to be
+ good&mdash;nothing can withstand the power, and exceed the
+ goodness of God Almighty. Armed with the confidence of his
+ protection; I walked down the church aisle, when I heard
+ something pit, pat, pit, pat, pit, pat, come after me, and
+ something touched my hand, which seemed as cold as a marble
+ monument. I could not think what this was, yet I knew that it
+ could not hurt me, and therefore I made myself easy; but being
+ very cold, and the church being paved with stones, which were
+ very damp, I felt my way, as well as I could, to the pulpit; in
+ doing which something rushed by me and almost threw me down,
+ However, I was not frightened, for I knew that God Almighty
+ would suffer nothing to hurt me.</p>
+
+ <p>"At last I found out the pulpit, and having shut the door, I
+ laid me down on the mat and cushion to sleep; when something
+ thrust and pulled the door, as I thought, for admittance, which
+ prevented my going to sleep. At last it cries, 'Bow, wow, wow;'
+ and I concluded it must be Mr. Saunderson's dog, which had
+ followed me from their house to church; so I opened the door,
+ and called Snip, Snip, and the dog jumped upon me immediately.
+ After this, Snip and I lay down
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page472" id="page472"></a>[pg
+ 472]</span> together, and had a comfortable nap; for when I
+ awoke again it was almost light. I then walked up and down all
+ the aisles of the church to keep myself warm; and though I went
+ into the vaults, and trod on Lady Ducklington's coffin, I saw
+ nothing, and I believe it was owing to the reason Mr. Long has
+ given you, namely, that there is no such thing to be seen. As
+ to my part, I would as soon lie all night in a church as in any
+ other place; and I am sure that any little boy or girl, who is
+ good and loves God Almighty, and keeps his commandments, may as
+ safely lie in the church, or the churchyard, as anywhere else,
+ if they take care not to get cold, for I am sure there are no
+ things either to hurt or to frighten them; though any one
+ possessed of fear might have taken Neighbor Saunderson's dog
+ with his cold nose for a ghost; and if they had not been
+ undeceived, as I was, would never have thought otherwise." All
+ the company acknowledged the justness of the observation, and
+ thanked Little Two-Shoes for her advice.</p>
+
+ <h4>REFLECTION</h4>
+
+ <p>After this, my dear children, I hope you will not believe
+ any foolish stories that ignorant, weak, or designing people
+ may tell you about ghosts; for the tales of ghosts, witches,
+ and fairies are the frolics of a distempered brain. No wise man
+ ever saw either of them. Little Margery was not afraid; no, she
+ had good sense, and a good conscience, which is a cure for all
+ these imaginary evils.</p>
+
+ <h4>VIII</h4>
+
+ <h4>OF SOMETHING WHICH HAPPENED TO LITTLE MARGERY TWO-SHOES IN
+ A BARN, MORE DREADFUL THAN THE GHOST IN THE CHURCH; AND HOW SHE
+ RETURNED GOOD FOR EVIL TO HER ENEMY, SIR TIMOTHY.</h4>
+
+ <p>Some days after this, a more dreadful accident befell Little
+ Madge. She happened to be coming late from teaching,
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page473" id="page473"></a>[pg
+ 473]</span> when it rained, thundered, and lightened and
+ therefore she took shelter in a farmer's barn at a distance
+ from the village. Soon after, the tempest drove in four
+ thieves, who not seeing such a little creep-mouse girl as
+ Two-Shoes, lay down on the hay next to her, and began to talk
+ over their exploits, and to settle plans for future robberies.
+ Little Margery, on hearing them, covered herself with straw. To
+ be sure she was frightened, but her good sense taught her that
+ the only security she had was in keeping herself concealed;
+ therefore she lay very still and breathed very softly. About
+ four o'clock these wicked people came to a resolution to break
+ both Sir William Dove's house and Sir Timothy Gripe's, and by
+ force of arms to carry off all their money, plate, and jewels;
+ but as it was thought then too late, they all agreed to defer
+ it till the next night. After laying his scheme, they all set
+ out upon their pranks, which greatly rejoiced Margery, as it
+ would any other little girl in her situation. Early in the
+ morning she went to Sir William, and told him the whole of
+ their conversation. Upon which he asked her name, then gave her
+ something, and bid her call at his house the day following. She
+ also went to Sir Timothy, notwithstanding he had used her so
+ ill, for she knew it was her duty to do good for evil. As soon
+ as he was informed who she was, he took no notice of her; upon
+ which she desired to speak to Lady Gripe, and having informed
+ her ladyship of the affair she went away. This lady had more
+ sense than her husband which indeed is not a singular case; for
+ instead of despising Little Margery and her information, she
+ privately set people to guard the house. The robbers divided
+ themselves, and went about the time mentioned to both houses,
+ and were surprised by the guards and taken. Upon examining
+ these wretches (one of which turned evidence), both Sir William
+ and Sir Timothy found that they owed their lives to the
+ discovery made by Little Margery; and the first took great
+ notice of her and would no longer let her lie in a barn; but
+ Sir Timothy only said that he was ashamed to owe his life to
+ the daughter of one who was his enemy; so true it is, "That a
+ proud man seldom forgives those he has
+ injured."</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page474"
+ id="page474"></a>[pg 474]</span>
+
+ <h4>IX</h4>
+
+ <h4>HOW LITTLE MARGERY WAS MADE PRINCIPAL OF A COUNTRY
+ COLLEGE</h4>
+
+ <p>Mrs. Williams, who kept a college for instructing little
+ gentlemen and ladies in the science of A, B, C, was at this
+ time very old and infirm, and wanted to decline this important
+ trust. This being told to Sir William Dove, who lived in the
+ parish, he sent for Mrs. Williams, and desired she would
+ examine Little Two-Shoes, and see whether she was qualified for
+ the office. This was done, and Mrs. Williams made the following
+ report in her favor, namely, that Little Margery was the best
+ scholar, and had the best head and the best heart of any one
+ she had examined. All the country had a great opinion of Mrs.
+ Williams, and this character gave them also a great opinion of
+ Mrs. Margery, for so we must now call her.</p>
+
+ <p>This Mrs. Margery thought the happiest period of her life;
+ but more happiness was in store for her. God Almighty heaps up
+ blessings for all those who love him, and though for a time he
+ may suffer them to be poor, and distressed, and hide his good
+ purposes from human sight, yet in the end they are generally
+ crowned with happiness here, and no one can doubt their being
+ so hereafter.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <h3>THE RENOWNED HISTORY OF MRS. MARGERY TWO-SHOES</h3>
+
+ <h4>PART TWO</h4>
+
+ <p>In the first part of this work the young student has read,
+ and I hope with pleasure and improvement, the history of this
+ lady, while she was known and distinguished by the name of
+ LITTLE TWO-SHOES. We are now come to a period of her life when
+ that name was discarded, and a more eminent one bestowed upon
+ her; I mean that of MRS. MARGERY TWO-SHOES;
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page475" id="page475"></a>[pg
+ 475]</span> for as she was now president of the A, B, C
+ college, it became necessary to exalt her in title as in
+ place.</p>
+
+ <p>No sooner was she settled in this office, but she laid every
+ possible scheme to promote the welfare and happiness of all her
+ neighbors, and especially of her little ones, in whom she took
+ great delight; and all those whose parents could not afford to
+ pay for their education, she taught for nothing but the
+ pleasure she had in their company; for you are to observe that
+ they were very good, or were soon made so by her good
+ management.</p>
+
+ <h4>I</h4>
+
+ <h4>OF HER SCHOOL, HER USHERS, OR ASSISTANTS, AND HER MANNER OF
+ TEACHING</h4>
+
+ <p>We have already informed the reader, that the school where
+ she taught was that which was before kept by Mrs. Williams. The
+ room was very large and spacious, and as she knew that nature
+ intended children should be always in action, she placed her
+ different letters, or alphabets, all round the school, so that
+ every one was obliged to get up and fetch a letter, or to spell
+ a word when it came to their turn; which not only kept them in
+ health, but fixed the letters and points firmly in their
+ minds.</p>
+
+ <h4>II</h4>
+
+ <h4>A SCENE OF DISTRESS IN A SCHOOL</h4>
+
+ <p>It happened one day, when Mrs. Two-Shoes was diverting the
+ children after dinner, as she usually did, with some innocent
+ games, or entertaining and instructive stories, that a man
+ arrived with the melancholy news of Sally Jones's father being
+ thrown from his horse, and thought past all recovery; nay, the
+ messenger said, that he was seemingly dying when he came away.
+ Poor Sally was greatly distressed, as indeed were all in the
+ school, for she dearly loved her father, and Mrs. Two-Shoes and
+ all her children dearly loved
+ her.</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page476"
+ id="page476"></a>[pg 476]</span>
+
+ <p>At this instant something was heard to flap at the window,
+ at which the children were surprised; but Mrs. Margery, knowing
+ what it was, opened the casement, and drew in a pigeon with a
+ letter.</p>
+
+ <p>As soon as he was placed upon the table, he walked up to
+ little Sally, and dropping the letter, cried "Co, co, coo;" as
+ much as to say, "There, read it."</p>
+
+ <blockquote>
+ <p>"My dear Sally&mdash;God Almighty has been very merciful
+ and restored your papa to us again, who is now so well as
+ to be able to sit up. I hear you are a good girl, my dear,
+ and I hope you will never forget to praise the Lord for
+ that his great goodness and mercy to us. What a sad thing
+ it would have been if your father had died, and left both
+ you and me, and little Tommy in distress, and without a
+ friend. Your father sends his blessing with mine. Be good,
+ my dear child, and God Almighty will also bless you, whose
+ blessing is above all things.</p>
+
+ <p style="text-indent:4em">"I am, my dear Sally,</p>
+
+ <p class="ctr" style="margin-top:-1em;">"Your affectionate
+ mother,</p>
+
+ <p class="author">"Martha Jones."</p>
+ </blockquote><br />
+
+
+ <h4>III</h4>
+
+ <h4>OF THE AMAZING SAGACITY AND INSTINCT OF A LITTLE DOG</h4>
+
+ <p>Soon after this, a very dreadful accident happened in the
+ school. It was on a Thursday morning, I very well remember,
+ when the children having learned their lessons soon, she had
+ given them leave to play, and they were all running about the
+ school, and diverting themselves with the birds and the lamb;
+ at this time the dog, all of a sudden, laid hold of his
+ mistress's apron, and endeavored to pull her out of the school.
+ She was at first surprised; however, she followed him, to see
+ what he intended. No sooner had he led her back into the
+ garden, but he ran back, and pulled out one of the children in
+ the same manner; upon which she ordered them all to leave the
+ school immediately, and they had not been out five minutes
+ before the <span class="pagenum"><a name="page477"
+ id="page477"></a>[pg 477]</span> top of the house fell in. What
+ a miraculous deliverance was here! How gracious! How good was
+ God Almighty to save all these children from destruction, and
+ to make use of such an instrument as a little sagacious animal
+ to accomplish his divine will! I should have observed that, as
+ soon as they were all in the garden, the dog came leaping round
+ them to express his joy, and when the house was fallen, laid
+ himself down quietly by his mistress.</p>
+
+ <p>Some of the neighbors who saw the school fall, and who were
+ in great pain for Margery and her little ones, soon spread the
+ news through the village, and all the parents, terrified for
+ their children, came crowding in abundance; they had, however,
+ the satisfaction to find them all safe, and upon their knees
+ with their mistress, giving God thanks for their happy
+ deliverance.</p>
+
+ <p>You are not to wonder, my dear reader, that this little dog
+ should have more sense than you, or your father, or your
+ grandfather.</p>
+
+ <p>Though God Almighty has made man the lord of the creation
+ and endowed him with reason; yet in many respects he has been
+ altogether as bountiful to other creatures of his forming. Some
+ of the senses of other animals are more acute than ours, as we
+ find by daily experience.</p>
+
+ <p>The downfall of the school was a great misfortune to Mrs.
+ Margery; for she not only lost all her books, but was destitute
+ of a place to teach in; but Sir William Dove, being informed of
+ this, ordered it to be built at his own expense, and till that
+ could be done, Farmer Grove was so kind as to let her have his
+ large hall to teach in.</p>
+
+ <h4>IV</h4>
+
+ <h4>WHAT HAPPENED AT FARMER GROVE'S, AND HOW SHE GRATIFIED HIM
+ FOR THE USE OF HIS ROOM</h4>
+
+ <p>While at Mr. Grove's, which was in the heart of the village,
+ she not only taught the children in the daytime, but the
+ farmer's servants and all the neighbors to read and write in
+ the evening; and it was a constant practice, before they went
+ away, to make <span class="pagenum"><a name="page478"
+ id="page478"></a>[pg 478]</span> them all go to prayers and
+ sing psalms. By this means the people grew extremely regular,
+ his servants were always at home instead of being at the
+ alehouse, and he had more work done than ever. This gave not
+ only Mr. Grove, but all the neighbors, a high opinion of her
+ good sense and prudent behavior; and she was so much esteemed
+ that the most of the differences in the parish were left to her
+ decision; and if a man and wife quarreled (which sometimes
+ happened in that part of the kingdom), both parties certainly
+ came to her for advice. Everybody knows that Martha Wilson was
+ a passionate, scolding jade, and that John her husband was a
+ surly, ill-tempered fellow. These were one day brought by the
+ neighbors for Margery to talk to them, when they talked before
+ her, and were going to blows; but she, stepping between them,
+ thus addressed the husband: "John," says she, "you are a man,
+ and ought to have more sense than to fly in a passion at every
+ word that is said amiss by your wife: and Martha," says she,
+ "you ought to know your duty better than to say anything to
+ aggravate your husband's resentment. These frequent quarrels
+ arise from the indulgence of your violent passions; for I know
+ you both love each other, notwithstanding what has passed
+ between you. Now, pray tell me, John, and tell me, Martha, when
+ you have had a quarrel over night, are you not both sorry for
+ it the next day?" They both declared that they were. "Why,
+ then," says she, "I'll tell you how to prevent this for the
+ future, if you promise to take my advice." They both promised
+ her. "You know," says she, "that a small spark will set fire to
+ tinder, and that tinder properly placed will set fire to a
+ house: an angry word is with you as that spark, for you are
+ both as touchy as tinder, and very often make your own house
+ too hot to hold you. To prevent this, therefore, and to live
+ happily for the future, you must solemnly agree, that if one
+ speaks an angry word, the other will not answer, till he or she
+ has distinctly called over the alphabet, and the other not
+ reply till he has told twenty; by this means your passions will
+ be stifled, and reason will have time to take the rule."</p>
+
+ <p>This is the best recipe that was ever given for a married
+ couple to live in peace. Though John and his wife frequently
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page479" id="page479"></a>[pg
+ 479]</span> attempted to quarrel afterwards, they never could
+ get their passions to a considerable height; for there was
+ something so droll in thus carrying on the dispute, that,
+ before they got to the end of the argument, they saw the
+ absurdity of it, laughed, kissed, and were friends.</p>
+
+ <h4>V</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE CASE OF MRS. MARGERY</h4>
+
+ <p>Mrs. Margery was always doing good, and thought she could
+ never sufficiently gratify those who had done anything to serve
+ her. These generous sentiments naturally led her to consult the
+ interest of Mr. Grove, and the rest of her neighbors; and as
+ most of their lands were meadow, and they depended much on
+ their hay, which had been for many years greatly damaged by the
+ wet weather, she contrived an instrument to direct them when to
+ mow their grass with safety, and prevent their hay being
+ spoiled. They all came to her for advice, and by that means got
+ in their hay without damage, while most of that in the
+ neighboring village was spoiled.</p>
+
+ <p>This occasioned a very great noise in the country, and so
+ greatly provoked were the people who resided in the other
+ parishes, that they absolutely sent old Gaffer Goosecap (a busy
+ fellow in other people's concerns) to find out evidence against
+ her. The wiseacre happened to come to her to school, when she
+ was walking about with a raven on one shoulder, a pigeon on the
+ other, a lark on her hand, and a lamb and a dog by her side;
+ which indeed made a droll figure, and so surprised the man that
+ he cried out, "A witch! a witch! a witch!"</p>
+
+ <p>Upon this she, laughing, answered, "a conjurer! a conjurer!
+ a conjurer!" and so they parted; but it did not end thus, for a
+ warrant was issued out against Mrs. Margery, and she was
+ carried to a meeting of the justices.</p>
+
+ <p>At the meeting, one of the justices who knew little of life,
+ and less of the law, behaved very idly; and, though nobody was
+ able to prove anything against her, asked who she could bring
+ to her character. "Who can you bring against my
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page480" id="page480"></a>[pg
+ 480]</span> character, sir?" says she. "There are people enough
+ who would appear in my defense, were it necessary: but I never
+ supposed that any one here could be so weak as to believe there
+ was any such thing as a witch. If I am a witch, this is my
+ charm; and" (laying a barometer or weather-glass on the table)
+ "it is with this," says she, "that I have taught my neighbor to
+ know the state of the weather." All the company laughed; and
+ Sir William Dove, who was on the bench, asked her accusers how
+ they could be such fools as to think there was any such thing
+ as a witch?</p>
+
+ <p>After this, Sir William inveighed against the absurd and
+ foolish notions which the country people had imbibed concerning
+ witches and witchcraft, and having proved that there was no
+ such thing, but that all were the effects of folly and
+ ignorance, he gave the court such an account of Mrs. Margery,
+ and her virtue, good sense, and prudent behavior, that the
+ gentlemen present were enamored with her, and returned her
+ public thanks for the great service she had done the country.
+ One gentleman in particular, I mean Sir Charles Jones, had
+ conceived such a high opinion of her that he offered her a
+ considerable sum to take care of his family, and the education
+ of his daughter, which, however, she refused; but this
+ gentleman sending for her afterwards, when he had a dangerous
+ fit of illness, she went, and behaved so prudently in the
+ family, and so tenderly to him and his daughter, that he would
+ not permit her to leave his house, but soon after made her
+ proposals of marriage. She was truly sensible of the honor he
+ intended her, but, though poor, she would not consent to be
+ made a lady till he had effectually provided for his daughter;
+ for she told him that power was a dangerous thing to be trusted
+ with, and that a good man or woman would never throw themselves
+ into the road of temptation.</p>
+
+ <p>All things being settled, and the day fixed, the neighbors
+ came in crowds to see the wedding; for they were all glad that
+ one who had been such a good little girl, and was become such a
+ virtuous and good woman, was going to be made a lady; but just
+ as the clergyman had opened his book, a gentleman richly
+ dressed ran into the church and cried, "Stop! stop!"
+ <span class="pagenum"><a name="page481" id="page481"></a>[pg
+ 481]</span> This greatly alarmed the congregation, particularly
+ the intended bride and bridegroom, whom he first accosted and
+ desired to speak with them apart. After they had been talking
+ some little time, the people were greatly surprised to see Sir
+ Charles stand motionless, and his bride cry and faint away in
+ the stranger's arms. This seeming grief, however, was only a
+ prelude to a flood of joy which immediately succeeded; for you
+ must know, gentle reader, that this gentleman, so richly
+ dressed, was that identical little boy, whom you before saw in
+ the sailor's habit; in short, it was Mrs. Margery's brother,
+ who was just come from sea, where he had, after a desperate
+ engagement, taken a rich prize; and hearing, as soon as he
+ landed, of his sister's intended wedding, had rode post to see
+ that a proper settlement was made on her, which she was now
+ entitled to, as he himself was both able and willing to give
+ her an ample fortune. They soon returned to the communion
+ table, and were married in tears, but they were tears of
+ joy.</p>
+
+ <h4>VI</h4>
+
+ <h4>THE TRUE USE OF RICHES</h4>
+
+ <p>About this time she heard that Mr. Smith was oppressed by
+ Sir Timothy Gripe and his friend Graspall; upon which she, in
+ conjunction with her brother, defended him in Westminster Hall,
+ where Mr. Smith gained a verdict. As a justice of the peace he
+ was struck off the list, and no longer permitted to act in that
+ capacity. A relation of his who had a right to the Mouldwell
+ estate, finding that it was possible to get the better at law
+ of a rich man, laid claim to it, brought his action, and
+ recovered the whole manor of Mouldwell; and being afterwards
+ inclined to sell it, he in consideration of the aid Lady
+ Margery had lent him during his distress, made her the first
+ offer, and she purchased the whole. This mortified Sir Timothy
+ and his friend Graspall, who experienced nothing but
+ misfortunes, and was in a few years so dispossessed of his
+ ill-gotten wealth, that his family were reduced to seek
+ subsistance from the parish, at which those who had felt the
+ weight of his <span class="pagenum"><a name="page482"
+ id="page482"></a>[pg 482]</span> iron hand rejoiced; but Lady
+ Margery desired that his children might be treated with care
+ and tenderness; "for they" (says she) "are noways accountable
+ for the actions of their father." At her first coming into
+ power, she took care to gratify her old friends, especially Mr.
+ and Mrs. Smith, whose family she made happy.</p>
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+ <div class="figright" style="width:40%;">
+ <a href="images/cover-2.jpg"><img width="100%"
+ src="images/cover-2s.jpg" alt="Back Cover of Book" /></a>
+ </div>
+
+ <div class="figleft" style="width:40%;">
+ <a href="images/cover-1.jpg"><img width="100%"
+ src="images/cover-1s.jpg" alt="Front Cover of Book" /></a>
+ </div><br clear="all" />
+
+ <p>&nbsp;</p><span class="pagenum"><a name="page483"
+ id="page483"></a>[pg 483]</span>
+
+ <h3>LIST OF BEST BOOKS OF CLASSIC TALES<br />
+ AND OLD-FASHIONED STORIES</h3>
+
+ <ul class="TOC">
+ <li>ABBOTT, JACOB <span class="tocright"><i>Franconia
+ Stories</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>ABBOTT, JACOB <span class="tocright"><i>Jonas
+ Stories</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>ABBOTT, JACOB <span class="tocright"><i>Rollo
+ Books</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>ADDISON, STEELE, BUDGELL
+ <span class="tocright"><i>Papers of Roger de
+ Coverley</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>AIKIN, JOHN, AND BARBAULD, ANNA LETITIA
+ <span class="tocright"><i>Evenings at Home</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>AGUILAR, GRACE <span class="tocright"><i>Home
+ Influence</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>AGUILAR, GRACE <span class="tocright"><i>The Mother's
+ Recompense</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>ARABIAN NIGHTS</li>
+
+ <li>BARBAULD, MRS. <span class="tocright"><i>Juvenile
+ Forget-me-not</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>BARNARD, MRS. CAROLINE <span class="tocright"><i>The
+ Parent's Offering</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>BROOKE, HENRY <span class="tocright"><i>The Fool of
+ Quality</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>BUNYAN, JOHN <span class="tocright"><i>Pilgrim's
+ Progress</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>CERVANTES, MIGUEL <span class="tocright"><i>Don
+ Quixote</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>CHAUCER, GEOFFREY <span class="tocright"><i>Canterbury
+ Tales</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>DAY, THOMAS <span class="tocright"><i>Sandford and
+ Merton</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>DAY, THOMAS <span class="tocright"><i>The History of
+ Little Jack</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>DEFOE, DANIEL <span class="tocright"><i>Robinson
+ Crusoe</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>EDGEWORTH, MARIA <span class="tocright"><i>Parent's
+ Assistant</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>EDGEWORTH, MARIA <span class="tocright"><i>Harry and
+ Lucy</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>EDGEWORTH, MARIA <span class="tocright"><i>Moral
+ Tales</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>ELIOT, GEORGE <span class="tocright"><i>Silas
+ Marner</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>FIELDING, SARAH <span class="tocright"><i>The
+ Adventures of David Simple</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>GODWIN, MRS. WILLIAM <span class="tocright"><i>The
+ Stories of Old Daniel</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>GOLDSMITH, OLIVER <span class="tocright"><i>The Vicar
+ of Wakefield</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>GOODRICH, S.G. <span class="tocright"><i>Fagots for the
+ Fireside</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>HOMER <span class="tocright"><i>The
+ Iliad</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>HOMER <span class="tocright"><i>The
+ Odyssey</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>HOWITT, MARY <span class="tocright"><i>Treasury of
+ Tales</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>HUGO, VICTOR <span class="tocright"><i>Les
+ Misérables</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>JAMES, G.P.R. <span class="tocright"><i>Prince
+ Life</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>LAMB, CHARLES <span class="tocright"><i>Mrs.
+ Leicester's School</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>LAMB, CHARLES AND MARY <span class="tocright"><i>Tales
+ from Shakespeare</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>LUCAS, E.V. (Ed.)
+ <span class="tocright"><i>Old-Fashioned
+ Tales</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>LUCAS, E.V. (Ed.) <span class="tocright"><i>Forgotten
+ Tales of Long Ago</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>MARTIN, WILLIAM <span class="tocright"><i>Peter
+ Parley's Annual</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>MANT, ALICIA CATHERINE <span class="tocright"><i>Tales
+ for Ellen</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>MORE, HANNAH <span class="tocright"><i>Coelebs in
+ Search of a Wife</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>PEARSON, MISS <span class="tocright"><i>A Few Weeks at
+ Clairmont Castle</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>RASPE, RODOLPH ERIC <span class="tocright"><i>The
+ Travels of Baron Munchausen</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>SHERWOOD, MRS. <span class="tocright"><i>The Fairchild
+ Family</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>SINCLAIR, KATHERINE <span class="tocright"><i>Holiday
+ House</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>SWIFT, JONATHAN <span class="tocright"><i>Gulliver's
+ Travels</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>WAKEFIELD, PRISCILLA <span class="tocright"><i>Juvenile
+ Anecdotes</i></span></li>
+
+ <li>WYSS, JOHANN RUDOLPH <span class="tocright"><i>Swiss
+ Family Robinson</i></span></li>
+ </ul>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<hr class="full" />
+<p>***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK YOUNG FOLKS TREASURY, VOLUME 3 (OF 12)***</p>
+<p>******* This file should be named 15560-h.txt or 15560-h.zip *******</p>
+<p>This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:<br />
+<a href="https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/1/5/5/6/15560">https://www.gutenberg.org/1/5/5/6/15560</a></p>
+<p>Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.</p>
+
+<p>Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.</p>
+
+
+
+<pre>
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+<a href="https://gutenberg.org/license">https://gutenberg.org/license)</a>.
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS,' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at https://www.gutenberg.org/about/contact
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit:
+https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Each eBook is in a subdirectory of the same number as the eBook's
+eBook number, often in several formats including plain vanilla ASCII,
+compressed (zipped), HTML and others.
+
+Corrected EDITIONS of our eBooks replace the old file and take over
+the old filename and etext number. The replaced older file is renamed.
+VERSIONS based on separate sources are treated as new eBooks receiving
+new filenames and etext numbers.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+<a href="https://www.gutenberg.org">https://www.gutenberg.org</a>
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+EBooks posted prior to November 2003, with eBook numbers BELOW #10000,
+are filed in directories based on their release date. If you want to
+download any of these eBooks directly, rather than using the regular
+search system you may utilize the following addresses and just
+download by the etext year.
+
+<a href="https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/etext06/">https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/etext06/</a>
+
+ (Or /etext 05, 04, 03, 02, 01, 00, 99,
+ 98, 97, 96, 95, 94, 93, 92, 92, 91 or 90)
+
+EBooks posted since November 2003, with etext numbers OVER #10000, are
+filed in a different way. The year of a release date is no longer part
+of the directory path. The path is based on the etext number (which is
+identical to the filename). The path to the file is made up of single
+digits corresponding to all but the last digit in the filename. For
+example an eBook of filename 10234 would be found at:
+
+https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/1/0/2/3/10234
+
+or filename 24689 would be found at:
+https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/2/4/6/8/24689
+
+An alternative method of locating eBooks:
+<a href="https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/GUTINDEX.ALL">https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/GUTINDEX.ALL</a>
+
+*** END: FULL LICENSE ***
+</pre>
+</body>
+</html>
diff --git a/15560-h/images/110.jpg b/15560-h/images/110.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6f49ffd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/110.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/110s.jpg b/15560-h/images/110s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..38eb7c9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/110s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/12.jpg b/15560-h/images/12.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..343e08e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/12.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/124.jpg b/15560-h/images/124.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d91f3ad
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/124.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/124s.jpg b/15560-h/images/124s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c990c89
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/124s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/12s.jpg b/15560-h/images/12s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..85bf347
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/12s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/140.jpg b/15560-h/images/140.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..28f45e4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/140.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/140s.jpg b/15560-h/images/140s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..04bc487
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/140s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/152.jpg b/15560-h/images/152.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..63435b4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/152.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/152s.jpg b/15560-h/images/152s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d5929ac
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/152s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/162.jpg b/15560-h/images/162.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f623532
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/162.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/162s.jpg b/15560-h/images/162s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f48a726
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/162s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/172.jpg b/15560-h/images/172.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9fcc713
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/172.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/172s.jpg b/15560-h/images/172s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9b12ea8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/172s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/196.jpg b/15560-h/images/196.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b7736f7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/196.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/196s.jpg b/15560-h/images/196s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..feb4647
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/196s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/220.jpg b/15560-h/images/220.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..359f472
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/220.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/220s.jpg b/15560-h/images/220s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..28fc70e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/220s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/234.jpg b/15560-h/images/234.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4e3bde1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/234.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/234s.jpg b/15560-h/images/234s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3966aea
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/234s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/246.jpg b/15560-h/images/246.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..05e271a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/246.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/246s.jpg b/15560-h/images/246s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..890e024
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/246s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/260.jpg b/15560-h/images/260.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..774beae
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/260.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/260s.jpg b/15560-h/images/260s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..94f4a65
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/260s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/262.jpg b/15560-h/images/262.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f9deaee
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/262.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/262s.jpg b/15560-h/images/262s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b242fa2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/262s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/266.jpg b/15560-h/images/266.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..08d8632
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/266.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/266s.jpg b/15560-h/images/266s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..698af40
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/266s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/290.jpg b/15560-h/images/290.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cc7ae75
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/290.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/290s.jpg b/15560-h/images/290s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..181ff6a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/290s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/296.jpg b/15560-h/images/296.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..675b642
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/296.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/296s.jpg b/15560-h/images/296s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0711cfd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/296s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/30.jpg b/15560-h/images/30.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4ed7be4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/30.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/30s.jpg b/15560-h/images/30s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e356527
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/30s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/374.jpg b/15560-h/images/374.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..071bba9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/374.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/374s.jpg b/15560-h/images/374s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..edff257
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/374s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/38.jpg b/15560-h/images/38.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5370c3c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/38.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/38s.jpg b/15560-h/images/38s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1f366b4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/38s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/390.jpg b/15560-h/images/390.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4314a3f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/390.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/390s.jpg b/15560-h/images/390s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..98ffaff
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/390s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/418.jpg b/15560-h/images/418.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3d583c8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/418.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/418s.jpg b/15560-h/images/418s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..27bcbf0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/418s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/436.jpg b/15560-h/images/436.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d9439ff
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/436.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/436s.jpg b/15560-h/images/436s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6817a5c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/436s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/440.jpg b/15560-h/images/440.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7e9a77e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/440.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/440s.jpg b/15560-h/images/440s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..58f8705
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/440s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/448.jpg b/15560-h/images/448.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3f666e7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/448.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/448s.jpg b/15560-h/images/448s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4f1f4fd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/448s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/48.jpg b/15560-h/images/48.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c4a677c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/48.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/48s.jpg b/15560-h/images/48s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a9d73e9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/48s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/54.jpg b/15560-h/images/54.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..19128ca
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/54.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/54s.jpg b/15560-h/images/54s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..412cca3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/54s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/6.jpg b/15560-h/images/6.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7d96d80
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/6.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/62.jpg b/15560-h/images/62.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..430c2db
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/62.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/62s.jpg b/15560-h/images/62s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..20640d1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/62s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/6s.jpg b/15560-h/images/6s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e655c4f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/6s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/80.jpg b/15560-h/images/80.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..659bf6c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/80.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/80s.jpg b/15560-h/images/80s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ea74334
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/80s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/96.jpg b/15560-h/images/96.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1c284ac
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/96.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/96s.jpg b/15560-h/images/96s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1753629
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/96s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/cover-1.jpg b/15560-h/images/cover-1.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..eb2bf18
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/cover-1.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/cover-1s.jpg b/15560-h/images/cover-1s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1dba748
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/cover-1s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/cover-2.jpg b/15560-h/images/cover-2.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..62a31b1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/cover-2.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/cover-2s.jpg b/15560-h/images/cover-2s.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5c072f3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/cover-2s.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/frontis.jpg b/15560-h/images/frontis.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e694062
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/frontis.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560-h/images/frontiss.jpg b/15560-h/images/frontiss.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..789cda8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560-h/images/frontiss.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/15560.txt b/15560.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0d4684a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,21077 @@
+The Project Gutenberg eBook, Young Folks Treasury, Volume 3 (of 12), by
+Various, Edited by Hamilton Wright Mabie
+
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+
+
+
+Title: Young Folks Treasury, Volume 3 (of 12)
+ Classic Tales And Old-Fashioned Stories
+
+
+Author: Various
+
+Editor: Hamilton Wright Mabie
+
+Release Date: April 6, 2005 [eBook #15560]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-646-US (US-ASCII)
+
+
+***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK YOUNG FOLKS TREASURY, VOLUME 3 (OF
+12)***
+
+
+E-text prepared by Juliet Sutherland, Sandra Brown, and the Project
+Gutenberg Online Distributed Proofreading Team
+
+
+
+Note: Project Gutenberg also has an HTML version of this
+ file which includes the original illustrations.
+ See 15560-h.htm or 15560-h.zip:
+ (https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/1/5/5/6/15560/15560-h/15560-h.htm)
+ or
+ (https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/1/5/5/6/15560/15560-h.zip)
+
+
+
+
+
+YOUNG FOLKS' TREASURY
+
+In 12 Volumes
+
+HAMILTON WRIGHT MABIE, Editor
+
+EDWARD EVERETT HALE, Associate Editor
+
+VOLUME III: CLASSIC TALES AND OLD-FASHIONED STORIES
+
+HAMILTON WRIGHT MABIE, Editor
+
+DANIEL EDWIN WHEELER, Assistant Editor
+
+New York
+The University Society Inc.
+Publishers
+
+1909
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+PARTIAL LIST OF EDITORS AND CONTRIBUTORS
+
+
+HAMILTON WRIGHT MABIE
+Editor
+
+EDWARD EVERETT HALE
+Associate Editor
+
+DANIEL EDWIN WHEELER
+Managing Editor
+
+
+Partial List of Contributors, Assistant Editors and Advisers:
+
+
+NICHOLAS MURRAY BUTLER, President Columbia University.
+
+WILLIAM R. HARPER, Late President Chicago University.
+
+Hon. THEODORE ROOSEVELT, Ex-President of the United States.
+
+Hon. GROVER CLEVELAND, Late President of the United States.
+
+JAMES CARDINAL GIBBONS, American Roman Catholic prelate.
+
+LAWRENCE J. BURPEE, Librarian Ottawa Public Library; author of
+"Canadian Life in Town and Country," etc.
+
+BLISS CARMAN, poet, essayist, and editor.
+
+THOMAS B. FLINT, Clerk House of Commons, Canada; editor "Parliamentary
+Practice and Procedure."
+
+AGNES C. LAUT, author "Lords of the North," "Hudson's Bay Company,"
+etc.
+
+BECKLES WILLSON, author of "The Romance of Canada," "Life and Letters
+of James Wolfe," etc.
+
+EDWARD W. BOK, editor "Ladies' Home Journal."
+
+HENRY VAN DYKE, author, poet, and Professor of English Literature,
+Princeton University.
+
+LYMAN ABBOTT, author, editor of "The Outlook."
+
+JACOB A. RIIS, author and journalist.
+
+EDWARD EVERETT HALE, JR., Professor at Union College.
+
+CHARLES G.D. ROBERTS, writer of animal stories.
+
+JANET H. KELMAN, author "Stories from the Crusades," "A Book of
+Butterflies," etc.
+
+VAUTIER GOLDING, author "Life of Henry M. Stanley," etc.
+
+LENA DALKEITH, author "A Book of Beasts," "Stories from French
+History," etc.
+
+H.E. MARSHALL, author "A Child's History of England." "History of
+English Literature," etc.
+
+JOEL CHANDLER HARRIS, creator of "Uncle Remus."
+
+GEORGE CARY EGGLESTON, novelist and journalist.
+
+WILLIAM BLAIKIE, author of "How to Get Strong and How to Stay So."
+
+JOSEPH JACOBS, folklore writer and editor of the "Jewish
+Encyclopedia."
+
+Mrs. VIRGINIA TERHUNE ("Marlon Harland"), author of "Common Sense in
+the Household," etc.
+
+A.D. INNES, author "England Under the Tudors," "England's Industrial
+Development," etc.
+
+EDMUND F. SELLAR, author "Life of Nelson," etc.
+
+MARY MACGREGOR, author "King Arthur's Knights," etc.
+
+JEANIE LANG, author "Life of General Gordon," etc.
+
+Rev. THEODORE WOOD, F.E.S., writer on natural history.
+
+MARGARET E. SANGSTER, author of "The Art of Home-Making," etc.
+
+HERBERT T. WADE, editor and writer on physics.
+
+JOHN H. CLIFFORD, editor and writer.
+
+ERNEST INGERSOLL, naturalist and author.
+
+IDA PRENTICE WHITCOMB, author of "Young People's Story of Music,"
+"Heroes of History," etc.
+
+MARK HAMBOURG, pianist and composer.
+
+Mme. BLANCHE MARCHESI, opera singer and teacher.
+
+ELBRIDGE S. BROOKS, author "Historic Boys," etc.
+
+PAULINE C. BOUVE, author "Stories of American Heroes for Boys and
+Girls," etc.
+
+
+
+
+CONTENTS
+
+
+Introduction
+
+
+CLASSIC TALES
+
+
+Don Quixote
+
+By Miguel Cervantes. Adapted by John Lang
+
+ I. HOW DON QUIXOTE WAS KNIGHTED
+
+ II. HOW DON QUIXOTE RESCUED ANDRES; AND HOW HE RETURNED HOME
+
+ III. HOW DON QUIXOTE AND SANCHO PANZA STARTED ON THEIR SEARCH FOR
+ ADVENTURES; AND HOW DON QUIXOTE FOUGHT WITH THE WINDMILLS
+
+ IV. HOW DON QUIXOTE WON A HELMET; HOW HE FOUGHT WITH TWO ARMIES; AND
+ HOW SANCHO'S ASS WAS STOLEN
+
+ V. HOW DON QUIXOTE SAW DULCINEA
+
+ VI. HOW DON QUIXOTE FOUGHT WITH A LION; AND HOW HE DEFEATED THE MOORS
+
+ VII. THE BATTLE WITH THE BULLS; THE FIGHT WITH THE KNIGHT OF THE WHITE
+ MOON; AND HOW DON QUIXOTE DIED
+
+
+Gulliver's Travels: Voyage to Lilliput
+
+By Jonathan Swift. Adapted by John Lang
+
+ I. GULLIVER'S BIRTH AND EARLY VOYAGES
+
+ II. GULLIVER IS WRECKED ON THE COAST OF LILLIPUT
+
+ III. GULLIVER IS TAKEN AS A PRISONER TO THE CAPITAL OF LILLIPUT
+
+ IV. GULLIVER IS FREED, AND CAPTURES THE BLEFUSCAN FLEET
+
+ V. GULLIVER'S ESCAPE FROM LILLIPUT AND RETURN TO ENGLAND
+
+
+The Arabian Nights
+
+Adapted by Amy Steedman
+
+ I. ALADDIN AND THE WONDERFUL LAMP
+
+ II. THE ENCHANTED HORSE
+
+ III. SINDBAD THE SAILOR
+
+
+The Iliad of Homer
+
+Adapted by Jeanie Lang
+
+ I. THE STORY Of WHAT LED TO THE SIEGE OF TROY
+
+ II. THE COUNCIL
+
+ III. THE FIGHT BETWEEN PARIS AND MENELAUS
+
+ IV. HECTOR AND ANDROMACHE
+
+ V. HOW PATROCLUS FOUGHT AND DIED
+
+ VI. THE ROUSING OF ACHILLES
+
+
+The Odyssey of Homer
+
+Adapted by Jeanie Lang
+
+ I. WHAT HAPPENED IN ITHACA WHILE ODYSSEUS WAS AWAY
+
+ II. HOW ODYSSEUS CAME HOME
+
+
+Robinson Crusoe
+
+By Daniel Defoe. Adapted by John Lang
+
+ I. HOW ROBINSON FIRST WENT TO SEA; AND HOW HE WAS SHIPWRECKED
+
+ II. ROBINSON WORKS HARD AT MAKING HIMSELF A HOME
+
+ III. THE EARTHQUAKE AND HURRICANE; AND HOW ROBINSON BUILT A BOAT
+
+ IV. ROBINSON BUILDS A SECOND BOAT, IN WHICH HE IS SWEPT OUT TO SEA
+
+ V. ROBINSON SEES A FOOTPRINT ON THE SAND, FINDS A CAVE, AND RESCUES
+ FRIDAY
+
+ VI. ROBINSON TRAINS FRIDAY AND THEY BUILD A LARGE BOAT; THEY RESCUE
+ TWO PRISONERS FROM THE CANNIBALS
+
+ VII. ARRIVAL OF AN ENGLISH SHIP: ROBINSON SAILS FOR HOME
+
+
+Canterbury Tales
+
+By Geoffrey Chaucer. Adapted by Janet Harvey Kelman
+
+ I. DORIGEN
+
+ II. EMELIA
+
+ III. GRISELDA
+
+
+The Pilgrim's Progress
+
+By John Bunyan. Adapted by Mary Macgregor
+
+
+Tales from Shakespeare
+
+By Charles and Mary Lamb
+
+ I. THE TEMPEST
+
+ II. A MIDSUMMER NIGHT'S DREAM
+
+
+OLD-FASHIONED STORIES
+
+
+Simple Susan
+
+By Maria Edgeworth. Adapted by Louey Chisholm
+
+ I. QUEEN OF THE MAY
+
+ II. BAD NEWS
+
+ III. SUSAN'S GUINEA-FOWL
+
+ IV. SUSAN VISITS THE ABBEY
+
+ V. SUSAN'S PET LAMB
+
+ VI. THE BLIND HARPER
+
+ VII. GOOD NEWS
+
+ VIII. BARBARA VISITS THE ABBEY
+
+ IX. A SURPRISE FOR SUSAN
+
+ X. BARBARA'S ACCIDENT
+
+ XI. THE PRIZE-GIVING
+
+ XII. ATTORNEY CASE IN TROUBLE
+
+ XIII. SUSAN'S BIRTHDAY
+
+
+Limby Lumpy
+
+
+The Sore Tongue
+
+By Jane Taylor
+
+
+Eyes and No Eyes, or The Art of Seeing
+
+By John Aikin and Mrs. Barbauld
+
+
+Prince Life
+
+By G.P.R. James
+
+
+The Fruits of Disobedience, or The Kidnapped Child
+
+
+Dicky Random, or Good Nature Is Nothing Without Good Conduct
+
+
+Embellishment
+
+By Jacob Abbott
+
+
+The Oyster Patties
+
+
+Two Little Boys
+
+By Thomas Day
+
+ I. THE GOOD-NATURED LITTLE BOY
+
+ II. THE ILL-NATURED LITTLE BOY
+
+
+The Purple Jar
+
+By Maria Edgeworth
+
+
+The Three Cakes
+
+By Armand Berquin
+
+
+Amendment
+
+
+Trial
+
+By John Aikin and Mrs. Barbauld
+
+
+A Plot of Gunpowder: An Old Lady Seized for a Guy
+
+Ascribed to William Martin ("Peter Parley")
+
+
+Uncle David's Nonsensical Story About Giants and Fairies
+
+By Katherine Sinclair
+
+
+The Inquisitive Girl
+
+
+Busy Idleness
+
+By Jane Taylor
+
+
+The Renowned History of Little Goody Two-Shoes
+
+Ascribed to Oliver Goldsmith
+
+INTRODUCTION
+
+ I. HOW AND ABOUT LITTLE MARGERY AND HER BROTHER
+
+ II. HOW AND ABOUT MR. SMITH
+
+ III. HOW LITTLE MARGERY OBTAINED THE NAME OF GOODY TWO-SHOES, AND
+ WHAT HAPPENED IN THE PARISH
+
+ IV. HOW LITTLE MARGERY LEARNED TO READ, AND BY DEGREES TAUGHT OTHERS
+
+ V. HOW LITTLE TWO-SHOES BECAME A TROTTING TUTORESS, AND HOW SHE
+ TAUGHT HER YOUNG PUPILS
+
+ VI. HOW THE WHOLE PARISH WAS FRIGHTENED
+
+ VII. CONTAINING AN ACCOUNT OF ALL THE SPIRITS OR THINGS SHE SAW IN THE
+ CHURCH
+
+ VIII. OF SOMETHING WHICH HAPPENED TO LITTLE MARGERY TWO-SHOES IN A
+ BARN, MORE DREADFUL THAN THE GHOST IN THE CHURCH; AND HOW SHE
+ RETURNED GOOD FOR EVIL TO HER ENEMY, SIR TIMOTHY
+
+ IX. HOW LITTLE MARGERY WAS MADE PRINCIPAL OF A COUNTRY COLLEGE
+
+
+(Part Two.) The Renowned History of Mrs. Margery Two-Shoes
+
+ I. OF HER SCHOOL, HER USHERS, OR ASSISTANTS, AND HER MANNER OF
+ TEACHING
+
+ II. A SCENE OF DISTRESS IN A SCHOOL
+
+ III. OF THE AMAZING SAGACITY AND INSTINCT OF A LITTLE DOG
+
+ IV. WHAT HAPPENED AT FARMER GROVE'S, AND HOW SHE GRATIFIED HIM FOR
+ THE USE OF HIS ROOM
+
+ V. THE CASE OF MRS. MARGERY
+
+ VI. THE TRUE USE OF RICHES
+
+
+
+
+ILLUSTRATIONS
+
+
+VOLUME III
+
+
+THE HORSE FLEW THROUGH THE AIR
+
+"PAY AT ONCE, YOU SCOUNDREL"
+
+HORSE AND MAN WERE SENT ROLLING ON THE GROUND
+
+THE BULLS HAD RUN RIGHT OVER HIM AND ROZINANTE
+
+HE FOUND THAT HIS ARMS AND LEGS WERE TIGHTLY FASTENED TO THE GROUND
+
+GULLIVER IN LILLIPUT
+
+ON THIS OCCASION, GULLIVER ATE MORE THAN USUAL
+
+ALADDIN AND THE MAGICIAN
+
+HINDBAD WAS CARRYING A VERY HEAVY LOAD
+
+FROM FAR AND WIDE DID THE GREEK HOSTS GATHER
+
+ANDROMACHE IN CAPTIVITY
+
+TELEMACHUS KNELT WHERE THE GRAY WATER BROKE ON THE SAND
+
+THE ESCAPE FROM THE SHIPWRECK
+
+HE SAW THE MARK OF A NAKED FOOT ON THE SAND
+
+ROBINSON RAN TO THE WHITE PRISONER AND CUT HIS BONDS
+
+ALAS! OF ALL THE SHIPS I SEE, IS THERE NEVER ONE THAT WILL BRING MY
+LORD HOME?
+
+THE CURTAIN AT THE DOORWAY WAS DRAWN ASIDE
+
+THEN DID CHRISTIAN DRAW HIS SWORD
+
+MIRANDA WATCHING THE STORM
+
+THE FAIRIES SING TITANIA TO SLEEP
+
+BENDING DOWN A BRANCH OF THE LABURNUM-TREE
+
+"IT WON'T DO," SAID BARBARA, TURNING HER BACK
+
+"AND HERE'S HER CROWN!" CRIED ROSE
+
+SHE SPOKE OF WHAT SHE DID NOT UNDERSTAND
+
+HE WAS WANTED TO HOLD THE JUG OF MILK
+
+HE TOOK THE CURRANT TART, AND ... THREW IT AT HIS NURSE
+
+ROSAMOND RAN UP TO IT WITH AN EXCLAMATION OF JOY
+
+WIDOW DOROTHY CAREFUL MADE A CURTSEY
+
+THE GOAT DASHED IN AMONG THEM AND THE CHAIR WAS UPSET
+
+EACH OF MY VISITORS IS QUITE AN EXCLUSIVE
+
+IF LOUISA RECEIVED A NOTE, SHE CAREFULLY LOCKED IT UP
+
+
+(Many of the illustrations in this volume are reproduced by special
+permission of E.P. Dutton & Company, owners of American rights.)
+
+
+
+
+INTRODUCTION
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+CLASSIC TALES
+
+
+After our boys and girls have read the first half of this volume,
+containing selected and simplified stories from some of the greatest
+books of all time, their authors will cease to be merely names. Homer,
+Shakespeare, Chaucer, Cervantes and Bunyan will be found here as
+familiar and easy in style as "Cinderella" or "The Three Bears." True
+enough, the first word in "Classic Tales" may look somewhat alarming
+to the eyes of youthful seekers after romance and adventure, but we
+challenge them to turn to any one of these selections from immortal
+masterpieces and not become spellbound and, moreover, impatient for
+more. And, believing now that they have grown very much interested in
+these famous books, of course we also believe they want to learn
+something about them.
+
+Following the order of our stories we must begin with "Don Quixote."
+Its author wrote it under great difficulties and distress; but one
+would never think so, as it is full of laughable doings. When you read
+our selections you must not think that Don Quixote was merely a silly
+old man, for indeed he was a very noble gentleman and tried with all
+his might to do what he believed to be his duty, and in no act of his
+life was there ever a stain of dishonor or of meanness. As for his
+queer fancies, you will find in your own experience that many things
+are not as they seem.
+
+Next comes one of Gulliver's voyages. Under all this account of a tiny
+race of people there is fun poked at government and its ministers.
+But we do not concern ourselves with such matters--all we think about
+is the wonderful deeds of Gulliver in the land of the Lilliputians. Do
+not think such people are impossible, for did not Stanley, the
+explorer, find in Africa a race of dwarfs so little that he called
+them pygmies? And perhaps when some of our young readers grow up,
+they, too, may discover small folks in the world.
+
+In regard to the "Arabian Nights," from which we give you three choice
+stories, you ought to know the way they came to be told. Once upon a
+time, a Sultan of Arabia thought that all women were of not much use,
+so every day he married a new wife, and before twenty-four hours were
+over he ordered that she have her head cut off. One brave woman
+thought of a clever plan by which she could end this cruelty. She went
+to the palace and offered to marry the Sultan, and that night she
+began to tell him such fascinating stories that when morning came he
+still wished to hear more. He commanded that she should not be
+beheaded until all her stories were told. Then for a thousand and one
+nights, night after night, she gave him fresh stories, and by the end
+of that time the Sultan had fallen very much in love with her.
+Naturally, they lived happily forever after. Perhaps these three
+stories which we have selected will compel you to seek out all the
+rest, and if you do, we are quite sure you will not wonder that the
+brave lady won the heart of the wicked Sultan and made him good.
+
+From the "Iliad" and the "Odyssey" of Homer, we have given you some
+soul-stirring happenings. Several thousand years ago these stories
+were sung by a blind minstrel named Homer. Some day you may read
+Homer's sublime poetry in the original Greek, and the selections which
+we give you will help you to remember the stories when you are
+struggling with that difficult language.
+
+Parts of the old favorite "Robinson Crusoe" follow the Grecian tales,
+and we trust its simple language will make the little ones love it
+more than ever. You will remember that Defoe wrote this nearly two
+hundred years ago. Everybody liked long stories in those days, but we
+have all heard children of to-day ask when a somewhat lengthy book
+would end, no matter how interesting, and many grown-ups are guilty
+of reading the close of a story before they have gone very far in it.
+So with that in mind we have put down in brief form most of Robinson
+Crusoe's important adventures during his twenty-eight years on the
+desert island.
+
+Here we also give three splendid stories from Chaucer's "Canterbury
+Tales," which were supposedly told to one another by a party of
+pilgrims on their way to Canterbury. According to our gentle author,
+who was one of them, they stopped over night at a house in England
+called the Tabard Inn, and here they passed the hours repeating fine
+stories. Afterward Chaucer wrote these down in a book in quaint old
+English. One might look at these words all day long and not know in
+the least what what some of them meant, though they do hold such
+beautiful tales.
+
+Now about "Pilgrim's Progress." More than two hundred years ago a
+tinker named John Bunyan was in jail, but one night this poor man left
+his prison and wandered into the land of dreams. There he saw
+wonderful sights and heard marvelous things, and as there was no one
+to listen to his dream, John Bunyan wrote it down, and had it made
+into a book. And this he called "The Pilgrim's Progress." It was about
+the journey and adventures of a pilgrim and his companions. In our
+version we have given most of the dream, but when the boys and girls
+grow older they will want to read it all in Bunyan's own language, and
+we hope this account will lead them to do so.
+
+Shakespeare is a magic name to grown-ups, but to children it does not
+mean much. All they know is, that sometimes this name is spelled on
+the back of one fat volume, sometimes on three, sometimes on a dozen
+or more, but of the inside they know almost nothing, and when they
+hear persons say that Shakespeare is the greatest writer that ever
+lived, they wonder about it. If they take down a volume containing one
+of his plays, they think it very dull, but here in simple language we
+present the stories of two of the most fairy-like and beautiful plays,
+as retold for children by Charles and Mary Lamb.
+
+DANIEL EDWIN WHEELER.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+OLD-FASHIONED STORIES
+
+
+There is much truth in the saying that "old things are best, old books
+are best, old friends are best." We like to connect in thought our
+best-loved books and our best-loved friends. A good friend must have
+some of the wisdom of a good book, though good books often talk to us
+with wisdom and also with humor and courtesy greater than any living
+friend may show. "Sometimes we think books are the best friends; they
+never interrupt or contradict or criticise us."
+
+Every year in our own country about ten thousand books are published.
+Most of them die in early life. Three hundred years from now every one
+of this year's ten thousand books will be dead and forgotten, except
+possibly thirty or forty. The very best books do not die young. The
+books written about three hundred years ago that are read to-day--like
+Shakespeare's plays--are as a rule the books that deserve to live
+forever. And, "Gentle Reader," if you are wise you will see _why_ the
+old books are best: they are the wheat, and the winds of time have
+blown only the chaff away.
+
+Is it not strange that in the olden times so few poems or books or
+stories were written for children? The "Iliad," the stories of King
+Arthur, the "Canterbury Tales," and "Gulliver's Travels" and "Robinson
+Crusoe," were written for men and women.
+
+But happily this is the children's age, and now nearly half of all the
+books written are written for children. You must remember, however,
+that all boys and girls are children--in the eyes of the law--till
+they are twenty-one years old.
+
+We know a little boy who read last week a very modern story. The book
+was bound in red cloth. It had a gilt top and very modern pictures
+drawn by a great artist and printed in three or four colors. How
+different from the books of one hundred years ago, with their black
+covers and queer pictures!
+
+This story read by the little New York boy last week has been read by
+many little boys in Iowa, and by many little girls in Georgia. It
+tells about an orphan boy who was "bound out" to a farmer who treated
+him cruelly. He ran away to the Rocky Mountain region, where he had
+many adventures with robbers and Indians and blizzards. He was strong
+and heroic; he could shoot straight and ride the swiftest horses, and
+nothing ever hurt him very much.
+
+This, as I have said, is a modern story. It does not tell the reader
+to be truthful and good. It just tells him a story of thrilling
+adventures and daring escapes from danger. But the old-fashioned story
+is different; and now we are getting close to our subject.
+
+I will tell you all about the old-fashioned stories in a moment; but I
+must remind you that these old stories were written about a hundred
+years ago. They were usually written to teach a moral lesson. Dear old
+John Aikin, or his sister Anna Letitia Barbauld, or Maria Edgeworth,
+or Jane Taylor would say some morning--at any rate, so it seems to
+me--"I will write a story to-day to teach boys and girls to be
+industrious." And so "Busy Idleness" was written. Or one of these old
+authors would decide to write a story the main object of which was to
+teach little girls not to be too curious, and so "The Inquisitive
+Girl" was written. Both of these stories, and many others equally
+good, are found in this volume.
+
+I could really tell you many interesting things about these
+old-fashioned stories but I will do something better--urge you to read
+them yourself. They are quaint, delightful, and entertaining stories,
+besides teaching a moral. You boys and girls should read every one of
+them, and then read them again, out loud, to your mothers or to
+anybody else who will listen.
+
+Among all the old-fashioned stories in this volume I find only one
+that seems to me "really funny," and that is "Uncle David's
+Nonsensical Story about the Giants and Fairies." Think of a giant so
+tall that "he was obliged to climb up a ladder to comb his own hair."
+But this bit of humor is not so good as a very modern nonsense-story
+entitled "The Giant's Shoes," which I read the other day, and from
+which the Managing Editor permits me to quote this little passage:
+
+"The Giant slept for three weeks at a time, and two days after he
+woke his breakfast was brought to him, consisting of bright brown
+horses sprinkled on his bread and butter. Besides his boots, the Giant
+had a pair of shoes, and in one of them his wife lived when she was at
+home; on other occasions she lived in the other shoe. She was a
+sensible, practical kind of woman, with two wooden legs and a
+clothes-horse, but in other respects not rich. The wooden legs were
+kept pointed at both ends, in order that if the Giant were
+dissatisfied with his breakfast, he might pick up any stray people
+that were within reach, using his wife as a fork; this annoyed the
+inhabitants of the district, so that they built their church in a
+southwesterly direction from the castle, behind the Giant's back, that
+he might not be able to pick them up as they went in. But those who
+stayed outside to play pitch-and-toss were exposed to great danger and
+sufferings."
+
+G.J.B.
+
+
+
+
+CLASSIC TALES
+
+
+
+
+DON QUIXOTE
+
+By MIGUEL CERVANTES
+
+ADAPTED BY JOHN LANG
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+HOW DON QUIXOTE WAS KNIGHTED
+
+
+Some three or four hundred years ago, there lived in sunny Spain an
+old gentleman named Quixada, who owned a house and a small property
+near a village in La Mancha.
+
+With him lived his niece, a housekeeper, and a man who looked after
+Quixada's farm and his one old white horse, which, though its master
+imagined it to be an animal of great strength and beauty, was really
+as lean as Quixada himself and as broken down as any old cab horse.
+
+Quixada had nothing in the world to do in the shape of work, and so,
+his whole time was taken up in reading old books about knights and
+giants, and ladies shut up in enchanted castles by wicked ogres. In
+time, so fond did he become of such tales that he passed his days, and
+even the best part of his nights, in reading them. His mind was so
+wholly taken up in this way that at last he came to believe that he
+himself lived in a land of giants and of ogres, and that it was his
+duty to ride forth on his noble steed, to the rescue of unhappy
+Princesses.
+
+In the lumber-room of Quixada's house there had lain, ever since he
+was born, a rusty old suit of armor, which had belonged to his
+great-grandfather. This was now got out, and Quixada spent many days
+in polishing and putting it in order.
+
+Unfortunately, there was no more than half of the helmet to be found,
+and a knight cannot ride forth without a helmet.
+
+So Quixada made the other half of strong pasteboard; and to prove that
+it was strong enough, when finished, he drew his sword and gave the
+helmet a great slash. Alas! a whole week's work was ruined by that one
+stroke; the pasteboard flew into pieces. This troubled Quixada sadly,
+but he set to work at once and made another helmet of pasteboard,
+lining it with thin sheets of iron, and it looked so well that, this
+time, he put it to no test with his sword.
+
+Now that his armor was complete, it occurred to him that he must give
+his horse a name--every knight's horse should have a good name--and
+after four days thought he decided that "Rozinante" would best suit
+the animal.
+
+Then, for himself, after eight days of puzzling, he resolved that he
+should be called Don Quixote de la Mancha.
+
+There was but one thing more. Every knight of olden time had a lady,
+whom he called the Mistress of his Heart, whose glove he wore in his
+helmet; and if anybody dared to deny that this lady was the most
+beautiful woman in the whole world, then the knight made him prove his
+words by fighting.
+
+So it was necessary that Don Quixote should select some lady as the
+Mistress of his Heart.
+
+Near La Mancha there lived a stout country lass, for whom some years
+before Don Quixote had had a kind of liking. Who, therefore, could
+better take the place of Mistress of his Heart? To whom could he
+better send the defeated knights and ogres whom he was going out to
+fight? It was true that her name. Aldonza Lorenzo, did not sound like
+that of a Princess or lady of high birth; so he determined in future
+to call her Dulcinea del Toboso. No Princess could have a sweeter
+name!
+
+All being now ready, one morning Don Quixote got up before daylight,
+and without saying a word to anybody, put on his armor, took his
+sword, and spear, and shield, saddled "Rozinante," and started on his
+search for adventures.
+
+But before he had gone very far, a dreadful thought struck him. He had
+not been knighted! Moreover, he had read in his books that until a
+knight had done some great deed, he must wear white armor, and be
+without any device or coat of arms on his shield. What was to be done?
+He was so staggered by this thought that he almost felt that he must
+turn back. But then he remembered that he had read how adventurers
+were sometimes knighted by persons whom they happened to meet on the
+road. And as to his armor, why, he thought he might scour and polish
+that till nothing could be whiter. So he rode on, letting "Rozinante"
+take which road he pleased, that being, he supposed, as good a way as
+any of looking for adventures.
+
+All day he rode, to his sorrow without finding anything worth calling
+an adventure.
+
+At last as evening began to fall, and when he and his horse were both
+very weary, they came in sight of an inn. Don Quixote no sooner saw
+the inn than he fancied it to be a great castle, and he halted at some
+distance from it, expecting that, as in days of old, a dwarf would
+certainly appear on the battlements, and, by sounding a trumpet, give
+notice of the arrival of a knight. But no dwarf appeared, and as
+"Rozinante" showed great haste to reach the stable, Don Quixote began
+to move towards the inn.
+
+At this moment it happened that a swineherd in a field near at hand
+sounded his horn to bring his herd of pigs home to be fed. Don
+Quixote, imagining that this must be the dwarf at last giving notice
+of his coming, rode quickly up to the inn door, beside which it
+chanced that there stood two very impudent young women, whom the
+Knight imagined to be two beautiful ladies taking the air at the
+castle gate.
+
+Astonished at the sight of so strange a figure, and a little
+frightened, the girls turned to run away. But Don Quixote stopped
+them.
+
+"I beseech ye, ladies, do not fly," he said. "I will harm no one,
+least of all maidens of rank so high as yours."
+
+And much more he said, whereat the young women laughed so loud and so
+long that Don Quixote became very angry, and there is no saying what
+he might not have done had not the innkeeper at that moment come out.
+This innkeeper was very fat and good-natured, and anxious not to
+offend anybody, but even he could hardly help laughing when he saw Don
+Quixote. However, he very civilly asked the Knight to dismount and
+offered him everything that the inn could provide.
+
+Don Quixote being by this time both tired and hungry, with some
+difficulty got off his horse and handed it to the innkeeper (to whom
+he spoke as governor of the castle), asking him to take the greatest
+care of "Rozinante," for in the whole world there was no better steed.
+
+When the landlord returned from the stable, he found Don Quixote in a
+room, where, with the help of the two young women, he was trying to
+get rid of his armor. His back and breastplates had been taken off,
+but by no means could his helmet be removed without cutting the green
+ribbons with which he had tied it on, and this the Knight would not
+allow.
+
+There was nothing for it, therefore, but to keep his helmet on all
+night, and to eat and drink in it, which was more than he could do
+without help. However, one of the young women fed him, and the
+innkeeper having made a kind of funnel, through it poured the wine
+into his mouth, and Don Quixote ate his supper in great peace of mind.
+
+There was but one thing that still vexed him. He had not yet been
+knighted.
+
+On this subject he thought long and deeply, and at last he asked the
+innkeeper to come with him to the stable. Having shut the door, Don
+Quixote threw himself at the landlord's feet, saying, "I will never
+rise from this place, most valorous Knight, until you grant me a
+boon."
+
+The innkeeper was amazed, but as he could not by any means make Don
+Quixote rise, he promised to do whatever was asked.
+
+"Then, noble sir," said Don Quixote, "the boon which I crave is that
+to-morrow you will be pleased to grant me the honor of knighthood."
+
+The landlord, when he heard such talk, thought that the wisest thing
+he could do was to humor his guest, and he readily promised. Thereupon
+Don Quixote very happily rose to his feet, and after some further talk
+he said to the innkeeper that this night he would "watch his armor" in
+the chapel of the castle, it being the duty of any one on whom the
+honor of knighthood was to be conferred, to stand on his feet in the
+chapel, praying, until the morning. The innkeeper, thinking that
+great sport might come of this, encouraged Don Quixote, but as his own
+chapel had lately--so he said--been pulled down in order that a better
+might be built, he advised Don Quixote to watch that night in the
+courtyard. This was "lawful in a case where a chapel was not at hand.
+And in the morning," he said, "I will knight you."
+
+"Have you any money?" then asked the innkeeper.
+
+"Not a penny," said Don Quixote, "for I never yet read of any knight
+who carried money with him."
+
+"You are greatly mistaken," answered the innkeeper. "Most knights had
+squires, who carried their money and clean shirts and other things.
+But when a knight had no squire, he always carried his money and his
+shirts, and salve for his wounds, in a little bag behind his saddle. I
+must therefore advise you never in future to go anywhere without
+money."
+
+Don Quixote promised to remember this. Then taking his armor, he went
+into the inn yard and laid it in a horse-trough.
+
+Backwards and forwards, spear in hand, he marched in the moonlight,
+very solemnly keeping his eyes on his armor, while the innkeeper's
+other guests, laughing, looked on from a distance.
+
+Now it happened that a carrier who lodged at the inn came into the
+yard to water his mules, and this he could not do while the armor lay
+in the horse-trough. As Don Quixote saw the man come up, "Take heed,
+rash Knight," he cried. "Defile not by a touch the armor of the most
+brave knight-errant that ever wore a sword."
+
+But the mule-driver took no notice of Don Quixote. He picked up the
+armor and threw it away.
+
+Don Quixote no sooner saw this than, raising his eyes to heaven, and
+calling on his Lady Dulcinea del Toboso, he lifted up his spear with
+both hands and gave the mule-driver such a whack over the head that
+the man fell down senseless. Then, picking up his armor and putting it
+back in the horse-trough, he went on with his march, taking no further
+notice of the poor mule-driver.
+
+Soon up came another carrier who also wanted to water his mules.
+
+Not a word did Don Quixote say this time, but he lifted up his spear
+and smote so heavily that he broke the man's head in three or four
+places. The poor wretch made such an outcry that all the people in the
+inn came running, and the friends of the two carriers began to pelt
+Don Quixote with stones. But drawing his sword, and holding his shield
+in front of him, he defied them all, crying, "Come on, base knaves!
+Draw nearer if you dare!"
+
+The landlord now came hurrying up and stopped the stone-throwing;
+then, having calmed Don Quixote, he said that there was no need for
+him to watch his armor any longer; to finish the ceremony it would now
+be enough if he were touched on the neck and shoulders with a sword.
+Don Quixote was quite satisfied, and prayed the innkeeper to get the
+business over as quickly as possible, "for," said he, "if I were but
+knighted, and should see myself attacked, I believe that I should not
+leave a man alive in this castle."
+
+The innkeeper, a good deal alarmed at this, and anxious to get rid of
+him, hurried off and got the book in which he kept his accounts, which
+he pretended was a kind of book of prayer. Having also brought the two
+young women, and a boy to hold a candle, he ordered Don Quixote to
+kneel. Then muttering from his book, as if he were reading, he
+finished by giving Don Quixote a good blow on the neck, and a slap on
+the back, with the flat of a sword. After this, one of the young women
+belted the sword round the newly made knight's waist, while the other
+buckled on his spurs, and having at once saddled "Rozinante." Don
+Quixote was ready to set out.
+
+The innkeeper was only too glad to see him go, even without paying for
+his supper.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+HOW DON QUIXOTE RESCUED ANDRES; AND HOW HE RETURNED HOME
+
+
+As he rode along in the early morning light, Don Quixote began to
+think that it would be well that he should return home for a little,
+there to lay in a stock of money and of clean shirts, and he turned
+his willing horse's head in the direction of his village.
+
+But ere he had gone far on his way, coming from a thicket he fancied
+that he heard cries of distress.
+
+"Certainly these are the moans of some poor creature in want of help,"
+thought Don Quixote. "I thank Heaven for so soon giving me the chance
+to perform my duty as a knight."
+
+And he rode quickly towards the sounds. No sooner had he reached the
+wood than he saw a horse tied to a tree, and bound to another was a
+lad of fifteen, all naked above the waist. By his side stood a
+countryman beating him with a strap, and with every blow calling out,
+"I'll teach you to keep your eyes open, you young scamp. I'll teach
+you to keep your mouth shut."
+
+The boy howled with pain. Quickly Don Quixote rode up to the man.
+
+"Sir Knight," said he angrily, "I would have thee to know that it is
+an unworthy act to strike one who cannot defend himself. Mount thy
+steed, therefore, take thy spear, and I will teach thee that thou art
+a coward."
+
+The countryman gave himself up for lost, and he gasped out very humbly
+that the boy was his servant, through whose carelessness many of the
+sheep that he should have watched had been lost, and that therefore he
+was giving him a sound beating. "And," said he, "because I beat him
+for his carelessness, he says I do it to cheat him out of his wages."
+
+"What!" shouted Don Quixote, "do you dare to lie to me? By the sun
+above us, I have a mind to run you through with my spear. Pay the boy
+this instant, and let him go free. What does he owe you, boy?"
+
+The boy said that the man owed him nine months' wages.
+
+"Pay at once, you scoundrel, unless you want to be killed," roared Don
+Quixote.
+
+The poor man, trembling with fear, said that there was a mistake; he
+did not owe nearly so much, and besides, he had no money with him. But
+if Andres would go home with him he would pay every penny.
+
+"Go home with him!" cried the boy. "I know a trick worth two of that.
+No sooner will he have me home than he'll take the skin off me. No,
+no, not I!"
+
+"He will not dare to touch you," said the Knight. "I command him, and
+that is enough. If he swears by his order of knighthood to do this
+thing, I will let him go, and he will pay you your wages."
+
+"Of course I will," said the man. "Come along with me. Andres, and I
+swear I'll give you all I owe."
+
+"Remember, then, what you have promised, for I am Don Quixote de la
+Mancha, the righter of wrongs, and it is at your peril to disobey me."
+
+So saying, Don Quixote clapped spurs to his horse, and galloped off
+through the trees.
+
+The countryman watched till the Knight was out of sight. Then,
+turning, he said "Come, my lad, and I'll pay thee what I owe, and
+more."
+
+"Ay," answered the boy, "see that you do, for if you do not, that
+brave man will come back and make you."
+
+"I dare swear that," said the man. "And just to show how much I love
+you, I am going to increase the debt, so that I may pay you more. Come
+here!"
+
+And with that he caught the boy by the arm, tied him again to the
+tree, and belted him till his arm was tired.
+
+"Now go," he said, "and tell your righter of wrongs. I wish I had
+flayed you alive, you young whelp."
+
+And so ended Don Quixote's first attempt to right wrongs.
+
+As the Knight cantered along, very well pleased with himself, about
+two miles from where he had freed the boy he saw riding towards him
+six men, each shading himself under a large umbrella. With them were
+four mounted servants, and three on foot.
+
+No sooner did Don Quixote see this party than it struck him that here
+was the chance for which, above all others, he had been longing.
+
+Posting himself in the middle of the road, he waited till the men were
+at no great distance. Then, "Halt!" shouted he. "Let all know that no
+man shall pass further till he owns that in the whole world there is
+no damsel more beautiful than the peerless Dulcinea del Toboso."
+
+"But," said the men (who were merchants of Toledo, on their way to buy
+silks), "we do not know the lady. We have never seen her. How then can
+we say that she is beautiful?"
+
+"What!" roared Don Quixote in a terrible rage, "not know the beauteous
+Lady Dulcinea del Toboso! That only makes matters worse. Do you dare
+to argue?"
+
+And with that he couched his spear, drove his spurs into "Rozinante,"
+and rode furiously at the nearest merchant.
+
+What he would have done it is not possible to say. But as he galloped,
+it chanced that "Rozinante" stumbled and fell heavily, rolling Don
+Quixote over and over. There the Knight lay helpless, the weight of
+his armor preventing him from rising to his feet. But as he lay, he
+continued to cry out at the top of his voice, "Stop, you rascals! Do
+not fly. It is my horse's fault that I lie here, you cowards!"
+
+One of the grooms, hearing his master called a rascal and a coward,
+thereupon ran up and snatched away Don Quixote's spear, which he broke
+in pieces. Then with each piece he belabored the poor Knight till the
+broken lance flew into splinters. The merchants then rode away,
+leaving Don Quixote lying where he fell, still shouting threats, but
+quite unable to rise.
+
+There he was found by a man who knew him well, and who with great
+difficulty mounted him on his donkey and took him home. When at last
+they reached Don Quixote's house, the poor Knight was put to bed,
+where he lay for many days, raving, and very ill.
+
+During this time the Curate of the village and the Barber came and
+burned nearly all the books which Don Quixote had so loved.
+
+"For," said they, "it is by reading these books that the poor
+gentleman has lost his mind, and if he reads them again he will never
+get better."
+
+So a bonfire was made of the books, and the door of Don Quixote's
+study was bricked up.
+
+When the Knight was again able to go about, he made at once for his
+study and his beloved books. Up and down the house he searched without
+saying a word, and often he would stand where the door of the study
+used to be, feeling with his hands and gazing about. At last he asked
+his housekeeper to show him the study.
+
+"Study!" cried the woman, "what study? There is no study in this house
+now, nor any books."
+
+"No," said his niece. "When you were away, a famous enchanter came
+along, mounted on a dragon, and he went into your study. What he did
+there we know not. But after a time he flew out of the roof, leaving
+the house full of smoke, and ever since then we have not been able to
+find either books or study."
+
+"Ha!" said Don Quixote. "That must have been Freston. He is a famous
+enchanter, and my bitter enemy. But when I am again well I shall get
+the better of him."
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+HOW DON QUIXOTE AND SANCHO PANZA STARTED ON THEIR SEARCH FOR
+ADVENTURES; AND HOW DON QUIXOTE FOUGHT WITH THE WINDMILLS
+
+
+For some weeks the poor Knight stayed very quietly at home. But he had
+not forgotten the things for which he had come back to his village.
+
+There was a farm laborer who lived near by, a fat, good-natured,
+simple man. To him Don Quixote talked long and often, and made many
+promises; among others that if he would but come with him as squire,
+he should be made governor of any island which the Knight might happen
+to conquer during his search after adventures.
+
+This seemed so grand a thing to the man (whose name was Sancho Panza),
+that he willingly promised to come.
+
+Having got together some money, and having made other preparations,
+Don Quixote and Sancho Panza one dark night stole out of the village
+without a word to any one, and began their adventures.
+
+Don Quixote rode "Rozinante;" Sancho Panza was mounted on an ass. That
+his squire should ride an ass at first troubled the Knight not a
+little, for in none of his books could he remember to have read of
+any squire being so mounted. However, he gave Sancho leave to bring
+the ass, thinking that in no great time a better mount would surely be
+found for him.
+
+As they rode along in the cool of the morning, Sancho Panza spoke to
+his master about their journey, and asked him to be sure not to forget
+his promise about the governorship of the island.
+
+"It may even happen," answered Don Quixote, "that I may by some
+strange chance conquer a kingdom. And then presently, I may be able to
+crown thee King."
+
+"Why," said Sancho, "if by some such miracle as your worship speaks
+of, I am made a King, then would my wife be Queen?"
+
+"Certainly," answered Don Quixote, "who can doubt it?"
+
+"I doubt it," replied Sancho, "for I think if it should rain kingdoms
+upon the face of the earth, not one of them would sit well on my
+wife's head. For I must tell you, sir, she's not worth two brass jacks
+to make a Queen of. No, no! countess will be quite good enough; that's
+as much as she could well manage."
+
+"Nay," said Don Quixote, "leave the matter in the hands of Providence,
+and be not tempted by anything less than the title of Viceroy."
+
+Thus talking, they came over the brow of a hill, and looking down on
+the plain below, Don Quixote saw there thirty or forty windmills.
+
+"Ha!" cried he. "Fortune directs our affairs better than we ourselves
+could do. Look yonder, friend Sancho, there are at at least thirty
+outrageous giants whom I must now fight."
+
+"Giants!" gasped Sancho Panza, "what giants?"
+
+"Those whom you see over there with their long arms," answered Don
+Quixote. "Some of that horrible race, I have heard, have arms near two
+leagues in length."
+
+"But, sir," said Sancho, "these are no giants. They are only
+windmills, and the things you think are arms are but their sails,
+whereby the wind drives them."
+
+"That is but a sign," answered Don Quixote, "whereby one may see how
+little you know of adventures. I tell you they are giants: and I shall
+fight against them all. If you are afraid, go aside and say your
+prayers."
+
+So saying, and without paying any heed to the bawlings of Sancho
+Panza, he put spurs to his horse and galloped furiously at the
+windmills, shouting aloud, "Stand, cowards! stand your ground, and fly
+not from a single Knight."
+
+Just at this moment the wind happened to rise, causing the arms of the
+windmills to move.
+
+"Base scoundrels!" roared the Knight, "though you wave as many arms as
+the giant Briareus, you shall pay for your pride."
+
+And with couched lance, and covering himself with his shield, he
+rushed "Rozinante" at top speed on the nearest windmill. Round whirled
+the sails, and as Don Quixote's lance pierced one of them, horse and
+man were sent rolling on the ground. There Sancho Panza came to help
+his sorely bruised master.
+
+"Mercy o' me!" cried Sancho, "did not I tell you they were windmills?"
+
+"Peace, friend Sancho," answered Don Quixote. "It is the fortune of
+war. I know very well it is that accursed wizard Freston, the enemy
+who took from me my study and my books, who has changed these giants
+into windmills to take from me the honor of the victory. But in the
+end I shall yet surely get the better of him."
+
+"Amen! say I" quoth Sancho: and heaving the poor Knight on to his
+legs, once more he got him seated on "Rozinante."
+
+As they now rode along, it was a great sorrow to Don Quixote that his
+spear had been broken to pieces in this battle with the windmill.
+
+"I have read," said he to Sancho, "that a certain Spanish knight,
+having broken his sword in a fight, pulled up by the roots a huge
+oak-tree, or at least tore down a great branch, and with it did such
+wonderful deeds that he was ever after called 'The Bruiser.' I tell
+you this because I intend to tear up the next oak-tree we meet, and
+you may think yourself fortunate that you will see the deeds I shall
+perform with it."
+
+"Heaven grant you may!" said Sancho. "But, an' it please you, sit a
+little more upright in your saddle; you are all to one side. But that,
+mayhap, comes from your hurts?"
+
+"It does so," answered Don Quixote, "and if I do not complain of the
+pain, it is because a knight-errant must never complain of his wounds,
+though they be killing him."
+
+"I have no more to say," replied Sancho. "Yet Heaven knows I should be
+glad to hear your honor complain a bit, now and then, when something
+ails you. For my part, I always cry out when I'm hurt, and I am glad
+the rule about not complaining doesn't extend to squires."
+
+That night they spent under the trees, from one of which Don Quixote
+tore down a branch, to which he fixed the point of his spear, and in
+some sort that served him for a lance. Don Quixote neither ate nor
+slept all the night, but passed his time, as he had learned from his
+books that a knight should do, in thoughts of the Lady Dulcinea. As
+for Sancho Panza, he had brought with him a big bottle of wine, and
+some food in his wallet, and he stuffed himself as full as he could
+hold, and slept like a top.
+
+As they rode along next day, they came to the Pass of Lapice.
+
+"Here, Sancho," said Don Quixote, "is the spot where adventures should
+begin. Now may we hope to thrust our hands, as it were, up to the very
+elbows in adventures. But remember this! However sore pressed and in
+danger I may be when fighting with another knight, you must not offer
+to draw your sword to help me. It is against the laws of chivalry for
+a squire to attack a knight."
+
+"Never fear me, master," said Sancho. "I'll be sure to obey you; I
+have ever loved peace. But if a knight offers to set upon me first,
+there is no rule forbidding me to hit him back, is there?"
+
+"None," answered Don Quixote, "only do not help me."
+
+"I will not," said Sancho. "Never trust me if I don't keep that
+commandment as well as I do the Sabbath."
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+HOW DON QUIXOTE WON A HELMET; HOW HE FOUGHT WITH TWO ARMIES; AND HOW
+SANCHO'S ASS WAS STOLEN
+
+
+Many were the adventures that now befell Don Quixote and Sancho Panza.
+In the very first, wherein he fought with a man from Biscay, whom he
+left lying in a pool of blood, Don Quixote lost part of his helmet,
+and had the half of one of his ears sliced off by the Biscayan's
+sword. The accident to the helmet was a great grief to him, and he
+swore an oath that until he had taken from some other knight as good a
+helmet as that which was now made useless to him, he would never again
+eat his food on a table-cloth.
+
+One day as they rode along a highway between two villages Don Quixote
+halted and looked eagerly at something.
+
+"Sancho," said he, "dost thou not see yonder knight that comes riding
+this way on a dapple-gray steed, with a helmet of gold on his head?"
+
+"Not a thing can I see," answered Sancho, "but a fellow on just such
+another ass as mine, with something that glitters on top of his head."
+
+"Can you not see," asked Don Quixote, "that it is a helmet? Do you
+stand back, and let me deal with him. Soon now shall I possess myself
+of the helmet that I need."
+
+Now, in those far-away days, when doctors were few, if anybody needed
+to be bled for a fever or any other illness (for it was then thought
+that "letting blood" was the cure for most illnesses), it was the
+custom for the barber to bleed the sick person. For the purpose of
+catching the blood that ran from a vein when it had been cut, a brass
+dish was carried, a dish with part of it cut away from one side, so
+that it might the more easily be held close to the patient's arm or
+body. A small dish like this you may sometimes still see hanging as a
+sign at the end of a pole outside barbers' shops. Barbers in those
+days of old were called barber-surgeons, for the reason that they bled
+people, as well as shaved them or cut their hair.
+
+And the truth of the matter was this, that the man whom Don Quixote
+now believed to be a knight, wearing a golden helmet, was a barber
+riding on his ass to bleed a sick man. And because it was raining, he
+had put his brass dish on his head, in order to keep his new hat from
+being spoiled.
+
+Don Quixote did not wait to speak to the man, but, couching his lance,
+galloped at him as hard as "Rozinante" could go, shouting as he rode,
+"Defend thyself, base wretch!"
+
+The barber no sooner saw this terrible figure charging down on him,
+than, to save himself from being run through, he flung himself on to
+the ground, and then jumping to his feet, ran for his life, leaving
+his ass and the brass basin behind him. Then Don Quixote ordered
+Sancho to pick up the helmet.
+
+"O' my word," said Sancho, as he gave it to his master, "it is a fine
+basin."
+
+Don Quixote at once put it on his head, saying, "It is a famous
+helmet, but the head for which it was made must have been of great
+size. The worst of it is that at least one-half of it is gone. What is
+the fool grinning at now?" he cried, as Sancho laughed.
+
+"Why, master," answered Sancho, "it is a barber's basin."
+
+"It has indeed some likeness to a basin," said Don Quixote, "but I
+tell you it is an enchanted helmet of pure gold, and for the sake of a
+little wretched money some one has melted down the half of it. When we
+come to a town where there is an armorer, I will have it altered to
+fit my head. Meantime I shall wear it as it is."
+
+As they rode along one day talking of many things, Don Quixote beheld
+a cloud of dust rising right before them.
+
+"Seest thou that cloud of dust, Sancho?" he asked. "It is raised by a
+great army marching this way."
+
+"Why, master," said Sancho, "there must be two armies there, for
+yonder is just such another cloud of dust."
+
+The knight looked, and was overjoyed, believing that two armies were
+about to meet and fight in the plain.
+
+"What are we to do, master?" asked Sancho.
+
+"Do!" said Don Quixote, "why, what can we do but help the weaker side?
+Look yonder, Sancho, that knight whom thou seest in the gilded armory
+with a lion crouching at the feet of a lady painted on his shield,
+that is the valiant Laurcalco. That other, the giant on his right,
+Brandabarbaran." And he ran over a long list of names of knights whom
+he believed that he saw.
+
+Sancho listened, as dumb as a fish; but at last he gasped. "Why,
+master, you might as well tell me that it snows. Never a knight, nor a
+giant, nor a man can I see."
+
+"How!" answered Don Quixote, "canst thou not hear their horses neigh,
+and their drums beating?"
+
+"Drums!" said Sancho. "Not I! I hear only the bleating of sheep."
+
+"Since you are afraid," said the Knight, "stand aside, and I will go
+by myself to fight."
+
+With that, he galloped down on to the plain, shouting, leaving Sancho
+bawling to him, "Hold, sir! Stop! For Heaven's sake come back. As sure
+as I'm a sinner, they are only harmless sheep. Come back, I say."
+
+But Don Quixote, paying not the least heed, galloped on furiously and
+charged into the middle of the sheep, spearing them right and left,
+trampling the living and the dead under "Rozinante's" feet. The
+shepherds, finding that he took no notice of their shouts, now hurled
+stones at him from their slings, and one big stone presently hit the
+Knight fair in his ribs and doubled him up in the saddle.
+
+Gasping for breath, with all speed Don Quixote got from his wallet a
+bottle filled with a mixture he had made, a mixture which he firmly
+believed to be a certain cure for all wounds. Of this he took a long
+gulp, but just at that moment another big stone hit him such a rap on
+the mouth that the bottle was smashed into a thousand pieces, and half
+of his teeth were knocked out.
+
+Down dropped the Knight on the ground, and the shepherds thinking that
+he was killed, ran away, taking with them seven dead sheep which he
+had slain.
+
+Sancho Panza found his master in a very bad way, with nearly all the
+teeth gone from one side of his mouth, and with a terrible pain under
+his ribs.
+
+"Ah! master," he said, "I told you they were sheep. Why would not you
+listen to me?"
+
+"Sheep! Sancho. No, no! There is nothing so easy for a wizard like
+Freston as to change things from one shape to the other. I will wager
+if you now mount your ass and ride over the hill after them, you will
+find no sheep there, but the knights and squires come back to their
+own shape, and the armies marching as when we first saw them."
+
+Now, after this and many other adventures (about which, perhaps, you
+may some day read for yourself), Don Quixote and Sancho Panza rode
+away into the mountains, for the Knight was sorely in need of a quiet
+place in which to rest.
+
+So weary were he and his squire, that one night, when they had ridden
+into a wood, and it chanced that the horse and the ass stood still,
+both Don Quixote and Sancho Panza fell sound asleep without even
+getting out of their saddles. There sat the Knight, leaning on his
+lance; and Sancho, doubled over the pommel, snored as loud as if he
+had been in a four-post feather bed.
+
+It happened that a wandering thief saw them as he passed.
+
+"Now," thought he, "I want something to ride upon, for I'm tired of
+walking in these abominable mountains. Here's a chance of a good ass.
+But how am I to get it, without waking its master?"
+
+Very quietly he cut four long sticks. One after the other he placed
+these under each side of Sancho's saddle; then loosening the girths,
+he gradually raised the sticks till the saddle was clear of the
+animal's back.
+
+Gently, in the moonlight, he led the tired ass away, and Sancho,
+undisturbed, snored on.
+
+When it was broad daylight, the squire awoke, and without opening his
+eyes, stretched himself. Down fell the sticks; down with a terrible
+bump fell Sancho.
+
+"Body o' me!" he yelled, "where is my ass?" And with many tears he
+searched high and low, but no ass was then to be found, nor for many
+months afterwards. And how at last Sancho got back the ass you must
+read for yourself in the History of Don Quixote. For yourself, too,
+you must read of Don Quixote's adventures in the mountains; how he
+there did penance; and of many other things, till at last the Curate
+and the Barber of La Mancha took him home in a cart which the Knight
+believed to be an enchanted chariot.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+HOW DON QUIXOTE SAW DULCINEA
+
+
+Now a third time did Don Quixote set off on his search for adventures,
+and as he and Sancho Panza rode again away from their village, it
+seemed to Don Quixote that certainly it was his duty as a
+knight-errant to visit the Mistress of his Heart, the beautiful
+Dulcinea.
+
+It was midnight when they reached Toboso, and the whole town was
+still, everybody in bed and asleep.
+
+"Lead me to her palace, Sancho," said Don Quixote.
+
+"Palace?" cried Sancho, "What palace do you mean? Body o' me! When
+last I saw her, she lived in a little cottage in a blind alley. And
+even if it were a palace, we can't go and thunder at the door at this
+time o' night."
+
+"When we find it, I will tell thee what to do. But, here! What is
+this?" said the Knight, riding up to a huge building, and knocking at
+the door. "This indeed, without doubt, must be her palace."
+
+But it was only the great Church of Toboso. Hunt as he would, he found
+no Dulcinea's palace, and as morning began to break, Sancho persuaded
+him to come and rest in a grove of trees two miles outside the town.
+From there Sancho was again sent to look for Dulcinea, bearing many
+messages from his sorrowful master.
+
+"Cheer up, sir," said Sancho. "I'll be back in a trice. Don't be cast
+down. Faint heart never won fair lady."
+
+And Sancho rode away, leaving the Knight sitting on his horse, very
+full of melancholy. But he had not ridden far, when, turning round and
+finding that his master was no longer in sight, the squire dismounted,
+and lying down under a shady tree, began to think the matter over.
+
+"Friend Sancho," said he to himself, "what's this you are doing?"
+
+"Why, hunting for a Princess, who, my master says, is the Sun of
+Beauty, and all sorts of other fine things, and who lives in a King's
+palace, or great castle, somewhere or other."
+
+"And how are you going to find her?"
+
+"Why, it's like looking for a needle in a bundle of hay, to look for
+Dulcinea all over Toboso. My master's mad, there's no doubt of that;
+and perhaps I'm not very much better, for they say birds of a feather
+flock together. But if he's so mad as to mistake windmills for giants,
+and flocks of sheep for armies, why, it shouldn't be so very hard to
+make him believe that the first country lass I meet is the Lady
+Dulcinea. If he won't believe, I'll swear it, and stand to it, so that
+he'll think some of those wicked wizards of his have played another
+trick on him, and have changed her into some other shape just to spite
+him."
+
+Having thus settled his plans, Sancho lay there till the evening, so
+that his master might think that all the day had been spent in going
+to and from Toboso, and in looking for Dulcinea.
+
+As luck would have it, just as he mounted his ass to ride back to Don
+Quixote, he spied coming that way three country lasses mounted on
+asses. As soon as Sancho saw the girls, he made haste to get to his
+master.
+
+"What news, Sancho?" asked the Knight. "Has your fortune been good?"
+
+"Ay, marry has it, sir," answered Sancho, "you have no more to do but
+to clap spurs to 'Rozinante' and get into the open fields, and you'll
+meet my Lady Dulcinea del Toboso with two of her damsels coming to see
+you."
+
+"Blessed Heaven!" cried the Knight. "What do you say, my dear Sancho?
+Is it possible?"
+
+"Possible!" said Sancho. "Why should I play a trick on you? Come, sir,
+and you will see her presently, all dressed up and decked with jewels.
+Her damsels and she are all covered with diamonds, and rubies, and
+cloth of gold. And what is more, they are riding three flea-bitten
+gambling hags, the like of which won't be seen again."
+
+"Ambling nags, thou meanest, Sancho," said Don Quixote.
+
+"Well, well, master, gambling hags or ambling nags, it's all one and
+the same thing. Any way, I'm sure I never set eyes on more beautiful
+ladies than those that sit upon them."
+
+"Let us be moving then, Sancho. And as a reward for your good news, I
+promise you the very best things I get in our next adventure. And if
+that is not enough, then I will give you the three colts that I have
+at home in La Mancha."
+
+"Thank you for the colts," said Sancho. "As for the other things, I'm
+not sure that they will be worth so very much."
+
+They were now out of the wood, and could see the three country lasses
+at a little distance.
+
+Don Quixote looked long towards Toboso, but seeing no one anywhere but
+these girls, he was much troubled in his mind, and asked Sancho if he
+were sure that the Princess had left the city.
+
+"Left the city!" cried Sancho. "Why where are your eyes, sir? In the
+name of wonder, do you not see her and her maidens coming towards us
+now, as bright as the sun at midday?"
+
+"I see nothing, Sancho, but three country wenches riding on asses."
+
+"Now Heaven help me," cried Sancho, "is it possible that you can
+mistake three what do you call 'ems--ambling nags as white as snow,
+for three asses! Pull my beard out by the roots if it is not so."
+
+"Believe me, Sancho, they are asses."
+
+"Come, sir," answered Sancho, "do but clear your eyes, and go and
+speak to the Mistress of your Heart, for she is near you now."
+
+So saying, Sancho hurried up to one of the girls, and, jumping off his
+ass, fell on his knees before her, gabbling a lot of nonsense.
+
+Don Quixote followed, and also knelt down, gazing with doubting and
+sorrowful eyes on the creature that Sancho had told him was the
+beautiful Dulcinea. He was lost in wonder, for she was a flat-nosed,
+blubber-cheeked, bouncing country girl, and Don Quixote could not
+utter a word.
+
+"Come! get out of the way," screamed the girl, "and let us go about
+our business. We're in a hurry."
+
+"Rise, Sancho," said Don Quixote when he heard the girl's voice. "I am
+now convinced that misfortune has not yet finished with me. O most
+beautiful lady! a spiteful enchanter puts mists before my eyes, and
+hides from me your loveliness."
+
+"My grandmother take him!" cried the girl. "Listen to his gibberish!
+Get out of the way, and let us alone." And kicking her donkey in the
+ribs, she galloped away with her friends. Don Quixote followed them
+long with his eyes.
+
+"O the spite of those wicked enchanters!" he sighed, "to turn my
+beautiful Dulcinea into so vile a shape as that: to take from her the
+sweet and delicate scent of fragrant flowers, and give to her what she
+has. For, to tell the truth, Sancho, she gave me such a whiff of raw
+onions that it was like to upset me altogether."
+
+"O the vile and evil-minded enchanters!" cried Sancho. "Oh that I
+might see the lot of you threaded on one string, and hung up in the
+smoke like so many herrings." And Sancho turned away to hide his
+laughter.
+
+Don Quixote rode on, very sad, and letting "Rozinante" go where he
+pleased.
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+HOW DON QUIXOTE FOUGHT WITH A LION; AND HOW HE DEFEATED THE MOORS
+
+
+As Don Quixote and Sancho Panza went along, they were overtaken by a
+gentleman in a fine green coat, who rode a very good mare. This
+gentleman stared very hard at Don Quixote, and the two began to speak
+together about knight-errantry, and were so interested in what they
+were saying, that Sancho took the opportunity of riding over to ask
+for a little milk from some shepherds, who were milking their ewes
+near at hand.
+
+While he was thus away from his master, a wagon, on top of which
+fluttered little yellow and red flags, came along the road towards
+them. Don Quixote at once imagined this to be some new adventure, and
+he called to Sancho for his helmet. At the moment, Sancho was
+bargaining with the shepherds for some curds. Hearing his master call,
+he had not time to wait till the shepherds could give him a bowl in
+which to carry them, and not wishing to lose his bargain (for he had
+paid the shepherds), he poured the curds into the Knight's helmet, and
+galloped off to see what his master wanted.
+
+"Give me my helmet," said Don Quixote, "for if I know anything of my
+business, here is an adventure for which I must be ready."
+
+The gentleman in green, hearing what Don Quixote said, looked
+everywhere, but he could see nothing except the wagon coming towards
+them, and as that had on it the King of Spain's colors, he thought
+that no doubt it was one of his Majesty's treasure-vans. He said as
+much to Don Quixote, but the Knight answered: "Sir, I cannot tell
+when, or where, or in what shape, my enemies will attack me. It is
+always wise to be ready. Fore-warned is fore-armed. Give me my helmet,
+Sancho!"
+
+Snatching it out of Sancho's unwilling hands, he clapped it on his
+head without looking into it.
+
+"What is this, Sancho?" he cried, as the whey ran down his face. "What
+is the matter with me? Is my brain melting, or am I breaking out in a
+cold sweat? If I am, it is not from fear. This must be a dreadful
+adventure that is coming. Quick. Sancho! give me something to wipe
+away the torrent of sweat, for I am almost blinded."
+
+Without a word, Sancho handed to his master a cloth. Don Quixote dried
+himself, and then took off his helmet to see what it was that felt so
+cold on his head.
+
+"What is this white stuff?" said he, putting some of the curds to his
+nose. "Sancho, you vile traitor, you have been putting curds in my
+helmet!"
+
+"Curds!--I?" cried Sancho. "Nay, the devil must have put them there.
+Would I dare to make such a mess in your helmet, sir? It must have
+been one of those vile enchanters. Where could I get curds? I would
+sooner put them in my stomach than in your helmet."
+
+"Well, that's true, I dare say," said Don Quixote. "There's something
+in that."
+
+Then again he put on the helmet, and made ready for the adventure.
+
+"Now come what may, I dare meet it," he cried.
+
+The wagon had now come near to them. On top was seated a man, and the
+driver rode one of the mules that drew it. Don Quixote rode up.
+
+"Whither go ye, my friends?" said he. "What wagon is this, and what
+have you in it? What is the meaning of the flags?"
+
+"The wagon is mine," said the driver, "and I have in it a lion that is
+being sent to the King, and the flags are flying to let the people
+know that it is the King's property."
+
+"A lion!" cried Don Quixote, "Is it a large one?"
+
+"The biggest I ever saw," said the man on top of the wagon. "I am the
+keeper, and I have had charge of many lions, but I never saw one so
+large as this. Pray get out of the way, sir, for we must hurry on to
+our stopping-place. It is already past his feeding-time; he is
+beginning to get hungry, and they are always savage when they are
+hungry."
+
+"What!" cried Don Quixote, "lion whelps against me! I'll let those
+gentlemen know who send lions this way, that I am not to be scared by
+any of their lions. So, Mr. Keeper, just jump down and open his cage,
+and let him out. In spite of all the enchanters in the world that have
+sent him to try me, I'll let the animal see who Don Quixote de la
+Mancha is."
+
+Up ran Sancho to the gentleman in green.
+
+"O good, dear sir," he cried, "don't let my master get at the lion, or
+we shall all be torn to pieces."
+
+"Why," said the gentleman, "is your master so mad that you fear he'll
+set upon such a dangerous brute."
+
+"Oh no, sir, he's not mad; he's only rash, very, very rash," cried
+Sancho.
+
+"Well," said the gentleman, "I'll see to it," and up he went to Don
+Quixote, who was trying to get the keeper to open the cage.
+
+"Sir," said he, "knight-errants ought not to engage in adventures from
+which there is no hope of coming off in safety. That is more like
+madness than courage. Besides, this is the King's wagon; it will
+never do to stop that. And after all, the lion has not been sent
+against you; it is a present to the King."
+
+"Pray, sir," cried Don Quixote, "will you attend to your own business?
+This is mine, and I know best whether this lion has been sent against
+me or not. Now you, sir," he cried to the keeper, "either open that
+cage at once, or I'll pin you to your wagon with my spear."
+
+"For mercy's sake, sir," cried the driver, "do but let me take my
+mules out of harm's way before the lion gets out. My cart and my mules
+are all I have in the world, and I shall be ruined if harm comes to
+them."
+
+"Take them out quickly, then," said Don Quixote, "and take them where
+you please."
+
+On this the driver made all the haste he could to unharness his mules,
+while the keeper called aloud, "Take notice, everybody, that it is
+against my will that I am forced to let loose the lion, and that this
+gentleman here is to blame for all the damage that will be done. Get
+out of the way, everybody: look out for yourselves."
+
+Once more the gentleman in green tried to persuade Don Quixote not to
+be so foolish, but the Knight only said, "I know very well what I am
+doing. If you are afraid, and do not care to see the fight, just put
+spurs to your mare and take yourself where you think you will be
+safe."
+
+Sancho now hurried up, and with tears in his eyes begged his master
+not to put himself in so great danger, but Don Quixote only said,
+"Take yourself away, Sancho, and leave me alone. If I am killed, go,
+as I have so often told you, to the beautiful Dulcinea, and tell
+her--you know what to tell her."
+
+The gentleman in green, finding that words were thrown away on Don
+Quixote, now quickly followed the driver, who had hastily taken his
+mules as far away as he could beyond the brow of the hill. Sancho
+hurried after them at the top speed of his ass, kicking him in the
+ribs all the while to make him go even faster, and loudly bewailing
+his master's coming death. The keeper made one more attempt to turn
+Don Quixote from his folly, but again finding it useless, very
+unwillingly opened the cage door.
+
+Meantime the Knight had been thinking whether it would be best to
+fight the lion on foot or on horseback, and he had made up his mind to
+fight on foot, for the reason that "Rozinante" would probably be too
+much afraid to face the lion. So he got off his horse, drew his sword,
+and holding his shield in front of him, marched slowly up to the cage.
+The keeper, having thrown the door wide open, now quickly got himself
+out of harm's way.
+
+The lion, seeing the cage open, and Don Quixote standing in front,
+turned round and stretched out his great paws. Then he opened his
+enormous mouth, and, letting out a tongue as long as a man's arm,
+licked the dust off his face. Now rising to his feet, he thrust his
+head out of the door and glared around with eyes like burning coals.
+
+It was a sight to make any man afraid; but Don Quixote calmly waited
+for the animal to jump out and come within reach of his sword.
+
+The lion looked at him for a moment with its great yellow eyes--then,
+slowly turning, it strolled to the back of the cage, gave a long,
+weary yawn, and lay quietly down.
+
+"Force him to come out," cried Don Quixote to the keeper, "beat him."
+
+"Not I," said the man. "I dare not for my life. He would tear me to
+pieces. And let me advise you, sir, to be content with your day's
+work. I beseech you, go no further. You have shown how brave you are.
+No man can be expected to do more than challenge his enemy and wait
+ready for him. If he does not come, the fault and the disgrace are
+his."
+
+"'Tis true," said the Knight. "Shut the door, my friend, and give me
+the best certificate you can of what you have seen me do; how you
+opened the door, and how I waited for the lion to come out, and how he
+turned tail and lay down. I am obliged to do no more."
+
+So saying, Don Quixote put on the end of his spear the cloth with
+which he had wiped the curds from his face, and began to wave to the
+others to come back.
+
+"I'll be hanged," cried Sancho when he saw this signal, "if my master
+has not killed the lion." And they all hurried up to the wagon where
+the keeper gave them a long account of what had happened, adding,
+that when he got to court he would tell the King of Don Quixote's
+bravery.
+
+"If his Majesty should happen to ask who did this thing, tell him,"
+said Don Quixote, "that it was the Knight of the Lions, for that is
+the name by which I shall now call myself."
+
+Sancho and his master now rode with the gentleman in green to his
+house, where they stopped some days, to the great contentment of
+Sancho. And of the wedding at which they were present, of the feast
+where Sancho so greatly enjoyed himself, as well as of other matters,
+you must read for yourself.
+
+When the Knight and his squire again began their travels, it chanced
+that they stopped one night at an inn. To this inn, while Don Quixote
+was outside, waiting for supper, there came a man, all dressed in
+chamois leather, and wearing over his left eye, and part of his face,
+a green patch.
+
+"Have you any lodgings, landlord?" he cried in a loud voice; "for here
+comes the fortune-telling ape, and the great puppet-show of
+Melisendra's Deliverance."
+
+"Why, bless me!" cried the innkeeper, "if here isn't Master Peter. Now
+we shall have a merry night of it. You are welcome, with all my heart.
+Where is the ape, Peter?"
+
+"Coming presently," said Master Peter. "I only came on before to see
+if lodgings were to be had."
+
+"Lodgings!" cried the landlord. "Why, I'd turn out the Duke of Alva
+himself rather than you should want room. Bring on the monkey and the
+show, for I have guests in the inn to-night who will pay well to see
+the performance."
+
+"That's good news," said Peter, going off to hurry up his cart.
+
+"Who is this Peter?" asked Don Quixote.
+
+"Why, sir," answered the landlord, "he has been going about the
+country this long time with his play of Melisendra and Don Gayferos,
+one of the very best shows that ever was seen. Then he has the
+cleverest ape in the world. You have only to ask it a question and it
+will jump on its master's shoulder and whisper the answer in his ear,
+and then Master Peter will tell you what it says. It's true, he isn't
+always right, but he so often hits the nail on the head that we
+sometimes think Satan is in him."
+
+Don Quixote no sooner saw the ape, than he marched up to it, and asked
+a question.
+
+"Ah!" said Master Peter, "the animal can't tell what is going to
+happen; only what has already happened."
+
+"I wouldn't give a brass centesimo," cried Sancho, "to know what is
+past. Who can tell that better than myself? Tell me what my wife
+Teresa is doing at home just now."
+
+Master Peter tapped his shoulder: the ape at once sprang on to it, and
+putting its head at his ear, began to chatter--as apes do--for a
+minute. Then it skipped down again, and immediately Master Peter ran
+to Don Quixote and fell on his knees before him.
+
+"O glorious restorer of knight-errantry!" he cried, "who can say
+enough in praise of the great Don Quixote de la Mancha, the righter of
+wrongs, the comfort of the afflicted and unhappy?"
+
+Don Quixote was amazed at these words, for he was certain that he was
+unknown to any one at the inn. He did not guess that Master Peter was
+a clever rogue, who, before giving a performance, always made it his
+business to find out about those who were likely to be looking on.
+
+As for Sancho, he quaked with fear.
+
+"And thou, honest Sancho," went on Master Peter, "the best squire to
+the best knight in the world, be not unhappy about your wife. She is
+well, and at this moment is dressing flax. By the same token, she has
+at her left hand, to cheer her, a broken-mouthed jug of wine."
+
+"That's like enough," said Sancho.
+
+"Well," cried Don Quixote, "if I had not seen it with my own eyes,
+nothing should have made me believe that apes have the gift of second
+sight. I am in very truth the Don Quixote de la Mancha that this
+wonderful animal has told you about."
+
+But he was not quite pleased at the idea of the ape having such
+powers, and taking Sancho aside he spoke to him seriously on the
+subject.
+
+While they spoke, the showman came to tell them that the puppet-show
+was now ready to begin, and Don Quixote and Sancho went into the room
+where it stood, with candles burning all round it. Master Peter got
+inside in order to move the puppets, and a boy standing in front
+explained what was going on.
+
+The story that was acted by the puppets was that of a certain Don
+Gayferos, who rescued his wife Melisendra from captivity by the Moors
+in the city of Saragossa. Melisendra was imprisoned in the castle, and
+the story goes that Don Gayferos, when riding past, in his search,
+spied her on the balcony. Melisendra, with the help of a rope, lets
+herself down to her husband, mounts behind him, and the two gallop
+away from the city. But Melisendra's flight has been noticed, and the
+city bells ring an alarm. The Moors rush out like angry wasps, start
+in pursuit, and the capture and death of Don Gayferos and Melisendra
+seem certain.
+
+Don Quixote listened and looked with growing excitement and anger, but
+when he saw the Moors gallop in pursuit and about to close on Don
+Gayferos and Melisendra, he could keep quiet no longer. Starting up,
+"It shall never be said," cried he, "that in my presence I suffered
+such a wrong to be done to so famous a knight as Don Gayferos. Stop
+your unjust pursuit, ye base rascals! Stop! or prepare to meet me in
+battle."
+
+Then, drawing his sword, with one spring he fell with fury on the
+Moors, hacking some in pieces, beheading others, and sending the rest
+flying into every corner. And had not Master Peter ducked and squatted
+down on the ground behind part of the show, Don Quixote would
+certainly have chopped off his head also.
+
+"Hold! hold, sir!" cried Master Peter, "for mercy's sake, hold! These
+are not real Moors. You will ruin me if you destroy my show."
+
+But Don Quixote paid not the slightest heed. He went on slashing and
+hacking till the whole show was a wreck. Everybody ran to get out of
+harm's way, and the ape scampered, chattering, on to the roof of the
+house. Sancho himself quaked with fear, for he had never before seen
+his master in such a fury.
+
+All the puppet Moors being now cut to pieces, Don Quixote became
+calmer, saying aloud, "How miserable had been the fate of poor Don
+Gayferos and Melisendra his wife if I had not been in time to save
+them from those infidel Moors! Long live knight-errantry!"
+
+"Ay, ay," moaned Master Peter in a doleful voice, "it may live long
+enough. As for me, I may as well die, for I am a ruined man and a
+beggar now."
+
+Sancho Panza took pity on the showman.
+
+"Come, come! Master Peter," said he, "don't cry. Don't be cast down.
+My master will pay you when he comes to know that he has done you an
+injury."
+
+"Truly," said Peter, "if his honor will pay for my puppets.'ll ask no
+more."
+
+"How!" cried Don Quixote. "I do not see that I have injured you, good
+Master Peter."
+
+"Not injured me!" cried Master Peter. "Do but look at those figures
+lying there, all hacked to bits."
+
+"Well," said Don Quixote, "now I know for certain a truth I have
+suspected before, that those accursed enchanters do nothing but put
+before my eyes things as they are, and then presently after change
+them as they please. Really and truly gentlemen, I vow and protest
+that all that was acted here seemed to me to be real. I could not
+contain my fury, and I acted as I thought was my duty. But if Master
+Peter will tell me the value of the figures, I will pay for them all."
+
+"Heaven bless your worship!" whined Master Peter. But had Don Quixote
+known that this same Master Peter was the very man who stole Sancho
+Panza's ass, perhaps he might have paid him in another way.
+
+
+
+
+VII
+
+THE BATTLE WITH THE BULLS; THE FIGHT WITH THE KNIGHT OF THE WHITE
+MOON; AND HOW DON QUIXOTE DIED
+
+
+Soon after this, Don Quixote and Sancho Panza rode forth in search of
+other adventures.
+
+They had ridden no great way when they happened upon some young people
+who had gaily dressed themselves as shepherds and shepherdesses, and
+were having a picnic in the woods. These people invited Don Quixote
+and Sancho to join their feast.
+
+When they had eaten and drunk, the Knight rose, and said that there
+was no sin worse than that of ingratitude, and that to show how
+grateful he was for the kindness that had been shown to him and to
+Sancho, he had only one means in his power.
+
+"Therefore," said he, "I will maintain for two whole days, in the
+middle of this high road leading to Saragossa, that these ladies here,
+disguised as shepherdesses, are the most beautiful damsels in the
+world, except only the peerless Dulcinea del Toboso, the mistress of
+my heart."
+
+So, mounting "Rozinante" he rode into the middle of the highway and
+there took his stand, ready to challenge all comers. He had sat there
+no long time when there appeared on the road coming towards him a
+number of riders, some with spears in their hands, all riding very
+fast and close together. In front of them thundered a drove of wild
+bulls, bellowing and tossing their horns. At once all the shepherds
+and the shepherdesses ran behind trees, but Don Quixote sat bravely
+where he was.
+
+When the horsemen came near, "Get out of the way!" bawled one of them.
+"Stand clear, or these bulls will have you in pieces in no time."
+
+"Halt, scoundrels!" roared the Knight. "What are bulls to Don Quixote
+de la Mancha, if they were the fiercest that ever lived? Stop,
+hangdogs!"
+
+But the herdsmen had no time to answer, nor Don Quixote to get out of
+the way had he wanted to do so, for before any one knew what was
+happening, the bulls had run right over him and "Rozinante," leaving
+them and Sancho and "Dapple," his ass, stunned and bruised, rolling in
+the dust.
+
+As soon as Don Quixote came to his senses he got up in great haste,
+stumbling here and falling there, and began to run after the herd.
+
+"Stop, you scoundrels!" he bawled. "Stop! It is a single knight that
+defies you."
+
+But no one took the least notice of him, and he sat sadly down on the
+road, waiting till Sancho brought "Rozinante" to him. Then master and
+man went on their way, Don Quixote sore ashamed of his defeat, hurt as
+much in mind as in body.
+
+That evening they dismounted at the door of an inn, and put up
+"Rozinante" and "Dapple" in the stable. Sancho asked the landlord what
+he could give them for supper.
+
+"Why," said the man, "you may have anything you choose to call for.
+The inn can provide fowls of the air, birds of the earth, and fishes
+of the sea."
+
+"There's no need for all that," said Sancho. "If you roast a couple of
+chickens it will be enough, for my master eats but little, and for
+myself, I have no great appetite."
+
+"Chickens?" said the host. "I am sorry I have no chickens just now.
+The hawks have killed them all."
+
+"Well, then, roast us a pullet, if it be tender."
+
+"A pullet? Well, now, that is unlucky. I sent away fifty to the market
+only yesterday. But, putting pullets aside, ask for anything you
+like."
+
+"Why, then," said Sancho, pondering, "let us have some veal, or a bit
+of kid."
+
+"Sorry sir, we are just out of veal and kid also. Next week we shall
+have enough and to spare."
+
+"That helps us nicely," said Sancho. "But at any rate, let us have
+some eggs and bacon."
+
+"Eggs!" cried the landlord. "Now didn't I tell him I had no hens or
+pullets, and how then can I have eggs? No, no! Ask for anything you
+please in the way of dainties, but don't ask for hens."
+
+"Body o' me!" said Sancho, "let us have something. Tell me what you
+have, and have done."
+
+"Well, what I really and truly have is a pair of cow-heels that look
+like calves'-feet, or a pair of calves'-feet that look like cow-heels.
+You can have that and some bacon."
+
+"They are mine," cried Sancho. "I don't care whether they are feet or
+heels."
+
+And as Don Quixote had supper with some other guests who carried with
+them their own cook and their own larder, Sancho and the landlord
+supped well on the cow-heels.
+
+Some days after this, the Knight and his squire reached Barcelona.
+Neither of them had ever before been near the sea, and the galleys
+that they saw in the distance being rowed about in the bay sorely
+puzzled Sancho, who thought that the oars were their legs, and that
+they must be some strange kind of beast.
+
+Now, one morning, when Don Quixote rode out, fully armed as usual, to
+take the air on the seashore, he saw a knight riding towards him,
+armed like himself, and having a bright moon painted on his shield. As
+soon as this knight came within hearing he halted, and in a loud voice
+called out:
+
+"Illustrious Don Quixote de la Mancha, I am the Knight of the White
+Moon, of whose doings you may have heard. I am come to fight with you
+and to make you own that the Lady of my Heart, whoever she may be, is
+more beautiful by far than the Lady Dulcinea del Toboso. Which truth,
+if you will confess, I will not slay you. And if we fight, and I
+should conquer you, then I ask no more than that you shall go to your
+own home, and for the space of one year give up carrying arms or
+searching for adventures. But if you should conquer me, then my head
+shall be at your disposal, my horse and arms shall be your spoils, and
+the fame of my deeds shall be yours. Consider what I say, and let your
+answer be quick."
+
+Don Quixote was amazed at hearing these words.
+
+"Knight of the White Moon," said he very solemnly, "the fame of whose
+doings has not yet come to my ears, I dare swear that thou hast never
+seen the beautiful Dulcinea, for hadst thou ever viewed her, thou
+wouldst have been careful not to make this challenge. The sight of her
+would have made thee know that there never has been, nor can be,
+beauty to match hers. And therefore, without giving thee the lie, I
+only tell thee thou art mistaken. I accept your challenge, on your
+conditions, and at once, except that I am content with the fame of my
+own deeds, and want not yours. Choose then whichever side of the field
+you please, and let us set to."
+
+The two knights then turned their horses to take ground for their
+charge, but at this moment up rode, with some friends, the Governor of
+the city of Barcelona, who knew Don Quixote, and who fancied that
+perhaps this was some new trick being played on him. The Governor,
+seeing both knights ready to turn for their charge, asked the Knight
+of the White Moon what was the cause of the combat, and having heard
+his answer, could not believe that the affair was not a joke, and so
+stood aside.
+
+Instantly the two knights charged at top speed. But the horse of the
+Knight of the White Moon was by far the bigger and heavier and faster,
+and he came with such a shock into poor old "Rozinante" that Don
+Quixote and his horse were hurled to the ground with terrible force,
+and lay stunned and helpless. In a moment the Knight of the White Moon
+was off his horse and holding his spear at Don Quixote's throat.
+
+"Yield, Sir Knight!" he cried, "or you are a dead man."
+
+Don Quixote, sorely hurt, but with steadfast look, gasped in a faint
+voice:
+
+"I do not yield. Dulcinea del Toboso is the most beautiful woman in
+the whole world. Press on with your spear, Sir Knight, and kill me."
+
+"Nay," said the Knight of the White Moon. "That will I not do. I am
+content if the great Don Quixote return to his home for a year, as we
+agreed before we fought."
+
+And Don Quixote answered very faintly that as nothing was asked of him
+to the hurt of Dulcinea, he would carry out all the rest faithfully
+and truly. The Knight of the White Moon then galloped away toward the
+city, where one of the Governor's friends followed him, in order to
+find out who he was. The victorious knight was Samson Carrasco, who,
+some months before, had fought with and had been beaten by Don
+Quixote. And he explained to the Governor's friend that all he wanted
+in fighting was, not to harm Don Quixote, but to make him promise to
+go home, and stop there for a year, by which time he hoped that his
+madness about knight-errantry might be cured.
+
+They raised Don Quixote and took off his helmet. His face was very
+pale, and he was covered with a cold sweat. "Rozinante" was in as bad
+plight as his master, and lay where he had fallen. Sancho, in great
+grief, could speak no word, and knew not what to do; to him it was all
+as a bad dream.
+
+Don Quixote was carried on a stretcher to the town, where for a week
+he lay in bed without ever raising his head, stricken to the soul by
+the disgrace of his defeat.
+
+Sancho tried to comfort him.
+
+"Pluck up your heart and be of good cheer, sir," he cried, "and thank
+Heaven you have broken no bones. They that give must take. Let us go
+home and give up looking for adventures."
+
+"After all, Sancho," said Don Quixote, "it is only for a year. After
+that I can begin again, and perhaps then I may be able to make thee an
+Earl."
+
+"Heaven grant it" said Sancho.
+
+So when the Knight was once more able to move they set out for home,
+Don Quixote riding "Rozinante" Sancho walking, for "Dapple" carried
+the armor.
+
+But all the way Don Quixote did not recover from his melancholy, and
+when at last they reached his village:
+
+"Help me to bed," he said, "for I think that I am not very well."
+
+He was put to bed, and carefully nursed. But a fever had taken hold of
+him, and for many days Sancho Panza never left his master's bedside.
+On the sixth day, the doctor told him he was in great danger. Don
+Quixote listened very calmly, and then asked that he might be left by
+himself for a little--he had a mind to sleep. His niece and Sancho
+left the room weeping bitterly, and Don Quixote fell into a deep
+sleep.
+
+When he awoke, with a firm voice he cried:
+
+"Blessed be God! My mind is is now clear, and the clouds have rolled
+away which those detestable books of knight-errantry cast over me. Now
+can I see their nonsense and deceit. I am at the point of death, and I
+would meet it so that I may not leave behind me the character of a
+madman. Send for the lawyer, that I may make my will."
+
+Excepting only a small sum of money which he gave to Sancho Panza, he
+left all to his niece.
+
+Thereafter he fell back in bed, and lay unconscious and without
+movement till the third day, when death very gently took him.
+
+So died Don Quixote de la Mancha, a good man and a brave gentleman to
+the end.
+
+
+
+
+GULLIVER'S TRAVELS
+
+_VOYAGE TO LILLIPUT_
+
+By JONATHAN SWIFT
+
+ADAPTED BY JOHN LANG
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+GULLIVER'S BIRTH AND EARLY VOYAGES
+
+
+Two hundred years ago, a great deal of the world as we now know it was
+still undiscovered; there were yet very many islands, small and great,
+on which the eyes of white men had never looked, seas in which nothing
+bigger than an Indian canoe had ever sailed.
+
+A voyage in those days was not often a pleasant thing, for ships then
+were very bluff-bowed and slow-sailing, and, for a long voyage, very
+ill-provided with food. There were no tinned meats two hundred years
+ago, no luxuries for use even in the cabin. Sailors lived chiefly on
+salt junk, as hard as leather, on biscuit that was generally as much
+weevil as biscuit, and the water that they drank was evil-smelling and
+bad when it had been long in the ship's casks.
+
+So, when a man said good-by to his friends and sailed away into the
+unknown, generally very many years passed before he came back--if ever
+he came back at all. For the dangers of the seas were then far greater
+than they now are, and if a ship was not wrecked some dark night on an
+unknown island or uncharted reef, there was always the probability of
+meeting a pirate vessel and of having to fight for life and liberty.
+Steam has nowadays nearly done away with pirates, except on the China
+coast and in a few other out-of-the-way places. But things were
+different long ago, before steamers were invented; and sailors then,
+when they came home, had many very surprising things to tell their
+friends, many astonishing adventures to speak of, among the strange
+peoples that they said they had met in far-off lands. One man, who saw
+more wonderful things than any one else, was named Lemuel Gulliver,
+and I will try to tell you a little about one of his voyages.
+
+Gulliver was born in Nottinghamshire, and when he was only fourteen
+years old he was sent to Emanuel College, Cambridge. There he remained
+till he was seventeen, but his father had not money enough to keep him
+any longer at the University. So, as was then the custom for those who
+meant to become doctors, he was bound apprentice to a surgeon in
+London, under whom he studied for four years. But all the time, as
+often as his father sent him money, he spent some of it in learning
+navigation (which means the art of finding your way across the sea,
+far from land). He had always had a great longing to travel, and he
+thought that a knowledge of navigation would be of use to him if he
+should happen to go a voyage.
+
+After leaving London, he went to Germany, and there studied medicine
+for some years, with the view of being appointed surgeon of a ship.
+And by the help of his late master in London, such a post he did get
+on board the "Swallow" on which vessel he made several voyages. But
+tiring of this, he settled in London, and, having married, began
+practise as a doctor.
+
+He did not, however, make much money at that, and so for six years he
+again went to sea as a surgeon, sailing both to the East and to the
+West Indies.
+
+Again tiring of the sea, he once more settled on shore, this time at
+Wapping, because in that place there are always many sailors, and he
+hoped to make money by doctoring them.
+
+But this turned out badly, and on May 4, 1699, he sailed from Bristol
+for the South Seas as surgeon of a ship named the "Antelope."
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+GULLIVER IS WRECKED ON THE COAST OF LILLIPUT
+
+
+At first, everything went well, but after leaving the South Seas, when
+steering for the East Indies, the ship was driven by a great storm far
+to the south. The gale lasted so long that twelve of the crew died
+from the effects of the hard work and the bad food, and all the others
+were worn out and weak. On a sailing ship, when the weather is very
+heavy, all hands have to be constantly on deck, and there is little
+rest for the men. Perhaps a sail, one of the few that can still be
+carried in such a gale, may be blown to ribbons by the furious wind,
+and a new one has to be bent on.
+
+The night, perhaps, is dark, the tattered canvas is thrashing with a
+noise like thunder, the ship burying her decks under angry black seas
+every few minutes. The men's hands are numb with the cold and the wet,
+and the hard, dangerous work aloft. There is no chance of going below
+when their job is done, to "turn in" between warm, dry blankets in a
+snug berth. Possibly even those who belong to the "watch below" may
+have to remain on deck. Or, if they have the good fortune to be
+allowed to go below, they may no sooner have dropped off asleep
+(rolled round in blankets which perhaps have been wet ever since the
+gale began) than there is a thump, thump overhead, and one of the
+watch on deck bellows down the forecastle-hatch, "All hands shorten
+sail." And out they must tumble again, once more to battle with the
+hungry, roaring seas and the raging wind. So, when there has been a
+long spell of bad weather, it is no wonder that the men are worn out.
+And when, as was the case with Gulliver's ship, the food also is bad,
+it is easy to understand why so many of the crew had died.
+
+It was on the 5th of November, the beginning of summer in latitudes
+south of the equator. The storm had not yet cleared off, and the
+weather was very thick, the wind coming in furious squalls that drove
+the ship along at great speed, when suddenly from the lookout man came
+a wild cry--"Breakers ahead!"
+
+But so close had the vessel come to the rocks before they were seen
+through the thick driving spray, that immediately, with, a heavy
+plunge, she crashed into the reef, and split her bows.
+
+Gulliver and six of the crew lowered a boat and got clear of the wreck
+and of the breakers. But the men were so weak from overwork that they
+could not handle the boat in such a sea, and very soon, during a
+fierce squall, she sank. What became of the men Gulliver never knew,
+for he saw none of them again. Probably they were drowned at once,
+for they were too weak to keep long afloat in a sea breaking so
+heavily.
+
+And indeed, Gulliver himself was like to have been lost. He swam till
+no strength or feeling was left in his arms and legs, swam bravely,
+his breath coming in great sobs, his eyes blinded with the salt seas
+that broke over his head. Still he struggled on, utterly spent, until
+at last, in a part where the wind seemed to have less force, and the
+seas swept over him less furiously, on letting down his legs he found
+that he was within his depth. But the shore shelved so gradually that
+for nearly a mile he had to wade wearily through shallow water, till,
+fainting almost with fatigue, he reached dry land.
+
+By this time darkness was coming on, and there were no signs of houses
+or of people. He staggered forward but a little distance, and then, on
+the short, soft turf, sank down exhausted and slept.
+
+When he woke, the sun was shining, and he tried to rise; but not by
+any means could he stir hand or foot. Gulliver had fallen asleep lying
+on his back, and now he found that his arms and legs were tightly
+fastened to the ground. Across his body were numbers of thin but
+strong cords, and even his hair, which was very long, was pegged down
+so securely that he could not turn his head.
+
+All round about him there was a confused sound of voices, but he could
+see nothing except the sky, and the sun shone so hot and fierce into
+his eyes that he could scarcely keep them open.
+
+Soon he felt something come gently up his left leg, and forward on to
+his breast almost to his chin. Looking down as much as possible, he
+saw standing there a very little man, not more than six inches high,
+armed with a bow and arrows.
+
+Then many more small men began to swarm over him. Gulliver let out
+such a roar of wonder and fright that they all turned and ran, many of
+them getting bad falls in their hurry to get out of danger. But very
+quickly the little people came back again.
+
+This time, with a great struggle Gulliver managed to break the cords
+that fastened his left arm, and at the same time, by a violent wrench
+that hurt him dreadfully, he slightly loosened the strings that
+fastened his hair, so that he was able to turn his head a little to
+one side. But the little men were too quick for him, and got out of
+reach before he could catch any of them.
+
+Then he heard a great shouting, followed by a shrill little voice that
+called sharply, "_Tolgo phonac_," and immediately, arrows like needles
+were shot into his hand, and another volley struck him in the face.
+Poor Gulliver covered his face with his hand, and lay groaning with
+pain.
+
+Again he struggled to get loose. But the harder he fought for freedom,
+the more the little men shot arrows into him, and some of them even
+tried to run their spears into his sides.
+
+When he found that the more he struggled the more he was hurt,
+Gulliver lay still, thinking to himself that at night at least, now
+that his left hand was free, he could easily get rid of the rest of
+his bonds. As soon as the little people saw that he struggled no more,
+they ceased shooting at him; but he knew from the increasing sound of
+voices that more and more of the little soldiers were coming round
+him.
+
+Soon, a few yards from him, on the right, he heard a continued sound
+of hammering, and on turning his head to that side as far as the
+strings would let him, he saw that a small wooden stage was being
+built. On to this, when it was finished, there climbed by ladders four
+men, and one of them (who seemed to be a very important person, for a
+little page boy attended to hold up his train) immediately gave an
+order. At once about fifty of the soldiers ran forward and cut the
+strings that tied Gulliver's hair on the left side, so that he could
+turn his head easily to the right.
+
+Then the person began to make a long speech, not one word of which
+could Gulliver understand, but it seemed to him that sometimes the
+little man threatened, and sometimes made offers of kindness.
+
+As well as he could, Gulliver made signs that he submitted. Then,
+feeling by this time faint with hunger, he pointed with his fingers
+many times to his mouth, to show that he wanted something to eat.
+
+They understood him very well. Several ladders were put against
+Gulliver's sides, and about a hundred little people climbed up and
+carried to his mouth all kinds of bread and meat. There were things
+shaped like legs, and shoulders, and saddles of mutton. Very good they
+were, Gulliver thought, but very small, no bigger than a lark's wing;
+and the loaves of bread were about the size of bullets, so that he
+could take several at a mouthful. The people wondered greatly at the
+amount that he ate.
+
+When he signed that he was thirsty, they slung up on to his body two
+of their biggest casks of wine, and having rolled them forward to his
+hand they knocked out the heads of the casks. Gulliver drank them both
+off at a draught, and asked for more, for they held only about a small
+tumblerful each. But there was no more to be had.
+
+As the small people walked to and fro over his body, Gulliver was
+sorely tempted to seize forty or fifty of them and dash them on the
+ground, and then to make a further struggle for liberty. But the pain
+he had already suffered from their arrows made him think better of it,
+and he wisely lay quiet.
+
+Soon another small man, who from his brilliant uniform seemed to be an
+officer of very high rank, marched with some others on to Gulliver's
+chest and held up to his eyes a paper which Gulliver understood to be
+an order from the King of the country. The officer made a long speech,
+often pointing towards something a long way off, and (as Gulliver
+afterwards learned) told him that he was to be taken as a prisoner to
+the city, the capital of the country.
+
+Gulliver asked, by signs, that his bonds might be loosed. The officer
+shook his head and refused, but he allowed some of his soldiers to
+slack the cords on one side, whereby Gulliver was able to feel more
+comfortable. After this, the little people drew out the arrows that
+still stuck in his hands and face, and rubbed the wounds with some
+pleasant-smelling ointment, which so soothed his pain that very soon
+he fell sound asleep. And this was no great wonder, for, as he
+afterwards understood, the King's physicians had mixed a very strong
+sleeping draught with the wine that had been given him.
+
+Gulliver awoke with a violent fit of sneezing, and with the feeling of
+small feet running away from off his chest.
+
+Where was he? Bound still, without doubt, but no longer did he find
+himself lying on the ground. It puzzled him greatly that now he lay on
+a sort of platform. How had he got there?
+
+Soon he began to realize what had happened; and later, when he
+understood the language, he learned all that had been done to him
+while he slept. Before he dropped asleep, he had heard a rumbling as
+of wheels, and the shouts of many drivers. This, it seemed, was caused
+by the arrival of a huge kind of trolley, a few inches high, but
+nearly seven feet long, drawn by fifteen hundred of the King's largest
+horses.
+
+On this it was meant that he should be taken to the city. By the use
+of strong poles fixed in the ground, to which were attached many
+pulleys, and the strongest ropes to be found in the country, nine
+hundred men managed to hoist him as he slept. They then put him on the
+trolley, where they again tied him fast.
+
+It was when they were far on their way to the city that Gulliver
+awoke. The trolley had stopped for a little to breathe the horses, and
+one of the officers of the King's Guard who had not before seen
+Gulliver, climbed with some friends up his body. While looking at his
+face, the officer could not resist the temptation of putting the point
+of his sword up Gulliver's nose, which tickled him so that he woke,
+sneezing violently.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+GULLIVER IS TAKEN AS A PRISONER TO THE CAPITAL OF LILLIPUT
+
+
+The city was not reached till the following day, and Gulliver had to
+spend the night lying where he was, guarded on each side by five
+hundred men with torches and bows and arrows, ready to shoot him if he
+should attempt to move.
+
+In the morning, the King and all his court, and thousands of the
+people, came out to gaze on the wonderful sight. The trolley, with
+Gulliver on it, stopped outside the walls, alongside a very large
+building which had once been used as a temple, but the use of which
+had been given up owing to a murder having been committed in it.
+
+The door of this temple was quite four feet high and about two feet
+wide, and on each side, about six inches from the ground, was a small
+window. Inside the building the King's blacksmiths fastened many
+chains, which they then brought through one of these little windows
+and padlocked round Gulliver's left ankle. Then his bonds were cut,
+and he was allowed to get up. He found that he could easily creep
+through the door, and that there was room inside to lie down.
+
+His chains were nearly six feet long, so that he could get a little
+exercise by walking backwards and forwards outside. Always when he
+walked, thousands of people thronged around to look at him; even the
+King himself used to come and gaze by the hour from a high tower which
+stood opposite.
+
+One day, just as Gulliver had crept out from his house and had got on
+his feet, it chanced that the King, who was a very fine-looking man,
+taller than any of his people, came riding along on his great white
+charger. When the horse saw Gulliver move it was terrified, and
+plunged and reared so madly that the people feared that a terrible
+accident was going to happen, and several of the King's guards ran in
+to seize the horse by the head. But the King was a good horseman, and
+managed the animal so well that very soon it got over its fright, and
+he was able to dismount.
+
+Then he gave orders that food should be brought for Gulliver, twenty
+little carts full, and ten of wine; and he and his courtiers, all
+covered with gold and silver, stood around and watched him eating.
+After the King had gone away the people of the city crowded round, and
+some of them began to behave very badly, one man even going so far as
+to shoot an arrow at Gulliver which was not far from putting out one
+of his eyes. But the officer in command of the soldiers who were on
+guard ordered his men to bind and push six of the worst behaved of the
+crowd within reach of Gulliver, who at once seized five of them and
+put them in his coat pocket. The sixth he held up to his mouth and
+made as if he meant to eat him, whereupon the wretched little creature
+shrieked aloud with terror, and when Gulliver took out his knife, all
+the people, even the soldiers, were dreadfully alarmed. But Gulliver
+only cut the man's bonds, and let him run away, which he did in a
+great hurry. And when he took the others out of his pocket, one by
+one, and treated them in the same way, the crowd began to laugh. After
+that the people always behaved very well to Gulliver, and he became a
+great favorite. From all over the kingdom crowds flocked to see the
+Great Man Mountain.
+
+In the meantime, as Gulliver learned later, there were frequent
+meetings of the King's council to discuss the question of what was to
+be done with him. Some of the councilors feared lest he might break
+loose and cause great damage in the city. Some were of opinion that to
+keep and feed so huge a creature would cause a famine in the land, or,
+at the least, that the expense would be greater than the public funds
+could bear; they advised, therefore, that he should be killed--shot in
+the hands and face with poisoned arrows. Others, however, argued that
+if this were done it would be a very difficult thing to get rid of so
+large a dead body, which might cause a pestilence to break out if it
+lay long unburied so near the city.
+
+Finally, the King and his council gave orders that each morning the
+surrounding villages should send into the city for Gulliver's daily
+use six oxen, forty sheep, and a sufficient quantity of bread and
+wine.
+
+It was also commanded that six hundred persons should act as his
+servants; that three hundred tailors were to make for him a suit of
+clothes; and that six professors from the University were to teach him
+the language of the country.
+
+When Gulliver could speak the language, he learned a great deal about
+the land in which he now found himself. It was called Lilliput, and
+the people, Lilliputians. These Lilliputians believed that their
+kingdom and the neighboring country of Blefuscu were the whole world.
+Blefuscu lay far over the sea, to these little people dim and blue on
+the horizon, though to Gulliver the distance did not seem to be more
+than a mile. The Lilliputians knew of no land beyond Blefuscu. And as
+for Gulliver himself, they believed that he had fallen from the moon,
+or from one of the stars; it was impossible, they said, that so big a
+race of men could live on the earth. It was quite certain that there
+could not be food enough for them. They did not believe Gulliver's
+story. He must have fallen from the moon!
+
+Almost the first thing that Gulliver did when he knew the language
+fairly well, was to send a petition to the King, praying that his
+chains might be taken off and that he might be free to walk about. But
+this he was told could not then be granted. He must first, the King's
+council said, "swear a peace" with the kingdom of Lilliput, and
+afterwards, if by continued good behavior he gained their confidence,
+he might be freed.
+
+Meantime, by the King's orders, two high officers of state were sent
+to search him, Gulliver lifted up these officers in his hand and put
+them into each of his pockets, one after the other, and they made for
+the King a careful list of everything found there.
+
+Gulliver afterward saw this inventory. His snuff-box they had
+described as a "huge silver chest, full of a sort of dust." Into that
+dust one of them stepped, and the snuff, flying up in his face, caused
+him nearly to sneeze his head off. His pistols they called "hollow
+pillars of iron, fastened to strong pieces of timber," and the use of
+his bullets, and of his powder (which he had been lucky enough to
+bring ashore dry, owing to his pouch being water-tight), they could
+not understand, while of his watch they could make nothing. They
+called it "a wonderful kind of engine, which makes an incessant noise
+like a water-wheel." But some fancied that it was perhaps a kind of
+animal. Certainly it was alive.
+
+All these things, together with his sword, which he carried slung to a
+belt round his waist, Gulliver had to give up, first, as well as he
+could, explaining the use of them. The Lilliputians could not
+understand the pistols, and to show his meaning, Gulliver was obliged
+to fire one of them. At once hundreds of little people fell down as if
+they had been struck dead by the noise. Even the King, though he stood
+his ground, was sorely frightened. Most of Gulliver's property was
+returned to him; but the pistols and powder and bullets, and his
+sword, were taken away and put, for safety, under strict guard.
+
+As the King and his courtiers gained more faith in Gulliver, and
+became less afraid of his breaking loose and doing some mischief,
+they began to treat him in a more friendly way than they had hitherto
+done, and showed him more of the manners and customs of the country.
+Some of these were very curious.
+
+One of the sports of which they were most fond was rope-dancing, and
+there was no more certain means of being promoted to high office and
+power in the state than to possess great cleverness in that art.
+Indeed, it was said that the Lord High Treasurer had gained and kept
+his post chiefly through his great skill in turning somersaults on the
+tight rope. The Chief Secretary for private affairs ran him very
+close, and there was hardly a Minister of State who did not owe his
+position to such successes. Few of them, indeed, had escaped without
+severe accidents at one time or another, while trying some specially
+difficult feat, and many had been lamed for life. But however many and
+bad the falls, there were always plenty of other persons to attempt
+the same or some more difficult jump.
+
+Taught by his narrow escape from a serious accident when his horse
+first saw Gulliver, the King now gave orders that the horses of his
+army, as well as those from the Royal stables, should be exercised
+daily close to the Man Mountain. Soon they became so used to the sight
+of him that they would come right up to his foot without starting or
+shying. Often the riders would jump their chargers over Gulliver's
+hand as he held it on the ground; and once the King's huntsman, better
+mounted than most of the others, actually jumped over his foot, shoe
+and all--a wonderful leap.
+
+Gulliver saw that it was wise to amuse the King in this and other
+ways, because the more his Majesty was pleased with him the sooner was
+it likely that his liberty would be granted. So he asked one day that
+some strong sticks, about two feet in height, should be brought to
+him. Several of these he fixed firmly in the ground, and across them,
+near the top, he lashed four other sticks, enclosing a square space of
+about two and a half feet. Then to the uprights, about five inches
+lower than the crossed sticks, he tied his pocket-handkerchief, and
+stretched it tight as a drum.
+
+When the work was finished, he asked the King to let a troop exercise
+on this stage. His Majesty was delighted with the idea, and for
+several days nothing pleased him more than to see Gulliver lift up the
+men and horses, and to watch them go through their drill on this
+platform. Sometimes he would even be lifted up himself and give the
+words of command; and once he persuaded the Queen, who was rather
+timid, to let herself be held up in her chair within full view of the
+scene. But a fiery horse one day, pawing with his hoof, wore a hole in
+the handkerchief, and came down heavily on its side, and after this
+Gulliver could no longer trust the strength of his stage.
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+GULLIVER IS FREED, AND CAPTURES THE BLEFUSCAN FLEET
+
+
+By this time Gulliver's clothes were almost in rags. The three hundred
+tailors had not yet been able to finish his new suit, and he had no
+hat at all, for that had been lost as he came ashore from the wreck.
+So he was greatly pleased one day when an express message came to the
+King from the coast, saying that some men had found on the shore a
+great, black, strangely-shaped mass, as high as a man; it was not
+alive, they were certain. It had never moved, though for a time they
+had watched, before going closer. After making certain that it was not
+likely to injure them, by mounting on each other's shoulders they had
+got on the top, which they found was flat and smooth, and, by the
+sound when stamped upon, they judged that it was hollow. It was
+thought that the object might possibly be something belonging to the
+Man Mountain, and they proposed by the help of five horses to bring it
+to the city.
+
+Gulliver was sure that it must be his hat, and so it turned out. Nor
+was it very greatly damaged, either by the sea or by being drawn by
+the horses over the ground all the way from the coast, except that two
+holes had been bored in the brim, to which a long cord had been fixed
+by hooks. Gulliver was much pleased to have it once more.
+
+Two days after this the King took into his head a curious fancy. He
+ordered a review of troops to be held, and he directed that Gulliver
+should stand with his legs very wide apart, while under him both horse
+and foot were commanded to march. Over three thousand infantry and one
+thousand cavalry passed through the great arch made by his legs,
+colors flying and bands playing. The King and Queen themselves sat in
+their State Coach at the saluting point, near to his left leg, and all
+the while Gulliver dared not move a hair's-breadth, lest he should
+injure some of the soldiers.
+
+Shortly after this, Gulliver was set free. There had been a meeting of
+the King's Council on the subject, and the Lord High Admiral was the
+only member in favor of still keeping him chained. This great officer
+to the end was Gulliver's bitter enemy, and though on this occasion he
+was out-voted, yet he was allowed to draw up the conditions which
+Gulliver was to sign before his chains were struck off.
+
+The conditions were:
+
+First, that he was not to quit the country without leave granted under
+the King's Great Seal.
+
+Second, that he was not to come into the city without orders; at which
+times the people were to have two hours' notice to keep indoors.
+
+Third, that he should keep to the high roads, and not walk or lie down
+in a meadow.
+
+Fourth, that he was to take the utmost care not to trample on anybody,
+or on any horses or carriages, and that he was not to lift any persons
+in his hand against their will.
+
+Fifth, that if at any time an express had to be sent in great haste,
+he was to carry the messenger and his horse in his pocket a six-days'
+journey, and to bring them safely back.
+
+Sixth, that he should be the King's ally against the Blefuscans, and
+that he should try to destroy their fleet, which was said to be
+preparing to invade Lilliput.
+
+Seventh, that he should help the workmen to move certain great stones
+which were needed to repair some of the public buildings.
+
+Eighth, that he should in "two moons' time" make an exact survey of
+the kingdom, by counting how many of his own paces it took him to go
+all round the coast.
+
+Lastly, on his swearing to the above conditions, it was promised that
+he should have a daily allowance of meat and drink equal to the amount
+consumed by seventeen hundred and twenty-four of the Lilliputians, for
+they estimated that Gulliver's size was about equal to that number of
+their own people.
+
+Though one or two of the conditions did not please him, especially
+that about helping the workmen (which he thought was making him too
+much a servant), yet Gulliver signed the document at once, and swore
+to observe its conditions.
+
+After having done so, and having had his chains removed, the first
+thing he asked was to be allowed to see the city (which was called
+Mildendo). He found that it was surrounded by a great wall about two
+and a half feet high, broad enough for one of their coaches and four
+to be driven along, and at every ten feet there were strong flanking
+towers.
+
+Gulliver took off his coat, lest the tails might do damage to the
+roofs or chimneys of the houses, and he then stepped over the wall and
+very carefully walked down the finest of the streets, one quite five
+feet wide. Wherever he went, the tops of the houses and the attic
+windows were packed with wondering spectators, and he reckoned that
+the town must hold quite half a million of people.
+
+In the center of the city, where the two chief streets met, stood the
+King's Palace, a very fine building surrounded by a wall. But he was
+not able to see the whole palace that day, because the part in which
+were the royal apartments was shut off by another wall nearly five
+feet in height, which he could not get over without a risk of doing
+damage.
+
+Some days later he climbed over by the help of two stools which he
+made from some of the largest trees in the Royal Park, trees nearly
+seven feet high, which he was allowed to cut down for the purpose. By
+putting one of the stools at each side of the wall Gulliver was able
+to step across. Then, lying down on his side, and putting his face
+close to the open windows, he looked in and saw the Queen and all the
+young Princes. The Queen smiled, and held her hand out of one of the
+windows, that he might kiss it. She was very pleasant and friendly.
+
+One day, about a fortnight after this, there came to call on him,
+Reldresal, the King's Chief Secretary, a very great man, one who had
+always been Gulliver's very good friend. This person had a long and
+serious talk with Gulliver about the state of the country.
+
+He said that though to the outward eye things in Lilliput seemed very
+settled and prosperous, yet in reality there were troubles, both
+internal and external, that threatened the safety of the kingdom.
+
+There had been in Lilliput for a very long time two parties at bitter
+enmity with each other, so bitter that they would neither eat, drink,
+nor talk together, and what one party did, the other would always try
+to undo. Each professed to believe that nothing good could come from
+the other. Any measure proposed by the party in power was by the other
+always looked upon as foolish or evil. And any new law passed by the
+Government party was said by the Opposition to be either a wicked
+attack on the liberties of the people, or something undertaken solely
+for the purpose of keeping that party in, and the Opposition out, of
+power. To such a pitch had things now come, said the Chief Secretary,
+entirely owing to the folly of the Opposition, that the business of
+the kingdom was almost at a standstill.
+
+Meantime the country was in danger of an invasion by the Blefuscans,
+who were now fitting out a great fleet, which was almost ready to sail
+to attack Lilliput. The war with Blefuscu had been raging for some
+years, and the losses by both nations of ships and of men had been
+very heavy.
+
+This war had broken out in the following way. It had always been the
+custom in Lilliput, as far back as history went, for people when
+breaking an egg at breakfast to do so at the big end. But it had
+happened, said the Chief Secretary, that the present King's
+grandfather, when a boy, had once when breaking his egg in the usual
+way, severely cut his finger. Whereupon his father at once gave strict
+commands that in future all his subjects should break their eggs at
+the small end.
+
+This greatly angered the people, who thought that the King had no
+right to give such an order, and they refused to obey. As a
+consequence no less than six rebellions had taken place: thousands of
+the Lilliputians had had their heads cut off, or had been cast into
+prison, and thousands had fled for refuge to Blefuscu, rather than
+obey the hated order.
+
+These "Big endians," as they were called, had been very well received
+at the Court of Blefuscu, and finally the Emperor of that country had
+taken upon himself to interfere in the affairs of Lilliput, thus
+bringing on war.
+
+The Chief Secretary ended the talk by saying that the King, having
+great faith in Gulliver's strength, and depending on the oath which he
+had sworn before being released, expected him now to help in defeating
+the Blefuscan fleet.
+
+Gulliver was very ready to do what he could, and he at once thought of
+a plan whereby he might destroy the whole fleet at one blow. He told
+all his ideas on the subject to the King, who gave orders that
+everything he might need should be supplied without delay. Then
+Gulliver went to the oldest seamen in the navy, and learned from them
+the depth of water between Lilliput and Blefuscu. It was, they said,
+nowhere deeper than seventy _glumgluffs_ (which is equal to about six
+feet) at high water, and there was no great extent so deep.
+
+After this he walked to the coast opposite Blefuscu, and lying down
+there behind a hillock, so that he might not be seen should any of the
+enemy's ships happen to be cruising near, he looked long through a
+small pocket-telescope across the channel. With the naked eye he could
+easily see the cliffs of Blefuscu, and soon with his telescope he made
+out where the fleet lay--fifty great men-of-war, and many transports,
+waiting for a fair wind.
+
+Coming back to the city, he gave orders for a great length of the
+strongest cable, and a quantity of bars of iron. The cable was little
+thicker than ordinary pack-thread, and the bars of iron much about the
+length and size of knitting-needles. Gulliver twisted three of the
+iron bars together and bent them to a hook at one end. He trebled the
+cable for greater strength, and thus made fifty shorter cables, to
+which he fastened the hooks.
+
+Then, carrying these in his hand, he walked back to the coast and
+waded into the sea, a little before high water. When he came to
+mid-channel, he had to swim, but for no great distance.
+
+As soon as they noticed Gulliver coming wading through the water
+towards their ships, the Blefuscan sailors all jumped overboard and
+swam ashore in a terrible fright. Never before had any of them seen or
+dreamt of so monstrous a giant, nor had they heard of his being in
+Lilliput.
+
+Gulliver then quietly took his cables and fixed one securely in the
+bows of each of the ships of war, and finally he tied the cables
+together at his end. But while he was doing this the Blefuscan
+soldiers on the shore plucked up courage and began to shoot arrows at
+him, many of which stuck in his hands and face. He was very much
+afraid lest some of these might put out his eyes; but he remembered,
+luckily, that in his inner pocket were his spectacles, which he put
+on, and then finished his work without risk to his eyes.
+
+On pulling at the cables, however, not a ship could he move. He had
+forgotten that their anchors were all down. So he was forced to go in
+closer and with his knife to cut the vessels free. While doing this he
+was of course exposed to a furious fire from the enemy, and hundreds
+of arrows struck him, some almost knocking off his spectacles. But
+again he hauled, and this time drew the whole fifty vessels after him.
+
+The Blefuscans had thought that it was his intention merely to cast
+the vessels adrift, so that they might run aground, but when they saw
+their great fleet being steadily drawn out to sea, their grief was
+terrible. For a great distance Gulliver could hear their cries of
+despair.
+
+When he had got well away from the land, he stopped in order to pick
+the arrows from his face and hands, and to put on some of the ointment
+that had been rubbed on his wounds when first the Lilliputians fired
+into him. By this time the tide had fallen a little, and he was able
+to wade all the way across the channel.
+
+The King and his courtiers stood waiting on the shore. They could see
+the vessels steadily drawing nearer, but they could not for some time
+see Gulliver, because only his head was above water. At first some
+imagined that he had been drowned, and that the fleet was now on its
+way to attack Lilliput.
+
+There was great joy when Gulliver was seen hauling the vessels; and
+when he landed, the King was so pleased that on the spot he created
+him a _Nardac_, the highest honor that it was in his power to bestow.
+
+His great success over the Blefuscans, however, turned out to be but
+the beginning of trouble for Gulliver. The King was so puffed up by
+the victory that he formed plans for capturing in the same way the
+whole of the enemy's ships of every kind. And it was now his wish to
+crush Blefuscu utterly, and to make it nothing but a province
+depending on Lilliput. Thus, he thought, he himself would then be
+monarch of the whole world.
+
+In this scheme Gulliver refused to take any part, and he very plainly
+said that he would give no help in making slaves of the Blefuscans.
+This refusal angered the King very much, and more than once he
+artfully brought the matter up at a State Council. Now, several of the
+councilors, though they pretended to be Gulliver's friends so long as
+he was in favor with the King, were really his secret enemies, and
+nothing pleased these persons better than to see that the King was no
+longer pleased with him. So they did all in their power to nurse and
+increase the King's anger, and to make him believe that Gulliver was a
+traitor.
+
+About this time there came to Lilliput ambassadors from Blefuscu,
+suing for peace. When a treaty had been made and signed (very greatly
+to the advantage of Lilliput), the Blefuscan ambassadors asked to see
+the Great Man Mountain, of whom they had heard so much, and they paid
+Gulliver a formal call. After asking him to give them some proofs of
+his strength, they invited him to visit their Emperor, which Gulliver
+promised to do.
+
+Accordingly, the next time that he met the King, he asked, as he was
+bound to do by the paper he had signed, for permission to leave the
+country for a time, in order to visit Blefuscu. The King did not
+refuse, but his manner was so cold that Gulliver could not help
+noticing it. Afterwards he learned from a friend that his enemies in
+the council had told the King lying tales of his meetings with the
+Blefuscan ambassadors, which had had the effect of still further
+rousing his anger.
+
+It happened too, most unfortunately, at this time, that Gulliver had
+offended the Queen by a well-meant, but badly-managed, effort to do
+her a service, and thus he lost also her friendship. But though he was
+now out of favor at court, he was still an object of great interest to
+every one.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+GULLIVER'S ESCAPE FROM LILLIPUT AND RETURN TO ENGLAND
+
+
+Gulliver had three hundred cooks to dress his food and these men, with
+their families, lived in small huts which had been built for them near
+his house.
+
+He had made for himself a chair and a table. On to this table it was
+his custom to lift twenty waiters, and these men then drew up by ropes
+and pulleys all his food, and his wine in casks, which one hundred
+other servants had in readiness on the ground. Gulliver would often
+eat his meal with many hundreds of people looking on.
+
+One day the King, who had not seen him eat since this table had been
+built, sent a message that he and the Queen desired to be present that
+day while Gulliver dined. They arrived just before his dinner hour,
+and he at once lifted the King and Queen and the Princes, with their
+attendants and guards, on to the table.
+
+Their Majesties sat in their chairs of state all the time, watching
+with deep interest the roasts of beef and mutton, and whole flocks of
+geese and turkeys and fowls disappear into Gulliver's mouth. A roast
+of beef of which he had to make more than two mouthfuls was seldom
+seen, and he ate them bones and all. A goose or a turkey was but one
+bite.
+
+Certainly, on this occasion, Gulliver ate more than usual, thinking by
+so doing to amuse and please the court.
+
+But in this he erred, for it was turned against him. Flimnap, the Lord
+High Treasurer, who had always been one of his enemies, pointed out to
+the King the great daily expense of such meals, and told how this huge
+man had already cost the country over a million and a half of _sprugs_
+(the largest Lilliputian gold coin). Things, indeed, were beginning to
+go very ill with Gulliver.
+
+Now it happened about this time that one of the King's courtiers, to
+whom Gulliver had been very kind, came to him by night very privately
+in a closed chair, and asked to have a talk, without any one else
+being present.
+
+Gulliver gave to a servant whom he could trust orders that no one else
+was to be admitted, and having put the courtier and his chair upon the
+table, so that he might better hear all that was said, he sat down to
+listen.
+
+Gulliver was told that there had lately been several secret meetings
+of the King's Privy Council, on his account. The Lord High Admiral
+(who now hated him because of his success against the Blefuscan
+fleet), Flimnap, the High Treasurer, and others of his enemies, had
+drawn up against him charges of treason and other crimes. The courtier
+had brought with him a copy of these charges, and Gulliver now read
+them.
+
+It was made a point against him that, when ordered to do so by the
+King, he had refused to seize all the other Blefuscan ships. It was
+also said that he would not join in utterly crushing the empire of
+Blefuscu, nor give aid when it was proposed to put to death not only
+all the Big endians who had fled for refuge to that country, but all
+the Blefuscans themselves who were friends of the Big-endians. For
+this he was said to be a traitor.
+
+He was also accused of being over-friendly with the Blefuscan
+ambassadors; and it was made a grave charge against him that though
+his Majesty had not given him written leave to visit Blefuscu, he yet
+was getting ready to go to that country, in order to give help to the
+Emperor against Lilliput.
+
+There had been many debates on these charges, said the courtier, and
+the Lord High Admiral had made violent speeches, strongly advising
+that the Great Man Mountain should be put to death. In this he was
+joined by Flimnap, and by others, so that actually the greater part of
+the council was in favor of instant death by the most painful means
+that could be used.
+
+The less unfriendly members of the council, however, while saying that
+they had no doubt of Gulliver's guilt, were yet of the opinion that,
+as his services to the kingdom of Lilliput had been great, the
+punishment of death was too severe. They thought it would be enough if
+his eyes were put out. This, they said, would not prevent him from
+being still made useful.
+
+Then began a most excited argument, the Admiral and those who sided
+with him insisting that Gulliver should be killed at once.
+
+At last the Secretary rose and said that he had a middle course to
+suggest. This was, that Gulliver's eyes should be put out, and that
+thereafter his food should be gradually so reduced in quantity that in
+the course of two or three months he would die of starvation. By which
+time, said the Secretary, his body would be wasted to an extent that
+would make it easy for five or six hundred men, in a few days, to cut
+off the flesh and take it away in cart-loads to be buried at a
+distance. Thus there would be no danger of a pestilence breaking out
+from the dead body lying near the city. The skeleton, he said, could
+then be put in the National Museum.
+
+It was finally decided that this sentence should be carried out, and
+twenty of the King's surgeons were ordered to be present in three
+days' time to see the operation of putting out Gulliver's eyes
+properly done. Sharp-pointed arrows were to be shot into the balls of
+his eyes.
+
+The courtier now left the house, as privately as he had come, and
+Gulliver was left to decide what he should do.
+
+At first he thought of attacking the city, and destroying it. But by
+doing this he must have destroyed, with the city, a great many
+thousands of innocent people, which he could not make up his mind to
+do.
+
+At last he wrote a letter to the Chief Secretary, saying that as the
+King had himself told him that he might visit Blefuscu, he had decided
+to do so that morning.
+
+Without waiting for an answer, he set out for the coast, where he
+seized a large man-of-war which was at anchor there, tied a cable to
+her bow, and then putting his clothes and his blanket on board, he
+drew the ship after him to Blefuscu. There he was well received by the
+Emperor. But as there happened to be no house big enough for him, he
+was forced, during his stay, to sleep each night on the ground,
+wrapped in his blanket.
+
+Three days after his arrival, when walking along the seashore, he
+noticed something in the water which looked not unlike a boat
+floating bottom up. Gulliver waded and swam out, and found that he was
+right. It was a boat. By the help of some of the Blefsucan ships, with
+much difficulty he got it ashore. When the tide had fallen, two
+thousand of the Emperor's dockyard men helped him to turn it over, and
+Gulliver found that but little damage had been done.
+
+He now set to work to make oars and mast and sail for the boat, and to
+fit it out and provision it for a voyage.
+
+While this work was going on, there came from Lilliput a message
+demanding that Gulliver should be bound hand and foot and returned to
+that country as a prisoner, there to be punished as a traitor. To this
+message the Emperor replied that it was not possible to bind him; that
+moreover the Great Man Mountain had found a vessel of size great
+enough to carry him over the sea, and that it was his purpose to leave
+the Empire of Blefuscu in the course of a few weeks.
+
+Gulliver did not delay his work, and in less than a month he was ready
+to sail.
+
+He put on board the boat the carcasses of one hundred oxen and three
+hundred sheep, with a quantity of bread and wine, and as much meat
+ready cooked as four hundred cooks could prepare.
+
+He also took with him a herd of six live black cows and two bulls, and
+a flock of sheep, meaning to take them with him to England, if ever he
+should get there. As food for these animals he took a quantity of hay
+and corn.
+
+Gulliver would have liked to take with him some of the people, but
+this the Emperor would not permit.
+
+Everything being ready, he sailed from Blefuscu on 24th September
+1701, and the same night anchored on the lee side of an island which
+seemed to be uninhabited. Leaving this island on the following
+morning, he sailed to the eastward for two days. On the evening of the
+second day he sighted a ship, on reaching which, to his great joy, he
+found that she was an English vessel on her way home from Japan.
+
+Putting his cattle and sheep in his coat-pockets, he went on board
+with all his cargo of provisions. The captain received him very
+kindly, and asked him from whence he had come, and how he happened to
+be at sea in an open boat.
+
+Gulliver told his tale in as few words as possible. The captain stared
+with wonder, and would not believe his story. But Gulliver then took
+from his pockets the black cattle and the sheep, which of course
+clearly showed that he had been speaking truth. He also showed gold
+coins which the Emperor of Blefuscu had given him, some of which he
+presented to the captain.
+
+The vessel did not arrive at the port of London till April, 1702, but
+there was no loss of the live stock, excepting that the rats on board
+carried off and ate one of the sheep. All the others were got safely
+ashore, and were put to graze on a bowling-green at Greenwich, where
+they throve very well.
+
+
+
+
+THE ARABIAN NIGHTS
+
+ADAPTED BY AMY STEEDMAN
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+ALADDIN AND THE WONDERFUL LAMP
+
+
+Far away on the other side of the world, in one of the great wealthy
+cities of China, there once lived a poor tailor called Mustapha. He
+had a wife whom he loved dearly and an only son whose name was
+Aladdin.
+
+But, sad to say, although the tailor was good and industrious, his son
+was so idle and bad that his father and mother did not know what to do
+with him. All day long he played in the streets with other idle boys,
+and when he grew big enough to learn a trade he said he did not mean
+to work at all. His poor father was very much troubled, and ordered
+Aladdin to come to the workshop to learn to be a tailor, but Aladdin
+only laughed, and ran away so swiftly that neither his father nor
+mother could catch him.
+
+"Alas!" said Mustapha sadly, "I can do nothing with this idle boy."
+
+And he grew so sad about it, that at last he fell ill and died.
+
+Then the poor widow was obliged to sell the little workshop, and try
+to make enough money for herself and Aladdin by spinning.
+
+Now it happened that one day when Aladdin was playing as usual with
+the idle street boys, a tall, dark, old man stood watching him, and
+when the game was finished he made a sign to Aladdin to come to him.
+
+"What is thy name, my boy?" asked this old man, who, though he
+appeared so kind, was really an African Magician.
+
+"My name is Aladdin," answered the boy, wondering who this stranger
+could be.
+
+"And what is thy father's name?" asked the Magician.
+
+"My father was Mustapha the tailor, but he has been dead a long time
+now," answered Aladdin.
+
+"Alas!" cried the wicked old Magician, pretending to weep, "he was my
+brother, and thou must be my nephew. I am thy long-lost uncle!" and he
+threw his arms round Aladdin's neck and embraced him.
+
+"Tell thy dear mother that I will come and see her this very day," he
+cried, "and give her this small present." And he placed in Aladdin's
+hands five gold pieces.
+
+Aladdin ran home in great haste to tell his mother the story of the
+long-lost uncle.
+
+"It must be a mistake," she said, "thou hast no uncle."
+
+But when she saw the gold she began to think that this stranger must
+be a relation, and so she prepared a grand supper to welcome him when
+he came.
+
+They had not long to wait before the African Magician appeared,
+bringing with him all sorts of fruits and delicious sweets for desert.
+
+"Tell me about my poor brother," he said, as he embraced Aladdin and
+his mother. "Show me exactly where he used to sit."
+
+Then the widow pointed to a seat on the sofa, and the Magician knelt
+down and began to kiss the place and weep over it.
+
+The poor widow was quite touched, and began to believe that this
+really must be her husband's brother, especially when he began to show
+the kindest interest in Aladdin.
+
+"What is thy trade?" he asked the boy.
+
+"Alas!" said the widow, "he will do nothing but play in the streets."
+
+Aladdin hung his head with shame as his uncle gravely shook his head.
+
+"He must begin work at once," he said. "How would it please thee to
+have a shop of thy own? I could buy one for thee, and stock it with
+silks and rich stuffs."
+
+Aladdin danced with joy at the very idea, and next day set out with
+his supposed uncle, who bought him a splendid suit of clothes, and
+took him all over the city to show him the sights.
+
+The day after, the Magician again took Aladdin out with him, but this
+time they went outside the city, through beautiful gardens, into the
+open country. They walked so far that Aladdin began to grow weary, but
+the Magician gave him a cake and some delicious fruit and told him
+such wonderful tales that he scarcely noticed how far they had gone.
+At last they came to a deep valley between two mountains, and there
+the Magician paused.
+
+"Stop!" he cried, "this is the very place I am in search of. Gather
+some sticks that we may make a fire."
+
+Aladdin quickly did as he was bid, and had soon gathered together a
+great heap of dry sticks. The Magician then set fire to them, and the
+heap blazed up merrily. With great care the old man now sprinkled some
+curious-looking powder on the flames, and muttered strange words. In
+an instant the earth beneath their feet trembled, and they heard a
+rumbling like distant thunder. Then the ground opened in front of
+them, and showed a great square slab of stone with a ring in it.
+
+By this time Aladdin was so frightened that he turned to run home as
+fast as he could, but the Magician caught him, and gave him such a
+blow that he fell to the earth.
+
+"Why dost thou strike me, uncle?" sobbed Aladdin.
+
+"Do as I bid thee," said the Magician, "and then thou shalt be well
+treated. Dost thou see that stone? Beneath it is a treasure which I
+will share with thee. Only obey me, and it will soon be ours."
+
+As soon as Aladdin heard of a treasure, he jumped up and forgot all
+his fears. He seized the ring as the Magician directed, and easily
+pulled up the stone.
+
+"Now," said the old man, "look in and thou wilt see stone steps
+leading downwards. Thou shalt descend those steps until thou comest to
+three great halls. Pass through them, but take care to wrap thy coat
+well round thee that thou mayest touch nothing, for if thou dost, thou
+wilt die instantly. When thou hast passed through the halls thou wilt
+come into a garden of fruit-trees. Go through it until thou seest a
+niche with a lighted lamp in it. Put the light out, pour forth the
+oil, and bring the lamp to me."
+
+So saying the Magician placed a magic ring upon Aladdin's finger to
+guard him, and bade the boy begin his search.
+
+Aladdin did exactly as he was told and found everything just as the
+Magician had said. He went through the halls and the garden until he
+came to the lamp, and when he had poured out the oil and placed the
+lamp carefully inside his coat he began to look about him.
+
+He had never seen such a lovely garden before, even in his dreams. The
+fruits that hung upon the trees were of every color of the rainbow.
+Some were clear and shining like crystal, some sparkled with a crimson
+light and others were green, blue, violet, and orange, while the
+leaves that shaded them were silver and gold. Aladdin did not guess
+that these fruits were precious stones, diamonds, rubies, emeralds,
+and sapphires, but they looked so pretty that he filled all his
+pockets with them as he passed back through the garden.
+
+The Magician was eagerly peering down the stone steps when Aladdin
+began to climb up.
+
+"Give me the lamp," he cried, stretching his hand for it.
+
+"Wait until I get out," answered Aladdin, "and then I will give it
+thee."
+
+"Hand it up to me at once," screamed the old man angrily.
+
+"Not till I am safely out," repeated Aladdin.
+
+Then the Magician stamped with rage, and rushing to the fire threw on
+it some more of the curious powder, uttered the same strange words as
+before, and instantly the stone slipped back into its place, the earth
+closed over it, and Aladdin was left in darkness.
+
+This showed indeed that the wicked old man was not Aladdin's uncle. By
+his magic arts in Africa he had found out all about the lamp, which
+was a wonderful treasure, as you will see. But he knew that he could
+not get it himself, that another hand must fetch it to him. This was
+the reason why he had fixed upon Aladdin to help him, and had meant,
+as soon as the lamp was safely in his hand, to kill the boy.
+
+As his plan had failed he went back to Africa, and was not seen again
+for a long, long time.
+
+But there was poor Aladdin shut up underground, with no way of
+getting out! He tried to find his way back to the great halls and the
+beautiful garden of shining fruits, but the walls had closed up, and
+there was no escape that way either. For two days the poor boy sat
+crying and moaning in his despair, and just as he had made up his mind
+that he must die, he clasped his hands together, and in doing so
+rubbed the ring which the Magician had put upon his finger.
+
+In an instant a huge figure rose out of the earth and stood before
+him.
+
+"What is thy will, my master?" it said. "I am the Slave of the Ring,
+and must obey him who wears the ring."
+
+"Whoever or whatever you are," cried Aladdin, "take me out of this
+dreadful place."
+
+Scarcely had he said these words when the earth opened, and the next
+moment Aladdin found himself lying at his mother's door. He was so
+weak for want of food, and his joy at seeing his mother was so great,
+that he fainted away, but when he came to himself he promised to tell
+her all that had happened.
+
+"But first give me something to eat," he cried, "for I am dying of
+hunger."
+
+"Alas!" said his mother, "I have nothing in the house except a little
+cotton, which I will go out and sell."
+
+"Stop a moment," cried Aladdin, "rather let us sell this old lamp
+which I have brought back with me."
+
+Now the lamp looked so old and dirty that Aladdin's mother began to
+rub it, wishing to brighten it a little that it might fetch a higher
+price.
+
+But no sooner had she given it the first rub than a huge dark figure
+slowly rose from the floor like a wreath of smoke until it reached the
+ceiling, towering above them.
+
+"What is thy will?" it asked. "I am the Slave of the Lamp, and must do
+the bidding of him who holds the Lamp."
+
+The moment the figure began to rise from the ground Aladdin's mother
+was so terrified that she fainted away, but Aladdin managed to snatch
+the lamp from her, although he could scarcely hold it in his own
+shaking hand.
+
+"Fetch me something to eat," he said in a trembling voice, for the
+terrible Genie was glaring down upon him.
+
+The Slave of the Lamp disappeared in a cloud of smoke, but in an
+instant he was back again, bringing with him a most delicious
+breakfast, served upon plates and dishes of pure gold.
+
+By this time Aladdin's mother had recovered, but she was almost too
+frightened to eat, and begged Aladdin to sell the lamp at once, for
+she was sure it had something to do with evil spirits. But Aladdin
+only laughed at her fears, and said he meant to make use of the magic
+lamp and wonderful ring, now that he knew their worth.
+
+As soon as they again wanted money they sold the golden plates and
+dishes, and when these were all gone Aladdin ordered the Genie to
+bring more, and so they lived in comfort for several years.
+
+Now Aladdin had heard a great deal about the beauty of the Sultan's
+daughter, and he began to long so greatly to see her that he could not
+rest. He thought of a great many plans, but they all seemed
+impossible, for the Princess never went out without a veil, which
+covered her entirely. At last, however, he managed to enter the palace
+and hide himself behind a door, peeping through a chink when the
+Princess passed to go to her bath.
+
+The moment Aladdin's eyes rested upon the beautiful Princess he loved
+her with all his heart, for she was as fair as the dawn of a summer
+morning.
+
+"Mother," he cried when he reached home, "I have seen the Princess,
+and I have made up my mind to marry her. Thou shalt go at once to the
+Sultan, and beg him to give me his daughter."
+
+Aladdin's mother stared at her son, and then began to laugh at such a
+wild idea. She was almost afraid that Aladdin must be mad, but he gave
+her no peace until she did as he wished.
+
+So the next day she very unwillingly set out for the palace, carrying
+the magic fruit wrapped up in a napkin, to present to the Sultan.
+There were many other people offering their petitions that day, and
+the poor woman was so frightened that she dared not go forward, and so
+no one paid any attention to her as she stood there patiently holding
+her bundle. For a whole week she had gone every day to the palace,
+before the Sultan noticed her.
+
+"Who is that poor woman who comes every day carrying a white bundle?"
+he asked.
+
+Then the Grand Vizier ordered that she should be brought forward, and
+she came bowing herself to the ground.
+
+She was almost too terrified to speak, but when the Sultan spoke so
+kindly to her she took courage, and told him of Aladdin's love for the
+Princess, and of his bold request, "He sends you this gift," she
+continued, and opening the bundle she presented the magic fruit.
+
+A cry of wonder went up from all those who stood around, for never had
+they beheld such exquisite jewels before. They shone and sparkled with
+a thousand lights and colors, and dazzled the eyes that gazed upon
+them.
+
+The Sultan was astounded, and spoke to the Grand Vizier apart.
+
+"Surely it is fit that I should give my daughter to one who can
+present such a wondrous gift?" he said....
+
+Now when three months were ended, Aladdin's mother again presented
+herself before the Sultan, and reminded him of his promise, that the
+Princess should wed her son.
+
+"I ever abide by my royal word," said the Sultan; "but he who marries
+my daughter must first send me forty golden basins filled to the brim
+with precious stones. These basins must be carried by forty black
+slaves, each led by a white slave dressed as befits the servants of
+the Sultan."
+
+Aladdin's mother returned home in great distress when she heard this,
+and told Aladdin what the Sultan had said.
+
+"Alas, my son!" she cried, "thy hopes are ended."
+
+"Not so, mother," answered Aladdin. "The Sultan shall not have long to
+wait for his answer."
+
+Then he rubbed the magic lamp, and when the Genie appeared, he bade
+him provide the forty golden basins filled with jewels, and all the
+slaves which the Sultan had demanded.
+
+Now when this splendid procession passed through the streets on its
+way to the palace, all the people came out to see the sight, and stood
+amazed when they saw the golden basins filled with sparkling gems
+carried on the heads of the great black slaves. And when the palace
+was reached, and the slaves presented the jewels to the Sultan, he
+was so surprised and delighted that he was more than willing that
+Aladdin should marry the Princess at once.
+
+"Go, fetch thy son," he said to Aladdin's mother, who was waiting
+near. "Tell him that this day he shall wed my daughter."
+
+But when Aladdin heard the news he refused to hasten at once to the
+palace, as his mother advised. First he called the Genie, and told him
+to bring a scented bath, and a robe worked in gold, such as a King
+might wear. After this he called for forty slaves to attend him, and
+six to walk before his mother, and a horse more beautiful than the
+Sultan's, and lastly, for ten thousand pieces of gold put up in ten
+purses.
+
+When all these things were ready, and Aladdin was dressed in his royal
+robe, he set out for the palace. As he rode along on his beautiful
+horse, attended by his forty slaves, he scattered the golden pieces
+out of the ten purses among the crowd, and all the people shouted with
+joy and delight. No one knew that this was the idle boy who used to
+play about the streets but they thought he was some great foreign
+Prince.
+
+Thus Aladdin arrived at the palace in great state, and when the Sultan
+had embraced him, he ordered that the wedding feast should be prepared
+at once, and that the marriage should take place that day.
+
+"Not so, your Majesty," said Aladdin; "I will not marry the Princess
+until I have built a palace fit for the daughter of the Sultan."
+
+Then he returned home, and once more called up the Slave of the Lamp.
+
+"Build me the fairest palace ever beheld by mortal eye," ordered
+Aladdin. "Let it be built of marble and jasper and precious stones. In
+the midst I would have a great hall, whose walls shall be of gold and
+silver, lighted by four-and-twenty windows. These windows shall all be
+set with diamonds, rubies, and other precious stones, and one only
+shall be left unfinished. There must also be stables with horses, and
+slaves to serve in the palace. Begone, and do thy work quickly."
+
+And lo! in the morning when Aladdin looked out, there stood the most
+wonderful palace that ever was built. Its marble walls were flushed a
+delicate pink in the morning light, and the jewels flashed from every
+window.
+
+Then Aladdin and his mother set off for the Sultan's palace, and the
+wedding took place that day. The Princess loved Aladdin as soon as she
+saw him, and great were the rejoicings throughout the city.
+
+The next day Aladdin invited the Sultan to visit the new palace, and
+when he entered the great hall, whose walls were of gold and silver
+and whose windows were set with jewels, he was filled with admiration
+and astonishment.
+
+"It is the wonder of the world," he cried. "Never before have mortal
+eyes beheld such a beautiful palace. One thing alone surprises me. Why
+is there one window left unfinished?"
+
+"Your Majesty," answered Aladdin, "this has been done with a purpose,
+for I wished that thine own royal hand should have the honor of
+putting the finishing touch to my palace."
+
+The Sultan was so pleased when he heard this, that he sent at once for
+all the court jewelers and ordered them to finish the window like the
+rest.
+
+The court jewelers worked for many days, and then sent to tell the
+Sultan that they had used up all the jewels they possessed, and still
+the window was not half finished. The Sultan commanded that his own
+jewels should be given to complete the work; even when these were used
+the window was not finished.
+
+Then Aladdin ordered the jewelers to stop their work, and to take back
+all the Sultan's jewels as well as their own. And that night he called
+up the Slave of the Lamp once more, and bade him finish the window.
+This was done before the morning, and great was the surprise of the
+Sultan and all his workmen.
+
+Now Aladdin did not grow proud of his great riches but was gentle and
+courteous to all, and kind to the poor, so that the people all loved
+him dearly. He fought and won many battles for the Sultan, and was the
+greatest favorite in the land.
+
+But far away in Africa there was trouble brewing for Aladdin. The
+wicked old Magician who had pretended to be Aladdin's uncle found out
+by his magic powers that the boy had not perished when he left him
+underground, but had somehow managed to escape and become rich and
+powerful.
+
+"He must have discovered the secret of the lamp," shrieked the
+Magician, tearing his hair with rage. "I will not rest day or night
+until I shall have found some way of taking it from him."
+
+So he journeyed from Africa to China, and when he came to the city
+where Aladdin lived and saw the wonderful palace, he nearly choked
+with fury to see all its splendor and richness. Then he disguised
+himself as a merchant, and bought a number of copper lamps, and with
+these went from street to street, crying, "New lamps for old."
+
+As soon as the people heard his cry, they crowded round him, laughing
+and jeering, for they thought he must be mad to make such an offer.
+
+Now it happened that Aladdin was out hunting, and the Princess sat
+alone in the hall of the jeweled windows. When, therefore, she heard
+the noise that was going on in the street outside, she called to her
+slaves to ask what it meant.
+
+Presently one of the slaves came back, laughing so much that she could
+hardly speak.
+
+"It is a curious old man who offers to give new lamps for old," she
+cried. "Did any one ever hear before of such a strange way of
+trading?"
+
+The Princess laughed too, and pointed to an old lamp which hung in a
+niche close by.
+
+"There is an old enough lamp," she said. "Take it and see if the old
+man will really give a new one for it."
+
+The slave took it down and ran out to the street once more, and when
+the Magician saw that it was indeed what he wanted, he seized the
+Magic Lamp with both his hands.
+
+"Choose any lamp you like," he said, showing her those of bright new
+copper. He did not care now what happened. She might have all the new
+lamps if she wanted them.
+
+Then he went a little way outside the city, and when he was quite
+alone he took out the Magic Lamp and rubbed it gently. Immediately the
+Genie stood before him and asked what was his will.
+
+"I order thee to carry off the palace of Aladdin, with the Princess
+inside, and set it down in a lonely spot in Africa."
+
+And in an instant the palace, with every one in it, had disappeared,
+and when the Sultan happened to look out of his window, lo! there was
+no longer a palace to be seen.
+
+"This must be enchantment," he cried.
+
+Then he ordered his men to set out and bring Aladdin to him in chains.
+
+The officers met Aladdin as he was returning from the hunt, and they
+immediately seized him, loaded him with chains, and carried him off to
+the Sultan. But as he was borne along, the people gathered around him,
+for they loved him dearly, and vowed that no harm should befall him.
+
+The Sultan was beside himself with rage when he saw Aladdin, and gave
+orders that his head should be cut off at once. But the people had
+begun to crowd into the palace, and they were so fierce and
+threatening that he dared not do as he wished. He was obliged to order
+the chains to be taken off, and Aladdin to be set free.
+
+As soon as Aladdin was allowed to speak he asked why all this was done
+to him.
+
+"Wretch!" exclaimed the Sultan, "come hither, and I will show thee."
+
+Then he led Aladdin to the window and showed him the empty space where
+his palace had once stood.
+
+"Think not that I care for thy vanished palace," he said. "But where
+is the Princess, my daughter?"
+
+So astonished was Aladdin that for some time he could only stand
+speechless, staring at the place where his palace ought to have been.
+
+At last he turned to the Sultan.
+
+"Your Majesty," he said, "grant me grace for one month, and if by that
+time I have not brought back thy daughter to thee, then put me to
+death as I deserve."
+
+So Aladdin was set free, and for three days he went about like a
+madman, asking every one he met where his palace was. But no one could
+tell him, and all laughed at his misery. Then he went to the river to
+drown himself; but as he knelt on the bank and clasped his hands to
+say his prayers before throwing himself in, he once more rubbed the
+Magic Ring. Instantly the Genie of the Ring stood before him.
+
+"What is thy will, O master?" it asked.
+
+"Bring back my Princess and my palace," cried Aladdin, "and save my
+life."
+
+"That I cannot do," said the Slave of the Ring. "Only the Slave of the
+Lamp has power to bring back thy palace."
+
+"Then take me to the place where my palace now stands," said Aladdin,
+"and put me down beneath the window of the Princess."
+
+And almost before Aladdin had done speaking he found himself in
+Africa, beneath the windows of his own palace.
+
+He was so weary that he lay down and fell fast asleep; but before
+long, when day dawned, he was awakened by the song of the birds, and
+as he looked around his courage returned. He was now sure that all his
+misfortunes must have been caused by the loss of the Magic Lamp, and
+he determined to find out as soon as possible who had stolen it.
+
+That same morning the Princess awoke feeling happier than she had felt
+since she had been carried off. The sun was shining so brightly, and
+the birds were singing so gaily, that she went to the window to greet
+the opening day. And who should she see standing beneath her window
+but Aladdin!
+
+With a cry of joy she threw open the casement and the sound made
+Aladdin look up. It was not long before he made his way through a
+secret door and held her in his arms.
+
+"Tell me, Princess," said Aladdin, when they had joyfully embraced
+each other many times, "what has become of the old lamp which hung in
+a niche of the great hall?"
+
+"Alas! my husband," answered the Princess, "I fear my carelessness has
+been the cause of all our misfortunes."
+
+Then she told him how the wicked old Magician had pretended to be a
+merchant, and had offered new lamps for old, and how he had thus
+managed to secure the Magic Lamp.
+
+"He has it still," she added, "for I know that he carries it always,
+hidden in his robe."
+
+"Princess," said Aladdin, "I must recover this lamp, and thou shalt
+help me. To-night when the Magician dines with thee, dress thyself in
+thy costliest robes, and be kind and gracious to him. Then bid him
+fetch some of the wines of Africa, and when he is gone, I will tell
+thee what thou shalt do."
+
+So that night the Princess put on her most beautiful robes, and looked
+so lovely and was so kind when the Magician came in, that he could
+scarcely believe his eyes. For she had been sad and angry ever since
+he had carried her off.
+
+"I believe now that Aladdin must be dead," she said, "and I have made
+up my mind to mourn no longer. Let us begin our feast. But see! I grow
+weary of these wines of China, fetch me instead the wine of thy own
+country."
+
+Now Aladdin had meanwhile prepared a powder which he directed the
+Princess to place in her own wine-cup. So when the Magician returned
+with the African wine, she filled her cup and offered it to him in
+token of friendship. The Magician drank it up eagerly, and scarcely
+had he finished when he dropped down dead.
+
+Then Aladdin came out of the next chamber where he had hidden himself,
+and searched in the Magician's robe until he found the Magic Lamp. He
+rubbed it joyfully, and when the Genie appeared, ordered that the
+palace should be carried back to China, and set down in its own place.
+
+The following morning, when the Sultan rose early, for he was too sad
+to take much rest, he went to the window to gaze on the place where
+Aladdin's palace had once stood. He rubbed his eyes, and stared wildly
+about.
+
+"This must be a dream," he cried, for there stood the palace in all
+its beauty, looking fairer than ever in the morning light.
+
+Not a moment did the Sultan lose, but he rode over to the palace at
+once, and when he had embraced Aladdin and his daughter, they told him
+the whole story of the African Magician. Then Aladdin showed him the
+dead body of the wicked old man, and there was peace between them once
+more.
+
+But there was still trouble in store for Aladdin. The African Magician
+had a younger brother who also dealt in magic, and who was if possible
+even more wicked than his elder brother.
+
+Full of revenge, this younger brother started for China, determined
+to punish Aladdin and steal the Magic Lamp for himself. As soon as he
+arrived he went in secret to the cell of a holy woman called Fatima,
+and obliged her to give him her robe and veil as a disguise. Then to
+keep the secret safe he killed the poor woman.
+
+Dressed in the robe and veil, the wicked Magician walked through the
+streets near Aladdin's palace, and all the people as he passed by
+knelt and kissed his robe, for they thought he was indeed the holy
+woman.
+
+As soon as the Princess heard that Fatima was passing by in the
+street, she sent and commanded her to be brought into the hall, and
+she treated the supposed holy woman with great respect and kindness,
+for she had often longed to see her.
+
+"Is not this a fine hall?" she asked, as they sat together in the hall
+of the jeweled windows.
+
+"It is indeed most beautiful," answered the Magician, who kept his
+veil carefully down, "but to my mind there is one thing wanting. If
+only thou couldst have a roc's egg hung in the dome it would be
+perfect."
+
+As soon as the Princess heard these words she became discontented and
+miserable, and when Aladdin came in, she looked so sad that he at once
+asked what was the matter.
+
+"I can never be happy until I have a roc's egg hanging from the dome
+of the great hall," she answered.
+
+"In that case thou shalt soon be happy," said Aladdin gaily, and
+taking down the lamp, he summoned the Genie.
+
+But when the Slave of the Lamp heard the order his face grew terrible
+with rage, and his eyes gleamed like burning coals.
+
+"Vile wretch!" he shrieked, "have I not given thee all thy wishes, and
+now dost thou ask me to kill my master, and hang him as an ornament in
+thy palace? Thou deservest truly to die; but I know that the request
+cometh not from thine own heart, but was the suggestion of that wicked
+Magician who pretends to be a holy woman."
+
+With these words the Genie vanished, and. Aladdin went at once to the
+room where the Princess was awaiting him.
+
+"I have a headache," he said. "Call the holy woman, that she may place
+her hand upon my forehead and ease the pain."
+
+But the moment that the false Fatima appeared Aladdin sprang up and
+plunged his dagger into that evil heart.
+
+"What hast thou done?" cried the Princess. "Alas! thou hast slain the
+holy woman."
+
+"This is no holy woman," answered Aladdin, "but an evil Magician whose
+purpose was to destroy us both."
+
+So Aladdin was saved from the wicked design of the two Magicians, and
+there was no one left to disturb his peace. He and the Princess lived
+together in great happiness for many years, and when the Sultan died
+they succeeded to the throne, and ruled both wisely and well. And so
+there was great peace throughout the land.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+THE ENCHANTED HORSE
+
+
+It was New Year's day in Persia, the most splendid feast-day of all
+the year, and the King had been entertained, hour after hour, by the
+wonderful shows prepared for him by his people. Evening was drawing on
+and the court was just about to retire, when an Indian appeared,
+leading a horse which he wished to show to the King. It was not a real
+horse, but it was so wonderfully made that it looked exactly as if it
+were alive.
+
+"Your Majesty," cried the Indian, as he bowed himself to the ground,
+"I beg thou wilt look upon this wonder. Nothing thou hast seen to-day
+can equal this horse of mine. I have only to mount upon its back and
+wish myself in any part of the world, and it carries me there in a few
+minutes." Now the King of Persia was very fond of curious and clever
+things, so he looked at the horse with great interest.
+
+"It seems only a common horse," he said, "but thou shalt show us what
+it can do."
+
+Then he pointed to a distant mountain, and bade the Indian to fetch a
+branch from the palm-trees which grew near its foot.
+
+The Indian vaulted into the saddle, turned a little peg in the horse's
+neck, and in a moment was flying so swiftly through the air that he
+soon disappeared from sight. In less than a quarter of an hour he
+reappeared, and laid the palm-branch at the King's feet.
+
+"Thou art right," cried the King; "thy enchanted horse is the most
+wonderful thing I have yet seen. What is its price? I must have it for
+my own."
+
+The Indian shook his head.
+
+"Your Majesty," he said, "this horse can never be sold for money, but
+can only be exchanged for something of equal value. It shall be thine
+only if thou wilt give me instead the Princess, your daughter, for my
+wife."
+
+At these words the King's son sprang to his feet.
+
+"Sire," he cried, "thou wilt never dream of granting such a request."
+
+"My son," answered the King, "at whatever cost I must have this
+wonderful horse. But before I agree to the exchange, I would wish thee
+to try the horse, and tell me what thou thinkest of it."
+
+The Indian, who stood listening to what they said, was quite willing
+that the Prince should try the Enchanted Horse, and began to give him
+directions how to guide it. But as soon as the Prince was in the
+saddle and saw the peg which made the horse start, he never waited to
+hear more. He turned the screw at once, and went flying off through
+the air.
+
+"Alas!" cried the Indian, "he has gone off without learning how to
+come back. Never will he be able to stop the horse unless he finds the
+second peg."
+
+The King was terribly frightened when he heard the Indian's words,
+for, by this time, the Prince had disappeared from sight.
+
+"Wretch," he cried, "thou shalt be cast into prison, and unless my son
+returns in safety, thou shalt be put to death."
+
+Meanwhile the Prince had gone gaily sailing up into the air until he
+reached the clouds, and could no longer see the earth below. This was
+very pleasant, and he felt that he had never had such a delicious ride
+in his life before. But presently he began to think it was time to
+descend. He screwed the peg round and round, backwards and forwards,
+but it seemed to make no difference. Instead of coming down he sailed
+higher and higher, until he thought he was going to knock his head
+against the blue sky.
+
+What was to be done? The Prince began to grow a little nervous, and he
+felt over the horse's neck to see if there was another peg to be found
+anywhere. To his joy, just behind the ear. He touched a small screw,
+and when he turned it, he felt he was going slower and slower, and
+gently turning round. Then he shouted with joy as the Enchanted Horse
+flew downwards through the starry night, and he saw, stretched out
+before him, a beautiful city gleaming white through the purple mantle
+of the night.
+
+Everything was strange to him, and he did not know in what direction
+to guide the horse, so he let it go where it would, and presently it
+stopped on the roof of a great marble palace. There was a gallery
+running round the roof, and at the end of the gallery there was a door
+leading down some white marble steps.
+
+The Prince began at once to descend the steps, and found himself in a
+great hall where a row of black slaves were sleeping soundly, guarding
+the entrance to a room beyond.
+
+Very softly the Prince crept past the guards, and lifting the curtain
+from the door, looked in.
+
+And there he saw a splendid room lighted by a thousand lights and
+filled with sleeping slaves, and in the middle, upon a sofa, was the
+most beautiful Princess his eyes had ever gazed upon.
+
+She was so lovely that the Prince held his breath with admiration as
+he looked at her. Then he went softly to her side, and, kneeling by
+the sofa, gently touched her hand. The Princess sighed and opened her
+eyes, but before she could cry out, he begged her in a whisper to be
+silent and fear nothing.
+
+"I am a Prince," he said, "the son of the King of Persia. I am in
+danger of my life here, and crave thy protection."
+
+Now this Princess was no other than the daughter of the King of
+Bengal, who happened to be staying alone in her summer palace outside
+the city.
+
+"I will protect thee," said the Princess kindly, giving him her hand.
+Then she awoke her slaves and bade them give the stranger food and
+prepare a sleeping-room for him.
+
+"I long to hear thy adventures and how thou camest here," she said to
+the Prince, "but first thou must rest and refresh thyself."
+
+Never before had the Princess seen any one so gallant and handsome as
+this strange young Prince. She dressed herself in her loveliest robes,
+and twined her hair with her most precious jewels, that she might
+appear as beautiful as possible in his eyes. And when the Prince saw
+her again, he thought her the most charming Princess in all the world,
+and he loved her with all his heart. But when he had told her all his
+adventures she sighed to think that he must now leave her and return
+to his father's court.
+
+"Do not grieve," he said, "I will return in state as befits a Prince,
+and demand thy hand in marriage from the King thy father."
+
+"Stay but a few days ere thou goest," replied the Princess. "I cannot
+part with thee so soon."
+
+The Prince was only too willing to wait a while, and the Princess
+entertained him so well with feasts and hunting-parties that day after
+day slipped by, and still he lingered.
+
+At last, however, the thought of his home and his father's grief made
+him decide to return at once.
+
+"My Princess," he said, "since it is so hard to part, wilt thou not
+ride with me upon the Enchanted Horse? When we are once more in Persia
+our marriage shall take place, and then we will return to the King thy
+father."
+
+So together they mounted the Enchanted Horse and the Prince placed his
+arm around the Princess and turned the magic peg. Up and up they flew
+over land and sea, and then the Prince turned the other screw, and
+they landed just outside his father's city. He guided the horse to a
+palace outside the gates, and there he left the Princess, for he
+wished to go alone to prepare his father.
+
+Now when the Prince reached the court he found every one dressed in
+brown, and all the bells of the city were tolling mournfully.
+
+"Why is every one so sad?" he asked of one of the guards.
+
+"The Prince, the Prince!" cried the man. "The Prince has come back."
+
+And soon the joyful news spread over the town, and the bells stopped
+tolling and rang a joyful peal.
+
+"My beloved son!" cried the King, as he embraced him. "We thought thou
+wert lost for ever, and we have mourned for thee day and night."
+
+Without waiting to hear more, the Prince began to tell the King all
+his adventures, and how the Princess of Bengal awaited him in the
+palace outside the gates.
+
+"Let her be brought here instantly," cried the King, "and the marriage
+shall take place to-day."
+
+Then he ordered that the Indian should be set free at once and allowed
+to depart with the Enchanted Horse.
+
+Great was the surprise of the Indian when, instead of having his head
+cut off as he had expected, he was allowed to go free with his
+wonderful horse. He asked what adventures had befallen the Prince, and
+when he heard of the Princess who was waiting in the palace outside
+the gates, a wicked plan came into his head.
+
+He took the Enchanted Horse, and went straight to the palace before
+the King's messengers could reach it.
+
+"Tell the Princess," he said to the slaves, "that the Prince of Persia
+has sent me to bring her to his father's palace upon the Enchanted
+Horse."
+
+The Princess was very glad when she heard this message, and she
+quickly made herself ready to go with the messenger.
+
+But alas! as soon as the Indian turned the peg and the horse flew
+through the air, she found she was being carried off, far away from
+Persia and her beloved Prince.
+
+All her prayers and entreaties were in vain. The Indian only mocked at
+her, and told her he meant to marry her himself.
+
+Meanwhile the Prince and his attendants had arrived at the palace
+outside the gates, only to find that the Indian had been there before
+them and had carried off the Princess.
+
+The Prince was nearly beside himself with grief, but he still hoped
+to find his bride. He disguised himself as a dervish and set off to
+seek for her, vowing that he would find her, or perish in the attempt.
+
+By this time the Enchanted Horse had traveled many hundreds of miles.
+Then, as the Indian was hungry, it was made to descend into a wood
+close to a town of Cashmere.
+
+Here the Indian went in search of food, and when he returned with some
+fruit he shared it with the Princess, who was faint and weary.
+
+As soon as the Princess had eaten a little she felt stronger and
+braver, and as she heard horses galloping past, she called out loudly
+for help.
+
+The men on horseback came riding at once to her aid, and she quickly
+told them who she was, and how the Indian had carried her off against
+her will. Then the leader of the horsemen, who was the Sultan of
+Cashmere, ordered his men to cut off the Indian's head. But he placed
+the Princess upon his horse and led her to his palace.
+
+Now the Princess thought that her troubles were all at an end, but she
+was much mistaken. The Sultan had no sooner seen her than he made up
+his mind to marry her, and he ordered the wedding preparations to be
+begun without loss of time.
+
+In vain the Princess begged to be sent back to Persia. The Sultan only
+smiled and fixed the wedding-day. Then when she saw that nothing would
+turn him from his purpose, she thought of a plan to save herself. She
+began talking all the nonsense she could think of and behaving as if
+she were mad, and so well did she pretend, that the wedding was put
+off, and all the doctors were called in to see if they could cure her.
+
+But whenever a doctor came near the Princess she became so wild and
+violent that he dared not even feel her pulse, so none of them
+discovered that she was only pretending.
+
+The Sultan was in great distress, and sent far and near for the
+cleverest doctors. But none of them seemed to be able to cure the
+Princess of her madness.
+
+All this time the Prince of Persia was wandering about in search of
+his Princess, and when he came to one of the great cities of India, he
+heard every one talking about the sad illness of the Princess of
+Bengal who was to have married the Sultan. He at once disguised
+himself as a doctor and went to the palace, saying he had come to cure
+the Princess.
+
+The Sultan received the new doctor with joy, and led him at once to
+the room where the Princess sat alone, weeping and wringing her hands.
+
+"Your Majesty," said the disguised Prince, "no one else must enter the
+room with me, or the cure will fail."
+
+So the Sultan left him, and the Prince went close to the Princess, and
+gently touched her hand.
+
+"My beloved Princess," he said, "dost thou not know me?"
+
+As soon as the Princess heard that dear voice she threw herself into
+the Prince's arms, and her joy was so great that she could not speak.
+
+"We must at once plan our escape," said the Prince. "Canst thou tell
+me what has become of the Enchanted Horse?"
+
+"Naught can I tell thee of it, dear Prince," answered the Princess,
+"but since the Sultan knows its value, no doubt he has kept it in some
+safe place."
+
+"Then first we must persuade the Sultan that thou art almost cured,"
+said the Prince. "Put on thy costliest robes and dine with him
+to-night, and I will do the rest."
+
+The Sultan was charmed to find the Princess so much better, and his
+joy knew no bounds when the new doctor told him that he hoped by the
+next day to complete the cure.
+
+"I find that the Princess has somehow been infected by the magic of
+the Enchanted Horse," he said. "If thou wilt have the horse brought
+out into the great square, and place the Princess upon its back, I
+will prepare some magic perfumes which will dispel the enchantment.
+Let all the people be gathered together to see the sight, and let the
+Princess be arrayed in her richest dress and decked with all her
+jewels."
+
+So next morning the Enchanted Horse was brought out into the crowded
+square, and the Princess was mounted upon its back. Then the disguised
+Prince placed four braziers of burning coals round the horse and threw
+into them a perfume of a most delicious scent. The smoke of the
+perfume rose in thick clouds, almost hiding the Princess, and at that
+moment the Prince leaped into the saddle behind her, turned the peg,
+and sailed away into the blue sky.
+
+But as he swept past the Sultan, he cried aloud, "Sultan of Cashmere,
+next time thou dost wish to wed a Princess, ask her first if she be
+willing to wed thee."
+
+So this was the manner in which the Prince of Persia carried off the
+Princess of Bengal for the second time. The Enchanted Horse never
+stopped until it had carried them safely back to Persia, and there
+they were married amid great rejoicings.
+
+But what became of the Enchanted Horse? Ah! that is a question which
+no one can answer.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+SINDBAD THE SAILOR
+
+
+In the city of Bagdad, far away in Persia, there lived a poor man
+called Hindbad. He was a porter, and one hot afternoon, as he was
+carrying a very heavy load, he stopped to rest in a quiet street near
+a beautiful house which he had never seen before. The pavement outside
+was sprinkled with rose-water, which felt very cool and pleasant to
+his hot, weary feet, and from the open windows came the most delicious
+scents which perfumed all the air.
+
+Hindbad wondered who lived in this beautiful house, and presently he
+went up to one of the splendidly dressed servants, who was standing at
+the door, and asked to whom it belonged. The servant stared in
+amazement.
+
+"Dost thou indeed live in Bagdad and knowest not my master's name?" he
+said. "He is the great Sindbad the Sailor, the man who has sailed all
+round the world, and who has had the most wonderful adventures under
+the sun."
+
+Now Hindbad had often heard of this wonderful man and of his great
+riches, and as he looked at the beautiful palace and saw the
+splendidly dressed servants it made him feel sad and envious. As he
+turned away sighing, to take up his load again, he looked up into the
+blue sky, and said aloud:
+
+"What a difference there is between this man's lot and mine. He has
+all that he wants, and nothing to do but to spend money and enjoy a
+pleasant life, while I have to work hard to get dry bread enough to
+keep myself and my children alive. What has he done that he should be
+so lucky, and what have I done that I should be so miserable?"
+
+Just then one of the servants touched him on the shoulder, and said to
+him: "My noble master wishes to see thee, and has bidden me fetch thee
+to him."
+
+The poor porter was frightened at first, for he thought some one might
+have overheard what he had been saying, but the servant took his arm
+and led him into the great dining-hall. There were many guests seated
+round the table, on which was spread a most delicious feast, and at
+the head of the table sat a grave, stately old man with a long white
+beard. This was Sindbad the Sailor. He smiled kindly on poor
+frightened Hindbad, and made a sign that he should come and sit at his
+right hand. Then all the most delicious things on the table were
+offered by the servants to Hindbad, and his glass was filled with the
+choicest wine, so that he began to feel it must all be a dream.
+
+But when the feast was over Sindbad turned to him and asked him what
+it was he had been saying outside the window just before he came in.
+
+Then Hindbad was very much ashamed, and hung his head as he answered:
+"My lord, I was tired and ill-tempered, and I said foolish words,
+which I trust thou wilt now pardon."
+
+"Oh," replied Sindbad, "I am not so unjust as to blame thee. I am
+indeed only sorry for thee. But thou wert wrong in thinking that I
+have always led an easy life, and that these riches came to me without
+trouble or suffering. I have won them by years of toil and danger."
+
+Then turning to his other guests he said, "Yes, my friends, the tale
+of my adventures is enough to warn every one of you never to go in
+search of wealth. I have never told you the story of my voyages, but
+if you will listen I will begin this very night."
+
+So the servants were ordered to carry home the porter's load, that he
+might stay in Sindbad's palace that evening and listen to the story.
+
+"My father left me a great deal of money when I was a young man, but I
+spent it so quickly and foolishly that I began to see it would soon
+all be gone. This made me stop and think, for I did not like the idea
+of being poor. So I counted up all the money that remained, and made
+up my mind that I would trade with it. I joined a company of
+merchants, and we set sail in a good ship, meaning to go from place to
+place, and sell or exchange our goods at whatever towns we stopped.
+And so began my first voyage.
+
+"For the first few days I could think of nothing but the heaving of
+the waves; but by and by I began to feel better, and never again was I
+at all unhappy upon the sea. One afternoon, when the wind had suddenly
+dropped and we were lying becalmed, we found ourselves near a little
+low green island, which looked like a meadow, and only just showed
+above the sea. The captain of the ship gave us permission to land, and
+presently we were all enjoying ourselves on the green meadow. We
+walked about for some time and then sat down to rest, and some of us
+set to work to light a fire, that we might make our evening meal.
+
+"But scarcely had the fire begun to burn, when we heard loud shouts
+from the ship warning us to come back at once, for what we had taken
+to be an island was indeed the back of a sleeping whale. My companions
+all rushed to the boats, but before I could follow them the great
+monster dived down and disappeared, leaving me struggling in the
+water.
+
+"I clung to a piece of wood which we had brought from the ship to make
+the fire, and I could only hope that I would soon be picked up by my
+companions. But alas! there was so much confusion on board that no one
+missed me, and as a wind sprang up the captain set sail, and I was
+left alone at the mercy of the waves.
+
+"All night long I floated, and when morning came I was so tired and
+weak that I thought I must die. But just then a great wave lifted me
+up and threw me against the steep side of an island, and to my joy I
+managed to climb the cliff and rest on the green grass above.
+
+"Soon I began to feel better, and as I was very hungry I went to look
+for something to eat. I found some plants which tasted good, and a
+spring of clear water, and having made a good meal, I walked about the
+island to see what I would find next.
+
+"Before long I came to a great meadow where a horse was tied, and as I
+stood looking at it, I heard men's voices which sounded as if they
+came from under the earth. Then from an underground cave a man
+appeared, who asked me who I was and where I came from. He took me
+into the cave where his companions were, and they told me they were
+the grooms belonging to the King of the island, whose horses they
+brought to feed in the meadow. They gave me a good meal, and told me
+it was very lucky that I had come just then, for next day, they meant
+to return to their master, and would show me the way, which I could
+never have found for myself.
+
+"So we set off together early next morning, and when we reached the
+city I was very kindly received by the King. He listened to the story
+of my adventures, and then bade his servants see that I wanted for
+nothing.
+
+"As I was a merchant I took great interest in the shipping, and often
+went down to the quay to see the boats unload. One day when I was
+looking over a cargo which had just been landed, what was my
+astonishment to see a number of bales with my own name marked on them.
+I went at once to the captain and asked him who was the owner of these
+bales of goods.
+
+"'Ah!' replied the captain, 'they belonged to a merchant of Bagdad
+called Sindbad. But he, alas! perished in a dreadful way soon after we
+sailed, for with a number of people belonging to my ship he landed on
+what looked like a green island, but which was really the back of a
+great sleeping whale. As soon as the monster felt the warmth of the
+fire which they had lighted on his back, he woke up and dived below
+the sea. Many of my men were drowned, and among them poor Sindbad. Now
+I mean to sell his goods that I may give the money to his relations
+when I find them.'
+
+"'Captain,' said I, 'these bales are mine, for I am that Sindbad who
+thou sayest was drowned.'
+
+"'What wickedness there is in the world,' cried the captain. 'How
+canst thou pretend to be Sindbad when I saw him drowned before my
+eyes?'
+
+"But presently, when I had told him all that had happened to me, and
+when the other merchants from the ship knew me to be the true Sindbad,
+he was overjoyed, and ordered that the bales should be at once given
+to me.
+
+"Now I was able to give the King a handsome present, and after I had
+traded with my goods for sandal-wood, nutmegs, ginger, pepper and
+cloves, I set sail once more with the kind old captain. On the way
+home I was able to sell all my spices at a good price, so that when I
+landed I found I had a hundred thousand sequins.
+
+"My family were delighted to see me again, and I soon bought some land
+and built a splendid house, in which I meant to live happily and
+forget all the troubles through which I had passed."
+
+Here Sindbad ended the story of his first voyage. He ordered the music
+to strike up and the feast to go on, and when it was over he gave the
+poor porter Hindbad a hundred gold pieces and told him to come back at
+the same time next evening if he wished to hear the tale of the second
+voyage.
+
+Hindbad went joyfully home, and you can imagine how happy the poor
+family were that night.
+
+Next evening he set out once more for Sindbad's house, dressed in his
+best clothes. There he enjoyed a splendid supper as before, and when
+it was over Sindbad said:
+
+"I was very happy for some time at home, but before long I began to
+grow weary of leading an idle life. I longed to be upon the sea again,
+to feel the good ship bounding over the waves, and to hear the wind
+whistling through the rigging.
+
+"So I set to work at once and bought all kinds of goods that I might
+sell again in foreign lands, and then, having found a suitable ship, I
+set sail with other merchants, and so began my second voyage.
+
+"We stopped at many places, and sold our goods at a great profit, and
+all went well until one day when we landed on a new island. It was a
+most beautiful place, fair as the garden of Eden, where exquisite
+flowers made a perfect rainbow of color and delicious fruits hung in
+ripe clusters above.
+
+"Here, under the shadow of the tree, I sat down to rest and to feast
+my eyes upon all the loveliness around. I ate the food I had brought
+with me, drank my wine, and then closed my eyes. The soft music of the
+stream which flowed close by was like a song in my ears, and, before I
+knew what I was doing, I fell asleep.
+
+"I cannot tell how long I slept, but when at last I opened my eyes, I
+could not see my companions anywhere, and when I looked towards the
+sea, to my horror I found the ship was gone. It was sailing away, a
+white speck in the distance, and here was I, left alone upon this
+desert island. I cried aloud and wrung my hands with grief, and wished
+with all my heart that I had stayed safely at home. But what was the
+use of wishing that now?
+
+"So I climbed into a high tree, and looked around to see if I could by
+any means find a way of escape from the island. First I looked towards
+the sea, but there was no hope for me there, and then I turned and
+looked inland. The first thing that caught my eye was a huge white
+dome, that seemed to rise from the center of the island, unlike
+anything I had ever seen before.
+
+"I climbed down the tree, and made my way towards the white dome as
+quickly as I could, but when I reached it, it puzzled me more than
+ever. It was like a great smooth ball, much too slippery to climb, and
+into it there was no door or entrance of any sort. I walked round and
+round it, wondering what it could be, when suddenly a dark shadow fell
+upon everything and it grew black as night.
+
+"I gazed upwards in great fear, and knew that the shadow was cast by a
+great bird with outspread wings hovering over the place where I stood
+and shutting out heaven's light. As I looked, it suddenly came
+swooping down, and sat upon the white dome.
+
+"Then it flashed into my mind that this must be the bird which I had
+heard sailors talk of, called a roc, and the smooth white ball must be
+its egg.
+
+"Quick as thought, I unbound my turban, and twisted it into a rope.
+Then I wound it round and round my waist, and tied the two ends
+tightly round the roc's leg, which was close to where I stood.
+
+"'It will fly away soon, and carry me away with it off this desert
+island,' I said to myself joyfully.
+
+"And sure enough, before very long I felt myself lifted off the
+ground, and carried up and up until it seemed as if we had reached the
+clouds. Then the huge bird began to sink down again, and when it
+reached the ground I quickly untied my turban, and set myself free.
+
+"I was so small, compared to the roc, that it had never even noticed
+me, but darted off towards a great black object lying near, which it
+seized with its beak and carried off. Imagine my horror when I looked
+again and saw other dark objects, and discovered that they were great
+black snakes.
+
+"Here was I, in a deep valley, with mountains rising sheer up on every
+side, and nothing to be seen among the rocks but those terrible black
+snakes.
+
+"'Oh!' I cried, 'why did I ever try to leave the desert island? I have
+indeed only come into worse misfortune.'
+
+"As I looked around, I noticed that the ground was strewn with
+sparkling stones, which seemed to quiver with light, and when I looked
+nearer, I found they were diamonds of extraordinary size, although
+lying about like common pebbles. At first I was delighted, but they
+soon ceased to please me, for I feared each moment I might be seized
+by one of the terrible snakes.
+
+"These snakes were so large that they could easily have swallowed an
+elephant, and although they lay quiet during the day, and hid
+themselves for fear of the roc, at night they came out in search of
+food. I managed to find a cave among the rocks before nightfall, and
+there I sat in fear and trembling until morning, when I once more went
+out into the valley.
+
+"As I sat thinking what I should do next, I saw a great piece of raw
+meat come bounding down into the valley, from rock to rock. Then
+another piece followed, and another, until several large pieces lay at
+my feet.
+
+"Then I remembered a tale which travelers had told me about the famous
+Diamond Valley. They said that every year, when the young eagles were
+hatched, merchants went to the heights above, and rolled down great
+pieces of raw meat into the valley. The diamonds on which the meat
+fell would often stick into the soft flesh, and then when the eagles
+came, and carried off the meat to feed their young ones, the merchants
+would beat them off their nests, and take the diamonds out of the
+meat.
+
+"I had never believed this wonderful tale, but now indeed I knew it to
+be true, and felt sure that I was in the famous Diamond Valley.
+
+"I had quite given up all hope of escape, for there was no possible
+way of climbing out of the valley, but as I watched the eagles carry
+off the lumps of raw meat, I thought of a plan, and hope revived.
+
+"First of all I searched around, and filled all my pockets with the
+biggest diamonds I could find. Then I chose out the largest piece of
+meat and fastened myself securely to it, with the rope made out of my
+turban. I knew that the eagles would soon come for more food, so I lay
+flat on the ground, with the meat uppermost, and holding on tightly, I
+waited for what would happen next. I had not long to wait before a
+gigantic eagle came swooping down. It seized the meat and carried it
+and me swiftly up, until it reached its nest high among the mountain
+rocks. And no sooner had it dropped me into the nest, than a man
+climbed out from behind the rock, and with loud cries frightened the
+eagle away. Then this man, who was the merchant to whom the nest
+belonged, came eagerly to look for his piece of meat. When he saw me,
+he started back in surprise and anger.
+
+"'What doest thou here?' he asked roughly. 'How dost thou dare to try
+and steal my diamonds?'
+
+"'Have patience,' I answered calmly, 'I am no thief, and when thou
+hast heard my story thou wilt pity and not blame me. As for diamonds,
+I have some here which will more than make up to thee for thy
+disappointment.'
+
+"Then I told him and the other merchants all my adventures, and they
+cast up their eyes to heaven in surprise at my courage, and the
+wonderful manner in which I had managed to escape so many dangers.
+Pulling out a handful of diamonds, I then passed the precious stones
+round among them, and they all declared them to be the finest they had
+ever seen.
+
+"'Thou shalt choose one, to make up for thy disappointment,' I said to
+the merchant who had found me.
+
+"'I will choose this small one,' he replied, picking out one of the
+least of the glistening heap.
+
+"I urged him to take a larger one, but he only shook his head.
+
+"'This one will bring me all the wealth I can desire,' he said, 'and I
+need no longer risk my life seeking for more.'
+
+"Then we all set off for the nearest port, where we found a ship ready
+to carry us home. We had many adventures on the way, but at last we
+reached our journey's end, and when I had sold my diamonds, I had so
+much money that I gave a great deal to the poor, and lived in even
+greater splendor than before."
+
+Here Sindbad paused, and ordered that another hundred gold pieces
+should be given to Hindbad, and that he should depart. But next
+evening when the guests had all assembled and Hindbad had also
+returned, Sindbad began once more to tell them a story of his
+adventures.
+
+"This time," began Sindbad, "I stayed at home for the space of a whole
+year, and then I prepared to set out on another voyage. My friends and
+relations did all in their power to prevent my going, but I could not
+be persuaded, and before long I set sail in a ship which was about to
+make a very long voyage.
+
+"Nothing went well with us from the beginning. We were driven out of
+our course by storms and tempests, and the captain and pilot knew not
+where we were. When at last they found out in which direction we had
+drifted, things seemed in a worse state than ever. We were alarmed to
+see the captain suddenly pull off his turban, tear the hair from his
+beard, and beat his head as if he were mad.
+
+"'What is the matter?' we asked, gathering round him.
+
+"'Alas!' he cried, 'we are lost. The ship is now caught in a dangerous
+current from which nothing can save her and us. In a very few moments
+we shall all be dashed to pieces.'
+
+"No sooner had he spoken than the ship was carried along at a
+tremendous speed straight on to a rocky shore which lay at the foot of
+a steep mountain.
+
+"But although the ship was dashed to pieces, we all managed to escape,
+and were thrown with our goods and some provisions high on to the
+rocky strip of shore. Here we found the scattered remains of many
+wrecks, and quantities of bones bleached white in the sun.
+
+"'We may prepare ourselves for death,' said the captain mournfully.
+'No man has ever escaped from this shore, for it is impossible to
+climb the mountain behind us, and no ship dare approach to save us.'
+
+"But nevertheless he divided the provisions among us, that we might
+live as long as possible.
+
+"One thing that surprised me greatly was a river of fresh water which
+flowed out of the mountain, and, instead of running into the sea,
+disappeared into a rocky cavern on the other side of the shore. As I
+gazed into the mouth of this cavern I saw that it was lined with
+sparkling gems, and that the bed of the river was studded with rubies
+and diamonds and all manner of precious stones. Great quantities of
+these were also scattered around, and treasures from the wrecked ships
+lay in every corner of the shore.
+
+"One by one my companions died as they came to the end of their food,
+and one by one I buried them, until at last I was left quite alone. I
+was able to live on very little, and so my food had lasted longer.
+
+"'Woe is me!' I cried, 'who shall bury me when I die? Why, oh! why was
+I not content to remain safe and happy at home?'
+
+"As I bemoaned my evil fate I wandered to the banks of the river, and
+as I watched it disappear into the rocky cave a happy thought came to
+me. Surely if this stream entered the mountain it must have an opening
+somewhere, and if I could only follow its course I might yet escape.
+
+"Eagerly I began to make a strong raft of the wood and planks which
+were scattered all over the shore. Then I collected as many diamonds
+and rubies and as much wrecked treasure as my raft would hold, and
+took my last little store of food. I launched the raft with great
+care, and soon found myself floating swiftly along until I disappeared
+into the dark passage of the cavern.
+
+"On and on I went through the thick darkness, the passage seeming to
+grow smaller and narrower until I was obliged to lie flat on the raft
+for fear of striking my head. My food was now all gone, and I gave
+myself up for lost, and then mercifully I fell into a deep sleep which
+must have lasted many hours. I was awakened by the sound of strange
+voices, and jumping up, what was my joy to find I was once more in
+heaven's sunshine.
+
+"The river was flowing gently through a green, pleasant land, and the
+sounds I had heard were the voices of a company of negroes who were
+gently guiding my raft to the bank.
+
+"I could not understand the language these negroes spoke, until at
+last one of their number began to speak to me in Arabic.
+
+"Peace be to thee!' he said. 'Who art thou, and whence hast thou come?
+We are the people of this country, and were working in our fields when
+we found thee asleep upon the raft. Tell us, then, how thou hast come
+to this place.'
+
+"I pray thee, by Allah." I cried, 'give me food, and then I will tell
+thee all.'
+
+"Then the men gave me food, and I ate until my strength returned and
+my soul was refreshed, and I could tell them of all my adventures.
+
+"'We must take him to the King,' they cried with one voice.
+
+"Then they told me that the King of Serendib was the richest and
+greatest king on earth, and I went with them willingly, taking with me
+my bales and treasures.
+
+"Never had I seen such splendor and richness as at the court of the
+King of Serendib, and great was his kindness towards me. He listened
+to the tale of my adventures with interest, and when I begged to be
+allowed to return home, he ordered that a ship should be made ready at
+once. Then he wrote a letter with his own hand to the Caliph, our
+sovereign lord, and loaded me with costly gifts.
+
+"Thus, when I arrived at Bagdad, I went at once to the court of the
+Caliph, and presented the letter and the gift which the King had sent.
+
+"This gift was a cup made out of a single ruby lined inside with
+precious stones, also a skin of the serpent that swallows elephants,
+which had spots upon its back like pieces of gold, and which could
+cure all illnesses.
+
+"The Caliph was delighted with the letter and the gift.
+
+"'Tell me, O Sindbad,' he said, 'is this King as great and rich as it
+is reported of him?'
+
+"'O my Lord,' I said, 'no words can give you an idea of his riches.
+His throne is set upon a huge elephant and a thousand horsemen ride
+around him, clad in cloth of gold. His mace is of gold studded with
+emeralds, and indeed his splendor is as great as that of King
+Solomon.'
+
+"The Caliph listened attentively to my words, and then, giving me a
+present, he allowed me to depart. I returned home swiftly to my family
+and friends, and when I had sold my treasures and given much to the
+poor, I lived in such peace and happiness that my evil adventures soon
+seemed like a far-off dream."
+
+So Sindbad finished the story, and bade his guests return the next
+evening as usual. And next day, when all the guests were once more
+seated at the table and had finished their feasting, Sindbad began the
+story of his last voyage.
+
+"I had now made up my mind that nothing would tempt me to leave my
+home again, and that I would seek for no more adventures.
+
+"One day, however, as I was feasting with my friends, one of my
+servants came to tell me that a messenger from the Caliph awaited my
+pleasure.
+
+"'What is thy errand?' I asked when the messenger was presented to me.
+
+"'The Caliph desires thy presence at once,' answered the messenger.
+
+"Thus was I obliged to set out immediately for the palace.
+
+"'Sindbad,' said the Caliph, when I had bowed myself to the ground
+before him, 'I have need of thy services. I desire to send a letter
+and a gift to the King of Serendib, and thou shalt be the bearer of
+them.'
+
+"Then indeed did my face fall, and I became pale as death.
+
+"'Commander of the Faithful,' I cried, 'do with me as thou wilt, but I
+have made a vow never to leave my home again.'
+
+"Then I told him all my adventures, which caused him much
+astonishment. Nevertheless, he urged me to do as he wished, and seeing
+that there was no escape, I consented.
+
+"I set sail at the Caliph's command, and after a good voyage I at last
+reached the island of Serendib, where I received a hearty welcome. I
+told the officers of the court what my errand was, and they led me to
+the palace, where I bowed myself to the ground before the great King.
+
+"'Sindbad,' he said kindly, 'thou art welcome. I have often thought of
+thee, and wished to see thy face again.'
+
+"So I presented the Caliph's letter, and the rich present he had sent,
+which pleased the King well. When a few days had passed, I begged to
+be allowed to depart, and after receiving many gifts I once more set
+sail for home.
+
+"But alas! the return journey began badly. We had not sailed many
+days, when we were pursued by pirates, who captured the ship, and took
+prisoners all those who were not killed. I, among others, was carried
+ashore and sold by a pirate to a rich merchant.
+
+"'What is thy trade?' asked the merchant when he had bought me.
+
+"'I am a merchant,' I answered, 'and know no trade.'
+
+"'Canst thou shoot with a bow and arrow?' asked my master.
+
+"This I said I could do, and putting one in my hand he led me out to a
+great forest and bade me climb into a high tree.
+
+"'Watch there,' he said, 'until thou shalt see a herd of elephants
+pass by. Then try to shoot one, and if thou art fortunate, come at
+once and tell me.'
+
+"All night I watched, and saw nothing, but in the morning a great
+number of elephants came thundering by, and I shot several arrows
+among them. One big elephant fell to the ground, and lay there while
+the rest passed on; so, as soon as it was safe, I climbed down and
+carried the news to my master. Together we buried the huge animal and
+marked the place, so that we might return to fetch the tusks.
+
+"I continued this work for some time, and killed many elephants, until
+one night I saw to my horror that the elephants, instead of passing
+on, had surrounded the tree in which I sat, and were stamping and
+trumpeting, until the very earth shook. Then one of them seized the
+tree with his trunk, and tore it up by the roots, laying it flat on
+the ground.
+
+"I was almost senseless with terror, but the next moment I felt myself
+gently lifted up by an elephant's trunk, and placed on his back. I
+clung on with all my might, as the elephant carried me through the
+forest, until at last we came to the slope of a hill, which was
+covered with bleached bones and tusks.
+
+"Here the elephant gently laid me down, and left me alone. I gazed
+around on this great treasure of ivory, and I could not help wondering
+at the wisdom of these animals. They had evidently brought me here to
+show me that I could get ivory without killing any more of their
+number. For this, I felt sure, was the elephants' burying-place.
+
+"I did not stay long on the hill, but gathering a few tusks together I
+sped back to the town, that I might tell my tale to the merchant. 'My
+poor Sindbad,' he cried, when he saw me, I thought thou wert dead, for
+I found the uprooted tree, and never expected to look upon thy face
+again.'
+
+"Great was his delight when I told him of the Hill of Ivory, and when
+we had gone there together, and he saw for himself the wonders I had
+described, he was filled with astonishment.
+
+"'Sindbad,' he cried, 'thou too shalt have a share of this great
+wealth. And first of all I shall give thee thy, freedom. Until now,
+year by year have all my slaves been killed by the elephants, but now
+we need no longer run any risks, for here is ivory enough to enrich
+the whole island.'
+
+"So I was set free, and loaded with honors, and when the trade winds
+brought the ships that traded in ivory, I bade good-by to the island,
+and set sail for home, carrying with me a great cargo of ivory and
+other treasures.
+
+"As soon as I landed I went to the Caliph, who was overjoyed to see
+me.
+
+"'Great has been my anxiety, O Sindbad,' he said, 'for I feared some
+evil had befallen thee.'
+
+"When, therefore, I had told him of my adventures, he was the more
+astonished, and ordered that all my story should be written in letters
+of gold, and placed among his treasures.
+
+"Then I returned to my own house, and ever since have remained at home
+in peace and safety."
+
+Thus Sindbad finished the story of his voyages, and turning to
+Hindbad, he said: "And now, friend Hindbad, what dost thou think of
+the way I have earned my riches? Is it not just that I should live in
+enjoyment and ease?"
+
+"O my lord," cried Hindbad, bowing before Sindbad, and kissing his
+hand, "great have been thy labors and perils, and truly dost thou
+deserve thy riches. My troubles are as nothing compared to thine. Long
+mayest thou live and prosper!"
+
+Sindbad was well pleased with this answer, and he ordered that Hindbad
+should dine every day at his table, and receive his golden pieces, so
+that all his life he might have reason to remember the adventures of
+Sindbad the Sailor.
+
+
+
+
+THE ILIAD OF HOMER
+
+ADAPTED BY JEANIE LANG
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+THE STORY OF WHAT LED TO THE SIEGE OF TROY
+
+
+In the deep forest that clothes Mount Ida, not far from the strong
+city of Troy, Paris, son of King Priam, watched his father's flocks by
+night.
+
+Suddenly through the dim woods he saw a light, as if the golden sun
+and silver moon shone both together.
+
+And, lo! in the radiance of this light there stood before him the
+three fairest of the godesses--queenly Hera, wise Athene, and lovely
+Aphrodite.
+
+Like music stealing through the trees came the soft voice of Hera:
+
+"Of all mortal men thou art the most beautiful, Paris, and to thee do
+we come for judgment. Tell us which of us is the fairest of all, and
+to that one whom thou so deemest, give this golden apple."
+
+So spake Hera, and placed in the hand of Paris an apple of purest
+gold.
+
+Again she spake: "If to me, Hera, queen of goddesses, and wife of
+mighty Zeus, king of all the gods, thou dost grant the prize of
+loveliness, Power immeasurable shall be thine. King shalt thou be of
+the lands where the gray dawn rises, and king even to where the red
+sun goes down. A hundred peoples shall call thee lord."
+
+She was silent, and the voice of Athene, fair and pure as a silver
+moonbeam, broke the stillness of the starless night.
+
+"To me award the prize," she said, "and wise as the gods shalt thou
+be. With me as thy friend and guide, all things will be possible to
+thee."
+
+Last of all, standing in a rosy light, as of the dawning sunlight in
+the spring, spoke Aphrodite.
+
+"What are Power and Wisdom, fair Paris?" she pled. "Wisdom and Power
+bring no joy at last. I will give thee Love, and for thy wife thou
+shalt have the fairest woman in all the world."
+
+And Paris, the melody of her voice still in his ears, as he gazed
+spellbound on her face of wondrous beauty, handed to Aphrodite the
+golden prize.
+
+So was it that the wrath of the gods came upon Paris, son of Priam.
+For Hera and Athene, filled with rage, vowed to be revenged upon Paris
+and all his race, and made all the gods pledge themselves to aid them
+in their vengeance.
+
+Across far seas sailed Paris, with Aphrodite as his guide, to Sparta,
+where Menelaus was king.
+
+A brave king was Menelaus, and happily he lived in his kingdom with
+Helen, his queen, fairest of all women. One child they had, a little
+maid, Hermione.
+
+When to Sparta there came Paris, with eyes blue as the sea, and hair
+that gleamed like gold on his purple robe, gallant and brave, and more
+beautiful than any mortal man, glad was the welcome that he had from
+Menelaus.
+
+And when Paris gazed on Helen's face, he knew that in all the world
+there was no woman half so fair as the wife of Menelaus.
+
+Then did Aphrodite cast her magic upon Helen.
+
+No longer did she love her husband, nor did she remember little
+Hermione, her own dear child.
+
+When Paris spoke to her words of love, and begged her to flee with
+him, and to be his wife, she knew only that she loved Paris more than
+all else. Gladly she went with him, and in his red-prowed ship
+together they sailed across the green waves to Troyland, where Mount
+Ida showed her snowy crown high above the forests.
+
+An angry man was Menelaus when he found that Paris had stolen from him
+the fair wife who was to him as his own heart.
+
+To his elder brother Agamemnon, overlord of all the Greeks, he went
+and told his grievous tale.
+
+And from far and wide did the Greek hosts gather, until a hundred
+thousand men and eleven hundred fourscore and six ships were ready to
+cross the seas to Troyland.
+
+Many were the heroes who sailed away from Greece to punish Paris and
+his kin, and to bring back fair Helen to her own land.
+
+Few there were who came home, for ten long years of woe and of
+spilling of blood came to the men of Greece and of Troy from the fatal
+beauty of Helen the queen.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+THE COUNCIL
+
+
+That night both gods and men slept long; only Zeus, king of the gods,
+lay wakeful, pondering in his heart how best he might do honor to
+Achilles. "I shall send a Dream to beguile Agamemnon," at length he
+resolved.
+
+Then did he call to a Dream, for by Dreams the gods sent their
+messages to mortal men.
+
+"Go now, thou evil Dream," said Zeus, "go to where Agamemnon sleeps in
+his tent near to his fleet ships, and tell him every word as I shall
+tell it thee. Bid him call to arms with speed his warriors, for now he
+shall take the strong city of Troy."
+
+To the tent of Agamemnon sped the Dream. Taking the form of the old
+warrior who had striven to make peace between Agamemnon and Achilles,
+the Dream stooped over the sleeping warrior, and thus to him it spoke:
+
+"Sleepest thou, Agamemnon? Ill fits it for the overlord of so mighty a
+host to sleep all through the night. From Zeus I come, and to thee he
+sends this message: 'Call to arms with speed thy warriors, Agamemnon,
+for now shalt thou take the strong city of Troy.'"
+
+Off then sped the Dream, winging its way like a strip of gray mist
+aloft to Mount Olympus.
+
+Then Agamemnon awoke from sleep, and the voice of the Dream still rang
+in his ears.
+
+Speedily he arose from his bed, donned his fair tunic, cast around him
+his great cloak, and bound his sandals on his feet. Then over his
+shoulder he cast his silver-studded sword, and with the scepter of his
+house, token of his overlordship, in his hand, he went down to where
+the Greek ships lay, and called a council together.
+
+To his lords he told what had befallen him as they slept.
+
+"Call to arms!" had been the message from Zeus. "Call to arms! for
+victory shall be thine."
+
+Then said the old warrior in whose likeness the Dream had come:
+
+"My friends, had any other told us this dream we might deem it false;
+but to our overlord the Dream hath come. Let us then call our men to
+arms."
+
+So did all the lords follow his counsel, and quickly did the Greeks
+obey their summons. Like bees that pour from out their nests in some
+hollow rock, and fly to where the spring flowers grow most sweet, even
+so did the warriors pour forth from their ships and their huts by the
+sea. Loudly they shouted as they came, till all the earth echoed. Nine
+heralds sought to quiet them, but it was long before they would cease
+their noise, and sit silent to listen to the voice of Agamemnon their
+lord.
+
+Then did Agamemnon prove his people. "Ill hath Zeus dealt with us, my
+friends," he said. "To us he promised ere we sailed hither that
+victory should be ours. But nine years have passed away, and our
+ships' timbers have rotted, and the rigging is worn. In our halls our
+wives and children still sit awaiting us, yet are we no nearer victory
+than we were on the day that we came hither. Come then, let us flee
+with our ships to our dear native land, for never shall Troy be ours."
+
+So spake Agamemnon, and stirred the hearts of all that had not heard
+his secret council.
+
+As the high sea-waves are swayed by the winds that rush upon them from
+the east and from the south, even so the Greek host was swayed. And
+even as the west wind sweeps over a cornfield and all the ears bow
+down before the blast, so were the warriors stirred.
+
+Shouting, they hastened down to their ships. And the dust rose up in
+clouds from under their hurrying feet.
+
+Quickly did they prepare their ships, and gladly did they make them
+ready to sail homeward across the bright salt sea.
+
+Then would the Greeks have returned, even though fate willed it not.
+But Hera spoke to Athene.
+
+"Shall we indeed allow the Greeks thus to flee homeward?" she cried.
+"Shame it will be to us if Helen is left, in Troy, and Paris goes
+unpunished. Haste, then, and with thy gentle words hold back the men
+from setting forth in their ships for their own homeland."
+
+Down from the peaks of Olympus darted the bright-eyed Athene, clown to
+where the dark ships were being dragged to the launching ways.
+
+By his ship stood Odysseus of the many devices, and heavy of heart was
+he.
+
+As one who speaks aloud the thoughts of another, so then to Odysseus
+spake the fair goddess who was ever his guide.
+
+"Will ye indeed fling yourselves upon your ships and flee homeward to
+your own land?" she said. "Will brave Odysseus leave Helen, for whose
+sake so many Greeks have died, to be the boast of the men of Troy?
+Hasten, then, and suffer not the Greeks to drag their ships down to
+the sea."
+
+At the sound of the voice of Athene, Odysseus cast away his mantle and
+ran to meet Agamemnon. From him he received the scepter of
+overlordship, and bearing it he went among the ships.
+
+Whenever he saw a chief, he would say to him with gentle words:
+
+"Good sir, it fits thee ill to be a coward. Stay, now, for thou
+knowest not what is the will of Agamemnon. He is only making trial of
+thee. Hold back then thy people, and anger him not."
+
+But when Odysseus met a common man hasting to the ships, with his
+scepter he smote him, saying:
+
+"Sit still, sir, and listen to the words of thy betters. No warrior
+art thou, but a weakling. One king only hath Zeus given to us. Hearken
+then to the will of Agamemnon!"
+
+Thus did Odysseus rule the people, driving them back from the ships to
+where sat Agamemnon.
+
+And the noise they made in returning was as the noise of mighty waves
+of the sea, when they crash upon the beach and drive their roaring
+echoes far abroad.
+
+Silence came upon them as they sat themselves down before Agamemnon
+and their lords. Upon all but one did silence fall. Thersites,
+bandy-legged, round-shouldered, lame of one foot, with ugly head
+covered with scanty stubble, most ill-favored of all men in the host,
+would not hold his peace.
+
+Shrilly he poured his upbraidings upon Agamemnon.
+
+"What lackest thou now?" he cried. "Surely thy huts are full of the
+spoils we have brought to thee each time we have taken a town. What
+more dost thou want? Soft fools, women, not men, are ye Greeks, else
+would ye return home now with the ships, and leave this fellow here in
+Troyland gorging himself on the spoils for which he himself hath never
+fought. To brave Achilles hath he done dishonor, a far better man than
+he!"
+
+Straight to the side of Thersites came the goodly Odysseus.
+
+"Hold thy peace," he sternly said. "Plainly I tell thee that if ever
+again I find thee raving as thou hast raved now, I myself will strip
+off thy mantle and tunic, with shameful blows beat thee out of the
+assembly, and send thee back weeping to the ships."
+
+So spake Odysseus, and with his scepter smote Thersites on his back
+and shoulders. And Thersites bowed down, and big tears fell from his
+eyes, and a bloody weal from the golden scepter stood up from his
+back. Amazed he sat down, and in pain and amazement he wiped away a
+tear. The others, though they were sorry, laughed at his bewilderment.
+
+"Many are the good deeds of Odysseus," said they, "but never did he do
+a better deed than when he stopped the tongue of this prating railer."
+
+Then spake Odysseus, scepter in hand.
+
+"Surely it is the wish of the Greeks to make thee the most despised of
+all kings, great Agamemnon," he said, "for like young children or
+mourning women do they wail that they must go home. Nine years have
+we stayed in this land, and small wonder is it that we long for our
+homes again. Yet shameful would it be to wait so long and to return
+with empty hands. Be of good heart, my friends, and wait a little, for
+surely Troy shall be ours. Do ye forget, on the day that we set sail
+for Troyland, the mighty portent that we saw? As we offered sacrifices
+to the gods beneath a fair plane-tree whence flowed clear water, a
+snake, blood-red on the back and dreadful to look upon, glided from
+beneath the altar and darted to the tree. On the tree's topmost bough
+was a sparrow's nest, and in it eight tender nestlings, over which the
+mother bird spread her wings. Pitifully did the little ones cheep as
+the snake swallowed them all, and pitifully cried the mother as she
+fluttered over her nestlings. But of her, too, did the snake lay hold,
+coiling himself round her and crushing her life out. Then did the god
+who sent this sign show us that a sign from the gods in truth it was,
+for he turned the snake into stone. And Chalcas, our soothsayer, told
+us then the meaning of the sign. 'Nine years,' said he--for nine birds
+did the snake slay--'shall ye fight in Troyland, but in the tenth year
+the city shall fall before you.' So then, let us abide here, until we
+have taken the great city!"
+
+When Odysseus had ceased to speak, the Greeks shouted aloud, until the
+ships echoed the praises of the goodly Odysseus.
+
+Then said Agamemnon:
+
+"Go now, all of you, and eat, that ye may be ready for battle. Let
+each man sharpen well his spear and see to his shield, and see to it
+that the horses are well fed and the chariots prepared. And whomsoever
+I see minded to stay far away from the fight, beside the ships here by
+the sea, for him shall there be no hope hereafter, but he shall be
+food for dogs and for birds of prey."
+
+And when Agamemnon had spoken, the shouts of the Greeks were as the
+thunder of mighty breakers on a reef when the winds blow high.
+
+Quickly then they scattered, and kindled fires, and made their evening
+meal, and offered sacrifices to the gods, praying for escape from
+death in the coming battle.
+
+To Zeus did Agamemnon offer his sacrifice and to the mighty god he
+prayed:
+
+"Great Zeus, god of the storm-cloud, let not the sun set nor the
+darkness fall until I have laid low the palaces of Troy and burned
+down its walls with fire."
+
+So he prayed, but as yet Zeus heeded not his prayer. Then did the
+Greeks gather themselves together to battle, and among them went the
+bright-eyed Athene, urging on each one, and rousing in each man's
+heart the joy of strength and of battle.
+
+As the red and golden blaze of a fire that devours a mighty forest is
+seen from afar, so was seen from afar the dazzling gleam of their
+bronze armor as they marched.
+
+Like wild geese and cranes and swans that in long-drawn strings fly
+tirelessly onward, so poured they forth, while the earth echoed
+terribly under the tread of men and horses.
+
+As flies that swarm in the spring when the herdsmen's milk-pails are
+full, so did the Greeks throng to battle, unnumbered as the leaves and
+the flowers upon which they trod in the flowery plain by the banks of
+the river Scamander.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+THE FIGHT BETWEEN PARIS AND MENELAUS
+
+
+To meet the great Greek host came the men of Troy. With loud shouting
+and clamor they came, noisy as the flocks of cranes that fly to
+far-off seas before the coming of winter and sudden rain.
+
+But in silence marched the Greeks, shoulder to shoulder, their hearts
+full of courage.
+
+Like the mist that rolls from the crest of the mountains until no man
+can see in front of him further than the cast of a stone, so did the
+dust rise in clouds under the tread of the warriors' feet as they
+marched across the plain.
+
+Front to front did the two armies stand at last, and from the Trojan
+ranks strode forth Paris the godlike, he who robbed Menelaus of her
+who was to him most dear.
+
+From the shoulders of Paris swung a panther's skin. He bore a curved
+bow and sword, and, brandishing two bronze-headed spears, he
+challenged all the chieftains of the Greek host to fight him, man to
+man, in mortal fight.
+
+As a hungry lion rejoices to see a great-horned stag coming to be his
+prey, even so did Menelaus rejoice when he saw Paris, the
+golden-haired and blue-eyed, stride proudly forth.
+
+Straightway, in his armor, did Menelaus leap from his chariot to the
+ground.
+
+But when Paris saw him to whom he had done so sore a wrong, his heart
+was smitten.
+
+As a man who, in a mountain glen, suddenly sees a deadly snake and
+shrinks away from it with shaking limbs, even so did Paris shrink back
+among his comrades.
+
+Scornfully did Hector his brother behold him.
+
+"Fair in face thou art!" said Hector, "but shamed I am by thee! I ween
+these long-haired Greeks make sport of us because we have for champion
+one whose face and form are beautiful, but in whose heart is neither
+strength nor courage. Art thou a coward? and yet thou daredst to sail
+across the sea and steal from her husband the fair woman who hath
+brought us so much harm. Thou shalt see what sort of warrior is he
+whose lovely wife thou hast taken. Thy harp and thy golden locks and
+fair face, and all the graces given to thee by Aphrodite, shall count
+for little when thou liest in the dust! Cowards must we Trojans be,
+else thou hadst been stoned to death ere this, for all the evil thou
+hast wrought."
+
+Then answered Paris:
+
+"No word hast thou said that I do not deserve, brave Hector. Yet scorn
+not the gifts of golden Aphrodite, for by his own desire can no man
+win the love and beauty that the goddess gives. But let me now do
+battle with Menelaus. Make the Trojans and the men of Greece sit down,
+while Menelaus and I fight for Helen. Let him who is conqueror have
+her and all that is hers for his own, and let the others take an oath
+of friendship so that the Greeks may depart in peace to their own
+land, and in peace the Trojans dwell in Troy."
+
+Greatly did Hector rejoice at his brother's word. His spear grasped
+by the middle, he went through the Trojan ranks and bid the warriors
+hold back.
+
+But as he went, the Greeks shot arrows at brave Hector and cast
+stones.
+
+"Hold! hold! ye Greeks," called Agamemnon. "Hector of the glancing
+helm hath somewhat to say to us."
+
+In silence, then, the two armies stood, while Hector told them the
+words of Paris his brother.
+
+When they had heard him, Menelaus spoke:
+
+"Many ills have ye endured," he said, "for my sake and because of the
+sins of Paris. Yet now, I think, the end of this long war hath come.
+Let us fight, then, and death and fate shall decide which of us shall
+die. Let us offer sacrifice now to Zeus, and call hither Priam, King
+of Troy. I fear for the faith of his sons, Paris and Hector, but Priam
+is an old man and will not break faith."
+
+Then were the Greeks and the Trojans glad. They came down from their
+chariots, and took off their arms, and laid them on the ground, while
+heralds went to tell Priam and to fetch lambs and a ram for the
+sacrifice.
+
+While they went, Hera sent to Troy Iris, her messenger, in the guise
+of the fairest daughter of Priam.
+
+To the hall where Helen sat came lovely Iris. And there she found
+Helen, fairest of women, her white arms swiftly moving back and
+forward as she wove a great purple web of double wool, and wrought
+thereon pictures of many battles of the Greeks and the men of Troy.
+
+"Come hither, dear lady," said Iris, "and see a wondrous thing. For
+they that so fiercely fought with each other, now sit in silence. The
+battle is stayed; they lean upon their shields, and their tall spears
+are thrust in the earth by their sides. But for thee are Menelaus and
+Paris now going to fight, and thou shalt be the wife of the
+conqueror."
+
+So spake lovely Iris, and into the sleeping heart of Helen there came
+remembrance, and a hungry longing for her old home, and for Menelaus,
+and her father and mother, and for little Hermione, her child.
+
+The tears rolled down her cheeks, but quickly she hid her face with a
+veil of fair linen, and hastened out, with her two handmaidens, to the
+place where the two armies lay.
+
+At the Scaean gates sat Priam and other old warriors.
+
+As Helen, in her fair white robes, drew near, the old men marveled at
+her loveliness.
+
+"Small wonder is it," said they, "that Trojans and Greeks should
+suffer hardships and lay down their lives for one so beautiful. Yet
+well would it be for her to sail away upon the Greek ships rather than
+stay here to bring trouble upon us now, and upon our children
+hereafter."
+
+Then Priam called to Helen:
+
+"Come hither, dear child, and sit beside me, that thou may'st see the
+man who once was thy husband, and thy kinsmen, and thy friends. No
+blame do I give to thee for all our woes, but only to the gods who
+have chosen thee to be the cause of all this bloodshed."
+
+Then did Priam ask her the names of the mighty heroes who stood by
+their spears in the Grecian ranks, and Helen, making answer to him,
+said:
+
+"Dear father of Paris, my lord, would that I had died ere I left my
+own land and my little child, and all those that I loved, and followed
+thy son hither. Agamemnon, a goodly king and a mighty spearsman, is
+the Greek warrior whose name thou dost ask. Brother of him who was my
+husband is he. Ah! shameless me, who did leave mine own."
+
+Of Odysseus also, and of many another warrior of great stature and
+brave looks, did Priam make inquiry. And Helen told him all she knew,
+while tears of longing stood in her eyes.
+
+"My two brethren, Castor, tamer of horses, and Polydeuces, the skilful
+boxer, I do not see," she said; "mayhap they have not crossed the
+sea." For she knew not that her two brothers lay dead in her own
+beautiful land.
+
+Then was the sacrifice to Zeus offered, and the vows made between
+Agamemnon and Priam, King of Troy.
+
+When the sacrifice and vows were accomplished, Priam in haste mounted
+his chariot and drove away.
+
+"Verily will I return to windy Ilios," said the old man, "for I cannot
+bear to watch the fight between Menelaus and my own dear son. But
+only Zeus and the gods know which one of them is to fall."
+
+Then Hector and Odysseus marked out a space for the fight, and into a
+bronze helmet Hector placed two pebbles and shook them in the helmet,
+looking behind him. And the pebble of Paris leapt out the first, so
+that to him fell the lot to cast first his spear of bronze.
+
+Then did Paris arm himself. Greaves of beauteous fashioning he placed
+upon his legs, and fastened them with silver ankle-clasps. Over his
+shoulders he put his silver-studded sword of bronze and his great
+shield. On his head he placed a helmet with nodding crest of
+horsehair, and in his hand he grasped his strong spear. In like manner
+did Menelaus arm himself.
+
+One moment did they stand face to face, wrath and hatred in their
+hearts, their spears gripped firm in their hands.
+
+Then did Paris hurl his spear and smite the shield of Menelaus. But
+the shield was strong and the spear could not pierce it.
+
+His hand lifted up for the cast, Menelaus looked upwards and called to
+Zeus.
+
+"Grant me revenge, great Zeus!" he cried. "On him that hath done me
+grievous wrong, grant me vengeance, so that all men hereafter may
+shudder to wrong one who hath treated him as his honored guest."
+
+Then hurled he his mighty spear. Through the bright shield it went,
+and through the shining breastplate, tearing the tunic of Paris on his
+thigh. But Paris swerved aside, and so escaped death.
+
+Then Menelaus drew his silver-studded sword and drove it crashing down
+upon the helmet of Paris. But in four pieces was the sword shattered,
+and fell from the hand of Menelaus.
+
+"Surely art thou the most cruel of all the gods, Zeus!" angrily he
+cried. "My spear is cast in vain, and my sword shattered, and my
+vengeance is still to come!"
+
+So saying, he leapt upon Paris. By the crest on his helmet he seized
+him, and, swinging him round, he dragged him towards the Greek host.
+The embroidered strap beneath the helmet of Paris strangled him, and
+so he would have shamefully died, had not Aphrodite marked his plight.
+Swiftly did she burst the leather strap, and the helmet was left
+empty in the grasp of Menelaus.
+
+Casting the empty helmet, with a swing, to his comrades, Menelaus
+sprang back, ready, with another spear, to slay his enemy.
+
+But Aphrodite snatched Paris up, and in thick mist she hid him, and
+bore him away to his own home. Like a wild beast Menelaus strode
+through the host, searching for him. But no Trojan would have hidden
+him, for with a bitter hatred did the men of Troy hate Paris, most
+beautiful of mortal men.
+
+Then said Agamemnon:
+
+"Hearken to me, ye Trojans. Now hath Menelaus gained the victory. Give
+us back Helen, and all that is hers, and pay me the recompense that ye
+owe me for all the evil days that are gone."
+
+So spake he, and glad were the shouts of the Greeks as they heard the
+words of their king.
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+HECTOR AND ANDROMACHE
+
+
+From where the battle still raged went Hector, son of Priam. At the
+oak-tree by the gates of Troy there came running to meet him wives and
+daughters of those who fought. For eagerly did they long for tidings
+of many a warrior who now lay dead on the field.
+
+When he reached the beautiful, many-pillared palace of his father, his
+mother came to meet him.
+
+His hand she took in hers, and gently spoke she to him.
+
+"Art thou wearied that thou hast left the battle, Hector, my son?" she
+said. "Let me bring thee wine that thou may'st be refreshed and yet
+gain strength."
+
+"Bring me no wine, dear mother," said Hector, "lest it take from me
+the strength and courage that I have. Rather go thou to the temple of
+Athene and offer her sacrifices, beseeching that she will have mercy
+on Troy and on the wives of the Trojans and their little children. So
+may she hold back Diomedes the destroyer. I go to Paris--would that he
+were dead!"
+
+And the mother of Hector straightway, with other old women, the
+mothers of heroes, offered sacrifices and prayers to Athene. But
+Athene paid no heed.
+
+To the palace of Paris, his mighty bronze spear in his hand, then
+strode Hector.
+
+Paris, the golden-haired, sat in a room with Helen, idly handling his
+shining shield and breastplate and curved bow.
+
+In bitter scorn spoke Hector to his brother.
+
+"Our people die in battle for thy sake!" he cried, "while here thou
+sittest idle. Up then, ere the enemies that thou hast made for us burn
+our city to the ground!"
+
+And Paris answered:
+
+"Justly dost thou chide me, Hector. Even now hath Helen urged me to
+play the man and go back to battle. Only let me put on my armor, and
+soon will I overtake thee."
+
+Never a word did Hector answer him.
+
+But to Hector did Helen then speak:
+
+"Brother Hector," she said, "unworthy am I to be sister of thine.
+Would that I had died on the day I was born, or would that the gods
+who have brought me this evil had given me for a husband one who was
+shamed by reproach and who feared dishonor. Rest thee here, my
+brother, who hast suffered so much for the sake of wretched me and for
+the sin of Paris. Well I know that for us cometh punishment of which
+men will sing in the far-off years that are yet to come."
+
+"Of thy love, ask me not to stay, Helen," answered Hector. "For to
+help the men of Troy is my whole heart set, and they are now in want
+of me. But rouse this fellow, and make him hasten after me. I go now
+to see my dear wife and my babe, for I know not whether I shall return
+to them again."
+
+In his own house Hector found not his fair wife Andromache, nor their
+little babe.
+
+"Whither went thy mistress?" he asked in eagerness of the
+serving-women.
+
+"Truly, my lord," answered one, "tidings came to us that the Trojans
+were sorely pressed and that with the Greeks was the victory. So then
+did Andromache, like one frenzied, hasten with her child and his nurse
+to the walls that she might see somewhat of what befell. There, on the
+tower, she stands now, weeping and wailing."
+
+Back through the streets by which he had come then hastened Hector.
+And as he drew near the gates, Andromache, who had spied him from
+afar, ran to meet him.
+
+As, hand clasped in hand, Andromache and Hector stood, Hector looked
+silently at the beautiful babe in his nurse's arms, and smiled.
+
+Astyanax, "The City King," those of Troy called the child, because it
+was Hector his father who saved the city.
+
+Then said Andromache:
+
+"Dear lord, thy courage will bring thee death. Hast thou no pity for
+this babe nor for thy wife, who so soon shall be thy widow? Better
+would it be for me to die if to thee death should come. For if I lose
+thee, then sorrow must for evermore be mine. No father nor mother have
+I, and on one day were my seven brothers slain. Father and mother and
+brother art thou to me, Hector, and my dear loved husband as well.
+Have pity now, and stay with thy wife and thy little child."
+
+"All these things know I well, my wife," answered Hector, "but black
+shame would be mine were I to shrink like a coward from battle. Ever
+it hath been mine to be where the fight was fiercest, and to win glory
+for my father's name, and for my own. But soon will that glory be
+gone, for my heart doth tell me that Troy must fall. Yet for the
+sorrows of the Trojans, and of my own father and mother and brethren,
+and of the many heroes that must perish, grieve I less bitterly than
+for the anguish that must come upon thee on that day when thou no
+longer hast a husband to fight for thee and a Greek leads thee away a
+prisoner. May the earth be heaped up high above me ere I hear thy
+crying, Andromache!"
+
+So spake Hector, and stretched out his arms to take his boy.
+
+But from his father's bronze helmet with its fiercely nodding plume of
+horsehair the babe shrank back in terror and hid his face in his
+nurse's breast. Then did the little City King's father and his sweet
+mother laugh aloud, and on the ground Hector laid his helmet, and
+taking his little son in his arms he kissed him and gently dandled
+him. And as he did so, thus Hector prayed to Zeus and all the gods:
+
+"O Zeus and all ye gods, grant that my son may be a brave warrior and
+a great king in Troyland. Let men say of him when he returns from
+battle, 'Far greater is he than his father,' and may he gladden his
+mother's heart."
+
+Then did Hector lay his babe in Andromache's arms, and she held him to
+her bosom, smiling through her tears.
+
+Full of love and pity and tenderness was the heart of Hector, and
+gently he caressed her and said:
+
+"Dear one, I pray thee be not of over-sorrowful heart. No man shall
+slay me ere the time appointed for my death hath come. Go home and
+busy thyself with loom and distaff and see to the work of thy maidens.
+But war is for us men, and of all those who dwell in Troyland, most of
+all for me."
+
+So spake Hector, and on his head again he placed his crested helmet.
+And his wife went home, many times looking back to watch him she loved
+going forth to battle, with her eyes half blinded by her tears.
+
+Not far behind Hector followed Paris, his armor glittering like the
+sun, and with a laugh on the face that was more full of beauty than
+that of any other man on earth. Like a noble charger that has broken
+its bonds and gallops exultingly across the plain, so did Paris stride
+onward.
+
+"I fear I have delayed thee," he said to his brother when he overtook
+him.
+
+"No man can speak lightly of thy courage," answered Hector, "only thou
+hast brought shame on thyself by holding back from battle. But now let
+us go forward, and may the gods give the Greeks into our hands."
+
+So went Hector and Paris together into battle, and many a Greek fell
+before them on that day.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+HOW PATROCLUS FOUGHT AND DIED
+
+
+While round the dark ships of Greece the fierce fight raged, Achilles,
+from afar, listened unmoved to the din of battle, and watched with
+stony eyes the men of Greece as they fell and died on the reddened
+ground.
+
+To him came Patroclus.
+
+"Why dost thou weep, Patroclus?" asked Achilles. "Like a fond little
+maid art thou that runs by her mother's side, plucking at her gown,
+hindering her as she walks, and with tearful eyes looking up at her
+until the mother lifts her in her arms. Like her, Patroclus, dost thou
+softly weep."
+
+Then Patroclus, heavily groaning, made answer:
+
+"Among the ships lie the bravest and best of the men of Greece, sore
+wounded or dead. Pitiless art thou, Achilles, pitiless and
+unforgiving. Yet if thou dost still hold back from the battle, give
+me, I pray thee, thine armor, and send me forth in thy stead.
+Perchance the Trojans may take me for the mighty Achilles, and even
+now the victory be ours."
+
+Then said Achilles, and heavy was his heart within him:
+
+"These Greeks took from me my well-won prize, Patroclus. Yet let the
+past be past; no man may keep his anger for ever. I have said that
+until the men of Troy come to burn my own ships I will hold me back
+from the battle. But take you my armor; lead my men in the fight, and
+drive from the ships the men of Troy. But to others leave it to chase
+them across the plain."
+
+Even as Achilles spoke, the strength of mighty Ajax had come to an
+end, and with furious rush did the Trojans board the ships. In their
+hands they bore blazing torches, and up to the sky rushed the fiercely
+roaring flames.
+
+Then cried Achilles, smiting his thighs:
+
+"Haste thee, Patroclus! They burn the ships! Arm thyself speedily, and
+I will call my men!"
+
+Corslet and shield and helmet did Patroclus swiftly don, and girded on
+the silver-studded sword and took two strong lances in his hand.
+
+In the chariot of Achilles he mounted, and Automedon, best and bravest
+of charioteers, took the reins.
+
+Swift as the wild west wind were Bayard and Piebald, the two horses of
+Achilles, and in the side harness was Pedasus, a horse only less swift
+than they.
+
+Gladly did the men of Achilles meet his call to arms, for fierce as
+wolves were they.
+
+"Many times hast thou blamed me," cried Achilles, "because in my
+wrath I kept ye back from battle. Here for ye now is a mighty fight,
+such as ye love."
+
+To battle they went, and while Patroclus led them forth, Achilles in
+his tent offered up an offering to Zeus.
+
+Like wasps that pour forth from their nests by the wayside to sting
+the boys who have stoned them, so now did the Greeks swarm from their
+ships.
+
+Before the sword of Patroclus fell a mighty warrior, and when the men
+of Troy saw the shining armor of Achilles in his own chariot their
+hearts sank within them.
+
+Out of the ships were they driven, the fire was quenched, and back to
+the trench rolled the tide of battle. In the trench writhed many a
+horse and many a man in dying agonies. But clear across it leaped the
+horses of Achilles, and close to the walls of Troy did Patroclus drive
+brave Hector before him.
+
+His chariot then he turned, and headed off the fleeing Trojans,
+driving them down to the ships. Before the furious rush of his swift
+steeds, other horses were borne off their feet, other chariots cast in
+ruins on the ground, and men crushed to death under his wheels. Chief
+after chief did Patroclus slay. A mighty destroyer was he that day.
+
+One only of the chiefs of Troy kept his courage before the destroyer
+who wore the shining arms of Achilles.
+
+"Shame on ye!" cried Sarpedon to his men, "whither do ye flee? I
+myself will fight this man who deals death and destruction to the
+Trojan host."
+
+From their chariots leaped Sarpedon and Patroclus.
+
+With the first cast of his spear Patroelus missed Sarpedon, but slew
+his charioteer. Then did Sarpedon cast, and his spear whizzed past
+Patroclus, and smote the good horse Pedasus. With a dreadful scream
+Pedasus fell, kicking and struggling, in the dust. This way and that
+did the other two horses plunge and rear, until the yoke creaked and
+the reins became entangled. But the charioteer leaped down, with his
+sword slashed clear the traces from Pedasus, and the horses righted
+themselves.
+
+Once again did Sarpedon cast his spear, and the point flew over the
+left shoulder of Patroclus. But Patroclus missed not. Through the
+heart of Sarpedon sped the fiercely hurled spear, and like a slim tree
+before the axe of the wood-cutter he fell, his dying hands clutching
+at the bloody dust.
+
+Furious was the combat then over the body of Sarpedon. One brave
+warrior after another did Patroclus lay dead.
+
+And more terrible still was the fight because in the ranks of the men
+of Troy there fought now, in all-devouring wrath, the god Apollo.
+
+Nine men, good warriors all, did Patroclus slay; then, waxing bolder,
+he tried to climb the very walls of Troy.
+
+Three times did Apollo thrust him back, and when, a fourth time, he
+attacked, the god cried aloud to him in anger, warning him not to dare
+so much.
+
+Against Patroclus did Hector then drive his war-horses, but Patroclus,
+leaping from his chariot, hurled at Hector a jagged stone. In the eyes
+it smote the charioteer of Hector, and the slain man dropped to the
+ground.
+
+"How nimble a man is this!" jeered Patroclus. "How lightly he diveth!
+Were this the sea, how good an oyster-seeker would this fellow be!"
+
+Then from his chariot leaped Hector and met Patroclus, and the noise
+of the battle was as the noise of a mighty gale in the forest when
+great trees fall crashing to the ground.
+
+When the sun went down, victory was with the Greeks. Three mighty
+charges did Patroclus make, and each time he slew nine men. But when,
+a fourth time, he charged, Apollo met him. In thick mist he met him,
+and Patroclus knew not that he fought with a god. With a fierce
+down-stroke from behind, Apollo smote his broad shoulders, and from
+off his head the helmet of Achilles fell with a clang, rattling under
+the hoofs of the horses. Before the smiting of the god, Patroclus
+stood stricken, stupid and amazed. Shattered in his hands was the
+spear of Achilles, and his mighty shield clanged on the ground.
+
+Ere he could know who was the smiter, a Trojan ally drove a spear
+between his shoulders, and Patroclus, sore wounded, fell back.
+
+Marking his dismay, Hector pressed forward, and clean through his
+body drove his bronze spear. With a crash Patroclus fell.
+
+"Thou that didst boast that thou wouldst sack my town, here shall
+vultures devour thee!" cried Hector.
+
+And in a faint voice Patroclus made answer:
+
+"Not to thee do I owe my doom, great Hector. Twenty such as thou would
+I have fought and conquered, but the gods have slain me. Yet verily I
+tell thee that thou thyself hast not long to live. Even now doth Death
+stand beside thee!"
+
+As he spoke, the shadow of Death fell upon Patroclus. No more in his
+ears roared the din of battle; still and silent for ever he lay.
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+THE ROUSING OF ACHILLES
+
+
+Fierce had been the fight before Patroclus died. More fiercely yet it
+raged when he lay dead.
+
+From his body did Hector take the arms of Achilles, and the dead
+Patroclus would the Trojans fain have dragged to their city, there to
+bring shame to him and to all the Greek host.
+
+But for him fought the Greeks, until the earth was wet with blood and
+the very skies echoed the clang of battle.
+
+To Achilles came Antilochos, a messenger fleet of foot.
+
+"Fallen is Patroclus!" he cried, "and around his naked body do they
+fight, for his armor is held by Hector."
+
+Then did Achilles moan aloud. On the ground he lay, and in his hair he
+poured black ashes. And the sound of his terrible lament was heard by
+his mother, Thetis, the goddess, as she sat in her palace down under
+the depths of the green sea.
+
+Up from under the waves swiftly came she to Achilles, and tenderly did
+she listen while he poured forth to her the tale of the death of his
+dear comrade.
+
+Then said Thetis:
+
+"Not long, methinks, shall Hector glory in the armor that was thine,
+for Death presseth hard upon him. Go not forth to battle, my son,
+until I return, bearing with me new and fair armor for thee."
+
+But when Thetis had departed, to Achilles in his sorrow came Iris,
+fair messenger of the gods.
+
+"Unto windy Ilios will the Trojans drag the body of Patroclus unless
+thou comest now. Thou needst not fight, Achilles, only show thyself to
+the men of Troy, for sore is the need of Patroclus thy friend."
+
+Then, all unarmed, did Achilles go forth, and stood beside the trench.
+With a mighty voice he shouted, and at the sound of his voice terror
+fell upon the Trojans. Backward in flight they went, and from among
+the dead did the Greeks draw the body of Patroclus, and hot were the
+tears that Achilles shed for the friend whom he had sent forth to
+battle.
+
+All that night, in the house of the Immortals, resounded the clang of
+hammer on anvil as Hephaistus, the lame god, fashioned new arms for
+Achilles.
+
+Bronze and silver and gold he threw in his fire, and golden
+handmaidens helped their master to wield the great bellows, and to
+send on the crucibles blasts that made the ruddy flames dance.
+
+No fairer shield was ever borne by man than that which Hephaistus made
+for Achilles. For him also he wrought a corslet brighter than a flame
+of fire, and a helmet with a golden crest.
+
+And in the morning light did Thetis dart down from snowy Olympus,
+bearing in her arms the splendid gift of a god.
+
+Glad was Achilles as he put on the armor, and terrible was his war-cry
+as he roused the Greek warriors. No man, however sore his wounds, held
+back when the voice of Achilles called him to the fight once again.
+Wounded was Agamemnon, overlord of the Greeks, but forth also came he.
+And there, while the sun rose on many a warrior who would fight no
+more, did Achilles and Agamemnon speak as friends once again, their
+long strife ended.
+
+Hungry for war, with Achilles as their leader, did the Greeks then
+meet the Trojans on the plain. And as a fierce fire rages through the
+forest, its flames driven by the wind, so did Achilles in his wrath
+drive through the host of Troy.
+
+Down to the Scamander he drove the fleeing Trojans, and the water
+reddened with blood, as he smote and spared not.
+
+Merciless was Achilles; pitilessly did he exult as one brave man after
+another was sent by him to dye red the swift flood of the Scamander.
+
+At length, at his lack of mercy, did even the river grow wrathful.
+
+"Choked is my stream with dead men!" it cried, "and still thou
+slayest!"
+
+But when Achilles heeded not, in fierce flood the river up-rose
+against him, sweeping the slain before it, and in furious spate
+seeking to destroy Achilles. But as its waves smote against his
+shield, Achilles grasped a tall elm, and uprooting it, cast it into
+the river to dam the torrent. For the moment only was the angry river
+stayed. In fear did Achilles flee across the plain, but with a mighty
+roar it pursued him, and caught him.
+
+To the gods then cried Achilles, and to his aid came Athene, and close
+to the walls of Troy again did Achilles chase the Trojan men.
+
+From the city walls old Priam saw the dreadful things Achilles
+wrought.
+
+And when, his armor blazing like the brightest stars of the sky, he
+drew near, and Hector would have gone to meet him, in grief did Priam
+cry to his dearly loved son:
+
+"Hector, beloved son, I pray thee go not alone to meet this man;
+mightier far than thou is he."
+
+But all eager for the fight was Hector. Of all the men of Troy he
+alone still stood unafraid. Then did the mother of Hector beseech him
+to hold back from what must surely mean death. Yet Hector held not
+back, but on his shining shield leaned against a tower, awaiting the
+coming of the great destroyer.
+
+And at last they met, face to face, spear to spear. As a shooting-star
+in the darkness so flashed the spear of Achilles as he hurled it home
+to pierce the neck of Hector. Gods and men had deserted Hector, and
+alone before the walls of Troy he fell and died.
+
+Thus ended the fight.
+
+For twelve days did the Greek host rejoice, and all through the days
+Hector's body lay unburied. For at the heels of swift horses had the
+Greeks dragged him to the ships, while from the battlements his mother
+and his wife Andromache watched, wailing in agony, with hearts that
+broke.
+
+Then at length went old Priam to the camp of the Greeks. And before
+Achilles he fell, beseeching him to have mercy and to give him back
+the body of his son.
+
+So was the heart of Achilles moved, and the body of Hector ransomed;
+and with wailing of women did the people of Troy welcome home their
+hero.
+
+Over him lamented his old mother, for of all her sons was he to her
+most dear, and over him wept, with burning tears, his wife Andromache.
+
+And to his bier came Helen, and with breaking heart did she sob forth
+her sorrow:
+
+"Dearest of my brothers," she said, "from thee have I heard neither
+reproach nor evil word. With kind words and gentle heart hast thou
+ever stood by me. Lost, lost is my one true friend. No more in
+Troyland is any left to pity me."
+
+On lofty funeral pyre then laid they the dead Hector, and when the
+flames had consumed his body his comrades placed his white bones in a
+golden urn, and over it with great stones did they raise a mighty
+mound that all might see where he rested.
+
+Yet still was the warfare between Greeks and Trojans not ended.
+
+To Achilles death came in a shaft from the bow of Paris. By a poisoned
+arrow driven at venture and at dark midnight from the bow of an
+outcast leper was fair Paris slain. While winter snow lay white on
+Ida, in Helen's arms did his life ebb away.
+
+Then came there a day when the Greeks burned their camp and sailed
+homeward across the gray water.
+
+Behind them they left a mighty horse of wood, and the men of Troy came
+and drew it into the city as trophy and sign of victory over those who
+had made it. But inside the horse were hidden many of the bravest
+warriors of Greece, and at night, when the Trojans feasted, the Greeks
+came out of their hiding-place and threw open the gates.
+
+And up from the sea came the Greek host, and in fire and in blood fell
+the city of Troy.
+
+Yet did not Helen perish. Back to his own kingdom by the sea Menelaus
+took her, to reign, in peace, a queen, she who had brought grief and
+death to so many, and to the city of Troy unutterable woe.
+
+
+
+
+THE ODYSSEY OF HOMER
+
+ADAPTED BY JEANIE LANG
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+WHAT HAPPENED IN ITHACA WHILE ODYSSEUS WAS AWAY
+
+
+While Odysseus was fighting far away in Troyland, his baby son grew to
+be a big boy. And when years passed and Odysseus did not return, the
+boy, Telemachus, grew to be a man.
+
+Telemachus loved his beautiful mother, Penelope, but his heart always
+longed for the hero father whom he could only dimly remember. As time
+went on, he longed more and more, for evil things came to pass in the
+kingdom of Odysseus.
+
+The chiefs and lords of Ithaca admired Penelope for her beauty. They
+also coveted her money and her lands, and when Odysseus did not
+return, each one of these greedy and wicked men wished to marry her
+and make his own all that had belonged to brave Odysseus.
+
+"Odysseus is surely dead," they said, "and Telemachus is only a lad
+and cannot harm us."
+
+So they came to the palace where Penelope and Telemachus lived, and
+there they stayed, year in, year out, feasting and drinking and
+wasting the goods of Odysseus. Their roughness and greed troubled
+Penelope, but still more did they each one daily torment her by rudely
+asking: "Wilt thou marry me?"
+
+At last she fell on a plan to stop them from talking to her of
+marriage.
+
+In the palace hall she set up a great web, beautiful and fine of woof.
+
+Then she said, "When I have finished weaving this robe I shall give
+you my answer."
+
+Each day she worked at it, but each night, when the wooers slept, she
+undid all that she had done during the day. So it seemed to the wooers
+as if the robe would never be finished.
+
+Penelope's heart was heavy, and heavy, too, was the heart of
+Telemachus. For three weary years, while Odysseus was imprisoned on
+the island of Calypso, the mother and son pined together.
+
+One day Telemachus sat at the door of the palace sadly watching the
+wooers as they drank and reveled. He was thinking of the brave father
+that he feared was dead, when there walked up to the door of the
+courtyard a stranger dressed like a warrior from another land.
+
+The stranger was the goddess Athene. At the same time that she gained
+leave from the gods to set Odysseus free, they had agreed that she
+should go to Ithaca and help Telemachus. But she came dressed as a
+warrior, and not as a beautiful, gray-eyed, golden-haired goddess with
+golden sandals on her feet.
+
+Telemachus rose up and shook her kindly by the hand, and led her into
+the hall. He took from her the heavy bronze spear that she carried,
+and made her sit down on one of the finest of the chairs, in a place
+where the noise of the rough wooers should not disturb her.
+
+"Welcome, stranger," he said. "When thou hast had food, then shalt
+thou tell us in what way we can help thee."
+
+He then made servants bring a silver basin and golden ewer that she
+might wash her hands, and he fetched her food and wine of the best.
+
+Soon the wooers entered, and noisily ate they and drank, and roughly
+jested.
+
+Telemachus watched them and listened with an angry heart. Then, in a
+low voice, he said to Athene:
+
+"These men greedily eat and drink, and waste my father's goods. They
+think the bones of Odysseus bleach out in the rain in a far land, or
+are tossed about by the sea. But did my father still live, and were he
+to come home, the cowards would flee before him. Tell me, stranger,
+hast thou come from a far-off country? Hast thou ever seen my father?"
+
+Athene answered: "Odysseus still lives. He is a prisoner on a
+sea-girt island, but it will not be long ere he escapes and comes
+home. Thou art like Odysseus, my son. Thou hast a head like his, and
+the same beautiful eyes."
+
+When Athene spoke to him so kindly and so hopefully, Telemachus told
+her all that was in his heart. And when the wickedness and greed of
+the wooers was made known to her, Athene grew very angry.
+
+"Thou art in sore need of Odysseus," she said. "If Odysseus were to
+come to the door now with lance in hand, soon would he scatter those
+shameless ones before him."
+
+Then she told Telemachus what he must do.
+
+"To-morrow," said she, "call thy lords to a council meeting, and tell
+the wooers to return to their homes."
+
+For himself, she told him to fit out a ship with twenty oars-men, that
+he might sail to a land where he should get tidings of his father.
+
+"Thou art tall and handsome, my friend," she said. "Be brave, that
+even in days to come men may praise thy name."
+
+"Thou speakest as a father to a son. I will never forget what thou
+hast said," said Telemachus.
+
+He begged Athene to stay longer, and wished to give her a costly gift.
+But she would not stay, nor accept any present. To Telemachus she had
+given a gift, though he did not know it. For into his heart she had
+put strength and courage, so that when she flew away like a beautiful
+bird across the sea she left behind her, not a frightened, unhappy
+boy, but a strong, brave man.
+
+The wooers took no notice of the comings and goings of the strange
+warrior, so busy were they with their noisy feast. As they feasted a
+minstrel played to them on his lyre, and sang a song of the return of
+the warriors from Troyland when the fighting was over.
+
+From her room above, Penelope heard the song, and came down. For a
+little, standing by the door, she listened. Then she could bear it no
+longer, and, weeping, she said to the minstrel:
+
+"Sing some other song, and do not sing a song of return from Troyland
+to me, whose husband never returned."
+
+Then Telemachus, in a new and manly way that made her wonder, spoke to
+his mother:
+
+"Blame not the minstrel, dear mother," he said. "It is not his fault
+that he sings sad songs, but the fault of the gods who allow sad
+things to be. Thou art not the only one who hast lost a loved one in
+Troyland. Go back to thy room, and let me order what shall be, for I
+am now the head of the house."
+
+In the same fearless, manly way he spoke to the wooers:
+
+"Ye may feast to-night," he said; "only let there be no brawling.
+To-morrow meet with me. For once and for all it must be decided if ye
+are to go on wasting my goods, or if I am to be master of my own house
+and king in mine own land."
+
+The wooers bit their lips with rage, and some of them answered him
+rudely; but Telemachus paid no heed, and when at last they returned to
+their houses, he went upstairs to his own room. The old woman who had
+nursed him when he was a child carried torches before him to show him
+the way. When he sat down on his bed and took off his doublet, she
+folded and smoothed it and hung it up. Then she shut the door with its
+silver handle, and left Telemachus, wrapped in a soft fleece of wool,
+thinking far into the night of all that Athene had said to him.
+
+When day dawned he dressed and buckled on his sword, and told heralds
+to call the lords to a council meeting. When all were assembled he
+went into the hall. In his hand he carried a bronze spear, and two of
+his hounds followed him, and when he went up to his father's seat and
+sat down there, the oldest men gave place to him. For Athene had shed
+on him such a wondrous grace that he looked like a young god.
+
+"Never since brave Odysseus sailed away to Troyland have we had a
+council meeting," said one old lord. "I think the man who hath called
+this meeting is a true man--good luck go with him! May the gods give
+him his heart's desire."
+
+So good a beginning did this seem that Telemachus was glad, and,
+burning to say all that had been in his heart for so long, he rose to
+his feet and spoke.
+
+Of the loss of his father he spoke sadly, and then, with burning
+words, of the cowardly wooers, of their feastings and revelings and
+wasting of his goods, and of their insolence to Penelope and himself.
+
+When he had thus spoken in rage and grief, he burst into tears.
+
+For a little there was silence, then one of the wooers said angrily:
+
+"Penelope is to blame, and no other. For three years she has deceived
+us. 'I will give you my answer when I have finished weaving this
+robe,' she said, and so we waited and waited. But now that three years
+have gone and a fourth has begun, it is told us by one of her maids
+that each night she has undone all she has woven during the day. She
+can deceive us no longer. She must now finish the robe, and tell us
+whom she will marry. For we will not leave this place until she has
+chosen a husband."
+
+Then, once again, with pleading words, Telemachus tried to move the
+hearts of the wooers.
+
+"If ye will not go," at last he said, "I will ask the gods to reward
+you for your wickedness."
+
+As he spoke, two eagles flew, fleet as the wind, from the mountain
+crest. Side by side they flew until they were above the place of the
+council meeting. Then they wheeled about, darted with fury at each
+other, and tore with their savage talons at each other's heads and
+necks. Flapping their great wings, they then went swiftly away and
+were lost in the far distance.
+
+Said a wise old man: "It is an omen. Odysseus will return, and woe
+will come upon the wooers. Let us make an end of these evil doings and
+keep harm away from us."
+
+"Go home, old man," angrily mocked the wooers. "Prophesy to thine own
+children. Odysseus is dead. Would that thou hadst died with him. Then
+thou couldst not have babbled nonsense, and tried to hound on
+Telemachus in the hope that he may give thee a gift."
+
+To Telemachus they said again:
+
+"We will go on wasting thy goods until Penelope weds one of us."
+
+Only one other beside the old man was brave enough to speak for
+Telemachus. Fearlessly and nobly did his friend Mentor blame the
+wooers for their shamelessness. But they jeered at him, and laughed
+aloud when Telemachus told them he was going to take a ship and go to
+look for his father.
+
+"He will never come back," said one, "and even were Odysseus himself
+to return, we should slay him when he came."
+
+Then the council meeting broke up, and the wooers went again to revel
+in the palace of Odysseus.
+
+Down to the seashore went Telemachus and knelt where the gray water
+broke in little white wavelets on the sand.
+
+"Hear me," he cried, "thou who didst speak with me yesterday. I know
+now that thou art a god. Tell me, I pray thee? how shall I find a ship
+to sail across the misty sea and find my father? For there is none to
+help me."
+
+Swiftly, in answer to his cry, came Athene.
+
+"Be brave. Be thy father's son," she said. "Go back to thy house and
+get ready corn and wine for the voyage. I will choose the best of all
+the ships in Ithaca for thee, and have her launched, and manned by a
+crew, all of them willing men."
+
+Then Telemachus returned to the palace. In the courtyard the wooers
+were slaying goats and singeing swine and making ready a great feast.
+
+"Here comes Telemachus, who is planning to destroy us," they mocked.
+"Telemachus, who speaks so proudly--- angry Telemachus."
+
+Said one youth:
+
+"Who knows but what if he goes on a voyage he will be like Odysseus,
+and never return. Then will we have all his riches to divide among
+ourselves, and his house will belong to the man who weds Penelope."
+
+Telemachus shook off the jeering crowd, and went down to the vaulted
+chamber where his father's treasures were kept. Gold and bronze lay
+there in piles, and there were great boxes of splendid clothes, and
+casks of wine. The heavy folding doors of the treasure chamber were
+shut day and night, and the old nurse was the keeper of the treasures.
+
+Telemachus bade her get ready corn and wine for the voyage.
+
+"When my mother has gone to rest I will take them away," he said, "for
+this night I go to seek my father across the sea."
+
+At this the old nurse began to cry.
+
+"Do not go, dear child," she wailed. "Thou art our only one, and we
+love thee so well. Odysseus is dead, and what canst thou do, sailing
+far away across the deep sea? As soon as thou art gone, those wicked
+men will begin to plot evil against thee. Do not go. Do not go. There
+is no need for thee to risk thy life on the sea and go wandering far
+from home."
+
+"Take heart, nurse," said Telemachus. "The goddess Athene has told me
+to go, so all will be well. But promise me not to tell my dear mother
+that I am gone until she misses me. For I do not wish to mar her fair
+face with tears."
+
+The nurse promised, and began to make ready all that Telemachus
+wished.
+
+Meantime Athene, in the likeness of Telemachus, found a swift-sailing
+ship, and men to sail it. When darkness fell, she sent sleep on the
+wooers and led Telemachus down to the shore where his men sat by their
+oars.
+
+To the palace, where every one slept and all was still and quiet,
+Telemachus brought his men. None but the old nurse knew he was going
+away, but they found the food and wine that she had got ready and
+carried it down to the ship. Then Athene went on board, and Telemachus
+sat beside her. A fresh west wind filled the sails and went singing
+over the waves. The dark water surged up at the bow as the ship cut
+through it. And all night long and till the dawn, the ship sailed
+happily on her way.
+
+At sunrise they came to land, and Athene and Telemachus went on shore.
+The rulers of the country welcomed them and treated them well, but
+could tell nothing of Odysseus after the siege of Troy was over.
+Athene gave Telemachus into their care, then, turning herself into a
+sea-eagle, she flew swiftly away, leaving them amazed because they
+knew she must be one of the gods.
+
+While Telemachus sought for news of his father in this kingdom, and
+the kingdoms near it, the wooers began to miss him at their feasts.
+They fancied he was away hunting, until, one day, as they played games
+in front of the palace, the man whose ship Athene had borrowed came to
+them.
+
+"When will Telemachus return with my ship?" he asked.
+
+"I need it that I may cross over to where I keep my horses. I wish to
+catch one and break him in."
+
+When the wooers heard from him that Telemachus had sailed away with
+twenty brave youths, in the swiftest ship in Ithaca, they were filled
+with rage.
+
+At once they got a ship and sailed to where they might meet Telemachus
+in a strait between Ithaca and another rocky island.
+
+"We will slay him there," said they. "We will give him a woful end to
+his voyage in search of his father."
+
+When Penelope heard this, and knew that her son was perhaps sailing to
+his doom, her heart well-nigh broke. She wept bitterly, and reproached
+her maidens with not having told her that Telemachus had gone.
+
+"Slay me if thou wilt," said the old nurse, "but I alone knew it.
+Telemachus made me promise not to tell thee, that thy fair face might
+not be marred by weeping. Do not fear, the goddess Athene will take
+care of him."
+
+Thus she comforted her mistress, and although she lay long awake that
+night, Penelope fell asleep at last. In her dreams Athene came to her
+and told her that Telemachus would come safely home, and so Penelope's
+sad heart was cheered.
+
+While she slept the wooers sailed away in a swift, black ship, with
+spears in their hands and murder in their hearts. On a little rocky
+isle they landed until the ship of Telemachus should pass, and there
+they waited, that they might slay him when he came.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+HOW ODYSSEUS CAME HOME
+
+
+While yet Telemachus sought news of his father, Odysseus was well-nigh
+home. On that misty morning when he found himself in Ithaca, and did
+not know it, because the gray fog made everything seem strange and
+unfriendly, Odysseus was very sad as he sat beside the moaning sea.
+
+Then came Athene, and drove the mist before her, and Odysseus saw
+again the land that he loved, and knew that his wanderings were past.
+She told him the tale of the wooers, and of the unhappiness of
+Penelope and Telemachus, and the heart of Odysseus grew hot within
+him.
+
+"Stand by me!" he said to the goddess. "If thou of thy grace wilt help
+me, I myself will fight three hundred men."
+
+"Truly I will stand by thee," said Athene, "and many of the greedy
+wooers shall stain the earth with their blood."
+
+She then told Odysseus how the wooers were to be destroyed, and
+Odysseus gladly agreed to her plans. First she made him hide far in
+the darkness of the cave, under the olive-tree, all the gold and
+bronze ornaments and beautiful clothes that had been given to him in
+the land of Nausicaa.
+
+Then she touched him with her golden wand. In a moment his yellow hair
+fell off his head; his bright eyes were dim; his skin was withered and
+wrinkled, and he had a stooping back and tottering legs like a feeble
+old man. His clothes of purple and silver she changed into torn and
+filthy old rags, and over his shoulders she threw the old skin of a
+stag with the hair worn off.
+
+"Go now," said Athene, "to where thy faithful swineherd sits on the
+hill, watching his swine as they grub among the acorns and drink of
+the clear spring. He has always been true to thee and to thy wife and
+son. Stay with him and hear all that he has to tell, and I will go and
+fetch home Telemachus."
+
+"When thou didst know all, why didst thou not tell Telemachus?" asked
+Odysseus. "Is he, too, to go wandering over stormy seas, far from his
+own land?"
+
+"Telemachus will be a braver man for what he has gone through," said
+Athene. "No harm shall come to him, although the wooers in their black
+ship wait to slay him."
+
+Then Athene flew across the sea, and Odysseus climbed up a rough track
+through the woods to where the swineherd had built himself a hut. The
+hut was made of stones and thorn-branches, and beside it were sties
+for the swine made in the same way. The wooers had eaten many swine at
+their daily feasts, but thousands remained. These the swineherd
+tended, with three men and four fierce dogs to help him.
+
+At an open space on the hill, from whence he could look down at the
+woods and the sea, Odysseus found the swineherd sitting at the door of
+his hut making himself a pair of sandals out of brown ox-hide.
+
+When the swineherd's dogs saw a dirty, bent old man toiling up the
+hill, they rushed at him, barking furiously. Up they leapt on him and
+would have torn him to pieces if their master had not cast away his
+ox-hide, dashed after them, scolded them and beaten them, and then
+driven them off with showers of stones.
+
+"If my dogs had killed thee I should have been for ever ashamed," he
+said to Odysseus, "and without that I have enough sorrow. For while my
+noble master may be wandering in a strange land and lacking food, I
+have to feed his fat swine for others to eat."
+
+So speaking, he led Odysseus to his hut. He laid some brushwood on the
+floor, spread over it the soft, shaggy skin of a wild goat, and bade
+Odysseus be seated. Then he went out to the sties, killed two sucking
+pigs, and roasted them daintily. When they were ready he cut off the
+choicest bits and gave them to Odysseus, with a bowl of honey-sweet
+wine.
+
+While Odysseus ate and drank, the swineherd talked to him of the greed
+and wastefulness of the wooers, and in silence Odysseus listened,
+planning in his heart how he might punish them.
+
+"Tell me thy master's name," he said at length. "I have traveled in
+many lands. Perchance I may have seen him, and may give thee news of
+him."
+
+But the swineherd answered:
+
+"Each vagrant who comes straying to the land of Ithaca goes to my
+mistress with lying tales of how he has seen or heard of my master.
+She receives them all kindly, and asks many questions, while tears run
+down her cheeks. You, too, old man, would quickly make up a story if
+any one would give thee some new clothes. My master is surely dead,
+and wherever I may go I shall never again find a lord so gentle."
+
+Then said Odysseus:
+
+"My friend, I swear to thee that Odysseus shall return. In this year,
+as the old moon wanes and the new is born, he shall return to his
+home."
+
+When the other herds returned that evening they found Odysseus and
+their master still deep in talk. At night the swineherd made a feast
+of the best that he had, and still they talked, almost until dawn. The
+night was black and stormy, and a drenching rain blotted out the moon,
+but the swineherd, leaving Odysseus lying in the bed he had made for
+him, with his own thick mantle spread over him, went outside and lay
+under a rock that sheltered him from the storm, keeping guard on the
+white-tusked boars that slept around him. And Odysseus knew that he
+had still at least one servant who was faithful and true.
+
+While Odysseus dwelt with the swineherd, Athene sought Telemachus and
+bade him hasten home. Speedily Telemachus went back to his ship and
+his men. The hawsers were loosed, the white sail hauled up, and Athene
+sent a fresh breeze that made the ship cut through the water like a
+white-winged bird. It was night when they passed the island where the
+wooers awaited their coming, and in the darkness none saw them go by.
+
+By daybreak they reached Ithaca, and Telemachus, as Athene had bidden
+him, sent on the men to the harbor with the ship, but made them put
+him ashore on the woody coast near the swineherd's dwelling.
+
+With his bronze-shod spear in his hand, Telemachus strode up the rocky
+path. Odysseus and the swineherd had kindled a fire, and were
+preparing the morning meal, when Odysseus heard the noise of
+footsteps. He looked out and saw a tall lad with yellow hair and
+bright eyes, and a fearless, noble face. "Surely here is a friend," he
+said to the swineherd. "Thy dogs are not barking, but jump up and fawn
+on him."
+
+The swineherd looked, and when he saw his young master he wept for
+joy.
+
+"I thought I should never see thee more, sweet light of my eyes," he
+said. "Come into my hut, that I may gladden my heart with the sight of
+thee."
+
+He then spread before him the best he had, and the three men ate
+together. Although Odysseus seemed only a poor, ragged, old beggar,
+Telemachus treated him with such gentleness and such courtesy that
+Odysseus was proud and glad of his noble son. Soon Telemachus sent the
+swineherd to tell Penelope of his safe return, and while he was gone
+Athene entered the hut. She made herself invisible to Telemachus, but
+beckoned to Odysseus to go outside.
+
+"The time is come for thee to tell thy son who thou art," she said,
+and touched him with her golden wand.
+
+At once Odysseus was again a strong man, dressed in fine robes, and
+radiant and beautiful as the sun.
+
+When he went back into the hut Telemachus thought he was a god.
+
+"No god am I," said Odysseus; "I am thy father, Telemachus."
+
+And Odysseus took his son in his arms and kissed him, and the tears
+that he had kept back until now ran down his cheeks. Telemachus flung
+his arms round his father's neck, and he, too, wept like a little
+child, so glad was he that Odysseus had come home.
+
+All day they spoke of the wooers and plotted how to slay them.
+
+When the swineherd returned, and Athene had once more changed Odysseus
+into an old beggar-man, he told Telemachus that the wooers had
+returned, and were so furious with Telemachus for escaping from them,
+that they were going to kill him next day.
+
+At this Telemachus smiled to his father, but neither said a word.
+
+Next morning Telemachus took his spear and said to the swineherd:
+
+"I go to the palace to see my mother. As for this old beggar-man, lead
+him to the city, that he may beg there."
+
+And Odysseus, still pretending to be a beggar, said:
+
+"It is better to beg in the town than in the fields. My garments are
+very poor and thin, and this frosty air chills me; but as soon as I am
+warmed at the fire and the sun grows hot, I will gladly set out."
+
+Down the hill to the city strode Telemachus. When he came to the
+palace, his old nurse, whom he found busy in the hall, wept for joy.
+And when Penelope heard his voice, she came from her room and cast her
+arms round him and kissed his face and his eyes, and said, while tears
+ran down her cheeks:
+
+"Thou art come, sweet light of my eyes. I thought I should never see
+thee more."
+
+Then Telemachus, looking like a young god, with his spear in his hand
+and his two hounds following at his heels, went to the hall where the
+wooers sat. To his friend Mentor he told his adventures, but he looked
+on the wooers with silence and scorn.
+
+Soon Odysseus and the swineherd followed him to the city. A beggar's
+bag, all tattered, was slung round the shoulders of Odysseus. In his
+hand he carried a staff. Men who saw him, tattered and feeble, mocked
+at him and his guide. But Odysseus kept down the anger in his heart,
+and they went on to the palace. Near the doorway, lying in the dirt,
+thin and old and rough of coat, lay Argos, the dog that long ago had
+been the best and fleetest that had hunted the hares and deer with
+Odysseus.
+
+When he heard his master's voice he wagged his tail and tried to crawl
+near him. But he was too feeble to move. He could only look up with
+loving, wistful eyes that were almost blind, and thump his tail
+gladly. So glad was he that his faithful heart broke for joy, and
+before Odysseus could pat his head or speak a kind word to him, old
+Argos rolled over dead.
+
+There were tears in the eyes of Odysseus as he walked past the body of
+his friend. He sat down on the threshold leaning on his staff, and
+when Telemachus sent him bread and meat from his table he ate
+hungrily. When the meal was over he went round the hall begging from
+the wooers. Some gave him scraps of broken meats, others called him
+hard names and bade him begone, and one of them seized a footstool and
+struck him with it.
+
+But Odysseus still kept down the anger in his heart, and went back to
+his seat on the threshold with his beggar's bag full of the scraps
+that had been given to him.
+
+As he sat there, a common beggar, well known for his greed and
+impudence, came to the palace.
+
+"Get thee hence, old man," said he to Odysseus, "else I shall knock
+all thy teeth from thy head."
+
+More, too, he said, rudely and roughly, and at last he struck
+Odysseus.
+
+Then Odysseus could bear no more, and smote him such a blow on his
+neck that the bones were broken, and he fell on the ground with blood
+gushing from his mouth. Odysseus dragged him outside by the heels, and
+propped him, with his staff in his hands, against the courtyard wall.
+
+"Sit there," he said, "and scare off dogs and swine."
+
+The wooers laughed and enjoyed the sport, and gave gifts of food to
+the sturdy old beggar, as they took Odysseus to be. All evening they
+feasted and drank, but when night fell they went to their own homes.
+
+When they were gone Odysseus and Telemachus carried all the helmets
+and swords and sharp-pointed spears that stood in the hall, away to
+the armory and hid them there.
+
+Then Telemachus went to his room to rest, but Odysseus sat in the hall
+where the servants were clearing away the remains of the feast. While
+he sat there, Penelope came with her maids and rested on a chair In
+front of the glowing wood fire on which the servants had piled fresh
+logs.
+
+She talked kindly and gently to the old beggar-man, and bade the old
+nurse bring water to wash his weary feet.
+
+Now, once long ago, a wild boar that he hunted had torn the leg of
+Odysseus with his tusk, and as the old nurse washed his feet she saw
+the scar. In a moment she knew her master, and cried out. The brazen
+bath fell with a clang on the floor, and the water was spilt.
+
+"Thou art Odysseus," she said; "I did not know thee, my dear child,
+until I found the scar."
+
+Penelope must have heard her glad cry, had not Athene at that moment
+made her deep in thoughts of other things. Quickly Odysseus bade the
+old nurse be silent, and the old woman obeyed him.
+
+Before Penelope went to rest she said sadly to Odysseus: "I feel that
+the end is drawing near. Soon I shall be parted from the house of
+Odysseus. My husband, who was always the best and bravest, used to set
+up the twelve axes ye see standing here, and between each axe he shot
+an arrow. I have told the wooers that I shall marry whichever one of
+them can do the like. Then I shall leave this house, which must be for
+ever most dear to me."
+
+Then answered the old beggar-man: "Odysseus will be here when they
+shoot. It will be Odysseus who shoots between the axes."
+
+Penelope, longing for his words to be true, went up to her room and
+lay crying on her bed until her pillows were wet. Then Athene sent
+sleep upon her eyelids and made her forget all her sorrows.
+
+Odysseus, too, would have tossed all night wide awake, with a heart
+full of anger and revenge, had not Athene gently laid her hands on his
+eyes and made him fall asleep.
+
+Next day the wooers came to the palace, and with rough jest and rude
+word they greeted Odysseus.
+
+"Who harms this man must fight with me," said Telemachus, and at that
+the wooers shouted with laughter.
+
+But a stranger who sat among them cried out in a voice of fear:
+
+"I see your hands and knees shrouded in blackness! I see your cheeks
+wet with tears! The walls and the pillars drip blood; the porch is
+full of shadows, and pale ghosts are hastening out of the gray mist
+that fills the palace."
+
+At this the wooers laughed the more, for they thought the man was mad.
+But, as in a dream, he had seen truly what was to come to pass.
+
+Weeping, Penelope then brought forth from the armory the great bow
+with which Odysseus had shot in years that were past. Her heart was
+full of love for Odysseus, and she could not bear to wed another.
+
+Telemachus then threw aside his red cloak and ranged out the bronze
+axes.
+
+One by one the wooers tried to move the great bow and make it drive a
+swift arrow before it. One by one they failed.
+
+And when it seemed as if no man there was strong enough to move it,
+Odysseus took it in his hands, and between each axe he shot an arrow.
+When the last arrow was shot he tore off his rags, and in a voice that
+rang through the palace he cried to Telemachus: "Now is it time to
+prepare supper for the wooers! Now, at last, is this terrible trial
+ended. I go to shoot at another mark!"
+
+With that he shot an arrow at the wooer who had ever been the most
+insolent and the most cruel. It smote him in the throat, his blood
+dripped red on the ground, and he fell dead.
+
+The others gave a great cry of rage, but Odysseus looked at them with
+burning eyes, and with a voice that made them tremble he cried:
+
+"Ye dogs! ye said I should never return, and, like the traitors ye
+are, ye have wasted my goods and insulted my queen. But now death has
+come for you, and none shall escape."
+
+In vain did the cowards, their faces pale with fear, beg for mercy.
+Mercy there was none that day. It was useless for those who drew their
+swords and rushed on Odysseus to try to slay him, for ere their swords
+could touch him, his bow had driven sharp arrows into their hearts.
+
+One of the servants of the palace treacherously climbed into the
+armory and brought spears and shields and helmets for the wooers. But
+even that did not daunt Odysseus and his son. Telemachus, with his
+spear, slew man after man. When his arrows were done Odysseus also
+snatched a spear, and they fought side by side. Beside them fought the
+swineherd and one other man, and they all fought the more fearlessly
+because, all the time, Athene put fresh courage in their hearts.
+
+There were four men to very many others when that fight began. When it
+was ended the floor ran with blood, and Odysseus, like a lion at bay,
+stood with the dead bodies of the wooers piled in heaps around him and
+his face and hands stained with blood.
+
+When all lay dead, the old nurse gave a great cry of joy.
+
+"Rejoice in thy heart, old nurse," said Odysseus. "It is an unholy
+thing to rejoice openly over slain men."
+
+The nurse hastened to Penelope's room.
+
+"Penelope, dear child!" she cried, "Odysseus is come home, and all the
+wooers lie dead."
+
+At first Penelope would not believe her. Too good did it seem to be
+true. Even when she came down and saw Odysseus leaning against a tall
+pillar in the light of the fire, she would not believe what her own
+eyes saw.
+
+"Surely, mother, thy heart is as hard as stone," said Telemachus.
+"Dost thou not know my father?"
+
+But Penelope saw only a ragged beggar-man, soiled with the blood of
+the men he had slain, old and ugly and poor.
+
+Then Athene shed her grace upon Odysseus, and once more he was tall
+and strong and gallant to look upon, with golden hair curling like
+hyacinth flowers around his head. And Penelope ran to him and threw
+out her arms, and they held each other close and wept together like
+those who have suffered shipwreck, and have been tossed for long by
+angry seas, and yet have won safely home at last.
+
+And when the sun went down that night on the little rocky island of
+Ithaca in the far seas, the heart of Odysseus was glad, for he knew
+that his wanderings were ended.
+
+
+
+
+ROBINSON CRUSOE
+
+By DANIEL DEFOE
+
+ADAPTED BY JOHN LANG
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+HOW ROBINSON FIRST WENT TO SEA; AND HOW HE WAS SHIPWRECKED
+
+
+Long, long ago, before even your grandfather's father was born, there
+lived in the town of York a boy whose name was Robinson Crusoe. Though
+he never even saw the sea till he was quite a big boy, he had always
+wanted to be a sailor, and to go away in a ship to visit strange,
+foreign, far-off lands; and he thought that if he could only do that,
+he would be quite happy.
+
+But his father wanted him to be a lawyer, and he often talked to
+Robinson, and told him of the terrible things that might happen to him
+if he went away, and how people who stopped at home were always the
+happiest. He told him, too, how Robinson's brother had gone away, and
+had been killed in the wars.
+
+So Robinson promised at last that he would give up wanting to be a
+sailor. But in a few days the longing came back as bad as ever, and he
+asked his mother to try to coax his father to let him go just one
+voyage. But his mother was very angry, and his father said, "If he
+goes abroad he will be the most miserable wretch that ever was born. I
+can give no consent to it."
+
+Robinson stopped at home for another year, till he was nineteen years
+old, all the time thinking and thinking of the sea. But one day when
+he had gone on a visit to Hull, a big town by the sea, to say good-by
+to one of his friends who was going to London, he could not resist the
+chance. Without even sending a message to his father and mother, he
+went on board his friend's ship, and sailed away.
+
+But as soon as the wind began to blow and the waves to rise, poor
+Robinson was very frightened and seasick, and he said to himself that
+if ever he got on shore he would go straight home and never again
+leave it.
+
+He was very solemn till the wind stopped blowing. His friend and the
+sailors laughed at him, and called him a fool, and he very soon
+forgot, when the weather was fine and the sun shining, all he had
+thought about going back to his father and mother.
+
+But in a few days, when the ship had sailed as far as Yarmouth Roads
+on her way to London, they had to anchor, and wait for a fair wind. In
+those days there were no steamers, and vessels had only their sails to
+help them along; so if it was calm, or the wind blew the wrong way,
+they had just to wait where they were till a fair wind blew.
+
+While they lay at Yarmouth the weather became very bad, and there was
+a great storm. The sea was so heavy and Robinson's ship was in such
+danger, that at last they had to cut away the masts in order to ease
+her and to stop her from rolling so terribly. The Captain fired guns
+to show that his ship wanted help. So a boat from another ship was
+lowered, and came with much difficulty and took off Robinson and all
+the crew, just before their vessel sank; and they got ashore at last,
+very wet and miserable, having lost all their clothes except what they
+had on.
+
+But Robinson had some money in his pocket, and he went on to London by
+land, thinking that if he returned home now, people would laugh at
+him.
+
+In London he made friends with a ship's captain, who had not long
+before come home from a voyage to the Guinea Coast, as that part of
+Africa was then called; and the Captain was so pleased with the money
+he had made there, that he easily persuaded Robinson to go with him on
+his next voyage.
+
+So Robinson took with him toys, and beads, and other things, to sell
+to the natives in Africa, and he got there, in exchange for these
+things, so much gold-dust that he thought he was soon going in that
+way to make his fortune.
+
+And therefore he went on a second voyage.
+
+But this time he was not so lucky, for before they reached the African
+coast, one morning, very early, they sighted another ship, which they
+were sure was a pirate. So fast did this other vessel sail, that
+before night she had come up to Robinson's ship, which did not carry
+nearly so many men nor so many guns as the pirate, and which therefore
+did not want to fight; and the pirates soon took prisoner Robinson and
+all the crew of his ship who were not killed, and made slaves of them.
+
+The pirate captain took Robinson as his own slave, and made him dig in
+his garden and work in his house. Sometimes, too, he made him look
+after his ship when she was in port, but he never took him away on a
+voyage.
+
+For two years Robinson lived like this, very unhappy, and always
+thinking how he might escape.
+
+At last, when the Captain happened one time to be at home longer than
+usual, he began to go out fishing in a boat two or three times a week,
+taking Robinson, who was a very good fisher, and a black boy named
+Xury, with him.
+
+One day he gave Robinson orders to put food and water, and some guns,
+and powder and shot, on a big boat that the pirates had taken out of
+an English ship, and to be ready to go with him and some of his
+friends on a fishing trip.
+
+But at the last moment the Captain's friends could not come, and so
+Robinson was told to go out in the boat with one of the Captain's
+servants who was not a slave, and with Xury, to catch fish for supper.
+
+Then Robinson thought that his chance to escape had come.
+
+He spoke to the servant, who was not very clever, and persuaded him to
+put more food and water on the boat, for, said Robinson, "we must not
+take what was meant for our master." And then he got the servant to
+bring some more powder and shot, because, Robinson said, they might as
+well kill some birds to eat.
+
+When they had gone out about a mile, they hauled down the sail and
+began to fish. But Robinson pretended that he could not catch anything
+there, and he said that they ought to go further out. When they had
+gone so far that nobody on shore could see what they were doing,
+Robinson again pretended to fish. But this time he watched his chance,
+and when the servant was not looking, came behind him and threw him
+overboard, knowing that the man could swim so well that he could
+easily reach the land.
+
+Then Robinson sailed away with Xury down the coast to the south. He
+did not know to what country he was steering, but cared only to get
+away from the pirates, and to be free once more.
+
+Long days and nights they sailed, sometimes running in close to the
+land, but they were afraid to go ashore very often, because of the
+wild beasts and the natives. Many times they saw great lions come
+roaring down on to the beach, and once Robinson shot one that he saw
+lying asleep, and took its skin to make a bed for himself on the boat.
+
+At last, after some weeks, when they had got south as far as the great
+cape that is called Cape Verde, they saw a Portuguese vessel, which
+took them on board. It was not easy for Robinson to tell who he was,
+because he could not talk Portuguese, but everybody was very kind to
+him, and they bought his boat and his guns and everything that he had.
+They even bought poor Xury, who, of course, was a black slave, and
+could be sold just like a horse or a dog.
+
+So, when they got to Brazil, where the vessel was bound, Robinson had
+enough money to buy a plantation; and he grew sugar and tobacco there
+for four years, and was very happy and contented for a time, and made
+money.
+
+But he could never be contented for very long. So when some of his
+neighbors asked him if he would go in a ship to the Guinea Coast to
+get slaves for them, he went, only making a bargain that he was to be
+paid for his trouble, and to get some of the slaves to work on his
+plantation when he came back.
+
+Twelve days after the ship sailed, a terrible storm blew, and they
+were driven far from where they wanted to go. Great, angry, foaming
+seas broke over the deck, sweeping everything off that could be moved,
+and a man and a boy were carried overboard and drowned. No one on the
+ship expected to be saved.
+
+This storm was followed by another, even worse. The wind howled and
+roared through the rigging, and the weather was thick with rain and
+flying spray.
+
+Then early one morning land was dimly seen through the driving rain,
+but almost at once the vessel struck on a sand-bank. In an instant the
+sails were blown to bits, and flapped with such uproar that no one
+could hear the Captain's orders. Waves poured over the decks, and the
+vessel bumped on the sand so terribly that the masts broke off near
+the deck, and fell over the side into the sea.
+
+With great difficulty the only boat left on the ship was put in the
+water, and everybody got into her. They rowed for the shore, hoping to
+get perhaps into some bay, or to the mouth of a river, where the sea
+would be quiet.
+
+But before they could reach the land, a huge gray wave, big like the
+side of a house, came foaming and thundering up behind them, and
+before any one could even cry out, it upset the boat, and they were
+all left struggling in the water.
+
+Robinson was a very good swimmer, but no man could swim in such a sea,
+and it was only good fortune that brought him at last safely to land.
+Big wave after big wave washed him further and further up the beach,
+rolling him over and over, once leaving him helpless, and more than
+half drowned, beside a rock.
+
+But before the next wave could come up, perhaps to drag him back with
+it into the sea, he was able to jump up and run for his life.
+
+And so he got safely out of the reach of the water, and lay down upon
+the grass. But of all on board the ship, Robinson was the only one who
+was not drowned.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+ROBINSON WORKS HARD AT MAKING HIMSELF A HOME
+
+
+When he had rested a little, Robinson got up and began to walk about
+very sadly, for darkness was coming on; he was wet, and cold, and
+hungry, and he did not know where to sleep, because he was afraid of
+wild beasts coming out of the woods and killing him during the night.
+
+But he found that he still had his knife in his pocket, so he cut a
+big stick to protect himself with. Then he climbed into a tree which
+had very thick leaves, and there he fixed himself among the branches
+as well as he could, and fell sound asleep.
+
+In the morning when he awoke, the storm was past, and the sea quieter.
+To his surprise, he saw that the ship had been carried in the night,
+by the great seas, much nearer to the shore than she had been when the
+boat left her, and was now lying not far from the rock where Robinson
+had first been washed up.
+
+By midday the sea was quite calm, and the tide had gone so far out
+that he could walk very near to the ship. So he took off his clothes
+and swam the rest of the way to her. But it was not easy to get on
+board, because the ship was resting on the sand, and lay so high out
+of the water that Robinson could not reach anything by which he could
+pull himself up.
+
+At last, after swimming twice round the vessel, he saw a rope hanging
+over, near the bow, and by its help he climbed on board.
+
+Everything in the stern of the ship was dry, and in pretty good order,
+and the water had not hurt the provisions much. So he took some
+biscuits, and ate them as he looked about, and drank some rum, and
+then he felt better, and stronger, and more fit to begin work.
+
+First of all, he took a few large spars of wood, and a spare topmast
+or two, that were on the deck. These he pushed overboard, tying each
+with a rope to keep it from drifting away. Then he went over the side
+of the ship, and tied all the spars together so as to make a raft, and
+on top he put pieces of plank across. But it was long before he could
+make the raft fit to carry the things he wanted to take on shore.
+
+At last, after much hard work, he got on to it three of the seamen's
+chests, which he had broken open, and emptied, and he filled these
+with bread, and rice, and cheese, and whatever he could find to eat,
+and with all sorts of things that he thought he might need. He found,
+too, the carpenter's tool-chest, and put it on the raft; and nothing
+on the whole ship was of more use to him than that.
+
+Then he set about looking for clothes, for while he had been on the
+ship, the tide had risen and had washed away his coat and waistcoat
+and shirt, which he had left lying on the sand.
+
+Guns and pistols also, and powder and shot, he took, and two rusty old
+cutlasses.
+
+Now the trouble was to reach land, for the raft had no mast nor sail
+nor rudder, and was too heavy and clumsy to be pulled by Robinson with
+the broken oars that he had found. But the tide was rising, and slowly
+she drifted nearer and nearer, and at last was carried up the mouth of
+a little river which Robinson had not seen when he was on shore.
+
+There was a strong tide running up, which once carried the raft
+against a point of land, where she stuck for a time, and very nearly
+upset all the things into deep water. But as the tide rose higher,
+Robinson was able to push her into a little bay where the water was
+shallow and the ground beneath flat, and when the tide went out there
+she was left high and dry, and he got everything safely ashore.
+
+The next thing that Robinson did was to climb a hill, that he might
+see what sort of country he was in, and find out if there were any
+other people in it. But when he got to the top, he saw to his sorrow
+that he was on an island, with no other land in sight except some
+rocks, and two smaller islands far over the sea. There were no signs
+of any people, and he saw nothing living except great numbers of
+birds, one of which he shot. But it was not fit to eat, being some
+kind of hawk.
+
+After this, with the chests and boards that he had brought on shore,
+he made a kind of hut to sleep in that night, and he lay there on the
+sand very comfortably.
+
+Day by day now for some time Robinson swam out to the ship, and made
+fresh rafts, loading them with many stores, powder and shot, and lead
+for bullets, seven muskets, a great barrel of bread, three casks of
+rum, a quantity of flour, some grain, a box of sugar, sails and ropes
+and twine, bags of nails, and many hatchets. With one of the sails he
+made himself a good tent, in which he put everything that could be
+spoiled by rain or sun. Around it he piled all the casks and other
+heavy things, so that no wild beast could very easily get at him.
+
+In about a fortnight the weather changed; it blew very hard one
+night, and in the morning the ship had broken up, and was no more to
+be seen. But that did not so much matter, for Robinson had got out of
+her nearly everything that he could use.
+
+Now Robinson thought it time to find some better place for his tent.
+The land where it then stood was low and near the sea, and the only
+water he could get to drink tasted rather salt. Looking about, he
+found a little plain, about a hundred yards across, on the side of a
+hill, and at the end of the plain was a great rock partly hollowed
+out, but not so as quite to make a cave. Here he pitched his tent,
+close to the hollow place in the rock. Round in front of the tent he
+drove two rows of strong stakes, about eighteen inches apart,
+sharpened at top; and he made this fence so strong that when it was
+finished he was sure that nothing could get at him, for he left no
+door, but climbed in and out by a ladder, which he always hauled up
+after him.
+
+Before closing up the end, Robinson hauled inside this fence all his
+stores, his food and his guns, his powder and shot, and he rigged
+inside a double tent, so better to keep off the hot sun and the rain.
+
+Then he began to dig into the rock, which was not very hard, and soon
+behind his tent he had a cave in which he thought it wise to stow his
+gunpowder, about one hundred and forty pounds in all, packed in small
+parcels; for, he thought, if a big thunderstorm were to come, a flash
+of lightning might explode it all, and blow him to bits, if he kept
+the whole of it in his tent.
+
+Robinson was now very comfortable, and as he had saved from the wreck
+two cats and a dog, he did not feel quite so lonely. He had got, also,
+ink and pens and paper, so that he could keep a diary; and he set up a
+large wooden cross, on which he cut with his knife the date of his
+landing on the island--September 30, 1659; and every day he cut a
+notch on the post, with a longer one each Sunday, so that he might
+always know how the months and years passed.
+
+As for food, he found that there were many goats on the island, and
+numbers of pigeons, and he had no difficulty in shooting as many as he
+needed.
+
+But now he saw that his tent and cave were too small for all the
+things he had stowed in them, so he began to make the cave bigger,
+bringing out all the rock and soil that he cut down, and making with
+it a kind of terrace round the inside of his stockade. And as he was
+sure that there were no wild beasts on the island to harm him, he went
+on tunneling to the right hand till he broke through the rock outside
+his fence.
+
+Then he began to hang things up against the side of the cave, and he
+even made shelves, and a door for the outside entrance. This was a
+very difficult job, and took him a long time; for, to make a board, he
+was forced to cut down a whole tree, and chop away with his axe till
+one side was flat, and then cut at the other side till the board was
+thin enough, when he smoothed it with his adze. But in this way, out
+of each tree he would only get one plank. He made for himself also a
+table and a chair, and finally got his castle, as he called it, in
+very good order.
+
+With all his care, however, there was one thing that he forgot, and
+that was, when he had made the cave so much bigger, to prop it, so as
+to keep the roof from falling in. And so one day he got a terrible
+fright, and was nearly killed, by a huge bit of the soft rock which
+fell and buried many of his things. It took weeks of hard work
+afterwards to clear away the fallen rubbish, and to cut beams strong
+enough to prop the roof.
+
+Every day, all this time, he used to climb up the hill and look around
+over the lonely waters, hoping, always hoping, that some morning he
+might see the sails of a ship that would take him home. But none ever
+came, and sometimes the tears ran down his cheeks because of the
+sorrow he felt at being so utterly alone. At times even, he thought in
+his misery that if he only had any kind of a boat, it would be better
+to sail away, and chance reaching other land, rather than to stop
+where he was. By and by, however, he grew less unhappy, for he had
+plenty of work to do.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+THE EARTHQUAKE AND HURRICANE; AND HOW ROBINSON BUILT A BOAT
+
+
+Now about this time, when Robinson had been some months on the island,
+heavy and constant rain began to fall, and sometimes weeks would pass
+without a single dry day. He found that instead of there being spring,
+summer, autumn, and winter, as in England, the seasons in his island
+were divided into the wet and the dry. There was no cold weather, no
+winter. It chanced that just before this first rain began, Robinson
+had emptied out some refuse from bags which had once held rice, and
+other grain, and he had forgotten all about having emptied them. So he
+was very much astonished to find, some time afterwards, both barley
+and rice growing near his tent, in the shade of the rock. The ears,
+when ripe, he kept to sow again, and from this very small beginning,
+in the course of a few seasons, he had a great quantity of grain, both
+for food and for sowing. But this meant every year much hard work, for
+he had no plow nor harrow, and all the ground had to be dug with a
+clumsy spade, made from a very hard, heavy wood that grew on the
+island.
+
+At first Robinson could not grind the grain that he grew, nor make
+bread from it. If he could have found a large stone, slightly hollow
+on top, he might, by pounding the grain on it with another round
+stone, have made very good meal. But all the stones he could find were
+too soft, and in the end he had to make a sort of mill of hard wood,
+in which he burnt a hollow place, and on that he pounded the grain
+into meal with a heavy stick.
+
+Baking he did by building a big fire, then raking away the ashes, and
+putting the dough on the hot place, covered with a kind of basin made
+of clay, over which he heaped the red ashes. In this way very good
+bread can be made.
+
+Before the rainy season was over, and just after he had finished the
+fence round his tent, one day when Robinson was at work in the cave,
+all of a sudden the earth began to fall from the roof, and the strong
+props he had put in cracked in a way which frightened him terribly. At
+the same time there was a curious moaning, rumbling noise, that he
+could not understand. He rushed out, and so afraid was he that the
+roof was falling in, and that he should be buried, that he got over
+the fence and began to run.
+
+But he was even more frightened when he found that all the ground was
+shaking. Then he knew that this was an earthquake.
+
+Three times there came violent shocks; a huge rock about half a mile
+away fell with a great noise like thunder, and the sea was churned up
+as if by a whirlwind. Robinson was sick with the movement of the
+ground, and trembling with the dread of being swallowed by the earth
+as it cracked and gaped; and after the noise and shaking were over, he
+was too frightened to go back to his tent, but sat where he was, all
+the time expecting another shock.
+
+Suddenly a furious wind began to blow, tearing up trees by the roots,
+and lashing the water till nothing could be seen but foam and flying
+spray. The air was full of branches and leaves torn off by the
+hurricane, and birds in hundreds were swept helpless out to sea. In
+about three hours, as suddenly as it had begun, the wind fell, and
+there was a dead calm, followed by rain such as Robinson had never
+before seen, which soaked him to the skin, and forced him to return to
+the cave, where he sat in great fear.
+
+For long after this he was very uneasy, and made up his mind to shift
+his quarters as soon as he could find a better place for his tent. But
+the earthquake had one good result, for what remained of the wreck was
+again thrown up by the sea, and Robinson got more things out of it
+which were useful to him, and for days he worked hard at that. One
+day, too, when he was on his way to the remains of the ship, he came
+on a large turtle, which he killed, and this gave him plenty of good
+food, for besides the flesh, there were, inside the animal, many eggs,
+which she had come to the shore to lay in the sand, as is the habit of
+turtles, and which Robinson thought were even better than hen's eggs.
+
+Now a few days after he had got so wet in the heavy rain, though the
+weather was hot, Robinson felt very cold and shivery, and had pains
+all over his body, and at night he dreamed terrible dreams. The
+following day, and many days, he lay very ill with fever and ague, and
+hardly knew what he was doing. So weak was he, that he believed he was
+dying, and there was no one to give him water to quench his thirst,
+nor to help him in any way. His only medicine was rum, in which he had
+soaked tobacco. It was very nasty, and made him sick, but it also
+made him sleep for more than a whole day and a night, and he woke much
+better, and able to walk about a little, though for a fortnight he was
+too weak to work. From this illness he learned not to go out more than
+he could help during the rainy season.
+
+When he was again quite strong, Robinson started to explore the island
+better than he had yet done, and he found many things growing, of
+which he made great use afterwards, tobacco, sugar-cane, and all
+manner of fruits, among them grapes, which he used to dry to raisins
+in the sun in great quantities.
+
+Near the spot where the most fruit grew, he built a hut, and round it,
+for safety, he put a double fence made of stakes cut from some of the
+trees near at hand. During the next rainy season these stakes took
+root, and grew so fast that soon nothing of the hut could be seen from
+outside the hedge, and it made so good a hiding-place, that Robinson
+cut more stakes of the same kind, and planted them outside the fence
+around his first dwelling; and in a year or two that also was quite
+hidden from view. The twigs of this tree, too, were good for making
+baskets, of which he had been in great need.
+
+When he had finished all this work, he started again to go over the
+rest of the island, and on his way across, from a hill, the day being
+very clear, he saw high land a great way off over the water, but
+whether it was another island, or the coast of America, he could not
+be sure.
+
+When he reached the other side of his island Robinson found the beach
+covered with turtles in astonishing numbers, and he thought how much
+better off he would have been if he had been cast ashore here, for not
+only would the turtles have supplied him with plenty of food, but
+there were far more birds than on the part of the island where he had
+been living, and far more goats.
+
+During the journey back to his castle he caught a young parrot, which,
+after a long time, he taught to speak and to call him by his name. It
+was so long since he had heard any voice, that it was a comfort to
+listen even to a parrot talking.
+
+Now, the sight which Robinson had had of the far distant land raised
+in him again the great longing to get away from this island where he
+had been so long alone, and he wished greatly for a boat. He went over
+to the remains of the boat in which he and the others had tried to
+come ashore when their ship struck on the sand-bank, and which had
+been flung far up on the beach by the sea, and he worked for weeks
+trying to repair her and to get her into the water. But it was all of
+no use; he could not move her.
+
+Then, he thought, "I'll cut down a tree, and make a new boat." This he
+fancied would be easy, for he had heard how the Indians make canoes by
+felling a tree and burning out the inside. "If they can do it, then
+surely I can do it even better," he thought. So he looked about, and
+chose a huge tree which stood about a hundred yards from the water,
+and with great labor in about three weeks he had cut it down.
+
+Four months Robinson worked at this boat, thinking all the time of
+what he would do when he reached the far distant land, and much
+pleased with himself for the beautiful boat he was making. Day after
+day he trimmed and shaped it, and very proud he was when it was
+finished and lay there on the ground, big enough to carry twenty men.
+
+Then he started to get her into the water. But that was quite another
+thing. By no means in his power could he move her an inch, try as he
+might. She was far too big. Then he began to dig a canal from the sea
+to the boat; but before he had got much of that work done, he saw
+clearly that there was so much earth to dig away, that, without some
+one to help him, it must take years and years before he could get the
+water to the boat. So he gave it up, and left her to lie and rot in
+the sun and the rain--a great grief to him.
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+ROBINSON BUILDS A SECOND BOAT, IN WHICH HE IS SWEPT OUT TO SEA
+
+
+By the time that Robinson had been four years on the island, all his
+clothes had become very ragged, and he had hardly anything that could
+be called a hat. Clothes he must have, for he could not go naked
+without getting his skin blistered by the hot sun, and he was afraid
+of getting a sunstroke if he went about without a hat.
+
+Now he had kept all the skins of the goats, and other animals, such as
+hares and foxes, that he had shot; and from these, after many
+failures, at last he made a hat and coat of goatskin, and a pair of
+short trousers, all with the hair outside, so as to shoot off the wet
+when it rained. The hat was very tall, and came to a sharp peak on
+top, and it had a flap which hung down the back of his neck. Robinson
+also, with much trouble, made of the skins an umbrella which he could
+open and shut; and if his clothes and his umbrella, and especially his
+hat, were not very good to look at, they were useful, and he could now
+go about in any weather.
+
+During the next five years nothing out of the common happened, and
+Robinson's time was mostly taken up with the getting of food, the
+yearly sowing and reaping of his crops, and the curing of his raisins.
+But towards the end of that time he made another attempt to build a
+boat, and this time he made one much smaller than the first, and
+though it took him nearly two years to finish, in the end he got her
+into the sea. She was not big enough for him to try to sail in to the
+far-off land that he had seen, and he used her only for cruising about
+the shores of his own island, and for fishing. In her he fixed a
+little mast, on which he rigged a small sail, made from a bit of one
+of the old ship's sails, and, using a paddle to steer with, he found
+that she sailed very well. Over the stern he fixed his big umbrella,
+to shade him from the sun, like an awning.
+
+Eager to go all round the island, one day Robinson put a lot of food
+on board, and, taking his gun, started on a voyage. All went well till
+he came to the east end of the island, where he found that a ledge of
+rocks, and beyond that a sand-bank, stretched out to sea for eight or
+nine miles. Robinson did not like the idea of venturing so far in a
+boat so small, and he therefore ran the boat ashore, and climbed a
+hill, to get a good view of the rocks and shoals before going near
+them. From the hill, he saw that a strong current was sweeping past
+the sand-bank, which showed just clear of the water, and on which the
+sea was breaking; but he thought there was an eddy which would swing
+him safely round the point, without bringing him near the breakers.
+However, that day and the next, there was a good deal of wind blowing
+in the direction contrary to the current, which, of course, raised a
+sea too big for a small boat, so Robinson stopped on shore where he
+was.
+
+On the third day it was calm, and he set off. But no sooner had he
+come abreast of the sand-bank than he found himself in very deep
+water, with a current running like a mill-race, which carried the boat
+further and further away from the land, in spite of all that he could
+do with his paddle. There was no wind, and the sail was useless.
+
+Now he gave himself up for lost, for the harder he worked, only the
+further away seemed the boat to be swept. The island was soon so far
+off that Robinson could hardly see it, and he was quite exhausted with
+the hard struggle to paddle the boat against the current. He was in
+despair, and giving up paddling, left the boat to drift where she
+would. Just then a faint puff of wind touched his cheek, and Robinson
+hurriedly hoisted his sail. Soon a good breeze blew, which carried him
+past a dangerous reef of rocks. Here the current seemed to divide, the
+part in which he now was began to swing round towards the island, and
+he plucked up heart again, and with his paddle did all he could to
+help the sail. Robinson felt like a man who is set free after he has
+been told that he must die; he could almost have wept for joy. Miles
+and miles he sailed, steadily getting nearer to the land, and late in
+the evening at last he got ashore, but on the other side of the point
+that he had tried to round in the morning. He drew up his boat on the
+shore of a little cove that he found, and when he had made her fast,
+so that the tide could not carry her away, there among the trees he
+lay down, and slept sound, quite worn out.
+
+In the morning he again got on board, and coasted along close inshore,
+till he came to a bay with a little river running into it, which made
+a very good harbor for the boat. Here he left her, and went on foot.
+
+Soon he found that he was not far from a spot that he had once before
+visited, and by afternoon he arrived at the hut which he called his
+country-house. Robinson got over the fence by the ladder, as usual,
+pulling it up after him, and then he lay down to rest in the shade,
+for he was still very weary from the hard work of the day before. Soon
+he fell asleep. But what was his surprise in a little time to be
+awakened by a voice calling, "Robin! Robin Crusoe! where are you?"
+
+At first he thought he was dreaming. But still the voice went on
+calling:
+
+"Where are you, Robin?"
+
+Up he jumped, trembling with fright and wonder, for it was so long
+since he had heard any voice but his own that he fancied it must be
+something more than human that he now listened to. But no sooner had
+he risen than he saw, sitting on the tree near to him, his parrot,
+which must have flown all the way from Robinson's other house, where
+it had been left. It was talking away at a great rate, very excited at
+again seeing its master, and Robinson hardly knew whether to be more
+relieved or disappointed that it was only the bird that had called
+him.
+
+For about a year after this Robinson kept to his own side of the
+island, and employed his time chiefly in working on his land, and in
+making dishes and pots of clay. These he had now learned to burn
+properly. Pipes, too, he made, and they were a great comfort to him,
+for he managed to cure very good tobacco from the wild plants that
+grew around. And as he feared lest his powder might begin to run
+short, he thought much over ways whereby he could trap goats for food,
+instead of shooting them. After many trials, the best plan, he
+decided, was to dig holes, which he covered with thin branches and
+leaves, on which he sprinkled earth, so that when anything heavy
+passed over, it must fall into the pit. By this means he caught many,
+and the kids he kept and tamed, so that in no great time he had quite
+a large herd of goats. These he kept in various small fields, round
+which from time to time he had put fences.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+ROBINSON SEES A FOOTPRINT ON THE SAND, FINDS A CAVE, AND RESCUES
+FRIDAY
+
+
+All this time Robinson had never gone near his canoe, but now the
+longing came on him to go over to where he had left her, though he
+felt that he should be afraid again to put to sea in her. This time,
+however, when he got to the hill from which he had watched the set of
+the current the day that he had been carried out to sea, he noticed
+that there was no current to be seen, from which he concluded that it
+must depend on the ebb and flow of the tide. Still, he was afraid to
+venture far in the canoe, though he stopped some time at his
+country-house, and went out sailing very often.
+
+One day when Robinson was walking along the sand towards his boat,
+suddenly, close to the water, he stopped as if he had been shot, and,
+with thumping heart, stood staring in wonder and fear at something
+that he saw. The mark of a naked foot on the sand! It could not be his
+own, he knew, for the shape was quite different. Whose could it be?
+
+He listened, he looked about, but nothing could he hear or see. To the
+top of a rising ground he ran, and looked all around. There was
+nothing to be seen. And though he searched everywhere on the beach for
+more footmarks, he found none.
+
+Whose footprint could it be? That of some man, perhaps, he thought,
+who might come stealing on him out from the trees, or murder him while
+he slept.
+
+Back to his house he hurried, all the way in a state of terror,
+starting every now and again and facing round, thinking he was being
+followed, and fancying often that a stump or a bush was a man, waiting
+to spring on him. That night he slept not at all, and so shaken was
+his nerve that every cry of a night-bird, even every sound made by an
+insect or a frog, caused him to start with fear, so that the
+perspiration ran down his brow.
+
+As day followed day, however, and nothing happened, Robinson began to
+be less uneasy in his mind, and went about his usual work again. But
+he strengthened the fence round his castle, and cut in it seven small
+loopholes, in which, fixed on frames, he placed loaded muskets, all
+ready to fire if he should be attacked. And some distance from the
+outside of the fence he planted a thick belt of small stakes, so that
+in a few years' time a perfect thicket of trees and bushes hid all
+trace of his dwelling.
+
+Years passed quietly, and nothing further happened to disturb
+Robinson, or to make him think more of the footprint that had
+frightened him so much. But he kept more than formerly to the interior
+of the island, and lost no chance of looking for good places to hide
+in, if he should ever need them. And he always carried a cutlass now,
+as well as his gun and a couple of pistols.
+
+One day it chanced, however, that he had gone further to the west of
+the island than he had ever done before, and, looking over the sea, he
+fancied that he saw, at a great distance, something like a boat or a
+long canoe, but it was so far off that he he could not be sure what it
+was. This made him determine that always in future he would bring with
+him to his lookout-place the telescope which he had saved from the
+wreck.
+
+The sight of this supposed boat brought back his uneasiness to some
+extent, but he went on down to the beach, and there he saw a sight
+which filled him with horror. All about the shore were scattered men's
+skulls and bones, and bits of burnt flesh, and in one place were the
+remains of a big fire. Robinson stood aghast, feeling deadly sick. It
+was easy for him to know the meaning of the terrible sight. It meant
+that cannibals had been there, killing and eating their prisoners; for
+when the natives of some parts of the world go to war, and catch any
+of their enemies, it is their habit to build a fire, then to kill the
+prisoners and feast on their roasted bodies, eating till they can eat
+no more. Sometimes, if the man they are going to eat is too thin, they
+keep him, and feed him up, till they think he is fat enough.
+
+Now Robinson knew all this, though he had never yet met any cannibals.
+And when he looked around he saw many bones lying about. They were so
+old that it seemed certain to him that all those years he had been
+living on an island which was a regular place for the natives to come
+to for such feasts. Then he saw what a mercy it was that he had been
+wrecked on the other side of the island, to which, he supposed, the
+cannibals never came, because the beach was not so good for them to
+land on.
+
+Full of horror, Robinson hurried back to his house, and for almost two
+years he never again came near that part of the island where the bones
+lay, nor ever visited his boat. But all the time he kept thinking how
+he might some day kill those cannibals while they were at their feast,
+and perhaps save some of the poor men whom they had not yet killed.
+
+Now one day when Robinson was down in the bottom of the valley,
+cutting thick branches to burn for charcoal, he cleared away some
+undergrowth at the foot of a great rock, in which, near the ground,
+there was a sort of hole, or opening. Into this hole Robinson
+squeezed, not very easily, and found himself in a cave of good size,
+high enough, at least, to stand up in. It was quite dark, of course,
+to him coming in from the sunlight, and he turned his back to the
+entrance to feel his way further in, when suddenly, from the back of
+the cave he saw two great fiery eyes glaring at him. His very hair
+bristled with fright, for he could only think that it must be the
+Devil at least that he saw; and through the mouth of the cave he fled
+with a yell.
+
+But when he got into the bright sunshine he began to feel ashamed of
+his panic, and to reason with himself that what he had seen must be
+only his own fancy. So, taking up a big burning branch from his fire,
+in he went again.
+
+Before Robinson had taken three steps he stopped, in almost as great a
+fright as at first. Close to him he heard a great sigh, as if of some
+one in pain, then a sound like a muttering, as of words that he could
+not understand; again another deep sigh. Cold sweat broke out all over
+him, and he stepped back trembling, yet determined this time not to
+run away.
+
+Holding his torch well over his head, he looked around, and there on
+the floor of the cave lay a huge old he goat, gasping for breath,
+dying, seemingly of mere old age.
+
+He stirred him with his toe to see if he could get him out of the
+cave, but the poor beast could not rise, and Robinson left him to die
+where he was.
+
+Now that he had got over his fright, Robinson looked carefully about
+him. The cave was small, not more than twelve feet across at its
+widest, but he noticed at the far end another opening. This was so low
+down, however, that he had to creep on his hands and knees to get in,
+and without a better light than the burning torch, he could not see
+how far it went. So he made up his mind to come again.
+
+Robinson had long before this made a good supply of very fair candles
+from the tallow of the goats he had killed, and next day he returned
+to the cave with six of these, and his tinder-box to light them with.
+In those days there were no matches, and men used to strike a light
+with a flint and steel, and tinder, which was a stuff that caught fire
+very easily from a spark.
+
+Entering the cave, Robinson found, on lighting a candle, that the goat
+was now dead. Moving it aside, to be buried later, he went down on his
+hands and knees, and crawled about ten yards through the small
+passage, till at last he found himself in a great chamber, the roof of
+which was quite twenty feet high. On every side the walls reflected
+the light of his candle, and glittered like gold, or almost like
+diamonds, he thought. The floor was perfectly dry and level, even on
+the walls there was no damp, and Robinson was delighted with his
+discovery. Its only drawback was the low entrance; but, as he decided
+to use the cave chiefly as a place to retreat to if he should ever be
+attacked, that was in reality an advantage, because one man, if he had
+firearms could easily defend it against hundreds.
+
+At once Robinson set about storing in it all his powder, except three
+or four pounds, all his lead for making bullets, and his spare guns
+and muskets. When moving the powder, he thought he might as well open
+a barrel which had drifted ashore out of the wreck 'after the
+earthquake, and though water had got into it, there was not a great
+deal of damage done, for the powder had crusted on the outside only,
+and in the inside there was about sixty pounds weight, quite dry and
+good. This, with what remained of the first lot, gave him a very large
+supply, enough to last all his life.
+
+For more than two-and-twenty years Robinson had now been in the
+island, and he had grown quite used to it, and to his manner of
+living. If he could only have been sure that no savages would come
+near him, he felt almost that he would be content to spend all the
+rest of his days there, to die at last, as the goat he found in the
+cave had died, of old age.
+
+At times, when his spirits were more than usually low, when the burden
+of the lonely years pressed most heavily upon him, Robinson used to
+think that surely if the savages could come to his land, he could go
+to theirs. How far did they come? Where was their country? What kind
+of boats had they? And so eager to go was he sometimes, that he forgot
+to think of what he would do when he got there, or what would become
+of him if he fell into the hands of the savages. His mind was utterly
+taken up with the one thought of getting to the mainland, and even his
+dreams were of little else.
+
+One night, when he had put himself almost into a fever with the
+trouble of his mind, he had lain long awake, tossing and moaning, but
+at last he had fallen asleep. And he dreamed, not as he had usually
+done of late, that he was sailing to the mainland, but that as he was
+leaving his castle in the morning he saw on the shore two canoes and
+eleven savages landing, and that they had with them another man, whom
+they were just about to kill and eat, when suddenly the prisoner
+jumped up and ran for his life. And in his dream Robinson fancied that
+the man came running to hide in the thicket round the castle, and that
+thereupon he went out to help him. Then in the dream, the savage
+kneeled down, as if begging for mercy, and Robinson took him over the
+ladder into the castle, saying to himself, "Now that I've got this
+fellow, I can certainly go to the mainland, for he will show me what
+course to steer, and where to go when we land." And he woke, with the
+joyful feeling that now at last all was well. But when he was wide
+awake, and knew that it was only a dream after all, poor Robinson was
+more cast down than ever, and more unhappy than he had been during all
+the years he had lived on the island.
+
+The dream had, however, this result; that he saw his only plan to get
+away was, if possible, to rescue some day one of the prisoners whom
+the cannibals were about to kill, and in time get the man to help him
+to navigate his canoe across the sea.
+
+With this idea, he set himself to watch, more closely than ever he had
+done before, for the savages to land, and during more than a year and
+a half he went nearly every day to his lookout-place, and swept the
+sea with his telescope, in the hope of seeing canoes coming. But none
+came, and Robinson was getting terribly tired of the constant watch.
+Still he did not give up, for he knew that sooner or later the savages
+would land again.
+
+Yet many months passed, and still they did not come, till one morning,
+very early, almost to his surprise, he saw no fewer than five canoes
+hauled up on the shore on his own side of the island. The savages who
+had come in them were nowhere to be seen. Now, he knew that always
+from four to six men came in each canoe, which meant that at least
+twenty, and perhaps as many as thirty men had landed.
+
+This was a greater number than he cared to face, so he kept inside his
+castle, in great doubt what to do, but ready to fight, in case they
+should attack him.
+
+When he had waited a long time and still could hear nothing of the
+savages, he climbed up his ladder and got to the top of the rock,
+taking great care not to show himself against the skyline. Looking
+through his glass, he saw that there were at least thirty savages,
+dancing wildly round a fire.
+
+As he looked, some of the men left the others, and going over to the
+canoes dragged from' them two prisoners. One of these almost at once
+fell forward on his face, knocked down from behind, as it seemed to
+Robinson, with a wooden club, and two or three of the cannibals at
+once cut him open to be ready for cooking, while for a moment or two
+they left the other prisoner standing by himself.
+
+Seeing a chance of escape, the man made a dash for his life, running
+with tremendous speed along the sands straight for that part of the
+beach near Robinson's castle.
+
+Now this alarmed Robinson very much, for it seemed to him that the
+whole of the savages started after the prisoner. He could not help
+thinking it likely that, as in his dream, this man would take shelter
+in the thicket round the castle, in which case Robinson was likely
+soon to have more fighting than he would relish, for the whole body of
+the cannibals would be on him at once.
+
+As he watched the poor man racing for life, however, he was relieved
+to see that he ran much faster than his pursuers, of whom only three
+continued to run after him. If he could hold out for another mile or
+two there was little doubt that he would escape. Between the castle
+and the runners was the creek up which Robinson used to run his rafts
+from the wreck, and when the escaped prisoner came to that, he plunged
+in, and though the tide was full, with less than thirty powerful
+strokes he reached the other side, and with long easy strides
+continued his run. Of the men in pursuit, two also plunged in and swam
+through, but less quickly than the man escaping, being more blown with
+running, because of what they had eaten before starting. The third man
+stopped altogether, and went back the way he came.
+
+Seeing the turn things were taking, it seemed to Robinson that now had
+come his chance to get a servant, and he resolved to try to save the
+life of the man who was fleeing from the cannibals. At once he hurried
+down the ladder, snatched up his two guns, and running as fast as he
+could, got between the man and his pursuers, calling out to him at the
+same time to stop. The man looked back, and the sight of Robinson
+seemed to frighten him at first as much as did the men who were trying
+to catch him. But Robinson again spoke, and signed to him with his
+hand to come back, and in the meantime went slowly towards the other
+men, who were now coming near. Then, rushing at the foremost, he
+knocked him senseless with the butt of his gun, for it seemed to him
+safer not to fire, lest the noise should bring the other cannibals
+around.
+
+The second man, seeing his comrade fall, hesitated, and stopped, but
+Robinson saw when nearer to him that the savage had in his hands a bow
+and arrow with which he was just about to shoot. There was then no
+choice but to fire first, which Robinson did, killing the man on the
+spot.
+
+Thereupon the man who had been chased by the others was so terrified
+by the flash and noise of the gun, and at seeing his enemy fall dead,
+that he stood stock still, trembling, and it was with great difficulty
+that Robinson coaxed him to come near. This at last he did, stopping
+every few paces and kneeling down. At length, coming close to
+Robinson, he again knelt, kissed the ground, and taking hold of
+Robinson's foot, set it on his head as it rested on the sand.
+
+While this was going on, Robinson noticed that the savage whom he had
+knocked down had begun to move, and to come to his senses. To this he
+drew the attention of the man whom he had rescued, who said some words
+that Robinson could not understand, but which sounded pleasant to an
+ear that had heard no voice but his own for more than twenty-five
+years. Next he made a motion with his hand, as if asking for the
+cutlass that hung at Robinson's belt, and when the weapon was given to
+him he ran at his enemy, and with one clean blow cut off his head.
+Then, laughing, he brought the head, and laid it with the cutlass at
+Robinson's feet.
+
+But what caused most wonder to the man was how the savage whom
+Robinson shot had been killed at so great a distance, and he went to
+look as the body, turning it over and over, and looking long at the
+wound in the breast that the bullet had made, evidently much puzzled.
+
+Robinson then turned to go away, beckoning to the savage to follow,
+but the man made signs that he would bury the two bodies in the sand,
+so that the others might not find them if they followed. With his
+hands he soon scraped holes deep enough to cover the bodies, and in
+less than a quarter of an hour there was hardly a trace left of what
+had happened.
+
+Calling him away, Robinson now took him, not to his castle, but to the
+cave, where he gave him food and water; and then he made signs for him
+to lie down and rest, pointing to a bundle of rice straw.
+
+Soon the man was sound asleep. He was, Robinson thought, a handsome
+and well-made man; the muscles of his arms and back and legs showed
+great strength, and all his limbs were beautifully formed. As near as
+Robinson could guess, he was about twenty-six years of age, with a
+good and manly face, and long black hair. His nose and lips were like
+those of a European, and his teeth were white and even. In color he
+was not black, but of a sort of rich chocolate brown, the skin shining
+with health, and pleasant to look upon.
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+ROBINSON TRAINS FRIDAY, AND THEY BUILD A LARGE BOAT; THEY RESCUE TWO
+PRISONERS FROM THE CANNIBALS
+
+
+In a little while Robinson began to speak to him, and to try to teach
+him things. First he made him understand that his name was to be
+"Friday" (that being the day of the week when Robinson had saved him
+from a horrible death). Then he taught him the meaning of "Yes," and
+"No," and to call Robinson "Master."
+
+Friday showed great quickness in learning. He seemed to be happy and
+contented, and free from trouble, except that the clothes which
+Robinson made him wear gave him at first great discomfort, for in
+those warm parts of the world the natives are not used to clothes, but
+always go about naked.
+
+The day following that on which Robinson had saved Friday, they went
+out together to see if there were any signs of the cannibals still
+being on the island, but it was evident that they had gone away
+without troubling about the two men whom Robinson had killed.
+
+For some time Robinson did not trust Friday, and did not allow him to
+sleep in the same part of his castle with himself, but kept him at
+night in a little tent outside the fence.
+
+Friday was quite faithful, never sulky nor lazy, but always merry, and
+ready to do anything that Robinson told him.
+
+At first when they went out in the woods together, Friday was
+terrified each time that Robinson's gun was fired. He had never seen
+anything like it, and it was more than he could understand how things
+could be killed merely by the noise and the flash of fire.
+
+Friday told Robinson much about his country, and about his people, who
+he said were Caribs. And a great way "beyond the moon," by which he
+meant to the west, he said that white men lived who had beards such as
+Robinson wore. These white men, he said, had killed very many natives,
+from which Robinson fancied that they must be Spaniards, who about
+that time were very cruel to the people whose countries they had
+taken.
+
+Robinson asked if Friday could tell him how he might get over to where
+the white men lived, and Friday said it would be very easy, if they
+had a big canoe, and again Robinson began to make plans and to hope to
+escape from the island.
+
+Some time after this Robinson and Friday chanced to be on the high
+hill at the east end of the island. The day was very clear. Friday
+gazed long over the sea, and then began to jump and dance, pointing to
+the dim blue coast. "There my country! See! There my people live!" he
+said, his eyes sparkling with joy, and an eager light on his face.
+
+After this, for a time Robinson was not easy in his mind about Friday.
+He had little doubt that if he could get back to his tribe, he would
+soon forget all he had been taught, might even return with a hundred
+or two of his friends, and kill and eat his master. But in this
+Robinson was very unjust to Friday, who had no such thoughts in his
+mind as those of which he was suspected. And this Robinson soon found
+out. One day he asked Friday if he would not be glad to be once more
+in his own land.
+
+"Yes" said Friday; "very glad."
+
+"Would you eat man's flesh again?"
+
+"No, never," said Friday.
+
+Then Robinson asked why he did not go back. Friday said he would go if
+Robinson came too.
+
+Then Robinson, who thought if he could reach other white men, he would
+finally reach England, began to build a boat in which to leave the
+island. Together he and Friday went to work to fell a tree, and Friday
+soon showed that he knew far better than Robinson the kind of tree
+best suited for boat-making. Robinson showed him how to use tools, and
+in a little more than a month the boat was finished. After the boat
+was put into the water, Robinson was astonished at Friday's skill in
+paddling so large a canoe.
+
+"Will she do to go over in?" he asked, and Friday, grinning, said,
+"Yes, even if big wind blow." But Robinson did not mean to depend on
+paddling, and fitted the boat with a mast, sails and rudder.
+
+Twenty-six years had passed since Robinson came to the island, and he
+still went on digging and sowing. One morning he sent Friday down to
+the beach for a turtle. Back he came in a great hurry, crying out,
+"Master! Master! over yonder, one, two, three canoe." Loading his
+guns, Robinson gave them to Friday to carry, while he armed himself
+with muskets, a cutlass, and a hatchet.
+
+When all was ready he went up the hill with his telescope, and saw
+that there were in all twenty-one savages, with three prisoners, one
+of whom was a white man.
+
+Robinson knew the savages had landed on the island to kill and eat
+their prisoners, so he resolved to prevent them if possible. To get at
+the savages without being seen, they had to go nearly a mile out of
+their way, and being heavily laden they could not go very fast.
+Reaching the place, they saw, from behind a clump of bushes, the white
+man bound hand and foot on the sand. There was no time to lose, and
+their first shot killed three and wounded five of the savages.
+Snatching up fresh guns, both fired again, before the savages who were
+not hurt could get on their feet, for they were so taken by surprise,
+that the poor wretches hardly knew what was happening. This time only
+two dropped, but many more were wounded.
+
+While Friday kept on firing, Robinson ran to the white prisoner and
+cut his bonds. The man said he was a Spaniard and began to thank
+Robinson for what he had done. Robinson handed him the cutlass and a
+pistol, telling him, if he had any strength left, to go and do what he
+could against the savages. As soon as the man got the weapons in his
+hands, he ran with fury at the cannibals and cut two down, and with
+equal fury attacked the rest. With the Spaniard to help them, Robinson
+and Friday were soon able to clear the place of these dreadful
+cannibals, many of whom jumped into the sea.
+
+Friday advised Robinson to take a canoe and go after them lest they
+return with hundreds of others to avenge the death of their friends.
+So the two ran to the beach and began to shove off a canoe. But to
+their surprise, on the bottom of the canoe lay another prisoner, an
+old man, tied so hard, neck and heels, that even when his bonds were
+cut he could not move.
+
+No sooner did Friday look at him and hear him speak, than he began to
+dance and shout and laugh, and then kneeling down, rubbed noses with
+the savage (which is what these folks do instead of kissing each
+other), and he was so excited that for some time he could not explain
+what was the matter. As soon as he could speak, he told Robinson that
+the man whom they had found was his father.
+
+Both Friday's father and the Spaniard, who was worn out with fighting,
+had to be carried up to the castle.
+
+No cannibals were ever again known to visit this island.
+
+
+
+
+VII
+
+ARRIVAL OF AN ENGLISH SHIP; ROBINSON SAILS FOR HOME
+
+
+Soon after this Robinson had a long talk with the Spaniard, who told
+him how he and his comrades had been wrecked four years since, on that
+part of the coast where Friday's tribe lived. He said that they were
+well treated by the natives, but that they were put to very great
+straits now for want of clothes, that their powder was finished, and
+that they had lost all hope of ever getting back to their own country.
+He himself, he said, had been captured in one of the many small wars
+that are always taking place among the various tribes.
+
+It struck Robinson that it might be possible for him to get these men
+over to his island, provided that he could be sure of their good
+faith, and that when they came, they did not take the island from him
+by treachery. It was a risk, he thought, but then, if he got so many
+men, it would not be difficult to build a small ship that could carry
+them all to England.
+
+So he asked the Spaniard if he would promise, and if he thought he
+could get his comrades to take an oath that, if Robinson helped them,
+they would look on him as their captain, and would swear to obey him
+in all things. The Spaniard readily promised for himself, and said
+that he was sure his comrades would keep faith.
+
+It was arranged, therefore, that in about six months, when the next
+harvest was reaped, and there would be plenty of food for so many
+extra men, the Spaniard and Friday's father should go over to the
+mainland in one of the canoes which had been taken from the savages.
+
+Meantime, all hands set about the curing of very large quantities of
+raisins, and much other work was done to be in readiness for the
+coming of these men.
+
+When the harvest was reaped, Robinson gave the Spaniard and Friday's
+father each a musket and a supply of powder and bullets, and loaded
+the canoe with food, enough to last them and the others about a
+fortnight, and the two men set off for the mainland in fine weather,
+and with a fair wind.
+
+It was about eight days after this, and when Robinson had begun to
+look out for their return, that one morning very early, when Robinson
+was asleep, Friday came running in, shouting, "Master! Master! They
+come." Up jumped Robinson, and hurrying on his clothes, ran out.
+
+Looking towards the sea, he soon made out a sailing-boat making for
+the shore, coming from the south end of the island, but still some
+miles away. This was not the direction from which the Spaniard and his
+comrades would come, nor were they likely to be in a sailing-boat. So
+Robinson took his telescope, and went to the top of the hill to see if
+he could make out who were on board, before they landed.
+
+Hardly had he got on to the hill when he noticed a ship at anchor some
+distance from the shore. She looked like an English vessel, he
+thought, and the boat like an English long-boat.
+
+This was a wonderful sight to Robinson, but yet he was not easy in his
+mind. It was not a part of the world where an English ship was likely
+to come, because in those days they were nearly all Spanish vessels
+that traded in these seas, and the English and Spaniards were bitter
+enemies. What could an English ship be doing here? There had been no
+storm to drive her out of her course.
+
+Robinson feared that if she was English there must be something wrong
+about her. Perhaps, he thought, she was a pirate. So he was careful
+not to show himself or Friday.
+
+Presently, as he watched, he saw the men in the boat run her ashore
+and draw her up on the beach, about half a mile from his castle. When
+they had landed, he could easily see through his glass that they were
+Englishmen.
+
+There were eleven men, but three of them had their hands tied behind
+their backs, and were evidently prisoners. When the first four or five
+men had jumped ashore, they brought out these three, all the while
+ill-treating them, and behaving as if they meant to kill their
+prisoners. Friday was sure that they meant to eat them.
+
+Soon, without further harming the three men, the others scattered
+about among the trees near the shore, leaving the three sitting on the
+ground very sad-looking, but with their hands now untied.
+
+At the time the boat was run aground, it was just high-water, and the
+two sailors who had been left in charge of her, and who had evidently
+been drinking too much rum, went to sleep, and never noticed that the
+tide was going out. When they woke, the boat was high and dry, and
+with all the strength of the whole crew they could not move her,
+because the sand at that part of the beach was very soft. This did not
+seem to trouble any of them very much, for Robinson heard one of the
+sailors shout, "Let her alone, Jack, can't ye? She'll float next
+tide."
+
+All forenoon Robinson watched, and when the hottest time of the day
+had come, he noticed the sailors throw themselves down under the
+trees, and go to sleep, some distance away from the three prisoners.
+
+Then Robinson and Friday, taking their muskets and pistols, stole down
+cautiously behind the three men, to try to speak to them without the
+others knowing.
+
+Robinson had put on his goatskin coat and the great hairy hat that he
+had made for himself; and with his cutlass and pistols in his belt,
+and a gun over each shoulder, he looked very fierce.
+
+The men did not see him till he spoke, and they were so startled by
+his wild look, and by the sight of two men armed to the teeth, that
+they nearly ran away. But Robinson told them not to be alarmed; he was
+an Englishman, and a friend, and would help them if they would show
+him how it could be done.
+
+Then they explained to him what had happened. One of the three was
+Captain of the ship that lay at anchor off the island. Of the others,
+one was mate of the ship, and the third man was a passenger. The crew
+had mutinied, the Captain told Robinson, and had put him and the other
+two in irons, and the ringleaders in the mutiny had proposed to kill
+them. Now they meant to leave them on the island to perish.
+
+The Captain was so astonished at finding anybody there who proposed to
+help him, that he said in his wonder: "Am I talking to a man, or to an
+angel from heaven?"
+
+"If the Lord had sent an angel, sir," said Robinson, "he would
+probably have come better clothed."
+
+Then he asked if the boat's crew had any firearms, and was told that
+they had only two muskets, one of which was left in the boat. "The
+rest should be easy, then," Robinson said; "we can either kill them
+all, or take them prisoners, as we please."
+
+The Captain was unwilling to see the men killed, for he said if two of
+the worst of them were got rid of, he believed the rest would return
+to their duty.
+
+Robinson made a bargain that if he saved the Captain from the
+mutineers, and recovered the ship, he and Friday were to be taken home
+to England in her, free of cost; and to this the Captain and the
+others agreed.
+
+Then Robinson gave each of them a musket, with powder and ball, after
+which the Captain and the mate and the passenger marched towards the
+spot where the mutinous sailors lay asleep. One of the men heard them
+advance, and turning round, saw them, and cried out to his companions.
+But it was too late, the mate and the passenger fired, and one of the
+ringleaders fell dead. A second man also fell, but jumped up
+immediately and called to the others to help him. But the Captain
+knocked him down with the butt of his musket, and the rest of the
+men, seeing Robinson and Friday coming, and knowing they had no chance
+against five armed men, begged for mercy. Three others who had been
+straying about among the trees came back on hearing the shots, and
+were also taken, and thus the whole crew of the boat was captured.
+
+The Captain and Robinson now began to think how they might recover the
+ship. There were on board, the Captain said, several men on whom he
+thought he could depend, and who had been forced by the others into
+the mutiny against their wills. But it would be no easy thing to
+retake the ship, for there were still twenty-six men on board, and as
+they were guilty of mutiny, all of them, if taken back to England,
+would most likely be hanged. Thus they were certain to make a fight
+for it.
+
+The first thing that Robinson and the others now did was to take
+everything out of the boat--oars, and mast, and sail, and rudder; then
+they knocked a hole in her bottom, so that she could not float. While
+they were doing this, and drawing her still further up on the beach,
+they heard first one gun and then another fired by the ship as signals
+to the boat to return.
+
+As she of course did not move, Robinson saw through his glass another
+boat with ten men on board, armed with muskets, leave the ship, coming
+to bring the others back.
+
+This was serious enough, for now Robinson and his party had to make
+plans whereby they might capture also this fresh boat's crew.
+Accordingly, they tied the hands of all the men they had first taken,
+and sent the worst of them to the cave under the charge of Friday and
+of one of the men that the Captain said was to be trusted, with orders
+to shoot any who tried to give an alarm or to escape. Then Robinson
+took his party and the rest of the prisoners into the castle, where,
+from the rock, they watched for the landing of the second boat.
+
+The Captain and mate were very nervous, and despaired of taking this
+fresh body of men, but Robinson was quite confident of success, and
+put heart into them by his cheerfulness.
+
+Of the prisoners in his castle, there were two whom the Captain
+believed to be honest men, and on their promising solemnly to keep
+faith, and to fight for him, Robinson released them.
+
+The crew of the second boat, when they landed, were terribly
+surprised to find the first boat empty and stove in, and they were
+seen anxiously consulting what to do. Then they hallooed and fired
+volleys. Getting no reply, they were evidently alarmed, for they all
+jumped into their boat and began to pull off to the ship. In a few
+minutes, however, they seemed to change their minds, for again they
+landed, this time leaving three men in charge of the boat, and keeping
+her in the water. The other seven came ashore, and started in a body
+across the island to look for their lost comrades. But they did not
+care to go far, and soon stopped, again firing volleys and hallooing.
+Getting again no reply, they began to march back to the sea. Whereupon
+Robinson ordered Friday and the mate to go over the creek to the west
+and halloo loudly, and wait till the sailors answered. Then Friday and
+the mate were to go further away and again halloo, thus gradually
+getting the men to follow them away from shore.
+
+This plan succeeded very well, for when the sailors, thinking they
+heard their missing friends hail, ran to find them, their way was
+stopped by the creek, over which they had to get the boat to carry
+them. They took with them, then, one of the three men whom they had
+left in the boat, and ordered the others to moor the boat to a tree,
+and remain there.
+
+This was just what Robinson wanted. And, moreover, one of the men
+played still further into his hands, for he left the boat and lay down
+under a tree to sleep. On him the Captain rushed, and knocked him down
+as he tried to rise to his feet, whereupon the sailor left in the boat
+yielded, and more readily that he had joined the mutineers very
+unwillingly, and was now glad of the chance to rejoin his Captain.
+
+Meantime Friday and the mate, by hallooing and answering, drew the
+rest of the boat's crew from hill to hill through the woods, till at
+last they had got them so far astray that it was not possible for them
+to find their way back before dark. When they did get back to where
+the boat had been left, and found the men whom they had left in her
+gone, they were in a terrible fright.
+
+It was not difficult for Robinson and his men to surround them, and
+it chanced that the boatswain of the ship, who was the greatest
+villain of the lot, and the chief cause of all the trouble, walked in
+the darkness close to the Captain, who jumped up and shot him dead.
+The others then surrendered, believing what they were told, that they
+were surrounded by fifty armed men. All begged hard for their lives,
+and a few whom the Captain said he could trust were set at liberty on
+promising to help retake the ship. The others were bound and put in
+the cave.
+
+Robinson and Friday remained on shore to look after the prisoners,
+while the Captain and the mate and the passenger, with those of the
+crew who were trustworthy, having patched up the damaged boat, pulled
+off in her and in the other to the ship, which they reached about
+midnight. When they were a short distance off, the Captain made one of
+the crew hail the ship and say that they had brought off the boat and
+the men they had gone in search of. Then both boats ran alongside at
+once, one on each side of the vessel, and before the mutineers knew
+what was happening they were overpowered, one or two of them being
+killed. Only one of the Captain's party was hurt, the mate, whose arm
+was broken by a musket-ball.
+
+As soon as the ship was secured, the Captain ordered seven guns to be
+fired, that being the signal he had agreed to make to let Robinson
+know if he succeeded in taking the ship.
+
+Robinson's stay in the island had now come to an end, after more than
+twenty-eight years, for in a few days he and Friday sailed for England
+in the ship. Some of the mutineers were left on the island, and were
+afterwards joined by the Spaniard and his comrades, for whom Robinson
+left a letter.
+
+Robinson did not forget, when he left, to take with him the money and
+gold bars he had got from the wreck of the Spanish ship, and he took
+also, as a memento, the goatskin coat and the great hairy hat. But the
+Captain was able before the ship sailed to give him proper clothing,
+the wearing of which at first put him to dreadful discomfort.
+
+The voyage was a long one, but they sighted the English coast at last.
+
+It was thirty-five years since Robinson had set foot in England. And
+that morning, when at last, after the weary years of exile, he again
+saw his native land, he laid his head down on his arms and cried like
+a child.
+
+And, may be, you too some day may know the joy of coming home, out of
+the land of bondage.
+
+
+
+
+CANTERBURY TALES
+
+By GEOFFREY CHAUCER
+
+ADAPTED BY JANET HARVEY KELMAN
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+DORIGEN
+
+
+Once upon a time a young knight, whose name was Arviragus, dwelt in
+Brittany. In the same country lived a beautiful lady called Dorigen.
+And the knight loved the lady.
+
+For years Arviragus did not know whether she loved him or not. She was
+a great lady and very fair, and he was afraid to ask her. But she knew
+that he loved her, for when he rode past her window on his way to the
+wars, she could see her colors streaming from his helmet. At first she
+did not think much of this, for many knights fought for love of her;
+but as she heard of new and greater deeds that this noble knight did
+year by year, she began to care for him a great deal. When she thought
+of his goodness and of the honor in which he held her, she knew that
+there was no one else that she could love as she loved Arviragus. And
+when Arviragus knew that she loved him and was willing to be his wife,
+his heart was full of joy. So greatly did he wish to make Dorigen
+happy with him, that he said to her that he would obey her and do what
+she wished as gladly all his life as he had done while he was trying
+to win her love. To this she replied:
+
+"Sir, since in thy great gentleness thou givest me so high a place, I
+pray to God that there may never be strife between us two by any fault
+of mine. Sir, I will be thy true and humble wife until I die!"
+
+Then Arviragus took his bride home with him to his castle by the sea.
+He honored Dorigen as much as he had done before his marriage, and
+tried to fulfil her wishes in everything. Dorigen was just as eager to
+please Arviragus as he was to please her, and they were happy together
+in all their work and play.
+
+Arviragus stayed quietly at home for a year, but after that he grew
+restless. He felt that no true knight had a right to live on quietly
+at home, with nothing to do except to order his castle and to hunt. So
+he sailed away to England that he might win honor and renown in the
+wars there.
+
+Dorigen stood by the castle and watched his sails disappear in the
+north. Poor Dorigen! her husband was gone, and she did not know if he
+would ever come back to her. For weeks she wept and mourned. At night
+she could not rest, and by day she would not eat. All the things that
+she had cared most to do were now dull and worthless to her because
+Arviragus was away.
+
+Her friends saw her sorrow, and tried to comfort her in every way they
+could. When they found she would not be comforted, they spoke harshly
+to her, and told her that it was very wrong of her to kill herself
+with sorrow, when Arviragus hoped to come home again strong and
+famous. Then they began to comfort her again, and to try to make her
+forget her sadness.
+
+After a long time Dorigen's sorrow began to grow quieter. She could
+not have lived if she had always felt her grief as deeply as she did
+at first. Indeed, as it was, this sorrow would have broken her heart,
+if letters had not come from Arviragus. They brought her tidings of
+his doings, and of the glory he had won. But what comforted her most
+was that they told her that he would soon return.
+
+When Dorigen's friends saw that she was less hopeless, they begged her
+to come and roam with them to drive away the last of her dark fears.
+This she did. Often she walked with them by the edge of the cliffs on
+which her castle stood. But there she saw the white ships and the
+brown barges sailing, one north, another south, to the havens for
+which they were bound. Then she would turn away from her friends and
+say to herself:
+
+"Alas! of all the ships I see, is there never one that will bring my
+lord home? Then should I need no comfort. My heart would be cured of
+this bitter smart."
+
+At times as she sat and thought, she leaned down and looked over the
+brink of the cliffs. But, when she saw the grisly, black rocks, her
+very heart trembled within her. Then she would sink down on the grass
+and wail:
+
+"O God, men say Thou hast made nothing in vain, but, Lord, why hast
+Thou made these black, grisly rocks? No man nor beast is helped by
+them in all the world. Rocks have destroyed a hundred thousand men,
+and which of all Thy works is so fair as man? No doubt wise men will
+say, 'All is for the best.' But, oh Thou God, who makest the winds to
+blow, keep Thou my lord! And--would to God that these black rocks were
+sunk in the deep for his sake! They slay my heart with fear."
+
+Dorigen's friends saw that the sea brought back her sorrow. They led
+her then by rivers and springs, and took her to every lovely place
+they knew, from which there was no glimpse of the sea.
+
+In the valley, to landward of the castle, lay many beautiful gardens.
+One day in May, when the soft showers of spring had painted in
+brightest colors the leaves and flowers, they spent the whole day in
+the fairest of these gardens. They had games there, and they dined
+under a spreading tree. The breath of the fresh green leaves and the
+sweet scent of the flowers blew round them.
+
+After dinner they began to dance and sing--every one except Dorigen.
+She had no heart to sing, and she would not dance because, of all who
+joined in the dance, not one was Arviragus. But, though she would not
+dance, she watched her friends and sometimes forgot her sorrow for a
+little.
+
+Among the dancers there was a young squire named Aurelius. He was much
+beloved because he was young, and strong, and handsome. Men thought
+him wise and good, but he was not always wise and good.
+
+When the dancing was over, Aurelius came up to Dorigen and asked her
+to give him a beautiful jewel that she wore on her breast. He said to
+her, "Madam, of what use is thy jewel to thee when thou wearest it on
+thy bosom? Give it to me, and I will share with thee the price of it."
+
+Dorigen turned and gazed at him.
+
+"Is this what thou dost wish? I knew not what thou didst mean when
+thou didst look at me, but now I know. Listen, this is all I have to
+say to thee. I shall never part with my jewel, not though I were in
+rags and without food."
+
+Then she remembered how Arviragus had loved to see her wear her jewel,
+as she always did, on a chain of gold that he had given to her on her
+wedding day. She thought of the sea that separated him from her, and
+of the cruel black rocks, and said in play:
+
+"Aurelius, I will freely give thee my jewel when thou dost remove
+every rock on the shore from end to end of Brittany."
+
+Then her anger at the selfishness of Aurelius rose again, and she bade
+him begone.
+
+"Madam," he said, "it is impossible to move the rocks."
+
+With that word he turned away, and went home to his own house. There
+his brother Austin found him in a trance, for Aurelius wished
+Dorigen's jewel more than he wished anything else on earth, and the
+thought that he could not get it made him so sad that he became dazed.
+Austin carried him to bed, and tried to soothe him in his grief and
+vexation.
+
+The jewel that Aurelius wished to get from Dorigen was no common one.
+It had been given to her at her birth. It was clear as crystal, but
+far more rare, and it shone in the daylight like the sun. When Dorigen
+was a little child her mother told her of this wonderful stone. She
+told her that it would bring her joy and peace and the love of all who
+were good and true, if she kept it bright and pure; but that, if she
+ever gave it away, she would lose her youth and her beauty, and would
+be hidden away from all her friends and left alone in the world.
+
+Dorigen shuddered at the thought of parting with her jewel. She did
+not know how her mother's words could come to pass, if she did give it
+away, nor by what magic power she could be so lost that no one who
+loved her could find her again. But she was sure that what her mother
+had said must be true.
+
+And that was why Dorigen was so angry with Aurelius. She knew that he
+must have heard what sorrow she would suffer if she gave him her
+jewel, for all the court knew the story of the wonderful stone.
+
+Not long after this, Arviragus came home. He had won more honor than
+before, and was now the very flower of chivalry. I cannot tell you how
+great the joy was, with which he greeted Dorigen, nor how soon she
+forgot her fears of the sea and the grisly rocks.
+
+For two years, while they lived a joyful life together, Aurelius lay
+in bed unable to rise, with no one to take care of him except his
+brother Austin. This brother mourned over Aurelius in secret and wept
+at his unhappy fate, till one day he remembered a book of magic that
+he had seen when he was a student in Orleans. In that book he had read
+of the strange ways in which Magicians can make things seem what they
+are not. His heart leapt up. He said to himself, "My brother shall be
+cured. I am sure I have heard of stranger things than that the rocks
+should seem to vanish. Once I heard of a Magician who made every one
+believe that a great brown barge was rowing up and down a sheet of
+water inside the hall of a castle! If he could do that, then surely we
+shall be able to find a Magician who will make those black rocks seem
+to vanish. Then Dorigen will have to keep her promise and give
+Aurelius her wonderful jewel."
+
+Austin then ran to his brother's room and told him about the book of
+magic at Orleans. No sooner had Aurelius heard him than he leapt out
+of bed. In less time than one would think possible he was ready to
+start on the long ride to Orleans.
+
+When they came near the city they met a Magician. They knew him to be
+a Magician because of the strange look in his eyes, and because of his
+curious dress. When they rode up to him he bowed before them and
+wished them "Good day." Then he began to tell them why they had come
+to Orleans. Aurelius wondered how it was that this stranger knew so
+much about him and his errand. He thought he must be a very wise man
+indeed, and leaping from his horse in surprise and joy, he went home
+with the Magician to his house. His brother went too.
+
+The house was the finest that Aurelius had ever seen. When he entered
+the study he looked in wonder at the rows of books that lined the
+walls, and at the quaint pictures and the strange old armor.
+
+In one corner a curious light burned. It was not like the light of a
+lamp or of a candle, but cold and blue. Above it hung a map of the
+stars, and other strange drawings. Below the light stood a table, and
+on it lay a great book which was chained to the wall.
+
+Austin saw Aurelius look at this book. He whispered to him, "It is the
+same book from which I read long ago."
+
+This corner with its blue light made Aurelius frightened. A shudder
+passed over him when he saw the Magician cross over into the circle of
+the light and wave his wand.
+
+In a moment Aurelius forgot all about the Magician and his own fear,
+for he and his brother saw before them the edge of a forest with a
+park stretching from the trees far, far away.
+
+The sun shone, and the branches waved a little in the breeze. In the
+park the brothers saw herds of deer. Beautiful animals they were, with
+the highest antlers deer ever had. At first the deer fed in peace and
+safety. Then archers, clad in green, came to the edge of the forest.
+They glided out and in among the trees to see where they could best
+take aim with their arrows. When the archers had let their arrows fly,
+hounds broke out from behind them, and soon there was not one living
+deer of all the herd left in sight.
+
+In a moment a calm river flowed where the park had been. In the
+shallow water at the river's edge tall herons stood. They watched for
+the little fishes that swam in the river. Again, into this quiet place
+a hunter came. He had no arrows. He had no dogs. But on his wrist he
+had an iron bracelet to which one end of a chain was fastened. The
+other end of the chain was round a hawk's foot, and the hawk sat on
+his master's wrist. When the hunter came near the river he loosed the
+chain from the bird's foot. The hawk flew over the river and swooped
+down among the herons. In a moment they had all vanished.
+
+Aurelius had scarcely time to sigh, when the river itself was gone,
+and a plain lay where it had been. There he saw the knights of King
+Arthur's Table jousting. Beautiful ladies sat and watched the
+struggle, and one more fair than all held the prizes the knights might
+win.
+
+Then the figures of the knights began to grow dim and uncertain. The
+plain changed into a great hall where knights and ladies danced.
+Everything was bright and sparkling. Mirrors lined the walls, and
+their cut edges flashed back the light that fell on them. As Aurelius
+watched the dance, he started. There, before him, more beautiful than
+ever, was Dorigen. His heart gave a great leap, for, as he watched
+her, he saw that she no longer wore her jewel. In his delight he
+swayed to the music of the dance. Clap! clap! went the Magician's
+hands, and all was gone.
+
+The great room that had seemed so splendid to Aurelius when he entered
+it, looked cold and plain now when he returned to it from fairyland.
+
+The Magician called his servant and asked for supper. Then he led the
+brothers away and feasted them royally.
+
+After supper the three men began to talk about what the Magician
+should get from Aurelius if he made the rocks vanish. The Magician
+said, "I cannot take less than a thousand pounds, and I am not sure if
+I can do it for that!" Aurelius was too delighted to bargain about
+what the cost would be. He said gladly: "What is a thousand pounds? I
+would give thee the whole round world, if I were lord of it. The
+bargain is made. Thou shalt be paid in full. But do not delay. Let us
+start to-morrow morning without fail."
+
+"Thou mayest count on me to-morrow," said the Magician.
+
+They went to bed, and Aurelius slept soundly and well; because of the
+hope he had that the Magician would make the rocks vanish.
+
+Next morning they rose early. It was Christmas time, and the air was
+cold and frosty as they rode away. The very sunlight was pale, and the
+trees were bare. When they reached home the neighbors gathered round
+and wished them a Merry Christmas. "Noel, Noel," they said, but they
+would not have done so had they known what sorrow the riders brought
+to their beautiful lady Dorigen.
+
+For many days the Magician worked with his maps and figures. Aurelius
+waited impatiently. There was nothing for him to do except to make the
+Magician as comfortable as he could, and to show him as much kindness
+as possible.
+
+One morning Aurelius looked from his window towards the sea. He saw
+the Magician standing on the shore. As Aurelius gazed out to sea, the
+rocks vanished from north to south. His heart stood still. Then he
+rushed out and away to the edge of the cliffs for fear some rocks
+might still lie close to the land. But no, there was not one.
+
+He went to meet the Magician and fell at his feet with the words,
+"Thanks to thee, my lord, thanks to thee, my cares are gone!"
+
+After he had thanked the Wise Man, he hurried away to meet Dorigen.
+When he saw her he trembled. She was so pure and beautiful. His heart
+sank. Then he looked out to sea and saw the smooth surface of the
+water, and he grew selfish again.
+
+Dorigen came quietly on. She had not noticed that the rocks had
+vanished, for Arviragus was safe on land, and she did not fear the sea
+any more. She had almost forgotten Aurelius and his selfish, greedy
+words. It was more than two years since she had seen him, and she had
+not heard of him since then.
+
+She started back when he greeted her. Before she had time to speak he
+said, "My lady, give me thy jewel."
+
+He saw Dorigen's face grow cold and angry, and said, "Think well lest
+thou break thy word, for, madam, thou knowest well what thou didst
+say. In yonder garden in the month of May thou didst promise to give
+me thy jewel when I should move the rocks. I speak to save thine
+honor. I have done as thou didst command me. Go thou and see if thou
+wilt, but well I know the rocks are vanished."
+
+He left her then. She stood still, white and sick. She had never
+dreamt that such a trap as this could close on her.
+
+"Alas," she said, "that such a thing could happen! I never thought a
+thing so strange and unheard-of could come to pass!"
+
+Home she went in sadness and dismay. She was so weak with fear that
+she could scarcely walk. She had to suffer her sorrow alone for three
+days, for Arviragus was away, and she would tell no one but him. Her
+ladies saw her distress, but they could not comfort her. To herself
+she moaned, "Alas, O Fortune, I lay the blame on thee; thou hast so
+bound me in thy chain, that I see no help nor escape save only in
+death."
+
+Arviragus came home on the third day after the rocks had vanished. He
+came at night, so he noticed nothing strange about the shore. Though
+every one was talking of the curious thing that had happened, no one
+liked to tell him. They knew he would not like to hear of it. He would
+think his country was bewitched.
+
+Arviragus looked for Dorigen in the hall. When he could not see her
+there, he hurried to her room, to make sure that she was safe and
+well. As he sprang up the broad staircase, the sheath of his sword and
+the spurs at his heels clanked harshly on the stone steps.
+
+Dorigen heard him, but, instead of going to meet him, she buried her
+head deeper in her cushions and wept. Arviragus crossed the room to
+where she sat, and knelt before her. He drew her hands from her eyes
+and said, "Dorigen, what is it? Why dost thou weep like this, my
+beloved?"
+
+For a little time Dorigen's tears only fell the faster, then she said
+brokenly: "Alas, that ever I was born! I have said it! Arviragus! I
+have promised!"
+
+"What hast thou promised, my wife?"
+
+Then Dorigen told Arviragus all that had happened; told him that she
+had promised to give her jewel to Aurelius when he would take all the
+rocks away.
+
+Arviragus leapt up and went to the window. The moon had burst through
+a cloud, and everything was bright and clear. He looked away north, as
+Dorigen had so often looked to watch for his coming. In the moonlight
+Arviragus saw the sea lie smooth and cold. His eyes swept the skyline.
+It seemed as as if all the rocks had sunk into his heart, it was so
+heavy.
+
+He turned towards Dorigen, and saw how great was her sorrow.
+
+Then he said very gently: "Is there aught else than this, that thou
+shouldst weep, Dorigen?"
+
+"Nay, nay, this is indeed too much already," she sighed.
+
+"Dear wife," he said, "something as wonderful as the sinking of the
+rocks may happen to save us yet. God grant it! But whether or not,
+thou must keep thy troth. I had rather that my great love for thee
+caused me to die, than that thou shouldest break thy promise. Truth is
+the highest thing that man may keep."
+
+Then his courage broke down, and he began to sob and weep along with
+Dorigen.
+
+Next morning he was strong and brave again. He said to Dorigen, "I
+will bear up under this great sorrow."
+
+He bade her farewell, and she set out with only a maid and a squire to
+follow her.
+
+Arviragus could not bear to see Dorigen as she went down from the
+castle, so he hid himself in an inner room. But some one saw her go
+out. It was Aurelius. For three days he had watched the castle gate to
+see what she did, and where she went. He came forward and said,
+"Whither goest thou?"
+
+Dorigen was almost mad with misery, but she said bravely, "To thee, to
+keep my troth, and give my jewel to thee, as my husband bids me. Alas!
+alas!"
+
+Aurelius was full of wonder when he heard this. He began to be sorry
+for Dorigen, and for Arviragus the worthy knight, who would rather
+lose his wife than have her break her word. He could be cruel no
+longer.
+
+"Madam," he said, "say to thy lord Arviragus that since I see his
+great honor and thy sad distress, I had rather bear my own sorrow than
+drive thee away from him and all thy friends. I give thee back thy
+promise. I shall never trouble thee more. Farewell, farewell! thou
+truest woman and best that I have ever seen."
+
+Down on her knees, on the roadway, fell Dorigen to thank Aurelius. Her
+blessing followed him as he turned and left her.
+
+But how can I tell of Dorigen's return? She seemed to be treading on
+air. When she reached the room where her husband sat with his head
+sunk on his arms, she paused. She had not known the greatness of his
+love till then. He looked old and forlorn after the night of sorrow.
+
+She spoke, and he raised his eyes to gaze on her, as if she had been a
+lady in a dream. But when she told him all, when he knew that she was
+there herself, and for always, he could not speak for joy.
+
+Aurelius wished he had never been born when he thought of the thousand
+pounds of pure gold that he owed to the Magician.
+
+He said to himself, "What shall I do? I am undone! I must sell my
+house and be a beggar. I will not stay here and make my friends
+ashamed of me, unless I can get the Magician to give me time. I will
+ask him to let me pay him part of my debt year by year till all is
+paid. If he will, my gratitude will know no bounds, and I will pay him
+every penny I owe."
+
+With a sore heart he went to his coffer and took out five hundred
+pounds of gold. These he took to the Wise Man, and begged him to grant
+him time to pay the rest.
+
+"Master," said he, "I can say truly, I never yet failed to keep a
+promise. My debt shall be paid to thee, even if I go begging in rags.
+But if thou wilt be so gracious as to allow me two years, or three, in
+which to pay the, rest, I will rejoice. If not, I must sell my house;
+there is no other way."
+
+When the Magician heard this he said, "Have not I kept my promise to
+thee?"
+
+"Yes, certainly, well and truly!"
+
+"Hast thou not thy jewel?"
+
+"No, no," said Aurelius, and sighed deeply.
+
+"Tell me, if thou mayest, what is the cause of this?"
+
+"Arviragus in his honor had rather die in sorrow and distress than
+that his wife should break her word. Dorigen would rather die than
+lose her husband and wander alone on the earth. She did not mean to
+give me her promise. She thought the rocks would never move. I pitied
+them so much that I gave her back her promise as freely as she brought
+her jewel to me. That is the whole story!"
+
+The Magician answered, "Dear brother, you have each behaved nobly.
+Thou art a squire, he is a knight, but by God's grace I can do a noble
+deed as well as another. Sir, thou art free from thy debt to me, as
+free as if thou hadst this moment crept out of the ground, and hadst
+never known me till now. For, sir, I will not take a penny from thee
+for all my skill, nor for all my work. It is enough! Farewell! Good
+day to thee!"
+
+Whereupon the Magician bowed once and again, mounted his horse, and
+rode away.
+
+Dorigen and Arviragus were walking on the cliffs as the Magician
+parted from Aurelius. They noticed the two men, and when the horseman
+rode away they saw a strange white mist rise from the sea and follow
+the rider.
+
+Dorigen caught her husband's arm, for there, there, out at sea, and
+close by the cliffs, were the rocks, grisly and black and fearsome as
+before. The sunlight fell on her jewel, and it shone more brightly
+than of old, nor did its light ever grow dim in all the happy years
+that followed.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+EMELIA
+
+
+Emelia the Radiant lived in a great castle in Athens.
+
+Hippolyta, Emelia's sister, had once been queen of the Warrior Women,
+and had led her armies to battle. But Emelia had never fought in these
+battles. When she was still a child, Duke Theseus of Athens had fought
+with Hippolyta and conquered her. Instead of sending his royal captive
+to prison, Theseus married her, and took her home to Athens with him.
+When he took her there, he took Emelia with her. He was very kind to
+them both, and the castle in Athens was a happy home for Hippolyta and
+her little sister.
+
+As Emelia grew up she became most beautiful. She was more graceful
+than a lily on its stem, and the flush on her cheeks was more delicate
+than the hue of the rose-petals in the old Greek castle garden. Her
+golden hair fell in heavy masses round her face, and lay in a great
+plait down her back. It caught all the light that fell on it, and sent
+it out again to make glad the hearts of those who looked on her. So
+men called her Emelia the Radiant, and all who met her smiled for joy
+at the sight of so beautiful a maid.
+
+One May morning Emelia went into the castle garden to bathe her face
+in the early dew. Everything was dim and gray in the twilight. She
+looked up at the great dungeon tower which overshadowed the garden,
+and thought of the two young princes who were prisoners there. Duke
+Theseus had brought them from Thebes. He was very proud of them, and
+would not give them up, although the people of their land offered to
+give him gold and jewels for their ransom. The princes were cousins,
+and were the last of the royal line of Thebes. In the stillness Emelia
+murmured their names to herself, "Palamon and Arcite, Palamon and
+Arcite. How miserable they must be in their narrow cell!" she thought.
+Then she sighed that life should be so sad for them while it was so
+bright for her!
+
+As she roamed up and down and gathered roses white and red to make a
+garland for her hair, the sun broke through the mist and shone into
+the garden. Once more she raised her eyes to the tower. This time she
+did not look at it, but at the sunlit clouds beyond. The light from
+the east fell on her. Her hair shone like gold, and her face was
+radiant with happiness.
+
+Palamon at that moment came to the narrow iron-barred window through
+which alone he and his cousin could see the sky and the fields and the
+city. He saw the morning light fall on the fair buildings of Athens,
+and on the plains and hills beyond. Then a glad song which burst from
+Emelia's happy heart floated up to him. He looked down. Before him
+stood the maiden bathed in sunlight.
+
+She seemed to him the very Spirit of Beauty. He thought of all the joy
+and life and freedom that he could never have. He started back from
+the window and cried aloud.
+
+His cousin Arcite sprang from his couch and said, "My cousin, what
+aileth thee? I pray thee that thou bear our imprisonment in patience.
+Sad it is in truth, but we must abide it. We can do nought else."
+
+But Palamon said: "Thou art mistaken. Prison walls drew not that cry
+from me. An arrow hath entered my heart through mine eye, and I am
+wounded. What life can give is bound up for me in the fairness of a
+maiden who roams in yonder garden. Be she Spirit or woman I know not!
+But this I know, was never woman nor Spirit half so fair before."
+
+"Spirit of Beauty," he cried, "if thou choosest to take the form of a
+radiant woman here before me in this garden, pity my wretchedness!
+Save us from this prison, and if that may not be, have pity on our
+country and help our fallen friends."
+
+Arcite pressed forward and leant over Palamon's shoulder. The window
+was only a narrow slit, and the wall through which it was cut was
+thick, so it was not easy for Arcite to see into the garden. At last
+he caught a glimpse of Emelia.
+
+"Oh, how lovely she is!" he said. "I shall die of my wish to serve
+her. Most beautiful of maidens she is, truly."
+
+When Palamon heard this, he turned on Arcite, looked coldly at him and
+asked, "Sayest thou so in earnest or in jest?"
+
+"Nay, truly in earnest, my cousin; I have little will to jest!"
+
+Palamon looked fiercely at him and said, "Little honor to thee then!
+Hast thou forgotten thine oath of truest brotherhood to me, and mine
+to thee? Hast thou forgotten thy promise to help me in all I do? How,
+then, canst thou dream of claiming to love my lady? This thou shalt
+not do, false Arcite! I loved her first, and told thee, and thou must
+help me to win her if ever we escape. Thine honor demands this of
+thee. Otherwise thou art no true knight."
+
+But Arcite drew himself up scornfully and said, "Rather it is thou
+that art false! A moment ago thou didst not know whether she were
+maiden or Spirit! I loved her first for what she is, and told thee as
+my brother! But even if thou hadst loved her first, could I, because
+of that, refuse to love the fairest of maidens? Besides, why should we
+strive? Thou knowest too well that thou shalt never win her smile, nor
+yet shall I! These prison walls so thick and black leave no hope for
+us. We fight as did the fabled dogs for the bone. They fought all day,
+yet neither won. There came a kite while they raged, and carried off
+the bone. Love thou the maid if thou wilt. I shall love her till I
+die."
+
+The prison had been narrow and bare and cold before, but now it seemed
+ten times more dismal. The world from which it shut them in was so
+much more sweet because of the maiden who dwelt there, and the
+friendship for each other which had cheered them through many evil
+days was broken.
+
+But Emelia the Radiant sang her gay songs and stepped lightly among
+the flowers, with never another thought of the weary eyes that watched
+her.
+
+One day the greatest friend that Duke Theseus of Athens had, came to
+see him. This friend had known Arcite in Thebes, and had loved the
+handsome boy. He begged Theseus to forgive him, and to let him go
+free. Theseus was glad to find something he could do to please his
+dear friend, so one morning he took him with him to the prison where
+Palamon and Arcite were. The attendants could scarcely follow, for the
+royal robes filled all the dingy little space! A streak of light from
+the window fell on the Duke's mantle and his jewels. They looked
+strangely bright in that dark room beside the faded clothes of the two
+young prisoners.
+
+Arcite and the friend of Theseus greeted each other joyously, and the
+heart of Arcite beat wildly with hope, but when he heard the words of
+Theseus the Duke it sank like lead.
+
+"Arcite," said he, "by the desire of my friend, I grant to thee thy
+freedom. I grant it on one condition only. Thou must wander away far
+beyond my kingdom. If ever thou art seen for one moment on any
+furthest corner of my land, that moment shall be thy last. By the
+sword thou shalt die."
+
+Homeward to Thebes sped Arcite with a sad heart.
+
+"Woe is me for the day that I was born!" he moaned; "woe is me that
+ever I knew the friend of Theseus! Had he not known me, I might even
+now be gazing on the maiden I serve, from the window in the Duke's
+tower. Ah, Palamon, thou art the victor now! Day by day thou gazest on
+her, and kind fortune may grant to thee thy freedom and her favor
+while I am banished for ever! Ah, why do we complain against our
+fortune? We know that we seek happiness, but know not the road
+thither! Think how I dreamt and longed for freedom, and thought that
+if I were only out of prison my joy would be perfect. Behold, my
+freedom is my banishment, and my hope my undoing!"
+
+As for Palamon, when he saw that Arcite was gone, he made the great
+tower walls re-echo with his howls of misery. The very fetters on his
+ankles were wet with his salt tears.
+
+"Alas," he groaned, "Arcite, my cousin, thou hast borne off the prize
+in this strife of ours! Thou walkest now at liberty in Thebes. Little
+thou thinkest of me and of my sorrow! Strong thou art, and wise.
+Doubtless thou art even now gathering together the people of Thebes to
+invade this land and win the sister of the Duke for thy wife, while I
+die here in this prison like a caged lion. The prison walls heed my
+weeping and my wailing not at all."
+
+He could not even rejoice in the sight of Emelia when she walked in
+the garden, so fearful was he lest Arcite should win her.
+
+Meanwhile Arcite passed his days in Thebes in grief. He wandered about
+alone, and wailed and made moan to himself. He cared not to eat, and
+sleep forsook him. His spirits were so feeble that the sound of music
+brought fresh tears to his eyes. He grew gaunt and thin, and his voice
+was hollow with sadness.
+
+At last, when he was nearly dazed with sorrow, he dreamt one night
+that a beautiful winged boy with golden curls stood before him. "Go
+thou to Athens," said the boy; "the end of all thy sorrow awaits thee
+there!"
+
+Arcite started up wide awake and said, "I will to Athens, to my lady.
+It were good even to die in her presence."
+
+He caught up a mirror. He had not cared to look in one for many
+months, but now that he meant to return to his lady, he wished to see
+if he looked strong and young as ever. At first he was shocked to see
+how great a change had passed over his face. Then he thought, "If I do
+not say who I am, I may live unknown in Athens for years. Then I shall
+see my lady day by day."
+
+Quickly he called to him a squire, and told him all his will, and
+bound him to keep his name a secret and to answer no questions about
+himself or his master. Then Arcite sent his squire to find clothes
+such as the laborers in Athens wore. When he returned, Arcite and he
+put on the clothes and set out by the straight road to Athens.
+
+In Athens no one took any notice of the two poor men.
+
+Before they came to the castle the squire left his master and found a
+house to live in, where he could do Arcite's bidding at any time. But
+Arcite hurried on to the courtyard gate. There he waited till the
+master of the servants who waited on Emelia came out. Then he said to
+him, "Take me, I pray thee, into thy service. Drudge I will and draw
+water, yea, and in all thou dost command I will obey."
+
+The master of the servants asked Arcite what was his name.
+"Philostrate, my lord," said Arcite, and as "Philostrate" he entered
+that part of the castle where Emelia's home was.
+
+He could hew wood and carry water well, but he was not long left to do
+such rough work. The master of the house saw that whatever he trusted
+to Philostrate's care was rightly done, so he gave him less humble
+work to do, and made him a page in the house of Emelia. The lords and
+ladies of the castle began to notice what a gentle and kind page this
+Philostrate was. They spoke to Theseus about him, and said that he
+deserved to have a higher place that he might show his goodness and
+courage in knightly deeds. To please them, Theseus made him one of his
+own squires.
+
+Seven years passed away, and Palamon was still in prison. This year,
+however, in the May-time, a friend of his, who heard where he was,
+helped him to escape. During the short night he fled as fast as he
+could, but when the early dawn began to break he strode tremblingly to
+a grove of trees, that he might hide there all day. When the darkness
+fell once more he meant to go on again to Thebes, there to gather his
+old armies to make war on Theseus. He wished either to win Emelia or
+to die. He cared little for his life if he might not spend it with
+her.
+
+As Palamon lay beside a bush in the grove, he watched the sunbeams
+drying up the dew drops on the leaves and flowers near him, and
+listened to the joyous song of a lark that poured forth its welcome to
+the morning.
+
+The same lark that Palamon heard awakened Arcite. He was now the chief
+knight in the Duke's house, and served him with honor in peace and
+war. He sprang up and looked out on the fresh green fields. Everything
+called to him to come out. He loosed his horse from the stall and
+galloped over hill and dale. He came to the edge of a grove, and tied
+up his steed to a tree. Then he wandered down a woodland path to
+gather honeysuckle and hawthorn to weave a garland for himself. Little
+he thought of the snare into which he was walking. As he roamed he
+sang--
+
+ "O May, of every month the queen,
+ With thy sweet flowers and forests green,
+ Right welcome be thou, fair fresh May."
+
+The grove was the one in which Palamon lay beside a pool of water.
+When he heard the song of Arcite, cold fear took hold on him. He did
+not know that it was Arcite who sang, but he knew that the horse must
+belong to a knight of the court, and he crouched down to the ground
+lest he should be seen and taken back to prison.
+
+Soon Arcite's joyous mood passed away, and he grew sorrowful. He
+sighed and threw himself down not far from the spot where Palamon lay.
+
+"Alas, alas!" said Arcite, "for the royal blood of Thebes! Alas that I
+should humbly serve my mortal enemy! Alas that I dare not claim my
+noble name, but must be known, forsooth, as Philostrate, a name worth
+not a straw! Of all our princely house not one is left save only me
+and Palamon, whom Theseus slays in prison. Even I, free though I am,
+am helpless to win Emelia. What am I to her but an humble squire?"
+
+Palamon was so angry when he heard this, that he forgot his own
+danger. He started out from his hiding-place and faced Arcite.
+
+"False Arcite," he cried, "now art thou caught indeed! Thou hast
+deceived Duke Theseus and hast falsely changed thy name, hast thou?
+Then surely I or thou must die. I will suffer no man to love my lady,
+save myself alone. For I am Palamon, thy mortal foe. I have no weapon
+in this place, for only last night did I escape from prison. Yet I
+fear thee not. Thou shalt die, or thou shalt cease to love my lady.
+Choose as thou wilt!"
+
+Then Arcite rose up in his wrath and drew his sword. He said, "Were it
+not that thou art ill and mad with grief, and that thou hast no
+weapon here, thou shouldest never step from where thou standest. I
+deny the bond thou claimest! Fool! how can I help thee to win the lady
+I fain would wed myself? But because thou art a worthy knight and a
+gentle, and art ready to fight for thy lady, accept my promise.
+To-morrow I will not fail to wait for thee here without the knowledge
+of any other. Also I will bring armor and weapons for thee and me, and
+thou shalt choose of them what thou wilt, ere I arm myself! Food and
+drink will I bring to thee this night into the grove. If so be that
+thou slay me here to-morrow, then indeed thou mayest win thy lady if
+thou canst!"
+
+Then Palamon answered, "Let it be so."
+
+Next morning Arcite rode to the wood alone. He met Palamon on the
+woodland path where the flowers he had gathered the day before lay
+withered on the ground. No word nor greeting passed between them, but
+each helped to arm the other in silence. As the buckles were tightened
+and the armor slipped into its place, the color came and went in the
+faces of the two princes. They deemed that this would be the last of
+all fights to one of them.
+
+When they were ready they fenced together for a little, and then the
+real fight began. So fierce was it that the men seemed like wild
+animals in their rage. Palamon sprang at Arcite like a strong lion,
+and Arcite glanced aside and darted at him again like a cruel tiger.
+In the midst of this they heard a sound of the galloping of horses
+that brought the royal hunters to the spot. In a moment the sword of
+Theseus flashed between the fighters, and his voice thundered out,
+"Ho! no more, on pain of death. Who are ye who dare to fight here
+alone, with none to see justice done?"
+
+The princes turned and saw Theseus, Duke of Athens. Behind him rode
+Hippolyta with her sister, Emelia the Radiant, and many knights and
+ladies.
+
+Palamon answered the Duke's question swiftly, before Arcite had time
+to speak. "Sire, what need of words? Both of us deserve death. Two
+wretches are we, burdened with our lives. As thou art a just judge,
+give to us neither mercy nor refuge, but slay us both. Thou knowrest
+not that this knight, Philostrate, is thy mortal foe, whom thou hast
+banished. He is Arcite, who hath deceived thee for that he loveth
+Emelia. And I too love her. I too am thy mortal foe, for I am Palamon,
+and I have broken from my prison. Slay us then, here before fair
+Emelia."
+
+"That is easily granted," said Theseus. "Ye judge yourselves. Ye shall
+die."
+
+Then the queen began to weep, and Emelia too. They were sad to think
+that these two princes should die so young, and all for the service
+they wished to do to the queen's sister.
+
+The other ladies of the court begged the Duke to forgive the fighters.
+"Have mercy, sire," they urged, "on us women, and save the princes!"
+
+At first Theseus was too angry to listen to them, but soon he thought
+that he would have done as the princes had done, if he had been in
+their place, so he said, "Arcite and Palamon, ye could both have lived
+in peace and safety in Thebes, yet love has brought you here to Athens
+into my power, who am your deadly foe. Here then for the sake of
+Hippolyta, my queen, and of Emelia the Radiant, our dear sister, I
+forgive you both. Promise never to make war on my land, but to yield
+me your friendship evermore." Joyfully the princes promised this, and
+thanked the Duke for his grace.
+
+Then Theseus said, "Both of you are noble. Either might wed Emelia the
+Radiant, but she cannot wed you both. Therefore I appoint a tournament
+in this place a year hence. Come here then, ye Princes of Thebes, each
+of you, with a hundred knights of the bravest, and that one of you,
+who shall slay or capture the other, he shall wed Emelia."
+
+Whose face could be brighter than was Palamon's when he heard those
+words, and who could step more lightly than did Arcite? Every one
+thanked the Duke for his kindness to the princes, while they rode off
+to Thebes with high hopes and light hearts.
+
+When the day of the tournament came, great buildings stood in a circle
+on the plain beside the grove. Within them stretched an immense arena
+in which the knights must fight. Great marble gates opened on to the
+space at either side.
+
+Palamon and Arcite found it easy to bring a hundred knights to Athens.
+So splendid were the preparations for the tournament that every one
+was eager to fight in it.
+
+Emelia alone was sad as the day of the fighting came nearer. Her
+maidens heard her say, "Oh that I might not wed at all! I love the
+free life of the woods. I love to hunt, and to ride, and to roam. Why
+cannot Palamon and Arcite love each other as they used to do long ago,
+and leave me free?"
+
+On the morning of the tournament Duke Theseus and his queen sat with
+Emelia on a high seat overlooking the lists. When the trumpet sounded,
+Arcite and his knights rode in through the western gate. His red
+banner shone bright against the white marble pillars. At the same
+moment Palamon entered from the east, and his white banner floated out
+against the blue sky.
+
+Soon the heralds ceased galloping up and down, and the whole space was
+left to the warriors.
+
+The trumpets sounded "Advance," and the fray began. Through the bright
+sunshine they fought, advancing here, and beaten back there, till at
+last Palamon was hurled from his horse and taken prisoner.
+
+The trumpets sounded, and all stood still while Theseus called out,
+"Ho! no more. All is over. Arcite of Thebes khall wed Emelia." Then
+the people shouted till it seemed that the great marble gates would
+fall.
+
+In the eagerness of the fight Emelia had begun to like the warriors
+who fought for her, and her liking grew ever stronger as they showed
+their worth. When Arcite rode towards her with glowing face she was
+proud of him, and leant forward to welcome him gladly.
+
+But as he galloped, his horse started aside and he was thrown to the
+ground. He was too much hurt to rise. So he was lifted by his knights
+and carried to the palace. There he was cared for in every way, but
+nothing could save him.
+
+Before he died, he called for Emelia and Palamon.
+
+"No words can tell the sorrow I bear because I must leave thee, my
+lady! Alas, death tears me from thee! Farewell, my wife! farewell, my
+Emelia! Ah, take me softly in thine arms, and listen while I speak!
+For years I have had strife with my dear cousin Palamon. Yet now I say
+to thee, in all this world I never have met with one so worthy to be
+loved as Palamon, that hath served thee, and will serve thee, his life
+long. Ah, if ever thou dost wed, let it be Palamon!"
+
+His voice began to fail. "Emelia!" he said, and died.
+
+Emelia mourned sadly for her valiant knight. As for Palamon, all his
+old love for Arcite came back, and he wept for him as bitterly as he
+had bewailed his own sorrow in the dungeon.
+
+When all the Greeks had ceased to mourn for Arcite, Palamon still
+grieved for the death of his friend, and for the strife that had been
+between them.
+
+After two years Theseus sent one day for Palamon and Emelia. Palamon
+came to the court in his black robes of mourning; but Emelia was
+dressed in white, as she had been on the May morning in the garden
+years before. She had ceased to mourn for Arcite, and was Emelia the
+Radiant once more.
+
+Palamon caught his breath. He had not seen her since they parted after
+Arcite's death.
+
+Duke Theseus said, "Sister, I desire thee now to take the noble knight
+Palamon to be thy husband. Have pity on his long service, and accept
+him."
+
+Then he said to Palamon, "It will not need much speech to gain thy
+consent! Come, take thy lady by the hand."
+
+Then, in the presence of all the court, they were wed. When all was
+over, Emelia fled from the noise and tumult of the hall, and beckoned
+to Palamon to follow. Out at the great hall doors she led him, and
+down the pathway to the garden beneath the tower. When he joined her,
+she pointed to the dungeon window, and told him of the day when she
+had looked at the prison in the morning mist, and murmured to herself
+the names of the captive princes, "Palamon and Arcite, Palamon and
+Arcite."
+
+But it was not till many years of joyous life had passed over their
+home that Palamon told Emelia that he had seen her first on that very
+morning when she had thought so sadly of his misery.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+GRISELDA
+
+
+Once upon a time there lived a fair young girl whose name was
+Griselda. Her home was in an Italian village. There she dwelt in a
+lowly cottage with her father, Janicola. He was too old and weak to
+work for her, or even for himself.
+
+All round the village lay the fruitful fields and vineyards of the
+plain, and on the slopes near grew olive-trees laden with fruit. Far
+in the distance rose the snow-capped mountains of the North.
+
+Even in so rich a land it was not easy for this young Griselda to make
+her father's life as pleasant as she would have wished it to be. She
+lived plainly and barely. She was busy all day long. Now she was
+herding a few sheep on the broken ground near the village, and
+spinning as she watched her flock. Again she fetched the water from
+the well or gathered roots and herbs from which to make drugs.
+
+Griselda was not unhappy though her life was hard, because she was so
+glad that she could serve her father and show her love to him,
+forgetting about herself and her own wishes.
+
+One day as she sat watching her sheep her eyes fell on the white
+towers of a castle that stood not far from the village where she
+lived. It was the castle of the Marquis Walter, who was lord of all
+that land. Griselda looked kindly at the white towers. She thought
+that their master was the best and greatest man in the world. She knew
+that he was kind also, and courteous. When she saw him ride towards
+her, her face lighted up, and she rose to courtesy to him. She hoped
+he would draw up his horse beside her, and greet her, and ask for her
+father Janicola.
+
+This morning, as she looked at the castle, she saw a company of men
+hurrying along the road that led to its gate. Farmers were there in
+dull and homely clothes, and knights in armor that flashed back the
+sunlight, and lords in gay colors that glanced and gleamed among the
+olive-trees under the blue Italian sky.
+
+Griselda knew why they were going to Lord Walter, and she wondered
+what they would do and say when they reached him. She could not go
+after them, for her sheep would have wandered away if she had left
+them.
+
+When the men that Griselda had watched reached the courtyard gate,
+they met Lord Walter. He was on horseback ready for the hunt. The
+foremost of the company prayed him to grant them a little time that
+they might tell him why they had come.
+
+Lord Walter threw the reins to a squire, and led his people into the
+great hall of the castle. There he seated himself in state to listen
+to their grievance whatever it might be.
+
+Then the same man who had spoken before said to him:
+
+"Noble Marquis, thy generous kindness in times past giveth us courage
+to come before thee. Truly, sire, thou and all thou dost art so dear
+to us that, save in one thing, we cannot wish for better fortune than
+to live under thy government. One thing alone disturbs the peace of
+thy faithful people. Though thou art young and strong, yet age creeps
+on! Time flies and waits for no man. Death threatens young and old
+alike. We pray thee, sire, that thou wilt wed, for if swift death
+should lay thee low ere a son be born to thee, then alack for us and
+for our children! In the power of a stranger then would lie our fair
+lands and even our lives. Grant us this boon, noble Marquis, and, if
+thou wilt, we will choose for thee a wife. Noble shall she be, and
+good, so that thou shalt have honor and gladness in thy wedding."
+
+Then the Marquis said:
+
+"My people, loyal and true, ye ask of me that which I thought not to
+grant, for the free life of the forest and the hunt pleaseth me well.
+Yet will I do this thing that ye desire. Only to me myself must fall
+the choice of her whom I will wed. On you I lay this command that, be
+she who she may, yet shall ye honor her as if she were an Emperor's
+daughter through all her life. Nor shall ye raise one word against the
+maiden of my choice. Unless ye agree to this, I will not wed!"
+
+Gladly the people promised. But ere they left the Marquis, they begged
+him to fix a day for the marriage lest he should put off too long. The
+Marquis granted their request, and farmers, knights, and lords trooped
+joyfully home.
+
+When the morning of the day that was fixed for the wedding came, the
+castle of the Marquis was gaily decorated. Flags floated out from the
+towers, and garlands trailed over the doorway and the gate. Within in
+the great hall a royal feast was spread, and there lay royal robes and
+gems.
+
+In the courtyard and on the terraces lords and ladies stood in groups.
+Wonder and doubt were on every face. The wedding-feast was prepared,
+the guests were come, but there was no bride.
+
+A trumpet sounded "to horse," and all was hurry and noise. Then Lord
+Walter rode out through the castle gate. He was followed by bearers,
+who carried the beautiful robes and gems that had lain in the hall.
+
+They rode out by the same road along which Griselda had watched the
+people go to ask the Marquis to wed, many months before. Now she saw
+the bridal train ride down from the castle. "Ah," she said, "they ride
+this way to fetch the bride. I shall work more busily than ever to-day
+that I may be free to stand and watch Lord Walter's fair bride as the
+riders return with her to the castle!"
+
+Then she went to the well to fetch water. When she came back she found
+Lord Walter at her father's door. In the narrow lane beside the
+cottage stood lords and ladies, while their horses impatiently pawed
+the ground.
+
+Quickly Griselda set her pitcher in a trough near the cottage door,
+and knelt before the Marquis to hear his will.
+
+"Where is thy father?" Lord Walter asked.
+
+"Close at hand, my Lord," said Griselda, and went to bring him without
+delay.
+
+"My faithful servant," said Lord Walter to the old man, "grant me thy
+daughter for my wife!"
+
+Janicola knew not what to say for surprise. At last he answered, "My
+will is thine! Do as thou wilt, my own dear Lord!"
+
+"Then must I ask Griselda if she will be my wife; but stay thou by us.
+Thou shalt hear her answer."
+
+Griselda was amazed. She did not know what the meaning of Lord
+Walter's visit was, and when she stood before him her face was full
+of fear. Her wonder was very great when she heard him say:
+
+"Griselda, I am come for thee. Thee only will I wed. Thy father also
+is willing. But ere thou tell me whether or no thou wilt be my bride,
+listen to the demand I make. Art thou ready to obey me in everything,
+and to let me do to thee evil or good as I will without so much as
+turning to me a frowning face?"
+
+This seemed a strange request to Grisdda, but she loved and trusted
+Lord Walter so truly that she said:
+
+"Lord, I am not worthy of this honor. Verily in all things thy will
+shall be mine. Life is sweet, but I will die rather than displease
+thee."
+
+"Enough, Griselda!" he said.
+
+Then Lord Walter turned to the courtiers and the people of the village
+who had gathered round:
+
+"Behold my wife! Let all show their love to me by the honor and love
+they bear to her."
+
+The ladies of the court were commanded to take off Griselda's old
+clothes and to array her in the costly robes they had brought with
+them. They did not like to touch the poor soiled clothes she wore, nor
+to move about in the little cottage with their sweeping gowns; but the
+gentleness of Griselda made it pleasant to help her. They caught up
+Griselda's royal robes with great clasps of gold set with gems, and
+put a crown on her beautiful hair.
+
+She came out and stood in the low doorway, where she had so often
+stood before. But now the people scarcely knew her: she looked so fair
+in her new robes and with the love-light shining in her eyes.
+
+Lord Walter did not wait till he reached the castle. He was married to
+Griselda at her father's cottage door. The villagers gathered round
+and gazed at the simple wedding. They saw Lord Walter put a great ring
+on Griselda's finger, and lift her on to a milk-white steed. Then they
+led her with joy towards the castle. Wedding-bells rang out gladly
+across the plain, and ever as the wedding-party drew near to the white
+towers with their floating flags, happy bands of people came to meet
+and welcome Griselda.
+
+Very soon the fame of Lord Walter's beautiful wife spread through the
+land. Nor was it only for her beauty that men praised her. Gracious
+she was and wise, able to rule her home, and to bend fiery spirits to
+her will.
+
+From all the countryside men came to her in trouble. Every one
+rejoiced in the good fortune that had come to their land, and some
+even called her an angel from heaven come to right all wrong.
+
+After some time a daughter was born to Griselda. Then she thought she
+was the happiest woman in the world. She thought of the care that she
+would give her child as she grew up, and of Lord Walter's delight in
+his little daughter when the time should come that she could talk and
+ride with him.
+
+But before the baby was a year old, all Griselda's dreams were broken.
+Lord Walter said to himself, "It is easy for Griselda to keep her
+promise when I ask of her nothing that is not just and right. How can
+I trust her until I know that she will obey me in everything? I wonder
+whether she would be patient still if I hurt our little daughter."
+
+These thoughts came back to his mind so often that at last he resolved
+to try Griselda's patience by taking away her baby from her.
+
+One evening Griselda was playing with her little child. The baby
+laughed in her arms and looked sweeter than ever. At that moment the
+curtain at the doorway was drawn aside and Lord Walter came into the
+room. His face was sad and drawn, and as Griselda looked up at him she
+feared that some great blow had fallen on him, or that some enemy had
+entered the country.
+
+Lord Walter said to her:
+
+"Griselda, thou hast not forgotten the day on which I brought thee
+from thy father's lowly cottage to this my castle. Although thou art
+most dear to me, thou art not dear to my nobles. They say that it is
+hard that they should serve one so lowly born as thou. Since thy
+daughter was born they have said this more and more, I doubt not. As
+thou knowest, my will is to live with my people in joy and peace.
+Therefore must I do to my child not as I wish myself, but as my
+nobles wish. Show then to me the obedience that thou didst promise to
+show when thou wert wed in the village street."
+
+As Griselda heard these words she made no moan. Neither did she let
+the pain that caught at her heart be seen in her face. When she could
+speak, she said:
+
+"Lord, we are thine! My child is thine. I also am thine. With thine
+own thou mayest ever do as pleaseth thee best."
+
+The Marquis was full of joy because of the patience and humbleness of
+Griselda; but he appeared to be sad, and left her with a troubled
+face.
+
+Soon after this, Griselda started as she heard a heavy footstep on the
+stairway. Then an evil-looking man walked into the quiet room.
+
+"Madam," he said, "I must obey my lord's will. He bids me take this
+child. Thou knowest we must obey, although we may complain and mourn."
+
+Then the soldier took the child so roughly that it seemed as if he
+would kill it before her. Griselda said:
+
+"Pray, sir, do thou suffer me to kiss my child ere it die." He gave it
+back to her. Gently she gathered it in her arms. She blessed it, and
+lulled it, and kissed it. Then she said in her sweet voice: "Farewell,
+my child, I shall see thee never again. The blessing of Him who died
+on a cross of wood for us, rest on thee. To Him I give thy soul, my
+little one! To-night thou must die because of me."
+
+To the rough soldier she said:
+
+"Take again the child and obey my Lord. But if it please my Lord, then
+of thy kindness bury thou the little body where no cruel bird nor
+beast can harm it!"
+
+But in silence the soldier carried away the child.
+
+Then Lord Walter looked to see if Griselda would fret or be less kind
+to him. He watched, but could see no change in her. She was as busy
+and loving and cheerful as ever. Neither in earnest nor in play did
+she name her child.
+
+After four years a son was born to Griselda. The people were very glad
+because there was now an heir to rule the land at the death of Lord
+Walter. Griselda too was happy, though her heart longed for the
+little maid who might have been playing with her brother.
+
+When the boy was two years old, Lord Walter began to wish once more to
+try the patience of Griselda.
+
+This time he said to her:
+
+"Wife, I have told thee before how ill the people bear our marriage.
+Now that a son is born they are more wrathful than before. My heart is
+weary with the thought of their complaints. They say, 'When Lord
+Walter is gone, the grandson of Janicola shall rule us!' Therefore I
+shall do with my son as I did with his sister. Be patient, I pray
+thee."
+
+"Thou art my Lord," said Griselda. "My will and my freedom lie in my
+father's cottage with the poor soiled clothes I left there on the day
+thou didst bring me hither. Could I know thy will before thou didst
+tell it to me, it would be done, though it were death to do it. Life
+cannot compare with thy love."
+
+Lord Walter looked down to the ground. He could not look at his wife
+lest he should not have heart to do as he wished.
+
+Again the rude soldier came to Griselda. He was even harsher than
+before, and carried off the child without a kind word to the patient
+mother.
+
+When the little boy was gone, the people said very bitter things about
+Lord Walter. The love they had given him before was turned into hatred
+because he had treated his beautiful wife so unkindly, and because he
+had murdered his children.
+
+Though Lord Walter saw this, he wished to try his wife once more. He
+knew that he could send away his wife and marry another if he got a
+letter from the Pope to say that he might. He sent a messenger to
+Rome, where the Pope lived. This messenger was told to bring back a
+letter, not from the Pope, but as like one of his as possible.
+
+The letter came. It said that because of the anger of Lord Walter's
+people at the lowly birth of his wife Griselda, the Marquis might send
+her away and marry another.
+
+The news of the letter spread throughout the land. Every one believed
+that it had really come from the Pope.
+
+Griselda's heart was very sore when she heard of this letter. But she
+went on quietly with each day's work. She did not even speak of the
+letter to her husband.
+
+At last Lord Walter spoke before all his court, and with no knightly
+gentleness.
+
+"Griselda," he said, "there is no freedom in the life of one who
+rules. I may not act after my own wish as any laborer on my land may
+do. As thou knowest, my people hate thy presence, and demand of me
+that I wed another. The Pope's letter thou hast heard. Return then,
+swiftly and without complaint, to thy father's cottage, for already my
+bride cometh hither."
+
+"My Lord, it is no new thought to me, that I am unworthy to be thy
+servant--far more unworthy to be thy wife. In this great house of
+which thou didst make me queen, I have not acted as mistress, but only
+as lowly handmaid to thee. For these years of thy kindness, I thank
+thee. Gladly do I go to my father's house. There he tended me when I
+was but a child. Now I will stay with him till death enters the
+cottage door. To thee and to thy bride be joy. To her I willingly
+yield the place where I have been so happy. Since thou, who once wert
+all my joy, wilt have me go, I go!"
+
+Lord Walter turned away in sadness. He could scarcely speak for pity,
+but he held to his purpose.
+
+Then Griselda drew her wedding-ring from her finger, and laid it down.
+Beside it she put the gems that Lord Walter had given her. Her
+beautiful robes she laid aside. In the simplest gown she could find,
+and with head and feet all bare, Griselda went down through the olive
+trees towards her father's house.
+
+Many of Lord Walter's people followed her, weeping and bewailing the
+fickleness of fortune. Griselda did not turn to them, nor speak, nor
+weep. She quietly went on her way.
+
+When the tidings reached her father, he wished that he had never been
+born, so sad was he in the sorrow of his beautiful daughter. He
+hastened out to meet her, and wrapped her tenderly in her old cloak,
+and led her home with tears.
+
+Griselda spoke no word of complaint, nor did she speak of her former
+happiness. Once more she tended the sheep on the common. Once more she
+carried water from the well. Once more she thought first of her
+father.
+
+After some weeks Lord Walter sent for Griselda. She went to the castle
+and greeted him humbly as of old. She showed no grudge because of his
+unkindness.
+
+"Griselda," he said, "thou knowest, as doth no other, how all this
+castle should be ordered for my pleasure. Stay thou then, and have all
+in readiness for the fair young bride whom I shall wed to-morrow. It
+is my will that she be welcomed royally."
+
+"My whole desire is to serve thee, my Lord. Neither weal nor woe shall
+ever make me cease to love thee with all my heart."
+
+At once Griselda took control of all who worked in the castle. Of them
+all she was the neatest and the quickest. Soon every room in the tower
+was sweet and clean. The great hall was decked for the wedding-feast,
+and the table glittered with silver.
+
+Early next morning many horsemen came to the castle. Among them was a
+beautiful girl dressed in a shimmering white robe. Near her rode a
+charming boy younger than the maiden. Round them were many nobles, and
+a guard of soldiers, who had brought them to Lord Walter's court.
+
+The people crowded round the gates. So charmed were they with the fair
+young maid, that some of them forgot their love for Griselda, and were
+ready to welcome the bride whose coming caused her so much sorrow.
+
+Still Griselda moved about the castle in her old worn clothes. She
+went to the gate to welcome the bride. Then she received the guests
+and greeted each of them according to his degree.
+
+The stranger nobles wondered who Griselda could be. She was so wise
+and gentle, and yet so meanly dressed.
+
+Before the feast began, Lord Walter called Griselda to him. Then he
+asked her, "What dost thou think of my wife? Is she beautiful?"
+
+"Never have I seen a fairer," said Griselda. "Joy be with you both
+evermore! But oh! I beg of thee, torment not this child as thou didst
+me. She has been tenderly cared for. She could not bear what I have
+borne."
+
+When Lord Walter saw her great patience, and thought of the pain he
+had caused her, his heart went out to her in great pity, and he
+cried, "It is enough, Griselda; fear no more, nor be thou longer sad.
+I have tried thy faith and thy sweetness, as faith and sweetness have
+never before been tried."
+
+His arms were around her, and he kissed her. Griselda looked at him in
+wonder. She could not understand.
+
+"Griselda," he said, "thou art my wife. I have no other. This is thy
+daughter; her brother is my heir. Thine are they both. Take them
+again, and dream not that thou art bereft of thy children."
+
+When Griselda heard all this she fainted away in her great joy. When
+she woke again she called her children to her. Timidly they came, but
+soon they were caught close to her breast. While she fondled them, and
+kissed them, her hot tears of joy fell on their fair faces, and on
+their hair. Then she looked at Lord Walter, and said, "Death cannot
+harm me now, since thou lovest me still." Then she turned back to the
+children.
+
+"Oh tender, oh dear, oh little ones, my children! Your sorrowful
+mother thought that cruel dogs or other fearsome beasts had torn you!
+but God has kept you safe."
+
+Once again the ladies of the court dressed Griselda in royal robes.
+Once again they set a golden crown upon her head. Once again the
+wedding-ring slipped into its own place on her finger.
+
+Ere she entered the hall of feasting again, swift messengers had
+brought her old father, Janicola, to the castle, never to leave it
+again.
+
+Then Griselda sat with her children beside her husband. To her feet
+came lords and nobles, peasants and farmers, eager to kiss her hand
+and to show the joy they felt in her return.
+
+Never had the walls of the castle reechoed the laughter of so glad a
+people. All day long till the stars shone in the cool clear sky the
+feasting went on.
+
+For Griselda this was the first of many happy days, happier than she
+had known before.
+
+In her home sounded the gay voices of happy children as they played
+with, and cared for, the old grandfather whom their mother loved so
+dearly. And ever as she moved about the castle she met the eyes of
+Lord Walter, that told her again and yet again that he trusted her
+utterly.
+
+
+
+
+THE PILGRIM'S PROGRESS
+
+By JOHN BUNYAN
+
+ADAPTED BY MARY MACGREGOR
+
+
+As I slept I dreamed a dream. I dreamed, and behold, I saw a man
+clothed with rags, standing in a certain place, with his face away
+from his own house, a book in his hand, and a great burden upon his
+back. I looked, and saw him open the book, and read therein, and as he
+read, he wept and trembled. His fear was so great that he brake out
+with a mournful cry, saying, "What shall I do?"
+
+In this plight therefore he went home, and did all he could to hide
+his distress from his wife and children. But he could not be silent
+long, because his trouble increased. Wherefore at length he began to
+talk to his wife and children thus: "O my dear wife," said he, "and
+you my children, I am in despair by reason of a burden that lieth
+heavy on me. Moreover I am for certain told that this our city will be
+burned with fire from heaven, when both myself, with thee, my wife,
+and you, my sweet babes, shall be ruined, except some way of escape
+can be found." At this his wife and children were sore amazed, not
+because they believed that what he had said to them was true, but
+because they thought he must be ill to talk in so strange a way.
+Therefore, as it was evening, and they hoped sleep might soothe him,
+with all haste they got him to bed. But the night was as troublesome
+to him as the day, wherefore instead of sleeping he spent it in sighs
+and tears.
+
+So when the morning was come, they asked him how he did. He told them,
+"Worse and worse," and began to talk to them again in the same strange
+manner, but they began to be careless of his words. They also thought
+to drive away his fancies by harsh and rough behavior to him.
+Sometimes they would mock, sometimes they would scold, and sometimes
+they would quite neglect him. Wherefore he began to stay in his room
+to pray for and pity them, and also to comfort his own misery. He
+would also walk alone in the fields, sometimes reading and sometimes
+praying, and thus for some days he spent his time.
+
+Now I saw in my dream that when he was walking in the fields, he was
+reading his book and greatly distressed in mind. And as he read, he
+burst out crying, "What shall I do to be saved?" I saw also that he
+looked this way and that way, as if he would run. Yet he stood still,
+because, as I saw, he could not tell which way to go. I looked then,
+and saw a man, named Evangelist, coming to him, who asked, "Wherefore
+dost thou cry?"
+
+He answered, "Sir, I see by the book in my hand that I am condemned to
+die, and after that to be judged. And I find I am not willing to die,
+nor able to be judged."
+
+Then said Evangelist, "Why not willing to die, since in this life you
+are so unhappy?"
+
+The man answered, "Because I fear this burden will sink me lower than
+the grave, and the thought of that makes me cry."
+
+Then said Evangelist, "If this be thy fear, why standest thou still?"
+
+He answered, "Because I know not whither to go."
+
+So Evangelist gave him a parchment roll, and there was written within,
+"Fly from the wrath to come." The man therefore read it, and looking
+upon Evangelist very carefully, said, "Whither must I fly!"
+
+Then said Evangelist, pointing with his finger over a very wide field,
+"Do you see yonder Wicket-gate?"
+
+The man said, "No."
+
+"Well," said the other, "do you see yonder shining light?"
+
+He said, "I think I do."
+
+Then said Evangelist, "Keep that light in thine eye, and go up
+directly thereto, so shalt thou see the gate. When thou knockest, it
+shall be told thee what thou shalt do."
+
+So I saw in my dream that the man began to run. Now he had not run far
+from his own door when his wife and children, seeing it, began to cry
+after him to return. But the man put his fingers in his ears, and ran
+on, crying, "Life, life, eternal life!" So he looked not behind him,
+but fled towards the middle of the plain. The neighbors also came out
+to see him run. And as he ran some mocked, others threatened, and some
+cried after him to return. Among those that did so were two that were
+resolved to fetch him back by force. The name of the one was
+Obstinate, and the name of the other was Pliable. Now by this time the
+man was got a good distance from them, but they had made up their
+minds to follow him, which they did, and in a little time overtook
+him.
+
+Then said the man, "Neighbors, wherefore are you come?"
+
+They said, "To persuade you to go back with us."
+
+But he said, "That can by no means be. You dwell in the City of
+Destruction, the place where I was born. Be content, good neighbors,
+and go along with me."
+
+"What!" said Obstinate, "and leave our friends and our comforts behind
+us!"
+
+"Yes," said Christian, for that was his name.
+
+"What do you seek, since you leave all the world to find it?" said
+Obstinate.
+
+"I seek a treasure that never fades away. It is laid up in heaven and
+is safe there," said Christian. "Read it so, if you will, in my book."
+
+"Tush!" said Obstinate, "away with your book. Will you go back with us
+or no?"
+
+"No, not I," said the other, "because I have just set out."
+
+"Come then, Neighbor Pliable, let us turn again and go home without
+him."
+
+Then said Pliable, "If what the good Christian says is true, the
+things he looks after are better than ours. My heart makes me wish to
+go with him. But, my good Christian, do you know the way you are
+going?"
+
+"I am directed by a man, whose name is Evangelist, to speed me to a
+little gate that is before us, where we shall be told about the way."
+
+"Come then, good neighbor," said Pliable, "let us be going." Then they
+went both together.
+
+"And I will go back to my place," said Obstinate. "I will be no
+companion of such mistaken and foolish fellows."
+
+Now I saw in my dream that when Obstinate was gone back, Christian and
+Pliable went talking over the plain. "I will tell you what my book
+says of the country to which we are going, and of the people we shall
+meet there," said Christian.
+
+"But do you think the words of your book are certainly true?" said
+Pliable.
+
+"Yes," said Christian, "for it was written by Him who cannot lie."
+
+"Well," said Pliable, "tell me about this country."
+
+"In this country," said Christian, "we shall live for ever. There are
+crowns of glory to be given us, and garments that will make us shine
+like the sun."
+
+"This is excellent," said Pliable; "and what else?"
+
+"There shall be no more crying nor sorrow, for He that is the Owner of
+the place will wipe all tears from our eyes," said Christian.
+
+"And what companions shall we have there?" asked Pliable.
+
+"There we shall be with those that will dazzle your eyes to look on.
+There also you shall meet with thousands and tens of thousands that
+have gone before us to that place. None of of them are hurtful, but
+loving and holy. In a word, there shall we see some with their golden
+crowns, there we shall see maidens with golden harps, there we shall
+see men that here were cut in pieces, burnt in flames, eaten by
+beasts, and drowned in the seas, all for the love they bare to the
+Lord of this place. Now they are all well, and clothed with beautiful
+garments."
+
+And as Pliable heard of the excellence of the country and of the
+company to which they were going, he said, "Well, my good companion,
+glad I am to hear of these things. Come on, let us go with more
+speed."
+
+"I cannot go as fast as I would by reason of this burden that is on my
+back," said Christian.
+
+Now I saw in my dream that just as they ended their talk, they drew
+nigh to a bog that was in the midst of the plain, and they being
+heedless did both fall suddenly into it. The name of this bog was the
+Slough of Despond. Here therefore they struggled for a time, being
+grievously covered with dirt. And Christian, because of the burden
+that was on his back, began to sink in the mire. Then said Pliable,
+"Ah, Neighbor Christian, where are you now?"
+
+"Truly," said Christian, "I do not know."
+
+At this Pliable began to be offended, and said angrily, "Is this the
+happiness you have told me of all this while? If I get out again with
+my life, you shall possess the wonderful country alone."
+
+And with that he gave a desperate struggle or two, and got out of the
+mire on that side of the bog which was next to his own house. So away
+he went, and Christian saw him no more. Wherefore Christian was left
+to tumble in the Slough of Despond alone. But still he tried to
+struggle to that side of the Slough that was further from his own
+house, and next to the Wicket-gate. But he could not get out because
+of the burden that was upon his back.
+
+And I beheld in my dream that a man came to him, whose name was Help,
+and asked him what he did there. "Sir," said Christian, "I was bid to
+go this way by a man called Evangelist, who directed me also to yonder
+gate, and as I was going thither I fell in here."
+
+"Why did you not look for the steps?" said Help.
+
+"I was so full of fear," answered Christian, "that I fled the next way
+and fell in."
+
+Then said Help, "Give me thy hand." So Christian gave him his hand,
+and he drew him out and set him upon sound ground, and bid him go on
+his way.
+
+Now in my dream I stepped up to the man that plucked Christian out,
+and said:
+
+"Sir, wherefore, since over this place is the way from the City of
+Destruction to the Wicket-gate, is it that this Slough is not mended,
+that poor travelers might go over in more safety?"
+
+And he said to me, "This place cannot be mended, yet it is not the
+pleasure of the King that it should remain so bad. His laborers also
+have for more than sixteen hundred years been employed on this patch
+of ground, in the hope that it might perhaps be mended. There has
+been swallowed up here twenty thousand cartloads of the best material
+in the attempt to mend the place. But it is the Slough of Despond
+still; and still will be so, when they have done all they can. It is
+true that there are some good and strong steps even through the very
+midst of this mire. But men through the dizziness of their head miss
+the steps and so tumble into the mire, but the ground is good when
+they have once got in at the gate."
+
+Then I saw in my dream that by this time Pliable was got home to his
+house. So his neighbors came to visit him, and some of them called him
+wise man for coming back, and some called him fool for going with
+Christian. Others again did mock at his cowardliness, saying, "Surely
+since you began to go, you need not have been so base as to have given
+out for a few difficulties." So Pliable sat like a coward among them.
+
+Now as Christian was walking alone, he espied one afar off, come
+crossing over the field to meet him. The gentleman's name was Mr.
+Worldly Wiseman. He dwelt in a very great town, close by the one from
+which Christian came. This man, then, meeting with Christian, began
+thus to enter into some talk with him: "How now, good fellow, whither
+are you going in this burdened manner?"
+
+"A burdened manner indeed," said Christian. "I am going, sir, to
+yonder Wicket-gate before me, for there, I am told, I shall be put
+into a way to be rid of my heavy burden."
+
+"Hast thou a wife and children?" asked Mr. Worldly Wiseman.
+
+"Yes, but I am so laden with this burden that I cannot take that
+pleasure in them as formerly."
+
+"Will you hearken to me if I give thee counsel?"
+
+"If it be good, I will, for I stand in need of good counsel."
+
+"I would advise thee, then, that thou with all speed get thyself rid
+of thy burden, for thou wilt never be contented till then."
+
+"That is what I seek for, even to be rid of this heavy burden, but get
+it off myself I cannot, nor is there any man living in our country who
+can take it off my shoulders. Therefore I am going this way, as I told
+you, that I may be rid of my burden."
+
+"Who bid thee go this way to be rid of thy burden?"
+
+"A man that appeared to me a very great and honorable person. His
+name, as I remember, is Evangelist."
+
+"He has given thee foolish counsel. There is not a more dangerous and
+troublesome way in the world than is that unto which he hath directed
+thee. Thou hast met with some danger already, for I see the mud of the
+Slough of Despond is upon thee. Hear me, I am older than thou. Thou
+art likely to meet with, in the way which thou goest, painfulness,
+hunger, nakedness, sword, lions, dragons, darkness, and death."
+
+"Why, sir, this burden upon my back is more terrible to me than all
+these things."
+
+"But why wilt thou seek for ease this way, seeing so many dangers
+attend it? Hadst thou but patience to listen, I could direct thee how
+to get what thou desirest, without the danger that thou in this way
+wilt run thyself into."
+
+"Sir, I pray that thou wilt tell me this secret."
+
+"Why, in yonder village there dwells a gentleman, who is very wise,
+and who has skill to help men off with burdens like thine from their
+shoulders. To him thou mayest go to be helped at once. His house is
+not quite a mile from this place, and if thou dost not desire to go
+back to the City of Destruction, as indeed I would not wish thee, thou
+mayest send for thy wife and children to come to thee to this village.
+There are houses now standing empty, one of which thou mayest have
+without great cost. Food is there also, cheap and good, and what will
+make thy life the more happy is, that thou shalt live beside honest
+neighbors, in respect and comfort."
+
+Now the Christian puzzled, but he thought, "If what Mr. Worldly
+Wiseman says is true, my wisest plan is to take his advice."
+
+"Sir," said Christian, "which is my way to this honest man's house?"
+
+"Do you see yonder high hill?"
+
+"Yes, very well."
+
+"By that hill you must go, and the first house you come to is his."
+
+So Christian turned out of his way to go to the house for help. But
+behold, when he was now close to the hill, it seemed so steep, and
+also that side of it that was next the wayside did hang so much over,
+that Christian was afraid to venture farther, lest the hill should
+fall on his head. Wherefore he stood still, and knew not what to do.
+Also his burden now seemed heavier to him than while he was in his
+way. There came also flashes of fire out of the hill, that made
+Christian afraid that he should be burned. Here therefore he did quake
+for fear. And now he began to be sorry that he had taken Mr. Worldly
+Wiseman's counsel. Then he saw Evangelist coming to meet him, at the
+sight also of whom he began to blush for shame. So Evangelist drew
+nearer and nearer, and coming up to him, he looked upon him with a
+severe and dreadful countenance.
+
+"What dost thou here, Christian?" said he. At which words Christian
+knew not what to answer, wherefore at first he stood speechless before
+him. Then said Evangelist, "Art not thou the man I found crying
+without the walls of the City of Destruction?"
+
+"Yes," said Christian, "I am the man."
+
+"Did I not direct thee the way to the little Wicket-gate?"
+
+"Yes," said Christian.
+
+"How is it, then, that thou art so quickly turned out of the way?"
+
+"I met with a gentleman as soon as I had got over the Slough of
+Despond, who told me that in yonder village I might find a man who
+could take off my burden."
+
+"What was he like?"
+
+"He looked like a gentleman, and talked much to me, and got me at last
+to believe his words. So I came hither, but when I beheld this hill
+and how it hangs over the way, I suddenly stood still lest it should
+fall on my head."
+
+"What said that gentleman to you?"
+
+"Why, he asked me whither I was going, and if I had a wife and
+children, and he bid me make speed to get rid of my burden. And I
+said, 'I am going to yonder gate to be told how I may get rid of it.'
+
+"So he said he would show me a better and a shorter way, and not so
+full of difficulties as the way that you directed me. But when I came
+to this place, I stopped for fear of danger, and now I know not what
+to do!" So Christian stood trembling before Evangelist.
+
+Then said Evangelist, "Give heed to the things I shall tell thee. Mr.
+Worldly Wiseman sought to turn thee out of the way and to bring thee
+into danger. In yonder village has no man ever yet got rid of his
+burden, nor is he ever likely to lose it there. Therefore, Mr. Worldly
+Wiseman and his friend are deceivers, and cannot help thee."
+
+After this there came words and fire out of the mountain under which
+Christian stood. Now Christian looked for nothing but death, and began
+to cry out, saying he would he had never met Mr. Worldly Wiseman or
+that he had never listened to him. Then he turned to Evangelist and
+said, "Sir, what do you think? Is there any hope? May I now go back
+and go up to the Wicket-gate? Or shall I be sent back from the gate
+ashamed? I am sorry I have listened to this man's counsel, but may my
+sins be forgiven?"
+
+Evangelist said to him, "Thy sin is very great. Thou hast left the
+good way and walked in forbidden paths. Yet will the man at the gate
+receive thee, for he has good will for men. Only," said he, "take heed
+that thou turn not aside again."
+
+Then did Christian prepare to go back. And Evangelist, after he had
+kissed him, gave him one smile, and bid him Godspeed. So Christian
+went on with haste, neither spake he to any man by the way. Even if
+any one spoke to him, he would not venture an answer. He walked like
+one that was all the while treading on forbidden ground, and could by
+no means think himself safe, till again he had got into the way which
+he had left to follow Mr. Worldly Wiseman's counsel. So in process of
+time Christian got up to the gate. Now over the gate there was
+written, "Knock, and it shall be opened unto you." He knocked
+therefore more than once or twice. At last there came a grave person
+to the gate, named Good-will. He asked who was there, and whence he
+came, and what he desired.
+
+"I am a sinner," said Christian; "I come from the City of Destruction,
+but am going to Mount Zion. I am told that by this gate is the way
+thither, and I would know if you are willing to let me in."
+
+"I am willing with all my heart," said Good-will, and he opened the
+gate. So when Christian was stepping in, the other gave him a pull.
+
+"Why do you do that?" said Christian.
+
+Then Good-will told him, "A little distance from this gate a strong
+castle has been built, of which Beelzebub is the captain. And he and
+those that are with him shoot arrows at those that come up to this
+gate, hoping they may die before they enter in."
+
+So when Christian had come in, Good-will asked him who had directed
+him to the gate.
+
+"Evangelist bid me come here and knock, as I did. And he said that
+you, sir, would tell me what I must do."
+
+Then Good-will said, "Come a little way with me, good Christian, and I
+will teach thee about the way thou must go. Look before thee; dost
+thou see this narrow way? That is the way thou must go, and it is as
+straight as a rule can make it. This is the way thou must go."
+
+"But," said Christian, "are there no turnings, nor windings, by which
+a stranger may lose his way?"
+
+"Yes, there are many ways join this, but they are crooked and wide.
+Thou mayest know the right from the wrong way, for the right way is
+always strait and narrow."
+
+Then I saw in my dream that Christian asked him if he could not help
+him off with his burden that was upon his back. For as yet he had not
+got rid of it, nor could he get it off without help. But Good-will
+said, "Thou must be content to bear it, until thou comest to a place
+where stands a Cross, for there it will fall from thy back of itself."
+
+Then Christian began to get ready to continue his journey. So
+Good-will told him that when he had gone some distance from the gate,
+he would come to the house of the Interpreter, at whose door he should
+knock, and he would show him wonderful things. Then Christian took
+leave of his friend, and he again bid him Godspeed. Now Christian went
+on till he came to the house of the Interpreter, where he knocked over
+and over. At last one came to the door and asked who was there.
+
+"Sir," said Christian, "I am a traveler who was told by Good-will to
+call here. I would therefore speak with the master of the house." So
+he called for the master of the house, who, after a little time, came
+to Christian and asked what he would have.
+
+"Sir," said Christian, "I am a man that has come from the City of
+Destruction, and I am going to Mount Zion. I was told by the man that
+stands at the Wicket-gate that if I called here you would show me
+things that would help me on my journey."
+
+Then said the Interpreter, "Come in, and I will show thee what will
+help thee." So he commanded his man to light the candle, and bid
+Christian follow him. Then he took him into a private room, and bid
+his man open a door. And Christian saw the picture of a very grave
+person hung up against the wall. He had eyes lifted up to heaven, the
+best of books in his hand, and a crown of gold did hang over his head.
+
+Then said Christian, "What means this?"
+
+"The man whose picture this is," answered the Interpreter, "is one of
+a thousand. He is the only man who may be thy guide in all difficult
+places thou mayest meet with in the way. Wherefore be very careful to
+remember whom thou hast seen."
+
+Then the Interpreter led him into a very large parlor that was full of
+dust, because it was never swept, and after he had looked at it for a
+little while, the Interpreter called for a man to sweep. Now when he
+began to sweep, the dust began to fly about, so that Christian was
+almost choked. Then said the Interpreter to a damsel that stood near,
+"Bring hither the water and sprinkle the room." And when this was done
+the room was swept and cleansed.
+
+Then said Christian, "What does this mean?"
+
+The Interpreter answered, "This parlor is like the heart of an evil
+man. The dust is his sin, and the damsel that sprinkles the water is
+the Gospel."
+
+I saw moreover in my dream, that the Interpreter took Christian by the
+hand and led him into a little room, where sat two little children,
+each one in his chair. The name of the eldest was Passion, and the
+name of the other Patience. Passion seemed to be very discontented,
+but Patience was very quiet.
+
+Then Christian asked, "What is the reason of the discontent of
+Passion?"
+
+The Interpreter answered, "The governor of the children would have
+them wait for their new toys, till the beginning of next year, but
+Passion wishes to have them all now, while Patience, is willing to
+wait." Then the Interpreter took Christian to a place where there was
+a fire burning against a wall, and one standing near it, always
+casting much water upon it to quench it, yet did the fire burn higher
+and hotter. But afterwards the Interpreter took him to the back of the
+wall, where he saw a man with a vessel of oil in his hand, and he
+poured the oil continually, but secretly, into the fire.
+
+"What does this mean?" asked Christian.
+
+The Interpreter answered, "The fire is a picture of the grace God puts
+into the heart. He that casts water on it to put it out is the Evil
+One. And the man who pours oil on the fire to keep it alight is
+Christ."
+
+I saw also that the Interpreter took Christian again by the hand and
+led him into a place, where was builded a stately palace, beautiful to
+behold, at the sight of which Christian was greatly delighted. He saw
+also upon the top of the palace certain persons walking, and they were
+clothed all in gold.
+
+Then said Christian, "May we go in here?" So the Interpreter took him
+and led him toward the door of the palace. Now before they came up to
+the door, they passed a man, sitting at a table, with a book and his
+inkhorn before him, to take down the name of any who should enter.
+And, behold, at the door stood a great company of men, who wished to
+go in, but did not dare to enter, for within the doorway stood many
+men in armor to guard it. Now, these men in armor were determined to
+do any who would enter as much harm and mischief as they could.
+Christian was amazed. At last, when every man started back for fear of
+the armed men, Christian saw a man with a very strong face come up to
+the man that sat at the table, saying:
+
+"Set down my name, sir."
+
+And when this was done, Christian saw the strong man draw his sword
+and put an helmet on his head, and rush toward the door upon the
+armed men. The armed men fought with great strength, but the man with
+the strong face was not at all discouraged, but fought most fiercely.
+So after he had received and given many wounds to those that tried to
+keep him out, he cut his way through them all, and pressed forward
+into the palace. Then there was a pleasant voice heard from those that
+walked upon the top of the palace, saying:
+
+ "Come in, come in;
+ Eternal glory thou shalt win."
+
+So he went in and was clothed in such garments as they.
+
+"Now," said Christian, "let me go."
+
+And the Interpreter said, "Hast thou understood these things?"
+
+"Yes," said Christian, and he began to get ready to go on his journey.
+
+Then said the Interpreter, "God be always with thee, good Christian,
+to guide thee in the way that leads to Mount Zion."
+
+Now I saw in my dream that the highway up which Christian was to go
+was fenced on either side with a wall. Up this way therefore, did
+Christian run, but not without great difficulty, because of the load
+on his back. He ran thus till he came to a steeper place, and upon
+that place stood a Cross, and a little below, a Sepulcher. So I saw in
+my dream that just as Christian came up to the Cross his burden fell
+from off his back, and began to tumble till it came to the mouth of
+the Sepulcher, where it fell in and I saw it no more. Then was
+Christian glad and happy, and he stood for a while to look and wonder,
+for it was surprising to him to see that the Cross should make him
+lose his burden. Now as he stood looking, behold three Shining Ones
+came to him and greeted him.
+
+The first said to him, "Thy sins be forgiven thee." The second took
+away all his rags and clothed him in new raiment. The third set a mark
+on his forehead and gave him a roll with a seal on it, which he should
+give in at the Celestial Gate. So they went their way.
+
+Then Christian gave three leaps for joy and went on singing. I saw
+then in my dream that as he walked he saw two men come tumbling over
+the wall into the narrow way.
+
+"Gentlemen, where do you come from and whither do you go?" said
+Christian.
+
+They told him, "We were born in a land called Vainglory, and we are
+going to Mount Zion."
+
+"Why came you not in at the gate?" said Christian.
+
+They said that to go to the gate was too far, so they had taken a
+short cut and climbed over the wall.
+
+"But," said Christian, "will the Lord of the City to which we are
+going be pleased that you should come into the way over the wall?"
+
+But the men said he need not trouble his head about that, for what
+they did had been done many times before. It had been a custom for
+more than a thousand years. And besides, said they, "If we get into
+the way, what does it matter how we get in? You came in by the
+Wicket-gate, and are in the way, and we came tumbling over the wall
+and are in the way, so now we are all in the same condition."
+
+"But," said Christian, "I walk by the Rule of my Master, and you walk
+just as you like best."
+
+Then said they, "We see not how thou art different to us, except by
+the coat thou wearest, and that, we suppose, was given thee by some of
+thy neighbors, to hide thy rags."
+
+"Well," said Christian, "the Lord of the City to which I go gave me
+this coat the day that he took away from me my rags. He will surely
+know me, since I have His coat on my back. I have also a mark in my
+forehead, which you may not have noticed, and this was given to me by
+one of my Lord's friends, on the day my burden fell off my shoulders.
+I will tell you too, that I had a roll given me, to comfort me by
+reading, as I go on the way. I am also to give in the roll at the
+Celestial Gate. All these things I think you are without, because you
+came not in at the gate."
+
+To these things they gave him no answer, only they looked at each
+other and laughed. I beheld then, that they all went on without
+talking much together, till they came to the foot of the hill
+Difficulty, at the bottom of which was a spring. The narrow way lay
+right up the hill, but there were also two other ways here. One turned
+to the left hand and the other to the right at the bottom of the hill.
+Christian now went to the spring and drank to refresh himself, and
+then began to go up the narrow path that led to the top of the hill.
+The other two also came to the foot of the hill. But when they saw
+that the hill was steep and high, they made up their minds to go in
+the other paths that lay round the side of the hill. So one took the
+way that was called Danger, which led him into a great wood, and the
+other took the way called Destruction, which led him into a wide
+field, full of dark mountains, where he stumbled and fell and rose no
+more. I looked then to Christian to see him go up the hill, and then I
+saw that he had begun to clamber upon his hands and his knees, because
+of the steepness of the place. Now about midway to the top of the hill
+was a pleasant arbor, made by the Lord of the hill for the refreshing
+of weary travelers. When Christian got there he sat down to rest, then
+he pulled out his roll and read in it to comfort himself, and he began
+again to look at the garment that was given to him at the Cross. Thus
+he at last fell into a slumber, and then into a sound sleep, which
+kept him in that place, until it was almost night, and in his sleep
+his roll fell out of his hand. Now, as he was sleeping, there came one
+to him and awaked him. Then Christian suddenly started up and sped on
+his way till he came to the top of the hill.
+
+When he was got to the top of the hill, there came two men running to
+meet him. The name of the one was Timorous, and the other Mistrust.
+
+"Sirs," said Christian, "what is the matter? You run the wrong way."
+
+Timorous answered that they were going to the City of Zion and had got
+up that difficult place. "But," said he, "the farther we go, the more
+danger we meet with, wherefore we turned and are going back again."
+
+"Yes," said Mistrust; "for just before us lie a couple of lions in the
+way, whether sleeping or waking we know not, but we thought if we came
+within reach, they would pull us in pieces."
+
+Then said Christian, "You make me afraid, but yet I will go forward."
+So Mistrust and Timorous ran down the hill, and Christian went on his
+way. And as he went he thought again of what he heard from the men.
+Then he felt for his roll, that he might read and be comforted, but he
+felt and found it not.
+
+Now was Christian in great distress and knew not what to do. At last
+he bethought himself that he had slept in the arbor that was on the
+side of the hill, and then he went back to look for his roll. But all
+the way he went back, who can tell the sorrow of Christian's heart?
+Sometimes he sighed, sometimes he wept, and often he chid himself for
+being so foolish as to fall asleep. Thus therefore he went back,
+carefully looking on this side and on that all the way as he went. For
+he hoped to find the roll that had been his comfort so many times in
+his journey. He went back till he came again within sight of the arbor
+where he had sat and slept, but that sight renewed his sorrow again,
+by reminding him how eagerly he had slept there. And as he went
+towards the arbor, he sighed over his sleepiness, saying, "Oh, foolish
+man that I was, why did I sleep in the daytime? oh, that I had not
+slept."
+
+Now, by the time he was come to the arbor again, for a while he sat
+down and wept, but, at last, looking sorrowfully down under the
+settle, he espied his roll, which with trembling haste he caught up.
+But who can tell how joyful Christian was when he had got his roll
+again, or with what joy and tears he began to go up the hill again.
+And, oh, how nimbly did he go up! Yet before he reached the top the
+sun went down. Now Christian remembered the story that Mistrust and
+Timorous had told him, how they were frightened with the sight of the
+lions. And he said to himself, "If these beasts meet me in the dark,
+how shall I escape being by them torn in pieces?"
+
+But while he was in this fright, he lifted up his eyes, and behold,
+there was a very stately palace before him, the name of which was
+Beautiful, and it stood by the highway side. So I saw in my dream that
+he made haste, that if possible he might get lodging there. Now before
+he had gone far, he entered into a very narrow passage; and looking
+before him as he went, he espied two lions in the way. The lions were
+chained, but Christian did not see the chains. Then he was afraid and
+thought he would go back, but the porter at the lodge, whose name is
+Watchful, seeing Christian stop, as if he would go back, cried, "Fear
+not the lions, for they are chained."
+
+Then I saw that Christian went on till he came and stood before the
+gate where the porter was. And Christian said to the porter, "Sir,
+what house is this? May I lodge here to-night?"
+
+The porter answered, "This house was built by the Lord of the hill,
+for the safety of pilgrims."
+
+So Watchful the porter rang a bell, at the sound of which a grave and
+beautiful damsel came out of the door. When she saw Christian she
+brought him into the Palace Beautiful, and she and her sisters talked
+with him until supper was ready. Now all their talk at table was about
+the Lord of the hill, and, by what they said, I knew that He had been
+a great Warrior, and that He had fought and slain Death, but not
+without great danger to Himself, which made me love Him the more. They
+talked together till late at night, and after they had committed
+themselves to their Lord for protection, they went to bed. The room in
+which the pilgrim slept had a window opening towards the sunrising,
+and the name of the room was Peace. In the morning they all got up,
+and after some more talk, they told him that they would take him to
+the armory before he left them. So they did, and when he came out, he
+was harnessed from head to foot, lest he should be attacked in the
+way. Then Christian walked with his friends to the gate, and there he
+asked the porter if he had seen any pilgrims pass.
+
+The porter answered, "Yes, a pilgrim called Faithful has passed this
+way."
+
+"Oh," said Christian, "I know him. He comes from the place where I was
+born. How far do you think he has got?"
+
+"By this time he is below the hill," said the porter.
+
+Then Christian began to go down the hill into the Valley of
+Humiliation, where it is difficult not to slip. He went down very
+warily, yet he slipped once or twice. Now in the valley Christian had
+a hard fight with a fiend called Apollyon. Apollyon was a monster and
+hideous to behold. He was clothed with scales like a fish, he had
+wings like a dragon, feet like a bear, and his mouth was as the mouth
+of a lion, and out of it came fire and smoke. When he came up to
+Christian he looked at him with rage in his face, and said, "Prepare
+thyself to die, for thou shalt go no farther." And he threw a flaming
+dart at him, but Christian had a shield in his hand, which caught the
+dart, so that it did him no harm. Then did Christian draw his sword,
+but Apollyon threw darts at him as thick as hail, and wounded him in
+his head, his hand, and foot. This great combat lasted half a day,
+till Christian was almost worn out.
+
+Then Apollyon came close to Christian, and wrestled with him and gave
+him a dreadful fall, and Christian's sword flew out of his hand.
+
+"I am sure of thee now," said Apollyon. But while he was taking a last
+blow to kill this good man altogether, Christian nimbly stretched out
+his hand for his sword, and caught it. Then he gave Apollyon a deadly
+thrust, and Apollyon spread his wings and sped him away, so that
+Christian saw him no more. In this combat no man could imagine, unless
+he had seen and heard as I did, what yelling and roaring Apollyon made
+all the time of the fight. He spake like a dragon. On the other side,
+sighs and groans burst from Christian's heart. I never saw him give so
+much as a pleasant look, till he saw that he had wounded Apollyon with
+his two-edged sword. Then indeed he did smile and look upward, but it
+was the dreadfulest sight that ever I saw.
+
+So when the battle was over, Christian said, "I will give thanks to
+Him that did help me against Apollyon."
+
+He also sat down in that place to eat and drink, so being refreshed,
+he again began his journey, with his sword drawn in his hand, "For,"
+said he, "I do not know if some other enemy may not be at hand."
+
+Now at the end of this valley was another, called the Valley of the
+Shadow of Death. Through it Christian must go, because the way to the
+Celestial City lay through it. Now this valley is a very lonely place.
+It is like a wilderness or a desert full of pits. No man dwells in it,
+and no man but a Christian passeth through it. Here Christian had a
+worse time than even in his fight with Apollyon. I saw then in my
+dream that when Christian had reached the borders of this valley,
+there met him two men, making haste to go back.
+
+Christian said to them, "Whither are you going?"
+
+"Back, back," they cried, "as you will go, if you prize life or
+peace!"
+
+"Why, what is the matter?" said Christian.
+
+"Matter!" said they. "We were going the way you are going, and we went
+as far as we dared. But had we gone a little farther we had not been
+here to bring the news to thee."
+
+"But what have you met with?" said Christian.
+
+"Why, we were almost in the Valley of the Shadow of Death, but by good
+chance we looked before us and saw the danger before we came to it."
+
+"But what have you seen?" said Christian.
+
+"Seen!" said the men, "why, the valley itself was as dark as pitch. We
+also saw hobgoblins and dragons, and we heard a continual howling and
+yelling as of people in great misery. Death also doth always spread
+his wings over it. In a word, it is altogether dreadful, being utterly
+without order."
+
+"But," said Christian, "this is the way to the Celestial City."
+
+"Be it your way, then; we will not choose it for ours." So they
+parted. Christian went on his way, but still with his sword drawn in
+his hand, lest he should be attacked.
+
+I saw then in my dream, that as far as this valley reached, there was
+on the right hand a very deep ditch. Again, behold, on the left hand,
+there was a very dangerous mire, into which if a man falls he finds no
+bottom for his foot to stand on. The pathway here was also exceeding
+narrow, and therefore Christian was the more distressed. For when he
+sought in the dark to shun the ditch on the one hand, he was ready to
+tumble over into the mire on the other, and when he sought to escape
+the mire, without great carefulness he would nearly fall into the
+ditch. Then he went on, and I heard him sigh bitterly. For besides
+these dangers, the pathway was here so dark, that when he lifted up
+his foot to go forward, he knew not where, nor upon what he should
+set it next. About the middle of this valley I saw the mouth of hell
+to be, and it stood close to the wayside.
+
+"Now," thought Christian, "what shall I do?"
+
+And ever and anon the flame and smoke came out in such abundance, with
+sparks and hideous noises, that he was forced to put away his sword
+and betake himself to another weapon, called All-prayer.
+
+Then he cried out in my hearing, "O Lord, I beseech thee, deliver my
+soul." Thus he went on a great while, yet still the flames would be
+rushing towards him. Also he heard doleful voices and rushings to and
+fro, so that sometimes he thought he should be torn in pieces, or
+trodden down like mire in the streets.
+
+This frightful sight was seen, and these dreadful noises were heard by
+him for several miles together. Then Christian came to a place where
+he thought he heard a company of fiends coming forward to meet him,
+and he stopped and began to think what it would be best for him to do.
+Sometimes he thought he would go back, but again he thought he might
+be half-way through the valley. So he resolved to go on, yet the
+fiends seemed to come nearer and nearer. But when they were come
+almost close to him, he cried out in a loud voice, "I will walk in the
+strength of the Lord God." Then the fiends went back and came no
+farther.
+
+Now Christian thought he heard the voice of a man going before him,
+saying, "Though I walk through the Valley of the Shadow of Death, I
+will fear no evil, for Thou art with me." Then he was glad, for he
+thought that some one who feared God was in this valley, as well as
+himself, and he hoped to overtake him and have company by and by.
+
+Now morning being come, he looked back to see by the light of day what
+dangers he had gone through in the night. So he saw more plainly the
+ditch that was on the one hand, and the mire that was on the other,
+also how narrow the way was that lay between them both. He saw, too,
+the hobgoblins and dragons, but all afar off, for after break of day
+they came not nigh.
+
+About this time the sun was rising, and this was a great help to
+Christian, for you must know that though the first part of the Valley
+of the Shadow of Death was dangerous, yet this second part, through
+which he had to go, was, if possible, far more dangerous. For, from
+the place where he now stood, even to the end of the valley, the way
+was all along so full of snares, traps, and nets here, so full of
+pits, pitfalls, and deep holes down there, that if it had been dark,
+he would almost surely have been lost, but as I said just now, the sun
+was rising. In this light, therefore, he came to the end of the
+valley.
+
+Now as Christian went on his way, he came to a little hill, and going
+up he looked forward and saw Faithful before him. Then said Christian,
+"Stay, and I will be your companion."
+
+And when he overtook Faithful they went very lovingly on together, and
+talked of all that had happened to them in their pilgrimage. Then I
+saw in my dream that when they got out of the wilderness they saw a
+town before them, and the name of that town was Vanity, and at the
+town there was a fair kept, called Vanity Fair. It was kept all the
+year long.
+
+At this fair there were sold houses, lands, trades, husbands, wives,
+children, silver, gold, pearls, and precious stones. And, moreover, at
+this fair, there were at all times cheats and jugglers and knaves and
+rogues.
+
+Now the way to the Celestial City lay just through this town, so the
+pilgrims had to go through the fair.
+
+The Prince of princes Himself, when here, went through this town to
+his own country, and that on a fair-day too. And, I think, it was
+Beelzebub the chief lord of this fair that invited the Prince to buy
+of his vanities. Beelzebub even said he would have made Him lord of
+the fair, if He would have done him reverence as He went through the
+town. Yea, because the Prince was so great a person, Beelzebub took
+Him from street to street and showed Him all his kingdoms, that he
+might, if possible, tempt the Prince to buy some of his vanities. But
+the Blessed One did not wish any of these vanities, and therefore left
+the town without spending so much as one farthing upon these vanities.
+
+Now these pilgrims, Christian and Faithful, as I said, had to go
+through this fair.
+
+Well, so they did, but behold, whenever they entered into the fair,
+it and the town itself were in a hubbub about them. For the pilgrims
+were clothed with raiment that was very different from the raiment of
+any that traded in that fair. The people gazed upon Christian and
+Faithful and called them outlandish men.
+
+Then also, they wondered at the pilgrim's speech, as few could
+understand what they said, for they spoke the language of the
+Celestial City. But those that kept the fair spoke the language of the
+city of Vanity Fair, and they could not understand one another.
+
+Now when these pilgrims would not buy their wares and would not even
+look at them, the sellers were angry and mocked these men, and some
+called on others to smite them. At last the master of the fair told
+his men to question the pilgrims. And when Christian and Faithful told
+the men that they were strangers in the world and were going to the
+Celestial City, the men thought they were mad. Therefore they took
+them and beat them and threw mud at them, and then they put them in a
+cage to be a show to the people at the fair. But when they were tired
+of mocking them, these two pilgrims were again examined and charged as
+guilty of the great disturbance in the fair. So they beat them
+pitilessly, and hanged irons upon them, and led them in chains up and
+down the fair. Then Christian and Faithful behaved so wisely and
+patiently, that the others were still more angry, and said they would
+put these men to death.
+
+Therefore, after a trial, Faithful was brought out, to do with him
+according to their law. And first they scourged him, then they
+buffeted him, then they stoned him with stones, then they pricked him
+with their swords, and last of all they burned him to ashes at the
+stake. Now I saw behind the people a chariot and a couple of horses
+waiting for Faithful, who was taken by it through the clouds, the
+nearest way to the Celestial City. Then was Christian sent back to the
+prison, where he dwelt for a time, till he escaped and went again on
+his way. But he did not go alone, for there was one whose name was
+Hopeful, who left the town of Vanity, and was a companion to Christian
+in his pilgrimage. They went on their way till they came to a
+pleasant river. Now their way lay just along the bank of the river,
+and Christian and his companion walked there with great delight. They
+drank also of the river, and ate of the fruit that grew on the trees
+by its bank. On either side of the river was also a meadow, very
+beautiful with lilies, and it was green all the year long. In this
+meadow they lay down and slept, for here they might lie safely. Now I
+beheld in my dream that they had not journeyed far, when the river and
+the way parted, and at this they were very sorry, yet they dare not go
+out of the way.
+
+A little before them was a meadow and a stile to go over into it. Then
+said Christian, "If this meadow lies along by our path, let us go
+over." He went to the stile to see, and behold, a path lay alongside
+of the way, on the other side of the fence.
+
+"That is as I wish," said Christian. "Come, good Hopeful, and let us
+go over.
+
+"But," said Hopeful, "what if this path should lead us out of the
+way?"
+
+"That is not likely," said the other. "Look, it goes along by the
+wayside." So Hopeful, being persuaded by Christian, went after him
+over the stile. When they had gone over and had got into the path,
+they found it very easy for their feet. And as they looked before them
+they saw a man walking as they did, and his name was Vain-confidence.
+So they called after him, and asked where this way led.
+
+He said, "To the Celestial City."
+
+"Look," said Christian to Hopeful, "did I not tell you so? You see, we
+are right after all." So they followed Vain-confidence, and he went
+before them.
+
+But behold, the night came on, and it was very dark, so that they that
+went behind lost sight of him that went before. Vain-confidence then
+went on, not seeing the way before him, and fell into a deep pit which
+was there. This pit was made by the Prince of those grounds on
+purpose, to catch such foolish men as Vain-confidence. He, then, fell
+into the pit and was dashed to pieces with his fall. Now Christian and
+Hopeful heard him fall, so they called to know what was the matter,
+but there was none to answer, only they heard a groaning.
+
+Then said Hopeful, "Where are we now?" But Christian was silent, for
+he began to be afraid that he had led Hopeful out of the way.
+
+Now it began to rain and thunder and lighten in a very dreadful
+manner, and the river flowed over the banks.
+
+And Hopeful groaned, "Oh that I had kept on my way."
+
+By this time the waters were greatly risen, so that to go back was
+very dangerous. Yet they tried to go back, but it was so dark, and the
+flood was so high, that as they went they were nearly drowned nine or
+ten times, and they could not reach the stile again that night.
+Wherefore at last, coming to a little shelter, they sat down, but
+being weary they fell asleep. Now there was, not far from the place
+where they lay, a castle, called Doubting Castle, and the owner of the
+castle was Giant Despair, and it was in his grounds the pilgrims were
+now sleeping. Wherefore the giant, getting up early, and walking up
+and down in his fields, caught Christian and Hopeful asleep. Then with
+a grim and surly voice he woke them, and asked them what they were
+doing in his grounds. They told him they were pilgrims and had lost
+their way.
+
+The giant said, "You have trampled on my ground, and slept on it, and
+therefore you must go along with me." So they were forced to go,
+because he was stronger than they. Also they said very little, for
+they knew they had done wrong.
+
+The giant therefore drove them before him, and put them into his
+castle, into a very dark dungeon. Here, then, they lay, from Wednesday
+morning till Saturday night, without one bit of bread or drop of
+drink, or light, or any one to speak to them. Now Giant Despair had a
+wife, and he told her he had taken a couple of men prisoners, because
+they were sleeping on his grounds. Then she told him that, when he
+arose in the morning, he should beat them without mercy.
+
+So Giant Despair got a cudgel, and went down to the dungeon and beat
+Christian and Hopeful fearfully, so that they could not move. Then the
+giant left them, and they spent their time in sighs and bitter tears.
+
+The next night Giant Despair again talked to his wife, and she said,
+"Tell your prisoners to kill themselves, for they will never escape
+from the dungeon."
+
+So when morning came, the giant went to them in a surly manner, and
+seeing they still ached with the stripes he had given them, he told
+them to poison themselves, for they would never get away from him in
+any other way. But they asked the giant to let them go. That made him
+so angry that he rushed on them and would have killed them, but he
+fell into a fit and lost for a time the use of his hand, wherefore he
+withdrew and left them as before. Well, towards evening the giant went
+down again to the dungeon to see if his prisoners had followed his
+advice and poisoned themselves. He found them alive, but because of
+their wounds and for want of bread and water they could do little but
+breathe.
+
+Now at night the giant's wife said: "Take the prisoners into the
+castle yard to-morrow, and show them the bones and skulls of those
+prisoners you have already killed. Tell them that in a week you will
+tear them to pieces, as you have torn your other prisoners."
+
+When the morning was come, the giant went to them again and took them
+into the castle yard, and showed them all his wife had bidden him.
+
+"These," said he, "were pilgrims once as you are, but they walked in
+my grounds as you have done. And when I thought fit, I tore them in
+pieces, and so within ten days I will do to you, Get you down to your
+den again," and he beat them all the way there.
+
+That night, about midnight, Christian and Hopeful began to pray, and
+they prayed till dawn of day.
+
+Now just at dawn Christian spoke in sudden amazement. "How foolish we
+are to lie here, when we might be free after all. I have a key in my
+pocket called Promise, that will, I am persuaded, open any lock in
+Doubting Castle."
+
+Then said Hopeful, "That is good news, pull it out of your pocket and
+try."
+
+Christian pulled it out and began to try the dungeon door, and the
+bolt, as he turned the key, yielded, and the door flew open, and
+Christian and Hopeful both came out. Then he went to the door that
+led to the castle yard, and with his key opened that door also. After
+that he went to the iron gate, for that must be opened too. That lock
+was terribly hard, yet the key did open it. Then they thrust open the
+gate to make their escape in haste, but, as it opened, that gate made
+such a creaking that it waked Giant Despair, who got up hastily to
+follow his prisoners, but he could not run after them, for again he
+took one of his fits. Then Christian and Hopeful went on till they
+came to the King's highway and so were safe, because they were out of
+the giant's grounds. Now when they had got over the stile, they began
+to wonder what they should do to keep other pilgrims from falling into
+the hands of Giant Despair. So they agreed to put up there a pillar,
+and to write on it this sentence: "Over this stile is the way to
+Doubting Castle, which is kept by Giant Despair, who despiseth the
+King of the Celestial Country and seeks to destroy His holy pilgrims."
+
+Many pilgrims, that came after, read what was written and escaped
+Giant Despair. They then went on till they came to the Delectable
+Mountains. These mountains belonged to the Lord of the steep hill
+which Christian had climbed. So they went up these mountains to behold
+the gardens and orchards, the vineyards and fountains. There, too,
+they drank and washed themselves and ate the fruit of the vineyards.
+Now there were Shepherds on the mountains, who welcomed them lovingly
+and showed them many wonders. First they took them to the top of a
+hill which was very steep on one side, and bid them look down to the
+bottom. So Christian and Hopeful looked down, and saw at the bottom
+several men dashed all to pieces by a fall that they had had from the
+top.
+
+"These," said the Shepherds, "are for an example to others to be
+careful not to clamber too high, or to come too near the brink of this
+mountain." The name of this mountain was Error.
+
+Then the Shepherds took them to the top of another mountain, and the
+name of it was Caution, and the Shepherds bid them look afar off. When
+the pilgrims did this, they saw, as they thought, several men walking
+up and down among the tombs that were there. And they saw that the men
+were blind, because they stumbled sometimes upon the tombs, and
+because they could not get out from among them.
+
+Then said Christian, "What means this?"
+
+The Shepherds then answered, "Did you see a little below these
+mountains a stile that led into a meadow?"
+
+They answered, "Yes."
+
+"From that stile," said the Shepherds, "there goes a path that leads
+straight to Doubting Castle, which is kept by Giant Despair. These
+men," and the Shepherds pointed to those among the tombs, "came once
+on a pilgrimage as you do now. But when they came to the stile,
+because the right way was rough, they went over it into the meadow.
+Here they were taken by Giant Despair and cast into Doubting Castle.
+After they had been kept some time in the dungeon, he at last did put
+out their eyes. Then he led them among those tombs, and left them to
+wander there till this very day."
+
+Then Christian and Hopeful thought of their escape from Doubting
+Castle, and they looked at one another with tears in their eyes. But
+yet they said nothing to the Shepherds. Now I saw in my dream that the
+Shepherds brought them to another place, where was a door in the side
+of a hill, and they opened the door and bid the pilgrims look in. They
+looked in therefore and saw that within it was very dark and smoky.
+They also thought that they heard there a rumbling noise as of fire,
+and a cry as of some in trouble.
+
+Then said Christian, "What means this?"
+
+The Shepherds said, "This is a byway to hell."
+
+And the Shepherds said one to another, "Let us show the pilgrims the
+gates of the Celestial City, if they have skill to look through our
+glass."
+
+So they took Christian and Hopeful to the top of another high hill,
+called Clear, and gave them the glass to look. They tried to look, but
+the remembrance of that last thing the Shepherds had showed them made
+their hands shake, so that they could not look steadily through the
+glass. Yet they thought they saw something like the gate, and also
+some of the beauty of the place. When they were about to depart, one
+of the Shepherds gave them a note of the way. Another of them bid
+them beware when they met the Flatterer. The third bid them take heed
+that they did not sleep upon the Enchanted Ground. And the fourth bid
+them "Godspeed." So I awoke from my dream.
+
+And I slept and dreamed again, and I saw the same two pilgrims going
+down the mountains and along the highway. They went on then till they
+came to a place where they saw another path that seemed to be as
+straight as the way which they should go. And here they knew not which
+of the two to take, for both seemed straight before them, therefore
+here they stood still to think.
+
+And as they were thinking about the way, behold, a man, black of
+flesh, but covered with a very light robe, came to them, and asked
+them why they stood there.
+
+They answered they were going to the Celestial City, but knew not
+which of these ways to take.
+
+"Follow me," said the man. "It is there I am going."
+
+So they followed him in the path that had joined the way, and this
+path slowly turned, and at last turned them so far from the City that
+they wished to go to, that in a little time their faces were turned
+away from it. Yet they still followed him. But by and by before they
+knew what had happened, he led them both into a net, in which they
+were so entangled that they knew not what to do. Then the white robe
+fell off the black man's back, and they knew that he was the Flatterer
+and had brought them into his net. Wherefore there they lay, crying
+some time, for they could not get themselves out. And as they lay
+weeping in the net, they saw a Shining One coming toward them with a
+whip of small cord in his hand. When he was come to the place where
+they were, he asked them whence they came, and what they were doing
+there.
+
+They told him that they were poor pilgrims going to Zion, but were led
+out of their way by a black man clothed in white. "He bid us," said
+they, "follow him, for he was going thither too."
+
+Then said the Shining One, "It is a Flatterer that has clothed himself
+like an angel of light." So he rent the net and let the men out. And
+he said to the pilgrims, "Follow me," and he led them back to the way
+which they had left when they followed the Flatterer.
+
+The one with the whip then asked them where they slept last night.
+
+They said, "With the Shepherds on the Delectable Mountains."
+
+He asked them if the Shepherds had not given them a note, telling them
+about the way. They answered, "Yes," but they had forgotten to read
+it. He asked them also if the Shepherds did not tell them to beware of
+the Flatterer. They answered, "Yes," but they did not think that this
+man who spoke so well could be he. Then I saw in my dream that the
+Shining One commanded them to lie down. And he took his whip, and when
+he had whipped them he said, "As many as I love I rebuke and punish,
+be careful therefore and repent."
+
+This done, he bid them go on their way and take good heed to the other
+directions of the Shepherds. So they thanked the Shining One for all
+his kindness, and went gladly along the right way. Now I saw in my
+dream that when the pilgrims had got safely over the Enchanted Ground,
+they entered a beautiful country where the air was very sweet and
+pleasant. Every day they heard continually the singing of birds, and
+every day they saw the flowers appear in the earth. In this country
+the sun shineth night and day, and here they were within sight of the
+City to which they went. So I saw that as they went on, there met them
+two men in raiment that shone like gold, also their faces shone as the
+light. These men asked the pilgrims where they came from, and they
+told them. They also asked them where they had lodged, what
+difficulties and dangers, what comforts and pleasures they had met in
+the way, and they told them.
+
+Then said the men that met them, "You have but two difficulties more
+to meet and then you are in the City." So they all walked together
+till they came in sight of the gate.
+
+Now I saw that between them and the gate was a river, but there was no
+bridge to go over, and the river was deep. At the sight of the river
+Christian and Hopeful were stunned, but the men that went with them
+said, "You must go through, or you cannot come in at the gate."
+
+The pilgrims then, especially Christian, began to be afraid, and
+looked this way and that way, but could find no way by which to escape
+the river. Then they entered the river, and Christian began to sink
+and to cry out to his friend Hopeful, saying, "I sink in deep waters,
+the billows go over my head."
+
+But Hopeful cheered Christian, and said he felt the ground under his
+feet. Yet a great horror and darkness fell upon Christian, for he
+thought he should never reach the Celestial City, and Hopeful had much
+difficulty to keep his friend's head above water. Then I saw in my
+dream that at last Christian took courage, and soon he found ground to
+stand upon, and the rest of the river was shallow. Thus they got over.
+Now upon the bank of the river, on the other side, they saw the two
+shining men again, who waited there for them, and led them toward the
+gate.
+
+The City stood upon a mighty hill, but the pilgrims went up that with
+ease, talking gladly to their shining companions, and thus they came
+up to the gate.
+
+And over the gate there were written in letters of gold "Blessed are
+they that do the King's Commandments and may enter in through the
+gates into the City."
+
+I saw in my dream that these two men went in at the gate, and lo! as
+they entered they were transfigured. And they had raiment put on that
+shone like gold. They had harps given to them to praise on, and crowns
+were given to them in token of honor.
+
+Then I heard in my dream that all the bells in the City rang again for
+joy, and that it was said, "Enter ye into the joy of your Lord."
+
+Now just as the gates were opened to let in the men, I looked in after
+them, and behold, the City shone like the sun, the streets also were
+paved with gold. And I heard many voices saying, "Holy, holy, holy is
+the Lord."
+
+And after that they shut up the gates, and when I had seen this, I
+wished I myself were within. So I awoke, and behold it was a dream.
+
+
+
+
+TALES FROM SHAKESPEARE
+
+By CHARLES AND MARY LAMB
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+THE TEMPEST
+
+
+There was a certain island in the sea, the only inhabitants of which
+were an old man, whose name was Prospero, and his daughter Miranda, a
+very beautiful young lady. She came to this island so young, that she
+had no memory of having seen any other human face than her father's.
+
+They lived in a cave or cell, made out of a rock; it was divided into
+several apartments, one of which Prospero called his study; there he
+kept his books, which chiefly treated of magic, a study at that time
+much affected by all learned men: and the knowledge of this art he
+found very useful to him; for being thrown by a strange chance upon
+this island, which had been enchanted by a witch called Sycorax, who
+died there a short time before his arrival, Prospero, by virtue of his
+art, released many good spirits that Sycorax had imprisoned in the
+bodies of large trees, because they had refused to execute her wicked
+commands. These gentle spirits were ever after obedient to the will of
+Prospero. Of these Ariel was the chief.
+
+The lively little sprite Ariel had nothing mischievous in his nature,
+except that he took rather too much pleasure in tormenting an ugly
+monster called Caliban, for he owed him a grudge because he was the
+son of his old enemy Sycorax. This Caliban, Prospero found in the
+woods, a strange misshapen thing, far less human in form than an ape:
+he took him home to his cell, and taught him to speak; and Prospero
+would have been very kind to him, but the bad nature which Caliban
+inherited from his mother Sycorax, would not let him learn anything
+good or useful: therefore he was employed like a slave, to fetch
+wood, and do the most laborious offices; and Ariel had the charge of
+compelling him to these services.
+
+When Caliban was lazy and neglected his work, Ariel (who was invisible
+to all eyes but Prospero's) would come slily and pinch him, and
+sometimes tumble him down in the mire; and then Ariel, in the likeness
+of an ape, would make mouths at him. Then swiftly changing his shape,
+in the likeness of a hedgehog, he would lie tumbling in Caliban's way,
+who feared the hedgehog's sharp quills would prick his bare feet. With
+a variety of such-like vexatious tricks Ariel would often torment him,
+whenever Caliban neglected the work which Prospero commanded him to
+do.
+
+Having these powerful spirits obedient to his will, Prospero could by
+their means command the winds, and the waves of the sea. By his orders
+they raised a violent storm, in the midst of which, and struggling
+with the wild sea-waves that every moment threatened to swallow it up,
+he showed his daughter a fine large ship, which he told her was full
+of living beings like themselves. "O my dear father," said she, "if by
+your art you have raised this dreadful storm, have pity on their sad
+distress. See! the vessel will be dashed to pieces. Poor souls! they
+will all perish. If I had power, I would sink the sea beneath the
+earth, rather than the good ship should be destroyed, with all the
+precious souls within her."
+
+"Be not so amazed, daughter Miranda," said Prospero; "there is no harm
+done. I have so ordered it, that no person in the ship shall receive
+any hurt. What I have done has been in care of you, my dear child. You
+are ignorant who you are, or where you came from, and you know no more
+of me, but that I am your father, and live in this poor cave. Can you
+remember a time before you came to this cell? I think you cannot, for
+you were not then three years of age."
+
+"Certainly I can, sir," replied Miranda.
+
+"By what?" asked Prospero; "by any other house or person? Tell me what
+you can remember, my child."
+
+Miranda said, "It seems to me like the recollection of a dream. But
+had I not once four or five women who attended upon me?"
+
+Prospero answered, "You had, and more. How is it that this still lives
+in your mind? Do you remember how you came here?"
+
+"No, sir," said Miranda, "I remember nothing more."
+
+"Twelve years ago, Miranda," continued Prospero, "I was duke of Milan,
+and you were a princess, and my only heir. I had a younger brother,
+whose name was Antonio, to whom I trusted everything; and as I was
+fond of retirement and deep study, I commonly left the management of
+my state affairs to your uncle, my false brother (for so indeed he
+proved). I, neglecting all worldly ends buried among my books, did
+dedicate my whole time to the bettering of my mind. My brother Antonio
+being thus in possession of my power, began to think himself the duke
+indeed. The opportunity I gave him of making himself popular among my
+subjects awakened in his bad nature a proud ambition to deprive me of
+my dukedom: this he soon effected with the aid of the king of Naples,
+a powerful prince, who was my enemy."
+
+"Wherefore," said Miranda, "did they not that hour destroy us?"
+
+"My child," answered her father, "they durst not, so dear was the love
+that my people bore me. Antonio carried us on board a ship, and when
+we were some leagues out at sea, he forced us into a small boat,
+without either tackle, sail, or mast: there he left us, as he thought,
+to perish. But a kind lord of my court, one Gonzalo, who loved me, had
+privately placed in the boat, water, provisions, apparel, and some
+books which I prize above my dukedom."
+
+"O my father," said Miranda, "what a trouble must I have been to you
+then!"
+
+"No, my love," said Prospero, "you were a little cherub that did
+preserve me. Your innocent smiles made me bear up against my
+misfortunes. Our food lasted till we landed on this desert island,
+since then my chief delight has been in teaching you, Miranda, and
+well have you profited by my instructions."
+
+"Heaven thank you, my dear father," said Miranda. "Now pray tell me,
+sir, your reason for raising this sea-storm?"
+
+"Know then," said her father, "that by means of this storm, my
+enemies, the king of Naples, and my cruel brother, are cast ashore
+upon this island."
+
+Having so said, Prospero gently touched his daughter with his magic
+wand, and she fell fast asleep; for the spirit Ariel just then
+presented himself before his master, to give an account of the
+tempest, and how he had disposed of the ship's company, and though the
+spirits were always invisible to Miranda, Prospero did not choose she
+should hear him holding converse (as would seem to her) with the empty
+air.
+
+"Well, my brave spirit," said Prospero to Ariel, "how have you
+performed your task?"
+
+Ariel gave a lively description of the storm, and of the terrors of
+the mariners; and how the king's son, Ferdinand, was the first who
+leaped into the sea; and his father thought he saw his dear son
+swallowed up by the waves and lost. "But he is safe," said Ariel, "in
+a corner of the isle, sitting with his arms folded, sadly lamenting
+the loss of the king, his father, whom he concludes drowned. Not a
+hair of his head is injured, and his princely garments, though
+drenched in the sea-waves, look fresher than before."
+
+"That's my delicate Ariel," said Prospero. "Bring him hither: my
+daughter must see this young prince. Where is the king, and my
+brother?"
+
+"I left them," answered Ariel, "searching for Ferdinand, whom, they
+have little hopes of finding, thinking they saw him perish. Of the
+ship's crew not one is missing; though each one thinks himself the
+only one saved: and the ship, though invisible to them, is safe in the
+harbor."
+
+"Ariel," said Prospero, "thy charge is faithfully performed: but there
+is more work yet."
+
+"Is there more work?" said Ariel. "Let me remind you, master, you have
+promised me my liberty. I pray, remember, I have done you worthy
+service, told you no lies, made no mistakes, served you without grudge
+or grumbling."
+
+"How now!" said Prospero. "You do not recollect what a torment I freed
+you from. Have you forgot the wicked witch Sycorax, who with age and
+envy was almost bent double? Where was she born? Speak; tell me."
+
+"Sir, in Algiers," said Ariel.
+
+"O, was she so?" said Prospero. "I must recount what you have been,
+which I find you do not remember. This bad witch, Sycorax, for her
+witchcrafts, too terrible to enter human hearing, was banished from
+Algiers, and here left by the sailors; and because you were a spirit
+too delicate to execute her wicked commands, she shut you up in a
+tree, where I found you howling. This torment, remember, I did free
+you from."
+
+"Pardon me, dear master," said Ariel, ashamed to seem ungrateful; "I
+will obey your commands."
+
+"Do so," said Prospero, "and I will set you free." He then gave orders
+what further he would have him do; and away went Ariel, first to where
+he had left Ferdinand, and found him still sitting on the grass in the
+same melancholy posture.
+
+"O my young gentleman," said Ariel, when he saw him, "I will soon move
+you. You must be brought, I find, for the Lady Miranda to have a sight
+of your pretty person. Come, sir, follow me." He then began singing,
+
+ "Full fathom five thy father lies;
+ Of his bones are coral made;
+ Those are pearls that were his eyes:
+ Nothing of him that doth fade
+ But doth suffer a sea-change
+ Into something rich and strange.
+ Sea-nymphs hourly ring his knell:
+ Hark! now I hear them--Ding-dong, bell."
+
+This strange news of his lost father soon aroused the prince from the
+stupid fit into which he had fallen. He followed in amazement the
+sound of Ariel's voice, till it led him to Prospero and Miranda, who
+were sitting under the shade of a large tree. Now Miranda had never
+seen a man before, except her own father.
+
+"Miranda," said Prospero, "tell me what you are looking at yonder."
+
+"O father," said Miranda, in a strange surprise, "surely that is a
+spirit. How it looks about! Believe me, sir, it is a beautiful
+creature. Is it not a spirit?"
+
+"No, girl," answered her father; "it eats, and sleeps, and has senses
+such as we have. This young man you see was in the ship. He is
+somewhat altered by grief, or you might call him a handsome person. He
+has lost his companions, and is wandering about to find them."
+
+Miranda, who thought all men had grave faces and gray beards like her
+father, was delighted with the appearance of this beautiful young
+prince; and Ferdinand, seeing such a lovely lady in this desert place,
+and from the strange sounds he had heard, expecting nothing but
+wonders, thought he was upon an enchanted island, and that Miranda was
+the goddess of the place, and as such he began to address her.
+
+She timidly answered, she was no goddess, but a simple maid, and was
+going to give him an account of herself, when Prospero interrupted
+her. He was well pleased to find they admired each other, for he
+plainly perceived they had (as we say) fallen in love at first sight:
+but to try Ferdinand's constancy, he resolved to throw some
+difficulties in their way: therefore advancing forward, he addressed
+the prince with a stern air, telling him, he came to the island as a
+spy, to take it from him who was the lord of it. "Follow me," said he,
+"I will tie you neck and feet together. You shall drink sea-water;
+shell-fish, withered roots, and husks of acorns shall be your food."
+"No," said Ferdinand, "I will resist such entertainment, till I see a
+more powerful enemy," and drew his sword; but Prospero, waving his
+magic wand, fixed him to the spot where he stood, so that he had no
+power to move.
+
+Miranda hung upon her father, saying, "Why are you so ungentle? Have
+pity, sir; I will be his surety. This is the second man I ever saw,
+and to me he seems a true one."
+
+"Silence," said the father: "one word more will make me chide you,
+girl! What! an advocate for an impostor! You think there are no more
+such fine men, having seen only him and Caliban. I tell you, foolish
+girl, most men as far excel this, as he does Caliban." This he said to
+prove his daughter's constancy; and she replied, "My affections are
+most humble. I have no wish to see a goodlier man."
+
+"Come on, young man," said Prospero to the prince; "you have no power
+to disobey me."
+
+"I have not indeed," answered Ferdinand; and not knowing that it was
+by magic he was deprived of all power of resistance, he was astonished
+to find himself so strangely compelled to follow Prospero: looking
+back on Miranda as long as he could see her, he said, as he went after
+Prospero into the cave, "My spirits are all bound up, as if I were in
+a dream: but this man's threats, and the weakness which I feel, would
+seem light to me if from my prison I might once a day behold this fair
+maid."
+
+Prospero kept Ferdinand not long confined within the cell: he soon
+brought out his prisoner, and set him a severe task to perform, taking
+care to let his daughter know the hard labor he had imposed on him,
+and then pretending to go into his study, he secretly watched them
+both.
+
+Prospero had commanded Ferdinand to pile up some heavy logs of wood.
+King's sons not being much used to laborious work, Miranda soon after
+found her lover almost dying with fatigue. "Alas!" said she, "do not
+work so hard; my father is at his studies, he is safe for these three
+hours; pray rest yourself."
+
+"O my dear lady," said Ferdinand, "I dare not. I must finish my task
+before I take my rest."
+
+"If you will sit down," said Miranda, "I will carry your logs the
+while." But this Ferdinand would by no means agree to. Instead of a
+help Miranda became a hindrance, for they began a long conversation,
+so that the business of log-carrying went on very slowly.
+
+Prospero, who had enjoined Ferdinand this task merely as a trial of
+his love, was not at his books, as his daughter supposed, but was
+standing by them invisible, to overhear what they said.
+
+Ferdinand inquired her name, which she told, saying it was against her
+father's express command she did so.
+
+Prospero only smiled at this first instance of his daughter's
+disobedience, for having by his magic art caused his daughter to fall
+in love so suddenly, he was not angry that she showed her love by
+forgetting to obey his commands. And he listened well pleased to a
+long speech of Ferdinand's, in which he professed to love her above
+all the ladies he ever saw.
+
+In answer to his praises of her beauty, which he said exceeded all the
+women in the world, she replied, "I do not remember the face of any
+woman, nor have I seen any more men than you, my good friend, and my
+dear father. How features are abroad, I know not; but, believe me,
+sir, I would not wish any companion in the world but you, nor can my
+imagination form any shape but yours that I could like. But, sir, I
+fear I talk to you too freely, and my father's precepts I forget."
+
+At this Prospero smiled, and nodded his head, as much as to say, "This
+goes on exactly as I could wish; my girl will be queen of Naples."
+
+And then Ferdinand, in another fine long speech (for young princes
+speak in courtly phrases), told the innocent Miranda he was heir to
+the crown of Naples, and that she should be his queen.
+
+"Ah! sir," said she, "I am a fool to weep at what I am glad of. I will
+answer you in plain and holy innocence. I am your wife if you will
+marry me."
+
+Prospero prevented Ferdinand's thanks by appearing visible before
+them.
+
+"Fear nothing, my child," said he; "I have overheard, and approve of
+all you have said. And, Ferdinand, if I have too severely used you, I
+will make you rich amends, by giving you my daughter. All your
+vexations were but trials of your love, and you have nobly stood the
+test. Then as my gift, which your true love has worthily purchased,
+take my daughter, and do not smile that I boast she is above all
+praise." He then, telling them that he had business which required his
+presence, desired they would sit down and talk together till he
+returned; and this command Miranda seemed not at all disposed to
+disobey.
+
+When Prospero left them, he called his spirit Ariel, who quickly
+appeared before him, eager to relate what he had done with Prospero's
+brother and the king of Naples. Ariel said he had left them almost out
+of their senses with fear, at the strange things he had caused them to
+see and hear. When fatigued with wandering about, and famished for
+want of food, he had suddenly set before them a delicious banquet, and
+then, just as they were going to eat, he appeared visible before them
+in the shape of a harpy, a voracious monster with wings, and the
+feast vanished away. Then, to their utter amazement, this seeming
+harpy spoke to them, reminding them of their cruelty in driving
+Prospero from his dukedom, and leaving him and his infant daughter to
+perish in the sea; saying, that for this cause these terrors were
+suffered to afflict them.
+
+The king of Naples, and Antonio the false brother, repented the
+injustice they had done to Prospero: and Ariel told his master he was
+certain their penitence was sincere, and that he, though a spirit,
+could not but pity them.
+
+"Then bring them hither, Ariel," said Prospero: "if you, who are but a
+spirit, feel for their distress, shall not I, who am a human being
+like themselves, have compassion on them? Bring them, quickly, my
+dainty Ariel."
+
+Ariel soon returned with the king, Antonio, and old Gonzalo in their
+train, who had followed him, wondering at the wild music he played in
+the air to draw them on to his master's presence. This Gonzalo was the
+same who had so kindly provided Prospero formerly with books and
+provisions, when his wicked brother left him, as he thought, to perish
+in an open boat in the sea.
+
+Grief and terror had so stupefied their senses, that they did not know
+Prospero. He first discovered himself to the good old Gonzalo, calling
+him the preserver of his life; and then his brother and the king knew
+that he was the injured Prospero.
+
+Antonio with tears, and sad words of sorrow and true repentance,
+implored his brother's forgiveness, and the king expressed his sincere
+remorse for having assisted Antonio to depose his brother: and
+Prospero forgave them; and, upon their engaging to restore his
+dukedom, he said to the king of Naples, "I have a gift in store for
+you too;" and opening a door, showed him his son Ferdinand playing at
+chess with Miranda.
+
+Nothing could exceed the joy of the father and the son at this
+unexpected meeting, for they each thought the other drowned in the
+storm.
+
+"O wonder!" said Miranda, "what noble creatures these are! It must
+surely be a brave world that has such people in it."
+
+The king of Naples was almost as much astonished at the beauty and
+excellent graces of the young Miranda, as his son had been. "Who is
+this maid?" said he; "she seems the goddess that has parted us, and
+brought us thus together." "No, sir," answered Ferdinand, smiling to
+find his father had fallen into the same mistake that he had done when
+he first saw Miranda, "she is a mortal, but by immortal Providence she
+is mine; I chose her when I could not ask you, my father, for your
+consent, not thinking you were alive. She is the daughter to this
+Prospero, who is the famous duke of Milan, of whose renown I have
+heard so much, but never saw him till now: of him I have received a
+new life: he has made himself to me a second father, giving me this
+dear lady."
+
+"Then I must be her father," said the king; "but oh! how oddly will it
+sound, that I must ask my child forgiveness."
+
+"No more of that," said Prospero: "let us not remember our troubles
+past, since they so happily have ended." And then Prospero embraced
+his brother, and again assured him of his forgiveness; and said that a
+wise overruling Providence had permitted that he should be driven from
+his poor dukedom of Milan, that his daughter might inherit the crown
+of Naples, for that by their meeting in this desert island, it had
+happened that the king's son had loved Miranda.
+
+These kind words which Prospero spoke, meaning to comfort his brother,
+so filled Antonio with shame and remorse, that he wept and was unable
+to speak; and the kind old Gonzalo wept to see this joyful
+reconciliation, and prayed for blessings on the young couple.
+
+Prospero now told them that their ship was safe in the harbor, and the
+sailors all on board her, and that he and his daughter would accompany
+them home the next morning. "In the meantime," says he, "partake of
+such refreshments as my poor cave affords; and for your evening's
+entertainment I will relate the history of my life from my first
+landing in this desert island." He then called for Caliban to prepare
+some food, and set the cave in order; and the company were astonished
+at the uncouth form and savage appearance of this ugly monster, who
+(Prospero said) was the only attendant he had to wait upon him.
+
+Before Prospero left the island, he dismissed Ariel from his service,
+to the great joy of that lively little spirit; who, though he had been
+a faithful servant to his master, was always longing to enjoy his free
+liberty, to wander uncontrolled in the air, like a wild bird, under
+green trees, among pleasant fruits, and sweet-smelling flowers. "My
+quaint Ariel," said Prospero to the little sprite when he made him
+free, "I shall miss you; yet you shall have your freedom." "Thank you,
+my dear master," said Ariel; "but give me leave to attend your ship
+home with prosperous gales, before you bid farewell to the assistance
+of your faithful spirit; and then, master, when I am free, how merrily
+I shall live!" Here Ariel sung this pretty song:
+
+ "Where the bee sucks, there suck I;
+ In a cowslip's bell I lie:
+ There I crouch when owls do cry.
+ On the bat's back I do fly
+ After summer Merrily.
+ Merrily, merrily shall I live now
+ Under the blossom that hangs on the bough."
+
+Prospero then buried deep in the earth his magical books and wand, for
+he was resolved never more to make use of the magic art. And having
+thus overcome his enemies, and being reconciled to his brother and the
+king of Naples, nothing now remained to complete his happiness, but to
+revisit his native land, to take possession of his dukedom, and to
+witness the happy nuptials of his daughter and Prince Ferdinand, which
+the king said should be instantly celebrated with great splendor on
+their return to Naples. At which place, under the safe convoy of the
+spirit Ariel, they, after a pleasant voyage, soon arrived.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+A MIDSUMMER NIGHT'S DREAM
+
+
+There was a law in the city of Athens which gave to its citizens the
+power of compelling their daughters to marry whomsoever they pleased;
+for upon a daughter's refusing to marry the man her father had chosen
+to be her husband, the father was empowered by this law to cause her
+to be put to death; but as fathers do not often desire the death of
+their own daughters, even though they do happen to prove a little
+refractory, this law was seldom or never put in execution, though
+perhaps the young ladies of that city were not unfrequently threatened
+by their parents with the terrors of it.
+
+There was one instance, however, of an old man, whose name was Egeus,
+who actually did come before Theseus (at that time the reigning duke
+of Athens), to complain that his daughter Hermia, whom he had
+commanded to marry Demetrius, a young man of a noble Athenian family,
+refused to obey him, because she loved another young Athenian, named
+Lysander. Egeus demanded justice of Theseus, and desired that this
+cruel law might be put in force against his daughter.
+
+Hermia pleaded in excuse for her disobedience, that Demetrius had
+formerly professed love for her dear friend Helena, and that Helena
+loved Demetrius to distraction; but this honorable reason, which
+Hermia gave for not obeying her father's command, moved not the stern
+Egeus.
+
+Theseus, though a great and merciful prince, had no power to alter the
+laws of his country; therefore he could only give Hermia four days to
+consider of it: and at the end of that time, if she still refused to
+marry Demetrius, she was to be put to death.
+
+When Hermia was dismissed from the presence of the duke, she went to
+her lover Lysander, and told him the peril she was in, and that she
+must either give him up and marry Demetrius, or lose her life in four
+days.
+
+Lysander was in great affliction at hearing these evil tidings; but
+recollecting that he had an aunt who lived at some distance from
+Athens, and that at the place where she lived the cruel law could not
+be put in force against Hermia (this law not extending beyond the
+boundaries of the city), he proposed to Hermia that she should steal
+out of her father's house that night, and go with him to his aunt's
+house, where he would marry her. "I will meet you," said Lysander, "in
+the wood a few miles without the city; in that delightful wood where
+we have so often walked with Helena in the pleasant month of May."
+
+To this proposal Hermia joyfully agreed; and she told no one of her
+intended flight but her friend Helena. Helena (as maidens will do
+foolish things for love) very ungenerously resolved to go and tell
+this to Demetrius, though she could hope no benefit from betraying her
+friend's secret, but the poor pleasure of following her faithless
+lover to the wood: for she well knew that Demetrius would go thither
+in pursuit of Hermia.
+
+The wood in which Lysander and Hermia proposed to meet, was the
+favorite haunt of those little beings known by the name of _Fairies_.
+
+Oberon the king, and Titania the queen of the Fairies, with all their
+tiny train of followers, in this wood held their midnight revels.
+
+Between this little king and queen of sprites there happened, at this
+time, a sad disagreement: they never met by moonlight in the shady
+walks of this pleasant wood, but they were quarreling, till all their
+fairy elves would creep into acorn-cups and hide themselves for fear.
+
+The cause of this unhappy disagreement was Titania's refusing to give
+Oberon a little changeling boy, whose mother had been Titania's
+friend; and upon her death the fairy queen stole the child from its
+nurse, and brought him up in the woods.
+
+The night on which the lovers were to meet in this wood, as Titania
+was walking with some of her maids of honor, she met Oberon attended
+by his train of fairy courtiers.
+
+"Ill met by moonlight, proud Titania," said the fairy king. The queen
+replied, "What, jealous Oberon, is it you? Fairies, skip hence; I have
+forsworn his company." "Tarry, rash fairy," said Oberon; "am not I thy
+lord? Why does Titania cross her Oberon? Give me your little
+changeling boy to be my page."
+
+"Set your heart at rest," answered the queen; "your whole fairy
+kingdom buys not the boy of me." She then left her lord in great
+anger. "Well, go your way," said Oberon: "before the morning dawns I
+will torment you for this injury."
+
+Oberon then sent for Puck, his chief favorite and privy counselor.
+
+Puck (or as he was sometimes called, Robin Goodfellow) was a shrewd
+and knavish sprite, that used to play comical pranks in the
+neighboring villages; sometimes getting into the dairies and skimming
+the milk, sometimes plunging his light and airy form into the
+butter-churn, and while he was dancing his fantastic shape in the
+churn, in vain the dairy-maid would labor to change her cream into
+butter: nor had the village swains any better success; whenever Puck
+chose to play his freaks in the brewing copper, the ale was sure to be
+spoiled. When a few good neighbors were met to drink some comfortable
+ale together, Puck would jump into the bowl of ale in the likeness of
+a roasted crab, and when some old goody was going to drink he would
+bob against her lips, and spill the ale over her withered chin; and
+presently after, when the same old dame was gravely seating herself to
+tell her neighbors a sad and melancholy story, Puck would slip her
+three-legged stool from under her, and down toppled the poor old
+woman, and then the old gossips would hold their sides and laugh at
+her, and swear they never wasted a merrier hour.
+
+"Come hither, Puck," said Oberon to this little merry wanderer of the
+night; "fetch me the flower which maids call _Love in Idleness_; the
+juice of that little purple flower laid on the eyelids of those who
+sleep, will make them, when they awake, dote on the first thing they
+see. Some of the juice of that flower I will drop on the eyelids of my
+Titania when she is asleep; and the first thing she looks upon when
+she opens her eyes she will fall in love with, even though it be a
+lion or a bear, a meddling monkey, or a busy ape; and before I will
+take this charm from off her sight, which I can do with another charm
+I know of, I will make her give me that boy to be my page."
+
+Puck, who loved mischief to his heart, was highly diverted with this
+intended frolic of his master, and ran to seek the flower; and while
+Oberon was waiting the return of Puck, he observed Demetrius and
+Helena enter the wood: he overheard Demetrius reproaching Helena for
+following him, and after many unkind words on his part, and gentle
+expostulations from Helena, reminding him of his former love and
+professions of true faith to her, he left her (as he said) to the
+mercy of the wild beasts, and she ran after him as swiftly as she
+could.
+
+The fairy king, who was always friendly to true lovers, felt great
+compassion for Helena; and perhaps, as Lysander said they used to walk
+by moonlight in this pleasant wood, Oberon might have seen Helena in
+those happy times when she was beloved by Demetrius. However that
+might be, when Puck returned with the little purple flower, Oberon
+said to his favorite, "Take a part of this flower; there has been a
+sweet Athenian lady here, who is in love with a disdainful youth; if
+you find him sleeping, drop some of the love-juice in his eyes, but
+contrive to do it when she is near him, that the first thing he sees
+when he awakes may be this despised lady. You will know the man by the
+Athenian garments which he wears." Puck promised to manage this matter
+very dexterously: and then Oberon went, unperceived by Titania, to her
+bower, where she was preparing to go to rest. Her fairy bower was a
+bank, where grew wild thyme, cowslips, and sweet violets, under a
+canopy of woodbine, musk-roses, and eglantine. There Titania always
+slept some part of the night; her coverlet the enameled skin of a
+snake, which, though a small mantle, was wide enough to wrap a fairy
+in.
+
+He found Titania giving orders to her fairies, how they were to employ
+themselves while she slept. "Some of you," said her majesty, "must
+kill cankers in the musk-rose buds, and some wage war with the bats
+for their leathern wings, to make my small elves coats; and some of
+you keep watch that the clamorous owl, that nightly hoots, come not
+near me: but first sing me to sleep. Then they began to sing this
+song:
+
+ "You spotted snakes with double tongue,
+ Thorny hedgehogs, be not seen;
+ Newts and blindworms do no wrong,
+ Come not near our Fairy Queen.
+ Philomel, with melody,
+ Sing in our sweet lullaby,
+ Lulla, lulla, lullaby; lulla, lulla, lullaby;
+ Never harm, nor spell, nor charm,
+ Come our lovely lady nigh;
+ So good night with lullaby."
+
+When the fairies had sung their queen asleep with this pretty lullaby,
+they left her to perform the important services she had enjoined them.
+Oberon then softly drew near his Titania, and dropped some of the
+love-juice on her eyelids, saying,
+
+ "What thou seest when them dost wake,
+ Do it for thy true-love take."
+
+But to return to Hermia, who made her escape out of her father's house
+that night, to avoid the death she was doomed to for refusing to marry
+Demetrius. When she entered the wood, she found her dear Lysander
+waiting for her, to conduct her to his aunt's house; but before they
+had passed half through the wood, Hermia was so much fatigued, that
+Lysander, who was very careful of this dear lady, who had proved her
+affection for him even by hazarding her life for his sake, persuaded
+her to rest till morning on a bank of soft moss, and lying down
+himself on the ground at some little distance, they soon fell fast
+asleep. Here they were found by Puck, who, seeing a handsome young man
+asleep, and perceiving that his clothes were made in the Athenian
+fashion, and that a pretty lady was sleeping near him, concluded that
+this must be the Athenian maid and her disdainful lover whom Oberon
+had sent him to seek; and he naturally enough conjectured that, as
+they were alone together, she must be the first thing he would see
+when he awoke; so, without more ado, he proceeded to pour some of the
+juice of the little purple flower into his eyes. But it so fell out,
+that Helena came that way, and, instead of Hermia, was the first
+object Lysander beheld when he opened his eyes; and strange to relate,
+so powerful was the love-charm, all his love for Hermia vanished away,
+and Lysander fell in love with Helena.
+
+Had he first seen Hermia when he awoke, the blunder Puck committed
+would have been of no consequence, for he could not love that faithful
+lady too well; but for poor Lysander to be forced by a fairy
+love-charm, to forget his own true Hermia, and to run after another
+lady, and leave Hermia asleep quite alone in a wood at midnight, was a
+sad chance indeed.
+
+Thus this misfortune happened. Helena, as has been before related,
+endeavored to keep pace with Demetrius when he ran away so rudely from
+her; but she could not continue this unequal race long, men being
+always better runners in a long race than ladies. Helena soon lost
+sight of Demetrius; and as she was wandering about, dejected and
+forlorn, she arrived at the place where Lysander was sleeping. "Ah!"
+said she, "this is Lysander lying on the ground: is he dead or
+asleep?" Then, gently touching him, she said, "Good sir, if you are
+alive, awake." Upon this Lysander opened his eyes, and (the love-charm
+beginning to work) immediately addressed her in terms of extravagant
+love and admiration; telling her she as much excelled Hermia in beauty
+as a dove does a raven, and that he would run through fire for her
+sweet sake; and many more such lover-like speeches. Helena, knowing
+Lysander was her friend Hermia's lover, and that he was solemnly
+engaged to marry her, was in the utmost rage when she heard herself
+addressed in this manner; for she thought (as well she might) that
+Lysander was making a jest of her. "Oh!" said she, "why was I born to
+be mocked and scorned by every one? Is it not enough, is it not
+enough, young man, that I can never get a sweet look or a kind word
+from Demetrius; but you, sir, must pretend in this disdainful manner
+to court me? I thought, Lysander, you were a lord of more true
+gentleness." Saying these words in great anger, she ran away; and
+Lysander followed her, quite forgetful of his own Hermia, who was
+still asleep.
+
+When Hermia awoke, she was in a sad fright at finding herself alone.
+She wandered about the wood, not knowing what was become of Lysander,
+or which way to go to seek for him. In the meantime Demetrius not
+being able to find Hermia and his rival Lysander, and fatigued with
+his fruitless search, was observed by Oberon fast asleep. Oberon had
+learnt by some questions he had asked of Puck, that he had applied the
+love-charm to the wrong person's eyes; and now having found the person
+first intended, he touched the eyelids of the sleeping Demetrius with
+the love-juice, and he instantly awoke; and the first thing he saw
+being Helena, he, as Lysander had done before, began to address
+love-speeches to her; and just as that moment Lysander, followed by
+Hermia (for through Puck's unlucky mistake it was now become Hermia's
+turn to run after her lover), made his appearance; and then Lysander
+and Demetrius, both speaking together, made love to Helena, they being
+each one under the influence of the same potent charm.
+
+The astonished Helena thought that Demetrius, Lysander, and her once
+dear friend Hermia, were all in a plot together to make a jest of her.
+
+Hermia was as much surprised as Helena: she knew not why Lysander and
+Demetrius, who both before loved her, were now become the lovers of
+Helena; and to Hermia the matter seemed to be no jest.
+
+The ladies, who before had always been the dearest of friends, now
+fell to high words together.
+
+"Unkind Hermia," said Helena, "it is you who have set Lysander to vex
+me with mock praises; and your other lover Demetrius, who used almost
+to spurn me with his foot, have you not bid him call me Goddess,
+Nymph, rare, precious, and celestial? He would not speak thus to me,
+whom he hates, if you did not set him on to make a jest of me. Unkind
+Hermia, to join with men in scorning your poor friend. Have you forgot
+our school-day friendship? How often, Hermia, have we two, sitting on
+one cushion, both singing one song, with our needles working the same
+flower, both on the same sampler wrought; growing up together in
+fashion of a double cherry, scarcely seeming parted! Hermia, it is not
+friendly in you, it is not maidenly to join with men in scorning your
+poor friend."
+
+"I am amazed at your passionate words," said Hermia: "I scorn you not;
+it seems you scorn me." "Ay, do," returned Helena, "persevere,
+counterfeit serious looks, and make mouths at me when I turn my back;
+then wink at each other, and hold the sweet jest up. If you had any
+pity, grace, or manners, you would not use me thus."
+
+While Helena and Hermia were speaking these angry words to each other,
+Demetrius and Lysander left them, to fight together in the wood for
+the love of Helena.
+
+When they found the gentlemen had left them, they departed, and once
+more wandered weary in the wood in search of their lovers.
+
+As soon as they were gone, the fairy king, who with little Puck had
+been listening to their quarrels, said to him, "This is your
+negligence, Puck; or did you do this wilfully?" "Believe me, king of
+shadows," answered Puck, "it was a mistake; did not you tell me I
+should know the man by his Athenian garments? However, I am not sorry
+this has happened, for I think their jangling makes excellent sport."
+"You heard," said Oberon, "that Demetrius and Lysander are gone to
+seek a convenient place to fight in. I command you to overhang the
+night with a thick fog, and lead these quarrelsome lovers so astray in
+the dark, that they shall not be able to find each other. Counterfeit
+each of their voices to the other, and with bitter taunts provoke them
+to follow you, while they think it is their rival's tongue they hear.
+See you do this, till they are so weary they can go no farther; and
+when you find they are asleep, drop the juice of this other flower
+into Lysander's eyes, and when he awakes he will forget his new love
+for Helena, and return to his old passion for Hermia; and then the two
+fair ladies may each one be happy with the man she loves, and they
+will think all that has passed a vexatious dream. About this quickly,
+Puck, and I will go and see what sweet love my Titania has found."
+
+Titania was still sleeping, and Oberon seeing a clown near her, who
+had lost his way in the wood, and was likewise asleep: "This fellow,"
+said he, "shall be my Titania's true love;" and clapping an ass's head
+over the clown's, it seemed to fit him as well as if it had grown upon
+his own shoulders. Though Oberon fixed the ass's head on very gently,
+it awakened him, and rising up, unconscious of what Oberon had done to
+him, he went towards the bower where the fairy queen slept.
+
+"Ah! what angel is that I see?" said Titania, opening her eyes, and
+the juice of the little purple flower beginning to take effect: "are
+you as wise as you are beautiful?"
+
+"Why, mistress," said the foolish clown, "if I have wit enough to find
+the way out of this wood, I have enough to serve my turn."
+
+"Out of the wood do not desire to go," said the enamored queen. "I am
+a spirit of no common rate. I love you. Go with me, and I will give
+you fairies to attend upon you."
+
+She then called four of her fairies: their names were, Pease-blossom,
+Cobweb, Moth, and Mustard-seed.
+
+"Attend," said the queen, "upon this sweet gentleman; hop in his
+walks, and gambol in his sight; feed him with grapes and apricots, and
+steal for him the honey-bags from the bees. Come, sit with me," said
+she to the clown, "and let me play with your amiable hairy cheeks, my
+beautiful ass! and kiss your fair large ears, my gentle joy!"
+
+"Where is Pease-blossom?" said the ass-headed clown, not much
+regarding the fairy queen's courtship, but very proud of his new
+attendants.
+
+"Here, sir," said little Pease-blossom.
+
+"Scratch my head," said the clown. "Where is Cobweb?"
+
+"Here, sir," said Cobweb.
+
+"Good Mr. Cobweb," said the foolish clown, "kill me the red humblebee
+on the top of that thistle yonder; and, good Mr. Cobweb, bring me the
+honey-bag. Do not fret yourself too much in the action, Mr. Cobweb,
+and take care the honey-bag break not; I should be sorry to have you
+overflown with a honey-bag. Where is Mustard-seed?"
+
+"Here, sir," said Mustard-seed: "what is your will?"
+
+"Nothing," said the clown, "good Mr. Mustard-seed, but to help Mr.
+Pease-blossom to scratch; I must go to a barber's, Mr. Mustard-seed,
+for methinks I am marvelous hairy about the face."
+
+"My sweet love," said the queen, "what will you have to eat? I have a
+venturous fairy shall seek the squirrel's hoard, and fetch you some
+new nuts."
+
+"I had rather have a handful of dried pease," said the clown, who with
+his ass's head had got an ass's appetite. "But, I pray, let none of
+your people disturb me, for I have a mind to sleep."
+
+"Sleep, then," said the queen, "and I will wind you in my arms. O how
+I love you! how I dote upon you!"
+
+When the fairy king saw the clown sleeping in the arms of his queen,
+he advanced within her sight, and reproached her with having lavished
+her favors upon an ass.
+
+This she could not deny, as the clown was then sleeping within her
+arms, with his ass's head crowned by her with flowers.
+
+When Oberon had teased her for some time, he again demanded the
+changeling boy; which she, ashamed of being discovered by her lord
+with her new favorite, did not dare to refuse him.
+
+Oberon, having thus obtained the little boy he had so long wished for
+to be his page, took pity on the disgraceful situation into which, by
+his merry contrivance, he had brought his Titania, and threw some of
+the juice of the other flower into her eyes; and the fairy queen
+immediately recovered her senses, and wondered at her late dotage,
+saying how she now loathed the sight of the strange monster.
+
+Oberon likewise took the ass's head from off the clown, and left him
+to finish his nap with his own fool's head upon his shoulders.
+
+Oberon and his Titania being now perfectly reconciled, he related to
+her the history of the lovers, and their midnight quarrels; and she
+agreed to go with him and see the end of their adventures.
+
+The fairy king and queen found the lovers and their fair ladies, at no
+great distance from each other, sleeping on a grass-plot; for Puck, to
+make amends for his former mistake, had contrived with the utmost
+diligence to bring them all to the same spot, unknown to each other;
+and he had carefully removed the charm from off the eyes of Lysander
+with the antidote the fairy king gave to him.
+
+Hermia first awoke, and finding her lost Lysander asleep so near her,
+was looking at him and wondering at his strange inconstancy. Lysander
+presently opening his eyes, and seeing his dear Hermia, recovered his
+reason which the fairy charm had before clouded, and with his reason,
+his love for Hermia; and they began to talk over the adventures of the
+night, doubting if these things had really happened, or if they had
+both been dreaming the same bewildering dream.
+
+Helena and Demetrius were by this time awake; and a sweet sleep having
+quieted Helena's disturbed and angry spirits, she listened with
+delight to the professions of love which Demetrius still made to her,
+and which, to her surprise as well as pleasure, she began to perceive
+were sincere.
+
+These fair night-wandering ladies, now no longer rivals, became once
+more true friends; all the unkind words which had passed were
+forgiven, and they calmly consulted together what was best to be done
+in their present situation. It was soon agreed that, as Demetrius had
+given up his pretensions to Hermia, he should endeavor to prevail upon
+her father to revoke the cruel sentence of death which had been passed
+against her. Demetrius was preparing to return to Athens for this
+friendly purpose, when they were surprised with the sight of Egeus,
+Hermia's father, who came to the wood in pursuit of his runaway
+daughter.
+
+When Egeus understood that Demetrius would not now marry his daughter,
+he no longer opposed her marriage with Lysander, but gave his consent
+that they should be wedded on the fourth day from that time, being the
+same day on which Hermia had been condemned to lose her life; and on
+that same day Helena joyfully agreed to marry her beloved and now
+faithful Demetrius.
+
+The fairy king and queen, who were invisible spectators of this
+reconciliation, and now saw the happy ending of the lovers' history,
+brought about through the good offices of Oberon, received so much
+pleasure, that these kind spirits resolved to celebrate the
+approaching nuptials with sports and revels throughout their fairy
+kingdom.
+
+And now, if any are offended with this story of fairies and their
+pranks, as judging it incredible and strange, they have only to think
+that they have been asleep and dreaming, and that all these adventures
+were visions which they saw in their sleep; and I hope none of my
+readers will be so unreasonable as to be offended with a pretty
+harmless Midsummer Night's Dream.
+
+
+
+
+OLD-FASHIONED STORIES
+
+
+
+
+SIMPLE SUSAN
+
+By MARIA EDGEWORTH
+
+ADAPTED BY LOUEY CHISHOLM
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+QUEEN OF THE MAY
+
+
+Simple Susan lived one hundred years ago. Mr. Price was Susan's
+father. He rented a small farm and was always hard at work. No more
+honest man could be found far or near, and he loved his little
+daughter from the bottom of his big heart.
+
+Mrs. Price was Susan's mother. She was a good woman who was always
+busy cooking, or cleaning, or sewing. The bread and cakes made by her
+were better than those made by any one else in the village. When she
+was not doing household work, she earned money by taking in plain
+needlework. All who knew Mrs. Price liked her and were sorry she was
+so far from strong. That no girl had a better mother than Susan, every
+one agreed.
+
+John and William were Susan's little brothers. They were quite sure
+that no other boys in all the world had such a good sister as theirs.
+
+Our story begins on the evening before the first of May. Now one
+hundred years ago, Mayday was looked forward to with glee by all
+English children living in the country. Early that morning the lads
+and lasses of the village, gaily decked with flowers, would go merrily
+singing from house to house. In their midst would walk the Queen of
+the May, or sometimes, seated in a chair twined round with blossom,
+she would be carried from door to door by her little companions. With
+a wreath of their gayest flowers they would crown her their Queen, and
+for her would be woven the fairest garlands. After the May carols were
+sung, cake, coppers, or small coins would be given to the boys and
+girls.
+
+To choose their Queen and to arrange their flowers the children would
+meet on the last day of April. This they did in the village where
+Susan lived, and their meeting-place was in a corner of a field close
+by a large pink hawthorn. A shady lane ran past one side of the bush.
+On another side a sweetbrier hedge separated it from the garden
+belonging to an attorney.
+
+This attorney was a very cross man, so cross that the village people
+were always in fear of him. Although he had hedged and fenced his
+garden, it sometimes happened that there would stray into it a pig, or
+a dog, or a goat, or a goose belonging to a poor neighbor. Then the
+attorney would go to the owner of the stray animal and in a harsh
+voice demand money to pay for the damage it had done.
+
+Nor did this cruel man let people walk along the paths through his
+meadows, although they did no harm. He blocked up the stiles with
+stones and prickly shrubs, so that not even a gosling could squeeze
+under them nor a giant climb over. Even the village children were
+afraid to fly their kites near his fields, lest they should get
+entangled in his trees or fall on his ground.
+
+Mr. Case was the name of this attorney, and he had one son and a
+daughter called Barbara.
+
+For long the father paid no attention to the education of his
+children, for all his time and thought were given to money-making.
+Meanwhile Barbara and her brother ran wild with the village children.
+But suddenly Mr. Case decided to send his son to a tutor to learn
+Latin, and to employ a maid to wait upon Barbara. At the same time he
+gave strict orders that his children should no longer play with their
+old companions.
+
+The village children were not at all sorry when they heard this.
+Barbara had not been a favorite among them, for she had always wanted
+to rule them and to secure for herself the chief part in their games.
+When Barbara saw that she was not missed by her old friends she was
+vexed, and she became angry when she found that they paid no attention
+to the grand air with which she now spoke nor to the fine frocks which
+she wore.
+
+To one girl Barbara had a special dislike. This was none other than
+Susan Price, the sweetest-tempered and busiest lass in the village,
+and the pride and delight of all who knew her. The farm rented by
+Susan's father was near the house in which Mr. Case lived, and Barbara
+from her window used to watch Susan at work.
+
+Sometimes the little girl was raking the garden-plots in her neat
+garden; sometimes she was weeding the paths; sometimes she was
+kneeling at her beehive with fresh flowers for her bees, and sometimes
+she was in the hen-yard scattering corn among the eager little
+chickens. In the evening Barbara often saw her sitting in the
+summer-house over which sweet honeysuckle crept, and there, with a
+clean three-legged pine table before her upon which to lay her work,
+Susan would sew busily. Her seams were even and neat, for Mrs. Price
+had taught her daughter that what is worth doing is worth doing well.
+
+Both Susan and her mother were great favorites in the village. It was
+at Mrs. Price's door that the children began their Mayday rounds, and
+it was Susan who was usually Queen of the May.
+
+It was now time for the village children to choose their queen. The
+setting sun was shining full upon the pink blossoms of the hawthorn
+when the merry group met to make their plans for the morrow.
+
+Barbara Case, sulkily walking alone in her father's garden, heard the
+happy voices and, crouching behind the hedge that divided her from the
+other children, she listened to their plans.
+
+"Where is Susan?" were the first words she overheard.
+
+"Yes, where is Susan?" repeated a boy called Philip, stopping short in
+a tune he was playing on his pipe: "I want her to sing me this air, I
+can't remember how it goes."
+
+"And I wish Susan would come, I'm sure," cried Mary, a little girl
+whose lap was full of primroses. "She will give me some thread to tie
+up my nosegays, and she will show me where the fresh violets grow, and
+she has promised to give me a great bunch of her cowslips to wear
+to-morrow. I wish she would come."
+
+"Nothing can be done without Susan!" cried another child. "She always
+shows us where the nicest flowers are to be found in the lanes and
+meadows."
+
+"Susan must help to weave the garlands," said another.
+
+"Susan must be Queen of the May!" shouted several together.
+
+"Why does she not come?" grumbled Philip.
+
+Rose, who was Susan's special friend, now came forward to remind them
+that when Susan was late it was always because she was needed at home.
+
+"Go, Rose, and tell her to make haste," cried the impatient Philip.
+"Attorney Case is dining at the Abbey to-day, and if he comes home and
+finds us here, perhaps he will drive us away. He says this bit of
+ground belongs to his garden, but that is not true, for Farmer Price
+says we have all as much right to it as he has. He wants to rob us of
+our playground. I wish he and Bab, or Miss Barbara, as I suppose we
+must now call her, were a hundred miles away, I do. Just yesterday she
+knocked down my ninepins on purpose as she passed with her gown
+trailing in the dust."
+
+"Yes," cried Mary, "her gown is always trailing. She does not hold it
+up nicely like Susan, and in spite of all her fine clothes she never
+looks half so neat. Mamma says she hopes I shall grow like Susan, and
+so do I. I should not like to be vain like Barbara were I ever so
+rich."
+
+"Rich or poor," said Philip, "it does not become a girl to be vain,
+much less bold, as Barbara was the other day. She stood at her
+father's door, and stared at a strange gentleman who stopped near by,
+to let his horse drink. I know what he thought of Bab, by his looks,
+and of Susan too; for Susan was in her garden, bending down a branch
+of the laburnum-tree, looking at its yellow flowers which had just
+come out, and when the gentleman asked her how many miles it was to
+the next village, she answered him modestly, not bashfully as if she
+had never seen any one before, but just right. Then she pulled on her
+straw hat that had fallen back while she was looking up at the
+laburnum, and went her way home, and the gentleman said to me after
+she was gone, 'Pray, who is that neat, modest girl?' But I wish,"
+cried Philip, interrupting himself, "I wish Susan would come!"
+
+Barbara, still crouching on the other side of the hedge, heard
+everything that was said.
+
+Susan was all this time, as her friend Rose had guessed, busy at home.
+She had been kept by her father's returning later than usual. His
+supper was ready for him nearly an hour before he came home, and Susan
+swept the hearth twice, and twice put on wood to make a cheerful blaze
+for him. At last, when he did come in, he took no notice of the blaze
+or of Susan; and when his wife asked him how he was, he made no
+answer, but stood with his back to the fire, looking very gloomy.
+Susan put his supper upon the table, and set his own chair for him,
+but he pushed away the chair and turned from the table, saying, "I
+shall eat nothing, child. Why have you such a fire to roast me at this
+time of year?"
+
+"You said yesterday, father, I thought, that you liked a little
+cheerful wood-fire in the evening, and there was a great shower of
+hail. Your coat is quite wet. We must dry it."
+
+"Take it, then, child," he said, pulling it off, "I shall soon have no
+coat to dry. Take my hat, too," he went on, throwing it upon the
+ground.
+
+Susan hung up his hat, put his coat over the back of a chair to dry,
+and then stood looking at her mother, who was not well. She had tired
+herself with baking, and now, alarmed by her husband's strange
+conduct, she sat down pale and trembling. The father threw himself
+into a chair, folded his arms, and gazed into the fire.
+
+Susan was the first who ventured to break the silence. Fondling her
+father, she tried to coax him to eat the supper prepared for him.
+This, however, she could not persuade him to do, but he said, with a
+faint smile, that he thought he could eat one of her guinea-hen's
+eggs. Susan thanked him, and showed her eagerness to please her dear
+father by running as fast as she could to her neat chicken-yard. Alas!
+the guinea-fowl was not there. It had strayed into the garden of Mr.
+Case. She could see it through the paling. Going to the garden-gate,
+Susan timidly opened it, and seeing Miss Barbara walk slowly by, she
+asked if she might come in and take her guinea-fowl.
+
+Barbara, who at that moment was thinking of all she had heard the
+village children say, started when she heard Susan's voice.
+
+"Shut the gate," she said crossly, "you have no business in our
+garden. As for the hen, I shall keep it; it is always flying in here
+and plaguing us, and my father told me I might catch it and keep it
+the next time it got in, and it is in now." Then Barbara called to her
+maid Betty and bid her catch the mischievous bird.
+
+"Oh, my guinea-hen! my pretty guinea-hen!" cried Susan, as mistress
+and maid hunted the frightened, screaming creature from corner to
+corner.
+
+"Now we have it!" said Betty, holding it fast by the legs.
+
+"Then pay damages, Queen Susan, or you may say good-by to your pretty
+guinea-hen," said Barbara in a rude tone.
+
+"It has done no damage," said Susan; "but tell me what I must pay."
+
+"A shilling," said Barbara.
+
+"Oh, if only sixpence would do!" said Susan; "I have but sixpence of
+my own in the world, and here it is."
+
+"It won't do," said Barbara, turning her back.
+
+"Nay, but hear me," cried Susan, "let me at least come in to look for
+its eggs. I only want one for my father's supper. You shall have all
+the rest."
+
+"What is your father or his supper to us; is he so particular that he
+can eat none but guinea-hen's eggs?" said Barbara. "If you want your
+hen and your eggs, pay for them, and you shall have them."
+
+"I have only sixpence and you say that won't do," said Susan with a
+sigh, as she looked at her favorite which was in the maid's cruel
+hands, struggling and screaming in vain.
+
+Susan went away feeling very sad. At the door of her father's cottage
+she saw her friend Rose, who had just come to summon her to the
+hawthorn-bush.
+
+"They are all at the hawthorn, and I have come for you. We can do
+nothing without you, dear Susan," cried Rose, running to meet her the
+moment she saw her, "You are chosen Queen of the May--come, make
+haste. But what is the matter? Why do you look so sad?"
+
+"Ah!" said Susan, "don't wait for me; I can't come to you, but," she
+added, pointing to the tuft of cowslips in the garden, "gather those
+for little Mary; I promised them to her, and tell her the violets are
+under a hedge just beside the stile, on the right as we go to church.
+Good-by! never mind me; I can't come--I can't stay, for my father
+wants me."
+
+"But don't turn away your face; I won't keep you a moment; only tell
+me what is the matter," said her friend, following her into the
+cottage.
+
+"Oh, nothing, not much," said Susan; "if I had not wanted the egg in a
+great hurry for father, it would not have vexed me--to be sure I
+should have clipped my guinea-hen's wings, and then she could not have
+flown over the hedge; but let us think no more about it now," she
+added, trying to hide a tear.
+
+When Rose, however, learned that her friend's guinea-hen was kept a
+prisoner by Barbara, she was hot with indignation, and at once ran
+back to tell the story to her companions.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+BAD NEWS
+
+
+As Susan entered the cottage parlor, Farmer Price drew his chair close
+to his wife. "You see there is something amiss with me," he said; "I
+must tell you what it is." Her father lowered his voice, and Susan,
+who was not sure that he wished her to hear what he was going to say,
+moved from behind his chair.
+
+"Susan, don't go; sit down here, sweet Susan," he said, making room
+for her beside him. "I am afraid I was cross when I came in to-night,
+but I had something to vex me, as you shall hear."
+
+Then the farmer told how, a fortnight before, lots had been drawn in
+the nearest town, to see which men there and in the surrounding
+villages should leave home to be trained as soldiers. For a hundred
+years ago it was in this way that men were found to defend their
+country. Only if they were under eighteen or above forty years of age
+could they escape drawing lots.
+
+"Now, as I would be forty in ten days," said the farmer, "I was told
+just to call myself forty then and there; but the truth is the truth,
+and should be spoken at all times, come what may. And when the lots
+were drawn, it fell to me among others to leave home to be trained to
+fight. I was thinking how unhappy we should be to part, when I heard
+that if I paid nine guineas to another man, he would take my place,
+and I could remain at home with you. I had not the money, for you know
+the bad luck we had with the sheep this year, and how they died one
+after the other. But I went to Mr. Case and asked him to lend me the
+money. He said he would if I handed over to him my lease, for he said,
+'If you do not repay me the guineas I shall keep the lease until you
+do.'"
+
+"That was a fortnight ago, and to-night Attorney Case tells me he has
+discovered that, owing to some mistake in the lease, we may be turned
+out of the farm at any time. But I've not come to the worst part yet."
+
+Here Farmer Price stopped short, and his wife and Susan gazed
+anxiously into his face.
+
+"The truth must be told," he said with a deep sigh, "I must now leave
+you in three days."
+
+"Must you?" said his wife faintly. "Susan dear, open the window."
+Susan ran to do as she was bid, and then returned to her mother's
+side. The fresh air soon revived the poor woman, and she begged her
+husband to go on with his story, and to hide nothing from her.
+
+Farmer Price had no wish to hide anything from those he loved so well.
+He believed that the truth should be spoken at all times, but never
+had he found it so difficult as at this moment. What had happened was
+this. Attorney Case had met Farmer Price that evening. The farmer was
+coming home, whistling, from a new-plowed field. The Attorney was on
+horseback, and had just dined at the Abbey with Sir Arthur Somers.
+The Abbey had until lately belonged to Sir Arthur's elder brother,
+but now that he was dead, Sir Arthur owned the estate.
+
+Attorney Case had looked after the property for the elder brother, and
+was anxious to be employed by Sir Arthur. There were many farms on the
+estate, and it had been part of the Attorney's work to look after the
+repairs and to collect the rents. Unfortunately, he had an unpleasant
+way of dealing with the farmers, ordering them as he had no right to
+do, and being harsh with those who, through misfortune, had not enough
+money to to pay their rent in full. As the Attorney met Farmer Price
+he stopped him, saying, "A word with you, Farmer Price, if you please.
+Walk alongside my horse, and listen. You know the field with the pink
+hawthorn where the village children play? I am going to add it to my
+garden. I hear you say it does not belong to me. What do you mean by
+that?"
+
+"I mean what I say," said Price; "the field is not yours." So angry
+was the Attorney on hearing this, that he at once made up his mind to
+hurt the farmer as much as he could.
+
+"My good man," he said, "you will remember that a fortnight ago I lent
+you nine guineas. To-morrow morning you must return them to me."
+
+"Those guineas," replied the farmer, "I paid, as you know, to the man
+who said he would go instead of me to be trained as a soldier. But he
+has not yet gone, and I can still get the guineas back from him and go
+myself to be trained."
+
+The Attorney was not prepared for this answer. "I do not want to drive
+you to that," he said, pretending to be kind. "Now about the
+field--you do not want to add it to the farm, do you?"
+
+"Certainly not, for it is not mine."
+
+"Then why object to my having it?"
+
+"Because it is not yours. The children who play there have the right.
+It belongs to the village. Truth is truth."
+
+"And a debt is a debt," shouted the angry Attorney, "and must be paid.
+Bring me my nine guineas!"
+
+With a heavy heart Farmer Price walked on. He passed the door of his
+cottage and went in search of the man to whom he had paid the money.
+The man was quite willing to return it, as there were many others, he
+said, who would be willing to give him the same sum or more for his
+services. The moment Price got the money he took it straight to Mr.
+Case, laid it on his desk and was going away, when the Attorney called
+out, "Not so fast, you have forgotten your lease."
+
+"Ah yes! my lease, I had forgotten it. Let me have it."
+
+"Pardon me," said the Attorney with a cruel smile, "but I cannot let
+you have it. On reading it over I find that owing to a mistake you may
+be turned out of the farm at any time. I must keep it to show to Sir
+Arthur. I have no doubt he will want me to look after things for him
+as I did for his brother. Now perhaps you wish you had quietly let me
+add the field to my garden."
+
+Farmer Price said nothing, but dragged himself home a sad man.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+SUSAN'S GUINEA-FOWL
+
+
+When Susan had heard her father's story, she quite forgot the loss of
+her guinea-hen, and thought only of her poor mother who, try as she
+might, could not bear the bad news. In the middle of the night Susan
+was roused, as Mrs. Price had become ill, and it was not until early
+morning that the poor woman fell asleep, her daughter's hand locked
+fast in hers. Susan remained sitting by the bedside, breathing
+quietly. Then seeing the candle burn low, she gently withdrew her
+hand, and on tiptoe went to put out the light, lest the unpleasant
+smell should wake her mother. All was silent. The gray light of dawn
+stole into the little room; the sun rose slowly, and Susan peered
+through the small panes of the lattice window at the glorious sight. A
+few birds began to chirp, and as the little girl listened to them, her
+mother started and spoke in her sleep. Susan quickly hung up a white
+apron before the window to keep out the light, and at the same moment
+she heard in the distance the voices of the village children singing
+their Mayday songs. Soon she could see them, Philip leading the way
+playing upon his pipe and tabor, the others following with nosegays
+and garlands in their hands. They were coming towards the cottage.
+Quickly but quietly Susan unlatched the door and ran to meet them.
+
+"Here she is!--here's Susan!" they exclaimed joyfully.
+
+"Here's the Queen of the May!"
+
+"And here's her crown!" cried Rose, pressing forward.
+
+But Susan put her finger to her lips, and pointed to her mother's
+window. Philip's pipe stopped at once.
+
+"Thank you," said Susan, "but my mother is ill. I can't leave her, you
+know." Then as she gently put aside the crown, her companions asked
+her to say who should wear it for her.
+
+"Will you, dear Rose?" she said, placing the garland upon her friend's
+head. "It's a charming May morning," she added, with a smile;
+"good-by. We shall not hear your voices or the pipe when you have
+turned the corner into the village, so you need only stop till then,
+Philip."
+
+"I shall stop for all day," said Philip: "I've no wish to play any
+more."
+
+"Good-by, poor Susan! It is a pity you can't come with us," said all
+the children.
+
+Little Mary ran after Susan to the cottage door. "I forgot to thank
+you," she said, "for the cowslips. Look how pretty they are, and smell
+how sweet the violets are that I wear, and kiss me quick or I shall be
+left behind."
+
+Susan kissed the little breathless girl, and returned softly to the
+side of her mother's bed. "How grateful that child is to me for a
+cowslip only! How can I be grateful enough to such a mother as this?"
+she said to herself, as she bent over the pale face of her sleeping
+mother.
+
+Her mother's unfinished knitting lay upon a table near the bed, and
+Susan sat down in her wicker armchair, and went on with the row, in
+the middle of which Mrs. Price had stopped the evening before. "She
+taught me to knit, she taught me everything that I know," thought
+Susan, "and best of all, she taught me to love her, to wish to be like
+her." Mrs. Price, when she awoke, felt much better, but slowly there
+came back to her memory the sad news she had heard the evening before.
+She asked herself if it could have been a dream, but no, it was all
+too true. She could recall her husband's look as he had said, "I must
+leave you in three days." Then suddenly she roused herself. "Why!
+he'll want, he'll want a hundred things," she said. "I must get his
+linen ready for him. I'm afraid it's very late. Susan, why did you let
+me sleep so long?"
+
+"Everything shall be ready, dear mother; only don't hurry," said
+Susan. And indeed her mother was not able to bear any hurry, or to do
+any work that day. Susan's loving help was never more wanted. She
+understood so well, she obeyed so exactly, and when she was left to
+herself, judged so wisely, that her mother had little trouble in
+directing her. She said that Susan never did too little or too much.
+
+Susan was mending her father's linen, when Rose tapped softly at the
+window, and beckoned to her to come out. She went.
+
+"How is your mother, in the first place?" said Rose.
+
+"Better, thank you."
+
+"That is nice, and I have a little bit of good news for you
+besides--here," she said, pulling out a purse, in which there was
+money. "We'll get the guinea-hen back again--we have all agreed about
+it. This is the money that has been given to us in the village this
+May morning. At every door they gave silver. See how generous they
+have been--twelve shillings. Now we are a match for Miss Barbara. You
+won't like to leave home, so I'll go to her, and you shall see your
+guinea-hen in ten minutes."
+
+Rose hurried away, filled with joy at the thought that soon she would
+return to Susan with her lost bird.
+
+Miss Barbara's maid, Betty, was the first person she saw on reaching
+the Attorney's house. Rose said she must see Barbara and was shown
+into a parlor where the young lady sat reading a book.
+
+"How you startled me! Is it only you?" she said, looking up and seeing
+no one but the maid. Then, as she caught sight of Rose, she went on,
+"You should have said I was not at home. Pray, my good girl, what do
+you want?" she said, turning to Rose. "Is it to borrow or to beg that
+you are here?"
+
+"The person from whom I come does not wish either to borrow or to beg,
+but to pay for what she asks," answered Rose. Then opening her
+well-filled purse, she held out to Barbara a bright shilling, saying,
+"Now please be so good as to give me Susan's guinea-hen."
+
+"You may keep your shilling," replied Barbara. "It would have been
+enough if it had been paid yesterday when I asked for it, but I told
+Susan that as it was not paid then I should keep the hen, and I shall.
+You may go back and tell her so."
+
+While Barbara spoke she had been looking into the open purse in Rose's
+hand. She thought she could count at least ten shillings. Could she
+not manage to get at least five of them for the guinea-hen, she
+wondered?
+
+Rose little guessed what was going on in Barbara's mind, and exclaimed
+angrily, "We must have Susan's favorite hen, whatever it costs. If one
+shilling won't do, take two. If two won't do, take three," and she
+flung the coins one after the other on the table.
+
+"Three won't do," said Barbara.
+
+"Then take four."
+
+Barbara shook her head.
+
+A fifth shilling was offered, but Barbara, seeing that she had the
+game in her own hands, was silent.
+
+Then Rose threw down shilling after shilling, till twelve bright
+pieces lay on the table, and her purse was empty.
+
+"Now you may take the guinea-hen," said Barbara.
+
+Rose pushed the money towards the greedy girl, but at the same moment
+remembered that it had not belonged to herself alone. At once she
+seized the silver coins, and saying that she must first see if the
+friends with whom she shared them were willing to part with them, she
+ran off.
+
+When the children heard Rose's story, they were amazed, that even
+Barbara could be so mean, but they all agreed that at any cost the
+guinea-fowl must be set free. In a body they went to Susan and told
+her so, at the same time handing her the purse. Then they ran off
+without waiting to be thanked. Rose only stayed behind. Susan knew
+that she must accept the present gladly, just as she would give one
+gladly. She was much touched by the kindness of her friends, but she
+took the purse as simply as she would have given it.
+
+"Well," said Rose, "shall I go back for the guinea-hen?"
+
+"The guinea-hen!" said Susan, starting from a dream into which she had
+fallen as she looked at the purse. "Certainly I do long to see my
+pretty guinea-hen once more; but I was not thinking of her just
+then--I was thinking of my father."
+
+Now Susan had often that day heard her mother wish that she had but
+money enough in the world to pay to the man who was willing to be
+trained to fight instead of her husband.
+
+"This, to be sure, will go but a little way," thought Susan; "but
+still it may be of some use." She told her thought to Rose, and ended
+by saying that if the money was given to her to spend as she pleased,
+she would give it to her father.
+
+"It is all yours, my dear, good Susan!" cried Rose. "This is so like
+you!--but I'm sorry that Miss Bab must keep your guinea-hen. I would
+not be her for all the guinea-hens, or guineas either, in the whole
+world. Why, the guinea-hen won't make her happy, and you'll be happy
+even without it, because you are good. Let me come and help you
+to-morrow," she went on, looking at Susan's work, "if you have any
+more mending to do--I never liked work till I worked with you. I won't
+forget my thimble or my scissors," she added, laughing--"though I used
+to forget them when I was a wilder girl. I assure you I am clever with
+my needle now--try me."
+
+Susan told her friend that she would most gladly accept her help, but
+that she had finished all the needlework that was wanted at present.
+"But do you know," she went on, "I shall be very busy to-morrow. I
+won't tell you what it is that I have to do, for I am afraid I shall
+not succeed, but if I do succeed, I'll come and tell you directly,
+because you will be so glad."
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+SUSAN VISITS THE ABBEY
+
+
+Susan, who had always been attentive to what her mother taught her,
+and who had often helped her when she was baking bread and cakes for
+the family at the Abbey, now thought that she could herself bake a
+batch of bread. One of the new servants from the Abbey had been sent
+all round the village in the morning in search of loaves, and had not
+been able to procure any that were eatable. Mrs. Price's last baking
+had failed for want of good yeast. She was not now strong enough to
+attempt another herself, and when the brewer's boy came to tell her
+that he had some fine fresh yeast, she thanked him, but sighed and
+said she feared it would be of little use to her. But Susan went to
+work with great care, and the next morning when her bread came out of
+the oven, it was excellent: at least her mother said so, and she was a
+good judge. It was sent to the Abbey, and as the family had not tasted
+any good bread since they had come there, they also were warm in its
+praise. With some surprise, they heard from the housekeeper that this
+excellent bread was made by a young girl only twelve years old. The
+housekeeper, who had known Susan since she was a child, was pleased to
+have a chance to speak about her.
+
+"She is the busiest little creature, ma'am, in the world," she said to
+her mistress. "I can't so well call her little now though, since she's
+grown tall and slender to look at; and glad I am she is grown up good
+to look at; for handsome is that handsome does, ma'am. She thinks no
+more of her being handsome than I do myself; yet she has as proper a
+respect for herself, ma'am, as you have; and I always see her neat,
+and she is always with her mother, or fit people, as a girl should be.
+As for her mother, she dotes upon her, as well she may; for I should
+myself if I had half such a daughter, ma'am; and then she has two
+little brothers, and she's as good to them and, my boy Philip says,
+taught them to read more than the school-mistress did; but I beg your
+pardon, ma'am, I cannot stop myself when I once begin to talk of
+Susan."
+
+"You have really said enough to make me wish to see her," said her
+mistress. "Pray send for her now; we can see her before we go out to
+walk."
+
+The kind housekeeper gladly sent off her boy Philip for Susan, who was
+never so untidy that she could not come at once when sent for. She had
+been very busy, but orderly people can be busy and neat at the same
+time. Putting on her usual straw hat, she set out for the Abbey. On
+the way she overtook Rose's mother, who was going there too with a
+basket of fresh muslin. When Susan reached the Abbey, her simple dress
+and manners and the good sense with which she answered the questions
+put to her, pleased the ladies greatly. They saw that the housekeeper
+had not spoken too highly of the farmer's daughter.
+
+These two ladies were the sisters of Sir Arthur Somers. They were kind
+and wise; kind in wishing to spread happiness among their poor
+neighbors, and wise in wishing these people to be happy in their own
+way. They did not wish to manage them, but only to help them. As Sir
+Arthur was always willing to aid his sisters, it seemed as if they
+would prove a blessing in in the village near which they had come to
+live. When Susan took leave of the ladies, she was told they would
+call at her home that evening at six o'clock. Such a grand event as
+Susan's visit to the Abbey soon became known to Barbara Case and her
+maid, and together they watched for her return.
+
+"There she is! She has just gone into her garden," cried Bab; "we'll
+run in at once and hear all about it."
+
+Susan was gathering some marigolds and parsley for her mother's soup.
+"Well, Susan, and how are things going with you to-day?" asked
+Barbara.
+
+"My mother is rather better, she says; thank you, ma'am."
+
+"'Ma'am, how polite we have grown all of a sudden!" said Bab, winking
+at her maid. "One can see you have been in good company. Come, tell us
+all about it."
+
+"Did you see the ladies themselves," asked Betty, "or only the
+housekeeper?"
+
+"What room were you in?" went on Bab. "Did you see Miss Somers or Sir
+Arthur?"
+
+"Miss Somers," replied Susan.
+
+"Betty, she saw Miss Somers! I must hear about it. Susan, stop
+gathering those things, and have a chat with us."
+
+"I can't indeed, Miss Barbara, for my mother wants her soup, and I am
+in a hurry." And Susan ran home.
+
+"Would you believe it, her head is full of soup now?" said Bab to her
+maid. "She seems to think nothing of her visit to the Abbey. My papa
+may well call her _Simple Susan_. But simple or not I mean to get what
+I want out of her. Maybe when she has settled the grand matter of the
+soup, she'll be able to speak. I'll step in and ask to see her mother.
+That will put her in a good humor in a trice."
+
+Barbara went to the cottage and found Susan standing over a pot on the
+fire. "Is the soup ready?" she asked. "I'll wait till you take it in
+to your mother and go in with you. I want to ask her how she is,
+myself."
+
+"Sit down then, miss," said Susan, "I have put in the parsley, so the
+soup is nearly ready."
+
+Barbara sat down and plied Susan with questions. How was Miss Somers
+dressed? Were the sisters dressed alike? What were they having for
+dinner at the Abbey? Above all, what could Miss Somers mean by saying
+she would call at Farmer Price's cottage at six o'clock that evening?
+"What do you think she could mean?" asked Barbara.
+
+"What she said," replied Susan, "that she would be here at six
+o'clock."
+
+"That's plain enough," said Barbara, "but what else do you think she
+meant? People, you know, often mean more or less than they say."
+
+"They do," answered Susan, with a smile that made Barbara guess of
+whom she was thinking.
+
+But Bab did not mean Susan to know that she guessed, so she said, "I
+suppose you think that Miss Somers meant more than she said?"
+
+"I was not thinking of Miss Somers when I said what I did," replied
+Susan.
+
+There was a pause, and then Bab remarked, "How nice the soup looks!"
+
+Susan had poured it into a basin, and as she dropped over it the
+bright yellow marigold, it looked very tempting. She tasted it and
+added a little salt; tasted it again, and added a little more. Then
+she thought it was just as her mother liked it.
+
+"Oh, I must taste it!" said Bab, seizing the basin greedily.
+
+"Won't you take a spoon?" said Susan, trembling as she saw the big
+mouthfuls Barbara took with a loud noise.
+
+"Take a spoon, indeed!" exclaimed Bab. "How dare you, how dare you
+speak so to me? 'Take a spoon, pig!' was what you meant to say! I'll
+never enter your cottage again!" And she flounced out of the house.
+
+Susan stood still, amazed at the beginning of Barbara's speech, but
+her last words explained the sudden outburst.
+
+Some years before this time, when Susan was a very little girl and
+could scarcely speak, as she was eating a basin of bread and milk for
+supper at the cottage door, a great pig came up and put his nose into
+the basin. Susan was willing that the pig should have some share of
+the bread and milk, but as she ate with a spoon and he with his large
+mouth, she soon found that he was likely to have more than his share;
+and she said to him, "Take a poon, pig." The saying became a proverb
+in the village, and Susan's little companions quoted it when any one
+claimed more than his share of anything good. Barbara, who was then
+not Miss Barbara, but plain Bab, and who played with all the poor
+children in the village, was often reproved by Susan's proverb. Susan,
+as she grew up, forgot the childish saying, but Barbara remembered it,
+and it was this that she thought was in Susan's mind when she asked
+her to take a spoon.
+
+"Indeed, miss," said Betty, when she found Barbara in a passion upon
+her return from the cottage, "indeed I wonder you set your foot within
+the door. Your own papa has been at the Abbey all morning, and you can
+hear all you wish to know from him."
+
+Barbara at once ran to her father's parlor, but saw at a glance that
+he was in no mood to answer questions. Instead of leaving him alone,
+she did all in her power to find out why he had been at the Abbey, and
+what he had seen and heard there. And when she found that her father
+would tell her nothing, she ran back to her maid, saying, "Papa is so
+cross! I cannot put up with him."
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+SUSAN'S PET LAMB
+
+
+It is true that Attorney Case was not in a happy mood. His visit to
+the Abbey had made him feel sure that Sir Arthur and he would not
+agree about the treatment of the farmers who lived on the estate. One
+matter they had talked about was Sir Arthur's wish to enlarge his
+grounds and make a drive round them. A map of the estate lay upon the
+table and they looked at it together.
+
+"Ah! but I see this new road for the drive would run through Farmer
+Price's garden," said Sir Arthur. "That would never do."
+
+"It need not trouble you," said Attorney Case, "you may do as you like
+with Price's land."
+
+"How so?" asked Sir Arthur. "His lease will not be out for ten years,
+I believe."
+
+"True, that would have been the case had there not been a mistake in
+it. I have the lease and can show you." The heartless man then went on
+to explain to Sir Arthur what the mistake was.
+
+Sir Arthur remained silent.
+
+"Oh! I see," said the Attorney. "You do not wish to annoy Farmer
+Price. But just put the matter into my hands and I will manage it for
+you."
+
+"You seem to forget that to take the farm out of this poor man's hands
+would be to ruin him," replied Sir Arthur, quietly.
+
+"Indeed," said the wicked Attorney, "indeed I should be sorry for
+that, if it were not that Farmer Price is such an unruly, stubborn
+man."
+
+"An unruly man, is he? If that be so, the sooner he leaves the place
+the better. When you go home, you will be good enough to send me the
+lease that I may, for myself, see the mistake."
+
+Attorney Case got up to go. But before he went, he thought he must try
+to find out if Sir Arthur was going to employ him to look after the
+estate, that is, if he was to be the agent. "I will not trouble you
+about this lease, Sir Arthur," he said, "but will hand it to your
+agent, if you will inform me who is to have that post."
+
+"I mean to be my own agent," answered Sir Arthur, "and will myself
+look after the happiness of the people among whom I have come to
+live."
+
+It was the surprise of this reply that had sent Attorney Case home so
+cross that Barbara had said to Betty she could not put up with him.
+
+When his daughter had left him atone, the Attorney walked up and down
+the room deep in thought. "At any rate," he said to himself at last,
+"if Sir Arthur means to manage the estate himself in summer, he at
+least will need an agent in winter. I must try to get the post." And
+he still walked up and down, trying to think of some plan by which he
+would find favor at the Abbey. Now that morning he had heard the
+housekeeper at the Abbey ask the servants if any lamb were to be had
+in the village, as Sir Arthur would like to have it one day soon for
+dinner.
+
+Knowing that he himself treated those farmers best who from time to
+time gave him presents, Attorney Case thought that if he sent a gift
+to Sir Arthur, it might help him to get what he wished.
+
+No sooner had the idea struck him than the Attorney went to the
+kitchen. Standing at the door was a shepherd-boy. Barbara, too, was
+there.
+
+"Do you know of a nice fat lamb?" the Attorney asked the lad.
+
+Before the shepherd-boy could answer, Barbara exclaimed, "I know of
+one. Susan Price has a pet lamb that is as fat as fat can be."
+
+At once Attorney Case walked over to Farmer Price's cottage. He found
+Susan packing her father's little wardrobe, and as she looked up, he
+saw she had been in tears.
+
+"How is your mother to-day, Susan?" inquired the Attorney.
+
+"Worse, sir. My father goes to-morrow."
+
+"That's a pity."
+
+"It can't be helped," said Susan, with a sigh.
+
+"It can't be helped--how do you know that?" said Mr. Case.
+
+"Sir, dear sir!" cried she, looking up at him, and a sudden ray of
+hope beamed in her sweet face.
+
+"What if you could help it, Susan?" he said.
+
+Susan clasped her hands in silence.
+
+"You can help it, Susan." She started up. "What would you give now to
+have your father at home for a whole week longer?"
+
+"Anything!--but I have nothing."
+
+"Yes, you have a lamb," said the hard-hearted Attorney.
+
+"My poor little Daisy!" said Susan; "but what good can she do?"
+
+"What good can any lamb do? Is not lamb good to eat? Why do you look
+so pale, girl? Are not sheep killed every day, and don't you eat
+mutton? Is your lamb better than anybody else's, think you?"
+
+"I don't know," said Susan, "but I love her dearly."
+
+"More silly you," said he.
+
+"She feeds out of my hand, she follows me about; I have always taken
+care of her; my mother gave her to me."
+
+"Well, say no more about it, then; if you love your lamb better than
+both your father and your mother, keep it, and good morning to you."
+
+"Stay, oh stay!" cried Susan, catching his coat with an eager,
+trembling hand--"a whole week, did you say? My mother may get better
+in that time. No, I do not love Daisy half so well." The struggle in
+her mind ceased, and with a calm voice she said, "Take the lamb."
+
+"Where is it?" said the Attorney.
+
+"Grazing in the meadow, by the river-side."
+
+"It must be brought up before nightfall for the butcher, remember."
+
+"I shall not forget it," said Susan, steadily.
+
+As soon, however, as the cruel man turned his back and left the house,
+Susan sat down, and hid her face in her hands. She was soon roused by
+the sound of her mother's feeble voice calling her from the inner room
+where she lay. Susan went in.
+
+"Are you there, love? I thought I heard some strange voice just now
+talking to my child. Something's amiss, Susan," her mother went on,
+raising herself as well as she could in bed, to look at her daughter's
+face.
+
+"Would you think it amiss, then, my dear mother," said Susan, stooping
+to kiss her--"would you think it amiss if my father was to stay with
+us a week longer?"
+
+"Susan! you don't say so?"
+
+"He is, indeed, a whole week--but how burning hot your hand is
+still."
+
+"Are you sure he will stay?" asked her mother. "How do you know? Who
+told you so? Tell me all quick!"
+
+"Attorney Case told me so; he can get him leave for a week longer, and
+he has promised he will."
+
+"God bless him for it for ever and ever!" said the poor woman, joining
+her hands. "May the blessing of Heaven be with him!"
+
+Susan was silent. The next moment she was called out of the room, for
+a messenger had come from the Abbey for the bread-bill. Susan always
+made out the bills, for although she had not had many writing-lessons,
+she had taken great pains to learn, and wrote in a neat, clear hand.
+It is true she was in no mood to write or add now, but the work must
+be done. Having carefully ruled lines for the pounds, shillings and
+pence, she made out the bill and gave it to the boy who waited for it.
+Then she said to herself she would make out the other bills, for many
+of the people in the village had bought a few loaves and rolls of her
+making. "And when these are done, I may go down to the meadow to take
+leave of my poor lamb."
+
+But Susan could not find her slate, and when she did find it many of
+the figures were blurred, for Barbara had sat upon it. And then the
+numbers seemed to dance before her, and each time that she added, the
+answer was different. She went over and over the sums until her head
+ached. The table was covered with little square bits of paper on which
+she had written the bills when her father came in, holding in his hand
+an account.
+
+"Look at this, Susan!" he said, handing it to her. "How could you be
+so careless, child? What have you been thinking about to let a bill
+like that go to the Abbey? Luckily, I met the messenger and asked to
+see how much it was. Look at it."
+
+Susan looked and blushed. Instead of "loaves" she had written "lambs."
+She altered the mistake and handed the bill to her father. He,
+meantime, was looking at the papers lying on the table.
+
+"What are all these, child?" he asked.
+
+"Some of them were wrong, and I wrote them out again."
+
+"Some of them! All of them as far as I can see," said her father
+rather angrily, pointing to the papers.
+
+Susan read the bills. Most of them were for lambs instead of for
+loaves or rolls. Her thoughts had indeed been running upon the pet she
+was to part with so soon.
+
+Once more she wrote the bills, and her father, who was struck by the
+patient way she set to work, said he would himself collect the money.
+He would be proud to be able to say to the neighbors that it was all
+earned by his own little daughter. Susan heard him sigh as he passed
+the knapsack she had packed for him, but she thought she would keep
+the pleasure of telling him of his week's leave until he came home. He
+had said he would have supper in her mother's room. She would tell the
+good news then. "How delighted he will be when he hears," she said to
+herself, "but I know he will be sorry too for poor Daisy."
+
+Susan thought she would now have time to run down to the meadow by the
+river-side to see her favorite, but just as she had tied on her straw
+hat the clock struck four. This was the hour at which she always went
+to fetch her brothers from the school near the village. So, as she
+knew that the little boys would be sorry if she were late, she put off
+her visit to the lamb and went at once to meet them.
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+THE BLIND HARPER
+
+
+The dame-school, which was about a mile from the village, was a long,
+low house with a thatched roof. It was sheltered by a few old oaks,
+under which the grandparents and great-grandparents of the children
+now at school had played long ago. The play-green sloped down from the
+front of the school, and was enclosed by a rough paling. The children
+obeyed and loved the dame who taught them, for she was ever quick to
+praise them when they did well, and to give them all the pleasure she
+could. Susan had been taught by her, and the dame often told her
+little pupils that they must try to be like her, wise and modest,
+gentle and kind. As she now opened the gate, she heard the merry
+voices of the little ones, and saw them streaming out of the narrow
+door and scattering over the green.
+
+"Oh, there's Susan!" cried her two little brothers, running, leaping
+and bounding up to her; and many of the other rosy boys and girls
+crowded round her to tell of their games.
+
+Susan always liked to hear of all that made others happy, but she had
+to tell the children that if they all spoke at once she would not be
+able to hear what any of them said. The voices were still raised one
+above the other, all eager to tell about ninepins, or marbles, or
+tops, or bows and arrows, when suddenly music was heard. The children
+at once became silent, and looked round to see whence the sound came.
+Susan pointed to the great oak-tree, and they saw, sitting under its
+shade, an old man playing upon his harp. The children all drew near
+quietly, for the music was solemn; but as the harper heard little
+footsteps coming towards him, he played one of his more lively tunes.
+The merry troop pressed nearer and nearer to the old man. Then some of
+those who were in front whispered to each other, "He is blind." "What
+a pity!" "He looks very poor." "What a ragged coat he wears!" "He must
+be very old, for his hair is white; and he must have come a long way,
+for his shoes are quite worn out."
+
+All this was said while the harper tuned his harp. When he once more
+began to play, not a word was spoken, but every now and again there
+was a cry of delight. The old man then let the children name the airs
+they would like best to hear. Each, time Susan spoke, he turned his
+face quickly to where she stood, and played the tune she asked for
+over and over again.
+
+"I am blind," he said, "and cannot see your faces, but I can tell
+something about each of you by your voices."
+
+"Can you indeed?" cried Susan's little brother William, who was now
+standing between the old man's knees. "It was my sister Susan who
+spoke last. Can you tell us something about her?"
+
+"That I can, I think," said the harper, lifting the little boy on his
+knee. "Your sister Susan is good-natured."
+
+William clapped his hands.
+
+"And good-tempered."
+
+"Right," said little William, clapping louder than before.
+
+"And very fond of the little boy who sits on my knee."
+
+"Oh! right, right, quite right!" exclaimed the child, and "quite
+right" echoed on all sides.
+
+"But how do you know so much, when you are blind?" said William,
+looking hard at the old man.
+
+"Hush!" whispered John, who was a year older than his brother and very
+wise, "you should not remind him that he is blind."
+
+"Though I am blind," said the harper, "I can hear, you know, and I
+heard from your sister herself all that I told you of her, that she
+was good-tempered and good-natured and fond of you."
+
+"Oh, that's wrong--you did not hear all that from her, I'm sure," said
+John, "for nobody ever hears her praising herself."
+
+"Did not I hear her tell you," said the harper, "when you first came
+round me, that she was in a great hurry to go home, but that she would
+stay a little while, since you wished it so much? Was not that
+good-natured? And when you said you did not like the tune she liked
+best, she was not angry with you, but said, 'Then play William's
+first, if you please.' Was not that good-tempered?"
+
+"Oh, yes," said William, "it's all true; but how did you find out she
+was fond of me?"
+
+"That is such a hard question," said the harper, "that I must take
+time to think."
+
+He tuned his harp, as he thought, or seemed to think, and at this
+instant two boys, who had been searching for birds' nests in the
+hedges and who had heard the sound of the harp, came blustering up,
+and pushing their way through the circle, one of them exclaimed,
+"What's going on here? Who are you, my old fellow? A blind harper!
+Well, play us a tune, if you can play a good one--play--let's see,
+what shall he play, Bob?" added he, turning to his companion. "Play
+'Bumper Squire Jones.'"
+
+The old man, though he did not seem quite pleased with the way in
+which he was asked, played "Bumper Squire Jones." Several tunes were
+afterwards named by the same rough voice.
+
+The little children shrunk back shyly, as they looked at the bold boy.
+He was the son of Attorney Case, and as his father had not cured his
+temper when he was a child, it became worse and worse as he grew up.
+All who were younger and weaker than himself were afraid of him and
+disliked him. When the old harper was so tired that he could play no
+more, a lad who usually carried his harp for him came up, and held his
+master's hat to those around, saying, "Will you please remember us?"
+The children readily gave their halfpence to this poor, good-natured
+man, who had taken so much pains to amuse them. It pleased them better
+even than to give them to the gingerbread-woman, whose stall they
+loved to visit. The hat was held to the Attorney's son before he chose
+to see it. At last he put his hand into his pocket and pulled out a
+shilling. There was sixpenny-worth of halfpence in the hat. "I'll take
+these halfpence," said he, "and here's a shilling for you."
+
+"God bless you, sir," said the lad; but as he took the shilling which
+the young gentleman had slyly put into the blind man's hand, he saw
+that it was not worth one farthing. "I am afraid It is not good, sir,"
+said the lad, whose business it was to look at the money for his
+master.
+
+"I am afraid, then, you'll get no other," said young Case, with a rude
+laugh.
+
+"It never will do, sir, look at it yourself; the edges are all yellow.
+You can see the copper through it quite plain. Sir, nobody will take
+it from us."
+
+"I have nothing to do with that," said the rude boy, pushing away his
+hand. "You may pass it, you know, as well as I do, if you look sharp.
+You have taken it from me, and I shan't take it back again, I can tell
+you."
+
+A whisper of "that's very unjust," was heard.
+
+"Who says it's unjust?" cried the Attorney's son sternly, looking down
+upon his judges.
+
+"Is any one here among yourselves a judge of silver?" said the old
+man.
+
+"Yes, here's the butcher's boy," said the Attorney's son; "show it to
+him."
+
+He was a quiet, timid boy, and young Case fancied that he would be
+afraid to say what he thought. However, after turning the shilling
+round several times, the butcher's lad said that so far as he could
+tell, although he would not like to be quite sure of it, the coin was
+not a good one. Then, seeing the Attorney's son scowl angrily at him,
+he turned to Susan saying that she knew more than he did about money,
+as so much passed through her hands in payment of the bread she made.
+
+"I'll leave it to her," said the old harper. "If she says the shilling
+is good, we will keep it."
+
+The coin was then handed to Susan, who had not yet spoken, but now
+that she was called upon she did not shrink from telling the truth. In
+a gentle but firm tone she said, "I think the shilling is a bad one."
+
+"There's another then," cried the Attorney's son; "I have plenty of
+shillings and sixpences. They are nothing to me." And he walked away.
+
+The children now all started for their homes, and the old harper
+begged that Susan would show him the way to the village, if she were
+going there. The lad took up the harp and little William led the old
+man by the hand, while John ran on before to gather buttercups in the
+meadows. When they reached a little brook which they must cross by a
+narrow plank, Susan was afraid to leave the harper to the care of his
+little guide, so she herself took his hand and led him safely to the
+other side.
+
+Soon they reached the road, and Susan told the boy who carried his
+master's harp that he could not now lose his way. She then said
+good-by to the harper, adding that she and her brothers must take the
+short path across the fields, which would not be so pleasant for him
+because of the stiles.
+
+"I am afraid Miss Somers will be waiting," said Susan to to her
+brothers as they ran along together. "You know she said she would call
+at six o'clock, and I am sure by the length of our shadows that it is
+getting late."
+
+
+
+
+VII
+
+GOOD NEWS
+
+
+When they came to their own cottage-door, they heard voices, and they
+saw, when they entered, two ladies standing in the kitchen.
+
+"Come in, Susan," said Miss Somers, "I fancy you forgot that we
+promised to pay you a visit this evening; but you need not blush so
+much, there is no great harm done; we have only been here about five
+minutes and we have been admiring your neat garden and your tidy
+shelves. Is it you, Susan, who keeps these things in such nice order?"
+went on Miss Somers, looking round the kitchen.
+
+Before Susan could reply, little William pushed forward and answered,
+"Yes, ma'am, it is my sister Susan that keeps everything neat; and she
+always comes to school for us too, which was what caused her to be so
+late."
+
+"Because," went on John, "she would not refuse to let us hear a blind
+man play on the harp. It was we who kept her, and we hope, ma'am, as
+you seem so good, you won't take it amiss."
+
+Miss Somers and her sister smiled as they listened to Susan's little
+brothers, but what they heard made them feel sure that Susan was
+indeed as kind a sister as the housekeeper had said.
+
+When the ladies left the cottage, they took Susan with them through
+the village.
+
+"I fancy we shall find what we want here," said Miss Somers, stopping
+before a shop-window where ribbons of all colors were displayed, and
+where lace collars, glass buttons and sheets of pins were laid out in
+order. They went in, and on the shelves behind the counter saw gay,
+neat linens and calicoes.
+
+"Now, Susan, choose yourself a gown," said Miss Somers. "Because you
+are a busy girl and behave well, we wish others to see that such is
+the conduct we approve."
+
+The shopkeeper was the father of Susan's friend, Rose. He stretched
+his arm to the highest shelf, then dived into drawers beneath the
+counter, sparing no pains to show the best goods to his customers.
+
+Susan did not show the interest that might have been expected. She was
+thinking much of her lamb and more of her father. Miss Somers had put
+a bright guinea into her hand and told her to pay for her own gown.
+But Susan felt that this was a great deal of money to spend upon a
+frock for herself, and yet she did not know how to ask if she might
+keep it for a better purpose. Although Susan said nothing, Miss Somers
+read in her face that she was perplexed. "She does not like any of
+these things," whispered the lady to her sister.
+
+"She seems to be thinking of something else," was the low reply.
+
+"If you do not fancy any of these calicoes," said the shopkeeper to
+Susan, "we shall have a larger choice soon."
+
+"Oh," answered Susan, with a smile, and a blush, "these are all too
+good for me, but--"
+
+"But what, Susan?" asked Miss Somers. "Tell us what is passing in your
+little mind."
+
+Susan said nothing.
+
+"Well then, it does not matter. You do not know us very well yet. When
+you do, you will not, I am sure, be afraid to be frank. Put the guinea
+in your pocket and make what use of it you please. From what we know
+and from what we have heard of you, we are sure you will make a good
+use of it."
+
+"I think, madam," said the shopkeeper, "I have a pretty good guess
+what will become of that guinea, but I say nothing."
+
+"No, that is right," said Miss Somers; "we leave Susan to do just as
+she likes with it, and now we must not keep her any longer. Good
+night, Susan, we shall soon come again to your neat cottage."
+
+Susan courtesied and looked gratefully at the ladies, but did not
+speak. She wished to say, "I cannot explain to you here, with people
+around, what I want to do with my guinea, but when you come to our
+cottage you shall know all."
+
+After Susan had left, Miss Somers turned to the obliging shopkeeper
+who was folding up all the goods he had opened. "You have had a great
+deal of trouble," she said, "and as Susan will not choose a gown for
+herself, I must find one for her," and she chose the prettiest.
+
+While the man rolled up the parcel, Miss Somers asked him many
+questions about Susan, and he was only too glad to be able to tell
+what he knew about the good girl.
+
+"No later than last May morning," he said, "Susan acted as it will
+please you to hear. She was to have been Queen of the May, which among
+the children in our village is a thing a good deal thought of. But
+Susan's mother was ill, and Susan, after being up with her all night,
+would not go out in the morning, even when they brought the crown to
+her. She put it upon my daughter Rose's head with her own hands, and
+to be sure Rose loves her as well as if she were her own sister. If I
+praise Susan it is not that I am any relation of the Prices, but just
+that I wish her well, as does every one that knows her. I'll send the
+parcel up to the Abbey, shall I, ma'am?"
+
+"If you please," said Miss Somers, "and as soon as your new goods come
+in, let us know. You will, I hope, find us good customers and
+well-wishers," she added, with a smile, "for those who wish others
+well surely deserve to have well-wishers themselves."
+
+But to return to Susan. When she left the shop she carefully put the
+bright guinea into the purse with the twelve shillings her little
+friends had given her on Mayday. She next added, as far as she could
+remember them, the bills for bread that were owing to her, and found
+they came to about thirty-eight shillings. Then she hoped that by some
+means or other she might, during the week her father was to remain at
+home, make up the nine guineas that would enable him to stay with them
+altogether. "If that could but be," she said to herself, "how happy it
+would make my mother! She is already a great deal better since I told
+her my father would stay for a week longer. Ah! but she would not have
+blessed Attorney Case, if she had known about my poor Daisy." Susan
+had now reached the path that led to the meadow by the river-side. She
+wanted to go there alone and take leave of her lamb. But her little
+brothers, who were watching for her return, ran after her as soon as
+they saw her and overtook her as she reached the meadow.
+
+"What did that good lady want with you?" cried William; but looking up
+in his sister's face, he saw tears in her eyes, and he was silent and
+walked on quietly. Susan saw her lamb by the water-side.
+
+"Who are those two men?" said William. "What are they going to do with
+Daisy?"
+
+The two men were Attorney Case and the butcher. The butcher was
+feeling whether the lamb was fat.
+
+Susan sat down upon the bank in silent sorrow. Her little brothers ran
+up to the butcher and asked whether he was going to do any harm to the
+lamb. The butcher did not answer, but the Attorney replied, "It is not
+your sister's lamb any longer; it's mine."
+
+"Yours!" cried the children with terror; "and will you kill it?"
+
+"No, that is what the butcher will do."
+
+The little boys now burst into loud cries. They pushed away the
+butcher's hand; they threw their arms round the neck of the lamb; they
+kissed its forehead. It bleated. "It will not bleat to-morrow!" said
+William, and he wept bitterly.
+
+The butcher looked aside, and hastily rubbed his eyes with the corner
+of his blue apron. The Attorney stood unmoved; he pulled up the head
+of the lamb, which had just stooped to crop a mouthful of clover. "I
+have no time to waste," he said. "Butcher, I leave it to you. If it's
+fat--the sooner the better. I've nothing more to say." And he walked
+off, deaf to the prayers of the poor children. As soon as the Attorney
+was out of sight, Susan rose from the bank where she was seated, came
+up to her lamb, and stooped to gather some of the fresh dewy clover,
+that she might feed her pet for the last time. Poor Daisy licked the
+well-known hand.
+
+"Now, let us go," said Susan.
+
+"I'll wait as long as you please," said the butcher.
+
+Susan thanked him, but walked away quickly, without looking back. Her
+little brothers begged the man to stay a few minutes, for they had
+gathered a handful of blue speedwell and yellow crowsfoot, and they
+were decking the poor animal. As it followed the boys through the
+village, the children looked after them as they passed, and the
+butcher's own son was among the number. The boy remembered Susan's
+firmness about the shilling, for it had saved him a beating. He went
+at once to his father to beg him to spare the lamb.
+
+"I was thinking about it myself," said the butcher. "It's a sin to
+kill a pet lamb, I'm thinking. Anyway, it's what I'm not used to, and
+don't fancy doing. But I've a plan in my head and I'm going
+straightway to Attorney Case. But he's a hard man, so we'll say
+nothing to the boys, lest nothing comes of it. Come, lads," he went
+on, turning to the crowd of children, "it is time you were going your
+ways home. Turn the lamb in here, John, into the paddock for the
+night." The butcher then went to the Attorney.
+
+"If it's a good, fat, tender lamb you want for Sir Arthur," he said,
+"I could let you have one as good or better than Susan's and fit to
+eat to-morrow."
+
+As Mr. Case wished to give the present to Sir Arthur as soon as he
+could, he said he would not wait for Susan's lamb, but would take the
+one offered by the butcher. In the meantime Susan's brothers ran home
+to tell her that the lamb was put into the paddock for the night. This
+was all they knew, but even this was some comfort to the poor girl.
+Rose was at Farmer Price's cottage that evening, and was to have the
+pleasure of hearing Susan tell her father the good news that he might
+stay at home for one week longer. Mrs. Price was feeling better and
+said that she would sit up to supper in her wicker armchair. As Susan
+began to get ready the meal, little William, who was standing at the
+house-door watching for his father's return, called out suddenly,
+"Susan, why here is our old man!"
+
+"Yes," said the blind harper, "I have found my way to you. The
+neighbors were kind enough to show me where-abouts you lived; for,
+though I didn't know your name, they guessed who I meant by what I
+said of you all."
+
+Susan came to the door, and the old man was delighted to hear her
+speak again. "If it would not be too bold," said he, "I'm a stranger
+in this part of the country, and come from afar off. My boy has got a
+bed for himself here in the village; but I have no place. Could you be
+so kind as to give an old blind man a night's lodging?"
+
+Susan said she would step in and ask her mother, and she soon returned
+with an answer that he was heartily welcome, if he could sleep upon
+the children's bed, which was but small.
+
+The old man entered thankfully, and, as he did so, struck his head
+against the low roof. "Many roofs that are twice as high do not
+shelter folk so kind," he said. For he had just come from the house of
+Mr. Case, and Barbara, who had been standing at the hall-door, said he
+could have no help there. The old man's harp was set down in Farmer
+Price's kitchen, and he promised to play a tune for the boys before
+they went to bed, as their mother had given them leave to sit up to
+supper with their father.
+
+The farmer came home with a sad face, but how soon did it brighten,
+when Susan, with a smile, said to him, "Father, we've good news for
+you! good news for us all!--You have a whole week longer to stay with
+us; and perhaps," she went on, putting her little purse into his
+hands--"perhaps with what's here, and the bread-bills, and what may
+somehow be got together before a week's at an end, we may make up the
+nine guineas. Who knows, dearest mother, but we may keep him with us
+for ever!" As she spoke, she threw her arms round her father, who
+pressed her to him without speaking, for his heart was full. It was
+some little time before he could believe that what he heard was true;
+but the smiles of his wife, the noisy joy of his little boys, and the
+delight that shone in Susan's face at last convinced him that he was
+not in a dream.
+
+As they sat down to supper, the old harper was made welcome to his
+share of the simple meal.
+
+Susan's father, as soon as supper was finished, even before he would
+let the harper play a tune for his boys, opened the little purse which
+Susan had given him. He was surprised at the sight of the twelve
+shillings, and still more, when he came to the bottom of the purse to
+see the bright golden guinea.
+
+"How did you come by all this money, Susan?" said he.
+
+"How, I can't make out, except by the baking," said her proud mother.
+"Hey, Susan, is this your first baking?"
+
+"Oh, no, no," said her father, "I have the money for her first baking
+snug here, besides, in my pocket. I kept it for a surprise, to do your
+mother's heart good, Susan. Here's twenty-nine shillings, and the
+Abbey bill, which is not paid yet, comes to ten more. What think you
+of this, wife? Have we not a right to be proud of our Susan? Why," he
+went on, turning to the harper, "I ask your pardon for speaking before
+strangers in praise of my own child; but the truth is the fittest
+thing to be spoken, I think, at all times. Here's your good health,
+Susan. Why, by and by she'll be worth her weight in gold--in silver at
+least. But tell us, child, how came you by all this wealth, and how
+comes it that I don't go to-morrow? The happy news makes me so gay,
+I'm afraid I shall hardly understand it rightly. Speak on, child--but
+first bring us a bottle of the good mead you made last year from your
+own honey."
+
+Susan did not like to tell the story of her guinea-hen, of the gown,
+and of her poor lamb. Part of this would seem as if she were speaking
+of her own good deeds, and part of it she did not like to remember.
+But her mother begged to know the whole, and she told it as simply as
+she could. When she came to the story of her lamb, her voice faltered,
+and everybody present was touched. The old harper sighed once, and
+cleared his throat several times. He then asked for his harp, and
+after tuning it for long, he played the air he had promised to the
+boys.
+
+
+
+
+VIII
+
+BARBARA VISITS THE ABBEY
+
+
+The old blind man had come from the mountains of Wales to try to gain
+a prize of ten guineas. This prize was to be awarded to the harper who
+should play the best at a large town about five miles from the village
+where Susan lived. In the evening, after the prize-giving was over,
+there was to be a ball in the town, so the events of the day were
+looked forward to by many around. Barbara was one of those who grew
+more and more excited as the time for the prize-giving and ball drew
+near. She longed to be asked to go there by some of the rich neighbors
+who could drive her in their carriage. So how pleased she was when,
+on the evening that her father and the butcher were talking about
+Susan's lamb, a servant in livery from the Abbey left a note for Mr.
+and Miss Barbara Case! It was to invite them to dinner and tea at the
+Abbey next day.
+
+"Now they will find out," cried Bab, "that I am indeed a genteel
+person, and they will wish to take me to the ball. At any rate, I
+shall do my best to be asked."
+
+"To be sure," said Betty, "a lady who would visit Susan Price might
+well be glad to take you in her carriage."
+
+"Then pray, Betty, do not forget to send to town first thing to-morrow
+for my new bonnet. Without that the ladies of the Abbey will think
+nothing of me. And I must coax Papa to buy me a new gown for the ball.
+I shall look well at all the ladies' dresses at the Abbey to-morrow
+and find out the fashion. And Betty, I have thought of a charming
+present to take Miss Somers. I shall give her Susan's guinea-hen. It's
+of no use to me, so carry it up early in the morning to the Abbey,
+with my compliments."
+
+Feeling quite sure that her bonnet and the guinea-fowl would make Miss
+Somers think well of her, Barbara paid her first visit to the Abbey.
+She expected to see wonders, but when she was shown into the room
+where Miss Somers and other ladies were sitting, simply dressed, and
+with work, books and drawings on the table before them, she was
+surprised and vexed. There was nothing grand to be seen anywhere.
+
+When Miss Somers tried to find out what would interest her, and talked
+of walks, and flowers and gardens, Miss Barbara was offended. "I will
+show them," she said to herself, "that I can talk of other things." So
+in a grand tone she spoke of what she did not understand, until her
+mistaken airs of gentility made the ladies of the Abbey feel first
+amused and then ashamed. One by one the ladies left the room, and when
+Miss Somers went to change her dress for dinner, Barbara was left
+alone with some pretty drawings to amuse her. But the silly girl paid
+no heed to these. She could think only of the ball. Suddenly she
+remembered that nothing had been said about the guinea-hen. The truth
+was that Betty, in the hurry of dressing Barbara for her visit to the
+Abbey, had forgotten the bird, but it arrived just as Miss Somers was
+dressing. The housekeeper went to her mistress's room to say it had
+come.
+
+"Ma'am," she said, "here's a beautiful guinea-hen just come with Miss
+Barbara Case's compliments."
+
+Miss Somers thought by the housekeeper's tone that she was not quite
+pleased, and she soon found she was right in thinking so. The woman
+came close up to the dressing-table, and said, "I never like to speak
+till I'm sure, ma'am, and I'm not quite sure in this case, ma'am, but
+still I think it right to tell you what crossed my mind about this
+same guinea-hen, ma'am, and you can ask about it or do as you feel
+best, ma'am. Some time ago we had guinea-fowls of our own, and not
+knowing they were going to die as they have done, ma'am, I made bold
+to give a couple last Christmas to Susan Price, and very proud of them
+she was, ma'am, and I'm sure would never have parted with the hen of
+her own will. But if my eyes don't deceive me, ma'am, this guinea-hen
+that Miss Barbara sends to you with her compliments is the same that I
+gave to Susan. How Miss Barbara came by it, I can't tell, ma'am, but
+if my boy Philip was at home, he might know, for he's often at Farmer
+Price's cottage. If you wish it, ma'am, I'll ask him when he comes
+home to-night."
+
+"I think the best way will be for me to ask Miss Case herself about it
+this evening," said Miss Somers.
+
+Dinner was now served. Attorney Case expected to smell mint sauce, and
+as the covers were taken off the dishes he looked around for lamb, but
+no lamb did he see.
+
+Among other things talked of at table was a carving-knife that Sir
+Arthur had made for his sister. From this the conversation passed to
+carving. "Now is my chance to find out about my present," thought the
+Attorney. "Pray, may I ask," he said to Sir Arthur, "how you carve a
+fore quarter of lamb?"
+
+Sir Arthur at once saw what the Attorney wanted to hear. Having
+answered his question, he went on to thank him for the present he had
+offered, but added, "I am sorry I cannot accept it, as it is my rule
+never to accept gifts from my neighbors. The reason is that our poor
+tenants cannot show their good will in this way, as they have little
+or nothing to offer."
+
+Attorney Case listened with surprise. He was annoyed and angry, for he
+did not understand Sir Arthur's just mind and kind heart. After the
+ladies left the dining-room and were walking up and down the large
+hall, one of them remarked that it would be a charming place for
+music. Barbara, who like her father always seized any chance of
+turning the conversation as best pleased herself, said what a fine
+instrument was the harp. Then she spoke of the prize-giving to the
+harpers and of the ball that was to follow. "I know a good deal about
+the ball," she said, "because a lady in the town where it is to be
+held offered to take me with her, but although she has a carriage,
+Papa did not like to let her send it so far." At this point Barbara
+fixed her eyes on Miss Somers, that she might, if possible, read her
+thoughts, but as the lady was at that moment letting down the veil of
+her hat, her face was not seen.
+
+"Shall we go for a little walk before tea?" said Miss Somers to the
+other ladies. "I have a pretty guinea-hen to show you." Barbara now
+felt hopeful, and when even among the pheasants and peacocks the
+guinea-hen was much admired, she was sure that Miss Somers must indeed
+be proud to accept her gift.
+
+At this moment Philip came running by on an errand for his mother. As
+his eye fell upon the guinea-hen, he exclaimed before he knew, "Why,
+that is Susan's guinea-hen!"
+
+"No, it is not Susan's guinea-hen," said Miss Barbara, coloring
+furiously, "it is mine, and I have made a present of it to Miss
+Somers."
+
+At the sound of Bab's voice, Philip turned round, his face ablaze with
+anger.
+
+"What is the matter, Philip?" asked Miss Somers in a soothing voice,
+but Philip was not in the mood to be soothed.
+
+"Why, ma'am, may I speak out?" he asked, and without waiting for leave
+he gave a full account of the loss of Susan's guinea-fowl, of Rose's
+visit to Barbara, and of Barbara's greedy and cruel conduct.
+
+Barbara denied all that Philip said, and told quite another tale. When
+she could find no more to say she blushed deeply, for she saw that her
+story was not believed. One might have thought she was covered with
+shame, had it not been that the moment Philip was out of sight, she
+exclaimed, "I am sure I wish I had never seen this wretched
+guinea-hen! It is all Susan's fault for letting it stray into our
+garden."
+
+Barbara was too angry to notice that she was admitting the truth of
+Philip's story.
+
+"Perhaps," said Miss Somers, "Susan will be more careful now that she
+has had so hard a lesson. Shall we see? Philip will, I am sure, carry
+the guinea-hen back to her, if we wish it."
+
+"If you please, ma'am," said Barbara sulkily.
+
+So the guinea-hen was given to Philip, who set off with joy and was
+soon in sight of Farmer Price's cottage.
+
+
+
+
+IX
+
+A SURPRISE FOR SUSAN
+
+
+When Philip came to the door he stopped suddenly, for the idea struck
+him that it would give Rose great pleasure to carry the guinea-fowl to
+Susan. So he ran into the village.
+
+All the children who had given up their Mayday money to Susan were
+playing on the green. They were delighted to see the guinea-hen once
+more. Philip took his pipe and tabor and they all marched together
+towards the whitewashed cottage.
+
+As they passed the butcher's house, his boy came out. They told him
+where they were going.
+
+"Let me come with you, let me come with you," he said. "But wait one
+moment, for my father has something to say to you," and he darted into
+the house. The children waited. In a few moments they heard the
+bleating of a lamb, and soon they saw it being gently led by the
+butcher from the paddock.
+
+"It is Daisy!" exclaimed Rose.
+
+"It is Daisy!" they all shouted with joy, "Susan's lamb! Susan's
+lamb!"
+
+"Well, for my part," said the good butcher, as soon as he could be
+heard, "for my part I would not be so cruel as Attorney Case for the
+whole world. It's true the lamb did not know what was before it, but
+poor Susan did, and to wring her gentle heart was what I call cruel.
+But at any rate, here it is, safe and sound now. I'd have taken it to
+her sooner, but was off early this morning to the fair, and am but
+just come back. Daisy, though, was as well off in my paddock as in the
+field by the water-side."
+
+The troop of happy children went on their way with the guinea-fowl and
+the lamb. As they passed the shop where Susan had been shown the
+pretty calicoes, the shopkeeper, who, you remember, was Rose's father,
+came out. When he saw the lamb, and learned whose it was and heard its
+story, he gave the children some pieces of colored ribbon, with which
+Rose decorated Susan's favorite.
+
+The children now once more moved on, led by Philip, who played
+joyfully upon his pipe and tabor. Susan was working in her
+summer-house, with her little pine table before her. When she heard
+the sound of the music, she put down her work and listened. She saw
+the crowd of children coming nearer and nearer. They had closed round
+Daisy, so she did not see her pet, but as they came up to the
+garden-gate she saw that Rose beckoned to her. Philip played as loud
+as he could, that she might not hear, until the proper moment, the
+bleating of the lamb. As Susan opened the gate, the children divided,
+and first she saw, in the midst of her taller friends, little smiling
+Mary, with the guinea-hen in her arms.
+
+"Come on! come on!" cried Mary, as Susan started with joyful surprise;
+"you have more to see."
+
+At this instant the music paused. Susan heard the bleating of a lamb,
+and pressing eagerly forward, she beheld poor Daisy. She burst into
+tears. "I did not shed one tear when I parted with you, my dear little
+Daisy," she said, "it was for my father and mother. I would not have
+parted with you for any one else in the whole world. Thank you, thank
+you all," she added to her companions, who were even gladder for her
+in her joy than they had been sorry for her in her sorrow. "Now, if my
+father was not to go away from us next week, and if my mother were
+quite strong, I should be the happiest person in the world." As Susan
+finished speaking, a voice behind the listening crowd cried, in a
+rough tone, "Let us pass, if you please; you have no right to block
+the road." This was the voice of Attorney Case, who was returning
+with Barbara from his visit to the Abbey. He saw the lamb and tried to
+whistle as he went on. Barbara also saw the guinea-hen and turned her
+head another way. Even her new bonnet, in which she had expected to be
+so much admired, now only served to hide her blushing face.
+
+"I am glad she saw the guinea-hen," cried Rose, who now held it in her
+hands.
+
+"Yes," said Philip, "she'll not forget Mayday in a hurry."
+
+"Nor I either, I hope," said Susan, looking round upon her companions
+with a most loving smile: "I hope, while I live, I shall never forget
+your goodness to me last Mayday. Now that I've my pretty guinea-hen
+safe once more, I should think of returning your money."
+
+"No! no! no!" was the cry, "we don't want the money--keep it--keep
+it--you want it for your father."
+
+"Well," said Susan, "I am not too proud to accept it. I will keep your
+money for my father. Perhaps some time or other I may be able to
+earn----"
+
+"Oh," said Philip, "don't let us talk of earning; don't let her talk
+to us of money now; she hasn't had time hardly to look at poor Daisy
+and her guinea-hen. Come, we had better go and let her have them all
+to herself."
+
+The children moved away, but Philip himself was the very last to stir
+from the garden-gate. He stayed, first, to tell Susan that it was Rose
+who tied the ribbons on Daisy's head. Then he stayed a little longer
+to let her hear the story of the guinea-fowl, and to tell her who it
+was that brought the hen home from the Abbey.
+
+As Philip finished speaking, Susan was already feeding her long-lost
+favorite. "My pretty guinea-hen," said Susan, "my naughty guinea-hen
+that flew away from me, you shall never serve me so again. I must cut
+your nice wings, but I won't hurt you."
+
+"Take care!" cried Philip, "you'd better, indeed you'd better let me
+hold her, while you cut her wings."
+
+When this was done, which it certainly never could have been had
+Philip not held the hen for Susan, he remembered his mother had given
+him a message for Mrs. Price. This led to another quarter of an hour's
+delay, for Philip had the whole story of the guinea-hen to tell over
+again to Mrs. Price, and as the farmer came in while it was going on,
+it was only polite to begin at the beginning once more. Farmer Price
+was so pleased to see Susan happy again with her two favorites, that
+he said he must himself see Daisy fed, and Philip found that he was
+wanted to hold the jug of milk, from which Susan's father now filled
+the pan for Daisy. When Philip at last left the cottage, Bab and her
+maid Betty were staring out of the window as usual. Seeing them after
+he had left the garden, he at once turned back to see if he had shut
+the gate fast, lest the guinea-hen might stray out and again fall into
+Barbara's hands.
+
+
+
+
+X
+
+BARBARA'S ACCIDENT
+
+
+As the day went on, Miss Barbara became more and more annoyed that her
+meanness had been found out, but she had no wish to cure herself of
+the fault. The ball was still her first thought.
+
+"Well," she said to Betty, "you have heard how things have turned out,
+but if Miss Somers does not ask me to go with, her, I think I know
+some one else who will."
+
+Now, some officers were quartered at the town where the ball was to be
+held. And because they had got into trouble with a tradesman there,
+out of which Mr. Case had undertaken to help them, they sometimes
+invited the Attorney to mess. The officers thought that if they showed
+some attention to Mr. Case, he would not charge them so much for his
+help. One of them even asked his wife to take, sometimes, a little
+notice of Miss Barbara. The name of this officer's wife was Mrs.
+Strathspey. It was of Mrs. Strathspey that Barbara was thinking when
+she said to Betty that if Miss Somers did not take her to the ball,
+she thought she knew of some one else who would.
+
+"Mrs. Strathspey and the officers are to breakfast here to-morrow,"
+said Bab. "One of them dined at the Abbey to-day and he said they
+would all come. They are going somewhere into the country and
+breakfast here on the way. Pray, Betty, don't forget that Mrs.
+Strathspey can't breakfast without honey. I heard her say so myself."
+
+"Then, indeed," said Betty, "I'm afraid Mrs. Strathspey will have to
+go without breakfast here, for not a spoonful of honey have we, let
+her long for it ever so much."
+
+"But, surely," said Bab, "we can contrive to get some honey in the
+neighborhood."
+
+"There's none to be bought, that I know of," said Betty.
+
+"But is there none to be begged or borrowed?" said Bab, laughing. "Do
+you forget Susan's beehive? Step over to her in the morning with my
+compliments, and see what you can do. Tell her it's for Mrs.
+Strathspey."
+
+In the morning Betty went with Miss Barbara's compliments to Susan, to
+beg some honey for Mrs. Strathspey, who could not breakfast without
+it. Susan did not like to part with her honey, because her mother
+loved it, and she therefore gave Betty only a little. When Barbara saw
+how little Susan sent, she called her a miser, and she said she must
+have some more for Mrs. Strathspey. "I'll go myself and speak to her.
+Come with me, Betty," said the young lady, who seemed to forget she
+had said, on the day that she was asked to "take a spoon," that she
+never would pay Susan another visit.
+
+"Susan," she said to the poor girl whom she had done everything in her
+power to hurt, "I must beg a little more honey from you for Mrs.
+Strathspey's breakfast. You know, at a great time such as this, we
+should help one another."
+
+"To be sure we should," added Betty.
+
+Susan, though she was generous, was not weak; she was willing to give
+to those she loved, but would not let anything be taken from her or
+coaxed out of her by those whom she could not respect. She answered
+that she was sorry she had no more honey to spare.
+
+Barbara grew angry. "I'll tell you what, Susan Price," she said, "the
+honey I will have, so you may as well give it to me by fair means. Yes
+or no? Speak! Will you give it to me or not? Will you give me that
+piece of the honeycomb that lies there?"
+
+"That bit of honeycomb is for my mother's breakfast," said Susan; "I
+cannot give it you."
+
+"Can't you?" said Bab, "then see if I don't take it."
+
+She stretched across Susan and grasped, but she did not reach far
+enough. She made a second dart at the honeycomb and, in her effort to
+get it, she overset the beehive. The bees swarmed about her. Her maid
+Betty screamed and ran away. Susan, who was sheltered by a
+laburnum-tree, called to Barbara, upon whom the black clusters of bees
+were now settling, and begged her to stand still and not to beat them
+away, "If you stand quietly you won't be stung, perhaps."
+
+But instead of standing quietly, Bab flung about her arms, and stamped
+and roared, and the bees stung her terribly. Her arms and her face
+swelled in a frightful manner. She was helped home by poor Susan and
+Betty. The maid, now that the mischief was done, thought only of how
+she could excuse herself to her master.
+
+"Indeed, Miss Barbara," said she, "it was quite wrong of you to go and
+get yourself into such a scrape. I shall be turned away for it, you'll
+see."
+
+"I don't care whether you are turned away or not," said Barbara; "I
+never felt such pain in my life. Can't you do something for me? I
+don't mind the pain either so much as being such a fright. Pray, how
+am I to be fit to appear at breakfast with Mrs. Strathspey; and I
+suppose I can't go to the ball either to-morrow, after all."
+
+"No, that you can't expect to do, indeed," said Betty. "You need not
+think of balls, for those lumps and swellings won't go off your face
+this week. That's not what I mind; I'm thinking of what your papa will
+say to me when he sees you, miss."
+
+Susan, seeing she could be of no further use, was about to leave the
+house, when at the door she met Mr. Case coming in. Now, since his
+second visit to the Abbey, the Attorney had been thinking things over.
+It was clear that both Sir Arthur and Miss Somers thought highly of
+the Price family, so perhaps it was a mistake on his part not to be on
+friendly terms with them too. He felt sure that if the story of
+Susan's lamb ever reached the Abbey, Sir Arthur would have no more to
+do with him. It would therefore be well to get into the good graces
+of the farmer and his family. So when Mr. Case met Susan at the door
+he smiled and said, "How is your mother? Have you called for something
+that may be of use to her? Barbara, Barbara--Bab, come downstairs,
+child, and see what you can do for Susan Price." But no Barbara
+answered, and her father stalked upstairs to her room. There he stood
+still, amazed at the sight of his daughter's swollen face.
+
+Before Mr. Case could speak, Betty began to tell the story of
+Barbara's mishap in her own way. Barbara spoke at the same time,
+giving quite another account of what had happened. The Attorney turned
+the maid away on the spot, and turning to Barbara asked how she dared
+to treat Susan Price so ill, "when," as he said, "she was kind enough
+to give you some of her honey. I will not let you treat her so."
+Susan, who could not but hear all that was said, now went to beg the
+angry father to forgive his daughter.
+
+"You are too good to her, as indeed you are to everybody," he said. "I
+forgive her for your sake."
+
+Susan courtesied in great surprise, but she could not forget the
+Attorney's treatment of Daisy, and she left his house as soon as she
+could to get ready her mother's breakfast. Mr. Case saw that Simple
+Susan was not to be taken in by a few simple words, and when he tried
+in the same way to approach her father, the blunt, honest farmer
+looked at him with disdain.
+
+
+
+
+XI
+
+THE PRIZE-GIVING
+
+
+So matters stood on the day of the long-expected prize-giving and
+ball. Miss Barbara Case, stung by Susan's bees, could not, after all
+her efforts, go with Mrs. Strathspey to the ball. The ballroom was
+filled early in the evening. There was a large gathering. The harpers
+who tried for the prize were placed under the music-gallery at the
+lower end of the room. Among them was our old blind friend, who, as he
+was not so well clad as the others, seemed to be looked down upon by
+many of the onlookers. Six ladies and six gentlemen were chosen to be
+judges of the performance. They were seated opposite to the harpers.
+The Misses Somers, who were fond of music, were among the ladies, and
+the prize was in the hands of Sir Arthur.
+
+There was now silence. The first harp sounded, and as each harper
+tried his skill, those who listened seemed to think that he deserved
+the prize. The old blind man was the last. He tuned his harp, and such
+a simple, sad strain was heard as touched every heart. All were
+delighted, and when the music ceased there was still silence for some
+moments.
+
+The silence was followed by loud cheers. The judges were all agreed
+that the old blind harper, who had played last, deserved the prize.
+The simple, sad air, which had moved all who listened, was composed by
+himself. He was asked to give the words belonging to the music, and at
+last he modestly said he would repeat them, as he could not see to
+write. Miss Somers took her pencil, and as the old harper repeated his
+ballad, she wrote the words. He called it "Susan's Lamentation for her
+Lamb." Miss Somers looked at her brother from time to time, as she
+wrote, and Sir Arthur, as soon as the old man had finished, took him
+aside and asked him some questions, which brought to light the whole
+story of Susan's lamb and of Attorney Case's cruelty.
+
+The Attorney himself was present when the harper began to repeat his
+ballad. His color, as Sir Arthur steadily looked at him, changed from
+red to white, and from white to red, until at length he suddenly
+shrunk back through the crowd and left the room. We shall not follow
+him. We had rather follow our old friend the harper. No sooner had he
+received the prize of ten guineas, than he went to a small room
+belonging to the people of the house, asked for pen, ink, and paper,
+and dictated, in a low voice to his boy, a letter, which he ordered
+him to put at once into the post-office. The boy ran off with the
+letter and was but just in time, for the postman's horn was sounding.
+The next morning Farmer Price was sitting beside his wife and Susan
+sorrowing that his week's leave was nearly at an end, and that they
+had not enough money to give to the man who was willing to go in his
+place, when a knock was heard at the door. Then the person who
+delivered the letters in the village put one into Susan's hand,
+saying, "A penny, if you please--here's a letter for your father."
+
+"For me!" said Farmer Price; "here's the penny then; but who can it be
+from, I wonder? Who can think of writing to me, in this world?" He
+tore open the letter, but the hard name at the bottom of the page
+puzzled him--"your obliged friend, Llewellyn."
+
+"And what's this?" he said, opening a paper that was enclosed in the
+letter. "It's a song, seemingly; it must be somebody that has a mind
+to make an April fool of me."
+
+"But it is not April, it is May, father," said Susan.
+
+"Well, let us read the letter, and we shall come to the truth all in
+good time."
+
+Farmer Price then sat down in his own chair, and read as follows:
+
+ "MY WORTHY FRIEND--I am sure you will be glad to hear that I
+ have had success this night. I have won the ten-guinea prize,
+ and for that I am much indebted to your sweet daughter Susan;
+ as you will see by a little ballad I enclose for her. Your
+ kindness to me has let me learn something of your family
+ history. You do not, I hope, forget that I was present when
+ you were counting the treasure in Susan's little purse, and
+ that I heard for what purpose it was all saved. You have not,
+ I know, yet made up the full sum you need; therefore, I will
+ be glad if you will use the five-guinea bank-note which you
+ will find within the ballad. Pay me the money again when it
+ suits you, and if it never suits you to pay it, I shall never
+ ask for it. I shall go my rounds again through this country,
+ I believe, about the same time next year, and will call to
+ see how you are, and to play the new tune for Susan and the
+ dear little boys.
+
+ "I should just add, to set your heart at rest about the
+ money, that it does not distress me at all to lend it to you.
+ I am not quite so poor as I appear to be. But it is my wish
+ to go about as I do. I see more of the world under my
+ tattered clothes than, perhaps, I should ever see in a
+ better dress. There are many of us like this, and we are
+ glad, when we can, to do any kindness to such a worthy family
+ as yours.--So fare ye well.
+
+ "Your obliged Friend,
+ LLEWELLYN."
+
+Susan now, at her father's bidding, opened the ballad. He took the
+five-guinea bank-note, while she read, with surprise, "Susan's
+Lamentation for her Lamb." Her mother leaned over her shoulder to read
+the words, but they were stopped before they had finished the first
+verse by another knock at the door.
+
+
+
+
+XII
+
+ATTORNEY CASE IN TROUBLE
+
+
+It was not the postman with another letter. It was Sir Arthur and his
+sisters.
+
+They came meaning to lend the farmer and his good family the money to
+pay the man who was willing to go away in the farmer's place. But they
+found their help was not needed.
+
+"Still, since we are here," said Sir Arthur, "there is something I
+should like to speak about. Mr. Price, will you come out with me, and
+let me show you a piece of your land through which I want to make a
+road. Look there," said Sir Arthur, pointing to the spot, "I am laying
+out a drive round my estate, and that bit of land of yours stops me."
+
+"Why, sir, true enough it's mine, but you are welcome to it. I can
+trust you to find me another bit worth the same, or to make up the
+value of it in some other way. I need say no more."
+
+Sir Arthur was silent for a few moments. Then he said, "What is this I
+hear about some mistake in your lease?"
+
+"Well, sir," replied the farmer, "the truth is the fit thing to be
+spoken at all times. I can show you a letter from your brother who had
+the estate before you, and who let the farm to me. That letter shows
+what he meant, Sir Arthur, and if in the writing of the lease it was
+otherwise said, it is, as you say, a mistake, sir. Now a mistake is a
+mistake all the world over, and should be treated as such, but
+Attorney Case says in the matter of a lease you must abide by the
+mistake as though it were the truth."
+
+"You seem," said Sir Arthur, "to have some quarrel with this Attorney
+of whom you talk so often. Now would you mind telling me frankly what
+is the matter between you?"
+
+"The matter between us, sir, is this," said Price. "You know the
+corner of the field with the pink hawthorn near Mr. Case's house? The
+lane runs past one side of it and a sweetbrier hedge separates it on
+the other from his garden. Well, sir, the Attorney wishes to enclose
+that bit of ground with his own, and as it belongs to the village, and
+moreover is a play-green for the children, and it has been their
+custom to meet by the hawthorn every Mayday for as many years as I can
+remember, I was loth to see them turned out of it."
+
+"Let us go together and look at this piece of ground," said Sir
+Arthur. "It is not far off, is it?"
+
+"Oh, no, sir, close by."
+
+When they reached the ground, Mr. Case saw them from his garden and
+hurried to the spot. He was afraid of what the farmer might tell Sir
+Arthur. But this time the Attorney was too late, for the truth had
+already been told.
+
+"Is this the place you speak of?" asked Sir Arthur.
+
+"Yes, sir," answered Price.
+
+"Why, Sir Arthur," said Attorney Case, seeing that he was too late,
+"let there be no dispute about the ground. Let it belong to the
+village if you will. I give up all claim to it."
+
+"But you know well, Mr. Case, that a man cannot give up claim to a
+place which is not his. You cannot give up this piece of land, for you
+have no claim to it, as I can prove to you by a look at my maps. This
+field used to belong to the farm on the other side of the road, but
+was cut off from it when the lane was made."
+
+"Indeed you must know best," said the trembling Attorney, who was
+afraid of Sir Arthur and enraged to be shown in the wrong before
+Farmer Price.
+
+"Then," said Sir Arthur to the farmer, "you understand that this
+little green is to be a playground for the village children, and I
+hope they may gather hawthorn from their favorite bush for many a
+Mayday to come."
+
+Farmer Price bowed low, which he seldom did, even when he received a
+kindness for himself, but he was now overjoyed to think of the
+children's delight when he should tell them the good news.
+
+"And now, Mr. Case," said Sir Arthur, turning to the Attorney, "you
+sent me a lease to look over."
+
+"Yes, I thought it my duty to do so. I hope it will not hurt the good
+farmer."
+
+"No, it will not hurt him," said Sir Arthur. "I am willing to write a
+new one for him when he pleases. He has a letter from my brother who
+let the farm to him, which shows exactly what was meant, even if there
+was a mistake made in making out the lease. I hope I shall never treat
+any one unfairly."
+
+"No, indeed," said the Attorney, "but I always thought if there was a
+mistake in a lease it was fair to take advantage of it."
+
+"Then you shall be judged by your own words," answered Sir Arthur.
+"You meant to send me Farmer Price's lease, but your son has somehow
+brought me yours instead. I have found a bad mistake in it."
+
+"A bad mistake in my lease!" gasped the alarmed Attorney.
+
+"Yes," replied Sir Arthur, pulling the lease out of his pocket. "Here
+it is. You will see it has not been signed."
+
+"But you won't take advantage of a mistake, surely!" said the
+Attorney, who seemed to forget that he had shortly before said that it
+was fair to do so.
+
+"I shall not take advantage of you as you would have done of this
+honest man," replied Sir Arthur. "You shall be paid the value of your
+house and land upon condition that you leave the parish within one
+month."
+
+The Attorney knew it was useless to reply. He therefore turned and
+sneaked away.
+
+
+
+
+XIII
+
+SUSAN'S BIRTHDAY
+
+
+"You write a good hand, you can keep accounts, cannot you?" said Sir
+Arthur to Mr. Price, as they walked towards the cottage. "I think I
+saw a bill of your little daughter's drawing out the other day, which
+was very neatly written. Did you teach her to write?"
+
+"No, sir," said Price, "I can't say I did that, for she mostly taught
+it to herself; but I taught her a few sums, as far as I knew, on
+winter nights when I had nothing else to do."
+
+"Your daughter shows that she has been well taught," said Sir Arthur;
+"and her good conduct is a credit to you and her mother."
+
+"You are very good, very good indeed, sir, to speak in this way," said
+the delighted father.
+
+"But I mean to do more than pay you with words," said Sir Arthur. "You
+are attached to your own family, perhaps you may become attached to
+me, when you know me, and we shall have many chances of judging one
+another. I want no one to do my hard work. I only want a steady,
+honest man, like you, to collect my rents, and I hope, Mr. Price, you
+will do that for me."
+
+"I hope, sir," said Price, with joy and gratitude glowing in his
+honest face, "that I'll never give you cause to regret your goodness
+to me."
+
+"And what are my sisters about here?" said Sir Arthur, entering the
+cottage and going behind the two ladies, who were busy measuring a
+pretty colored calico.
+
+"It is for Susan, my dear brother. I knew she did not keep that guinea
+for herself," said Miss Somers. "I have just asked her mother to tell
+me what became of it. Susan gave it to her father; but she must not
+refuse a gown of our choosing this time; and I am sure she will not,
+because her mother, I see, likes it. And, Susan, I hear that instead
+of becoming Queen of the May this year, you were sitting in your
+mother's room as she was ill. Your mother has a little color in her
+cheeks now."
+
+"Oh, ma'am," said Mrs. Price, "I'm a different being. Joy, I think,
+has done it."
+
+"Then," said Miss Somers, "I hope you will be able to come out on your
+daughter's birthday, which, I hear, is on the twenty-fifth of this
+month. Make haste and get quite well before that day, for my brother
+means that all the boys and girls of the village shall have a dance on
+Susan's birthday."
+
+"Yes," said Sir Arthur, "and I hope on that day, Susan, you will be
+very happy with your little friends upon their play-green. I shall
+tell them that it is your good conduct which has won it for them; and
+if you have anything to ask, any little favor for any of your friends,
+which we can grant, ask now, Susan."
+
+"Sir," said Susan, after glancing at her mother, "there is, to be
+sure, a favor I should like to ask; it is for Rose."
+
+"Well, I don't know who Rose is," said Sir Arthur, smiling; "but go
+on."
+
+"Ma'am, you have seen her, I believe; she is a very good girl indeed,"
+said Mrs. Price to Miss Somers.
+
+"And works very neatly, ma'am," continued Susan eagerly, "and she and
+her mother heard you were looking out for some one to wait upon you."
+
+"Say no more," said Miss Somers; "your wish is granted. Tell Rose to
+come to the Abbey to-morrow morning, or rather come with her yourself,
+for our housekeeper, I know, wants to talk to you about a certain
+cake. She wishes, Susan, that you should be the maker of the cake for
+the dance, and she has good things looked out for it already, I know.
+It must be large enough for everybody to have a slice, and the
+housekeeper will ice it for you. I only hope your cake will be as good
+as your bread. Good-by."
+
+"How I do wish, now," said Farmer Price, "how I do wish, wife, that
+our good friend the harper was only here at this time. It would do his
+warm old heart good. Well, the best of it is, we shall be able next
+year, when he comes his rounds, to pay him his money with thanks,
+being all the time and for ever as much obliged to him as if we kept
+it. I long to see him in this house again, drinking, as he did, a
+glass of Susan's mead, just on this spot."
+
+"Yes," said Susan, "and the next time he comes, I can give him one of
+my guinea-hen's eggs, and I shall show him Daisy."
+
+"True, love," said her mother, "and he will play that tune and sing
+that pretty ballad. Where is it? I have not finished it."
+
+"Rose ran away with it, mother, but I'll run after her, and bring it
+back to you this minute," said Susan.
+
+Susan found her friend Rose at the hawthorn, in the midst of a crowd
+of children, to whom she was reading "Susan's Lamentation for her
+Lamb."
+
+"The words are something, but the tune--the tune--I must have the
+tune," cried Philip. "I'll ask my mother to ask Sir Arthur to try and
+find out which way that good old man went after the ball; and if he's
+to be found, we'll have him back by Susan's birthday, and he shall sit
+here--just exactly here--by our bush, and he shall play--I mean, if he
+will--that same tune for us, and I shall learn it--I mean, if I
+can--in a minute."
+
+The good news that Farmer Price was to collect the rents and that
+Attorney Case was to leave the parish in a month soon spread over the
+village. Many came out of their houses to have the pleasure of hearing
+the joyful tidings from Susan herself. The crowd on the play-green
+grew bigger every minute.
+
+"Yes," cried Philip, "I tell you it's quite true, every word of it.
+Susan's too modest to say it herself, but I tell you all, that Sir
+Arthur has given us this play-green just because she is so good."
+
+
+
+
+LIMBY LUMPY
+
+I
+
+
+LIMBY LUMPY was the only son of his mother. His father was called the
+"Pavior's Assistant," for he was so large and heavy that, when he used
+to walk through the streets, the men who were ramming the stones down
+with a large wooden rammer would say, "Please to walk over these
+stones, sir," and then the men would get a rest.
+
+Limby was born on April 1--I do not know how long ago; but before he
+came into the world such preparations were made! There was a beautiful
+cradle, and a bunch of coral with bells on it, and lots of little
+caps, and a fine satin hat, and tops and bottoms for pap, and two
+nurses to take care of him. He was, too, to have a little chaise, when
+he grew big enough; after that, he was to have a donkey, and then a
+pony. In short, he was to have the moon for a plaything, if it could
+be got; and, as to the stars, he would have had them, if they had not
+been too high to reach.
+
+Limby made a rare to-do when he was a little baby. But he never was a
+_little_ baby--he was always a big baby; nay, he was a big baby till
+the day of his death.
+
+"Baby Big," his mother used to call him; he was "a noble baby," said
+his aunt; he was "a sweet baby," said old Mrs. Tomkins, the nurse; he
+was "a dear baby," said his papa--and so he was, for he _cost_ a good
+deal. He was "a darling baby," said his aunt, by the mother's side;
+"there never was such a fine child," said everybody, before the
+parents; when they were at another place they called him, "a great,
+ugly fat child."
+
+Limby was almost as broad as he was long. He had what some people
+called an open countenance--that is, one as broad as a full moon. He
+had what his mother called beautiful auburn locks, but what other
+people said were carroty--not before the mother, of course.
+
+Limby had a flattish nose and a widish mouth, and his eyes were a
+little out of the right line. Poor little dear, he could not help that
+and therefore it was not right to laugh at him.
+
+Everybody, however, laughed to see him eat his pap, for he would not
+be fed with the patent silver pap-spoon which his father bought him,
+but used to lay himself flat on his back, and seize the pap-boat with
+both hands, and never let go of it till its contents were fairly in
+his dear little stomach.
+
+So Limby grew bigger and bigger every day, till at last he could
+scarcely draw his breath, and was very ill; so his mother sent for
+three apothecaries and two physicians, who looked at him, and told his
+mother there were no hopes: the poor child was dying of overfeeding.
+The physicians, however, prescribed for him--a dose of castor-oil.
+
+His mother attempted to give him the castor-oil, but Limby, although
+he liked tops and bottoms, and cordial, and pap, and sweetbread, and
+oysters, and other things nicely dished up, had no fancy for
+castor-oil, and struggled and kicked and fought every time his nurse
+or mother attempted to give it him.
+
+"Limby, my darling boy," said his mother, "my sweet cherub, my only
+dearest, do take its oily-poily, there's a ducky-deary, and it shall
+ride in a coachy-poachy."
+
+"Oh, the dear baby!" said the nurse; "take it for nursey. It will take
+it for nursey, that it will."
+
+The nurse had got the oil in a silver medicine-spoon, so contrived
+that, if you could get it into the child's mouth, the medicine must go
+down. Limby, however, took care that no spoon should go into his
+mouth, and when the nurse tried the experiment for the nineteenth
+time, gave a plunge and a kick, and sent the spoon up to the ceiling,
+knocked off the nurse's spectacles, upset the table on which all the
+bottles and glasses were, and came down whack on the floor.
+
+His mother picked him up, clasped him to her breast, and almost
+smothered him with kisses.
+
+"Oh, my dear boy!" said she; "it shan't take the nasty oil! it won't
+take it, the darling! Naughty nurse to hurt baby! It shall not take
+nasty physic!"
+
+And then she kissed him again.
+
+Poor Limby, although only two years old, knew what he was at--he was
+trying to be the master of his mother. He felt he had gained his
+point, and gave another kick and a squall, at the same time planting a
+blow on his mother's eye.
+
+"Dear little creature!" said she; "he is in a state of high
+convulsions and fever. He will never recover!"
+
+But Limby did recover, and in a few days was running about the house,
+and the master of it. There was nobody to be considered, nobody to be
+consulted, nobody to be attended to, but Limby Lumpy.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+
+Limby grew up big and strong; he had everything his own way. One day,
+when he was at dinner with his father and mother, perched upon a
+double chair, with his silver knife and fork, and silver mug to drink
+from, he amused himself by playing drums on his plate with the mug.
+
+"Don't make that noise, Limby, my dear," said his father.
+
+"Dear little lamb!" said his mother; "let him amuse himself. Limby,
+have some pudding?"
+
+"No, Limby no pudding!"
+
+_Drum! drum! drum!_
+
+A piece of pudding was, however, put on Limby's plate, but he kept on
+drumming as before. At last he drummed the bottom of the mug into the
+soft pudding, to which it stuck, and by which means it was scattered
+all over the carpet.
+
+"Limby, my darling!" said his mother; and the servant was called to
+wipe Limby's mug and pick the pudding up from the floor.
+
+Limby would not have his mug wiped, and floundered about, and upset
+the cruet-stand and the mustard on the table-cloth.
+
+"Oh, Limby Lumpy--naughty boy!" said his father.
+
+"Don't speak so cross to the child: he is but a child," said his
+mother. "I don't like to hear you speak so cross to the child."
+
+"I tell you what it is," said his father, "I think the boy does as he
+likes. But I don't want to interfere."
+
+Limby now sat still, resolving what to do next. He was not hungry,
+having been stuffed with a large piece of pound-cake about an hour
+before dinner; but he wanted something to do, and could not sit still.
+
+Presently a saddle of mutton was brought on the table. When Limby saw
+this he set up a crow of delight.
+
+"Limby ride," said he--"Limby ride!" and rose up in his chair, as if
+to reach the dish.
+
+"Yes, my ducky, it shall have some mutton," said his mother, and
+immediately gave him a slice, cut up into small morsels.
+
+That was not it. Limby pushed that on the floor, and cried out: "Limby
+on meat! Limby on meat!"
+
+His mother could not think what he meant. At last, however, his father
+recollected that he had been in the habit of giving him a ride
+occasionally, first on his foot, sometimes on the scroll end of the
+sofa, at other times on the top of the easy chair. Once he put him on
+a dog, and more than once on the saddle; in short, he had been in the
+habit of perching him on various things, and now Limby, hearing this
+was a _saddle_ of mutton, wanted to take a ride on it.
+
+"Limby on! Limby ride on bone!" said the child in a whimper.
+
+"Did you _ever hear_?" said the father.
+
+"What an extraordinary child!" said the mother. "How clever to know it
+was like a saddle, the little dear! No, no, Limby; grease frock,
+Limby."
+
+But Limby cared nothing about a greasy frock, not he--he was used
+enough to that--and therefore roared out more lustily for a ride on
+the mutton.
+
+"Did you ever know such a child? What a dear, determined spirit!"
+
+"He is a child of an uncommon mind," said his mother. "Limby,
+dear--Limby, dear, silence! silence!"
+
+The truth was, Limby made such a roaring that neither father nor
+mother could get their dinners, and scarcely knew whether they were
+eating beef or mutton.
+
+"It is impossible to let him ride on the mutton," said his
+father--"quite impossible!"
+
+"Well, but you might just put him astride the dish, just to satisfy
+him. You can take care his legs or clothes do not go into the gravy."
+
+"Anything for a quiet life," said the father. "What does Limby want?
+Limby ride?"
+
+"Limby on bone! Limby on meat!"
+
+"Shall I put him across?" said Mr. Lumpy.
+
+"Just for one moment," said his mother; "it won't hurt the mutton."
+
+The father rose, and took Limby from his chair, and, with the greatest
+caution, held his son's legs astride, so that they might hang on each
+side of the dish without touching it--"just to satisfy him," as he
+said, "that they might dine in quiet--" and was about to withdraw him
+from it immediately.
+
+But Limby was not to be cheated in that way. He wished to feel the
+saddle _under_ him, and accordingly forced himself down upon it; but
+feeling it rather warmer than was agreeable, started, and lost his
+balance, and fell down among the dishes, soused in melted butter,
+cauliflower, and gravy, floundering, and kicking, and screaming, to
+the detriment of glasses, jugs, dishes, and everything else on the
+table.
+
+"My child! my child!" said his mother. "Oh, save my child!"
+
+She snatched him up, and pressed his begreased garments close to the
+bosom of her best silk gown.
+
+Neither father nor mother wanted any more dinner after this. As to
+Limby, he was as frisky afterwards as if nothing had happened, and
+about half an hour from the time of this disaster _cried for his
+dinner._
+
+
+
+
+THE SORE TONGUE
+
+By JANE TAYLOR
+
+
+There was a little girl called Fanny, who had the misfortune one day
+to bite her tongue as she was eating her breakfast. It hurt her so
+much that she could scarcely help crying; and even when the first
+smart was over, it continued so sore that whenever she spoke it pained
+her considerably. Finding this to be the case, she said very pitifully
+to her mother, "Mamma, you can't think how it hurts me when I speak!"
+"Does it?" replied her mother; "then I'll tell you what I would advise
+you to do. Resolve all this day to say nothing but what is either
+necessary or useful; this will give your tongue a fine holiday, and
+may answer more purposes than one."
+
+Fanny, knowing that she had the character of being somewhat
+loquacious, could not help laughing at this, and said, "Well, I will
+try for once; so, mum! I am going to begin now, mamma."
+
+_Mother_. Do so; and whenever you are beginning to speak, be sure you
+ask yourself whether what you were going to say was likely to be of
+any use, or whether it was necessary.
+
+_Fanny_. Yes, yes, I will! but don't talk to me, mamma, for fear. So
+saying, she screwed up her lips, and taking her work, sat for about
+five minutes as still as a mouse. She then looked up, smiled and
+nodded at her mother, as much as to say, "See how well I can hold my
+tongue," still screwing her lips very tight for fear she should speak.
+Soon, however, she began to feel a great inclination to say something;
+and was glad to recollect that if she could but think of anything
+either useful or necessary, she might speak. Whereupon she endeavored
+to find something to say that would come "within the act." To aid her
+invention, she looked all round the room.
+
+_Fanny_. Mamma, don't you think the fire wants stirring? (This
+question, she thought, savored of both qualifications.)
+
+_Mother_. Not at present, my dear.
+
+Then followed another long silence; for Fanny found it vastly more
+difficult than she had any previous idea of, to think of anything
+useful to talk about; and she knew her mamma would laugh at her if she
+said what was obviously idle or silly, just now. She was beginning to
+repent having made such an agreement, when her three elder sisters
+entered the room. She now thought it quite reasonable, if not
+absolutely necessary, to tell them of her misfortune; which she did at
+considerable length, and with many needless digressions (the usual
+custom with great talkers); upon which they all laughed, prophesying
+that her resolution would not last half an hour, and rallying her for
+telling such a long story with a sore tongue.
+
+Soon after, some ladies called to pay their mother a morning visit.
+This gave Fanny's tongue such a long rest that the moment they were
+gone it seemed irresistibly to resume its wonted functions.
+
+_Fanny_. What a while old Mrs. W. has had that brown satin pelisse!
+Really, poor old lady, I am quite tired of seeing her in it!
+
+_Mother_. How is your tongue, Fanny?
+
+_Fanny_. Oh, better, mamma, thank you--almost well.
+
+_Mother_. I am sorry for it: I was in hopes it would have been sore
+enough at least to prevent your making impertinent remarks upon
+anybody all this day.
+
+_Fanny_. No, but really, mamma, is it not an old rubbishing thing?
+
+_Mother_. I don't know, indeed. It is no business of mine; therefore I
+took no notice of it.
+
+A silence ensued after this; but conversation revived when Caroline,
+who had stood for some time with her eyes fixed on their opposite
+neighbor's window, suddenly exclaimed, "I do believe the Joneses are
+going to have company again to-day! The servant has just been lighting
+the fire in the drawing-room; and there is Miss Jones now gone up to
+dress. I saw her draw down the blinds in her room this instant." "So
+she is," said Lucy, looking up: "I never knew such people in my life!
+they are always having company."
+
+"I wonder whom they are expecting to-day," said Eliza;
+"dinner-company, I suppose."
+
+The proceedings of their neighbors, the Joneses, continued to furnish
+matter for various sagacious conjectures and remarks for a
+considerable time. At length Caroline exclaimed with the eagerness of
+discovery, "Look! look! there's the baker now at the door, with a
+whole tray full of tarts and things. Make haste, or he'll be gone in."
+
+_Lucy_. So he is, I declare; it is a dinner-party then. Well, we shall
+see presently, I hope, who are coming.
+
+_Caroline_. Oh, no, they never dine till five when they have company.
+
+_Eliza_. And it will be dark then; how tiresome!
+
+_Lucy_. If Miss Jones is not dressed already! She is this instant come
+into the drawing-room.
+
+_Caroline_. Stand back, stand back! Don't let her see us all staring.
+Ah, there she is,--got on her pink sarcenet body and sleeves to-day.
+How pretty that dress is, to be sure!
+
+_Eliza_. And how nicely she has done her hair! Look, Caroline--braided
+behind.
+
+_Lucy_. There, she is putting down the sash. That chimney smokes, I
+know, with this wind.
+
+_Fanny_. And there is that little figure, Martha Jones, come down now.
+Do look--as broad as she is long! What a little fright that child is,
+to be sure!
+
+_Mother_. Pray, Fanny, was that remark useful or necessary?
+
+_Fanny_. Oh, but mamma, I assure you, my tongue is quite well now.
+
+_Mother_. I am sorry for it, my dear. Do you know, I should think it
+well worth while to bite my tongue every day if there were no other
+means of keeping it in order.
+
+At this the girls laughed; but their mother, resuming her gravity,
+thus continued:
+
+"My dear girls, I should before now have put a stop to this idle
+gossiping, if I had not hoped to convince you of the folly of it. It
+is no wonder, I confess, that at your age you should learn to imitate
+a style of remark which is but too prevalent in society. Nothing,
+indeed, is more contagious. But let me also tell you, that girls of
+your age, and of your advantages, are capable of seeing the meanness
+of it, and ought to despise it. It is the chief end of education to
+raise the minds of women above such trifling as this. But if a young
+person who has been taught to think, whose taste has been cultivated,
+and who might therefore possess internal resources, has as much idle
+curiosity about the affairs of her neighbors, and is as fond of
+retailing petty scandal concerning them, as an uneducated woman, it
+proves that her mind is incurably mean and vulgar, and that
+cultivation is lost upon her.
+
+"This sort of gossiping, my dear girls, is the disgrace of our sex.
+The pursuits of women lie necessarily within a narrow sphere, and they
+naturally sink, unless raised by refinement, or by strong principle,
+into that littleness of character, for which even their own husbands
+and fathers (if they are men of sense) are tempted to despise them.
+The minds of men, from their engagements in business, necessarily take
+a larger range; and they are, in general, too much occupied with
+concerns comparatively important to enter into the minute details
+which amuse women. But women of education have no such plea to urge.
+When your father and I direct you to this or that pursuit, it is not
+so much for the sake of your possessing that particular branch of
+knowledge, but that by knowledge in general you may become intelligent
+and superior, and that you may be furnished with resources which will
+save you from the miserable necessity of seeking amusement from
+intercourse with your neighbors, and an acquaintance with their
+affairs.
+
+"Let us suppose, now, that this morning you had been all more
+industriously inclined; and had been engaged in any of your
+employments with that ardor which some happy young people manifest in
+the acquisition of knowledge; would you, in that case, have felt any
+desire to know the date of Mrs. W.'s pelisse, or any curiosity in the
+proceedings of our neighbors the Joneses? No, you would then have
+thought it a most impertinent interruption, if any one had attempted
+to entertain you with such particulars. But when the mind is indolent
+and empty, then it can receive amusement from the most contemptible
+sources. Learn, then, to check this mean propensity. Despise such
+thoughts whenever you are tempted to indulge them. Recollect that this
+low curiosity is the combined result of idleness, ignorance,
+emptiness, and ill-nature; and fly to useful occupation, as the most
+successful antidote against the evil. Nor let it be forgotten that
+such impertinent remarks as these come directly under the description
+of those 'idle words,' of which an account must be given in the day of
+judgment. Yes, this vulgar trifling is as inconsistent with the spirit
+of Christian benevolence, and with the grand rule of 'doing to others
+as we would that they should do to us,' as it is with refinement of
+taste and dignity of character."
+
+"Who would have thought," said little Fanny, "that my happening to
+bite my tongue this morning would have led to all this?"
+
+"It would be a fortunate bite for you, Fanny," said her mother, "and
+for your neighbors, if it should make you more careful in the use of
+it. If we were liable to such a misfortune whenever we use our tongues
+improperly, some persons would be in a constant agony. Now, if our
+consciences were but half as sensitive as our nerves, they would
+answer the purpose much better. Foolish talking pains a good
+conscience, just as continual speaking hurts a sore tongue; and if we
+did but regard one smart as much as the other, it would act as a
+constant check upon the unruly member."
+
+
+
+
+EYES AND NO EYES, OR THE ART OF SEEING
+
+By JOHN AIKIN and MRS. BARBAULD
+
+
+"Well, Robert, where have you been walking this after noon?" said Mr.
+Andrews, to one of his pupils at the close of a holiday.
+
+_R._ I have been, sir, to Broom heath, and so round by the windmill
+upon Camp-mount, and home through the meadows by the river-side.
+
+_Mr. A._ Well, that's a pleasant round.
+
+_R._ I thought it very dull, sir; I scarcely met with a single person.
+I had rather by half have gone along the turnpike road.
+
+_Mr. A._ Why, if seeing men and horses is your object, you would,
+indeed, be better entertained on the highroad. But did you see
+William?
+
+_R._ We set out together, but he lagged behind in the lane, so I
+walked on and left him.
+
+_Mr. A._ That was a pity. He would have been company for you.
+
+_R._ Oh, he is so tedious, always stopping to look at this thing and
+that! I had rather walk alone. I dare say he is not got home yet.
+
+_Mr. A._ Here he comes. Well, William, where have you been?
+
+_W._ Oh, sir, the pleasantest walk! I went all over Broom-heath, and
+so up to the mill at the top of the hill, and then down among the
+green meadows by the side of the river.
+
+_Mr. A._ Why, that is just the round Robert has been taking, and he
+complains of its dullness, and prefers the highroad.
+
+_W._ I wonder at that. I am sure I hardly took a step that did not
+delight me, and I have brought home my handkerchief full of
+curiosities.
+
+_Mr. A._ Suppose, then, you give us some account of what amused you so
+much. I fancy it will be as new to Robert as to me.
+
+_W._ I will, sir. The lane leading to the heath, you know, is close
+and sandy, so I did not mind it much, but made the best of my way.
+However, I spied a curious thing enough in the hedge. It was an old
+crab-tree, out of which grew a great bunch of something green, quite
+different from the tree itself. Here is a branch of it.
+
+_Mr. A._ Ah! this is mistletoe, a plant of great fame for the use made
+of it by the Druids of old in their religious rites and incantations.
+It bears a very slimy white berry, of which birdlime may be made,
+whence its Latin name of _Viscus_. It is one of those plants which do
+not grow In the ground by a root of their own, but fix themselves upon
+other plants; whence they have been humorously styled _parasitical_,
+as being hangers-on, or dependents. It was the mistletoe of the oak
+that the Druids particularly honored.
+
+_W._ A little farther on I saw a green woodpecker fly to a tree, and
+run up the trunk like a cat.
+
+_Mr. A._ That was to seek for insects in the bark, on which they live.
+They bore holes with their strong bills for that purpose, and do much
+damage to the trees by it.
+
+_W._ What beautiful birds they are!
+
+_Mr. A._ Yes; they have been called, from their color and size, the
+English parrot.
+
+_W._ When I got upon the open heath, how charming it was! The air
+seemed so fresh, and the prospect on every side so free and unbounded!
+Then it was all covered with gay flowers, many of which I had never
+observed before. There were at least three kinds of heath (I have got
+them In my handkerchief here), and gorse, and broom, and bellflower,
+and many others of all colors, that I will beg you presently to tell
+me the names of.
+
+_Mr. A._ That I will readily.
+
+_W._ I saw, too, several birds that were new to me. There was a pretty
+grayish one, of the size of a lark, that was hopping about some great
+stones; and when he flew he showed a great deal of white above his
+tail.
+
+_Mr. A._ That was a wheatear. They are reckoned very delicious birds
+to eat, and frequent the open downs in Sussex, and some other
+countries, in great numbers.
+
+_W_. There was a flock of lapwings upon a marshy part of the heath,
+that amused me much. As I came near them, some of them kept flying
+round and round just over my head, and crying _pewet_ so distinctly
+one might fancy they almost spoke, I thought I should have caught one
+of them, for he flew as if one of his wings was broken, and often
+tumbled close to the ground: but as I came near, he always made a
+shift to get away.
+
+_Mr. A._ Ha, ha! you were finely taken in then! This was all an
+artifice of the bird's to entice you away from its nest; for they
+build upon the bare ground, and their nests would easily be observed,
+did they not draw off the attention of intruders by their loud cries
+and counterfeit lameness.
+
+_W._ I wish I had known that, for he led me a long chase, often over
+shoes in water. However, it was the cause of my falling in with an old
+man and a boy who were cutting and piling up turf for fuel, and I had
+a good deal of talk with them about the manner of preparing the turf,
+and the price it sells at. They gave me, too, a creature I never saw
+before--a young viper, which they had just killed, together with its
+dam. I have seen several common snakes, but this is thicker in
+proportion, and of a darker color than they are.
+
+_Mr. A._ True. Vipers frequent those turfy, boggy grounds pretty much,
+and I have known several turf-cutters bitten by them.
+
+_W._ They are very venomous, are they not?
+
+_Mr. A._ Enough so to make their wounds painful and dangerous, though
+they seldom prove fatal.
+
+_W._ Well--I then took my course up to the windmill on the mount. I
+climbed up the steps of the mill in order to get a better view of the
+country round. What an extensive prospect! I counted fifteen church
+steeples; and I saw several gentlemen's houses peeping out from the
+midst of green woods and plantations; and I could trace the windings
+of the river all along the low grounds, till it was lost behind a
+ridge of hills. But I'll tell you what I mean to do, sir, if you will
+give me leave.
+
+_Mr. A._ What is that?
+
+_W._ I will go again, and take with me Carey's county map, by which I
+shall probably be able to make out most of the places.
+
+_Mr. A._ You shall have it, and I will go with you, and take my pocket
+spying-glass.
+
+_W._ I shall be very glad of that. Well--a thought struck me, that as
+the hill is called _Camp-mount,_ there might probably be some remains
+of ditches and mounds with which I have read that camps were
+surrounded. And I really believe I discovered something of that sort
+running round one side of the mount.
+
+_Mr, A._ Very likely you might. I know antiquaries have described such
+remains as existing there, which some suppose to be Roman, others
+Danish. We will examine them further, when we go.
+
+_W._ From the hill I went straight down to the meadows below, and
+walked on the side of a brook that runs into the river. It was all
+bordered with reeds and flags and tall flowering plants, quite
+different from those I had seen on the heath. As I was getting down
+the bank to reach one of them, I heard something plunge into the water
+near me. It was a large water-rat, and I saw it swim over to the other
+side, and go into its hole. There were a great many large dragon-flies
+all about the stream. I caught one of the finest, and have got him
+here in a leaf. But how I longed to catch a bird that I saw hovering
+over the water, and every now and then darting down into it! It was
+all over a mixture of the most beautiful green and blue, with some
+orange color. It was somewhat less than a thrush, and had a large head
+and bill, and a short tail.
+
+_Mr. A._ I can tell you what that bird was--a kingfisher, the
+celebrated halcyon of the ancients, about which so many tales are
+told. It lives on fish, which it catches in the manner you saw. It
+builds in holes in the banks, and is a shy, retired bird, never to be
+seen far from the stream where it inhabits.
+
+_W_. I must try to get another sight at him, for I never saw a bird
+that pleased me so much. Well--I followed this little brook till it
+entered the river, and then took the path that runs along the bank.
+On the opposite side I observed several little birds running along the
+shore, and making a piping noise. They were brown and white, and about
+as big as a snipe.
+
+_Mr. A_. I suppose they were sandpipers, one of the numerous family of
+birds that get their living by wading among the shallows, and picking
+up worms and insects.
+
+_W_. There were a great many swallows, too, sporting upon the surface
+of the water, that entertained me with their motions. Sometimes they
+dashed into the stream; sometimes they pursued one another so quick,
+that the eye could scarcely follow them. In one place where a high
+steep sand-bank rose directly above the river, I observed many of them
+go in and out of holes with which the bank was bored full.
+
+_Mr. A_. Those were sand-martins, the smallest of our species of
+swallows. They are of a mouse color above, and white beneath. They
+make their nests and bring up their young in these holes, which run a
+great depth, and by their situation are secure from all plunderers.
+
+_W_. A little farther I saw a man in a boat, who was catching eels in
+an odd way. He had a long pole with broad iron prongs at the end, just
+like Neptune's trident, only there were five instead of three. This he
+pulled straight down among the mud in the deepest parts of the river,
+and fetched up the eels sticking between the prongs.
+
+_Mr. A_. I have seen this method. It is called spearing of eels.
+
+_W_. While I was looking at him, a heron came flying over my head,
+with his large flagging wings. He lit at the next turn of the river,
+and I crept softly behind the bank to watch his motions. He had waded
+into the water as far as his long legs would carry him, and was
+standing with his neck drawn in, looking intently on the stream.
+Presently he darted his long bill as quick as lightning into the
+water, and drew out a fish, which he swallowed. I saw him catch
+another in the same manner. He then took alarm at some noise I made,
+and flew away slowly to a wood at some distance, where he settled.
+
+_Mr. A_. Probably his nest was there, for herons build upon the
+loftiest trees they can find, and sometimes in society together like
+rooks. Formerly, when these birds were valued for the amusement of
+hawking, many gentlemen had their _heronries_, and a few are still
+remaining.
+
+_W_. I think they are the largest wild birds we have.
+
+_Mr. A_. They are of a great length and spread of wing, but their
+bodies are comparatively small.
+
+_W_. I then turned homeward across the meadows, where I stopped awhile
+to look at a large flock of starlings which kept flying about at no
+great distance. I could not tell at first what to make of them; for
+they rose all together from the ground as thick as a swarm of bees,
+and formed themselves into a kind of black cloud, hovering over the
+field. After taking a short round, they settled again, and presently
+rose again in the same manner, I dare say there were hundreds of them.
+
+_Mr. A_. Perhaps so; for in the fenny countries their flocks are so
+numerous as to break down whole acres of reeds by settling on them.
+This disposition of starlings to fly in close swarms was remarked even
+by Homer, who compares the foe flying from one of his heroes to a
+_cloud_ of starlings retiring dismayed at the approach of the hawk.
+
+_W_. After I had left the meadows, I crossed the cornfields and got to
+the high field next our house just as the sun was setting, and I stood
+looking at it till it was quite lost. What a glorious sight! The
+clouds were tinged with purple and crimson and yellow of all shades
+and hues, and the clear sky varied from blue to a fine green at the
+horizon. But how large the sun appears just as it sets! I think it
+seems twice as big as when it is overhead.
+
+_Mr. A_. It does so; and you may probably have observed the same
+apparent enlargement of the moon at its rising.
+
+_W_. I have; but pray what is the reason of this?
+
+_Mr. A_. It is an optical deception, depending upon principles which I
+cannot well explain to you till you know more of that branch of
+science. But what a number of new ideas this afternoon's walk has
+afforded you! I do not wonder that you found it amusing; It has been
+very instructive, too. Did _you_ see nothing of all these sights,
+Robert?
+
+_R_. I saw some of them, but I did not take particular notice of them.
+
+_Mr. A_. Why not?
+
+_R_. I don't know. I did not care about them, and I made the best of
+my way home.
+
+_Mr. A_. That would have been right if you had been sent of a message;
+but as you only walked for amusement it would have been wiser to have
+sought out as many sources of it as possible. But so it is--one man
+walks through the world with his eyes open, and another with them
+shut; and upon this difference depends all the superiority of
+knowledge the one acquires above the other. I have known sailors, who
+had been in all quarters of the world, and could tell you nothing but
+the signs of the tippling-houses they frequented in different ports,
+and the price and quality of the liquor. On the other hand, a Franklin
+could not cross the channel without making some observations useful to
+mankind. While many a vacant, thoughtless youth is whirled throughout
+Europe without gaining a single idea worth crossing a street for, the
+observing eye and inquiring mind find matter of improvement and
+delight in every ramble in town or country. Do _you_ then, William,
+continue to make use of your eyes; and _you_, Robert, learn that eyes
+were given you to use.
+
+
+
+
+PRINCE LIFE
+
+By G.P.R. JAMES
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+
+Once upon a time there was a young Prince who met with a very curious
+kind of misfortune. Most people want something which they cannot get;
+and because they cannot get it, they generally desire it more than
+anything else, which is very foolish, for it would be much better to
+be contented with what they have.
+
+He was a wise fox, my dear Charlie, who thought the grapes were sour
+when he could not reach them. Now the Prince's misfortune consisted in
+this, that he had everything on earth he could want or desire, and a
+little more. He had a fine palace and a fine country, obedient
+subjects and servants, and true friends. When he got up in the
+morning, there was some one ready to put on his clothes for him; when
+he went to bed at night, some one to take them off again. A fairy
+called Prosperity gave him everything he desired as soon as he desired
+it. If he wanted peaches at Christmas, or cool air at mid-summer, the
+first came instantly from his hothouses, and the second was produced
+by an enormous fan, which hung from the top of the room, and was moved
+by two servants.
+
+But strange to say, the Prince got weary of all this; he was tired of
+wanting nothing. When he sat down to dinner he had but little
+appetite, because he had had such a good breakfast; he hardly knew
+which coat to put on, they were all so beautiful; and when he went to
+bed at night, though the bed was as soft as a white cloud, he could
+not sleep, for he was not tired.
+
+There was only one ugly thing in the whole palace, which was a little,
+drowsy, gray dwarf, left there by the fairy Prosperity. He kept
+yawning all day, and very often set the Prince yawning, too, only to
+look at him. This dwarf they called Satiety, and he followed the
+Prince about wherever he went.
+
+One day the Prince asked him what he was yawning for, and Satiety
+answered:
+
+"Because I have nothing to do, and nothing to wish for, my Prince."
+
+"I suppose that is the reason why I yawn too," replied the Prince.
+
+"Rather is it having me always with you,".answered Satiety.
+
+"Then get away and leave me," said the Prince.
+
+"I cannot do that," answered Satiety. "You can go from me, but I
+cannot go from you; I can never leave you as long as you remain in the
+palace of Prosperity."
+
+"Then I will have you turned out," said the Prince.
+
+"No one can do that," said Satiety, "but Misfortune, and he is a very
+capricious person. Though he is a very disagreeable monster, some
+people seem to court him, but cannot get him to come near them; while
+to a great many he comes unawares, and catches them, though they fly
+from him eagerly. I tell you, Prince, you can go from me, but I cannot
+go from you as long as you remain in the palace of Prosperity."
+
+That night, when he went to his soft bed, the Prince thought very much
+as to the conversation he had held with Satiety, and he resolved to go
+out of the palace for a time, just to get rid of the ugly little gray,
+yawning dwarf.
+
+The very resolution seemed to do him good, and he slept better that
+night after he had made it than he had done for many a night before.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+
+The next morning when he rose he felt quite refreshed, and he said to
+a groom: "Bring me my stout horse, Expedition; I am going out to take
+a ride all alone."
+
+The groom answered not a word, for in that palace every one obeyed the
+Prince at once, and nobody troubled him but the ugly little dwarf,
+Satiety. As he went away, however, the groom said to himself with a
+sigh: "It is a sad thing to be in the wide world all alone. My Prince
+does not know what it is. But let him try; it may be better for him."
+
+He accordingly brought the horse to the palace-door. But when the
+Prince came down he felt quite well, and, looking about among all his
+attendants, he could only catch a distant glimpse of Satiety standing
+yawning behind. For a minute he was half inclined not to go, for he
+did not mind seeing Satiety at a distance if he did not come near. But
+the groom, whose name was Resolution, seeing him hesitate, said: "You
+had better go, my Prince, as you determined; it may do you good." And
+a chamberlain called Effort helped him on his horse.
+
+At first, as the Prince rode along, everything was quite delightful to
+him. He seemed to breathe more freely now that he was no more troubled
+with Satiety. The flowers looked bright, and the sky beautiful, for a
+cloud or two here and there only gave variety. The very air seemed
+fresher than it had been in the sheltered gardens of the palace, and
+the Prince said to himself: "What a delightful country this is, just
+on the verge of the land of Prosperity."
+
+Just then he saw a countryman gathering grapes in a vineyard, and
+every now and then putting some into his mouth, and the Prince asked
+him whose fine estate it was that he was passing through.
+
+"It belongs to a gentleman and lady equally, sir," replied the good
+man; "they are called Activity and Ease. They are the happiest couple
+ever seen. When Activity is tired, Ease takes his head upon her lap;
+and soon as she is weary of her burden, Activity jumps up and relieves
+her from it."
+
+"But to whom does that more barren country just beyond belong?" asked
+the Prince. "And what is that great thick wood I see farther on
+still?"
+
+"That is the land of Labor and the Forest of Adversity," said the man.
+"I would advise you to get through them as soon as possible, for the
+first you will find very wearisome, and the second exceedingly
+unpleasant, although people do say that there is a great deal of very
+good fruit in the forest; only one gets well-nigh torn to pieces with
+the thorns before one can reach it."
+
+The Prince determined to follow his advice, and rode on. There was not
+anything very tempting to him as he passed through the land of Labor,
+and it seemed a long and weary way from the beginning to the end of
+it. But the forest, even at its entrance, was very dark and gloomy
+indeed. Thick trees crossed each other overhead, and shut out the
+bright, cheerful daylight. He could hardly see his way along the
+narrow, tortuous paths, and the thorns which the peasant had spoken of
+ran into him continually, for they grew high as well as thick, and
+crossed the path in every direction. He began heartily to repent that
+he had quitted the palace of Prosperity, and wished himself back again
+with all his heart, thinking that he should care little about yawning
+Satiety if he could but get out of the thorns of Adversity. Indeed, he
+tried to turn his horse back; but he found it more difficult than he
+imagined, for, as I have told you, the road was very narrow and those
+thorns hedged it on every side. There was nothing for it, in short,
+but to try and force his way on through the wood, in the hope of
+finding something better beyond.
+
+The Prince did not know which way to take, indeed, and he tried a
+great number of paths, but in vain. Still there were the same thorns
+and the same gloomy darkness. He was hungry and thirsty, and he looked
+round for those fruits he had heard of; but he could see none of them
+at the time, and the more he sought his way out, the deeper he seemed
+to get into the forest. The air was very sultry and oppressive, too;
+he grew weary and faint, quite sick at heart, and even the limbs of
+his good horse seemed to be failing him, and hardly able to carry him
+on.
+
+Dark as it all was, it at length began to grow darker, and he
+perceived that night was coming, so that the poor Prince began to give
+up all hope, and to think that there would be nothing for him but to
+lie down and die in despair, when suddenly he caught a sort of
+twinkling light through the thick bushes, which seemed to lie in the
+way he was going, and on he went, slowly enough, poor man! But still
+the light was before him, till suddenly he came to a great rock,
+overgrown in many places with briers and brambles. In the midst of
+it, however, was the mouth of a large cave, with great masses of
+stone hanging over, as if ready to fall on a traveler's head. It was a
+very stern and gloomy looking place indeed, with clefts and crevices
+and ragged crags all around. But a few steps in the cave some one
+seemed to have built himself a house; for it was blocked up with
+large, unhewn boards of wood, and in this partition there was a door
+and a window, through which came the light he had seen. The Prince
+dismounted from his horse, and though he did not know who might be
+within, he thought it best to knock at the door, and ask for food and
+shelter.
+
+The moment he knocked a loud, hoarse voice cried: "Come in!" and tying
+his horse to a tree, he opened the door.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+
+Now, whatever the poor Prince had expected to find, he was certainly
+disappointed; for that thicket of Adversity is full of disappointments,
+as every one knows who has traveled through it. He had thought he
+should see some poor woodman or honest peasant, who would welcome him
+to his homely hut in the rock with kindness and benevolence; but
+instead of that he beheld, seated at the table, carving away at a
+piece of stick by the light of a very small twinkling candle, one of
+the most tremendous monsters ever man's eyes lighted upon. In shape he
+was like a man, but he was a great deal stronger than any man. His
+face looked as if it were cast in iron, so hard and rigid were all the
+features; and there was an ever-lasting frown planted on his brow. His
+hands were long and sinewy, with terrible sharp claws upon them; and
+his feet were so large and heavy that they seemed as if they would
+crush anything they would set upon to pieces.
+
+The poor Prince, though he was a very brave young man, stopped and
+hesitated at the sight of this giant; but the monster, without ever
+turning his head, cried out again: "Come in! Why do you pause? All men
+must obey me, and I am the only one that all men do obey."
+
+"You must be a mighty monarch, then," said the young Prince, taking
+courage, "Pray, what is your name?"
+
+"My name is Necessity," answered the other in his thundering voice;
+"and some people give me bad names, and call me 'Hard Necessity' and
+'Dire Necessity;' but, nevertheless, I often lead men to great things
+and teach them useful arts if they do but struggle with me valiantly."
+
+"Then I wish you would lead me to where I can get some rest," said the
+Prince, "and teach me how I can procure food for myself and my poor
+famishing horse."
+
+The monster rose up almost as tall as a steeple and suddenly laid his
+great clutches upon the Prince's shoulders, saying: "I will do both,
+if you do but wrestle with me courageously. You must do it, for there
+is no other way of escaping from my hands."
+
+The Prince had never been handled so roughly before, and as he was
+brave, strong, and active, he made a great effort to free himself, and
+tried a thousand ways, but to no purpose. The giant did not hurt him,
+however, though he pressed him very hard, and at length he cried out:
+"Ho, ho! you are a brave young man! Leave off struggling, and you
+shall have some food and drink, such as you would never have tasted
+had you not come to me."
+
+Thereupon he led him to his own coarse wooden table, and set before
+him half of a hard brown loaf and a pitcher of water; but so hungry
+and thirsty was the Prince that the bread seemed to him the best he
+had ever eaten, and the water sweeter than any in the world.
+
+"Unfasten your horse's bridle," said Necessity, when the Prince had
+done, "and I will soon teach him where to find something to feed
+upon."
+
+The Prince did as the giant told him at once, and then his
+stern-looking companion pointed to a wooden bedstead in a dark corner
+of the cave, which looked as hard as his own face, saying: "There, lie
+down and sleep."
+
+"I can never sleep on that thing," said the Prince.
+
+"Ho, ho!" cried the other; "Necessity can make any bed soft," and
+taking a bundle of straw, he threw it down on the bedstead.
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+
+Sleep was sweeter to the Prince that night than it had ever been upon
+a bed of down, and when he rose the next morning the monster's
+features did not seem half so stern and forbidding as they had done at
+first. The inside of the cave, too, looked much more light and
+blithesome, though it was a dark and frowning place enough still, with
+hard rock all round, and nothing but one window to let in a little
+sunshine.
+
+Necessity, however, did not intend to keep the Prince there, and as
+soon as he was up the giant said to him: "Come, trudge; you must quit
+my cave, and go on."
+
+"You must open the door for me, then," said the Prince; "for the bolt
+is so high up I cannot reach it."
+
+"You cannot get out by the door through which you came in," said the
+giant, "for it is the door of Idleness. There is but one way for you
+to get out, and that I will show you."
+
+So, taking him by the hand, he led him on into a very dark part of the
+cave, which went a long way under ground, and then said to him: "You
+must now go on until you come to a great house, where you will find an
+old woman, who will give you your meals at least."
+
+"But I want to return to my own palace of Prosperity," replied the
+Prince.
+
+"She will show you the way," replied the monster, "and without her you
+will never find it. Go on at once, and don't stand talking."
+
+"But I cannot see the path," said the Prince.
+
+"You must find it," said Necessity, and gave him a great push, which
+sent him on at a very rapid rate.
+
+For some time he continued to grope his way almost in darkness, but
+soon a light began to shine before him, which grew bigger and bigger
+as he advanced, and he perceived that he was coming to another mouth
+of the cave, leading to an open but very rough country. The Prince was
+very glad indeed to issue forth and breathe the fresh air, and he
+looked at the clear sky with great satisfaction. Just before him,
+however, there was a large house, with a great number of doors and
+windows; and as he felt very hungry, he determined to knock, and see
+if he could get any breakfast.
+
+Almost as soon as he had touched the knocker the door was opened by a
+little old woman, plainly dressed, but neat and tidy: and when the
+Prince told her who he was, and what he wanted, she answered him with
+a good-humored smile, very different from the frown of stern
+Necessity: "Every one can have food in my house who chooses to work
+for it; nobody without. I can help you on your way, too; and as for
+your poor horse you talk about, he shall be provided for. My name is
+Industry, and Industry always takes care of her beasts. Come in, young
+man; come in."
+
+The Prince went in with a glad step, and found the house quite full of
+people, all as busy as bees in a field of clover, and all looking as
+bright and cheerful as if they had washed their faces in sunshine.
+
+It would take me an hour to tell you all the different things they
+were employed in, every one working by himself on his separate task,
+although two or three were often seen doing different pieces of the
+same work. But there were two very nice, pretty girls there whom I
+must speak of, who seemed to be handmaidens to the mistress of the
+house. One was a thoughtful-looking, careful girl, who was busy in
+every part of the room alternately, picking up all the little odds and
+ends which were left after any piece of work was completed--little
+bits of string, ends of tape or thread, stray nails, chips of wood, or
+pieces of paper. These, as soon as she had gathered them up, she put
+safely by, where she could find them again; and it is wonderful how
+often she was called upon by the workmen for some little scrap or
+another, just sufficient to complete what they were about. Her name
+was Economy.
+
+The other was a brighter, quicker-looking person, with very clear
+eyes, like two stars, who went continually through the room, putting
+everything to rights. If a chair was out of its place, or a table
+turned awry, or a tool put down where it should not be, she could not
+bear to see it for a minute, but put all things straight again, so
+that nobody was at a loss where to find anything, She was called
+Order.
+
+The hungry Prince was somewhat mortified to find a good, large piece
+of work assigned him to do before he could get his breakfast, and at
+first he was exceedingly awkward, and did not know how to set about
+it; but Industry showed him the way, Order helped him a good deal, and
+Economy supplied him with the materials.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+
+At the end of an hour he had completed his task, and the old lady
+patted him on the shoulder, saying, "Well done; you are a very good
+young man. Now Industry will give you your breakfast, and help you on
+the way to a very nice place, where you will get all you desire."
+
+Thus saying, she led him into a great hall, where there was a vast
+number of people, all eating rich fruits, with a somewhat hard-favored
+dame, whom they called Labor, scattering sugar on the different
+dishes.
+
+When the Prince heard her name, he asked one of the people near if
+that was really Labor, saying, "I passed through her land not long
+ago, and it seemed so poor and hard a country that I should have
+thought it produced nothing good."
+
+"That is a mistake," said the other. "That is the land where grows the
+sugar-cane, and Labor always sweetens the food of Industry."
+
+As soon as his breakfast was over, the Prince was taken to another
+door, and shown a road which was very narrow at first, but seemed to
+grow wider and wider as it went on.
+
+"You have nothing to do but to walk straight forward," said Industry,
+"neither to turn to the right nor to the left. Keep yourself upright,
+so that you may have that distant mountain peak before your eyes, and
+don't suffer yourself to grow faint or get tired. If you should have
+any doubt or difficulty, you will find some one on the road who will
+show you the way. But only remember always to keep straight forward,
+and don't be tempted to turn aside."
+
+"What is the name of this road?" asked the Prince.
+
+"It is called the 'Right Path'" was the reply; and on he set upon his
+way with a stout heart. Nevertheless, he began to get somewhat tired
+before an hour was over, although the road was pleasant enough to walk
+in. There were beautiful green meadows on every side, and richly
+colored flowers, and what seemed very delicious fruit; and here and
+there, at a little distance, were pleasant groves, with a number of
+gay birds, singing very sweetly.
+
+At the end of an hour and a half the Prince became hungry and thirsty
+again, as well as tired, and he said to himself, "There could be no
+great harm surely in going across that meadow and gathering some of
+that fruit, to eat under the shade of the trees, while the birds sing
+over my head. I do not know how far I have to go. I see no end to this
+long, straight road. I think I will try and rest for a little under
+those trees. I can easily find my way back again."
+
+But just at that moment, luckily for himself, the Prince spied a man
+trudging on before him, and he hurried after, saying to himself, "I
+will ask him how far I have to go, and whether I have time to stop."
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+
+The man did not walk very fast, but he kept steadily on, with a great
+pikestaff in his hand; and though the Prince called after him as soon
+as he was within hearing, he did not halt for a moment, or even turn
+his head, but trudged onward, saying, "Come along, come along; one
+never gets to the end of one's journey if one stops to chatter by the
+way."
+
+At length the Prince came up with him, and said in a civil tone, "Pray
+can you tell me whither this road leads, and if it will be very long
+before I get to some house where I can find rest and food?"
+
+"It leads to a very fine and beautiful castle," replied the other
+somewhat doggedly, and still walking on. "I think, if you come along
+with me, you will get there in time. I am generally well received
+there, and in some sort may call myself the master of the house, so
+that those who go with me are generally made welcome by my lady, who,
+though she is sometimes a little whimsical, is the most charming
+person in the world when she smiles upon me. But you must keep on
+steadily with me; for if you stop or turn aside, a thousand to one you
+will be lost."
+
+When the Prince found him so communicative, he asked him if they could
+not cross one of the meadows to refresh themselves a little, and told
+him how he had been tempted to do so just before he saw him.
+
+"Lucky you did not," answered the other; "for those meadows are full
+of swamps and quagmires, the groves filled with snakes, and many of
+the fruits poisonous. You might have got yourself into such troubles
+that not even I could have helped you out of them."
+
+"If it is not improper, may I ask your name?" said the Prince.
+
+"Come along," answered the other, "Names matter little; but if you
+want to know mine, it is Perseverance."
+
+Not long after the Prince began to think he saw several tall towers
+glittering before him in the distance, with some misty clouds round
+about them, which only seemed to make them look the more beautiful.
+
+"What a fine castle!" he exclaimed.
+
+"That is where I am leading you," answered the other; "and the first
+prospect is always very charming. But we have some way to go yet, I
+can tell you, and not a little to overcome. You would never get there
+without me; so come on, and do not be daunted at anything you see."
+
+The Prince soon found that his companion's warning was just. The way
+did seem very long; and sometimes, as they went over hill and dale,
+the sight of the beautiful castle, which cheered him so much, was
+quite shut out from his eyes, and at length, when they were coming
+very near it, with nothing but one valley between them and the
+building, he perceived that the road went over a narrow drawbridge,
+and saw two terrible monsters lying close beside the way. Their bodies
+were like those of lions, very large and very strong, but they had
+necks like that of a snake, and from each neck issued a hundred
+horrible heads, all differing in kind from one another.
+
+The poor Prince was alarmed, and said to his companion: "Do you see
+those horrible brutes? Is there no other way into the castle but
+between them?"
+
+"There are a thousand ways into the castle," replied his companion,
+"but every way is guarded by monsters just like those. But do not be
+alarmed. Go on with me, and I will help you. Besides, some one will
+come out of the castle, most likely, to give us assistance."
+
+
+
+
+VII
+
+
+Upon these words, the Prince went on more cheerfully, especially when
+he saw a man come running down from the gate of the castle as they
+approached the drawbridge.
+
+"Ay," said his companion, stepping on without stopping a moment,
+"there comes my friend Courage to help us. He is a good, serviceable
+fellow."
+
+Just as he spoke, the two monsters sprang forward, and the one which
+was nearest to Perseverance growled terribly at him; but he struck him
+a blow with his pikestaff, which knocked him down and cowed him
+entirely; and there he lay, with all his hundred heads prostrated in a
+manner which the Prince could hardly have thought possible. The other
+brute sprang right at the Prince himself, as if to destroy him, so
+that he was inclined to draw back; but the man Courage, who had run
+down from the castle, put his foot upon the creature's snaky neck, and
+crushed it into the earth.
+
+"Go on, go on, young man!" he cried. "These are terrible monsters
+truly, but you see our friend Perseverance has vanquished Difficulty,
+and I have trampled upon Danger."
+
+As he spoke, the Prince passed on rapidly over the drawbridge; and
+when he stood under the gate of the castle, Perseverance took him by
+the hand with a smiling air, and led him in, saying: "Now I will
+conduct you to my lady, Success."
+
+At the very sound the poor Prince seemed quite refreshed, forgot all
+the weary way he had traveled, the dark forest of Adversity, the grim
+frown of Necessity, the faintness and the weariness, and
+hundred-headed Difficulty and Danger. But he was more rejoiced still
+when, on entering the building, he found himself suddenly, all at
+once, in the great hall of his own palace of Prosperity, with a
+beautiful lady, all smiles, standing ready to receive him with a crown
+in her hand.
+
+"Come hither, Prince," she said, "and receive this crown, which I
+never bestow on any but my greatest favorites. It is called the crown
+of Contentment. I reserve it for those who, led on by Perseverance,
+come to me by the Right Path, in spite of Difficulty and Danger. Those
+who arrive at my presence by any of the many other roads that are open
+to mankind I give over to the charge of some of my inferior
+attendants, such as Pride, Vanity, or Ambition, who amuse themselves
+by making them play all manner of strange tricks."
+
+Thus saying, she put the crown upon his head, and the Prince found the
+most delightful tranquil feeling spread through his whole body.
+Nevertheless, he could not help looking about almost instantly for the
+figure of the ugly little gray dwarf; and, as he could not see him
+anywhere, he said to the beautiful lady: "Where is that hideous,
+yawning Satiety? I hope he has left the palace."
+
+"He may be hanging about in some dark corners of the palace," answered
+the lady, "or hiding among the roses in your garden of Pleasure; but
+he will never appear in your presence again, so long as you wear that
+crown upon your head; for there is a rich jewel called Moderation in
+the crown of Contentment which is too bright and pure to be looked
+upon by Satiety."
+
+
+
+
+THE FRUITS OF DISOBEDIENCE
+
+OR THE KIDNAPPED CHILD
+
+
+In a beautiful villa on the banks of the Medway resided a gentleman
+whose name was Darnley, who had, during the early part of life, filled
+a post of some importance about the Court, and even in its decline
+preserved that elegance of manners which so peculiarly marks a
+finished gentleman.
+
+The loss of a beloved wife had given a pensive cast to his features,
+and a seriousness to his deportment, which many people imagined
+proceeded from haughtiness of disposition, yet nothing could be
+further from Mr. Darnley's character, for he was affable, gentle,
+benevolent, and humane.
+
+His family consisted of an only sister, who, like himself, had lost
+the object of her tenderest affection, but who, in dividing her
+attention between her brother and his amiable children, endeavored to
+forget her own misfortunes.
+
+Mr. Darnley's fortune was sufficiently great to enable him to place
+his daughters in the first school in London, but he preferred having
+them under his immediate instruction, and as Mrs. Collier offered to
+assist him in their education he resolved for some years not to engage
+a governess, as Nurse Chapman was one of those worthy creatures to
+whose care he could securely trust them.
+
+An old friend of Mr. Darnley's had recently bought a house at
+Rochester, and that gentleman and his sister were invited to pass a
+few days there, and as Emily grew rather too big for the nurse's
+management Mrs. Collier resolved to make her of the party, leaving
+Sophia, Amanda, and Eliza under that good woman's protection.
+
+It was Mr. Darnley's wish that the young folks should rise early and
+take a long walk every morning before breakfast, but they were
+strictly ordered never to go beyond their own grounds unless their
+aunt or father accompanied them. This order they had frequently
+endeavored to persuade Nurse Chapman to disregard, but, faithful to
+the trust reposed in her, she always resisted their urgent entreaties.
+
+The morning after Mr. Darnley went to Rochester the poor woman found
+herself thoroughly indisposed, and wholly incapable of rising at the
+accustomed hour. The children, however, were dressed for walking, and
+the nurse-maid charged not to go beyond the shrubbery, and they all
+sallied out in high good humor.
+
+"Now, Susan," said Sophia, as soon as they entered the garden, "this
+is the only opportunity you may ever have of obliging us. Do let us
+walk to the village, and then you know you can see your father and
+mother."
+
+"La, missy!" replied the girl, "why, you know 'tis as much as my place
+is worth if Nurse Chapman should find out."
+
+"Find it out indeed," said Amanda; "how do you think she is to find it
+out? Come, do let us go, there's a dear, good creature."
+
+"Yes, dear, dear Susan, do let us go," said Eliza, skipping on before
+them, "and I'll show you the way, for I walked there last summer with
+father."
+
+Whether it was the wish of obliging the young ladies, or the desire of
+seeing her parents, I cannot pretend to say, but in a luckless hour
+Susan yielded, and the party soon reached the village.
+
+Susan's mother was delighted at seeing her, and highly honored by the
+young ladies' presence.
+
+"Oh, sweet, dear creatures!" said the old woman, "I must get something
+for them to eat after their long walk, and my oven's quite hot, and I
+can bake them a little cake in a quarter of an hour, and I'll milk
+Jenny in ten minutes."
+
+The temptation of her hot cake and new milk was not to be withstood,
+and Susan began taking down some smart china cups, which were arranged
+in form upon the mantelpiece, and carefully dusted them for the young
+ladies' use.
+
+Eliza followed the old woman into the cow-house, and began asking a
+thousand questions, when her attention was suddenly attracted by the
+appearance of a tame lamb, who went up bleating to its mistress with
+a view of asking its accustomed breakfast.
+
+"You must wait a little, Billy," said the woman, "and let your betters
+be served before you. Don't you see that we have got gentlefolks to
+breakfast with us this morning?"
+
+Eliza was so delighted with the beauty of the little animal that she
+wanted to kiss it, and attempted to restrain it for that purpose,
+while Billy, ungrateful for her intended kindness, gave a sudden
+spring and frisked away.
+
+Eliza followed in hopes of being able to catch him, but he ran baaing
+along into the high road.
+
+A woman whose appearance was descriptive of poverty but whose smiling
+countenance indicated good nature, at that moment happened to pass,
+and, accosting Eliza in a tone of familiarity, said: "That's not half
+such a pretty lamb, miss, as I have got at home, and not a quarter so
+tame, for if you did but say, 'Bob' he'd follow you from one end of
+the town to the other, and then he'll fetch and carry like a dog,
+stand up on his hind legs, when my husband says 'Up' for the thing,
+and play more tricks than a young kitten."
+
+"Oh, the pretty creature," replied Eliza, "how I should like to see
+it!"
+
+"Well, come along with me, miss," said the woman, "for I only lives
+just across the next field, but you must run as hard as you can,
+because my husband is going to work, and he generally takes Bob with
+him."
+
+"Well, make haste, then," said Eliza.
+
+"Give me your hand, miss," replied the woman; "for we can run faster
+together. But there goes my husband, I declare; and there's Bob, as
+usual, skipping on before."
+
+"Where? where?" exclaimed Eliza, stretching her little neck as far as
+she possibly could, to see if she could discern the lamb.
+
+"You are not tall enough," said the artful creature; "but let me lift
+you up, miss, and then I dare say you will see them;" and, instantly
+catching her up, she cried out: "Look directly towards the steeple,
+miss; but I'll run with you in my arms, and I warrant we'll soon
+overtake them."
+
+Eliza looked, but looked in vain, and, perceiving the woman had soon
+carried her out of sight of the cottage, begged she would set her
+down, as she dare not go any farther.
+
+The vile creature was absolutely incapable of replying, for her breath
+was nearly exhausted by the rapidity of the motion, and Eliza
+continued entreating her to stop, and struggled violently to elude her
+grasp.
+
+At length, after a quarter of an hour's exertion, the woman found
+herself incapable of proceeding, and stopped suddenly, sat down on a
+bank, keeping tight hold of Eliza's arms, who cried dreadfully, and
+besought her to let her go.
+
+"Let you go!" she replied; "what, after all the plague I've had to
+knap you? No, no, you don't catch me at that, I promise you; but be a
+good girl, and don't cry, and then you may see Bob by and by,
+perhaps."
+
+"Oh, my sisters! my sisters! Let me go to my sisters!" cried the
+child.
+
+"I'll find plenty of sisters for you in a few days," said the vile
+creature; "but they won't know you in them there fine clothes; so
+let's pull them off in a minute, and then we'll have another run after
+Bob."
+
+So saying, she stripped off the white frock, hat, and tippet. The rest
+of the things shared the same fate, and Eliza was compelled to put on
+some old rags which the inhuman creature took out of a bag she carried
+under her petticoat; then, taking a bottle of liquid from the same
+place, she instantly began washing Eliza's face with it, and,
+notwithstanding all her remonstrances, cut her beautiful hair close to
+her head.
+
+Thus metamorphosed, it would have been impossible even for Mr. Darnley
+to have known his child, and they proceeded onward until her little
+legs would carry her no farther. At this period they were overtaken by
+the Canterbury wagon, and for a mere trifle the driver consented to
+let them ride to London. Eliza's tears continued to flow, but she
+dared not utter a complaint, as her inhuman companion protested she
+would break every bone in her skin if she ventured to make the least
+noise.
+
+When they arrived in town, she was dragged (for to walk she was
+unable) to a miserable hole down several steps, where they gave her
+some bread and butter to eat, and then desired her to go to bed.
+
+The bed, if such it might be called, was little else than a bundle of
+rags thrown into a corner of the room, with a dirty blanket spread
+across it; and there she was left by her inhuman kidnapper to mourn
+her misfortunes and lament having disregarded her fathers'
+injunctions.
+
+The next morning she was forced to rise the moment it was light, and
+to walk as far as her little legs would carry her before they stopped
+anywhere to take refreshment. The second night was passed in a barn,
+and about five o'clock the third afternoon they knocked at the door of
+a neat-looking cottage, where nine or ten children were sitting in a
+little room making lace.
+
+"Why, Peggy," said the woman, as she opened the door, "I thought you
+never would have come again! However, I see you have got me a hand at
+last, and God knows I'm enough in want of her; for two of my brats
+have thought proper to fall sick, and I have more to do than ever I
+had in my life."
+
+On the following day Eliza's filthy rags were all taken off, and she
+was dressed in a tidy brown-stuff gown, a nice clean round-eared cap,
+and a little colored bib and apron; and she was ordered, if any person
+asked her name, to say it was Biddy Bullen, and that she was niece to
+the woman who employed her.
+
+The severity with which all this wretch's commands were enforced
+wholly prevented any of the helpless victims who were under her
+protection from daring to disobey them; and though most of them were
+placed under her care by the same vile agent who had decoyed Eliza,
+yet they were all tutored to relate similar untruths.
+
+But I now think it is high time to carry my little readers back to the
+cottage scene, where Susan was arranging things in order for
+breakfast, and Sophia and her sister were anxiously watching the
+moment when the cake was pronounced completely ready.
+
+The old woman soon returned with the milk-pail on her arm, and Susan
+eagerly demanded: "Where's Miss Eliza?"
+
+"Oh, the pretty creature!" replied her mother, "she'll be here in a
+minute, I warrant her; but she has gone skipping after our Billy, and
+the two sweet innocents they are together."
+
+She then went to the oven, produced the cake, and began buttering it
+with all expedition, while Sophia joyously ran to the door of the
+cow-house, and began loudly calling her sister Eliza.
+
+No answer being returned, Susan began to feel alarmed, but the young
+ladies told her not to be frightened, as they knew it was only one of
+Eliza's pranks. But, alas! too soon were they convinced it was no
+joke, but some dreadful misfortune must have happened.
+
+"Miss Eliza! Miss Eliza!" was vociferated through the village, not
+only by Susan and her mother, but by all the neighbors who had heard
+of the calamity, while her sisters ran about frantic with grief,
+crying, "Eliza, my love! my darling! Oh, if you are hid, for pity's
+sake speak!"
+
+Nurse Chapman got up about half-past nine, and, hearing the children
+were not returned from their walk, sent the housemaid directly after
+them.
+
+The garden, the shrubbery, and the lawn were all searched without
+success; and just as Betty was returning to inform the nurse they were
+not to be found, she perceived Susan and the two children enter a
+little green gate at the bottom of the shrubbery.
+
+"Where's Miss Eliza?" called Betty, in a voice as loud as she could
+articulate.
+
+"God knows! God knows!" replied the careless girl, sobbing so loud she
+could scarcely speak.
+
+"How! where! when!" said the others. "Why, poor nurse will go stark,
+staring mad!"
+
+By that time the poor woman had quitted her room, and walked into the
+garden to see what had become of her little charges; and, not directly
+missing Eliza from the group, which was then fast approaching towards
+the house, she called out:
+
+"Come, my dear children--come along! I thought you would never have
+returned again." And, observing Eliza was not with them, she
+continued: "But, Susan, what's become of my sweet bird? Where's my
+little darling, Miss Eliza?"
+
+"Oh, nurse! nurse!" said Sophia, "my sister's lost! indeed she's
+lost!"
+
+"Lost!" exclaimed the poor old woman--"lost! What do you tell me? What
+do I hear? Oh, my master! my dear master! never shall I bear to see
+his face again!"
+
+Susan then repeated every circumstance just as has been related, and
+with sighs and tears bewailed her own folly in suffering herself to be
+over-persuaded. And the children declared they dare not encounter
+their father's displeasure.
+
+The men servants were instantly summoned and sent on horseback
+different ways. That she had been stolen admitted of no doubt, as
+there was no water near the cottage; and had any accident happened,
+they must have found her, as they had searched every part of the
+village before they ventured to return home.
+
+One servant was sent to Rochester, another towards London, and a third
+and fourth across the country roads; but no intelligence could be
+obtained, nor the slightest information gathered, by which the
+unfortunate child could be found, or her wicked decoyer's footsteps
+traced.
+
+When Mr. Darnley was apprised of the calamitous event, the agitation
+of his mind may be easily conceived, but can never be described.
+
+Handbills were instantly circulated all over the country, the child's
+person described, and a reward of five hundred guineas offered for her
+restoration.
+
+Sophia and Amanda were inconsolable, and Susan was ordered to be
+discharged before Mr. Darnley returned home, which he did not for more
+than a month after the melancholy circumstance happened, as he was not
+satisfied with sending messengers in pursuit of his lost treasure, but
+went himself to all those wretched parts of London where poverty and
+vice are known to dwell, in the hope of meeting the object of his
+solicitude, and at length gave up the interesting pursuit, because he
+found his health rendered him incapable of continuing it.
+
+Nine tedious months passed away without any intelligence of the lost
+Eliza; and time, which is a general remedy for all misfortunes, had
+not softened the severity of their affliction. Mrs. Collier had
+engaged a lady to be governess to her nieces, as her attention had
+been wholly devoted to her unfortunate brother, whose agitated state
+of mind had produced a bodily complaint which demanded her unremitting
+care and tenderness.
+
+Although Emily loved Eliza with the fondest affection, yet her grief
+was much less poignant than either of her sisters', as she could not
+accuse herself with being accessory to her loss.
+
+"Never, never shall I forgive myself," Sophia would often say, "for
+having deviated from my dear father's command! Oh, so good and
+indulgent as he is to us, how wicked it was to transgress his will! I
+was the eldest, and ought to have known better, and my poor Eliza is
+the sufferer for my crime!"
+
+Thus would she bewail her folly and imprudence, until, agonized by the
+torture of her own reflections, she would sink down in a chair quite
+exhausted, and burst into a flood of tears.
+
+While the family at Darnley Hall were thus a prey to unavailing
+sorrow, the lovely little girl who had occasioned it was beginning to
+grow more reconciled to the cruelty of her destiny, and to support her
+different mode of life with resignation and composure. She had
+acquired such a degree of skill in the art of lacemaking (which was
+the business her employer followed) as generally to be able to perform
+the tasks which were allotted her; and if it so happened she was
+incapable of doing it, Sally Butchell, a child almost two years older
+than herself, of whom she was very fond, was always kind enough to
+complete it for her.
+
+The cottage in which the vile Mrs. Bullen resided was situated about a
+quarter of a mile from High Wycombe; and whenever she was obliged to
+go to that place, either to purchase or to dispose of her goods, she
+always went either before her family were up, or after they had
+retired to rest, locking the door constantly after her, and putting
+the key in her pocket, so that the poor little souls had no
+opportunity of telling their misfortunes to any human creature.
+
+One intense hot afternoon, in the month of August, as the children
+were sitting hard at work with the door open for the sake of air, an
+elderly lady and gentleman walked up to it, and begged to be
+accommodated with a seat, informing Mrs. Bullen their carriage had
+broken down a mile distant, and they had been obliged to walk in the
+heat of the sun.
+
+The appearance of so many children, all industriously employed, was a
+sight particularly pleasing to the liberal-minded Mrs. Montague, and
+she immediately began asking the woman several questions about them;
+but there was something of confusion in her manner of replying that
+called forth Mrs. Montague's surprise and astonishment.
+
+"They really are lovely children, my dear," said she, turning to Mr.
+Montague, who had stood at the door watching the approach of the
+carriage, which he perceived coming forward; "and as to that little
+creature with the mole under her left eye, I declare I think it is a
+perfect beauty."
+
+Mr. Montague turned his head, and regarded Eliza with a look that at
+once proved that his sentiments corresponded with those of his lady.
+
+"What is your name, my love?" said he, in a tone of kindness which
+poor Eliza had long been a stranger to.
+
+The child colored like scarlet, and looked immediately at her inhuman
+employer, who, catching the contagion, replied with evident marks of
+confusion:
+
+"Her name is Biddy Bullen, sir; she's my niece; but 'tis a poor timid
+little fool, and is always in a fright when gentlefolks happen to
+speak to her. Go, Biddy," she continued--"go up into my bedroom, and
+mind that thread which you'll find upon the reel."
+
+"You should try to conquer that timidity," said Mr. Montague, "by
+making her answer every stranger who speaks to her; but by taking that
+office upon yourself, you absolutely encourage the shyness you
+complain of. Come hither, my little girl," continued he, observing she
+was retiring upstairs, "and tell the lady what your name is."
+
+Encouraged by the kindness of Mr. Montague's address, the agitated
+child obeyed the summons, although Mrs. Bullen attempted to force her
+into resistance.
+
+"Well," continued the old gentleman, patting her on the cheek, "and
+where did you get that pretty mole?"
+
+"My mother gave it me, sir," replied the blushing child; "but I did
+not see her do it, because Nurse Chapman told me she went to heaven as
+soon as I was born."
+
+"Your mother! And what was your mother's name?" said Mr. Montague.
+
+"Darnley, sir," said the child, and suddenly recollecting the lesson
+that had been taught her--"but my name is Biddy Bullen, and that is my
+aunt."
+
+"Darnley!" exclaimed Mrs. Montague--"the very child that has been for
+these twelve months past advertised in all the papers"--then turning
+to convince herself of the fact--"and the very mole confirms it."
+
+Mr. Montague immediately attempted to secure the woman, but her
+activity eluded his grasp, and darting out at the back door she was
+out of sight in a few moments.
+
+"Is she really gone? Is she gone?" all the little voices at once
+demanded, and upon Mr. Montague's assuring them she was really gone
+for ever, their joy broke out in a thousand different ways--some
+cried, some laughed, and others jumped. In short, there never was a
+scene more completely calculated to interest the feelings of a
+benevolent heart.
+
+Mr. Montague's carriage at this period arrived, and the footman was
+desired to fetch a magistrate from Wycombe, while the worthy clergyman
+resolved to remain there until his arrival, and began questioning all
+the children. Two had been there from so early a period that they
+could give no account of their name or origin, but all the rest were
+so clear in their description that the benevolent Mr. Montague had no
+doubt of being able to restore them to their afflicted parents.
+
+The magistrate soon arrived, attended by the worthy rector of the
+place, who, hearing from Mr. Montague's servant that a child had been
+stolen, came with the intent of offering his services.
+
+All but Eliza were immediately put under his protection, but Mrs.
+Montague was so anxious she should be their earliest care that she
+begged her husband to order a post-chaise directly, and set off
+immediately for town. This request was willingly complied with, and by
+three o'clock the next afternoon the party arrived at Darnley Hall.
+
+Mrs. Collier was standing at the window when the carriage stopped, and
+looking earnestly at her niece suddenly exclaimed in a tone of
+rapture: "My child! My child! My lost Eliza!"
+
+Mr. Darnley, who was reading, sprang from his seat, and flew to the
+door in a ecstasy of joy. In less than a minute he returned folding
+his Eliza to his throbbing heart. The joyful intelligence ran through
+the house, and the other children impatiently flew to this scene of
+transport.
+
+To describe their feelings or express their felicity would require the
+aid of the most descriptive pen, and even then would be but faintly
+told, and therefore had much better be passed over.
+
+From that moment the children all unanimously agreed strictly to
+attend to their father's orders, and never in the slightest instance
+act in opposition to his will.
+
+Mr. and Mrs. Montague were laden with caresses, and earnestly
+entreated to remain Mr. Darnley's guests. The hospitable invitation
+would have been gladly accepted had not the thoughts of the poor
+children who were still at Wycombe seemed to claim his immediate
+attention, and so great was the philanthropy of Mr. Montague's
+character that he could never rest satisfied if a single duty remained
+unfulfilled.
+
+
+
+
+DICKY RANDOM
+
+OR GOOD NATURE IS NOTHING WITHOUT GOOD CONDUCT
+
+
+ "In festive play this maxim prize--
+ Be always merry--always WISE!"
+
+"Do you know what hour it is when you see a clock?" said Mr. Random to
+his little son Richard.
+
+"Yes, father," said Richard; "for I can count it all round. When both
+hands are at the top of the clock, then I know it is time to leave
+school."
+
+"Then go and see what time it is," said his father.
+
+Away ran Richard, and brought back word in a moment that it was
+exactly six o'clock.
+
+In a few minutes after came in a friend with a young lady, the former
+of whom asked Mr. Random why he was not ready to go with them to the
+concert that evening, as he had promised. Mr. Random replied that it
+was but six o'clock, which, however, he was soon convinced was a
+mistake of Richard's, who, on being asked what he saw when he looked
+on the clock, replied, "I saw the two hands together close to the six,
+and that made me say it was six, for I always call it twelve when they
+are right opposite."
+
+"Remember, my dear," said his father, "that the long hand never tells
+the hour, except on the stroke of twelve. You ought to know that the
+minute hand overtakes its fellow somewhat later every hour, till at
+noon and midnight they again start exactly even; and when a bigger boy
+I shall expect you to tell me how much difference is increased every
+time they come into conjunction. You now see, Dicky, that through such
+a mistake I must make my friends wait; pray, therefore, mind better
+another time."
+
+In a few minutes after his father bid him go into the dining-room, and
+bring down a bottle of wine, which stood in the _hither_ corner of
+the cellaret, that he might help the gentleman, and lady to a glass.
+
+"Yes, father," said little Dick, and up he went. On the stairs he met
+puss, and stopped to play with her, during which he forgot what had
+been told him. Having gotten a bottle, downstairs he came, and,
+pouring out a couple of glasses, he returned with it. But, when on the
+landing-place, he naughtily drew out the cork to have a taste himself.
+It was not only very vulgar to drink out of the neck of a bottle, but
+wrong to make free slily with that which he was merely entrusted to
+serve out. However, it rushed so fast into his mouth, and was so hot,
+that he was afraid of being strangled. It happened that he had bitten
+his cheek that morning, and the liquor bathing the sore place made it
+smart so that he put down the bottle on the floor, when, in stamping
+about, it rolled downstairs and made a fine clatter. His father ran
+out on hearing the noise, but was stopped in the way by seeing the
+young lady almost gasping for breath, and it was some minutes before
+she could say that he had given her brandy instead of wine.
+
+Mr. Random next proceeded upstairs, where little Dick was picking up
+the pieces of broken glass, in doing which he cut a deep gash in his
+hand.
+
+"Where did you take the bottle from?"
+
+"Out of the _farther_ side of the cellaret," said Dicky.
+
+"I told you to take it from the _hither_ side," replied Mr. Random.
+"But, however, you shall smart for your neglect: what remains of the
+brandy will serve to bathe your hand, and I hope the pain will make
+you reflect that the loss is the same to me, whether you spilt it from
+design or inattention."
+
+He one day made his mother look very simple at table, for which he
+deserved to have suffered much more than her good nature required.
+Young Random was to have a grand rout in the evening with some of his
+little favorites. A few nice tarts, custards, etc., had been made in
+the morning for the occasion, and had been most temptingly baked in
+the forenoon.
+
+It happened that two gentlemen called on Mr. Random about two o'clock,
+and he insisted upon their staying to dinner; in consequence of which
+his lady had the pastry removed from the side board to the
+china-closet.
+
+All children must frequently have heard their mothers say, when they
+wish to have anything saved for another occasion, "My friends, you see
+your dinner before you; I hope you will consider yourselves at home
+and not spare." This is always thought to be a sufficient excuse for
+not bringing anything of another sort to table.
+
+When the meat was nearly done with, Mrs. Random made the above remark
+to her visitors, who declared that nothing more was requisite. She
+then bid the servant put the cheese on the table.
+
+"What, mother," said Richard, "is there nothing else?"
+
+"No, my love," said his mother; "I am sure you want nothing more."
+
+"Why, yes, mother. Where are the tarts and custards you put into the
+closet?"
+
+"Surely you dream?" said his mother.
+
+"No, I don't indeed," replied Dicky. "You put them away directly the
+gentlemen said they would stay to dine, and observed what a deal of
+trouble visitors do give."
+
+Any one will easily believe that this made Mrs. Random look very
+confused. She hardly knew what to reply, but she turned it off in the
+best manner she could, and said:
+
+"It is you, Richard, who trouble me more than the visits of my
+friends. I am happy to see them always, but on some days more than
+others. To-day, you know, we have been preparing for _your_ company,
+and therefore the reserve I have kept would not have been made but on
+your account. The pastry was intended for _your_ visitors, and not
+your father's. However, if you are such a child that you cannot wait
+till night, they shall be brought to table now; but, remember, I will
+not order any more to be made, and you shall provide for your
+playmates out of the money put by to purchase the magic-lantern and
+the books."
+
+Richard looked quite down when he heard this sentence, and more so
+when he saw the pastry placed on the table.
+
+Dear me, how soon had the tarts and custards disappeared, if one of
+each had been served round to the company! But the gentlemen were too
+polite even to taste them, and father and mother declined eating any.
+Richard's sister said she could very well wait till supper; hence they
+were all saved. But Dicky was afterwards very severely taken to task
+for speaking out of time, when he was not spoken to.
+
+When evening came, and the little visitors were assembled, Richard,
+who had seen some of the sports at a country fair, would show his
+dexterity to amuse his young party. He took up the poker, and,
+supposing it to be a pole, performed some imitations. But, unable long
+to preserve it upright from its weight, the sooty end fell on Master
+Snapper's book, who was reading a little work upon "Affability." The
+blow fairly knocked it out of his hand, and made a great smear on his
+frilled shirt, at which a loud laugh ensued. Now Master Snapper could
+not bear to be laughed at, and was so much out of humor all the
+evening that he would not play.
+
+Little Dick never once, all this time, thought that if it had fallen
+on his playfellow's toe, it might have lamed him, and he would at
+least have had to carry him a pick-a-back home; nor did he think who
+was to have paid the doctor; but, pleased with the mirth he had made,
+he went upstairs and fetched down one of the pistols, which his father
+kept in a private drawer. Then, pulling in his rocking-horse, he
+fancied he was one of the Light Horse, and mounted it to show the
+sword exercise, and how he could shoot a Frenchman or a Turk at full
+gallop. He had no business with a rocking-horse or a pistol among
+young ladies, but he never thought if it were proper or not, and much
+less if the pistol were loaded.
+
+While he was going on a full canter, he gave the words, "Present!
+fire!" and off it went, knocked him backwards, and shivered a
+beautiful mirror into a thousand pieces. Oh, what a sad scene of
+confusion ensued! Some of the young ladies screamed out with fright.
+Miss Timid, knocked down by Dicky in falling backwards, lay on the
+ground bleeding at the nose. Some were employed in picking up the
+pieces of glass, or pinning their handkerchiefs over the fracture, to
+prevent its being seen while they stayed; but such a hope was vain.
+
+The noise brought Mr. and Mrs. Random and all the servants upstairs,
+who too soon found out the havoc that had been made, and demanded how
+it happened. All the children would willingly have screened Dicky,
+because they knew he had not done it to frighten, but to amuse them.
+Master Snapper, however, now thinking it was his turn, in a very
+ill-natured speech made the worst of the story. But the spiteful way
+in which he spoke did little Dick no harm, as he seemed more rejoiced
+at his misfortune than sorry for Mr. Random's loss; hence it had the
+effect not to increase the latter's anger.
+
+"Playing with balancing poles and pistols," said Mr. Random in a stern
+accent to his son, "is very well in a proper place, but quite
+inadmissible in a room full of company. Now, sir, what business had
+you to take this pistol out of my room?"
+
+"Indeed, father," said Dicky, crying, "I did not know it was loaded."
+
+"It is but last week," continued his father, "that you were told never
+to take such a thing without asking, and not even then till some one
+had tried if it were loaded. So many accidents have happened with
+firearms which have been supposed not to be loaded, that he who
+unguardedly shoots another ought to take a similar chance for his own
+life; for you know the Scripture says: 'An eye for an eye, and a tooth
+for a tooth.' Think, Richard, that if I had been standing before the
+mirror, what would have been the consequence. You would have shot your
+father! Your mother would have died of grief, and you and Letitia have
+been orphans!"
+
+"Ah, then I should have died too!" said Dicky, wiping the tears from
+his eyes with the back of his hand. "But how came you to load the
+pistol last night, father?"
+
+"Because," replied his father, "I thought I heard something fall in
+the parlor, and the passage-door being directly after shut to in a
+still manner. I loaded the pistols, thinking that thieves had broken
+into the house, and pushed up the sash to shoot the first that came
+out."
+
+"Then it was lucky," said Richard, "I did not come out again, or you
+might have killed me; for I got up in the night to let Juno out of the
+shed, where I had tied her up, and she was making a sad howling.
+Indeed, before I was aware, she ran into the parlor, and, as it was
+quite dark, I tumbled over her."
+
+"And broke the geranium tree," added his father.
+
+"Yes, I did indeed," said Dicky, "but I did not go to do it. After
+that I turned Juno into the yard, and this I dare say is all the noise
+you heard."
+
+"There is an old saying, my dear little friends," said Mr. Random,
+"which I wish you to attend to, because it has a great deal of truth
+in it: '_The pitcher that goes often safe to the well may come home
+broken at last_.' And so, though the thoughtless and giddy may go on
+for a long while without danger, it will overtake them sooner or
+later. Here is a strong instance of escape from the consequences which
+might have attended Richard's thoughtlessness; besides which, his
+mother could get no more sleep all night, and I, after running the
+risk of catching cold in searching over the house, have this morning
+been at the expense of new fastenings to the doors and windows. The
+next time, however, you rise, Richard, to alarm the family, you shall
+in future roost with the hens or bed in the stable."
+
+Dicky now thought that his parent's resentment had subsided, and, upon
+the latter's calling to him to come, he sprang across the room with
+the greatest alertness; but how suddenly was his smile cast down when
+Mr, Random, taking his hand, ordered him to wish his young friends
+much mirth and a good appetite, while he was going to be punished for
+his misconduct. At once were all their little hands put out to prevent
+Mr. Random's resolution of taking him away, but all their petitions
+were in vain. Richard was forced into an empty cellar, and left with
+no other companion than a glimmering rushlight. Here he was told he
+might do as much mischief as he pleased. The iron bars kept him from
+getting out on one side, and the door was padlocked on the other. In
+this dilemma he marched round and round, crying, with his little
+candle, and saw stuck on the walls the following lines:
+
+ "Empty caves and commons wild
+ Best befit a thoughtless child,
+ A solid wall, an earthen floor,
+ Prison lights, a padlock'd door,
+ Where's no plaything which he may
+ Turn to harm by random play,
+ For in such sport too oft is found
+ A penny-toy will cost a pound.
+ Be wise and merry;---play, but think;
+ For danger stands on folly's brink."
+
+After having been kept in confinement nearly half an hour, Mr. Random
+could no longer resist the pressing solicitations of his son's guests,
+who declined partaking of the supper till Richard was returned to
+them.
+
+Having learned the above lines by heart, he repeated them to his young
+company, and, on his promising to remember their contents, he was
+permitted to sit down to table.
+
+The rest of the evening was spent in innocent cheerfulness, and for
+some time after little Random played with more caution.
+
+We must omit many of the less important neglects of young Random, such
+as letting the toast fall in handling it, shooting his arrow through
+the window, riding a long stick where it might throw persons down,
+leaving things in the way at dark, etc., and proceed to relate a
+good-natured fancy of his which tended more than any of the preceding
+events, to show him the folly of taking any step without first looking
+to what it might lead.
+
+In Mr. Random's garden was a fine tall pear-tree, and that year a very
+fine pear grew on the topmost twig. His mother and sister had several
+times wished for the luscious fruit, but it seemed to bid defiance to
+every attack that was not aided by a tall ladder. "Oh!" thought Dicky,
+"if I can get it down and present it to my mother, how pleased she
+will be!" So, when he was alone, he picked out some large stones and
+threw at it, but without any success. The next day he renewed his
+attack in the evening, and to insure a better chance employed several
+large pieces of brick and tile.
+
+Now all these dangerous weapons went over into a poor man's garden,
+where his son and some other boys were weeding it. One of them fell
+upon the little fellow's leg, and cut it in so desperate a manner that
+he cried out, quite terrified at the blow and sight of the blood. The
+other boys directly took the alarm, and picking up some stones as
+large as that which had done the mischief, they mounted on a high
+bench, and discharged such a well-directed volley at the person of
+Master Random that he was most violently struck upon the nose, and
+knocked backwards into a glass cucumber-frame.
+
+Here he lay in a most pitiable condition, calling upon his mother,
+while the wounded boy on the other side joined in the concert of woe.
+
+"Oh, it served you rightly!" exclaimed the young assailants, who were
+looking over the wall, and ran away as soon as they saw Mr. Random
+come into the garden to inquire the cause of the uproar.
+
+His first concern was to carry Dicky indoors, and then, having wiped
+away the blood and tears, he asked him how it happened.
+
+"I was only trying to get a pear for my mother," said Richard, "when
+these boys threw stones at me, and hit me!"
+
+"That was very cruel," said his father, "to meddle with you when you
+were doing nothing to them, and if I can find them out they shall be
+punished for it."
+
+Mr. Random immediately set off to the next house, but was met at his
+own door by the father of the wounded boy, who was coming with him in
+his arms to demand satisfaction. This brought the whole truth out, and
+the artful little fellow was found to have concealed a part of the
+real case. Instead of saying "he was only getting a pear," he should
+have said that he was throwing large stones at the topmost pear on the
+tree, and that every stone went over the wall, he could not tell
+where.
+
+"Ah, Richard," said his father, "it is little better than
+story-telling to conceal a part of the truth. The affair now wears
+quite a new face. It was you that gave the first assault, and will
+have to answer for all the bad consequences. It is my duty to see that
+this unoffending boy is taken care of; but if his leg be so cut or
+bruised that he cannot get so good a living when he comes to be a man
+as he might otherwise have done, how would you like to make up the
+deficiency? You cannot doubt that he has a demand upon you equal to
+the damage you may have done to him. He is poor, and his father must
+send him to the hospital, but it would be unjust of me to suffer it.
+No, on the contrary, I shall prevent this by taking him home and
+sending you there, where Dr. Hardheart makes his patients smart before
+he cures them. Come, get ready to go, for delays in wounds of the head
+are not to be trifled with."
+
+Mr. Random then ordered the servant to go for a coach, in which Dicky
+most certainly would have been sent off had not word been brought back
+that there was not a coach on the stand. During this time Dicky had
+fallen on his knees, entreating that he might remain at home, and
+offering promises to be less heedless in future; nay, he was willing
+to yield up all his toys to the maimed little gardener.
+
+The boy's father, though but a laboring man, had a generous mind; he
+wanted nothing of this kind, but only wished him to be more cautious
+in future, as the same stones, thrown at random, might have either
+blinded his son or fractured his skull, instead of merely hurting his
+leg. Mr. Random then insisted on Richard's giving him half-a-crown,
+and asking pardon for the misfortune occasioned by his carelessness.
+
+This heavy sum was directly taken out of the hoard which had been laid
+by for the purchase of a set of drawing instruments, but he had a yet
+heavier account to settle with his father for damaging the
+cucumber-frame. He had broken as much of it as would come to fifteen
+shillings to mend, and as payment was insisted on, or close
+confinement until the whole was settled, he was compelled to transfer
+to his father all his receipts for the ensuing five months before he
+could again resume his scheme of laying by an adequate sum to purchase
+the drawing utensils. Independently of which he always carried a
+strong memorial of his folly on his nose, which was so scarred that he
+endured many a joke, as it were, to keep alive in his memory the
+effect of his folly. Indeed, he never looked in the glass without
+seeing his reproach in his face, and thus at length learned never to
+play without first thinking if it were at a proper time and in a
+proper place.
+
+
+
+
+EMBELLISHMENT
+
+By JACOB ABBOTT
+
+
+One day Beechnut, who had been ill, was taken by Phonny and Madeline
+for a drive. When Phonny and Madeline found themselves riding quietly
+along in the wagon in Beechnut's company, the first thought which
+occurred to them, after the interest and excitement awakened by the
+setting out had passed in some measure away, was that they would ask
+him to tell them a story. This was a request which they almost always
+made in similar circumstances. In all their rides and rambles
+Beechnut's stories were an unfailing resource, furnishing them with an
+inexhaustible fund of amusement sometimes, and sometimes of
+instruction.
+
+"Well," said Beechnut, in answer to their request, "I will tell you
+now about my voyage across the Atlantic Ocean."
+
+"Yes," exclaimed Madeline, "I should like to hear about that very much
+indeed."
+
+"Shall I tell the story to you just as it was," asked Beechnut, "as a
+sober matter of fact, or shall I embellish it a little?"
+
+"I don't know what you mean by embellishing it," said Madeline.
+
+"Why, not telling exactly what is true," said Beechnut, "but inventing
+something to add to it, to make it interesting."
+
+"I want to have it true," said Madeline, "and interesting, too."
+
+"But sometimes," replied Beechnut, "interesting things don't happen,
+and in such cases, if we should only relate what actually does happen,
+the story would be likely to be dull."
+
+"I think you had better embellish the story a little," said
+Phonny--"just a _little_, you know."
+
+"I don't think I can do that very well," replied Beechnut. "If I
+attempt to relate the actual acts, I depend simply on my memory, and I
+can confine myself to what my memory teaches; but if I undertake to
+follow my invention, I must go wherever it leads me."
+
+"Well," said Phonny, "I think you had better embellish the story, at
+any rate, for I want it to be interesting."
+
+"So do I," said Madeline.
+
+"Then," said Beechnut, "I will give you an embellished account of my
+voyage across the Atlantic. But, in the first place, I must tell you
+how it happened that my father decided to leave Paris and come to
+America. It was mainly on my account. My father was well enough
+contented with his situation so far as he himself was concerned, and
+he was able to save a large part of his salary, so as to lay up a
+considerable sum of money every year; but he was anxious about me.
+
+"There seemed to be nothing," continued Beechnut, "for me to do, and
+nothing desirable for me to look forward to, when I should become a
+man. My father thought, therefore, that, though it would perhaps be
+better for _him_ to remain in France, It would probably be better for
+_me_ if he should come to America, where he said people might rise in
+the world, according to their talents, thrift, and industry. He was
+sure, he said, that I should rise, for, you must understand, he
+considered me an extraordinary boy."
+
+"Well," said Phonny, "_I_ think you were an extraordinary boy."
+
+"Yes, but my father thought," rejoined Beechnut, "that I was something
+very extraordinary indeed. He thought I was a genius."
+
+"So do I," said Phonny.
+
+"He said," continued Beechnut, "he thought it would in the end be a
+great deal better for him to come to America, where I might become a
+man of some consequence in the world, and he said that he should enjoy
+his own old age a great deal better, even in a strange land, if he
+could see me going on prosperously in life, than to remain all his
+days in that porter's lodge.
+
+"All the money that my father had saved," Beechnut continued, "he got
+changed into gold at an office in the Bouleyard; but then he was very
+much perplexed to decide how it was best to carry it."
+
+"Why did he not pack it up in his chest?" asked Phonny.
+
+"He was afraid," replied Beechnut, "that his chest might be broken
+open, or unlocked by false keys, on the voyage, and that the money
+might be thus stolen away; so he thought that he would try to hide it
+somewhere in some small thing that he could keep with him all the
+voyage."
+
+"Could not he keep his chest with him all the voyage?" asked Phonny.
+
+"No," said Beechnut; "the chests, and all large parcels of baggage
+belonging to the passengers, must be sent down into the hold of the
+ship out of the way. It is only a very little baggage that the people
+are allowed to keep with them between the decks. My father wished very
+much to keep his gold with him, and yet he was afraid to keep it in a
+bag, or in any other similar package, in his little trunk, for then
+whoever saw it would know that it was gold, and so perhaps form some
+plan to rob him of it.
+
+"While we were considering what plan it would be best to adopt for the
+gold, Arielle, who was the daughter of a friend of ours, proposed to
+hide it in my _top_. I had a very large top which my father had made
+for me. It was painted yellow outside, with four stripes of bright
+blue passing down over it from the stem to the point. When the top was
+in motion, both the yellow ground and the blue stripes entirely
+disappeared, and the top appeared to be of a uniform green color.
+Then, when it came to its rest again, the original colors would
+reappear."
+
+"How curious!" said Madeline. "Why would it do so?" "Why, when it was
+revolving," said Beechnut, "the yellow and the blue were blended
+together in the eye, and that made green. Yellow and blue always make
+green. Arielle colored my top, after my father had made it, and then
+my father varnished it over the colors, and that fixed them.
+
+"This top of mine was a monstrous large one, and being hollow, Arielle
+thought that the gold could all be put inside. She said she thought
+that that would be a very safe hiding-place, too, since nobody would
+think of looking into a top for gold. But my father said that he
+thought that the space would not be quite large enough, and then if
+anybody should happen to see the top, and should touch it, the weight
+of it would immediately reveal the secret.
+
+"At last my father thought of a plan which he believed would answer
+the purpose very perfectly. We had a very curious old clock. It was
+made by my grandfather, who was a clockmaker in Geneva. There was a
+little door in the face of the clock, and whenever the time came for
+striking the hours, this door would open, and a little platform would
+come out with a tree upon it. There was a beautiful little bird upon
+the tree, and when the clock had done striking, the bird would flap
+its wings and sing. Then the platform would slide back into its place,
+the door would shut, and the clock go on ticking quietly for another
+hour.
+
+"This clock was made to go," continued Beechnut, "as many other clocks
+are, by two heavy weights, which were hung to the wheel-work by strong
+cords. The cords were wound round some of the wheels, and as they
+slowly descended by their weight, they made the wheels go round. There
+was a contrivance inside the clock to make the wheels go slowly and
+regularly, and not spin round too fast, as they would have done if the
+weights had been left to themselves. This is the way that clocks are
+often made.
+
+"Now, my father," continued Beechnut, "had intended to take this old
+family clock with him to America, and he now conceived the idea of
+hiding his treasure in the weights. The weights were formed of two
+round tin canisters filled with something very heavy. My father said
+he did not know whether it was shot or sand. He unsoldered the bottom
+from these canisters, and found that the filling was shot. He poured
+out the shot, put his gold pieces in in place of it, and then filled
+up all the interstices between and around the gold pieces with sand,
+to prevent the money from jingling. Then he soldered the bottom of the
+canisters on again, and no one would have known that the weights were
+anything more than ordinary clock-weights. He then packed the clock in
+a box, and put the box in his trunk. It did not take up a great deal
+of room, for he did not take the case of the clock, but only the face
+and the works and the two weights, which last he packed carefully and
+securely in the box, one on each side of the clock itself.
+
+"When we got to Havre, all our baggage was examined at the Custom
+House, and the officers allowed it all to pass. When they came to the
+clock, my father showed them the little door and the bird inside, and
+they said it was very curious. They did not pay any attention to the
+weights at all.
+
+"When we went on board of the vessel our chests were put by the side
+of an immense heap of baggage upon the deck, where some seamen were at
+work lowering it down into the hold through a square opening in the
+deck of the ship. As for the trunk, my father took that with him to
+the place where he was going to be himself during the voyage. This
+place was called the steerage. It was crowded full of men, women, and
+children, all going to America. Some talked French, some German, some
+Dutch, and there were ever so many babies that were too little to talk
+at all. Pretty soon the vessel sailed.
+
+"We did not meet with anything remarkable on the voyage, except that
+once we saw an iceberg."
+
+"What is that?" asked Madeline.
+
+"It is a great mountain of ice," replied Beechnut, "floating about in
+the sea on the top of the water. I don't know how it comes to be
+there."
+
+"I should not think it would float upon the top of the water," said
+Phonny. "All the ice that I ever saw in the water sinks into it."
+
+"It does not sink to the bottom," said Madeline.
+
+"No," replied Phonny, "but it sinks down until the top of the ice is
+just level with the water. But Beechnut says that his iceberg rose up
+like a mountain."
+
+"Yes," said Beechnut, "it was several hundred feet high above the
+water, all glittering in the sun. And I think that if you look at any
+small piece of ice floating in the water, you will see that a small
+part of it rises above the surface."
+
+"Yes," said Phenny, "a very little."
+
+"It is a certain proportion of the whole mass," rejoined Beechnut.
+"They told us on board our vessel that about one-tenth part of the
+iceberg was above the water; the rest--that is, nine-tenths--was under
+it; so you see what an enormous big piece of ice it must have been to
+have only one-tenth part of it tower up so high.
+
+"There was one thing very curious and beautiful about our iceberg,"
+said Beechnut. "We came in sight of it one day about sunset, just
+after a shower. The cloud, which was very large and black, had passed
+off into the west, and there was a splendid rainbow upon it. It
+happened, too, that when we were nearest to the iceberg it lay toward
+the west, and, of course, toward the cloud, and it appeared directly
+under the rainbow, and the iceberg and the rainbow made a most
+magnificent spectacle. The iceberg, which was very bright and dazzling
+in the evening sun, looked like an enormous diamond, with the rainbow
+for the setting."
+
+"How curious!" said Phonny.
+
+"Yes," said Beechnut, "and to make it more remarkable still, a whale
+just then came along directly before the iceberg, and spouted there
+two or three times; and as the sun shone very brilliantly upon the jet
+of water which the whale threw into the air, it made a sort of silver
+rainbow below in the center of the picture."
+
+"How beautiful it must have been!" said Phonny.
+
+"Yes," rejoined Beechnut, "very beautiful indeed. We saw a great many
+beautiful spectacles on the sea; but then, on the other hand, we saw
+some that were dreadful.
+
+"Did you?" asked Phonny. "What?"
+
+"Why, we had a terrible storm and shipwreck at the end," said
+Beechnut. "For three days and three nights the wind blew almost a
+hurricane. They took in all the sails, and let the ship drive before
+the gale under bare poles. She went on over the seas for five hundred
+miles, howling all the way like a frightened dog."
+
+"Were you frightened?" asked Phonny.
+
+"Yes," said Beechnut. "When the storm first came on, several of the
+passengers came up the hatchways and got up on the deck to see it; and
+then we could not get down again, for the ship gave a sudden pitch
+just after we came up, and knocked away the step-ladder. We were
+terribly frightened. The seas were breaking over the forecastle and
+sweeping along the decks, and the shouts and outcries of the captain
+and the sailors made a dreadful din. At last they put the step-ladder
+in its place again, and we got down. Then they put the hatches on, and
+we could not come out any more."
+
+"The hatches?" said Phonny. "What are they?"
+
+"The hatches," replied Beechnut, "are a sort of scuttle-doors that
+cover over the square openings in the deck of a ship. They always have
+to put them on and fasten them down in a great storm."
+
+Just at this time the party happened to arrive at a place where two
+roads met, and as there was a broad and level space of ground at the
+junction, where it would be easy to turn the wagon, Beechnut said that
+he thought it would be better to make that the end of their ride, and
+so turn round and go home. Phonny and Madeline were quite desirous of
+going a little farther, but Beechnut thought that he should be tired
+by the time he reached the house again.
+
+"But you will not have time to finish the story," said Phonny.
+
+"Yes," replied Beechnut; "there is very little more to tell. It is
+only to give an account of our shipwreck."
+
+"Why, did you have a shipwreck?" exclaimed Phonny.
+
+"Yes," said Beechnut. "When you have turned the wagon, I will tell you
+about it."
+
+So Phonny, taking a great sweep, turned the wagon round, and the party
+set their faces toward home. The Marshal was immediately going to set
+out upon a trot, but Phonny held him back by pulling upon the reins
+and saying:
+
+"Steady, Marshal! steady! You have got to walk all the way home."
+
+"The storm drove us upon the Nova Scotia coast," said Beechnut,
+resuming his story. "We did not know anything about the great danger
+that we were in until just before the ship went ashore. When we got
+near the shore the sailors put down all the anchors; but they would
+not hold, and at length the ship struck. Then there followed a
+dreadful scene of consternation and confusion. Some jumped into the
+sea in their terror, and were drowned. Some cried and screamed, and
+acted as if they were insane. Some were calm, and behaved rationally.
+The sailors opened the hatches and let the passengers come up, and we
+got into the most sheltered places that we could find about the decks
+and rigging, and tied ourselves to whatever was nearest at hand. My
+father opened his trunk and took out his two clock-weights, and gave
+me one of them; the other he kept himself. He told me that we might as
+well try to save them, though he did not suppose that we should be
+able to do so.
+
+"Pretty soon after we struck the storm seemed to abate a little. The
+people of the country came down to the shore and stood upon the rocks
+to see if they could do anything to save us. We were very near the
+shore, but the breakers and the boiling surf were so violent between
+us and the land that whoever took to the water was sure to be dashed
+in pieces. So everybody clung to the ship, waiting for the captain to
+contrive some way to get us to the shore."
+
+"And what did he do?" asked Phonny.
+
+"He first got a long line and a cask, and he fastened the end of the
+long line to the cask, and then threw the cask overboard. The other
+end of the line was kept on board the ship. The cask was tossed about
+upon the waves, every successive surge driving it in nearer and nearer
+to the shore, until at last it was thrown up high upon the rocks. The
+men upon the shore ran to seize it, but before they could get hold of
+it the receding wave carried it back again among the breakers, where
+it was tossed about as if it had been a feather, and overwhelmed with
+the spray. Presently away it went again up upon the shore, and the men
+again attempted to seize it. This was repeated two or three times. At
+last they succeeded in grasping hold of it, and they ran up with it
+upon the rocks, out of the reach of the seas.
+
+"The captain then made signs to the men to pull the line in toward the
+shore. He was obliged to use signs, because the roaring and thundering
+of the seas made such a noise that nothing could be heard. The sailors
+had before this, under the captain's direction, fastened a much
+stronger line--a small cable, in fact--to the end of the line which
+had been attached to the barrel. Thus, by pulling upon the smaller
+line, the men drew one end of the cable to the shore. The other end
+remained on board the ship, while the middle of it lay tossing among
+the breakers between the ship and the shore.
+
+"The seamen then carried that part of the cable which was on shipboard
+up to the masthead, while the men on shore made their end fast to a
+very strong post which they set in the ground. The seamen drew the
+cable as tight as they could, and fastened their end very strongly to
+the masthead. Thus the line of the cable passed in a gentle slope from
+the top of the mast to the land, high above all the surges and spray.
+The captain then rigged what he called a sling, which was a sort of
+loop of ropes that a person could be put into and made to slide down
+in it on the cable to the shore. A great many of the passengers were
+afraid to go in this way, but they were still more afraid to remain on
+board the ship."
+
+"What were they afraid of?" asked Phonny.
+
+"They were afraid," replied Beechnut, "that the shocks of the seas
+would soon break the ship to pieces, and then they would all be thrown
+into the sea together. In this case they would certainly be destroyed,
+for if they were not drowned, they would be dashed to pieces on the
+rocks which lined the shore.
+
+"Sliding down the line seemed thus a very dangerous attempt, but they
+consented one after another to make the trial, and thus we all escaped
+safe to land."
+
+"And did you get the clock-weights safe to the shore?" asked Phonny.
+
+"Yes," replied Beechnut, "and as soon as we landed we hid them in the
+sand. My father took me to a little cove close by, where there was not
+much surf, as the place was protected by a rocky point of land which
+bounded it on one side. Behind this point of land the waves rolled up
+quietly upon a sandy beach. My father went down upon the slope of this
+beach, to a place a little below where the highest waves came, and
+began to dig a hole in the sand. He called me to come and help him.
+The waves impeded our work a little, but we persevered until we had
+dug a hole about a foot deep. We put our clock-weights into this hole
+and covered them over. We then ran back up upon the beach. The waves
+that came up every moment over the place soon smoothed the surface of
+the sand again, and made it look as if nothing had been done there. My
+father measured the distance from the place where he had deposited his
+treasure up to a certain great white rock upon the shore exactly
+opposite to it, so as to be able to find the place again, and then we
+went back to our company. They were collected on the rocks in little
+groups, wet and tired, and in great confusion, but rejoiced at having
+escaped with their lives. Some of the last of the sailors were then
+coming over in the sling. The captain himself came last of all.
+
+"There were some huts near the place on the shore, where the men made
+good fires, and we warmed and dried ourselves. The storm abated a
+great deal in a few hours, and the tide went down, so that we could go
+off to the ship before night to get some provisions. The next morning
+the men could work at the ship very easily, and they brought all the
+passengers' baggage on shore. My father got his trunk with the clock
+in it. A day or two afterward some sloops came to the place, and took
+us all away to carry us to Quebec. Just before we embarked on board
+the sloops, my father and I, watching a good opportunity, dug up our
+weights out of the sand, and put them back safely in their places in
+the clock-box."
+
+"Is that the end?" asked Phonny, when Beechnut paused.
+
+"Yes," replied Beechnut, "I believe I had better make that the end."
+
+"I think it is a very interesting and well-told story," said Madeline.
+"And do you feel very tired?"
+
+"No," said Beechnut. "On the contrary, I feel all the better for my
+ride. I believe I will sit up a little while."
+
+So saying, he raised himself in the wagon and sat up, and began to
+look about him.
+
+"What a wonderful voyage you had, Beechnut!" said Phonny. "But I never
+knew before that you were shipwrecked."
+
+"Well, in point of fact," replied Beechnut, "I never was
+shipwrecked."
+
+"Never was!" exclaimed Phonny. "Why, what is all this story that you
+have been telling us, then?"
+
+"Embellishment," said Beechnut quietly.
+
+"Embellishment!" repeated Phonny, more and more amazed.
+
+"Yes," said Beechnut.
+
+"Then you were not wrecked at all?" said Phonny.
+
+"No," replied Beechnut.
+
+"And how did you get to the land?" asked Phonny.
+
+"Why, we sailed quietly up the St. Lawrence," replied Beechnut, "and
+landed safely at Quebec, as other vessels do."
+
+"And the clock-weights?" asked Phonny.
+
+"All embellishment," said Beechnut. "My father had no such clock, in
+point of fact. He put his money in a bag, his bag in his chest, and
+his chest in the hold, and it came as safe as the captain's sextant."
+
+"And the iceberg and the rainbow?" said Madeline.
+
+"Embellishment, all embellishment," said Beechnut.
+
+"Dear me!" said Phonny, "I thought it was all true."
+
+"Did you?" said Beechnut. "I am sorry that you were so deceived, and I
+am sure it was not my fault, for I gave you your choice of a true
+story or an invention, and you chose the invention."
+
+"Yes," said Phonny, "so we did."
+
+
+
+
+THE OYSTER PATTIES
+
+
+There was once a little boy who perhaps might have been a good little
+fellow if his friends had taken pains to make him so; but--I do not
+know how it was--instead of teaching him to be good, they gave him
+everything he cried for; so, whenever he wished to have anything, he
+had only to cry, and if he did not get it directly, he cried louder
+and louder till at last he got it. By this means Alfred was not only
+very naughty, but very unhappy. He was crying from morning till night.
+He had no pleasure in anything; he was in everybody's way, and nobody
+liked to be with him.
+
+Well, one day his mother thought she would give him a day of pleasure,
+and make him very happy indeed, so she told him he should have a
+feast, and dine under the great cedar tree that stood upon the lawn,
+and that his cousins should be invited to dine with him, and that he
+should have whatever he chose for his dinner. So she rang the bell,
+and she told the servants to take out tables and chairs and to lay the
+cloth upon the table under the tree, and she ordered her two footmen
+to be ready to wait upon him.
+
+She desired the butler to tell the cook to prepare the dinner, and to
+get all sorts of nice dishes for the feast; but she said to Alfred:
+
+"What shall you like best of all, my dear boy?"
+
+So Alfred tried to think of something that he had never had before,
+and he recollected that one day he had heard a lady, who was dining
+with his father and mother, say that the oyster patties were the best
+she had ever eaten. Now Alfred had never tasted oyster patties, so he
+said he would have oyster patties for dinner.
+
+"Oyster patties, my dear boy? You cannot have oyster patties at this
+time of the year; there are no oysters to be had," his mother said to
+him. "Try, love, to think of something else."
+
+But naughty Alfred said:
+
+"No, I can think of nothing else."
+
+So the cook was sent for, and desired to think of something that he
+might like as well. The cook proposed first a currant pie, then a
+barberry pie, or a codlin pie with custard.
+
+"No, no, no!" said Alfred, shaking his head.
+
+"Or a strawberry tart, my sweet boy? or apricot jam?" said his mother,
+in a soothing tone of voice.
+
+But Alfred said:
+
+"No, mother, no. I don't like strawberries. I don't like apricot jam.
+I want oysters."
+
+"But you cannot have oysters, my little master," said the cook.
+
+"But I will have oysters," said the little boy, "and you shan't say
+that I can't have them--shall she, mother?"
+
+And he began to scream and to cry.
+
+"Do not cry, my sweet soul," said his mother, "and we will see what we
+can do. Dry up your tears, my little man, and come with me, and, the
+cook, I dare say, will be able to get some oysters before dinner. It
+is a long time to dinner, you know, and I have some pretty toys for
+you upstairs, if you will come with me till dinner is ready."
+
+So she took the little crying boy by the hand and led him up to her
+room, and she whispered to the cook, as she passed, not to say
+anything more about it now, and that she hoped he would forget the
+oyster patties by the time dinner was ready. In the meantime she took
+all the pains she could to amuse and please him, and as fast as he
+grew tired of one toy she brought out another.
+
+At last, after some hours, she gave him a beautiful toy for which she
+had paid fifteen shillings. It was a sand toy of a woman sitting at a
+spinning-wheel, and when it was turned up the little figure began
+spinning away, and the wheel turned round and round as fast as if the
+woman who turned it had been alive. Alfred wanted to see how it was
+done, but, instead of going to his mother to ask her if she would be
+so good as to explain it to him, he began pulling it to pieces to look
+behind it. For some time he was very busy, and he had just succeeded
+in opening the large box at the back of the figure when all the sand
+that was in it came pouring out upon the floor, and when he tried to
+make the little woman spin again, he found she would not do it any
+more. She could not, for it was the sand dropping down that had made
+her move before.
+
+Now, do you know that Alfred was so very silly that he began to be
+angry even with the toy, and he said, "Spin, I say! spin directly!"
+and then he shook it very hard, but in vain. The little hands did not
+move, and the wheel stood still. So then he was very angry indeed,
+and, setting up a loud cry, he threw the toy to the other end of the
+room. Just at this very moment the servant opened the door and said
+that dinner was ready, and that Alfred's cousins were arrived.
+
+"Come, my dear child; you are tired of your toys, I see," said his
+mother, "so come to dinner, darling. It is all ready under the tree."
+
+So away they went, leaving the room all strewed with toys, with broken
+pieces, and the sand all spilt in a heap upon the floor. When they
+went under the dark spreading branches of the fine old cedar-tree,
+there they saw the table covered with dishes and garnished with
+flowers. There were chickens, and ham, and tongue, and lobsters,
+besides tarts, and custards, and jellies, and cakes, and cream, and I
+do not know how many nice things besides. There was Alfred's high
+chair at the head of the table, and he was soon seated in it, as
+master of the feast, with his mother sitting by him, his cousins
+opposite to him, his nurse standing on the other side, and the two
+footmen waiting besides.
+
+As soon as his cousins were helped to what they liked best, his mother
+said:
+
+"What will you eat first, Alfred, my love? A wing of a chicken?"
+
+"No," said Alfred, pushing it away.
+
+"A slice of ham, darling?" said nurse.
+
+"No," said Alfred, in a louder tone.
+
+"A little bit of lobster, my dear?"
+
+"No, no," replied the naughty boy.
+
+"Well, what _will_ you have, then?" said his mother, who was almost
+tired of him.
+
+"I will have oyster patties," said he.
+
+"That is the only thing you cannot have, my love, you know, so do not
+think of it any more, but taste a bit of this pie. I am sure you will
+like it."
+
+"You _said_ I should have oyster patties by dinner-time," said Alfred,
+"and so I will have nothing else."
+
+"I am sorry you are such a sad, naughty child," said his mother. "I
+thought you would have been so pleased with all these nice things to
+eat."
+
+"They are _not_ nice," said the child, who was not at all grateful for
+all that his mother had done, but was now in such a passion that he
+took the piece of currant tart which his nurse again offered to him,
+and, squeezing, up as much as his two little hands could hold, he
+threw it at his nurse, and stained her nice white handkerchief and
+apron with the red juice.
+
+Just at this moment his father came into the garden, and walked up to
+the table.
+
+"What is all his?" said he. "Alfred, you seem to be a very naughty boy
+indeed; and I must tell you, sir, I shall allow this no longer. Get
+down from your chair, sir, and beg your nurse's pardon."
+
+Alfred had hardly ever heard his father speak so before, and he felt
+so frightened that he left off crying and did as he was bid. Then his
+father took him by the hand and led him away.
+
+His mother said she was sure he would now be good and eat the currant
+tart; but his father said:
+
+"No, no, it is now too late; he must come with me."
+
+So he led him away, without saying another word.
+
+He took him into the village, and he stopped at the door, of a poor
+cottage.
+
+"May we come in?" said his father.
+
+"Oh yes, and welcome," said a poor woman, who was standing at a table
+with a saucepan in her hand.
+
+"What are you doing, my good woman?"
+
+"Only putting out the children's supper, your honor."
+
+"And what have you got for their supper?"
+
+"Only some potatoes, please you, sir; but they be nicely boiled, and
+here come the hungry boys! They are coming in from their work, and
+they will soon make an end of them, I warrant."
+
+As she said these words in came John, and William, and Thomas, all
+with rosy cheeks and smiling faces. They sat down--one on a wooden
+stool, one on a broken chair, and one on the corner of the table--and
+they all began to eat the potatoes very heartily.
+
+But Alfred's father said:
+
+"Stop, my good boys; do not eat any more, but come with me."
+
+The boys stared, but their mother told them to do as they were bid, so
+they left off eating and followed the gentleman.
+
+Alfred and his father walked on till they arrived once more under the
+cedar-tree in the garden, and there was the fine feast all standing
+just as they had left it, for Alfred's cousins were gone away, and his
+mother would not have the dinner taken away, because she hoped that
+Alfred would come back to it.
+
+"Now, boys," said the gentleman, "you may all sit down to this table
+and eat whatever you like."
+
+John, William, and Thomas sat down as quickly as they could, and began
+to devour the chickens and tarts, and all the good things, at a great
+rate; and Alfred, who now began to be very hungry, would gladly have
+been one of the party; but when he was going to sit down, his father
+said:
+
+"No, sir; this feast is not for _you_. There is nothing here that you
+like to eat, you know; so you will wait upon these boys, if you
+please, who seem as if they would find plenty that they will like."
+
+Alfred at this began to cry again, and said he wanted to go to his
+mother; but his father did not mind his crying, and said he should not
+go to his mother again till he was quite a good boy.
+
+"So now, sir, hand this bread to John, and now take a clean plate to
+Thomas, and now stand ready to carry this custard to William. There
+now, wait till they have all done."
+
+It was of no use now to cry or scream; he was obliged to do it all.
+
+When the boys had quite finished their supper they went home, and
+Alfred was led by his father into the house. Before he went to bed, a
+cup of milk and water and a piece of brown bread were put before him,
+and his father said:
+
+"That is your supper, Alfred."
+
+Alfred began to cry again, and said he did not want such a supper as
+that.
+
+"Very well," said his father, "then go to bed without, and it shall be
+saved for your breakfast."
+
+Alfred cried and screamed louder than ever, so his father ordered the
+maid to put him to bed. When he was in bed, he thought his mother
+would come and see him and bring him something nice, and he lay awake
+a long while; but she did not come, and he cried and cried till at
+last he fell asleep.
+
+In the morning, when he awoke, he was so hungry he could hardly wait
+to be dressed, but asked for his breakfast every minute. When he saw
+the maid bring in the brown bread again without any butter, and some
+milk and water, he was very near crying again; but he thought if he
+did he should perhaps lose his breakfast as he had lost his supper, so
+he checked his tears, and ate a hearty meal.
+
+"Well," said his father, who came into the room just as he was eating
+the last bit of bread, "I am glad to see the little boy who could not
+yesterday find anything good enough for him at a feast eating such
+simple fare as this so heartily. Come, Alfred, now you may come to
+your dear mother."
+
+
+
+
+TWO LITTLE BOYS
+
+By THOMAS DAY
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+THE GOOD-NATURED LITTLE BOY
+
+
+A little boy went out one morning to walk to a village about five
+miles from the place where he lived, and carried with him in a basket
+the provision that was to serve him the whole day. As he was walking
+along a poor little half-starved dog came up to him, wagging his tail
+and seeming to entreat him to take compassion on him.
+
+The little boy at first took no notice of him, but at length,
+remarking how lean and famished the creature seemed to be, he said:
+"This animal is certainly in very great necessity. If I give him part
+of my provision I shall be obliged to go home hungry myself; however,
+as he seems to want it more than I do, he shall partake with me."
+Saying this, he gave the dog part of what he had in his basket, who
+ate as if he had not tasted victuals for a fortnight.
+
+The little boy went on a little further, his dog still following him
+and fawning upon him with the greatest gratitude and affection, when
+he saw a poor old horse lying upon the ground, and groaning as if he
+was very ill. He went up to him, and saw that he was almost starved,
+and so weak that he was unable to rise. "I am very much afraid," said
+the little boy, "if I stay to assist this horse that it will be dark
+before I can return, and I have heard there are several thieves in the
+neighborhood. However, I will try. It is doing a good action to
+attempt to relieve him, and God Almighty will take care of me." He
+then went and gathered some grass, which he brought to the horse's
+mouth, who immediately began to eat with as much relish as if his
+chief disease was hunger. He then fetched some water in his hat,
+which the animal drank up, and seemed immediately to be so much
+refreshed that after a few trials he got up and began grazing.
+
+He then went on a little further, and saw a man wading about in a pool
+of water without being able to get out, in spite of all his endeavors.
+"What is the matter, good man?" said the little boy to him. "Can't you
+find your way out of this pond?" "No, God bless you, my worthy master,
+or miss," said the man, "for such I take you to be by your voice. I
+have fallen into this pond, and know not how to get out again, as I am
+quite blind, and I am almost afraid to move for fear of being
+drowned." "Well," said the little boy, "though I shall be wetted to
+the skin, if you will throw me your stick, I will try to help you out
+of it."
+
+The blind man then threw the stick on to that side on which he heard
+the voice; the little boy caught it, and went into the water, feeling
+very carefully before him, lest he should unguardedly go beyond his
+depth. At length he reached the blind man, took him very carefully by
+the hand, and led him out. The blind man then gave him a thousand
+blessings, and told him he could grope his way home, and the little
+boy ran on as hard as he could to prevent being benighted.
+
+But he had not proceeded far when he saw a poor sailor, that had lost
+both his legs in an engagement by sea, hopping along upon crutches.
+
+"God bless you, my little master!" said the sailor. "I have fought
+many a battle with the French to defend poor old England, but now I am
+crippled, as you see, and have neither victuals nor money, although I
+am almost famished." The little boy could not resist his inclination
+to relieve him, so he gave him all his remaining victuals, and said:
+"God help you, poor man! This is all I have, otherwise you should have
+more."
+
+He then ran along, and presently arrived at the town he was going to,
+did his business, and returned towards his own home with all the
+expedition he was able.
+
+But he had not gone much more than half-way before the night shut in
+extremely dark, without either moon or stars to light him. The poor
+little boy did all he could to find his way, but unfortunately missed
+it in turning down a lane which brought him into a wood, where he
+wandered about a great while without being able to find any path to
+lead him out.
+
+Tired out at last and hungry, he felt himself so feeble that he could
+go no further, but sat himself down upon the ground, crying most
+bitterly. In this situation he remained for some time, till at last
+the little dog, who had never forsaken him, came up to him, wagging
+his tail, and holding something in his mouth. The little, boy took it
+from him, and saw it was a handkerchief nicely pinned together, which
+someone had dropped and the dog had picked up; and upon opening it he
+found several slices of bread and meat, which the little boy ate with
+great satisfaction, and felt himself extremely refreshed with his
+meal. "So," said the little boy, "I see that if I have given you a
+breakfast you have given me a supper, and a good turn is never lost,
+not even to a dog."
+
+He then once more attempted to escape from the woods, but it was to no
+purpose; he only scratched his legs with the briars, and slipped down
+in the dirt, without being able to find his way out. He was just going
+to give up all further attempts in despair, when he happened to see a
+horse feeding before him, and going up to him saw, by the light of the
+moon which just then began to shine a little, that it was the very
+same horse he had fed in the morning. "Perhaps," said the little boy,
+"this creature that I have been so good to will let me get upon his
+back, and he may bring me out of the wood, as he is accustomed to feed
+in this neighborhood."
+
+The little boy then went up to the horse, speaking to him and stroking
+him, and the horse let him mount his back without opposition, and then
+proceeded slowly through the wood, grazing as he went, till he brought
+him to an opening which led to the high road. The little boy was much
+rejoiced at this and said: "If I hadn't saved the creature's life in
+the morning I should have been obliged to have stayed here all the
+night. I see by this that a good deed is never lost."
+
+But the poor little boy had yet a greater danger to undergo, for as he
+was going along a solitary lane two men rushed out upon him, laid hold
+of him, and were going to strip him of his clothes; but just as they
+were beginning to do it the little dog bit the leg of one of the men
+with so much violence that he left the little boy and pursued the dog,
+which ran howling and barking away. In this instant a voice was heard
+that cried out: "There are the rascals! Let us knock them down!" which
+frightened the remaining man so much that he ran away, and his
+companion followed him.
+
+The little boy then looked up, and saw that it was the sailor whom he
+had relieved in the morning, carried upon the shoulders of the blind
+man whom he had helped out of the pond. "There, my little dear!" said
+the sailor. "God be thanked! we have come in time to do you a service
+in return for what you did us in the morning. As I lay under a hedge I
+heard these villains talk of robbing a little boy that from the
+description I concluded must be you; but I was so lame that I should
+not have been able to come time enough to help you if I had not met
+this honest blind man, who took me upon his back, while I showed him
+the way." The little boy thanked them very gratefully for thus
+defending him, and they went all together to his father's house, which
+was not far off, where they were all kindly entertained with a supper
+and bed.
+
+The little boy took care of his faithful dog as long as he lived, and
+never forgot the importance and necessity of doing good to others if
+we wish them to do the same to us.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+THE ILL-NATURED LITTLE BOY
+
+
+There was once a little boy who was so unfortunate as to have a very
+bad man for his father, who was always surly and ill-tempered, and
+never gave his children either good instruction or good example. In
+consequence of this, this little boy, who might otherwise have been
+happier and better, became ill-natured and quarrelsome, and
+disagreeable to every one. He very often was severely beaten for his
+impertinence by boys that were bigger than himself, and sometimes by
+boys that were less; for though he was very abusive and quarrelsome,
+he did not much like fighting, and generally trusted more to his heels
+than his courage when he had engaged himself in a quarrel. This little
+boy had a cur dog that was the exact image of himself; he was the most
+troublesome, surly creature imaginable, always barking at the heels of
+every horse he came near, and worrying every sheep he could meet with,
+for which reason both the dog and the boy were disliked by all the
+neighborhood.
+
+One morning his father got up early to go to the ale-house, where he
+intended to stay till night, as it was a holiday; but before he went
+out he gave his son some bread and cold meat and sixpence, and told
+him he might go and divert himself as he would the whole day. The
+little boy was very much pleased with this liberty, and as it was a
+very fine morning he called his dog Tiger to follow him, and began his
+walk.
+
+He had not proceeded far before he met a boy that was driving a flock
+of sheep towards a gate that he wanted them to enter. "Pray, master,"
+said the little boy, "stand still, and keep your dog close to you, for
+fear you frighten my sheep." "Oh yes, to be sure," answered the
+ill-natured little boy. "I am to wait here all the morning till you
+and your sheep have passed, I suppose! Here, Tiger, seize them, boy"!
+Tiger at this sprang forth into the middle of the flock, barking and
+biting on every side, and the sheep, in a general consternation,
+hurried each a separate way.
+
+Tiger seemed to enjoy this sport equally with his master, but in the
+midst of his triumph he happened unguardedly to attack an old ram that
+had more courage than the rest of the flock. He, instead of running
+away, faced about and aimed a blow with his forehead at his enemy with
+so much force and dexterity that he knocked Tiger over and over,
+butting him several times while he was down, and obliged him to limp
+howling away.
+
+The ill-natured little boy, who was not capable of loving anything,
+had been very much diverted with the trepidation of the flock of
+sheep, but now he laughed heartily at the misfortune of his dog, and
+he would have laughed much longer had not the other little boy, his
+patience provoked at this treatment, thrown a stone at him, which hit
+him full upon the temples and almost knocked him down. He immediately
+began to cry in concert with his dog, when, perceiving a man coming
+towards them, whom he fancied might be the owner of the sheep, he
+thought it most prudent to escape as speedily as possible.
+
+But he had scarcely recovered from the smart which the blow had
+occasioned when his former mischievous disposition returned, which he
+determined to gratify to the utmost. He had not gone far before he saw
+a little girl standing by a stile, with a large pot of milk at her
+feet. "Pray," said the little girl, "help me with this pot of milk. My
+mother sent me out to fetch it this morning, and I have brought it
+alone a mile on my head; but I am so tired that I have been obliged to
+stop at this stile to rest me, and if I don't return home presently we
+shall have no pudding to-day, and, besides, my mother will be very
+angry with me."
+
+"What," said the boy, "you are to have a pudding to-day, are you,
+miss?" "Yes," said the girl, "and a fine piece of roast beef, for
+there's Uncle Will, and Uncle John, and grandfather, and all my
+cousins, to dine with us, and we shall all be very merry in the
+evening, I can assure you; so pray help me up as speedily as
+possible." "That I will, miss," said the boy, taking up the jug, and
+pretending to fix it upon her head. Just as she had hold of it he gave
+it a little push, as if he had stumbled, and overturned it upon her.
+The little girl began to cry violently, but the mischievous boy ran
+away, laughing heartily, and saying: "Good-by, little miss! Give my
+humble service to your Uncle Will, and grandfather, and the dear
+little cousins."
+
+This prank encouraged him very much indeed, for he then felt that now
+he had certainly escaped without any bad consequences; so he went on
+applauding his own ingenuity, and came to a farm where several little
+boys were at play. He desired leave to play with them, which they
+allowed him to do. But he could not be contented long without exerting
+his evil disposition, so taking an opportunity when it was his turn to
+fling the ball, instead of flinging it the way he ought to have done,
+he threw it into a muddy ditch. The little boys ran in a great hurry
+to see what was become of it, and as they were standing all together
+upon the brink he gave the outermost boy a violent push against his
+neighbor; he, not being able to resist the violence, tumbled against
+the next, that against the next, and that next against another, by
+which means they all soused into the ditch together.
+
+They soon scrambled out, although in a dirty plight, and were going to
+have punished him for all his ill behavior; but he patted Tiger upon
+the back, who began snarling and growling in such a manner as made
+them desist. Thus this little mischievous boy escaped a second time
+with impunity.
+
+The next thing he met with was a poor jackass feeding very quietly in
+a ditch. The little boy, seeing that nobody was within sight, thought
+this was an opportunity of plaguing an animal that was not to be lost,
+so he went and cut a large branch of thorns, which he contrived to fix
+to the poor beast's tail, and then, setting Tiger at him, he was
+extremely diverted to see the fright and agony the creature was in.
+But it did not fare so well with Tiger, who while he was baying and
+biting the animal's heels receive so severe a kick upon his head as
+laid him dead upon the spot.
+
+The boy, who had no affection for his dog, left him with the greatest
+unconcern when he saw what had happened, and, finding himself hungry,
+sat down by the wayside to eat his dinner. He had not long been there
+before a poor blind man came groping his way out with a couple of
+sticks. "Good morning to you," said the boy. "Pray did you see a
+little girl come this road with a basket of eggs upon her head,
+dressed in a green gown, with a straw hat upon her head?" "God bless
+you, master!" said the beggar, "I am so blind I can see nothing,
+either in heaven above or in the earth below. I have been blind these
+twenty years, and they call me 'poor old blind Richard.'"
+
+Though the poor old man was such an object of charity and compassion,
+yet the little boy determined, as usual, to play him some trick, and
+as he was a great liar and deceiver, he spoke to him thus: "Poor old
+Richard, I am heartily sorry for you with all my heart. I am just
+eating my breakfast, and if you will sit down by me I will give you
+part, and feed you myself." "Thank you with all my heart!" said the
+poor man; "and if you will give me your hand I will sit by you with
+great pleasure, my dear good little master."
+
+The little boy then gave him his hand, and, pretending to direct him,
+guided him to sit down in a large heap of wet mud that lay by the
+roadside. "There," said he, "now you are nicely seated I am going to
+feed you." So, taking a little of the dirt in his fingers, he was
+going to put it into the blind man's mouth; but the man, who now
+perceived the trick that had been played him, made a sudden snap at
+his fingers, and getting them between his teeth bit them so severely
+that the wicked boy roared out for mercy, and promised never more to
+be guilty of such wickedness. At last the blind man, after he had put
+him to very severe pain, consented to let him go, saying as he went:
+"Are you not ashamed, you little scoundrel, to attempt to do hurt to
+those who have never injured you, and to want to add to the suffering
+of those who already are sufficiently miserable? Although you escape
+now, be assured, sir, that if you do not repent and mend your manners,
+you will meet with a severe punishment for your bad behavior."
+
+One would think that this punishment would have cured him entirely of
+this mischievous disposition, but, unfortunately nothing is so
+difficult to overcome as bad habits that have been long indulged. He
+had not gone far before he saw a lame beggar that had just made a
+shift to support himself by the means of a couple of sticks. The
+beggar asked him to give him something, and the mischievous little
+boy, pulling out his sixpence, threw it down before him, as if he
+intended to make him a present of it; but while the poor man was
+stooping with difficulty to pick it up, the wicked little boy knocked
+the stick away, by which means the beggar fell down upon his face; and
+then snatching up the sixpence, the little boy ran away laughing very
+heartily at the accident.
+
+This was the last trick this ungrateful boy had it in his power to
+play, for seeing two men come up to the beggar and enter into
+discourse with him, he was afraid of being pursued, and therefore ran
+as fast as he was able over several fields. At last he came into a
+lane which led to a farmer's orchard, and as he was preparing to
+clamber over the fence a large dog seized him by the leg and held him
+fast. He cried out in an agony of terror, which brought the farmer
+out, who called the dog off, but seized the boy very roughly, saying:
+"So, sir, you are caught at last, are you? You thought you might come
+day after day and steal my apples without detection; but it seems you
+are mistaken, and now you shall receive the punishment you have so
+long deserved." The farmer then began to chastise him very severely
+with a whip he had in his hand, and the boy in vain protested he was
+innocent, and begged for mercy. At last the farmer asked him who he
+was and where he lived; but when he heard his name, he cried out:
+"What! are you the little rascal that frightened my sheep this
+morning, by which means several of them are lost? and do you think to
+escape?" Saying this he lashed him more severely than before, in spite
+of all his cries and protestations. At length, thinking he had
+punished him enough, he turned him out of the orchard, bade him go
+home, and frighten sheep again if he liked the consequences.
+
+The little boy slunk away crying very bitterly, for he had been very
+severely beaten, and now began to find out that no one can long hurt
+others with impunity; so he determined to go away quietly home, and
+behave better for the future.
+
+But his sufferings were not yet at an end, for as he jumped down from
+a stile he felt himself very roughly seized, and, looking up, found
+that he was in the power of the lame beggar whom he had thrown upon
+his face. It was in vain that he now cried, entreated, and begged for
+pardon; the man, who had been much hurt by his fall, thrashed him very
+severely with his stick before he would part with him.
+
+He now again went on crying and roaring with pain, but at least
+expected to escape without any further damage. But here he was
+mistaken, for as he was walking slowly through a lane, just as he
+turned a corner he found himself in the middle of the very troop of
+boys that he had used so ill in the morning. They all set up a shout
+as soon as they saw him, their enemy, in their power, without his dog,
+and began persecuting him in a thousand various ways. Some pulled him
+by the hair, others pinched him, some whipped his legs with their
+handkerchiefs, while others covered him with handfuls of dirt. In vain
+did he attempt to escape; they were still at his heels, and,
+surrounding him on every side, continued their persecutions.
+
+At length, while he was in this disagreeable situation, he happened to
+come up to the same jackass he had seen in the morning, and, making a
+sudden spring, jumped upon his back, hoping by this means to escape.
+The boys immediately renewed their shouts, and the ass, who was
+frightened at the noise, began galloping with all his might, and
+presently bore him from the reach of his enemies.
+
+But he had little reason to rejoice at this escape, for he found it
+impossible to stop the animal, and was every instant afraid of being
+thrown off and dashed upon the ground. After he had been thus hurried
+along a considerable time the ass on a sudden stopped short at the
+door of a cottage, and began kicking and prancing with so much fury
+that the little boy was presently thrown to the ground, and broke his
+leg in the fall.
+
+His cries immediately brought the family out, among whom was the very
+little girl he had used so ill in the morning. But she, with the
+greatest good nature, seeing him in such a pitiable situation,
+assisted in bringing him in and laying him upon the bed. There this
+unfortunate boy had leisure to recollect himself and reflect upon his
+own bad behavior, which in one day's time had exposed him to such a
+variety of misfortunes; and he determined with great sincerity that if
+ever he recovered from his present accident he would be as careful to
+take every opportunity of doing good as he had before been to commit
+every species of mischief.
+
+
+
+
+THE PURPLE JAR
+
+By MARIA EDGEWORTH
+
+
+Rosamond, a little girl about seven years old, was walking with her
+mother in the streets of London. As she passed along she looked in at
+the windows of several shops, and saw a great variety of different
+sorts of things, of which she did not know the use, or even the names.
+She wished to stop to look at them, but there was a great number of
+people in the streets, and a great many carts, carriages, and
+wheelbarrows, and she was afraid to let go her mother's hand.
+
+"Oh, mother, how happy I should be," she said, as she passed a
+toy-shop, "if I had all these pretty things!"
+
+"What, all! Do you wish for them all, Rosamond?"
+
+"Yes, mamma, all."
+
+As she spoke they came to a milliner's shop, the windows of which were
+decorated with ribbons and lace, and festoons of artificial flowers.
+
+"Oh, mamma, what beautiful roses! Won't you buy some of them?"
+
+"No, my dear."
+
+"Why?"
+
+"Because I don't want them, my dear."
+
+They went a little farther, and came to another shop, which caught
+Rosamond's eye. It was a jeweler's shop, and in it were a great many
+pretty baubles, ranged in drawers behind glass.
+
+"Mamma, will you buy some of these?"
+
+"Which of them, Rosamond?"
+
+"Which? I don't know which; any of them will do, for they are all
+pretty."
+
+"Yes, they are all pretty; but of what use would they be to me?"
+
+"Use! Oh, I am sure you could find some use or other for them if you
+would only buy them first."
+
+"But I would rather find out the use first."
+
+"Well, then, mamma, there are buckles; you know that buckles are
+useful things, very useful things."
+
+"I have a pair of buckles; I don't want another pair," said her
+mother, and walked on.
+
+Rosamond was very sorry that her mother wanted nothing. Presently,
+however, they came to a shop, which appeared to her far more beautiful
+than the rest. It was a chemist's shop, but she did not know that.
+
+"Oh, mother, oh!" cried she, pulling her mother's hand, "look, look!
+blue, green, red, yellow, and purple! Oh, mamma, what beautiful
+things! Won't you buy some of these?"
+
+Still her mother answered, as before, "Of what use would they be to
+me, Rosamond?"
+
+"You might put flowers in them, mamma, and they would look so pretty
+on the chimney-piece. I wish I had one of them."
+
+"You have a flower-pot," said her mother, "and that is not a
+flower-pot."
+
+"But I could use it for a flower-pot, mamma, you know."
+
+"Perhaps if you were to see it nearer, if you were to examine it you
+might be disappointed."
+
+"No, indeed, I'm sure I should not; I should like it exceedingly."
+
+Rosamond kept her head turned to look at the purple vase, till she
+could see it no longer.
+
+"Then, mother," said she, after a pause, "perhaps you have no money."
+
+"Yes, I have."
+
+"Dear me, if I had money I would buy roses, and boxes, and buckles,
+and purple flower-pots, and everything." Rosamond was obliged to pause
+in the midst of her speech.
+
+"Oh, mamma, would you stop a minute for me? I have got a stone in my
+shoe; it hurts me very much."
+
+"How came there to be a stone in your shoe?"
+
+"Because of this great hole, mamma,--it comes in there; my shoes are
+quite worn out. I wish you would be so very good as to give me another
+pair."
+
+"Nay, Rosamond, but I have not money enough to buy shoes, and
+flower-pots, and buckles, and boxes, and everything."
+
+Rosamond thought that was a great pity. But now her foot, which had
+been hurt by the stone, began to give her so much pain that she was
+obliged to hop every other step, and she could think of nothing else.
+They came to a shoemaker's shop soon afterwards.
+
+"There, there! mamma, there are shoes; there are little shoes that
+would just fit me, and you know shoes would be really of use to me."
+
+"Yes, so they would, Rosamond. Come in."
+
+She followed her mother into the shop.
+
+Mr. Sole the shoemaker, had a great many customers, and his shop was
+full, so they were obliged to wait.
+
+"Well, Rosamond," said her mother, "you don't think this shop so
+pretty as the rest?"
+
+"No, not nearly; it is black and dark, and there are nothing but shoes
+all round; and, besides, there's a very disagreeable smell."
+
+"That smell is the smell of new leather."
+
+"Is it? Oh!" said Rosamond, looking round, "there is a pair of little
+shoes; they'll just fit me, I'm sure."
+
+"Perhaps they might; but you cannot be sure till you have tried them
+on, any more than you can be quite sure that you should like the
+purple vase exceedingly, till you have examined it more attentively."
+
+"Why, I don't know about the shoes, certainly, till I have tried; but,
+mamma, I am quite sure that I should like the flower-pot."
+
+"Well, which would you rather have, a jar or a pair of shoes? I will
+buy either for you."
+
+"Dear mamma, thank you--but if you could buy both?"
+
+"No, not both."
+
+"Then the jar, if you please."
+
+"But I should tell you, that in that case I shall not give you another
+pair of shoes this month."
+
+"This month! that's a very long time, indeed! You can't think how
+these hurt me; I believe I'd better have the new shoes. Yet, that
+purple flower-pot. Oh, indeed, mamma, these shoes are not so very,
+very bad! I think I might wear them a little longer, and the month
+will soon be over. I can make them last till the end of the month,
+can't I? Don't you think so, mamma?"
+
+"Nay, my dear, I want you to think for yourself; you will have time
+enough to consider the matter, while I speak to Mr. Sole about my
+clogs."
+
+Mr. Sole was by this time at leisure, and while her mother was
+speaking to him, Rosamond stood in profound meditation, with one shoe
+on, and the other in her hand.
+
+"Well, my dear, have you decided?"
+
+"Mamma!--yes,--I believe I have. If you please, I should like to have
+the flower-pot; that is, if you won't think me very silly, mamma."
+
+"Why, as to that, I can't promise you, Rosamond; but when you have to
+judge for yourself you should choose what would make you happy, and
+then it would not signify who thought you silly."
+
+"Then, mamma, if that's all, I'm sure the flower-pot would make me
+happy," said she, putting on her old shoe again; "so I choose the
+flower-pot."
+
+"Very well, you shall have it; clasp your shoe and come home."
+
+Rosamond clasped her shoe and ran after her mother. It was not long
+before the shoe came down at the heel, and many times she was obliged
+to stop to take the stones out of it, and she often limped with pain;
+but still the thoughts of the purple flower-pot prevailed, and she
+persisted in her choice.
+
+When they came to the shop with the large window, Rosamond felt much
+pleasure upon hearing her mother desire the servant, who was with
+them, to buy the purple jar, and bring it home. He had other
+commissions, so he did not return with them. Rosamond, as soon as she
+got in, ran to gather all her own flowers, which she kept in a corner
+of her mother's garden.
+
+"I am afraid they'll be dead before the flower-pot comes, Rosamond,"
+said her mother to her, as she came in with the flowers in her lap.
+
+"No, indeed, mamma, it will come home very soon, I dare say. I shall
+be very happy putting them into the purple flower-pot."
+
+"I hope so, my dear."
+
+The servant was much longer returning home than Rosamond had expected;
+but at length he came, and brought with him the long-wished-for jar.
+The moment it was set down upon the table, Rosamond ran up to it with
+an exclamation of joy: "I may have it now, mamma?"
+
+"Yes, my dear, it is yours."
+
+Rosamond poured the flowers from her lap upon the carpet, and seized
+the purple flower-pot.
+
+"Oh, dear, mother!" cried she, as soon as she had taken off the top,
+"but there's something dark in it which smells very disagreeably. What
+is it? I didn't want this black stuff."
+
+"Nor I, my dear."
+
+"But what shall I do with it, mamma?"
+
+"That I cannot tell."
+
+"It will be of no use to me, mamma."
+
+"That I cannot help."
+
+"But I must pour it out, and fill the flower-pot with water."
+
+"As you please, my dear."
+
+"Will you lend me a bowl to pour it into, mamma?"
+
+"That was more than I promised you, my dear; but I will lend you a
+bowl."
+
+The bowl was produced, and Rosamond proceeded to empty the purple
+vase. But she experienced much surprise and disappointment, on
+finding, when it was entirely empty, that it was no longer a purple
+vase. It was a plain white glass jar, which had appeared to have that
+beautiful color merely from the liquor with which it had been filled.
+
+Little Rosamond burst into tears.
+
+"Why should you cry, my dear?" said her mother; "it will be of as much
+use to you now as ever, for a flower-pot."
+
+"But it won't look so pretty on the chimney-piece. I am sure, if I
+had known that it was not really purple, I should not have wished to
+have it so much."
+
+"But didn't I tell you that you had not examined it; and that perhaps
+you would be disappointed?"
+
+"And so I am disappointed, indeed. I wish I had believed you at once.
+Now I had much rather have the shoes, for I shall not be able to walk
+all this month; even walking home that little way hurt me exceedingly.
+Mamma, I will give you the flower-pot back again, and that purple
+stuff and all, if you'll only give me the shoes."
+
+"No, Rosamond; you must abide by your own choice; and now the best
+thing you can possibly do is to bear your disappointment with good
+humor."
+
+"I will bear it as well as I can," said Rosamond, wiping her eyes; and
+she began slowly and sorrowfully to fill the vase with flowers.
+
+But Rosamond's disappointment did not end here. Many were the
+difficulties and distresses into which her imprudent choice brought
+her, before the end of the month.
+
+Every day her shoes grew worse and worse, till as last she could
+neither run, dance, jump, nor walk in them.
+
+Whenever Rosamond was called to see anything, she was detained pulling
+her shoes up at the heels, and was sure to be too late.
+
+Whenever her mother was going out to walk, she could not take Rosamond
+with her, for Rosamond had no soles to her shoes; and at length, on
+the very last day of the month, it happened that her father proposed
+to take her with her brother to a glass-house, which she had long
+wished to see. She was very happy; but, when she was quite ready, had
+her hat and gloves on, and was making haste downstairs to her brother
+and father, who were waiting for her at the hall door, the shoe
+dropped off. She put it on again in a great hurry, but, as she was
+going across the hall, her father turned round.
+
+"Why are you walking slipshod? no one must walk slipshod with me. Why,
+Rosamond," said he, looking at her shoes with disgust, "I thought that
+you were always neat; no, I cannot take you with me."
+
+Rosamond colored and retired.
+
+"Oh, mamma," said she as she took off her hat, "how I wish that I had
+chosen the shoes! They would have been of so much more use to me than
+that jar: however, I am sure, no, not quite sure, but I hope I shall
+be wiser another time."
+
+
+
+
+THE THREE CAKES
+
+By ARMAND BERQUIN
+
+
+"There was a little boy named Henry," said Mr Glassington "about your
+age. His parents had but lately fixed him at a boarding-school.
+
+"He was a special boy, forever at his book, and happened once to get
+the highest place at exercises. His mother was told it. She could
+nohow keep from dreaming of the pleasure; and when morning came, she
+got up early, went to speak with the cook and said as follows:
+
+"'Cook, you are to make a cake for Henry, who yesterday was very good
+at school.'
+
+"'With all my heart,' replied the cook, and set immediately about it.
+It was as big as--let me see--as big as--as a hat when flapped. The
+cook had stuffed it with nice almonds, large pistachio nuts, and
+candied lemon-peel, and iced it over with a coat of sugar, so that it
+was very smooth and a perfect white. The cake no sooner was come home
+from baking than the cook put on her things, and carried it to school.
+
+"When Henry first saw it, he jumped up and down like any Merry Andrew.
+He was not so patient as to wait till they could let him have a knife,
+but fell upon it tooth and nail. He ate and ate till school began, and
+after school was over he ate again; at night, too, it was the same
+thing till bedtime--nay, a little fellow that Henry had for a playmate
+told me that he put the cake upon his bolster when he went to bed, and
+waked and waked a dozen times, that he might take a bit. I cannot so
+easily believe this last particular; but, then, it is very true, at
+least, that on the morrow, when the day was hardly broke, he set about
+his favorite business once again, continuing at it all the morning,
+and by noon had eaten it up. The dinner-bell now rung; but Henry, as
+one may fancy, had no stomach, and was vexed to see how heartily the
+other children ate. It was, however, worse than this at five o'clock,
+when school was over.
+
+"His companions asked him if he would not play at cricket, tan, or
+kits. Alas! he could not; so they played without him. In the meantime
+Henry could hardly stand upon his legs; he went and sat down in a
+corner very gloomily, while the children said one to another: 'What is
+the matter with poor Henry, who used to skip about and be so merry?
+See how pale and sorrowful he is!'
+
+"The master came himself, and, seeing him, was quite alarmed. It was
+all lost labor to interrogate him. Henry could not be brought to speak
+a single word.
+
+"By great good luck, a boy at length came forward in the secret; and
+his information was that Henry's mother had sent him a great cake the
+day before, which he had swallowed in an instant, as it were, and that
+his present sickness was occasioned only by his gluttony. On this, the
+master sent for an apothecary, who ordered him a quantity of physic,
+phial after phial. Henry, as one would fancy, found it very nauseous,
+but was forced to take the whole for fear of dying, which, had he
+omitted it, would certainly have been the case. When some few days of
+physic and strict regimen had passed, his health was re-established as
+before; but his mother protested that she would never let him have
+another cake."
+
+_Percival_. He did not merit so much as the smell of such a thing. But
+this is but one cake, father; and you informed me that there were
+three, if you remember, in your story.
+
+_Mr. G._ Patience! patience! Here is another cake in what I am now
+going to tell.
+
+"Henry's master had another scholar, whose name was Francis. He had
+written his mother a very pretty letter, and it had not so much as a
+blotted stroke; in recompense for which she sent him likewise a great
+cake, and Francis thus addressed himself: 'I will not, like that
+glutton Henry, eat up my cake at once, and so be sick as he was; no, I
+will make my pleasure last a great deal longer.' So he took the cake,
+which he could hardly lift by reason of its weight, and watched the
+opportunity of slipping up into his chamber with it, where his box
+was, and in which he put it under lock and key. At playtime every day
+he slipped away from his companions, went upstairs a-tiptoe, cut a
+tolerable slice off, swallowed it, put by the rest, and then came down
+and mixed again with his companions. He continued this clandestine
+business all the week, and even then the cake was hardly half
+consumed. But what ensued? At last the cake grew dry, and quickly
+after moldy; nay, the very maggots got into it, and by that means had
+their share; on which account it was not then worth eating, and our
+young curmudgeon was compelled to fling the rest away with great
+reluctance. However, no one grieved for him."
+
+_Percival_. No, indeed; nor I, father. What, keep a cake locked up
+seven days together, and not give one's friends a bit! That is
+monstrous! But let us have the other now.
+
+"There was another little gentleman who went to school with Henry and
+Francis likewise, and his name was Gratian. His mother sent him a cake
+one day, because she loved him, and, indeed, he loved her also very
+much. It was no sooner come than Gratian thus addressed his young
+companions: 'Come and look at what mother has sent me; you must every
+one eat with me.' They scarcely needed such a welcome piece of
+information twice, but all got round the cake, as you have doubtless
+seen the bees resorting to a flower just blown. As Gratian was
+provided with a knife, he cut a great piece off, and then divided it
+into as many shares as he had brought boys together by such a
+courteous invitation. Gratian then took up the rest, and told them
+that he would eat his piece next day; on which he put it up, and went
+to play with his companions, who were all solicitous to have him
+choose whatever game he thought might entertain him most.
+
+"A quarter of an hour had scarcely passed as they were playing, when a
+poor old man, who had a fiddle, came into the yard.
+
+"He had a very long white beard, and, being blind, was guided by a
+little dog, who went before him with a collar round his neck. To this
+a cord was fastened, which the poor blind man held in his hand.
+
+"It was noticed with how much dexterity the little dog conducted him,
+and how he shook a bell, which, I forgot to say, hung underneath his
+collar, when he came near any one, as if he had designed to say by
+such an action, 'Do not throw down or run against my master.' Being
+come into the yard, he sat him down upon a stone, and, hearing several
+children talking round him, 'My dear little gentlemen,' said he, 'I
+will play you all the pretty tunes that I know, if you will give me
+leave.' The children wished for nothing half so much. He put his
+violin in tune, and then thrummed over several jigs and other scraps
+of music, which, it was easy to conjecture, had been new in former
+times.
+
+"Little Gratian saw that while he played his merriest airs, a tear
+would now and then roll down his cheeks, on which he stopped to ask
+him why he wept?
+
+"'Because,' said the musician, 'I am very hungry. I have no one in the
+world that will give my dog or me a bit of of anything to eat. I wish
+I could but work, and get for both of us a morsel of something; but I
+have lost my strength and sight. Alas! I labored hard till I was old,
+and now I want bread.'
+
+"The generous Gratian, hearing this, wept too. He did not say a word,
+but ran to fetch the cake which he had designed to eat himself. He
+brought it out with joy, and, as he ran along, began: 'Here, good old
+man, here is some cake for you.'
+
+"'Where?' replied the poor musician, feeling with his hands; 'where is
+it? For I am blind, and cannot see you.'
+
+"Gratian put the cake into his hand, when, laying down his fiddle on
+the ground, he wiped his eyes, and then began to eat. At every piece
+he put into his mouth, he gave his faithful little dog a bit, who came
+and ate out of his hand; and Gratian, standing by him, smiled with
+pleasure at the thought of having fed the poor old man when he was
+hungry."
+
+_Percival_. Oh, the good, good Gratian! Let me have your knife,
+father.
+
+_Mr. G._ Here, Percival; but why my knife?
+
+_Percival_. I will tell you. I have only nibbled here a little of my
+cake, so pleased I was in listening to you! So I will cut it smooth.
+There, see how well I have ordered it! These scraps, together with the
+currants, will be more than I shall want for breakfast; and the first
+poor man that I meet going home shall have the rest, even though he
+should not play upon the violin.
+
+
+
+
+AMENDMENT
+
+
+Charles Grant lived in a good house, and wore fine clothes, and had a
+great many pretty toys to play with; yet Charles was seldom happy or
+pleased; for he was never good. He did not mind what his mother said
+to him, and would not learn to read, though he was now seven years
+old.
+
+He called the servants names, pinched and beat his little sister
+Clara, and took away her playthings, and was not kind and good to her,
+as a brother should be. "Oh, what a sad boy Charles is!" was his
+mother's daily bitter exclamation.
+
+His father was a proud, bad man, who let Charles have his own way,
+because he was his only son, and he thought him handsome. But how
+could anyone be handsome that was so naughty? I am sure that when he
+was froward, and put out his lip, and frowned, he looked quite ugly.
+Mother told him so, and said that no one was pretty that was not good;
+but Charles did not mind his mother, and was so vain he would stand
+before the looking-glass half the day, instead of learning his
+lessons; and was so silly he would say, "What a pretty little boy I
+am! I am glad I am not a shabby boy, like Giles Bloomfield, our
+cowboy." At such times his mother would say to him: "I wish, Charles,
+you were only half as good as Giles; he is not much older than you,
+yet he can read in the Bible quite well; he works hard for his poor
+mother, and never vexes her, as you do me; and when he comes home of
+an evening, he nurses the baby, and is kind to all his sisters. I dare
+say he never pinched nor beat any of them in his life."
+
+"Oh!" said that wicked Charles, "I hate him for all that, for he wears
+ragged clothes, and has no toys to play with."
+
+"Oh fie, Charles!" said his mother; "you are a wicked boy: have not I
+often told you that God made the poor as well as the rich, and He will
+hate those who despise them? Now, Charles, if God, to punish you for
+your pride, were to take away your father and me, and you had no money
+to buy food, and your clothes became old and ragged, you would then
+be a poor, shabby boy, and worse off than Giles; for you could not
+earn your own living, as he does; and you would consequently be
+starved to death if God did not take care of you. And if, while you
+were rich, you hated the poor, how could you expect God to care for
+you when you grew poor, like those you had scorned?"
+
+But Charles, however, was so naughty he would not stay to hear what
+his mother said, but ran away into the fields.
+
+Then Charles's mother was so vexed that she could not help crying at
+his being such a wicked, proud boy; and she could not sleep all that
+night for the grief his conduct had occasioned her. The next day she
+was forced to take a long journey to visit a friend who was very ill,
+and who lived in London. She was very sorry to leave her children, for
+she knew if Charles behaved naughty when she was with him, he would be
+a sad boy indeed when he was left to himself, and had none to correct
+him and tell him of his faults.
+
+When the carriage that was to take Mrs. Grant to London drove to the
+door, she kissed her children a great many times, and begged that they
+would be very good while she was away from them.
+
+"You, my dear Clara, I know, will mind what nurse says to you, and
+will try to be good while I am gone; for you know that God will see
+everything you do amiss, if I do not; and I hope you will never forget
+to say your prayers to Him night and morning."
+
+Clara kissed her dear mother, and promised that she would attend to
+all she said; and her mother was satisfied, for she knew that Clara
+never told stories, though she was but a little girl.
+
+Then Mrs. Grant turned to Charles, and said: "As for you, Charles, I
+cannot help feeling great pain at leaving you; for you are such a bad,
+wilful boy that I shall not have a happy moment while I am away from
+you, lest you should do anything amiss. But if you love me, you will
+try to be good; and whenever you are about to do anything wrong, say
+to yourself, 'How much this would grieve my poor mother if she knew
+it! and how much it will offend God, who does see, and knows, not
+only everything I do, but even my most secret thoughts! And He will
+one day bring me to an account for all I do or say against His holy
+will and my kind parents' commands.'"
+
+Charles, who knew he was a bad boy, hung down his head, for he did not
+like to be told of his faults.
+
+Then his mother said: "My dear Charles, do try and be good, and I will
+love you dearly."
+
+"But what will you bring me from London," said Charles, "if I am a
+good boy? for I never will behave well for nothing."
+
+"Do you call the love of God and of dear mother nothing?" said Clara;
+"I will behave well, even if mother forgets to bring me the great wax
+doll, and the chest of drawers to keep her clothes in, which she told
+me about yesterday."
+
+Mrs. Grant smiled fondly on her little girl, but made no reply to
+Charles; and soon the coach drove away from the door.
+
+Charles was very glad when his mother was gone, and he said: "Now
+mother is gone to London, I will do just as I please: I will learn no
+ugly lessons, but play all day long. How happy I shall be! I hope
+mother may not come for a whole month."
+
+But Charles soon found he was not so happy as he thought he should
+have been; he did not know the reason, but I will tell you why he was
+not happy. No one can be happy who is not good, and Charles was so
+naughty as to resolve not to obey his kind mother, who loved him so
+much.
+
+Charles brought out all his toys to play with, but he soon grew weary
+of them, and he kicked them under the table, saying, "Nasty dull toys,
+I hate you, for you do not amuse me or make me happy. I will go to
+father, and ask him to give me something to please me that I am not
+used to."
+
+But father was busy with some friends in the study, and could not
+attend to his wants. Charles was a rude, tiresome boy; so he stood by
+his father, and shook his chair, and pulled his sleeve, and teased him
+so much that his father at last grew angry, and turned him out of the
+room.
+
+Then Charles stood and kicked at the door, and screamed with all his
+might, when one of the gentlemen said to him: "If you were my little
+boy, I would give you something to cry for." So Charles's father told
+him if he did not go away, he would come out of the study and whip
+him.
+
+When Charles heard this, he ran away, for he was afraid of being
+beaten; but, instead of playing quietly with his toys, he went and
+laid under the great table in the hall and sulked and fretted till
+dinner-time.
+
+When nurse came to call him to dinner, he said: "I won't come; Go
+away, ugly nurse!"
+
+Then said nurse: "Master Charles, if you like to punish yourself by
+going without your dinner, no one will prevent you, I am sure."
+
+Then Charles began to cry aloud, and tried to tear nurse's apron; but
+nurse told him he was a bad boy, and left him.
+
+Now, when Clara sat down to dinner, she said to nurse: "Where is
+brother Charles? Why is he not here?"
+
+"Miss Clara, he is a naughty child," said nurse, "and chooses to go
+without his dinner, thinking to vex us; but he hurts no one but
+himself with his perverse temper."
+
+"Then," said Clara, "I do not like to dine while Charles goes without;
+so I will try and persuade him to come and eat some pie."
+
+"Well, Miss Clara," said nurse, "you may go, if you please; but I
+would leave the bad boy to himself."
+
+When Clara came to Charles, and asked him if he would come and eat his
+dinner, he poked out his head, and made such an ugly face that she was
+quite frightened at him, and ran away.
+
+Nurse did not take the trouble of calling him to tea; and, though he
+was very hungry, he was too sulky to come without being asked; so he
+lay under the table, and cried aloud till bedtime. But when it grew
+dark, he was afraid to stay by himself, for bad children are always
+fearful; so he came upstairs and said in a cross, rude tone of voice:
+"Nurse, give me something to eat."
+
+Nurse said: "Master Charles, if you had been good, you would have had
+some chicken and some apple-pie for your dinner, and bread and butter
+and cake for your tea; but as you were such a bad boy, and would not
+come to your meals, I shall only give you a piece of dry bread and a
+cup of milk, and you do not deserve even that."
+
+Then Charles made one of his very worst faces, and threw the bread on
+the ground, and spilt the milk.
+
+Nurse told him that there were many poor children in the world who
+would be glad of the smallest morsel of what he so much despised, and
+that the time would come when he might want the very worst bit of it;
+and she bade him kneel down and say his prayers, and ask God to
+forgive him for having been such a wicked boy all day.
+
+But Charles did not mind what she said, and went crying to bed. Thus
+ended the first day of Charles Grant's happiness.
+
+He awoke very early the next morning, and told nurse to get him his
+breakfast, for he was very hungry. But nurse said he must wait till
+eight o'clock, which was the breakfast hour.
+
+He now found it was of no use sulking, as no one seemed to care for
+his tempers; so he looked about for something to eat, but found
+nothing but the piece of bread he had thrown on the ground the night
+before; and he was glad to eat that, and only wished there had been
+more of it.
+
+As soon as breakfast was over, Clara brought her books, and began to
+learn her lessons, and nurse asked Charles if he would do the same.
+But Charles said, "No, indeed! I do not mean to learn any lessons
+while mother is away, for I mean to please myself and be happy."
+
+"You did as you pleased yesterday, Master Charles," said nurse; "yet I
+do not think you were so very happy, unless happiness consists in
+lying under a table and crying all day, and going without dinner and
+tea, merely to indulge a sullen, froward temper."
+
+Now, Charles hated to be told of his faults, so he left nurse, and
+went into the garden to try and amuse himself. When there, instead of
+keeping in the walks, as he ought to have done, he ran on the beds,
+trampled down the flowers, and pulled the blossoms from the
+fruit-trees.
+
+The gardener's boy earnestly requested Charles not to do so much
+mischief; but Charles told him he was a gentleman's son, and would do
+as he pleased. So he again ran over the new-raked borders, and pulled
+up the flowers; and the poor boy was sadly vexed to see his nice work
+all spoiled.
+
+Charles did not care for that, and would have behaved still worse, had
+not the gardener, who then came up, taken him in his arms, and carried
+him into the house, in spite of his kicking and screaming. He cried
+for a long time, and made a sad noise; but, finding that no one paid
+any regard to him, he became quiet, and went into the nursery, and
+asked Clara to come and play with him.
+
+"I cannot come just now, brother Charles," said she; "for I want to
+finish this frock that I am making for Giles Bloomfield's little
+sister."
+
+"I am sure," said Charles, "if I were you, I would much rather play
+than sit still and sew."
+
+"Not if you knew what pleasure there is in doing good," said Clara;
+"but if you will wait till I have finished it, you shall go with me
+and give it to the poor woman, and then you will see how pleased she
+will be, and how nicely the baby will look when she is dressed in this
+pretty frock, instead of her old faded, ragged one."
+
+Charles did not know how to amuse himself, so he sat down on his
+little stool, and watched his sister while she worked.
+
+When Clara had finished making the frock, she said: "Thank you, dear
+nurse, for cutting out and fixing the frock for me." So she threw her
+arms round nurse's neck, and kissed her cheek; and nurse put on
+Clara's tippet and her new bonnet, and walked with Charles and her to
+Dame Bloomfield's cottage.
+
+The good woman took the baby out of the cradle, and laid it on Clara's
+lap, and Clara had the pleasure of dressing it herself in the nice new
+frock; and the baby looked so neat and pretty, and the poor mother was
+so pleased, that Clara was much happier than if she had spent her time
+in playing or working for her doll.
+
+While Clara was nursing and caressing the baby, Charles went into the
+little garden, where he found Giles Bloomfield, who had just returned
+from working in the fields, with a beautiful milk-white rabbit in his
+arms, which he had taken out of the hutch, and was nursing with much
+affection.
+
+"Oh, what a pretty rabbit!" said Charles. "Giles, will you sell it to
+me?"
+
+"No, Master Charles," said Giles, "I cannot sell my pretty Snowball."
+
+"And why not?" asked Charles in a fretful tone.
+
+"Because, Master Charles, the old doe, its mother, died when Snowball
+was only a week old, and I reared it by feeding it with warm milk and
+bran; and it is now so fond of me that I would not part with it for a
+great deal."
+
+So saying, he stroked his pretty favorite, who licked his hand all
+over, and rubbed her soft white head against his fingers.
+
+Then Giles said: "My dear Snowball, I would not sell you for the
+world."
+
+"But you shall sell Snowball to me," said Charles, making one of his
+ugly faces. "I will give you a shilling for her; and if you do not let
+me carry her home this very day, I will tell father of you, and he
+will turn you out of the cottage."
+
+When Giles's mother heard Charles say so, she came out of the house,
+and said: "Pray, Giles, let Master Charles have the rabbit."
+
+"Dear mother," said Giles, "Master Charles has a pony and a dog, and a
+great many fine toys to play with, and I have only my pretty Snowball;
+and it will break my heart to part with her."
+
+"Then," said his mother, "would you rather see your mother and sisters
+turned out of doors than part with your rabbit? You know, Giles, that
+I had so many expenses with your poor father's illness and death that
+I have not paid the rent due last quarter-day; and you know it is in
+our landlord's power to turn us into the streets to-morrow."
+
+"Well, mother," cried Giles, bursting into tears, "Master Charles must
+have the rabbit. But oh!" continued he, "he does not love you as I do,
+my pretty Snowball; he will not feed and take care of you as I have
+done, and you will soon die, and I shall never see you again." And his
+tears fell fast on the white head of his little pet as he spoke.
+
+Clara was quite grieved, and begged her naughty brother not to
+deprive poor Giles of his rabbit; but Charles was a wicked and
+covetous boy; he therefore took Snowball from Giles, and carried her
+home in his arms, and put her in a box. He went into the fields and
+gathered some green herbs for her to eat, and said: "I am glad I have
+got Snowball; now I shall be quite happy."
+
+But how could Charles be happy when he had broken God's holy
+commandment, which says, "Thou shalt not covet?" Nurse and Clara told
+him so, and begged him to give Snowball back again to Giles. But
+Charles said he would not, for he meant to keep her all his life; but
+the next morning, when he went into the stable to look at her, he
+found her stretched at the bottom of the box. He called her, but
+Snowball did not stir; he then took her out of the box to see what
+ailed her; but she was quite cold and dead.
+
+Oh dear! how Charles did cry! But it was of no use. He had better not
+have taken her away from Giles, for he did not know what to feed her
+with, and had given her among the greens he had gathered a herb called
+hemlock, which is poisonous and will kill whatever eats of it; and it
+had killed poor Snowball.
+
+The coachman told Charles so when he saw how swollen she was, and
+Charles cried the more. Giles cried too when he heard what a sad death
+poor Snowball had died; but he had been a good dutiful boy in parting
+with her when his mother wished it, though it had cost him much pain
+and many tears.
+
+Well, Charles's mother was gone a long time, more than a month, and it
+would quite shock you to be told how naughty Charles was all that
+time; at last a letter came to say she was very ill, and then another
+to tell them she was dead.
+
+What would Charles then have given if he had not grieved her so often
+with his perverse temper and wicked conduct? He now said when he saw
+her again, he would beg her to forgive him; but when Charles did see
+his poor mother again she was in her coffin and could not hear him;
+and he cried exceedingly, and wished he had been good. Clara, though
+she cried as much as Charles for her dear mother, was glad she had
+obeyed her, and been so good while she was away.
+
+"And I will always be as good as if dear mother could see me, and love
+me for it too," said she to nurse the day after her mother was buried.
+
+"My dear young lady," said nurse, "your mother _will_ see it, and love
+you for doing your duty."
+
+"How can dear mother see me? Her eyes are closed, and she is in the
+dark grave," said Clara.
+
+"But she will see you from heaven, Miss Clara, where she is gone to
+receive the reward of her good conduct in this world; for though her
+body is in the earth, her spirit is in heaven."
+
+"And shall I never see my own dear mother again?" said Clara.
+
+"Yes, Miss Clara; if you are good, you will go to heaven when you die,
+and become an angel like her."
+
+"Then," said Clara, "I will pray to God to make me good, and when I am
+going to do anything wrong I will say to myself, 'If I do this, I
+shall never go to heaven, and see my dear mother when I die.'"
+
+"I wish," said nurse, "that Master Charles was like you, and would try
+to be good."
+
+But though Charles was sometimes sorry for his bad behavior, he did
+not try to mend, because he thought it was too much trouble to be
+good, and said he did not care, because he was the son of a gentleman.
+
+Charles did not know that at this very time his father had spent all
+his money, and owed a great many debts to different people; and at
+last he ran away that he might not be put in prison; and the people to
+whom he owed so much money came and seized his fine house and gardens,
+and the coach, and all the furniture, and sold them by auction, to
+raise money to pay the debts; so Charles found that, instead of being
+rich, he was now very, very poor.
+
+When the auction was over and all the things were sold, and it was
+getting quite dark (for it was in the month of November), Clara and
+Charles stood in one of the empty parlors, and wondered what they
+should do for supper, and where they should sleep that night; for all
+the beds were sold, and they saw the servants go away one after
+another.
+
+At last nurse came in with her bonnet and cloak, and said: "Miss
+Clara, I am going away to my own cottage, and as you have always been
+a kind, good child, you shall go with me, and I will take care of
+you."
+
+Then Clara said, "Thank you; but will you not take Charles also?"
+
+"No," said nurse; "he has always been such a proud bad boy that I will
+not take him. I have very little to spare, for I am a poor woman, and
+what I have is not more than will keep my own children and you, Miss
+Clara."
+
+Saying this, she got into the cart, and took Clara on her lap, and one
+of the footmen got in after her, and drove away from the door.
+
+Charles stood on the step of the door, and looked after them till they
+were out of sight; and then he began to cry as if his heart would
+break. The servant of the gentleman who had purchased the house came
+and locked the door, so Charles could not get in any more, and he sat
+down on the stone steps, and covered his face with his hands, and
+cried bitterly.
+
+"Unhappy child that I am," sobbed he; "what will become of me? Oh, if
+I had but been good like Clara, I should have found a friend, as she
+has; but no one cares what becomes of me, because I have been so
+wicked. I used to despise the poor, and God, to punish me, has made me
+poor indeed."
+
+It was very cold, and the snow began to fall fast, and it grew quite
+dark. Charles rested his head on his knees, and was afraid to look
+round; his clothes were almost wet through, and his limbs were
+benumbed with cold; he had no place where he could ask shelter, for no
+one loved him; and he thought he should be obliged to stay there all
+night, and perhaps be frozen to death.
+
+Just then some one softly touched his hand, and said: "Master Charles,
+I have been looking for you for more than an hour."
+
+Charles looked up; but when he saw it was Giles Bloomfield who had
+come to seek him in his distress, he remembered how ill he had behaved
+to him, so he hid his face, and began to weep afresh.
+
+Then Giles sat down by him on the steps, and said: "Dear Master
+Charles, you must not stay here. See how fast it snows. You will catch
+your death of cold."
+
+"Yes, I am very cold and hungry," sobbed Charles, "but I have no home
+now; I have nowhere else to go, and must stay here all night."
+
+"No, Master Charles," said Giles, "you shall come home with me, and
+shall share my supper and my bed, though it is not such as you have
+been used to; notwithstanding we are very poor, we will do our best to
+make you comfortable."
+
+"Oh, Giles!" said Charles, throwing his arms round Giles's neck, "I do
+not deserve this kindness; I have been such a proud, wicked boy, and
+have treated you so ill. I am sure you can never forgive me for having
+taken your pretty Snowball; and if _you_ forgive me, I can never
+forgive myself."
+
+"Dear Master Charles, do not think of that now," said Giles, taking
+both Charles's cold hands in his. "Indeed, Master Charles, I should
+never dare say my prayers if I was so wicked as to bear malice; and,
+now you are in distress, I would do anything in my power to serve you.
+So pray come home with me, and warm yourself, and get some supper."
+
+But Charles hid his face on Giles's bosom, and cried the more; at last
+he said:
+
+"Giles, I am so ashamed of having behaved so cruelly to you, that I
+can never go to your home, and eat the food that you are obliged to
+labor so hard for."
+
+"Master Charles," said Giles, "that is because you are so proud."
+
+"Oh no, no!" sobbed Charles, "I am not proud now, and I think I shall
+never be proud again." So he kissed Giles, and they both went home to
+Dame Bloomfield's cottage together.
+
+When Giles's mother saw Charles, she said: "Why did you bring this
+proud, cross, young gentleman here, Giles?"
+
+Charles, when he heard her say so, thought he should be turned out
+again into the cold, and began to cry afresh; but Giles said:
+
+"Dear mother, Master Charles has no home to go to now; he is cold and
+hungry; I am sure you will let him stay here, and share my bed and my
+supper."
+
+"He can stay here if he likes," said Dame Bloomfield; "but you know,
+Giles, we are forced to work hard for what food we have, and I am sure
+we cannot afford to maintain Master Charles."
+
+"Then," said Giles, "he shall have my supper to-night: he wants it
+more than I do, for he has had no food all day."
+
+"You may please yourself about that, Giles: but remember, if you give
+your food to Master Charles, you must go without yourself."
+
+"Well," said Giles, "I shall feel more pleasure in giving my supper to
+Master Charles than in eating it myself."
+
+So he brought a stool, and, placing it in the warmest corner by the
+fire, made Charles sit down, and chafed his cold frozen hands, and
+tried to comfort him; for Charles was greatly afflicted when he saw
+that everyone hated him; but he knew that it was his own fault, and a
+just punishment for his pride and bad conduct.
+
+When Giles brought his basin of hot milk and bread for his supper, he
+could not thank him for crying; and he was ashamed to eat it while
+Giles went without; but he was so hungry, and the milk looked so nice,
+that he did not know how to refuse it; and Giles begged him so
+earnestly to eat that at last he did so, and once more felt warm and
+comfortable.
+
+Then Giles said to him: "Now, Master Charles, will you go to bed? Mine
+is but a coarse, hard bed, but it is very clean." So he took the lamp
+to show Charles the way to the chamber in which he was to sleep.
+
+Charles was surprised at seeing no staircase, but only a ladder. Giles
+laughed when he saw how Charles stared, and he said:
+
+"You have been used to live in a grand house, Master Charles, and know
+nothing of the shifts the poor are forced to make."
+
+Then Charles climbed up the ladder, and Giles showed him a little
+room, not much larger than a closet, with no furniture in it, but a
+stump bed without any hangings, and covered with a coarse, woolen
+rug. Charles Grant had never even seen such a bed before, but he was
+thankful that he could get any place to sleep in, out of the cold and
+snow.
+
+Giles helped Charles to undress, for Charles was so helpless he did
+not know how to undress himself. When he was going to step into bed,
+Giles exclaimed:
+
+"Will you not say your prayers before you go to bed, Master Charles?"
+
+Charles blushed and hung down his head, for he had been so naughty
+that he had not said his prayers for a long time past, and had almost
+forgotten what his dear mother had taught him; and he told Giles so at
+last.
+
+"Dear, dear!" said Giles, "I never dare go to bed without saying
+mine."
+
+Then Charles said: "I am sorry I have been so naughty as to forget my
+prayers; will you teach me yours, and I will never forget them again?"
+
+Then they both knelt down by the side of the little bed, and Giles
+taught Charles such prayers as he knew, and Charles went to bed much
+happier than he had been for a long time.
+
+Though the bed was hard, and the sheets brown and coarse, Charles was
+so weary that he soon fell asleep, and slept so soundly that he did
+not awake till it was broad day, and Giles was up and gone to work in
+the fields.
+
+When Charles looked round he thought he had never seen such a shabby
+room in his life. There was not so much as a chair or table or carpet
+in it; he could see all the thatch and the rafters in the roof, for
+the chamber was not even ceiled, but showed the thatch and rafters,
+and, as I said before, there was not a single article of furniture in
+the room, except the bed. How different from the pretty little chamber
+in which Charles used to sleep, with the nice white dimity
+window-curtains and hangings and mahogany tent-bed, with such
+comfortable bedding and handsome white counterpane! However, he now
+thought himself very fortunate that he had any roof to shelter him, or
+any bed, however homely it might be, on which he could sleep.
+
+He thought he should like to get up and go downstairs, but he had
+always been used to have a servant to dress him, and he did not know
+how to dress himself, so while he was considering what he should do
+Giles came into the chamber. He had returned to get his breakfast, and
+not seeing Charles downstairs he concluded the cause of his absence,
+and came to assist him to dress. Charles observed how this matter was
+arranged, and resolved to do it for himself the next morning.
+
+When he was dressed they both knelt down by the bedside and said their
+prayers, for though Giles had said his at the dawn of day, yet he
+never omitted an opportunity of repeating his thanksgivings and
+praises to his heavenly Father for the mercies and blessings which he
+enjoyed through His grace, for Giles possessed a grateful and
+contented heart, which made him look upon that state of life unto
+which it had pleased God to call him, as that which was meet and fit
+for him, so he worked hard, and ate the bread of labor with
+cheerfulness and satisfaction.
+
+When Charles and Giles joined the family below Dame Bloomfield set a
+porringer of milk and a piece of brown bread for every one but
+Charles, who looked ready to cry, but Giles put his porringer before
+him, and gave him another spoon, and said: "Master Charles, we will
+eat together, for there will be enough for both of us." The tears came
+into Charles's eyes, and he whispered: "Dear Giles, you are very
+good." So these boys ate out of the same porringer, and broke of the
+same bread.
+
+After breakfast Giles went out to work, and Charles thought it very
+dull till he returned to dinner. When Dame Bloomfield gave her
+children their dinners there was a dumpling for everyone but Charles;
+then Giles cut his dumpling in half, and gave one part to Charles, and
+ate the other half himself. Now this was very good of Giles, for he
+was very hungry himself, but he could not bear to see Charles sad and
+hungry while he was eating, and Giles liked to do good because he knew
+it was pleasing to God.
+
+As soon as dinner was over, Giles went out to work again, and Charles
+was as dull as he had been in the morning, for all the family were at
+work in some way or other, and could not spare time to amuse or talk
+to him, and he did nothing but sigh and fret to himself till evening,
+when Giles came home from work.
+
+Giles's eldest sister made a bright fire, and they all sat round it
+and talked and told stories, and Giles nursed the baby, and played
+with the other little ones, and seemed quite happy, and so he was, for
+he had done his duty, and every one loved him for being so good.
+
+After supper Giles taught those of his sisters who were old enough to
+read and write, and when they had finished learning their tasks
+Charles took up the book, and said: "Giles, will you teach me to
+read?" and Giles said: "Certainly, Master Charles, but I am sure you
+must know how to read a great deal better than such a poor boy as I
+am."
+
+"I might have done so," said Charles, "but Giles, I was a sad,
+naughty, perverse boy, and hated to learn any thing that was good; but
+I hope I know better now, and if you will only take the trouble of
+teaching me I will try and make up for my lost time."
+
+So Giles gave Charles a lesson that very night, and every evening
+after supper he heard him read and spell what he had learned during
+the day, and Charles took such pains that he soon began to read so
+well that he used to amuse himself by reading pretty stories, and by
+teaching little Betty, one of Giles's youngest sisters, to read.
+
+Still Charles used to be exceedingly hungry, for he had not more than
+half the quantity of food he was used to eat, and Giles was hungry
+too, and grew pale and thin.
+
+Then Charles said to himself: "It is not right for me to eat the bread
+which poor Giles works so hard to earn; I will try and get my own
+living, for why should I not do so, as well as Giles?" So one morning,
+when Giles rose, as usual, at five o'clock, Charles got up too. Then
+Giles said:
+
+"Why do you rise so early this cold morning, Master Charles?"
+
+"Because I am going out to work with you, Giles, if you will permit
+me," answered Charles.
+
+"Oh, Master Charles, such work as I do is not fit for a young
+gentleman like you," said Giles.
+
+"You must not call me a young gentleman _now_, for I am only a poor
+boy, and poorer than other poor boys, for they can earn their own
+living, while I should have been starved to death had not you given me
+half of the bread you work so hard for. But I will not be a burthen to
+you any longer, but learn to work and get my own living as you do."
+
+Charles now meant to keep his word, and they both went out into the
+fields, and worked together at picking stones off the young crops of
+wheat and clover, and before breakfast. Giles had picked up two
+bushels of stones and Charles one, and the farmer gave them a penny
+per bushel for gathering them up.
+
+Then they made haste back to the cottage, and Giles gave his mother
+the money he had earned, and Charles did the same, and when the dame
+poured out the milk for the family Charles saw that she filled a
+porringer for him also, and they had all a good breakfast that
+morning, and Charles felt quite happy because he had not eaten the
+bread of idleness. So he went out to work with Giles again, and earned
+twopence before dinner.
+
+When Dame Bloomfield took up the dumplings Charles saw there was one
+for him, and he felt happy that poor Giles had not to deprive himself
+of half his food that he might eat.
+
+Charles went out to work every day with Giles, and in the evening he
+learned to read and write. He became quite good and gentle, and
+enjoyed more happiness than he had experienced in his life before, And
+why was Charles happy? I will tell you, my dear children. Because he
+was no longer a proud, froward boy as he had been, but was kind and
+sweet-tempered to every one, and did his duty both to God and himself.
+
+The winter passed swiftly away, and the spring came, and the birds
+began to sing, and the trees looked green and gay, and the pretty
+flowers bloomed in the gardens and covered the meadows all over, and
+scented the air with their fragrance, and Charles thought it very
+pleasant to work in the fields, and hear the birds sing as they tended
+their young, or built their nests among the green boughs or in the
+hedges.
+
+One day Giles said to Charles: "Master Charles, we cannot work
+together in the fields any more; I have got a new employment"
+
+"But why cannot I work with you?" asked Charles.
+
+"Because, sir, you will not like to work where I am going," answered
+Giles. Charles asked where that was. "In the garden of the great
+house, Master Charles, where you used to live," said Giles.
+
+Charles looked very sorrowful, and remained silent for some minutes;
+at last he said: "Well, Giles, I will go with you; my clothes are
+grown shabby now, and nobody will know me, and if they did I hope I am
+too wise to be ashamed of doing my duty, so let us go directly."
+
+Then Giles took Charles into the garden, and the gardener gave them
+each a hoe and a rake, and told them to hoe up the weeds on the flower
+borders, and then rake them neatly over, and promised if they worked
+well he would give them eight-pence per day.
+
+Now this was much pleasanter than picking stones in the field, but
+Charles was very sad, and could not refrain from shedding tears when
+he thought of the time when he used to play in that very garden, and
+he thought, too, of his dear mamma who was dead, and of his sister
+Clara, whom he had not seen for so many months, but he worked as hard
+as he could, and the gardener praised them both, and he gave them a
+basket to put the weeds in, and showed them how to rake the borders
+smooth.
+
+Just as they had finished the job, and Charles was saying to Giles,
+"How neat our work looks!" a little boy, dressed very fine, came into
+the garden, and, as he passed them, said: "I am glad I am a
+gentleman's son, and not obliged to work like these dirty boys."
+
+When Charles thought the little boy was out of hearing, he said to
+Giles: "That little boy is as wicked as I used to be, and I doubt not
+but that God will punish him in the same way if he does not mend his
+manners."
+
+The little boy, who had overheard what Charles said, was very angry,
+and made ugly faces, and ran into the newly-raked beds, and covered
+them with footmarks. Then Charles said: "I am sorry for you, young
+gentleman, for I see you are not good."
+
+"How dare you say I am not good?" said this naughty child. "I am a
+great deal better than you, for I am a gentleman, and you are only a
+poor boy."
+
+"Yes," said Charles, his eyes filling with tears as he spoke, "I am,
+indeed, only a poor boy _now_, but I was once rich like you, and lived
+in this very house, and wore fine clothes, and had plenty of toys and
+money, and was just as proud and naughty as you are, but God, to
+punish me, took away my parents and all those things that I had been
+so proud of, and that I had made such a bad use of, and reduced me to
+a poor boy, as you see."
+
+When the little boy heard this he looked very serious, and said: "I
+have been very naughty, but I will do so no more," and he went into
+the house, and never teased Charles or Giles again.
+
+A few months after this, when Charles and Giles were working as usual
+in the garden, they saw a gentleman come down one of the walks,
+leading by the hand a little girl dressed in a black silk frock and
+bonnet trimmed with crape.
+
+"Ah, Giles," said Charles, "how like that young lady is to my sister
+Clara. I wonder whether I shall ever see my dear sister Clara again."
+
+"Brother Charles, dear brother Charles, you have not then quite
+forgotten your sister Clara," said the little girl, throwing her arms
+round his neck as she spoke.
+
+When Charles saw that it was, indeed, his own dear sister Clara, he
+kissed her and cried with joy.
+
+Then he told Clara all that had happened to him since the day they had
+parted, and how sorry he had been for all his past conduct, and he
+asked her who the gentleman was that had brought her into the garden.
+
+"It is our uncle, dear Charles. You know our dear mother had a brother
+who lived in India that she used frequently to talk about. Well, when
+he came home, and heard that mother was dead, and we were in distress,
+he came to nurse's cottage, and took me home to his house, and has
+now come to find you, for he is very good and kind, and loves us both
+for our dear mother's sake."
+
+"And will he take me home too?" said Charles.
+
+"Yes, my boy," said Charles's uncle, taking him by the hand, "because
+you are good and kind, and are no longer cross and proud, as I heard
+you used to be. You shall come home with me this very day, if you
+please, and I will teach you everything that a young gentleman should
+know, and you and Clara shall be my children so long as you continue
+to be deserving of my love, and are not unkind, nor despise those who
+are beneath you in situation."
+
+"Indeed, uncle," said Charles, "I can now feel for the poor, and I
+would rather remain as I am than be rich if I thought I should ever
+behave as I used to do."
+
+"My dear child," said his uncle, kissing him with great affection,
+"continue to think so, and you will never act amiss. The first and
+greatest step toward amendment is acknowledging our faults. What is
+passed shall be remembered no more, and I doubt not but that we shall
+all be happy for the time to come."
+
+"But uncle," said Charles, laying his hand on his uncle's arm, "I have
+something to ask of you."
+
+"Well, Charles, and what would you have of me?" said his uncle.
+
+Then Charles led Giles to his uncle, and related all he had done for
+him; how he had taken him to his own home, and given him half of his
+food and his bed, and taught him to read and to work; he, likewise,
+told his uncle how ill he had behaved to Giles in depriving him of his
+pretty Snowball, and he said: "Dear uncle, will you allow Giles to
+share my good fortune, for I cannot be happy while he is in want, and
+he is better than me, for he returned good for evil."
+
+Then his uncle said: "Charles, I should not have loved you had you
+forgotten your kind friend." And he asked Giles if he would like to go
+to his house and live with him, and spend his time in learning to read
+and write, and in improving his mind, instead of hard labor.
+
+"I should like it very much indeed, sir," said Giles, "but I cannot
+accept your kind offer."
+
+"And why not, my good little friend?"
+
+"Because, sir," said Giles, bursting into tears, "my poor mother and
+sisters must go to the workhouse or starve if I did not stay and work
+for them, and I could not be happy if I lived in a fine house, and
+knew they were in want of a bit of bread to eat."
+
+"Then," said the gentleman smiling, "for your sake they shall never
+want anything, for I will put them into a cottage of my own, and will
+take care of them, and you shall live with me, and I will love you as
+if you were my own child, and remember, Giles, I do this as a reward
+for your kindness to Charles when he was unhappy and in great
+distress."
+
+Charles's uncle was as good as his word, and Giles received the
+blessings of a good education, while his mother and sisters were
+maintained by the benevolence of his benefactor.
+
+Charles was so careful not to relapse into his former errors that he
+became as remarkable for his gentleness and the goodness of his heart
+as he had formerly been for his pride and unkindness, and in the
+diligent performance of his duty, both to God and man, he proved to
+his uncle the sincerity of his amendment.
+
+
+
+
+TRIAL
+
+_Of a Complaint made against Sundry Persons for Breaking in the
+Windows of Dorothy Careful, Widow and Dealer in Gingerbread_
+
+By JOHN AIKIN AND MRS. BARBAULD
+
+
+The court being sat, there appeared in person the widow Dorothy
+Careful to make a complaint against Henry Luckless, and other person
+or persons unknown, for breaking three panes of glass, value
+ninepence, in the house of the said widow. Being directed to tell her
+case to the court, she made a curtsey and began as follows:
+
+"Please, your lordship, I was sitting at work by my fireside between
+the hours of six and seven in the evening, just as it was growing
+dusk, and little Jack was spinning beside me, when all at once crack
+went the window, and down fell a little basket of cakes that was set
+up against it. I started up and cried to Jack: 'Bless me, what's the
+matter?' 'So,' says Jack, 'sombody has thrown a stone and broke the
+window, and I dare say it is some of the schoolboys.' With that I ran
+out of the house, and saw some boys making off as fast as they could
+go. So I ran after them as quick as my old legs would carry me, but I
+should never have come near them if one had not happened to fall down.
+Him I caught and brought back to my house, when Jack knew him at once
+to be Master Henry Luckless. So I told him I would complain of him the
+next day, and I hope your worship will make him pay the damage, and I
+think he deserves a good whipping into the bargain for injuring a poor
+widow woman."
+
+The Judge, having heard Mrs. Careful's story, desired her to sit down,
+and then calling up Master Luckless, asked him what he had to say for
+himself. Luckless appeared with his face a good deal scratched, and
+looking very ruefully. After making his bow and sobbing two or three
+times, he said:
+
+"My lord, I am as innocent of this matter as any boy in the school,
+and I am sure I have suffered enough about it already. My lord, Billy
+Thompson and I were playing in the lane near Mrs. Careful's house when
+we heard the window crash, and directly after she came running out
+towards us. Upon this Billy ran away, and I ran too, thinking I might
+bear the blame. But after running a little way I stumbled over
+something that lay in the road, and before I could get up again she
+overtook me, and caught me by the hair, and began lugging and cuffing
+me. I told her it was not I that broke her window, but it did not
+signify; so she dragged me to the light, lugging and scratching me all
+the while, and then said she would inform against me. And that is all
+I know of the matter."
+
+"I find, good woman," said the Judge, "you were willing to revenge
+yourself without waiting for the justice of this court."
+
+"My lord, I must confess I was put into a passion, and did not
+properly consider what I was doing."
+
+"Well, where is Billy Thompson?"
+
+"Here, my lord."
+
+"You have heard what Henry Luckless says. Declare upon your honor
+whether he has spoken the truth."
+
+"My lord," said Billy, "I am sure neither he nor I had any concern in
+breaking the window. We were standing together at the time, and I ran
+on hearing the door open, for fear of being charged with it, and he
+followed; but what became of him I did not stay to see."
+
+"So you let your friend," the Judge remarked, "shift for himself, and
+thought only of saving yourself. But did you see any other person
+about the house or in the lane?"
+
+"My lord, I thought I heard some one creeping along the other side of
+the hedge a little before the window was broken, but I saw nobody."
+
+"You hear, good woman, what is alleged in behalf of the person you
+have accused. Have you any other evidence against him?"
+
+"One might be sure," the widow replied, "they would deny it, and tell
+lies for one another; but I hope I am not to be put off in that
+manner."
+
+"I must tell you, mistress, that you give too much liberty to your
+tongue, and are as guilty of as much injustice as that of which you
+complain. I should be sorry indeed if the young gentlemen of this
+school deserved the general character of liars. You will find among
+us, I hope, as just a sense of what is right and honorable as among
+those who are older, and our worthy master would certainly not permit
+us to try offences in this manner if he thought us capable of bearing
+false witness in each other's favor."
+
+"I ask your lordship's pardon; I did not mean to offend; but it is a
+heavy loss for a poor woman, and though I did not catch the boy in the
+act, he was the nearest when it was done."
+
+"As that is no more than a suspicion, and he has the positive evidence
+of his schoolfellow in his favor, it will be impossible to convict him
+consistently with the rules of justice. Have you discovered any other
+circumstance that may point out the offender?"
+
+"My lord, next morning Jack found on the floor this top, which I
+suppose the window was broke with."
+
+"Hand it up. Here, gentlemen of the jury, please to examine it, and
+see if you can discover anything of its owner."
+
+"Here is 'P.R.' cut upon it."
+
+"Yes," said another boy, "I am sure I remember Peter Riot having just
+such a one."
+
+"So do I," still another remarked.
+
+"Master Riot, is this your top?"
+
+"I don't know, my lord," said Riot; "perhaps it may be mine. I have
+had a great many tops, and when I have done with them I throw them
+away, and any body may pick them up that pleases. You see, it has lost
+its peg."
+
+"Very well, sir. Mrs. Careful, you may retire."
+
+"And must I have no amends, my lord?"
+
+"Have patience; leave everything to the court. We shall do you all the
+justice in our power."
+
+As soon as the widow was gone the Judge rose from his seat, and with
+much solemnity thus addressed the assembly:
+
+"Gentlemen, this business, I confess, gives me much dissatisfaction. A
+poor woman has been insulted and injured in her property, apparently
+without provocation, and although she has not been able to convict the
+offender, it cannot be doubted that she, as well as the world in
+general, will impute the crime to some of our society. Though I am in
+my own mind convinced that in her passion she charged an innocent
+person, yet the circumstance of the top is a strong suspicion--indeed,
+almost a proof--that the perpetrator of this unmanly mischief was one
+of our body.
+
+"The owner of the top has justly observed that its having been his
+property is no certain proof against him.
+
+"Since, therefore, in the present defect of evidence the whole school
+must remain burdened with both the discredit of this action and share
+in the guilt of it, I think fit, in the first place, to decree that
+restitution shall be made to the sufferer out of the public chest,
+and, next, that a Court of Inquiry be instituted for the express
+purpose of searching thoroughly into the affair, with the power to
+examine all persons upon honor who are thought likely to be able to
+throw light upon it. I hope, gentlemen, these measures meet with your
+concurrence."
+
+The whole court bowed to the Judge, and expressed their entire
+satisfaction with his determination.
+
+It was then ordered that the Public Treasurer should go to the Widow
+Careful's house, and pay her a sum of one shilling, making at the same
+time a handsome apology in the name of the school; and six persons
+were taken by lot of the jury to compose the Court of Inquiry, which
+was to sit in the evening.
+
+The Court then adjourned.
+
+On the meeting of the Court of Inquiry the first thing proposed by the
+President was that the persons who usually played with Master Riot
+should be sent for. Accordingly Tom Frisk and Bob Loiter were
+summoned, when the President asked them upon their honor if they knew
+the top to have been Riot's.
+
+They said they did. They were then asked if they remembered when Riot
+had it in his possession.
+
+"He had it," said Frisk, "the day before yesterday, and split a top of
+mine with it."
+
+"Yes," said Loiter, "and then as he was making a stroke at mine the
+peg flew out."
+
+"What did he do with it?"
+
+"He put it into his pocket, and said as it was a strong top he would
+have it mended."
+
+"Then he did not throw it away, or give it to any one?"
+
+"Yes; a day or two before he went to the Widow Careful's shop for some
+gingerbread; but as he already owed her sixpence, she would not let
+him have any till he had paid his debts."
+
+"How did he take the disappointment?"
+
+"He said he would be revenged on her."
+
+"Are you sure he used such words?"
+
+"Yes. Loiter heard him as well as myself."
+
+"I did, sir," said Loiter.
+
+"Do either of you know any more of this affair?"
+
+"No, sir," replied both boys together.
+
+"You may go," said the President, adding "that these witnesses had
+done a good deal in establishing proof against Riot; for it was pretty
+certain that no one but himself could have been in possession of the
+top at the time the crime was committed, and it also appeared that he
+had declared a malicious intention against the woman, which it was
+highly probable he would put into execution. As the court were
+debating about the next step to be taken they were acquainted that
+Jack, the widow's son, was waiting at the school-door for admission;
+and a person being sent out for him, Riot was found threatening the
+boy, and bidding him go home about his business. The boy, however, was
+conveyed safely into the room, when he thus addressed himself to the
+President:
+
+"Sir, and please your worship," said Jack, "as I was looking about
+this morning for sticks in the hedge over against our house, I found
+this buckle. So I thought to myself, 'Sure this must belong to the
+rascal that broke our window.' So I have brought it to see if any one
+in the school would own it."
+
+"On which side of the hedge did you find it?"
+
+"On the other side from our house, in the close."
+
+"Let us see it Gentlemen," said the President, "this is so smart a
+buckle that I am sure I remember it at once, and I dare say you all
+do."
+
+"It is Riot's!" exclaimed all together.
+
+"Has anybody observed Riot's shoes to-day?" the President asked.
+
+"Yes; he has got them tied with strings," a boy replied.
+
+"Very well, then, gentlemen, we have nothing more to do than to draw
+up the evidence we have heard, and lay it before his lordship. Jack,
+you may go home."
+
+"Pray, sir, let somebody go with me, for I am afraid of Riot, who has
+just been threatening me at the door."
+
+"Master Bold will please to go along with the boy."
+
+The minutes of the court were then drawn up, and the President took
+them to the Judge's chamber. After the Judge had perused them, he
+ordered an indictment to be drawn up against Peter Riot: "For that he
+meanly and clandestinely and with malice aforethought had broken three
+panes in the window of Widow Careful with a certain instrument called
+a top, whereby he had committed an atrocious injury upon an innocent
+person, and had brought a disgrace upon the society to which he
+belonged."
+
+At the same time he sent an officer to inform Master Riot that his
+trial would come on the next morning.
+
+Riot, who was with some of his gay companions, affected to treat the
+matter with great indifference, and even to make a jest of it.
+However, in the morning he thought it best to endeavor to make it up,
+and accordingly, when the court was assembled, he sent one of his
+friends with a shilling, saying that he would not trouble them with
+further inquiries, but would pay the sum that had been issued out of
+the public stock. On the receipt of this message the Judge rose with
+much severity in his countenance, and observing that by such
+contemptuous behavior towards the court the criminal had greatly added
+to his offence, he ordered two officers with their staves immediately
+to go and bring in Riot, and to use force if he should resist them.
+
+The culprit, thinking it best to submit, was presently led in between
+the two officers, when, being placed at the bar, the Judge then
+addressed him: "I am sorry, sir, that any member of this society can
+be so little sensible of the nature of a crime and so little
+acquainted with the principles of a court of justice as you have shown
+yourself to be by the proposal you took the improper liberty of
+sending us. If you mean it as a confession of your guilt, you
+certainly ought to have waited to receive from us the penalty we
+thought proper to inflict, and not to have imagined that an offer of
+the mere payment of damages would satisfy the claims of justice
+against you. If you had only broken the window by accident, and on
+your own accord offered restitution, nothing less than the full
+damages could have been accepted; but you now stand charged with
+having done this mischief meanly, secretly, and maliciously, and
+thereby have added a great deal of criminal intention to the act. Can
+you, then, think that a court like this, designed to watch over the
+morals, as well as protect the property of our community, can so
+slightly pass over such aggravated offences? You can claim no merit
+from confessing the crime now that you know so much evidence will
+appear against you. And if you choose still to plead not guilty, you
+are at liberty to do it, and we will proceed immediately to the trial
+without taking any advantage of the confession implied by your offer
+of payment."
+
+Riot stood silent for some time, and then begged to be allowed to
+consult with his friends what was the best for him to do. This was
+agreed to, and he was permitted to retire, though under guard of an
+officer. After a short absence he returned with more humility in his
+looks, and said that he pleaded guilty, and threw himself on the mercy
+of the court. The Judge then made a speech of some length, for the
+purpose of convincing the prisoner, as well as the bystanders, of the
+enormity of his crime. He then pronounced the following sentence:
+
+"You, Peter Riot, are hereby sentenced to pay to the public treasury
+the sum of half a crown as a satisfaction for this mischief you have
+done, and your attempt to conceal it.
+
+"You are to repair to the house of Widow Careful, accompanied by such
+witnesses as we shall appoint, and then, having first paid her the
+sum you owe her, you shall ask her pardon for the insult you offered
+her. You shall likewise to-morrow after school stand up in your place
+and before all the scholars ask pardon for the disgrace you have been
+the means of bringing upon the society, and in particular you shall
+apologize to Master Luckless for the disagreeable circumstances you
+were the means of bringing him into. Till after this is complied with
+you shall not presume to come into the playground or join in any of
+the diversions of the school, and all persons are hereby admonished
+not to keep you company till this is done."
+
+Riot was then dismissed to his room, and in the afternoon he was taken
+to the widow, who was pleased to receive his submission graciously,
+and at the same time to apologize for her own improper treatment of
+Master Luckless, to whom she sent a present of a nice ball by way of
+amends.
+
+Thus ended this important business.
+
+
+
+
+A PLOT OF GUNPOWDER:
+AN OLD LADY SEIZED FOR A GUY
+
+Ascribed to WILLIAM MARTIN ("PETER PARLEY")
+
+
+Gunpowder! Yes, it is a dreadful thing, and many a little boy has lost
+his eyesight by it. Next to playing with fire, I do not know anything
+so bad as playing with gunpowder.
+
+Every one knows of the fifth of November, the day set apart for
+commemorating the deliverance of King James and his Parliament from
+the horrible plot to blow them up with gunpowder, and how on that day
+Guido Fawkes, who was to have put the plan in execution, has his
+effigy paraded about.
+
+Well, it was on the fifth of November, in the year 1789, when Peter
+Parley was a boy, that the circumstances took place of which I am
+going to give a relation. The boys of those days, I think, were more
+fond of Guy Fawkes, and bonfires, and squibs, and crackers than they
+are now.
+
+I remember it was the first of November, early in the morning, that a
+lad, who was on a visit to my father, and who was my second cousin,
+got out of bed and said to me (for we both slept in one room):
+
+"Peter," said he, "do you have a guy in this town? I had a famous one
+last year, and such a bonfire as you never saw, for we burnt down a
+haystack. I should like to have a guy this year; do let us make one."
+
+I was only about twelve years old, and very fond of a bit of fun, and
+so I said:
+
+"That is a good idea. I was thinking of the same thing last night,
+because the clerk gave out in the church that there would be prayers
+on the fifth of November, on account of the Gunpowder Plot; and, as I
+came out of the church porch I saw a very old woman sitting there. She
+looked just like an old witch, and I said to myself, 'I should like to
+seize her for a guy.'"
+
+"Seize an old woman for a guy! Well, that would be the drollest thing
+that ever happened," said he; "and I should like to go you halves.
+Shall we go partners in it? We can easily get a chair and tie her down
+in it, and get a dark lantern and some matches and all that."
+
+"But she must be dressed like a man," said I; "there never was a
+female Guy Fawkes. The people would laugh at us."
+
+"So much the better," said he; "that is just what we want. I like
+something original, out of the common way. Now, a female Guy Fawkes is
+a thing that few persons ever saw, or even heard of."
+
+"But shall we not be taken up," said I, "perhaps put in prison, and
+get ourselves into a hobble?"
+
+"Well, what if we do? But we shall not do that. I am sure it is all
+right enough. But, however, to be quite certain, if you like we will
+ask Ephraim Quidd. You know, his father is a lawyer, and he will tell
+us in a minute. So when we go to school we will ask him, shall we?"
+
+"With all my heart," said I. And so with that we began to dress
+ourselves, and went downstairs to breakfast. I was so full of the
+matter that I sat and thought of it all the time I was eating my food;
+and at last my imagination painted the old woman sitting in a chair,
+calling out, "I am no guy! I am no guy!" the mob laughing, and the
+boys hurrahing so vividly that I burst into a fit of laughter myself.
+
+"Why, Peter," said my father, "'what is the matter now?"
+
+Instead of telling him I continued to laugh, till at last he grew very
+angry with me, and ordered me from the breakfast-table. I then took my
+hat and bag, and went off to school. Simon Sapskull--for that was my
+cousin's name--soon followed me.
+
+When he came up with me he said:
+
+"I thought what you were laughing at. It will be good fun. Let us make
+haste and see Quidd before he goes in. It will be good fun, won't
+it?"
+
+And here Master Simon jumped and capered about with delight.
+
+When we came to the schoolyard there were several boys assembled and
+Quidd among them. Simon immediately ran up to him.
+
+"Quidd," said he, "I want to ask you a question. You know the law, do
+you not? Your father is the town clerk, and you ought."
+
+"I do know the law," said Quidd. "Have I not been bred to it? And is
+not my father to be made Recorder next year?"
+
+"Well, then, answer me this," said Simon. "Is there any law against
+_seizing an old woman for a guy_?"
+
+The next morning Sapskull and myself, with Thomas Hardy and half a
+dozen other boys, met with a view to talk about the intended exploit.
+We withdrew to the backyard of the schoolroom, and there, in a corner
+where we thought we could not be overheard, we began to plot against
+the liberty of Dame Clackett.
+
+Hardy was one of the rarest boys for making fireworks I ever knew in
+my life. He had bought a book called "Every Boy his own Squib-Maker,"
+in which were directions for making squibs, crackers, rockets, Roman
+candles, serpents, slow fire, blue lights, and other descriptions of
+fireworks. This he nearly knew by heart. Sapskull said:
+
+"Look in your book and see if there is not in it how to make a guy."
+
+So Hardy looked all over the book, but to no purpose; there was no
+description of a guy manufactory. It was of no consequence; we had a
+guy in our head, and we only now wished to know how we should get hold
+of the old lady, and what we should do on this joyful occasion.
+
+Hardy said he had several pounds of gunpowder, and would sell us all
+squibs and crackers. But these we did not so much want. What we wanted
+was an old chair, an old jacket, hat, and other matters to dress up
+the old lady when we could catch her. But how to get her into the
+chair was the difficulty, and some proposed one thing and some
+another. Sapskull said, "We must make her merry with some beer."
+Hardy said, "We must tie her down." But I proposed to ask her to sit
+for her picture as a guy, and then to carry her off. Master Quidd was,
+however, more cunning than any of us, and said, "I know how to nab
+her; I have a plan, and a capital one it is, too."
+
+"What is it? what is it?" said all of us.
+
+The fact was old Dame Clackett was a very staunch churchwoman, and
+used always to go both on Wednesdays and Fridays, Rain or sunshine,
+hot or cold, nothing could keep her away from her church, and we silly
+boys laughed at her for it. Poor old creature! she felt more real
+pleasure in this than we could imagine.
+
+"I will tell you what we will do," said Quidd. "There is in our
+outhouse an old wheeled chair which my mother used to ride about in
+when she was so long ill, a year or two ago. Now, I know old Dame
+Clackett is very lame just now, from having let fall her fender on her
+foot. I will take this chair down, and offer to draw her to church in
+it, and then, when we have once got her in the chair, we can do as we
+like with her. Hurrah!"
+
+"Won't that be fun?" continued Quidd. "Let us do it--let us do it.
+There is no law against it; the thing was never thought of. It is just
+like the law that was never made among the Romans that I read about in
+my lessons yesterday: there was no law against a child killing his own
+father. I tell you," said he, "if there were twenty old women to be
+seized and burnt, nobody could be hurt for it. But you do not mean to
+burn her, I suppose, do you?"
+
+"Oh no," said we; "we only want to have some fun. We should like to
+make a guy of her, that is all, and rare fun it will be."
+
+"Let me join you," said one; "Let me join," said another, till at last
+the whole school entered into the plot.
+
+We all forgot what we should have remembered--namely, that, instead of
+despising or ridiculing people who are old and helpless and poor, we
+ought to treat them with kindness, respect, and consideration. We
+forgot that we, if suffered to live long enough, should also become
+old, and that it would be hard for us to bear the coldness and neglect
+of the world, but much harder to endure the ridicule and ill-behavior
+of wicked children. Ay, we were thoughtless lads, and so we suffered
+for it, as you will afterwards hear.
+
+ * * * * *
+
+The old lady whom I had seen sitting in the church porch, who was so
+ugly, as I thought, and so withered and old, was a very poor widow.
+Her husband had died in battle long ago, and she had from year to year
+supported herself by her spinning wheel and the little relief she had
+from the parish. She lived in a little hut on a piece of waste ground,
+and kept a little poultry, and now and then a pig or two.
+
+Among other animals, the old lady kept an enormous goat, or, rather,
+he kept himself. It was one her husband had brought her from abroad,
+of the Syrian breed. It was quite young when it came over, but at last
+grew and grew so, as to become a very formidable animal, so strong and
+fierce, that every dog was afraid of it, being, no doubt, terrified by
+the sight of its large horns and undaunted aspect. The name of this
+dread animal was Hannibal.
+
+Poor old Goody Clackett--for that was her name--had little thoughts of
+ever being "smugged," as it was termed, by our schoolfellows to make a
+guy on the fifth of November, and sat quietly enough spinning her
+wheel and drawing out her yarn. Sometimes the thrum of the old wheel
+would send her soundly to sleep, and then she never dreamed of such a
+thing as was to happen to her.
+
+Every boy was delighted with this proposition, and it was arranged
+that on the following evening I and my cousin Simon should assist in
+the endeavor to get the chair from the outhouse to a convenient place,
+while Hardy was to provide lantern, matches, cap, and feathers, with
+red and black paint to disfigure the features of the poor old
+creature.
+
+"We will make her amends," said Quidd, "all the money we get shall be
+hers."
+
+"Oh yes; that is quite fair," said I.
+
+When the evening came and it was quite dark, Simon and I went to the
+back part of Quidd's father's house. After waiting some little time we
+heard a knock. Presently Quidd opened the gates and came out.
+
+"There, get it," said he. "Look about to see if anybody is coming, and
+you can take it away."
+
+We did so. The coast was clear, and out rolled the chair.
+
+Simon and I took hold of it, one behind and one before at the
+handle-stick. Away we went, as had been preconcerted between us in the
+stable-yard of another schoolfellow of ours in the plot, who placed it
+near the gate and covered it over with loose straw, so that no one
+could see it.
+
+The next evening, which was the fourth of November, we met again by
+appointment at the dark hollow of the churchyard. This meeting was for
+the purpose of determining about the way in which Dame Clackett should
+be dressed in her triumphal entry to the Town Hall, the place where
+the bonfires were usually made. Hardy had brought what was of
+essential service--namely, an old coat which had formerly belonged to
+his father when in the yeomanry cavalry, an old helmet, a
+cartridge-box, and a pair of boots.
+
+"We shall never get the boots on," said I.
+
+Another boy brought an old lantern with the horn burnt out, a third a
+bunch of matches; then there was a mask and a lath-sword and a drum,
+with sticks and straw in abundance. They were all deposited in the
+same place with the chair. The conspirators (for conspirators we were)
+then made a promise to each other not to split, as they call it--that
+is, not to betray each other, and to go through with our work like
+_Britons;_ so we all shook hands and parted.
+
+The next morning was a holiday, and we were up betimes. After a
+consultation it was determined that I and Quidd should go to the old
+dame and see how she was, and if she was determined to go to church,
+and if there would be any difficulty to get her to accept of the
+convenience of our vehicle; so off we set. In less than half-an-hour
+we reached the old dame's cottage, and found her at that very moment
+dressing her foot.
+
+Quidd was the first who spoke.
+
+"Good morning, Goody," said he. "What, is not your foot well yet?
+Why, I hear you have not been to church lately. The curate was at
+father's last night, and said if you were so lame that you could not
+walk, you might have our easy four-wheeled chair. But I suppose you
+won't go to church to-day--it is only the fifth of November?"
+
+"Not go to church!" said the old woman--"not go to church! I have
+always gone on the fifth of November for forty years. My poor husband
+was in a French prison, and he knew well enough what the Jacobites
+are. Was he not blown up, poor fellow, in the 'Glorious?' and were not
+King James and all his people to have been blown up so high by the
+horrid Papist plot that I suppose they would not have been down by
+this time? No Popery, I say! I would sooner crawl to church on my
+hands and knees than not go to-day, young gentlemen. And then Mr.
+Hassock, the kind, good curate, to ask for me!"
+
+"Yes, and then there is the 'coal money' given on the fifth, that all
+the widows in the parish may have a good fire through the winter, you
+know, Goody."
+
+"Yes, I must go to church," said Mrs. Clackett.
+
+"That you must," said Quidd, "and I will tell you what these young
+gentlemen and I will do. We will bring down the chair, and take you
+there ourselves. I am sure it would please Mr. Hassock. Would it not,
+Parley?"
+
+"Yes, and the rector also," said I. "And I have no doubt but the
+churchwardens would like to see Goody at church, for the tickets for
+flannel petticoats are to be given away to-day."
+
+"What is that?" said Mrs. Clackett. "Oh, yes, I could not keep away
+from my church! Good young gentlemen, I shall never forget your
+kindness."
+
+We stopped to hear no more. We were overjoyed with the success of our
+plot. Away we ran to our companions, and, without stopping to explain,
+cried out:
+
+"The chair! the chair! We shall have a guy, the best in the whole
+country!"
+
+So away we ran with the chair, and all our other preparations for
+dressing and tying and securing.
+
+The whole party surrounded the chair, some pushing, some pulling.
+When, however, we got within a convenient distance of the old lady's
+hut, Hardy and the others stepped on one side, and placed the helmet,
+coat, lantern, matches, etc., under a hedge, to be ready when
+required, while Quidd, Sapskull, and myself went with the chair to the
+old lady's cottage.
+
+When we got there we found her spruce and prim with her best black
+silk bonnet, something in shape like a coal-scuttle, her stick in her
+hand, and her shoes on her feet. We drove up the chair in fine style.
+There were several cottages close by, and the neighbors came out to
+see the old lady ride. At last some one who knew Quidd said:
+
+"Why, that is the lawyer's son. Sure enough old Goody has got some
+money left her."
+
+So then there was a talking and surmising, and before Goody got to
+church it was reported all over the town that she was made the
+possessor of several thousand pounds prize-money; that she was to be a
+lady, and ride in her carriage. Being sent for, as it was supposed, by
+the lawyer must be for something--a large legacy, no doubt.
+
+The chair wheeled on with Goody in it. The boys looked as if they were
+up to something, and sure enough they were. When they came to that
+part of the lane at which the various habiliments had been left, the
+chair stopped, and out rushed the other conspirators.
+
+"Do not be alarmed, Goody," said Hardy. "We are only going to make a
+guy of you for an hour or two. No one shall harm you, and you shall
+have all the money we get."
+
+"I want to go to church--I want to go to church!" said the old lady,
+and tried to get out of the chair.
+
+Hardy, however, very dexterously threw some cord round the arms, and
+tied the poor old creature down.
+
+"We won't hurt you, Goody," said he. "We only want you for a guy. You
+shall have all the money."
+
+"I won't be a guy! I won't be a guy!" said Goody. "I do not want any
+money. Let me out! let me out!"
+
+She then made a blow with her broomstick, and struck Master Hardy on
+the nose, from which the blood flowed freely. This, however, only made
+him the more determined, and in a few minutes the poor old woman's
+arms were secured as well as her legs.
+
+"Oh, help, neighbors! They are going to burn me!" said the old lady,
+and then she fell coughing, for she had long suffered from asthma.
+
+While convulsed with this fit, the boys took the opportunity to
+besmear her face with red and black paint, and to place the helmet on
+her head, and the coat round her, so that the arms hung on each side
+with nothing on them. The chair was then crammed with straw, and the
+lantern and the matches suspended from it. In this state the chair was
+wheeled rapidly along in the direction of the town.
+
+Other boys soon joined, and surrounded the vehicle, shouting and
+laughing. The old lady, made several ineffectual attempts to get out
+of the chair. She called out, "A plot! a plot! a Popery plot! No
+Popery! Oh! I shall be killed!" and many such exclamations. The
+populace took this as a part of the character, and laughed most
+heartily. The greatest number of persons thought the guy to be a boy
+dressed up, and cried out that he acted his part well. No one
+suspected it was old Dame Clackett.
+
+Away they went in the midst of the hubbub, up one street and down
+another, over the market-place and by the church. Just as the clock
+struck twelve the boys of the Free School came from the latter place,
+and joined the procession. It was now a national affair, and, as it
+proceeded from the church doors, it was thought to be the church Guy
+Fawkes--and so it was.
+
+"Hurrah! hurrah!" shouted a hundred voices; and while Hardy and his
+companions held on the chair, Quidd and I went about with our hats to
+collect as much money as we could.
+
+The old lady was vociferous, and struggled to get out. She flung her
+arms about, and cried out, "Deliver me from the flames! Save me from
+being burnt!" and everybody thought that the part of guy was acted to
+perfection.
+
+Quidd and I got a great deal of money--silver, and copper, and even
+gold. Seven-shilling pieces were in circulation at that time, and the
+squire and Mr. Hassock passing us, one threw sixpence and the other a
+seven-shilling piece to us, for which we gave a louder cheer than
+usual. In short, our hats were very nearly half full of money.
+
+The old woman began to be more pacified as she saw the money coming
+in, particularly as we put it all into her lap, and told her it should
+be hers. But the sight of the squire and the curate, and the
+seven-shilling piece, which latter we put into her mouth, seemed quite
+to reconcile her to her fate. She became then as gentle as a lamb. She
+said:
+
+"Do as you like--do as you like, only don't burn me for a guy; and
+give me a drop of something to drink."
+
+"Oh yes," said Quidd, "here is something for you. Hold up your head."
+
+And half a pint of good strong ale soon found its way down the throat
+of the dame. After this the chair again moved on, till at last it came
+to the market-place, opposite the Town Hall, where an enormous bonfire
+was in preparation, over which stood a gallows.
+
+The old lady, when she saw the gallows, screamed "Murder! fire!
+brimstone!" and all sorts of horrid cries; but nobody took any heed of
+it, except to laugh. They thought it was in keeping with her
+character.
+
+"We will not hurt you, we will not hurt you," said I.
+
+But it was of no use; the old lady refused to be pacified.
+
+Just at this moment Quidd felt a severe blow from behind, which sent
+him sprawling. I also received a push or a drive, and a loud laugh
+burst from those around.
+
+When I turned to see what was the cause of the laughter, what should I
+observe but Hannibal, the goat, who had, it appeared, followed his
+mistress, and, being excited by her cries, dashed at my schoolfellow
+in the way described. Several of the spectators now tried to seize the
+goat, but he being of extraordinary strength, butted and pushed so
+vigorously that several measured their length upon the earth, to the
+no small merriment of the clownish persons who had collected together
+to the burning of the guy.
+
+During all this time Dame Clackett cried out loudly, and in the
+confusion her chair was upset, and she became liberated from her
+duress. As soon as she was free, she laid about on all sides of her
+with her stick, pulled off the helmet and jacket in which she had been
+nearly smothered, and cried out at the top of her voice:
+
+"I am no guy! I am Dame Clackett! For goodness' sake do not burn me
+for a witch!"
+
+She, however, kept her apron close in which the money was, and took
+care not to let the seven-shilling piece fall out of her mouth.
+
+The mob cheered. It would have been well if this had been all, but no:
+as soon as ever the old lady told her story that she had been seized
+for a guy, an effort was immediately made to secure the offenders. The
+constable, who happened to be present, laid hold of me and cousin
+Simon; several others were seized by the bystanders; and the whole,
+with the exception of Quidd, were dragged off to what in the country
+is called the goose-house--that is, the cage. Quidd, lawyer-like,
+contrived to get out of the scrape, leaving others in it. So we were
+all put into the cage, and bolted and barred. It was very dark, and as
+we were terribly frightened, we all began to howl most hideously.
+
+As to Quidd, he went homewards, as if nothing had happened, and soon
+made his reappearance, prepared for the usual squibbing and cracking,
+with his pockets full of squibs and crackers. He was so pleased with
+the success of the scheme in which he had been so forward an actor
+that he determined to have more fun before he went to bed; so he
+looked about, and it was not long before he saw a fit object, as he
+thought.
+
+At the corner of the street leading to the market-place sat poor old
+Hannah Grimly, as she was called. She had sold roasted chestnuts on
+the fifth of November for a score of years, and many a pinch of
+gunpowder had been put under the lid of the saucepan upon which the
+chestnuts were laid. Quidd determined to have a good explosion, and
+took the opportunity, while the chestnuts were being put into his
+hand, to introduce a packet of gunpowder into the kettle. He thought
+to run away before it should ignite, but there being a small hole in
+the paper, the moment it touched the fire the whole went off with a
+loud explosion. Quidd's hand was shattered to pieces, and he fell
+stunned with the effects of the powder. He was taken home senseless,
+and put to bed.
+
+The rest of the conspirators, including myself, were kept in the cage
+all night in bitter tears. The next morning we were taken before the
+magistrates. The chairman, who happened to be the very squire who had
+given us the seven-shilling piece, looked very severely at us, and
+said:
+
+"This is the most horrible plot I ever heard of--seizing an old woman
+for a guy! Gentlemen," said he to those around him, "if this be
+permitted none of us are safe."
+
+Some people used to call the magistrates old women, and so this raised
+a laugh.
+
+He then called to the clerk to look over the Act of Parliament to see
+what could be the punishment for such an offence, but found none.
+Quidd was right--there was no law against seizing an old woman for a
+guy. The bench were puzzled what to do. At last Quidd's father said we
+should be indicted for stealing his chair, and be put on our trial for
+robbery and sacrilege--the first for the abduction of the chair, the
+second for keeping the old lady _from church._
+
+Our fathers and mothers, however, pleaded so eloquently that, after a
+severe admonition, we got off upon payment of the costs and a handsome
+compensation to Dame Clackett. When I reached home my father took me
+into the stable and gave me a sound whipping, and at the conclusion of
+the flagellation said:
+
+"Now, Peter Parley, I think you will not again seize an old woman for
+a guy!"
+
+And I never did.
+
+
+
+
+UNCLE DAVID'S NONSENSICAL STORY ABOUT GIANTS AND FAIRIES
+
+By KATHERINE SINCLAIR
+
+
+In the days of yore children were not all such clever, good, sensible
+people as they are now. Lessons were then considered rather a plague,
+sugar-plums were still in demand, holidays continued yet in fashion,
+and toys were not then made to teach mathematics, nor storybooks to
+give instruction in chemistry and navigation. These were very strange
+times, and there existed at that period a very idle, greedy, naughty
+boy, such as we never hear of in the present day. His father and
+mother were--no matter who, and he lived--no matter where. His name
+was Master No-book, and he seemed to think his eyes were made for
+nothing but to stare out of the windows, and his mouth for no other
+purpose but to eat. This young gentleman hated lessons like mustard,
+both of which brought tears into his eyes, and during school hours he
+sat gazing at his books, pretending to be busy, while his mind
+wandered away to wish impatiently for dinner, and to consider where he
+could get the nicest pies, pastry, ices, and jellies, while he smacked
+his lips at the very thoughts of them.
+
+Whenever Master No-book spoke it was always to ask for something, and
+you might continually hear him say in a whining tone of voice:
+"Father, may I take this piece of cake?" "Aunt Sarah, will you give me
+an apple?" "Mother, do send me the whole of that plum-pudding."
+Indeed, very frequently, when he did not get permission to gormandize,
+this naughty glutton helped himself without leave. Even his dreams
+were like his waking hours, for he had often a horrible nightmare
+about lessons, thinking he was smothered with Greek lexicons or pelted
+out of the school with a shower of English grammars, while one night
+he fancied himself sitting down to devour an enormous plum-cake, and
+all on a sudden it became transformed into a Latin dictionary.
+
+One afternoon Master No-book, having played truant all day from
+school, was lolling on his mother's best sofa in the drawing-room,
+with his leather boots tucked up on the satin cushions, and nothing to
+do but to suck a few oranges, and nothing to think of but how much
+sugar to put upon them, when suddenly an event took place which filled
+him with astonishment.
+
+A sound of soft music stole into the room, becoming louder and louder
+the longer he listened, till at length, in a few moments afterwards, a
+large hole burst open in the wall of his room, and there stepped into
+his presence two magnificent fairies, just arrived from their castles
+in the air, to pay him a visit. They had traveled all the way on
+purpose to have some conversation with Master No-book, and immediately
+introduced themselves in a very ceremonious manner.
+
+The fairy Do-nothing was gorgeously dressed with a wreath of flaming
+gas round her head, a robe of gold tissue, a necklace of rubies, and a
+bouquet in her hand of glittering diamonds. Her cheeks were rouged to
+the very eyes, her teeth were set in gold, and her hair was of a most
+brilliant purple; in short, so fine and fashionable-looking a fairy
+never was seen in a drawing-room before. The fairy Teach-all, who
+followed next, was simply dressed in white muslin, with bunches of
+natural flowers in her light-brown hair, and she carried in her hand a
+few neat small volumes, which Master No-book looked at with a shudder
+of aversion.
+
+The two fairies now informed him that they very often invited large
+parties of children to spend some time at their palaces, but as they
+lived in quite an opposite direction, it was necessary for their young
+guests to choose which it would be best to visit first; therefore they
+had now come to inquire of Master No-book whom he thought it would be
+most agreeable to accompany on the present occasion.
+
+"In my house," said the fairy Teach-all, speaking with a very sweet
+smile and a soft, pleasing voice, "you shall be taught to find
+pleasure in every sort of exertion, for I delight in activity and
+diligence. My young friends rise at seven every morning, and amuse
+themselves with working in a beautiful garden of flowers, rearing
+whatever fruit they wish to eat, visiting among the poor, associating
+pleasantly together, studying the arts and sciences, and learning to
+know the world in which they live, and to fulfil the purposes for
+which they have been brought into it. In short, all our amusements
+tend to some useful object, either for our own improvement or the good
+of others, and you will grow wiser, better, and happier every day you
+remain in the palace of Knowledge."
+
+"But in Castle Needless, where I live," interrupted the fairy
+Do-nothing, rudely pushing her companion aside with an angry,
+contemptuous look, "we never think of exerting ourselves for anything.
+You may put your head in your pocket and your hands in your sides as
+long as you choose to stay. No one is ever asked a question, that he
+may be spared the trouble of answering. We lead the most fashionable
+life imaginable, for nobody speaks to anybody. Each of my visitors is
+quite an exclusive, and sits with his back to as many of the company
+as possible, in the most comfortable arm-chair that can be contrived.
+There, if you are only so good as to take the trouble of wishing for
+anything, it is yours without even turning an eye round to look where
+it comes from. Dresses are provided of the most magnificent kind,
+which go on themselves, without your having the smallest annoyance
+with either buttons or strings; games which you can play without an
+effort of thought; and dishes dressed by a French cook, smoking hot
+under your nose, from morning till night; while any rain we have is
+either made of lemonade or lavender-water, and in winter it generally
+snows iced punch for an hour during the forenoon."
+
+Nobody need be told which fairy Master No-book preferred, and quite
+charmed at his own good fortune in receiving so agreeable an
+invitation, he eagerly gave his hand to the splendid new acquaintance
+who promised him so much pleasure and ease, and gladly proceeded in a
+carriage lined with velvet, stuffed with downy pillows, and drawn by
+milk-white swans, to that magnificent residence, Castle Needless,
+which was lighted by a thousand windows during the day, and by a
+million of lamps every night.
+
+Here Master No-book enjoyed a constant holiday and a constant feast,
+while a beautiful lady covered with jewels was ready to tell him
+stories from morning till night, and servants waited to pick up his
+playthings if they fell, or to draw out his purse or his
+pocket-handkerchief when he wished to use them.
+
+Thus Master No-book lay dozing for hours and days on rich embroidered
+cushions, never stirring from his place, but admiring the view of
+trees covered with the richest burnt almonds, grottoes of sugar-candy,
+a _jet d'eau_ of champagne, a wide sea which tasted of sugar instead
+of salt, and a bright, clear pond, filled with gold fish that let
+themselves be caught whenever he pleased. Nothing could be more
+complete, and yet, very strange to say, Master No-book did not seem
+particularly happy. This appears exceedingly unreasonable, when so
+much trouble was taken to please him; but the truth is that every day
+he became more fretful and peevish. No sweetmeats were worth the
+trouble of eating, nothing was pleasant to play at, and in the end he
+wished it were possible to sleep all day, as well as all night.
+
+Not a hundred miles from the fairy Do-nothing's palace there lived a
+most cruel monster called the giant Snap-'em-up, who looked, when he
+stood up, like the tall steeple of a great church, raising his head so
+high that he could peep over the loftiest mountains, and was obliged
+to climb up a ladder to comb his own hair.
+
+Every morning regularly this prodigiously great giant walked round the
+world before breakfast for an appetite, after which he made tea in a
+large lake, used the sea as a slop-basin, and boiled his kettle on
+Mount Vesuvius. He lived in great style, and his dinners were most
+magnificent, consisting very often of an elephant roasted whole,
+ostrich patties, a tiger smothered in onions, stewed lions, and whale
+soup; but for a side-dish his greatest favorite consisted of little
+boys, as fat as possible, fried in crumbs of bread, with plenty of
+pepper and salt.
+
+No children were so well fed or in such good condition for eating as
+those in the fairy Do-nothing's garden, who was a very particular
+friend of the giant Snap-'em-up's, and who sometimes laughingly said
+she would give him a license, and call her own garden his "preserve,"
+because she always allowed him to help himself, whenever he pleased,
+to as many of her visitors as he chose, without taking the trouble to
+even count them; and in return for such extreme civility, the giant
+very frequently invited her to dinner.
+
+Snap-'em-up's favorite sport was to see how many brace of little boys
+he could bag in a morning; so, in passing along the streets, he peeped
+into all the drawing-rooms, without having occasion to get upon
+tiptoe, and picked up every young gentleman who was idly looking out
+of the windows, and even a few occasionally who were playing truant
+from school; but busy children seemed always somehow quite out of his
+reach.
+
+One day, when Master No-book felt even more lazy, more idle, and more
+miserable than ever, he lay beside a perfect mountain of toys and
+cakes, wondering what to wish for next, and hating the very sight of
+everything and everybody. At last he gave so loud a yawn of weariness
+and disgust that his jaw very nearly fell out of joint, and then he
+sighed so deeply that the giant Snap-'em-up heard the sound as he
+passed along the road after breakfast, and instantly stepped into the
+garden, with his glass at his eye, to see what was the matter.
+Immediately, on observing a large, fat, overgrown boy, as round as a
+dumpling, lying on a bed of roses, he gave a cry of delight, followed
+by a gigantic peal of laughter, which was heard three miles off, and
+picking up Master No-book between his finger and thumb, with a pinch
+that very nearly broke his ribs, he carried him rapidly towards his
+own castle, while the fairy Do-nothing laughingly shook her head as he
+passed, saying:
+
+"That little man does me great credit. He has only been fed for a
+week, and is as fat already as a prize ox. What a dainty morsel he
+will be! When do you dine to-day, in case I should have time to look
+in upon you?"
+
+On reaching home the giant immediately hung up Master No-book by the
+hair of his head, on a prodigious hook in the larder, having first
+taken some large lumps of nasty suet, forcing them down his throat to
+make him become still fatter, and then stirring the fire, that he
+might be almost melted with heat, to make his liver grow larger. On a
+shelf quite near Master No-book perceived the bodies of six other
+boys, whom he remembered to have seen fattening in the fairy
+Do-nothing's garden, while he recollected how some of them had
+rejoiced at the thoughts of leading a long, useless, idle life, with
+no one to please but themselves.
+
+The enormous cook now seized hold of Master No-book, brandishing her
+knife with an aspect of horrible determination, intending to kill him,
+while he took the trouble of screaming and kicking in the most
+desperate manner, when the giant turned gravely round, and said that,
+as pigs were considered a much greater dainty when whipped to death
+than killed in any other way, he meant to see whether children might
+not be improved by it also; therefore she might leave that great hog
+of a boy till he had time to try the experiment, especially as his own
+appetite would be improved by the exercise. This was a dreadful
+prospect for the unhappy prisoner, but meantime it prolonged his life
+a few hours, as he was immediately hung up in the larder and left to
+himself. There, in torture of mind and body, like a fish upon a hook,
+the wretched boy began at last to reflect seriously upon his former
+ways, and to consider what a happy home he might have had, if he could
+only have been satisfied with business and pleasure succeeding each
+other, like day and night, while lessons might have come in as a
+pleasant sauce to his play-hours, and his play-hours as a sauce to his
+lessons.
+
+In the midst of many reflections, which were all very sensible, though
+rather too late, Master No-book's attention became attracted by the
+sound of many voices laughing, talking, and singing, which caused him
+to turn his eyes in a new direction, when, for the first time, he
+observed that the fairy Teach-all's garden lay upon a beautiful
+sloping bank not far off. There a crowd of merry, noisy, rosy-cheeked
+boys were busily employed, and seemed happier than the day was long,
+while poor Master No-book watched them during his own miserable hours,
+envying the enjoyment with which they raked the flower-borders,
+gathered the fruit, carried baskets of vegetables to the poor, worked
+with carpenter's tools, drew pictures, shot with bows-and-arrows,
+played at cricket, and then sat in the sunny arbors learning their
+tasks, or talking agreeably together, till at length, a dinner-bell
+having been rung, the whole party sat merrily down with hearty
+appetites and cheerful good humor, to an entertainment of plain roast
+meat and pudding, where the fairy Teach-all presided herself, and
+helped her guests moderately to as much as was good for each.
+
+Large tears rolled down the cheeks of Master No-book while watching
+this scene, and remembering that if he had known what was best for
+him, he might have been as happy as the happiest of these excellent
+boys, instead of suffering ennui and weariness, as he had done at the
+fairy Do-nothing's, ending in a miserable death. But his attention was
+soon after most alarmingly roused by hearing the giant Snap-'em-up
+again in conversation with his cook, who said that, if he wished for a
+good large dish of scolloped children at dinner, it would be necessary
+to catch a few more, as those he had already provided would scarcely
+be a mouthful.
+
+As the giant kept very fashionable hours, and always waited dinner for
+himself till nine o'clock, there was still plenty of time; so, with a
+loud grumble about the trouble, he seized a large basket in his hand,
+and set off at a rapid pace towards the fairy Teach-all's garden. It
+was very seldom that Snap-'em-up ventured to think of foraging in this
+direction, as he never once succeeded in carrying off a single captive
+from the enclosure, it was so well fortified and so bravely defended;
+but on this occasion, being desperately hungry, he felt as bold as a
+lion, and walked, with outstretched hands, straight towards the fairy
+Teach-all's dinner-table, taking such prodigious strides that he
+seemed almost as if he would trample on himself.
+
+A cry of consternation arose the instant this tremendous giant
+appeared, and, as usual on such occasions, when he had made the same
+attempt before, a dreadful battle took place. Fifty active little boys
+bravely flew upon the enemy, armed with their dinner-knives, and
+looked like a nest of hornets, stinging him in every direction, till
+he roared with pain, and would have run away; but the fairy Teach-all,
+seeing his intention, rushed forward with the carving-knife, and
+brandishing it high over her head, she most courageously stabbed him
+to the heart.
+
+If a great mountain had fallen to the earth it would have seemed like
+nothing in comparison with the giant Snap-em-up, who crushed two or
+three houses to powder beneath him, and upset several fine monuments
+that were to have made people remembered for ever. But all this would
+have seemed scarcely worth mentioning had it not been for a still
+greater event which occurred on the occasion, no less than the death
+of the fairy Do-nothing, who had been indolently looking on at this
+great battle without taking the trouble to interfere, or even to care
+who was victorious; but being also lazy about running away, when the
+giant fell, his sword came with so violent a stroke on her head that
+she instantly expired.
+
+Thus, luckily for the whole world, the fairy Teach-all got possession
+of immense property, which she proceeded without delay to make the
+best use of in her power.
+
+In the first place, however, she lost no time in liberating Master
+No-book from his hook in the larder, and gave him a lecture on
+activity, moderation, and good conduct, which he never afterwards
+forgot; and it was astonishing to see the change that took place
+immediately in his whole thoughts and actions. From this very hour
+Master No-book became the most diligent, active, happy boy in the
+fairy Teach-all's garden; and on returning home a month afterwards, he
+astonished all the masters at school by his extraordinary reformation.
+The most difficult lessons were a pleasure to him, he scarcely ever
+stirred without a book in his hand, never lay on a sofa again, would
+scarcely even sit on a chair with a back to it, but preferred a
+three-legged stool, detested holidays, never thought any exertion a
+trouble, preferred climbing over the top of a hill to creeping round
+the bottom, always ate the plainest food in very small quantities,
+joined a temperance society, and never tasted a morsel till he had
+worked very hard and got an appetite.
+
+Not long after this an old uncle, who had formerly been ashamed of
+Master No-book's indolence and gluttony, became so pleased at the
+wonderful change that on his death he left him a magnificent estate,
+desiring that he should take his name; therefore, instead of being
+any longer one of the No-book family, he is now called Sir Timothy
+Blue-stocking, a pattern to the whole country around for the good he
+does to everyone, and especially for his extraordinary activity,
+appearing as if he could do twenty things at once. Though generally
+very good-natured and agreeable, Sir Timothy is occasionally observed
+in a violent passion, laying about him with his walking-stick in the
+most terrific manner, and beating little boys within an inch of their
+lives; but on inquiry it invariably appears that he has found them out
+to be lazy, idle, or greedy; for all the industrious boys in the
+parish are sent to get employment from him, while he assures them that
+they are far happier breaking stones on the road than if they were
+sitting idly in a drawing-room with nothing to do.
+
+
+
+
+THE INQUISITIVE GIRL
+
+
+Dr. Hammond was a physician in great practice in the West of England.
+He resided in a small market-town and his family consisted of one son,
+named Charles, and two daughters, Louisa and Sophy.
+
+Sophy possessed many amiable qualities, and did not want for sense,
+but every better feeling was lost in her extreme inquisitiveness. Her
+faculties were all occupied in peeping and prying about, and, provided
+she could gratify her own curiosity, she never cared how much vexation
+she caused to others.
+
+This propensity began when she was so very young that it had become a
+habit before her parents perceived it. She was a very little creature
+when she was once nearly squeezed to death between two double doors as
+she was peeping through the keyhole of one of them to see who was in
+the drawing-room; and another time she was locked up for several hours
+in a closet in which she had hid herself for the purpose of
+overhearing what her mother was saying to one of the servants.
+
+When Sophy was eleven and her sister about sixteen years old their
+mother died. Louisa was placed at the head of her father's house, and
+the superintendence of Sophy's education necessarily devolved on her.
+The care of such a family was a great charge for a young person of
+Miss Hammond's age, and more especially as her father was obliged to
+be so much from home that she could not always have his counsel and
+advice even when she most needed it. By this means she fell into an
+injudicious mode of treating her sister.
+
+If Louisa received a note she carefully locked it up, and never spoke
+of its contents before Sophy. If a message was brought to her she
+always went out of the room to receive it, and never suffered the
+servant to speak in her sister's hearing. When any visitors came
+Louisa commonly sent Sophy out of the room, or if they were intimate
+friends she would converse with them in whispers; in short, it was her
+chief study that everything which passed in the family should be a
+secret from Sophy. Alas! this procedure, instead of repressing Sophy's
+curiosity, only made it the more keen; her eyes and ears were always
+on the alert, and what she could not see, hear, or thoroughly
+comprehend she made out by guesses.
+
+The worst consequence of Louisa's conduct was that as Sophy had no
+friend and companion in her sister, who treated her with such constant
+suspicion and reserve, she necessarily was induced to find a friend
+and companion among the servants, and she selected the housemaid
+Sally, a good-natured, well-intentioned girl, but silly and ignorant
+and inquisitive like herself, and it may be easily supposed how much
+mischief these two foolish creatures occasioned, not only in the
+family, but also among their neighbors.
+
+It happened soon after, that for an offence which was the cause of
+very great vexation to her brother, and was the occasion of his being
+for a time deprived of the friendship of Sir Henry and Lady Askham,
+two of Dr. Hammond's nearest and most intimate neighbors, her father
+ordered Sophy, as a still further punishment, to be locked up in her
+own room till the Sunday following. This was on Friday, and Sophy had
+two days of solitude and imprisonment before her. The first day she
+passed very dismally, but yet not unprofitably, for she felt truly
+ashamed and sorry for her fault, and made many good resolutions of
+endeavoring to cure herself of her mischievous propensity. The second
+day she began to be somewhat more composed, and by degrees she was
+able to amuse herself with watching the people in the street, which
+was overlooked by the windows of her apartment, and she began, almost
+unconsciously to herself, to indulge in her old habit of trying to
+find out what everybody was doing, and in guessing where they were
+going.
+
+She had not long been engaged in watching her neighbors before her
+curiosity was excited by the appearance of a servant on horseback, who
+rode up to the door, and, after giving a little three-cornered note to
+Dr. Hammond's footman, rode off. The servant she knew to be Mrs.
+Arden's, an intimate friend of her father, and the note she
+conjectured was an invitation to dinner, and the guessing what day the
+invitation was for, and who were to be the company, and whether she
+was included in the invitation, was occupying her busy fancy, when she
+saw her sister going out of the house with the three-cornered note in
+her hand, and cross the street to Mr. McNeal's stocking shop, which
+was opposite. Almost immediately afterwards Mr. McNeal's shopman came
+out of the shop, and, running down the street, was presently out of
+sight, but soon returned with Mr. McNeal himself. She saw Louisa
+reading the note to Mr. McNeal, and in a few minutes afterwards return
+home. Here was a matter of wonder and conjecture. Sophy forgot all her
+good resolutions, and absolutely wearied herself with her useless
+curiosity.
+
+At length the term of her imprisonment was over, and Sophy was
+restored to the society of her family. At first she kept a tolerable
+guard over herself. Once she saw her father and sister whispering, and
+did not, though she longed much to do it, hold her breath that she
+might hear what they were saying. Another time she passed Charles's
+door when it was ajar and the little study open, and she had so much
+self-command that she passed by without peeping in, and she began to
+think she was cured of her faults. But in reality this was far from
+being the case, and whenever she recollected Mrs. Arden's mysterious
+note she felt her inquisitive propensities as strong as ever. Her eyes
+and ears were always on the alert, in hopes of obtaining some clue to
+the knowledge she coveted, and if Mrs, Arden's or Mr. McNeal's names
+were mentioned she listened with trembling anxiety in the hope of
+hearing some allusion to the note.
+
+At last, when she had almost given up the matter in despair, an
+unlooked-for chance put her in possession of a fragment of this very
+note to which she attached so much importance.
+
+One day Louisa wanted to wind a skein of silk, and in looking for a
+piece of paper to wind it upon she opened her writing-box, and took
+out Mrs. Arden's note. Sophy knew it again in an instant from its
+three-cornered shape. She saw her sister tear the note in two, throw
+one-half under the grate, and fold the other part up to wind her silk
+upon. Sophy kept her eye upon the paper that lay under the grate in
+the greatest anxiety, lest a coal should drop upon it and destroy it,
+when it seemed almost within her grasp. Louisa was called out of the
+room, and Sophy, overpowered by the greatness of the temptation,
+forgot all the good resolutions she had so lately made, and at the
+risk of setting fire to her sleeve, snatched the paper from among the
+ashes, and concealed it in her pocket. She then flew to her own room
+to examine it at her ease. The note had been torn the lengthway of the
+paper, and that part of it of which Sophy had possessed herself
+contained the first half of each line of the note. Bolting her door
+for fear of interruption, she read, with trembling impatience, as
+follows:
+
+ Will you
+ be kind enough to go to
+ Mr. McNeal, and tell him
+ he has made a great mistake
+ the last stockings he sent;
+ charging them as silk) he has cheated
+ of several pounds.--I am sorry to say
+ that he has behaved very ill
+ And Mr. Arden tells me that
+ it must end in his being hanged
+ I am exceedingly grieved
+ but fear this will be the end
+
+When Sophy had read these broken sentences she fancied that she fully
+comprehended the purport of the whole note, and she now saw the reason
+of her sister's hastening to Mr. McNeal's immediately on the receipt
+of the note, and of the hurry in which he had been summoned back to
+his shop. It appeared very clear to her that he had defrauded Mrs.
+Arden of a considerable sum of money, and that he was no longer that
+honest tradesman he had been supposed. The weight of this important
+discovery quite overburdened her, and, forgetful of her past
+punishment, and regardless of future consequences, she imparted the
+surprising secret to Sally. Sally was not one who could keep such a
+piece of news to herself; it was therefore soon circulated through
+half the town that Mr. McNeal had defrauded Mrs. Arden, and that Mr.
+Arden declared he would have him hanged for it. Several persons in
+consequence avoided Mr. McNeal's shop, who saw his customers forsaking
+him without being able to know why they did so. Thus the conduct of
+this inconsiderate girl took away the good name of an honest
+tradesman, on no better foundation than her own idle conjectures,
+drawn from the torn fragments of a letter.
+
+Mr. McNeal at length became informed of the injurious report that was
+circulated about him. He immediately went to Mrs. Arden to tell her of
+the report, and to ask her if any inadvertency of his own in regard to
+her dealings at his shop occasioned her speaking so disadvantageously
+of him. Mrs. Arden was much astonished at what he told her, as she
+might well be, and assured him that she had never either spoken of him
+or thought of him but as thoroughly an honorable and honest tradesman.
+Mrs. Arden was exceedingly hurt that her name should be attached to
+such a cruel calumny, and, on consulting with Sir Henry Askham, it was
+agreed that he and Mrs. Arden should make it their business to trace
+it back to its authors. They found no real difficulty in tracing it
+back to Sally, Dr. Hammond's servant. She was accordingly sent for to
+Mr. McNeal's, where Sir Henry Askham and Mr. Arden, with some other
+gentlemen, were assembled on this charitable investigation. Sally, on
+being questioned who had told her of the report, replied, without
+hesitation, that she had been told by Miss Sophy, who had seen all the
+particulars in Mrs. Arden's handwriting.
+
+Mr. Arden was greatly astonished at hearing this assertion, and felt
+confident that the whole must have originated from some strange
+blunder. He and the other gentlemen immediately proceeded to Dr.
+Hammond's, and having explained their business to him, desired to see
+Sophy. She, on being asked, confirmed what Sally had said, adding that
+to satisfy them she could show them Mrs. Arden's own words, and she
+accordingly produced the fragment of the note. Miss Hammond, the
+instant she saw the paper recollected it again, and winding off the
+silk from the other half of Mrs. Arden's note, presented it to Mr.
+Arden, who, laying the two pieces of paper together read as follows:
+
+ "MY DEAR MISS HAMMOND,--Will you as soon as you receive this
+ be kind enough to go to your opposite neighbor, Mr. McNeal,
+ and tell him I find by looking at his bill he has made a
+ great mistake as to the price of the last stockings he sent;
+ and it seems to me (by not charging them as silk) he has
+ cheated himself, as he'll see, of several pounds.--I am sorry
+ to say of our new dog, that he has behaved very ill and
+ worried two sheep, and Mr. Arden tells me he very much fears
+ it must end in his being hanged or he'll kill all the flock.
+ I am exceedingly grieved, for he is a noble animal, but fear
+ this will be the end of my poor dog.
+
+ "I am, dear Louisa, yours truly
+
+ "MARY ARDEN."
+
+Thus by the fortunate preservation of the last half of the note the
+whole affair was cleared up, Mrs. Arden's character vindicated from
+the charge of being a defamer, and Mr. McNeal from all suspicion of
+dishonesty. And all their friends were pleased and satisfied. But how
+did Sophy feel? She did feel at last both remorse and humiliation. She
+had no one to blame but herself; she had no one to take her part, for
+even her father and her brother considered it due to public justice
+that she should make a public acknowledgment of her fault to Mr.
+McNeal, and to ask his pardon.
+
+
+
+
+BUSY IDLENESS
+
+By JANE TAYLOR
+
+
+Mrs. Dawson being obliged to leave home for six weeks, her daughters,
+Charlotte and Caroline, received permission to employ the time of her
+absence as they pleased; that is, she did not require of them the
+usual strict attention to particular hours and particular studies, but
+allowed them to choose their own employments--only recommending them
+to make a good use of the license, and apprising them, that, on her
+return, she should require an exact account of the manner in which the
+interval had been employed.
+
+The carriage that conveyed their mother away was scarcely out of
+hearing, when Charlotte, delighted with her freedom, hastened upstairs
+to the schoolroom, where she looked around on books, globes, maps,
+drawings, to select some new employment for the morning. Long before
+she had decided upon any, her sister had quietly seated herself at her
+accustomed station, thinking that she could do nothing better than
+finish the French exercise she had begun the day before. Charlotte,
+however, declined attending to French that day, and after much
+indecision, and saying "I have a great mind to" three several times
+without finishing the sentence, she at last took down a volume of
+Cowper, and read in different parts for about half an hour. Then
+throwing it aside, she said she had a great mind to put the
+bookshelves in order--a business which she commenced with great
+spirit. But in the course of her laudable undertaking, she met with a
+manuscript in shorthand; whereupon she exclaimed to her sister,
+"Caroline, don't you remember that old Mr. Henderson once promised he
+would teach us shorthand? How much I should like to learn! Only, mamma
+thought we had not time. But now, this would be such a good
+opportunity. I am sure I could learn it well in six weeks; and how
+convenient it would be! One could take down sermons, or anything; and
+I could make Rachel learn, and then how very pleasant it would be to
+write to each other in shorthand! Indeed, it would be convenient in a
+hundred ways." So saying, she ran upstairs, without any further delay,
+and putting on her hat and spencer, set off to old Mr. Henderson's.
+
+Mr. Henderson happened to be at dinner. Nevertheless, Charlotte
+obtained admittance on the plea of urgent business; but she entered
+his apartment so much out of breath, and in such apparent agitation,
+that the old gentleman, rising hastily from table, and looking
+anxiously at her over his spectacles, inquired in a tremulous tone
+what was the matter. When, therefore, Charlotte explained her
+business, he appeared a little disconcerted; but having gently
+reproved her for her undue eagerness, he composedly resumed his knife
+and fork, though his hand shook much more than usual during the
+remainder of his meal. However, being very good-natured, as soon as he
+had dined he cheerfully gave Charlotte her first lesson in shorthand,
+promising to repeat it regularly every morning.
+
+Charlotte returned home in high glee. She at this juncture considered
+shorthand as one of the most useful, and decidedly the most
+interesting of acquirements; and she continued to exercise herself in
+it all the rest of the day. She was exceedingly pleased at being able
+already to write two or three words which neither her sister nor even
+her father could decipher. For three successive mornings Charlotte
+punctually kept her appointment with Mr. Henderson; but on the fourth
+she sent a shabby excuse to her kind master; and, if the truth must be
+told, he from that time saw no more of his scholar. Now the cause of
+this desertion was twofold: first, and principally, her zeal for
+shorthand, which for the last eight-and-forty hours had been sensibly
+declining in its temperature, was, on the above morning, within half a
+degree of freezing point; and, second, a new and far more arduous and
+important undertaking had by this time suggested itself to her mind.
+Like many young persons of desultory inclinations, Charlotte often
+amused herself with writing verses; and it now occurred to her that an
+abridged history of England in verse was still a desideratum in
+literature. She commenced this task with her usual diligence; but was
+somewhat discouraged in the outset by the difficulty of finding a
+rhyme to Saxon, whom she indulged the unpatriotic wish that the Danes
+had laid a tax on. But, though she got over this obstacle by a new
+construction of the line, she found these difficulties occur so
+continually that she soon felt a more thorough disgust at this
+employment than at the preceding one. So the epic stopped short, some
+hundred years before the Norman conquest. Difficulty, which quickens
+the ardor of industry, always damps, and generally extinguishes, the
+false zeal of caprice and versatility.
+
+Charlotte's next undertaking was, to be sure, a rapid descent from the
+last in the scale of dignity. She now thought, that, by working very
+hard during the remainder of the time, she should be able to
+accomplish a patch-work counterpane, large enough for her own little
+tent bed; and the ease of this employment formed a most agreeable
+contrast in her mind with the extreme difficulty of the last.
+Accordingly, as if commissioned with a search warrant, she ransacked
+all her mother's drawers, bags, and bundles in quest of new pieces;
+and these spoils proving very insufficient, she set off to tax all her
+friends, and to tease all the linen drapers in the town for their odds
+and ends, urging that she wanted some particularly. As she was posting
+along the street on this business, she espied at a distance a person
+whom she had no wish to encounter, namely, old Mr. Henderson. To avoid
+the meeting she crossed over. But this maneuver did not succeed; for
+no sooner had they come opposite to each other, than, to her great
+confusion, he called out across the street, in his loud and tremulous
+voice, and shaking his stick at her, "How d'ye do, Miss Shorthand? I
+thought how it would be! Oh, fie! Oh, fie!"
+
+Charlotte hurried on; and her thoughts soon returned to the idea of
+the splendid radiating star which she designed for the centerpiece of
+her counterpane. While she was arranging the different patterns, and
+forming the alternations of light and shade, her interest continued
+nearly unabated; but when she came to the practical part of sewing
+piece to piece with unvarying sameness, it began, as usual, to flag.
+She sighed several times, and cast many disconsolate looks at the
+endless hexagons and octagons, before she indulged any distinct idea
+of relinquishing her task. At length, however, it did forcibly occur
+to her that, after all, she was not obliged to go on with it; and
+that, really, patchwork was a thing that was better done by degrees,
+when one happens to want a job, than to be finished all at once. So,
+with this thought (which would have been a very good one if it had
+occurred in proper time), she suddenly drew out her needle, thrust all
+her pieces, arranged and unarranged, into a drawer, and began to
+meditate a new project.
+
+Fortunately, just at this juncture some young ladies of their
+acquaintance called upon Charlotte and Caroline. They were attempting
+to establish a society among their young friends for working for the
+poor, and came to request their assistance. Caroline very cheerfully
+entered into the design; but as for Charlotte, nothing could exceed
+the forwardness of her zeal. She took it up so warmly that Caroline's
+appeared, in comparison, only lukewarm. It was proposed that each
+member of the society should have an equal proportion of the work to
+do at her own house; but when the articles came to be distributed,
+Charlotte, in the heat of her benevolence, desired that a double
+portion might be allotted to her. Some of the younger ones admired her
+industrious intentions, but the better judging advised her not to
+undertake too much at once. However, she would not be satisfied till
+her request was complied with. When the parcels of work arrived,
+Charlotte with exultation seized the larger one, and without a
+minute's delay commenced her charitable labors. The following morning
+she rose at four o'clock, to resume the employment; and not a little
+self-complacency did she feel, when, after nearly two hours' hard
+work, she still heard Caroline breathing in a sound sleep. But, alas!
+Charlotte soon found that work is work, of whatever nature, or for
+whatever purpose. She now inwardly regretted that she had asked for
+more than her share; and the cowardly thought that after all she was
+not obliged to do it next occurred to her. For the present, therefore,
+she squeezed all the things, done and undone, into what she called
+her "Dorcas bag;" and to banish unpleasant thoughts, she opened the
+first book that happened to lie within reach. It proved to be "An
+Introduction to Botany." Of this she had not read more than a page and
+a half before she determined to collect some specimens herself; and
+having found a blank copy-book she hastened into the garden, where,
+gathering a few common flowers, she proceeded to dissect them, not, it
+is to be feared, with much scientific nicety. Perhaps as many as three
+pages of this copy-book were bespread with her specimens before she
+discovered that botany was a dry study.
+
+It would be too tedious to enumerate all the subsequent ephemeral
+undertakings which filled up the remainder of the six weeks. At the
+expiration of that time Mrs. Dawson returned. On the next morning
+after her arrival she reminded her daughters of the account she
+expected of their employments during her absence, and desired them to
+set out on two tables in the schoolroom everything they had done that
+could be exhibited, together with the books they had been reading.
+Charlotte would gladly have been excused her part of the exhibition;
+but this was not permitted; and she reluctantly followed her sister to
+make the preparation.
+
+When the two tables were spread, their mother was summoned to attend.
+Caroline's, which was first examined, contained, first, her various
+exercises in the different branches of study, regularly executed the
+same as usual. And there were papers placed in the books she was
+reading in school hours, to show how far she had proceeded in them.
+Besides these, she had read in her leisure time, in French, Florian's
+"Numa Pompilius," and in English, Mrs. More's "Practical Piety," and
+some part of Johnson's "Lives of the Poets." All the needlework which
+had been left to do or not, at her option, was neatly finished; and
+her parcel of linen for the poor was also completely and well done.
+The only instance in which Caroline had availed herself of her
+mother's license, was that she had prolonged her drawing lessons a
+little every day, in order to present her mother with a pretty pair of
+screens, with flowers copied from nature. These were, last of all,
+placed on the table with an affectionate note, requesting her
+acceptance of them.
+
+Mrs. Dawson, having carefully examined this table, proceeded to the
+other, which was quite piled up with different articles. Here, amid
+the heap, were Charlotte's three pages of shorthand; several scraps of
+paper containing fragments of her poetical history; the piece (not
+large enough for a doll's cradle) of her patchwork counterpane; her
+botanical specimens; together with the large unfinished pile out of
+the Dorcas bag, many of the articles of which were begun, but not one
+quite finished. There was a baby's cap with no border, a frock body
+without sleeves, and the skirt only half hemmed at the bottom; and
+slides, tapes, and buttonholes were all, without exception, omitted.
+After these, followed a great variety of thirds, halves, and quarters
+of undertakings, each perhaps good in itself, but quite useless in its
+unfinished state.
+
+The examination being at length ended, Mrs. Dawson retired, without a
+single comment, to her dressing-room; where, in about an hour
+afterwards, she summoned the girls to attend her. Here also were two
+tables laid out, with several articles on each. Their mother then
+leading Caroline to the first, told her that, as the reward of her
+industry and perseverance, the contents of the table were her own.
+Here, with joyful surprise, she beheld, first, a little gold watch,
+which Mrs. Dawson said she thought a suitable present for one who had
+made a good use of her time; a small telescope next appeared; and
+lastly, Paley's "Natural Theology," neatly bound. Charlotte was then
+desired to take possession of the contents of the other table, which
+were considerably more numerous. The first prize she drew out was a
+very beautiful French fan; but upon opening it, it stretched out in an
+oblong shape, for want of the pin to confine the sticks at bottom.
+Then followed a new parasol; but when unfurled there was no catch to
+confine it, so that it would not remain spread. A penknife handle
+without a blade, and the blade without the handle, next presented
+themselves to her astonished gaze. In great confusion she then
+unrolled a paper which discovered a telescope apparently like her
+sister's; but on applying it to her eye, she found it did not contain
+a single lens--so that it was no better than a roll of pasteboard. She
+was, however, greatly encouraged to discover that the last remaining
+article was a watch; for, as she heard it tick, she felt no doubt that
+this at least was complete; but upon examination she discovered that
+there was no hour hand, the minute hand alone pursuing its lonely and
+useless track.
+
+Charlotte, whose conscience had very soon explained to her the moral
+of all this, now turned from the tantalizing table in confusion, and
+burst into an agony of tears. Caroline wept also; and Mrs. Dawson,
+after an interval of silence, thus addressed her daughters:
+
+"It is quite needless for me to explain my reasons for making you such
+presents, Charlotte. I assure you your papa and I have had a very
+painful employment the past hour in spoiling them all for you. If I
+had found on your table in the schoolroom any one thing that had been
+properly finished, you would have received one complete present to
+answer it; but this you know was not the case. I should be very glad
+if this disappointment should teach you what I have hitherto vainly
+endeavored to impress upon you--that as all those things, pretty or
+useful as they are in themselves, are rendered totally useless for
+want of completeness, so exertion without perseverance is no better
+than busy idleness. That employment does not deserve the name of
+industry which requires the stimulus of novelty to keep it going.
+Those who will only work so long as they are amused will do no more
+good in the world, either to themselves or others, than those who
+refuse to work at all. If I had required you to pass the six weeks of
+my absence in bed or in counting your fingers, you would, I suppose,
+have thought it a sad waste of time; and yet I appeal to you whether
+(with the exception of an hour or two of needlework) the whole mass of
+articles on your table could produce anything more useful. And thus,
+my dears, may life be squandered away, in a succession of busy
+nothings.
+
+"I have now a proposal to make to you. These presents, which you are
+to take possession of as they are, I advise you to lay by carefully.
+Whenever you can show me anything that you have begun, and voluntarily
+finished, you may at the same time bring with you one of these things,
+beginning with those of least value, to which I will immediately add
+the part that is deficient. Thus, by degrees, you may have them all
+completed; and if by this means you should acquire the wise and
+virtuous habit of perseverance, it will be far more valuable to you
+than the richest present you could possibly receive."
+
+
+
+
+THE RENOWNED HISTORY OF LITTLE GOODY TWO-SHOES
+
+Ascribed to OLIVER GOLDSMITH
+
+
+
+
+INTRODUCTION
+
+
+All the world must allow that Two-Shoes was not her real name. No; her
+father's name was Meanwell; and he was for many years a considerable
+farmer in the parish where Margery was born; but by the misfortunes
+which he met with in business, and the wicked persecutions of Sir
+Timothy Gripe, and an overgrown farmer called Graspall, he was
+effectually ruined.
+
+The case was thus: The parish of Mould well, where they lived, had for
+many ages been let by the lord of the manor in twelve different farms,
+in which the tenants lived comfortably, brought up large families, and
+carefully supported the poor people who labored for them, until the
+estate by marriage and by death came into the hands of Sir Timothy.
+
+This, gentleman, who loved himself better than all his neighbors,
+thought it was less trouble to write one receipt for his rent than
+twelve; and Farmer Graspall offering to take all the farms as the
+leases expired, Sir Timothy agreed with him, and in process of time he
+was possessed of every farm but that occupied by little Margery's
+father, which he also wanted; for as Mr. Meanwell was a charitable,
+good man, he stood up for the poor at the parish meetings, and was
+unwilling to have them oppressed by Sir Timothy and this avaricious
+farmer. Judge, O kind, humane, and courteous reader, what a terrible
+situation the poor must be in, when this covetous man was perpetual
+overseer, and everything for their maintenance was drawn from his hard
+heart and cruel hand. But he was not only perpetual overseer, but
+perpetual churchwarden; and judge, O ye Christians, what state the
+church must be in, when supported by a man without religion or
+virtue. He was also perpetual surveyor of the highways, and what sort
+of roads he kept up for the convenience of travelers, those best knew
+who have had the misfortune to pass through that parish. Complaints
+indeed were made, but to what purpose are complaints, when brought
+against a man who can hunt, drink, and smoke, without the lord of the
+manor, who is also the justice of peace?
+
+The opposition which Little Margery's father made to this man's
+tyranny gave offense to Sir Timothy, who endeavored to force him out
+of his farm; and, to oblige him to throw up the lease, ordered both a
+brick-kiln and a dog kennel to be erected in the farmer's orchard.
+This was contrary to law, and a suit was commenced, in which Margery's
+father got the better. The same offense was again committed three
+different times, and as many actions brought, in all of which the
+farmer had a verdict, and costs paid him; but notwithstanding these
+advantages, the law was so expensive, that he was ruined in the
+contest, and obliged to give up all he had to his creditors; which
+effectually answered the purpose of Sir Timothy, who erected those
+nuisances in the farmer's orchard with that intention. Ah, my dear
+reader, we brag of liberty, and boast of our laws; but the blessings
+of the one, and the protection of the other, seldom fall to the lot of
+the poor; and especially when a rich man is their adversary. How, in
+the name-of goodness, can a poor wretch obtain redress, when thirty
+pounds are insufficient to try his cause? Where is he to find money to
+fee counsel, or how can he plead his cause himself (even if he was
+permitted) when our laws are so obscure and so multiplied that an
+abridgment of them cannot be contained in fifty volumes folio?
+
+As soon as Mr. Meanwell had called together his creditors, Sir Timothy
+seized for a year's rent, and turned the farmer, his wife, Little
+Margery, and her brother out of doors, without any of the necessaries
+of life to support them.
+
+This elated the heart of Mr. Graspall, this crowned his hopes, and
+filled the measure of his iniquity; for, besides gratifying his
+revenge, this man's overthrow gave him the sole dominion over the
+poor, whom he depressed and abused in a manner too horrible to
+mention.
+
+Margery's father flew into another parish for succor, and all those
+who were able to move left their dwellings and sought employment
+elsewhere, as they found it would be impossible to live under the
+tyranny of two such people. The very old, the very lame, and the blind
+were obliged to stay behind, and whether they were starved, or what
+became of them, history does not say; but the characters of the great
+Sir Timothy, and the avaricious tenant, were so infamous, that nobody
+would work for them by the day, and servants were afraid to engage
+themselves by the year, lest any unforseen accident should leave them
+parishioners in a place where they knew they must perish miserably; so
+that great part of the land lay untilled for some years, which was
+deemed a just reward for such diabolical proceedings.
+
+But what, says the reader, can occasion all this? do you intend this
+for children? Permit me to inform you, that this is not the book, sir,
+mentioned in the title, but an introduction to that book; and it is
+intended, sir, not for that sort of children, but for children of six
+feet high, of which, as my friend has justly observed, there are many
+millions in the kingdom; and these reflections, sir, have been
+rendered necessary by the unaccountable and diabolical scheme which
+many gentlemen now give in to, of laying a number of farms into one,
+and very often a whole parish into one farm; which in the end must
+reduce the common people to a stage of vassalage, worse than that
+under the barons of old, or of the clans in Scotland, and will in time
+depopulate the kingdom. But as you are tired of the subject, I shall
+take myself away, and you may visit Little Margery.
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+HOW AND ABOUT LITTLE MARGERY AND HER BROTHER
+
+
+Care and discontent shortened the days of Little Margery's father. He
+was forced from his family, and seized with a violent fever in a place
+where Dr. James's powder was not to be had, and where he died
+miserably. Margery's poor mother survived the loss of her husband but
+a few days, and died of a broken heart, leaving Margery and her little
+brother to the wide world; but, poor woman, it would have melted your
+heart to have seen how frequently she heaved her head, while she lay
+speechless, to survey with languishing looks her little orphans, as
+much as to say, "Do, Tommy, do, Margery, come with me." They cried,
+poor things, and she sighed away her soul; and I hope is happy.
+
+It would both have excited your pity, and have done your heart good,
+to have seen how these two little ones were so fond of each other, and
+how hand in hand they trotted about.
+
+They were both very ragged, and Tommy had no shoes, and Margery had
+but one. They had nothing, poor things, to support them (not being in
+their own parish) but what they picked from the hedges, or got from
+the poor people, and they lay every night in a barn. Their relations
+took no notice of them; no, they were rich, and ashamed to own such a
+poor little ragged girl as Margery, and such a dirty little
+curly-pated boy as Tommy. Our relations and friends seldom take notice
+of us when we are poor; but as we grow rich they grow fond. And this
+will always be the case, while people love money better than they do
+God Almighty. But such wicked folks who love nothing but money, and
+are proud and despise the poor, never come to any good in the end, as
+we shall see by and by.
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+HOW AND ABOUT MR. SMITH
+
+
+Mr. Smith was a very worthy clergyman, who lived in the parish where
+Little Margery and Tommy were born; and having a relation come to see
+him, who was a charitable, good man, he sent for these children to
+come to him. The gentleman ordered Little Margery a new pair of shoes,
+gave Mr. Smith some money to buy her clothes, and said he would take
+Tommy and make him a little sailor.
+
+After some days the gentleman intended to go to London, and take
+little Tommy with him, of whom you will know more by and by, for we
+shall at a proper time present you with his history, his travels, and
+adventures.
+
+The parting between these little children was very affecting. Tommy
+cried, and they kissed each other an hundred times: at last Tommy thus
+wiped off her tears with the end of his jacket, and bid her cry no
+more, for that he would come to her again when he returned from sea.
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+HOW LITTLE MARGERY OBTAINED THE NAME OF GOODY TWO-SHOES, AND WHAT
+HAPPENED IN THE PARISH
+
+
+As soon as Little Margery got up in the morning, which was very early,
+she ran all round the village, crying for her brother; and after some
+time returned greatly distressed.
+
+However, at this instant, the shoemaker very opportunely came in with
+the new shoes, for which she had been measured by the gentleman's
+order.
+
+Nothing could have supported Little Margery under the affliction she
+was in for the loss of her brother, but the pleasure she took in her
+two shoes. She ran out to Mrs. Smith as soon as they were put on, and
+stroking down her ragged apron thus cried out, "Two shoes, ma'am, see
+two shoes." And so she behaved to all the people she met, and by that
+means obtained the name of Goody Two-Shoes.
+
+Little Margery was very happy in being with Mr. and Mrs. Smith, who
+were very charitable and good to her, and had agreed to bring her up
+with their family: but as soon as that tyrant of the parish, that
+Graspall, heard of her being there, he applied first to Mr. Smith, and
+threatened to reduce his tithes if he kept her; and after that he
+spoke to Sir Timothy, who sent Mr. Smith a peremptory message by his
+servant, that he should send back Meanwell's girl to be kept by her
+relations, and not harbor her in the parish. This so distressed Mr.
+Smith, that he shed tears, and cried, "Lord, have mercy on the poor!"
+
+The prayers of the righteous fly upwards, and reach unto the throne of
+heaven, as will be seen by the sequel.
+
+Mrs. Smith was also greatly concerned at being thus obliged to
+discard poor Little Margery. She kissed her, and cried, as did also
+Mr. Smith; but they were obliged to send her away, for the people who
+had ruined her father could at any time have ruined them.
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+HOW LITTLE MARGERY LEARNED TO READ, AND BY DEGREES TAUGHT OTHERS
+
+
+Little Margery saw how good and how wise Mr. Smith was, and concluded
+that this was owing to his great learning, therefore she wanted of all
+things to learn to read. For this purpose she used to meet the little
+boys as they came from school, borrow their books, and sit down and
+read till they returned. By this means she got more learning than any
+of her playmates, and laid the following scheme for instructing those
+who were more ignorant than herself. She found that only the following
+letters were required to spell all the words; but as some of these
+letters are large, and some small, she with her knife cut out of
+several pieces of wood ten sets of each of these:
+
+a b c d e f g h i j k l m n o p q r s t u v w x y z.
+
+And having got an old spelling book, she made her companions set up
+all the words they wanted to spell, and after that she taught them to
+compose sentences. "You know what a sentence is, my dear. 'I will be
+good' is a sentence; and is made up, as you see, of several words."
+
+I once went her rounds with her, and was highly diverted, as you may
+see, if you please to look into the next chapter.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+HOW LITTLE TWO-SHOES BECAME A TROTTING TUTORESS, AND HOW SHE TAUGHT
+HER YOUNG PUPILS
+
+
+It was about seven o'clock in the morning when we set out on this
+important business, and the first house we came to was Farmer
+Wilson's. Here Margery stopped, and ran up to the door, tap, tap, tap.
+"Who's there?" "Only Little Goody Two-Shoes," answered Margery, "come
+to teach Billy." "Oh! Little Goody," says Mrs. Wilson, with pleasure
+in her face, "I am glad to see you Billy wants you sadly for he has
+learned his lesson." Then out came the little boy. "How do, Doody
+Two-Shoes," says he, not able to speak plain. Yet this little boy had
+learned all his letters; for she threw down this alphabet mixed
+together thus:
+
+b d f h k m o q s u w y x f a c e g i l n p r t v z j,
+
+and he picked them up, called them by their right names, and put them
+all in order thus:
+
+a b c d e f g h i j k i m n o p q r s t u v w x y z.
+
+The next place we came to was Farmer Simpson's.
+
+"Bow, wow, wow," says the dog at the door. "Sirrah," says his
+mistress, "what do you bark at Little Two-Shoes? come in, Madge; here,
+Sally wants you sadly, she has learned all her lesson." "Yes, that's
+what I have," replied the little one, in the country manner: and
+immediately taking the letters she set up these syllables:
+
+ ba be bi bo bu, ca ce ci co cu,
+
+ da de di do du, fa fe fi fo fu,
+
+and gave them their exact sounds as she composed them.
+
+After this, Little Two-Shoes taught her to spell words of one
+syllable, and she soon set up pear, plumb, top, ball, pin, puss, dog,
+hog, fawn, buck, doe, lamb, sheep, ram, cow, bull, cock, hen, and many
+more.
+
+The next place we came to was Gaffer Cook's cottage. Here a number of
+poor children were met to learn, who all came round Little Margery at
+once, who having pulled out her letters, asked the little boy next her
+what he had for dinner? Who answered, "Bread" (the poor children in
+many places live very hard). "Well then," says she, "set up the first
+letter." He put up the B, to which the next added r, and the next e,
+the next a, the next d, and it stood thus, Bread.
+
+And what had you, Polly Comb, for your dinner? "Apple Pie," answered
+the little girl; upon which the next in turn set up a great A, the two
+next a p each, and so on, till the two words Apple and Pie were united
+and stood thus, Apple Pie.
+
+The next had potatoes, the next beef and turnips; which were spelled,
+with many others, till the game of spelling was finished. She then set
+them another task, and we proceeded.
+
+The next place we came to was Farmer Thomson's, where there was a
+great many little ones waiting for her.
+
+"So, Little Mrs. Goody Two-Shoes," says one of them, "where have you
+been so long?" "I have been teaching," says she, "longer than I
+intended, and am, I am afraid, come too soon for you now." "No, but
+indeed you are not," replied the other; "for I have got my lesson, and
+so has Sally Dawson, and so has Harry Wilson, and so have we all;" and
+they capered about as if they were overjoyed to see her. "Why, then,"
+says she, "you are all very good, and God Almighty will love you; so
+let us begin our lessons." They all huddled round her, and though at
+the other place they were employed about words and syllables, here we
+had people of much greater understanding who dealt only in sentences.
+
+The letters being brought upon the table, one of the little ones set
+up the following sentence:
+
+"The Lord have mercy upon me, and grant that I may be always good, and
+say my prayers, and love the Lord my God with all my heart, with all
+my soul, and with all my strength; and honor the King and all good men
+in authority under him."
+
+Then the next took the letters, and composed this sentence:
+
+"Lord, have mercy upon me, and grant that I may love my neighbor as
+myself, and do unto all men as I would have them do unto me, and tell
+no lies; but be honest and just in all my dealings."
+
+LESSON FOR THE CONDUCT OF LIFE
+
+ He that would thrive,
+ Must rise by five.
+ He that hath thriven,
+ May lay till seven.
+ Truth may be blamed
+ But can't be shamed.
+ Tell me with whom you go,
+ And I'll tell what you do.
+ A friend in your need,
+ Is a friend indeed.
+ They never can be wise,
+ Who good counsel despise.
+
+As we were returning home, we saw a gentleman, who was very ill,
+sitting under a shady tree at the corner of the rookery. Though ill,
+he began to joke with Little Margery, and said, laughing, "So, Goody
+Two-Shoes, they tell me you are a cunning little baggage; pray can you
+tell me what I shall do to get well?" "Yes, sir," says she, "go to bed
+when your rooks do and get up with them in the morning; earn, as they
+do, every day what you eat, and eat and drink no more than you earn:
+and you'll get health and keep it. What should induce the rooks to
+frequent gentlemen's houses, only but to tell them how to lead a
+prudent life? they never build under cottages or farmhouses, because
+they see that these people know how to live without their admonition.
+
+ "Thus wealth and wit you may improve.
+ Taught by tenants of the grove."
+
+The gentleman, laughing, gave Margery sixpence, and told her she was a
+sensible hussy.
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+HOW THE WHOLE PARISH WAS FRIGHTENED
+
+
+Who does not know Lady Ducklington, or who does not know that she was
+buried at this parish church? Well, I never saw a grander funeral in
+all my life; but the money they squandered away would have been better
+laid out in little books for children, or in meat, drink, and clothes
+for the poor.
+
+All the country round came to see the burying, and it was late before
+the corpse was interred. After which, in the night, or rather about
+two o'clock in the morning, the bells were heard to jingle in the
+steeple, which frightened the people prodigiously, who all thought it
+was Lady Ducklington's ghost dancing among the bell ropes. The people
+flocked to Will Dobbins, the clerk, and wanted him to go to see what
+it was; but William said he was sure it was a ghost, and that he would
+not offer to open the door. At length Mr. Long, the rector, hearing
+such an uproar in the village, went to the clerk, to know why he did
+not go into the church, and see who was there. "I go, sir?" says
+William; "why, the ghost would frighten me out of my wits!" Mrs.
+Dobbins, too, cried, and laying hold of her husband, said he should
+not be eat up by the ghost. "A ghost, you blockhead," says Mr. Long,
+in a pet; "did either of you ever see a ghost in a church, or know
+anybody that did?" "Yes," says the clerk, "my father did once in the
+shape of a windmill, and it walked all around the church in a trice,
+with jack boots on, and had a gun by its side, instead of a sword." "A
+fine picture of a ghost, truly," says Mr. Long; "give me the key of
+the church, you monkey, for I tell you there is no such thing now,
+whatever may have been formerly." Then taking the key, he went to the
+church, all the people following him. As soon as he had opened the
+door, what sort of a ghost do you think appeared? Why, Little
+Two-Shoes, who being weary had fallen asleep in one of the pews during
+the funeral service, and was shut in all night. She immediately asked
+Mr. Long's pardon for the trouble she had given him, told him she had
+been locked into the church, and said she should not have rung the
+bells, but that she was very cold, and hearing Farmer Boult's man go
+whistling by with his horses, she was in hopes he would have gone to
+the clerk for the key to let her out.
+
+
+
+
+VII
+
+CONTAINING AN ACCOUNT OF ALL THE SPIRITS OR THINGS SHE SAW IN THE
+CHURCH
+
+
+The people were ashamed to ask Little Madge any questions before Mr.
+Long, but as soon as he was gone, they all got round her to satisfy
+their curiosity, and desired she would give them a particular account
+of all that she had heard or seen.
+
+
+HER TALE
+
+
+"I went to the church," said she, "as most of you did last night, to
+see the burying, and, being very weary, I sat me down in Mr. Johns's
+pew, and fell fast asleep. At eleven of the clock I awoke; which I
+believe was in some measure occasioned by the clock's striking, for I
+heard it. I started up, and could not at first tell where I was; but
+after some time I recollected the funeral, and soon found that I was
+shut in the church. It was dismal dark, and I could see nothing; but
+while I was standing in the pew, something jumped up upon me behind,
+and laid, as I thought, its hands over my shoulders. I own I was a
+little afraid at first; however, I considered that I had always been
+constant at prayers, and at church, and that I had done nobody any
+harm, but had endeavored to do what good I could; and then thought I,
+what have I to fear? Yet I kneeled down to say my prayers. As soon as
+I was on my knees, something very cold, as cold as marble, ay, as cold
+as ice, touched my neck, which made me start, however, I continued my
+prayers, and having begged protection from Almighty God, I found my
+spirits come, and I was sensible I had nothing to fear; for God
+Almighty protects not only all those that are good, but also all those
+who endeavor to be good--nothing can withstand the power, and exceed
+the goodness of God Almighty. Armed with the confidence of his
+protection; I walked down the church aisle, when I heard something
+pit, pat, pit, pat, pit, pat, come after me, and something touched my
+hand, which seemed as cold as a marble monument. I could not think
+what this was, yet I knew that it could not hurt me, and therefore I
+made myself easy; but being very cold, and the church being paved with
+stones, which were very damp, I felt my way, as well as I could, to
+the pulpit; in doing which something rushed by me and almost threw me
+down, However, I was not frightened, for I knew that God Almighty
+would suffer nothing to hurt me.
+
+"At last I found out the pulpit, and having shut the door, I laid me
+down on the mat and cushion to sleep; when something thrust and pulled
+the door, as I thought, for admittance, which prevented my going to
+sleep. At last it cries, 'Bow, wow, wow;' and I concluded it must be
+Mr. Saunderson's dog, which had followed me from their house to
+church; so I opened the door, and called Snip, Snip, and the dog
+jumped upon me immediately. After this, Snip and I lay down together,
+and had a comfortable nap; for when I awoke again it was almost light.
+I then walked up and down all the aisles of the church to keep myself
+warm; and though I went into the vaults, and trod on Lady
+Ducklington's coffin, I saw nothing, and I believe it was owing to the
+reason Mr. Long has given you, namely, that there is no such thing to
+be seen. As to my part, I would as soon lie all night in a church as
+in any other place; and I am sure that any little boy or girl, who is
+good and loves God Almighty, and keeps his commandments, may as safely
+lie in the church, or the churchyard, as anywhere else, if they take
+care not to get cold, for I am sure there are no things either to hurt
+or to frighten them; though any one possessed of fear might have taken
+Neighbor Saunderson's dog with his cold nose for a ghost; and if they
+had not been undeceived, as I was, would never have thought
+otherwise." All the company acknowledged the justness of the
+observation, and thanked Little Two-Shoes for her advice.
+
+
+
+
+REFLECTION
+
+
+After this, my dear children, I hope you will not believe any foolish
+stories that ignorant, weak, or designing people may tell you about
+ghosts; for the tales of ghosts, witches, and fairies are the frolics
+of a distempered brain. No wise man ever saw either of them. Little
+Margery was not afraid; no, she had good sense, and a good conscience,
+which is a cure for all these imaginary evils.
+
+
+
+
+VIII
+
+OF SOMETHING WHICH HAPPENED TO LITTLE MARGERY TWO-SHOES IN A BARN,
+MORE DREADFUL THAN THE GHOST IN THE CHURCH; AND HOW SHE RETURNED GOOD
+FOR EVIL TO HER ENEMY, SIR TIMOTHY.
+
+
+Some days after this, a more dreadful accident befell Little Madge.
+She happened to be coming late from teaching, when it rained,
+thundered, and lightened and therefore she took shelter in a farmer's
+barn at a distance from the village. Soon after, the tempest drove in
+four thieves, who not seeing such a little creep-mouse girl as
+Two-Shoes, lay down on the hay next to her, and began to talk over
+their exploits, and to settle plans for future robberies. Little
+Margery, on hearing them, covered herself with straw. To be sure she
+was frightened, but her good sense taught her that the only security
+she had was in keeping herself concealed; therefore she lay very still
+and breathed very softly. About four o'clock these wicked people came
+to a resolution to break both Sir William Dove's house and Sir Timothy
+Gripe's, and by force of arms to carry off all their money, plate, and
+jewels; but as it was thought then too late, they all agreed to defer
+it till the next night. After laying his scheme, they all set out upon
+their pranks, which greatly rejoiced Margery, as it would any other
+little girl in her situation. Early in the morning she went to Sir
+William, and told him the whole of their conversation. Upon which he
+asked her name, then gave her something, and bid her call at his house
+the day following. She also went to Sir Timothy, notwithstanding he
+had used her so ill, for she knew it was her duty to do good for evil.
+As soon as he was informed who she was, he took no notice of her; upon
+which she desired to speak to Lady Gripe, and having informed her
+ladyship of the affair she went away. This lady had more sense than
+her husband which indeed is not a singular case; for instead of
+despising Little Margery and her information, she privately set people
+to guard the house. The robbers divided themselves, and went about the
+time mentioned to both houses, and were surprised by the guards and
+taken. Upon examining these wretches (one of which turned evidence),
+both Sir William and Sir Timothy found that they owed their lives to
+the discovery made by Little Margery; and the first took great notice
+of her and would no longer let her lie in a barn; but Sir Timothy only
+said that he was ashamed to owe his life to the daughter of one who
+was his enemy; so true it is, "That a proud man seldom forgives those
+he has injured."
+
+
+
+
+IX
+
+HOW LITTLE MARGERY WAS MADE PRINCIPAL OF A COUNTRY COLLEGE
+
+
+Mrs. Williams, who kept a college for instructing little gentlemen and
+ladies in the science of A, B, C, was at this time very old and
+infirm, and wanted to decline this important trust. This being told to
+Sir William Dove, who lived in the parish, he sent for Mrs. Williams,
+and desired she would examine Little Two-Shoes, and see whether she
+was qualified for the office. This was done, and Mrs. Williams made
+the following report in her favor, namely, that Little Margery was the
+best scholar, and had the best head and the best heart of any one she
+had examined. All the country had a great opinion of Mrs. Williams,
+and this character gave them also a great opinion of Mrs. Margery, for
+so we must now call her.
+
+This Mrs. Margery thought the happiest period of her life; but more
+happiness was in store for her. God Almighty heaps up blessings for
+all those who love him, and though for a time he may suffer them to be
+poor, and distressed, and hide his good purposes from human sight, yet
+in the end they are generally crowned with happiness here, and no one
+can doubt their being so hereafter.
+
+
+
+
+THE RENOWNED HISTORY OF MRS. MARGERY TWO-SHOES
+
+PART TWO
+
+
+In the first part of this work the young student has read, and I hope
+with pleasure and improvement, the history of this lady, while she was
+known and distinguished by the name of LITTLE TWO-SHOES. We are now
+come to a period of her life when that name was discarded, and a more
+eminent one bestowed upon her; I mean that of MRS. MARGERY TWO-SHOES;
+for as she was now president of the A, B, C college, it became
+necessary to exalt her in title as in place.
+
+No sooner was she settled in this office, but she laid every possible
+scheme to promote the welfare and happiness of all her neighbors, and
+especially of her little ones, in whom she took great delight; and all
+those whose parents could not afford to pay for their education, she
+taught for nothing but the pleasure she had in their company; for you
+are to observe that they were very good, or were soon made so by her
+good management.
+
+
+
+
+I
+
+OF HER SCHOOL, HER USHERS, OR ASSISTANTS, AND HER MANNER OF TEACHING
+
+
+We have already informed the reader, that the school where she taught
+was that which was before kept by Mrs. Williams. The room was very
+large and spacious, and as she knew that nature intended children
+should be always in action, she placed her different letters, or
+alphabets, all round the school, so that every one was obliged to get
+up and fetch a letter, or to spell a word when it came to their turn;
+which not only kept them in health, but fixed the letters and points
+firmly in their minds.
+
+
+
+
+
+II
+
+A SCENE OF DISTRESS IN A SCHOOL
+
+
+It happened one day, when Mrs. Two-Shoes was diverting the children
+after dinner, as she usually did, with some innocent games, or
+entertaining and instructive stories, that a man arrived with the
+melancholy news of Sally Jones's father being thrown from his horse,
+and thought past all recovery; nay, the messenger said, that he was
+seemingly dying when he came away. Poor Sally was greatly distressed,
+as indeed were all in the school, for she dearly loved her father, and
+Mrs. Two-Shoes and all her children dearly loved her.
+
+At this instant something was heard to flap at the window, at which
+the children were surprised; but Mrs. Margery, knowing what it was,
+opened the casement, and drew in a pigeon with a letter.
+
+As soon as he was placed upon the table, he walked up to little Sally,
+and dropping the letter, cried "Co, co, coo;" as much as to say,
+"There, read it."
+
+ "My dear Sally--God Almighty has been very merciful and
+ restored your papa to us again, who is now so well as to be
+ able to sit up. I hear you are a good girl, my dear, and I
+ hope you will never forget to praise the Lord for that his
+ great goodness and mercy to us. What a sad thing it would
+ have been if your father had died, and left both you and me,
+ and little Tommy in distress, and without a friend. Your
+ father sends his blessing with mine. Be good, my dear child,
+ and God Almighty will also bless you, whose blessing is above
+ all things.
+
+ "I am, my dear Sally,
+
+ "Your affectionate mother,
+
+ "MARTHA JONES."
+
+
+
+
+III
+
+OF THE AMAZING SAGACITY AND INSTINCT OF A LITTLE DOG
+
+
+Soon after this, a very dreadful accident happened in the school. It
+was on a Thursday morning, I very well remember, when the children
+having learned their lessons soon, she had given them leave to play,
+and they were all running about the school, and diverting themselves
+with the birds and the lamb; at this time the dog, all of a sudden,
+laid hold of his mistress's apron, and endeavored to pull her out of
+the school. She was at first surprised; however, she followed him, to
+see what he intended. No sooner had he led her back into the garden,
+but he ran back, and pulled out one of the children in the same
+manner; upon which she ordered them all to leave the school
+immediately, and they had not been out five minutes before the top of
+the house fell in. What a miraculous deliverance was here! How
+gracious! How good was God Almighty to save all these children from
+destruction, and to make use of such an instrument as a little
+sagacious animal to accomplish his divine will! I should have observed
+that, as soon as they were all in the garden, the dog came leaping
+round them to express his joy, and when the house was fallen, laid
+himself down quietly by his mistress.
+
+Some of the neighbors who saw the school fall, and who were in great
+pain for Margery and her little ones, soon spread the news through the
+village, and all the parents, terrified for their children, came
+crowding in abundance; they had, however, the satisfaction to find
+them all safe, and upon their knees with their mistress, giving God
+thanks for their happy deliverance.
+
+You are not to wonder, my dear reader, that this little dog should
+have more sense than you, or your father, or your grandfather.
+
+Though God Almighty has made man the lord of the creation and endowed
+him with reason; yet in many respects he has been altogether as
+bountiful to other creatures of his forming. Some of the senses of
+other animals are more acute than ours, as we find by daily
+experience.
+
+The downfall of the school was a great misfortune to Mrs. Margery; for
+she not only lost all her books, but was destitute of a place to teach
+in; but Sir William Dove, being informed of this, ordered it to be
+built at his own expense, and till that could be done, Farmer Grove
+was so kind as to let her have his large hall to teach in.
+
+
+
+
+IV
+
+WHAT HAPPENED AT FARMER GROVE'S, AND HOW SHE GRATIFIED HIM FOR THE USE
+OF HIS ROOM
+
+
+While at Mr. Grove's, which was in the heart of the village, she not
+only taught the children in the daytime, but the farmer's servants and
+all the neighbors to read and write in the evening; and it was a
+constant practice, before they went away, to make them all go to
+prayers and sing psalms. By this means the people grew extremely
+regular, his servants were always at home instead of being at the
+alehouse, and he had more work done than ever. This gave not only Mr.
+Grove, but all the neighbors, a high opinion of her good sense and
+prudent behavior; and she was so much esteemed that the most of the
+differences in the parish were left to her decision; and if a man and
+wife quarreled (which sometimes happened in that part of the kingdom),
+both parties certainly came to her for advice. Everybody knows that
+Martha Wilson was a passionate, scolding jade, and that John her
+husband was a surly, ill-tempered fellow. These were one day brought
+by the neighbors for Margery to talk to them, when they talked before
+her, and were going to blows; but she, stepping between them, thus
+addressed the husband: "John," says she, "you are a man, and ought to
+have more sense than to fly in a passion at every word that is said
+amiss by your wife: and Martha," says she, "you ought to know your
+duty better than to say anything to aggravate your husband's
+resentment. These frequent quarrels arise from the indulgence of your
+violent passions; for I know you both love each other, notwithstanding
+what has passed between you. Now, pray tell me, John, and tell me,
+Martha, when you have had a quarrel over night, are you not both sorry
+for it the next day?" They both declared that they were. "Why, then,"
+says she, "I'll tell you how to prevent this for the future, if you
+promise to take my advice." They both promised her. "You know," says
+she, "that a small spark will set fire to tinder, and that tinder
+properly placed will set fire to a house: an angry word is with you as
+that spark, for you are both as touchy as tinder, and very often make
+your own house too hot to hold you. To prevent this, therefore, and to
+live happily for the future, you must solemnly agree, that if one
+speaks an angry word, the other will not answer, till he or she has
+distinctly called over the alphabet, and the other not reply till he
+has told twenty; by this means your passions will be stifled, and
+reason will have time to take the rule."
+
+This is the best recipe that was ever given for a married couple to
+live in peace. Though John and his wife frequently attempted to
+quarrel afterwards, they never could get their passions to a
+considerable height; for there was something so droll in thus carrying
+on the dispute, that, before they got to the end of the argument, they
+saw the absurdity of it, laughed, kissed, and were friends.
+
+
+
+
+V
+
+THE CASE OF MRS. MARGERY
+
+
+Mrs. Margery was always doing good, and thought she could never
+sufficiently gratify those who had done anything to serve her. These
+generous sentiments naturally led her to consult the interest of Mr.
+Grove, and the rest of her neighbors; and as most of their lands were
+meadow, and they depended much on their hay, which had been for many
+years greatly damaged by the wet weather, she contrived an instrument
+to direct them when to mow their grass with safety, and prevent their
+hay being spoiled. They all came to her for advice, and by that means
+got in their hay without damage, while most of that in the neighboring
+village was spoiled.
+
+This occasioned a very great noise in the country, and so greatly
+provoked were the people who resided in the other parishes, that they
+absolutely sent old Gaffer Goosecap (a busy fellow in other people's
+concerns) to find out evidence against her. The wiseacre happened to
+come to her to school, when she was walking about with a raven on one
+shoulder, a pigeon on the other, a lark on her hand, and a lamb and a
+dog by her side; which indeed made a droll figure, and so surprised
+the man that he cried out, "A witch! a witch! a witch!"
+
+Upon this she, laughing, answered, "a conjurer! a conjurer! a
+conjurer!" and so they parted; but it did not end thus, for a warrant
+was issued out against Mrs. Margery, and she was carried to a meeting
+of the justices.
+
+At the meeting, one of the justices who knew little of life, and less
+of the law, behaved very idly; and, though nobody was able to prove
+anything against her, asked who she could bring to her character. "Who
+can you bring against my character, sir?" says she. "There are people
+enough who would appear in my defense, were it necessary: but I never
+supposed that any one here could be so weak as to believe there was
+any such thing as a witch. If I am a witch, this is my charm; and"
+(laying a barometer or weather-glass on the table) "it is with this,"
+says she, "that I have taught my neighbor to know the state of the
+weather." All the company laughed; and Sir William Dove, who was on
+the bench, asked her accusers how they could be such fools as to think
+there was any such thing as a witch?
+
+After this, Sir William inveighed against the absurd and foolish
+notions which the country people had imbibed concerning witches and
+witchcraft, and having proved that there was no such thing, but that
+all were the effects of folly and ignorance, he gave the court such an
+account of Mrs. Margery, and her virtue, good sense, and prudent
+behavior, that the gentlemen present were enamored with her, and
+returned her public thanks for the great service she had done the
+country. One gentleman in particular, I mean Sir Charles Jones, had
+conceived such a high opinion of her that he offered her a
+considerable sum to take care of his family, and the education of his
+daughter, which, however, she refused; but this gentleman sending for
+her afterwards, when he had a dangerous fit of illness, she went, and
+behaved so prudently in the family, and so tenderly to him and his
+daughter, that he would not permit her to leave his house, but soon
+after made her proposals of marriage. She was truly sensible of the
+honor he intended her, but, though poor, she would not consent to be
+made a lady till he had effectually provided for his daughter; for she
+told him that power was a dangerous thing to be trusted with, and that
+a good man or woman would never throw themselves into the road of
+temptation.
+
+All things being settled, and the day fixed, the neighbors came in
+crowds to see the wedding; for they were all glad that one who had
+been such a good little girl, and was become such a virtuous and good
+woman, was going to be made a lady; but just as the clergyman had
+opened his book, a gentleman richly dressed ran into the church and
+cried, "Stop! stop!" This greatly alarmed the congregation,
+particularly the intended bride and bridegroom, whom he first accosted
+and desired to speak with them apart. After they had been talking some
+little time, the people were greatly surprised to see Sir Charles
+stand motionless, and his bride cry and faint away in the stranger's
+arms. This seeming grief, however, was only a prelude to a flood of
+joy which immediately succeeded; for you must know, gentle reader,
+that this gentleman, so richly dressed, was that identical little boy,
+whom you before saw in the sailor's habit; in short, it was Mrs.
+Margery's brother, who was just come from sea, where he had, after a
+desperate engagement, taken a rich prize; and hearing, as soon as he
+landed, of his sister's intended wedding, had rode post to see that a
+proper settlement was made on her, which she was now entitled to, as
+he himself was both able and willing to give her an ample fortune.
+They soon returned to the communion table, and were married in tears,
+but they were tears of joy.
+
+
+
+
+VI
+
+THE TRUE USE OF RICHES
+
+
+About this time she heard that Mr. Smith was oppressed by Sir Timothy
+Gripe and his friend Graspall; upon which she, in conjunction with her
+brother, defended him in Westminster Hall, where Mr. Smith gained a
+verdict. As a justice of the peace he was struck off the list, and no
+longer permitted to act in that capacity. A relation of his who had a
+right to the Mouldwell estate, finding that it was possible to get the
+better at law of a rich man, laid claim to it, brought his action, and
+recovered the whole manor of Mouldwell; and being afterwards inclined
+to sell it, he in consideration of the aid Lady Margery had lent him
+during his distress, made her the first offer, and she purchased the
+whole. This mortified Sir Timothy and his friend Graspall, who
+experienced nothing but misfortunes, and was in a few years so
+dispossessed of his ill-gotten wealth, that his family were reduced to
+seek subsistance from the parish, at which those who had felt the
+weight of his iron hand rejoiced; but Lady Margery desired that his
+children might be treated with care and tenderness; "for they" (says
+she) "are noways accountable for the actions of their father." At her
+first coming into power, she took care to gratify her old friends,
+especially Mr. and Mrs. Smith, whose family she made happy.
+
+
+
+
+LIST OF BEST BOOKS OF CLASSIC TALES AND OLD-FASHIONED STORIES
+
+ABBOTT, JACOB _Franconia Stories_
+ABBOTT, JACOB _Jonas Stories_
+ABBOTT, JACOB _Rollo Books_
+ADDISON, STEELE, BUDGELL _Papers of Roger de Coverley_
+AIKIN, JOHN, AND BARBAULD, ANNA LETITIA _Evenings at Home_
+AGUILAR, GRACE _Home Influence_
+AGUILAR, GRACE _The Mother's Recompense_
+ARABIAN NIGHTS
+BARBAULD, MRS. _Juvenile Forget-me-not_
+BARNARD, MRS. CAROLINE _The Parent's Offering_
+BROOKE, HENRY _The Fool of Quality_
+BUNYAN, JOHN _Pilgrim's Progress_
+CERVANTES, MIGUEL _Don Quixote_
+CHAUCER, GEOFFREY _Canterbury Tales_
+DAY, THOMAS _Sandford and Merton_
+DAY, THOMAS _The History of Little Jack_
+DEFOE, DANIEL _Robinson Crusoe_
+EDGEWORTH, MARIA _Parent's Assistant_
+EDGEWORTH, MARIA _Harry and Lucy_
+EDGEWORTH, MARIA _Moral Tales_
+ELIOT, GEORGE _Silas Marner_
+FIELDING, SARAH _The Adventures of David Simple_
+GODWIN, MRS. WILLIAM _The Stories of Old Daniel_
+GOLDSMITH, OLIVER _The Vicar of Wakefield_
+GOODRICH, S.G. _Fagots for the Fireside_
+HOMER _The Iliad_
+HOMER _The Odyssey_
+HOWITT, MARY _Treasury of Tales_
+HUGO, VICTOR _Les Miserables_
+JAMES, G.P.R. _Prince Life_
+LAMB, CHARLES _Mrs. Leicester's School_
+LAMB, CHARLES AND MARY _Tales from Shakespeare_
+LUCAS, E.V. (Ed.) _Old-Fashioned Tales_
+LUCAS, E.V. (Ed.) _Forgotten Tales of Long Ago_
+MARTIN, WILLIAM _Peter Parley's Annual_
+MANT, ALICIA CATHERINE _Tales for Ellen_
+MORE, HANNAH _Coelebs in Search of a Wife_
+PEARSON, MISS _A Few Weeks at Clairmont Castle_
+RASPE, RODOLPH ERIC _The Travels of Baron Munchausen_
+SHERWOOD, MRS. _The Fairchild Family_
+SINCLAIR, KATHERINE _Holiday House_
+SWIFT, JONATHAN _Gulliver's Travels_
+WAKEFIELD, PRISCILLA _Juvenile Anecdotes_
+WYSS, JOHANN RUDOLPH _Swiss Family Robinson_
+
+
+
+***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK YOUNG FOLKS TREASURY, VOLUME 3 (OF
+12)***
+
+
+******* This file should be named 15560.txt or 15560.zip *******
+
+
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+https://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/1/5/5/6/15560
+
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+https://gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH F3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need, is critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at https://www.gutenberg.org/about/contact
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including including checks, online payments and credit card
+donations. To donate, please visit:
+https://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ https://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
diff --git a/15560.zip b/15560.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7748675
--- /dev/null
+++ b/15560.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7937afd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #15560 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/15560)